This is a modern-English version of Captain Cook's Journal During His First Voyage Round the World: Made in H. M. Bark "Endeavour", 1768-71, originally written by Cook, James. It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.

CAPTAIN COOK'S JOURNAL.
FIRST VOYAGE.

PLATE: PORTRAIT OF CAPTAIN JAMES COOK WITH A FACSIMILE OF HIS SIGNATURE.
Collotype, Waterlow & Sons Ltd.

 

CAPTAIN COOK'S JOURNAL
DURING HIS
FIRST VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD
MADE IN
H.M. BARK "ENDEAVOUR"
1768-71
A Literal Transcription of the Original MSS.
WITH
NOTES AND INTRODUCTION
EDITED BY
CAPTAIN W.J.L. WHARTON, R.N., F.R.S.
Hydrographer of the Admiralty.
Illustrated by Maps and Facsimiles.

LONDON
ELLIOT STOCK, 62 PATERNOSTER ROW
1893

43931

DEDICATED BY PERMISSION
TO
ADMIRAL H.R.H. THE DUKE OF EDINBURGH,
K.G., ETC.,
WHOSE DEEP INTEREST IN ALL MATTERS CONNECTED WITH
THE RISE AND PROGRESS OF THE BRITISH NAVY
IS WELL KNOWN TO ALL WHO HAVE HAD
THE PRIVILEGE OF SERVING WITH HIM.

 

PREFACE.

STRANGE it must appear that the account of perhaps the most celebrated and, certainly to the English nation, the most momentous voyage of discovery that has ever taken place--for it practically gave birth to the great Australasian Colonies--has never before been given to the world in the very words of its great leader. It has fallen out in this wise.

STRANGE it might seem that the story of perhaps the most famous and, certainly for the English people, the most significant voyage of discovery ever undertaken—since it essentially led to the establishment of the great Australasian Colonies—has never before been presented to the world in the exact words of its remarkable leader. This has happened in this way.

After the return of the Endeavour it was decided that a full and comprehensive account of the voyage should be compiled. COOK'S JOURNAL dealt with matters from the point of view of the seaman, the explorer, and the head of the expedition, responsible for life, and for its general success. The Journals of Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander looked from the scientific side on all that presented itself to their enthusiastic observation.

After the Endeavour returned, it was decided that a complete and detailed account of the journey should be put together. COOK'S JOURNAL covered things from the perspectives of the sailor, the explorer, and the leader of the expedition, who was responsible for the crew’s safety and the overall success of the mission. The journals of Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander focused on the scientific aspects of everything they enthusiastically observed.

What could be better than to combine these accounts, and make up a complete narrative from them all?

What could be better than combining these accounts to create a complete story from them all?

The result, however, according to our nineteenth-century ideas, was not altogether happy. Dr. Hawkesworth, into whose hands the Journals were put, not only interspersed reflections of his own, but managed to impose his own ponderous style upon many of the extracts from the united Journals; and, moreover, as they are all jumbled together, the whole being put into Cook's mouth, it is impossible to know whether we are reading Cook, Banks, Solander, or Hawkesworth himself.

The result, however, according to our nineteenth-century views, was not entirely positive. Dr. Hawkesworth, who was given the Journals, not only added his own reflections but also imposed his heavy writing style on many of the excerpts from the combined Journals. Furthermore, since everything is mixed together and presented as if it's all coming from Cook, it’s impossible to tell if we’re reading Cook, Banks, Solander, or Hawkesworth himself.

The readers of the day were not, however, critical. Hawkesworth's book,* (* "Hawkesworth's Voyages" 3 volumes quarto 1773.) which undoubtedly contains all the most generally interesting passages of the three writers, gave a clear description of the events of the voyage in a connected manner, and was accepted as sufficient; and in the excitement of devouring the pages which introduced so many new lands and peoples, probably few wished for more, and the Journals were put away as dealt with.

The readers of the time weren’t particularly critical. Hawkesworth's book,* (* "Hawkesworth's Voyages" 3 volumes quarto 1773.) which certainly includes all the most interesting parts from the three authors, provided a clear and connected account of the voyage’s events and was accepted as adequate. In the thrill of immersing themselves in the pages that introduced so many new lands and cultures, it’s likely that few wanted anything more, and the Journals were set aside as completed.

Since that time it has been on several occasions in contemplation to publish Mr. (after Sir Joseph) Banks' Journal; but this has never been accomplished.

Since that time, there have been several occasions where it was considered to publish Mr. (later Sir Joseph) Banks' Journal; however, this has never happened.

Cook's Journal was in triplicate. The Admiralty Orders of the day enjoined that the captain should keep a journal of proceedings, a copy of which was to be forwarded to the Admiralty every six months, or as soon after as possible. In the case of this voyage the ship was two and a half years from England before any opportunity of sending this copy occurred. The ship was the whole of this time in new and savage lands. When Batavia was reached the duplicate of Cook's Journal was sent home, and six months later, when the ship arrived in England, the full Journal of the voyage was deposited at the Admiralty.

Cook's Journal was in triplicate. The daily Admiralty Orders required the captain to keep a journal of events, with a copy to be sent to the Admiralty every six months or as soon as possible after that. In this voyage's case, the ship was two and a half years from England before there was an opportunity to send this copy. During that time, the ship spent the entire duration in new and wild territories. When they reached Batavia, the duplicate of Cook's Journal was sent home, and six months later, when the ship arrived back in England, the complete Journal of the voyage was submitted to the Admiralty.

The Secretary of the Admiralty, Sir Philip Stephens, a personal friend and appreciator of Cook, appears to have appropriated the Batavia duplicate, as we find it in the hands of his descendants, and passing thence by sale, first to Mr. Cosens in 1868, and then in 1890 to Mr. John Corner.

The Secretary of the Admiralty, Sir Philip Stephens, a personal friend and admirer of Cook, seems to have taken the Batavia duplicate, as it has come down through his descendants. It was then sold first to Mr. Cosens in 1868 and later in 1890 to Mr. John Corner.

The other and complete copy is still in possession of the Admiralty, though in some unexplained manner it was absent for some years, and was only recovered by the exertions of Mr. W. Blakeney, R.N.

The other full copy is still held by the Admiralty, although it was mysteriously missing for several years and was only found thanks to the efforts of Mr. W. Blakeney, R.N.

A third copy of the Journal also terminates a few days before reaching Batavia. It is in the possession of Her Majesty the Queen, and from its appearance was kept for, and probably presented to, George III, who took great interest in the voyage.

A third copy of the Journal also ends a few days before arriving in Batavia. It's owned by Her Majesty the Queen, and based on its condition, it was likely kept for, and probably given to, George III, who was very interested in the voyage.

Neither private possessors nor the Admiralty have felt moved to publish this interesting document until Mr. Corner acquired his copy, when, being an enthusiastic admirer of Captain Cook, he determined to do so, and was making preliminary arrangements, when he suddenly died, after a few hours' illness. His son, anxious to carry out his father's wishes, which included the devotion of any proceeds to the restoration of Hinderwell Church--the parish church of Staithes, whence Cook ran away to sea--has completed these arrangements, and the present volume is the result.

Neither private collectors nor the Admiralty have felt compelled to publish this fascinating document until Mr. Corner got his copy. As an enthusiastic admirer of Captain Cook, he decided to publish it and was making preliminary arrangements when he suddenly passed away after a brief illness. His son, eager to fulfill his father's wishes, which included dedicating any proceeds to the restoration of Hinderwell Church—the parish church of Staithes, where Cook ran away to sea—has completed these arrangements, and this volume is the result.

The text is taken from Mr. Corner's copy so far as it goes, paragraphs from the Admiralty copy, which do not appear in the former, being added, with a notation of their source.

The text is taken from Mr. Corner's copy as far as it goes, with added paragraphs from the Admiralty copy that don't appear in the former, along with a note of their source.

The last portion, from October 23rd, 1770, which is only given in the Admiralty copy, is necessarily taken from it.

The final section, dated October 23rd, 1770, which is only found in the Admiralty copy, is understandably sourced from it.

The three copies are, practically, identical, except for the period August 13th to 19th, 1770, during which the wording is often different, though the events are the same.

The three copies are practically identical, except for the period from August 13th to 19th, 1770, during which the wording often differs, though the events are the same.

It is not very difficult to account for this.

It’s not hard to explain this.

The two first-mentioned Journals are in the handwriting of an amanuensis, Mr. Orton, the clerk. No autograph journal is, so far as is known, in existence, but some rough original must have been kept, as both copies bear internal evidence of having been written up after the lapse of an interval after the events described.

The first two journals mentioned were written by a scribe, Mr. Orton, the clerk. As far as we know, no original handwritten journal exists, but there must have been some rough original kept, since both copies show signs of having been written up after some time had passed since the events described.

This is markedly the case in the Australian part of the Journal.

This is especially true in the Australian section of the Journal.

It is known that Botany Bay was at first called by Cook, Stingray Bay, on account of the number of rays caught there; but after Banks had examined his collection, and found all his plants new to science, Cook determined to call it Botany Bay. It is, however, called Botany Bay from the first in the Journals.

It’s known that Botany Bay was initially named Stingray Bay by Cook because of the many rays caught there. However, after Banks looked at his collection and discovered that all his plants were new to science, Cook decided to name it Botany Bay. Still, it has been referred to as Botany Bay from the beginning in the Journals.

The name, "New South Wales," was not bestowed without much consideration, and apparently at one stage New Wales was the appellation fixed upon, for in Mr. Corner's copy it is so called throughout, whereas the Admiralty copy has "New South Wales."

The name "New South Wales" wasn't given without careful thought, and it seems that at one point "New Wales" was actually the name chosen, as Mr. Corner's version refers to it that way throughout, while the Admiralty version uses "New South Wales."

It would therefore seem that about the period of the discrepant accounts Mr. Corner's copy was first made, and that Cook, in the Admiralty copy, which for this part is fuller, revised the wording of his description of this very critical portion of the voyage.

It seems that around the time of the conflicting accounts, Mr. Corner's copy was created first, and that Cook, in the Admiralty copy—which is more detailed for this part—updated the wording of his description of this crucial part of the voyage.

The Queen's Copy has been written with especial care, and by several different hands. It was evidently the last in point of time.

The Queen's Copy has been carefully written by several different authors. It was clearly the most recent version.

In reading COOK'S JOURNAL of his First Voyage it must be remembered that it was not prepared for publication. Though no doubt the fair copies we possess were revised with the care that characterises the man, and which is evidenced by the interlineations and corrections in his own hand with which the pages are dotted, it may be supposed, from the example we have in the published account of his Second Voyage, which was edited by himself, that further alterations and additions would have been made, to make the story more complete, had he contemplated its being printed.

While reading COOK'S JOURNAL from his First Voyage, it's important to note that it wasn't meant for publication. Although the fair copies we have were likely revised with the meticulousness that defines the man, as shown by the notes and corrections in his handwriting scattered throughout the pages, it can be inferred from the published account of his Second Voyage, which he edited himself, that he would have made more alterations and additions to create a more complete story if he had intended for it to be printed.

This does not, however, in any way detract from the interest of a transcript of his record on the spot; and though many circumstances recorded in Hawkesworth, from Banks or others, will not be found, it is probable that an exact copy of the great navigator's own impressions, and the disentanglement of them from the other interpolated matter, will be welcome.

This doesn't, however, take away from the interest of a direct transcript of his record on site; and although many details noted in Hawkesworth, from Banks or others, may not be present, it’s likely that an accurate copy of the great navigator's own insights, separated from the other added content, will be appreciated.

In printing this Journal the only alterations that have been made are the breaking-up into chapters, with modern headings; the addition of punctuation; and in the form of the insertion of the daily record of wind, weather, and position of the ship. These in the original are on the left hand page in log form. To save space they have been placed at the end of every day's transactions.

In publishing this Journal, the only changes that were made are dividing it into chapters with modern titles; adding punctuation; and including the daily records of wind, weather, and the ship's position. In the original, these were on the left-hand page in log format. To save space, they have been moved to the end of each day's entries.

The eccentricities in the spelling have been preserved. A good many of these would seem to be due to Mr. Orton, the transcriber, as Cook's own letters are generally correct in their orthography. The use of the capital letter was usual at the time.

The unusual spellings have been kept. Many of these appear to be from Mr. Orton, the transcriber, since Cook's own letters are usually correct in their spelling. Using capital letters was common at that time.

References will be found to sketches and plans which have not been reproduced.

References will be found to sketches and plans that haven't been reproduced.

Cook's knack of finding names for localities was peculiarly happy. Those who have had to do this, know the difficulty. Wherever he was able to ascertain the native name, he adopts it; but in the many cases where this was impossible, he manages to find a descriptive and distinctive appellation for each point, bay, or island.

Cook had a remarkable talent for naming places. Anyone who has tried it knows how challenging it can be. Whenever he could find out the local name, he used it; but in the many instances where this wasn't possible, he came up with a unique and descriptive name for each spot, bay, or island.

He seems to have kept these names very much to himself, as it is seldom the officers' logs know anything of them; and original plans, still in existence, in many cases bear different names to those finally pitched upon.

He seems to have kept these names mostly to himself, as the officers' logs rarely mention them; and original plans, still around, in many cases have different names than those ultimately chosen.

Cook's names have rarely been altered, and New Zealand and Australian places will probably for all time bear those which he bestowed.

Cook's names have rarely changed, and places in New Zealand and Australia will likely always carry the names he gave them.

In the orthography of his native names he was not so successful. The constant addition of a redundant "o" has altered many native sounds, such as Otaheite for Tahiti, Ohwhyhee for Hawaii; while his spelling generally has been superseded by more simple forms. This is a matter, however, in which great difficulties are found to the present day by Englishmen, whose language presents no certain laws for rendering any given sound into a fixed combination of letters.

In the spelling of his native names, he didn't have much success. The frequent addition of an unnecessary "o" changed many native sounds, like Otaheite for Tahiti and Ohwhyhee for Hawaii; meanwhile, his spelling has generally been replaced by simpler versions. However, this remains a challenge for English speakers today, as the English language has no definite rules for translating any specific sound into a reliable combination of letters.

Cook's language is unvarnished and plain, as a sailor's should be. His incidents, though often related with circumstance, are without exaggeration; indeed if any fault is to be found, it is that he takes occurrences involving much labour and hardship as such matters of course, that it is not easy for the reader, especially if he be a landsman, to realise what they really entail.

Cook's language is straightforward and simple, just as a sailor's should be. His stories, though often told with context, are not exaggerated; in fact, if there is any criticism to be made, it's that he presents events that involve a lot of work and struggle as if they're normal, making it hard for the reader, especially if they're someone from the land, to grasp what they truly involve.

Cook was assiduous in obtaining observations to ascertain the Variation of the compass--i.e., the difference between the direction shown by the magnetic needle and the true north. He is constantly puzzled by the discrepancies in these observations made at short intervals. These arose from the different positions of the ship's head, whereby the iron within a certain distance of the compass is placed in different positions as regards the needle working the compass card, the result being that the needle is attracted from its correct direction in varying degree. This is known as the Deviation of the compass. The cause of this, and of the laws which govern it, were only discovered by Captain Flinders in 1805. Happily for the navigators of those days, little iron entered into the construction of ships, and the amount of the Deviation was not large, though enough to cause continual disquiet and wonderment.

Cook was diligent in taking measurements to determine the variation of the compass — that is, the difference between the direction indicated by the magnetic needle and true north. He was constantly confused by the inconsistencies in these measurements taken at short intervals. These discrepancies came from the different positions of the ship's head, which meant that the iron within a certain distance of the compass was positioned differently relative to the needle moving the compass card. As a result, the needle was pulled away from its accurate direction by varying degrees. This is known as the deviation of the compass. The cause of this and the rules governing it were only discovered by Captain Flinders in 1805. Fortunately for the navigators of that time, ships contained very little iron, and the amount of deviation wasn't significant, though it was enough to cause ongoing concern and curiosity.

Cook's longitudes in this voyage are all given as west of Greenwich, not divided into east and west, as is usual at this day. The latter system again has only been adopted universally since his time.

Cook's longitudes in this voyage are all noted as west of Greenwich, without dividing them into east and west like we typically do today. That latter system has only been widely adopted after his time.

Though Cook himself gives, at the beginning of the Journal, a note of the method of reckoning days adopted, it may not be amiss to give further explanation here.

Though Cook himself provides a note on the method of counting days at the start of the Journal, it might be helpful to explain it further here.

It was the usual custom on board ships to keep what was known as Ship time--i.e., the day began at noon BEFORE the civil reckoning, in which the day commences at midnight. Thus, while January 1st, as ordinarily reckoned, is from midnight to midnight, in ship time it began at noon on December 31st and ended at noon January 1st, this period being called January 1st. Hence the peculiarity all through the Journal of the p.m. coming before the a.m. It results that any events recorded as occurring in the p.m. of January 1st in the log, would, if translated into the ordinary system, be given as happening in the p.m. of December 31st; while occurrences in the a.m. of January 1st would be equally in the a.m. of January 1st in both systems.

It was the usual practice on ships to follow what was called Ship time—meaning the day started at noon before the regular civil time, where the day begins at midnight. So, while January 1st, as typically counted, spans from midnight to midnight, in ship time, it starts at noon on December 31st and ends at noon on January 1st, this timeframe being referred to as January 1st. This explains the uniqueness in the Journal where the p.m. is noted before the a.m. As a result, any events logged as happening in the p.m. of January 1st would, if translated to the regular system, actually occur in the p.m. of December 31st; while events in the a.m. of January 1st would be the same in both systems.

This puzzling mode of keeping the day at sea continued to a late period, and was common to seamen of all nations.

This strange way of keeping track of time at sea lasted for a long time and was used by sailors from all over the world.

The astronomical day, again, begins at noon AFTER the midnight at which the civil day begins, and hence is a whole day later than the ship's day. This does not enter into Cook's Journal, but one of the logs of the Endeavour, extant, that of Mr. Green the astronomer, was kept in this time, and the events of say Thursday, June 24th, of Cook's Journal, are therein given as happening on Wednesday, June 23rd. These differences of reckoning have been a fertile source of confusion in dates in many voyages.

The astronomical day starts at noon after the midnight when the civil day begins, making it a full day later than the ship's day. This detail isn't included in Cook's Journal, but one remaining log from the Endeavour, kept by Mr. Green the astronomer, recorded events during this period. For instance, the events noted on Thursday, June 24th, in Cook's Journal are listed as happening on Wednesday, June 23rd, in Green's log. These differences in timekeeping have caused a lot of confusion regarding dates in many voyages.

Besides Cook's Journals there are other Journals and Logs of the voyage extant. Perhaps it may be necessary to state that a Log is the official document in which the progress of the ship from hour to hour is recorded, with such official notes as the alteration in sail carried, expenditure of provisions and stores, etc. A Journal contains this information in a condensed form, with such observations as the officer keeping it may feel inclined to insert.

Besides Cook's Journals, there are other Journals and Logs of the voyage that still exist. It may be helpful to clarify that a Log is the official document where the ship's progress is recorded hour by hour, along with official notes like changes in the sails, the use of provisions and supplies, etc. A Journal presents this information in a shortened format, including any observations the officer keeping it chooses to add.

The ship's Log Book of the Endeavour is in the British Museum. Mr. R.M. Hudson of Sunderland possesses Cook's own log, not autograph however, presented by Cook to Sir Hugh Palliser, the ancestor of his wife.

The ship's Log Book of the Endeavour is in the British Museum. Mr. R.M. Hudson of Sunderland has Cook's personal log, though it's not an autograph, which Cook gave to Sir Hugh Palliser, the ancestor of his wife.

The Journals of all the officers of the Endeavour are preserved at the Public Record Office. There is, however, nothing to be got out of them, as they are mainly copies one of the other, founded on the ship's log.

The journals of all the officers of the Endeavour are kept at the Public Record Office. However, there's nothing to gain from them since they mostly duplicate each other, based on the ship's log.

The portion of Mr. Molineux's, the Master's, Log that exists (at the Admiralty) is a most beautifully kept and written document, enriched with charts and sketches that attest the accuracy of Cook's remark, that he was a "young man of good parts."

The part of Mr. Molineux's, the Master's, Log that is available (at the Admiralty) is a beautifully maintained and well-written document, filled with charts and sketches that prove Cook's comment that he was a "young man of good parts."

The log kept by Mr. Green, however, does contain a few original remarks, some of which have been made use of. This book contains a mass of astronomical observations, and witnesses to the zeal of this gentleman in his especial duty.

The log maintained by Mr. Green does include some original comments, some of which have been utilized. This book is filled with astronomical observations and showcases the dedication of this gentleman in his specific role.

He records in one place, when far away from land, his disgust that the officers were unwilling to aid him in lunar observations. No doubt they saw no particular use in them when there was no coast to fix; but there is ample proof that he received every aid when Cook thought it necessary.

He notes in one spot, when far from land, his frustration that the officers were unwilling to help him with lunar observations. They probably didn’t see any real value in them when there was no coast to establish a position; however, there's plenty of evidence that he got all the support he needed when Cook deemed it important.

Sufficient charts have been placed in this book to enable the reader to follow the more interesting parts of the voyage; some being reproductions of Cook's own charts, others modern publications. In the case of the coast of East Australia, the coast-line as laid down by Cook, and as now known, are given side by side for comparison.

Sufficient charts have been included in this book to help the reader follow the more interesting parts of the voyage; some are reproductions of Cook's original charts, while others are more recent publications. For the coast of East Australia, Cook's mapped coastline is presented alongside the current understanding for comparison.

It must be understood, that although this book is styled CAPTAIN COOK'S JOURNAL, he was on this voyage only a Lieutenant in Command, and therefore only Captain by courtesy.

It should be noted that although this book is titled CAPTAIN COOK'S JOURNAL, he was actually a Lieutenant in Command during this voyage, and thus only a Captain by courtesy.

W.J.L. WHARTON.

W.J.L. Wharton.

FLORYS, WIMBLEDON PARK,

FLORYS, WIMBLEDON PARK,

April 7th, 1893.

April 7, 1893.

 

CONTENTS.

ILLUSTRATIONS.


SKETCH OF CAPTAIN COOK'S LIFE.

CAPTAIN COOK'S life, or the account of so much of it as is recoverable, has been so often recounted that there is no occasion to insert more in this publication than is necessary as a reference to the reader, to enable him to realise the career and character of the man.

CAPTAIN COOK'S life, or the parts of it that we can still find, has been told so many times that there's no need to include more in this publication than what's necessary for the reader to understand the journey and character of the man.

Cook's first biographer, Andrew Kippis, wrote in 1788, and his work has recently been republished.* (* "A Narrative of the Voyage round the World, performed by Captain James Cook, with an Account of His Life" by A. Kippis, D.D., F.R.S. London: Bickers & Son 1889.)

Cook's first biographer, Andrew Kippis, wrote in 1788, and his work has recently been republished.* (* "A Narrative of the Voyage round the World, performed by Captain James Cook, with an Account of His Life" by A. Kippis, D.D., F.R.S. London: Bickers & Son 1889.)

The latest and best life is by Walter Besant,* (* "Captain Cook" by Walter Besant: "English Men of Action" London, Macmillan & Co. 1890.) whose graceful pen has given us a fascinating, interesting, and, as far as is possible, complete picture of this great Englishman. Many details of Cook's private life are lost, but enough has been collected by Mr. Besant to place our hero vividly before us, and a perusal of his work is strongly recommended.

The latest and best life is by Walter Besant,* (* "Captain Cook" by Walter Besant: "English Men of Action" London, Macmillan & Co. 1890.) whose elegant writing has provided us with a captivating, engaging, and as complete as possible portrait of this great Englishman. While many aspects of Cook's personal life are missing, Mr. Besant has gathered enough information to vividly present our hero, and reading his work is highly recommended.

Many things in the following sketch are taken from Mr. Besant, to whom I wish to tender my acknowledgments.

Many elements in the following sketch are borrowed from Mr. Besant, and I would like to express my gratitude to him.

James Cook rose from nearly the lowest ranks. The second son of James Cook, a Yorkshire labourer, and Grace his wife, he was born on the edge of the Cleveland Hills on February 27th, 1728, in the little village of Marton, which lies about four miles south-south-east of Middlesborough, and five miles west of the well-known hill and landmark, Roseberry Topping. Eight years later his father removed to Great Ayton, which lies close under Roseberry Topping.

James Cook started from almost the lowest position. The second son of James Cook, a laborer from Yorkshire, and his wife Grace, he was born on February 27, 1728, on the outskirts of the Cleveland Hills in the small village of Marton, which is about four miles south-southeast of Middlesborough and five miles west of the famous hill and landmark, Roseberry Topping. Eight years later, his father moved the family to Great Ayton, located right under Roseberry Topping.

At the age of thirteen Cook, who, it is recorded, had had some elementary schooling both at Marton and Great Ayton, was apprenticed to one Sanderson, a draper and grocer of Staithes, a fishing village on the coast, about fourteen miles from Ayton and nine north-west of Whitby.

At the age of thirteen, Cook, who is noted to have had some basic schooling at both Marton and Great Ayton, became an apprentice to a man named Sanderson, a draper and grocer in Staithes, a fishing village on the coast, about fourteen miles from Ayton and nine miles northwest of Whitby.

A year later Cook went, or ran away, to sea, shipping at Whitby on board the Freelove, a collier belonging to the brothers Walker.

A year later, Cook went, or ran away, to sea, getting a job in Whitby on the Freelove, a coal ship owned by the Walker brothers.

In this hard school Cook learnt his sailor duties. No better training could have been found for his future responsibilities. Here he learnt to endure the utmost rigours of the sea. Constant fighting with North Sea gales, bad food, and cramped accommodation, taught him to regard with the indifference that afterwards distinguished him, all the hardships that he had to encounter, and led him to endure and persevere where others, less determined or more easily daunted by difficulties, would have hurried on, and left their work incomplete.

In this tough environment, Cook learned his duties as a sailor. There was no better training for his future responsibilities. Here, he learned to withstand the harsh realities of the sea. Constant battles with North Sea storms, poor food, and tight living conditions taught him to view the challenges he faced with the indifference that later defined him. This helped him to endure and keep going when others, less determined or more easily discouraged by obstacles, would have rushed off and left their tasks unfinished.

All details of Cook's life during his thirteen years in the merchant service are lost: what voyages he made, how he fared, whether he advanced in general knowledge, all is gone. The only fact known is that in May 1755, when Cook was twenty-seven years of age, and mate of a vessel of Messrs. Walker, then in the Thames, he, to avoid the press, then active on account of the outbreak of the war with France, volunteered on board H.M.S. Eagle, of 60 guns, as an able seaman.

All details of Cook's life during his thirteen years in the merchant service are gone: what journeys he took, how he managed, whether he gained more knowledge—it's all lost. The only known fact is that in May 1755, when Cook was twenty-seven years old and the mate of a ship owned by Messrs. Walker, which was then in the Thames, he volunteered to join H.M.S. Eagle, a 60-gun ship, as an able seaman to avoid being pressed into service, which was common due to the outbreak of war with France.

Captain Hugh Palliser, who succeeded to the command of this ship in October, was certainly Cook's warmest patron, and it would appear that Cook did work superior to that of an able seaman in the Eagle. Be that as it may, all that is absolutely known is that that ship took her share of the fighting at the taking of Louisbourg and elsewhere on the North American and West Indian Station, and returned to England in 1759.

Captain Hugh Palliser, who took over the command of this ship in October, was definitely Cook's biggest supporter, and it seems that Cook contributed more than just his skills as a seaman on the Eagle. Regardless, all that is definitely known is that that ship was involved in the fighting during the capture of Louisbourg and other battles on the North American and West Indian Station, and it returned to England in 1759.

By Palliser's interest Cook was now appointed master of the Mercury. It is therefore evident that his qualifications as a navigator recommended themselves to Palliser.

By Palliser's interest, Cook was now appointed captain of the Mercury. It's clear that his skills as a navigator impressed Palliser.

The Mercury went to North America, and here Cook did his first good service recorded, namely, taking soundings in the St. Lawrence, to enable the fleet then attacking Quebec to take up safe positions in covering the army under Wolfe. This he accomplished with great skill, under many difficulties, in the face of the enemy, much of it being done at night. He was immediately employed in making a survey of the intricate channels of the river below Quebec, and for many years his chart was the guide for navigation. Cook was indeed a born surveyor. Before his day charts were of the crudest description, and he must have somehow acquired a considerable knowledge of trigonometry, and possessed an intuitive faculty for practically applying it, to enable him to originate, as it may truly be said he did, the art of modern marine surveying.

The Mercury went to North America, and here Cook completed his first significant task, which was taking soundings in the St. Lawrence River to help the fleet attacking Quebec secure safe positions to support Wolfe's army. He did this skillfully, overcoming many challenges and often working at night in view of the enemy. He was soon tasked with surveying the complex channels of the river below Quebec, and for many years, his chart was the standard for navigation. Cook was truly a natural surveyor. Before his time, charts were very basic, and he must have gained a substantial understanding of trigonometry, as well as an innate ability to apply it practically, allowing him to pioneer what we now call modern marine surveying.

The expedition to Quebec concluded, Cook was appointed master of the Northumberland, bearing Admiral Lord Colville's flag, and during that ship's winter at Halifax he applied himself to further study of mathematics and astronomy.

The trip to Quebec wrapped up, and Cook was named master of the Northumberland, flying Admiral Lord Colville's flag. While the ship spent the winter in Halifax, he focused on studying mathematics and astronomy more deeply.

In 1762, the Northumberland being at Newfoundland during the capture of that island from the French, Cook again was employed in surveys. This attracted the attention of Captain Graves, the Governor, who conceived a high opinion of his abilities in this respect.

In 1762, while the Northumberland was in Newfoundland during the capture of the island from the French, Cook was once again involved in surveys. This caught the attention of Captain Graves, the Governor, who came to hold a high opinion of his skills in this area.

In the latter part of 1762 Cook returned to England and married Elizabeth Batts, daughter of a man in business at Wapping; but a few months afterwards he was called upon by Captain Graves to go again to Newfoundland to make marine surveys.

In late 1762, Cook returned to England and married Elizabeth Batts, the daughter of a businessman from Wapping. However, just a few months later, he was asked by Captain Graves to return to Newfoundland to conduct marine surveys.

In this important work he was engaged until 1767, Captain Palliser, who succeeded Captain Graves as Governor, being only too glad to avail himself of Cook's services.

In this important work, he was involved until 1767, with Captain Palliser, who replaced Captain Graves as Governor, more than happy to take advantage of Cook's skills.

The charts he made during these years in the schooner Grenville were admirable. The best proof of their excellence is that they are not yet wholly superseded by the more detailed surveys of modern times. Like all first surveys of a practically unknown shore, and especially when that shore abounds in rocks and shoals, and is much indented with bays and creeks, they are imperfect, in the sense of having many omissions; but when the amount of the ground covered, and the impediments of fogs and bad weather on that coast is considered, and that Cook had at the most only one assistant, their accuracy is truly astonishing. The originals of these surveys form part of the most precious possessions of the Hydrographic Office of the Admiralty.

The charts he created during his time on the schooner Grenville were impressive. The best evidence of their quality is that they haven’t been completely replaced by the more detailed surveys of today. Like all initial surveys of a largely unknown coastline, especially one filled with rocks, shallow waters, and many bays and creeks, they have their flaws, mainly due to numerous omissions. However, considering the vast area covered, the challenges posed by fog and bad weather along that coast, and the fact that Cook had only one assistant at most, their accuracy is truly remarkable. The original surveys are a key part of the Hydrographic Office of the Admiralty's most valuable assets.

We now approach the crowning achievements of Cook's life.

We now come to the greatest accomplishments of Cook's life.

After many years' neglect the exploration of the Pacific was awaking interest. This great ocean, which very few, even to this day, realise occupies nearly one half of the surface of the globe, had been, since the first voyage of Magellan, crossed by many a vessel.

After many years of being overlooked, the exploration of the Pacific was gaining interest. This vast ocean, which very few people even today recognize takes up almost half of the Earth's surface, has been crossed by many ships since Magellan's first voyage.

Notwithstanding, very little was known of the islands occupying its central portion.

Not much was known about the islands in the middle part.

For this there were two reasons. First, the comparatively small area covered by islands; secondly, the fact that nearly all who traversed it had followed Magellan's track, or, if they started, as many did, from Central America, they made straight for Magellan's discovery, the Ladrone Islands. For this, again, there was a reason.

For this, there were two reasons. First, the relatively small area covered by islands; second, the fact that almost everyone who traveled through it had followed Magellan's route, or, if they started, as many did, from Central America, they headed directly for Magellan's discovery, the Ladrone Islands. For this, there was also a reason.

Few sailed for the purpose of exploration pure and simple; and even those who started with that view found, when embarked on that vast expanse, that prudence dictated that they should have a moderate certainty of, by a certain time, falling in with a place of sure refreshment. The provisions they carried were bad at starting, and by the time they had fought their way through the Straits of Magellan were already worse; water was limited, and would not hold out more than a given number of days. Every voyage that is pursued tells the same story--short of water, and eagerly looking out for an opportunity of replenishing it. The winds were found to blow in fixed directions, and each voyager was fearful of deviating from the track on which it was known they would be fair, for fear of delays. And ever present in each captain's mind was the dread of the terrible scourge, scurvy. Every expedition suffered from it. Each hoped they would be exempt, and each in turn was reduced to impotence from its effects.

Few set sail simply for the sake of exploration; even those who intended to do so realized, once they were on that vast ocean, that they needed to be reasonably sure of finding a reliable source of fresh supplies by a certain time. The provisions they had were poor from the start, and by the time they navigated through the Straits of Magellan, they were even worse; water was scarce and wouldn’t last more than a few days. Every journey tells the same tale—running low on water, anxiously searching for a chance to refill it. The winds blew in consistent directions, and each traveler was wary of straying from the known route for fear of delays. And always looming in each captain's thoughts was the fear of the dreadful disease, scurvy. Every expedition battled it. Each hoped to escape its grasp, but in the end, each was left powerless by its effects.

It was the great consideration for every leader of a protracted expedition, How can I obviate this paralyzing influence? And one after another had to confess his failure.

It was a major concern for every leader of a long expedition: How can I get past this disabling problem? And one by one, they had to admit their defeat.

It is yearly becoming more difficult for us to realise these obstacles.

It’s becoming harder for us to recognize these obstacles each year.

The prevailing winds and currents in each part of the ocean are well known to us: the exact distance and bearing from one point to another are laid down in the chart; steam bridges over calm areas, and in many cases conducts us on our entire journey at a speed but little inferior to that of land travelling by railroad; modern science preserves fresh and palatable food for an indefinite period; and, in a word, all the difficulties and most of the dangers of long voyages have disappeared.

The dominant winds and currents in every part of the ocean are well understood: the precise distance and direction from one point to another are detailed in the map; steamships cross calm waters, and often take us through our entire journey at a speed close to that of trains on land; modern science keeps food fresh and tasty for a long time; and, in short, all the challenges and most of the risks of long trips have vanished.

Take one element alone in long voyages--the time required. The average progress of a ship in the eighteenth century was not more than fifty miles a day. Nowadays we may expect as much as four hundred miles in a full powered steamer, and not less than one hundred and fifty in a well-fitted sailing ship.

Take one aspect of long journeys—time. The average distance a ship traveled in the eighteenth century was about fifty miles a day. Today, we can expect around four hundred miles on a fully powered steamer, and no less than one hundred and fifty with a well-equipped sailing ship.

But navigation, and more especially the navigation of the unknown Pacific, was very different in Cook's days, when all the obstacles above mentioned impeded the explorers, and impelled them to follow a common track.

But navigation, especially navigating the uncharted Pacific, was very different in Cook's time, when all the obstacles mentioned earlier hindered the explorers and pushed them to stick to a common route.

There were a few who had deviated from the common track.

There were a few who had strayed from the usual path.

The Spaniards, Mendana, Quiros, Torres, in the latter part of the sixteenth century, starting first from their colonies in Peru, had ventured along the central line of the Pacific, discovering the Marquesas, certain small coral islands, the Northern New Hebrides, and the Solomon Islands; but their voyages, mainly for fear of Drake and his successors, were kept so secret that no one quite knew where these islands lay.

The Spaniards Mendana, Quiros, and Torres, in the late sixteenth century, originally set out from their colonies in Peru and traveled along the central Pacific. They discovered the Marquesas, some small coral islands, the Northern New Hebrides, and the Solomon Islands. However, their journeys were kept so secret, mainly out of fear of Drake and his followers, that no one really knew the locations of these islands.

Abel Tasman, in 1642, coming across the Indian Ocean from the westward, had touched at Tasmania, or, as he called it, Van Diemen's Land, had skirted the western coast of the north island of New Zealand without landing, and had stretched away to the north-east, and found the Tonga Group.

Abel Tasman, in 1642, crossing the Indian Ocean from the west, had arrived at Tasmania, which he named Van Diemen's Land. He had gone along the western coast of the North Island of New Zealand without stopping and then headed northeast, where he discovered the Tonga Group.

The English Buccaneers were not among these discoverers; Dampier, Woods Rogers, and others, all went from Acapulco to the Ladrones, looking out for the valuable Spanish galleons from Manila, and they added little or nothing to the knowledge of the Pacific and what it contained.

The English Buccaneers weren't part of these explorers; Dampier, Woods Rogers, and others all sailed from Acapulco to the Ladrones, trying to spot the valuable Spanish galleons from Manila, and they contributed very little to understanding the Pacific and what was in it.

It was not therefore strange that the imagination of geographers ran riot amongst the great unknown areas. They were impressed, as they looked at the globes of the day, with the fact that, while the northern hemisphere contained much land, the southern showed either water or blank spaces; and starting with the ill-founded idea that the solid land in either hemisphere should balance, they conceived that there must be a great unknown continent in the southern part of the Pacific to make up the deficiency. This was generally designated Terra Australis Incognita, and many is the ancient chart that shows it, sketched with a free and uncontrolled hand, around the South Pole. It was held by many that Tasman had touched it in New Zealand; that Quiros had seen it near his island of Encarnacion, and again at Espiritu Santo (New Hebrides), but no one had been to see.

It wasn't surprising that geographers' imaginations ran wild about the vast unknown areas. They noted, when looking at the globes of their time, that while the northern hemisphere had plenty of land, the southern hemisphere mostly showed either water or blank spots; and starting with the misguided idea that the land in both hemispheres should be balanced, they assumed there had to be a massive undiscovered continent in the southern Pacific to cover the gap. This was commonly referred to as Terra Australis Incognita, and many ancient maps depict it, drawn with a loose and uninhibited style, around the South Pole. Many believed that Tasman had encountered it near New Zealand; that Quiros had seen it close to his island of Encarnacion, and again at Espiritu Santo (New Hebrides), but no one had actually gone to check it out.

In George III's reign the desire to know more of this unknown ocean arose in England. The king himself took great interest in it, and for the first time since Queen Elizabeth's age, when Davis, Frobisher, Drake, Narborough, and others, had gone on voyages of discovery, the pursuit was renewed.

During George III's reign, the curiosity about this unknown ocean grew in England. The king himself was very interested in it, and for the first time since Queen Elizabeth's era, when explorers like Davis, Frobisher, Drake, Narborough, and others embarked on journeys of discovery, the quest was reignited.

In 1764 the Dolphin and Tamor, under the command of Commodore Byron and Captain Mouat, sailed on a voyage round the world. They spent some time, as ordered, in exploring the Falkland Islands, and, after a two months' passage through Magellan Strait, they stood across the Pacific. They, however, also followed near the well-beaten track, and passing north of the Paumotus, of which they sighted a few small islands, they too made for the Ladrones. As usual, they suffered much from scurvy, and the one idea was to get to a known place to recover. Byron returned in May 1766, having added but little to the knowledge of the Pacific, and the Dolphin was again sent in the August of the same year, with the Swallow, under the command of Captains Wallis and Carteret, on a similar voyage.

In 1764, the Dolphin and Tamor, led by Commodore Byron and Captain Mouat, set out on a journey around the world. They spent some time, as instructed, exploring the Falkland Islands and, after two months of navigating through the Magellan Strait, headed across the Pacific. They followed the usual route, passing just north of the Paumotus, where they spotted a few small islands, and made their way to the Ladrones. As always, they suffered greatly from scurvy, and their main goal was to reach a familiar location to recover. Byron returned in May 1766, having contributed little to Pacific knowledge, and the Dolphin was sent out again in August of the same year, this time with the Swallow, under the command of Captains Wallis and Carteret, on a similar journey.

They did somewhat better. After the usual struggle through the long and narrow Strait of Magellan, against the strong and contrary winds that continually blow, and which occupied four months, they got into the Pacific.

They did a little better. After the usual struggle through the long and narrow Strait of Magellan, against the strong and opposing winds that blow constantly, which took four months, they finally entered the Pacific.

As they passed out they separated, the Dolphin outsailing the Swallow, and a dispassionate reader cannot well escape the conclusion that the senior officers unnecessarily parted company.

As they drifted apart, the Dolphin sped ahead of the Swallow, and a neutral reader can hardly avoid the conclusion that the senior officers mistakenly decided to separate.

The Dolphin kept a little south of the usual route, fell in with some of the Paumotu Group, and finally discovered Tahiti, where she anchored at Royal Bay, after grounding on a reef at its entrance, with her people, as usual, decimated by scurvy. They were almost immediately attacked by the natives, who, however, received such a reception that they speedily made friends, and fast friends too. The remainder of the month of the Dolphin stay was marked with the most friendly intercourse, and she sailed with a high opinion of Tahiti and the Tahitians; the Queen, Cook's Obereia, being especially well disposed to them. Their communication with the natives must, however, have been limited, as they remained too short a time to learn the language, and we gather little of the manners and customs from the account of the voyage.

The Dolphin took a slightly different route than usual, encountered some of the Paumotu Group, and eventually found Tahiti, where it anchored in Royal Bay after running aground on a reef at the entrance, with its crew, as usual, suffering from scurvy. They were quickly attacked by the locals, but after a warm reception, they soon became friends, and good friends at that. The rest of the month the Dolphin stayed was filled with friendly interactions, and the crew left with a positive impression of Tahiti and its people; the Queen, Cook's Obereia, was particularly friendly towards them. However, their communication with the natives must have been limited, as they spent too little time there to learn the language, and we get little insight into the local customs and manners from the voyage's account.

After sailing from Tahiti we hear the same tale--sickness, want of water, doubt of what was before them. After sailing by several small islands, and an attempt to water at one, course was steered as before for the Ladrones. Let Wallis tell his own story. He says:--

After leaving Tahiti, we keep hearing the same story—sickness, lack of water, uncertainty about what lies ahead. After passing by several small islands and trying to get water from one, we set our course again for the Ladrones. Let Wallis share his own experience. He says:--

"I considered that watering here would be tedious and attended with great fatigue; that it was now the depth of winter in the southern hemisphere; that the ship was leaky, that the rudder shook in the stern very much, and that what other damage she might have received in her bottom could not be known. That for these reasons she was very unfit for the bad weather which she would certainly meet with, either in going round Cape Horn or through the Streight of Magellan; that if she should get safely through the streight or round the Cape, it would be absolutely necessary to refresh in some port; but in that case no port would be in her reach. I therefore determined to make the best of my way to Tinian, Batavia, and so to Europe by the Cape of Good Hope.

I figured that watering here would be a hassle and really tiring; that it was the middle of winter in the southern hemisphere; that the ship had leaks, the rudder was shaking a lot at the back, and any other damage to the hull was unknown. For these reasons, she was really unfit for the bad weather she would definitely face, whether going around Cape Horn or through the Strait of Magellan; that if she somehow made it through the strait or around the Cape, it would be essential to restock in some port, but in that case, no port would be within reach. So, I decided to head straight to Tinian, Batavia, and then on to Europe via the Cape of Good Hope.

"By this rout, as far as we could judge, we should sooner be at home; and if the ship should prove not to be in a condition to make the whole voyage, we should still save our lives, as from this place to Batavia we should probably have a calm sea, and be not far from a port."

"By this route, as far as we could tell, we would reach home sooner; and if the ship turned out not to be capable of completing the entire journey, we could still save ourselves, since from this point to Batavia we would likely have calm seas and wouldn't be far from a port."

These are scarcely the sentiments of a bold explorer, and we shall look in vain for any similar ideas on the part of Cook. Here was a ship just a year from England, just come from a convenient and friendly island, where every refreshment and opportunity for refit were to be found, and the only thought is how to get home again!

These aren’t really the thoughts of a brave explorer, and we won’t find any similar ideas from Cook. Here was a ship just a year out from England, just back from a nearby friendly island, where all the supplies and chances to repair the ship were available, and the only concern is how to get back home!

It was the vastly different conduct of Cook's voyages; the determination that nothing should stop the main object of the expedition; his resource in every difficulty and danger; that caused, and rightly caused, him to be hailed as a born leader of such expeditions.

It was the vastly different way Cook conducted his voyages; the determination that nothing would stand in the way of the main goal of the expedition; his resourcefulness in every difficulty and danger; that led to him being rightfully recognized as a natural leader of such expeditions.

Wallis followed nearly on Byron's track: went from the Ladrones, through the China Sea, to Batavia, and so home, arriving in May 1768.

Wallis closely followed Byron's route: traveled from the Ladrones, through the China Sea, to Batavia, and then home, arriving in May 1768.

The Swallow, under Captain Carteret, was navigated in a different spirit. She was badly fitted out for such a voyage, had not even a forge, and all the articles for trade were on board the Dolphin. But Carteret was not easily daunted. He might, under the circumstances, when he found himself alone, have abandoned the voyage; but he boldly went forward. Passing from the Strait of Magellan, he touched at Juan Fernandez, and steering somewhat south of Wallis's line, he passed south of Tahiti, discovering Pitcairn's Island on his way, and some of the islands south of the Paumotus.

The Swallow, captained by Carteret, was navigated with a different attitude. She was poorly equipped for the journey, lacking even a forge, and all the trade goods were on the Dolphin. But Carteret wasn't easily discouraged. Given the situation, he could have chosen to abandon the voyage when he found himself alone, but he confidently pressed on. After leaving the Strait of Magellan, he stopped at Juan Fernandez, and while steering slightly south of Wallis's line, he passed south of Tahiti, discovering Pitcairn's Island along the way, as well as some of the islands south of the Paumotus.

By this time his people were severely afflicted with scurvy, and his ship in a bad state; but Carteret only thought of getting to some place of refreshment, from which he might afterwards pass on his voyage towards the south, in the hope of falling in with the great southern Continent.

By this point, his crew was really suffering from scurvy, and his ship was in rough shape; but Carteret was only focused on reaching a place where they could replenish their supplies, from which he could later continue his journey south, hoping to encounter the great southern continent.

In this he was not fortunate. Missing all other islands, he fell across the Santa Cruz Group, and hoping that he had found what he wanted, he anchored and tried to water. The party were, however, attacked by the natives, and several, including the master, were wounded and died by poisoned arrows. All hope of a quiet refit was over, and his ship's company being in a wretched condition, no forge or tools on board to enable him to effect his many repairs, Carteret, who was himself very ill, was obliged to give up all intention of exploration to the southward. He got enough water to last him, and sailed on toward the Solomon Islands. These he also just missed, but fell in with New Britain, and passing between it and New Ireland, demonstrated for the first time that these two large islands were not one, as had been supposed. He here managed to do something to repair his leaky vessel, heeling and caulking her, but got little but fruit for his scurvy-stricken crew. He was attacked by the fierce islanders, and was altogether unable to do as much as he evidently earnestly desired towards examining the islands.

In this, he was not lucky. Missing all other islands, he came across the Santa Cruz Group and, hoping he had found what he was looking for, he anchored and tried to get fresh water. However, the crew was attacked by the natives, and several, including the captain, were wounded and died from poisoned arrows. All hope of a peaceful repair was gone, and with his crew in terrible condition, lacking any forge or tools to make the necessary repairs, Carteret, who was also very ill, had to abandon any plans for exploration to the south. He managed to get enough water to last and set sail towards the Solomon Islands. He missed those as well but encountered New Britain, and by passing between it and New Ireland, he confirmed for the first time that these two large islands were not one, as previously believed. Here, he was able to do some repairs on his leaky ship, heeling and caulking it, but could only provide his scurvy-stricken crew with fruit. He was attacked by the fierce islanders and was completely unable to do as much as he clearly wanted to in examining the islands.

Thence they struggled on by Mindanao to Makassar in Celebes, delayed by contrary winds, disappointed of refreshments at every place they tried, and losing men from scurvy. At Makassar they met with but an inhospitable reception from the Dutch, who refused to permit them to receive refreshments there, and after waiting at Bonthain, a place in Celebes, several months, for the monsoon to change, they at last arrived at Batavia, the only port in the Dutch Indies really open to ships, in June 1768. Thence, after heaving down and a thorough repair, they reached home, via the Cape, on March 20th, 1769.

Then they struggled on from Mindanao to Makassar in Celebes, delayed by unfavorable winds, let down by the lack of food at every stop they made, and losing men to scurvy. At Makassar, they were met with a cold reception from the Dutch, who refused to let them get supplies there. After waiting several months at Bonthain, a location in Celebes, for the monsoon to change, they finally arrived at Batavia, the only truly open port in the Dutch Indies, in June 1768. From there, after unloading and making thorough repairs, they headed home via the Cape, arriving on March 20th, 1769.

Of all the voyages before Cook's, Carteret's showed most determination and true spirit of enterprise; and had his ship been better supplied, and more suited to the exigencies of such a long cruise, he would, but for one thing, have accomplished far more. This was the fatal disease, which no captain had as yet succeeded in warding off, and which hampered and defeated the efforts of the most enthusiastic. No man could go beyond a certain point in disregarding the health of his crew.

Of all the journeys before Cook's, Carteret's displayed the most determination and true spirit of adventure; if his ship had been better stocked and more equipped for such a lengthy voyage, he would have achieved much more, except for one thing. This was the deadly illness that no captain had managed to prevent yet, which hindered and undermined the efforts of even the most passionate. No one could push beyond a certain limit when it came to the health of their crew.

These, then, were the kind of voyages, with their scanty fruits, to which the English people were getting accustomed, and they were not such as to encourage repetition.

These were the kinds of voyages, with their meager results, that the English people were getting used to, and they weren’t likely to inspire more of the same.

In all the years that had elapsed since the Spaniards first sailed on the Pacific, but little real knowledge of the lands in it had been gained.

In all the years since the Spaniards first sailed on the Pacific, not much real knowledge of the lands there had been gained.

Let us attempt to give a picture of what was known.

Let's try to provide an overview of what was known.

The Marquesas and Santa Cruz Group were known to exist; but of the Solomons grave doubts were felt, as no man had seen them but Mendana, and they were, if placed on a map at all, shown in very different longitudes.

The Marquesas and Santa Cruz Group were recognized as real, but there were serious doubts about the Solomons since only Mendana had seen them, and when they were shown on a map, they appeared in very different longitudes.

Several voyagers had sighted different members of the extensive Paumotu Group, but the varying positions caused great confusion.

Several travelers had seen different parts of the vast Paumotu Group, but the differing locations led to a lot of confusion.

Tahiti had been found by Wallis.

Tahiti was found by Wallis.

Tasman had laid down the south point of Tasmania, the western coast of the North Island of New Zealand, and the Tonga Islands. Dampier and Carteret had shown that New Britain and New Ireland were separate islands, lying north-east of New Guinea. Quiros had found the northern island of the New Hebrides.

Tasman had mapped the southern tip of Tasmania, the western coast of New Zealand's North Island, and the Tonga Islands. Dampier and Carteret proved that New Britain and New Ireland were separate islands located northeast of New Guinea. Quiros discovered the northern island of the New Hebrides.

But of none of these lands was anything really known. Those who had visited them had merely touched. In no case had they gone round them, or ascertained their limits, and their descriptions, founded on brief experience, were bald and much exaggerated.

But nothing was really known about any of these lands. Those who had visited them had only scratched the surface. In no instance had they circled around them or figured out their boundaries, and their descriptions, based on limited experience, were bare and highly exaggerated.

Let us turn to what was unknown.

Let’s discover the unknown.

This comprises the whole of the east coast of Australia, or New Holland, and whether it was joined to Tasmania on the south, and New Guinea to the north; the dimensions of New Zealand; New Caledonia and the New Hebrides, with the exception of the fact that the northern island of the latter existed; the Fiji Islands; Sandwich Islands; the Phoenix, Union, Ellice, Gilbert, and Marshall Groups, with innumerable small islands scattered here and there; the Cook Islands, and all the Society Islands except Tahiti. The majority of the Paumotu Group. The coast of North America north of 45 degrees north was unknown, and there was the great, undefined, and imaginary southern Continent to disprove.

This includes the entire east coast of Australia, or New Holland, and whether it was connected to Tasmania in the south and New Guinea in the north; the size of New Zealand; New Caledonia and the New Hebrides, noting that the northern island of the latter existed; the Fiji Islands; Sandwich Islands; the Phoenix, Union, Ellice, Gilbert, and Marshall Groups, along with countless small islands scattered around; the Cook Islands, and all the Society Islands except Tahiti. The majority of the Paumotu Group. The coast of North America north of 45 degrees north was unknown, and there was the vast, undefined, and imaginary southern continent to consider.

Whether other voyages of exploration would have been undertaken one cannot say; but in 1768 the Royal Society put in a word.

Whether other exploration voyages would have taken place is uncertain; however, in 1768, the Royal Society made a suggestion.

A transit of Venus over the sun's disc was to occur in 1769, and astronomers were anxious to take advantage of it, the object of the observation being to ascertain the distance of the earth from the sun, the fundamental base line in all astronomical measurements, and which was very imperfectly known.

A transit of Venus across the sun's surface was set to happen in 1769, and astronomers were eager to make the most of it. The goal of the observation was to determine the distance from the Earth to the sun, which is the essential starting point for all astronomical measurements and was not well understood at the time.

The Central Pacific afforded a favourable position, and the Royal Society memorialised the king to send a ship for the purpose. The request was granted, and at first Alexander Dalrymple, who had conducted marine surveys in the East Indies, and was known as a scientific geographer, was selected as observer. As, however, it was found that he also expected to command the ship, the Admiralty positively refused to have anything to do with him, and after some discussion James Cook was selected.

The Central Pacific offered a good location, and the Royal Society asked the king to send a ship for that purpose. The request was approved, and initially, Alexander Dalrymple, who had conducted marine surveys in the East Indies and was recognized as a scientific geographer, was chosen as the observer. However, when it became clear that he also wanted to command the ship, the Admiralty outright refused to work with him, and after some discussion, James Cook was chosen instead.

This says volumes for Cook's reputation at the time. To have risen absolutely from the ranks was a great deal, but to be chosen as a master, to command a ship, and undertake a scientific observation of this importance, was a most exceptional occurrence, and speaks well for the judgment of those who had the selection.

This really highlights Cook's reputation at the time. Rising completely from the ranks was impressive, but being chosen as a master, commanding a ship, and taking on a scientific observation of this significance was truly exceptional and reflects positively on the judgment of those who made the selection.

It seems that Mr. Stephens, the Secretary to the Admiralty, had much to do with it. How Stephens had become acquainted with Cook history does not relate, but doubtless his personal visits to the Admiralty in connection with the completion of his charts of Newfoundland, from which he returned every winter, had brought him into contact with the Secretary, who had clearly formed a high opinion of him.

It seems that Mr. Stephens, the Secretary to the Admiralty, played a big role in this. It's not clear how Stephens learned about Cook's history, but his regular visits to the Admiralty to work on his charts of Newfoundland, which he returned from every winter, likely brought him into contact with the Secretary, who clearly thought highly of him.

Cook, we may be sure, jumped at the chance, and his pride must have been great when he found he was to receive a commission as Lieutenant.

Cook definitely seized the opportunity, and he must have felt immense pride when he learned he was being appointed as a Lieutenant.

This in itself was a most unusual step. The occasions on which a master had been transferred to the executive line of the Royal Navy were very rare, and many an admiral used his influence in favour of some deserving officer in vain.

This was an unusual move. It was quite rare for a master to be promoted to the executive line of the Royal Navy, and many admirals had tried to use their influence to help deserving officers without success.

This was not without good reason, as the whole training of the Master of those days was unfavourable to success in command of ships or men. The exception was, however, in this case amply justified.

This was not without good reason, as the entire training of the Master at that time was not conducive to success in commanding ships or people. However, in this case, the exception was more than justified.

Cook was allowed to choose his vessel, and bearing in mind the dangers of grounding in unknown seas, he pitched upon his old friends, the stoutly-built, full-bottomed colliers of the North Sea trade.

Cook was allowed to choose his ship, and considering the risks of running aground in unfamiliar waters, he went with his old favorites, the sturdy, spacious colliers of the North Sea trade.

His ship, the Endeavour, was a Whitby built vessel of three hundred and seventy tons, and was known as H.M. Bark Endeavour, there being another vessel, a cutter, of the same name in the Royal Navy. She was brought to the dockyard at Deptford to fit out. Her appearance was, of course, wholly different from that of a vessel built as a man-of-war, and we shall see that this caused trouble at Rio Janeiro, where the combination of merchant build and officers in uniform in an armed ship, aroused suspicions in the mind of the Portuguese Viceroy.

His ship, the Endeavour, was a Whitby-built vessel weighing three hundred and seventy tons, known as H.M. Bark Endeavour, as there was another vessel, a cutter, with the same name in the Royal Navy. It was taken to the dockyard at Deptford for outfitting. Its appearance was completely different from that of a warship, and we will see that this led to trouble in Rio de Janeiro, where the combination of a merchant design and uniformed officers aboard an armed ship raised suspicions in the mind of the Portuguese Viceroy.

It is nowhere directly stated whether the Endeavour was sheathed with copper or not; but as Cook in the account of his second voyage expresses himself as adverse to this method of protecting ships' bottoms, and the operation is recorded of heeling and boot topping, which was cleaning and greasing the part of the ship just below waterline, it may be concluded that her sheathing was wood.

It’s not directly mentioned whether the Endeavour was covered in copper or not; however, since Cook mentions in his account of his second voyage that he was against this method of protecting the bottoms of ships, and there’s a record of heeling and boot topping, which involved cleaning and greasing the section of the ship just below the waterline, we can conclude that it was sheathed with wood.

She proved a most suitable vessel. The log states she was a little crank, but an admirable sea-boat. Her rate of sailing was of course, with her build, slow, but her strength and flat bottom stood her in good stead when she made acquaintance with a coral reef.

She turned out to be a perfect boat. The log notes that she was a bit unstable, but she was a great sea vessel. Naturally, her speed was slow due to her design, but her sturdiness and flat bottom helped her a lot when she encountered a coral reef.

She mounted ten small carriage guns and twelve swivels.

She set up ten small carriage guns and twelve swivel guns.

Mr. Banks, a scientific botanist, afterwards well known as Sir Joseph Banks, and for a long time President of the Royal Society, a gentleman of private means, volunteered to accompany Cook, and took with him a staff of his own, of artists and others.

Mr. Banks, a scientific botanist who later became known as Sir Joseph Banks and served for many years as President of the Royal Society, a man of independent wealth, volunteered to join Cook and brought along his own team of artists and other personnel.

He also induced Dr. Solander, a Swedish naturalist, afterwards attached to the British Museum, to accompany him.

He also convinced Dr. Solander, a Swedish naturalist who later worked at the British Museum, to join him.

Mr. Charles Green, one of the assistants at the Royal Observatory at Greenwich, was sent as astronomer.

Mr. Charles Green, one of the assistants at the Royal Observatory in Greenwich, was sent as an astronomer.

This scientific staff added much to the success of the expedition.

This scientific team contributed greatly to the success of the expedition.

Banks and Solander, both men of observation, were able to collect specimens of natural history, and study the manners and customs of the natives with whom they came in contact, which neither the time at Cook's disposal nor his training enabled him to undertake; and though the Journal of the former has never yet been published, and cannot at the present time be traced, many interesting remarks were extracted by Dr. Hawkesworth from it and went far to make his account of the voyage complete.

Banks and Solander, both keen observers, were able to gather samples of natural history and study the behaviors and customs of the local people they encountered, which neither the time that Cook had nor his training allowed him to do; and although the Journal of the former has never been published and can't be found at the moment, Dr. Hawkesworth pulled many interesting insights from it that significantly enhanced his account of the voyage.

Mr. Green also demands special notice.

Mr. Green also needs special attention.

One great question of the day amongst seamen and geographers was the discovering of some ready and sure method of ascertaining the longitude. Half the value of the explorations made up to this time had been lost from this want. The recognised means of finding longitude was by the observation of lunars; that is, accurately measuring the angular distance between the centres of the moon and of the sun, or of the moon and some star.

One big question of the day among sailors and mapmakers was finding a reliable and easy way to determine longitude. Half the value of the explorations done so far had been wasted because of this issue. The common way to find longitude was through lunar observations, which means carefully measuring the angular distance between the centers of the moon and the sun, or the moon and some star.

The motion of the moon is so rapid that this angular distance changes from second to second, and thereby, by previous astronomical calculation, the time at Greenwich at which its distance from any body is a certain number of degrees can be ascertained and recorded.

The moon moves so quickly that its angular distance changes every second, allowing us to calculate the time at Greenwich when its distance from any object is a specific number of degrees, based on earlier astronomical calculations.

By well-known calculations the local time at any spot can be obtained, and when this is ascertained, at the precise moment that the angular distance of sun and moon is observed, the difference gives the longitude.

By using established calculations, you can find the local time at any location. Once you have that, at the exact moment you observe the angular distance between the sun and the moon, the difference will determine the longitude.

This seems simple enough, but there is a good deal of calculation to go through before the result is reached, and neither the observation nor the calculation is easy, especially with the astronomical tables of those days, and there were very few sailors who were capable of, or patient enough to make them, nor was the result, as a rule, very accurate. For one thing, the motions of the moon, which are extremely complicated, were not enough known to allow her calculated position in the heavens to be very accurate, and a very small error in this position considerably affects the time, and therefore the longitude.

This seems pretty straightforward, but there’s a lot of math involved before reaching the outcome, and neither the observation nor the calculations are easy, especially with the astronomical tables from that time. Very few sailors had the ability or the patience to work with them, and the results were usually not very accurate. For one thing, the moon's movements are quite complex and not well understood enough to determine its position in the sky with precision. A tiny mistake in this position significantly impacts the timing, and thus the longitude.

Luckily for Cook, the Nautical Almanac had just been started, and contained tables of the moon which had not previously been available, and which much lightened the calculations.

Luckily for Cook, the Nautical Almanac had just launched and included tables of the moon that hadn't been available before, which made the calculations much easier.

The great invention of the chronometer, that is, a watch that can be trusted to keep a steady rate for long periods, was at this time completed by Harrison; but very few had been manufactured, and astronomers and sailors were slow to believe in the efficacy of this method of carrying time about with a ship. Thus Cook had no chronometer supplied to him.

The amazing invention of the chronometer, which is a watch that can be relied upon to keep accurate time over long periods, was completed by Harrison at this time; however, very few had been made, and astronomers and sailors were hesitant to trust this method of managing time on a ship. As a result, Cook did not receive a chronometer.

Green had accompanied Mr. Maskelyne, afterwards Astronomer Royal, to Barbados in 1763 in H.M.S. Princess Louisa, in order to test Harrison's timekeeper, and also a complicated chair, from which it was supposed observations of Jupiter's satellites could be observed on board ship; and as this trial afforded the final triumph of the new method, one would have thought that on a voyage of circumnavigation he would have made every effort to get one of these watches.

Green had gone with Mr. Maskelyne, who later became the Astronomer Royal, to Barbados in 1763 on H.M.S. Princess Louisa to test Harrison's timekeeper and a complicated chair designed for observing Jupiter's moons from aboard the ship. Since this trial marked the success of the new method, one would think that during a circumnavigation voyage, he would have done everything possible to acquire one of these watches.

Be this as it may, the Endeavour had no chronometer, and lunars were the mainstay of the expedition.

Be that as it may, the Endeavour didn’t have a chronometer, and lunar measurements were the backbone of the expedition.

In these observations Green was indefatigable. Cook, an excellent observer himself frequently took part in them; but it was Green's especial business, and no doubt to him is due the major part of the determinations of accurate longitude, which is one of the very remarkable points of this voyage.

In these observations, Green was tireless. Cook, a great observer himself, often participated, but it was Green's specific responsibility, and he deserves much of the credit for accurately determining longitude, which is one of the standout achievements of this voyage.

Green's log, which is extant, is filled with lunar observations, and the extraordinary coincidence between different observations attests the care with which they were made. I dwell upon this because, while full of admiration for Cook's knowledge, and his untiring zeal in every detail of his expedition, it is evident, from a study of the original documents, that without Green many opportunities of getting longitude would have been lost, Cook having no time to spare to make use of them. Let us give honour to whom honour is due.

Green's log, which still exists, is packed with lunar observations, and the remarkable consistency between different observations shows the meticulousness with which they were recorded. I emphasize this because, while I greatly admire Cook's expertise and his relentless dedication to every aspect of his expedition, it’s clear from examining the original documents that without Green, many chances to determine longitude would have been missed, as Cook didn’t have the time to take advantage of them. Let’s give credit where it’s due.

The final results of the observations are not equally good, but this arises from the errors, before referred to, in the moon's place in the heavens as given in the almanac, which would vary with her position, and affect the longitude accordingly. The astonishing thing is, not that some longitudes are considerably in error, but that the majority of them are so near the truth.

The final results of the observations aren't all equally good, but this comes from the errors mentioned earlier regarding the moon's position in the sky as listed in the almanac, which would change depending on her position and affect the longitude accordingly. The surprising thing is not that some longitudes are quite off, but that most of them are so close to the truth.

The Endeavour sailed from the Thames on June 30th, 1768, and was in Plymouth Sound from July 14th to the 26th, when she finally sailed, Banks and the scientific staff having joined here.

The Endeavour set sail from the Thames on June 30, 1768, and was in Plymouth Sound from July 14 to July 26, when it finally departed, with Banks and the scientific team having come aboard.

She carried a complement, all told, of ninety-four, and very close stowage it must have been.

She had a total of ninety-four, and it must have been packed very tightly.

A list is given in this book, immediately before the "Journal," of every person on board when the ship sailed from Plymouth.

A list is provided in this book, right before the "Journal," of everyone on board when the ship left Plymouth.

The draught of the ship was 13 feet 6 inches, and her provisions were calculated to last eighteen months. The original intention had been that the transit of Venus should be observed at the Marquesas; but the Dolphin's return before Cook sailed, with the news of the discovery of Tahiti and its friendly inhabitants, caused this island to be finally selected.

The ship had a draft of 13 feet 6 inches, and her supplies were meant to last for eighteen months. Initially, the plan was to observe the transit of Venus at the Marquesas; however, the Dolphin's return before Cook set sail, bringing news of the discovery of Tahiti and its welcoming people, led to the final choice of this island.

The exact text of Cook's orders cannot be given. They were secret orders; but, curiously enough, while the covering letter, which enjoined him to show them to nobody, which is dated July 30th, 1768, is duly entered in Admiralty Records, the orders themselves, which should follow in the letter book, are omitted. They have never been published. Nevertheless, we can gather what they were.

The exact text of Cook's orders can't be shared. They were classified; however, interestingly, while the covering letter, which instructed him not to show them to anyone, is dated July 30th, 1768, and is properly recorded in Admiralty Records, the orders themselves, which should be included in the letter book, are missing. They have never been made public. Still, we can infer what they were.

Cook, in the published account of his Second Voyage, says he had instructions to proceed directly to Tahiti, and afterwards to prosecute the design of making discoveries in the Pacific by proceeding southward to the latitude of 40 degrees, and if he did not find land to continue his voyage to the west till he fell in with New Zealand, which he was directed to explore, and thence to return to England by such route as he should judge most convenient.

Cook, in the published account of his Second Voyage, says he had instructions to go straight to Tahiti, and after that, to focus on making discoveries in the Pacific by heading south to the latitude of 40 degrees. If he didn’t find any land, he was to keep sailing west until he reached New Zealand, which he was supposed to explore, and then return to England by whatever route he thought was best.

Precautions against the terrible scourge, scurvy, had not been forgotten.

Precautions against the terrible disease, scurvy, had not been forgotten.

Besides the supply of all anti-scorbutics then known, a special letter was written to Cook directing him to take a quantity of malt to sea, for the purpose of being made into wort, as a cure for scorbutic disorders, as recommended by Dr. McBride.

Besides providing all the known anti-scorbutics at the time, a special letter was sent to Cook instructing him to take a supply of malt to sea, so it could be brewed into wort as a treatment for scurvy, as suggested by Dr. McBride.

The directions for its use were as follows:--

The instructions for using it were as follows:--

"The malt must be ground under the direction of the surgeon, and made into wort, fresh every day, in the following manner:--

"The malt needs to be ground under the supervision of the surgeon and turned into wort, fresh every day, like this:--

"1. Take one quart of ground malt, and pour on it three quarts of boiling water. Stir them well, and let the mixture stand close covered up for three or four hours, after which strain off the liquor.

"1. Take one quart of ground malt and pour three quarts of boiling water over it. Stir it well and let the mixture sit, covered, for three or four hours, then strain off the liquid."

"2. The wort, so prepared, is then to be boiled into a panada, with sea biscuit or dried fruits generally carried to sea.

"2. The wort, prepared this way, is then boiled into a porridge, using sea biscuits or dried fruits typically taken on sea voyages."

"3. The patient must make at least two meals a day of the said panada, and should drink a quart or more of the fresh infusion as it may agree with him, every twenty-four hours.

"3. The patient needs to prepare at least two meals a day using the mentioned panada and should drink a quart or more of the fresh infusion, depending on how well it suits him, every twenty-four hours."

"4. The surgeon is to keep an exact account of its effects."

"4. The surgeon must keep a detailed record of its effects."

Though it is somewhat anticipating events, it is convenient to record here the result of these efforts to defeat the hitherto unconquerable enemy. Mr. Perry's report at the termination of the voyage is as follows:--

Though it is a bit ahead of the timeline, it’s useful to note the outcome of these attempts to defeat the previously unbeatable enemy. Mr. Perry's report at the end of the voyage is as follows:--

"Sour krout, mustard, vinegar, wheat, inspissated orange and lemon juices, saloup, portable soup, sugar, molasses, vegetables (at all times when they could be got) were, some in constant, others in occasional use. These were of such infinite service to the people in preserving them from a scorbutic taint, that the use of the malt was (with respect to necessity) almost entirely precluded.

"Sauerkraut, mustard, vinegar, wheat, concentrated orange and lemon juices, sago, dehydrated soup, sugar, molasses, and vegetables (whenever they could be found) were used constantly or occasionally. These were incredibly helpful for the people in preventing scurvy, making the use of malt nearly unnecessary."

"Again cold bathing was encouraged and enforced by example; the allowance of salt beef and pork was abridged from nearly the beginning of the voyage, and the sailors' usual custom of mixing the salt beef fat with their flour, etc., was strictly forbad.

"Once again, cold bathing was promoted and enforced by example; the ration of salt beef and pork was reduced from almost the start of the journey, and the sailors' typical practice of mixing the fat from salt beef with their flour, etc., was strictly prohibited."

"Upon our leaving England, also, a stop was put to our issuing butter and cheese, and throughout the voyage raisins were served with the flour instead of pickled suet. At Tierra del Fuego we collected wild celery, and every morning our breakfast was made with this herb, with ground wheat and portable soup.

"After we left England, we also stopped distributing butter and cheese, and during the whole trip, we had raisins with the flour instead of pickled suet. At Tierra del Fuego, we gathered wild celery, and every morning our breakfast included this herb, along with ground wheat and portable soup."

"We passed Cape Horn, all our men as free from scurvy as on our sailing from Plymouth.

"We passed Cape Horn, and all our crew were as free from scurvy as they were when we set sail from Plymouth."

"Three slight cases of scorbutic disorders occurred before arriving at Otaheite. Wort was given, with apparently good effect, and the symptoms disappeared.

"Three minor cases of scurvy occurred before we arrived in Tahiti. We provided wort, which seemed to help, and the symptoms went away."

"No other cases occurred during the voyage, but the wort was served out at sea as a regular article of diet."

"No other issues came up during the voyage, but the wort was provided at sea as a regular part of the diet."

To this it may be added, that no opportunity was, as appears by the Journal, ever lost of getting wild celery and any other wild herb that presented itself.

To this, it should be noted that, as recorded in the Journal, no chance was ever missed to collect wild celery or any other wild herb that came up.

The personal washing is mentioned by Mr. Perry, and the tradition in the Navy is, that the men's deck was more constantly scrubbed than had then been usual; in fact, that unusual attention was paid to cleanliness. Stoves were used to dry the decks below even in hot weather.

Mr. Perry talks about personal washing, and in the Navy, the tradition was that the men's deck was scrubbed more frequently than usual; in fact, there was an unusual focus on cleanliness. Stoves were used to dry the decks below even in hot weather.

As this voyage forms the subject of this book, its events may be passed over briefly.

As this journey is the focus of this book, we can summarize its events briefly.

Calling at Madeira--where the log records that the Endeavour was fired upon by the fort on the Loo Rock through some misapprehension while shifting berth, though Cook passes this by in silence--and Rio Janeiro, Cook proceeded to double Cape Horn. His predecessors had struggled through the Strait of Magellan, losing much time and wearing out their men with the continual anchoring and weighing in that long and narrow passage, rendered necessary by the constant foul and strong winds that prevail. The idea was to avoid the heavy seas and gales of the open sea; but Cook's action was amply justified by a more rapid passage without any danger. Discovering several of the low coral atolls of the Paumotu Group, he arrived at Tahiti on April 13th, 1769.

Stopping at Madeira—where the log notes that the Endeavour was fired upon by the fort on Loo Rock due to some misunderstanding while changing berth, although Cook doesn’t mention this—then at Rio de Janeiro, Cook moved on to round Cape Horn. His predecessors had struggled through the Strait of Magellan, wasting a lot of time and exhausting their crews with constant anchoring and unanchoring in that long and narrow passage, required by the persistent strong winds. The goal was to avoid the rough seas and storms of the open ocean; however, Cook’s decision was proven right with a faster journey and no danger. After discovering several low coral atolls of the Paumotu Group, he arrived at Tahiti on April 13th, 1769.

On July 13th, the transit of Venus having been observed under favourable conditions on June 1st, he left Tahiti, exploring and mapping the Society Islands immediately to the westward, never before visited, and then stood to the southward. It may here be mentioned that it is only during the last decade that Cook's charts of the Society Group have been superseded by more elaborate surveys by the French.

On July 13th, after observing the transit of Venus under good conditions on June 1st, he left Tahiti and started exploring and mapping the Society Islands just to the west, which had never been visited before, and then headed south. It’s worth noting that only in the last ten years have Cook's maps of the Society Group been replaced by more detailed surveys conducted by the French.

Cook went to 40 degrees south, discovering one of the Austral Group on his way, when, finding no sign of the hypothetical southern Continent, and getting into very dirty weather, he first gained a more northern latitude and favourable winds, and then stood for New Zealand.

Cook sailed to 40 degrees south, discovering one of the Austral Group along the way. After not finding any sign of the supposed southern continent and encountering rough weather, he first moved to a more northern latitude with better winds and then headed toward New Zealand.

On October 7th he arrived at Poverty Bay, and during the next six months he completely circumnavigated and mapped the islands of New Zealand. He had received on board at Tahiti a native, one Tupia, formerly the high priest, and a man of much intelligence. Tupia proved to be of the utmost service, as, to their astonishment and delight, they found that the languages were sufficiently identical to enable him to act as a most efficient interpreter; which made it possible to obtain information, and establish relations with the New Zealanders which they could never have succeeded in doing without him.

On October 7th, he arrived at Poverty Bay, and over the next six months, he fully circumnavigated and mapped the islands of New Zealand. He had brought on board in Tahiti a native named Tupia, who was previously the high priest and quite intelligent. Tupia turned out to be extremely helpful because, to their surprise and joy, they discovered that the languages were similar enough for him to serve as an excellent interpreter. This made it possible to gather information and build relationships with the New Zealanders, something they would have never been able to do without him.

Cook now, after consideration, determined to explore the unknown east coast of New Holland. The health of his ship's company, and the good order on board, permitted him to make this good use of his time, instead of hurrying on to a civilised port, as all his forerunners had had to do.

Cook now, after some thought, decided to explore the uncharted east coast of New Holland. The health of his crew and the smooth operation on board allowed him to take advantage of this time, instead of rushing to a civilized port like all his predecessors had to do.

He struck Australia at its south-east point, and followed the whole coast to the northward, mapping it as he went.

He hit Australia at its southeast point and followed the entire coast north, mapping it as he went.

When nearing the northern end the voyage nearly came to a premature conclusion by the ship grounding on a coral reef, twenty miles from the land. Cook's seamanship was, however, equal to the occasion. The ship was got off, much damaged and leaking severely, and carried into a little port they discovered not far off. Here she was cleared out and laid upon the ground, the tide sufficing to dry enough of her bottom to let the carpenters repair it.

When they were close to the northern end of the journey, the trip almost ended early when the ship ran aground on a coral reef, twenty miles from land. Cook's sailing skills, however, were up to the challenge. They managed to get the ship off the reef, although it was badly damaged and leaking a lot, and brought it into a small port they found nearby. There, they emptied the ship and beached it, with the tide being enough to dry out part of the hull for the carpenters to fix it.

The wisdom of Cook's choice of a ship of the build of the Endeavour was here very apparent. It was not every ship that could be safely beached in this way without danger of falling over. After long delay she proceeded on her voyage, and soon had a second narrow escape. The long line of coral reefs that front the northern part of Eastern Australia, for a distance of 1200 miles, approach the coast about the place where the ship had grounded. The passage between the outer reef and the land is strewn with shoals, and finding his further progress much impeded by them, and fearful of a repetition of his disaster, Cook with some difficulty found a channel to seaward, and gained the open ocean. He was, however, yet determined to follow the land he was exploring, and more especially to solve the great question as to whether Australia was joined to New Guinea or no; and three days after his escape from the line of reefs he found himself with a light wind, embayed on the outer side of them, with the reefs close to him, and the ship drifting slowly but surely on them, the heavy swell of the great ocean breaking mountains high on their outer edge.

Cook's choice of a ship like the Endeavour proved to be wise. Not every ship could be safely beached like that without the risk of tipping over. After a long wait, she continued on her journey and soon had another close call. The long stretch of coral reefs that runs along the northern coast of Eastern Australia for about 1200 miles comes close to shore right where the ship had run aground. The area between the outer reef and the land is filled with shallow waters, and as Cook found his progress severely slowed by them and worried about another mishap, he finally managed to find a channel out to sea and reached the open ocean. However, he was still determined to continue exploring the land, particularly to answer the important question of whether Australia and New Guinea were connected. Three days after escaping the reefs, he found himself with a light wind, caught on the outer side of the reefs, with them close by, and the ship was slowly but surely drifting toward them, the strong swell of the vast ocean crashing into the outer edge like massive mountains.

Here again calmness and promptitude saved him, and the ship was pushed through a narrow channel in these terrible reefs into the smooth, though reef-dotted, waters within. No event in the voyage is more dramatically narrated, though without any exaggeration, than this hair-breadth escape.

Here again, calmness and quick action saved him, and the ship was navigated through a narrow channel in these dangerous reefs into the calm, although reef-dotted, waters inside. No event in the voyage is told in a more dramatic way, though without any exaggeration, than this close call.

With the caution born of recent dangers, Cook now slowly found his way through the maze of reefs, by a route that no one has again followed, to the northern point of Australia, and was rewarded for his pertinacity by finding the channel now known as Torres Strait, which led him between New Guinea and Australia.

With the caution learned from recent dangers, Cook now carefully navigated through the maze of reefs, following a path that no one has taken since, to the northern tip of Australia. His persistence paid off when he discovered the channel now called Torres Strait, which took him between New Guinea and Australia.

Thus far Cook's enthusiasm in adventure and desire to explore had been fully shared by his companions; but it is apparent that at this point they fell short of his high standard. Cook, having secured his direct passage to Batavia, and having still a little provision left, was anxious to do still more in the way of discovery, and stood over to the little-known New Guinea shore. It is evident, however, from Cook's expressions, though he does not complain, that his people were pining for fresh food and civilisation. Australia had produced them little but occasional fish and a few turtle. The salt provisions of those days were most unpalatable, and the effect of their continued hard work and inadequate food for so long, for they were now over two years from England, with no communication of any kind with the outer world, were telling on them, though they were still free from scurvy.

So far, Cook's excitement for adventure and his desire to explore had been fully shared by his crew; however, it's clear that at this point, they fell short of his high standards. Cook, having secured his direct route to Batavia and still having a bit of provisions left, was eager to discover even more and headed over to the little-known New Guinea shore. However, it's evident from Cook's words, even though he doesn't complain, that his crew was longing for fresh food and the comforts of civilization. Australia had given them little more than occasional fish and a few turtles. The preserved food from that time was very unappetizing, and the effects of their continued hard work and inadequate food for so long—having now been over two years away from England with no contact with the outside world—were starting to weigh on them, though they were still free from scurvy.

Cook, therefore, after landing once in New Guinea, unwillingly turned his ship's head towards Batavia.

Cook, after arriving in New Guinea, reluctantly turned his ship towards Batavia.

The complaints grew louder as he passed by Timor without attempting to communicate, and falling in with the island of Savu, he yielded to importunity, and touched there to get refreshments.

The complaints grew louder as he went by Timor without trying to communicate, and when he reached the island of Savu, he gave in to pressure and stopped there to get some refreshments.

Thence he went by the south shore of the chain of islands to Sunda Strait and Batavia.

Then he traveled along the south shore of the chain of islands to the Sunda Strait and Batavia.

So far all had gone well. It was undoubtedly far the most successful voyage ever made. Much had been done--more than his orders directed--to explore unknown lands, and the dire enemy of seamen, scurvy, had been conquered.

So far, everything had gone smoothly. This was definitely the most successful voyage ever undertaken. A lot had been accomplished—more than his orders specified—to explore uncharted territories, and the dreaded enemy of sailors, scurvy, had been defeated.

But his luck was not to last.

But his luck wasn’t meant to last.

It was absolutely necessary to remain some time at Batavia, while the roughly repaired damage to the ship was made good in the Dutch dockyard.

It was essential to stay in Batavia for a while while the hastily repaired damage to the ship was fixed properly in the Dutch dockyard.

Two months and a half in the sickly climate of Batavia, during a bad time of the year, wrought a sad change in his ship's company. The port they so much desired proved but the door of the grave to many of them, and Cook sailed for England on December 27th, 1770, with dysentery pervading the ship. The surgeon had already died of it; so had the poor Tahitian, Tupia, with two seamen, and one of Mr. Banks' artists.

Two and a half months in the unhealthy climate of Batavia, during a rough time of year, took a heavy toll on his crew. The port they longed for turned out to be a gateway to death for many, and Cook set sail for England on December 27th, 1770, with dysentery spreading throughout the ship. The surgeon had already succumbed to it; so had the unfortunate Tahitian, Tupia, along with two sailors and one of Mr. Banks' artists.

Worse was, however, to follow. Day by day, as the ship slowly found her way over the Indian Ocean towards the Cape, against the wet and unhealthy north-west monsoon, the sick list grew larger. Man after man succumbed, and before half the distance to Capetown was traversed twenty-two more were carried off. Green, the astronomer, two more of Banks' staff, two midshipmen, the boatswain and carpenter were among the number. The crew was more than decimated.

Worse was yet to come. Day by day, as the ship slowly made her way over the Indian Ocean towards the Cape, battling the wet and unhealthy north-west monsoon, the number of sick crew members continued to rise. One by one, men fell ill, and before they covered half the distance to Cape Town, twenty-two more had been lost. Green, the astronomer, two more of Banks' staff, two midshipmen, the boatswain, and the carpenter were among them. The crew was more than decimated.

The ship touched at the Cape, and war with France being expected, the Endeavour joined the East India convoy, under H.M.S. Portland, at St. Helena. The heavy-sailing, collier-built craft was not, however, when the ships had crossed the line and got upon a wind, able to keep up with them, and she once more found herself alone on her way.

The ship arrived at the Cape, and with war with France on the horizon, the Endeavour joined the East India convoy led by H.M.S. Portland at St. Helena. However, once the ships crossed the equator and caught the wind, the heavy, collier-built craft couldn't keep up with them, and once again, she was left alone on her journey.

Two more officers, the First Lieutenant, Mr. Hicks, and the Master, Mr. Molineux, died after leaving the Cape, but not of dysentery, and the ship finally reached England on June 12th, 1771.

Two more officers, First Lieutenant Mr. Hicks and Master Mr. Molineux, died after leaving the Cape, but not from dysentery, and the ship finally arrived in England on June 12th, 1771.

Ninety-four persons left England in the Endeavour, of whom fifty-four returned. Thirty-eight died on the voyage, out of which number thirty-one died after reaching Batavia, most of them from fever and dysentery contracted at that place.

Ninety-four people left England on the Endeavour, of whom fifty-four returned. Thirty-eight died during the voyage, with thirty-one dying after reaching Batavia, most of them from fever and dysentery caught there.

After paying off in August 1771, the Endeavour was sold in 1775, and for many years sailed as a collier in the North Sea.

After being paid off in August 1771, the Endeavour was sold in 1775, and for many years, it operated as a coal ship in the North Sea.

This voyage gave a new impetus to discovery, and the immediate thought was to resume it, under this heaven-born leader.

This journey sparked a renewed drive for exploration, and the immediate idea was to continue it, under this inspiring leader.

Cook was given little leisure, as it was nearly at once decided to send him out again, and he was appointed to command the Resolution on November 28th, 1771, the interval having been occupied in considering what ships should be employed.

Cook had little free time, as it was almost immediately decided to send him out again. He was appointed to command the Resolution on November 28th, 1771, and the time in between was spent figuring out which ships should be used.

Cook's experience of the qualities of the Endeavour caused him to uphold the selection of similar vessels, for there were to be two, and the Resolution and Adventure, of 462 and 336 tons respectively, both Whitby built colliers, were bought for the voyage. Cook was promoted to Commander, and Tobias Furnaux, in the Adventure, was placed under his command. It was not, however, until April 1772 that they sailed.

Cook's experience with the qualities of the Endeavour led him to support the choice of similar ships, as there were to be two more. The Resolution and Adventure, weighing 462 and 336 tons respectively, both built in Whitby as colliers, were purchased for the journey. Cook was promoted to Commander, and Tobias Furnaux, in the Adventure, was put under his command. However, they didn't set sail until April 1772.

It was originally intended that Banks should again accompany Cook, and with a view to his better accommodation a poop was added to the Resolution. The short trip, however, from Deptford to Sheerness proved to Cook that the ship was dangerously over-weighted, and the poop was removed, with the consequence that Banks did not sail. The alteration delayed final departure until June 22nd from Sheerness, and July 13th from Plymouth.

It was initially planned for Banks to join Cook again, and to make him more comfortable, a poop deck was added to the Resolution. However, the brief journey from Deptford to Sheerness showed Cook that the ship was dangerously overloaded, so the poop was taken off, which meant Banks couldn't sail. This change delayed the final departure until June 22nd from Sheerness and July 13th from Plymouth.

The naturalists on this voyage were two Forsters, Germans, father and son; and as astronomers Mr. Wales sailed in the Resolution, and Mr. Bayley in the Adventure. Two of Cook's former companions sailed as Lieutenants: Clerke, who was Lieutenant, and Pickersgill, who was master of the Endeavour when she reached England. This witnesses to the confidence and enthusiasm that Cook inspired amongst those under him. There were also other Endeavours amongst the junior officers.

The naturalists on this journey were a father-and-son duo, the Forsters, both from Germany. Mr. Wales served as an astronomer on the Resolution, and Mr. Bayley was on the Adventure. Two of Cook's previous associates were aboard as Lieutenants: Clerke, who held the rank of Lieutenant, and Pickersgill, who was the master of the Endeavour when it returned to England. This shows the confidence and excitement that Cook inspired in his crew. Additionally, there were other Endeavours among the junior officers.

The main object of the voyage was the settlement of the great question of the southern Continent. Cook was directed to explore the whole region about the South Pole, starting from the Cape of Good Hope, and working eastward. The winter of the southern hemisphere was to be employed as Cook thought fit.

The main goal of the voyage was to address the major issue of the southern continent. Cook was instructed to explore the entire area around the South Pole, beginning at the Cape of Good Hope and moving eastward. Cook could use the winter of the southern hemisphere as he saw fit.

This voyage brought Cook's qualities as a seaman and commander more prominently to view even than the former. The conditions were very different. Instead of mapping coasts and islands, the principal duty was exploration of tempestuous seas in high latitudes, amongst ice, searching in vain for the illusive southern land.

This journey highlighted Cook's skills as a sailor and leader even more than before. The circumstances were quite different. Rather than charting coastlines and islands, the main task was to explore stormy waters in the far north, navigating through ice, and searching unsuccessfully for the elusive southern continent.

Cook carried it out thoroughly. No gales, no temperatures deterred him from searching wherever the ships would safely sail, and it was only ice in dense masses that turned him back.

Cook carried it out perfectly. No storms or temperatures stopped him from searching wherever the ships could safely navigate, and it was only thick ice that made him turn back.

What his people thought of it we do not know, but the Forsters have given a piteous account of the privations and hardships of an exploration that gave them little chance of exercising their special knowledge.

What his people thought about it, we don’t know, but the Forsters have provided a sad account of the difficulties and challenges of an exploration that gave them little opportunity to use their specialized knowledge.

Cook was better provided with instruments for the determination of longitude than before, and the ships carried four chronometric timekeepers; but the proper method of making use of them was scarcely yet realised, and the course of his voyage did not permit them to be of much service.

Cook had better tools for determining longitude than before, and the ships carried four chronometric timekeepers. However, the right way to use them was not fully understood yet, and the path of his voyage didn’t allow them to be very helpful.

Mindful of his former success in combating scurvy, and making use of his experience, Cook carried with him all his former anti-scorbutics, and redoubled his general precautions as to cleanliness, both of person and ship. The result was complete immunity from more than symptoms of scurvy. He was able to say, when he returned, that no man had died not only of this disease, but of any other, due to the exposures of the voyage. Three lost by accidents, and one from a complaint contracted before leaving England, were the sole losses on a voyage lasting three years, and during which the exposure to heat, cold, rain, and all the hardships of a sea life was probably never surpassed.

Aware of his previous success in fighting scurvy, and drawing on his experience, Cook took all his earlier remedies with him and stepped up his overall hygiene measures for both the crew and the ship. The outcome was complete prevention of serious scurvy symptoms. When he returned, he could confidently say that no one had died from this illness or any others related to the hardships of the voyage. Only three men died due to accidents, and one from a condition acquired before leaving England, making it the only losses during a three-year journey that faced extreme heat, cold, rain, and all the challenges of life at sea.

Leaving the Cape on November 22nd, Cook stood at once to the southward, intending to pass over a spot in latitude 54 degrees South, where in 1739 M. Bouvet sighted land that was generally supposed to be a part of the Southern Continent, and which he had been especially directed to examine. Gales, however, drove him from his course, and to this day Bouvet's Islands (for Cook proved they could be nothing else) are doubtfully shown upon charts.* (* They were again reported in 1825 by the Sprightly, an English whaler, but Sir James Ross searched for them in 1840 without success.) Cook soon got into the ice, and fought with it and gales of wind, in snow and sleet and fog, working gradually eastwards from the longitude of the Cape for four months. The ship penetrated to 67 degrees South at one point, and kept as high a latitude as ice permitted everywhere, but without discovering any land. Cook found to his great joy that the ice yielded good fresh water, and replenished his water casks in this manner, without any fear of falling short. With all his power of communicating his enthusiasm to others, it may be doubted if they shared his pleasure at finding that the search in these inclement regions need not be curtailed from lack of this necessary.

Leaving the Cape on November 22nd, Cook immediately headed south, planning to cross a point at latitude 54 degrees South, where in 1739 M. Bouvet saw land that was believed to be part of the Southern Continent, which he had been especially instructed to explore. However, storms pushed him off course, and to this day Bouvet's Islands (which Cook showed were nothing more than that) are still uncertainly marked on maps.* (*They were reported again in 1825 by the Sprightly, an English whaler, but Sir James Ross searched for them in 1840 without success.) Cook soon encountered ice and battled against it and strong winds, facing snow, sleet, and fog, gradually moving eastward from the longitude of the Cape for four months. The ship reached as far as 67 degrees South at one point and maintained the highest latitude possible due to the ice, but he did not find any land. To his great relief, Cook discovered that the ice provided fresh water, and he filled his water casks this way, without worrying about running low. Despite his ability to share his enthusiasm with others, it's uncertain if they felt the same joy in realizing that their search in these harsh regions could continue without the worry of lacking this essential resource.

At last, in the longitude of Tasmania, Cook hauled to the northward, and headed for New Zealand, where, after sailing over eleven thousand miles since leaving the Cape without once sighting land, he anchored in Dusky Bay on March 26th, 1774, with the Resolution only, the Adventure having parted company in thick weather on February 9th. Moving on to Queen Charlotte's Sound, his old anchorage at the north end of Middle Island, he found the Adventure there on May 18th. Captain Furneaux had, after vainly searching for his consort, run for Tasmania, and explored the east coast. He did not, however, clear up the point for which he states he visited this coast, namely, whether it joined New Holland or not, as strong winds from the eastward made him fearful of closing what he thought was a deep bay, though really the Strait, and he sailed for the rendezvous in New Zealand under the impression that Tasmania and Australia were one.

At last, near the longitude of Tasmania, Cook headed north and made his way to New Zealand, where, after sailing over eleven thousand miles since leaving the Cape without seeing any land, he anchored in Dusky Bay on March 26th, 1774, with just the Resolution, since the Adventure had separated in thick weather on February 9th. Continuing on to Queen Charlotte's Sound, his usual anchorage at the north end of Middle Island, he found the Adventure there on May 18th. Captain Furneaux had, after searching in vain for his ship, gone to Tasmania and explored the east coast. However, he didn't resolve the question that prompted his visit to this coast, which was whether it connected with New Holland or not, as strong winds from the east made him worried about approaching what he thought was a deep bay, but was actually the Strait, and he sailed to the rendezvous in New Zealand believing that Tasmania and Australia were one.

The ships left New Zealand on June 7th, 1773, and, after making a wide circuit to the south and east in search of land, arrived at Tahiti on August 16th. A good many of the Adventure's people were ill with scurvy, and Cook is much puzzled to know the reason why they were attacked while his own crew were free. He puts it down to the greater trouble he had taken to make all his men use wild celery and other herbs in New Zealand, and no doubt this had its effect; but one cannot but suspect that the constant care on his part to keep the ship clean and sweet below had much to do with it. The Adventure had the same anti-scorbutics, and Cook especially mentions that they were in use; but the personal efforts of the captain in the direction of general sanitary precautions were, we know, exercised in one case, while we know nothing of the other.

The ships left New Zealand on June 7, 1773, and after taking a wide route to the south and east searching for land, they arrived at Tahiti on August 16. Many of the crew on the Adventure were suffering from scurvy, and Cook is puzzled as to why they were affected while his own crew was fine. He attributes it to the extra effort he made to ensure all his men consumed wild celery and other herbs in New Zealand, which likely helped; but one can't help but think that his constant attention to keeping the ship clean and fresh played a big role too. The Adventure had the same anti-scurvy supplies, and Cook specifically mentions that they were being used; however, we know that the captain took personal steps for general cleanliness in one case, while we have no information about the other.

After a month's stay at Tahiti and the Society Islands, where the crews were much benefited by fresh provisions, the ships sailed for the Friendly Islands, never visited since Tasrnan's time, and touched at Eoa and Tongatabu, or, as Tasman had called them, Middleburg and Amsterdam. These were finally left on October 7th for New Zealand, which was made on the 21st, and from this day to November 2nd the time was spent in fruitless endeavours to get into Cook's Strait. Gale succeeded gale--no uncommon thing here--and in one of them the Adventure parted company never again to rejoin. Cook anchored in Queen Charlotte's Sound on November 2nd, and waited until the 25th for his consort in vain. Whilst here they gained further and indisputable proof of the cannibalistic tendencies of the Maoris, some of the natives eating human flesh before them. Cook has been much blamed for permitting this scene, which took place on board; but there had been so much disputing in England as to the possibility of the fact, that he could not resist the opportunity of putting it beyond a doubt.

After staying a month in Tahiti and the Society Islands, where the crews greatly benefited from fresh supplies, the ships set sail for the Friendly Islands, which hadn't been visited since Tasman's time. They made stops at Eoa and Tongatabu, which Tasman had named Middleburg and Amsterdam. They finally left on October 7th for New Zealand, arriving on the 21st. From that day until November 2nd, they struggled unsuccessfully to enter Cook's Strait. Strong gales were common in the area, and during one of these storms, the Adventure lost contact and never rejoined. Cook anchored in Queen Charlotte's Sound on November 2nd and waited in vain until the 25th for his companion ship. While there, they witnessed undeniable evidence of the cannibalistic behavior of the Maoris, with some of the locals eating human flesh right in front of them. Cook faced a lot of criticism for allowing this incident to happen on board, but there had been so much debate back in England about the possibility of such acts that he couldn't pass up the chance to confirm it.

It was, however, to be shortly proved in a much more horrible manner, for the Adventure, which only arrived at Queen Charlotte's Sound after the Resolution left, had a boat's crew attacked, overpowered, and eaten by the natives. The circumstances were never wholly known, as not a man escaped; but the cooked remains were found, the natives decamping as the search-party approached.

It was soon going to be shown in a much more terrible way, because the Adventure, which only got to Queen Charlotte's Sound after the Resolution had left, had its boat crew attacked, overpowered, and eaten by the locals. The details were never fully understood, since no one survived; however, the cooked remains were discovered, and the locals fled as the search party got closer.

Cook sailed south on November 25th, 1773, and was soon again battling with the ice, into which he pushed as far as was safe with as much hardihood as if he had still had the second ship with him. He gained the latitude of 67 degrees south, and worked eastward, searching religiously for land--which, needless to say, he never found--his ropes frozen, and sails like, as he says, plates of metal. Whatever the feelings of others on board were, Cook never flinched from every effort to get south, penetrating in one place to 71 degrees south, where he was stopped by dense pack, until he found himself nearly in the longitude of Tierra del Fuego, when, satisfied that no Southern Continent existed in the Pacific, he, on February 6th, steered north, to continue exploration in more genial weather and more profitable latitudes. All this time there was no scurvy, and very little sickness of any kind; an indisputable proof of the untiring supervision Cook exercised over the health of his men. The object of his voyage, so far as the Southern Pacific was concerned, was now accomplished, and Cook might have rounded Cape Horn, and made for the Cape of Good Hope, completing his tour of the world in southern latitudes; but such was not his idea of his duty. His own nervous words will explain his feelings best:--

Cook set sail south on November 25th, 1773, and soon found himself battling the ice again, pushing as far as was safe with as much determination as if he still had the second ship with him. He reached a latitude of 67 degrees south and moved eastward, diligently searching for land—which, of course, he never found—his ropes frozen and sails, as he described, stiff like metal plates. Whatever the feelings of the others on board were, Cook never wavered in his efforts to go south, reaching as far as 71 degrees south, where he was halted by dense pack ice. He found himself nearly at the longitude of Tierra del Fuego, and when he was convinced that no Southern Continent existed in the Pacific, he steered north on February 6th to continue exploring in more favorable weather and more promising latitudes. Throughout this time, there was no scurvy and very little illness, a clear sign of the tireless attention Cook paid to the health of his crew. The purpose of his voyage, at least regarding the Southern Pacific, was now fulfilled. Cook could have rounded Cape Horn and headed toward the Cape of Good Hope, completing his journey around the world in southern latitudes, but that was not his idea of duty. His own anxious words will express his feelings best:--

"We undoubtedly might have reached the Cape of Good Hope in April, and so have put an end to the expedition so far as related to the finding of a continent, which indeed was the first object of the voyage; but for me at this time to have quitted this Southern Pacific Ocean with a good ship expressly sent out on discoveries, a healthy crew, and not in want either of stores or provisions, would have betrayed not only a want of perseverance, but of judgment, in supposing the South Pacific Ocean to be so well explored that nothing remained to be done in it. This, however, was not my opinion; for, although I had proved there was no continent but what must lie far to the south, there remained, nevertheless, room for very large islands in places wholly unexamined, and many of those which were formerly discovered are but imperfectly explored, and their situation as imperfectly known. I was, besides, of opinion that my remaining in this sea some time longer would be productive of improvements in navigation and geography, as well as other sciences."

"We could have definitely reached the Cape of Good Hope in April, which would have ended the expedition regarding the search for a continent, the main goal of the voyage. However, it wouldn’t have made sense for me to leave the Southern Pacific Ocean at this point with a good ship specifically sent for discoveries, a healthy crew, and no shortage of supplies or provisions. Doing so would have shown a lack of persistence and poor judgment in thinking that the South Pacific Ocean is so thoroughly explored that there’s nothing left to do. However, that wasn’t my view. While I proved that there’s no continent nearby, there are still likely large islands in entirely unexplored areas, and many of those that were previously discovered are only partially explored, with their locations not fully known. I also believed that staying in this sea a bit longer would lead to advancements in navigation, geography, and other sciences."

Cook mentions that, on communicating his intentions to his officers, they all heartily concurred; and he adds, "Under such circumstances it is hardly necessary to say that the seamen were always obedient and alert, and they were so far from wishing the voyage at an end that they rejoiced at the prospect of its being prolonged another year." This, be it remembered, without a prospect of news from home or contact with civilisation, for Cook's design was to pass again through the breadth of the Pacific searching for islands as far as Quiros' discovery of Espiritu Santo, which lay due north of New Zealand, and then to return through the tempestuous regions they were now quitting to Cape Horn. Perhaps the charms of Tahiti reconciled them.

Cook states that when he shared his plans with his officers, they all fully supported him; he adds, "Given these circumstances, it’s hardly necessary to mention that the sailors were always obedient and attentive, and they were so far from wanting the voyage to end that they celebrated the possibility of it being extended for another year." It’s worth noting that this was without any news from home or interaction with civilization, as Cook’s goal was to travel once more across the width of the Pacific, searching for islands as far as Quiros’ discovery of Espiritu Santo, which is directly north of New Zealand, and then to return through the stormy areas they were currently leaving behind to reach Cape Horn. Perhaps the allure of Tahiti kept their spirits up.

This design Cook triumphantly carried out; though shortly after leaving southern latitudes he was so ill of what he describes as a bilious cholic, that his life was despaired of. He first searched for, and visited, Davis' discovery of Easter Island, where he examined and described the wonderful colossal, though rude, statues there found. He then went to the Marquesas, a group but little known, where, after the usual attempt of the natives to appropriate sundry articles, and the consequent necessity of firing upon them, peaceful relations were established, and a brisk trade in much-wanted refreshments was set up. This did not last long, however, as the market was spoiled by some red feathers, obtained at the Friendly Islands, being given for a pig; after which nothing would buy provisions but these same red feathers, and these being scarce, trade ceased. Cook therefore sailed once more for Tahiti.

Cook carried out this design triumphantly; however, shortly after leaving the southern latitudes, he became seriously ill with what he described as a bilious colic, and his life was feared to be in danger. He first searched for and visited Davis' discovery of Easter Island, where he examined and described the impressive colossal, though crude, statues found there. Then he went to the Marquesas, a group that was little known at the time, where, after the usual attempts by the natives to take various items, which led to the need to fire upon them, peaceful relations were established, and a lively trade in much-needed refreshments was set up. Unfortunately, this didn’t last long, as the market was disrupted when some red feathers, obtained from the Friendly Islands, were exchanged for a pig; after that, nothing could buy provisions except for those same red feathers, which became scarce, and trade came to a halt. Cook then set sail again for Tahiti.

On his way he touched at some of the coral atolls of the innumerable Paumotu Group, and arrived at Matavai on April 22nd, again with not a sick man on board.

On his journey, he stopped at some of the coral atolls in the countless Paumotu Group and reached Matavai on April 22nd, once again without a sick person on board.

Three weeks were spent here with much satisfaction to all. Provisions were in plenty, the king and people very friendly, and all went well. The islanders were preparing for an attack on Eimeo, a neighbouring island, and a gathering of the fleets gave Cook an opportunity of learning much of their naval power and manner of conducting war. He observed that the general prosperity of Tahiti seemed to be at a much higher point than on his former visit.

Three weeks were spent here with great satisfaction for everyone. There was plenty of food, the king and the people were very friendly, and everything was going well. The islanders were getting ready to attack Eimeo, a nearby island, and a gathering of the fleets gave Cook a chance to learn a lot about their naval strength and how they waged war. He noticed that the overall prosperity of Tahiti seemed to be much higher than during his previous visit.

After another three weeks' stay at Huaheine, and Ulietea, also amongst old friends, the Resolution sailed on June 4th to the west.

After another three weeks at Huaheine, and Ulietea, also with old friends, the Resolution set sail to the west on June 4th.

Discovering Palmerston and Savage Islands on the way, she called at Namuka, one of the Friendly Group, thus extending the knowledge of those islands gained the year before. Thence Cook sailed west, discovering Turtle Island, but just passing out of sight to the southward of the large Fiji Group, and thus lost the chance of adding them to his other finds.

Discovering Palmerston and Savage Islands along the way, she stopped at Namuka, one of the Friendly Islands, thereby enhancing the knowledge of those islands gathered the previous year. From there, Cook sailed west, discovering Turtle Island, but he just missed the large Fiji Group to the south, missing the opportunity to include them in his other discoveries.

He was now bound for the New Hebrides, of which the northern island had been discovered by Quiros. Bougainville, the French explorer, had, in 1768, passed just south of Quiros' Island, and named one or two others he sighted, but had made no stay, and knew nothing of the extent of the Group.

He was now headed for the New Hebrides, where the northern island had been discovered by Quiros. Bougainville, the French explorer, had passed just south of Quiros' Island in 1768 and named a couple of other islands he saw, but he didn't stay long and didn't know anything about the size of the Group.

This was not Cook's fashion. He explored and circumnavigated the whole Group, which extends in a long line for three hundred and fifty miles. He touched first at Mallicolo, where, after a temporary disagreement, friendship was formed. Passing Sandwich Island, Erromanga was landed upon; but the suspicion of the natives here impelled them to attack the boats, and no intercourse was established.

This wasn’t Cook’s style. He explored and sailed all the way around the entire group, which stretches in a long line for three hundred and fifty miles. He first stopped at Mallicolo, where, after a brief disagreement, they became friends. After passing Sandwich Island, he landed on Erromanga, but the natives' suspicion led them to attack the boats, and no interaction took place.

The ship then anchored in the convenient harbour of Resolution Bay in the island of Tanna, and remained a fortnight, wooding and watering. Observations on the hot springs that gush from the side of the volcano bordering the harbour were made, and the relations with the natives were altogether friendly. Sighting Anityeum, the southern member of the New Hebrides, and making sure there was nothing beyond it, Cook returned along the west side of the islands, passing eastward of them again, between Mallicolo and Espiritu Santo. The latter island was closely followed round its whole extent, and Quiros' Bay of St. Philip and St. James identified in the great inlet in the northern side. Having laid down the whole of this extensive group of islands, and very accurately fixed the longitude by many lunar observations, Cook, on August 31st, sailed to the westward to search for more lands.

The ship then dropped anchor in the convenient harbor of Resolution Bay on the island of Tanna and stayed for two weeks, gathering wood and water. They made observations on the hot springs that flow from the side of the volcano near the harbor, and their relations with the locals were completely friendly. After spotting Anityeum, the southern island of the New Hebrides, and confirming there was nothing beyond it, Cook returned along the west side of the islands, passing to the east of them again, between Mallicolo and Espiritu Santo. The latter island was carefully navigated around its entire coast, and Quiros' Bay of St. Philip and St. James was identified in the large inlet on the northern side. After charting the entire extensive group of islands and accurately determining the longitude through multiple lunar observations, Cook set sail to the west on August 31st to search for more land.

His chart of the New Hebrides is still, for some of the islands, the only one; and wherever superseded by more recent surveys the general accuracy of his work, both in outline and position, is very remarkable. On several occasions up to the present year (1893) Cook's recorded positions have saved the adoption of so-called amendments reported by passing ships, which would have been anything but amendments in reality.

His map of the New Hebrides is still, for some islands, the only one available; and where it has been replaced by newer surveys, the overall accuracy of his work, both in layout and location, is quite impressive. On several occasions up to this year (1893), Cook's recorded positions have prevented the acceptance of so-called corrections reported by passing ships, which would have actually been anything but corrections.

Four days after leaving the New Hebrides Cook discovered New Caledonia. He explored the whole of the eastern side of this large island, which is three hundred miles in length, anchoring in one harbour inside the reefs which border it, and making friends with the natives. Other attempts to get inside the reefs were, however, unsuccessful, and after several narrow escapes from shipwreck Cook gave up, to his regret, a complete circumnavigation of the island. The summer approaching, he wished to refit and recruit in New Zealand before once more standing south.

Four days after leaving the New Hebrides, Cook discovered New Caledonia. He explored the entire eastern side of this large island, which is three hundred miles long, anchoring in a harbor inside the surrounding reefs and befriending the locals. However, other attempts to get inside the reefs were unsuccessful, and after several close calls with shipwrecks, Cook regrettably gave up on completely circumnavigating the island. With summer approaching, he wanted to restock and recover in New Zealand before heading south again.

Norfolk Island was discovered and landed upon on the way, and Queen Charlotte's Sound was once more reached on October 19th.

Norfolk Island was discovered and visited along the way, and Queen Charlotte's Sound was reached again on October 19th.

The Adventure's visit was ascertained from the Maoris, but Cook was much puzzled by incompletely understood accounts of white men having been killed. As far as could be gathered a ship had been lost on the coast, and Cook was led to believe that this disaster had no reference to the Adventure.

The Adventure's visit was confirmed by the Maoris, but Cook was quite confused by the unclear reports of white men being killed. From what he could gather, a ship had been lost on the coast, and Cook was led to believe that this incident was unrelated to the Adventure.

It was found that pigs and fowls left here on the former visit were still in existence, and presumably thriving. It may here be mentioned, that wherever Cook touched he invariably, so far as his stock allowed, left animals to stock the country, and that New Zealand was, when the settlers eventually came, found to be well supplied with pigs.

It was discovered that the pigs and chickens left here during the previous visit were still around and likely doing well. It's worth noting that wherever Cook landed, he always tried to leave behind animals to help populate the area, and when the settlers eventually arrived in New Zealand, they found it was well stocked with pigs.

After a stay of three weeks the Resolution sailed, on November 10th, for Cape Horn. She kept farther north than on the last occasion, the object being to pass over new ground, and more completely disprove the existence of any land.

After staying for three weeks, the Resolution set sail on November 10th for Cape Horn. She kept farther north than before, aiming to explore new areas and provide more conclusive evidence against the existence of any land.

The western part of Tierra del Fuego being reached, Cook followed the shore to the south-east, mapping the outside of this dangerous and inhospitable archipelago. On December 20th he put in to what he afterwards called Christmas Sound, where large numbers of kelp geese were obtained, giving the crew what Cook describes as a dainty Christmas feast, though the flesh of these birds is as tough, fishy, and unpalatable as can well be imagined; on this occasion, however, the seamen seemed to have concurred in the verdict of their omnivorous commander, to whom nothing ever came amiss. Be it remembered, however, how long they had been on salt provisions, and that the South Sea Islands, though pleasant in many respects, produced but little solid food--no beef, mutton, or flesh of any quadruped but pigs, and those in not very great plenty--while New Zealand gave them nothing but fish.

Once Cook reached the western part of Tierra del Fuego, he followed the coastline to the southeast, charting the exterior of this perilous and uninviting archipelago. On December 20th, he stopped at a place he later named Christmas Sound, where they caught a lot of kelp geese, which provided the crew with what Cook described as a fancy Christmas meal. However, the meat of these birds is notoriously tough, fishy, and unpleasant; on this occasion, though, the sailors seemed to agree with their omnivorous captain, who always found something to enjoy. It's worth noting how long they had been on salted provisions and that the South Sea Islands, while appealing in many ways, offered very little solid food—no beef, mutton, or any quadruped meat besides pigs, which were not very abundant—while New Zealand only provided fish.

Rounding Cape Horn, he passed through the Strait Le Maire, and followed the north shore of Staten Island, anchoring at one place to obtain seals and birds.

Rounding Cape Horn, he went through the Strait Le Maire and followed the north coast of Staten Island, stopping at one spot to collect seals and birds.

Whilst praising the flavour of a young seal cub, Cook is compelled to admit that the flesh of an old sea lion is abominable; a remarkable statement as coming from him.

While praising the taste of a young seal pup, Cook is forced to admit that the meat of an old sea lion is terrible; a notable statement for him.

Leaving Staten Island, Cook steered east and discovered South Georgia, named after the king. He followed the north coast of this desolate and ice-clad island, obtaining more refreshment in the shape of seals, penguins, and shags--unpalatable, but welcome food to men who had so long subsisted on bad salt meat. From South Georgia the ship's head was once more turned southwards, and before many days ice was again encountered. In stormy and thick weather the Resolution made her way, disproving the existence of a great tract of land laid down by speculative geographers, until January 31st, 1775, when Sandwich Land was discovered in about latitude 60 degrees south. This ice-covered group of islands was sketched under great difficulties from gales, fogs, snow, and numerous icebergs; and Cook then bore away along their parallel, to seek once more for Bouvet's Islands to the eastward.

Leaving Staten Island, Cook steered east and discovered South Georgia, named after the king. He followed the north coast of this desolate and icy island, finding more food in the form of seals, penguins, and shags—unpleasant, but welcome nourishment for men who had been living on bad salted meat for so long. From South Georgia, the ship headed south again, and before long, they encountered ice once more. In stormy and thick weather, the Resolution made its way, disproving the existence of a vast landmass suggested by speculative geographers, until January 31st, 1775, when Sandwich Land was discovered around latitude 60 degrees south. This ice-covered group of islands was charted under great difficulties from gales, fog, snow, and many icebergs; Cook then continued along their latitude, searching once again for Bouvet's Islands to the east.

He found nothing, and on February 26th steered for the Cape of Good Hope, even he being glad to leave this trying, tempestuous latitude. On March 23rd he anchored in Table Bay, having learnt from some vessels outside of the safe arrival of the Adventure in England the year before, and of her boat's crew having been eaten by the Maoris, which cleared up the mystery of the wrecked ship.

He found nothing, and on February 26th headed for the Cape of Good Hope, glad to leave this challenging, stormy area behind. On March 23rd, he anchored in Table Bay, having learned from some ships outside that the Adventure made it safely to England the year before, and that her crew had been eaten by the Maoris, which explained the mystery of the wrecked ship.

The Resolution finally arrived at Spithead on July 29th, 1775, after an absence of three years and eighteen days.

The Resolution finally arrived at Spithead on July 29, 1775, after being gone for three years and eighteen days.

Captain Furneaux had, on leaving New Zealand, sailed straight for Cape Horn, the Cape of Good Hope, and England, arriving just a year before the Resolution.

Captain Furneaux had, upon leaving New Zealand, sailed directly for Cape Horn, the Cape of Good Hope, and England, arriving just a year before the Resolution.

Cook speaks most warmly of Captain Furneaux; but one cannot help contrasting his action with Cook's. Left, by the separation, his own master, he might have continued exploration, as did Cook. His ship was staunch, his provisions in much the same condition as the Resolution's; but he went straight home. His crew had suffered from scurvy, whereas Cook's had not; but he says not one word of this, nor does he give any reason why he gave up any further thought of the objects of the voyage, except a search for Bouvet's Islands, which he also looked for on his way.

Cook speaks very highly of Captain Furneaux; however, it’s hard not to compare his actions with Cook's. Left on his own due to the separation, he could have continued exploring, just like Cook. His ship was reliable, and his supplies were in much the same condition as the Resolution's; yet he headed straight home. His crew had been affected by scurvy, while Cook's had not; but he doesn’t mention this at all, nor does he provide any reason for abandoning the goals of the voyage, aside from searching for Bouvet's Islands, which he also looked for on his way.

It was the indomitable perseverance that led Cook to act so differently that raised his reputation so far above all other leaders.

It was Cook's unyielding determination to act so differently that elevated his reputation far above all other leaders.

Thus ended this very remarkable voyage. Never was a ship's crew exposed to more continual hardships, with so little to keep up interest and excitement, as the people of the Resolution; and yet Cook is able to record, with allowable pride, that only four lives had been lost, and only one by a sickness contracted before leaving England.

Thus ended this truly remarkable voyage. No ship's crew has faced such constant hardships, with so little to keep their spirits up and excitement alive, as the crew of the Resolution; and yet Cook is able to note, with justifiable pride, that only four lives were lost, and only one due to an illness caught before leaving England.

Once more the scurvy was defeated; and, without a doubt, owing to the intelligent action and untiring supervision of the captain. He gives a full description of the measures adopted, and while giving full acknowledgment to the anti-scorbutics with which he was supplied, he is of opinion that the general sanitary precautions formed the best prevention. Cleanliness of persons, bedding, clothes, and ship, were continually enforced. All these were foreign to the sailors of the time, and extraordinary it is that it was a man born in the lower rank of life, and brought up in a collier, who had the sense to perceive that in these lay the surest preventatives against this paralysing scourge.

Once again, scurvy was overcome, and without a doubt, thanks to the smart actions and relentless supervision of the captain. He provides a detailed account of the measures taken, and while he fully credits the anti-scorbutics he received, he believes the overall sanitary precautions were the best prevention. Cleanliness for people, bedding, clothes, and the ship was constantly enforced. All of this was unfamiliar to the sailors of that time, and it's remarkable that a man born into a lower class and raised in a coal ship was smart enough to recognize that these practices were the most effective safeguards against this debilitating disease.

Cook was promoted to captain--a proud position for the collier boy--and elected a Fellow of the Royal Society; perhaps even a greater distinction for a man of his bringing up. He contributed papers on his methods of preventing scurvy, and on the tides of the Pacific.

Cook was promoted to captain—a proud position for a coal miner—and elected a Fellow of the Royal Society; possibly even a greater honor for someone from his background. He wrote papers on his methods for preventing scurvy and on the tides of the Pacific.

He also employed himself in publishing the account of his recent voyage, the only one which he himself edited.

He also focused on publishing the account of his recent voyage, the only one that he edited himself.

He was not, however, long at rest. The Admiralty wished to send an expedition to explore the north-western coasts of North America, and to examine the Polar Sea from the Bering Straits side, with a view of the discovery of a north-west passage. Cook seems to have volunteered for the command without being actually asked, and, needless to say, was at once accepted.

He didn't stay inactive for long. The Admiralty wanted to send a team to explore the northwestern coasts of North America and to investigate the Polar Sea from the Bering Straits to find a northwest passage. Cook appears to have volunteered for the command without being officially asked, and, of course, he was immediately accepted.

In February he once more received his commission to command the Resolution, this time accompanied by the Discovery, a vessel very similar to the Adventure, his consort during the last voyage. Clerke, a master's mate in the Endeavour, and second lieutenant in the Resolution, was appointed as commander to the Discovery. He, like Cook, was fated not to return from this third journey to the great Pacific.

In February, he received his commission again to command the Resolution, this time along with the Discovery, a ship very similar to the Adventure, which had been his partner during the last voyage. Clerke, a master's mate on the Endeavour and the second lieutenant on the Resolution, was named the commander of the Discovery. Like Cook, he was destined not to return from this third journey to the vast Pacific.

Others who had sailed with Cook before were ready to accompany him, once more to encounter privations and find new lands.

Others who had sailed with Cook before were eager to join him again to face challenges and discover new territories.

Cook's orders were long and detailed, but were to the effect that he was to proceed by way of the Cape of Good Hope to search in the Indian Ocean for the land recently seen by M. Kerguelen; thence via Tahiti, on to the coast of North America in about latitude 45 degrees, which he was to follow to latitude 65 degrees, searching especially for any channel which might lead to the north-east, as it was supposed there might be a passage communicating with Hudson's Bay. He was further to look for any passage north of North America to the Atlantic, and to make such other explorations as might seem fit to him. A money reward of 20,000 pounds was also offered in case of success in finding such a passage.

Cook's instructions were long and detailed, but essentially, he was to travel around the Cape of Good Hope to search the Indian Ocean for the land recently spotted by M. Kerguelen; from there, he was to head to Tahiti, and then to the coast of North America around latitude 45 degrees, which he was to follow up to latitude 65 degrees, particularly looking for any channel that might lead to the northeast, as there was thought to be a passage connecting to Hudson's Bay. He was also to search for any route north of North America to the Atlantic and conduct any other explorations he deemed necessary. A reward of £20,000 was also offered if he successfully found such a passage.

Chronometers were again carried, and more confidence in them being felt, more use was made of them.

Chronometers were carried again, and since there was more confidence in them, they were used more often.

Cook took with him Omai, a young Society islander, who had induced Captain Furneaux to take him to England, and whom Cook now engaged to return to his native country.

Cook took Omai, a young islander from the Society Islands, with him. Omai had persuaded Captain Furneaux to bring him to England, and now Cook was set to send him back to his homeland.

The ships sailed on July 11th, 1776, and arrived at Table Bay on October 18th.

The ships set sail on July 11, 1776, and reached Table Bay on October 18.

Sailing thence on November 30th, he passed and roughly mapped Prince Edward's, Marion, and Croset's Islands, all of which had been discovered by Marion de Fresne. He then struck Kerguelen's Land, spent Christmas Day in one of its harbours, and mapped the eastern side of this large but desolate island. He was unaware that Kerguelen had visited this island a second time, and had gained much more information about it than he did in his first voyage.

Sailing from there on November 30th, he passed by and roughly mapped Prince Edward's, Marion, and Croset's Islands, all of which had been discovered by Marion de Fresne. He then reached Kerguelen's Land, spent Christmas Day in one of its harbors, and mapped the eastern side of this large but barren island. He didn't know that Kerguelen had visited this island a second time and had gathered much more information about it than he did on his first voyage.

Cook had taken on board at the Cape as many cattle, horses, bulls, cows, goats, and sheep as he could stow, with a view of landing them at Tahiti or elsewhere, and it is without surprise that we learn that after several weeks in these stormy seas a good many of them had died. When we consider the size of the ships the wonder is where they found room for these animals.

Cook had loaded as many cattle, horses, bulls, cows, goats, and sheep as he could fit at the Cape, planning to unload them at Tahiti or elsewhere. It's not surprising to hear that after several weeks in these rough seas, many of them had died. Considering the size of the ships, it's amazing to think about where they found space for all these animals.

On January 26th the ships arrived in Tasmania, and anchored in Adventure Bay, principally with a view of getting fodder for the remaining cattle. Pigs were left here, according to Cook's usual custom.

On January 26th, the ships arrived in Tasmania and anchored in Adventure Bay, mainly to gather feed for the remaining cattle. Pigs were left here, as was Cook's usual practice.

After four days the ships sailed, and arrived in Queen Charlotte's Sound, New Zealand, on February 12th, 1777. Here Cook learnt the history of the attack on the Adventure's boat's crew from the chief who led it, but made no attempt at reprisals, although urged by many other natives to kill him. He seems to have been guided by the consideration that, as related by the natives, it was a dishonest act of barter on the part of one of the sailors which commenced the disturbance; and that occurring so long before, no good purpose would be served by punishment. It says much for his humane treatment of natives.

After four days, the ships set sail and arrived in Queen Charlotte's Sound, New Zealand, on February 12, 1777. Here, Cook learned about the attack on the Adventure's boat crew from the chief who led it, but he made no attempt to retaliate, even when urged by many other locals to kill him. He seemed to believe that, according to the natives, it was a dishonest trade by one of the sailors that sparked the conflict, and since that had happened so long ago, punishing the chief wouldn't serve any good purpose. This reflects well on his humane treatment of the natives.

On leaving this, Cook records that he had at different times left about a dozen pigs in New Zealand. These increased, and stocked the whole island by the time the English settlers arrived.

On leaving this, Cook notes that he had, at various times, left around a dozen pigs in New Zealand. These multiplied and populated the entire island by the time the English settlers arrived.

On the way to Tahiti Cook fell across several islands belonging to what was afterwards called after him, the Cook Group. He visited Mangaia, Atiu, Takutea,* (* Spelt by Cook Mangeea, Wateeo, and Otakootaia.) and the Hervey Islands. Relations were established with the natives, and Cook was much interested at finding on Atiu three natives of the Society Islands, the survivors of twelve, who had been blown away in a canoe, and landed on this island, five hundred miles distant. As he remarks, this throws great light on the manner in which the different islands of the Pacific have been peopled.

On the way to Tahiti, Cook came across several islands that were later named the Cook Group after him. He visited Mangaia, Atiu, Takutea,* (* Spelled by Cook Mangeea, Wateeo, and Otakootaia.) and the Hervey Islands. He established relationships with the locals and was very interested to find three natives from the Society Islands on Atiu, who were the last survivors of twelve people blown off course in a canoe and who ended up on this island, five hundred miles away. As he noted, this provides important insight into how the various islands of the Pacific were populated.

Cook now made up his mind that he was too late to prosecute discovery this year on the American Continent, it being well into April, and being anxious to save the remaining cattle that he wished to land at Tahiti, and which had been taken on board especially for this purpose, the island being still far to windward, he bore away for the Friendly Islands for fodder and refreshments. He landed on Palmerston on the way--an island discovered last voyage--and arrived at Namuka* (* Cook's Anamooka.) on May 1st, with not a sick man in the ships.

Cook decided he was too late to start exploration this year on the American continent, since it was already well into April. Wanting to save the remaining cattle he aimed to take to Tahiti—which had been specifically brought on board for that purpose, with the island still far upwind—he headed for the Friendly Islands to find fodder and refreshments. He made a stop at Palmerston on the way, an island he had discovered during his last voyage, and arrived at Namuka (*Cook's Anamooka*) on May 1st, with all his crew in good health.

The ships remained in the Friendly Group for two months and a half, visiting and mapping the different islands, and learning much of the manners of this interesting race, seeing their great concerted dances, and the ceremonies of coming of age of the heir to the throne. Cook here first became acquainted with the mysterious rite of Tabu, which was closely connected with his own death. A selection of useful animals, including horses, were left at Tongatabu.

The ships stayed in the Friendly Group for two and a half months, visiting and mapping the different islands, and learning a lot about the customs of this fascinating culture, witnessing their impressive group dances and the coming-of-age ceremonies for the heir to the throne. It was here that Cook first learned about the mysterious rite of Tabu, which was linked to his own death. A selection of useful animals, including horses, was left at Tongatabu.

While at the Friendly Islands Cook heard of the Fiji Group, and saw some of the natives, who had come over in a canoe. The intelligence he was able to gather concerning them was imperfect, and he saw no reason to justify a long detour to leeward to search for them, when his object was to stock the Society Islands with the animals he had. Had he known their size and importance, his course might possibly have been different. As it was, he sailed for Tahiti, and discovering Tubuai, one of the Austral Group, on his passage, arrived there on August 13th, 1777.

While at the Friendly Islands, Cook heard about the Fiji Group and met some of the locals who had come over in a canoe. The information he was able to gather about them was incomplete, and he saw no reason to take a long detour to the south to search for them when his goal was to stock the Society Islands with the animals he had. If he had known their size and significance, he might have chosen a different route. As it was, he sailed for Tahiti and, on the way, discovered Tubuai, one of the Austral Group, arriving there on August 13th, 1777.

Six weeks were spent here, and the old friendships further cemented. Bulls and cows and other animals were presented to the king. Cook also attended at several ceremonies consequent on war being declared against Eimeo, which included the offering of the dead body of a man, previously killed for the purpose, to the war god. He positively refused to aid in this war, which very shortly came to an end.

Six weeks were spent here, and old friendships were strengthened even more. Bulls, cows, and other animals were given to the king. Cook also attended several ceremonies following the declaration of war against Eimeo, which included the offering of a man’s dead body, previously killed for this purpose, to the war god. He firmly refused to participate in this war, which ended very soon after.

Eimeo was next visited, and here the theft of a goat, which Cook intended to land at Huaheine, induced him to take severe measures to get it back. Several war canoes and houses were destroyed before it was returned. At Huaheine, Omai was established, with many valuable European articles in his possession. Here again Cook acted with considerable severity in the case of a thief cutting off his ears, and confining him on board. His action has been questioned, but considering his humane character, and the judgment that he always displayed in these questions, we are justified in believing that he had good reason for departing from his ordinary custom of mild treatment of natives. At Ulietea, or Raiatea, next visited, a midshipman and a seaman of the Discovery deserted. Cook took his usual step of confining some natives of importance, and informing their relatives that they would be retained until the deserters were returned. In this case he impounded the king's son and daughter, with the desired effect, as the stragglers were soon brought back from Bolabola, whither they had gone; but both Cook and Captain Clerke were nearly captured by the natives when on shore in the interval.

Eimeo was the next stop, and here the theft of a goat, which Cook planned to deliver to Huaheine, prompted him to take drastic action to get it back. Several war canoes and houses were destroyed before it was returned. At Huaheine, Omai was set up with many valuable European items in his possession. Once again, Cook acted quite harshly in response to a thief, having his ears cut off and confining him on board. His actions have been criticized, but given his compassionate nature and the judgment he typically displayed in such matters, we can believe he had valid reasons for deviating from his usual approach of treating the natives kindly. At Ulietea, or Raiatea, the next stop, a midshipman and a crew member from the Discovery deserted. Cook took his usual measure of detaining some important locals and informing their families that they would be kept until the deserters returned. In this instance, he detained the king's son and daughter, which proved effective, as the deserters were quickly brought back from Bolabola, where they had gone; however, both Cook and Captain Clerke were nearly captured by the natives while they were on shore in the meantime.

It is only surprising that more of Cook's people did not attempt to remain in these pleasant islands. The hardships of the sea press much on certain natures, and the allurements of the easy and careless life of a tropical island offered such a contrast, that it scarcely required the desire of the natives to get white men with their superior knowledge, and above all superior arms, to remain with them, to induce them to desert. This last, however, made desertion more easy, and had not Cook taken strong measures, no doubt the epidemic would have spread.

It's surprising that more of Cook's crew didn't try to stay in these beautiful islands. The challenges of life at sea can be tough for some people, and the tempting, laid-back lifestyle of a tropical island was such a stark contrast that it hardly needed the natives' encouragement for white men, with their better knowledge and, most importantly, superior weapons, to choose to stay. However, this made it easier for them to abandon ship, and had Cook not taken strong action, the situation would likely have gotten out of hand.

After visiting Bolabola, Cook sailed north, to prosecute the main object of his voyage, the exploration of the north-west coast of America. On December 24th he fell in with Christmas Island, which he so named from the season. After mapping it, and getting many turtle, he continued his course to the north, and discovered Atooi or Kauai, the western island of the Sandwich Group.

After visiting Bolabola, Cook sailed north to pursue the main goal of his voyage, which was to explore the north-west coast of America. On December 24th, he encountered Christmas Island, which he named after the holiday. After mapping the island and catching a lot of turtles, he continued north and discovered Atooi, or Kauai, the western island of the Sandwich Group.

Communicating with this island and another, he finally left on February 3rd, 1778, and on March 7th made the coast of North America, a little south of the Columbia River. Gales ensued, and Cook missed the entrance of Juan de Fuca Strait, making the land again a little north of it.

Communicating with this island and another, he finally departed on February 3rd, 1778, and on March 7th reached the coast of North America, just south of the Columbia River. Strong winds followed, and Cook missed the entrance to Juan de Fuca Strait, making land again a bit north of it.

Anchoring first in Nootka Sound in Vancouver Island--though Cook did not know it was an island--the ships continued their exploration to the north-west, skirting the coast as near as stormy weather permitted them, and calling at various places until the north-west extremity of the Alaska Peninsula was reached. In one place, afterwards called Cook's River, it was hoped that the desired passage eastward was found; but it was soon discovered that it was merely an inlet.

Anchoring first in Nootka Sound on Vancouver Island—although Cook didn’t realize it was an island—the ships continued their exploration northwest, hugging the coast as closely as the stormy weather allowed, and stopping at various locations until they reached the northwest tip of the Alaska Peninsula. In one spot, later named Cook's River, they hoped they had found the sought-after passage eastward; however, it was soon revealed that it was just an inlet.

Passing through the Aleutian Chain, east of Unalaska, Cook visited that island, and continued his voyage through the Bering Sea, clinging to the land as much as possible, and finally got into Bering Strait. Here he had both continents in sight, and communicated with both sides.

Passing through the Aleutian Chain, east of Unalaska, Cook visited that island and continued his journey through the Bering Sea, staying close to the land as much as he could, and eventually reached the Bering Strait. Here, he could see both continents and communicated with both sides.

Standing further north, he, in latitude 70 degrees 30 minutes north, came across the icy barrier of the Arctic Sea. After vainly trying for a passage in fog and strong wind, surrounded by loose ice, and after mapping a good deal of the shores on both sides, the ships again turned south at the end of August, exploring as they went first on the Asiatic side, and afterwards on the American, especially examining Norton Sound. In the beginning of October they once more arrived at Unalaska, and the Resolution having sprung a dangerous leak, the opportunity was taken to stop it.

Standing further north, at latitude 70 degrees 30 minutes north, he encountered the icy barrier of the Arctic Sea. After unsuccessfully attempting to find a passage through fog and strong winds, surrounded by loose ice, and after mapping much of the coastline on both sides, the ships turned back south at the end of August, exploring first along the Asian side and then the American side, particularly examining Norton Sound. At the beginning of October, they arrived back at Unalaska, and with the Resolution having developed a dangerous leak, they took the opportunity to fix it.

On October 26th the ships sailed for the Sandwich Islands, where Cook had determined to winter, for the double purpose of refreshing his crew, gaining more knowledge of the Group, and being in a convenient position for resuming his exploration in the spring.

On October 26th, the ships set sail for the Sandwich Islands, where Cook planned to spend the winter. His goals were to refresh his crew, learn more about the islands, and be well-positioned to continue his exploration in the spring.

The voyage just accomplished was very remarkable, whether for the amount of coast mapped, which extended for between three and four thousand miles, or for the determination with which it was prosecuted in tempestuous and thick weather, on a most dangerous and inhospitable coast, part of the time in ice. The crews were perfectly healthy, with no sign of scurvy, and he brought both his ships off without any damage.

The recent voyage was quite impressive, both for the distance covered—between three and four thousand miles of coast mapped—and for the determination shown in rough and bad weather along a very dangerous and unwelcoming coastline, some of which was icy. The crews were in excellent health, showing no signs of scurvy, and he returned both ships without any damage.

Maui, another of the Sandwich Group, was made on November 26th, and after communicating, the ships stood over to Owhyhee (Hawaii). Wind was against them, and it was not until January 17th that the two ships, having passed along the north side of the island to the eastward, at last anchored in Kealakekua Bay, on the south-west side.

Maui, another island in the Sandwich Group, was made on November 26th, and after communicating, the ships headed over to Owhyhee (Hawaii). The wind was against them, and it wasn't until January 17th that the two ships, after passing along the north side of the island to the east, finally anchored in Kealakekua Bay, on the southwest side.

The events which followed the arrival of the ships at Hawaii, which terminated in Captain Cook's death, were not understood at the time, but have been elucidated by the inquiries of the early missionaries, which throw much light upon the beliefs of the islanders.

The events that happened after the arrival of the ships in Hawaii, which ended with Captain Cook's death, weren't fully understood at the time. However, the investigations by the early missionaries have clarified these events and shed a lot of light on the beliefs of the islanders.

It appears that a tradition existed that a chief of earlier times, one Rono, Orono, or Lono (the R and the L in the Pacific languages are almost interchangeable), had, after killing his wife, become frantically insane, and after travelling through the islands boxing and wrestling with all he met, had departed in a canoe, prophesying that he would some day return in an island with trees, hogs, and dogs. He was deified, and temples erected in his honour.

It seems that there was a tradition about an ancient chief named Rono, Orono, or Lono (the R and the L in Pacific languages are almost interchangeable) who, after killing his wife, went into a frenzy and lost his mind. After roaming the islands, boxing and wrestling with everyone he encountered, he left in a canoe, predicting that he would one day return on an island filled with trees, pigs, and dogs. He was worshiped as a god, and temples were built in his honor.

When Cook's ships arrived it was believed that the prophecy was fulfilled. Rono had returned as he had said, and the natives flocked to do him honour. When Cook landed he was received with adoration, the crowds prostrating themselves, and the priests escorting him with much ceremony. Led to a temple, he was clothed with red cloth, had pigs offered to him, and was generally treated in a manner which, though satisfactory as showing the friendly feelings of the natives, was puzzling to the Europeans. This continued throughout their stay, presents of all kinds being showered upon them. The officers, however, observed that the warrior chiefs were not so enthusiastic as the priests and common people. The death of a seaman, who was buried on shore in the presence of a large concourse, would seem to have been the first circumstance that threw doubts upon the godlike character of the visitors; but the ready way in which the fence of a Morai or sacred inclosure, which included various images, was granted for fuel, shows that the priests still held to their idea. The king, Taraiopu (or Terreooboo, as his name was written by Captain King), arrived shortly after the ships anchored, and showed himself to be as much impressed with the public belief as any of his subjects.

When Cook's ships arrived, people believed the prophecy had been fulfilled. Rono had returned as promised, and the natives came to honor him. When Cook landed, he was welcomed with adoration, with crowds bowing down and priests escorting him with great ceremony. He was taken to a temple, dressed in red cloth, had pigs offered to him, and was treated in a way that, although it showed the natives' friendly feelings, puzzled the Europeans. This continued throughout their stay, with gifts of all kinds given to them. However, the officers noticed that the warrior chiefs were not as enthusiastic as the priests and common people. The death of a seaman, who was buried onshore in front of a large crowd, seemed to be the first event that raised doubts about the godlike status of the visitors. But the way the fence of a Morai, or sacred enclosure that contained various images, was willingly given for fuel shows that the priests still believed in their idea. The king, Taraiopu (or Terreooboo, as Captain King wrote it), arrived shortly after the ships anchored and seemed just as impressed with the public belief as any of his subjects.

Thus matters continued during the eighteen days the ships remained; but towards the end of this time the natives began to show anxiety that they should be gone. The drain of hogs and other provisions, which were poured upon the visitors, doubtless led to anxious thoughts as to how long this was to last; and probably those members of the community who were less amenable to the influence of the priests, and were jealous of their own authority, were by no means so certain that the popular opinion of the supernatural nature of the white men was correct.

Thus, things went on for the eighteen days the ships stayed; however, by the end of this period, the locals started to worry that they would leave. The large supply of pigs and other food given to the visitors likely led to concerns about how much longer this would continue; and probably those in the community who were less influenced by the priests and were protective of their own power were not convinced that the general belief in the supernatural nature of the white men was accurate.

The ships sailed on February 4th, but, as ill-luck had it, the Resolution sprung her foremast in a gale, and Cook resolved to return to Kealakekua Bay for repairs. Here they again anchored on the 11th.

The ships set sail on February 4th, but unfortunately, the Resolution lost its foremast in a storm, and Cook decided to head back to Kealakekua Bay for repairs. They anchored there again on the 11th.

Their reception was, however, very different.

Their reception was, however, quite different.

No crowd of canoes round the ship; no enthusiastic mass of natives on shore. Everything was silence.

No crowd of canoes around the ship; no excited group of locals on the shore. Everything was silent.

What had happened was that the king had departed, leaving the bay under "tabu," i.e., a sacred interdict.

What happened was that the king left, placing the bay under "tabu," meaning a sacred ban.

The priests, however, received them with as much friendliness as before, and the Morai was given up to them as a place of repairs for the damaged mast.

The priests, however, welcomed them just as warmly as before, and the Morai was handed over to them as a place to fix the damaged mast.

The king hurried back on hearing of the return of the ships, and removed the tabu; but the native disposition was changed. Some of the party on shore had persuaded women to break the tabu.

The king hurried back upon hearing that the ships had returned and lifted the ban; however, the attitude of the locals had shifted. Some people on the shore had convinced women to break the ban.

Whether this affected relations is uncertain, but the inhabitants generally exhibited considerable hostility, and headed by some chiefs, showed an inclination to attack a watering party. Thefts followed, and the capture of a canoe as a reprisal caused a scuffle on the beach, in which the Englishmen were worsted by the crowd, though a friendly chief soon restored order.

Whether this affected relations is uncertain, but the locals generally showed a lot of hostility, and led by a few chiefs, they seemed ready to attack a group getting water. Thefts happened, and when a canoe was captured in retaliation, it led to a fight on the beach, in which the Englishmen were overpowered by the crowd, though a friendly chief quickly intervened to restore order.

Instructions were now given to the party on shore at the Morai to permit no natives to approach in the night, and a musket was fired at one of them who came near.

Instructions were now given to the group on shore at the Morai to allow no natives to come close during the night, and a musket was fired at one of them who approached.

On the morning of February 14th the Discovery's cutter was found to have been stolen.

On the morning of February 14th, the Discovery's small boat was discovered to be missing.

Cook at once decided to have recourse to his usual practice, and get either the king or some principal chief on board, as a hostage till it was returned. He at the same time gave orders to prevent any canoes from leaving the bay, in order that he might, if necessary, seize them, and sent his boats to carry this out. Guns were fired from the ships at two large canoes that attempted to pass. Cook himself landed with a small armed force, and went in search of the king, who at once consented to come on board. The conduct of Taraiopu throughout showed that he had perfect confidence in Cook, and was entirely friendly, whether he still believed in the Rono theory or not.

Cook immediately decided to stick to his usual approach and either get the king or some important chief on board as a hostage until it was returned. At the same time, he ordered that no canoes be allowed to leave the bay so he could seize them if necessary, and sent his boats to enforce this. The ships fired guns at two large canoes that tried to pass by. Cook himself landed with a small armed force and went in search of the king, who readily agreed to come on board. Taraiopu's behavior throughout showed that he had complete trust in Cook and was entirely friendly, whether or not he still believed in the Rono theory.

While walking down to the boat, the natives, who were momentarily increasing in numbers, implored the king not to go. His wife joined her entreaties. Taraiopu hesitated. At this moment a man ran up and cried, "It is war; they have killed a chief!" One of the guard boats had, in fact, fired at a canoe attempting to leave the bay, and killed a man. The natives at once ran to arms, and Cook, seeing his intentions frustrated, walked towards the boat. A native attacked him with a spear, and Cook shot him with his gun. Still, no further attack was made, but the men in the boats hearing Cook's shot, and seeing the excited crowd, commenced to fire without orders. Cook still moved to the shore, calling to his men to cease firing; but whilst so doing, and with his back to the exasperated natives, he was stabbed in the back with a dagger, and fell with his face in the water.

While walking down to the boat, the natives, who were quickly gathering in larger numbers, begged the king not to go. His wife joined in the pleas. Taraiopu hesitated. Just then, a man ran up and shouted, "It's war; they’ve killed a chief!" One of the guard boats had indeed fired on a canoe trying to leave the bay, resulting in a death. The natives instantly went to grab their weapons, and seeing his plans thwarted, Cook walked toward the boat. A native attacked him with a spear, and Cook shot him with his gun. Still, there was no further attack, but the men in the boats, hearing Cook’s gunshot and seeing the agitated crowd, started firing without orders. Cook continued moving to the shore, calling for his men to stop shooting; however, while doing so, with his back turned to the angry natives, he was stabbed in the back with a dagger and fell face-first into the water.

There was then general confusion. The boats were a little way from the beach, and several of the marines were also killed, before they could reach them. Cook's body was at once dragged off by the natives.

There was a lot of confusion. The boats were a short distance from the beach, and several of the marines were killed before they could get to them. The natives quickly dragged Cook's body away.

The boats returned on board amid general consternation, and it is mentioned that a general silence reigned on board when it was known that their beloved commander had fallen.

The boats came back on board to widespread shock, and it was noted that a heavy silence fell over the ship when news broke that their beloved commander had fallen.

The party at the Morai were shortly after attacked, but beat off the assailants, and reinforcements were sent from the ships. Lieutenant King, a favourite officer of Cook's, behaved with great discretion, and assisted by some of the priests, made a truce, during which the mast and other articles on shore for repairs were got off.

The party at Morai was soon attacked but managed to fend off the attackers, and reinforcements were dispatched from the ships. Lieutenant King, a favored officer of Cook's, acted with great caution and, with the help of some of the priests, negotiated a truce during which the mast and other items on shore for repairs were retrieved.

The sailors were mad for reprisals, but Captain Clerke, on whom the command devolved, decided on pacific measures, and every attempt was made to recover Cook's body. All that was obtained, however, were some of his bones, which were brought down with much solemnity by a chief, and delivered wrapped up in new cloth and red feathers.

The sailors were eager for revenge, but Captain Clerke, who took over command, chose to pursue peaceful actions, and every effort was made to retrieve Cook's body. However, all that was recovered were some of his bones, which were brought down with great seriousness by a chief and presented wrapped in new cloth and red feathers.

It was known in after years that Cook's body had been instantly cut up; the flesh was burnt, as was the custom with great chiefs and many of the bones were preserved with great honour in a Morai dedicated to Rono.

It was later learned that Cook's body had been immediately dismembered; the flesh was burned, as was the tradition for great chiefs, and many of the bones were preserved with great honor in a Morai dedicated to Rono.

It seems clear that Cook's death was due to a revulsion of feeling on the part of some of the natives, who no longer believed in his divine character, but that many regarded the outrage with horror. When the first Europeans came to reside on the island, and learnt the story from the native side, they found universal regret prevailing at this untoward occurrence.

It’s obvious that Cook’s death was caused by a backlash from some of the locals, who no longer saw him as a god, though many were horrified by what happened. When the first Europeans settled on the island and heard the locals' version of events, they found a widespread sense of regret about this unfortunate incident.

Cook left officers imbued with his own noble sentiments. No general attack was made in revenge for what they saw was the result of misunderstanding, although they were ignorant of the exact circumstances which led, first to the uncommon and extraordinary veneration with which he had been treated, and then to the sudden change in the native behaviour.

Cook left the officers filled with his own noble feelings. No all-out attack was launched in retaliation for what they believed was the outcome of a misunderstanding, even though they were unaware of the specific circumstances that led, first to the extraordinary respect he had received, and then to the abrupt shift in the natives' behavior.

It was found necessary to fire on the natives who prevented the watering party from working, and some of the sailors on this duty burnt some houses; but before the ships left, friendly relations were again established, and many natives visited them.

It became necessary to open fire on the locals who were stopping the watering crew from doing their job, and some of the sailors on this mission set some houses on fire; however, before the ships departed, friendly relations were reestablished, and many locals came to visit them.

After Cook's remains had been committed to the sea, the prosecution of the voyage was determined upon, although Captain Clerke was in the last stage of consumption, and as soon as the Resolution's mast could be repaired, the two vessels once more departed, on February 22nd, 1779.

After Cook's remains were laid to rest at sea, it was decided to continue the voyage, even though Captain Clerke was gravely ill with tuberculosis. As soon as the Resolution's mast was fixed, the two ships set sail again on February 22nd, 1779.

Cook's intentions were carried out as if he had still been in command. The remainder of the Sandwich Group was mapped, and the ships proceeded once more to the north. Calling at Petropavlovsk in Avatcha Bay, Kamtchatka, they again passed through Bering Strait, and sought in vain for a passage either to the north-east or north-west, being everywhere baffled by dense masses of ice. Captain Clerke at last abandoned the struggle, and repassed Bering Strait on his way south on August 1st.

Cook's plans were executed as if he were still in charge. The rest of the Sandwich Group was charted, and the ships headed north again. They stopped at Petropavlovsk in Avatcha Bay, Kamchatka, then passed through Bering Strait again, searching in vain for a route to the northeast or northwest, constantly thwarted by thick ice. Captain Clerke finally gave up the attempt and re-crossed Bering Strait on his way south on August 1st.

On August 22nd Captain Clerke died.

On August 22nd, Captain Clerke passed away.

This officer had accompanied Captain Cook in all his voyages, and had also circumnavigated the globe in the Dolphin with Captain Byron before. No man had seen more of the Pacific, and he proved himself, during his short period of command, a worthy successor of Cook.

This officer had joined Captain Cook on all his voyages and had also sailed around the world on the Dolphin with Captain Byron before that. No one had experienced more of the Pacific, and he demonstrated, during his brief time in command, that he was a deserving successor to Cook.

Captain Gore, who had been with Cook on his First Voyage, now succeeded, King being put as Commander into the Discovery, and the two ships made the best of their way home, via Macao and the Straits of Sunda, arriving at the Nore on October 4th, 1780, after an absence of four years and two months. During the whole of this voyage not the slightest symptom of scurvy appeared in either ship, so completely were Cook's precautions successful.

Captain Gore, who had sailed with Cook on his First Voyage, took over command. King was assigned as the Commander of the Discovery, and the two ships made their way home, passing through Macao and the Straits of Sunda, arriving at the Nore on October 4th, 1780, after being away for four years and two months. Throughout the entire voyage, there was not a single sign of scurvy in either ship, which showed just how effective Cook's precautions were.

Cook had six children. Three died young. Of the others, all boys, the eldest, James, entered the Navy, and lived to be a Commander, when, in 1794, he was drowned. The second, Nathaniel, also in the Navy, was lost in a hurricane in 1780. The third died when at Cambridge. They none of them lived to be married, and no descendant of the great navigator has perpetuated his race.

Cook had six children. Three died young. Of the others, all boys, the eldest, James, joined the Navy and eventually became a Commander, but drowned in 1794. The second, Nathaniel, also served in the Navy and was lost during a hurricane in 1780. The third died while studying at Cambridge. None of them lived to get married, and no descendants of the great navigator have continued his lineage.

Of Cook's private life during his brief intervals at home we know nothing. A man rising from the ranks, and of his reserved character, would have but few friends, when he had such short time to make them in his new sphere. He lived at Mile End when at home, but after his death his widow removed to Clapham, living there for forty years, at first with her cousin, Isaac Smith, who had served with Cook in the Endeavour and Resolution. She died in 1835, at the great age of ninety-three.

Of Cook's private life during his short breaks at home, we don't know much. A man who came from humble beginnings and had a reserved personality would have had only a few friends, especially with such little time to form them in his new environment. He lived in Mile End when he was home, but after he passed away, his wife moved to Clapham, where she lived for forty years, initially with her cousin, Isaac Smith, who had served with Cook on the Endeavour and Resolution. She died in 1835, at the impressive age of ninety-three.

Of Cook's character, none could be a better judge than Captain King, who writes as follows, after describing his death:--

Of Cook's character, no one could judge better than Captain King, who writes the following after describing his death:--

"Thus fell our great and excellent commander. After a life of so much distinguished and successful enterprise, his death, as far as regards himself, cannot be considered premature, since he lived to finish the great work for which he seems to have been designed. How sincerely his loss was felt and lamented, by those who had so long found their general security in his skill and conduct, and every consolation in their hardships in his tenderness and humanity, it is neither necessary nor possible for me to describe. The constitution of his body was robust, inured to labour, and capable of undergoing the severest hardships. His stomach bore without difficulty the coarsest and most ungrateful food. Indeed, temperance with him was scarcely a virtue, so great was the indifference with which he submitted to every kind of self-denial. The qualities of his mind were of the same hardy, vigorous kind with those of his body. His understanding was strong and perspicacious. His judgment in whatever related to the service he was engaged in quick and sure. His designs were bold and manly, and both in the conception and in the mode of execution bore evident marks of a great original genius. His courage was cool and determined, and accompanied by an admirable presence of mind in the moment of danger. His manners were plain and unaffected. His temper might, perhaps, have been justly blamed as subject to haughtiness and passion, had not these been disarmed by a disposition the most benevolent and humane. Those intervals of recreation, which sometimes unavoidably occurred, and were looked for by us with a longing that persons who have experienced the fatigues of service will readily excuse, were submitted to by him with a certain impatience whenever they could not be employed in making further provision for the more effectual prosecution of his designs."

"Thus fell our great and excellent commander. After a life filled with remarkable and successful endeavors, his death, in terms of himself, cannot be considered premature since he lived to complete the great work for which he seemed to be meant. How deeply his loss was felt and mourned by those who had long relied on his skill and leadership for their safety, and found solace in their struggles through his kindness and compassion, is something I cannot fully express. His body was strong, accustomed to hard work, and able to withstand the harshest challenges. He could handle the coarsest and least appetizing food without trouble. In fact, being moderate in his eating was almost not a virtue, as he showed great indifference to all forms of self-denial. The qualities of his mind were just as resilient and vigorous as those of his body. His understanding was sharp and insightful. His judgment in matters related to his service was quick and reliable. His plans were bold and courageous, and both in their conception and execution showed clear signs of a great original genius. His bravery was calm and resolute, accompanied by an impressive presence of mind in moments of danger. His demeanor was straightforward and unpretentious. His temperament might have been justifiably criticized as prone to arrogance and anger if these traits hadn’t been tempered by a deeply benevolent and kind nature. Those moments of leisure, which sometimes unavoidably occurred, and which we eagerly anticipated—something those who have felt the strains of service can easily understand—were met by him with a certain impatience whenever they couldn’t be used to further prepare for the more effective pursuit of his goals."

This is a pretty complete picture, and of a great man; a man who had before him continually his duty, and who had in an eminent degree the capacity to carry it out.

This is a pretty complete picture of a great man; a man who constantly faced his duty and had a remarkable ability to fulfill it.

Though, under his determination to do this, he drove his people hard; though he tried them with his irascibility; their conviction of his greatness, their confidence in his leadership and in his justice, led them to love him. He had no sympathy with the ordinary foibles and weaknesses of his men. The charms of Tahiti, the paradise of the sailor, were no charms for him; he hardly notices the attractive ladies of that island; the attractions of the place to him were the abundance of provisions, as a means of fitting his expedition for further exploration and hardship. The strongest proof of his capacity as a commander is the devotion of his officers. Those who know the Navy know how difficult it is for any man who rises from the ranks to be successful in command. But Cook was a gentleman born; he had the intuition of great minds for fitting themselves to every position to which they may rise, and there is never a whisper of disinclination to submit to the rule of the once collier boy, the son of a labourer.

Though he was determined to achieve his goals, he pushed his crew hard; even with his irritability, their belief in his greatness and their trust in his leadership and fairness made them love him. He had no patience for the usual faults and weaknesses of his men. The allure of Tahiti, the sailor's paradise, held no appeal for him; he scarcely noticed the attractive women on that island; to him, the attractions were the plentiful food supplies, essential for preparing his expedition for more exploration and challenges. The strongest evidence of his capability as a leader is the loyalty of his officers. Those familiar with the Navy understand how tough it is for anyone to rise through the ranks and succeed in command. But Cook was born a gentleman; he had the intuition of great minds to adapt to any position he attained, and there was never any hint of reluctance to follow the orders of the former coal miner, the son of a laborer.

His intelligence is remarkably shown in his greatest triumph, the suppression of scurvy. That it should be left to a man of little education to discern the combination of means by which this enemy of long voyages could be conquered, is the most remarkable thing about this remarkable man. He himself notices the disinclination of the sailor to any new article of food, especially when not particularly palatable; but he soon found the means to induce them to understand that their lives greatly depended upon these rather nasty messes. Sour krout; the unsavoury portable soups of that day; the strange greens that Cook insisted on hunting up at every land he visited, and boiling with their ordinary food; the constant washing between decks; the drying below with stoves, even in the hottest weather; the personal baths; the change of wet clothing; the airing of bedding, were all foreign and repugnant to the notions of the seamen of the day, and it required constant supervision and wise management to enforce the adoption of these odd foods and customs.

His intelligence is vividly demonstrated in his greatest achievement: eliminating scurvy. The fact that a man with little education was the one to figure out how to defeat this major issue for long sea journeys is the most impressive aspect of this extraordinary individual. He noticed that sailors were resistant to trying new foods, especially if they didn't taste great; however, he quickly found a way to make them realize that their lives depended on these unappealing dishes. Sauerkraut, the unappetizing portable soups of that time, the unusual greens that Cook insisted on gathering at every port and cooking with their usual meals, the regular cleaning between decks, drying out below with stoves even in the warmest weather, personal baths, changing out of wet clothes, and airing out bedding were all strange and off-putting to the sailors of his time. It took constant oversight and clever management to encourage them to adopt these unusual foods and practices.

It is evident that it is to Cook's personal action the success was due. Wallis and Byron had anti-scorbutics, but they suffered from scurvy; Furneaux, sailing with Cook in the second voyage, under precisely similar circumstances, suffered from scurvy. It was only in Cook's ships, and in the Discovery, commanded and officered by men who had sailed with Cook, and seen his methods, that exemption occurred.

It’s clear that Cook's personal actions were responsible for the success. Wallis and Byron had anti-scurvy measures, yet they still dealt with scurvy; Furneaux, who sailed with Cook on the second voyage under the same conditions, also experienced scurvy. The only ships that avoided this issue were Cook's and the Discovery, which was commanded and staffed by men who had sailed with Cook and were familiar with his methods.

Cook did more, incomparably more, than any other navigator to discover new lands. This was only accomplished by dint of hard work; and yet his men suffered less than in any ships, British or foreign, or similar expeditions. Though his tracks were in new and unknown waters, we never hear of starvation; he always manages to have an abundant supply of water.

Cook did way more, by far, than any other navigator to discover new lands. This was only achieved through hard work; yet his crew suffered less than on any other ships, whether British or foreign, or similar expeditions. Even though his routes were in new and unknown waters, we never hear of starvation; he always made sure to have plenty of water.

The completeness and accuracy of his accounts and charts are no less remarkable.

The completeness and accuracy of his accounts and charts are just as impressive.

M. de La Perouse, one of the foremost of the great French navigators, told Captain Phillip, the founder of the Colony of New South Wales, that "Cook had left him nothing but to admire." This was all but literally true; wherever Cook went he finished his work, according to the requirements of navigation of his time. He never sighted a land but he determined its dimensions, its shape, its position, and left true guides for his successors. His charts are still for some parts unsuperseded, and his recorded observations still save us from hasty and incorrect alterations desired by modern navigators.

M. de La Perouse, one of the top French navigators, told Captain Phillip, the founder of the Colony of New South Wales, that "Cook left him nothing but to admire." This was almost literally true; everywhere Cook went, he completed his work according to the navigation standards of his time. He never encountered land without determining its size, shape, location, and leaving accurate references for those who followed. His maps are still unmatched in some areas, and his documented observations still help us avoid rushed and inaccurate changes that modern navigators might want.

Well may Englishmen be proud that this greatest of navigators was their countryman.

Englishmen can be proud that this greatest of navigators was one of their own.


PERSONS WHO LEFT ENGLAND IN H.M.S. ENDEAVOUR, 26TH AUGUST, 1768.

 


A JOURNAL OF THE PROCEEDINGS OF HIS MAJESTY'S BARK ENDEAVOUR,
ON A VOYAGE ROUND THE WORLD, BY LIEUTENANT JAMES COOK,
COMMANDER, COMMENCING THE 25TH OF MAY, 1768.

EXPLANATION (FROM JOURNAL).

IT is necessary to premise by way of explanation, that in this Journal (except while we lay at George's Island) the day is supposed to begin and end at noon, as for instance, Friday the 27th May, began at noon on Thursday 26th, and ended the following noon according to the natural day, and all the courses and bearings are the true courses and bearings according to the Globe, and not by Compass. The longitude is counted West from the meridian of Greenwich where no other place is particularly mentioned. The proportional length of the log-line to the half minute glass, by which the ships run was measured, is as thirty seconds is to thirty feet.

It’s important to clarify that in this Journal (except while we were at George's Island), the day starts and ends at noon. For example, Friday, May 27, began at noon on Thursday, May 26, and ended at the following noon according to the natural day. All the directions and angles are based on true courses according to the Globe, not by Compass. The longitude is measured west from the Greenwich meridian unless specified otherwise. The proportional length of the log-line to the half-minute glass, which the ships use to measure distance, is thirty seconds for every thirty feet.

While the ship lay in port or was coasting in sight of land, or sailing in narrow seas, this Journal is not kept in the usual form, but the degrees of Latitude and Longitude the ship passes over are put down at the top of each page, by which together with the notes in the margin* an easy reference will be had to the Chart. (* These notes in the margin have not been printed. ED.)

While the ship was in port, along the coast, or navigating in shallow waters, this Journal isn't maintained in the usual way. Instead, the degrees of Latitude and Longitude the ship travels through are noted at the top of each page, which, along with the side notes*, provides an easy reference to the Chart. (*These side notes haven't been printed. ED.)


CHAPTER 1. ENGLAND TO RIO JANEIRO.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES ON BOARD HIS MAJESTY'S BARK ENDEAVOUR.

1768.

[May to July 1768.]

[May to July 1768.]

RIVER THAMES, Friday, May 27th, to Friday, July 29th. Moderate and fair weather; at 11 a.m. hoisted the Pendant, and took charge of the Ship, agreeable to my Commission of the 25th instant, she lying in the Bason in Deptford Yard. From this day to the 21st of July we were constantly employed in fitting the Ship, taking on board Stores and Provisions, etc. The same day we sailed from Deptford and anchored in Gallions reach, were we remained until the 30th. The transactions of Each Day, both while we lay here and at Deptford, are inserted in the Log Book, and as they contain nothing but common Occurrences, it was thought not necessary to insert them here.

RIVER THAMES, Friday, May 27th, to Friday, July 29th. The weather was moderate and fair; at 11 a.m., I raised the Pendant and took command of the Ship, according to my Commission from the 25th of this month, while it was docked in the Basin at Deptford Yard. From this day until July 21st, we were consistently busy outfitting the Ship, loading Stores and Provisions, etc. On the same day, we set sail from Deptford and anchored in Gallions Reach, where we stayed until the 30th. The daily activities, both while we were docked here and at Deptford, are recorded in the Log Book, and since they only include routine events, it was deemed unnecessary to include them here.

[July to August 1768.]

[July to August 1768.]

July 30th to August 7th. Saturday, July 30th, Weighed from Gallions, and made sail down the River, the same day Anchored at Gravesend, and the next Morning weighed from thence, and at Noon Anchored at the Buoy of the Fairway. On Wednesday, 3rd of August, Anchored in the Downs in 9 fathoms of water, Deal Castle North-West by West. On Sunday, 7th, I joined the Ship, discharged the Pilot, and the next day saild for Plymouth.

July 30th to August 7th. Saturday, July 30th, Weighed anchor from Gallions and set sail down the River. That same day, we anchored at Gravesend, and the next morning, set off from there and at noon anchored at the Fairway Buoy. On Wednesday, August 3rd, we anchored in the Downs in 9 fathoms of water, with Deal Castle to the North-West by West. On Sunday, August 7th, I rejoined the ship, discharged the pilot, and the next day we sailed for Plymouth.

Monday, 8th. Fresh Breezes and Cloudy weather the most part of these 24 hours. At 10 a.m. weighed and came to sail; at Noon the South Foreland bore North-East 1/2 North, distant 6 or 7 Miles. Wind West by North, North-West.

Monday, 8th. Fresh breezes and mostly cloudy weather for most of these 24 hours. At 10 a.m., we weighed anchor and set sail; at noon, the South Foreland was to the North-East 1/2 North, about 6 or 7 miles away. Wind was from the West by North, North-West.

Tuesday, 9th. Gentle breezes and Cloudy weather. At 7 p.m. the Tide being against us, Anchored in 13 fathoms of Water; Dungeness South-West by West. At 11 a.m. Weighed and made Sail down Channel; at Noon, Beachy Head, North by East 1/2 East, distant 6 Leagues, Latitude observed 50 degrees 30 minutes North. Wind North-West to North.

Tuesday, 9th. Gentle breezes and cloudy weather. At 7 p.m., with the tide against us, we anchored in 13 fathoms of water; Dungeness was to the southwest by west. At 11 a.m., we weighed anchor and set sail down the channel; at noon, Beachy Head was north by east 1/2 east, 6 leagues away, with a latitude of 50 degrees 30 minutes north. The wind was from the northwest to north.

Wednesday, 10th. Variable: light Airs and Clear weather. At 8 p.m. Beachy Head North-East by East, distant 4 Leagues, and at 8 a.m. it bore North-East by North, 9 Leagues. Found the Variation of the Compass to be 23 degrees West; at Noon the Isle of Wight North-West by North. Wind West by North, North-East by East.

Wednesday, 10th. Weather: light winds and clear skies. At 8 p.m., Beachy Head was to the North-East by East, 4 leagues away, and at 8 a.m., it was to the North-East by North, 9 leagues away. The compass variation was found to be 23 degrees West; at noon, the Isle of Wight was to the North-West by North. Wind was from the West by North, North-East by East.

Thursday, 11th. Light Airs and Clear weather. At 8 p.m. Dunnose North by West 5 Leagues, and at 4 a.m. it bore North-North-East 1/2 East, distant 5 Leagues. Wind Variable.

Thursday, 11th. Light winds and clear weather. At 8 p.m., Dunnose was to the North by West, 5 leagues away, and at 4 a.m. it was to the North-North-East 1/2 East, also 5 leagues away. Wind was variable.

Wednesday, 12th. Light Airs and Calms all these 24 Hours. At Noon the Bill of Portland bore North-West 1/2 West, distant 3 Leagues. Latitude Observed 50 degrees 24 minutes North. Wind Easterly.

Wednesday, 12th. Light breezes and calm conditions for the past 24 hours. At noon, the Bill of Portland was located to the North-West 1/2 West, about 3 leagues away. Latitude observed at 50 degrees 24 minutes North. Wind coming from the east.

Thursday, 13th. Ditto weather. At Noon the Start Point West 7 or 8 miles. Latitude Observed 50 degrees 12 minutes North, which must be the Latitude of the Start, as it bore West.* (* This is correct.) Wind Variable.

Thursday, 13th. Same weather. At noon, the Start Point was 7 or 8 miles west. Latitude observed was 50 degrees 12 minutes North, which must be the latitude of the Start, as it was to the west.* (* This is correct.) Wind was variable.

Sunday, 14th. Fine breezes and Clear weather. At 1/2 past 8 p.m. Anchored in the Entrance of Plymouth Sound in 9 fathoms water. At 4 a.m. weighed and worked into proper Anchoring ground, and Anchored in 6 fathoms, the Mewstone South-East, Mount Batten North-North-East 1/2 East, and Drake's Island North by West. Dispatched an Express to London for Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to join the Ship, their Servants and Baggage being already on board. Wind North-Easterly.

Sunday, 14th. Nice breezes and clear weather. At 8:30 p.m., we anchored at the entrance of Plymouth Sound in 9 fathoms of water. At 4 a.m., we weighed anchor and made our way into suitable anchoring ground, and we anchored in 6 fathoms, with the Mewstone to the southeast, Mount Batten to the north-northeast, and Drake's Island to the north by west. I sent an express to London for Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to join the ship, as their servants and luggage were already on board. The wind was coming from the northeast.

Monday, 15th. First and latter parts Moderate breezes and fair; Middle squally, with heavy showers of rain. I this day received an order to Augment the Ship's Company to 85 Men, which before was but 70. Received on board fresh Beef for the Ship's Company. Wind South-West to South-East.

Monday, 15th. The morning and evening had moderate breezes and good weather; the middle of the day was squally, with heavy rain showers. Today, I got an order to increase the ship's crew from 70 to 85 men. Also received fresh beef for the crew. Wind from the South-West to South-East.

Tuesday, 16th. First part moderate and Hazey; Middle hard Squalls with rain; the Latter moderate and fair. Received on board a supply of Bread, Beer, and Water. A Sergeant, Corporal, Drummer, and 9 Private Marines as part of the Complement. Wind South-South-East to North-East.

Tuesday, 16th. The first part of the day was moderate and hazy; the middle had strong gusts with rain; the latter part was moderate and clear. We received a supply of bread, beer, and water on board. A sergeant, corporal, drummer, and 9 private marines joined the crew. The wind was from the south-southeast to northeast.

Wednesday, 17th. Little wind and Hazey weather. Sent some Cordage to the Yard in order to be Exchanged for Smaller. Several Shipwrights and Joiners from the Yard Employed on board refitting the Gentlemen's Cabins, and making a Platform over the Tiller, etc. Wind South-East to East by South.

Wednesday, 17th. Light wind and hazy weather. Sent some rope to the yard to be exchanged for smaller ones. Several shipwrights and joiners from the yard are working on board to refit the gentlemen's cabins and build a platform over the tiller, etc. Wind from the southeast to east by south.

Thursday, 18th. Little wind and Cloudy. Struck down 4 guns into the Hold. Received on board 4 More, with 12 Barrels of Powder and several other Stores. Shipwrights and Joiners Employed on board. Wind Easterly.

Thursday, 18th. Little wind and cloudy. Lowered 4 guns into the hold. Received on board 4 more, along with 12 barrels of powder and several other supplies. Shipwrights and carpenters are working on board. Wind is coming from the east.

Friday, 19th. Former part little wind with rain; remainder fair weather; a.m. Read to the Ship's Company the Articles of War and the Act of Parliament, they likewise were paid two Months' Wages in advance. I also told them that they were to Expect no additional pay for the performance of our intended Voyage; they were well satisfied, and Expressed great Cheerfulness and readiness to prosecute the Voyage. Received on board another Supply of Provisions, Rum, etc. Wind North-West to South-West.

Friday, 19th. In the first part of the day, there was little wind with rain; the rest of the day was fair. In the morning, I read the Articles of War and the Act of Parliament to the crew, and they were paid two months' wages in advance. I also informed them that they shouldn't expect any extra pay for our upcoming voyage; they were quite satisfied and expressed great enthusiasm and readiness to continue with the journey. We received another supply of provisions, rum, etc. The wind was from the North-West to the South-West.

Saturday, 20th. First part little wind with rain; remainder fresh Gales and thick rainy weather. Employed making ready for Sea. Wind West-South-West.

Saturday, 20th. The first part of the day had a light wind with rain; the rest of the day had fresh gales and thick rainy weather. I spent the time getting ready for the sea. The wind was coming from the West-South-West.

Sunday, 21st. Fresh Gales and Ditto Weather. The Shipwrights having finished their Work, intended to have sailed, instead of which was obliged to let go another Anchor. Wind South-West, West-South-West.

Sunday, 21st. Strong winds and similar weather. The shipbuilders finished their work and planned to set sail, but instead had to drop another anchor. Wind from the South-West and West-South-West.

Monday, 22nd. Fresh Gales, with heavy squalls of Wind and Rain all this 24 hours. Wind South-West.

Monday, 22nd. Strong winds with heavy gusts of wind and rain all throughout the past 24 hours. Wind from the South-West.

Tuesday, 23rd. Ditto weather. Struck Yards and Topmasts; Anchored between the Island and the Main His Majesty's Ship Gibraltar. Wind West by South.

Tuesday, 23rd. Same weather. Took down the yards and topmasts; anchored between the island and the mainland on His Majesty's Ship Gibraltar. Wind from the west by south.

Wednesday, 24th. Fresh Gales and Hazey weather; a.m. hove up the Small Bower Anchor and got Topmasts and Yards. Wind West by South.

Wednesday, 24th. Strong winds and hazy weather; in the morning, we lifted the small bower anchor and got the top masts and yards ready. Wind from the west by south.

Thursday, 25th. Moderate and Cloudy weather; a.m. received on Board a supply of Beer and Water, and returned all our Empty Casks. Loosed the Topsails as a Signal for Sailing. Wind West, North by West, North-West by West.

Thursday, 25th. Mild and cloudy weather; in the morning, we received a supply of beer and water on board and returned all our empty barrels. We loosened the topsails as a signal to set sail. Wind from the west, northwest by west.

[Sailed from Plymouth.]

Sailed from Plymouth.

Friday, 26th. First part fresh Breezes and Cloudy, remainder little wind and Clear. At 2 p.m. got under Sail and put to Sea, having on board 94 Persons, including Officers, Seamen, Gentlemen, and their Servants; near 18 Months' Provisions, 10 Carriage Guns, 12 Swivels, with good Store of Ammunition and Stores of all kinds. At 8 the Dodman Point West-North-West, distant 4 or 5 Leagues; at 6 a.m. the Lizard bore West-North-West 1/2 West, 5 or 6 Leagues distant. At Noon Sounded and had 50 fathoms, Grey sand with small Stones and broken Shells. Wind North by West, North-West, West by South; course South 21 degrees East; distance 23 miles; latitude 49 degrees 30 minutes North, longitude 5 degrees 52 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 21 degrees West distant 23 miles.

Friday, 26th. The first part of the day had fresh breezes and was cloudy, while the remainder was mostly clear with little wind. At 2 p.m., we set sail and went out to sea, carrying 94 people on board, including officers, seamen, gentlemen, and their servants; nearly 18 months' worth of provisions, 10 cannon, 12 swivel guns, along with a good supply of ammunition and various supplies. By 8 p.m., the Dodman Point was to the West-North-West, about 4 or 5 leagues away; at 6 a.m., the Lizard was to the West-North-West 1/2 West, 5 or 6 leagues away. At noon, we took soundings and found 50 fathoms, with gray sand, small stones, and broken shells. The wind was from the North by West, North-West, and West by South; we were on a course of South 21 degrees East, covering a distance of 23 miles; our latitude was 49 degrees 30 minutes North and longitude 5 degrees 52 minutes West; at noon, the Lizard was to the North 21 degrees West, 23 miles away.

Saturday, 27th. First part Light Airs and Clear weather, remainder fresh breezes and Cloudy. Berthed the Ship's Company, Mustered the Chests and Stove all that were unnecessary. Wind North-West, North-East, South-East; course South-West; distance 77 miles; latitude 48 degrees 42 minutes North, longitude 6 degrees 49 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 29 degrees East, 80 miles.

Saturday, 27th. The first part of the day had light winds and clear skies, while the rest of the day brought fresh breezes and clouds. The crew was settled in, and we stored away all unnecessary items. The wind was coming from the North-West, North-East, and South-East; we were heading South-West; distance traveled was 77 miles; latitude 48 degrees 42 minutes North, longitude 6 degrees 49 minutes West; at noon, the Lizard was 29 degrees East, 80 miles away.

Sunday, 28th. Former part fresh Gales and Hazey with rain; remainder a Moderate breeze and Cloudy. Wind Easterly; course South 48 degrees West; distance 130 miles; latitude 47 degrees 16 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 7 minutes West; at noon Lizard North 40 degrees 5 minutes East; 69 leagues.

Sunday, 28th. The first part of the day had fresh winds and was hazy with rain; the rest of the day saw a moderate breeze and cloudy skies. The wind was coming from the east; our course was South 48 degrees West; we covered a distance of 130 miles; latitude was 47 degrees 16 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 7 minutes West; at noon, we were at Lizard North 40 degrees 5 minutes East; 69 leagues.

Monday, 29th. Light Airs and Hazey the Most part of these 24 hours with some Rain. Wind North-Westerly; course South 21 degrees West; distance 41 miles; latitude 46 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 29 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 37 degrees 45 minutes East, 86 leagues.

Monday, 29th. Light breezes and hazy for most of the 24 hours with some rain. Wind from the northwest; course south 21 degrees west; distance 41 miles; latitude 46 degrees 38 minutes north, longitude 9 degrees 29 minutes west; at noon, Lizard north 37 degrees 45 minutes east, 86 leagues.

Tuesday, 30th. Fresh Gales all these 24 Hours. At 1/2 past 1 p.m. Spoke with His Majesty's Ship Guardaloupe; at 6 Close Reeft the Topsails, and got down the Top Gallant Yards. Wind Westerly; course South 27 degrees West; distance 33 miles; latitude 46 degrees 9 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 52 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 36 degrees East, 96 leagues.

Tuesday, 30th. Strong winds all day. At 1:30 p.m., we spoke with His Majesty's Ship Guardaloupe; at 6, we clewed up the topsails and lowered the topgallant yards. Winds were coming from the west; we were heading south 27 degrees west; we traveled 33 miles; our latitude was 46 degrees 9 minutes north, and longitude was 9 degrees 52 minutes west; at noon, Lizard was north 36 degrees east, 96 leagues away.

Wednesday, 31st. First and Middle parts, Moderate breezes and Clear; Latter, fresh Gales and Cloudy. At 6 p.m. loosed the 2nd Reef out of the Topsails, and at 8 a.m. took them in again; at Noon Tacked and stood to the North-West, having stood before to the Southward. Wind West to South-West; course South 36 degrees East; distance 82 miles; latitude 45 degrees 3 minutes North, longitude 8 degrees 43 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North-North-East, 105 leagues.

Wednesday, the 31st. Morning and midday had moderate breezes and clear skies; later, there were fresh gales and cloudy conditions. At 6 p.m., we let out the second reef from the topsails, and by 8 a.m., we took them in again. At noon, we tacked and headed northwest after previously traveling south. Winds were from the west to southwest; our course was South 36 degrees East; we covered a distance of 82 miles; at noon, our position was latitude 45 degrees 3 minutes North, longitude 8 degrees 43 minutes West; at noon, the Lizard was North-North-East, 105 leagues away.

[September 1768. Plymouth to Madeira.]

[September 1768. Plymouth to Madeira.]

Thursday, September 1st. Very hard gales, with some heavy showers of Rain, the most part of these 24 Hours, which brought us under our two Courses, Broke one of our Main Topmast phuttock Plates, washed overboard a small Boat belonging to the Boatswain, and drowned between 3 and 4 Dozen of our Poultry, which was worst of all. Towards Noon it moderated, so that we could bear our Maintopsail close Reefd. At Midnight wore and stood to the Southward. Wind Westerly; course South 70 degrees West; distance 20 miles; latitude 44 degrees 56 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 9 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 28 degrees 15 minutes West, 109 leagues.

Thursday, September 1st. There were very strong winds and heavy rain for most of the 24 hours, which forced us to take down our two sails. We broke one of the main topmast phuttock plates, washed a small boat belonging to the boatswain overboard, and lost between 3 and 4 dozen of our poultry, which was the worst part. By noon, the weather calmed down enough for us to set the main topsail close-reefed. At midnight, we turned and headed south. The wind was coming from the west; our course was South 70 degrees West; we covered 20 miles; our latitude was 44 degrees 56 minutes North, and longitude was 9 degrees 9 minutes West; at noon, the Lizard was North 28 degrees 15 minutes West, 109 leagues away.

Friday, 2nd. Fresh Gales and Cloudy the most part of these 24 hours. P.M. got up the spare Mainsail to dry, it being Wet by the Water getting into the Sail room, occasioned by the Ship being very Leakey in her upper works. At 5 a.m. loosed 2 Reefs out of each Topsail, and saw the Land, which we judged to be Cape Finister and Cape Ortugal. At 10 Tackt, being about 4 miles off Shore, and stood to the North-West; at Noon, Cape Ortugal bore East by South, distance about 8 Leagues. Wind North by West, West, South-West, West-South-West; course South by West; distance 64 miles; latitude 43 degrees 53 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 26 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North-North-East, 130 leagues.

Friday, 2nd. Strong winds and mostly cloudy for most of these 24 hours. In the afternoon, we raised the spare mainsail to dry it out since it was wet from water entering the sail room, which was due to the ship being quite leaky in its upper sections. At 5 a.m., we let out 2 reefs from each topsail and spotted land, which we thought was Cape Finister and Cape Ortugal. At 10 o'clock, we were about 4 miles off the shore and headed Northwest; by noon, Cape Ortugal was bearing East by South, about 8 leagues away. The wind was blowing from the North by West, West, South-West, and West-South-West; our course was South by West, covering a distance of 64 miles; at latitude 43 degrees 53 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 26 minutes West; by noon, the Lizard was North-North-East, 130 leagues away.

Saturday, 3rd. First part little wind and Hazey, with rain; remainder strong Gales with hard squalls, which brought us under our close Reeft Topsails, and obliged us to strike Topgallant Yards. At 8 a.m. wore ship and stood to the Southward. Wind South-West and West; course South 68 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 44 miles; latitude 44 degrees 9 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees 20 minutes West; at noon, Lizard North 29 1/2 degrees East, 138 leagues.

Saturday, 3rd. The first part of the day had light wind and hazy conditions, with rain; the rest of the day was marked by strong gales and heavy squalls, which forced us to take in our close-reefed topsails and lower the topgallant yards. At 8 a.m., we changed course and headed south. The wind was coming from the south-west and west; we were on a course of south 68 degrees 45 minutes west; we traveled 44 miles; our latitude was 44 degrees 9 minutes north, and our longitude was 10 degrees 20 minutes west; at noon, the Lizard was at 29 1/2 degrees east, 138 leagues away.

Sunday, 4th. Fore part fresh Gales and Clear; remainder light Airs and Calm. At 6 a.m. Cape Finister bore South by West 1/2 West, distance 10 or 11 leagues. Loosed all the Reefs out of the Topsails, and got Topgallant Yards across. Wind Westerly, Calm; at noon, Island of Cyserga,* (* Sisarga, near Coruna.) East-South-East 3 leagues.

Sunday, 4th. The morning started with strong winds and clear skies; later it was light breezes and calm. At 6 a.m., Cape Finister was located South by West 1/2 West, around 10 or 11 leagues away. We released all the reefs from the topsails and set the topgallant yards. The wind was from the west and calm; at noon, the Island of Cyserga* *(Sisarga, near Coruna) was 3 leagues East-South-East.

Monday, 5th. Light breezes and Calm all these 24 hours. At 2 p.m. had an Observation of the Sun and Moon, which gave the Longitude 8 degrees 42 minutes West from Greenwich. At 6 Cape Finister bore South by West 1/2 West, 6 Leagues. Variation of the Compass per Azimuth 18 degrees 42 minutes West. At Noon, Cape Finister South by East, distant 4 leagues; latitude observed 43 degrees 4 minutes, therefore Cape Finister must lay in latitude 42 degrees 53 minutes North.* (* This is correct.) Wind Westerly, North-West, Calm.

Monday, 5th. Light breezes and calm for the entire 24 hours. At 2 p.m., I took a measurement of the Sun and Moon, which indicated a longitude of 8 degrees 42 minutes west from Greenwich. At 6, Cape Finister was located south by west 1/2 west, 6 leagues away. The compass variation by azimuth was 18 degrees 42 minutes west. At noon, Cape Finister was south by east, 4 leagues away; latitude observed was 43 degrees 4 minutes, so Cape Finister must be at latitude 42 degrees 53 minutes north.* (* This is correct.) Wind was westerly, north-west, calm.

Tuesday, 6th. Moderate breezes and Clear weather these 24 Hours. A.M. found the Variation by the Mean of 5 Azimuth to be 21 degrees 40 minutes West, 3 Degrees more than what it was found Yesterday, which I cannot account for,* (* Cook, as all other navigators of his time, was unaware of the deviation of the compass caused by the iron of the ship.) as both Observations appeared to me to be equally well made. At 10.28 had an Observation of the sun and moon, which gave the Longitude 9 degrees 40 minutes West from Greenwich. By this Observation Cape Finister must lay in 8 degrees 52 minutes, and by that made yesterday in 8 degrees 40 minutes. The Mean of the two is 8 degrees 46 minutes West of Greenwich the Longitude of the Cape,* (* The correct longitude is 9 degrees 15 minutes West.) its latitude being 42 degrees 53 minutes North. Wind North-West; course South 42 degrees West; distance 70 miles; latitude 42 degrees 1 minute North, longitude 9 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 42 degrees East, 70 miles.

Tuesday, 6th. Moderate breezes and clear weather for the last 24 hours. This morning, I found the variation from the mean of five azimuths to be 21 degrees 40 minutes West, which is 3 degrees more than yesterday, and I can’t explain this.* (*Cook, like all other navigators of his time, was unaware of the compass deviation caused by the ship's iron.) Both observations seemed equally reliable to me. At 10:28, I made an observation of the sun and moon, which determined the longitude to be 9 degrees 40 minutes West from Greenwich. From this observation, Cape Finister should be located at 8 degrees 52 minutes, compared to yesterday's measurement of 8 degrees 40 minutes. The average of the two is 8 degrees 46 minutes West of Greenwich for the longitude of the Cape,* (*The correct longitude is 9 degrees 15 minutes West.) with a latitude of 42 degrees 53 minutes North. The wind is coming from the North-West; our course is South 42 degrees West; we traveled 70 miles; currently at latitude 42 degrees 1 minute North, longitude 9 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister is at North 42 degrees East, 70 miles away.

Wednesday, 7th. Moderate breezes and Clear weather; found the Variation to be 21 degrees 4 minutes West. Wind West-North-West; course South by West; distance 92 miles; latitude 40 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees 11 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 13 degrees East, 49 leagues.

Wednesday, 7th. Light winds and clear skies; discovered the variation to be 21 degrees 4 minutes West. Wind from the West-North-West; heading South by West; traveled 92 miles; latitude 40 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees 11 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister was 13 degrees East, 49 leagues away.

Thursday, 8th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy weather. A.M. Past by 2 Sail, which were standing to the North-East. Wind West-North-West to West by South; course South 4 degrees East; distance 111 miles; latitude 38 degrees 33 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees West; at noon, Cape Finister North 12 degrees East, 88 leagues.

Thursday, 8th. Fresh winds and cloudy weather. A.M. Passed by 2 ships that were heading to the Northeast. Wind from the West-Northwest to West by South; course South 4 degrees East; distance 111 miles; latitude 38 degrees 33 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees West; at noon, Cape Finister North 12 degrees East, 88 leagues.

Friday, 9th. First part fresh Gales; remainder moderate breezes and fine, Clear weather. Set up the Topmast rigging, and found the Variation to be 19 degrees 50 minutes West. Wind West by North to North-East; course South 40 degrees West; distance 116 miles; latitude 37 degrees 4 minutes North, longitude 11 degrees 33 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 20 degrees East, 124 leagues.

Friday, 9th. The first part of the day had strong winds; the rest of the day was filled with moderate breezes and nice, clear weather. We set up the topmast rigging and discovered the variation to be 19 degrees 50 minutes West. The wind was from West by North to North-East; the course was South 40 degrees West; we traveled 116 miles; latitude 37 degrees 4 minutes North, longitude 11 degrees 33 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister was North 20 degrees East, 124 leagues away.

Saturday, 10th. A steady, fresh breeze and fine Clear weather. Found the Variation of the Compys by the Evening and Morning Amplitude and by 2 Azimuth to be 20 degrees 59 minutes West. Wind North-East by East; course South 36 minutes West; distance 130 miles; latitude 35 degrees 20 minutes North, longitude 13 degrees 28 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 24 degrees East, 166 leagues.

Saturday, 10th. A steady, fresh breeze and clear weather. By the evening and morning measurements, we found the compass variation to be 20 degrees 59 minutes West. The wind was coming from the North-East by East; we were heading South 36 minutes West; we traveled 130 miles; our latitude was 35 degrees 20 minutes North and our longitude was 13 degrees 28 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister was to the North 24 degrees East, 166 leagues away.

Sunday, 11th. The same Winds and weather Continue. Found the Variation to be this Evening 18 degrees 54 minutes, and in the Morning 17 degrees 58 minutes West, they both being the mean result of several good Observations. Wind North-East by East, North by East; course South 32 degrees West; distance 94 miles; latitude 34 degrees 1 minute North, longitude 14 degrees 29 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 26 1/2 degrees East, 198 leagues.

Sunday, 11th. The same winds and weather continue. Found the variation to be this evening 18 degrees 54 minutes, and in the morning 17 degrees 58 minutes West, both being the average result of several accurate observations. Wind North-East by East and North by East; course South 32 degrees West; distance 94 miles; latitude 34 degrees 1 minute North, longitude 14 degrees 29 minutes West; at noon, Cape Finister North 26 1/2 degrees East, 198 leagues.

Monday, 12th. Moderate breezes and fine Clear weather. At 6 a.m. the Island of Porto Santo bore North-West by West, distance 9 or 10 leagues. Hauld the Wind to the westward at noon, the Deserters extending from West-South-West to South-West by South, the Body of Madeira West 1/2 South, and Porto Santo North-North-West 1/2 West. Wind North-North-West; course South 40 degrees West; distance 102 miles; latitude 32 degrees 43 minutes North, longitude 15 degrees 53 minutes West.

Monday, 12th. Light breezes and clear weather. At 6 a.m., the Island of Porto Santo was to the North-West by West, about 9 or 10 leagues away. Changed our course to the west at noon, with the Deserters stretching from West-South-West to South-West by South, Madeira directly to the West 1/2 South, and Porto Santo to the North-North-West 1/2 West. Wind from the North-North-West; course set to South 40 degrees West; distance traveled 102 miles; latitude 32 degrees 43 minutes North, longitude 15 degrees 53 minutes West.

Tuesday, 13th. Fresh breezes and clear weather. At 8 p.m. anchored in Funchal Road in 22 fathoms. Found here His Majesty's Ship Rose and several Merchants' Vessels. In the Morning new berthed the Ship, and Moor'd with the Stream Anchor, half a Cable on the Best Bower and a Hawser and a half on the Stream Wind North-West.

Tuesday, 13th. Nice breezes and clear skies. At 8 p.m., we anchored in Funchal Road at 22 fathoms. We found His Majesty's Ship Rose and several merchant vessels here. In the morning, we re-berthed the ship and moored with the stream anchor, half a cable on the best bower, and a hawser and a half on the stream, with the wind coming from the northwest.

MOORED IN FUNCHAL ROAD, MADEIRA, Wednesday, 14th. First part fine, Clear weather, remainder Cloudy, with Squals from the land, attended with Showers of rain. In the Night the Bend of the Hawsers of the Stream Anchor Slip'd owing to the Carelessness of the Person who made it fast. In the Morning hove up the Anchor in the Boat and carried it out to the Southward. In heaving the Anchor out of the Boat Mr. Weir, Master's Mate, was carried overboard by the Buoy rope and to the Bottom with the Anchor. Hove up the Anchor by the Ship as soon as possible, and found his Body intangled in the Buoy rope. Moor'd the Ship with the two Bowers in 22 fathoms Water; the Loo Rock West and the Brazen Head East. Saild His Majesty's Ship Rose. The Boats employed carrying the Casks a Shore for Wine, and the Caulkers caulking the Ship Sides. Wind Easterly.

MOORED IN FUNCHAL ROAD, MADEIRA, Wednesday, 14th. The first part of the day was nice, with clear weather. The rest of the day was cloudy, with squalls coming from the land, accompanied by rain showers. At night, the bend of the hawsers for the stream anchor slipped due to the carelessness of the person who secured it. In the morning, we pulled up the anchor in the boat and took it out to the south. While we were lifting the anchor out of the boat, Mr. Weir, the Master's Mate, was pulled overboard by the buoy rope and went down with the anchor. We raised the anchor by the ship as quickly as we could and found his body entangled in the buoy rope. We moored the ship with both bower anchors in 22 fathoms of water; the Loo Rock to the west and the Brazen Head to the east. His Majesty's Ship Rose set sail. The boats were busy bringing casks ashore for wine, and the caulkers were working on sealing the ship's sides. The wind was blowing from the east.

Thursday, 15th. Squals of Wind from the Land, with rain the most part of these 24 Hours. Received on board fresh Beef and Greens for the Ship's Company, and sent on shore all our Casks for Wine and Water, having a Shore Boat employed for that purpose. Wind North-East to South-East.

Thursday, 15th. Squalls of wind from the land, with rain for most of these 24 hours. We received fresh beef and greens on board for the crew and sent all our casks for wine and water ashore, using a shore boat for that purpose. Wind from the north-east to south-east.

Friday, 16th. The most part fine, Clear weather. Punished Henry Stevens, Seaman, and Thomas Dunster, Marine, with 12 lashes each, for refusing to take their allowance of Fresh Beef. Employed taking on board Wine and Water. Wind Easterly.

Friday, 16th. Mostly fine, clear weather. Punished Henry Stevens, Seaman, and Thomas Dunster, Marine, with 12 lashes each for refusing to take their share of fresh beef. Worked on loading wine and water. Wind from the east.

Saturday, 17th. Little wind, and fine Clear weather. Issued to the whole Ship's Company 20 pounds of Onions per Man. Employed as Yesterday. Wind Westerly.

Saturday, 17th. There was little wind and clear, nice weather. Gave the whole ship's crew 20 pounds of onions each. Worked as we did yesterday. The wind was coming from the west.

Sunday, 18th. Ditto Weather. P.M. received on board 270 pounds of fresh Beef, and a Live Bullock charged 613 pounds. Compleated our Wine and Water, having received of the former 3032 Gallons, of the Latter 10 Tuns. A.M. unmoor'd and prepar'd for Sailing. Funchall, in the Island of Madeira, by Observations made here by Dr. Eberton, F.R.S., lies in the latitude of 32 degrees 33 minutes 33 seconds North and longitude West from Greenwich 16 degrees 49 minutes,* (* Modern determination is 32 degrees 38 minutes North, 16 degrees 54 minutes West.) the Variation of the Compass 15 degrees 30 minutes West, decreasing as he says, which I much doubt;* (* Cook was right: the variation was increasing.) neither does this Variation agree with our own Observations. The Tides flow full, and Change North and South, and rise Perpendicular 7 feet at Spring Tides and 4 feet at Niep tides. We found the North point of the Diping Needle, belonging to the Royal Society, to Dip 77 degrees 18 minutes. The Refreshments for Shipping to be got at this place are Wine, Water, Fruit of Several Sorts, and Onions in Plenty, and some Sweatmeats; but Fresh Meat and Poultry are very Dear, and not to be had at any rate without Leave from the Governour. Wind southerly, East-South-East, South-West.

Sunday, 18th. Same weather. In the afternoon, we received 270 pounds of fresh beef and a live bullock that weighed 613 pounds. We completed our wine and water supply, having received 3,032 gallons of wine and 10 tons of water. In the morning, we unmoored and prepared for sailing. According to observations made here by Dr. Eberton, F.R.S., Funchall, in the Island of Madeira, is located at a latitude of 32 degrees 33 minutes 33 seconds North and a longitude of 16 degrees 49 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* The modern coordinates are 32 degrees 38 minutes North, 16 degrees 54 minutes West.) The compass variation is 15 degrees 30 minutes West and is supposed to be decreasing, although I have my doubts about that.* (* Cook was correct: the variation was actually increasing.) This variation also does not match our own observations. The tides flow fully, changing direction between North and South, rising vertically 7 feet during spring tides and 4 feet during neap tides. We found that the north point of the dipping needle belonging to the Royal Society dips at 77 degrees 18 minutes. The available supplies at this location for shipping include wine, water, various fruits, plenty of onions, and some sweets; however, fresh meat and poultry are very expensive and cannot be obtained without permission from the governor. The wind is coming from the south, east-southeast, and southwest.

[Sailed from Madeira.]

Left Madeira.

Monday, 19th. Light breezes and fine Clear weather. At Midnight Sailed from Funchall. At 8 a.m. the high land over it bore North 1/2 East. Unbent the Cables, stow'd the Anchors, and issued to the Ship's Company 10 pounds of Onions per Man. Ship's Draught of Water, Fore 14 feet 8 inches; Aft 15 feet 1 inch. Wind East-South-East; latitude 31 degrees 43 minutes North; at noon, High land over Funchall North 7 degrees East, 49 miles.

Monday, 19th. Light breezes and clear weather. Sailed from Funchal at midnight. At 8 a.m., the high land over it was located at North 1/2 East. We unbent the cables, stowed the anchors, and distributed 10 pounds of onions per crew member. The ship's draft of water was 14 feet 8 inches at the bow and 15 feet 1 inch at the stern. Wind was coming from the East-South-East; latitude was 31 degrees 43 minutes North; at noon, the high land over Funchal was at North 7 degrees East, 49 miles away.

Tuesday, 20th. Light Airs and Clear weather. P.M. took several Azimuth, which gave the Variation 16 degrees 30 minutes West. Put the Ship's Company to three Watches. Wind variable; course South 21 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 28 miles; latitude 31 degrees 17 minutes, longitude 17 degrees 19 minutes West; at noon, Funchall, Island of Madeira, North 13 degrees East, 76 miles.

Tuesday, 20th. Light breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, took several azimuth readings, which showed the variation as 16 degrees 30 minutes west. Organized the ship's crew into three watches. The wind was variable; course was South 21 degrees 30 minutes West; distance traveled was 28 miles; latitude 31 degrees 17 minutes, longitude 17 degrees 19 minutes West; at noon, the island of Madeira was located 76 miles to the North 13 degrees East.

Wednesday, 21st. First part light Airs, remainder fresh Breezes and Clear weather. Served Hooks and Lines to the Ship's Company, and employed them in the day in making Matts, etc., for the Rigging. Wind South-West to South-West by West; course South 60 degrees East; distance 60 miles; latitude 30 degrees 46 minutes North, longitude 16 degrees 8 minutes South; at noon, Funchall North 10 degrees West, 113 miles.

Wednesday, 21st. The first part of the day had light winds, with the rest of the day experiencing fresh breezes and clear weather. Provided hooks and lines to the crew, and they spent the day making mats and other items for the rigging. Wind was from the South-West to South-West by West; course was South 60 degrees East; distance covered was 60 miles; latitude was 30 degrees 46 minutes North, longitude was 16 degrees 8 minutes South; at noon, Funchal was located North 10 degrees West, 113 miles away.

Thursday, 22nd. Genteel breezes and Clear weather. At 4 p.m. saw the Salvages bearing South; at 6, the Body of the Island bore South 1/2 West, distant about 5 leagues. Found the Variation of the Compass by an Azimuth to be 17 degrees 50 minutes West. At 10 the Isles of Salvages bore West by South 1/2 South, distance 2 leagues. I make those Islands to be in latitude 30 degrees 11 minutes South, and South 16 degrees East, 58 leagues from Funchall, Madeira. Wind South-West; course South 35 degrees 30 minutes East; distance 73 miles; latitude 29 degrees 40 minutes North, longitude 15 degrees 31 minutes West; at noon, Funchall North 21 degrees West, 62 leagues.

Thursday, 22nd. There were gentle breezes and clear weather. At 4 p.m., I saw the Salvages to the south; at 6, the main island was located to the south 1/2 west, about 5 leagues away. I determined the compass variation by an azimuth to be 17 degrees 50 minutes west. At 10, the Isles of Salvages were to the west by south 1/2 south, 2 leagues away. I estimate those islands to be at latitude 30 degrees 11 minutes south and south 16 degrees east, 58 leagues from Funchal, Madeira. The wind was coming from the southwest; the course was south 35 degrees 30 minutes east; the distance traveled was 73 miles; the latitude was 29 degrees 40 minutes north, and the longitude was 15 degrees 31 minutes west; at noon, Funchal was north 21 degrees west, 62 leagues away.

Friday, 23rd. Light breezes and Clear weather. At 6 a.m. saw the Peak of Teneriff bearing West by South 1/2 South, and the Grand Canaries South 1/2 West. The Variation of the Compass from 17 degrees 22 minutes to 16 degrees 30 minutes, Wind South-West, North-East; course South 26 degrees West; distance 54 miles; latitude 28 degrees 51 minutes North, longitude 15 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Funchal North 12 degrees 45 minutes West, 77 leagues.

Friday, 23rd. Light breezes and clear weather. At 6 a.m., I spotted the peak of Tenerife to the West by South 1/2 South, and the Grand Canaries to the South 1/2 West. The compass variation was from 17 degrees 22 minutes to 16 degrees 30 minutes, with the wind coming from the South-West and North-East; we were on a course of South 26 degrees West, covering a distance of 54 miles; latitude 28 degrees 51 minutes North, longitude 15 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Funchal was to the North 12 degrees 45 minutes West, 77 leagues away.

Saturday, 24th. A fresh Breeze and Clear weather the most part of these 24 Hours. I take this to be the North-East Trade we have now got into. At 6 p.m. the North-East end of the Island of Teneriff West by North, distance 3 or 4 Leagues. Off this North-East point lies some Rocks high above the water. The highest is near the point, and very remarkable. By our run from Yesterday at Noon this end of the Island must lie in the latitude of 28 degrees 27 minutes and South 7 degrees 45 minutes East, distance 83 leagues from Funchal, and South 18 degrees West, 98 miles from the Salvages. At 1 a.m. the Peak of Teneriff bore West-North-West. Found the Variation to be this morning 16 degrees 14 minutes West. The Peak of Teneriff (from which I now take my departure) is a very high Mountain upon the Island of the same name--one of the Canary Islands. Its perpendicular higth from Actual Measurement is said to be 15,396 feet.* (* The received height is 12,180 feet. Latitude 28 degrees 16 minutes North, Longitude 16 degrees 38 minutes West.) It lies in the Latitude of 28 degrees 13 minutes North, and Longitude 16 degrees 32 minutes from Greenwich. Its situation in this respect is allowed to be pretty well determined. Wind North-East by East; latitude 27 degrees 10 minutes North; at noon Peak of Teneriff North 18 degrees 45 minutes, 74 miles.

Saturday, 24th. A fresh breeze and clear weather for most of these 24 hours. I believe we've entered the North-East Trade winds. At 6 p.m., the North-East end of the island of Tenerife was off to the west by north, about 3 or 4 leagues away. Off this North-East point, there are some rocks that rise high above the water. The tallest one is near the point and is quite distinctive. From our run yesterday at noon, this end of the island should be at a latitude of 28 degrees 27 minutes and longitude 7 degrees 45 minutes East, approximately 83 leagues from Funchal, and 18 degrees South, 98 miles from the Salvages. At 1 a.m., the peak of Tenerife was located to the west-northwest. This morning, I found the variation to be 16 degrees 14 minutes West. The peak of Tenerife (which I’m now using as my reference point) is a very high mountain on the island with the same name—one of the Canary Islands. Its actual measured height is said to be 15,396 feet.* (* The accepted height is 12,180 feet. Latitude 28 degrees 16 minutes North, Longitude 16 degrees 38 minutes West.) It’s located at a latitude of 28 degrees 13 minutes North and longitude 16 degrees 32 minutes West from Greenwich. Its location in this regard is generally considered to be quite accurately determined. Wind from the North-East by East; latitude 27 degrees 10 minutes North; at noon, the peak of Tenerife was at North 18 degrees 45 minutes, 74 miles away.

Sunday, 25th. A Steady Trade Wind and Clear Weather. The Variation by the Amplitude this Evening was 14 degrees 58 minutes West. Wind East by North, East-North-East; course South 41 degrees West; distance 126 miles; latitude 25 degrees 36 minutes North; at noon Peak of Teneriff North 33 degrees 15 minutes East, 61 leagues.

Sunday, 25th. A steady trade wind and clear weather. The variation by the amplitude this evening was 14 degrees 58 minutes west. Wind from the east by north, east-north-east; course south 41 degrees west; distance 126 miles; latitude 25 degrees 36 minutes north; at noon, the peak of Teneriff was at North 33 degrees 15 minutes East, 61 leagues.

Monday, 26th. Fresh breezes and somewhat Hazey. Variation by this Evening Amplitude 15 degrees 1 minute West. Wind North-East by East; course South 22 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 122 miles; latitude 23 degrees 43 minutes North; at noon Peak of Teneriff North 29 degrees East, 317 miles.

Monday, 26th. Fresh breezes and a bit hazy. Variation by this evening: amplitude 15 degrees 1 minute West. Wind from North-East by East; course South 22 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 122 miles; latitude 23 degrees 43 minutes North; at noon, Peak of Teneriff North 29 degrees East, 317 miles.

Tuesday, 27th. Ditto weather. Served Wine to the Ship's Company, the Beer being all Expended but 2 Casks, which I intend to keep some time Longer, as the whole has proved very good to the last Cask. At Noon found the Ship by Observation 10 miles a Head of the Log, which I suppose may be owing to a Current setting in the same direction of the Trade Wind. Wind North-East; course South 19 degrees West; distance 145 miles; latitude 21 degrees 26 minutes North; at noon, Peak of Teneriff, North 26 degrees East, 154 leagues.

Tuesday, 27th. Same weather. Gave wine to the crew since we only have 2 casks of beer left, which I plan to save for a while longer, as the beer has been really good up to the last cask. At noon, I found the ship 10 miles ahead of the log, which I think might be due to a current moving in the same direction as the trade winds. Wind from the North-East; course South 19 degrees West; distance 145 miles; latitude 21 degrees 26 minutes North; at noon, Peak of Teneriff, North 26 degrees East, 154 leagues.

Wednesday, 28th. A Fresh Trade wind and Hazey weather. The Variation of the Compass by the mean of Several Azimuth taken this Evening 12 degrees 46 minutes, and in the Morning by the same Method 12 degrees 43 minutes West. This day's Log and Observed Latitude agree, which is not reconcilable to Yesterday. Exercised the People at Small Arms. Wind North-East, East-North-East; course South 12 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 150 miles; latitude 18 degrees 59 minutes North; at noon, Peak of Teneriff North 23 degrees 15 minutes East, 204 leagues.

Wednesday, 28th. A fresh trade wind and hazy weather. The variation of the compass based on several azimuths taken this evening is 12 degrees 46 minutes, and in the morning by the same method it's 12 degrees 43 minutes west. Today's log and observed latitude match, which doesn't align with yesterday. I had the crew practice with small arms. Wind from the North-East, East-North-East; course South 12 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 150 miles; latitude 18 degrees 59 minutes North; at noon, the Peak of Teneriff is North 23 degrees 15 minutes East, 204 leagues away.

Thursday, 29th. Fresh breezes and Hazey weather. The Variation 12 degrees 33 minutes West; the Observed Latitude ahead of that given by the Log 10 miles. Wind North-East by North; course South 14 degrees West; distance 90 miles; latitude 17 degrees 32 minutes North; at noon Peak of Teneriff, North 33 degrees East, 236 leagues.

Thursday, 29th. There are fresh breezes and hazy weather. The variation is 12 degrees 33 minutes West; the observed latitude is 10 miles ahead of what the log shows. Wind is coming from North-East by North; our course is South 14 degrees West; we covered a distance of 90 miles; latitude is 17 degrees 32 minutes North; at noon, the peak of Tenerife is North 33 degrees East, 236 leagues away.

[Off Cape de Verd Islands.]

[Off Cape Verde Islands.]

Friday, 30th. A Steady breeze and Pleasant weather. At 6 a.m. saw the Island of Bonavista (one of the Cape de Verd islands), Extending from South by East to South-West by South, distance 3 or 4 Leagues. Ranged the East side of this Island at the Distance of 3 or 4 miles from the Shore, until we were obliged to Haul Off to avoid a Ledge of Rocks which stretched out South-West by West from the Body or South-East Point of the Island 1 1/2 leagues. Had no ground with 40 fathoms a Mile without this Ledge. The Island of Bonavista is in Extent from North to South about 5 leagues, is of a very uneven and hilly Surface, with low sandy beaches on the East side. The South-East part of the Island, from which I take my Departure, by an Observation this day at Noon lies in the latitude of 16 degrees North, and according to our run from Madeira in the longitude of 21 degrees 51 minutes West from Greenwich, and South 21 degrees West; 260 leagues from Tenerriff. Drawings Numbers 1 and 2 represent the appearance of the East side of this Island, where (2) is the South-East point, with the hill over it, which is high, of a round Figure, and the southermost on the Island. Wind North-East; course South 12 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 97 miles; latitude 15 degrees 37 minutes North per observation; Teneriffe, North 20 degrees 43 minutes East, 262 1/3 leagues; at noon the hill on the South-East Point of the Island Bonavista North 69 degrees West, distant from the shore 3 leagues.

Friday, 30th. A steady breeze and nice weather. At 6 a.m., we saw the Island of Bonavista (one of the Cape Verde islands) stretching from South by East to Southwest by South, about 3 or 4 leagues away. We sailed along the east side of the island, about 3 or 4 miles from the shore, until we had to pull away to avoid a ledge of rocks that extended Southwest by West from the southeast point of the island for 1.5 leagues. We had no depth with 40 fathoms a mile from this ledge. The Island of Bonavista is about 5 leagues long from north to south, with a very uneven and hilly surface, featuring low sandy beaches on the east side. The southeast part of the island, from where I took my reference today at noon, lies at a latitude of 16 degrees North, and based on our journey from Madeira, it is at a longitude of 21 degrees 51 minutes West from Greenwich, and South 21 degrees West; 260 leagues from Tenerife. Drawings Numbers 1 and 2 show the view of the east side of this island, where (2) is the southeast point, with a high, round hill, which is the southernmost point on the island. Wind from the Northeast; course South 12 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 97 miles; latitude 15 degrees 37 minutes North according to observation; Tenerife, North 20 degrees 43 minutes East, 262 1/3 leagues; at noon, the hill on the southeast point of Bonavista was located North 69 degrees West, 3 leagues from the shore.

[October 1768.]

[October 1768.]

Saturday, October 1st. A steady gale and somewhat Hazey. Variation by very good Azimuths this Evening 10 degrees 37 minutes, and by the same in the Morning 10 degrees 0 minutes West; at Noon found the ship a Head of the Log 5 Miles. Wind North, North-North-East; course South 12 degrees 12 minutes West; distance 114 miles; latitude 14 degrees 6 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 10 minutes West; at noon Island of Bonavista, South-East point, North 9 degrees West, 116 miles.

Saturday, October 1st. There was a steady gale and it was a bit hazy. The variation measured by good azimuths this evening was 10 degrees 37 minutes, and in the morning it was 10 degrees 0 minutes West; at noon, I found the ship ahead of the log by 5 miles. The wind was coming from the North-North-East; our course was South 12 degrees 12 minutes West, covering a distance of 114 miles; we were at a latitude of 14 degrees 6 minutes North and a longitude of 22 degrees 10 minutes West; at noon, the Island of Bonavista was located at its southeast point, North 9 degrees West, 116 miles away.

Sunday, 2nd. First part a Steady breeze and pleasant weather, remainder light breezes and Cloudy. At noon found the Ship by Observation ahead of the Log 7 miles. Wind North by East, North-North-West; course South 1 degree West; distance 92 miles; latitude 12 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 10 minutes West; at noon Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees 45 minutes East, 69 leagues.

Sunday, 2nd. The first part of the day had a steady breeze and nice weather, but the rest was light breezes and cloudy. At noon, we found the ship was 7 miles ahead of the log based on observations. The wind was coming from the North by East and North-North-West; we were on a course of South 1 degree West; distance traveled was 92 miles; latitude 12 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 10 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, was North 5 degrees 45 minutes East, 69 leagues away.

Monday, 3rd. Cloudy weather, with light winds and Calms. Variation by this Evening Amplitude South 8 degrees 49 minutes West. A.M. hoisted out a Boat to try if there was any Current; found one setting to the South-East at the rate of 3/4 of a Mile per hour. Wind North, calm, South-South-West 1/2 West; course South 3 degrees 30 minutes East; distance 20 miles; latitude 12 degrees 14 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 10 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees East, 76 leagues.

Monday, 3rd. The weather was cloudy, with light winds and calm conditions. By this evening, the variation was an amplitude of 8 degrees 49 minutes west. In the morning, we launched a boat to check for any current; we found one heading southeast at a speed of ¾ of a mile per hour. The wind was calm from the north, with a slight breeze from the south-southwest. We were on a course of 3 degrees 30 minutes east; we covered a distance of 20 miles, reaching a latitude of 12 degrees 14 minutes north and a longitude of 22 degrees 10 minutes west. At noon, Bonavista was located at the southeast point, 5 degrees east, 76 leagues away.

Tuesday, 4th. Calm for the Greatest part of the 24 Hours. By an Observation we had this Morning of the Sun and Moon found our Selves in the Longitude of 22 degrees 32 minutes 30 seconds West from Greenwich; that by account is 21 degrees 58 minutes, the Difference being 34 miles Westerly, which does not agree with the Setting of the Current, for having try'd it twice to-day and found it set to the East-South-East 1 Mile per Hour, and at the same time found the Ship to the Southward of the Log by the Noon Observation 10 miles. Served Portable soup and Sour kroutt to the Ship's Company. Wind variable; course South 53 degrees West; distance 17 miles; latitude 11 degrees 53 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 33 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 2 degrees East, 82 leagues.

Tuesday, 4th. It was mostly calm for the whole day. This morning, by observing the Sun and Moon, we found ourselves at a longitude of 22 degrees, 32 minutes, 30 seconds West of Greenwich; according to our calculations, that is 21 degrees, 58 minutes, which means there's a difference of 34 miles to the west. This doesn't match the current's direction, as we tried measuring it twice today and found it moving to the East-Southeast at 1 mile per hour. At the same time, our ship was 10 miles south of where the log indicated it should be based on our noon observation. We served portable soup and sauerkraut to the crew. The wind was variable; we were headed South 53 degrees West; covering a distance of 17 miles; our position was latitude 11 degrees, 53 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees, 33 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista's southeast point was North 2 degrees East, 82 leagues away.

Wednesday, 5th. Light breezes of Wind, sometimes Clear and sometimes Cloudy weather. Variation 6 degrees 10 minutes West by an Amplitude and Azimuth this evening. At noon found the Ship by the Observed Latitude 7 Miles to the Southward of the Log, and by the Observed Longitude 30 degrees to the Eastward of Yesterday's Observations; and as these Observations for finding the Longitude (if carefully observed with good Instrument) will generally come within 10 or 15 Miles of each other, and very often much nearer, it therefore can be no longer in Doubt but that there is a Current setting to the Eastward;* (* This was the Counter Equatorial Current.) yet we cannot have had this Current long, because the Longitude by account and that by Observation agree to-day, but Yesterday she was 28 miles to the Westward of the Observation. Wind calm, North-East, East; course South 29 degrees East; distance 57 miles; latitude 10 degrees 56 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 3 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 2 degrees East, 101 leagues.

Wednesday, 5th. Light breezes of wind, with weather that was sometimes clear and sometimes cloudy. Variation of 6 degrees 10 minutes West by an amplitude and azimuth this evening. At noon, I found the ship was 7 miles south of what the log showed, and by the observed longitude, it was 30 degrees east of yesterday's observations. These observations to determine longitude (if carefully taken with a good instrument) usually come within 10 or 15 miles of each other, and quite often much closer, so it’s now clear there’s a current flowing to the eastward;* (* This was the Counter Equatorial Current.) However, we can't have been under this current for long, because the longitude by account and that by observation matched today, but yesterday it was 28 miles to the west of the observation. Wind is calm, from the North-East, East; course is South 29 degrees East; distance is 57 miles; latitude is 10 degrees 56 minutes North, longitude is 22 degrees 3 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 2 degrees East, 101 leagues.

Thursday, 6th. First part light Breezes and Cloudy; Middle frequent heavy Squalls, with rain, till towards Noon when we had again little wind. Found the Variation by the mean of 3 Azimuth, taken this Morning, to be 8 degrees 52 minutes West, which makes the Variation found Yesterday doubtful. Wind North-East, South-East, Southerly; course South 10 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 77 miles; latitude 9 degrees 40 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 28 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 4 degrees East, 128 leagues.

Thursday, 6th. The first part of the day had light breezes and was cloudy; in the middle of the day, there were frequent heavy squalls with rain until around noon when the wind died down again. I determined the variation by averaging three azimuths taken this morning to be 8 degrees 52 minutes West, which makes yesterday's variation uncertain. The wind was coming from the North-East, South-East, and Southerly directions; we were on a course of South 10 degrees 30 minutes West; we covered a distance of 77 miles; our latitude was 9 degrees 40 minutes North, and longitude was 22 degrees 28 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, was North 4 degrees East, 128 leagues away.

Friday, 7th. Variable light Airs and Calm all these 24 Hours. At Noon found the Current to set South-East 1/4 South one Mile per hour, and yet by Observation at Noon I find the Ship 12 Miles to the Northward of Account, a Circumstance that hath not hapned for many days, and which I believe to be owing to the heavy Squalls we had Yesterday from the South-East, which obliged us to put frequently before the Wind. Wind Southerly, calm, Northerly; course South 5 degrees West; distance 10 miles; latitude 9 degrees 42 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 19 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 4 degrees East, 127 leagues.

Friday, 7th. Light variable winds and calm for the entire 24 hours. At noon, I found the current moving southeast at a quarter south at one mile per hour, and yet, according to my observations at noon, the ship is 12 miles north of where I expected, which hasn’t happened in many days. I believe this is due to the heavy squalls we experienced yesterday from the southeast, which forced us to frequently sail with the wind. Wind was southerly, calm, then northerly; course set at south 5 degrees west; distance traveled 10 miles; latitude 9 degrees 42 minutes north, longitude 22 degrees 19 minutes west; at noon, Bonavista, southeast point, north 4 degrees east, 127 leagues.

[Between Cape de Verd Islands and Equator.]

[Between Cape Verde Islands and Equator.]

Saturday, 8th. First part, light Airs and Clear weather; Middle, Squally, with Thunder and Lightning all round; latter part, Moderate breezes and Clear weather. Had several Azimuths both in the Evening and Morning, which gave the Variation South 8 degrees 30 minutes West. At Noon found by Observation that the Ship had outrun the Log 20 Miles, a Proof that there is a Current setting to the Southward. Wind North-East by North to East-South-East; course South by East; distance 78 miles; latitude 8 degrees 25 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 4 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 1 degree 45 minutes East, 152 leagues.

Saturday, the 8th. In the morning, it was lightly breezy and clear; by midday, it became squally with thunder and lightning all around; later, it settled to moderate breezes and clear skies. We took several azimuth readings in the evening and morning, which indicated a variation of 8 degrees 30 minutes west. At noon, observations showed that the ship had surpassed the log by 20 miles, proving there’s a current moving southward. The wind was from the northeast by north to east-southeast; our course was south by east; we traveled 78 miles; latitude was 8 degrees 25 minutes north, longitude was 22 degrees 4 minutes west; at noon, Bonavista’s southeast point was to the north 1 degree 45 minutes east, 152 leagues away.

Sunday, 9th. Light Airs and fine Clear weather. Found the Variation by a great Number of Azimuth made this Afternoon to be 8 degrees 21 minutes 30 seconds West, and by the Morning Amplitude 7 degrees 48 minutes. At Noon try'd the Current, and found it set North-North-West 3/4 West, 1 1/8 miles per hour. The Shifting of the Current was conformed by the Observed Latitude Wind East-South-East; course South 16 degrees West; distance 29 miles; latitude 7 degrees 58 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 2 degrees 40 minutes, 161 leagues.

Sunday, 9th. Light winds and clear weather. I found the variation through a lot of azimuth readings this afternoon to be 8 degrees 21 minutes 30 seconds West, and from the morning amplitude, 7 degrees 48 minutes. At noon, I checked the current and discovered it was flowing North-North-West 3/4 West at 1 1/8 miles per hour. The change in the current was confirmed by the observed latitude. The wind was coming from the East-South-East; my course was South 16 degrees West; I traveled 29 miles; my position was at a latitude of 7 degrees 58 minutes North and a longitude of 22 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, I was near Bonavista, Southeast point, North 2 degrees 40 minutes, 161 leagues.

Monday, 10th. First part, light breezes and Clear weather; Middle, squally, with heavy Showers of Rain; latter, Variable, light Airs and Calm and dark gloomy weather. At 3 p.m. found the Current to set North-North-East 1/4 East, 1 1/4 Mile per Hour, and at Noon found it to set North-East 3/4 North at the same rate, and the Variation to be 8 degrees 39 minutes West by the Mean of Several Azimuth. Wind South-East by East, Southerly; course South; distance 10 miles; latitude 7 degrees 48 minutes North; longitude 22 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 3 degrees East, 164 leagues.

Monday, 10th. In the morning, there were light breezes and clear skies; in the afternoon, it got squally with heavy rain showers; by evening, the weather became variable with light winds and calm, but it was dark and gloomy. At 3 p.m., I found the current setting North-North-East 1/4 East at 1 1/4 miles per hour, and at noon, it was setting North-East 3/4 North at the same speed, with a variation of 8 degrees 39 minutes West based on several azimuth readings. The wind was coming from the South-East by East, moving southerly; we were on a course heading south; the distance covered was 10 miles; at latitude 7 degrees 48 minutes North and longitude 22 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista was located at the South-East point, North 3 degrees East, 164 leagues away.

Tuesday, 11th. Very Variable weather, with frequent Squalls rain, and Lightning. By the Observed Latitude at Noon I find the Ship hath only made 22 Miles Southing since the last Observation two days ago, whereas the Log gives 55 Miles, a Proof that there is a Current setting to the Northward. Wind South-East; course South 52 degrees West; distance 18 miles; latitude 7 degrees 36 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 8 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 3 degrees East, 168 leagues.

Tuesday, 11th. The weather was very unpredictable, with frequent rain squalls and lightning. By checking the latitude at noon, I found that the ship had only traveled 22 miles south since the last observation two days ago, while the log shows 55 miles—proof that there is a current pushing northward. The wind was coming from the southeast; we were on a course of south 52 degrees west; the distance covered was 18 miles; our latitude was 7 degrees 36 minutes north, and longitude was 22 degrees 8 minutes west; at noon, Bonavista, southeast point, was north 3 degrees east, 168 leagues away.

Wednesday, 12th. Much the same weather as Yesterday the first part, the remainder mostly Calm and cloudy weather. A.M. try'd the Current and found it set South by West 1/4 West, 1/2 Mile per Hour, which is not agreeable to yesterday's remark. Wind variable; course South 33 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 20 miles; latitude 7 degrees 21 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 39 minutes West; at noon Bonavista North 5 degrees East, 174 leagues.

Wednesday, 12th. The weather was pretty much the same as yesterday for the first part of the day, with the rest being mostly calm and cloudy. In the morning, I tested the current and found it flowing South by West 1/4 West at 1/2 mile per hour, which doesn’t match what I noted yesterday. The wind was variable; we headed South 33 degrees 30 minutes West; traveled 20 miles; our latitude was 7 degrees 21 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 39 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista was North 5 degrees East, 174 leagues away.

Thursday, 13th. Light Airs of Wind, with some heavy showers of rain. Variation by Azimuth and Amplitude this Evening 8 degrees 46 minutes West. At Noon try'd the Current, and found it set South 3/4 East, 1/3 of a Mile per Hour; but finding the Observation and Log agree, I am inclinable to think it hath had no effect upon the Ship. Wind South-West, West-South-West; course South 16 degrees 45 minutes East; distance 21 miles; latitude 7 degrees 1 minute North, longitude 22 degrees 32 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees East, 181 leagues.

Thursday, 13th. Light winds with some heavy rain showers. Variation by azimuth and amplitude this evening is 8 degrees 46 minutes west. At noon, I checked the current and found it moving south 3/4 east at 1/3 of a mile per hour; however, since the observation and log match, I think it hasn’t affected the ship. Wind is from the south-west, west-south-west; course is south 16 degrees 45 minutes east; distance is 21 miles; latitude is 7 degrees 1 minute north, longitude is 22 degrees 32 minutes west; at noon, Bonavista, south-east point, north 5 degrees east, 181 leagues.

Friday, 14th. Dark, gloomy weather, with much rain, the Wind Variable from West-South-West to South-South-East, sometimes on one Tack and sometimes on the other. Wind West-South-West to South-South-East; course South 5 degrees East; distance 24 miles; latitude 6 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 30 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 3 degrees 15 minutes, 188 leagues.

Friday, 14th. Dark, gloomy weather with a lot of rain, the wind shifting from West-South-West to South-South-East, sometimes on one tack and sometimes on the other. Wind from West-South-West to South-South-East; course South 5 degrees East; distance 24 miles; latitude 6 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 30 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, Southeast point, North 3 degrees 15 minutes, 188 leagues.

Saturday, 15th. First part, little wind and Cloudy; Middle, Squally, with rain; latter part, light Airs and Clear weather. A little before Noon took several Observations of the sun and moon, the mean result of which gave the Longitude to be 23 degrees 46 minutes West from Greenwich, which is 1 degree 22 minutes more Westerly than that by account carried on from the last Observation; and the Observed Latitude is 24 Miles more Northerly than the Log since the Last Observation 2 days ago, all of which shows that the North-Westerly Current hath prevailed for this some Days past. Wind South-South-West to South-East; course South 30 degrees East per log; distance 12 miles; latitude 6 degrees 50 minutes North; longitude 22 degrees 23 minutes West per account, 23 degrees 46 minutes per sun and moon; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North by East, 187 leagues.

Saturday, 15th. In the first part of the day, there was little wind and it was cloudy; in the middle, it got squally with rain; and in the latter part, there were light breezes and clear weather. A little before noon, I took several observations of the sun and moon, and the average result indicated the longitude to be 23 degrees 46 minutes west of Greenwich, which is 1 degree 22 minutes further west than what we calculated from the last observation. The observed latitude is 24 miles further north than the log since the last observation two days ago, all of which indicates that the north-westerly current has been strong for the past few days. The wind was from the south-southwest to the southeast; the course was south 30 degrees east according to the log; the distance covered was 12 miles; the latitude was 6 degrees 50 minutes north; the longitude was 22 degrees 23 minutes west according to the log, and 23 degrees 46 minutes based on the sun and moon; at noon, Bonavista, southeast point, was north by east, 187 leagues.

Sunday, 16th. First part Calm, the remainder Gentle breezes and fine, Pleasant weather. At 3 hours 30 minutes 39 seconds Apparent time p.m. the observed distance of the sun and moon's nearest Limb was 52 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds; the Altitude of the sun's lower limb 32 degrees 39 minutes; the Altitude of the moon's lower limb 58 degrees 36 minutes; the longitude of the Ship from the aforegoing Observations 23 degrees 33 minutes 33 seconds West from Greenwich, differing 13 minutes from those made this Morning or Yesterday, the Ship laying all the time becalmed. Variation of the Compass 8 degrees 45 minutes West. Wind South-East, variable, North-East; course South 2 degrees East; distance 72 miles; latitude 5 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude 23 degrees 45 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees 15 minutes East, 208 leagues.

Sunday, 16th. First part calm, the rest with gentle breezes and nice weather. At 3:30:39 PM, the observed distance from the nearest edge of the sun and moon was 52 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds; the altitude of the sun's lower edge was 32 degrees 39 minutes; the altitude of the moon's lower edge was 58 degrees 36 minutes; the ship's longitude from these observations was 23 degrees 33 minutes 33 seconds West from Greenwich, differing by 13 minutes from those taken this morning or yesterday, with the ship remaining calm the whole time. The compass variation was 8 degrees 45 minutes West. Wind was coming from the South-East, variable to the North-East; course was South 2 degrees East; distance traveled was 72 miles; latitude was 5 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude was 23 degrees 45 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, was North 5 degrees 15 minutes East, 208 leagues.

Monday, 17th. Variable, light Airs and Calm clear weather. 1/2 past 1 p.m. took two Distances of the sun and moon, the first of which gave the Longitude 23 degrees 45 minutes 56 seconds, and the last 23 degrees 44 minutes West, the difference being not quite two miles, which shows how near to one another these observations can be made. Wind South, South-East, variable; course South by West 1/2 West; distance 11 miles; latitude 5 degrees 17 minutes North, longitude 23 degrees 47 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees 15 minutes East, 212 leagues.

Monday, 17th. Variable, light winds and clear, calm weather. At 1:30 p.m., I took two measurements of the sun and moon. The first gave a longitude of 23 degrees 45 minutes 56 seconds, and the second 23 degrees 44 minutes West, with a difference of less than two miles, demonstrating how close these observations can be. Wind was coming from the South, South-East, variable; our course was South by West 1/2 West; we covered a distance of 11 miles; latitude 5 degrees 17 minutes North, longitude 23 degrees 47 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 5 degrees 15 minutes East, 212 leagues.

Tuesday, 18th. Sometimes little wind, sometimes Squally, with rain and Lightning. Wind South to East-South-East; course South 48 degrees West; distance 45 miles; latitude 4 degrees 47 Minutes North, longitude 24 degrees 23 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 12 degrees East, 229 leagues.

Tuesday, 18th. At times there was a light breeze, and at other times it was gusty, with rain and lightning. The wind was blowing from the South to East-South-East; we were headed South 48 degrees West; covering a distance of 45 miles; our latitude was 4 degrees 47 minutes North, and longitude was 24 degrees 23 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, the Southeast point, was 12 degrees North, 229 leagues away.

Wednesday, 19th. Fresh breezes and Cloudy weather. The Observed Latitude to the Northward of that given by the Log 9 miles, which I suppose must be owing to a Current. Wind South by East to South-East by South; course South 42 degrees West; distance 88 miles; latitude 3 degrees 44 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 23 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 14 degrees East, 253 leagues.

Wednesday, 19th. Fresh breezes and cloudy weather. The observed latitude is 9 miles north of what the log recorded, which I think is due to a current. Wind from South by East to South-East by South; course South 42 degrees West; distance 88 miles; latitude 3 degrees 44 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 23 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 14 degrees East, 253 leagues.

Thursday, 20th. A Genteel gale and Clear weather. At a little before 5 p.m. had an Observation of the sun and moon, which gave the Longitude 25 degrees 46 minutes West from Greenwich, which is more Westerly than that by account carried on from the last Observation; and the Observed latitude being again to the Northward shows that there must be a current setting between the North and West. Wind South by East to South-East by South; course South 52 degrees West; distance 48 miles; latitude 3 degrees 16 minutes North, longitude 26 degrees 20 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, North 18 degrees 30 minutes East, 270 leagues.

Thursday, 20th. A Gentle breeze and clear skies. Just before 5 p.m., I took a reading of the sun and moon, which showed the longitude as 25 degrees 46 minutes West from Greenwich, which is farther west than what we calculated from the last observation. The observed latitude being further north indicates that there must be a current flowing between the north and west. Wind direction was South by East to South-East by South; course was South 52 degrees West; distance traveled was 48 miles; latitude 3 degrees 16 minutes North, longitude 26 degrees 20 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, North 18 degrees 30 minutes East, 270 leagues.

[Crossing Equator.]

[Crossing the Equator.]

Friday, 21st. A moderate breeze, and for the most part clear weather. Longitude per the Mean of 2 Observations of the sun and moon made at 4 hours 45 minutes and at 4 hours 54 minutes p.m., 26 degrees 33 minutes West. Variation of the Compass 4 degrees 7 minutes West, and the Observed Latitude at Noon to the Northward of the Log 7 Miles. Wind South-East to South-South-East; course South 58 degrees West; distance 57 miles; latitude 2 degrees 46 minutes North, longitude 27 degrees 11 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista South-East point, North 21 degrees East, 281 leagues.

Friday, 21st. A light breeze, mostly clear skies. Longitude based on the average of two observations of the sun and moon taken at 4:45 p.m. and 4:54 p.m., 26 degrees 33 minutes West. Compass variation is 4 degrees 7 minutes West, and the observed latitude at noon is 7 miles north of the log. Wind is coming from the South-East to South-South-East; course is South 58 degrees West; distance traveled is 57 miles; latitude is 2 degrees 46 minutes North, longitude is 27 degrees 11 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista is to the South-East, North 21 degrees East, 281 leagues.

Saturday, 22nd. Moderate breezes and fine, pleasant weather. Variation 3 degrees 17 minutes West. Wind South-East by South; course South 43 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 87 miles; latitude 1 degree 40 minutes North, longitude 28 degrees 12 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 23 degrees East, 312 leagues.

Saturday, 22nd. Light winds and nice, enjoyable weather. Variation 3 degrees 17 minutes West. Wind from the South-East by South; course South 43 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 87 miles; latitude 1 degree 40 minutes North, longitude 28 degrees 12 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 23 degrees East, 312 leagues.

Sunday, 23rd. A moderate, Steady breeze and fine Clear weather. The Ship by Observation at Noon is 8 Miles to the Northward of the Log. Wind South-South-East; course South; distance 5 miles; latitude 1 degree 40 minutes North, longitude 28 degrees 12 West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 23 degrees East, 312 leagues.

Sunday, 23rd. A steady, moderate breeze and clear weather. The ship, according to our noon observation, is 8 miles north of what the log shows. Wind is coming from the south-southeast; we’re heading south; traveled 5 miles; latitude 1 degree 40 minutes north, longitude 28 degrees 12 minutes west; at noon, Bonavista, southeast point, is north 23 degrees east, 312 leagues.

Monday, 24th. First part ditto weather; remainder fresh Breezes and Cloudy, with some flying Showers of rain. Variation per Azimuth this morning 3 degrees West. At Noon by Observation found the Ship 11 Miles ahead of the Log. Wind South by East to South-East by South; course South 49 degrees West; distance 50 miles; latitude 1 degree 7 minutes North; longitude 28 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 25 degrees East, 328 leagues.

Monday, 24th. The first part of the day was the same weather; the rest was fresh breezes and cloudy, with some brief rain showers. This morning’s compass variation was 3 degrees west. At noon, by observation, the ship was 11 miles ahead of the log. The wind was from South by East to South-East by South; course was South 49 degrees West; distance was 50 miles; latitude was 1 degree 7 minutes North; longitude was 28 degrees 50 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 25 degrees East, 328 leagues.

Tuesday, 25th. A Genteel breeze and Clear weather, with a Moist Air. Soon after sunrise found the Variation of the Compass to be 2 degrees 24 minutes West, being the Mean result of several very good Azimuths. This was just before we crossed the Line in the Longitude of 29 degrees 29 minutes West from Greenwich. We also try'd the Diping Needle belonging to the Royal Society, and found the North point to Dip 26 degrees below the Horizon; but this Instrument cannot be used at Sea to any great degree of accuracy on account of the Motion of the Ship, which hinders the Needle from resting. However, as the Ship was pretty steady, and by means of a Swinging Table I had made for that purpose, we could be Certain of the Dip to two Degrees at most. The Observed Latitude and that by account nearly Agree. Wind South-East to South-East by East; course South 30 degrees West; distance 95 miles; latitude 0 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 29 degrees 30 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 26 degrees East, 358 leagues.

Tuesday, 25th. A gentle breeze and clear weather with moist air. Shortly after sunrise, we found the compass variation to be 2 degrees 24 minutes West, which was the average result of several good azimuth readings. This was just before we crossed the equator at a longitude of 29 degrees 29 minutes West from Greenwich. We also tested the dipping needle belonging to the Royal Society and found that the North point dipped 26 degrees below the horizon; however, this instrument can't be used at sea with high accuracy due to the ship's motion, which prevents the needle from stabilizing. Still, since the ship was fairly steady, and thanks to a swinging table I made for this purpose, we could determine the dip to within two degrees at most. The observed latitude and the calculated latitude nearly match. Wind from the South-East to South-East by East; course South 30 degrees West; distance 95 miles; latitude 0 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 29 degrees 30 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 26 degrees East, 358 leagues.

Wednesday, 26th. First part light Airs and Cloudy weather, the remainder a Moderate Breeze and Cloudy. After we had got an observation, and it was no longer Doubted that we were to the Southward of the Line, the Ceremony on this occasion practis'd by all Nations was not Omitted. Every one that could not prove upon the Sea Chart that he had before Crossed the Line was either to pay a Bottle of Rum or be Duck'd in the Sea, which former case was the fate of by far the Greatest part on board; and as several of the Men chose to be Duck'd, and the weather was favourable for that purpose, this Ceremony was performed on about 20 or 30, to the no small Diversion of the Rest. Wind South-East to South-South-East; course South 31 degrees West; distance 77 miles; latitude 1 degree 21 minutes South, longitude 30 degrees 18 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 25 degrees 30 minutes East, 385 leagues.

Wednesday, 26th. The first part of the day had light breezes and cloudy weather; the rest of the day had a moderate breeze and continued to be cloudy. Once we took our observation and it was clear that we were south of the Equator, we went ahead with the traditional ceremony practiced by all nations. Anyone who couldn't prove on the sea chart that they had crossed the Equator before had to either pay a bottle of rum or be dunked in the sea, which was the fate for most of the crew. Several of the men opted to be dunked, and since the weather was good for that, about 20 or 30 participated in the ceremony, much to the amusement of the others. Wind from the South-East to South-South-East; course South 31 degrees West; distance 77 miles; latitude 1 degree 21 minutes South, longitude 30 degrees 18 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 25 degrees 30 minutes East, 385 leagues.

Thursday, 27th. Fresh Gales and Close Cloudy weather. Variation 2 degrees 48 minutes West. Wind South-South-East to South-East; course South 38 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 79 miles; latitude 2 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 31 degrees 7 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 26 degrees East, 410 leagues.

Thursday, 27th. Strong winds and overcast weather. Variation of 2 degrees 48 minutes West. Wind from South-South-East to South-East; course South 38 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 79 miles; latitude 2 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 31 degrees 7 minutes West; at noon, Bonavista, South-East point, North 26 degrees East, 410 leagues.

Friday, 28th. Fresh Breeze and fine Clear weather. At a little past 1 a.m. Longitude in by the 3 following Observations--viz., by the Moon and the star Arietis, 32 degrees 27 minutes; by the Moon and Pollux, 32 degrees 0 minutes 15 seconds; by ditto, 31 degrees 48 minutes 32 seconds; the mean of the whole is 32 degrees 5 minutes 16 seconds West from Greenwich, which is 31 minutes more Westerly than the longitude by account carried on since the last Observation. The two first observations were made and computed by Mr. Green, and the last by myself. The star Arietis was on one side of the Moon and Pollux on the other. This day at Noon, being nearly in the latitude of the Island Ferdinand Noronha, to the Westward of it by some Charts and to the Eastward by others, was in Expectation of seeing it or some of those Shoals that are laid down in most Charts between it and the Main; but we saw neither one nor a Nother. We certainly passed to the Eastward of the Island, and as to the Shoals, I don't think they Exhist, grounding this my Opinion on the Journal of some East India Ships I have seen who were detain'd by Contrary winds between this Island and the Main, and being 5 or 6 Ships in Company, doubtless must have seen some of them did they lay as Marked in the Charts.* (* There is a very dangerous reef, As Rocas, 80 miles west of Fernando Noronha. The Endeavour passed 60 miles east of latter.) Wind South-East to South-East by East; course South 33 degrees West; distance 93 miles, latitude 3 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 32 degrees 29 minutes West.

Friday, 28th. Fresh breeze and clear weather. At a little past 1 a.m., the longitude based on the following three observations was as follows: by the Moon and the star Arietis, 32 degrees 27 minutes; by the Moon and Pollux, 32 degrees 0 minutes 15 seconds; and by the same, 31 degrees 48 minutes 32 seconds. The average of all three is 32 degrees 5 minutes 16 seconds West from Greenwich, which is 31 minutes more westward than the longitude recorded since the last observation. The first two observations were made and calculated by Mr. Green, while I made the last one. The star Arietis was on one side of the Moon, and Pollux was on the other. Today at noon, being nearly in the latitude of Island Ferdinand Noronha—some charts place it to the west and others to the east—we expected to see it or some of the shoals shown on most charts between it and the mainland, but we saw neither. We definitely passed to the east of the island, and as for the shoals, I don't think they exist. I'm basing this on the journal of some East India ships I’ve seen that were stuck by contrary winds between this island and the mainland, and since there were 5 or 6 ships in the group, they would have surely seen some of them if they were marked on the charts. (* There is a very dangerous reef, As Rocas, 80 miles west of Fernando Noronha. The Endeavour passed 60 miles east of the latter.) Wind from the South-East to South-East by East; course South 33 degrees West; distance 93 miles, latitude 3 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 32 degrees 29 minutes West.

Saturday, 29th. Fresh Breezes and pleasant weather. Variation of the Compass 2 degrees 25 minutes West. Wind East-South-East; course South by West; distance 101 miles; latitude 5 degrees 25 minutes South, longitude 32 degrees 48" West.

Saturday, 29th. Fresh breezes and nice weather. The compass variation is 2 degrees 25 minutes West. Wind is coming from the East-South-East; course is South by West; distance traveled is 101 miles; latitude is 5 degrees 25 minutes South, longitude is 32 degrees 48" West.

Sunday, 30th. A Steady breeze, and for the most part close cloudy weather. Variation by several Azimuths 1 degree 31 minutes West. At noon the observed latitude 7 miles southward of account. Wind East-South-East; course South 3/4 West; distance 107 miles; latitude 7 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 33 degrees 4 minutes West.

Sunday, 30th. A steady breeze and mostly overcast weather. Variation by several azimuths: 1 degree 31 minutes West. At noon, the observed latitude was 7 miles south of the recorded account. Wind from the East-South-East; course South 3/4 West; distance 107 miles; latitude 7 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 33 degrees 4 minutes West.

Monday, 31st. A Fresh breeze and Clear weather. Variation 0 degrees 15 minutes West. Observed Latitude again to the Southward of the Log. Wind East to East-South-East; course, South 1/2 West; distance 114 miles; latitude 9 degrees 1 minute South, longitude 33 degrees 16 minutes West.

Monday, 31st. A fresh breeze and clear weather. Variation 0 degrees 15 minutes West. Observed latitude again to the south of the log. Wind from East to East-South-East; course, South 1/2 West; distance 114 miles; latitude 9 degrees 1 minute South, longitude 33 degrees 16 minutes West.

[November 1768. Between Equator and Rio.]

[November 1768. Between Equator and Rio.]

Tuesday, November 1st. Moderate breezes, for the most part Cloudy. Variation by the mean of Several Azimuths 0 degrees 58 minutes West in the Evening, and in the Morning found it to be 0 degrees 18 minutes West. Wind East-South-East; course South 3/4 West; distance 98 miles; latitude 10 degrees 38 minutes South.

Tuesday, November 1st. Mild breezes, mostly cloudy. Variation by the average of several azimuths: 0 degrees 58 minutes west in the evening, and in the morning it was 0 degrees 18 minutes west. Wind from the east-southeast; course south 3/4 west; distance 98 miles; latitude 10 degrees 38 minutes south.

Wednesday, 2nd. A Steady breeze and fine pleasant weather. This Afternoon, by the mean of Several Azimuths and the Amplitude, found the Variation to be 0 degrees 34 minutes East, from which it appears that about the aforegoing Noon we have Crossed the Line of no Variation in the Latitude of 10 degrees 38 minutes South, and, according to the following Observations, in 32 degrees 0 minutes West longitude from Greenwich. At 5 hours 5 minutes 0 seconds Apparent time a.m. the longitude of the Ship and the Observation of the moon and the star Aldebaran was found to be 32 degrees 0 minutes 45 seconds; at 8 hours 17 minutes 0 seconds, per sun and moon, 32 degrees 25 minutes 0 seconds; and at 9 hours 0 minutes 16 seconds, 32 degrees 19 minutes 0 seconds. The mean of the three is 32 degrees 14 minutes 55 seconds. And again at 7 hours 12 minutes 52 seconds, per sun and moon, 32 degrees 10 minutes 4 seconds; and at 7 hours 19 minutes 42 seconds, per sun and moon, 32 degrees 15 minutes 20 seconds. The mean of these two is 32 degrees 12 minutes 42 seconds, and the mean of the whole is 32 degrees 13 minutes 43 seconds West from Greenwich, which is less by a whole Degree than that by account, which is a Considerable Error to be made in 5 Days in these low Latitudes. One would think from this that we must have had a Current setting to the Eastward, which is not likely that it should set against the settled trade wind. The 3 first of these Observations were made by Mr. Green, and the 2 last by myself. Wind East-South-East, South; course South by West; distance 132 miles; latitude 12 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 32 degrees 20 minutes West per Observation.

Wednesday, 2nd. A steady breeze and nice weather. This afternoon, by measuring several azimuths and the amplitude, I found the variation to be 0 degrees 34 minutes East. This indicates that around noon, we crossed the line of no variation at a latitude of 10 degrees 38 minutes South, and according to the following observations, at 32 degrees 0 minutes West longitude from Greenwich. At 5:05:00 AM apparent time, the ship's longitude, based on observations of the moon and the star Aldebaran, was found to be 32 degrees 0 minutes 45 seconds; at 8:17:00, using the sun and moon, it was 32 degrees 25 minutes 0 seconds; and at 9:00:16, it was 32 degrees 19 minutes 0 seconds. The average of the three is 32 degrees 14 minutes 55 seconds. Again, at 7:12:52, using the sun and moon, it was 32 degrees 10 minutes 4 seconds; and at 7:19:42, also using the sun and moon, it was 32 degrees 15 minutes 20 seconds. The average of these two is 32 degrees 12 minutes 42 seconds, and the overall average is 32 degrees 13 minutes 43 seconds West from Greenwich, which is a full degree less than what was recorded, indicating a significant error in just five days in these low latitudes. One would think from this that we must have encountered a current setting to the east, which seems unlikely against the established trade wind. The first three observations were made by Mr. Green, and the last two were made by myself. Wind East-South-East, South; course South by West; distance 132 miles; latitude 12 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 32 degrees 20 minutes West based on observation.

Thursday, 3rd. A Fresh Trade wind and fair weather. Variation per Azimuth this Evening 0 degrees 47 minutes East, and at a little past 9 a.m. longitude in per sun and moon 33 degrees 0 minutes West of Greenwich. Wind East by South-East; course South 15 degrees West; distance 128 miles; latitude 14 degrees 51 minutes South, longitude 33 degrees 7 minutes West.

Thursday, 3rd. A fresh trade wind and pleasant weather. Variation by azimuth this evening is 0 degrees 47 minutes East, and just after 9 a.m., longitude calculated through the sun and moon is 33 degrees 0 minutes West of Greenwich. Wind is coming from East by South-East; course is South 15 degrees West; distance covered is 128 miles; latitude is 14 degrees 51 minutes South, longitude is 33 degrees 7 minutes West.

Friday, 4th. A Steady Gale and fair weather. P.M. Variation per Azimuth 1 degree 29 minutes West, ditto 1 degree 28 minutes West, and by the Amplitude 1 degree 12 minutes West; mean 1 degree 23 minutes West, by which it appears that we have again Crossed the Line of no Variation. At 1/2 past 9 a.m. the longitude of the Ship, per Observation of the sun and moon, 33 degrees 26 minutes 30 seconds. Wind East by South; course South 19 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 125 miles; latitude 16 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 33 degrees 37 minutes West.

Friday, 4th. A steady gale and good weather. In the afternoon, variation per azimuth was 1 degree 29 minutes West, the same 1 degree 28 minutes West, and by amplitude 1 degree 12 minutes West; the average is 1 degree 23 minutes West, which shows that we have crossed the line of no variation again. At 9:30 a.m., the ship's longitude, based on observations of the sun and moon, was 33 degrees 26 minutes 30 seconds. The wind was blowing from the east by south; the course was south 19 degrees 30 minutes west; we covered a distance of 125 miles; the latitude was 16 degrees 49 minutes South, and the longitude was 33 degrees 37 minutes West.

Saturday, 5th. Fine pleasant weather. Variation per Azimuth this morning 3 degrees 21 minutes East, which makes me Doubtful of the Variation found yesterday, tho' at the time I had not the least room to doubt of the Accuracy of the Observations. Longitude per Observation 34 degrees 43 minutes 30 seconds West. Wind East to North-East; course South 30 degrees 35 minutes West; distance 109 miles; latitude 18 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude 34 degrees 50 minutes West.

Saturday, 5th. Beautiful, pleasant weather. This morning, the azimuth variation was 3 degrees 21 minutes East, which makes me question the variation recorded yesterday, although at the time I had no reason to doubt the accuracy of the observations. Longitude according to the observation is 34 degrees 43 minutes 30 seconds West. The wind was from East to North-East; we were headed South 30 degrees 35 minutes West; the distance covered was 109 miles; latitude was 18 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude 34 degrees 50 minutes West.

Sunday, 6th. First and Latter part squally, with heavy Showers of rain; middle moderate and fair. I now determined to put into Rio de Janeiro in preferance to any other port in Brazil or Falkland Islands, for at this place I knew we could recruit our Stock of Provisions, several Articles of which I found we should in time be in want of, and at the same time procure Live Stock and refreshment for the People; and from the reception former Ships had met with here I doubted not but we should be well received. Wind North-North-East, variable, South; course South 55 degrees West; distance 74 miles; latitude 19 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 35 degrees 50 minutes West.

Sunday, 6th. The first part of the day was windy and rainy, with heavy downpours; the middle was moderate and clear. I decided to head into Rio de Janeiro instead of any other port in Brazil or the Falkland Islands, because I knew we could restock our supplies here, as I noticed we would soon run low on several items. At the same time, we could get fresh produce and livestock for the crew. Given how other ships had been received here, I was confident we would be welcomed. Wind was coming from the North-North-East, variable, then South; heading South 55 degrees West; distance traveled was 74 miles; latitude 19 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 35 degrees 50 minutes West.

Monday, 7th. Moderate breezes and Clear weather. P.M. found the Variation to be 4 degrees 49 minutes East. At 6 Sounded and had 32 fathoms Water; the Bottom Coral Rocks, fine Sand and Shells, which Soundings we carried upon a South-West 1/2 West Course 9 or 10 leagues, and then had no ground with 100 fathom. We were by our account and per run afterwards 54 Leagues East from the Coast of Brazil and to the Southward of the Shoals called Abrollos, as they are laid down in Most Charts. Wind South-East to North-East; course South 58 degrees West; distance 68 miles; latitude 19 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 36 degrees 50 minutes West.

Monday, 7th. Moderate breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, we found the variation to be 4 degrees 49 minutes East. At 6 o'clock, we took soundings and found 32 fathoms of water; the bottom was made up of coral rocks, fine sand, and shells. We continued on a South-West 1/2 West course for 9 or 10 leagues, and then found no ground at 100 fathoms. By our calculations and based on our later run, we were 54 leagues East from the coast of Brazil and south of the shoals known as Abrollos, as shown on most charts. The wind was from South-East to North-East; our course was South 58 degrees West; the distance traveled was 68 miles; and we recorded a latitude of 19 degrees 46 minutes South and a longitude of 36 degrees 50 minutes West.

Tuesday, 8th. Fresh breezes and Cloudy weather. P.M. variation by the Mean of 12 Azimuths 5 degrees 26 minutes East, and by an Amplitude in the Morning 7 degrees 52 minutes. At 6 a.m. saw the Land of Brazil bearing North-West 1/2 North, distance 8 or 10 leagues. At 8 Sounded, had 37 fathoms, Coarse Sand, broken Shells, and Coral Rocks. At 9 brought too and Spoke with a Fishing Boat, who informed us that the land in sight lay to the Southward of Santo Espiritu. It appears high and Mountainous; the drawing Number (3) exhibits a View of this Land as it appeared from the Ship (A), being near to Santo Espiritu, and a remarkable hill (B) bore North-West 1/2 North, distance 7 or 8 leagues. Made Sail in Shore, the wind being Southerly. Had from the above Depth to 14 fathoms the same sort of Bottom. Found the Ship at Noon by Observation 10 Miles to the Southward of account, which I suppose to be occasioned by a Current setting between the South and West. Wind North-North-East, North by West, South-South-West to South by West; course South 50 degrees West; distance 140 miles; latitude 21 degrees 16 minutes South, longitude 37 degrees 35 minutes West.

Tuesday, 8th. Fresh breezes and cloudy weather. In the afternoon, the variation from the mean of 12 azimuths was 5 degrees 26 minutes east, and from an amplitude in the morning, it was 7 degrees 52 minutes. At 6 a.m., we saw the land of Brazil bearing northwest 1/2 north, about 8 or 10 leagues away. At 8, we took soundings and had 37 fathoms of coarse sand, broken shells, and coral rocks. At 9, we stopped to talk with a fishing boat, which informed us that the visible land lay to the south of Santo Espiritu. It looked high and mountainous; drawing number (3) shows a view of this land as seen from the ship (A), with a notable hill (B) bearing northwest 1/2 north at a distance of 7 or 8 leagues. We made sail toward shore, the wind coming from the south. From the above depth to 14 fathoms, the bottom remained the same. At noon, by observation, we found the ship to be 10 miles south of our expected position, which I believe was due to a current running between the south and west. The wind was from north-north-east, north by west, south-south-west to south by west; our course was south 50 degrees west; the distance covered was 140 miles; latitude was 21 degrees 16 minutes south, longitude was 37 degrees 35 minutes west.

Wednesday, 9th. First and Latter part Hazey, with a Moderate Breeze; Middle, fresh Gales, with Thunder, Lightning, and rain. At 3 p.m. tack't in 16 fathoms, distance from the Shore 5 Leagues, the land Extending from the North-West by West to North-East. At 5 took the 2nd Reef in the Topsails and got down Topgallant Yards, stood to the South-East until Midnight, then tack'd, Sounding from 16 to 55 fathoms. At 8 a.m. Loosed the Reefs out of the Topsails and got Topgallant Yards a Cross; unstowed the Anchors and bent the Cables. At Noon Latitude Observed 21 degrees 29 minutes South, the Land Extending from South-West by South to North-North-West, distance 4 leagues, Soundings from 55 to 10 fathoms. Wind South-South-East, South-South-West, South; course South 62 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 28 miles; latitude 21 degrees 29 minutes South.

Wednesday, 9th. The beginning and end of the day were hazy, with a light breeze; in the middle, there were fresh gales accompanied by thunder, lightning, and rain. At 3 p.m., we changed direction in 16 fathoms, 5 leagues from shore, with the land stretching from the northwest by west to northeast. At 5, we took in the second reef in the topsails and brought down the topgallant yards, heading southeast until midnight, then tacked, with soundings ranging from 16 to 55 fathoms. At 8 a.m., we loosened the reefs from the topsails and crossed the topgallant yards; we unstowed the anchors and prepared the cables. At noon, the observed latitude was 21 degrees 29 minutes south, with the land extending from southwest by south to north-northwest, 4 leagues away, with soundings from 55 to 10 fathoms. The wind was south-southeast, south-southwest, and south; our course was south 62 degrees 15 minutes west; distance covered was 28 miles; latitude was 21 degrees 29 minutes south.

[Nearing Rio Janeiro.]

[Nearing Rio de Janeiro.]

Thursday, 10th. Moderate breezes and Hazey upon the Land. Stood in for the Shore South-West 1/2 West. Depth of water from 10 to 9 fathoms and from 9 to 16 fathoms, being then 4 Leagues from the Land. From 16 fathoms it shoalded gradually to 5 fathoms; then we tacked, being about 1 1/2 Leagues from the Shore. The extreams of the Land to the Southward, which we took for Cape St. Thomas, bore South 3/4 West, distance 4 leagues. The Land from Cape St. Thomas to the Northward lies North by East 1/2 East. Along the Shore is low land covered with Wood and Sandy Beaches, but inland are very high Mountains, the greatest part of them being hid in the Clouds. Stood off until 5 in the Morning East and East by South. Depth of Water 10, 20, 16, 23, and 30 fathoms. At Noon Latitude Observed 21 degrees 30 minutes; Depth of Water 14 fathoms; Grey sand with black Specks. Extreams of the Land from South-West by West to North-North-West; distance 12 or 14 leagues. Wind South-South-East, South-East by South, South by East; course East 1/4 South; distance 17 miles; latitude 21 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 37 degrees 43 minutes West per account.

Thursday, 10th. There were moderate breezes and it was hazy over the land. We headed towards the shore at South-West 1/2 West. The water depth ranged from 10 to 9 fathoms, and then from 9 to 16 fathoms, being about 4 leagues from the shore. From 16 fathoms it gradually shallowed to 5 fathoms; then we changed course, being about 1 1/2 leagues from the shore. The extreme points of land to the south, which we believed to be Cape St. Thomas, were positioned South 3/4 West, a distance of 4 leagues. The land from Cape St. Thomas to the north lies North by East 1/2 East. The shoreline features low land covered in woods and sandy beaches, but inland there are very high mountains, most of which were hidden in the clouds. We moved away until 5 in the morning, with a course of East and East by South. The water depth measured 10, 20, 16, 23, and 30 fathoms. At noon, the observed latitude was 21 degrees 30 minutes; the water depth was 14 fathoms, consisting of grey sand with black specks. The extreme points of land stretched from South-West by West to North-North-West, at a distance of 12 or 14 leagues. The wind was coming from South-South-East, South-East by South, and South by East; we were on an East 1/4 South course; the distance traveled was 17 miles; latitude was 21 degrees 30 minutes South, and longitude was 37 degrees 43 minutes West according to our records.

Friday, 11th. First and Latter parts, moderate breezes and fair, but Cloudy and Hazey over the Land; middle, a fresh breeze and Cloudy. At 8 tack'd and Stood to the North-East. Extream of the Land to the southward, which we took for Cape St. Thomas, South-West 1/2 South; distance 5 or 6 leagues; Depth of Water 13 fathoms, Grey sand. At 11 a.m. tack'd in 14 fathoms and Stood to the South-South-East, and at 3 a.m. Stood over a Shoal or Bank of 6 fathoms, afterwards the Depth increased to 30 fathoms, at Noon in 36 fathoms. Latitude Observed 22 degrees 37 minutes South, which is 10 miles to the Southward of the Log. No Land in sight. Wind South-East to East; course South 5 degrees West; distance 67 miles; latitude 23 degrees 37 minutes South, longitude 37 degrees 49 minutes West.

Friday, 11th. First and Last sections, with mild breezes and clear skies, but cloudy and hazy over the land; in the middle of the day, a fresh breeze and cloudy. At 8, we tacked and headed northeast. The extreme land to the south, which we identified as Cape St. Thomas, is to the southwest 1/2 south; the distance is about 5 or 6 leagues; depth of water is 13 fathoms, with gray sand. At 11 a.m., we tacked in 14 fathoms and headed south-southeast, and at 3 a.m., we crossed a shoal or bank of 6 fathoms; afterward, the depth increased to 30 fathoms, and at noon, it was 36 fathoms. Latitude observed at 22 degrees 37 minutes south, which is 10 miles south of the log. No land is visible. Wind from southeast to east; course south 5 degrees west; distance 67 miles; latitude 23 degrees 37 minutes south, longitude 37 degrees 49 minutes west.

Saturday, 12th. Genteel breezes and fine Clear weather. At 2 p.m. Sounded, but had no ground with 38 fathoms, and soon after sounded and had none at 50 fathoms, from which it appears that we are to the Southward of the Bank we have been upon this 2 days past. It Extends off from the Land between the Latitude 21 degrees and 22 degrees nor less than 18 or 20 Leagues, How much farther I know not. Standing in from Sea, the Depth of Water very soon diminisheth from 30 to 20 and 17 fathoms, afterwards gradually from 9, 8 and even to 6 fathoms; but between this Shoal Water and the Main, which is 6 or 7 leagues, you will have 10, 12 and even 16 fathoms, till you come within 2 or 3 leagues of the Shore. The Bottom is of Various kinds, sometimes Coral Rocks, Coral Rocks and broken Shells, Coarse sand and broken Shells, Small Stones and at other times fine Sand varying at almost every Cast of the Lead. At 5 p.m. saw the Land bearing North-West by West 1/2 West, distance 10 or 12 leagues, which proved to be the Island of Cape Frio; it appeared in two Hillocks, and from the Deck looked like two Islands. Took several Azimuth of the Sun, which gave the Variation 6 degrees 40 minutes East. At 8 a.m. the Isle of Cape Frio bore West by North 4 leagues. This Island is situated in the Latitude of 23 degrees 2 minutes South, and according to our Reckoning in the Longitude of 38 degrees 45 minutes West from Greenwich, but from many Circumstances I have good reason to think that our reckoning is wrong and that it lies in the Longitude 41 degrees 10 minutes West. It is not of a Large Circuit, but Tolerable high, with a hollow in the Middle, which makes it look like 2 Islands when it first makes its appearance out of the Water. It lays not far from the Main, which with the Island forms a right Angle, one side trending North and the other West. To the northward of the Island and between it and the Main there appears to lay several smaller Islands near each other. The Main land on the Sea Coast appears to be low, but inland are high Mountains. Drawing Number 4 exhibits a View of this Island when it bore West-North-West, distance 4 leagues. Wind North-East, East-North-East; course South 60 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 59 miles; latitude 23 degrees 6 minutes South; Isle of Cape Frio North 60 degrees East, 4 leagues.

Saturday, the 12th. Pleasant breezes and clear weather. At 2 p.m. we took soundings but found no bottom at 38 fathoms, and shortly after, we sounded again at 50 fathoms with the same result. This indicates that we are south of the bank we've been on for the past two days. It extends off the land between latitude 21 degrees and 22 degrees for at least 18 or 20 leagues; how much beyond that, I’m not sure. As we moved in from the sea, the water depth quickly decreased from 30 to 20 and then to 17 fathoms, gradually dropping to 9, 8, and even 6 fathoms. However, between this shallow area and the mainland, which is 6 or 7 leagues away, you’ll find depths of 10, 12, and even 16 fathoms until you get within 2 or 3 leagues of the shore. The seabed varies, sometimes consisting of coral rocks, coral and broken shells, coarse sand and broken shells, small stones, and at other times fine sand, changing almost with every cast of the lead. At 5 p.m., we saw land to the northwest by west, about 10 or 12 leagues away, which turned out to be Cape Frio. From the deck, it appeared to consist of two hillocks, resembling two islands. We took several azimuth readings of the sun, which indicated a variation of 6 degrees 40 minutes east. At 8 a.m., Cape Frio was 4 leagues west by north. This island is located at latitude 23 degrees 2 minutes south and according to our calculations, in longitude 38 degrees 45 minutes west from Greenwich. However, due to various reasons, I have strong doubts about our calculations, believing it lies at longitude 41 degrees 10 minutes west. It's not very large but has a decent height, with a hollow in the middle, which gives it the appearance of two islands when first seen above the water. It’s located not far from the mainland, forming a right angle, with one side stretching north and the other west. North of the island, and between it and the mainland, there seem to be several smaller islands close together. The mainland at the coastline appears low, but there are high mountains inland. Drawing Number 4 shows a view of this island when it bore west-northwest, 4 leagues away. Wind was from the northeast, east-northeast; course was south 60 degrees 30 minutes west; distance traveled was 59 miles; latitude 23 degrees 6 minutes south; and Cape Frio was north 60 degrees east, 4 leagues away.

Sunday, 13th. First and Latter parts a Genteel Sea breeze and Clear weather, the Middle Calm. P.M. standing along Shore for Rio De Janeiro observed that the land on the Sea Coast is high and Mountainous, and the shore forms some small Bays or Coves wherein are Sandy Beaches. At 8 Shortned Sail; the Sugar Loaf Hill at the West Entrance to Rio De Janeiro West-North-West, distant 4 or 5 leagues, at the same time was abreast of 2 Small rocky Islands, that lie about 4 Miles from the Shore. At 9 a.m. Sprung up a light breeze at South-East, at which time we made Sail for the Harbour, and sent the Pinnace with a Lieutenant before us up to the city of Rio De Janeiro, to acquaint the Vice Roy with the reason that induced us to put in here, which was to procure Water and other refreshments, and to desire the Assistance of a Pilot to bring us into proper Anchoring ground; at Noon Standing in for the Harbour.

Sunday, 13th. The morning started with a pleasant sea breeze and clear skies, but it calmed down in the middle of the day. In the afternoon, as we sailed along the coast towards Rio de Janeiro, I noticed that the land was high and mountainous, with small bays and coves featuring sandy beaches. At 8, we reduced our sail; the Sugar Loaf Hill at the west entrance to Rio de Janeiro was located to the West-North-West, about 4 or 5 leagues away, and we were also level with two small rocky islands situated about 4 miles from shore. At 9 a.m., a light breeze picked up from the Southeast, prompting us to set sail for the harbor. We sent the pinnace with a lieutenant ahead to the city of Rio de Janeiro to inform the Vice Roy of our reasons for stopping here, which were to gather water and other provisions, and to request the help of a pilot to guide us to a proper anchoring area. By noon, we were heading into the harbor.

[At Rio Janeiro.]

[In Rio de Janeiro.]

ARRIVAL AT RIO DE JANEIRO, Monday, 14th. Moderate Sea and Low breezes and fine pleasant weather. At 5 p.m. Anchored in 5 fathoms just above the Isle of Cobras, which lies before the City of Rio De Janeiro. A little before we Anchor'd the Pinnace return'd and informed me that the Vice Roy had thought proper to detain the Officer until I went ashore. Soon after we Anchored a Boat came on board bringing several of the Vice Roy's Officers, who asked many Questions in respect to the Ship: Cargo, from whence she came, Number of Guns, Men, etc., all of which was Answered to their satisfaction. They told me it was the Custom of the Port to Detain the first Officer that came from any Ship on her first Arrival until a Boat from the Vice Roy had Visited her; that my Officer would be sent on board as soon as they got on shore, which was accordingly done. About this time a Boat filled with Soldiers kept rowing about the Ship, which had orders, as I afterwards understood, not to Suffer any one of the Officers or Gentlemen, except myself, to go out of the Ship. In the Morning I waited upon the Vice Roy and obtained leave to purchase Provisions, Refreshments, etc., for the Ship, but obliged me to employ a person to buy them for me under a pretence that it was the Custom of the Place, and he likewise insisted (notwithstanding all I could say to the contrary), on putting a Soldier into the Boats that brought anything to or from the Ship, alledging that it was the Orders of his Court, and they were such as he could not Dispence with, and this indignity I was obliged to submit to, otherwise I could not have got the supplys I wanted; being willing, as much as in me lay, to avoid all manner of Disputes that might cause the least delay, and at the same time to Convince him that we did not come here to Trade, as I believe he imagined--for he Certainly did not believe a word about our being bound to the Southward to observe the Transit of Venus, but looked upon it only as an invented story to cover some other design we must be upon, for he could form no other Idea of that Phenomenon (after I had explained it to him), than the North Star Passing through the South Pole; these were his own words. He would not permit the Gentlemen to reside ashore during our Stay here, nor permit Mr. Banks to go into the country to gather plants, etc.; but not the least hint was given me at this time that no one of the Gentlemen was to come out of the Ship but myself, or that I was to be put under a Guard when I did come; but this I was soon Convinced of after I took my leave of His Excellency and found that an Officer was to attend upon me whereever I went, which at first the Vice Roy pretended was only meant as a Complement, and to order me all the Assistance I wanted. This day the People were Employed in unbending the Sails, in fitting and rigging the Spare Topmasts in the room of the others, and getting on shore Empty Water Casks.

ARRIVAL AT RIO DE JANEIRO, Monday, 14th. Moderate sea and light breezes with pleasant weather. At 5 p.m., we anchored in 5 fathoms just off the Isle of Cobras, which is in front of the city of Rio de Janeiro. Just before we anchored, the pinnace returned and informed me that the Vice Roy had decided to detain the officer until I went ashore. Shortly after we anchored, a boat came aboard with several of the Vice Roy's officers, who asked many questions about the ship: its cargo, where it came from, number of guns, men, etc., all of which were answered to their satisfaction. They informed me that it was the custom of the port to detain the first officer from any ship upon its arrival until a boat from the Vice Roy had visited her; my officer would be sent back on board as soon as they got ashore, which was indeed done. Around this time, a boat filled with soldiers kept rowing around the ship, which had orders, as I later understood, not to allow any officers or gentlemen, except myself, to leave the ship. In the morning, I met with the Vice Roy and received permission to purchase provisions, refreshments, etc., for the ship, but I was required to hire someone to buy them for me under the pretense that it was local custom. He also insisted (despite my objections) on putting a soldier in the boats that carried anything to or from the ship, claiming it was an order from his court, which he could not override. I had to accept this indignity, or I wouldn't have been able to get the supplies I needed, as I wanted to avoid any disputes that might cause delays, while also trying to convince him that we weren't here to trade, as I believe he thought—he certainly didn’t believe my explanation about being bound south to observe the Transit of Venus. He saw it only as a fabricated excuse to cover some other plan we must have, as he couldn’t grasp the concept of that phenomenon (after I explained it to him), thinking instead that it was like the North Star passing through the South Pole; those were his own words. He wouldn’t allow the gentlemen to stay ashore during our time here, nor would he let Mr. Banks go into the country to collect plants, etc.; however, at this time, there was no indication given to me that no one except myself was to leave the ship or that I would be under guard when I did go ashore. But I realized this soon after I took my leave of His Excellency and found that an officer would be accompanying me wherever I went, which at first the Vice Roy pretended was merely a courtesy and meant to provide me with any assistance I needed. That day, people were busy taking down the sails, fitting and rigging the spare topmasts in place of the others, and getting empty water casks ashore.

Tuesday, 15th. Fine pleasant weather. Received on board fresh Beef and Greens for the Ship's Company, with which they was served every Day During our Stay here. Got all the Empty Casks on shore, and set the Coopers to Work to repair them; Heeld and Boot Topt the Starboard side.

Tuesday, 15th. Great weather. We received fresh beef and greens on board for the crew, which they were served every day during our stay here. We got all the empty casks ashore and had the coopers start working on repairing them; we heeled and boot topped the starboard side.

Wednesday, 16th. Set up the Forge to repair the Iron Work; the People employed in Heeling and Boot Topping the Larboard side, Blacking the Yards, etc.

Wednesday, 16th. Set up the Forge to fix the Iron Work; the people were working on repairing and refurbishing the left side, cleaning the Yards, etc.

Thursday, 17th. Set some People to repair the Sails and the Caulkers to Caulk the Ship; the rest of the People employed in the Hold and about the Rigging. For 3 days past I have remonstrated to the Vice Roy and his Officers against his putting a Guard into my Boat, thinking I could not Answer it to the Admiralty the tamely submitting to such a Custom, which, when practiced in its full force, must bring Disgrace to the British Flag. On the other hand, I was loath to enter into Disputes, seeing how much I was like to be delay'd and imbarrassed in getting the supplys I wanted, for it was with much difficulty that I obtained leave for one of my People to attend the Market to buy necessaries for my Table and to assist the Agent to buy the things for the Ship. Having gained this Point and settled everything with the Agent in regard to what was wanting for the Ship, I resolved, rather than be made a Prisoner in my own Boat, not to go any more ashore unless I could do it without having a Soldier put into the Boat, as had hitherto been done; and thinking that the Vice Roy might lay under some Mistake, which on proper Application might be clear'd up, I therefore drew up a Memorial stating the whole case and sent to the Vice Roy this afternoon; and thus a Paper War commenced between me and His Excellency, wherein I had no other Advantage than the racking his invention to find reasons for treating us in the manner he did, for he never would relax the least from any one point.

Thursday, 17th. I had some people fix the sails and the caulkers work on the ship. The rest of the crew was busy in the hold and with the rigging. For the past three days, I’ve been arguing with the Viceroy and his officers about their decision to put a guard in my boat. I felt I couldn’t just accept this without reporting it to the Admiralty, as it would certainly bring shame to the British flag. However, I was hesitant to start conflicts since it would likely delay me and complicate things in getting the supplies I needed. It took a lot of effort to get permission for one of my crew members to go to the market to buy essentials for me and to help the agent purchase what was needed for the ship. After achieving that and sorting everything out with the agent for the ship’s needs, I decided that rather than being treated like a prisoner in my own boat, I wouldn’t go ashore again unless I could do so without having a soldier in the boat, as had been done before. Believing that the Viceroy might be operating under some misunderstanding that could be clarified, I wrote up a memorial outlining the situation and sent it to the Viceroy this afternoon. Thus began a paper war between me and His Excellency, where my only advantage was making him come up with excuses for his treatment of us, as he wouldn’t budge even a little from his position.

Friday, 18th. This day I received an Answer to my Memorial, wherein he tells me, amongst other things, that if I think it hard submitting to the Customs of this Port I may leave it when I please; but this did not suit my purpose at present, but I resolved to make my stay as short as possible. I must own that the Memorial of the Vice Roy's was well drawn up and very much to the Purpose, which is more than I can say of any of the subsequent ones.

Friday, 18th. Today I received a response to my letter, in which he tells me, among other things, that if I find it difficult to follow the customs of this port, I can leave anytime I want; however, that didn't fit my current plans, so I decided to keep my stay as brief as possible. I have to admit that the Vice Roy's letter was well written and very much to the point, which is more than I can say for any of the ones that came after.

Saturday, 19th. Close cloudy weather. Employed getting aboard Rum, Water, and other necessaries. Caulking and refitting the Ship. Punished John Thurman, Seaman, with 12 Lashes for refusing to assist the Sailmaker in repairing the Sails.

Saturday, 19th. Overcast weather. Spent the day loading Rum, Water, and other supplies. Caulking and repairing the Ship. Punished John Thurman, Seaman, with 12 lashes for refusing to help the Sailmaker with the Sails.

Sunday, 20th. First part cloudy weather; the Middle very hard Storms of Wind and Rain; the Latter moderate, with rain. This Afternoon sent Lieutenant Hicks in the Pinnace with an Answer to the Vice Roy's Memorial, with orders not to Suffer a Soldier to be put into the Boat; upon which the Guard Boat attended him to the Landing Place and reported it to the Vice Roy, who refused to receive the Memorial, and ordered Mr. Hicks on board Again; but in the Meantime they had put a Guard into the Boat, which Mr. Hicks insisted should be order'd out, that he might return on board in the same manner as he came, without a Guard; and upon his refusing to return other way, all the Crew were by Arm'd force taken out of the Boat (though they gave no provocation nor made the least resistance) and hurried to Prison, where they remained until the next day. Mr. Hicks was then put into one of their Boats, and brought on board under the Custody of a Guard. Immediately upon my hearing of this I wrote to the Vice Roy demanding my Boat and Crew and his Excellency's reason for detaining her, and inclosed the Memorial he had before refused to receive. This I sent by a petty Officer, as I had never objected against a Guard being put into any of my Boats wherein was no Commissioned Officer. He was admitted ashore and delivered the Letter, and was told an Answer would be sent the next day. This evening, between 8 and 9 o'Clock, came on an Excessive hard storm of Wind and Rain, the Longboat coming on board the same time with 4 Pipes of Rum in her. The rope they got hold of broke, and she went a Drift. The Yawl was immediately sent after her; but the Longboat filling with Water, they brought her to a Grapnel and left her, and the Yawl with the People got on board about 3 in the morning. Early this Morning I sent to the Vice Roy to acquaint him with the loss of our Boat, to desire leave and the Assistance of a Shore Boat to look after her, and at the same time to demand the Pinnace and her Crew. After some time the whole was granted, and we was so fortunate as to find the Longboat the same Day, and likewise the 4 Pipes of Rum; but every other thing that was in her was lost.

Sunday, 20th. The first part of the day was cloudy; then there were strong storms of wind and rain, followed by moderate weather with rain in the afternoon. I sent Lieutenant Hicks in the pinnace with a response to the Vice Roy's memorial, instructing him not to allow any soldiers to board the boat. A guard boat accompanied him to the landing spot and reported to the Vice Roy, who refused to accept the memorial and ordered Mr. Hicks back on board. Meanwhile, they had placed a guard in the boat, which Mr. Hicks insisted should be removed so he could return to the ship the same way he came, without a guard. When he refused to return any other way, armed force was used to remove the entire crew from the boat (though they provided no provocation or resistance) and rushed them to prison, where they stayed until the next day. Mr. Hicks was then placed in one of their boats and brought on board under guard. Once I heard about this, I wrote to the Vice Roy demanding the return of my boat and crew and requesting his Excellency’s reason for detaining them, along with the memorial he had previously refused. I sent this with a petty officer, as I had never objected to a guard being placed in any of my boats that didn't have a commissioned officer. He was allowed ashore and delivered the letter, and was told an answer would come the next day. That evening, between 8 and 9 o'clock, we experienced a severe storm of wind and rain, while the longboat was coming on board with 4 pipes of rum. The rope they grabbed broke, and the longboat went adrift. The yawl was immediately sent after it, but the longboat filled with water, so they secured it with a grapnel and left it behind. The yawl and the crew managed to get on board around 3 in the morning. Early this morning, I contacted the Vice Roy to inform him about our lost boat, requesting permission and assistance from a shore boat to look for it, and at the same time demanding the return of the pinnace and her crew. After some time, everything was granted, and we were fortunate to find the longboat on the same day, along with the 4 pipes of rum; however, everything else that was in it was lost.

Monday, 21st. This Morning I received his Excellency's Answer to my last Memorial and Letter. In his Letter he owns there was some indecency in Detaining the Boat, but lays the Blame to my Officer, who only Executed the orders I gave him with Spirit. In one part of his Memorial he says that from the Built of the Ship and other Circumstances he Doubts that she is the King's. This I thought proper to Answer in Writing by telling his Excellency that I was ready to produce my Commission. Rain the most part of this Day.

Monday, 21st. This morning I received his Excellency's response to my last memorial and letter. In his letter, he acknowledges that there was some impropriety in detaining the boat, but he blames my officer, who was just following the orders I gave him with determination. At one point in his memorial, he mentions that based on the construction of the ship and other factors, he doubts that it belongs to the King. I thought it appropriate to respond in writing, informing his Excellency that I was ready to present my commission. It rained for most of the day.

Tuesday, 22nd. Moderate breezes, with frequent Showers of Rain. Employed getting on board Water, Provisions, etc. Caulking the Ship and repairing the Sails.

Tuesday, 22nd. Light winds, with occasional showers. Spent the day loading water, provisions, and other supplies. Caulking the ship and fixing the sails.

Wednesday, 23rd. Fine pleasant weather. Employed as before and setting up the Rigging. This day I received from the Vice-Roy an Answer to my last Memorial, wherein he still keeps up his Doubts that she is not a King's Ship, and accuseth my people of Smuggling, a thing I am very Certain they were not guilty of, and for which his Excellency could produce no proof, notwithstanding many Artful means were made use of to tempt such of our People as were admitted ashore to Trade by the Very Officers that were under His Excellency's own Roof. I thought it incumbent on me to Answer this Memorial, in which I desir'd His Excellency to take into Custody any one of my People that should be found trading even if it amounted to no more than one of the Sailors selling his Cloaths from off his Back for a Bottle of Rum--for what His Excellency called smuggling I was very certain amounted to no more, and even this was only Suspicions of my own.

Wednesday, 23rd. It was nice, pleasant weather. I was working again on setting up the rigging. Today, I received a response from the Vice-Roy regarding my last memorandum, where he still doubts that it’s a King's ship and accuses my crew of smuggling. I’m quite sure they weren’t guilty of that, and his Excellency couldn’t provide any evidence, even though many clever tactics were used to tempt those of our crew who were allowed ashore to trade by the very officers under his Excellency's own roof. I felt it was necessary to reply to this memorandum, in which I asked his Excellency to detain anyone from my crew found trading, even if it was just one of the sailors selling his clothes off his back for a bottle of rum—because what his Excellency referred to as smuggling was something I believed amounted to nothing more, and even that was just my own suspicion.

Thursday, 24th. This day a Spanish Packet (a Small Brig) from Buenos Ayres put in here in her way to Spain. This Vessel belonged to his Catholic Majesty, and notwithstanding the Vice-Roy had all along pretended that the orders he had respecting Foreign Vessels were General, yet this Vessel meet with very Different Treatment from us. No Guard was put over her, and her Officers and Crew went wherever they pleased.* (* The build and general appearance of the Endeavour not being that of a man-of-war, the Portuguese authorities entertained suspicions regarding her true character, which is not altogether surprising, considering the times; but we can well understand Cook's indignation.)

Thursday, 24th. Today, a Spanish packet (a small brig) from Buenos Aires stopped here on its way to Spain. This vessel belonged to his Catholic Majesty, and even though the Vice-Roy had always claimed that his orders regarding foreign vessels were general, this ship received very different treatment from us. No guard was placed over her, and her officers and crew went wherever they wanted. (*The build and overall appearance of the Endeavour not resembling that of a warship, the Portuguese authorities had suspicions about her true nature, which isn't surprising given the times; but we can certainly understand Cook's frustration.)

Friday, 25th, Saturday, 26th. Employed getting on board Water as fast as the Coopers could set up and repair the Casks, setting up the rigging and Caulking the Ship's sides.

Friday, 25th, Saturday, 26th. We worked on boarding water as quickly as the coopers could set up and fix the casks, setting up the rigging and caulking the ship's sides.

Sunday, 27th. Bent the Sails and Cleaned the Ship Fore and Aft.

Sunday, 27th. Adjusted the sails and cleaned the ship inside and out.

Monday, 28th. Fine pleasant weather. The Caulkers having finished the sides, paid them with Tar. This day I unexpectedly received an Answer from my last Memorial, wherein were only a few weak Arguments to support His Excellency's Suspicions that the Ship did not belong to the King, and that my People Smugled. This Memorial I answered.

Monday, 28th. Beautiful, nice weather. The Caulkers finished the sides and sealed them with tar. Today, I unexpectedly got a reply to my last memorial, which contained only a few weak arguments backing His Excellency's suspicions that the ship didn't belong to the King and that my people were smuggling. I responded to this memorial.

Tuesday, 29th. Employed Lashing the Casks that were on the upper Deck and between Decks and making ready for Sea.

Tuesday, 29th. Worked on securing the barrels that were on the upper deck and between decks, getting ready for sea.

Wednesday, 30th. Punished Robert Anderson, Seaman, and William Judge, Marine, with 12 Lashes Each, the former for leaving his Duty ashore and attempting to desert from the Ship, and the latter for using abusive language to the Officer of the Watch, and John Reading, Boatswain's Mate, with 12 lashes for not doing his Duty in punishing the above two Men. Sent a Shore to the Vice-Roy for a Pilot to Carry us to Sea, who sent one on board together with a Large Boat, which I did not want, but it is the Custom in this Port for the Pilots to have such a Boat to attend upon the Ship they Pilot out, and for which you must pay 10 shillings per day, besides the Pilot's fees, which is Seven pounds four Shillings Sterling.

Wednesday, 30th. Punished Robert Anderson, Seaman, and William Judge, Marine, with 12 lashes each; the former for leaving his duty onshore and trying to desert the ship, and the latter for using abusive language towards the Officer of the Watch. John Reading, Boatswain’s Mate, also received 12 lashes for failing to do his duty in punishing the two men above. Sent ashore to the Vice-Roy for a pilot to take us to sea, who sent one on board along with a large boat, which I didn’t want, but it’s customary in this port for pilots to have such a boat to assist the ship they are guiding out, and for this, you have to pay 10 shillings per day, in addition to the pilot's fees, which total seven pounds four shillings sterling.

[December 1768.]

[December 1768.]

Thursday, 1st December. Wind at South-East, which hinder'd us from Sailing as we intended. Received on board a large Quantity of fresh Beef, Greens and Yams for the Ship's Company.

Thursday, December 1st. The wind was coming from the Southeast, which prevented us from sailing as we had planned. We received a large supply of fresh beef, greens, and yams for the crew.

Friday, 2nd. This morning sent a Packet for the Secretary of the Admiralty on board the Spanish Pacquet, containing copies of all the Memorials and Letters that have passed between the Vice-Roy and me, and likewise another Packet containing Duplicates thereof I left with the Vice-Roy to be by him forwarded to Lisbon. At 9 Weighed and came to Sail and turned down the Bay. Peter Flower, Seaman, fell overboard, and before any Assistance could be given him was drowned; in his room we got a Portugue.

Friday, 2nd. This morning, I sent a packet for the Secretary of the Admiralty on board the Spanish mail ship, which included copies of all the memorials and letters exchanged between the Vice-Roy and me. I also left another packet with the Vice-Roy that contained duplicates to be forwarded to Lisbon. At 9, we weighed anchor and set sail out of the bay. Peter Flower, a seaman, fell overboard and, before anyone could help him, drowned; in his place, we got a Portuguese sailor.

Saturday, 3rd. First part, moderate breezes at South-East; remainder, fresh Gales at South with Rain. At 1 p.m. Anchored in 18 fathoms Water in the Great Road (see Plan).

Saturday, 3rd. First part, moderate winds from the Southeast; remainder, strong winds from the South with rain. At 1 p.m., anchored in 18 fathoms of water in the Great Road (see Plan).

Sunday, 4th. Fore and Middle parts fresh Gales at South-South-East with heavy rain; Latter, Variable Light Airs and fair weather. Hoisted in the Long-boat and secured her.

Sunday, 4th. The morning and early afternoon had strong winds from the South-South-East with heavy rain; in the late afternoon, the winds became light and variable with nice weather. We hoisted the longboat and secured it.

Monday, 5th. First part, little wind and Cloudy; Middle, Thunder, Lightning and Rain; latter, little wind at South-West and fair. At 4 a.m. Weighed and tow'd down the Bay (being Calm) with an intent to go to Sea, but having 2 Shott fired at us from Santa Cruze Fort was obliged to come to an Anchor and to send a Boat to the Fort to know the Reason of their firing, who it seems had no orders to let us pass, without which no Ship can go to Sea. This surprized me not a little, as I had but this very morning received a very Polite Letter from the Vice-Roy (in answer to one I had wrote some days ago), wherein he wishes me a good voyage. I immediately dispatched a petty Officer to the Vice-Roy to know the reason why we was not permitted to pass the Fort; the Boat very soon return'd with an order to the Captain of the Fort to let us pass, which Order had been wrote some Days Ago, but either by Design or neglect had not been sent. At 11 weighed in order to put to Sea, but before we could heave up the Anchor, it got hold of a Rock, where it held fast in spite of all our endeavours to Clear it until the Sea Breeze set in.

Monday, 5th. In the morning, there was little wind and it was cloudy; in the middle of the day, there was thunder, lightning, and rain; in the afternoon, a little wind from the southwest and clear skies. At 4 a.m., we weighed anchor and towed down the bay (it was calm) with the intention of going to sea, but after two shots were fired at us from Santa Cruze Fort, we had to anchor and send a boat to the fort to find out why they fired at us. It turned out they had no orders to let us pass, and without those, no ship can go to sea. This surprised me quite a bit, as I had just received a very polite letter from the Vice-Roy (in response to one I had sent a few days ago), wishing me a good voyage. I immediately sent a petty officer to the Vice-Roy to ask why we were not allowed to pass the fort; the boat soon returned with an order for the Captain of the Fort to let us through. This order had been written a few days earlier but hadn’t been sent due to either oversight or intention. At 11, we weighed anchor to go to sea, but before we could lift the anchor, it got caught on a rock and held fast despite all our efforts to free it until the sea breeze kicked in.

Tuesday, 6th. The Sea breeze continued all this day. At 2 p.m. the Ship tended to the Wind, which cleared the Anchor. Hove it up and run higher up the Bay and Anchored in 15 fathoms, a little below the Isle or Church of Bon Voyage; found the cable very much rubbed several fathoms from the Anchor.

Tuesday, 6th. The sea breeze persisted all day. At 2 p.m., the ship adjusted to the wind, which lifted the anchor. We hoisted it and moved further up the bay, anchoring in 15 fathoms, just below the Isle or Church of Bon Voyage; we noticed the cable was significantly worn several fathoms from the anchor.

Wednesday, 7th. First and latter part a Genteel breeze at South-East and East; the Middle, Calm. At 5 a.m. weighed and tow'd out of the Bay; at 8 Discharged the Pilot and his Boat. A breeze of Wind Springing up Easterly made Sail out to Sea, and sent a boat to one of the Islands laying before the Bay to cut Brooms, a thing we was not permitted to do while we lay in the Harbour; the Guard Boat which had constantly attended all the time we lay in the Bay and Harbour did not leave us until the Pilot was discharged. At noon the Sugar Loaf at the west Entrance of the Bay bore North by West 1/2 West, distance, 8 or 9 miles.

Wednesday, 7th. The day started and ended with a gentle breeze from the Southeast and East; the middle part was calm. At 5 a.m., we weighed anchor and towed out of the Bay; by 8, we had discharged the Pilot and his boat. An easterly wind picked up, allowing us to set sail out to sea, and we sent a boat to one of the islands in front of the Bay to gather brooms, which we weren't allowed to do while in the Harbour. The guard boat that had been with us the entire time we were in the Bay and Harbour didn’t leave until the Pilot was off the ship. At noon, the Sugar Loaf at the west entrance of the Bay was positioned North by West 1/2 West, about 8 or 9 miles away.

[Description of Rio Janeiro.]

[Description of Rio de Janeiro.]

A DESCRIPTION OF THE BAY OR RIVER OF RIO DE JANEIRO.

A DESCRIPTION OF THE BAY OR RIVER OF RIO DE JANEIRO.

The few days' delay we met with in getting out of Rio de Janeiro gave me an opportunity of Drawing a Plan or Sketch of great part of the Bay, but the Strict watch that was kept over us during our whole stay hinder'd me from taking so accurate a Survey as I wisht to have done, and all the Observations I could make was taken from on board the Ship. This Plan hath no pretensions to accuracy, yet it will give a very good idea of the place, differing not much from the truth in what is Essential.

The few days' delay we experienced in leaving Rio de Janeiro gave me a chance to draw a plan or sketch of a large part of the bay, but the strict watch that was kept over us during our entire stay prevented me from taking as accurate a survey as I wanted to. All the observations I could make were taken from on board the ship. This plan doesn't claim to be accurate, but it will give a pretty good idea of the place, differing not much from the truth in what matters.

The Bay of Rio de Janeiro, by some called a River--which its Name Signifies--but this I think is improper, it being nothing more than a Deep inlet of the Sea, into which no considerable fresh water River Emptys itself that I could hear of. Be this as it will, it is Capacious and Capable of Containing a vast Number of Shipping where they may ride in perfect Security. The Entrance is Situated West by North 18 Leagues from Cape Frio, and may be known by a remarkable Hill in the Form of a Sugar Loaf, at the West Entrance of the Bay; but as all the Coast is exceeding high, terminating at the top in Peaked Hills, it is much better known by the Islands laying before it, one of which (called Rodonda) is high and round in form of a Hay Stack, and lies South by West 2 1/2 leagues from the Sugar Loaf or Entrance of the Bay. A little without the East Entrance of the Bay, and near the shore, lay 2 Islands near each other: 3 leagues from the Eastward and 4 miles from the Shore are 2 low Rocky Islands, which are the first you meet with in coming from the Eastward or from Cape Frio.

The Bay of Rio de Janeiro, sometimes referred to as a river—which its name suggests—but I believe that's incorrect, as it’s really just a deep inlet of the sea, with no significant freshwater river flowing into it that I know of. Regardless, it is spacious and can accommodate a large number of ships, allowing them to anchor safely. The entrance is located west by north, 18 leagues from Cape Frio, and can be identified by a distinctive hill shaped like a sugar loaf, at the bay's west entrance. However, because the entire coast is very steep, ending in peaked hills, it’s better recognized by the islands that are in front of it. One of these islands (called Rodonda) is tall and round, resembling a haystack, and is situated south by west, 2.5 leagues from the sugar loaf or the bay entrance. A bit outside the east entrance of the bay, and close to the shore, are two islands that are near each other: 3 leagues to the east and 4 miles from the shore, there are two low rocky islands, which are the first ones you encounter when coming from the east or from Cape Frio.

To sail into Rio de Janeiro there is not the least Danger until you are the length of the Fort of Santa Cruze, which stands on the point that forms the East Entrance of the Bay or River; on the West Entrance is Fort Lorio, built upon a Rock which lies close to the Main Land, the distance from one Fort to the other is 3/4 of a mile East and West, but the Channel for Shipping is not quite so broad by reason of Sunken Rocks laying off each of the Forts; these rocks may not be properly placed in the plan, being only laid down from the information of the Pilot. The Narrowness of the Channell here causeth the Tides both Flood and Ebb to run pretty strong, insomuch that you cannot Stem it without a fresh breeze of Wind, nor is it safe Anchoring because the bottom is foul and Rocky. By keeping in the Middle of the Channell you will not only avoid being forced to come to an Anchor, but all other Dangers. Being got within the entrance your Course up the Bay is North by West 1/2 West and North-North-West something more than one League; this brings you the length of the great Road, and North-West and West-North-West one league more carrys you the length of the Ilha dos Cobras, which lies before the City. Keep the North side of this Island close on board and Anchor above it in 5 fathoms of water, where you see most Convenient before the Monastery of Benedictines, which stands upon a hill at the North-West End of the City. Small Ships and Vessels generally lay between the Town and the Ilha dos Cobras, but in order to get there they must come round the North side of the Island.

To sail into Rio de Janeiro, there's virtually no danger until you reach the Fort of Santa Cruz, which is at the eastern entrance of the bay or river. On the western entrance is Fort Lorio, built on a rock close to the mainland. The distance between the two forts is 3/4 of a mile east to west, but the shipping channel isn’t quite as wide because of submerged rocks near each fort. These rocks might not be accurately shown on the map, as they are marked based on the pilot's information. The narrowness of the channel causes the tides—both incoming and outgoing—to flow pretty strongly, so you can't fight against it without a good breeze, and it's not safe to anchor because the bottom is rocky and cluttered. By staying in the middle of the channel, you can avoid being forced to anchor or facing other dangers. Once you’re past the entrance, your course up the bay is North by West 1/2 West and North-North-West for just over a league, which brings you along the great road. Continuing North-West and West-North-West for another league takes you along the Ilha dos Cobras, which is in front of the city. Stay close to the north side of this island and anchor above it in 5 fathoms of water, in a spot that seems most convenient before the Benedictine Monastery, which is on a hill at the north-west end of the city. Smaller ships typically anchor between the town and Ilha dos Cobras, but to get there, they have to go around the north side of the island.

I shall now give the best description I can of the Different Forts that are Erected for the Defence of the Bay. The first you meet with coming in from Sea is a Battery of 22 Guns, seated in the Bottom of a sandy Bay, which is on the South side of the Sugar Loaf, and can be designed for no other use than to hinder an Enemy from landing in that valley, from whence I suppose they may March up to the Town or round by the West side of the Sugar Loaf to attack the Forts that are on that side of the Entrance into the Bay, the first of which is Seated under the foot of the Sugar Loaf on a low Isthmus which joyns the Peninsula or point of the Bay with the Land of the Sugar Loaf. It appears to be a square of Stone Work without a Ditch, with Bastions and furnished with Cannon. A little within this fort are 2 battrys of 5 or 6 Guns each. They are designed to play upon Shipping, but neither these battrys or the Fort are out of reach of a Ship's Cannon. Hard by these batterys stands Fort Logie. It is an irregular hexagon, built of Stone upon a Small Rock standing at the west Entrance of the Bay, and is surrounded on all Sides by the Sea. It is mounted with 14 or 15 guns, which are placed so as to play upon Shipping going in and out of the Harbour. There is only one way to go into it, which is by Steps Leading up to a Sally Port on the North-West side. Opposite this is the Fort of Santa Cruze, built upon a low rocky point that forms the East Entrance of the Bay. It hath the Appearance of a Regular Fortification of Stone Work built upon the Slope of the Rock, on which account there are in some places 2 Tier of Guns. It hath no Ditch but on the Land side, where it is cut out of the Rock; in every other part the Sea washes up to its Walls. It seems everywhere to be well Mounted with Cannon Except on the land side, where none are wanting, because they could be of no use, the land being so very high above it. Yet, after all, neither this Fort nor those on the opposite shore do not appear to be of any great Strength, even against Shipping, for which they are wholly design'd, being the key of the Bay. They lay low, and Ships may come so near as to have them entirely within the reach of their Guns; but it would require 5 or 6 Sail of the line to insure Success. Between 2 and 3 Miles within the Entrance of the Bay, on the West Side, is the Isle Borghleone, upon the east point of which is Erected a Battry of Stone, and Mounted with 17 pieces of Cannon. Besides this, on the highest part of the Island, is a Battry of 6 Guns mounted on an Open Platform. These battrys are designed to play upon Shipping in the Bay, and seems not ill designed for that purpose; yet they would be Obliged to Submit to the Attack of Shipping or that of a Land force, there being nothing to hinder the latter from Landing on the Island behind the Battrys. Opposite to this Island, on the low point on the east side of the Bay, is the Battry of St. Dominica of 7 Guns. A little without this Battry, on the East side of the Bay, is a small but high Island, close to the Shore, on the Top of which is the Church of Bonn Voyage, about half-way down the Cliff. Below the Church is a Battry of 3 Guns. Neither the one nor the other of these battry's are of much Consequence. They serve, indeed, to force Shipping coming into the Bay between 2 Fires, and hinder them from Anchoring on that side until they are silenced. The next fortification is that on the Ilha dos Cobras, the east point and North side of which consists of a Rampart Bastion and a Parrapet faced with Stones and mounted with Cannon, but no Ditch, which is not much wanting, as the works are built on the Edge of the rising Ground. The other side next the Town hath no other inclosure but a plain wall without any Guns. It is said that the works on this Island are in bad repair, on account of being so Extensive that they would take more men to Defend them than they could spare, and, placing no Dependancy on their Strength, let them go to decay. The ground on which the Monastry of Benedictines Stands Commands the Works on the Island. Over the South end of the City stands the Castle of St. Sebastian; it is Seated upon a Hill, and Commands the whole Town; and this is all I know of it, only that it is not counted a place of any great Strength. For the Defence of these Forts and the Town the King of Portugal Maintains 7 Regiments of Regular Troops. Those I saw were well cloathed and in good Condition; but this, as I was told, was not the Case with the whole. Besides these Troops are 3 Regiments of Militia, 2 of Horse and one of foot. These consist of the principal inhabitants of the place, who serve without pay, Muster and Exercise in turns nine Months in the year, on which account they rank with the Regular Troops.

I will now provide the best description I can of the various forts built to defend the bay. The first one you encounter when coming in from the sea is a battery of 22 guns, located at the bottom of a sandy bay on the south side of the Sugar Loaf. Its sole purpose is to prevent an enemy from landing in that area, from where they could march up to the town or around the west side of the Sugar Loaf to attack the forts on that side of the bay entrance. The first of those forts is situated at the foot of the Sugar Loaf on a low isthmus that connects the peninsula of the bay with the land of the Sugar Loaf. It looks like a square structure made of stone without a ditch, featuring bastions and armed with cannons. A bit inside this fort, there are two batteries with 5 or 6 guns each, designed to target ships, but neither these batteries nor the fort are safe from a ship’s cannon. Nearby these batteries stands Fort Logie. It has an irregular hexagon shape, built of stone on a small rock at the western entrance of the bay and is completely surrounded by the sea. It is equipped with 14 or 15 guns arranged to fire at vessels entering and leaving the harbor. There’s only one way in, which is through steps leading up to a sally port on the northwest side. Opposite this is Fort Santa Cruze, located on a low rocky point that forms the east entrance to the bay. It resembles a well-constructed fortification made of stone built on the slope of the rock, which is why it has two tiers of guns in some places. There’s no ditch except on the land side, which is carved from the rock; on every other side, the sea comes right up to its walls. It seems to be well-mounted with cannons except on the land side, where none are needed because the land rises high above it. Yet, after everything, neither this fort nor those on the opposite shore appear to be very strong, even against shipping, for which they were entirely designed, being the key to the bay. They are low, allowing ships to come close enough that they could be entirely within the reach of their guns; however, it would take 5 or 6 ships of the line to ensure success. About 2 to 3 miles inside the entrance of the bay, on the west side, is Borghleone Island, where a stone battery with 17 cannons is situated on the eastern point. Additionally, on the highest part of the island, there’s a battery with 6 guns mounted on an open platform. These batteries are meant to target ships in the bay and seem reasonably well-designed for that purpose, yet they would have to withstand attacks from either ships or land forces since there’s nothing to stop the latter from landing on the island behind the batteries. Opposite this island, on the low point on the east side of the bay, is the St. Dominica battery with 7 guns. Just outside this battery, on the east side of the bay, is a small but high island close to the shore, on top of which sits the Church of Bonn Voyage, about halfway down the cliff. Below the church is a battery with 3 guns. Neither of these batteries carries much significance. They do serve, however, to trap ships coming into the bay between two fires and prevent them from anchoring on that side until they are silenced. The next fortification is on Ilha dos Cobras, where the east point and north side feature a rampart bastion and a parapet faced with stone and armed with cannons but no ditch. This isn’t a big issue, as the structures are built on the edge of rising ground. The side facing the town has no other enclosure except for a plain wall without any guns. It’s said that the defenses on this island are in poor repair, as they are so extensive that it would require more men to defend them than could be spared, and since they don’t rely on their strength, they are allowed to fall into disrepair. The ground where the Benedictine monastery stands overlooks the defenses on the island. At the southern end of the city stands Castle St. Sebastian; it’s located on a hill and overlooks the whole town. That’s all I know about it, except that it’s not considered a place of great strength. To defend these forts and the town, the King of Portugal maintains 7 regiments of regular troops. The ones I saw were well-clothed and in good condition, but I was told that this was not the case for all of them. In addition to these troops, there are 3 regiments of militia: 2 cavalry and one infantry. These consist of the main inhabitants of the area, who serve without pay and drill and train in shifts for nine months of the year, which is why they are considered on par with the regular troops.

The City of Rio de Janeiro is in the Latitude of 22 degrees 50 minutes South and Longitude 42 degrees 15 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* Modern determination, 22 degrees 54 minutes South, 43 degrees 10 minutes West.) According to Observations made at Sea it is Seated on a plain close to the Shore on the West side of the Bay, at the foot of Several high Mountains. It is neither ill designed nor ill built. The Houses are mostly stone, generally one and two Storys high, with Balconys to most of them. The Streets are of a Convenient breadth, and Cross each other at right Angles, and the whole City may be about 3 miles in Compass. It is Govern'd by a Governor appointed by the King. The present Governor is Don Anto Mendoyaz Fastada, who is no Friend to the English. It likewise is the Residence of the Vice-Roy and Captain General of the States of Brazil, who is as absolute as any Monarch on Earth, and the people to all appearance as much Slaves. This City and Adjacent parts about the Bay are said to contain 100,000 Souls; but not above a twentieth part are Whites. The rest are blacks, many of whom are free, and seem to live in tolerable Circumstances.

The city of Rio de Janeiro is located at a latitude of 22 degrees 50 minutes south and longitude of 42 degrees 15 minutes west from Greenwich. (*Modern coordinates are 22 degrees 54 minutes south, 43 degrees 10 minutes west.) According to observations made at sea, it sits on a flat area close to the shore on the west side of the bay, at the base of several tall mountains. It's neither poorly designed nor poorly built. Most of the houses are made of stone, typically one or two stories high, with balconies on many of them. The streets are a convenient width, intersecting at right angles, and the entire city has a perimeter of about 3 miles. It is governed by a governor appointed by the king. The current governor is Don Anto Mendoyaz Fastada, who is not a friend to the English. The city also serves as the residence of the Viceroy and Captain General of the States of Brazil, who holds absolute power like any monarch on earth, and the people seem as much like slaves. This city and the nearby areas around the bay are said to have around 100,000 inhabitants, but only about one-twentieth of them are white. The rest are black, many of whom are free and appear to live in decent conditions.

The city of Rio de Janeiro is supplied with Water from 2 Different parts of the Adjacent Mountains. That which comes from the Southward is Convey'd a Cross a Deep Valley by an Acquiduct, which Consists of a great Number of Arches placed in 2 Rows, one upon the other; from thence in pipes to a fountain which stands in the Middle of the Square before the Vice-Roy's Palace. At another part of the City is a Reservoir, to which the water is conveyed much in the same manner. From these 2 places, but mostly from the former, the inhabitants fetch all they want, where there is always a Centinel to keep order: and it is likewise here that the Ships Water. They land their Casks upon a Smooth sandy beach about 100 yards from the Fountain, and upon application to the Vice-Roy you have a Centinel to look after them and to clear the way for to come to the fountain to fill water. Upon the whole, Rio de Janeiro is not a bad place for Ships to put in at that want refreshments, not only because the Harbour is safe and Commodious, but that Provision and all manner of Refreshments may be had in tolerable plenty. Bread and Flour are, however, Scarce and Dear, being brought hither from Europe, and are never the better for that Passage. In lieu of these are to be had Yams and Casada. All sorts of Grain--though it may be the produce of this Country--is Dear. Fresh Beef (tho' bad) is to be had in plenty at about 2 1/4 pence per pound, and Jurked Beef about the same price. This is cured with Salt, and dryd in the shade, the bones being taken out, and the Meat cut into large but very thin slices. It eats very well, and if kept in a dry place will remain good a long time at Sea. Rum, Sugar, and Molasses are all good and Cheap. Tobacco is Cheap, but not good. Mutton they have very little. Hogs and all sorts of Poultry are to be got, tho' in no great plenty, and of Course rather dear. Garden Stuff and Fruit in plenty, but none that will keep long at Sea except Pumpkins.

The city of Rio de Janeiro gets its water from two different areas in the nearby mountains. The water from the south is transported across a deep valley through an aqueduct made up of a large number of arches arranged in two rows, one on top of the other. From there, it flows through pipes to a fountain located in the middle of the square in front of the Vice-Roy's Palace. In another part of the city, there’s a reservoir where water is brought in a similar way. Residents collect water from these two places, mostly from the former, where a guard is always present to maintain order. This is also where ships get their water. They offload their barrels on a smooth sandy beach about 100 yards from the fountain, and upon request to the Vice-Roy, a guard is assigned to look after them and clear the way to fill their barrels. Overall, Rio de Janeiro is a decent place for ships seeking supplies, not just because the harbor is safe and convenient, but also because provisions and various refreshments are available in reasonable quantity. Bread and flour, however, are scarce and expensive, as they are imported from Europe and do not improve in quality during the journey. Instead, yams and cassava are available. All types of grain, even those produced locally, are pricey. Fresh beef (though not great) is plentiful at around 2.25 cents per pound, and jerked beef is about the same price. Jerked beef is cured with salt and dried in the shade, with the bones removed and the meat sliced into large but very thin pieces. It tastes good and, if stored in a dry place, can last a long time at sea. Rum, sugar, and molasses are all of good quality and cheap. Tobacco is inexpensive but of low quality. There's very little mutton available. Pork and various poultry can be found, but not in large quantities, thus they tend to be somewhat expensive. There's an abundance of garden produce and fruit, but only pumpkins can be stored for long periods at sea.

They have a Yard for building Shipping and a small Hulk for heaving down by, there being no other method to come at a Ship's bottom, as the Tides doth not rise above 6 or 7 feet. At the New and full Moon it is high Water at that time about 8 o'clock, when the Land and Sea breezes are regular, but when they are not the Course of Tides are alter'd. The Sea breeze begins to blow about 10 or 12 o'clock, and continues until sunset, when it dies away and is succeeded by the land breeze, which continues most part of the night. From a little after sunrise until the Sea breeze sets in it is generally Calm, and is then the Hotest and most Disagreeable part of the whole day.

They have a yard for shipbuilding and a small hulk for repairs since that's the only way to access the bottom of a ship, as the tides only rise about 6 to 7 feet. During the new and full moon, high water occurs around 8 o'clock when the land and sea breezes are consistent; however, when they’re not, the tidal patterns change. The sea breeze usually starts around 10 or 12 o’clock and lasts until sunset, then it fades and is replaced by the land breeze, which blows most of the night. From shortly after sunrise until the sea breeze kicks in, it’s typically calm, and that's the hottest and most uncomfortable part of the entire day.


CHAPTER 2. RIO JANEIRO TO TAHITI.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES FROM RIO DE JANEIRO TOWARDS TERRA DEL FUEGO.

[December 1768. Rio to Strait Le Maire.]

[December 1768. Rio to Strait Le Maire.]

THURSDAY, December 8th. Fore and Middle parts Moderate breezes and Cloudy; remainder, little wind and Clear weather. At 3 p.m. the Boat returned from the Island; hoisted her in and made Sail at 6. The Sugar Loaf at the west Entrance of Rio de Janeiro bore North 1/2 East, distance 7 leagues; it lies from the City of Rio de Janeiro, from which I take my Departure, South-West 4 miles. Wind East-North-East, North-East, North by East; course South 7 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 85 miles; latitude 24 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 29 minutes West.

THURSDAY, December 8th. The fore and middle parts had moderate breezes and were cloudy; the remainder had light winds and clear weather. At 3 p.m., the boat returned from the island; we hoisted it up and set sail at 6. The Sugar Loaf at the west entrance of Rio de Janeiro was located at North 1/2 East, 7 leagues away; it's situated South-West 4 miles from the city of Rio de Janeiro, which is my point of departure. The wind was coming from the East-North-East, North-East, and North by East; our course was South 7 degrees 30 minutes West; we covered a distance of 85 miles; our latitude was 24 degrees 17 minutes South, and our longitude was 42 degrees 29 minutes West.

Friday, 9th. Genteel light breezes and Clear weather. At 3 a.m. the Fore top-gallant Mast broke short by the Cap; the Carpenter employed making another. Wind North, North-East, South-South-West; course South 22 degrees East; distance 32 miles; latitude 24 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 16 minutes West.

Friday, 9th. Gentle light breezes and clear weather. At 3 a.m., the fore top-gallant mast broke short by the cap; the carpenter is busy making a new one. Wind directions: North, North-East, South-South-West; course: South 22 degrees East; distance: 32 miles; latitude: 24 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude: 42 degrees 16 minutes West.

Saturday, 10th. Moderate breezes with some flying showers of Rain the first part. Wind southerly; course, South-East 1/2 East; distance 75 miles; latitude 25 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 12 minutes West.

Saturday, 10th. Light winds with some scattered rain showers early on. The wind was coming from the south; heading, South-East 1/2 East; distance covered was 75 miles; latitude 25 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 12 minutes West.

Sunday, 11th. Little wind and Clear weather the Most part of this day. Serv'd Slops* (* Slops are materials for making clothes.) to the People. Wind southerly; course South 20 degrees East; distance 9 miles; latitude 25 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 8 minutes West.

Sunday, 11th. It was mostly clear with little wind today. Provided clothing materials to the crew. The wind was coming from the south; we traveled on a course of South 20 degrees East; covered a distance of 9 miles; latitude 25 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 8 minutes West.

Monday, 12th. First part, light Airs; remainder, Genteel breezes and Clear weather. Found the variation of the Compass by the Evening Amplitude and an Azimuth in the Morning to be 8 degrees 30 minutes East, and the Observed Latitude at Noon to be short of that given by the Log 10 Miles. Exercised the People at Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind variable; course South-South-West; distance 34 miles; latitude 26 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 23 minutes West.

Monday, 12th. The first part of the day had light breezes; the rest was pleasant winds and clear skies. In the evening, I found the compass variation by checking the amplitude, and in the morning, the azimuth showed it to be 8 degrees 30 minutes East. The observed latitude at noon fell short of what the log indicated by 10 miles. I drilled the crew with big guns and small arms. The wind was variable; we traveled south-southwest for a distance of 34 miles; our latitude was 26 degrees 14 minutes South, and longitude 41 degrees 23 minutes West.

Tuesday, 13th. First part Gentle breezes and Clear, remainder a Steady Gale. The weather a little hazey. Variation 8 degrees 23 minutes East. Wind North-East and North-North-East; course South 19 degrees 40 minutes West; distance 113 miles; latitude 28 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 6 minutes West.

Tuesday, 13th. First part gentle breezes and clear, remainder a steady gale. The weather is a bit hazy. Variation 8 degrees 23 minutes east. Wind north-east and north-north-east; course south 19 degrees 40 minutes west; distance 113 miles; latitude 28 degrees 0 minutes south, longitude 42 degrees 6 minutes west.

Wednesday, 14th. First and latter parts, fresh breezes and Cloudy; middle, little wind, with Thunder, Lightning and Rain. The Caulkers employed Caulking the Ship's Decks. Wind, North-West, West, South by West; course South 16 degrees East; distance 87 miles; latitude 29 degrees 24 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 55 minutes West.

Wednesday, 14th. In the morning and evening, there were fresh breezes and clouds; in the middle of the day, there was little wind, along with thunder, lightning, and rain. The caulkers were busy caulking the ship's decks. The wind was coming from the northwest, west, and south by west; the course was south 16 degrees east; the distance covered was 87 miles; latitude 29 degrees 24 minutes south, longitude 41 degrees 55 minutes west.

Thursday, 15th. The first part a fresh Gale and dark Cloudy weather; Remainder, little wind and clear; a large swell from South-West. Wind South-West by South, South, East-South-East; course South 14 degrees 15 minutes East; distance 45 miles; latitude 30 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 41 degrees 39 minutes West.

Thursday, 15th. The first part had a strong wind and cloudy weather; the rest was a light breeze and clear skies; there was a large swell from the South-West. Wind direction was South-West by South, South, and East-South-East; course was South 14 degrees 15 minutes East; distance covered was 45 miles; latitude was 30 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude was 41 degrees 39 minutes West.

Friday, 16th. Genteel breezes and Clear weather. Variation 9 degrees 36 minutes East. Wind East-North-East, North-West, North-East; course South 32 degrees West: distance 86 miles; latitude 31 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 32 minutes West.

Friday, 16th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. Variation 9 degrees 36 minutes East. Wind East-North-East, North-West, North-East; course South 32 degrees West: distance 86 miles; latitude 31 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 32 minutes West.

Saturday, 17th. Hazey with frequent Showers of Rain all the Fore and Middle part; latter, Clear weather with a Gentle breeze of wind. Wind, variable from North-West, South-West, to South-South-East; course South 14 degrees West; distance 56 miles; latitude 32 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 42 degrees 48 minutes West.

Saturday, 17th. It was hazy with frequent rain showers throughout the morning and early afternoon; later, the weather cleared up with a gentle breeze. The wind varied from the Northwest to the Southwest and then to the South-Southeast; heading was 14 degrees West of South; distance covered was 56 miles; latitude was 32 degrees 15 minutes South, and longitude was 42 degrees 48 minutes West.

Sunday, 18th. First part, light winds; remainder, fresh breezes and Clear weather. Variation 11 degrees 3 minutes East. Wind, South-East to North-East; course South 51 West; distance 43 miles; latitude 32 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 43 degrees 27 minutes West.

Sunday, 18th. First part, light winds; the rest, fresh breezes and clear weather. Variation 11 degrees 3 minutes East. Wind, South-East to North-East; course South 51 West; distance 43 miles; latitude 32 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 43 degrees 27 minutes West.

Monday, 19th. A steady fresh breeze and fair weather. At half-past 5 p.m. Longitude in per Observation of the sun and moon 43 degrees 38 minutes West from Greenwich. Variation 11 degrees 3 minutes East. The Observed Latitude exceeds that given by the Log 7 Miles. Wind northerly; course South-West; distance 116 miles; latitude 34 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 45 degrees 6 minutes West.

Monday, 19th. A steady, fresh breeze and good weather. At 5:30 p.m. Longitude based on observations of the sun and moon: 43 degrees 38 minutes West from Greenwich. Variation: 11 degrees 3 minutes East. The observed latitude is 7 miles more than what the log indicates. Wind from the north; course southwest; distance traveled: 116 miles; latitude: 34 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude: 45 degrees 6 minutes West.

Tuesday, 20th. A fresh breeze of Wind and hazey. Variation 13 degrees 44 minutes East. Observed Latitude exceeds that given by the Log 11 miles. Wind north; course South-West 1/4 South; distance 160 miles; latitude 36 degrees 2 minutes South, longitude 47 degrees 14 minutes West.

Tuesday, 20th. A fresh breeze and hazy. Variation 13 degrees 44 minutes East. The observed latitude is 11 miles more than what the log shows. Wind is from the north; course is South-West 1/4 South; distance traveled is 160 miles; latitude is 36 degrees 2 minutes South, longitude is 47 degrees 14 minutes West.

Wednesday, 21st. Wind and weather Variable. Saw several black sheer Waters. Sounded twice this 24 Hours but found no ground with 90 fathoms. The Observed Latitude again ahead of the Log 16 miles. Wind variable; course South 42 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 90 miles; latitude 37 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 48 degrees 30 minutes West.

Wednesday, 21st. Wind and weather were unpredictable. Saw several dark waters. Used the sounding line twice in the last 24 hours but found no bottom at 90 fathoms. The observed latitude is again ahead of the log by 16 miles. The wind was variable; course South 42 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 90 miles; latitude 37 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 48 degrees 30 minutes West.

Thursday, 22nd. Little wind the most part of this day. Variation 15 degrees 30 minutes East. Bent a New Suit of Sails. Wind southerly; course West; distance 40 miles; latitude 37 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 49 degrees 1 minute West.

Thursday, 22nd. There was little wind for most of the day. The variation was 15 degrees 30 minutes East. We put up a new set of sails. The wind was coming from the south; we headed west; we covered a distance of 40 miles; our latitude was 37 degrees 8 minutes South, and our longitude was 49 degrees 1 minute West.

Friday, 23rd. Light Airs and Clear weather. Saw some Turtle upon the Water but could not catch any. Sounded no ground with 200 fathoms. Variation 15 degrees 40 minutes East. Wind southerly; course North 48 degrees West; distance 33 miles; latitude 36 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 49 degrees 32 minutes West.

Friday, 23rd. Light winds and clear weather. Saw some turtles on the water but couldn’t catch any. Did not find any bottom with 200 fathoms. Variation 15 degrees 40 minutes East. Wind from the south; course North 48 degrees West; distance 33 miles; latitude 36 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 49 degrees 32 minutes West.

Saturday, 24th. First part Calm; remainder a Genteel breeze and fine Clear weather. This night had 2 Sets of Observations of the Moon and the Star Aldebaran, which gave the Longitude 49 degrees 54 minutes 15 seconds West; the first sett gave 49 degrees 55 minutes 15 seconds, and the Second 49 degrees 53 minutes 15 seconds. Wind calm, north-easterly; course South 50 degrees West; distance 39 miles; latitude 37 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 50 degrees 32 minutes West.

Saturday, 24th. First part calm; the rest a nice breeze and clear weather. That night, I made two sets of observations of the Moon and the star Aldebaran, which gave the longitude of 49 degrees 54 minutes 15 seconds West. The first set showed 49 degrees 55 minutes 15 seconds, and the second set showed 49 degrees 53 minutes 15 seconds. The wind was calm and coming from the northeast; course South 50 degrees West; distance 39 miles; latitude 37 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 50 degrees 32 minutes West.

Sunday, 25th. Fresh breezes and fine Clear weather. Wind North-East by North to North; course South 50 degrees West; distance 116 miles; latitude 38 degrees 37 minutes South, longitude 52 degrees 5 minutes West.

Sunday, 25th. Fresh breezes and clear weather. Wind North-East by North to North; course South 50 degrees West; distance 116 miles; latitude 38 degrees 37 minutes South, longitude 52 degrees 5 minutes West.

Monday, 26th. A Fresh breeze of Wind and Cloudy weather; passed by some Rock Weed. At noon the Observed latitude 26 Miles to the Southward of the Log, which I believe is chiefly owing to her being Generally steer'd to the Southward of her Course. Yesterday being Christmas Day the people were none of the Soberest. Wind North; course South-West; distance 158 miles; latitude 40 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 54 degrees 30 minutes West.

Monday, 26th. A fresh breeze and cloudy weather; passed by some rockweed. At noon, the observed latitude was 26 miles south of the log, which I believe is mainly due to it generally being steered south of its course. Yesterday was Christmas Day, and the crew wasn't exactly sober. Wind from the north; course southwest; distance 158 miles; latitude 40 degrees 19 minutes south, longitude 54 degrees 30 minutes west.

Tuesday, 27th. Fresh breezes and Hazey with Squalls which Obliged us during the Night to take in the small Sails and 2 reefs in the Topsails which were let out in the Morning. Wind northerly; course South 50 degrees West; distance 123 miles; latitude 41 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 56 degrees 15 minutes West.

Tuesday, 27th. Fresh breezes and hazy with squalls that forced us during the night to take in the small sails and put 2 reefs in the topsails, which were released in the morning. Wind from the north; course South 50 degrees West; distance 123 miles; latitude 41 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 56 degrees 15 minutes West.

Wednesday, 28th. First part Strong Gales and Cloudy, which Obliged us to get down Top-Gallant Yards. At 8 p.m. it blew a Storm of Wind with Rain which brought us under our Mainsail with her Head to the Westward. Sounded 50 fathoms, fine brown Sand; at midnight had 40 fathoms, the same bottom. At 4 a.m. had 46 fathoms Coral Rock. The weather being more Moderate, made Sail under the Courses and Set the Topsails with 2 Reefs in. Wind South-East to South; latitude 40 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 58 degrees 29 minutes West.

Wednesday, 28th. First part Strong Winds and Cloudy, which forced us to lower the Top-Gallant Yards. At 8 p.m., a Storm with Rain hit us, making us sail under our Mainsail with the bow facing West. We measured 50 fathoms, fine brown Sand; at midnight we found 40 fathoms, the same bottom. At 4 a.m., we had 46 fathoms of Coral Rock. As the weather became more Moderate, we set sail under the Courses and raised the Topsails with 2 Reefs in. Wind was from the South-East to South; latitude 40 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 58 degrees 29 minutes West.

Thursday, 29th. First part moderate breezes and Cloudy; remainder fresh breezes and Clear. P.M. loosed all the Reefs out, and got Topgallant Yards a Cross. Variation per Azimuth 16 degrees 12 minutes, per Amplitude 16 degrees 32 minutes; Mean of the Two 16 degrees 22 minutes East. Between 9 and 10 a.m. took 7 sets of Observations between the sun and moon to find the Longitude of the Ship. Each set Consists of three Observations; the Mean of the whole gave 59 degrees 18 minutes 34 seconds West of Greenwich. The result of each set was as follows: viz., 1st set, 59 degrees 8 minutes; Second, 59 degrees 21 minutes; Third, 59 degrees 34 minutes; Fourth, 59 degrees 17 minutes; Fifth, 59 degrees 11 minutes 45 seconds; Sixth, 59 degrees 19 minutes 30 seconds; and the Seventh, 59 degrees 20 minutes 45 seconds. The greatest differance between any two--viz., the first and third--is but 26 minutes, and the mean of these two differ from the mean of the whole only 2 minutes 26 seconds. This shews to what degree of accuracy these observations can be made even by Different Persons, for four of these were made and computed by Mr. Green and the rest by myself. The Longitude given by the Ship, reckoning from the last Observation 5 Days ago, differs only 8 Miles from the Observation, which shews that we have not been in any Currents. Soundings from 40 to 47. Wind North-Easterly; course South 46 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 81 miles; latitude 41 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 59 degrees 37 minutes West.

Thursday, 29th. The first part of the day had mild breezes and was cloudy; the rest of the day had fresh breezes and was clear. In the afternoon, I released all the reefs and crossed the topgallant yards. The variation based on azimuth was 16 degrees 12 minutes, and based on amplitude was 16 degrees 32 minutes; the average of the two was 16 degrees 22 minutes East. Between 9 and 10 a.m., I took 7 sets of observations between the sun and moon to determine the ship's longitude. Each set consisted of three observations, and the overall average gave 59 degrees 18 minutes 34 seconds West of Greenwich. The results for each set were as follows: 1st set, 59 degrees 8 minutes; 2nd, 59 degrees 21 minutes; 3rd, 59 degrees 34 minutes; 4th, 59 degrees 17 minutes; 5th, 59 degrees 11 minutes 45 seconds; 6th, 59 degrees 19 minutes 30 seconds; and 7th, 59 degrees 20 minutes 45 seconds. The largest difference between any two—specifically, the first and third—was only 26 minutes, and the average of those two differed from the overall average by just 2 minutes 26 seconds. This demonstrates the level of accuracy that can be achieved with these observations, even by different people, as four of these were made and calculated by Mr. Green while the rest were done by me. The longitude provided by the ship, calculated from the last observation 5 days ago, differs by only 8 miles from the observed value, indicating we haven't encountered any currents. Soundings ranged from 40 to 47. The wind was coming from the northeast; course was South 46 degrees 30 minutes West; distance covered was 81 miles; latitude was 41 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude was 59 degrees 37 minutes West.

Friday, 30th. Little wind, and sometimes Calm; the first part Clear weather, remainder Foggy and Hazey. Soundings from 44 to 49 fathoms; Grey sandy Bottom. Caught both this Morning and last Night a great Number of insects. Some were upon the Wing, but the greater part were upon the water, and many of these alive and of such sort as cannot fly far; and yet at this Time we could not be less than 30 Leagues from Land. Wind variable; course South 30 degrees West; distance 54 miles; latitude 42 degrees 32 minutes South, longitude 60 degrees 15 minutes West.

Friday, 30th. There was little wind, and sometimes it was calm; the first part of the day was clear, while the rest was foggy and hazy. The soundings ranged from 44 to 49 fathoms, with a gray sandy bottom. We caught a large number of insects both this morning and last night. Some were flying, but most were on the water, and many of these were alive and of a type that can’t fly far; still, at this point, we were at least 30 leagues from land. The wind was variable; we were on a course of South 30 degrees West, covering a distance of 54 miles; latitude 42 degrees 32 minutes South, longitude 60 degrees 15 minutes West.

Saturday, 31st. Cloudy weather, with some Lightning and a few showers of rain. Variation 18 degrees 36 minutes East. Soundings from 46 to 50 fathoms; fine dark sand. Wind South-Easterly; course South 18 degrees West; distance 43 miles; latitude 43 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 60 degrees 26 minutes West.

Saturday, 31st. The weather is cloudy, with some lightning and a few rain showers. Variation 18 degrees 36 minutes East. Depths range from 46 to 50 fathoms; fine dark sand. Wind is coming from the southeast; heading is South 18 degrees West; distance traveled is 43 miles; latitude is 43 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude is 60 degrees 26 minutes West.

[January 1769.]

[January 1769.]

Sunday, January 1st, 1769. First and Latter part, fresh breezes and Clear weather; in the Middle, light Airs and Calm. At Noon, longitude in per 4 Sets of Observations between the sun and moon 61 degrees 8 minutes 28 seconds west. The Difference between the least and Greatest of these sets was 8 minutes, and the mean of 2 differs from the Mean of the whole but 32 seconds. The Longitude by account carried on from the last Observations exactly agree with these Observations. Saw a great number of small Whales about the Ship. Wind South to West-South-West; course South 36 degrees West; distance 39 miles; latitude 43 degrees 35 minutes South; longitude 61 degrees 8 minutes 28 seconds West.

Sunday, January 1st, 1769. In the beginning and at the end, there were fresh breezes and clear weather; in the middle, there were light winds and calm conditions. At noon, the longitude, based on four sets of observations between the sun and moon, was 61 degrees 8 minutes 28 seconds west. The difference between the least and greatest of these sets was 8 minutes, and the average of two differs from the overall average by only 32 seconds. The longitude calculated from the previous observations matches these observations perfectly. We saw a large number of small whales near the ship. Wind was blowing from the south to the west-southwest; course was South 36 degrees West; distance traveled was 39 miles; latitude was 43 degrees 35 minutes South; longitude was 61 degrees 8 minutes 28 seconds West.

Monday, January 2nd. The first part of this day a Genteel gale and Clear weather; middle, Squally, with Lightning and rain, and some showers of Large Hail Stones; towards Noon a Steady fresh breeze and Clear weather. At noon longitude in by 3 sets of Observations between the sun and moon 61 degrees 7 minutes 45 seconds, which is 43 seconds to the Eastward of yesterday's Observations. The Ship by the Log has made 4 minutes East. Wind Westerly; course South 2 degrees East; distance 92 miles; latitude 45 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude 61 degrees 7 minutes 45 seconds West.

Monday, January 2nd. The morning had a gentle breeze and clear weather; in the middle of the day, it got squally with lightning and rain, along with some heavy hail. By noon, there was a steady, fresh breeze and clear skies. At noon, the longitude from three sets of observations between the sun and moon was 61 degrees 7 minutes 45 seconds, which is 43 seconds east of yesterday's observations. According to the log, the ship has traveled 4 minutes east. The wind was from the west; the course was south 2 degrees east; the distance covered was 92 miles; latitude was 45 degrees 17 minutes south, and longitude was 61 degrees 7 minutes 45 seconds west.

Tuesday, 3rd. Fresh gales and clear weather; under Single Reef Topsails. P.M. Saw some Whales and Porpoises and small red Crawfish, some of which we Caught. At Noon saw several Birds of a light Grey Colour, like Pidgeons, but smaller; these are of the Mother Carey's kind. Longitude per Observation 61 degrees 29 minutes 45 seconds, which is 22 minutes to the westward of Yesterday, but the ship hath made 41 minutes, Consequently there is an Error of 19 minutes, which is not to be supposed to be in the Log in one Day's run; but, be it which way it will, it is not great. Wind West, Southerly; course South 11 degrees; distance 122 miles; latitude 47 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude 61 degrees 29 minutes 45 seconds West.

Tuesday, 3rd. Fresh winds and clear skies; under Single Reef Topsails. P.M. Saw some whales and porpoises, as well as small red crawfish, some of which we caught. At noon, saw several birds that were a light gray color, similar to pigeons but smaller; these are of the Mother Carey's type. Longitude by observation is 61 degrees 29 minutes 45 seconds, which is 22 minutes west of yesterday, but the ship has made 41 minutes, so there is an error of 19 minutes. It shouldn't be thought that this error is in the log for one day's run; however, either way, it's not significant. Wind is from the west, southerly; course is South 11 degrees; distance traveled is 122 miles; latitude is 47 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude is 61 degrees 29 minutes 45 seconds West.

MODERN CHART OF SOUTH PACIFIC OCEAN SHOWING TRACK OF H.M.S. ENDEAVOUR, 1769 TO 1770.

 

Wednesday, 4th. First part, genteel breeze and Clear; latter, fresh gales, with heavy squalls of wind and rain, which brought us under our courses and main topsails close reefed. Soon after noon saw the appearance of Land to the Eastward, and being in the Latitude of Peypes Island, as it is lay'd down in some Charts, imagined it might be it.* (* Pepys' Island, placed on charts, from a report by Captain Cowley in 1683, about 230 miles north of Falkland Islands, and long imagined to exist. It was eventually recognised, after the discovery of Cowley's manuscript Journal, that Cowley had sighted the Falklands.) Bore down to be Certain, and at 1/2 past 2 p.m. discovered our Mistake, and hauld the Wind again. At 6 sounded, and had 72 fathoms black sand and mud. Variation 19 degrees 45 minutes East. Wind West-North-West to South-West by South; course South 30 degrees East; distance 76 miles; latitude 48 degrees 28 minutes South, longitude 60 degrees 51 minutes West.

Wednesday, 4th. In the morning, there was a gentle breeze and clear skies; in the afternoon, fresh gales with heavy squalls of wind and rain forced us to reduce our sails and reef the main topsails. Shortly after noon, we spotted land to the east and, being in the latitude of Pepys Island as indicated on some charts, we thought it might be it.* (*Pepys' Island was marked on charts based on a report by Captain Cowley in 1683, about 230 miles north of the Falkland Islands, and was long thought to exist. It was later confirmed, after the discovery of Cowley's manuscript journal, that Cowley had actually seen the Falklands.) We changed course to confirm and at 2:30 p.m. realized our mistake, so we adjusted the wind again. At 6, we took soundings and found 72 fathoms of black sand and mud. Variation was 19 degrees 45 minutes East. The wind was from the West-North-West to South-West by South; our course was South 30 degrees East; distance traveled was 76 miles; latitude was 48 degrees 28 minutes South, longitude was 60 degrees 51 minutes West.

[Nearing Terra del Fuego.]

[Nearing Tierra del Fuego.]

Thursday, 5th. Fore part, fresh Gales and Clear; Middle, light Airs; remainder, fresh Gales and a little hazey. P.M. found the Variation to be 20 degrees 4 minutes East; Soundings 75 and 73 fathoms. A great Number of Water Fowl about the Ship. Wind South-West, North-East, North-North-East; course South 28 degrees West; distance 92 miles; latitude 49 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 61 degrees 67 minutes West.

Thursday, 5th. In the morning, it was breezy and clear; in the middle of the day, there were light winds; in the afternoon, it became breezy again and a bit hazy. In the afternoon, we measured the magnetic variation to be 20 degrees 4 minutes East; Depths were 75 and 73 fathoms. There were a lot of waterfowl around the ship. The wind was coming from the South-West, North-East, and North-North-East; we were on a course of South 28 degrees West; we covered a distance of 92 miles; our latitude was 49 degrees 49 minutes South, and our longitude was 61 degrees 67 minutes West.

Friday, 6th. Fresh gales, the Air very Sharp and Cold; frequent showers of rain and Squalls. Soundings 75 fathoms. Saw some Penguins. Gave to each of the People a Fearnought Jacket and a pair of Trowsers, after which I never heard one Man Complain of Cold, not but that the weather was cold enough. Wind West, Southerly; course South 8 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 92 miles; latitude 51 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 62 degrees 19 minutes West.

Friday, 6th. Fresh winds, the air very sharp and cold; frequent rain showers and squalls. Depth measured at 75 fathoms. Saw some penguins. Gave each person a heavy jacket and a pair of trousers, after which I never heard anyone complain about the cold, even though the weather was cold enough. Wind from the west, southerly; heading south 8 degrees 45 minutes west; distance 92 miles; latitude 51 degrees 20 minutes south, longitude 62 degrees 19 minutes west.

Saturday, 7th. First part, Strong Gales, with excessive hard Squals, with rain. At 9 p.m. wore and brought too, her head to the Westward under the Mainsail, and Reef'd the Foresail for the first time. The Storm continued with a little intermission until a little towards Noon, when it abated, so we could set the Topsails close Reefed. Saw many Penguins and some Seals. Wind southerly: course South 62 degrees East; distance 14 miles; latitude 51 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 61 degrees 59 minutes West.

Saturday, 7th. First part, Strong Winds, with heavy squalls and rain. At 9 p.m., we changed direction and stopped, facing west under the mainsail, and reefed the foresail for the first time. The storm continued, with a brief break, until just before noon when it eased up enough for us to set the topsails close reefed. We saw many penguins and a few seals. Wind was coming from the south: course South 62 degrees East; distance 14 miles; latitude 51 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 61 degrees 59 minutes West.

Sunday, 8th. Wind and weather both Variable, but for the most part little wind. P.M. loosed the Reef out of the Foresail and 2 Reefs out of Each Topsail. A.M. got Top gallant Yards aCross and loosed all the Reefs out. Soundings from 80 to 75 fathoms. Wind South, South-West, West, North-West; course North 72 degrees West; distance 33 miles; latitude 51 degrees 16 minutes South; longitude 62 degrees 50 minutes West.

Sunday, 8th. The wind and weather were both unpredictable, but mostly there was little wind. In the afternoon, I released the reef from the foresail and took 2 reefs out of each topsail. In the morning, I got the topgallant yards across and loosened all the reefs. The soundings were between 80 and 75 fathoms. The wind was coming from the South, South-West, West, and North-West; we were on a course of North 72 degrees West, covering a distance of 33 miles; latitude 51 degrees 16 minutes South; longitude 62 degrees 50 minutes West.

Monday, 9th. First and Latter parts, a moderate breeze and Clear weather; Middle, squally with rain. P.M. found the Variation by several azimuths to be 22 degrees 24 minutes East. Saw a great Number of Penguins and Seals.

Monday, 9th. First and Latter parts, a gentle breeze and clear skies; Middle, windy with rain. In the afternoon, found the variation by several azimuths to be 22 degrees 24 minutes East. Saw a large number of penguins and seals.

Tuesday, 10th. Moderate breezes and fine clear weather. At 2 p.m. Sounded 86 fathoms; black sand and Small stones. Variation 21 degrees 57 minutes East. At 1/2 past 10 Tackt having Stood south 12 Leagues. After standing to the Westward 14 Miles, sounded, and had 80 fathoms black grey sand; 3 Leagues farther 76, coarse black sand; Tack'd, and at noon had 70 fathoms black gravel and Small Stones of different Colours. Saw several flights of black Sheerwaters. Wind West-South-West, South-West; course South 18 degrees West; distance 38 miles; latitude 52 degrees 54 minutes South, longitude 63 degrees 10 minutes West.

Tuesday, 10th. There were moderate breezes and clear weather. At 2 p.m., we took soundings at 86 fathoms; there was black sand and small stones. The variation was 21 degrees 57 minutes East. At 10:30, we had traveled south for 12 leagues. After heading west for 14 miles, we took soundings again and found 80 fathoms of black gray sand; 3 leagues farther, we had 76 fathoms of coarse black sand. We changed direction and at noon had 70 fathoms of black gravel and small stones in various colors. We saw several flights of black shearwaters. The wind was from the West-South-West and South-West; our course was South 18 degrees West; we covered a distance of 38 miles; latitude was 52 degrees 54 minutes South, longitude 63 degrees 10 minutes West.

Wednesday, 11th. A Steady Genteel breeze and clear weather. P.M. after standing 13 Leagues South-South-West Sounded 64 fathoms Gravel and small Stones; Standing South-West by South 11 leagues farther, had 46 fathoms, the same sort of bottom. At 8 a.m. saw the land of Terra del Fuego, extending from the west to the South-East by South, distance off shore between 3 and 4 Leagues; sounded and had 35 fathoms small, soft, Slate Stones. Variation 23 degrees 30 minutes East. In ranging along shore to the South-East at the distance of 2 or 3 leagues, had 27 and 26 fathoms muddy bottom. Saw some of the natives, who made a Smook in several places, which must have been done as a Signal to us as they did not continue it after we passed. By our Longitude we ought not to have been so far to the Westward as Statenland, as it is laid down in the Charts; but it appeared from Subsequent Observations that the Ship had got near a Degree of Longitude to the Westward of the Log, which is 35 Miles in these Latitudes. Probably this in part may be owing to a Small Current setting to the Westward, occasioned by the Westerly Current which comes round Cape Horn and through Strait La Maire, and the inDraught of the Streights of Magellan. Wind westerly; course South 30 degrees West; distance, 100 miles; latitude 54 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 64 degrees 35 minutes West per log.

Wednesday, 11th. A steady, gentle breeze and clear weather. In the afternoon, after traveling 13 leagues South-South-West, we measured 64 fathoms of gravel and small stones; continuing South-West by South for another 11 leagues, we found 46 fathoms with the same type of bottom. At 8 a.m., we spotted the land of Terra del Fuego, stretching from the west to South-East by South, about 3 to 4 leagues offshore; we measured 35 fathoms of small, soft slate stones. The variation was 23 degrees 30 minutes East. As we moved along the shore to the South-East, about 2 or 3 leagues out, we measured 27 and 26 fathoms of muddy bottom. We saw some of the natives, who started fires in several places, likely as a signal to us since they stopped after we passed. According to our longitude, we shouldn’t have been as far west as Statenland is shown on the charts; however, later observations indicated that the ship was near a degree of longitude further west than recorded, which is 35 miles in these latitudes. This might be partly due to a small current pushing to the west, caused by the westerly current coming around Cape Horn and through the Strait of La Maire, along with the in-draft of the Strait of Magellan. The wind was westerly; our course was South 30 degrees West; distance traveled was 100 miles; latitude 54 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 64 degrees 35 minutes West according to the log.

Thursday, 12th. First part, moderate breezes and Cloudy; remainder sometimes a fresh breeze, sometimes Calm, Hazey weather with rain. At 5 the wind coming to the Northward obliged us to Tack and Stood North-Westward, being then about 5 Miles from the Shore, and had 23 fathoms, sandy Bottom. At Midnight Tackt and Stood to the Eastward. At Noon the Land over the Entrance of Straits La Maire, East-North-East, distance, 7 leagues; Soundings from 28 to 38 fathoms. Wind North, North-North-East, variable, West-South-West; latitude 54 degrees 34 minutes South per observation.

Thursday, 12th. In the morning, there were light breezes and cloudy skies; the rest of the day saw occasional fresh breezes and calm spells, with hazy weather and rain. At 5 PM, the wind shifted to the north, forcing us to tack and head northwest, about 5 miles from shore, where the depth was 23 fathoms and the bottom was sandy. At midnight, we tacked again and turned east. By noon, we could see land over the entrance of the Straits of Le Maire, to the east-north-east, 7 leagues away; the soundings ranged from 28 to 38 fathoms. The wind was from the north, north-north-east, variable, and from the west-south-west; our latitude was 54 degrees 34 minutes south, according to our observations.

Friday, 13th. The greatest part of this day little wind and Cloudy. At 8 p.m., Cape St. Diego, at the west entrance of Straits La Maire, East, distance about 5 leagues. Keept under an easey Sail until daylight, at which time we were abreast of Cape St. Diego, and then put into the Straits, but the Tide soon turned against us and obliged us to haul under the Cape again and wait until 9 a.m. when it shifted in our favour. Put into the Straits again with a Moderate breeze at South-West, which soon grew Boisterous with very heavy Squalls, with rain and hail, and obliged us to Close reef our Topsails. Wind North-East by East, West-South-West, South-West; latitude 54 degrees 39 minutes South; at noon, Cape St. Diego North 2 leagues.

Friday, the 13th. Most of the day was windy and cloudy. At 8 p.m., we were about 5 leagues east of Cape St. Diego, which is at the west entrance of the Straits of La Maire. We kept an easy sail until daylight, at which point we were even with Cape St. Diego, and then we entered the Straits. However, the tide quickly turned against us, forcing us to head back under the Cape and wait until 9 a.m. when it shifted in our favor. We entered the Straits again with a moderate breeze from the southwest, which soon became strong and brought heavy squalls, with rain and hail, forcing us to close reef our topsails. The wind was coming from the northeast by east, west-southwest, and southwest; we were at latitude 54 degrees 39 minutes south; at noon, Cape St. Diego was 2 leagues to the north.

[In Strait of Le Maire.]

[In Strait of Le Maire.]

Saturday, 14th. First part Strong Gales, and very heavy squalls with Hail and Rain; remainder more moderate but unsettled, sometimes a fresh breeze and Squally, and sometimes little wind. Kept plying in the Straits until 1/2 past 4 p.m., at which time the Tide had made strong against us, and the wind not abating, bore away, intending to have hauled under Cape St. Diego, but was prevented by the force of the Tide, which carried us past that Cape with surprising rapidity, at the same time caused a very great sea. At 6, the weather being Clear, took 9, or 3 sets of, Observations of the sun and moon in order to find the Longitude of the place, and as they perhaps are the first Observations of this kind that were ever made so near to the Extremity of South America, I have inserted them below just as they were taken, that everybody may judge for themselves.

Saturday, 14th. The first part of the day had strong gales and heavy squalls with hail and rain; the remainder was more moderate but unsettled, sometimes with a fresh breeze and squally, and at other times with little wind. We kept navigating in the Straits until 4:30 p.m., at which point the tide was flowing strongly against us, and with the wind not letting up, we changed course, planning to go under Cape St. Diego. However, we were unable to do so due to the force of the tide, which carried us past the Cape surprisingly quickly and created a very large sea. At 6, with clear weather, I took 9 observations, or 3 sets, of the sun and moon to determine the longitude of our location. Since these might be the first observations of this kind made so close to the southern tip of South America, I’ve included them below exactly as recorded, so everyone can assess them for themselves.

COLUMN 1: NAME OF SET. COLUMN 2: TIME BY THE WATCH IN HOURS, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 3: APPARENT TIME COMPUTED FROM IN HOURS, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 4: OBSERVED DISTANCE. SUN AND MOON'S NEAREST LIMB IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 5: OBSERVED ALTITUDE. SUN'S LOWER LIMB IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 6: OBSERVED ALTITUDE. MOON'S UPPER LIMB IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 7: CORRECT ALTITUDE. SUN'S CENTER IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 8: CORRECT ALTITUDE. MOON'S CENTER IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS. COLUMN 9: THE LONGITUDE RESULTING FROM BOTH SETS OF OBSERVATIONS IN DEGREES, MINUTES AND SECONDS.

COLUMN 1: NAME OF SET. COLUMN 2: TIME BY THE WATCH IN HOURS, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 3: APPARENT TIME CALCULATED IN HOURS, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 4: OBSERVED DISTANCE. SUN AND MOON'S NEAREST EDGE IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 5: OBSERVED ALTITUDE. SUN'S LOWER EDGE IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 6: OBSERVED ALTITUDE. MOON'S UPPER EDGE IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 7: CORRECT ALTITUDE. SUN'S CENTER IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 8: CORRECT ALTITUDE. MOON'S CENTER IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS. COLUMN 9: LONGITUDE RESULTING FROM BOTH SETS OF OBSERVATIONS IN DEGREES, MINUTES, AND SECONDS.

-- : 8 27 15 : -- : 71 26 0 : 15 36 0 : 24 13 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 30 30 : -- : 71 28 0 : 15 11 0 : 24 8 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 32 15 : -- : 71 29 0 : 14 56 0 : 23 57 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------ -- : 25 30 00 : -- : - 83 0 : 45 43 0 : 72 18 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------ 1st set : 8 30 0 : 6 12 53 : 71 27 40 : 15 14 20 : 24 6 0 : 15 22 39 : 23 43 0 : 66 7 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- ----------------

-- : 8 27 15 : -- : 71 26 0 : 15 36 0 : 24 13 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 30 30 : -- : 71 28 0 : 15 11 0 : 24 8 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 32 15 : -- : 71 29 0 : 14 56 0 : 23 57 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------ -- : 25 30 00 : -- : - 83 0 : 45 43 0 : 72 18 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------ 1st set : 8 30 0 : 6 12 53 : 71 27 40 : 15 14 20 : 24 6 0 : 15 22 39 : 23 43 0 : 66 7 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- ----------------

-- : 8 33 50 : -- : 71 30 0 : 14 43 0 : 23 38 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 35 39 : -- : - 31 0 : 14 25 0 : 23 42 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 37 46 : -- : - 30 30 : 14 10 0 : 23 32 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- -- : 8 107 15 : -- : - 91 30 : 43 18 0 : 23 112 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- 2nd set : 8 35 45 : 6 18 41 : 71 30 30 : 14 26 0 : 23 37 20 : 14 34 00 : 23 14 0 : 66 19 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------

-- : 8 33 50 : -- : 71 30 0 : 14 43 0 : 23 38 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 35 39 : -- : - 31 0 : 14 25 0 : 23 42 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 37 46 : -- : - 30 30 : 14 10 0 : 23 32 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- -- : 8 107 15 : -- : - 91 30 : 43 18 0 : 23 112 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- 2nd set : 8 35 45 : 6 18 41 : 71 30 30 : 14 26 0 : 23 37 20 : 14 34 00 : 23 14 0 : 66 19 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------

-- : 8 39 10 : -- : 71 31 30 : 13 56 0 : 23 26 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 41 20 : -- : - 32 00 : 13 40 0 : 23 20 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 43 49 : -- : - 33 00 : 13 18 0 : 23 6 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- -- : 8 124 19 : -- : - 96 30 : - 114 0 : - 52 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- 3rd set : 8 41 26 : 6 24 26 : 71 32 10 : 13 38 0 : 23 17 20 : 13 46 0 : 22 55 0 : 66 0 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------

-- : 8 39 10 : -- : 71 31 30 : 13 56 0 : 23 26 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 41 20 : -- : - 32 00 : 13 40 0 : 23 20 0 : -- : -- : --. -- : 8 43 49 : -- : - 33 00 : 13 18 0 : 23 6 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- -- : 8 124 19 : -- : - 96 30 : - 114 0 : - 52 0 : -- : -- : --. ------------------------------------------------- 3rd set : 8 41 26 : 6 24 26 : 71 32 10 : 13 38 0 : 23 17 20 : 13 46 0 : 22 55 0 : 66 0 45. ------------------------------------------------------------------------- -------------------

N.B. The mean of the three sets is 66 degrees 9 minutes 25 seconds, and the mean of Mr. Green's Computations from the same Observations was 66 degrees 14 minutes 0 seconds, and the mean of his computations and mine will be 66 degrees 11 minutes 32 seconds, and therefore the Longitude of Cape St. Diego or the North-West entrance of Strait Le Maire will be 66 degrees 0 minutes 0 seconds West from Greenwich, and its Latitude 54 degrees 39 minutes South.* (* Modern determination is 54 degrees 40 minutes South, 65 degrees 8 minutes West.)

N.B. The average of the three sets is 66 degrees 9 minutes 25 seconds, while Mr. Green's average from the same observations was 66 degrees 14 minutes 0 seconds. The average of his calculations and mine will be 66 degrees 11 minutes 32 seconds. Therefore, the longitude of Cape St. Diego or the north-west entrance of Strait Le Maire will be 66 degrees 0 minutes 0 seconds west of Greenwich, and its latitude is 54 degrees 39 minutes south.* (*Modern determination is 54 degrees 40 minutes south, 65 degrees 8 minutes west.)

Note: The distance of the sun and moon was taken by Mr. Green alone, my Quadrant being out of Order.

Note: The distance of the sun and moon was measured solely by Mr. Green, as my quadrant was not functioning.

Cape St. Diego bore at this time South by East about 4 Leagues Distant. At 1/2 past 7 Tackt and Stood to the South-East, Cape St. Diego bearing South by East, distance 5 Leagues. At 1 a.m., Squally, wore Ship, Staten Land extending from North to East. At 4, Moderate Weather, loosed a Reef out of each Topsail, the Cape of Good Success West by South, and Cape St. Diego North-North-West, being now in the Strait, but the Tide turning against us soon carried us out. The Violence of the Tide of Ebb rose such a Sea off Cape St. Diego, that it looked as if it was breaking Violently on the ledge of Rocks, and would be taken for such by any who know'd not the true cause. When the Ship was in this Torrent she frequently Pitched her Bowsprit in the Water. By Noon we got under the Land between Cape St. Diego and Cape St. Vincent, where I thought to have Anchored, but found the Bottom every where hard and Rocky; the Depth of Water from 30 to 12 fathoms. Sent the Master to Examine a small Cove which appeared to our View a little to the Eastward of Cape St. Vincent. Wind South-South-West and South-West by South.

Cape St. Diego was located about 4 leagues to the South by East at this time. At 7:30, we turned and headed Southeast, with Cape St. Diego at South by East, now 5 leagues away. At 1 a.m., it was squally, and we changed course, with Staten Land stretching from North to East. By 4 a.m., the weather had moderated, and we eased a reef out of each topsail, with the Cape of Good Success to the West by South and Cape St. Diego to the North-North-West, as we were now in the Strait. However, the tide was against us and quickly pushed us out. The force of the ebb tide created such rough seas off Cape St. Diego that it looked like it was crashing violently against the rocks, which anyone unfamiliar with the situation might mistake for something else. In this strong current, the ship frequently pitched her bowsprit into the water. By noon, we arrived at the land between Cape St. Diego and Cape St. Vincent, where I planned to anchor but found the bottom hard and rocky everywhere, with water depths ranging from 30 to 12 fathoms. I sent the master to check out a small cove that appeared to be just east of Cape St. Vincent. The wind was from the South-South-West and South-West by South.

Sunday, 15th. Moderate breezes at South and South-East, and cloudy weather, the greater part of this day. At 2 p.m. the Master return'd with an account that there was Anchorage in 4 fathoms Water and a good bottom close to the Eastward of the first black bluff point which is on the East side of Cape St. Vincent, at the very Entrance of the Cove we saw from the Ship (which I named Vincent Bay). Before this Anchoring ground lay several Rocky Ledges covered with Sea Weed: on these Ledges I was informed was not less than 8 or 9 fathoms, but in standing in with the Ship the first we came upon had only 4 fathoms upon it. I therefore thought that Anchoring here would be attended with some Risk, and that it would be better to Endeavour to find some Port in the Strait, and there Compleat our Wood and Water. However, I sent an Officer with a Boat on shore to attend to Mr. Banks and people who was very desirous of being on shore at any rate, while I keept plying as near the shore as possible with the Ship. At 9 they return'd on board bringing with them several Plants, Flowers, etc., most of them unknown in Europe, and in that Alone consisted their whole Value; they saw none of the Natives, but meet with several of their old Hutts. Hoisted the Boat in and made Sail into the Straits and at 3 a.m. Anchord in 12 1/2 fathoms Water (the bottom Coral rocks) before a small Cove which we took for Port Maurice, and near 1/2 a Mile from the shore Cape St. Diego South-South-West, and Cape St. Bartholomew (which is the south point of Staten Land) East-South-East.

Sunday, 15th. There were gentle breezes from the South and South-East, with mostly cloudy weather throughout the day. At 2 p.m., the Captain returned with the news that there was anchorage in 4 fathoms of water and a good bottom close to the East of the first black bluff point on the East side of Cape St. Vincent, right at the entrance of the cove we saw from the ship (which I named Vincent Bay). In front of this anchoring spot were several rocky ledges covered in seaweed; I was told that there was at least 8 or 9 fathoms of water over them, but as we maneuvered the ship closer, we found the first ledge had only 4 fathoms. I thought that anchoring here would involve some risk, so I decided it would be better to try to find a port in the strait to complete our wood and water supplies. However, I sent an officer with a boat ashore to assist Mr. Banks and his crew, who were very eager to go ashore at any cost, while I kept the ship as close to the shore as possible. At 9, they returned on board with several plants, flowers, and other items, most of which were unknown in Europe, which was their main value; they didn’t see any natives but did come across some old huts. I hoisted the boat and set sail into the strait, anchoring at 3 a.m. in 12.5 fathoms of water (with coral rocks at the bottom) before a small cove that we thought was Port Maurice, about half a mile from the shore with Cape St. Diego to the South-South-West and Cape St. Bartholomew (which is the southern point of Staten Land) to the East-South-East.

Port Maurice appeared to afford so little Shelter for Shipping that I did not think it worth while to hoist a Boat out to Examine it; we saw here 2 of the Natives come down to the Shore, who stay'd sometime, then retir'd into the Woods againe. At 10 o'Clock got under Sail, Wind at South-East, and plyed to Windward.

Port Maurice seemed to provide so little shelter for ships that I thought it wasn't worth it to launch a boat for a closer look; we saw two locals come down to the shore, hang around for a bit, and then head back into the woods. At 10 o'clock, we set sail with the wind coming from the southeast and tacked into the wind.

[In Success Bay.]

[In Success Bay.]

Monday, 16th. A Fresh breeze of Wind at South and South-West, with frequent showers of Rain and Snow. At 2 p.m. Anchored in the Bay of Success in 9 fathoms, the bottom Owse and sand.* (* The Endeavour was three days and a half in getting through the Strait of Le Maire, as far as Success Bay. It is a difficult passage for a sailing vessel even in the present day, as the tides are strong and winds generally contrary, but experience has enabled good directions to be given as to the best way to pass the Strait. Cook himself gives capital advice farther on.) The south point of the Bay bore South-East and the north point East-North-East. This Bay I shall describe when I come to speake of the rest of the Coast. Hoisted out the Boats and moor'd with the Stream Anchor. While this was doing I went ashore accompanyed by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to look for a Watering place and to speak with the Natives, who were assembled on the Beach at the Head of the Bay to the Number of 30 or 40. They were so far from being afraid or surprised at our coming amongst them that three of them came on board without the least hesitation. They are something above the Middle size, of a Dark Copper Colour with long black hair; they paint their Bodies in Streakes, mostly Red and Black. Their Cloathing consists wholy in a Guanacoe Skin or that of a Seal, in the same form as it came from the Animal's back.

Monday, 16th. A fresh breeze coming from the south and southwest, with frequent rain and snow showers. At 2 p.m., we anchored in the Bay of Success in 9 fathoms, with the bottom being mud and sand. (*The Endeavour took three and a half days to navigate through the Strait of Le Maire to Success Bay. This passage is challenging for sailing vessels even today, as the tides are strong and the winds are usually against you, but experience has provided good guidance on the best way to pass through the Strait. Cook himself gives excellent advice later on.) The south point of the Bay was southeast and the north point was east-northeast. I will describe this Bay when I discuss the rest of the coast. We lowered the boats and moored with the stream anchor. While this was happening, I went ashore accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to look for a watering spot and to talk to the locals, who had gathered on the beach at the head of the bay, about 30 or 40 of them. They were not at all afraid or surprised by our arrival; in fact, three of them came on board without hesitation. They were slightly above average height, with a dark copper skin tone and long black hair; they painted their bodies in stripes, mostly red and black. Their clothing was made entirely from guanaco skin or seal skin, in the same form it came from the animal's back.

The Women Wear a Piece of Skin over their Privy Parts, but the Men observe no such decency. Their Hutts are made like a behive, and open on one side where they have their fires; they are made of small Sticks and covered with branches of trees, long Grass, etc., in such a manner that they are neither Proof against Wind, Hail, rain or Snow, a sufficient proof that these People must be a very hardy race. They live chiefly on shell fish, such as Muscels, which they gather from off the Rocks along the Sea Shore, and this seems to be the Work of the Women. Their Arms are Bows and Arrows neatly made; their Arrows are bearded, some with glass and others with fine flint; several Pieces of the former we saw amongst them with other European things, such as rings, Buttons, Cloth, Canvas, etc., which I think proves that they must sometimes travel to the Northward, as we know of no Ship that hath been in these parts for many Years; besides, they were not at all surprised at our Fire Arms; on the Contrary, they seemed to know the use of them, by making signs to us to fire at Seals or Birds that might come in the way. They have no Boats that we saw or anything to go upon the Water with; their number doth not Exceed 50 or 60 young and old, and there are fewer Women than Men. They are Extreamly fond of any Red thing, and seemed to set more Value on Beads than anything we could give them; in this Consists their whole Pride, few, either Men or Women, are without a Necklace or String of Beads made of Small Shells or bones about their Necks. They would not taste any strong Liquor, neither did they seem fond of our Provisions. We could not discover that they had any Head or Chief or Form of Government, neither have they any useful or necessary Utensil except it be a Bag or Basket to gather their Muscels into. In a word they are perhaps as Miserable a sett of People as are this day upon Earth.* (* Cook's description of the natives of Tierra del Fuego is good to the present day, except that those who live farther westward are still more wretched. Those of the main island, in which the Bay of Good Success lies, are able to kill guanaco, and enjoy a better climate. They, as Cook observed, never go on the water, whereas those westward practically live in canoes.) Having found a convenient place on the south side of the Bay to Wood and Water at, we set about that Work in the Morning, and Mr. Banks with a Party went into the Country to gather Plants, etc.

The women wear a piece of skin over their private parts, but the men don’t bother with any such modesty. Their huts are shaped like beehives and open on one side where they build their fires. They're constructed of small sticks and covered with branches, long grass, and other materials, making them neither protected from the wind, hail, rain, nor snow, which suggests that these people must be quite resilient. They mainly eat shellfish, like mussels, which the women gather from the rocks along the shore. Their weapons consist of neatly made bows and arrows; some arrows have glass tips while others are tipped with fine flint. We noticed several pieces of glass among them along with other European items like rings, buttons, cloth, and canvas, which suggests that they sometimes travel northward, as we know of no ships that have visited this area for many years. They weren't at all surprised by our firearms; instead, they seemed familiar with them, gesturing for us to shoot at seals or birds that might come by. We didn’t see any boats or anything for traveling on the water; their population is around 50 or 60, both young and old, with fewer women than men. They are extremely fond of anything red and seemed to value beads more than anything else we could offer. This seems to be their main pride, as few, whether men or women, go without a necklace or a string of beads made from small shells or bones around their necks. They wouldn’t try any strong liquor and didn’t seem to like our food. We couldn’t figure out if they had any leaders or form of government, nor did they have any useful tools except maybe a bag or basket to collect their mussels. In short, they are probably one of the most miserable groups of people on Earth. (*Cook's description of the natives of Tierra del Fuego remains accurate today, except those living further west are even worse off. The ones on the main island, where the Bay of Good Success is located, can hunt guanacos and experience a better climate. As Cook noted, they never go on the water, whereas those to the west essentially live in canoes.) After finding a good spot on the south side of the bay to gather wood and water, we started that work in the morning, and Mr. Banks and a group went into the countryside to gather plants and other items.

Tuesday, 17th. Fresh Gales at South-South-West and West-South-West with rain and Snow, and, of Course, very cold weather; notwithstanding we kept geting on board Wood and Water, and finished the Survey of the Bay. Mr. Banks and his Party not returning this Evening as I expected, gave me great uneasiness, as they were not prepared for Staying out the Night. However, about Noon they returned in no very Comfortable Condition, and what was still worse 2 blacks, servants to Mr. Banks, had perished in the Night with Cold. Great part of the day they landed was spent before they got through the Woods, after which they advanced so far into the Country that they were so far from being able to return that night, and with much difficulty they got to a place of Tolerable Shelter where they could make a fire: these 2 men being Intrusted with great part of the Liquor (that was for the whole party) had made too free with it, and Stupified themselves to that degree that they either could or would not Travel, but laid themselves down in a place where there was not the least thing to Shelter them from the inclemency of the night. This was about 1/4 of a Mile from where the rest took up their Quarters, and notwithstanding their repeated Endeavours, they could not get them to move one Step farther, and the bad travelling made it impossible for any one to Carry them, so that they were Obliged to leave them, and the next morning they were both found dead.

Tuesday, 17th. Strong winds from the South-South-West and West-South-West, with rain and snow, made for some very cold weather. Still, we managed to get wood and water on board and completed the survey of the bay. Mr. Banks and his group not returning that evening as I expected made me very uneasy since they weren’t prepared to spend the night outside. However, around noon, they returned in poor shape, and worse still, two of Mr. Banks's servants, who were Black, had frozen to death overnight. They spent most of the day trying to get through the woods, and after going so far into the countryside, they were too far away to return that night. Eventually, they found a spot with some shelter where they could make a fire. These two men, who were responsible for much of the liquor meant for the whole group, had overindulged and became so incapacitated that they couldn’t or wouldn’t move, and just laid down in a place with no protection from the harsh night. This was about a quarter of a mile from where the rest of the group set up camp, and despite repeated efforts, they couldn’t get them to move any further. The poor conditions made it impossible for anyone to carry them, forcing them to leave them behind, and the next morning, both were found dead.

Wednesday, 18th. All the Middle and Latter parts of this day it blow'd very strong from the South-South-West and South-West, attended with Snow, Hail and Rain, and brought such a Sea into the Bay, which rose the Surf to such a Height that no Boat could land. The same Stormy weather and Surf continued all

Wednesday, 18th. Throughout most of the day, it was very windy from the south-southwest and southwest, accompanied by snow, hail, and rain. This created such rough seas in the bay that no boat could land. The stormy weather and rough surf continued all

Thursday, 19th. All this time the Ship road very easy with her Broad side to the swell. The great Surf that always will be upon the Shore when the wind blows hard from the Southward makes Wooding and Watering tedious, notwithstanding there are great plenty of both close to high water Mark.

Thursday, 19th. All this time, the ship sailed smoothly with her broadside to the waves. The heavy surf that consistently hits the shore when the wind blows strong from the south makes collecting wood and water a hassle, even though there’s plenty of both available close to high water mark.

Friday, 20th. Moderate gales and Cloudy with frequent Showers of rain all this day. This Evening the Surf abated, and at 2 a.m. sent the People on shore to Wood and Water and cut Brooms, all of which we Completed this day. In this Service we lost our small Kedge Anchor, it having been laid off the Watering Place to ride the Long-boat by, and the Gale had broke away the Hawser and Buoy rope, and perhaps buried the Anchor in the Sand, for notwithstanding our utmost Endeavours we were not able to Hook it. Took up the Stream Anchor and made ready for Sailing.

Friday, 20th. There were moderate winds and it was cloudy with frequent rain showers throughout the day. This evening, the surf calmed down, and at 2 a.m. I sent the crew ashore to gather wood and water and to cut brooms, all of which we completed today. During this task, we lost our small kedge anchor, which had been set off the watering place to secure the longboat. The strong winds had broken the hawser and buoy rope, possibly burying the anchor in the sand, and despite our best efforts, we couldn't retrieve it. We took up the stream anchor and got ready to set sail.

[Sailed from Success Bay.]

[Sailed from Success Bay.]

Saturday, 21st. Wind from South-South-West to South-West; moderate breezes the first part; latter, fresh Gales with Showers of Rain. P.M. hoisted in the Boats, and made ready for Sailing; at 2 a.m. weighed and made Sail out of the Bay. At 1/2 past 4 the Cape of good Success bore West, and Cape Bartholomew East. Variation per Azimuth, 24 degrees 9 minutes East; at Noon the Cape of good Success bore North 36 degrees West; distance, 11 leagues.

Saturday, 21st. Wind from South-South-West to South-West; moderate breezes in the morning; later, fresh gales with rain showers. In the afternoon, we hoisted the boats and got ready to set sail; at 2 a.m., we weighed anchor and left the bay. At 4:30 a.m., the Cape of Good Success was to the west, and Cape Bartholomew was to the east. Variation according to azimuth was 24 degrees 9 minutes east; at noon, the Cape of Good Success was at North 36 degrees West; distance covered, 11 leagues.

Sunday, 22nd. Wind between the South and the West first and Latter part, fresh Gales and Squally, with rain; the Middle, little wind and rain. A.M. found the Variation by several Azimuths to be 20 degrees 4 minutes East. Unbent the Cables and Stowed the Anchors. At Noon, Latitude observed 56 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude, made from the Cape of Good Success, 42 minutes East.

Sunday, 22nd. The wind was blowing between the South and the West at first, and later it picked up with fresh gales and squalls, along with some rain; in the middle of the day, there was little wind and some rain. In the morning, we determined the variation by several azimuths to be 20 degrees 4 minutes East. We unbent the cables and stored the anchors. At noon, the latitude observed was 56 degrees 7 minutes South, and the longitude calculated from the Cape of Good Success was 42 minutes East.

Monday, 23rd. Winds variable from South-East round by the South-West to North-West. First part, a fresh breeze and Squally, the remainder moderate breezes and sometimes Calm and clear weather, which is more than we have had for several days past. At 4 a.m. saw the Land in the South-West Quarter, and a small Island bearing West; from this Time until 9 it was Calm, at which time the Ship drove very fast to the North-East by North. At 9 Sprung up a light breeze at North, loos'd all the Reefs out, and set the Steering sails. The Cape of good Success bore North-East by North; Staten land seen from the Deck bearing North-East; the Sugar Loaf on Terra Del Fuego North-North-East, and is the same Hill as is seen from the North-East side of the Land; it appears to stand but a little way in Land from the Shore; and the Mainland and Islands on the Coast extending from the Cape of good Success to the South by West. The Country Mountainous, of an indifferent height; the Tops were covered with Snow, which had lately fell, as it did not lay long. There appeared to be several Bays and inlets and Islands laying along the Coast; the 3rd view in the Chart exhibits the appearance of this Coast where g is new Island, c the Sugar Loaf, and h the Cape of good Success. At noon the West End of New Island bore North-West by West, 5 leagues. Latitude observed 55 degrees 25 minutes South, this Island I named New Island because it is not laid down in any Chart.* (* This island is still so called in the charts.)

Monday, 23rd. The winds were variable, shifting from the Southeast to the Southwest and then to the Northwest. In the morning, there was a fresh breeze and squally conditions, but later it turned into moderate breezes and sometimes calm, clear weather, which is more than we've had for several days. At 4 a.m., I spotted land in the southwest and a small island to the west; from that moment until 9, it was calm, during which the ship drifted quickly to the northeast. At 9, a light breeze picked up from the north, so I loosened all the reefs and set the steering sails. The Cape of Good Success was to the northeast; Staten Land was visible from the deck to the northeast; the Sugar Loaf on Terra del Fuego was northeast-north and is the same hill seen from the northeast side of the land; it looks like it’s only a short distance inland from the shore. The mainland and islands along the coast stretch from the Cape of Good Success to the south-southwest. The landscape is mountainous but of medium height; the peaks were covered in snow that had recently fallen, as it didn’t stay long. There seemed to be several bays, inlets, and islands along the coast; the 3rd view in the chart shows what this coast looks like, where g marks the new island, c indicates the Sugar Loaf, and h represents the Cape of Good Success. By noon, the west end of New Island was northwest by west, 5 leagues away. Latitude was recorded at 55 degrees 25 minutes south; I named this island New Island because it doesn’t appear on any charts.* (* This island is still referred to as New Island on the charts.)

Tuesday, 24th. The fore and Middle parts of these 24 Hours Moderate Gales and Cloudy with some Showers of Rain; the Latter, fresh gales with flying Showers. At 7 p.m. New Island bore North-West by North, and a small Island laying to the Westward of it bore West by North. Variation per Several Azimuths 21 degrees 0 minutes East, which is much less than we have yet found it upon this Coast; yet I am satisfied with the Goodness of the Observations. At 1/2 past 1 a.m. the Wind Shifted from South-South-West to East-South-East. Tackt and stood South-West; at 6 Saw the Land to the Westward making like several Islands. At 8 two Small Islands laying off a low Point of Land bore West by South, distant 3 Leagues, and the small Island we saw last night bore North-North-West. This I take to be the Island of Evouts, it is about one League in Circuit, and of a Moderate height and lies 4 Leagues from the Main. Near the South Point of it are some Peaked rocks pretty high above Water; the wind coming to the Southward we did but just weather this Island; in passing it, sounded and had 40 fathoms Water, sand, and broken Shells. At Noon it bore North-East distance one League, and the low point of land before mentioned South 17 degrees West distant 4 or 5 Leagues. Tackt and Stood to the South-East, wind at South-South-West. From this low Point the land trends to the North-West, about 4 Leagues, where it ends in a low point round which to the Westward appears to be a Deep Bay, unless this land should prove to be an Island or Islands, which is most likely. It rises into high Craggy hills, and the Shore seems to form several Bays; if so, they must afford good Shelter for Shipping against Southerly and Westerly winds.

Tuesday, the 24th. The first part of the day had moderate winds and cloudy skies with some rain showers; the latter part brought fresh winds with occasional showers. At 7 p.m., New Island was located to the North-West by North, and a small island to the West of it was situated to the West by North. The variation recorded from several azimuths was 21 degrees 0 minutes East, which is much less than we’ve observed anywhere else along this coast; however, I’m confident in the accuracy of the observations. At 1:30 a.m., the wind shifted from South-South-West to East-South-East. We tacked and headed South-West; at 6, we spotted land to the West that appeared to be several islands. At 8, we saw two small islands off a low point of land located West by South, about 3 leagues away, and the small island we observed last night was North-North-West. I believe this to be the island of Evouts; it’s roughly one league around, moderately high, and lies 4 leagues from the mainland. Near its southern point, there are some peaked rocks that rise significantly above the water. As the wind came from the south, we just managed to pass around this island; while passing it, we took soundings and found 40 fathoms of water, with sand and broken shells. At noon, the island was North-East, one league away, and the low point of land we mentioned before was South 17 degrees West, about 4 or 5 leagues distant. We tacked and headed South-East, with the wind at South-South-West. From this low point, the land trends North-West for about 4 leagues, where it ends at a low point. Around this point, to the West, appears to be a deep bay, unless the land turns out to be an island or islands, which seems likely. It rises into high, craggy hills, and the shore appears to form several bays; if that’s the case, they would provide good shelter for ships against southern and western winds.

[Off Cape Horn.]

[Off Cape Horn.]

Wednesday, 25th. Winds from the South to the West-North-West, the first part fresh Gales and Squally with some Rain; Middle, little wind with Hail and Rain; latter, fresh Gales and Hazey, with Showers of Rain. At 8 p.m. the Island of Evouts North-West, distant 3 or 4 miles. Variation, per morning Amplitude 21 degrees 16 minutes East. At 8 a.m. the Southermost low point of land seen Yesterday Bore South 74 degrees West, and a remarkable Peaked Hill to the Southward of it South-West; and soon after we discovered that the land which we took Yesterday to be a part of the Main or an Island, was three Islands, which I take to be Hermites. At Noon the South Point of the Southermost Island bore North-West by West distant 3 leagues, having then 58 fathoms Peble Stones. This Point is pretty high and consists of Peaked Craggy rocks, and not far from it lay several others high above Water. It lies in the Latitude of 55 degrees 53 minutes South and South-West 26 Leagues from Straits La Mair, and by some on board thought to be Cape Horn; but I was of another Opinion, and with good reason, because we saw land to the Southward of it about 3 or 4 leagues. It appeared not unlike an Island with a very high round Hummock upon it; this I believe to be Cape Horn, for after we had stood about 3 Leagues the weather cleared up for about a quarter of an hour, which gave us a sight of the land bearing West-South-West, but we could see no land to the southward or Westward of it, and therefore conclude that it must be the Cape, but whether it be an Island of itself, a part of the Southermost of Hermits Islands, or a part of Terra del Fuego, I am not able to determine. However, this is of very little Consequence to Navigation: I only wished to be Certain whether or no it was the Southermost Land on or near to Terra del Fuego; but the thick foggy weather and the westerly winds which Carried us from the land prevented me from satisfying my Curiosity in this point, but from its Latitude and the reasons before given I think it must, and if so it must be Cape Horn, and lies in the latitude of 55 degrees 53 minutes South and Longitude 68 degrees 13 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich,* (* No doubt this was Cape Horn, but it lies in 55 degrees 58 minutes South, 67 degrees 16 minutes West.) being the Mean result of Several Observations of the sun and moon made the day after we left the land, and which agreed with those made at Straits Le Mair, allowing for the distance between one place and the other, which I found means very accurately to determine. As we are now about taking our departure from the Land, which we are not likely to fall in with again, I shall give a more full Description of such parts of the Coasts of Terra del Fuego as hath fallen under my inspection.

Wednesday, 25th. Winds from the South to the West-North-West, initially fresh gales and squally conditions with some rain; in the middle, little wind with hail and rain; later, fresh gales and hazy skies with rain showers. At 8 p.m. the Island of Evouts was to the North-West, about 3 or 4 miles away. Variation, based on the morning amplitude, 21 degrees 16 minutes East. At 8 a.m. the southernmost low point of land seen yesterday bore South 74 degrees West, with a remarkable peaked hill to the South-West of it; soon after, we realized that the land we thought was part of the mainland or an island was actually three islands, which I believe to be the Hermite Islands. At noon, the southern point of the southernmost island was located North-West by West, 3 leagues away, with a depth of 58 fathoms of pebble stones. This point is quite high and consists of jagged, craggy rocks, with several other high formations not far from it. It lies at a latitude of 55 degrees 53 minutes South and is 26 leagues South-West from the Straits of La Mair, which some on board thought to be Cape Horn; however, I disagreed for good reason, as we saw land to the South about 3 or 4 leagues away. It looked somewhat like an island with a very high round hill on it; I believe this to be Cape Horn. After traveling about 3 leagues, the weather cleared up for about a quarter of an hour, allowing us to see the land bearing West-South-West, but we couldn't see any land to the south or west of it, leading me to conclude that it must be the cape. I cannot determine whether it is an island by itself, part of the southernmost Hermite Islands, or a part of Tierra del Fuego. Nevertheless, this is of little consequence to navigation; I only wished to confirm whether it was the southernmost land on or near Tierra del Fuego. However, the thick foggy weather and westerly winds that carried us away from the land prevented me from satisfying my curiosity on this point. But based on its latitude and the reasons given earlier, I believe it must be Cape Horn, which lies at 55 degrees 53 minutes South and 68 degrees 13 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich,* (* No doubt this was Cape Horn, but it lies at 55 degrees 58 minutes South, 67 degrees 16 minutes West.) determined by averaging several observations of the sun and moon taken the day after we left the land, which agreed with those made at the Straits of La Mair, adjusting for the distance between the two places, which I found to be very accurate. As we are about to depart from the land, which we are unlikely to encounter again, I will provide a more detailed description of the parts of the coast of Tierra del Fuego that I have observed.

We fell in with this Coast 21 Leagues to the Westward of Straits Le Mair, and ranged the coast from thence to the Strait within 2 or 3 Leagues of the Land, and had soundings all the way from 40 to 20 fathoms, a Gravelly and Sandy Bottom. The land near the Shore is in general low but hilly, the face of the Country appears Green and Woody, but in land are Craggy Mountains; they appeared to be of no great height, nor were they Covered with Snow. The most remarkable land on Terra Del Fuego is a high Mountain in form of a Sugar Loaf, situated not far from the sea on the South-West side of the Land, and 3 hills called the 3 Brothers. They lay near the Shore and nine Miles to the Westward of Cape St. Diego, which is a low point that forms the North-West Entrance of Strait Le Mair, and are Contiguous to Each other. The Sugar Loaf lies from these Hills South-South-West, and when it was in this situation the Appearances of the Land is represented in the first View in the Chart, but it must be observed that from this point of View the Three Brothers appear far more Conspicuous than from any other; these land Marks are by some Voyagers thought very necessary to know Strait Le Mair by, but whoever coasts Terra Del Fuego within sight of land cannot possibly miss the Strait, it being of itself so very Conspicuous; and Staten Land, which forms the East side, is still more so from its very rugged appearance. One League and a half to the Westward of Cape St. Diego lies Cape St. Vincent, between these two Capes lies Vincent's Bay,* (* Now called Thetis Bay, it is a very poor anchorage.) a Small Cove wherein is Wood and Water, and before which a Ship might Anchor with a Southerly or South-West wind, but the ground is none of the best, unless you go into the very Mouth of the Cove, which is on the East side of the first Bluff point from Cape St. Vincent, where there is Anchorage in 4 fathoms, a Sandy Bottom. In going in keep clear of the Sea Weed, and send a Boat Ahead to sound, and at best this is but a bad place for Shipping, and only recommended to such as are in want of Wood and Water, and have no Opportunity to put into the Strait, which in Prudence ought not to be attempted but with a fair wind or Moderate weather, and upon the very first of the Tide of Flood, which hapens here at the full and Change of the Moon about 1 or 2 o'clock, and then to keep as near to Terra Del Fuego Shore as the winds will permit. By using these Precautions you will be sure of either getting quite through the Straits in one Tide or to the Southward of Success Bay; and it may be more Prudent to put in there should the wind be Southerly, than to attempt to weather Staten Land with a Lee Wind and Current, for I believe this to be the Chief reason why Ships have run a Risk of being drove on that Island.

We sailed with this Coast 21 leagues west of the Strait Le Maire and followed the coastline from there to the Strait, staying about 2 or 3 leagues from the land. We found depths ranging from 40 to 20 fathoms, with a bottom of gravel and sand. The land close to the shore is generally low but hilly, with green and wooded areas, while further inland are rugged mountains that don’t seem very tall and aren’t covered in snow. The most notable feature in Tierra del Fuego is a tall mountain shaped like a sugar loaf, located not far from the sea on the southwest side of the land, along with three hills referred to as the Three Brothers. These hills are close to each other and about nine miles west of Cape St. Diego, which is a low point that marks the northwest entrance to the Strait Le Maire. The sugar loaf is south-southwest from these hills, and in this position, the landscape is shown in the first view on the chart. However, it should be noted that from this viewpoint, the Three Brothers look much more prominent than from anywhere else. Some sailors believe these landmarks are essential for navigating the Strait Le Maire, but anyone sailing along Tierra del Fuego within sight of land can't miss the Strait since it's very noticeable. Staten Land, which forms the eastern side, is even more apparent due to its rugged features. A mile and a half west of Cape St. Diego is Cape St. Vincent. Between these two capes is Vincent’s Bay,* (*Now called Thetis Bay, it’s not a great anchorage.) a small cove with wood and water, where a ship could anchor with a southerly or southwest wind, though the ground isn’t ideal unless you go right into the cove’s entrance, located on the east side of the first bluff point from Cape St. Vincent, where there’s anchorage in 4 fathoms with a sandy bottom. When entering, avoid the seaweed and send a boat ahead to sound the depth. Overall, this is not a good place for shipping and should only be recommended to those in need of wood and water who can't make it into the Strait. This should ideally be attempted only in fair winds or moderate weather, and at the very start of the flood tide, which occurs here during the full and new moons around 1 or 2 o'clock. Once you enter, stay as close to the shore of Tierra del Fuego as the winds allow. By taking these precautions, you should either make it through the Straits within one tide or end up south of Success Bay. It might be wiser to head in there if the wind is southerly rather than trying to go around Staten Land with the wind and current working against you, as I believe this is the main reason why ships have risked being pushed onto that island.

Strait Le Maire is formed on the West by part of Terra Del Fuego, and on the East by the West end of Staten Land or Island; its Length and Breadth is about 5 Leagues each; about the Middle of the Strait is Success Bay, on Terra Del Fuego side, and about a 1/4 of a League more to the Northwards is Port Maurice, a little Cove, before which we Anchored in 12 fathoms.

Strait Le Maire is bordered on the West by part of Tierra del Fuego and on the East by the western edge of Staten Island. It's about 5 leagues long and wide. In the middle of the strait is Success Bay on the Tierra del Fuego side, and about a quarter of a league further north is Port Maurice, a small cove where we anchored in 12 fathoms.

[Description of Strait of Le Maire.]

[Description of Strait of Le Maire.]

The Bay of Success is discovered immediately upon entring the Strait from the Northward; there is likewise a good Land Mark near the South head to know it by, which is a Mark on the land like a lane or broad road leading up from the Sea into the Country; this Bay is 1/2 a League Wide at the Entrance, and lies in West 2 1/2 Miles, and hath good Anchorage in every part of it, in 10, 8, and 7 fathoms clear ground, and affords plenty of exceeding good Wood and Water. The Wood is of the Birch kind, but of a diffrent Quality to that in England or North America; here are likewise of the Winter Bark tree and some few others, Wild Selary, some Berrys like Cranberrys, but growing on Bushes, very few Wild Fowls of any Sort, and no Fish Except Shell Fish, such as Muscels, Limpets, etc.; and what we saw of the interior parts of the Country is still more barren of the necessaries of Life than the Sea. The few days we stay'd here we had constant bad weather, the Winds from the South-West and West-South-West with rain, Hail and Snow. Snow generally fell on the Hills everywhere with these winds when we had rain in the Bay or upon the Sea Coast. I observed the same in respect to Staten Land, but as it never froze it did not lay long; yet it must render the Country Cold and barren, and unfit for Cultivation. The Tides in Success Bay flows at the full and Change of the Moon, about 4 or 5 o'Clock, and riseth between 5 and 6 feet Perpendicular, but in the Strait the flood runs 2 or 3 Hours longer, and there the Ebb or Southerly Current runs near Double the strength of the Flood or Northerly Current.

The Bay of Success is found right after entering the Strait from the north. There's also a useful landmark near the south head that looks like a lane or wide road leading from the sea into the land. This bay is half a league wide at the entrance and extends westward for 2.5 miles, offering excellent anchorage everywhere in depths of 10, 8, and 7 fathoms with clear ground, plus there's plenty of great wood and fresh water. The wood is of the birch variety but differs from what's found in England or North America. There's also winter bark and a few other trees, wild celery, some berries like cranberries that grow on bushes, very few wild birds, and no fish except for shellfish like mussels and limpets. What we saw of the country inland looked even less promising for the essentials of life than the sea. During the few days we stayed here, we faced constant bad weather, with winds from the southwest and west-southwest bringing rain, hail, and snow. Snow usually fell on the hills with these winds whenever it rained in the bay or along the coast. I noticed the same thing in Staten Land, although it didn’t stay long since it never froze. Still, it makes the country cold, barren, and unsuitable for farming. The tides in Success Bay rise at the full and new moons, around 4 or 5 o'clock, by about 5 to 6 feet vertically. However, in the Strait, the flood lasts 2 or 3 hours longer, and the ebb or southerly current is nearly twice as strong as the flood or northerly current.

Staten Island lies nearest East and West, and from what I could see and judge of it may be about 12 Leagues in length and 5 in breadth. On the North side are the appearances of Bays or Harbours, and the land is not destitute of Wood and Verdure, nor covered with Snow any more than Terra del Fuego.

Staten Island is located towards the east and west, and from what I could see and assess, it seems to be about 12 leagues long and 5 leagues wide. On the north side, there are signs of bays or harbors, and the land isn't lacking in trees and greenery, nor is it covered in snow any more than Tierra del Fuego.

On the South-West side of the Cape of good Success (which forms the South-West entrance of Strait Le Mair, and is known by some rocks off it) lies Valentine's Bay, the entrance of which we only saw. From this Bay the land Trends to the West-South-West; for 20 or 30 Leagues it appears High and Mountainous, and forms several Bays and inlets South-West 1/2 South 14 Leagues from the Cape of good Success, and 2 or 3 Leagues from the Shore lies New Island; it is 2 leagues in length, North-East and South-West, the North-East end is terminated by a remarkable Hillock. South-West 7 Leagues from New Island lies the Isle Evouts, and South, a little Westerly from this island, lies Barnevelts, two small flatt Islands close to each other; they are partly Environ'd with rocks of Different height above water, and lay South-West 24 leagues from Strait le Mair. From Barnevelts Island to the South-East point of Hermites island is South-West by South, distance 3 Leagues. These Islands lay South-East and North-West, and are pretty high, and will, from most points of view, be taken for one Island or a part of the Main; from the South-East point of Hermites Isles to Cape Horn, the Course is South-West by South, distance 3 Leagues. The Appearance of this Cape and Hermites Islands is represented in the last View in the chart which I have drawn of this Coast from our first making the land unto Cape Horn, in which is included Strait Le Mair and part of Staten Land. In this chart I have laid down no land nor figured out any Shore, but what I saw myself and thus far the Chart may be depended upon. The Bays and inlets are left voide, the openings of which we only see from the Ship. It cannot be doubted but what there is Anchorage, Wood and Water in those Bays, and it must have been in some of them that the Dutch Squadron commanded by Hermites put into in the year 1624. It was the Vice Admiral Chapenham, of this Squadron, who first discovered that the land of Cape Horn was consisted of a Number of Islands, but the account they have given of those parts is very short and imperfect, and that of Schouton and Le Maire still worse, that it is no wonder that the Charts hitherto published should be found incorrect, not only in laying down the Land, but in the Latitude and Longitude of the places they contain, but I can now venture to Assert that the Longitude of few parts of the World are better Ascertained than that of Strait Le Maire and Cape Horn, being determined by several Observations of the Sun and moon made both by myself and Mr. Green, the Astronomer.

On the southwest side of the Cape of Good Success (which marks the southwest entrance of the Strait Le Maire and is recognized by some rocks nearby) lies Valentine's Bay, which we could only glimpse the entrance of. From this bay, the land stretches west-southwest for about 20 to 30 leagues; it appears high and mountainous and features several bays and inlets southwest, 14 leagues from the Cape of Good Success. Two or three leagues from the shore lies New Island; it is 2 leagues long, running northeast and southwest, with a distinctive hill at its northeast end. Seven leagues southwest of New Island is Isle Evouts, and a little to the south and west of this island lies Barnevelts, which consists of two small flat islands close together; they are partially surrounded by rocks of varying heights above water and are located 24 leagues southwest from Strait Le Maire. The distance from Barnevelts Island to the southeast point of Hermites Island is 3 leagues, heading southwest by south. These islands are oriented southeast and northwest, and are relatively high; from most viewpoints, they will look like one island or a section of the mainland. The course from the southeast point of Hermites Isles to Cape Horn is also southwest by south, covering a distance of 3 leagues. The appearance of this cape and the Hermites Islands is depicted in the last view in the chart I created of this coastline from when we first spotted land up to Cape Horn, which includes Strait Le Maire and part of Staten Land. In this chart, I have not depicted any land or shorelines except for what I personally observed, so the chart can be relied upon thus far. The bays and inlets are left blank, as we only see their openings from the ship. There’s no doubt that there is anchorage, wood, and water in those bays, and it must have been in some of them that the Dutch Squadron commanded by Hermites took refuge in 1624. It was Vice Admiral Chapenham from this squadron who first discovered that the land of Cape Horn consists of multiple islands, but their account of those areas is very brief and incomplete, while the descriptions by Schouton and Le Maire are even worse. It's not surprising that the charts published up to now have been found inaccurate, not only in mapping the land, but also in the latitude and longitude of the locations they include. However, I can now confidently say that few parts of the world have their longitude as accurately determined as that of Strait Le Maire and Cape Horn, based on several observations of the sun and moon made by both myself and Mr. Green, the astronomer.

We found the Variation of the Compass on this Coast to be from 23 to 25 degrees east, except near Barnevelts Islands and Cape Horn, where we found it less and unsettled; it is likely that it is here disturbed by the land, as the Dutch Squadron before mentioned found in this very place all their Compasses to differ from each other. The declination of the South point of the Dipping Needle when set up ashore in Success Bay was 68 degrees 15 minutes below the horizon. Between Strait Le Maire and Cape Horn we found a Current setting generally pretty strong to the North-East when we were in with the Shore, but when 15 or 20 Leagues off we were not sencible of any.

We found that the magnetic variation on this coast ranges from 23 to 25 degrees east, except near Barnevelts Islands and Cape Horn, where it was less stable; it's likely that the presence of land is disrupting it, as the Dutch squadron noted that all their compasses differed in this exact location. The declination of the southern point of the dipping needle, when set up on shore in Success Bay, was 68 degrees 15 minutes below the horizon. Between Strait Le Maire and Cape Horn, we noticed a strong current generally flowing to the northeast when we were close to the shore, but when we were 15 or 20 leagues out, we didn’t feel any current.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES IN JANUARY 1769. SOUTH SEAS.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES IN JANUARY 1769. SOUTH SEAS.

[Off Cape Horn.]

[Off Cape Horn.]

Thursday, 26th. Fresh Gales and thick Hazey weather, with small rain. At 2 p.m., the weather clearing up a little, saw Cape Horn bearing West-South-West, distance about 6 leagues, and from which I take my departure. Its Latitude and Longitude have before been taken notice of. Wind South-West by West to West-North-West; course South 15 degrees West; distance, 63 miles; latitude 56 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 68 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, Cape Horn North, 58 miles.

Thursday, 26th. Fresh winds and thick, hazy weather, with light rain. At 2 p.m., the weather cleared up a bit, and I spotted Cape Horn to the West-South-West, about 6 leagues away, from which I set out. Its latitude and longitude have been noted before. Wind is from the South-West by West to West-North-West; heading South 15 degrees West; distance traveled is 63 miles; latitude 56 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 68 degrees 13 minutes West; at noon, Cape Horn was 58 miles to the North.

Friday, 27th. First part, moderate breezes and thick Hazey weather; the Middle, fair and Cloudy; and the Latter, fresh Gales with some rain. At 8 a.m. took two Setts of Observations of the sun and moon; the first gave 68 degrees 15 minutes; the second, 68 degrees 9 minutes; the Mean of the 2 is 68 degrees 12 minutes West. The Longitude of the Ship at Noon by these Observations is 68 degrees 42 minutes less 14 minutes, the Longitude made from Cape Horn, equal to 68 degrees 28 minutes, the longitude of Cape Horn according to the Observation. A Great many large Albetrosses about the Ship. Wind, South-West, West and North; course, South and West; distance, 32 miles; latitude 57 degrees 2 minutes South, longitude 68 degrees 27 minutes West.

Friday, 27th. In the morning, there were moderate breezes and thick hazy weather; in the middle of the day, it was fair and cloudy; and in the afternoon, there were fresh gales with some rain. At 8 a.m., I took two sets of observations of the sun and moon; the first showed 68 degrees 15 minutes and the second showed 68 degrees 9 minutes; the average of the two is 68 degrees 12 minutes West. By these observations, the ship's longitude at noon is 68 degrees 42 minutes minus 14 minutes, making the longitude from Cape Horn equal to 68 degrees 28 minutes, which is the longitude of Cape Horn based on the observation. There are a lot of large albatrosses around the ship. The wind is coming from the South-West, West, and North; the course is South and West; the distance traveled is 32 miles; the latitude is 57 degrees 2 minutes South, and the longitude is 68 degrees 27 minutes West.

Saturday, 28th. Fresh Gales the most part of this day; first and Middle parts cloudy; latter, clear with a Sharp cold air. At 2 p.m. saw the land, bearing North, distant about 8 Leagues; it made in 2 Hummocks, and appeared to be an Island, which I take to be the Isle of Diego Ramirez. It lays in the Latitude of 56 degrees 38 minutes South and Longitude 68 degrees 47 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* Diego Ramirez is in 56 degrees 31 minutes South, 68 degrees 43 minutes West.) Found the Variation this Evening to be 22 degrees East. A.M. had 3 sets of Observations of the sun and moon, which gave the Longitude 69 degrees 7 minutes 15 seconds West. The Longitude of the Ship at Noon by the Observation is 69 degrees 24 minutes, from which take 1 degree 48 minutes, the longitude made from Cape Horn, the remainder is 67 degrees 36 minutes, the Longitude of the Cape, which is 52 minutes less than the result of Yesterday's Observations.* (* This was the best observation.) This difference may arise partly from the Observations and partly from the Ship's runs; the mean of the 2 gives 68 degrees 2 minutes and 68 degrees 24 minutes, the Longitude of the Cape from the Observations taken at Strait Maire 136 degrees 26 minutes/2 = 68 degrees 13 minutes West from Greenwich. The Longitude of Cape Horn being deduced from no less than 24 Observations taken at no very great distance from the Cape, and on both sides of it, and when the Sun was both to the East and West of the Moon; for in this case the Errors arising from the Observations are most likely to Correct one another. Wind, North and West by North to North-West by West; course, South 39 degrees West; distance, 80 miles; latitude 58 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 70 degrees 1 minute West.

Saturday, 28th. Strong winds for most of the day; cloudy in the morning and middle parts, clear with a sharp cold breeze later. At 2 p.m., I spotted land straight ahead, about 8 leagues away to the north. It appeared as two humps and looked like an island, which I believe is the Isle of Diego Ramirez. It's located at a latitude of 56 degrees 38 minutes South and a longitude of 68 degrees 47 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* Diego Ramirez is at 56 degrees 31 minutes South, 68 degrees 43 minutes West.) This evening, I found the variation to be 22 degrees East. In the morning, I took 3 sets of observations of the sun and moon, which gave a longitude of 69 degrees 7 minutes 15 seconds West. The ship's longitude at noon, according to my observations, is 69 degrees 24 minutes. Subtracting 1 degree 48 minutes for the longitude made from Cape Horn leaves 67 degrees 36 minutes, the longitude of the cape, which is 52 minutes less than yesterday's observations.* (* This was the best observation.) This difference could be due to the observations and the ship's travel. The average of the two gives 68 degrees 2 minutes and 68 degrees 24 minutes for the cape’s longitude based on the observations taken at Strait Maire, which averages to 68 degrees 13 minutes West from Greenwich. The longitude of Cape Horn is based on no fewer than 24 observations taken from a short distance around the cape and when the sun was both to the east and west of the moon, as this tends to correct the errors from the observations. Wind direction was North and Northwest by North to Northwest by West; course was South 39 degrees West; distance traveled was 80 miles; current latitude is 58 degrees 4 minutes South, and longitude is 70 degrees 1 minute West.

Sunday, 29th. First and Latter parts, fresh Gales and Squally, with flying Showers of rain and Hail; the Middle, strong Gales with heavy Squalls and showers of rain. At 8 p.m. took 2nd Reef Topsails, at 6 a.m. Close reefd the Foretopsails and took in the Mizen Topsl, and at 10 set it again and let the reef out of the Fore top-sails. Wind, West Northerly; course South-West; distance, 79 miles; latitude 59 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 72 degrees 48 minutes West.

Sunday, 29th. First and later parts, fresh winds and squally conditions, with intermittent showers of rain and hail; in the middle part, strong winds with heavy squalls and rain showers. At 8 p.m., we took in the 2nd reef on the topsails, and at 6 a.m., we closely reefed the foretopsails and took in the mizen topsail. By 10, we set it again and let out the reef on the foretopsails. Wind direction was from the west-northwest; course was southwest; distance traveled was 79 miles; latitude was 59 degrees 0 minutes south, and longitude was 72 degrees 48 minutes west.

Monday, 30th. Fore part, fresh Gales and Squally with Hail and rain, remainder moderate and Cloudy. At 6 a.m. loosed the 2nd reef out of the Topsails and set Top-gallant Sails. At 11 Longitude per 3 sets of Observations of the sun and moon, 1st set 73 degrees 38 minutes 15 seconds; second set 73 degrees 25 minutes 45 seconds; and 3rd, 73 degrees 19 minutes 30 seconds; the mean of the whole is 73 degrees 27 minutes 50 seconds West, and 35 minutes less than the Longitude by Dead reckoning, which is only 6 Leagues in this Latitude, and therefore not worth taking notice of. Latitude per Observation 60 degrees 4 minutes South. Wind West by North and West-North-West; course, South 33 degrees West; distance, 76 miles; latitude 60 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 74 degrees 10 minutes West.

Monday, 30th. In the morning, there were strong winds and squalls with hail and rain; the rest of the day was moderate and cloudy. At 6 a.m., I released the second reef from the topsails and set the top-gallant sails. By 11 a.m., using three sets of observations of the sun and moon, I recorded the following longitudes: first set 73 degrees 38 minutes 15 seconds; second set 73 degrees 25 minutes 45 seconds; and third set 73 degrees 19 minutes 30 seconds. The average of these is 73 degrees 27 minutes 50 seconds West, which is 35 minutes less than the longitude from dead reckoning, only 6 leagues in this latitude, so it's not worth noting. The latitude from observation is 60 degrees 4 minutes South. The wind is from the West by North and West-North-West; course, South 33 degrees West; distance, 76 miles; latitude 60 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 74 degrees 10 minutes West.

Tuesday, 31st. First part moderate and Cloudy, with some rain; in the night, little wind and Calm; towards Noon, fresh Gales and Cloudy. Between 7 and 8 p.m., being then in the Latitude of 60 degrees 10 minutes, which was the farthest south we were, and in the Longitude of 74 degrees 30 minutes found the Variation of the Compass by the mean of Azimuth to be 27 degrees 9 minutes East. At 3 a.m. wind at East-South-East, and Moderate breeze. Set the Steeringsails, and soon after 2 Birds like Penguins were seen by the Mate of the Watch. Wind West-North-West, calm, East-South-East, South-South-East; course North 71 degrees West; distance, 55 miles; latitude 59 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 75 degrees 54 minutes West.

Tuesday, 31st. The first part of the day was moderate and cloudy, with some rain; at night, there was little wind and calm. By noon, there were fresh gales and it remained cloudy. Between 7 and 8 p.m., while we were at a latitude of 60 degrees 10 minutes, which was the furthest south we reached, and a longitude of 74 degrees 30 minutes, the compass variation was measured by the average of azimuth to be 27 degrees 9 minutes East. At 3 a.m., the wind was coming from the East-South-East with a moderate breeze. We set the steeringsails, and shortly after, the mate of the watch spotted two birds resembling penguins. The wind was blowing from the West-North-West, calm, then from the East-South-East and South-South-East; our course was North 71 degrees West; distance was 55 miles; latitude 59 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 75 degrees 54 minutes West.

[February 1769.]

[February 1769.]

Wednesday, February 1st. First part, fresh Gales; latter, light Airs and Cloudy; P.M. found the Variation by several Azimuth to be 24 degrees 53 minutes East. At Noon sounded, but had no ground with 240 fathoms of line; hoisted a Boat out to try if there was any Current, but found none. The weather was such as to admit Mr. Banks to row round the Ship in a Lighterman's Skiff shooting birds. Wind, South-East by East, South-South-East, East; course, North-West by West; distance, 106 miles; latitude 58 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 78 degrees 42 minutes West.

Wednesday, February 1st. In the morning, there were strong winds; in the afternoon, it was lightly breezy and cloudy. At 12 PM, I checked the magnetic variation using several azimuths and found it to be 24 degrees 53 minutes East. At noon, I sounded the depths but couldn't find the bottom with 240 fathoms of line; I launched a boat to see if there was any current, but found none. The weather was nice enough for Mr. Banks to row around the ship in a small skiff and shoot birds. The wind was coming from the South-East by East, South-South-East, and East; our course was North-West by West; we covered a distance of 106 miles; latitude 58 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 78 degrees 42 minutes West.

Thursday, 2nd. First part, light breezes and Cloudy; remainder, sometimes a fresh breeze and at other times little wind and hazey, rainy, Cold weather. Took in the Steeringsls and a reef in each Topsail. Wind variable, North-North-West, South-West and South; course, West by North; distance, 82 miles; latitude 58 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 80 degrees 58 minutes West.

Thursday, 2nd. In the morning, there were light breezes and cloudy skies; later, at times a fresh breeze, but often little wind with hazy, rainy, and cold weather. We took in the steering sails and put a reef in each topsail. The wind was variable, coming from North-North-West, South-West, and South; we were heading West by North; covered a distance of 82 miles; our latitude was 58 degrees 30 minutes South, and our longitude was 80 degrees 58 minutes West.

Friday, 3rd. Calm and Light Airs, and for the most part Cloudy and sometimes drizling rain. Variation 24 degrees 4 minutes East. Wind, West by North, North-West by West; course South 82 West; distance 30 miles; latitude 58 degrees 33 minutes South, longitude 81 degrees 55 minutes West.

Friday, 3rd. Peaceful with light breezes, mostly cloudy, and occasionally drizzling rain. Variation 24 degrees 4 minutes East. Wind coming from the West by North, North-West by West; heading South 82 West; covered a distance of 30 miles; latitude 58 degrees 33 minutes South, longitude 81 degrees 55 minutes West.

Saturday, 4th. Fore and Middle parts, little wind and dark cloudy weather; latter, fresh Gales and Cloudy with some rain. P.M. had a Boat out and Shott several sorts of Birds, one of which was an Albetross as large as a Goose, whose wings when Extended measured 10 feet 2 inches; this was grey, but there are of them all White except the very tip end of their Wings. Another sort, in size between an Albetross and a large Gull, of a grey Colour, with a white Spot above their Tail about the Breadth of one's hand, and several other sorts. Wind Westerly; course North 13 degrees West; distance 48 miles; latitude 57 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 16 minutes West.

Saturday, 4th. In the morning and early afternoon, there was little wind and dark, cloudy weather; later, fresh gales and cloudy skies with some rain. In the afternoon, I took a boat out and shot several kinds of birds, one of which was an albatross as large as a goose, whose wings, when fully extended, measured 10 feet 2 inches. This one was gray, but there are all-white ones except for the very tips of their wings. I also saw another type, which was between the size of an albatross and a large gull, gray in color with a white spot above its tail about the width of a hand, along with several other types. The wind was coming from the west; we were heading north 13 degrees west; traveled 48 miles; latitude 57 degrees 45 minutes south, longitude 82 degrees 16 minutes west.

Sunday, 5th. Fresh gales with heavy squalls the first part; remainder, little wind and Cloudy. Very cold weather. Wind, West-South-West, West by North and South-West by West; course North; distance 49 miles; latitude 56 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 16 minutes West.

Sunday, 5th. Strong winds with heavy squalls in the beginning; for the rest of the time, light winds and cloudy. It was very cold. Wind direction: West-Southwest, West by North, and Southwest by West; course: North; distance: 49 miles; latitude: 56 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude: 82 degrees 16 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. A moderate breeze of Wind with some flying showers of hail and rain; close upon a Wind all this day. Wind South-West by West to West by North; course North 1/4 East; distance 86 miles; latitude 55 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 23 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. A light breeze with occasional hail and rain showers; it was a bit overcast all day. The wind was from the South-West by West to West by North; heading North 1/4 East; distance covered was 86 miles; latitude 55 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 23 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. A fresh breeze and dark cloudy weather, with some showers of rain; the wind, varying from West to North by West, obliged us to Tack several times. Wind North-West by West, West by South; course North 20 degrees West; distance 46 miles; latitude 54 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 54 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. A cool breeze and dark, cloudy weather, with some rain showers; the wind, shifting from West to North by West, forced us to tack several times. Wind North-West by West, West by South; course North 20 degrees West; distance 46 miles; latitude 54 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 82 degrees 54 minutes West.

Wednesday, 8th. First part, cloudy with Squalls of wind and Showers of rain and hail; Latter part thick hazey weather, with frequent Showers. Wind, Westerly, South by West; course North 14 degrees 43 minutes West; distance 58 miles; latitude 53 degrees 36 minutes South, longitude 83 degrees 19 minutes West.

Wednesday, 8th. In the morning, it was cloudy with gusty winds and showers of rain and hail; in the afternoon, the weather was thick and hazy, with frequent showers. Wind was coming from the west, slightly south of west; course was North 14 degrees 43 minutes West; distance traveled was 58 miles; latitude 53 degrees 36 minutes South, longitude 83 degrees 19 minutes West.

Thursday, 9th. Fresh gales all this day, sometimes squally with rain; under Double-reef Topsails in the night, and Single-reeft Topsail in the day. Wind Southerly; course North 55 degrees West: distance 130 miles; latitude 52 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude 86 degrees 17 minutes West.

Thursday, 9th. Strong winds all day, occasionally stormy with rain; sailing under double-reefed topsails at night, and single-reefed topsails during the day. Wind from the south; heading North 55 degrees West: distance 130 miles; latitude 52 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude 86 degrees 17 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. The former part of this day had fresh breezes and Dark cloudy weather; in the night hard Squalls with rain, and afterwards hazy, rainy weather. Wind Westerly; course North 22 degrees West; distance 67 miles; latitude 51 degrees 16 minutes South, longitude 86 degrees 37 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. The earlier part of the day had fresh breezes and dark, cloudy weather; at night there were strong gusts with rain, followed by hazy, rainy weather. The wind was coming from the west; our course was North 22 degrees West; we covered a distance of 67 miles; latitude was 51 degrees 16 minutes South, longitude 86 degrees 37 minutes West.

Saturday, 11th. Former part Light Airs with drizling rain; remainder, a Moderate breeze and Cloudy. Wind, variable, southerly; course, North 54 degrees West; distance 36 miles; latitude 50 degrees 55 minutes South, longitude 87 degrees 24 minutes West.

Saturday, 11th. In the morning, light winds with drizzling rain; in the afternoon, a moderate breeze and overcast skies. Wind was variable, coming from the south; course was North 54 degrees West; distance covered was 36 miles; latitude 50 degrees 55 minutes South, longitude 87 degrees 24 minutes West.

Sunday, 12th. First and Middle parts, fresh gales and cloudy; latter, little wind and clear. Having for some time past generally found the Ship by Observation to the Northward of the Log, which is not owing to a Current as I at first imagined, but to a wrong Division of the Log line, being 2 1/2 feet in each Knot--but this is now rectified. Wind South-West by South; course North 48 degrees West; distance 113 miles; latitude 49 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 89 degrees 36 minutes West.

Sunday, 12th. First and Middle parts, fresh winds and cloudy; later, light wind and clear. For some time now, I’ve noticed that the Ship's position is generally north of what the Log shows. This isn’t due to a current as I initially thought, but rather an incorrect division of the Log line, which was 2 1/2 feet per Knot—this has now been fixed. Wind from the South-West by South; course North 48 degrees West; distance 113 miles; latitude 49 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 89 degrees 36 minutes West.

Monday, 13th. The first part of these 24 Hours, moderate breezes and Cloudy; remainder, fresh Gales and cloudy. P.M saw a great many Albetrosses and other Birds about the Ship; some were all white and about the size of Teal. Took several Observations of the sun and moon, the result of which gave 90 degrees 13 minutes West Longitude from Greenwich. The Variation of the Compass by the Mean of several Azimuths 17 degrees East. The Longitude by account is less than that by Observation, 37 minutes, which is about 20 Miles in these high Latitudes, and nearly equal to the Error of the Log line before mentioned. This near Agreement of the 2 Longitudes proves to a Demonstration that we have had no Western Current since we left the Land. Wind West, Northerly; course North 75 degrees West; distance 35 miles; latitude 49 degrees 35 minutes, longitude 90 degrees 37 minutes.

Monday, 13th. The first part of these 24 hours had moderate breezes and clouds; the rest of the day brought fresh gales and continued cloudiness. In the afternoon, I saw many albatrosses and other birds around the ship; some were completely white and about the size of teal. I took several observations of the sun and moon, which resulted in a longitude of 90 degrees 13 minutes West from Greenwich. The variation of the compass averaged at 17 degrees East from several azimuth readings. The calculated longitude is 37 minutes less than that from observation, which is about 20 miles in these high latitudes, and nearly matches the error of the log line mentioned earlier. This close agreement between the two longitudes clearly indicates that we have not encountered any western current since leaving land. Wind was from the west, with a northerly direction; course was North 75 degrees West; distance traveled was 35 miles; latitude was 49 degrees 35 minutes, and longitude was 90 degrees 37 minutes.

[Remarks on Passage round Cape Horn.]

[Remarks on Passage round Cape Horn.]

From the Foregoing observations it will appear that we are now advanced about 12 degrees to the westward of the Strait of Magellan, and 3 1/2 degrees to the Northward of it, having been 33* (* N.B. 23 days only from Success Bay.) days in Doubling Cape Horn or the Land of Terra del Fuego, and Arriving into the Degree of Latitude and Longitude we are now in, and without being brought once under our close Reef'd Topsails since we left Strait Le Maire, a Circumstance that perhaps never hapned before to any ship in those Seas so much dreaded for Hard gales of Wind; in so much that the doubling of Cape Horn is thought by some to be a mighty thing, and others to this day prefer the Straits of Magellan. As I have never been in those Straits I can only form my Judgement on a Carefull Comparison of the Different Ships' Journals that have passed them, and those that have sail'd round Cape Horn, particularly the Dolphin's two last Voyages and this of ours, being made at the same season of the Year, when one may reasonable expect the same Winds to prevail. The Dolphin in her last Voyage was three Months in getting through the Straits, not reckoning the time she lay in Port Famine; and I am firmly perswaided from the Winds we have had, that had we come by that Passage we should not have been in these Seas, besides the fatiguing of our People, the damage we must have done to our Anchors, Cables, Sails, and Rigging, none of which have suffer'd in our passage round Cape Horn.

From the previous observations, it appears that we are currently about 12 degrees west of the Strait of Magellan and 3.5 degrees north of it, having spent 33 days rounding Cape Horn or the Land of Terra del Fuego, and arriving at our current latitude and longitude without once needing to take in our tightly reefed topsails since leaving Strait Le Maire. This is a situation that may have never occurred before for any ship in these dreaded seas known for their strong winds. Because of this, some people consider rounding Cape Horn to be a significant achievement, while others still prefer the Strait of Magellan. Since I have never been in those Straits, I can only form my opinion by carefully comparing the different ship logs of those who have passed through them and those that have sailed around Cape Horn, particularly the last two voyages of the Dolphin and our own, which took place during the same time of year when similar winds can be expected. The Dolphin took three months to get through the Straits on her last voyage, not counting the time spent in Port Famine. I am strongly convinced that based on the winds we’ve experienced, if we had taken that route, we wouldn’t be in these waters now, and we would have exhausted our crew and damaged our anchors, cables, sails, and rigging—all of which have remained intact on our journey around Cape Horn.

From what I have said it will appear that I am no advocate for the Straits of Magellan, but it should be expected that I should say something of Strait le Mair, through which we passed, and this is the more incumbant on me as it was by choice and contrary to the Advice given by Mr. Walter, the ingenious Author of Lord Anson's Voyage, who advised all Ships not to go through this Strait but to go to the Eastward of Staten Land, and likewise to stand to the Southward as far as 61 or 62 degrees south before any Endeavour is made to get to the Westward. With respect to the Passing of Strait le Mair or going round Staten Land, I look upon of little Consequence, and either one or the other to be pursued according to Circumstances; for if you happen to fall in with the land to the Westward of the Strait, and the winds favourable for going through, it certainly must be a piece of folly to lose time in going round Staten Land, for by paying a little Attention to the Directions I have already given no ill Consequences can attend; but on the Contrary if you should fall in with the land to the eastward of the Straits or the wind should prove Boisterous, or unfavourable, in any of these Cases the going to the eastward of Staten Land is the most Advisable. And next, as to running into the Latitude of 61 or 62 degrees South before any Endeavour is made to get to the Westward, is what I think no man will ever do that can avoid it, for it cannot be supposed that anyone will steer south mearly to get into a high Latitude, when at the same time he can steer west, for it is not Southing but Westing that is wanting. But this way you cannot Steer because the Wind blows almost Constantly from that Quarter, so that you have no other Choice but to stand to the Southward, close upon a Wind, and by keeping upon that Tack you not only make Southing but Westing also, and sometimes not a little when the wind Varies to the Northward of West; and the farther you advance to the Southward the better Chance you have of having the Winds from that Quarter or Easterly, and likewise of meeting with finer weather, both of which we ourselves Experienced. Prudence will direct every man when in those high Latitudes to make sure of sufficient Westing to double all the lands before he thinks of standing to the Northward. When the winds was Westerly the Mountains on Terra Del Fuego were generally covered with dense Clouds, formed, as one may reasonably suppose, by Westerly Exhalations and by Vapours brought thither by the Westerly winds. From that Quarter come frequent Showers of rain, hail, and Snow; and after we had left the land and were standing to the Southward, with the winds westerly, dark dence clouds were Continually forming in the Horizon, and rose to about 45 degrees, where they began to dissipate. These were generally attended with Showers of Rain, or hail, and Squals of Wind, but as we advanced to the Southward, these Clouds became less dence, and in the Latitude of 60 degrees 10 minutes, when we got the winds Easterly, the weather was more serene and Milder; again as we advanced to the Northward we had a constant Clouded sky and dark gloomy weather, the whole time exceeding Cold.

From what I've said, it's clear that I'm not a fan of the Straits of Magellan, but I should mention Strait le Mair, which we chose to go through, especially since this decision went against the advice of Mr. Walter, the clever author of Lord Anson's Voyage. He suggested that ships should avoid this Strait and instead go east of Staten Land and head south as far as 61 or 62 degrees south before trying to go west. Regarding whether to take Strait le Mair or go around Staten Land, I think both options are fairly equal and should be chosen based on the situation. If you find yourself near the land west of the Strait with favorable winds for going through, it would be foolish to waste time going around Staten Land. By following the advice I've already given, you should avoid any negative consequences. However, if you come across land east of the Straits or if the winds are strong and unfavorable, then heading east of Staten Land is the better option. As for going down to 61 or 62 degrees south before trying to head west, I believe no one would choose to do that if they could avoid it, since it makes little sense to steer south just to reach a high latitude when you could simply head west. Yet, you can’t go west because the wind almost always comes from that direction, leaving you with no choice but to head south, close-hauled. By keeping this course, you not only head south but also west, especially when the wind shifts to the north of west. The further you go south, the better your chances are of having winds from that direction or easterly, along with nicer weather, both of which we experienced ourselves. Prudence will guide anyone in those high latitudes to ensure they make enough westing before thinking about going north. When the wind was from the west, the mountains on Tierra del Fuego were often shrouded in thick clouds, likely created by westerly exhalations and vapors brought in by the west winds. This direction brings frequent showers of rain, hail, and snow. After we left the land and headed south with westerly winds, dark, dense clouds continually formed on the horizon and rose to about 45 degrees before dissipating. These were typically followed by showers of rain or hail and gusty winds. However, as we progressed southward, these clouds became less dense, and in the latitude of 60 degrees 10 minutes, when the winds shifted easterly, the weather became clearer and milder. Conversely, as we moved north again, we encountered a constantly overcast sky and dark, gloomy weather, with temperatures being quite cold throughout.

[Cape Horn to Tahiti.]

[Cape Horn to Tahiti.]

Tuesday, 14th. The first part, fresh Gales and Hazey with rain; the remainder moderate and Cloudy, with frequent rain. Wind, Westerly, South; course South-West; distance 32 miles; latitude 49 degrees 6 minutes South, longitude 91 degrees 12 minutes West.

Tuesday, the 14th. The first part of the day had strong winds and hazy conditions with rain; the rest was moderate and cloudy, with frequent rain. Wind from the west-southwest; course southwest; distance 32 miles; latitude 49 degrees 6 minutes south, longitude 91 degrees 12 minutes west.

Wednesday, 15th. Little wind and Cloudy the most part of this day. Variation per Azimuth in the Evening 12 degrees East, and in the morning both by an Amplitude and an Azimuth 11 degrees East. A.M. Shifted the Mainsail, Mizen, Fore, and Main topsail. Wind, South-South-West, South-West, West by North; course North 46 degrees West; distance 86 miles; latitude 48 degrees 27 minutes South, longitude 92 degrees 5 minutes West.

Wednesday, 15th. There was little wind and it was mostly cloudy today. The variation by azimuth in the evening was 12 degrees east, and in the morning, both by amplitude and azimuth it was 11 degrees east. In the morning, we adjusted the mainsail, mizen, fore, and main topsails. The wind was coming from the south-southwest, southwest, and west by north; we were on a course of north 46 degrees west; we traveled 86 miles; latitude 48 degrees 27 minutes south, longitude 92 degrees 5 minutes west.

Thursday, 16th. The first part of this day had fresh Gales and Cloudy; in the night thick hazey weather with heavy squalls of wind and rain, which obliged us to close-reef our Topsails. In the morning and all the forenoon had strong gales and cloudy weather, and very heavy Seas from the South-South-West, one of which broke upon the Quarter and carried away the Driver Boom. Wind North-West, West, and South; course North 74 degrees West; distance 97 miles; latitude 48 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 94 degrees 25 minutes West.

Thursday, 16th. The first part of the day was breezy and overcast; at night, we experienced thick, hazy weather with heavy gusts of wind and rain, which forced us to close-reef our topsails. In the morning and throughout the forenoon, we encountered strong winds and cloudy conditions, with very rough seas coming from the South-South-West. One wave hit the quarter and knocked away the driver boom. Wind directions were North-West, West, and South; course was North 74 degrees West; distance covered was 97 miles; latitude was 48 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude was 94 degrees 25 minutes West.

Friday, 17th. Strong Gales and Cloudy the most part of this day. Split the Maintopsail and unbent it, and bent another. Wind South-South-West; course North-West by West 1/2 West; distance 132 miles; latitude 46 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 97 degrees 17 minutes West.

Friday, 17th. Strong winds and cloudy for most of the day. We split the main topsail, took it off, and put on another one. Wind from the South-South-West; heading North-West by West 1/2 West; distance 132 miles; latitude 46 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 97 degrees 17 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. Fresh gales all this day. The weather Variable, sometimes fair and Cloudy, other times hazey, with drizzling rain. Saw some Birds nearly as big as Albetrosses; they were all black, with Yellow Beaks. Wind South-West by West; course North 32 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 140 miles; latitude 44 degrees 50 minutes South, longitude 99 degrees 7 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. Fresh winds all day. The weather was changeable, sometimes clear and cloudy, other times hazy, with light rain. I saw some birds almost as big as albatrosses; they were all black with yellow beaks. Wind from the South-West by West; course North 32 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 140 miles; latitude 44 degrees 50 minutes South, longitude 99 degrees 7 minutes West.

Sunday, 19th. First part, fresh Gales and Hazey; the Middle part, hazey, with drizling rain; the latter, gentle breezes and fine Clear weather, yet the Air is still Cold. Wind South-West by West to West by South; course North-North-West 3/4 West; distance 103 miles; latitude 43 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 100 degrees 21 minutes West.

Sunday, 19th. In the morning, there were fresh winds and hazy skies; in the afternoon, it was hazy with light rain; in the evening, gentle breezes and clear weather, but the air was still cold. The wind was from the South-West by West to West by South; heading North-North-West 3/4 West; distance traveled was 103 miles; latitude 43 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 100 degrees 21 minutes West.

Monday, 20th. Moderate breezes and fine weather the greater part of this day, and the Sea very smooth. Found by repeated trials that the South point of the Dipping Needle Dip'd 65 degrees 52 minutes below the Horizon. Wind Westerly; course South 65 degrees West; distance 58 miles; latitude 43 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 101 degrees 34 minutes West.

Monday, 20th. There were light breezes and nice weather for most of the day, and the sea was very calm. After several tests, I determined that the south point of the dipping needle dipped 65 degrees 52 minutes below the horizon. The wind was coming from the west; we were headed south 65 degrees west; we traveled 58 miles; latitude 43 degrees 46 minutes south, longitude 101 degrees 34 minutes west.

Tuesday, 21st. Fresh breezes and pretty Clear weather. Variation 6 degrees 30 minutes East. Wind North-West; course South 62 degrees West; distance 115 miles; latitude 44 degrees 39 minutes South, longitude 103 degrees 54 minutes West.

Tuesday, 21st. Fresh breezes and clear weather. Variation 6 degrees 30 minutes East. Wind North-West; course South 62 degrees West; distance 115 miles; latitude 44 degrees 39 minutes South, longitude 103 degrees 54 minutes West.

Wednesday, 22nd. Hazey, rainy weather the most part of this Day. Wind North-Westerly; course South 86 degrees West; distance 91 miles; latitude 44 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 106 degrees 1 minute West.

Wednesday, 22nd. Most of the day was hazy and rainy. The wind was coming from the northwest; course south 86 degrees west; distance 91 miles; latitude 44 degrees 46 minutes south, longitude 106 degrees 1 minute west.

Thursday, 23rd. Little wind and Calm, and some Lightning, a thing we have not seen for some time past, and therefore suppose not common in these Seas in high Latitudes. Variation 5 degrees 34 minutes East. Wind North-West, calm; course North 30 degrees East; distance 13 miles; latitude 44 degrees 35 minutes South, longitude 105 degrees 52 minutes West.

Thursday, 23rd. Little wind and calm, with some lightning, something we haven't seen for a while, so we assume it's not common in these high latitudes. Variation is 5 degrees 34 minutes east. Wind is from the northwest, calm; course is north 30 degrees east; distance is 13 miles; latitude is 44 degrees 35 minutes south, longitude is 105 degrees 52 minutes west.

Friday, 24th. First part, Calm; Middle, light breezes; latter, fresh breezes and hazey. P.M. had several Azimuths, all of which gave the Variation less than 4 degrees East, but they were a little doubtful on account of the Rowling of the Ship. What winds we have had this day hath been from the Eastward, and are the first we have had from that Quarter since we left the Latitude 58 degrees 46 minutes. Wind calm, East-North-East and East-South-East; course North 42 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 79 miles: latitude 43 degrees 37 minutes South, longitude 107 degrees 6 minutes West.

Friday, 24th. Morning was calm; midday had light breezes; later, there were fresh breezes and it was hazy. In the afternoon, I took several azimuth readings, all showing a variation of less than 4 degrees East, but they were a bit uncertain due to the rolling of the ship. The winds we experienced today have been from the east, and these are the first we've had from that direction since we left Latitude 58 degrees 46 minutes. Wind was calm, from East-North-East and East-South-East; course was North 42 degrees 45 minutes West; distance covered was 79 miles: latitude 43 degrees 37 minutes South, longitude 107 degrees 6 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. First and Middle parts, fresh Gales and Cloudy, with some rain; the Latter, little Wind and Cloudy. Wind South-East by East, South-South-East; course North 48 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 112 miles; latitude 42 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 109 degrees 0 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. In the morning and afternoon, there were fresh winds and cloudy skies, with some rain; in the evening, there was little wind and it remained cloudy. Wind direction was South-East by East, South-South-East; we traveled a course of North 48 degrees 30 minutes West; covered a distance of 112 miles; latitude 42 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 109 degrees 0 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. First part, Calm and light Airs; remainder, very strong gales and Squally, with Showers of rain, which at length brought us under our two Courses, and close-reefed Maintopsail. Wind calm, North-West and West-South-West; course North 26 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 88 miles; latitude 41 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 109 degrees 52 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. In the beginning, it was calm with light breezes; later, we experienced very strong winds and squalls with rain showers, which eventually forced us to set our two sails and reef the mainsail. The wind was calm, coming from the North-West and West-South-West; we were heading North 26 degrees 15 minutes West; covered 88 miles; at a latitude of 41 degrees 4 minutes South and a longitude of 109 degrees 52 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. First part, Strong Gales and Cloudy; the remainder, Gentle Breezes and clear weather. P.M. set the topsail one Reef out. A large swell from the South-West. Wind westerly; course North 18 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 39 degrees 43 minutes South, 110 degrees 26 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. First part, strong winds and cloudy; the rest, light breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, set the topsail one reef out. There was a large swell from the southwest. Wind was coming from the west; course was North 18 degrees West; distance covered was 85 miles; latitude 39 degrees 43 minutes South, 110 degrees 26 minutes West.

Tuesday, 28th. The former part little wind and fine clear weather; the Air full as warm as in the same Degree of North Latitude at the Correspondent Season of the Year. The South-West swells still keep up, notwithstanding the Gale hath been over about 30 Hours, a proof that there is no land near in that Quarter.* (* These are instances of Cook's observation and seamanlike perspicacity. The prevailing belief of the time was in a great southern continent.) The remainder part of this day fresh breezes and clear. At 9 a.m. took 3 Sets of Observations of the sun and moon in order to find the Longitude of the Ship. Wind West to North-West; course North 13 degrees West; distance 42 miles; latitude 39 degrees 33 minutes 30 seconds South, longitude 110 degrees 38 minutes West.

Tuesday, 28th. The morning had little wind and nice clear weather; the air was as warm as in the same degree of North Latitude during this time of year. The South-West swells are still ongoing, even though the gale has been over for about 30 hours, which shows that there's no land nearby in that direction.* (*These are examples of Cook's keen observations and seafaring insight. The common belief at the time was in a large southern continent.) The rest of the day had fresh breezes and clear skies. At 9 a.m., I took three sets of observations of the sun and moon to determine the ship's longitude. Wind was from West to North-West; heading was North 13 degrees West; distance traveled was 42 miles; latitude was 39 degrees 33 minutes 30 seconds South, longitude was 110 degrees 38 minutes West.

[March 1769.]

[March 1769.]

Wednesday, March 1st. First part fresh breezes, the remainder moderate breezes and clear weather. The result of the Forementioned Observations gives 110 degrees 33 minutes West Longitude from Greenwich, and exactly agrees with the Longitude given by the Log from Cape Horn. This Agreement of the two Longitudes after a Run of 660 leagues is surprizing, and much more than could be expected; but, as it is so, it serves to prove, as well as the repeated trials we have made when the weather would permit, that we have had no Current that hath Affected the Ship since we came into these Seas. This must be a great Sign that we have been near no land of any extent, because near land are generally found Currents. It is well known that on the East side of the Continent in the North Sea we meet with Currents above 100 Leagues from the Land, and even in the Middle of the Atlantic Ocean, between Africa and America, are always found Currents; and I can see no reason why Currents should not be found in this Sea, supposing a Continent or lands lay not far West from us, as some have imaggin'd, and if such land was ever seen we cannot be far from it, as we are now 560 leagues West of the Coast of Chili.* (* These are instances of Cook's observation and seamanlike perspicacity. The prevailing belief of the time was in a great southern continent.) Wind West by South; course North 76 degrees West; distance 52 miles; latitude 38 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 111 degrees 43 minutes West; at noon, Cape Horn South 60 degrees East 660 leagues.

Wednesday, March 1st. The first part of the day had fresh breezes, while the rest had moderate breezes and clear weather. Our observations indicate a longitude of 110 degrees 33 minutes West from Greenwich, which matches exactly with the longitude recorded in the log from Cape Horn. This agreement between the two longitudes after a journey of 660 leagues is surprising and much better than expected; however, it shows, along with the repeated tests we've conducted whenever the weather allowed, that we haven't encountered any current affecting the ship since entering these waters. This is a strong indication that we haven't been close to any large land masses, as currents are typically found near land. It is well known that on the eastern side of the continent in the North Sea, currents can be found over 100 leagues from the shore, and even in the middle of the Atlantic Ocean, between Africa and America, currents are always present. I see no reason why we shouldn't find currents in this sea, assuming there isn’t a continent or land not far west of us, as some have imagined. If such land was ever observed, we can't be far from it since we are now 560 leagues west of the coast of Chile.* (*These instances illustrate Cook's observational skills and maritime insight. The prevailing belief at the time was in a vast southern continent.) Wind from the West by South; course North 76 degrees West; distance 52 miles; latitude 38 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 111 degrees 43 minutes West; at noon, Cape Horn is South 60 degrees East, 660 leagues away.

Thursday, 2nd. Former part, fresh gales and hazey, with much rain; the remainder, a Strong fresh gale and pretty clear weather. Wind Westerly; course North by West; distance 87 miles; latitude 37 degrees 16 minutes South, longitude 112 degrees 5 minutes West.

Thursday, 2nd. In the morning, it was windy and hazy with a lot of rain; in the afternoon, there were strong winds and mostly clear skies. The wind was coming from the west; we headed north by northwest; traveled 87 miles; latitude 37 degrees 16 minutes south, longitude 112 degrees 5 minutes west.

Friday, 3rd. First part, moderate breezes; remainder, calm and clear weather. A.M. employed filling salt Water in the Fore Hold and airing all the Spare Sails. Wind West, calm; course North 17 degrees East; distance 31 miles; latitude 36 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 111 degrees 34 minutes West.

Friday, 3rd. In the morning, we had moderate breezes, but the rest of the day was calm and clear. In the A.M., we were busy filling the fore hold with salt water and airing out all the spare sails. The wind was calm from the West; we were heading North 17 degrees East; we traveled 31 miles; our latitude was 36 degrees 49 minutes South, and our longitude was 111 degrees 34 minutes West.

Saturday, 4th. First part, Calm; remainder, a fine genteel breeze and clear weather. Variation per Azimuth and Amplitude this Evening 2 degrees 26 minutes East. The South-West swell still keeps up, notwithstanding it hath been Calm 24 hours. Wind calm, North-East, North; course North 50 degrees West; distance 58 miles; latitude 36 degrees 12 minutes South, longitude 112 degrees 50 minutes West.

Saturday, 4th. First part, calm; the rest of the day, a nice gentle breeze and clear weather. The variation measured this evening was 2 degrees 26 minutes East. The South-West swell continues, even though it has been calm for 24 hours. Wind calm, North-East, North; course North 50 degrees West; distance 58 miles; latitude 36 degrees 12 minutes South, longitude 112 degrees 50 minutes West.

Sunday, 5th. First and latter parts, fine Clear weather; the Middle, fresh gales and Hazey, with rain. Wind North-West by North and North-West; course South 81 degrees 40 minutes West; distance 64 miles; latitude 36 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 114 degrees 9 minutes West.

Sunday, 5th. Early and late parts, nice clear weather; in the middle, fresh winds and hazy, with rain. Wind from North-West by North and North-West; course South 81 degrees 40 minutes West; distance 64 miles; latitude 36 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 114 degrees 9 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. Moderate breezes and Tolerable clear weather all this day. The wind a little Variable, which caused us to Tack several Times. Wind North-West by North to West-North-West; course South 57 degrees West; distance 20 miles; latitude 36 degrees 32 minutes South, longitude 114 degrees 30 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. There were moderate breezes and reasonably clear weather throughout the day. The wind was a bit variable, which made us change course several times. The wind direction was North-West by North to West-North-West; our course was South 57 degrees West; we covered a distance of 20 miles; latitude 36 degrees 32 minutes South, longitude 114 degrees 30 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. A Moderate steady breeze and clear weather. Wind North-West; course South 64 degrees 15 minutes West; distance, 83 miles; latitude 37 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 116 degrees 8 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. A light, steady breeze and clear skies. Wind from the Northwest; heading South 64 degrees 15 minutes West; distance covered, 83 miles; latitude 37 degrees 8 minutes South, longitude 116 degrees 8 minutes West.

Wednesday, 8th. The first and Middle parts moderate breezes and Cloudy; the Latter Part Variable winds and much Rain. Wind North-West, variable; course South 78 degrees West; distance, 76 miles; latitude 37 degrees 24 minutes South, longitude 117 degrees 41 minutes West.

Wednesday, 8th. The first and middle parts had mild breezes and cloudy skies; the latter part had changing winds and a lot of rain. Wind was from the northwest, variable; course was south 78 degrees west; distance was 76 miles; latitude was 37 degrees 24 minutes south, longitude was 117 degrees 41 minutes west.

Thursday, 9th. First part, moderate and Hazey, with Drizling rain; the remainder fresh breezes and clear weather. Variation 4 degrees 41 minutes east. Wind South-West by West to South by East; course North 38 degrees West; distance 123 miles; latitude 35 degrees 47 minutes South, longitude 119 degrees 18 minutes West.

Thursday, 9th. The first part was moderate and hazy, with light rain; the rest of the day brought fresh breezes and clear skies. Variation 4 degrees 41 minutes east. Wind from South-West by West to South by East; course North 38 degrees West; distance 123 miles; latitude 35 degrees 47 minutes South, longitude 119 degrees 18 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. Moderate breezes and fine Pleasant weather. Wind South-East; course North 40 degrees West; distance 121 miles; latitude 34 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 120 degrees 54 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. Light winds and lovely weather. Wind from the South-East; course North 40 degrees West; distance 121 miles; latitude 34 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 120 degrees 54 minutes West.

Saturday, 11th. A Steady gale and fine weather. Variation 4 degrees 12 minutes East. Wind South-East; course North 46 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 116 miles; latitude 32 degrees 54 minutes South, longitude 122 degrees 35 minutes West.

Saturday, 11th. A strong breeze and nice weather. Variation 4 degrees 12 minutes East. Wind from the Southeast; course Northwest at 46 degrees 15 minutes; distance 116 miles; latitude 32 degrees 54 minutes South, longitude 122 degrees 35 minutes West.

Sunday, 12th. Ditto weather. Variation 4 degrees 12 minutes East. Put the Ship's Company to three Watches, they having been at Watch and Watch since our first arrival on the coast of Terra del Fuego. Wind South-East; course North 49 degrees West; distance 122 miles; latitude 31 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 124 degrees 25 minutes West.

Sunday, 12th. Same weather. Variation 4 degrees 12 minutes East. Divided the crew into three watches since they’ve been on watch together since we first got to the coast of Tierra del Fuego. Wind from the Southeast; course North 49 degrees West; distance covered 122 miles; latitude 31 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 124 degrees 25 minutes West.

Monday, 13th. First part a Steady, fresh Gale; the remainder, little wind and fine Clear weather. Wind South-East; course North 48 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 72 miles; latitude 30 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 125 degrees 28 minutes West.

Monday, 13th. The first part was a steady, fresh gale; the rest had little wind and clear weather. The wind came from the southeast; we were heading north 48 degrees 15 minutes west; distance covered was 72 miles; latitude 30 degrees 46 minutes south, longitude 125 degrees 28 minutes west.

Tuesday, 14th. Little wind and fine Pleasant weather. At 3 p.m. took several Observations of the sun and moon; the mean result of which gave 126 degrees 20 minutes 45 seconds, the Longitude of the Ship West of Greenwich, and is 47 degrees Longitude West of account carried on from Cape Horn. Wind South, East-South-East, East-North-East; course North 50 degrees West; distance 47 miles; latitude 30 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude 126 degrees 10 minutes West.

Tuesday, 14th. Light wind and nice weather. At 3 p.m., I took several observations of the sun and moon; the average result showed 126 degrees 20 minutes 45 seconds, which is the ship's longitude west of Greenwich, and is 47 degrees longitude west of the account continued from Cape Horn. Wind from the South, East-South-East, East-North-East; course North 50 degrees West; distance 47 miles; latitude 30 degrees 17 minutes South, longitude 126 degrees 10 minutes West.

Wednesday, 15th. Light breezes and clear weather. Variation, p.m. 3 degrees 45 minutes East, a.m. 3 degrees 22 minutes East. Saw a Tropic Bird. Wind, East-North-East and East-South-East; course, North 47 degrees 15 minutes West; distance, 50 miles; latitude 29 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 126 degrees 53 minutes West.

Wednesday, 15th. Light breezes and nice weather. Variation, p.m. 3 degrees 45 minutes East, a.m. 3 degrees 22 minutes East. Saw a Tropic Bird. Wind from the East-North-East and East-South-East; course North 47 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 50 miles; latitude 29 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 126 degrees 53 minutes West.

Thursday, 16th. Light Airs next to a Calm and clear Weather. Variation by the mean result of 21 Azimuths, 1 degree 30 minutes East. This evening observed an Occultation of h by the [crescent],* (* h is Saturn, [crescent] the Moon.) Immersion at ---- hours ---- minutes and Emersion at ---- hours ---- minutes ---- seconds a.m.* (* Blanks in manuscript.) Variation per several Azimuths 2 degrees East. Wind East-South-East, South-South-East, South-West; course North-North-West; distance 34 miles; latitude 29 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 8 minutes West.

Thursday, 16th. Light winds, almost calm, and clear weather. The average of 21 azimuths showed a variation of 1 degree 30 minutes East. This evening, I observed the occultation of h by the [crescent]. (* h is Saturn, [crescent] is the Moon.) Immersion at ---- hours ---- minutes and emersion at ---- hours ---- minutes ---- seconds a.m. (* Blanks in manuscript.) Variation from several azimuths was 2 degrees East. Wind was coming from the East-South-East, South-South-East, and South-West; the course was North-North-West; distance traveled was 34 miles; latitude was 29 degrees 22 minutes South, longitude was 127 degrees 8 minutes West.

Friday, 17th. Little wind and fine Pleasant weather. Variation, p.m. 3 degrees 27 minutes East. Wind, South-East by South; course, North 20 degrees West; distance, 55 miles; latitude 28 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 29 minutes West.

Friday, 17th. Light wind and nice weather. Variation, p.m. 3 degrees 27 minutes East. Wind, South-East by South; course, North 20 degrees West; distance, 55 miles; latitude 28 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 29 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. First part, little wind and Cloudy; latter, fresh gales and hard Squalls, with much rain. Took 2 Reefs in the Topsails. Wind North-East North; course North 60 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 78 miles; latitude 27 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 128 degrees 44 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. In the morning, there was little wind and it was cloudy; in the afternoon, fresh gales and strong squalls with a lot of rain. We took in 2 reefs in the topsails. The wind was blowing from the North-East North; we were heading North 60 degrees 45 minutes West; we covered a distance of 78 miles; latitude 27 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 128 degrees 44 minutes West.

Sunday, 19th. First part fresh Gales and Squally, with rain; remainder more moderate and cloudy. Variation, a.m. per Means of several Azimuths, 3 degrees 14 minutes East. Loosed the 2d reefs out of the Topsails. Wind between the North and West; course North 52 degrees West; distance 50 miles; latitude 27 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Sunday, 19th. The first part of the day had strong winds and squalls, with rain; the rest of the day was more moderate and cloudy. Variation in the morning, according to several measurements, was 3 degrees 14 minutes East. We took the second reefs out of the topsails. The wind was between the North and West; our course was North 52 degrees West; we traveled 50 miles; latitude was 27 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Monday, 20th. A Fine breeze and pleasant weather. Saw several Tropic Birds. Wind West; course North; distance 95 miles; latitude 25 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Monday, 20th. A nice breeze and pleasant weather. Saw several Tropic Birds. Wind from the West; heading North; distance 95 miles; latitude 25 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Tuesday, 21st. First part little wind, the remainder Calm. Variation, 3 degrees 43 minutes East. Saw some rock weed and a great many Tropic Birds. Wind West by North, calm; course North; distance 23 miles; latitude 25 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Tuesday, 21st. The first part had a light wind, then it was calm. The variation is 3 degrees 43 minutes East. We saw some rock weed and a lot of Tropic Birds. Wind was from the West by North, calm; heading North; distance covered 23 miles; latitude 25 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 28 minutes West.

Wednesday, 22nd. First part Calm, in the night Squally, with rain. A.M. a fresh breeze and Cloudy. Variation per Amplitude 3 degrees 10 minutes East. Saw some Egg Birds. Wind North by East to North-North-West; course West; distance 57 miles; latitude 25 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 52 minutes West.

Wednesday, 22nd. First part Calm, at night Squally, with rain. A.M. a fresh breeze and cloudy. Variation per amplitude 3 degrees 10 minutes East. Saw some egg birds. Wind North by East to North-North-West; course West; distance 57 miles; latitude 25 degrees 21 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 52 minutes West.

Thursday, 23rd. Fresh gales and Squally, with rain, the first part; remainder fresh Gales and Cloudy. P.M. saw some Men-of-War Birds, and Egg Birds, and in the Morning saw more Egg Birds and Tropic Birds. The Man-of-War and Tropic Birds are pretty well known, but the Egg Bird (as it is called in the Dolphin's Journal) requires some discription to know it by that Name. It is a small slender Bird of the Gull kind, and all white, and not much unlike the small white Gulls we have in England, only not so big.* (* Terns.) There are also Birds in Newfoundland called Stearings that are of the same shape and Bigness, only they are of a Greyish Colour. These Birds were called by the Dolphin Egg Birds on account of their being like those known by that name by Sailors in the Gulph of Florida; neither they nor the Man-of-War Birds are ever reckoned to go very far from Land. Wind North by West to West by North: course North 13 degrees West; distance 49 miles; latitude 24 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 130 degrees 8 minutes West.

Thursday, 23rd. Fresh winds and squally, with rain in the morning; the rest of the day had fresh winds and was cloudy. In the afternoon, we saw some Man-of-War birds and Egg birds, and in the morning, we spotted more Egg birds and Tropic birds. The Man-of-War and Tropic birds are pretty well known, but the Egg bird (as it’s called in the Dolphin's Journal) needs some description to recognize it by that name. It is a small, slender bird similar to a gull, completely white, and not much different from the small white gulls we have in England, only not as large. There are also birds in Newfoundland called Starlings that have the same shape and size, but they are a grayish color. These birds were named Egg birds by the Dolphin because they resemble those known by that name by sailors in the Gulf of Florida; neither they nor the Man-of-War birds are thought to go very far from land. Wind from North by West to West by North: course North 13 degrees West; distance 49 miles; latitude 24 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 130 degrees 8 minutes West.

[Passing Low Archipelago.]

[Passing Low Archipelago.]

Friday, 24th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy, with some rain in the forepart of this day. All the forepart of these 24 hours the Sea was smooth, but at 12 at night it was more so, and about 3 in the Morning one of the people saw, or thought he saw, a Log of Wood pass the Ship. This made us think that we were near some land,* (* The Endeavour was now passing to the northward of the easternmost islands of the Paumotu or Low Archipelago, though out of sight of them.) but at daylight we saw not the least appearance of any, and I did not think myself at liberty to spend time in searching for what I was not sure to find, although I thought myself not far from those Islands discovered by Quiros in 1606; and very probably we were not, from the birds, etc., we have seen for these 2 or 3 days past. Wind West-North-West to North-West; course North-East by North 1/4 East; distance 99 miles; latitude 22 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 2 minutes West.

Friday, 24th. There were strong winds and clouds, with some rain in the early part of the day. For most of the last 24 hours, the sea was calm, but at midnight it was even calmer, and around 3 in the morning, one of the crew thought he saw a log of wood pass by the ship. This made us think we might be close to land,* (*The Endeavour was now passing to the north of the easternmost islands of the Paumotu or Low Archipelago, although they were out of sight.) but at dawn, there was no sign of any land. I didn’t feel it was right to waste time searching for something I wasn't sure existed, even though I thought we were near those islands discovered by Quiros in 1606; and it was likely we were, based on the birds and other signs we’ve seen over the past couple of days. Wind was from the West-Northwest to Northwest; our course was Northeast by North 1/4 East; distance traveled was 99 miles; latitude was 22 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude was 129 degrees 2 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. First part dark cloudy weather, with rain and a fresh breeze of wind; remainder fair and Cloudy. Wind North-West by North, to West by North; course North-East 1/2 North; distance 95 miles; latitude 22 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 55 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. The first part of the day had dark, cloudy weather, with rain and a fresh breeze; the rest of the day was fair and cloudy. The wind was blowing from North-West by North to West by North. We traveled in a North-East direction, half North; covering a distance of 95 miles; latitude 22 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 55 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. Squally weather, with rain. At 5 p.m. saw some sea Weed pass the Ship, and at 7 William Greenslade, Marine, either by Accident or design, went overboard and was Drowned. The following circumstances makes it appear as tho' it was done design'dly. He had been Centinel at the Steerage door between 12 and 4 o'clock, where he had taken part of a Seal Skin put under his charge, and which was found upon him. The other Marines thought themselves hurt by one of their party commiting a crime of this nature, and he being a raw young fellow, and, as very probable, made him resolve upon commiting this rash Action, for the Serjeant not being willing that it should pass over unknown to me, was about 7 o'clock going to bring him aft and have it inquired into, when he gave him the Slip between Decks, and was seen to go upon the Forecastle, and from that time was seen no more. I was neither made acquainted with the Theft or the Circumstances attending it, until the Man was gone. Wind, North-West to West; longitude 127 degrees 43 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. Stormy weather with rain. At 5 p.m. saw some seaweed pass the ship, and at 7, William Greenslade, a Marine, either by accident or on purpose, went overboard and drowned. The following circumstances make it seem as though it was intentional. He had been on guard at the steerage door between 12 and 4 o'clock, where he had taken charge of part of a seal skin, which was found on him. The other Marines felt wronged by one of their own committing such a crime, and being an inexperienced young guy, it’s likely this drove him to take this reckless action. The sergeant, not wanting me to remain unaware of this, was about to bring him aft around 7 o'clock to investigate when he slipped away between decks. He was seen going onto the forecastle, and after that, he was never seen again. I was not informed about the theft or the circumstances surrounding it until after the man was gone. Wind, North-West to West; longitude 127 degrees 43 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. Variable winds and weather, with frequent showers of rain. At Noon saw a Bird like a Gannet. Wind variable; course North 1/4 East; distance 30 miles; latitude 21 degrees 2 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 38 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. Changing winds and weather, with frequent rain showers. At noon, I saw a bird that looked like a gannet. The wind was variable; heading North 1/4 East; distance 30 miles; latitude 21 degrees 2 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 38 minutes West.

Tuesday, 28th. Little wind and Cloudy. Variation per Amplitude 3 degrees 56 minutes East. Wind Easterly; course North-North-West; distance 37 miles; latitude 20 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 127 degrees 50 minutes West.

Tuesday, 28th. Light wind and cloudy. Variation by amplitude 3 degrees 56 minutes east. Wind from the east; course north-northwest; distance 37 miles; latitude 20 degrees 38 minutes south, longitude 127 degrees 50 minutes west.

Wednesday, 29th. Little winds and Cloudy weather. Variation per Azimuth 2 degrees 27 minutes East. Saw a Bird like a Dove and several fish about the Ship. Employed worming the Best Br. Cable, repairing and Painting the Boats. Wind Easterly; course North 75 degrees West; distance 50 miles; latitude 20 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 27 minutes West.

Wednesday, 29th. Light winds and cloudy weather. Variation by azimuth 2 degrees 27 minutes east. Saw a bird that looked like a dove and several fish around the ship. Spent the day worming the best Brazil cable, repairing and painting the boats. Wind was from the east; course was north 75 degrees west; distance traveled was 50 miles; latitude 20 degrees 14 minutes south, longitude 129 degrees 27 minutes west.

Thursday, 30th. First part, Calm and close Cloudy weather; in the night had Variable winds and weather, with rain. A.M. Genteel Breezes and Cloudy weather. Between 10 and 11 a.m. took several Observations of the sun and moon; the mean result of them gave the Longitude of the Ship at Noon to be 127 degrees 38 minutes, and is 1 degree 49 minutes East of the Longitude given by the Log; but on the 4th Instant the ship by Observation was 47 minutes West of the Log, therefore she must have lost 2 degrees 36 minutes of the Log since the last Observation--an Error too great to be accounted for. Wind calm, variable, South-South-East; course North 40 degrees West; distance 53 miles; latitude 19 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 129 degrees 27 minutes West.

Thursday, 30th. First part, Calm and humid. The weather was cloudy; during the night we had variable winds and rain. In the morning, there were gentle breezes with cloudy skies. Between 10 and 11 a.m., I took several observations of the sun and moon; the average result indicated that the ship's longitude at noon is 127 degrees 38 minutes, which is 1 degree 49 minutes east of the longitude recorded in the log. However, on the 4th, the ship's observation showed it was 47 minutes west of the log, meaning it has lost 2 degrees 36 minutes according to the log since the last observation—a discrepancy too significant to explain. The wind was calm and variable from the south-southeast; our course was north 40 degrees west; distance traveled was 53 miles; latitude was 19 degrees 34 minutes south, longitude 129 degrees 27 minutes west.

Friday, 31st. A Steady breeze and fine pleasant weather. A.M. took several Observations of the sun and moon, the mean result of them came within 8 Miles of Yesterday's Observations computed both by Mr. Green and myself, and yet cannot think so great an error can have been committed in the ship's run in so short a time as these observations seem to point out, and therefore I shall abide by the Longitude given by the Log unless from subsequent Observations this error should be found to be just. Wind South; course North 75 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 111 miles; latitude 19 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude 131 degrees 21 minutes West.

Friday, 31st. There was a steady breeze and nice weather. In the morning, I took several observations of the sun and moon, and the average result was within 8 miles of yesterday's observations calculated by both Mr. Green and me. I can't believe such a significant error could occur in the ship's distance traveled in such a short time as these observations suggest, so I'll stick with the longitude recorded in the log unless later observations prove this error to be valid. Wind from the south; course at 75 degrees 45 minutes west; distance 111 miles; latitude 19 degrees 7 minutes south, longitude 131 degrees 21 minutes west.

[April 1769.]

[April 1769.]

Saturday, April 1st. A steady fresh Trade and fine Weather. Variation per several Azimuths 2 degrees 32 minutes East. Wind South-East to East 1/2 North; course West; distance 122 miles; latitude 19 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude 133 degrees 28 minutes West.

Saturday, April 1st. A steady, fresh trade wind and nice weather. Variation from several azimuths is 2 degrees 32 minutes East. Wind is coming from the South-East to East 1/2 North; course is West; distance traveled is 122 miles; latitude is 19 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude is 133 degrees 28 minutes West.

Sunday, 2nd. A fresh Trade wind and fine pleasant weather. At Noon saw a Large flock of Birds; they had brown backs and white Bellies. They fly and make a noise like Stearings, and are shaped like them, only something larger. Saw likewise some black Sheerwaters and Several Man-of-War birds. Wind East; course North 86 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 118 miles; latitude 19 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 135 degrees 33 minutes West.

Sunday, 2nd. A fresh trade wind and nice, pleasant weather. At noon, we saw a large flock of birds; they had brown backs and white bellies. They fly and make a noise like steer, and are shaped like them, just a bit larger. We also saw some black shearwaters and several man-of-war birds. Wind from the east; course North 86 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 118 miles; latitude 19 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 135 degrees 33 minutes West.

Monday, 3rd. First and Latter parts a steady fresh Breeze and cloudy; the Middle, sometimes squally with rain, at other times little wind. P.M. saw 2 Birds like Albetrosses; they were all white except the Tip of their wings and Tails. Wind East; course North 82 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 110 miles; latitude 18 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 137 degrees 29 minutes West.

Monday, 3rd. The first and last parts of the day had a steady fresh breeze and were cloudy; the middle part was sometimes squally with rain, and at other times there was little wind. In the afternoon, I saw 2 birds that looked like albatrosses; they were all white except for the tips of their wings and tails. The wind was coming from the east; our course was North 82 degrees 45 minutes West; we covered a distance of 110 miles; latitude 18 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 137 degrees 29 minutes West.

Tuesday, 4th. A Steady fresh Trade and clear weather. At 1/2 past 10 a.m. saw land bearing south, distance 3 or 4 Leagues. Haul'd up for it, and soon found it to be an Island of about 2 Leagues in Circuit and of an Oval form, with a Lagoon in the Middle, for which I named it Lagoon Island. The Border of land Circumscribing this Lagoon is in many places very low and narrow, particularly on the south side, where it is mostly a Beach or Reef of rocks; it is the same on the North side in 3 places, and these disjoins the firm land and make it appear like so many Islands covered with wood. On the West end of the Island is a large Tree which looks like a large Tower, and about the Middle of the Island are two Cocoa Nutt Trees that appears above all the other wood, which as we approached the Island looked very much like a flag. We approached the north side of this Island within a Mile, and found no Bottom with 130 fathoms of line, nor did there appear to be Anchorage about it. We saw several of the Inhabitants, the most of them men, and these Marched along the shore abreast of the Ships with long Clubs in their hands as tho' they meant to oppose our landing. They were all naked except their Privy parts, and were of a Dark Copper Colour with long black Hair, but upon our leaving the Island some of them were seen to put on a Covering, and one or two we saw in the Skirts of the Wood was Cloathed in White; these we supposed to be Women. This Island lies in the Latitude of 18 degrees 47 minutes and Longitude 139 degrees 28 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich;* (* This island is Vahitahi, one of the Paumotu or Low Archipelago.) variation 2 degrees 54 minutes East. Wind East, East by South; course North 88 degrees West; distance 114 miles; latitude 18 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 139 degrees 29 minutes West.

Tuesday, 4th. There was a steady, fresh breeze and clear weather. At 10:30 a.m., we spotted land to the south, about 3 or 4 leagues away. We headed toward it and soon discovered it was an island, roughly 2 leagues around and oval-shaped, with a lagoon in the middle, which I named Lagoon Island. The land surrounding this lagoon is low and narrow in many areas, especially on the south side, where it mainly consists of a beach or a rocky reef. The north side has three similar spots that separate the solid land, making it look like several islands covered in trees. At the west end of the island, there is a large tree that resembles a tower, and in the middle, there are two coconut trees that stand out above the rest, which, as we approached the island, looked quite like a flag. We got within a mile of the north side of the island and couldn’t find any bottom with 130 fathoms of line, nor did there seem to be any anchorage. We saw several inhabitants, mostly men, marching along the shore beside the ships with long clubs in their hands, as if they intended to prevent us from landing. They were all naked except for their private parts and had a dark copper skin tone and long black hair. However, as we were leaving the island, some of them were seen putting on coverings, and one or two that we noticed at the edge of the woods were clothed in white; we assumed they were women. This island is located at a latitude of 18 degrees 47 minutes and a longitude of 139 degrees 28 minutes west from the Greenwich Meridian;* (* This island is Vahitahi, one of the Paumotu or Low Archipelago.) with a variation of 2 degrees 54 minutes east. Wind was from the east, east by south; we were on a course of north 88 degrees west; distance covered was 114 miles; latitude was 18 degrees 42 minutes south, longitude was 139 degrees 29 minutes west.

Wednesday, 5th. A fresh steady gale and fine weather. At 1 p.m. made Sail to the Westward, and at 1/2 past 3 saw land to the North-West, which we got up with at Sun sett and proved to be a low woody Island of a Circular form, and not much above a Mile in Compass. This Island I called Thrum Cap* (* Akiaki. It is inhabited.); it lies in the Latitude of 18 degrees 35 minutes South and in the Longitude of 139 degrees 48 minutes West from Greenwich, and North 62 degrees West, 7 Leagues from Lagoon Island. We saw no inhabitants, nor the appearance of any, and yet we were within 1/2 a Mile of the Shore. I observed by the Shore that it was near low Water, and at Lagoon Island I observed that it was either high Water or else there was no Ebbing and flowing of the Sea. From these Circumstances I infer that a South by East or South Moon makes high Water. Here we caught a King Fish, being the first fish we have got in these Seas. Wind East; course North 77 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 79 miles; latitude 18 degrees 25 minutes South, longitude 140 degrees 51 minutes West.

Wednesday, 5th. A strong, consistent wind and nice weather. At 1 p.m. we set sail to the west, and at 3:30 p.m. we spotted land to the northwest, which we reached by sunset. It turned out to be a low, wooded island shaped like a circle, not much more than a mile around. I named this island Thrum Cap* (* Akiaki. It is inhabited.); it is located at 18 degrees 35 minutes south latitude and 139 degrees 48 minutes west longitude from Greenwich, and 62 degrees north west, 7 leagues from Lagoon Island. We didn’t see any inhabitants or signs of them, even though we were just half a mile from the shore. I noticed that it was close to low tide by the shore, and at Lagoon Island I saw that it was either high tide or there was no ebb and flow of the sea. From these observations, I conclude that a south by east or south moon indicates high tide. Here we caught a kingfish, the first fish we’ve caught in these waters. Wind from the east; course north 77 degrees 30 minutes west; distance 79 miles; latitude 18 degrees 25 minutes south, longitude 140 degrees 51 minutes west.

Thursday, 6th. A fresh Trade and fine Pleasant weather. At 3 p.m. Saw land to the Westward, which proved to be an Island of about 12 or 15 Leagues in Compass; is very low and entirely drown'd in the Middle, forming there a large lake, into which there appeared to be no inlet. The border of land and Reef surrounding this lake like a wall appeared to be of a Bow-like figure, for which reason I named it Bow Island. The South side, along which we sail'd, was one continued low narrow Beach or Reef like a Causeway for 4 Leagues and upwards, and lies East by North and West by South. The East and West Ends and North side of this Island are wooded-in Groves, and the firm Land appeared disjoined and like a Number of Islands, and very probably is so. The North-West parts of the Island we only saw aCross the Lake, and not very distinct on account of its great extent, and night coming on before we had run the whole length of the Island. This description must be imperfect, and the whole Island may form a Different figure to what I have here described.* (* Hao. It is a large atoll, thirty miles in length. Cook only saw a portion of it.) The east end lies in the Latitude of 18 degrees 23 minutes South, and Longitude 141 degrees 12 minutes West from Greenwich. Variation 5 degrees 38 minutes East. This Island is Inhabited; we not only saw smook in Different Parts, but people also. At Noon saw Land to the Westward. Wind east; course North 85 degrees West; distance 94 miles; latitude 18 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 142 degrees 29 minutes West.

Thursday, 6th. A fresh breeze and nice weather. At 3 p.m., we spotted land to the west, which turned out to be an island about 12 to 15 leagues around; it's very low and completely flooded in the middle, forming a large lake, with no visible inlet. The land and reef surrounding this lake, forming a wall, appeared bow-shaped, which is why I named it Bow Island. The southern side, along which we sailed, was a continuous low narrow beach or reef acting like a causeway for over 4 leagues, lying east by north and west by south. The east and west ends and the northern side of this island are filled with wooded groves, and the solid land looked fragmented, almost like multiple islands, which it likely is. We could only see the northwestern parts of the island across the lake, and not very clearly due to its vast size and the night approaching before we could travel the entire length of the island. This description might not be perfect, and the full shape of the island could be different from what I've described. (*Hao. It is a large atoll, thirty miles long. Cook only saw a portion of it.) The east end is located at a latitude of 18 degrees 23 minutes south and longitude 141 degrees 12 minutes west from Greenwich. Variation 5 degrees 38 minutes east. This island is inhabited; we not only saw smoke in different areas but also people. At noon, we spotted land to the west. Wind was coming from the east; course was north 85 degrees west; distance covered was 94 miles; latitude was 18 degrees 19 minutes south, longitude 142 degrees 29 minutes west.

Friday, 7th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. At 1/2 past 2 p.m. got up with the East end of the Land seen yesterday at Noon, and which proved to be an assemblage of Islands join'd together by Reef, and extending themselves North-West by North and South-East by South in 8 or 9 Leagues and of various breadths; but there appeared to be a total Seperation in the middle by a Channell of half a Mile broad, and on this account they are called the two Groups.* (* Marokau and Ravahare. Two atolls close together.) The South Eastermost of them lies in the Latitude of 18 degrees 12 minutes and Longitude of 142 degrees 42 minutes West from Greenwich, and West 1/2 North distant 25 Leagues from the West end of Bow Island. We ranged along the South-West side of this Island, and hauled into a Bay which lies to the North-West of the Southermost point of them, and where there appeared to be Anchorage and the Sea was smooth and not much Surf on the Shore; but we found no ground with 100 fathoms 3/4 of a Mile from the Shore, and nearer we did not go. Here several of the Inhabitants assembled together with their Canoes, with a design, as we thought, to come off to us, as they hauld one of them over the reef seemingly for that purpose; but after waiting near 1/2 an hour, and they not attempting to come, we bore away and made Sail, and presentley the Canoe put off after us; but, as we did not stop, they soon went back again. They were in all respects like those we had seen on Lagoon Island, and Armed with Clubs and long Pikes like them. At 1/2 past 6 a.m. Saw a small Island to the Northward, hauled our wind for it, and soon got close in with it. It is about 3 or 4 Miles in Circuit, and very low, with a Pond in the Middle. There is some wood upon it, but no inhabitants but Birds, and for this reason is called Bird Island.* (* Reitoru.) It lies in the latitude 17 degrees 48 minutes and longitude 143 degrees 35 minutes West, and West 1/2 North 10 Leagues from the West end of the two Groups. The birds we saw were Men-of-War Birds and several other sorts. Wind East; course North 66 degrees West; distance 66 miles; latitude 17 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 143 degrees 31 minutes West.

Friday, 7th. Fresh winds and cloudy. At 2:30 p.m., we spotted the east end of the land we saw yesterday at noon, which turned out to be a cluster of islands connected by a reef, stretching northwest by north and southeast by south for about 8 or 9 leagues and varying in width. However, there was a clear separation in the middle due to a channel about half a mile wide, which is why they’re called the two groups.* (* Marokau and Ravahare. Two atolls close together.) The southeasternmost island is located at a latitude of 18 degrees 12 minutes and a longitude of 142 degrees 42 minutes west from Greenwich, about 25 leagues west 1/2 north from the west end of Bow Island. We navigated along the southwest side of this island and entered a bay to the northwest of its southernmost point, where it seemed like there was good anchorage, and the sea was calm without much surf on the shore. However, we didn’t find any bottom with 100 fathoms, 3/4 of a mile from the shore, and we didn’t go any closer. Here, several inhabitants gathered with their canoes, seemingly planning to come to us, as they pulled one canoe over the reef for that purpose. But after waiting for about half an hour without them coming, we set sail, and shortly after, the canoe followed us. Since we didn’t stop, they eventually turned back. They were similar in every way to those we had seen on Lagoon Island, armed with clubs and long pikes like them. At 6:30 a.m., we spotted a small island to the north, adjusted our course toward it, and soon got close. It’s about 3 or 4 miles in circumference and very low, with a pond in the middle. There are a few trees, but no inhabitants except for birds, which is why it's called Bird Island.* (* Reitoru.) It’s located at a latitude of 17 degrees 48 minutes and a longitude of 143 degrees 35 minutes west, about 10 leagues west 1/2 north from the west end of the two groups. The birds we saw included frigatebirds and several other types. Wind east; course north 66 degrees west; distance 66 miles; latitude 17 degrees 48 minutes south, longitude 143 degrees 31 minutes west.

Saturday, 8th. Fresh Trade and pleasant weather, but about noon had a few flying showers of rain. Variation 6 degrees 32 minutes East. Wind East by South and East; course North 87 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 17 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 145 degrees 16 minutes West.

Saturday, 8th. New trade and nice weather, but around noon we had a few brief rain showers. Variation 6 degrees 32 minutes East. Wind East by South and East; course North 87 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 17 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 145 degrees 16 minutes West.

Sunday, 9th. A steady fresh gale and pleasant weather. At 2 p.m. saw Land to the Northward, hauld up for it, and found it to be a double range of low woody islands joined together by reefs, by which means they make one Island in form of an Ellipsis or Oval, in the Middle of which is a Salt water lake. The small Islands and reefs circumscribes or bounds this lake like a Chain; it is therefore called Chain Island.* (* Anaa.) It is in length, North-West and South-East, about 5 Leagues, and in breadth about 5 Miles. The middle of it lies in the Latitude of 17 degrees 23 minutes South, and Longitude 145 degrees 54 minutes West, and West by North 45 Leagues from Bird Island. Variation per Several Azimuths 4 degrees 54 minutes East. Wind East by North to North by East; course West, Northerly; distance 81 miles; latitude 17 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 146 degrees 40 minutes West.

Sunday, 9th. A steady fresh breeze and nice weather. At 2 p.m. spotted land to the north, headed toward it, and discovered it was a double range of low, wooded islands connected by reefs, forming a single island shaped like an ellipse or oval. In the middle, there’s a saltwater lake. The small islands and reefs surround this lake like a chain; that’s why it’s called Chain Island.* (* Anaa.) It’s about 5 leagues long, running northwest to southeast, and about 5 miles wide. The center of the island is located at a latitude of 17 degrees 23 minutes south and a longitude of 145 degrees 54 minutes west, and it's 45 leagues west by north from Bird Island. Variation from several azimuths is 4 degrees 54 minutes east. Wind direction is east by north to north by east; course is west, heading north; distance is 81 miles; latitude is 17 degrees 42 minutes south, and longitude is 146 degrees 40 minutes west.

Monday, 10th. P.M. moderate breezes and cloudy; in the Night, dark, cloudy, unsettled weather, with very much Thunder, Lightning, and rain. A.M. little wind and fair. P.M. variation per Several Azimuths 5 degrees 41 minutes East. At 8 a.m. saw Osnaburg Island* (* Maitea, the easternmost of the Society Islands, which are all high, and a great contrast to the low coral atolls of the Paumotus.) (so called by Captain Wallis, the first discoverer) bearing North-West by West, distance 4 or 5 Leagues. It is a high round Island, and appears to be not above a League in Circuit, and when it bears as above it looks like a high Crown'd Hatt, but when it bears North the Top is more like the roof of a House. It lies in the Latitude of 17 degrees 48 minutes South and Longitude 148 degrees 10 minutes West, and West by South, 44 Leagues, from Chain Island. Wind North-North-West, variable, North-West by North; course South 13 degrees West; distance 67 miles; latitude 18 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 47 minutes West; at noon, Osnaburg Island North by West 1/2 West, 5 leagues.

Monday, 10th. Evening: moderate breezes and cloudy; during the night, dark, cloudy, and unsettled weather with a lot of thunder, lightning, and rain. Morning: light wind and clear. Afternoon: variation by several azimuths was 5 degrees 41 minutes east. At 8 a.m., we spotted Osnaburg Island* (* Maitea, the easternmost of the Society Islands, which are all high and sharply contrast with the low coral atolls of the Paumotus.) (named by Captain Wallis, the first discoverer) to the northwest, about 4 to 5 leagues away. It is a high, round island that appears to be no more than a league in circumference. When seen from that direction, it looks like a tall crowned hat, but when viewed from the north, the top resembles the roof of a house. It is located at a latitude of 17 degrees 48 minutes south and a longitude of 148 degrees 10 minutes west, and is 44 leagues west by south from Chain Island. The wind is coming from the north-northwest, variable, and northwest by north; our course is south 13 degrees west; distance traveled is 67 miles; latitude is 18 degrees 00 minutes south, longitude is 147 degrees 47 minutes west; at noon, Osnaburg Island is north by west half west, 5 leagues away.

[Arrive at Tahiti.]

[Arrive in Tahiti.]

Tuesday, 11th. First part, little wind and cloudy; the remainder, little wind and very Variable; unsettled weather, with some rain. P.M. took several Observations of the sun and moon, which gave the Longitude of the ship to be 148 degrees 18 minutes West, and differs but little from that given by the Log. At 6 a.m. saw King George's Island* (* So named by Captain Wallis. The native name was ascertained by Cook, who spelt it Otaheite. Now known as Tahiti. It is the chief island of the Society Group, and was annexed by the French in 1844.) Extending from West by South 1/2 South to West by North 1/2 North. It appeared very high and Mountainous. Wind variable; course North 66 degrees West; distance 54 miles; latitude 17 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 39 minutes West; Osnaburg Island East 1/2 South, 13 leagues.

Tuesday, the 11th. In the morning, there was a light wind and it was cloudy; later, the wind remained light and very changeable; the weather was unsettled with some rain. In the afternoon, I took several observations of the sun and moon, which determined the ship's longitude to be 148 degrees 18 minutes West, which is very close to what we recorded in the log. At 6 a.m., I saw King George's Island* (* Named by Captain Wallis. The native name was recorded by Cook, who spelled it Otaheite. It is now known as Tahiti. It is the main island of the Society Group and was annexed by the French in 1844.) It was in view from West by South 1/2 South to West by North 1/2 North. It looked very high and mountainous. The wind was changeable; course North 66 degrees West; distance traveled 54 miles; latitude 17 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 39 minutes West; Osnaburg Island is East 1/2 South, 13 leagues away.

Wednesday, 12th. Variable, light Airs all these 24 Hours, and Hot sultry weather. At 5 p.m. King George's Island extending from North-West by West to South-West, distance 6 or 7 Leagues; and at 6 a.m. it bore from South-South-West to West by North, being little wind with Calms. Several of the Natives came off to us in their Canoes, but more to look at us than anything else. We could not prevail with any of them to come on board, and some would not come near the ship. Wind variable; course West; distance 18 miles; latitude 17 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 58 minutes West; at noon, King George's Island, from South to West by North, 5 leagues.

Wednesday, 12th. The air was light and variable all day, with hot and humid weather. At 5 p.m., King George's Island was visible from the North-West by West to South-West, about 6 or 7 leagues away; and at 6 a.m., it was in sight from South-South-West to West by North, with very little wind and calm conditions. Several locals came out in their canoes, but they seemed more interested in watching us than anything else. We couldn't get any of them to come on board, and some wouldn't even come close to the ship. The wind was variable; our course was west; we covered a distance of 18 miles; latitude 17 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 58 minutes West; at noon, King George's Island was seen from South to West by North, 5 leagues away.

Thursday, 13th. The first part Cloudy and Squally, with Showers of rain; remainder, genteel breezes and clear weather. At 4 p.m. the North-East point of Royal Bay West 1/2 North; run under an easy sail all night, and had soundings from 22 to 12 fathoms 2 or 3 Miles from the Shore. At 5 a.m. made sail for the bay, and at 7 anchored in 13 fathoms.* (* Matavai Bay.) At this time we had but very few men upon the sick list, and these had but slite complaints. The Ship's company had in general been very healthy, owing in a great measure to the Sour kroutt, Portable Soup and Malt; the two first were served to the People, the one on Beef Days and the other on Banyan Days. Wort was made of the Malt, and at the discretion of the Surgeon given to every man that had the least simptoms of Scurvy upon him. By this means, and the Care and Vigilance of Mr. Monkhouse, the Surgeon, this disease was prevented from getting a footing in the Ship. The Sour Kroutt, the Men at first would not eat it, until I put it in practice--a method I never once Knew to fail with seamen--and this was to have some of it dressed every day for the Cabin Table, and permitted all the Officers, without exception, to make use of it, and left it to the Option of the men either to take as much as they pleased or none at all; but this practice was not continued above a Week before I found it necessary to put every one on board to an allowance; for such are the Tempers and disposition of Seamen in general that whatever you give them out of the common way--altho' it be ever so much for their good--it will not go down, and you will hear nothing but murmurings against the Man that first invented it; but the moment they see their superiors set a value upon it, it becomes the finest stuff in the world and the inventor an honest fellow. Wind easterly.

Thursday, 13th. The first part of the day was cloudy and stormy with rain showers; the rest of the day had gentle breezes and clear skies. At 4 p.m., the North-East point of Royal Bay was 1/2 North; we sailed comfortably all night, with depths ranging from 22 to 12 fathoms 2 or 3 miles from the shore. At 5 a.m., we set sail for the bay, and by 7 a.m. we were anchored in 13 fathoms.* (* Matavai Bay.) At this time, we had very few men on the sick list, and those who were had only minor complaints. The crew had generally been quite healthy, largely due to the sauerkraut, portable soup, and malt; the first two were served to the crew, one on beef days and the other on banyan days. Wort was made from the malt, and at the surgeon's discretion, it was given to every man showing any symptoms of scurvy. Thanks to this approach and the care and vigilance of Mr. Monkhouse, the surgeon, we managed to keep the disease from taking hold on the ship. The men initially wouldn't eat the sauerkraut until I implemented a method I've never known to fail with sailors—by having some of it cooked every day for the cabin table, allowing all officers, without exception, to use it, and leaving it up to the crew to take as much as they wanted, or none at all. However, I quickly found it necessary to put everyone on a set allowance, as sailors tend to resist anything out of the ordinary, no matter how beneficial it may be, and they will complain about the person who first introduced it. Yet, the moment they see their superiors valuing it, it suddenly becomes the best thing ever, and the inventor is regarded as a good guy. Wind was easterly.


CHAPTER 3. TAHITI.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES, ETC., AT GEORGE'S ISLAND.

[At Tahiti.]

[In Tahiti.]

NOTE. The way of reckoning the day in Sea Journals is from Noon to Noon, but as the most material transaction at this Island must hapen in the Day time, this method will be attended with ill conveniences in inserting the transactions of each day; for this reason I shall during our stay at this Island, but no longer, reckon the day according to the Civil account that is to begin and end at Midnight.

NOTE. In Sea Journals, the day is counted from Noon to Noon, but since the most important activities at this Island will take place during the daytime, this method will make it difficult to record the events of each day. For this reason, while we are at this Island, but not beyond that, I will count the day using the Civil method, which starts and ends at Midnight.

We had no sooner come to an Anchor in Royal Bay, as before-mentioned, than a great number of the Natives in their Canoes came off to the Ship and brought with them Cocoa Nuts, etc.; these they seem'd to set a great value upon. Amongst those that came off to the Ship was an elderly man whose Name was Owhaa, him the Gentlemen that had been here before in the Dolphin* (* Lieutenant Gore and Mr. Molineux, the Master.) knew and had often spoke of as one that had been of Service to them. This man (together with some others) I took on board and made much of, thinking that he might on some occasions be of use to us. As our stay at this place was not likely to be very short, I thought it very necessary that some order should be observed in Traficking with the Natives, that such Merchandize as we had on board for that purpose might continue to bear a proper value, and not leave it to everyone's own particular fancy, which could not fail to bring on Confusion and Quarrels between us and the Natives, and would infallibly lessen the value of such Articles as we had to trafick with. In Order to prevent this, the following rules were ordered to be Observed; viz.:--

We had barely anchored in Royal Bay, as mentioned before, when a large number of locals in their canoes approached the ship, bringing Cocoa Nuts and other items, which they seemed to value highly. Among those who came to the ship was an elderly man named Owhaa, who the gentlemen who had visited before on the Dolphin (Lieutenant Gore and Mr. Molineux, the Master) recognized and spoke of as someone who had been helpful to them. I took this man, along with a few others, on board and treated them well, thinking he might prove useful to us at times. Since our stay in this area was expected to be lengthy, I felt it was essential to establish some order in trading with the locals so that the goods we had on board for this purpose would retain their proper value and not become subject to individual whims, which could only lead to confusion and disputes between us and the locals, ultimately diminishing the value of our trading items. To prevent this, the following rules were established:

Rules to be observed by every person in or belonging to His Majesty's Bark the Endeavour for the better Establishing a regular and uniform Trade for Provisions, etc., with the Inhabitants of George's Island:--

Rules to be followed by everyone in or associated with His Majesty's Bark the Endeavour to better establish a regular and uniform trade for provisions, etc., with the inhabitants of George's Island:--

1. To endeavour by every fair means to Cultivate a Friendship with the Natives, and to treat them with all imaginable humanity.

1. To try by every reasonable way to build a friendship with the locals and to treat them with all possible kindness.

2. A Proper Person or Persons will be appointed to Trade with the Natives for all manner of Provisions, Fruits, and other Productions of the Earth; and no Officer or Seaman or other person belonging to the Ship, excepting such as are so appointed, shall Trade or offer to Trade for any sort of Provisions, Fruit or other Productions of the Earth, unless they have my leave so to do.

2. A designated person or group will be chosen to trade with the locals for all kinds of supplies, fruits, and other goods from the land; and no officer, crew member, or anyone else associated with the ship, except for those appointed, shall trade or attempt to trade for any supplies, fruits, or other goods from the land without my permission to do so.

3. Every Person employ'd on shore on any duty whatsoever is strictly to attend to the same, and if by neglect he looseth any of His Arms or working Tools, or suffers them to be stole, the full value thereof will be charged against his pay, according to the Custom of the Navy in such Cases, and he shall receive such further punishment as the nature of the Offence may deserve.

3. Everyone working on shore for any duty must pay full attention to their responsibilities, and if they lose any of their weapons or tools through negligence, or allow them to be stolen, the full value will be deducted from their pay, following Navy customs in these situations. They will also face additional punishment based on the severity of the offense.

4. The same Penalty will be inflicted upon every person who is found to Embezzle, Trade, or Offer to Trade with any of the Ship's Stores of what Nature so ever.

4. The same penalty will be applied to anyone who is found to embezzle, trade, or offer to trade any of the ship's supplies, regardless of what they are.

5. No sort of Iron or anything that is made of Iron, or any sort of Cloth or other useful or necessary Articles, are to be given in Exchange for anything but Provisions.

5. No type of iron or anything made of iron, or any kind of cloth or other useful or necessary items, should be exchanged for anything other than provisions.

J.C.

J.C.

As soon as the Ship was properly secured I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and the other Gentlemen,* (* Cook generally uses this term for the civilians on board.) with a Party of Men under Arms; we took along with us Owhaa--who took us to the place where the Dolphin watered, and made signs to us as well as we could understand that we might Occupy that ground, but it hapned not to be fit for our purpose. No one of the Natives made the least opposition at our landing, but came to us with all imaginable Marks of Friendship and Submission. We Afterwards made a Circuit through the Woods, and then came on board. We did not find the inhabitants to be numerous, and we imagin'd that several of them had fled from their habitations upon our Arrival in the Bay.

As soon as the ship was secured, I went ashore with Mr. Banks and the other gentlemen, along with a group of armed men. We took Owhaa with us, who showed us the spot where the Dolphin had taken on water and indicated, as best as we could understand, that we could use that area, but it turned out to be unsuitable for our needs. None of the natives opposed our landing; instead, they approached us with gestures of friendship and submission. We then took a route through the woods before heading back on board. We noticed that the inhabitants weren't very numerous and guessed that several had fled their homes when we arrived in the bay.

Friday, 14th. This morning we had a great many Canoes about the Ship; the most of them came from the Westward, and brought nothing with them but a few Cocoa Nuts, etc. Two that appeared to be Chiefs we had on board, together with several others, for it was a hard matter to keep them out of the Ship, as they Climb like Munkeys; but it was still harder to keep them from Stealing but everything that came within their reach; in this they are Prodigious Expert. I made each of these two Chiefs a present of a Hatchet, things that they seemed mostly to value. As soon as we had partly got clear of these People I took 2 Boats and went to the Westward, all the Gentlemen being along with me. My design was to see if there was not a more commodious Harbour, and to try the disposition of the Natives, having along with us the 2 Chiefs above mentioned; the first place we landed at was in great Canoe Harbour (so called by Captain Wallis); here the Natives Flocked about us in great numbers, and in as friendly a manner as we could wish, only that they show'd a great inclination to Pick our Pockets. We were conducted to a Chief, who for distinction sake we called Hurcules. After staying a short time with him, and distributing a few Presents about us, we proceeded farther, and came to a Chief who I shall call Lycurgus; this man entertained us with broil'd fish, Cocoa Nutts, etc., with great Hospitality, and all the time took great care to tell us to take care of our Pockets, as a great number of People had crowded about us. Notwithstanding the care we took, Dr. Solander and Dr. Monkhouse had each of them their Pockets picked: the one of his spy glass and the other of his snuff Box. As soon as Lycurgus was made acquainted with the Theft he dispers'd the people in a moment, and the method he made use of was to lay hold on the first thing that came in his way and throw it at them, and happy was he or she that could get first out of his way. He seem'd very much concern'd for what had hapned, and by way of recompence offered us but everything that was in his House; but we refused to accept of anything, and made signs to him that we only wanted the things again. He had already sent people out after them, and it was not long before they were return'd. We found the Natives very numerous wherever we came, and from what we could judge seemed very peacably inclin'd. About six o'Clock in the evening we return'd on board, very well satisfied with our little Excursion.

Friday, 14th. This morning, we had a lot of canoes around the ship; most of them came from the west and only brought a few coconuts, etc. We had two men who seemed to be chiefs on board, along with several others, as it was hard to keep them off the ship since they climbed like monkeys. It was even harder to stop them from stealing everything they could reach; they were incredibly skilled at it. I gave each of the two chiefs a hatchet, which they seemed to value most. Once we managed to get free from these people, I took two boats and headed west, with all the gentlemen accompanying me. My plan was to see if there was a better harbor and to gauge the natives' disposition, bringing along the two chiefs I mentioned earlier. The first place we landed was in Great Canoe Harbour (as Captain Wallis called it); here, the natives gathered around us in large numbers and were as friendly as we could hope, though they showed a strong tendency to pick our pockets. We were led to a chief that we named Hercules for distinction. After spending some time with him and giving out a few gifts, we moved on to another chief whom I’ll call Lycurgus; he treated us to grilled fish, coconuts, etc., with great hospitality, while repeatedly warning us to watch our pockets, as many people crowded around us. Despite our precautions, Dr. Solander and Dr. Monkhouse both had their pockets picked: Dr. Solander lost his spyglass and Dr. Monkhouse his snuffbox. As soon as Lycurgus learned of the theft, he scattered the crowd instantly, using the first thing he could grab to throw at them, and whoever managed to get away quickly was lucky. He seemed very upset about what had happened and, as compensation, offered us everything in his house, but we refused, signaling to him that we only wanted our things back. He had already sent people searching for them, and it wasn’t long before they returned. We found the natives to be very numerous wherever we went, and from what we could tell, they seemed quite peaceful. By about six o'clock in the evening, we returned on board, very satisfied with our little excursion.

Saturday, 15th. Winds at East during the day, in the Night a light breeze off the land; and as I apprehend it be usual here for the Trade wind to blow during a great part of the day from the Eastern Board, and to have it Calm or light breezes from the land that is Southerly during the night with fair weather, I shall only mention the wind and weather when they deviate from this rule. This morning several of the Chiefs we had seen Yesterday came on board, and brought with them Hogs, Bread fruit, etc., and for these we gave them Hatchets, Linnen, and such things as they valued. Having not met with yesterday a more Convenient situation for every purpose we wanted than the place we now are, I therefore, without delay, resolved to pitch upon some spot upon the North-East point of the Bay, properly situated for observing the Transit of Venus, and at the same time under the command of the Ship's Guns, and there to throw up a small fort for our defence. Accordingly I went ashore with a party of men, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Mr. Green. We took along with us one of Mr. Banks's Tents, and after we had fix'd upon a place fit for our purpose we set up the Tent and marked out the ground we intended to Occupy. By this time a number of the Natives had got collected together about us, seemingly only to look on, as not one of them had any weapon, either Offensive or defensive. I would suffer none to come within the lines I had marked out, excepting one who appeared to be a chief and old Owhaa--to these 2 men we endeavour'd to explain, as well as we could, that we wanted that ground to Sleep upon such a number of nights and then we should go away. Whether they understood us or no is uncertain, but no one appeared the least displeased at what we was about; indeed the Ground we had fixed upon was of no use to them, being part of the sandy Beach upon the shore of the Bay, and not near to any of their Habitations. It being too late in the day to do anything more, a party with a petty officer was left to guard the Tent, while we with another party took a Walk into the woods, and with us most of the natives. We had but just crossed the River when Mr. Banks shott three Ducks at one shott, which surprised them so much that most of them fell down as though they had been shott likewise. I was in hopes this would have had some good effect, but the event did not prove it, for we had not been long from the Tent before the natives again began to gather about, and one of them more daring than the rest pushed one of the Centinels down, snatched the Musket out of his hand and made a push at him, and then made off, and with him all the rest. Immediately upon this the Officer ordered the party to fire, and the Man who took the musket was shot Dead before he had got far from the Tent, but the musquet was carried quite off when this hapned. I and Mr. Banks with the other party was about half a Mile off, returning out of the woods, upon hearing the firing of Muskets, and the Natives leaving us at the same time, we Suspected that something was the matter and hastened our march, but before we arrived the whole was over, and every one of the Natives fled except old Owhaa, who stuck by us the whole time, and I believe from the first he either knew or had some suspicion that the People would attempt something at the Tent, as he was very much against our going into the Woods out of sight of the Tent. However, he might have other reasons, for Mr. Hicks, being ashore the day before, the natives would not permit him to go into the Woods. This made me resolved to go and see whether they meant to prescribe bounds to us or no. Old Owhaa, as I have said before, was the only one of the Natives that stayed by us, and by his means we prevail'd on about 20 of them to come to the Tent and there sit down with us, and Endeavour'd by every means in our power to Convince them that the Man was kill'd for taking away the Musket, and that we still would be friends with them. At sunset they left us seemingly satisfied, and we struck our Tent and went on board.

Saturday, 15th. The winds were coming from the East during the day, and at night there was a light breeze coming off the land. I believe it’s common here for the trade winds to blow from the east for most of the day, and at night, it tends to be calm or have light breezes from the south, along with fair weather. So, I’ll only mention the wind and weather when they differ from this pattern. This morning, several of the chiefs we had seen yesterday came on board and brought with them hogs, breadfruit, and other goods. In exchange, we gave them hatchets, linen, and other items they valued. Since we hadn’t found a better location yesterday for our needs than where we currently are, I decided to set up camp on the northeast point of the bay, which was suitable for observing the transit of Venus and also under the protection of the ship's guns. We went ashore with a group of men, including Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Mr. Green. We took one of Mr. Banks's tents, and after finding a suitable spot, we set up the tent and marked the area we intended to use. By then, a number of natives had gathered around us, apparently just to watch, as none of them had any weapons. I allowed no one to come inside the lines I had marked, except for one man who seemed to be a chief and an older man named Owhaa. We tried to explain to the two of them, as best as we could, that we needed the area to sleep for a few nights and that we would then leave. It was unclear if they understood us, but no one seemed upset about what we were doing; in fact, the ground we had chosen was of no use to them, being part of the sandy beach on the shore of the bay and not near any of their homes. Since it was too late in the day to do anything else, we left a party with a petty officer to guard the tent while the rest of us took a walk into the woods, accompanied by most of the natives. We had just crossed the river when Mr. Banks shot three ducks with one shot, which surprised the natives so much that most of them fell to the ground as if they had been shot as well. I hoped this would have a positive effect, but it didn’t turn out that way, as we hadn't been away from the tent for long before the natives started to gather again, and one of them, bolder than the rest, pushed one of the sentries down, grabbed the musket from his hand, lunged at him, and then ran off with the others. Immediately, the officer ordered the party to fire, and the man who took the musket was shot dead before he got far from the tent, but the musket was taken away completely. I and Mr. Banks were about half a mile away, coming back from the woods, and upon hearing the gunfire and seeing the natives flee, we suspected something was wrong and quickened our pace, but by the time we arrived, everything was over, and every native had fled except for old Owhaa, who stayed with us. I believe he either knew or suspected that the others would try something at the tent because he was very much opposed to us going into the woods out of sight of the tent. However, he might have had other reasons, as Mr. Hicks, who had been ashore the day before, wasn’t allowed by the natives to go into the woods. This led me to decide to see if they intended to limit our movements. Old Owhaa, as I mentioned, was the only native who remained with us, and through him, we managed to persuade about 20 of them to come to the tent and sit down with us. We did our best to convince them that the man was killed for taking the musket, and that we still wanted to be friends with them. At sunset, they left us seemingly satisfied, and we packed up our tent and went back on board.

Sunday, 16th. This day worked the Ship nearer the Shore and moored her in such a manner as to command all the shore of the North-East part of the Bay, but more particularly the place where we intended to Erect a Fort. Punished Richard Hutchins, seaman, with 12 lashes for disobeying commands. Several of the Natives came down to the shore of the Bay, but not one of them came off to the Ship during the whole day. In the evening I went on shore with only a Boat's crew and some of the Gentlemen. The Natives gathered about us to the Number of about 30 or 40, and brought us Cocoa Nuts, etc., and seemed as friendly as ever.

Sunday, 16th. Today, we brought the ship closer to shore and anchored it in a way that allowed us to monitor the entire northeastern part of the bay, especially the spot where we planned to build a fort. We punished Richard Hutchins, a seaman, with 12 lashes for disobeying orders. Several locals came down to the bay, but not a single one came aboard the ship all day. In the evening, I went ashore with just a boat crew and some gentlemen. The locals gathered around us, numbering about 30 or 40, and brought us coconuts and other items, appearing as friendly as ever.

Monday, 17th. At two o'Clock this morning, departed this life, Mr. Alex Buchan, Landskip Draftsman to Mr. Banks, a Gentleman well skill'd in his profession and one that will be greatly missed in the Course of this Voyage. He had long been subject to a disorder in his Bowels, which had more than once brought him to the very point of Death, and was at one time subject to fits, of one of which he was taken on Saturday morning; this brought on his former disorder, which put a Period to his life. Mr. Banks thought it not so advisable to Inter the Body ashore in a place where we were utter strangers to the Custom of the Natives on such occasions; it was therefore sent out to sea and committed to that Element with all the decency the Circumstance of the place would admit of. This morning several of the Chiefs from the westward made us a Visit: they brought with them Emblems of Peace, which are Young Plantain Trees. These they put on board the Ship before they would venture themselves. They brought us a present of 2 Hogs (an Article we find here very Scarce) and some Bread Fruit; for these they had Hatchets and other things. In the afternoon we set up one of the Ship's Tents ashore, and Mr. Green and myself stay'd there the night to observe an eclipse of Jupiter's first Satilite, which we was hinder'd from seeing by Clouds.

Monday, 17th. At two o'clock this morning, Mr. Alex Buchan, the landscape draftsman for Mr. Banks, passed away. He was very skilled in his profession and will be greatly missed during this voyage. He had long suffered from a bowel disorder that had nearly taken his life more than once, and he had also experienced fits, one of which occurred on Saturday morning; this triggered his previous condition, ultimately ending his life. Mr. Banks thought it best not to bury the body on land where we were completely unfamiliar with the natives' customs regarding such matters; therefore, it was sent out to sea and laid to rest in the water with as much dignity as the circumstances allowed. This morning, several chiefs from the west visited us, bringing symbols of peace, which were young plantain trees. They placed these on board the ship before coming aboard themselves. They also offered us a gift of two hogs (which we find very rare here) and some breadfruit; in exchange, they requested hatchets and other items. In the afternoon, we set up one of the ship's tents on shore, and Mr. Green and I stayed there overnight to observe an eclipse of Jupiter's first satellite, but clouds obstructed our view.

Tuesday, 18th. Cloudy weather with some showers of rain. This morning took as many people out of the Ship as could possibly be spared, and set about Erecting a Fort. Some were employ'd in throughing up intrenchment, while others was cutting facines, Picquets, etc. The Natives were so far from hindering us that several of them assisted in bringing the Picquets and facines out of the woods, and seemed quite unconcern'd at what we was about. The wood we made use of for this occasion we purchased of them, and we cut no Tree down before we had first obtained their Consent. By this time all the Ship's sails were unbent and the Armourer's Forge set up to repair the Ironwork, etc. Served fresh Pork to the Ship's Company to-day for the first time. This is like to be a very scarce Article with us, but as to Bread fruit, Cocoa Nutts and Plaintains, the Natives supply us with as much as we can destroy.

Tuesday, 18th. It was cloudy with some rain showers. This morning, we took as many people off the ship as we could spare and started building a fort. Some were busy digging trenches while others were cutting fascines, pickets, and so on. The natives didn't hinder us at all; in fact, several helped us bring the pickets and fascines out of the woods and seemed completely unconcerned about what we were doing. We purchased the wood we used from them, and we didn’t cut down any trees without first getting their permission. By this time, all the sails were taken down and the armorer's forge was set up for repairing the ironwork. Today, we served fresh pork to the ship's crew for the first time. It's likely to be a rare item for us, but as for breadfruit, coconuts, and plantains, the natives provide us with as much as we can use.

Wednesday, 19th. This morning Lycurgus, whose real name is Toobouratomita, came with his family from the Westward in order, from what we could understand, to live near us. He brought with him the cover of a House, with several other Materials for building one. We intend to requite the confidence this man seems to put in us by treating him with all imaginable kindness. Got on shore some Empty Casks, which we placed in a double row along the Bank of the River, by way of a breast work on that side.

Wednesday, 19th. This morning, Lycurgus, whose real name is Toobouratomita, arrived with his family from the West, apparently to settle near us. He brought along the covering for a house, along with several other materials for building one. We plan to repay the trust he seems to have in us by treating him with all possible kindness. We got some empty barrels ashore, which we arranged in a double row along the bank of the river as a barrier on that side.

Thursday, 20th. Wind at South-East and Squally, with rain. All hands employ'd on shore, and nothing remarkable, excepting a Hog weighing about 90 pound was brought alongside the Ship for Sale, but those who brought it would not part with it for anything we could offer them but a Carpenter's broad axe, and this was what we could not part with; they carried it away. Thus we see those very People who but 2 years ago prefer'd a spike Nail to an Axe of any Sort, have so far learnt the use of them that they will not part with a Pig of 10 or 12 pounds weight for anything under a Hatchet, and even those of an inferior or small sort are of no great esteem with them, and small Nails such as 10 penny, 20 penny, or any under 40 penny, are of no value at all; but beads, particularly white cut glass beads, are much valued by them. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander lays ashore to-night for the first time, their Markee's being set up within the Walls of the Fort and fit for their reception.

Thursday, 20th. Wind from the Southeast and stormy, with rain. Everyone was working onshore, and nothing notable happened, except a pig weighing about 90 pounds was brought next to the ship for sale. However, those who brought it wouldn’t trade it for anything we had to offer, except for a carpenter’s broad axe, which we couldn’t give up; they took it away. It’s interesting to see that just 2 years ago, these same people preferred a spike nail over any kind of axe, but now they’ve learned enough about tools that they won’t trade a pig weighing 10 or 12 pounds for anything less than a hatchet. Even those that are smaller or of lower quality aren’t held in high regard, while smaller nails like 10 penny, 20 penny, or any under 40 penny are worthless to them. However, they highly value beads, especially white cut glass beads. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander stayed on shore tonight for the first time, as their marquee was set up within the fort walls and ready for them.

Friday, 21st. Got the Copper Oven ashore and fixed it in the bank of the breastwork. Yesterday, as Mr. Green and Dr. Monkhouse were taking a walk, they happened to meet with the Body of the Man we had shott, as the Natives made them fully understand; the manner in which the body was interred being a little extraordinary. I went to-day, with some others, to see it. Close by the House wherein he resided when living was built a small shed, but whether for the purpose or no I cannot say, for it was in all respects like some of the Sheds or Houses they live in. This shed was about 14 or 16 feet long, 10 or 12 broad, and of a proportionable height. One end was wholy open, the other end and two sides was partly inclosed with a kind of wicker'd work. In this Shed lay the Corps, upon a Bier or frame of wood, with a matted bottom, like a Cott frame used at Sea, and Supported by 4 Posts about 5 feet from the Ground. The body was cover'd with a Matt, and over that a white Cloth; alongside of the Body lay a wooden Club, one of their Weapons of War. The Head of the Corps lay next the close end of the Shed, and at this end lay 2 Cocoa Nutt Shells, such as they sometimes use to carry water in; at the other end of the Shed was a Bunch of Green leaves, with some dry'd twigs tied all together and stuck in the Ground, and a stone lying by them as big as a Cocoa Nutt. Near to these lay a young Plaintain Tree, such as they use as Emblems of Peace, and by it lay a stone Axe. At the open end of the Shed was stuck upwright in the ground the Stem of a Plaintain Tree about 5 feet high, on the Top of which stood a Cocoa Nutt shell full of fresh water, and on the side of the post hung a small Bag, wherein was a few pieces of Bread Fruit roasted ready for eating. Some of the pieces were fresh and others Stale. The Natives did not seem to like that we should go near the body, and stood at a little distance themselves while we examin'd these matters, and appeared to be pleased when we came away. It certainly was no very agreeable place, for it stunk intollerably, and yet it was not above 10 yards from the Huts wherein several of the living resided. The first day we landed we saw the Skeleton of a human being laying in this manner under a shade that was just big enough to cover it, and some days after that, when some of the Gentlemen went with a design to examine it more narrowly, it was gone. It was at this time thought that this manner of interring their Dead was not common to all ranks of People, as this was the first we had seen Except the Skeleton just mentioned; but various were the opinions concerning the Provisions, etc., laid about the Dead. Upon the whole, it should seem that these people not only believe in a Supreem being, but in a future state also, and this must be meant either as an Offering to some Deitie or for the use of the Dead in the other world; but this latter is not very probable, as there appeared to be no Priest Craft in the thing, for whatever Provisions were put there it appeared very plain to us that there it remain'd until it consumed away of itself. It is most likely that we shall see more of this before we leave the Island, but if it is a Religious ceremony we may not be able to understand it, for the Misteries of most Religions are very Dark and not easily understood, even by those who profess them.

Friday, 21st. We brought the Copper Oven ashore and set it up in the bank of the breastwork. Yesterday, while Mr. Green and Dr. Monkhouse were taking a walk, they stumbled upon the body of the man we shot, as the locals made clear to them; the way the body was buried was quite unusual. Today, I went with a few others to check it out. Near the house where he lived, a small shed was constructed, but I can't say if it was for this purpose or not, as it resembled some of the sheds or houses they live in. This shed was about 14 or 16 feet long, 10 or 12 feet wide, and had a proportional height. One end was completely open, while the other end and two sides were partially enclosed with a type of wickerwork. Inside this shed lay the body on a bier or wooden frame with a matted bottom, similar to a cot frame used at sea, elevated by four posts about 5 feet off the ground. The body was covered with a mat and, on top of that, a white cloth; next to the body lay a wooden club, one of their weapons. The head of the body was at the closed end of the shed, where there were also two coconut shells, which they sometimes use to carry water. At the other end of the shed, there was a bunch of green leaves tied together with some dried twigs stuck in the ground, along with a stone about the size of a coconut. Nearby lay a young plantain tree, which they use as a symbol of peace, along with a stone axe. At the open end of the shed, the stem of a plantain tree about 5 feet high was stuck upright in the ground, topped with a coconut shell full of fresh water, and hanging from the side of the post was a small bag containing a few pieces of roasted breadfruit ready to eat. Some pieces were fresh, while others were stale. The locals didn’t seem to want us to get too close to the body, standing a bit away while we examined these things, and they appeared relieved when we left. It certainly wasn’t a pleasant place; it smelled awful, and yet it was only about 10 yards from the huts where several living people stayed. On the first day we landed, we saw a skeleton lying in this way under a shade just big enough to cover it, and a few days later, when some of the gentlemen went to examine it more closely, it was gone. At this time, it was thought that this way of burying their dead was not common to all social classes, as this was the first instance we had seen aside from the mentioned skeleton; however, opinions varied concerning the provisions, etc., left around the dead. Overall, it seems these people not only believe in a supreme being but also in an afterlife; this must signify either an offering to some deity or provisions for the dead in the next world. However, the latter seems unlikely, as there appeared to be no priestly influence in this practice. From what we could tell, any provisions left there stayed until they naturally decomposed. It's very likely we'll witness more of this before we leave the island, but if it's a religious ceremony, we might not fully understand it, as the mysteries of many religions are quite murky and not easily grasped, even by their followers.

Saturday, 22nd, to Thursday, 27th. Nothing worthy of Note Hapned. The people were Continually at work upon the Fort,* (* Near the site of this Fort is still a Tamarind Tree, planted by Captain Cook. All visitors to Tahiti go to see "Cook's Tamarind.") and the Natives were so far reconciled to us that they rather assisted us than not. This day we mounted 6 Swivels at the Fort, which was now nearly finished. This struck the Natives with some fear, and some fishermen who lived upon the point moved farther off, and old Owhaa told us by signs that after 4 days we should fire Great Guns from the Ship. There were some other Circumstances co-operated with this man's prophecy, whether an opinion hath prevailed amongst them that after that time we intend to fire upon them, or that they intend to Attack us, we know not: the first we do not intend unless the latter takes place, which is highly improbable.

Saturday, the 22nd, to Thursday, the 27th. Nothing noteworthy happened. The people were constantly working on the Fort,* (* Near the site of this Fort is still a Tamarind Tree, planted by Captain Cook. All visitors to Tahiti go to see "Cook's Tamarind.") and the Natives had become so reconciled to us that they were more helpful than not. On this day, we mounted 6 swivel guns at the Fort, which was now nearly finished. This made the Natives somewhat fearful, and some fishermen who lived nearby moved further away. Old Owhaa communicated to us through signs that after 4 days, we would be firing big guns from the ship. There were some other factors that supported this man's prediction, whether it's because they believe we plan to fire on them, or that they plan to attack us, we don’t know: we certainly do not intend to fire unless the latter happens, which is highly unlikely.

Friday, 28th. This morning a great number of the natives came to us in their Canoes from differant parts of the Island, several of whom we had not seen before. One of these was the Woman called by the Dolphins the Queen of this Island; she first went to Mr. Banks's tent at the fort, where she was not known, till the Master, happening to go ashore, who knew her, and brought her on board with 2 Men and several Women, who seem'd to be all of her family. I made them all some presents or other, but to Oberiea (for that is this Woman's name) I gave several things, in return for which, as soon as I went on shore with her, she gave me a Hog and several Bunches of plaintains. These she caused to be carried from her Canoes up to the Fort in a kind of Procession, she and I bringing up the rear. This Woman is about 40 years of Age, and, like most of the other Women, very Masculine. She is head or chief of her own family or Tribe, but to all appearance hath no Authority over the rest of the Inhabitants, whatever she might have when the Dolphin was here. Hercules, whose real Name is Tootaha, is, to all appearance, the Chief Man of the Island, and hath generally visited us twice a week since we have been here, and came always attended by a number of Canoes and people; and at those times we were sure to have a supply, more or less, of everything the Island afforded, both from himself and from those that came with him, and it is a Chance thing that we get a Hog at any other time. He was with us at this Time, and did not appear very well pleased at the Notice we took of Oberiea.

Friday, 28th. This morning, a large number of natives came to us in their canoes from different parts of the island, many of whom we hadn’t seen before. One of them was the woman known as the Queen of this Island, called by the dolphins; she first visited Mr. Banks's tent at the fort, where she wasn't recognized until the master happened to go ashore, recognized her, and brought her on board with two men and several women, who all seemed to be part of her family. I gave them all some gifts, but to Oberiea (this is the woman’s name), I gave several items, for which, as soon as I went ashore with her, she gifted me a hog and several bunches of plantains. She arranged for these to be carried from her canoes to the fort in a sort of procession, with her and me walking at the end. This woman is about 40 years old and, like most of the other women, has a very masculine presence. She is the head of her own family or tribe but seemingly has no authority over the rest of the inhabitants, whatever power she might have had when the dolphin was here. Hercules, whose real name is Tootaha, appears to be the chief man of the island and has generally visited us twice a week since we arrived, always accompanied by several canoes and people; during those visits, we could count on receiving a good supply of everything the island had to offer, both from him and from those with him, and it’s quite rare that we get a hog at any other time. He was with us this time and didn’t seem very pleased with the attention we gave to Oberiea.

Saturday, 29th. This day got the 4 guns out of the Hold, and Mounted 2 of them on the Quarter Deck and the other 2 in the Fort on the Bank of the River.

Saturday, 29th. Today, we got 4 guns out of the hold and mounted 2 of them on the quarter deck and the other 2 in the fort on the riverbank.

Sunday, 30th. This being the day that Owhaa told us that we should fire our Guns, no one of us went from the Fort; however, the day passed over without any Visible alteration in the behaviour of any one of the Natives.

Sunday, 30th. This was the day that Owhaa told us we should fire our guns, but none of us left the fort; still, the day went by without any noticeable change in the behavior of any of the natives.

[May 1769.]

[May 1769.]

Monday, 1st May. This morning Tootaha came on board the Ship, and was very Desireous of seeing into every Chest and Drawer that was in the Cabin. I satisfied his curiosity so far as to open most of those that belong'd to me. He saw several things that he took a fancy to, and collected them together; but at last he Cast his eyes upon the Adze I had from Mr. Stephens* (* The Secretary of the Admiralty.) that was made in imitation of one of their Stone Adzes or Axes.* (* The stone adzes of Tahiti were of excellent workmanship.) The Moment he lays his hands upon it he of his own accord put away everything he had got before, and ask'd me if I would give him that, which I very readily did, and he went away without asking for any one thing more, which I by experience knew was a sure sign that he was well pleased with what he had got.

Monday, May 1st. This morning, Tootaha came on board the ship and was eager to look into every chest and drawer in the cabin. I satisfied his curiosity by opening most of the ones belonging to me. He saw several items he liked and gathered them together, but eventually, he spotted the adze I got from Mr. Stephens (the Secretary of the Admiralty) that was designed to imitate one of their stone adzes or axes. The moment he picked it up, he set aside everything else he had collected and asked me if I would give him that, which I gladly did. He left without asking for anything else, which I knew from experience was a sure sign that he was happy with what he had received.

This day one of the Natives, who appeared to be a Chief, dined with us, as he had done some days before; but then there were always some Women present, and one or another of them put the Victuals into his Mouth, but this day there hapned to be none to Perform that Office. When he was help'd to victuals and desir'd to eat, he sat in the Chair like a Statute, without once attempting to put a Morsel to his mouth, and would certainly have gone without his dinner if one of the Servants had not fed him. We have often found the women very officious in feeding us, from which it would seem that it is the Custom on some occasions for them to feed the Chiefs. However, this is the only instance of that kind we have seen, or that they could not help themselves as well as any of us.

Today, one of the Natives, who looked like a Chief, had lunch with us, just like he had a few days ago. But back then, there were always some women around, and one of them would feed him. Today, though, there were no women to help him. When he was offered food and asked to eat, he sat there like a statue, without even trying to bring a bite to his mouth, and he definitely would have gone without lunch if one of the servants hadn’t fed him. We’ve often noticed that the women are very eager to feed us, which seems to suggest that it’s customary for them to feed the Chiefs on certain occasions. Still, this is the only instance we’ve witnessed where they couldn’t manage to feed themselves like the rest of us.

This afternoon we set up the Observatory and took the Astronomical Quadrant ashore for the first time, together with some other Instruments, the fort being now finished and made as Tenantable as the time, Nature, and situation of the Ground and Materials we had to work upon would admit of. The North and South parts consisted of a Bank of Earth 4 1/2 feet high on the inside, and a Ditch without, 10 feet broad and 6 feet deep; on the West side facing the Bay a Bank of Earth 4 feet high, and Palisades upon that, but no Ditch, the works being at high-water mark. On the East side upon the Bank of the river was placed a double row of Casks, and, as this was the weakest side, the 2 four Pounders were planted there, and the whole was defended, beside these 2 Guns, with 6 Swivels, and generally about 45 Men with small Arms, including the Officers and Gentlemen who resided ashore. I now thought myself perfectly secure from anything these people would attempt.

This afternoon, we set up the Observatory and brought the Astronomical Quadrant ashore for the first time, along with some other instruments. The fort is now completed and made as livable as the time, nature, and the condition of the ground and materials allowed. The North and South sides consist of an earth bank 4.5 feet high on the inside, with a ditch outside that's 10 feet wide and 6 feet deep. On the West side facing the Bay, there's a 4-foot-high earth bank with palisades on top, but no ditch, as the works are at high-water mark. On the East side, along the riverbank, is a double row of casks, and since this was the weakest side, we placed two four-pounders there. The whole area is defended, in addition to these two guns, by six swivels and approximately 45 men with small arms, including the officers and gentlemen who lived ashore. I felt completely secure from any attempts these people might make.

Tuesday, 2nd. This morning, about 9 o'Clock, when Mr. Green and I went to set up the Quadrant, it was not to be found. It had never been taken out of the Packing Case (which was about 18 Inches square) since it came from Mr. Bird, the Maker; and the whole was pretty heavy, so that it was a matter of Astonishment to us all how it could be taken away, as a Centinal stood the whole night within 5 Yards of the door of the Tent, where it was put, together with several other Instruments; but none of them was missing but this. However, it was not long before we got information that one of the Natives had taken it away and carried it to the Eastward. Immediately a resolution was taken to detain all the large Canoes that were in the Bay, and to seize upon Tootaha and some others of the principal people, and keep them in Custody until the Quadrant was produced; but this last we did not think proper immediately to put in Execution, as we had only Oberiea in our power, and the detaining of her by force would have alarm'd all the rest. In the meantime, Mr. Banks (who is always very alert upon all occasions wherein the Natives are concern'd) and Mr. Green went into the Woods to enquire of Toobouratomita which way and where the Quadrant was gone. I very soon was inform'd that these 3 was gone to the Eastward in quest of it, and some time after I followed myself with a small party of Men; but before I went away I gave orders that if Tootaha came either to the Ship or the Fort he was not to be detain'd, for I found he had no hand in taking away the Quadrant, and that there was almost a Certainty of getting it again. I met Mr. Banks and Mr. Green about 4 miles from the Fort, returning with the Quadrant. This was about Sun set, and we all got back to the Fort about 8 o'Clock, where I found Tootaha in Custody, and a number of the Natives crowding about the Gate of the Fort. My going into the Woods with a party of Arm'd men so alarmed the Natives that in the evening they began to move off with their Effects, and a Double Canoe putting off from the Bottom of the Bay was ohserv'd by the Ship, and a Boat sent after her. In this Canoe hapned to be Tootaha, and as soon as our Boat came up with her, he and all the people that were in the Canoe jump'd overboard, and he only was taken up and brought on board the Ship, together with the Canoe; the rest were permitted to swim to the Shore. From the Ship Tootaha was sent to the Fort, where Mr. Hicks thought proper to detain him until I return'd. The Scene between Toobouratomita and Tootaha, when the former came into the Fort and found the latter in Custody, was really moving. They wept over each other for some time. As for Tootaha, he was so far prepossessed with the thought that he was to be kill'd that he could not be made sencible to the Contrary till he was carried out of the Fort to the people, many of whom Expressed their joy by embracing him; and, after all, he would not go away until he had given us two Hogs, notwithstanding we did all in our power to hinder him, for it is very certain that the Treatment he had meet with from us did not merit such a reward. However, we had it in our power to make him a present of equal value whenever we pleased.

Tuesday, 2nd. This morning, around 9 o'clock, when Mr. Green and I went to set up the Quadrant, it was missing. It had never been taken out of the packing case (which was about 18 inches square) since it arrived from Mr. Bird, the maker; the whole thing was quite heavy, so we were all puzzled about how it could have been taken, especially since a guard had stood within 5 yards of the tent door all night, where it was stored along with several other instruments; but none of them were missing except for this one. However, it wasn’t long before we learned that one of the locals had taken it and carried it eastward. We immediately decided to detain all the large canoes in the bay and to take Tootaha and a few other important people into custody until the Quadrant was returned; but we didn't think it was wise to carry out that last part right away, since we only had Oberiea in our power, and taking her forcefully would have alarmed everyone else. In the meantime, Mr. Banks (who is always very quick to act when it comes to the locals) and Mr. Green went into the woods to ask Toobouratomita which way and where the Quadrant had gone. I soon learned that the three of them had gone eastward to look for it, and some time later I followed with a small group of men; but before I left, I ordered that if Tootaha came to either the ship or the fort, he should not be detained, as I found out he had nothing to do with the Quadrant’s disappearance, and there was a strong chance we could get it back. I met Mr. Banks and Mr. Green about 4 miles from the fort, returning with the Quadrant. This was around sunset, and we all got back to the fort around 8 o'clock, where I found Tootaha in custody and a crowd of locals surrounding the gate. My venture into the woods with a group of armed men alarmed the locals so much that in the evening, they started to leave with their belongings, and a double canoe was spotted leaving from the bottom of the bay, prompting us to send a boat after it. Tootaha was in this canoe, and as soon as our boat caught up, he and everyone else in the canoe jumped overboard, but he was the only one captured and brought onto the ship along with the canoe; the rest were allowed to swim to the shore. From the ship, Tootaha was sent to the fort, where Mr. Hicks decided to hold him until I returned. The scene between Toobouratomita and Tootaha, when the former entered the fort and found the latter in custody, was quite emotional. They cried over each other for a while. Tootaha was so convinced that he was going to be killed that he couldn't accept otherwise until he was taken out of the fort to the people, many of whom showed their happiness by embracing him; and after all that, he wouldn’t leave until he had given us two hogs, despite our best efforts to stop him, as it was clear that the treatment he received from us didn’t deserve such a reward. However, we could easily give him a gift of equal value whenever we wanted.

Wednesday, 3rd. Very early this morning Tootaha sent for the Canoe we had detained yesterday, and in the Afternoon sent a man for an Axe and a Shirt in return for the Hogs he gave us last night; but as this man told us that Tootaha would not come near us himself in less than 10 days, we thought proper not to send them, to try if he would not come himself for them sooner.

Wednesday, 3rd. Very early this morning, Tootaha sent for the canoe we held onto yesterday, and in the afternoon, he sent a man for an axe and a shirt in exchange for the hogs he gave us last night. However, since this man told us that Tootaha wouldn't come near us himself for at least 10 days, we decided not to send them, to see if he would come for them sooner.

Thursday, 4th. Some people came to the Fort to-day from York Island; one of them gave us an account of 22 Islands lying in this Neighbourhood. Set up the 2 Clocks; one in the Tent wherein Mr. Green and I lay, and the other in the Observatory. This evening Tootaha sent a man again for the Axe and Shirt, and we sent him word by the same man that Mr. Banks and I would come and see him to-morrow and bring them along with us, for it now became necessary that we should take some steps to reconcile this man to us in order to procure a sufficient supply of Bread fruit, and Cocoa Nuts, which we have not had for these 2 days past, owing, as we apprehend, to Tootaha not being reconciled to us, or otherwise the people take this method to shew their resentment of the Treatment their Chief meet with.

Thursday, 4th. Some people came to the Fort today from York Island; one of them told us about 22 islands in the area. We set up 2 clocks; one in the tent where Mr. Green and I are sleeping, and the other in the observatory. This evening, Tootaha sent a man again for the axe and shirt, and we communicated back through the same man that Mr. Banks and I would come to see him tomorrow and bring those items with us. It has become necessary for us to take steps to reconcile with this man to ensure we get a sufficient supply of breadfruit and cocoa nuts, which we haven't had for the last 2 days, likely because Tootaha isn’t on good terms with us, or maybe the people are showing their resentment for how their chief has been treated.

Friday, 5th. Early this morning Tootaha sent some of his people to put us in mind of our promise, and these seem'd very uneasy until we set out, which Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself did about 10 o'clock in the Pinnace, having one of these men with us. As soon as we came to Appara, the place where Tootaha resided, we saw a great number of People at the landing place near his House; one among them, who had a large Turban about his Head, and a long white stick in his Hand, drove the others from the landing place by beating them with his Stick, and throwing stones at them, and at the same time directed us whereabouts to land. After we had landed he conducted us to the Chief, but in this there was no order, everyone crowded upon us crying out "Tyo Tootaha," this Tootaha was our Friend. We found the chief setting in the shade under a large Tree, with a Circle of old men round him; he made us set down by him, and immediately asked for the Axe. I then gave him one, together with an upper Garment made of Broad Cloth after their Fashion, and a Shirt. The Garment he put on, but the Shirt he gave to the man who first received us at landing, who was now seated by us, and the Chief seemed desirous that we should take particular notice of him. By that Time Obaria, and several other women whom we knew, came and sat down by us. Tootaha did not stay long before he went away, as we thought to show himself to the people in his new Dress. He was not gone long before he return'd and took his seat again for a few minutes, then went away again, as we was told, to order something to be got for us to Eat, and at this time we gladly would have gone too, being almost Suffocated with the Crowd that was about us. However, here we remained for about 10 Minutes longer, when word was brought us that the Chief wanted us. We were then conducted to our own Boat, where we found him setting alone under the Awning. He made signs to us to come to him, which we did, and as many with us as the Boat would hold. Here he ordered some Bread fruit and Cocoa Nut to be brought, of both of which we tasted.

Friday, 5th. Early this morning, Tootaha sent some of his people to remind us of our promise, and they seemed quite anxious until we set out, which Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I did around 10 o'clock in the Pinnace, with one of these men accompanying us. As soon as we arrived at Appara, where Tootaha lived, we saw a large crowd at the landing area near his house; one of them, wearing a large turban and carrying a long white stick, pushed the others away by hitting them with his stick and throwing stones while directing us where to land. After we landed, he led us to the chief, but it was chaotic, with everyone crowding around us shouting "Tyo Tootaha," referring to Tootaha, our friend. We found the chief sitting in the shade under a big tree, surrounded by a circle of older men; he invited us to sit with him and immediately asked for an axe. I then gave him one, along with an upper garment made of broadcloth in their style and a shirt. He put on the garment, but he handed the shirt to the man who welcomed us at the landing, who was now seated with us, and the chief seemed eager for us to notice him. By that time, Obaria and several other women we recognized came and sat down with us. Tootaha didn't stay long before he left, as we thought, to show off his new outfit to the people. He was gone for a little while before returning and taking his seat with us again for a few minutes, then left again, as we were told, to arrange something for us to eat, and at that moment, we would have gladly left too, as we were almost suffocated by the crowd. However, we stayed for about 10 more minutes when word came that the chief wanted us. We were then led to our own boat, where we found him sitting alone under the awning. He gestured for us to join him, which we did, along with as many as the boat could hold. Here, he ordered some breadfruit and coconut to be brought, and we sampled both.

After we had set here sometime, a Message was brought to the Chief, who immediately went out of the Boat, and we was desired to follow, and was conducted to a large Aria or Court Yard on one side of his House, where we were entertained with Public wrestling. Tootaha seated himself at one end of the place, and several of his Principal men sat round him in a Semicircle. We were desir'd to sit down here likewise, but we rather chose to walk about. Everything being now ready, several men entered the Theater, 8, 10, or 12, sometimes more. These walked about in a Stooping Poster, with their left hand upon their right breast, and with their Right hand Open struck with a smack their left Arm and fore-arm. In this manner they walked about until one Challenged another, which was done by motion and jesture, without speaking one word. The 2 Antagonists would then meet and endeavour to seize each other by the thighs, but if that fail'd they would seize each other by the Hair of the Head or wherever they could, and then Wrestle together until by main Strength the one or the other was thrown on his back. This was always (Except once) followed by three Huzzas from some old men who sat in the House, and at the same time another Company of men would dance for about a Minute, the Wrestlers all the time continuing their game without taking the least notice of anything else. The only dexterity the Wrestlers seemed to make use of was in first seizing each other, for after they had closed it was all decided by Main strength. It would sometimes happen that neither the one nor the other could throw his Antagonist; in this Case they would either part by mutual consent or were parted by others. The Conqueror never exulted over the Conquer'd, neither did the Conquer'd ever repine at his ill luck, but the whole was carried on with great good Humour. There were present, Young and old, near 500 People. The women do not seem to partake of this diversion, only some few of the Principal ones were present, and that appeared to be owing to us being there.

After we had been here for a while, a message was delivered to the Chief, who immediately got out of the boat, and we were asked to follow him. We were led to a large area or courtyard beside his house, where we were entertained with public wrestling. Tootaha sat at one end of the area, and several of his important men sat around him in a semicircle. We were invited to sit down too, but we preferred to walk around. Once everything was ready, several men entered the arena—about 8, 10, or 12, sometimes more. They walked around in a stooped posture, with their left hand on their right breast, and with their right hand open, they slapped their left arm and forearm. This continued until one man challenged another, which was done through motions and gestures, without saying a word. The two opponents would then meet and try to grab each other by the thighs, and if that failed, they would grab each other's hair or hold on wherever they could, then wrestle until one of them was thrown onto his back. This was always followed (except once) by three cheers from some older men who sat in the house, while another group of men danced for about a minute. The wrestlers kept going, not paying any attention to anything else. The only skill the wrestlers seemed to use was in the initial grabbing; once they had closed, it was all about pure strength. Sometimes neither could throw the other; in those cases, they would either separate by mutual agreement or be separated by others. The winner never bragged over the loser, and the loser never complained about his bad luck; the whole thing was conducted in a good-natured way. There were about 500 people present, both young and old. The women did not seem to take part in this activity, with only a few prominent ones present, and that seemed to be because we were there.

After this was over we were given to understand that we were to go to Dinner, and were desired to follow Tootaha, who led us into our own Boat, and soon after came a small Pig ready roasted, with some Bread Fruit and Cocoa Nuts. Here we thought we were to have dined, but Tootaha, after waiting about 10 Minutes, made signs to us to put off the Boat and go a Board, which we did, and bring him and Toobouratomida along with us. As soon as we got on board we all dined on the Cheer the Chief had provided. We soon found the good effects of having made friends with this man, for it was no sooner known to the Natives that he was on board the Ship than they brought Bread Fruit, Cocoa Nuts, etc., to the Fort.

After this was done, we learned that we were supposed to go to dinner and were asked to follow Tootaha, who led us to our own boat. Not long after, a small roasted pig arrived, along with some breadfruit and coconuts. We thought we would be dining there, but Tootaha, after waiting about 10 minutes, gestured for us to push off the boat and go on board, which we did, bringing him and Toobouratomida with us. As soon as we were on board, we all had dinner with the food the chief had provided. We quickly saw the benefits of befriending this man since it wasn't long after the natives realized he was on board the ship that they started bringing breadfruit, coconuts, and more to the fort.

Saturday, 6th; Sunday, 7th. Nothing remarkable, only that the Natives supply us with as much bread fruits and Cocoa Nuts as we can destroy.

Saturday, 6th; Sunday, 7th. Nothing significant, just that the locals provide us with as many breadfruits and coconuts as we can consume.

Monday, 8th. Early this morning the Master went to the Eastward in the Pinnace to try if he could procure some Hogs and Fowls from that Quarter; but he return'd in the evening without success. He saw but very few, and those the inhabitants pretended belonged to Tootaha; so great is this man's influence or authority over them that they dare part with nothing without his Consent, or otherwise they use his Name to Excuse themselves from parting with the few they have, for it is very certain these things are in no great plenty with them.

Monday, 8th. Early this morning, the Master went east in the small boat to see if he could get some pigs and chickens from that area; however, he came back in the evening empty-handed. He saw very few animals, and the locals claimed they all belonged to Tootaha. This man has such influence or authority over them that they won’t give up anything without his permission, or they use his name as an excuse to avoid sharing what little they have, as it’s clear that these supplies aren’t very plentiful for them.

Tuesday, 9th; Wednesday, 10th; Thursday, 11th. Nothing remarkable hapned for these three days. Oberiea, the Dolphin's queen, made us a Visit for the first time since the Quadrant was Stolen. She introduced herself with a Small Pig, for which she had a Hatchet, and as soon as she got it she Lugg'd out a Broken Axe, and several pieces of Old Iron. These, I believe, she must have had from the Dolphin; the Axe she wanted to be mended, and Axes made of the old iron. I obliged her in the first, but excused myself in the latter: since the Natives had seen the Forge at work they have frequently brought pieces of Iron to be made into one sort of Tool or other, which hath generally been done whenever it did not hinder our own work--being willing to Oblige them in everything in my power. These Pieces of old Iron the Natives must have got from the Dolphin, as we know of no other Ship being here;* (* M. de Bougainville, in the French ships La Boudeuse and L'Etoile, had visited Tahiti the year before, after its discovery by the Dolphin. He was unfortunate in his choice of anchorage, and his ships lost anchors and got into various difficulties. The crews were also much afflicted with scurvy.) and very probable some from us, for there is no species of Theft they will not commit to get this Article, and I may say the same of the common Seamen when in these parts.

Tuesday, 9th; Wednesday, 10th; Thursday, 11th. Nothing significant happened on these three days. Oberiea, the queen of the Dolphin, visited us for the first time since the Quadrant was stolen. She introduced herself with a small pig that she had a hatchet for, and as soon as she got it, she pulled out a broken axe and several pieces of old iron. I believe she must have received these from the Dolphin; she wanted the axe repaired and new axes made from the old iron. I helped her with the first request but declined the second, since the locals had often brought pieces of iron to be made into various tools since they had seen the forge working. We usually accommodated them whenever it didn’t interfere with our own work, wanting to help them as much as we could. The locals must have gotten these pieces of old iron from the Dolphin, as we know of no other ship being here; (* M. de Bougainville, in the French ships La Boudeuse and L'Etoile, had visited Tahiti the year before, after its discovery by the Dolphin. He was unfortunate in his choice of anchorage, and his ships lost anchors and ran into various difficulties. The crews were also severely affected by scurvy.) and it’s very likely some came from us, as there’s no limit to the kinds of theft they will commit to obtain this item, and I can say the same about the common sailors when they are in these waters.

Friday, 12th. Cloudy weather with Showers of rain. This morning a Man and 2 Young Women, with some others, came to the Fort, whom we had not seen before, and as their manner of introducing themselves was a little uncommon, I shall insert it. Mr. Banks was as usual at the gate of the Fort trading with the people, when he was told that some Strangers were coming, and therefore stood to receive them. The Company had with them about a Dozen young Plantain Trees, and some other small Plants, these they laid down about 20 feet from Mr. Banks; the people then made a Lane between him and them. When this was done the Man (who appeared to be only a Servant to the two Women) brought the young Plantains singly, together with some of the other plants, and gave them to Mr. Banks, and at the delivery of each pronounced a Short sentence which we understood not. After he had thus disposed of all his plantain trees, he took several pieces of Cloth and spread them on the ground. One of the Young women then stepp'd upon the Cloth, and with as much innocency as one could possibly conceive, exposed herself, entirely naked, from the waist downwards; in this manner she turn'd herself once or twice round, I am not certain which, then stepped off the cloth, and dropp'd down her Cloaths. More Cloth was then spread upon the former, and she again performed the same Ceremony. The Cloth was then rowled up and given to Mr. Banks, and the two Young women went and Embraced him, which ended the Ceremony.

Friday, 12th. It was cloudy with some rain. This morning, a man and two young women, along with a few others we hadn't seen before, came to the Fort, and their way of introducing themselves was a bit unusual, so I’ll describe it. Mr. Banks was at the gate of the Fort, trading with the locals when he was informed that some strangers were approaching, so he prepared to meet them. The group had about a dozen young plantain trees and some other small plants, which they placed about 20 feet away from Mr. Banks. Then, the people made a path between him and them. Once that was done, the man (who seemed to be just a servant to the two women) brought the young plantains one by one, along with some other plants, and handed them to Mr. Banks, saying a short sentence each time that we didn’t understand. After he gave away all the plantain trees, he took several pieces of cloth and spread them on the ground. One of the young women then stepped onto the cloth and, with the utmost innocence, exposed herself completely naked from the waist down. In this manner, she turned around once or twice; I’m not sure which, then stepped off the cloth and dropped her clothes. More cloth was spread on top of the first, and she repeated the same ceremony. The cloth was then rolled up and handed to Mr. Banks, and the two young women embraced him, which concluded the ceremony.

Saturday, 13th. Nothing worthy of Note hapned during the day; in the Night one of the Natives attempted to get into the Fort by Climbing over the Wall, but, being discovered by the Centinel, he made off. The Iron and Iron Tools daily in use at the Armourer's Forge are Temptations that these people cannot possibly withstand.

Saturday, 13th. Nothing noteworthy happened during the day; at night, one of the locals tried to get into the Fort by climbing over the wall, but when the guard spotted him, he ran away. The iron and iron tools constantly in use at the Armorer's Forge are temptations that these people just can't resist.

Sunday, 14th. This day we performed divine Service in one of the Tents in the fort, where several of the Natives attended and behaved with great decency the whole time. This day closed with an odd sceen at the Gate of the Fort, where a young Fellow above 6 feet high made love to a little Girl about 10 or 12 years of Age publickly before several of our people and a number of the Natives. What makes me mention this is because it appear'd to be done according to Custom, for there were several women present, particularly Obariea and several others of the better sort, and these were so far from showing the least disapprobation that they instructed the Girl how she should Act her part, who, young as she was, did not seem to want it.

Sunday, 14th. Today we held a church service in one of the tents in the fort, where several of the locals attended and behaved very respectfully the entire time. The day ended with a strange scene at the fort gate, where a young man over 6 feet tall publicly flirted with a little girl about 10 or 12 years old in front of several of our people and a number of the locals. I mention this because it seemed to be done according to custom, as there were several women present, especially Obariea and others of higher status, and they did not show any disapproval; instead, they guided the girl on how to play her part, and, despite her young age, she seemed to have no problem with it.

Monday, 15th. Winds variable and cloudy weather. Last Night one of our Water Casks was taken away from the outside of the Fort, where they stood full of water. In the morning there was not one of the Natives but what knew it was gone; yet, Contrary to what we had always met with on these Occasions, not one of them would give us any information about it, and I thought it of too little Consequence to take any methods to Oblige them. In the evening Toobouratomida and his Wife, and a Man belonging to Tootaha, would needs lay all Night by the Casks to prevent any more from being taken away; but, as we had placed a Centinel there, this care of theirs became unnecessary, and they were prevailed upon to go home; but before they went away they made signs to the Centinel to keep his Eyes open. From this it should seem that they knew that an attempt would be made in the night to take away more, which would have been done had not the Centinel prevented it.

Monday, 15th. The winds were variable and the weather was cloudy. Last night, one of our water barrels was taken from outside the fort, where they stood full of water. In the morning, every native knew it was gone; however, unlike in previous situations, not one of them would share any information about it, and I thought it was too trivial to force them to speak. In the evening, Toobouratomida, his wife, and a man from Tootaha insisted on staying by the barrels all night to stop any more from being taken. But since we had placed a guard there, their effort became unnecessary, and they were convinced to go home. Before they left, they signaled to the guard to keep watch. This suggests they were aware that there might be another attempt to take more barrels during the night, which would have happened if the guard hadn’t stopped it.

Tuesday, 16th. Winds Westerly. The morning cloudy, with heavy showers of rain; the Remainder of the day fair weather. From this day nothing remarkable hapned until

Tuesday, 16th. Winds from the west. The morning was cloudy, with heavy rain showers; the rest of the day was fair. From this day on, nothing remarkable happened until

Monday, 22nd, which was usher'd in with thick Cloudy weather, and Excessive hard Showers of rain and very much Thunder and Lightning, which Continued the Greater part of the day.

Monday, 22nd, started off with thick cloudy weather and heavy rain showers along with a lot of thunder and lightning, which lasted for most of the day.

Tuesday, 23rd. Wind Southerly and fair weather in the Forenoon, but in the Afternoon Showers. We have had a Scarcity of all sorts of Fruit for these 2 days past, which we immagine to be owing to the Wet weather.

Tuesday, 23rd. The wind was coming from the south and it was nice in the morning, but there were showers in the afternoon. We’ve experienced a shortage of all kinds of fruit for the past two days, which we think is due to the wet weather.

Wednesday, 24th. Fine clear weather all this day. Having found the Long boat Leakey for these few days past, we hauld her ashore to-day to stop the leakes, when, to our great surprise, we found her bottom so much Eaten by the Worms that it was necessary to give her a new one, and all the Carpenters were immediately set to work upon her.

Wednesday, 24th. Beautiful clear weather all day. After discovering the Longboat Leakey had been leaking for the past few days, we pulled her ashore today to fix the leaks. To our surprise, we found that the bottom was so badly damaged by worms that we needed to give her a new one, and all the carpenters were immediately put to work on her.

Thursday, 25th. Most part of these 24 hours Cloudy, with frequent Showers of Rain.

Thursday, 25th. Most of these 24 hours were cloudy, with frequent rain showers.

Friday, 26th. Some flying showers again. This morning we hauled the pinnace a Shore to examine her bottom, and had the Satisfaction to find that not one worm had touched it, notwithstanding she hath been in the water nearly as long as the Long Boat. This must be owing to the White Lead with which her bottom is painted, the Long boats being paid with Varnish of Pine, for no other reason can be assign'd why the one should be preserved and the other destroy'd, when they are both built on the Same sort of Wood and have been in equal use. From this Circumstance alone the Bottom of all Boats sent into Countrys where these worms are ought to be painted with White Lead, and the Ships supply'd with a good stock in order to give them a New Coat whenever it's necessary. By this means they would be preserved free from these destructive Vermin. The Long boat's Bottom being so much destroy'd appear'd a little extraordinary, as the Dolphin's Launch was in the Water at this very place full as long, and no such thing happened to her, as the Officers that were in the Dolphin say.

Friday, 26th. We had some light rain again. This morning, we pulled the small boat ashore to check the bottom, and we were pleased to see that not a single worm had touched it, even though it’s been in the water nearly as long as the longboat. This must be because the bottom is painted with white lead, while the longboat is coated with pine varnish. There's no other explanation for why one would be preserved while the other is damaged, considering they’re both made from the same type of wood and have been used equally. This alone suggests that the bottoms of all boats sent to areas with these worms should be painted with white lead, and ships should be kept well-stocked to give them a new coat whenever necessary. This way, they would be protected from these destructive pests. The longboat's bottom being so damaged seemed a bit odd since the dolphin's launch has been in the water at this spot just as long, and nothing like that happened to it, according to the officers on the dolphin.

Saturday, 27th. Winds variable and fair weather.

Saturday, 27th. Winds changing and nice weather.

Sunday, 28th. Winds Southerly and clear weather. This morning myself, Mr. Banks, and Dr. Solander set out in the Pinnace to pay Tootaha a Visit, who had moved from Apparra to the South-West part of the island. What induced us to make him this visit was a Message we had received from him some days ago importing that if we would go to him he would give us several Hogs. We had no great faith in this, yet we were resolved to try, and set out accordingly. It was Night before we reached the place where he was, and, as we had left the Boat about half-way behind us, we were obliged to take up our Quarters with him for the Night. The Chief received us in a Friendly manner, and a Pig was ordered to be killed and dressed for Supper; but we saved his Life for the present, thinking it would do us more service in another place, and we supped on Fruit and what else we could get. Here was, along with the Chief, Obariea and many more that we knowd. They all seem'd to be travellers like ourselves, for neither the Canoes they had along with them, nor the Houses where they were, were sufficient to contain the one half of them. We were in all Six of us, and after supper began to look out for Lodgings. Mr. Banks went to one place, Dr. Solander to another, while I and the other 3 went to a third. We all of us took as much care of the little we had about us as possible, knowing very well what sort of People we were among; yet, notwithstanding all the care we took, before 12 o'clock the most of us had lost something or other. For my own part I had my Stockings taken from under my head, and yet I am certain that I was not a Sleep the whole time. Obariea took charge of Mr. Banks's things, and yet they were stol'n from her, as she pretended. Tootaha was acquainted with what had hapned, I believe by Obariea herself, and both him and her made some stir about it; but this was all meer shew, and ended in nothing. A little time after this Tootaha came to the Hutt where I and those that were with me lay, and entertain'd us with a Consort of Musick consisting of 3 Drums, 4 Flutes, and Singing. This lasted about an Hour, and then they retir'd. The Music and Singing was so much of a piece that I was very glad when it was over. We stay'd with them till near noon the next day in hopes of getting some of our things again, and likewise some Hogs; but we were at last obliged to come away with the one we had saved out of the Fire last Night, and a promise from Tootaha that he would come to the Ship in a Day or two with more, and bring with him the things that are lost, a promise we had no reason to expect he would fulfill. Thus ended our Visit, and we got to the Fort late in the evening.

Sunday, the 28th. The wind was coming from the south, and the weather was clear. This morning, Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I took the Pinnace to visit Tootaha, who had moved from Apparra to the southwest part of the island. We decided to visit him after receiving a message a few days ago stating that he would give us several pigs if we came to see him. We weren’t too sure about this, but we decided to give it a try and set out. We didn’t arrive until nightfall, and since we had left the boat about halfway, we had to stay the night with him. The chief welcomed us warmly, and they prepared a pig to be killed and cooked for supper; however, we spared its life for now, thinking it would be more useful to us later, and instead, we had fruit and whatever else we could find. Along with the chief were Obariea and several others we recognized. They all seemed to be travelers like us, as neither their canoes nor the houses they were in could accommodate half of them. There were six of us in total, and after supper, we started looking for places to sleep. Mr. Banks went one way, Dr. Solander another, while the other three of us headed to yet another spot. We took as much care of our belongings as we could because we were aware of the kind of people we were with; however, despite our precautions, most of us had something stolen before midnight. Personally, I had my stockings taken from under my head, and I was sure I hadn't slept at all. Obariea was supposed to look after Mr. Banks’s things, but they were stolen from her, or so she claimed. I believe Tootaha learned about what happened from Obariea herself, and both of them made a fuss about it, but it was all just for show and led to nothing. Shortly after this, Tootaha came to the hut where I and my companions were staying and entertained us with a music performance that included three drums, four flutes, and singing. This lasted about an hour, and then they left. The music and singing were so overwhelming that I was relieved when it ended. We stayed with them until near noon the next day, hoping to retrieve some of our belongings and also get some pigs; however, in the end, we had to leave with only the one we had saved from the fire the night before and a promise from Tootaha that he would come to the ship in a day or two with more pigs and our lost items, a promise we doubted he would keep. Thus, our visit ended, and we returned to the fort late in the evening.

Tuesday, 30th. We are now very buisey in preparing our Instruments, etc., for the Observations, and Instructing such Gentlemen in the use of them, as I intend to send to other parts to observe, for fear we should fail here.

Tuesday, 30th. We are now very busy getting our instruments ready for the observations and teaching some gentlemen how to use them, as I plan to send them to other locations to observe, in case we don't succeed here.

Wednesday, 31st. Late this Evening the Carpenters finished the Long boat.

Wednesday, 31st. Late this evening, the carpenters finished the longboat.

[June 1769.]

[June 1769.]

Thursday, June 1st. This day I sent Lieutenant Gore in the Long boat to York Island* (* Eimeo, westward of, and near to Tahiti.) with Dr. Monkhouse and Mr. Sporing (a Gentleman belonging to Mr. Banks) to Observe the Transit of Venus, Mr. Green having furnished them with Instruments for that purpose. Mr. Banks and some of the Natives of this Island went along with them.

Thursday, June 1st. Today, I sent Lieutenant Gore in the longboat to York Island* (* Eimeo, located west of and near Tahiti) with Dr. Monkhouse and Mr. Sporing (a gentleman who works with Mr. Banks) to observe the transit of Venus. Mr. Green provided them with instruments for that purpose. Mr. Banks and some of the island’s natives went along with them.

Friday, 2nd. Very early this morning Lieutenant Hicks, Mr. Clark, Mr. Pickersgill and Mr. Saunders went away in the Pinnace to the Eastward, with orders to fix upon some Convenient situation upon this Island, and there to Observe the Transit of Venus, they being likewise provided with Instruments for that purpose.

Friday, 2nd. Very early this morning, Lieutenant Hicks, Mr. Clark, Mr. Pickersgill, and Mr. Saunders left in the Pinnace heading east, with instructions to find a suitable spot on this island to observe the Transit of Venus. They were also equipped with instruments for that purpose.

Saturday, 3rd. This day proved as favourable to our purpose as we could wish. Not a Cloud was to be seen the whole day, and the Air was perfectly Clear, so that we had every advantage we could desire in observing the whole of the Passage of the planet Venus over the Sun's Disk. We very distinctly saw an Atmosphere or Dusky shade round the body of the planet, which very much disturbed the times of the Contact, particularly the two internal ones. Dr. Solander observed as well as Mr. Green and myself, and we differ'd from one another in Observing the times of the Contact much more than could be expected. Mr. Green's Telescope and mine where of the same Magnifying power, but that of the Doctor was greater than ours. It was nearly calm the whole day, and the Thermometer Exposed to the Sun about the Middle of the day rose to a degree of heat we have not before met with.

Saturday, 3rd. This day turned out to be as favorable to our purpose as we could have hoped. Not a cloud was in sight all day, and the air was perfectly clear, giving us every advantage we wanted in observing the full transit of Venus across the Sun's disk. We clearly noticed an atmosphere or dark shade around the planet, which significantly affected the timing of the contacts, especially the two internal ones. Dr. Solander, Mr. Green, and I all made observations, but our recorded times for the contacts varied more than expected. Mr. Green's telescope and mine had the same magnifying power, but the Doctor's was stronger than ours. It was nearly calm the whole day, and the thermometer exposed to the sun around midday reached a level of heat we hadn't encountered before.

FACSIMILE OF SATURDAY, 3RD JUNE, 1769.

 

Sunday, 4th. Punished Archd. Wolf with 2 Dozen lashes for Theft, having broken into one of the Storerooms and stol'n from thence a large quantity of Spike Nails; some few of them where found upon him. This evening the Gentlemen that were sent to observe the Transit of Venus, return'd with success; those that were sent to York Island were well received by the Natives. That Island appear'd to them not to be very fruitful.

Sunday, 4th. Punished Archd. Wolf with 24 lashes for theft, having broken into one of the storerooms and stolen a large quantity of spike nails; a few of them were found on him. This evening, the gentlemen who were sent to observe the transit of Venus returned successfully; those sent to York Island were well received by the natives. That island seemed to them not very fruitful.

Monday, 5th. Got some of the Bread ashore out of the Bread Room to dry and Clean. Yesterday being His Majesty's birthday, we kept it to-day and had several of the Chiefs to dine with us.

Monday, 5th. Took some of the bread ashore from the Bread Room to dry and clean. Since yesterday was His Majesty's birthday, we celebrated it today and had several of the chiefs join us for dinner.

Tuesday, 6th. This day and for some days past we have been informd by several of the Natives that about 10 or 15 months ago Two Ships touched at this Island and stayed 10 days in a Harbour to the Eastward, called Ohidea, the Commander's name was Tootteraso,* (* M. de Bougainville, who laid at Hitiaa from April 6th to April 16th, 1768.)--so at least the Natives call him--and that one of the Natives, Brother to the Chief of Ohidea, went away with him. They likewise say these ships brought the venerial distemper to this Island, where it is now as Common as in any part of the world, and which the people bear with as little concern as if they have been accustom'd to it for Ages past. We had not been here many days before some of our People got this disease, and as no such thing hapned to any of the Dolphin's people while she was here, that I ever heard of, I had reason (notwithstanding the improbability of the thing) to think that we had brought it along with us, which gave me no small uneasiness, and did all in my power to prevent its progress, but all I could do was to little purpose, as I was obliged to have the most part of the Ship's Company ashore every day to work upon the Fort, and a Strong Guard every Night; and the Women were so very liberal with their favours--or else Nails, Shirts, etc., were temptations that they could not withstand, that this distemper very soon spread itself over the greatest part of the Ship's company, but now I have the satisfaction to find that the Natives all agree that we did not bring it here.

Tuesday, 6th. For today and the past few days, several locals have told us that about 10 or 15 months ago, two ships stopped at this island and stayed for 10 days in a harbor to the east called Ohidea. The captain's name was Tootteraso,* (* M. de Bougainville, who was in Hitiaa from April 6th to April 16th, 1768.)--that’s what the locals call him--and one native, the brother of the chief of Ohidea, left with him. They also claim that these ships brought a venereal disease to this island, which is now as common here as anywhere else in the world, and the locals seem to accept it with as little concern as if they had been dealing with it for ages. We hadn’t been here long before some of our crew contracted the disease, and since none of the Dolphin's crew had this issue while they were here, it made me suspect (despite how unlikely it seemed) that we had brought it with us, which caused me a lot of worry. I did everything I could to prevent its spread, but my efforts mostly fell short since I had to send most of the ship's crew ashore daily to work on the fort and maintain a strong guard every night. The women were very generous with their favors—or maybe things like nails, shirts, etc., were too tempting to resist—so this disease quickly spread among the majority of the ship's crew. However, I’m now relieved to hear that the locals all agree we didn’t bring it here.

We have several times seen Iron tools and other Articles with these people that we suspected came not from the Dolphin, and these they now say they had from these two Ships.

We have seen Iron tools and other items with these people several times, and we suspected they didn't come from the Dolphin. Now they say they got them from these two ships.

Wednesday, 7th; Thursday, 8th; Friday, 9th. These three days we have been employ'd in Careening both sides of the Ship, and paying them with Pitch and Brimstone. We found her Bottom in good order, and that the worm had not got into it.

Wednesday, 7th; Thursday, 8th; Friday, 9th. We spent these three days working on both sides of the ship, cleaning and sealing them with pitch and sulfur. We found the bottom in good shape, and the woodworm hadn't gotten into it.

Saturday, 10th. Wind Variable, with very much rain all day and last night.

Saturday, 10th. The wind was variable, and it rained heavily all day and throughout the night.

Sunday, 11th. Cloudy, with rain last night and this morning; the remainder of the day fair weather. This day Mr. Banks and I took Toobouratomita on board the Ship and shew'd him the print containing the Colours worne by the ships of Diffrent Nations, and very soon made him understand that we wanted to know which of them was worn by the ships that were at Ohidea. He at once pitched upon the Spanish Flag and would by no means admit of any other; this, together with several Articles we have lately seen amongst these people, such as Jackets, Shirts, etc., usually worn by Spanish Seamen, proves beyond doubt that they must have been Ships of that Nation, and come from some Port on the Coast of South America.* (* This was of course a mistake, as the ships were French.)

Sunday, 11th. It was cloudy, with rain last night and this morning; the rest of the day was nice. Today, Mr. Banks and I brought Toobouratomita on board the ship and showed him the image of the flags used by the ships of different nations. We quickly made him understand that we wanted to know which flag was used by the ships at Ohidea. He immediately pointed to the Spanish flag and refused to consider any other option. This, along with several items we've recently seen among these people, like jackets and shirts typically worn by Spanish sailors, strongly suggests that those must have been ships from that nation, coming from some port on the South American coast.* (* This was, of course, a mistake, as the ships were French.)

Monday, 12th. Yesterday Complaint was made to me by some of the Natives that John Thurman and James Nicholson, Seamen, had taken by force from them several Bows and Arrows and plaited Hair, and the fact being proved upon them they were this day punished with 2 dozen lashes each.

Monday, 12th. Yesterday, some of the locals complained to me that John Thurman and James Nicholson, sailors, had forcefully taken several bows, arrows, and braided hair from them. Since the evidence was clear, they were punished today with 24 lashes each.

Tuesday, 13th. Some Showers of rain last night, but fair weather the most part of the day. Tootaha, whom we have not seen for some time past, paid us a Visit to-Day. He brought with him a Hog and some Bread Fruit, for which he was well paid.

Tuesday, 13th. There were some showers of rain last night, but mostly it was fair weather today. Tootaha, whom we haven't seen for a while, visited us today. He brought along a pig and some breadfruit, for which he was well compensated.

Wednesday, 14th. Between 2 and 4 o'clock this morning, one of the Natives stole out of the Fort an Iron rake, made use of for the Oven. It hapned to be set up against the Wall, and by that means was Visible from the outside, and had been seen by them in the evening, as a man had been seen lurking about the Fort some Hours before the thing was Missed. I was informed by some others of the Natives that he watch'd an opportunity when the Centinel's back was turned, he hooked it with a long crooked stick, and haled it over the Wall. When I came to be informed of this theft in the Morning I resolved to recover it by some Means or other, and accordingly went and took possession of all the Canoes of any value I could meet with, and brought them into the River behind the Fort to the number of 22, and told the Natives then present (most of them being the owners of the Canoes) that unless the principal things they had stol'n from us were restored I would burn them every one: not that I ever intended to put this in execution, and yet I was very much displeased with them, as they were daily committing, or attempting to commit, one theft or other, when at the same time--contrary to the opinion of everybody, I would not suffer them to be fir'd upon, for this would have been putting it in the power of the Centinels to have fir'd upon them upon the most slitest occasions, as I had before experienced. And I have a great Objection to firing with powder only amongst People who know not the difference, for by this they would learn to despise fire Arms and think their own Arms superior, and if ever such an Opinion prevailed they would certainly attack you, the Event of which might prove as unfavourable to you as them. About Noon the rake was restored us, when they wanted to have their Canoes again; but now, as I had them in my possession, I was resolved to try if they would not redeem them by restoring what they had stol'n from us before. The Principal things which we had lost was the Marine Musquet, a pair of Pistols belonging to Mr. Banks, a Sword belonging to one of the Petty Officers, and a Water Cask, with some other Articles not worth mentioning. Some said that these things were not in the Island, others that Tootaha had them, and those of Tootaha's friends laid the whole to Obariea, and I believe the whole was between these two persons.

Wednesday, 14th. Between 2 and 4 o'clock this morning, one of the locals sneaked out of the Fort with an iron rake we used for the oven. It happened to be propped against the wall, making it visible from the outside, and they must have seen it the evening before, as a man had been noticed hanging around the Fort a few hours before the rake was discovered missing. Some other locals told me that he waited for a chance when the guard's back was turned, hooked it with a long crooked stick, and pulled it over the wall. When I learned about this theft in the morning, I decided to get it back by any means necessary. I went and collected all the valuable canoes I could find, bringing a total of 22 into the river behind the Fort. I told the locals who were present (most of them being the canoe owners) that unless we got back the main items they had stolen from us, I would burn each canoe. I never actually planned to follow through with this threat, but I was very upset with them since they were constantly stealing or trying to steal from us, even though I refused to let them be fired upon, contrary to what everyone else thought. I didn't want to give the sentinels the power to shoot at them over the smallest excuses, which I had experienced before. I strongly opposed firing with powder around people who didn't understand the difference because they would learn to disrespect firearms and think their own weapons were better. If that opinion took hold, they would likely attack us, and that could end poorly for everyone involved. Around noon, the rake was returned to us when they wanted their canoes back. However, since I had them, I was determined to see if they would trade them back for the items they had stolen from us earlier. The main things we had lost were a marine musket, a pair of pistols belonging to Mr. Banks, a sword belonging to one of the petty officers, a water cask, and a few other items that weren’t worth mentioning. Some claimed these items were not on the island, while others said Tootaha had them, and Tootaha's friends blamed it all on Obariea. I believe the whole situation revolved around these two individuals.

Thursday, 15th. We have been employed for some Days past in overhauling all the Sea Provisions, and stowing such as we found in a State of decay to hand, in order to be first expended; but having the people divided between the Ship and the Shore, this work, as well as refitting the Ship, goes on but slowly.

Thursday, 15th. We have spent the last few days going through all the sea provisions and putting aside the ones that are decaying to use first. However, with the crew split between the ship and the shore, both this task and the ship's repairs are progressing slowly.

Friday, 16th; Saturday, 17th. Variable winds, with Showers of rain and Cloudy weather.

Friday, 16th; Saturday, 17th. Changing winds, with rain showers and overcast skies.

Sunday, 18th. Variable winds and Clear weather. This Night was observed the Moon totally Eclipsed.

Sunday, 18th. Changing winds and clear skies. Last night, the Moon was completely eclipsed.

Monday, 19th. Punished James Tunley with 12 lashes for taking Rum out of the Cask on the Quarter Deck.

Monday, 19th. Punished James Tunley with 12 lashes for taking rum out of the cask on the quarterdeck.

Tuesday, 20th. Got all the Powder aShore to Air, all of which we found in a bad Condition, and the Gunner informs me that it was very little better when it came first on board. Last Night Obariea made us a visit, whom we have not seen for some time. We were told of her coming, and that she would bring with her some of the Stol'n things, which we gave Credit to because we know'd several of them were in her possession; but we were surprised to find this Woman put herself wholy in our power, and not bring with her one Article of what we had lost. The Excuse she made was that her Gallant, a man that used to be along with her, did Steal them, and she had beat him and turned him away, but she was so Sencible of her own Guilt that she was ready to drop down through fear, and yet she had resolution Enough to insist upon Sleeping in Mr. Banks's Tent all Night, and was with difficulty prevailed upon to go to her canoe, altho no one took the least notice of her. In the morning she brought her Canoe, with everything she had, to the Gate of the Fort, after which we could not help admiring her for her Courage and the Confidence she seem'd to place in us, and thought that we could do no less than to receive her into favour, and except the Present she had brought us, which consisted of a Hog, a Dog, some Bread Fruit and Plantains.

Tuesday, 20th. We got all the powder ashore to air, but it was in pretty bad condition, and the gunner told me it wasn’t much better when it was first brought on board. Last night, Obariea visited us; we hadn't seen her for a while. We were informed of her arrival and that she would bring some of the stolen items, which we believed because we knew some were in her possession. However, we were surprised to find that this woman put herself completely in our hands and didn’t bring a single item we had lost. Her excuse was that her partner, a guy who used to be with her, had stolen them, and she had beaten him and sent him away. But she was so aware of her own guilt that she seemed ready to collapse from fear, yet she had enough determination to insist on sleeping in Mr. Banks's tent all night. It took some convincing for her to go to her canoe, even though no one paid her any attention. In the morning, she brought her canoe, with everything she had, to the fort's gate. After that, we couldn’t help but admire her for her courage and the trust she seemed to place in us. We thought we could do nothing less than welcome her back and accept the gift she had brought us, which included a hog, a dog, some breadfruit, and plantains.

We refused to Except of the Dog, as being an Animal we had no use for; at which she seemed a little surprised, and told us it was very good eating, and we very soon had an opportunity to find that it was so, for Mr. Banks, having bought a Basket of Fruit in which was the Thigh of a Dog ready dressed, of this several of us tasted, and found that it was Meat not to be despised, and therefore took Obariea's Dog and had him immediately dressed by some of the Natives in the following manner: They first made a hole in the Ground about a foot Deep, in which they made a fire and heated some small Stones. While this was doing the Dog was strangled and the hair got off by laying him frequently on the fire, and as clean as if it had been scalded off with hot water. His Intrails was taken out, and the whole washed Clean, and as soon as the Stones and Hole was sufficiently heated the fire was put out and part of the Stones were left in the bottom of the hole. Upon these stones were laid green leafs, and upon them the Dog, together with the Intrails, these were likewise covered with leaves, and over them hot stones; and then the hole was close cover'd with mould. After he had laid here about 4 Hours, the Oven (for so I must call it) was op'ned, and the dog taken out, whole and well done, and it was the Opinion of every one who tasted it that they never eat sweater Meat, therefore we resolved for the future never to dispise Dog's flesh. It is in this manner that the Natives dress and Bake all their Victuals that require it--Flesh, fish, and Fruit. I now gave over all thoughts of recovering any of the things the Natives had stol'n from us, and therefore intend to give them up their Canoes whenever they apply for them.

We refused to accept the dog since we saw it as an animal we had no use for; this surprised her a bit, and she told us it was very good to eat. We soon got a chance to find out that she was right because Mr. Banks had bought a basket of fruit that included a thigh of a dog ready to eat. Several of us tried it and agreed it was pretty good meat, so we took Obariea's dog and had some locals prepare it right away. They first dug a hole about a foot deep, made a fire, and heated some small stones. While that was happening, they strangled the dog and removed the hair by frequently laying it on the fire, making it as clean as if it were scalded with hot water. They took out the entrails and washed the whole animal clean. Once the stones and the hole were hot enough, they put out the fire and left some stones at the bottom of the hole. They laid green leaves on top of the stones, placed the dog and entrails on the leaves, covered everything with more leaves, added more hot stones, and then sealed the hole with dirt. After it cooked for about 4 hours, they opened the "oven," and the dog came out whole and well-cooked. Everyone who tasted it agreed that they'd never had better meat, so we decided not to look down on dog meat in the future. This is how the locals prepare and bake all their food that needs cooking—meat, fish, and fruit. I gave up on recovering any of the things the locals had stolen from us and decided to return their canoes whenever they asked for them.

CHART OF THE ISLAND OTAHEITE, BY LIEUTENANT JAMES COOK, 1769. REPRODUCTION OF THE ORIGINAL PUBLISHED CHART.

 

Wednesday, 21st. Employed drying the Powder, or getting on board Wood, Water, etc. Confined Robert Anderson, Seaman, for refusing to obey the orders of the Mate when at work in the Hold. This morning a Chief, whose Name is Oamo, and one we had not seen before, came to the Fort. There came with him a Boy about 7 Years of Age and a Young Woman of about 18 or 20. At the Time of their coming Obariea and several others were in the fort. They went out to meet them, having first uncovered their Heads and Bodies as low as their Waists; and the same thing was done by all those that were on the outside of the Fort. As we looked upon this as a Ceremonial respect, and had not seen it paid to any one before, we thought that this Oamo must be some extraordinary person, and wondered to see so little notice taken of him after the Ceremony was over. The Young woman that came along with him could not be prevailed upon to come into the Fort, and the Boy was Carried upon a Man's back, altho' he was as able to walk as the Man who carried him. This Lead us to inquire who they were; and we was informed that the Boy was Heir Apparent to the Sovereignty of the Island, and the Young Woman was his Sister, and as such the respect was paid them which was due to no one else except the Arreedehi, which was not Tootaha, from what we could learn, but some other person who we had not seen, or like to do, for they say that he is no Friend of ours, and therefore will not come near us. The Young Boy above mentioned is son to Oamo by Obariea, but Oamo and Obariea do not at this time live together as Man and Wife, he not being able to endure with her troublesome disposition. I mention this because it shows that seperation in the Marriage state is not unknown to these people.* (* See note Notes on Tahiti below.)

Wednesday, 21st. Spent the day drying the powder and loading wood, water, etc. Confined Robert Anderson, a seaman, for refusing to follow the Mate's orders while working in the hold. This morning a chief named Oamo, someone we hadn't seen before, arrived at the fort. He was accompanied by a boy about 7 years old and a young woman around 18 or 20. When they arrived, Obariea and several others were in the fort. They went out to greet them, first uncovering their heads and bodies down to their waists; everyone outside the fort did the same. We saw this as a sign of respect and, having never seen it shown to anyone before, thought that Oamo must be someone special. We were surprised at how little attention he received after the ceremony was over. The young woman with him wouldn’t come into the fort, and the boy was carried on a man’s back, even though he was perfectly able to walk. This led us to ask who they were, and we learned that the boy is the heir to the island’s sovereignty, and the young woman is his sister. The respect shown to them was due only to them and the Arreedehi, who was not Tootaha, from what we could gather, but someone else we hadn’t seen and likely wouldn’t, as we were told he is no friend of ours and doesn’t come near us. The young boy mentioned above is Oamo's son with Obariea, but Oamo and Obariea are not currently living together as husband and wife because he can't stand her difficult personality. I mention this because it shows that separation in marriage is not unknown among these people.* (* See note Notes on Tahiti below.)

Thursday, 22nd. This morning I released Robert Anderson from Confinement at the intercession of the Master and a promise of behaving better for the future.

Thursday, 22nd. This morning I let Robert Anderson go from confinement after the Master intervened and he promised to behave better in the future.

Friday, 23rd. This morning Emanuel Parreyra, a Portugue, was Missing, and I had some reason to think that he was gone with an intent to stay here. It was not long before I was informed that he was at Apparra with Tootaha. The Man who gave us this information was one of Tootaha's Servants. He was Offer'd a Hatchet if he would go to Apparra and bring him to us. This was perhaps the very thing he came for, for he immediately set out and return'd with the Man in the Evening. The man said in his defence that as he was going to the Boat to go on board last night, he was taken away by force by 3 Men, and upon enquiring farther into this matter I found it to be so, and that Tootaha wanted to have kept him, only that he was perswaided to the contrary, or perhaps he thought that the Hatchet he would get by returning him would do him more service than the Man.

Friday, 23rd. This morning, Emanuel Parreyra, a Portuguese, was missing, and I had a reason to believe he intended to stay here. It wasn't long before I heard he was at Apparra with Tootaha. The person who gave us this information was one of Tootaha's servants. He was offered a hatchet to go to Apparra and bring him back to us. This was probably why he came, as he immediately set out and returned with the man in the evening. The man claimed that as he was heading to the boat to board last night, he was taken away by force by three men, and upon further inquiry into this matter, I found it to be true. Tootaha wanted to keep him, but he was persuaded otherwise, or he perhaps thought that the hatchet he would receive for returning him would be of greater use than the man.

Saturday, 24th, Sunday, 25th. Nothing remarkable.

Saturday, the 24th, Sunday, the 25th. Nothing notable.

[Tahiti: Expedition round Island.]

[Tahiti: Island Expedition.]

Monday, 26th. Very early this morning I set out in the pinnace, accompanied by Mr. Banks, with an intent to make the Circuit of the Island in order to Examine and draw a Sketch of the Coast and Harbours thereof. We took our rout to the Eastward, and this night reached the Isthmus, which is a low neck of Land running across the Island, which divides it into two districts or Governments wholly independent of each other as we was informed. The first thing we saw which struck our attention in this day's rout was a small Pig that had not been roasted above a Day or 2 laid upon one of their Altars near to a place where lay the Body or Bones of a Dead Person. This Pig must have been put their as an offering to their God, but on what account we know not. The Coast from Royal Bay trends East by South and East-South-East 10 miles South by East and South 11 miles to the Isthmus. In the first direction the Shore is mostly open to the Sea, but in the last it is cover'd by reefs of rocks; these forms several good Harbours, wherein are safe Anchorage for Shipping in 16, 18, 20, and 24 fathoms, with other Conveniences. It was in one of these Harbours the Spanish Ships before mentioned lay; the Natives shew'd us the place where they Pitched their Tent and the Brook they water'd at, otherways there was not the least signs of Shipping having been there.

Monday, 26th. Early this morning, I headed out in the small boat with Mr. Banks, aiming to circle the island to examine and sketch the coastline and harbors. We traveled east and reached the isthmus tonight, which is a low strip of land that divides the island into two completely independent districts, as we were informed. The first thing that caught our attention on our route today was a small pig that had been roasted only a day or two ago, lying on one of their altars near where the body or bones of a deceased person were. This pig must have been placed there as an offering to their god, but we don’t know the reason behind it. The coast from Royal Bay trends east by south and east-southeast for 10 miles south by east and south for 11 miles to the isthmus. In the first direction, the shore is mostly open to the sea, but in the latter, it's covered by rocky reefs. These create several good harbors with safe anchorage for ships in depths of 16, 18, 20, and 24 fathoms, along with other conveniences. It was in one of these harbors that the previously mentioned Spanish ships stayed; the natives showed us where they set up their tent and the stream they used for water, but there were no signs of any ships having been there.

Tuesday, 27th. Winds Easterly and fine weather. It was late last night before we reached the Isthmus, and all the Observations I could make this morning was that it appeared to be a Marshey flatt of about 2 miles in Extent aCross which the Natives Haul their Canoes partly by land and partly by water. From the Isthmus the land trends East Southerly near 3 Leagues, to the South-East point of the Great Bay which lies before the Isthmus. On the west side of this point is a Bay called Ohitepepa, which is in many respects similar to Royal Bay, and is situated in every bit as fertile and populous part of the Island. There are other places formed by the Reefs that lay along the Shore between this and the Isthmus, where Shipping can lay in perfect security. The Land then trends South-East and South to the South-East part of the Island, which is near 3 Leagues, and covered all the way by a Reef of Rocks, but no Harbour. We took up our Quarters at the East part of the Island, being conducted thither by a Young Chief we had Often seen on board the Ship, and the next morning proceeded round the South-East point of the Island, part of which is not cover'd by any reef, but lies wholy open to the Sea and here the Hills rise directly from the Shore. At the Southernmost part of the Island the Shore is again cover'd by a Reef, and there forms a very good Harbour, and the land about it very fertile. At this place we saw a Goose and a Turkey left at Royal Bay by the Dolphin; they were in possession of a Chief who came along with us in the Boat, and remain'd with us the remainder of the day, and conducted us over the Shoals we here meet with; and for this piece of service we lent him a Cloak to Sleep in in the night, but we had not been laid down above 10 minutes before he thought proper to move off with it, but both Mr. Banks and I pursued him so close that he was obliged to relinquish his prize, and we saw no more of him. When we returned to our Lodging we found the House, in which were not less than 2 or 300 people when we went away, intirely deserted, so that we had one of the Largest and best houses on the Island wholy to ourselves; but when they found that we meant them no harm the Chief and his Wife with some others came and Slept by us the remainder of the night. This place is situated on the South-West side of Tiarreboo,* (* Taiarapu.) the South-East district of the Island, and about 5 miles South-East from the Isthmus. Here is a large, safe, and Commodious Harbour, inferior to none on the whole Island, and the land about it Rich in Produce. We found that the people of this district had had little or no communication with us, yet we was everywhere well received by them. We found all this part of the Island very fertile and the Natives numerous, and had a great many large Double Canoes built and Ornamented uniformly. They were all halled ashore, and appeared to be going to decay for want of use. Their Mories or Burial places stood generally upon these points of land that projected into the Sea, and were both better built and Ornamented than those about Royal Bay--Tootaha's excepted. In general this district appear'd to be in a more flourishing state than the other, although it is not above one fourth part as big and cannot contain nothing near the Number of inhabitants.

Tuesday, 27th. The wind was coming from the east and the weather was nice. It was late last night when we got to the Isthmus, and all I could observe this morning was that it looked like a marshy flat stretching about 2 miles across, where the locals pull their canoes partly by land and partly by water. From the Isthmus, the land trends southeast for about 3 leagues to the southeast point of the Great Bay in front of the Isthmus. On the west side of this point is a bay called Ohitepepa, which is quite similar to Royal Bay and is just as fertile and populated. There are also other areas created by reefs along the shore between this bay and the Isthmus where ships can anchor safely. The land then trends southeast and south toward the southeastern part of the island, which is about 3 leagues away, and is lined with a rocky reef but has no harbor. We set up camp on the eastern side of the island, guided there by a young chief we had often seen on the ship, and the next morning we went around the southeast point of the island, part of which isn’t covered by any reef but is entirely open to the sea, and here the hills rise directly from the shore. At the southernmost part of the island, the shore is again covered by a reef, forming a very good harbor, with the surrounding land being very fertile. Here, we spotted a goose and a turkey that had been left at Royal Bay by the Dolphin; they were with a chief who traveled with us in the boat and stayed with us for the rest of the day, guiding us over the shoals we encountered. For his help, we lent him a cloak to sleep in that night, but we hadn’t been lying down for more than 10 minutes before he decided to take it. Both Mr. Banks and I chased him closely until he had to give it up, and we didn’t see him again. When we returned to our lodging, we found the house that had at least 200 or 300 people in it when we left was completely deserted, so we had one of the largest and best houses on the island all to ourselves. However, when they realized we meant them no harm, the chief and his wife, along with a few others, came back and slept near us for the rest of the night. This place is located on the southwest side of Tiarreboo, the southeast district of the island, about 5 miles southeast from the Isthmus. Here, there is a large, safe, and convenient harbor, second to none on the island, and the surrounding land is rich in produce. We discovered that the people of this district had little to no contact with us, yet they welcomed us everywhere. We found this part of the island to be very fertile, with numerous locals, and many large double canoes that were uniformly built and decorated. They were all pulled ashore and looked like they were falling apart from lack of use. Their burial places, or Mories, were typically on points of land that jutted into the sea and were better built and decorated than those near Royal Bay—excluding Tootaha's. Overall, this district seemed to be thriving more than the others, even though it was only about a quarter of the size and couldn’t support nearly as many inhabitants.

Thursday, 29th. Squally weather with Showers of rain. This morning we left Tiaraboo and entered upon that of Opooreonoo, the North-West district of the Island. The first thing we met with worthy of note was at one of their Mories, where lay the scull bones of 26 Hogs and 6 Dogs. These all lay near to and under one of their Altars. These Animals must have been offer'd as a Sacrifice to their Gods either all at once or at different times, but on what account we could not learn. The next day we met with an Effigy or Figure of a Man made of Basket work and covered with white and Black feathers placed in such order as to represent the Colour of their Hair and Skins when Tattow'd or painted. It was 7 1/2 feet high and the whole made in due proportion; on its head were 4 Nobs not unlike the stumps of Large Horns--3 stood in front and one behind. We were not able to learn what use they made of this Monster; it did not at all appear to us that they paid it the least Homage as a God: they were not the least Scrupulous of letting us examine every part of it. I am inclinable to think that it is only used by way of diversion at their Hevas or public entertainments, as Punch is in a Puppet show.* (* Note by Cook in Admiralty copy: "Tupia informs us that this is a representation of one of the Second rank of Eatuas or Gods, called Mauwi, who inhabited the Earth upon the Creation of man. He is represented as an immense Giant who had seven heads, and was indued with immense strength and abilities. Many absurd stories are told of his Feats by Tupia.") We next passed through a Harbour, which is the only one on the south side of Opooreonoo fit for Shipping. It is situated about 5 Miles to the Westward of the Isthmus between 2 Small Islands that lay near the shore and a Mile from each other. In this Harbour is 11 and 12 fathoms of water and good Anchorage. About a League and a half to the Westward of this Harbour is the Morie of Oamo or Oberia, for some told us it belong'd to the one and some to the other; it far Exceeds every thing of this Kind upon the whole Island. It is a long square of Stonework built Pyramidically; its base is 267 feet by 87 feet; at the Top it is 250 feet by 8 feet. It is built in the same manner as we do steps leading up to a Sun Dial or fountain erected in the Middle of a Square where there is a flite of steps on each side. In this building there are 11 of such steps; each step is about 4 feet in height and the breadth 4 feet 7 inches, but they decreased both in height and breadth from the bottom to the Top. On the middle of the Top stood the Image of a Bird carved in Wood, near it lay the broken one of a Fish carved in stone. There was no hollow or Cavity in the inside, the whole being fill'd up with stones. The outside was faced partly with hewn stones and partly with others, and these were placed in such a manner as to look very agreeable to the Eye. Some of the hewn stones were 4 feet 7 inches by 2 feet 4 inches and 15 inches thick, and had been squared and Polished with some sort of an Edge Tool. On the East side was enclosed with a stone wall a piece of ground in form of a square, 360 feet by 354, in this was growing several Cypress trees and Plantains. Round about this Morie was several smaller ones all going to decay, and on the Beach between them and the Sea lay scatter'd up and down a great quantity of human bones. Not far from the Great Morie was 2 or 3 pretty large Altars, where lay the Scull bones of some Hogs and dogs. This Monument stands on the south side of Opooreonoo, upon a low point of land about 100 Yards from the Sea.* (* On map Morai-no te Oamo.) It appeared to have been built many Years, and was in a State of decay, as most of their Mories are. From this it would seem that this Island hath been in a more Flourishing state than it is at present, or that Religious Customs are (like most other Nations) by these people less observed. We took up our Quarters near this Morie for the night, and early in the Morning proceeded on our rout, and without meeting with anything remarkable, got on board the Ship on Saturday, the 1st of July, having made the Circuit of the whole Island, which I Estimated at something more than 30 Leagues.* (* A remarkably close estimate.) The Plan or Sketch which I have drawn, altho' it cannot be very accurate, yet it will be found sufficient to point out the Situation of the different Bays and Harbours and the true figure of the Island, and I believe is without any Material error. For the first 2 or 3 days we was out upon this excursion we labour'd under some difficulty for want of Provisions--particularly bread--an Article we took but little of with us--not doubting that we should get bread fruit, more than sufficient for a Boat's Crew at every place we went to, but, on the Contrary, we found the season for that fruit wholy over, and not one to be seen on the Trees, and all other fruit and roots were scarce. The Natives live now on Sour paist--which is made from bread fruit--and some bread fruit and plantains that they get from the Mountains where the season is Later, and on a Nut not unlike a chessnut which are now in Perfection; but all these Articles are at present very scarce, and therefore it is no wonder that the Natives have not supply'd us with these things of Late. [At Tahiti.] Upon my return to the Ship I found that the Provisions had been all examined and the Water got on board, amounting to 65 Tons. I now determind to get everything off from the Shore and leave the Place as soon as possible. The getting the several Articles on board, and Scraping and paying the Ship's side, took us up the following Week without anything remarkable happening until

Thursday, 29th. Windy weather with rain showers. This morning we left Tiaraboo and entered the North-West district of Opooreonoo. The first noteworthy thing we encountered was at one of their Mories, where we found the skull bones of 26 pigs and 6 dogs. These were all near and underneath one of their altars. These animals must have been sacrificed to their gods either all at once or at different times, though we couldn’t find out why. The next day we came across a figure of a man made of woven baskets and covered in black and white feathers arranged to represent their hair and skin when tattooed or painted. It was 7.5 feet tall and fully proportional; on its head were 4 knobs resembling the stumps of large horns—3 in front and one behind. We couldn’t learn what purpose this figure served; it didn’t seem like they showed it any reverence as a god: they were completely unbothered about letting us examine every part of it. I’m inclined to think it’s just used for entertainment during their Hevas or public gatherings, kind of like Punch in a puppet show.* (*Note by Cook in Admiralty copy: "Tupia informs us that this is a representation of one of the lower-ranked Eatuas or gods, called Mauwi, who inhabited the Earth at the time of human creation. He is depicted as a giant with seven heads, possessing immense strength and abilities. Several absurd stories are told of his feats by Tupia.") We then passed through a harbor, the only one on the south side of Opooreonoo suitable for shipping. It’s situated about 5 miles to the west of the isthmus between 2 small islands that lie near the shore, a mile apart. The harbor has 11 to 12 fathoms of water and good anchorage. About a mile and a half to the west of this harbor is the Morie of Oamo or Oberia, as some said it belonged to one and some to the other; it far exceeds anything of its kind on the entire island. It’s a long rectangular stone structure built in a pyramid shape; its base is 267 feet by 87 feet, and at the top, it measures 250 feet by 8 feet. It’s built similarly to steps leading up to a sundial or fountain in the center of a square, with steps on each side. In this building, there are 11 steps; each step is about 4 feet high and 4 feet 7 inches wide, but they decrease in height and width from bottom to top. At the center of the top stood a wooden carving of a bird, and nearby lay the broken remains of a fish carved in stone. There’s no hollow or cavity inside; it’s filled with stones. The outside is faced with a mix of hewn stones and others, arranged in a visually pleasing way. Some of the hewn stones measured 4 feet 7 inches by 2 feet 4 inches and 15 inches thick, and were squared and polished with some edge tool. On the east side, a square piece of land measuring 360 feet by 354 feet was enclosed with a stone wall, and it had various cypress trees and plantains growing in it. Surrounding this Morie were several smaller ones all falling into decay, and on the beach between them and the sea lay a lot of human bones scattered about. Not far from the Great Morie were 2 or 3 fairly large altars holding the skull bones of some pigs and dogs. This monument stands on the south side of Opooreonoo, on a low point of land about 100 yards from the sea.* (*On map Morai-no te Oamo.) It looked like it had been built many years ago and was in a state of decay, like most of their Mories. It seems that this island was once more prosperous than it is now, or that religious customs (like many other nations) are not as strictly followed by these people. We set up camp near this Morie for the night, and early the next morning we continued on our route, and without encountering anything remarkable, we boarded the ship on Saturday, July 1st, after making a circuit of the entire island, which I estimated to be slightly over 30 leagues.* (*A remarkably close estimate.) The plan I made, although not very accurate, should be sufficient to indicate the location of different bays and harbors and the actual shape of the island, and I believe it contains no major errors. For the first couple of days on this excursion, we faced some difficulty due to a lack of provisions—especially bread—an item we didn’t bring much of, not expecting to find it at every stop. However, we discovered that the season for that fruit was completely over, and not a single piece was visible on the trees, with all other fruit and roots being scarce. The natives are now living on sour paste made from breadfruit and some breadfruit and plantains sourced from the mountains, where the season is later, along with a nut resembling a chestnut, which are currently in season; however, all these items are presently quite scarce, so it’s no surprise that the natives haven’t been able to supply us with these things lately. [At Tahiti.] Upon my return to the ship, I found that the provisions had been fully examined and the water was loaded on board, amounting to 65 tons. I decided to get everything off the shore and leave the place as soon as possible. Loading the various items on board, along with scraping and painting the ship's sides, took us the following week without any notable events happening until

[July 1769. At Tahiti.]

[July 1769. In Tahiti.]

Sunday, July 9th. When, sometime in the Middle Watch, Clement Webb and Saml. Gibson, both Marines and young Men, found means to get away from the Fort (which was now no hard matter to do) and in the morning were not to be found. As it was known to everybody that all hands were to go on board on the Monday morning, and that the ship would sail in a day or two, there was reason to think that these 2 Men intended to stay behind. However I was willing to stay one day to see if they would return before I took any step to find them.

Sunday, July 9th. At some point during the Middle Watch, Clement Webb and Saml. Gibson, both Marines and young men, managed to escape from the Fort (which wasn’t too difficult by now), and by morning, they were nowhere to be found. Everyone knew that everyone was supposed to board the ship on Monday morning, and that the ship would leave in a day or two, so it seemed likely that these two men planned to stay behind. Still, I decided to wait a day to see if they would come back before I took any action to find them.

Monday, 10th. The 2 Marines not returning this morning, I began to enquire after them, and was inform'd by some of the Natives that they were gone to the Mountains, and that they had got each of them a Wife and would not return; but at the same time no one would give us any certain intelligence where they were, upon which a resolution was taken to seize upon as many of the Chiefs as we could. This was thought to be the readiest method to induce the other natives to produce the 2 Men. We had in our custody Obariea, Toobouratomita, and 2 other Chiefs, but that I know'd Tootaha would have more weight with the Natives than all these put together, I dispatched Lieutenant Hicks away in the Pinnace to the place where Tootaha was, to endeavour to decoy him into the Boat and bring him on board, which Mr. Hicks performed without the least disturbance. We had no sooner taken the other Chiefs into Custody in Mr. Banks's Tent than they became as desirous of having the Men brought back has they were before of keeping them, and only desir'd that one of our people might be sent with some of theirs for them. Accordingly I sent a petty officer and the Corporal of Marines with 3 or 4 of their People, not doubting but they would return with the 2 Men in the evening; but they not coming as soon as I expected, I took all the Chiefs on board the ship for greater safety. About 9 o'Clock in the evening Webb, the Marine, was brought in by some of the natives and sent on board. He informed me that the Petty Officer and Corporal that had been sent in quest of them were disarm'd and seiz'd upon by the natives, and that Gibson was with them. Immediately upon getting this information I dispatch'd Mr. Hicks away in the Long boat with a strong party of men to rescue them but before he went Tootaha and the other Chiefs was made to understand that they must send some of their People with Mr. Hicks to shew him the place where our men were, and at the same time to send orders for their immediate releasement, for if any harm came to the men they (the Chiefs) would suffer for it; and I believe at this time they wished as much to see the Men return in safety as I did, for the guides conducted Mr. Hicks to the place before daylight, and he recovered the men without the least opposition, and return'd with them about 7 o'Clock in the morning of

Monday, 10th. Since the 2 Marines didn't return this morning, I started asking about them and learned from some of the locals that they had gone to the mountains and taken wives, and wouldn’t be coming back. However, no one could give us any reliable information on their exact location, so we decided to capture as many of the chiefs as we could. We thought this would encourage the other locals to bring back the 2 men. We had Obariea, Toobouratomita, and 2 other chiefs in custody, but I knew that Tootaha would have more influence over the locals than all these combined. So, I sent Lieutenant Hicks in the pinnace to where Tootaha was, to try to lure him onto the boat and bring him on board, which Mr. Hicks managed to do without any trouble. As soon as we took the other chiefs into Mr. Banks's tent, they became just as eager to have the men returned as they had been to keep them and requested that one of our people go with a few of theirs to retrieve them. I sent a petty officer and the Corporal of Marines with 3 or 4 of their people, confident they would come back with the 2 men by the evening. But when they didn't return as quickly as I had hoped, I brought all the chiefs on board the ship for safety. Around 9 o'clock in the evening, Webb, the Marine, was brought back by some of the locals and sent on board. He informed me that the petty officer and corporal who had been sent to find them were disarmed and captured by the locals, and that Gibson was with them. As soon as I got this information, I sent Mr. Hicks out in the longboat with a strong group of men to rescue them, but before he left, Tootaha and the other chiefs needed to understand that they had to send some of their people with Mr. Hicks to show him where our men were, and at the same time send orders for their immediate release, because if any harm came to the men, the chiefs would face consequences. I believe at that moment they wanted the men to return safely as much as I did, because the guides led Mr. Hicks to the location before dawn, and he was able to bring back the men without any resistance, returning with them around 7 o'clock in the morning.

Tuesday, 11th. I then told the Chiefs that there remain'd nothing more to be done to regain their liberty but to deliver up the Arms the People had taken from the Petty Officer and Corporal, and these were brought on board in less than half an Hour, and then I sent them all on shore. They made but a short stay with our people there before they went away, and most of the natives with them: but they first wanted to give us 4 Hogs. These we refused to except of them, as they would take nothing in return. Thus we are likely to leave these people in disgust with our behaviour towards them, owing wholy to the folly of 2 of our men, for it does not appear that the natives had any hand in inticing them away, and therefore were not the first Agressors. However, it is very certain that had we not taken this step we never should have recovered them. The Petty Officer whom I sent in quest of the deserters told me that the Natives would give him no intelligence where they were, nor those that went along with him, but, on the contrary, grew very troublesome, and, as they were returning in the evening, they were suddenly seized upon by a number of Armed men that had hid themselves in the wood for that purpose. This was after Tootaha had been seized upon by us, so that they did this by way of retaliation in order to recover their Chief; but this method did not meet with the approbation of them all. A great many condemn'd these proceedings, and were for having them set at liberty, while others were for keeping them until Tootaha was releas'd. The dispute went so far that they came from words to blows, and our people were several times very near being set at liberty; but at last the party for keeping them Prevailed, but, as they had still some friends, no insult was offer'd them. A little while after they brought Webb and Gibson, the two deserters, to them as Prisoners likewise; but at last they agreed that Webb should be sent to inform us where the others were. When I came to Examine these 2 Men touching the reasons that induced them to go away, it appeared that an acquaintance they had contracted with 2 Girls, and to whom they had strongly attached themselves, was the Sole reason of their attempting to stay behind. Yesterday we weighed the small Bower Anchor, the Stock of which was so much eaten by the worms as to break in heaving up, and to-day we hove up the best Bower, and found the Stock in the very same Condition. This day we got everything off from the Shore, and to-night everybody lays on board.

Tuesday, 11th. I then told the Chiefs that the only way to regain their freedom was to hand over the weapons the people had taken from the Petty Officer and Corporal, and these were brought on board in less than half an hour. After that, I sent them all ashore. They didn't stay long with our people before they left, and most of the natives went with them. However, they first wanted to give us 4 pigs. We refused to accept them, as they didn’t want anything in return. This likely means we are leaving these people feeling upset with our behavior, mostly due to the foolishness of 2 of our men, as it seems the natives weren’t involved in luring them away and were therefore not the first aggressors. However, it’s clear that if we hadn’t taken this step, we would never have gotten them back. The Petty Officer I sent to find the deserters told me that the natives wouldn’t give him any information about their whereabouts, nor would anyone with him, but instead became troublesome. On their way back in the evening, they were suddenly ambushed by a group of armed men who had hidden in the woods for that purpose. This was after we had captured Tootaha, so they did this as retaliation to recover their Chief; however, not everyone agreed with this method. Many condemned these actions and wanted to set them free, while others wanted to keep them until Tootaha was released. The argument escalated to the point that they went from words to blows, and our people were several times very close to being freed; but in the end, the group wanting to keep them prevailed. However, since they still had some friends, no harm was done to them. Shortly after, they brought Webb and Gibson, the two deserters, to them as prisoners as well; but eventually, they agreed that Webb should be sent to inform us where the others were. When I questioned these 2 men about why they had left, it turned out that their attachment to 2 girls they had befriended was the sole reason they tried to stay behind. Yesterday, we weighed the small bower anchor, which had been so damaged by worms that it broke when we tried to lift it, and today we raised the best bower anchor, finding the stock in the same poor condition. Today, we got everything off the shore, and tonight, everyone is on board.

Wednesday, 12th. The Carpenter employ'd in stocking the Anchors and the Seamen in getting the Ship ready for Sea. This morning we found the Staves of the Cask the Natives stole from us some time ago laying at the Watering place; but they had been Sencible enough to keep the Iron Hoops, and only return what to them was of no use.

Wednesday, 12th. The carpenter was busy repairing the anchors, and the sailors were getting the ship ready to set sail. This morning, we found the staves from the cask that the natives stole from us a while ago lying at the watering place; however, they were smart enough to keep the iron hoops and only returned what was useless to them.

[Sail from Tahiti.]

[Set sail from Tahiti.]

Thursday, 13th. Winds Easterly, a light breeze. This morning we was visited by Obariea and several others of our acquaintance, a thing we did not expect after what had hapned but 2 days ago; but this was in some measures owing to Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself going to Apparra last night, where we so far convinc'd them of our Friendly disposition that several of them were in tears at our coming away. Between 11 and 12 o'Clock we got under Sail, and took our final leave of these People, after a stay of just three Months, the most part of which time we have been upon good terms with them. Some few differences have now and then hapned owing partly to the want of rightly understanding each other, and partly to their natural thievish disposition, which we could not at all times bear with or guard against; but these have been attended with no ill consequence to either side except the first, in which one of them was kill'd, and this I was very sorry for, because from what had hapned to them by the Dolphin I thought it would have been no hard matter to have got and keep a footing with them without bloodshed. For some time before we left this Island several of the Natives were daily offering themselves to go away with us; and as it was thought they must be of use to us in our future discoveries we resolved to bring away one whose name is Tupia, a Chief and a Priest. This man had been with us most part of the time we had been upon the Island, which gave us an opportunity to know something of him. We found him to be a very intelligent person, and to know more of the Geography of the Islands situated in these Seas, their produce, and the religion, laws, and Customs of the inhabitants, than any one we had met with, and was the likeliest person to answer our Purpose. For these reasons, and at the request of Mr. Banks, I received him on board, together with a young Boy, his Servant. For the first two Months we were at this Island the Natives supplied us with as much Bread fruit, Cocoa Nuts, etc., as we could well dispence with, and now and then a few Hogs, but of these hardly sufficient to give the Ship's company one and sometimes two fresh Meals a week. As to Fowls, I did not see above 3 dozen upon the whole Island, and fish they seldom would part with; but during the last Month we got little refreshment of any sort. The detaining of their Canoes broke off Trade at that time, and it never after was begun again with any Spirit. However, it was not wholy owing to this, but to a Scarcity. The Season for Bread fruit was wholy over, and what other Fruits they had were hardly sufficient for themselves; at least, they did not care to part with them. All sorts of Fruits we purchased with Beads and Nails, not less than 40-penny, for a nail under that size was of no value; but we could not get a Hog above 10 or 12 pounds weight for anything less than a Hatchet, not but that they set great value upon Spike Nails; but, as this was an Article many in the Ship are provided with, the Women soon found a much easier way at coming at them than by bringing Provisions. Our Traffick with this people was carried on with as much Order as in the best regulated Market in Europe. It was managed ashore chiefly by Mr. Banks, who took uncommon Pains to procure from the Natives every kind of refreshment that was to be got. Axes, Hatchets, Spikes, large Nails, looking Glasses, Knives, and Beads are all highly valued by this People, and nothing more is wanting to Traffick with them for everything they have to dispose of. They are likewise very fond of fine Linnen Cloth, both White and Printed, but an Axe worth half a Crown will fetch more than a Piece of Cloth worth Twenty Shillings.

Thursday, 13th. The wind was coming from the east, with a light breeze. This morning, we received a visit from Obariea and several others we knew, which was unexpected after what happened just two days ago; however, this was partly due to Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I visiting Apparra last night, where we managed to convince them of our friendly intentions, leaving several of them in tears when we departed. Between 11 and 12 o'clock, we set sail and said our final goodbyes to these people after a stay of exactly three months, most of which time we had a good relationship with them. There were a few disagreements here and there, partly due to miscommunication and partly because of their natural tendency to steal, which we couldn't always tolerate or protect against; but these issues led to no serious harm for either side, except for the initial incident where one of them was killed. I felt terrible about that because, from what had happened to them with the Dolphin, I thought it would have been easy to maintain a positive relationship without any bloodshed. For a while before we left the island, several natives expressed their desire to come with us; it was believed they could assist us in our future explorations, so we decided to take one named Tupia, a chief and a priest. This man had been with us for most of our time on the island, allowing us to get to know him. We found him to be very knowledgeable about the geography of the islands in these seas, their resources, and the religion, laws, and customs of the locals—more than anyone else we had encountered, making him the best fit for our needs. For these reasons, and at Mr. Banks' request, I welcomed him aboard, along with a young boy who was his servant. During our first two months on this island, the natives supplied us with plenty of breadfruit, coconuts, and occasionally a few pigs, though there were hardly enough for the crew to enjoy one or two fresh meals a week. I only saw about three dozen chickens on the entire island, and fish were rarely offered. However, during the last month, we received little food of any kind. The seizure of their canoes halted trade at that point, and it never fully resumed afterward. This was not entirely due to that incident but also because of a scarcity. The season for breadfruit was completely over, and whatever fruits they had were barely enough for their own needs; at least, they were reluctant to share. We bought all kinds of fruits with beads and large nails, not smaller than 40-penny because smaller nails had no value. However, we couldn't obtain a pig weighing more than 10 or 12 pounds for anything less than a hatchet; they valued spike nails highly, but since many people on the ship had them, the women quickly found an easier way to get them than by bringing provisions. Our trade with them was conducted with as much order as in the best-regulated market in Europe. Mr. Banks managed the trading onshore, going to great lengths to acquire every kind of refreshment available from the natives. Axes, hatchets, spikes, large nails, mirrors, knives, and beads were all highly valued by these people, and that was all we needed to trade for anything they had for sale. They also had a fondness for fine linen cloth, both white and printed, but an axe worth half a crown would fetch more than a piece of cloth worth twenty shillings.

Upon our arrival at Batavia we had certain information that the two ships that were at George's Island some time before our arrival there were both French ships.* (* In Admiralty copy.)

Upon our arrival at Batavia, we learned for sure that the two ships that had been at George's Island a while before we got there were both French ships.* (* In Admiralty copy.)

DESCRIPTION OF KING GEORGE'S ISLAND.

DESCRIPTION OF KING GEORGE'S ISLAND.

This Island is called by the Natives Otaheite, and was first discovered by Captain Wallis, in His Majesty's ship Dolphin, on June 19th, 1767, and to the Credit of him and his Officers, the Longitude of Royal Bay was by them settled to within half a degree of the Truth, and the whole figure of the Island not ill described. It is situated between the Latitude of 17 degrees 29 minutes and 17 degrees 53 minutes South, and between the Longitude of 149 degrees 10 minutes and 149 degrees 39 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich.* (* These latitudes are exact. The modern limits of longitude are 149 degrees 7 minutes to 149 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds.) Point Venus, so called from the Observation being made there, is the Northern extremity of the Island, and lies in the Longitude of 149 degrees 30 minutes,* (* Now considered to be 149 degrees 29 minutes.) being the mean result of a Great number of Observations made upon the Spot. The Shores of this Island are mostly guarded from the Sea by reefs of coral rocks, and these form several excellent Bays and Harbours, wherein are room and depth of Water sufficient for the largest Ships.

This island is called Otaheite by the natives and was first discovered by Captain Wallis on His Majesty's ship Dolphin on June 19, 1767. To the credit of him and his officers, they determined the longitude of Royal Bay to within half a degree of the truth, and they provided a fairly accurate description of the island's shape. It is located between latitudes 17 degrees 29 minutes and 17 degrees 53 minutes south, and longitudes 149 degrees 10 minutes and 149 degrees 39 minutes west from the Greenwich Meridian.* (*These latitudes are exact. The modern limits of longitude are 149 degrees 7 minutes to 149 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds.) Point Venus, named because the observation was made there, is the northern tip of the island and is situated at a longitude of 149 degrees 30 minutes,* (*now considered to be 149 degrees 29 minutes.) This value is the average of numerous observations taken at the site. The shores of this island are mostly protected from the sea by coral reef formations, which create several excellent bays and harbors that have enough space and depth for the largest ships.

Royal Bay, called by the Natives Matavie,* (* Matavai.) in which we lay, and the Dolphin before us, is not inferior to any on the Island, both in Point of conveniency and Situation. It may easily be known by a Prodigious high Mountain in the middle of the Island, which bears due south from Point Venus, which is the Eastern point of the Bay. To sail into it either keep the West point of the Reefs which lies before Point Venus close on board, or give it a berth of near half a Mile in order to avoid a small Shoal of Coral Rocks, whereon is but 2 1/2 fathoms of water. The best Anchoring is on the Eastern side of the Bay in 16 or 14 fathoms of water, owsey bottom. The Shore of the bay is all a fine sandy beach, behind which runs a river of Fresh Water, so that any Number of Ships might Water here without discommoding one another. The only wood for fuel upon the whole Island is fruit Trees, and these must be purchased of the Natives, if you mean to keep on good Terms with them. There are some Harbours to the Westward of this bay that have not been mentioned, but as they lay Contiguous to it, and are to be found in the plan, the description of them is unnecessary.

Royal Bay, known to the Natives as Matavie,* (*Matavai.) where we are anchored, is as good as any bay on the island in terms of convenience and location. You can easily identify it by the towering mountain in the middle of the island, which lies directly south of Point Venus, the eastern point of the bay. To sail into the bay, either stay close to the west point of the reefs near Point Venus or keep a distance of about half a mile to avoid a small area of coral rocks with only 2.5 fathoms of water. The best anchorage is on the eastern side of the bay in 16 or 14 fathoms of water with a sandy bottom. The shore of the bay features a nice sandy beach, and there’s a freshwater river running behind it, so multiple ships can take on water without getting in each other’s way. The only firewood available on the island comes from fruit trees, and you'll need to buy these from the locals if you want to maintain a good relationship with them. There are some harbors to the west of this bay that haven't been mentioned, but since they are close by and shown on the map, I won't go into detail about them.

The land of this Island, except what is immediately bordering upon the Sea coast, is of a very uneven Surface, and rises in ridges which run up into the middle of the Island, and there form mountains, that are of a height Sufficient to be seen at the distance of 20 leagues. Between the foot of the ridges and the Sea is a border of low Land surrounding the whole Island, except in a few places where the ridge rises directly from the Sea. This low land is of Various Breadths, but nowhere exceeds a Mile and a half. The Soil is rich and fertile, being for the most part well stock'd with fruit Trees and small Plantations. and well water'd by a number of small Rivulets of Excellent Water which come from the adjacent hills. It is upon this low Land that the greatest part of the inhabitants live, not in Towns or Vilages, but dispersed everywhere round the whole Island; the Tops of most of the ridges and mountains are Barren and, as it were, burnt up with the sun, yet many parts of some of them are not without their produce, and many of the Valleys are fertile and inhabited.

The land on this island, except for the areas directly along the coastline, is very uneven and rises in ridges that stretch toward the center of the island, forming mountains that can be seen from 20 leagues away. Between the bases of the ridges and the sea is a strip of low land that surrounds the entire island, except in a few spots where the ridge rises straight from the sea. This low land varies in width but is never more than a mile and a half wide. The soil is rich and fertile, mostly filled with fruit trees and small farms, and is well-watered by several small streams of excellent water that flow from the nearby hills. Most of the inhabitants live on this low land, not in towns or villages, but scattered all over the island; the tops of most ridges and mountains are barren and scorched by the sun, yet some parts do produce crops, and many valleys are fertile and inhabited.

[Produce of Tahiti.]

[Tahiti's Produce.]

OF THE PRODUCE.

OF THE PRODUCE.

The produce of this Island is Bread Fruit, Cocoa Nuts, Bonanoes, Plantains, a fruit like an Apple, sweet Potatoes, Yams, a Fruit known by the name of Eag Melloa, and reck'ned most delicious; Sugar Cane which the inhabitants eat raw; a root of the Salop kind, called by the inhabitants Pea; the root also of a plant called Ether; and a fruit in a pod like a Kidney bean, which when roasted eats like a Chestnut, and is called Ahee; the fruit of a Tree which they call Wharra, something like a Pine Apple; the fruit of a Tree called by them Nano; the roots of a Fern and the roots of a plant called Thive. All these Articles the Earth almost Spontaniously produces, or, at least, they are raised with very little Labour. In the Article of food these people may almost be said to be exempt from the Curse of our Forefathers, scarcely can it be said that they Earn their bread with the sweat of their brow; benevolent Nature hath not only Supply'd them with necessarys, but with abundance of Superfluities. The Sea coast supplies them with vast Variety of most Excellent fish, but these they get not without some Trouble and Perseverance. Fish seems to be one of their greatest Luxuries, and they Eat it either raw or Dressed and seem to relish it one way as well as the other. Not only fish but almost everything that comes out of the Sea is Eat and Esteem'd by these People; Shell Fish, Lobsters, Crabs, and even sea insects, and what is commonly called blubbers of many kinds, conduce to their support.

The produce of this island includes breadfruit, coconuts, bananas, plantains, a fruit similar to an apple, sweet potatoes, yams, a fruit known as eag melloa, which is considered very delicious, sugar cane that the locals eat raw, a root of the salop type called pea, a root from a plant called ether, and a fruit in a pod resembling a kidney bean that, when roasted, tastes like a chestnut and is called ahee; the fruit of a tree they refer to as wharra, which is somewhat like a pineapple; the fruit of a tree called nano; the roots of a fern; and the roots of a plant called thive. All these items are produced by the earth almost spontaneously, or at least they require very little effort to grow. When it comes to food, these people could almost be said to be free from the curse of our forefathers; it’s hardly accurate to say they earn their bread through hard labor; nature has not only provided them with the essentials but also an abundance of extras. The coastline supplies them with a vast variety of excellent fish, although they do have to work a bit to catch it. Fish seems to be one of their biggest luxuries, and they eat it either raw or cooked, enjoying it both ways. Not only fish but nearly everything that comes from the sea is eaten and valued by these people; shellfish, lobsters, crabs, and even sea insects, along with what is commonly referred to as blubber of various kinds, contribute to their sustenance.

For tame Animals they have Hogs, Fowls, and Dogs, the latter of which we learned to Eat from them, and few were there of us but what allow'd that a South Sea dog was next to an English Lamb. One thing in their favour is that they live intirely upon Vegetables; probably our Dogs would not Eat half so well. Little can be said in favour of their Fowles, but their pork is most Excellent, they have no beasts of Prey of any Sort, and Wild Fowls are scarce and confin'd to a few Species. When any of the Chiefs kill a Hog it seems to be almost equally divided among all his Dependents, and as these are generally very numerous, it is but a little that come to each person's share, so that their chief food is Vegetables, and of these they eat a large quantity.

For domesticated animals, they have pigs, chickens, and dogs, the last of which we learned to eat from them, and few of us disagreed that a South Sea dog was nearly as good as an English lamb. One good thing about them is that they live entirely on vegetables; our dogs probably wouldn’t eat as well. There’s not much to say in favor of their chickens, but their pork is excellent. They have no predatory animals at all, and wild birds are rare and limited to a few species. When any of the chiefs kill a pig, it seems to be divided almost equally among all their dependents, and since these are usually very numerous, each person's share is small, so their main food source is vegetables, and they eat a large amount of them.

Cookery seems to have been but little studied here; they have only 2 Methods of applying Fire--broiling and Baking, as we called it; the method this is done I have before described, and I am of Opinion that Victuals dressed this way are more juicy and more equally done than by any of our Methods, large Fish in particular, Bread Fruit, Bananoes. Plantains Cooked this way eat like boil'd Potatoes, and was much used by us by way of bread whenever we could get them. Of bread Fruit they make 2 or 3 dishes by beating it with a Stone Pestle till it makes a Paste, mixing Water or Cocoa Nut Liquor, or both, with it, and adding ripe Plantains, Bananoes, Sour Paste, etc.

Cooking seems to have been studied very little here; they have only two methods of applying heat—broiling and baking, as we've called it. I've described this method before, and I believe that food cooked this way is juicier and more evenly done than by any of our methods, especially large fish, breadfruit, and bananas. Plantains cooked this way taste like boiled potatoes and were often used by us as bread whenever we could get them. From breadfruit, they make two or three dishes by pounding it with a stone pestle until it becomes a paste, mixing in water or coconut milk, or both, and adding ripe plantains, bananas, sour paste, etc.

This last is made from bread Fruit in the following manner. This fruit, from what I can find, remains in Season only 8 or 9 months in the year, and as it is the Chief support of the inhabitants a reserve of food must be made for those months when they are without it. To do this the Fruit is gathered when upon the point of ripening; after the rinde is scraped off it is laid in heaps and coverd close with leaves, where it undergoes a fermentation, and becomes soft and disagreeably sweet. The Core is then taken out, and the rest of the fruit thrown into a Hole dug for that purpose, the sides and bottom of which are neatly laid with grass. The whole is covered with leaves and heavy stones laid upon them; here it undergoes a second Fermentation and becomes sourish, in which condition they say it will keep good 10 or 12 months. As they want to use it they make it into balls, which they wrap up in leaves and bake in the same manner as they do the Fruit from the Tree; it is then ready for eating either hot or cold, and hath a sour and disagreeable taste. In this last State it will keep good a Month or 6 Weeks; it is called by them Mahai, and they seldom make a Meal without some of it, one way or another. To this plain diet Salt Water is the universal sauce, hardly any one sets down to a meal without a Cocoa Nut shell full of it standing by them, into which they dip most of what they Eat, especially Fish, drinking at Intervals large sops of it out of their Hands, so that a man may use half a Pint at a Meal.

This last dish is made from breadfruit in the following way. From what I can gather, this fruit is only in season for about 8 or 9 months a year, and since it is the main food source for the locals, they need to prepare a reserve for the months when it's not available. To do this, the fruit is harvested just before it ripens; after the skin is scraped off, it’s piled up and covered securely with leaves, where it ferments and becomes soft and unpleasantly sweet. The core is then removed, and the remaining fruit is placed in a hole dug specifically for this purpose, with the sides and bottom neatly lined with grass. This is all covered with leaves and heavy stones are placed on top; here, it goes through a second fermentation and turns sour, which allows it to last for 10 to 12 months. When they want to use it, they shape it into balls, wrap them in leaves, and bake them just like they do the fresh fruit; they can then eat it either hot or cold, though it has a sour and unpleasant taste. In this form, it remains good for a month or 6 weeks; they call it Mahai, and they rarely have a meal without it, in some form or another. For this simple diet, saltwater serves as the universal condiment. Almost everyone sits down to eat with a coconut shell full of it beside them, dipping most of their food into it, especially fish, and frequently sipping sizable amounts from their hands, so a person may use half a pint during a meal.

It is not common for any 2 to eat together, the better sort hardly ever; and the women never upon any account eat with the Men, but always by themselves. What can be the reason of so unusual a custom it is hard to say; especially as they are a people, in every other instance, fond of Society and much so of their Women. They were often Asked the reason, but they never gave no other Answer, but that they did it because it was right, and Express'd much dislike at the Custom of Men and Women Eating together of the same Victuals. We have often used all the intreatys we were Masters of to invite the Women to partake of our Victuals at our Tables, but there never was an instance of one of them doing it publick, but they would Often goe 5 or 6 together into the Servants apartments, and there eat very heartily of whatever they could find, nor were they the least disturbed if any of us came in while they were dining; and it hath sometimes hapned that when a woman was alone in our company she would eat with us, but always took care that her own people should not know what she had don, so that whatever may be the reasons for this custom, it certainly affects their outward manners more than their Principle.

It's not typical for any two people to eat together, and the higher class almost never does; the women never eat with the men under any circumstances, but always by themselves. It's hard to say why this unusual custom exists, especially since they're a people who generally enjoy companionship and are particularly fond of their women. They were often asked about the reason, but they only replied that they did it because it was the right thing to do and expressed strong disapproval of the practice of men and women eating together. We’ve often tried everything we could think of to invite the women to share our meals at our tables, but there was never a case of one of them doing so publicly. However, they would often go five or six at a time into the servants' quarters and eat heartily on whatever they could find, and they weren’t bothered at all if any of us walked in while they were dining. Sometimes, when a woman was alone in our company, she would eat with us but always made sure her own people would not know what she had done, which suggests that whatever the reasons behind this custom may be, it definitely influences their outward behavior more than their principles.

[Natives of Tahiti.]

[Tahitians.]

PERSON OF THE NATIVES.

NATIVE PEOPLE.

With respect to their persons the Men in general are tall, strong-limb'd, and well shaped. One of the tallest we saw measured 6 feet 3 inches and a half. The superior women are in every respect as large as Europeans, but the inferior sort are in General small, owing possibly to their early Amours, which they are more addicted to than their superiors. They are of various Colours: those of the inferior sort, who are obliged to be much exposed to the Sun and air, are of a very Dark brown; the superiors again, who spend most of their Time in their Houses under Shelter, are not browner than people who are born or reside longer in the West Indies; nay, some of the Women are almost as fair as Europeans. Their hair is almost universally black, thick, and Strong; this the Women wear short Cropt Round their Ears. The Men, on the other hand, wear it different ways: the better sort let it grow long, and sometimes tying it up on the Top of their Heads, or letting it hang loose over their Shoulders; but many of the inferiors, and such who, in the exercise of their professions, fishing, etc., are obliged to be much upon or in the Water, wear it cropt short like the women. They always pluck out a part of their beards, and keep what remains neat and Clean. Both Sexes eradicate every hair from under their Armpits, and look upon it as a mark of uncleanliness in us that we do not do the Same.

In general, men are tall, strong, and well-built. One of the tallest we saw was 6 feet 3 and a half inches. The upper-class women are just as large as Europeans, but the lower-class women tend to be smaller, possibly due to their earlier relationships, which they seem to engage in more often than their counterparts. Their skin colors vary: the lower-class women, who are often exposed to the sun and elements, have very dark brown skin; meanwhile, the upper-class women, who spend most of their time sheltered at home, are not much darker than people born or living for a long time in the West Indies; some women are almost as fair as Europeans. Most have black, thick, and strong hair, which women wear cropped short around their ears. The men wear their hair in different styles: the upper-class men let it grow long, sometimes tying it up on top of their heads or letting it hang loose over their shoulders; however, many lower-class men, especially those who work in fishing or other water-related professions, keep their hair cropped short like the women. They always pluck out part of their beards and keep the rest neat and clean. Both sexes remove all hair from under their armpits and consider it unclean for us not to do the same.

They have all fine white Teeth, and for the most part short flat Noses and thick lips; yet their features are agreeable, and their gaite graceful, and their behavior to strangers and to each other is open, affable, and Courteous, and, from all I could see, free from treachery, only that they are thieves to a man, and would steal but everything that came in their way, and that with such dexterity as would shame the most noted Pickpocket in Europe. They are very cleanly people, both in their persons and diet, always washing their hands and Mouth immediately before and after their Meals, and wash or Bathe themselves in fresh Water 3 times a day, morning, Noon, and Night.

They all have nice white teeth, mostly short flat noses, and thick lips; however, their features are appealing, their gait is graceful, and their behavior towards strangers and each other is welcoming, friendly, and polite. From what I observed, they seem to be free from deceit, except that they are all thieves and will steal almost anything that comes their way, doing so with a skill that would embarrass even the most famous pickpocket in Europe. They are very clean people, both in their personal hygiene and their diet, always washing their hands and mouths right before and after their meals, and they wash or bathe in fresh water three times a day—morning, noon, and night.

The only disagreeable thing about them is the Oil with which they anoint their heads, Monoe, as they call it; this is made of Cocoanutt Oil, in which some sweet Herbs or Flowers are infused. The Oil is generally very rancid, which makes the wearer of it smell not very agreeable.* (* Other voyagers have, on the contrary, described the odour of this sweetened oil as agreeable.) Another custom they have that is disagreeable to Europeans, which is eating lice, a pretty good stock of which they generally carry about them. However, this custom is not universal; for I seldom saw it done but among Children and Common People, and I am perswaided that had they the means they would keep themselves as free from lice as we do; but the want of Combs in a Hot climate makes this hardly possible. There are some very fine men upon this Island whose skins are whiter than any European's, but of a Dead Colour, like that of the Nose of a White Horse; their Eyes, eyebrows, hair and beards are also White. Their bodys were cover'd, more or less, with a kind of White down. Their skins are spotted, some parts being much whiter than others. They are short-sighted, with their eyes oftimes full of rheum, and always look'd unwholesome, and have neither the Spirit nor the activity of the other Natives. I did not see above 3 or 4 upon the whole Island, and these were old men; so that I concluded that this difference of colour, etc., was accidental, and did not run in families, for if it did they must have been more Numerous. The inhabitants of this Island are Troubled with a sort of Leprosy, or Scab all over their bodys. I have seen Men, Women, and Children, but not many, who have had this distemper to that degree as not to be able to walk. This distemper, I believe, runs in familys, because I have seen both mother and Child have it.

The only unpleasant thing about them is the oil they use to anoint their heads, called Monoe. This is made from coconut oil, infused with some sweet herbs or flowers. The oil is usually very rancid, which makes the wearer smell not very nice. (*Other travelers have, on the contrary, described the scent of this sweetened oil as pleasant.*) Another custom they have that Europeans find unappealing is eating lice, which they typically have a good supply of. However, this practice isn't universal; I rarely saw it practiced except among children and common people. I believe that if they had the means, they would keep themselves as free from lice as we do, but the lack of combs in a hot climate makes that nearly impossible. There are some very fine men on this island whose skin is whiter than any European's, but with a dull color like the nose of a white horse; their eyes, eyebrows, hair, and beards are also white. Their bodies are covered, to some extent, with a kind of white down. Their skin is spotted, with some areas much whiter than others. They are short-sighted, often have eyes full of mucus, and always appear unwell, lacking the spirit and energy of the other natives. I saw only about three or four of them on the whole island, and they were all old men, so I concluded that this difference in color and so on was random and didn’t run in families, because if it did, there should have been more of them. The inhabitants of this island suffer from a type of leprosy or scab that affects their entire bodies. I have seen men, women, and children, but not many, who have had this condition to the extent that they could not walk. I believe this illness does run in families because I have seen both mothers and children with it.

Both sexes paint their Bodys, Tattow, as it is called in their Language. This is done by inlaying the Colour of Black under their skins, in such a manner as to be indelible. Some have ill-design'd figures of men, birds, or dogs; the women generally have this figure Z simply on every joint of their fingers and Toes; the men have it likewise, and both have other differant figures, such as Circles, Crescents, etc., which they have on their Arms and Legs; in short, they are so various in the application of these figures that both the quantity and Situation of them seem to depend intirely upon the humour of each individual, yet all agree in having their buttocks covered with a Deep black. Over this Most have Arches drawn one over another as high as their short ribs, which are near a Quarter of an inch broad. These Arches seem to be their great pride, as both men and Women show them with great pleasure.

Both men and women tattoo their bodies, which is what they call it in their language. This is done by embedding black ink under their skin in a way that makes it permanent. Some have poorly designed images of men, birds, or dogs; women usually have a simple pattern on every joint of their fingers and toes. Men have similar patterns, and both genders have other different designs like circles, crescents, and more on their arms and legs. In short, the variety of these designs is so great that both the amount and placement seem to depend entirely on the personal preference of each individual. However, everyone agrees on having their buttocks covered in deep black ink. Above this, most have arches drawn over one another that extend up to their short ribs, and these arches are about a quarter of an inch wide. These arches seem to be a major source of pride for both men and women, who display them with great enjoyment.

Their method of Tattowing I shall now describe. The colour they use is lamp black, prepar'd from the Smoak of a Kind of Oily nut, used by them instead of Candles. The instrument for pricking it under the Skin is made of very thin flatt pieces of bone or Shell, from a quarter of an inch to an inch and a half broad, according to the purpose it is to be used for, and about an inch and a half long. One end is cut into sharp teeth, and the other fastened to a handle. The teeth are dipped into black Liquor, and then drove, by quick, sharp blows struck upon the handle with a Stick for that purpose, into the skin so deep that every stroke is followed with a small quantity of Blood. The part so marked remains sore for some days before it heals. As this is a painful operation, especially the Tattowing their Buttocks, it is perform'd but once in their Life times; it is never done until they are 12 or 14 years of Age.

I will now describe their tattooing method. The color they use is lamp black, made from the smoke of a type of oily nut that they use instead of candles. The tool for pricking under the skin is made from very thin, flat pieces of bone or shell, ranging from a quarter of an inch to an inch and a half wide, depending on its purpose, and about an inch and a half long. One end is shaped into sharp teeth, while the other is attached to a handle. The teeth are dipped into a black liquid and then driven into the skin with quick, sharp blows on the handle using a stick designed for this purpose, going deep enough that each stroke draws a small amount of blood. The marked area remains sore for several days before healing. Since this is a painful process, especially when tattooing their buttocks, it is only done once in their lifetime and never before they are 12 or 14 years old.

[Clothing of Tahitians.]

Tahitians' clothing.

Their Cloathing is either of Cloth or Matting of several different sorts; the dress of both Men and Women are much the same, which is a Piece of Cloth or Matting wrapp'd 2 or 3 times round their waist, and hangs down below their Knees, both behind and before, like a Pettycoat; another piece, or sometimes 2 or 3, about 2 yards or 2 1/2 yards long, with a hole in the Middle, through which they put their heads. This hangs over their Shoulders down behind and before, and is tied round their waist with a long piece of thin Cloth, and being open at the sides gives free liberty to their arms. This is the common dress of all ranks of people, and there are few without such a one except the Children, who go quite naked, the Boys until they are 6 or 7 years of Age, and the girls until 3 or 4. At these Ages they begin to cover what nature teaches them to hide. Besides the dress I have mentioned some of the better sort, such as can afford it, but more especially the Women, will one way or other wrap round them several pieces of Cloth, each 8 or 10 Yards long and 2 or 3 broad, so much that I have often wondered how they could bear it in so hot a climate. Again, on the other hand, many of the inferior sort during the heat of the Day, go almost naked, the women wearing nothing but the Petticoat aforementioned, and sometimes hardly that. The men wear a piece of Cloth like a Sack, which goes between their thighs, and brought up before and behind, and then wrapped round their waist. This every man wears always without exception, and it is no uncommon thing to see many of the better sort have nothing else on, as it is reckoned no shame for any part of the body to be exposed to View, except those which all mankind hide.

Their clothing is made from various types of cloth or matting. The outfits for both men and women are quite similar, consisting of a piece of cloth or matting wrapped 2 or 3 times around their waist, hanging down below their knees, both in front and behind, like a petticoat. Another piece, sometimes 2 or 3, measuring about 2 to 2.5 yards in length with a hole in the middle for their heads, hangs over their shoulders, draping down in front and back. It's tied around their waist with a long strip of thin cloth, and being open at the sides allows their arms to move freely. This is the standard dress for people of all social classes, with few exceptions, mainly children who are completely naked. Boys stay naked until they are about 6 or 7 years old, while girls remain so until they are around 3 or 4. At these ages, they start to cover themselves as they grow aware of modesty. In addition to the basic attire I've mentioned, those who can afford it, particularly women, often wrap themselves in several pieces of cloth, each 8 to 10 yards long and 2 or 3 wide, which makes me question how they manage to cope in such a hot climate. On the other hand, many from the lower classes go almost naked during the heat of the day, with women typically wearing only the aforementioned petticoat, and sometimes nothing at all. Men wear a piece of cloth similar to a sack that goes between their thighs, brought up in front and behind, and then wrapped around their waist. This is a garment that every man wears without exception, and it’s not uncommon to see many from the upper classes wearing nothing else, as exposing any part of the body is not considered shameful—except for those areas that everyone generally covers.

Both sexes sometimes shade their faces from the Sun with little Bonnets made of Cocoa-Nut leaves. Some have them of fine Matting, but this is less common. They sometimes wear Turbands, but their Chief Headdress is what they call Tomou, which is human Hair plaited scarce thicker than common thread. Of this I can safely affirm that I have seen pieces near a mile in length worked upon one end without a Knott. These are made and worn only by the women, 5 or 6 such pieces of which they will sometimes wind round their Heads, the effect of which, if done with taste, is very becoming. They have Earings by way of Ornament, but wear them only at one Ear. These are made of Shells, Stones, Berries, red pease, and some small pearls which they wear 3 tied together; but our Beads, Buttons, etc., very soon supply'd their places.

Both men and women sometimes shield their faces from the sun with small hats made of coconut leaves. Some use fine mats for this purpose, but that's less common. They occasionally wear turbans, but their main headgear is something they call Tomou, which is human hair braided so finely it’s almost as thin as regular thread. I can confidently say that I’ve seen strands nearly a mile long worked on one end without a knot. These are made and worn only by women, and they might wrap 5 or 6 of these strands around their heads, which looks quite attractive if done well. They have earrings for decoration, but they only wear them in one ear. These are made from shells, stones, berries, red peas, and small pearls, usually worn in groups of three; however, our beads and buttons quickly took their place.

[Customs of Tahiti.]

[Tahiti Customs.]

MANNERS AND CUSTOMS.

Etiquette and Traditions.

After their meals in the Heat of the day they often Sleep, middle Aged people especially, the better sort of whom seem to spend most of their time in eating and Sleeping. Diversions they have but few, shooting with the Bow and Wrestling are the Chief; the first of which is confin'd almost wholy to the Chiefs; they shoot for distance only, kneeling upon one knee and dropping the Bow the instant of the Arrows parting from it. I have seen one of them shoot an Arrow 274 yards, yet he looked upon it as no Great Shotte.

After their meals during the hottest part of the day, they often take a nap, especially middle-aged people, who seem to spend most of their time eating and sleeping. They have very few activities, with shooting arrows and wrestling being the main ones. Bow shooting is mostly reserved for the chiefs; they aim for distance only, kneeling on one knee and dropping the bow as soon as the arrow leaves it. I’ve seen one of them shoot an arrow 274 yards, yet he considered it nothing special.

Musick is little known to them, yet they are very fond of it; they have only 2 Instruments--the flute and the Drum. The former is made of hollow Bamboo about 15 inches long, in which are 3 Holes; into one of them they blow with one Nostril, stopping the other with the thumb of the left hand, the other 2 Holes they stop and unstop with their fingers, and by this means produce 4 Notes, of which they have made one Tune, which serves them upon all Occasions, to which they sing a number of songs generally consisting of 2 lines and generally in rhime. At any time of the day when they are Lazy they amuse themselves by singing these Couplets, but especially after dark when their candles are lighted, which are made of the Kernels of a Nutt abounding much in oil; these are stuck upon a Skewer of Wood one upon another, and give a very Tolerable light, which they often keep burning an hour after dark, and if they have strangers in the House much longer. Their drums are made of a hollow block of wood covered with Shark's Skin, and instead of Drumsticks they use their hands. Of these they make out 5 or 6 tunes and accompany the flutes.

Music is not well known to them, but they really enjoy it; they have only two instruments—the flute and the drum. The flute is made from hollow bamboo about 15 inches long, with three holes. They blow into one hole with one nostril, blocking the other with the thumb of their left hand, and they cover and uncover the other two holes with their fingers. This way, they create four notes, for which they have composed one tune that they use for every occasion, singing a number of songs that usually consist of two lines and typically rhyme. Whenever they feel lazy during the day, they pass the time by singing these couplets, especially after dark when they light their candles made from the kernels of a nut rich in oil. These are stacked on a wooden skewer, one on top of another, providing a decent light, which they often keep burning for an hour after dark and even longer if they have guests. Their drums are made of hollow wooden blocks covered with shark skin, and instead of drumsticks, they use their hands. From this, they create five or six tunes to accompany the flutes.

The drums are Chiefly used at their Heivas, which are a set of Musicians, 2 or 3 Drums for instance, as many flutes and singers, which go about from House to House and play, and are always received and rewarded by the Master of the family, who gives them a Piece of Cloth or whatever he can spare, for which they will stay 3 or 4 hours, during which time his house will be crowded full, for the people are extravagantly fond of this diversion. The Young Girls whenever they can collect 8 or 10 Together dance a very indecent Dance, which they call Timorodee, singing most indecent songs and using most indecent actions, in the practice of which they are brought up from their earliest childhood; in doing this they keep time to a great nicety. This exercise is generally left off as soon as they arrive at Years of Maturity, for as soon as they have form'd a connection with man they are expected to leave off dancing Timorodee.

The drums are mainly used at their Heivas, which includes a group of musicians, usually 2 or 3 drums, alongside flutes and singers. They go from house to house to play and are always welcomed and rewarded by the head of the family, who gives them a piece of cloth or whatever else he can spare. They usually stay for 3 or 4 hours, during which time the house becomes crowded because people are extremely fond of this entertainment. Young girls, whenever they can gather 8 or 10 together, perform a very risqué dance called Timorodee, singing explicit songs and performing inappropriate movements, which they learn from a very young age. They keep the rhythm perfectly. This practice generally stops as soon as they reach adulthood, because once they form a relationship with a man, they are expected to stop dancing Timorodee.

One amusement or custom more I must mention, though I confess I do not expect to be believed, it is founded upon a Custom so inhuman and contrary to the Principles of human nature. It is this: that more than one half of the better sort of the inhabitants have enter'd into a resolution of injoying free liberty in Love, without being Troubled or disturbed by its consequences. These mix and Cohabit together with the utmost freedom, and the Chilldren who are so unfortunate as to be thus begot are smother'd at the Moment of their Birth; many of these People contract intimacies and live together as man and wife for years, in the course of which the Children that are born are destroy'd. They are so far from concealing it that they look upon it as a branch of freedom upon which they Value themselves. They are called Arreoys, and have meetings among themselves, where the men amuse themselves with Wrestling, etc., and the Women in dancing the indecent dance before-mentioned, in the course of which they give full Liberty to their desires, but I believe keep up to the appearance of decency. I never see one of these meetings; Dr. Monkhouse saw part of one, enough to make him give Credit to what we had been told.

One more custom I have to mention, although I admit I don’t expect anyone to believe it, is based on a practice that is so cruel and against human nature. Here it is: more than half of the upper-class residents have made a choice to enjoy full freedom in love, without worrying about the consequences. They mix and live together with complete freedom, and the children who are unfortunately conceived this way are smothered at birth; many of these people form close relationships and live together like husband and wife for years, during which the children born are killed. They are so open about it that they see it as a form of freedom that they take pride in. They are called Arreoys and have gatherings where the men entertain themselves with wrestling and the women perform the indecent dance previously mentioned, during which they fully indulge their desires, though I believe they maintain a semblance of decency. I never attended one of these gatherings; Dr. Monkhouse saw a part of one, enough to convince him of what we had been told.

Both sexes express the most indecent ideas in conversation without the least emotion, and they delight in such conversation beyond any other. Chastity, indeed, is but little valued, especially among the middle people--if a Wife is found guilty of a breach of it her only punishment is a beating from her husband. The Men will very readily offer the Young Women to Strangers, even their own Daughters, and think it very strange if you refuse them; but this is done merely for the sake of gain.

Both men and women talk about the most inappropriate things in conversation without feeling any shame, and they enjoy those discussions more than anything else. Chastity isn't really respected, especially among the average people—if a wife is caught cheating, her only punishment is a beating from her husband. Men are quick to offer young women to strangers, even their own daughters, and think it’s odd if you say no; but they do this solely for profit.

The Houses or dwellings of these People are admirably calculated for the continual warmth of the Climate; they do not build them in Towns or Villages, but seperate each from the other, and always in the Woods, and are without walls, so that the air, cooled by the shade of the Trees, has free access in whatever direction it hapens to blow. No country can boast of more delightful walks than this; the whole Plains where the Natives reside are covered with groves of Bread Fruit and Cocoa Nut Trees, without underwood, and intersected in all directions by the Paths which go from House to House, so that nothing can be more grateful in a Climate where the sun hath so powerful an influence. They are generally built in form of an Oblong square, the Roofs are supported by 3 Rows of Pillars or posts, and neatly covered with Thatch made of Palm leaves. A middle-siz'd house is about 24 feet by 12, extream heigth about 8 or 9, and heigth of the Eves 3 1/2 or 4. The floors are cover'd some inches deep with Hay, upon which, here and there, lay matts for the conveniency of sitting down; few houses has more than one Stool, which is only used by the Master of the family.

The houses of these people are perfectly designed for the constant warmth of the climate. They don’t build them in towns or villages, but instead separate each one and always place them in the woods. They are without walls, allowing the air, cooled by the shade of the trees, to flow freely in any direction the wind blows. No country can claim more pleasant paths than this; the entire plains where the natives live are filled with groves of breadfruit and coconut trees, without underbrush, and crisscrossed in all directions by paths that connect one house to another, making it incredibly lovely in a climate where the sun has such a powerful effect. The houses are generally built in an oblong square shape, with roofs supported by three rows of pillars or posts, and neatly thatched with palm leaves. A medium-sized house measures about 24 feet by 12 feet, with a height of around 8 or 9 feet, and the eaves reaching 3.5 or 4 feet high. The floors are covered several inches deep with hay, and here and there, mats are laid out for sitting. Few houses have more than one stool, which is only used by the head of the family.

TAHITI: TYPES OF CANOES.

 

In their houses are no rooms or Partitions, but they all huddle and Sleep together; yet in this they generally observe some order, the Married people laying by themselves, and the unmarried each sex by themselves, at some small distance from each other. Many of the Eares or Chiefs are more private, having small movable houses in which they Sleep, man and Wife, which, when they go by Water from place to place, are tied upon their Canoes; these have walls made of Cocoa-Nut leaves, etc. I have said that the houses are without walls, but this is only to be understood in general, for many of them are walled with wickering, but not so close but to admit a free circulation of Air. The matts which serve them to sit upon in the daytime are also their beds in the night, and the Cloathes they wear in the day serve for covering, a little wood Stool, block of wood, or bundle of Cloth for a Pillow. Besides these common houses there are others much larger, 200 feet long and upwards, 30 broad, and 20 in heigth. There are generally 2 or 3 of these in every district, and seem'd not only built for the accommodation of the principal people, but common to all the inhabitants of that district, and raised and kept up by their joint Labour; these are always without walls, and have generally a large Area on one side neatly inclosed with low pallisades, etc.

In their homes, there are no separate rooms or partitions; everyone sleeps together. However, they do maintain some order, with married couples sleeping together and unmarried individuals of each gender sleeping separately, at a small distance from one another. Many of the leaders have more private arrangements, using small movable houses where they sleep, husband and wife together. When they travel by water, these houses are tied onto their canoes. The walls are made of coconut leaves, among other materials. Although I've mentioned that the houses have no walls, this is a generalization; many are made with woven materials but still allow for good air circulation. The mats they sit on during the day also serve as their beds at night, and the clothing they wear doubles as blankets, with a small wooden stool, a block of wood, or a bundle of cloth used as a pillow. Besides these common houses, there are some much larger ones, over 200 feet long, 30 feet wide, and 20 feet high. Usually, there are 2 or 3 of these in each district; they seem to be built not only for the main people but are also shared by all the residents of that district. They are constructed and maintained by the community's joint efforts. These larger houses are always without walls and usually feature a large area on one side, neatly enclosed with low palisades and other structures.

[Tahitian Canoes.]

[Tahitian Canoes.]

Their Canoes or Proes are built all of them very narrow, and some of the largest are 60 or 70 feet long. These consist of several pieces; the bottom is round and made of large logs hollow'd out to the thickness of about 3 Inches, and may consist of 3 or 4 pieces; the sides are of Plank of nearly the same thickness, and are built nearly perpendicular, rounding in a little towards the Gunwale. The pieces on which they are built are well fitted, and fastned or sewed together with strong platting something in the same manner as old China, Wooden Bowls, etc., are mended. The greatest breadth is at the after part, which is generally about 18 or 20 Inches, and the fore part about 1/3 Narrower; the heigth from the bottom to the Gunwale seldom exceeds 2 1/2 or 3 feet. They build them with high curv'd Sterns which are generally ornamented with carved work; the head or fore part curves little or nothing. The smaller Canoes are built after the same plan, some out of one, 2, or more trees according to their size or the use they are for. In order to prevent them from oversetting when in the Water, all those that go single, both great and Small, have what is called Outriggers, which are Pieces of Wood fastened to the Gunwale and project out on one side about 6, 8, or 10 feet, according to the size of the Boat. At the end is fastened in a Parrallel direction to the Canoe a long log of wood simply; or some have it Shaped in the form of a small Boat, but this is not common; this lays in the Water and Balances the Boat. Those that are for sailing have Outriggers only on the other side abreast of the Mast; these serves to fasten the Shrouds to, and are of use in Trimming the Boat when it blows fresh; the sailing proes have some one and some 2 masts; the sails are of Matting and are made narrow at the head and Square at the foot, something like a Shoulder of Mutton Sail, such as are generally used in Man-of-War Barges, etc.

Their canoes or proas are all built very narrow, with some of the largest measuring 60 to 70 feet long. They are made from several pieces; the bottom is rounded and crafted from large logs hollowed out to about 3 inches thick, and can consist of 3 or 4 pieces. The sides are made from planks of similar thickness and are built nearly vertical, curving slightly towards the gunwale. The pieces are well-fitted and fastened or sewn together with strong weaving, similar to how old Chinese wooden bowls are repaired. The widest part is usually at the back, about 18 or 20 inches, while the front is about one-third narrower; the height from the bottom to the gunwale seldom exceeds 2.5 or 3 feet. They feature high, curved sterns that are often adorned with carvings, while the bow curves very little or not at all. Smaller canoes are constructed similarly, made from one, two, or more trees depending on their size or intended use. To prevent capsizing in the water, all single canoes, both large and small, have what are called outriggers; these are pieces of wood attached to the gunwale that extend outward on one side by about 6, 8, or 10 feet, depending on the size of the boat. At the end, a long, straight log is attached parallel to the canoe, or some are shaped like a small boat, although this is less common; this helps balance the canoe. Those designed for sailing only have outriggers on the opposite side of the mast; these serve to secure the shrouds and help trim the boat when the wind picks up. The sailing proas can have one or two masts; the sails are made from matting, narrow at the top and square at the bottom, resembling the shoulder of mutton sails commonly used on warship barges, etc.

I have mentioned above that the single Canoes have Outriggers, for those that go double--that is 2 together, which is very common--have no need of any; and it is done in this manner: 2 Canoes are placed in a parrallel direction to each other, about 3 or 4 feet asunder, securing them together by small Logs of Wood laid across and lashed to each of their gunwales; thus the one boat supports the other, and are not in the least danger of upsetting, and I believe it is in this manner that all their large Proes are used, some of which will carry a great number of Men, by means of a Platform made of Bamboo or other light wood and the whole length of the Proes and considerably broader, but I never saw but one fitted in this manner upon the whole Island. Upon the Forepart of all these large double Proes was placed an Oblong Platform about ten or twelve feet in length, and six or eight in Breadth, and supported about 4 feet above the Gunwale by stout Carved Pillars. The use of these Platforms, as we were told, are for the Club Men to stand and fight upon in time of Battle, for the large Canoes, from what I could learn, are built most, if not wholly, for war, and their method of fighting is to Graple one another and fight it out with Clubs, spears, and stones. I never saw but one of these sort of Canoes in the water, the rest was all hauled ashore and seemed to be going to decay, neither were there very many of them upon the Island.* (* The war canoes of Tahiti exist no longer. The others are still used, and merit all Cook's encomiums on their sailing qualities.)

I mentioned earlier that single canoes have outriggers, but those that are double—meaning two canoes together, which is quite common—don’t need them. Here’s how it works: two canoes are placed parallel to each other, about 3 or 4 feet apart, and secured together with small logs laid across and tied to each of their sides. This setup allows one canoe to support the other, which makes them quite stable and prevents them from tipping over. I believe this is also how all their large proas are used, some of which can carry a lot of people, thanks to a platform made of bamboo or other lightweight wood that runs the entire length of the proa and is much wider. However, I only saw one like this on the whole island. At the front of all these large double proas, there’s a rectangular platform about ten or twelve feet long and six or eight feet wide, supported about four feet above the edge by sturdy carved pillars. We were told these platforms are for the club men to stand and fight on during battles, as large canoes, from what I could gather, are primarily built for war. Their fighting method involves grappling each other and battling with clubs, spears, and stones. I only saw one of these war canoes in the water; the others were all pulled ashore and seemed to be falling apart, and there weren't many of them on the island. (*The war canoes of Tahiti no longer exist. The others are still in use and deserve all of Cook's praise for their sailing qualities.*)

The Chiefs and better sort of People generally go from one part of the island to another in small double Canoes which carry a little movable House, this not only Skreens them from the Sun by day, but serves them to Sleep in in the Night, and this way of Travelling is Extremely commodious about such Islands as are inclosed by a reef as this is; for as these Canoes draw but Little water they can always keep in the Reefs, and by that means are never in danger.

The leaders and upper-class people usually travel from one part of the island to another in small double canoes that carry a portable house. This not only protects them from the sun during the day but also serves as a place to sleep at night. This way of traveling is very convenient around islands that are surrounded by a reef like this one because these canoes draw very little water, allowing them to stay within the reefs and avoid danger.

They have some few other Canoes, Pahees as they call them, which differ from those above discribed, but of these I saw but 6 upon the whole Island, and was told they were not built here. The 2 largest was each 76 feet long, and when they had been in use had been fastned together. These are built Sharp and Narrow at both Ends and broad in the Middle; the bottom is likewise Sharp, inclining to a Wedge, yet Buldges out very much and rounds in again very quick just below the Gunwale. They are built of several pieces of thick plank and put together as the others are, only these have timbers in the inside, which the others have not. They have high Curved Sterns, the head also Curves a little, and both are ornamented with the image of a man carved in wood, very little inferior work of the like kind done by common Ship Carvers in England.

They have a few other canoes, called Pahees, which are different from the ones described above, but I only saw 6 of them on the whole island, and I was told they weren’t made here. The two largest were each 76 feet long, and when they had been used, they were tied together. These canoes are pointed and narrow at both ends but wide in the middle; the bottom is also pointed and shaped like a wedge, but it bulges out a lot and curves back in sharply just below the gunwale. They’re made from several pieces of thick planks, just like the others, but these have internal wooden supports that the others lack. They feature high curved sterns, and the bow also curves a little, with both ends decorated with a wooden carving of a man, which is quite good craftsmanship compared to what common ship carvers in England do.

When one Considers the Tools these people have one cannot help but admiring their workmanship; these are Adzes and small Hatchets made of a hard Stone, Chizels and Gouges made of human bones, generally the bones of the Forearm, but Spike Nails have pretty well supplyd the place of these. With these ordinary Tools, that a European would expect to break the first stroke, I have seen them work surprisingly fast. To plain or polish their work they rub upon it, with a small stone, Coral Beat small and Mixed with Water; this is done sometimes by scraping it with Shells, with which alone they perform most of their Small wood work.

When you look at the tools these people use, you can't help but admire their craftsmanship. They have adzes and small hatchets made from hard stone, chisels and gouges made from human bones, usually bones from the forearm. However, spike nails have mostly replaced these tools. With these basic tools, which a European would expect to break after the first use, I've seen them work surprisingly quickly. To smooth or polish their work, they rub it with a small stone and finely ground coral mixed with water. Sometimes they scrape the surface with shells, which they also use for most of their small woodworking tasks.

Their Proes or Canoes, large and Small, are row'd and Steer'd with Paddles, and, notwithstanding the large ones appear to be very unweildy, they manage them very dexterously, and I believe perform long and distant Voyages in them, otherwise they could not have the knowledge of the Islands in these Seas they seem to have. They wear for Shew or Ornament at the Mast Head of most of their Sailing Canoes Pendants made of Feathers.

Their boats, both large and small, are rowed and steered with paddles, and even though the larger ones seem quite cumbersome, they handle them skillfully. I believe they undertake long journeys in these boats; otherwise, they wouldn't have the knowledge of the islands in these seas that they appear to possess. For decoration, many of their sailing canoes display pennants made of feathers at the top of the mast.

Having described their fighting Canoes I shall next describe their Arms with which they attack their Enemys, both by Sea and Land. These are Clubs, Spears or Lances, Slings and Stones which they throw by hand. The Clubs are made of a hard wood, and are about 8 or 9 feet long; the one half is made flatish with 2 Edges, and the other half is round and not thicker than to be easily grasped by the hand. The Lances are of various lengths, some from 12, 20 or 30 feet, and are generally Arm'd at the Small end with the Stings of Sting-rays, which makes them very dangerous weapons. Altho' these people have Bows and Arrows--and those none of the worst--we are told that they never use them in their wars, which doubtless is very extraordinary and not easily accounted for. They have very Curious breastplates, made of small wickers, pieces of Matting, etc., and neatly Cover'd with Sharks' teeth, Pearl Oyster shells, birds' feathers, and dogs' hair. Thus much for their Arms, etc.

Having described their fighting canoes, I will now describe their weapons used to attack their enemies, both at sea and on land. These include clubs, spears or lances, slings, and stones thrown by hand. The clubs are made of hard wood and are about 8 or 9 feet long; one half is flattened with two edges, while the other half is round and narrow enough to be easily held. The lances come in various lengths, some measuring 12, 20, or 30 feet, and are typically armed at the narrow end with stingray stingers, making them very dangerous. Although these people have bows and arrows—which are quite good—we're told that they never use them in warfare, which is certainly unusual and not easily explained. They also have intricate breastplates made from small wicker, pieces of matting, etc., and are beautifully decorated with shark teeth, pearl oyster shells, bird feathers, and dog hair. This covers their weapons and armor.

[Tahitian Cloth.]

[Tahitian Fabric.]

I shall now describe their way of making Cloth, which, in my opinion, is the only Curious manufacture they have. All their Cloth is, I believe, made from the Bark of Trees; the finest is made from a plant which they Cultivate for no other purpose.* (* Broussonetia papyrifera. The manufacture is common to all Polynesia, and the ordinary name for it in the Pacific is Tapa. The Tahitians, however, called it Ahu.) Dr. Solander thinks it is the same plant the bark of which the Chinese make paper of. They let this plant grow till it is about 6 or 8 feet high, the Stem is then about as thick as one's Thum or thicker; after this they cut it down and lay it a Certain time in water. This makes the Bark strip off easy, the outside of which is scraped off with a rough Shell. After this is done it looks like long strips of ragged linnen; these they lay together, by means of a fine paist made of some sort of a root, to the Breadth of a yard more or less, and in length 6, 8 or 10 Yards or more according to the use it is for. After it is thus put together it is beat out to its proper breadth and fineness, upon a long square piece of wood, with wooden beaters, the Cloth being keept wet all the time. The beaters are made of hard wood with four square sides, are about 3 or 4 inches broad and cut into grooves of different fineness; this makes the Cloth look at first sight as if it was wove with thread, but I believe the principal use of the Groves is to facilitate the beating it out, in the doing of which they often beat holes in it, or one place thinner than another; but this is easily repair'd by pasting on small bits, and this they do in such a manner that the Cloth is not the least injured. The finest sort when bleached is very white and comes nearest to fine Cotton. Thick cloth, especially fine, is made by pasting two or more thickness's of thin cloth, made for that Purpose, together. Coarse thick cloth and ordinary thin cloth is made of the Bark of Bread fruit Trees, and I think I have been told that it is sometimes made from the Bark of other trees. The making of Cloth is wholy the work of the women, in which all ranks are employ'd. Their common colours are red, brown and yellow, with which they dye some pieces just as their fancy leads them. Besides Cloth they make several different sorts of matting, both better and finer than any we have in Europe; the stuff they make it on is the Produce of the Palm tree.

I’m going to explain how they make cloth, which I think is the only interesting product they have. All their cloth is made from tree bark, and the best quality comes from a plant they grow specifically for this purpose.* (*Broussonetia papyrifera. This type of manufacturing is common throughout Polynesia, and it’s usually called Tapa in the Pacific. However, in Tahiti, they call it Ahu.) Dr. Solander believes it is the same plant that the Chinese use to make paper. They let this plant grow until it’s about 6 or 8 feet tall, with stems that are roughly as thick as a thumb or even thicker. After that, they cut it down and soak it in water for a certain period. This makes it easy to strip off the bark, which is then scraped with a rough shell. Once this is done, it looks like long strips of ragged linen. They then lay these strips together using a fine paste made from some kind of root, to form a width of about a yard or so, and lengths of 6, 8, or 10 yards or more, depending on its intended use. After assembling, they beat it out to the desired width and fineness on a long rectangular piece of wood, using wooden beaters while keeping the cloth wet. The beaters are made from hard wood, have four square sides, are about 3 or 4 inches wide, and have grooves of varying fineness; this makes the cloth initially appear as if it’s woven with thread. However, I believe the main purpose of the grooves is to aid in the beating process, during which they often create holes or make certain areas thinner than others. This can be easily fixed by pasting on small pieces, which is done carefully so the cloth remains unimpaired. The finest type, once bleached, is very white and resembles fine cotton. They create thicker cloth, especially finer varieties, by pasting together two or more layers of thin cloth made specifically for that purpose. Coarse thick cloth and regular thin cloth are made from the bark of breadfruit trees, and I think I’ve heard it can also be made from the bark of other trees. The entire process of making cloth is done by women, and women of all social ranks are involved. Their common colors are red, brown, and yellow, with which they dye some pieces according to their preferences. In addition to cloth, they produce various kinds of matting that are both better and finer than anything we have in Europe; the material for this is derived from palm trees.

This Island produceth 2 or 3 sorts of plants, of which they make the rope they use in rigging their Canoes, etc.; the finest sort, such as fishing lines, saine twine, etc., is made of the Bark of a Tree, and some from the Kind of Silk grass. Their fishing lines and saines are in Point of goodness preferable to any of ours. Their fishing Hooks are very curiously made of Tortoise, Pearl Oyster Shells, etc. They have a sort of Saine that is made of Coarse broad grass like flags; these are twisted and tied together in a loose manner until the whole is as thick as a large sack, and 60 or 80 fathoms long. This they haul in Shoal smooth water; its own weight keeps it so close to the ground that hardly the smallest fish can escape out.

This island has 2 or 3 types of plants that they use to make the rope for rigging their canoes and other things. The best quality, which is used for fishing lines, seines, and so on, is made from the bark of a tree and some from a type of silk grass. Their fishing lines and seines are actually better than ours in terms of quality. Their fishing hooks are really well-crafted from tortoise shells and pearl oyster shells. They also have a type of seine made from coarse, broad grass that looks like flags; these are twisted and loosely tied together until it's as thick as a large sack and about 60 to 80 fathoms long. They use this to haul in shallow, calm water; its own weight keeps it close to the ground so that even the smallest fish can hardly get away.

I have before mentioned that the Island is divided into two districts or kingdoms, which are frequently at war with each other, as hapned about 12 Months ago, and each of these are again divided into smaller districts, Whennuas as they call them. Over each of the kingdoms is an Eare dehi, or head, whom we call a King, and in the Whennuas are Eares, or Chiefs. The King's power seems to be but very little; he may be reverenced as a father, but he is neither fear'd nor respected as a monarch, and the same may be said of the other Chiefs. However, they have a pre-eminence over the rest of the People, who pay them a kind of a Voluntary Obedience. Upon the whole, these people seem to enjoy liberty in its fullest extent--every man seems to be the sole judge of his own actions and to know no punishment but death, and this perhaps is never inflicted but upon a public enemy. There are 3 ranks of Men and Women: first, the Eares, or chiefs; second, the Manahoonas, or Middling sort; and lastly, the Toutous, which comprehend all the lower-class, and are by far the most numerous. These seem to live in some sort dependent on the Eares, who, together with the Manahoonas, own most, if not all the land. This is Hereditary in their families, and the moment the Heir is born he succeeds the Father, both in title and Estate; at least to the name, for its most likely that the latter must have the power during his Son or Daughter's Minority.

I have previously mentioned that the Island is divided into two regions or kingdoms, which frequently go to war with each other, as happened about 12 months ago. Each of these is further divided into smaller areas, called Whennuas. Over each kingdom is an Eare dehi, or leader, whom we refer to as a King, and in the Whennuas are Eares, or Chiefs. The King's authority seems to be very limited; he may be respected like a father, but he is neither feared nor regarded as a monarch, and the same applies to the other Chiefs. However, they do hold a higher status over the rest of the people, who offer them a sort of voluntary obedience. Overall, these people appear to enjoy complete freedom—each person seems to be the ultimate judge of their own actions and knows no punishment except death, which is typically only imposed on a public enemy. There are three classes of Men and Women: first, the Eares, or chiefs; second, the Manahoonas, or middle class; and lastly, the Toutous, which include all the lower class and are by far the most numerous. These individuals seem to live in some dependence on the Eares, who, along with the Manahoonas, own most, if not all, of the land. This ownership is hereditary in their families, and the moment an heir is born, they inherit the title and estate from the father; at least the title, since it’s very likely that the father retains control during the son or daughter’s minority.

Note by Cook. Upon our arrival at Batavia, we were informed the two French Ships, commanded by the Monsieurs Beaugainvile, touched at that place in their way home from the South Seas two years ago. We were here told many circumstances of these two Ships, all tending to prove that they were the same ships that were at George's Island, which we judged were Spaniards; being led into this mistake by the Spanish Iron, etc., we saw among the natives, which is easy accounted for, for we are told that while Beaugainvile in the Frigate was delivering up that part of Falkland Islands possess'd by the French, to the Spaniards, the Store ship was trading with the Spaniards in the River Plate, where it is very probable she disposed of all her European goods, and purchased others to trade with the Islands in the South Seas. To confirm these last circumstances we were told that when they arrived at Batavia, the Frigate had on board a great quantity of Spanish Dollars.

Note by Cook. When we got to Batavia, we learned that two French ships, led by Monsieur Beaugainvile, stopped there on their way home from the South Seas two years ago. We were told many details about these two ships, which suggested they were the same ones we saw at George's Island, which we initially thought were Spanish. This misunderstanding was partly due to the Spanish iron and other items we saw among the locals. It's easy to explain, since we learned that while Beaugainvile was on the frigate handing over the part of the Falkland Islands owned by the French to the Spaniards, the store ship was trading with the Spaniards in the River Plate. It's very likely that she sold all her European goods there and bought others to trade in the islands in the South Seas. To back up these details, we were informed that when they arrived in Batavia, the frigate had a large amount of Spanish dollars on board.

[Religion of Tahiti.]

Tahiti's Religion

Having given the best account I can of the manners and Customs of these people, it will be expected that I should give some account of their religion, which is a thing I have learned so little of that I hardly dare to touch upon it, and should have passed it over in silence, was it not my duty as well as inclination to insert in this Journal every and the least knowledge I may obtain of a People, who for many Centuries have been shut up from almost every other part of the world.

Having provided the best description I can of the customs and behaviors of these people, it’s natural for me to share some insight into their religion. However, I know so little about it that I barely feel qualified to discuss it. I would have skipped it altogether if it weren't my responsibility and desire to include in this Journal every bit of knowledge I can gather about a people who have been isolated from nearly all other parts of the world for many centuries.

They believe that there is one Supreem God whom they call Tane; from him sprung a number of inferior Deities, Eatuas as they call them--these they think preside over them and intermeddle in their affairs. To these they offer Oblations such as Hogs, Dogs, Fish, Fruit, etc., and invoke them on some particular occasions, as in time of real or Apparent Danger, the setting out of a long Voyage, sickness's, etc.; but the Ceremony made use of on these occasions I know not. The Mories, which we at first thought were burying places, are wholy built for Places of worship, and for the Performing of religious ceremonies in.* (* Cook did not apparently learn anything in this voyage of the human sacrifices offered in the Morais on many occasions, such as before war; at the coronation of the king; etc. The Tahitians were, however, never guilty of cannibalism.) The Viands are laid upon altars erected 8, 12, or 12 Feet high, by stout Posts, and the Table of the Altar on which the Viands lay, is generally made of Palm leaves; they are not always in the Mories, but very often at some Distance from them. Their Mories, as well as the Tombs of the Dead, they seem to hold sacred, and the women never enter the former, whatever they may do the latter. The Viands laid near the Tombs of the Dead are, from what I can learn, not for the deceased, but as an Offering to the Eatua made upon that Occasion who, if not, would distroy the body and not except of the soul--for they believe of a future state of rewards and punishments; but what their Ideas are of it I know not. We have seen in some few places small Houses set apart on purpose for the Oblations offer'd to the Eatua, which consists of small strips of Cloth, Viands, etc. I am of Opinion they offer to the Eatua a Strip or small piece of every piece of Cloth they make before they use it themselves, and it is not unlikely but what they observe the same thing with respect to their Victuals, but as there are but few of these houses this cannot be a common Custom; it may only be observ'd by the Priests and such families as are more religious than others.

They believe in one supreme God, whom they call Tane; from him came several lesser deities, known as Eatuas. They think these deities oversee them and get involved in their lives. They offer sacrifices like pigs, dogs, fish, fruits, etc., and call on them during specific times, such as in true or apparent danger, when setting off on a long journey, or when someone is sick; however, I don’t know the specific ceremonies used during these times. The Mories, which we initially thought were burial sites, are entirely built for worship and conducting religious ceremonies. *(Cook apparently didn’t learn about the human sacrifices offered at the Morais on many occasions, such as before war or at the king’s coronation. However, the Tahitians were never known for cannibalism.)* The offerings are placed on altars that are built 8, 12, or even 12 feet high, supported by sturdy posts, and the altar table, where the offerings sit, is typically made of palm leaves. These altars aren’t always located in the Mories but often a bit away from them. They seem to consider both the Mories and the tombs of the dead as sacred, and women never enter the former, although they may enter the latter. The offerings placed near the tombs aren’t meant for the deceased but are given as an offering to the Eatua on that occasion; if they didn’t, they believe the body would be destroyed and only the soul would be accepted — because they believe in an afterlife of rewards and punishments, though I don’t know what their specific beliefs are on that. We have seen a few small houses set aside specifically for offerings to the Eatua, which consist of small strips of cloth, food, etc. I believe they offer a strip or small piece of every piece of cloth they make before using it themselves, and it’s likely they do the same with their food. However, since there are only a few of these houses, it can’t be a common practice; it may only be observed by the priests and families that are more religious than others.

Now I have mentioned Priests, there are men that Exercise that function, of which Numbers Tupia is one. They seem to be in no great repute, neither can they live wholy by their Profession, and this leads me to think that these People are no bigots to their religion. The Priests on some occasions do the Office of Physicians, and their prescriptions consists in performing some religious ceremony before the sick person. They likewise Crown the Eare dehi, or King, in the performing of which we are told much form and Ceremony is used, after which every one is at liberty to treat and play as many Tricks with the new King as he pleaseth during the remainder of the day.

Now that I've mentioned priests, there are men who perform that role, one of whom is Numbers Tupia. They don't seem to have a great reputation, nor can they fully support themselves through their profession, which makes me think that these people aren't fanatics about their religion. Sometimes the priests also act as doctors, and their prescriptions involve performing a religious ceremony in front of the sick person. They also crown the ear dehi, or king, in a process that apparently involves a lot of formality and ceremony, after which everyone is free to make jokes and play tricks on the new king for the rest of the day.

There is a ceremony which they perform at or after the Funerals of the Dead which I had forgot to mention at the time; we hapned to see it sometime before we left the Island. An old Woman, a relation of Toobouratomita's, hapned to die and was interr'd in the Usual manner. For several successive evenings after, one of her relations dressed himself in a very odd dress, which I cannot tell how to describe or to convey a better Idea of it than to suppose a man dress'd with plumes of feathers, something in the same manner as those worn by Coaches, Hearses, Horses, etc., at the Funerals in London. It was very neatly made up of black or brown and white cloth, black and white feathers, and pearl Oyster Shells. It cover'd the head, face, and body, as low as the Calf of the Legs or lower, and not only looked grand but awful likewise. The man thus equip'd, and attended by 2 or 3 more men and Women with their faces and bodys besmear'd with soot, and a Club in their hands, would about sunset take a Compass of near a mile running here and there, and wherever they came the People would fly from them as tho' they had been so many hobgoblins, not one daring to come in their way. I know not the reason for their Performing this ceremony, which they call Heiva, a name they give to most of their divertisements.

There’s a ceremony they hold at or after the funerals of the deceased that I forgot to mention earlier; we happened to see it sometime before we left the island. An old woman, a relative of Toobouratomita, passed away and was buried in the usual way. For several consecutive evenings afterward, one of her relatives dressed in a very unusual outfit, which I can only describe as resembling a man adorned with plumes of feathers, similar to those worn by coaches, hearses, horses, etc., at funerals in London. It was carefully put together using black or brown and white cloth, black and white feathers, and pearl oyster shells. The outfit covered the head, face, and body down to the calves or lower, looking both grand and eerie. The man, dressed this way and accompanied by two or three others whose faces and bodies were smeared with soot and holding clubs, would take a route of nearly a mile, running here and there at sunset. Wherever they went, people would flee from them as if they were all a bunch of goblins, with no one daring to cross their path. I don’t know the reason for this ceremony, which they call Heiva, a term they use for most of their entertainments.

They compute time by the Moon, which they call Malama, reckoning 30 days to each moon, 2 of which they say the moon is Mattee, that is, dead, and this is at the time of the new moon, when she cannot be seen. The day they divide into smaller Portions not less than 2 Hours. Their computations is by units, tens, and scores, up to ten score, or 200, etc. In counting they generally take hold on their fingers one by one, Shifting from one hand to the other, until they come to the number they want to express; but if it be a high number, instead of their fingers they use pieces of Leaves, etc.

They track time by the Moon, which they call Malama, counting 30 days for each lunar cycle. They say that for 2 of those days, the moon is Mattee, meaning dead, which happens during the new moon when it's not visible. They break the day into smaller segments, no less than 2 hours each. Their counting system is based on units, tens, and scores, going up to ten score, or 200, and so on. When they count, they typically use their fingers one by one, moving from one hand to the other until they reach the number they want to show. However, if the number is high, instead of using their fingers, they use pieces of leaves or similar items.

In conversation one with another they frequently join signs to their words, in which they are so expressive that a stranger will very soon comprehend their meaning by their actions.

In conversations with each other, they often use gestures alongside their words, making it so expressive that a stranger can quickly understand what they mean through their actions.

Having now done with the People, I must once more return to the Island before I quit it altogether, which, notwithstanding nature hath been so very bountiful to it, yet it does not produce any one thing of intrinsick value or that can be converted into an Article of Trade; so that the value of the discovery consists wholy in the refreshments it will always afford to shipping in their passage through those seas; and in this it may be greatly improved by transporting hither horned cattle, etc. Pumpkins have got quite a footing here, the seeds of which most probably were brought here by the Spaniards.* (* Bougainville.) We sowed of the seeds of Water and Musk Mellons, which grew up and throve very fast. We also gave of these seeds and the seeds of Pine Apples to several of the Natives, and it cannot be doubted but what they will thrive here, and will be a great addition to the fruits they already have. Upon our first arrival we sowed of all sorts of English garden seeds and grain, but not a single thing came up except mustard sallad; but this I know was not owing either to the Soil or Climate, but to the badness of the seeds, which were spoil'd by the length of the Passage.

Now that I’ve finished discussing the People, I need to return to the Island one last time before leaving it for good. Despite the island’s natural beauty, it doesn’t produce anything of real value that can be traded. So, the worth of this discovery lies entirely in the supplies it provides for ships passing through these waters. This could be improved significantly by bringing in livestock, among other things. Pumpkins are well-established here, most likely the seeds were brought by the Spaniards. We planted seeds for Watermelons and Muskmelons, and they grew quickly. We also shared these seeds and Pineapple seeds with several of the Natives, and there’s no doubt they will flourish here, adding to the local fruits. When we first arrived, we planted all kinds of English garden seeds and grains, but nothing grew except mustard salad. I know this wasn't due to the soil or climate but rather the poor quality of the seeds, which were damaged during the long journey.

[Winds at Tahiti.]

Winds in Tahiti.

Altho' this Island lies within the Tropick of Capricorn, yet the Heat is not Troublesome, nor do the winds blow constantly from the East, but are subject to variations, frequently blowing a fresh gale from the South-West Quarter for two or three days together, but very seldom from the North-West. Whenever these variable winds happen they are always accompanied with a swell from the South-West or West-South-West, and the same thing happens whenever it is calm and the Atmosphere at the same time loaded with Clouds--sure indication that the winds are Variable or Westerly out at Sea, for clear weather generally attends the settled Trade.

Although this island is located within the Tropic of Capricorn, the heat is not uncomfortable, nor do the winds constantly blow from the east. Instead, they vary, often bringing a strong breeze from the southwest for two or three days at a time, and very rarely from the northwest. Whenever these changing winds occur, they are always accompanied by swells coming from the southwest or west-southwest. The same situation arises when it is calm and the atmosphere is cloudy, which is a clear indication that the winds are variable or westerly out at sea, as clear weather usually follows settled trade winds.

The meeting of Westerly winds within the general Limits of the Easterly Trade is a little extraordinary, and has induced former Navigators, when they met with them, to think that they were caused by the nearness of some large Tracks of Land: but I rather think they were owing to another Cause. It hath been found both by the Dolphin and us that the trade winds in those parts of this Sea doth not extend further to the Southward than 20 degrees, and without which we generally meet with a wind from the westward. Now, is it not reasonable to suppose that when these winds blow strong they must encroach upon and drive back the Easterly winds as to cause the variable winds and South-Westerly swells I have been speaking of? It is well known that the Trade winds blow but faint for some distance within their limits, and are therefore easily stopt by a wind from the Contrary direction. It is likewise known that these limits are subject to vary several degrees, not only at different seasons of the Year, but at one and the same season. Another reason why I think that these South-West winds are not caused by the nearness of any large Track of land, is in their being always accompanied with a large swell from the same Quarter, and we find a much greater surf beating upon the Shores of the South-West sides of the Islands situated just within the Limits of the Trade winds than upon any other part of them.

The interaction of Westerly winds with the Easterly Trade winds is somewhat unusual, leading earlier navigators to believe that they were caused by the proximity of large land masses. However, I believe there’s a different explanation. Both the Dolphin and our own observations show that the trade winds in this region don’t extend further south than 20 degrees, and beyond that point, we typically encounter winds from the west. Isn’t it reasonable to think that when these winds are strong, they push back the Easterly winds, resulting in the variable winds and South-Westerly swells I’ve mentioned? It’s well known that the Trade winds are weak for some distance within their boundaries, making them easily overridden by opposing winds. It’s also established that these boundaries can shift several degrees, not only between different seasons but even within the same season. Another reason I believe these South-West winds aren’t caused by nearby land is that they are always associated with a significant swell from the same direction, and we observe a much stronger surf crashing against the shores on the South-West sides of the islands located just within the boundaries of the Trade winds compared to other areas.

The tides are perhaps as inconsiderable in these Seas as in any part of the world. A South or South by West moon makes high water in Royal Bay, but the water does not rise upon a perpendicular above 10 or 12 inches, except on some very Extraordinary occasions.

The tides in these seas are probably as minimal as anywhere in the world. A moon from the south or south by west causes high water in Royal Bay, but the water doesn’t rise more than 10 or 12 inches perpendicularly, except on some very rare occasions.

The variation of the Compass I found to be 4 degrees 46 minutes Easterly, this being the mean result of a great number of Trials made by 4 of Dr. Knight's needles belonging to the Azimuth Compasses, all of which I judged to be good ones, and yet when applied to the Meridian line I found them not only differ one from another sometimes a degree and a half; but the same needle would differ from itself more or less, the difference sometimes amounting to half a degree, both at the same time and on differant days. This will in a great measure account for the seeming errors that may, upon a nice examination, appear to have been made in observing the Variation inserted in the Course of this Journal. This variableness in Magnetick Needles I have many times and in many places experienced both ashore and on board of Ships, and I do not remember of ever finding two Needles that would agree exactly together at one and the same time and place, but I have often found the same Needle agree with itself for several Trials made immediately one after another.* (* These discrepancies result from imperfections in the suspension and mounting of the needles, and are only absent in instruments too delicate for ordinary sea service.) However, all this is of no sort of consequence to Navigation, as the Variation of the Compass can always be found to a degree of accuracy more than sufficient for all nautical Purposes.

The variation of the compass I found to be 4 degrees 46 minutes east. This is the average result of numerous trials conducted with four of Dr. Knight's needles from the azimuth compasses, all of which I considered to be reliable. However, when tested against the meridian line, I discovered that they sometimes differed from each other by as much as a degree and a half. Additionally, the same needle would sometimes show different readings even at the same time and on different days, with the difference sometimes reaching half a degree. This largely explains the apparent errors that might emerge during a detailed review of the variation noted in this journal's course. I've experienced this variability in magnetic needles many times in various locations, both on land and aboard ships. I don’t recall ever finding two needles that aligned perfectly at the same time and place, though I have often seen a single needle remain consistent over several consecutive trials. (*These discrepancies arise from imperfections in the needles' suspension and mounting, and are not present in instruments that are too delicate for typical sea use.*) Nevertheless, none of this significantly impacts navigation, as the compass variation can always be determined with a degree of accuracy that is more than sufficient for all nautical purposes.

I have before hinted that these People have an Extensive knowledge of the Islands situated in these Seas. Tupia, as well as several others, hath given us an account of upwards of 70; but, as the account they have given of their situation is so Vague and uncertain, I shall refer giving a list of them until I have learnt from Tupia the Situation of each island with a little more certainty. Four of these islands--viz., Huaheine, Ulietea, Otaha, and Bolabola* (* These islands are now known as Huaheine, Raiatea, Tahaa, and Borabora or Bolabola, and are under French sovereignty.)--we were informed, lay only one or two days' sail to the Westward of George's Island, and that we might there procure Hogs, Fowls, and other refreshments, Articles that we have been very sparingly supply'd with at this last Island, as the Ship's Company (what from the Constant hard duty they have had at this place, and the two free use of Woman) were in a worse state of health than they were on our first arrival, for by this Time full half of them had got the Venerial disease, in which Situation I thought they would be ill able to stand the Cold weather we might expect to meet with to the Southward at this Season of the Year, and therefore resolved to give them a little time to recover while we ran down to and explored the Islands before-mentioned.

I’ve previously mentioned that these people have extensive knowledge of the islands in these seas. Tupia, along with several others, has informed us of more than 70 islands; however, since their descriptions of their locations are vague and uncertain, I’ll hold off on providing a list until I learn more precisely from Tupia about where each island is located. We were informed that four of these islands—Huaheine, Ulietea, Otaha, and Bolabola* (*These islands are now known as Huaheine, Raiatea, Tahaa, and Borabora or Bolabola, and are under French sovereignty.)—lie just a day or two's sail west of George's Island, and that we could find pigs, chickens, and other supplies there. We have been very limited in our supplies at this last island, as the ship's crew had been working hard here, and with their constant interaction with women, their health had declined since our arrival; by now, about half of them had contracted a venereal disease. Considering this situation, I thought they wouldn’t be able to withstand the cold weather we might encounter to the south this time of year, so I decided to give them some time to recover while we sailed down to explore the aforementioned islands.

Tupia informs us that in the Months of November, December, and January they have constant Westerly winds, with rain; also that the whole island can muster 6780 Fighting Men, by which some judgment can be formed of the number of inhabitants. Each district furnishes a certain number, which the chief is obliged to bring into the field when summoned by the Eare dehi, or King of the Island, either to make war or repell an invasion.* (* This paragraph is added in Admiralty copy.)

Tupia tells us that during November, December, and January, there are consistent west winds and rain. He also states that the entire island can field 6,780 warriors, which gives an idea of the population size. Each district is required to contribute a specific number of fighters that the chief must bring when called upon by the Eare dehi, or King of the Island, either for warfare or to defend against an invasion.* (* This paragraph is added in Admiralty copy.)

[Historical Notes, Tahiti.]

[Historical Notes, Tahiti.]

Notes on Tahiti. The missionaries who came to Tahiti in 1797, in the missionary ship Duff, and settled at Matavai, gathered many details of the history and economy of the islands. It appears that the state of society, though in many respects savage, had attained a certain pitch of civilisation, especially with regard to government. There was generally a head chief or king of the whole island, who governed after the feudal manner by the sub-chiefs. The sovereignty was hereditary, with this peculiarity, that the eldest son of the king became from his birth the sovereign. The father governed henceforth as regent until the son was of an age to take the reins in his own hands, when the father retired. This was the idea; but, as may be imagined, it led to various complications and difficulties, and wars between the different parts of the island and the different chiefs were frequent.

Notes on Tahiti. The missionaries who arrived in Tahiti in 1797 on the missionary ship Duff and settled at Matavai collected many details about the islands' history and economy. Although the society was considered savage in many ways, it had reached a certain level of civilization, particularly in terms of government. Typically, there was a head chief or king for the entire island, who governed in a feudal manner through sub-chiefs. The sovereignty was hereditary, with the unique feature that the king's eldest son was considered the sovereign from the moment he was born. The father would then act as regent until the son was old enough to take over, at which point the father would step down. This was the intended structure, but as one might expect, it led to various complications and challenges, and conflicts between different parts of the island and various chiefs were common.

When Wallis discovered the island, in June 1767, Amo was king, or Arii-rahi (called by Cook Eare-dehi), Bereia (Cook's Obereia) being his wife. The latter seems to have been a woman of much character, and to have practically governed the island. The two were separated, inasmuch that they had mutually contracted other alliances, but, according to the custom of the country, without affecting their friendship.

When Wallis found the island in June 1767, Amo was the king, or Arii-rahi (called Eare-dehi by Cook), and his wife was Bereia (Cook's Obereia). She appears to have been a strong woman who practically ruled the island. The two were separated since they had both entered into other relationships, but, according to local customs, this didn't harm their friendship.

On Wallis's appearance the warlike Tahitians at once attacked the Dolphin, but were easily defeated, and the guns and small arms with which they then for the first time made acquaintance had such an effect upon them that they speedily made peace, and recognised the superiority of Europeans.

Upon Wallis's arrival, the fierce Tahitians immediately attacked the Dolphin, but they were easily defeated. The guns and small arms they encountered for the first time had such an impact on them that they quickly sought peace and acknowledged the superiority of Europeans.

The defeat had, however, a great effect on the prestige of Amo, whose authority rapidly diminished. Tootaha, Amo's brother, and chief of the district of Matavai, where the Dolphin anchored, was much enriched by her visit, and became a greater man in the eyes of his compatriots. Bougainville also touched at Tootaha's district; and although his two ships only remained ten days, it was long enough to furnish this chief with many more valuable and coveted articles.

The defeat, however, had a significant impact on Amo's prestige, causing his authority to decline rapidly. Tootaha, Amo's brother and the chief of the Matavai district where the Dolphin anchored, greatly benefited from her visit and became a more prominent figure among his peers. Bougainville also stopped by Tootaha's district; even though his two ships only stayed for ten days, it was sufficient for this chief to acquire many more valuable and desirable items.

In about December 1768, or six months before Cook's visit, war broke out in the island, and Amo was totally defeated by the chief who governed the eastern peninsula. Cook saw at Papara, on the south side of the main island, the relics of this battle in the shape of many human bones. Tootaha, who had joined in the war against his brother, became regent for the son (Pomare) of another brother, Hapai, and was therefore the principal man in the island when Cook appeared. Notwithstanding, when Amo (whom Cook calls Oamo), came to visit the Europeans on 21st June, bringing his young son, Temare, with him, the latter was carried on men's shoulders, which was one of the ceremonial observances due to the Otou, or young king, and the natives present recognised his royal character by uncovering their shoulders.

In about December 1768, or six months before Cook's visit, war broke out on the island, and Amo was completely defeated by the chief who ruled the eastern peninsula. Cook observed the remnants of this battle at Papara, on the south side of the main island, in the form of many human bones. Tootaha, who had allied with his brother against Amo, became regent for the son (Pomare) of another brother, Hapai, and was therefore the main leader on the island when Cook arrived. However, when Amo (whom Cook refers to as Oamo) came to visit the Europeans on June 21, bringing his young son, Temare, with him, Temare was carried on men's shoulders, which was one of the ceremonial honors due to the Otou, or young king, and the locals acknowledged his royal status by uncovering their shoulders.

Tupia (or Tupaia), who left the island with Cook, was the chief priest of the island, and had been living with Bereia; but having shortly before conspired to kill Tootaha, it is probable that he felt his life was unsafe in the island.

Tupia (or Tupaia), who left the island with Cook, was the chief priest of the island and had been living with Bereia. However, having recently plotted to kill Tootaha, it's likely that he felt his life was in danger on the island.

Frequent wars raged in the island for many years after Cook's first visit. Tootaha was killed in one of these, and when Cook again arrived, in 1773, Pomare was king, though Cook only knew him by his title of Otou, which he apparently still retained, though there was no regent.

Frequent wars erupted on the island for many years after Cook's first visit. Tootaha was killed in one of these conflicts, and when Cook returned in 1773, Pomare was king, although Cook only recognized him by his title of Otou, which he apparently still held, even though there was no regent.

In 1789 Captain Bligh called at Tahiti in the Bounty, to export young bread-fruit trees to the West Indies. The delights of Tahiti probably had their part in bringing about the well-known mutiny a few days after the ship left; and on the return of the Bounty with her crew of mutineers, sixteen of them remained on the island. These men took a leading part in the continual dissensions in the island, until, in 1791, they were carried off by the Pandora, sent with the object of capturing the mutineers.

In 1789, Captain Bligh stopped at Tahiti on the Bounty to take young breadfruit trees to the West Indies. The pleasures of Tahiti likely contributed to the famous mutiny just days after the ship departed. When the Bounty returned with its crew of mutineers, sixteen of them chose to stay on the island. These men played a major role in the ongoing conflicts on the island until 1791, when they were taken away by the Pandora, sent to capture the mutineers.

English missionaries came to Tahiti in 1797; but after twelve years' residence, during which they made no progress, and were constantly in danger from the frequent wars, they retreated to Sydney, in New South Wales, leaving two only of their number in Huahine and Eimeo, two of the Society Islands. Two years later, on the invitation of Pomare II, who was, however, then expelled from Tahiti and living in Eimeo, some of them returned, and Pomare became the first convert. Christianity rapidly spread, and in 1815, Pomare having returned to Tahiti, he and his Christian followers were attacked. The battle ended in the complete victory of Pomare, and for the first time in the sanguinary history of the island no butchery of the vanquished followed, nor any devastation of the country. The principal idols were destroyed; and whether in consequence of the surprise the natives felt at finding that no retribution followed this sacrilege, or from gratitude at the clemency of the victors, opposition to the new religion ceased, the whole island soon became Christian, and the customs of the inhabitants were much changed. In 1827 the British Government declined to accede to a request to throw its protectorate over Tahiti.

English missionaries arrived in Tahiti in 1797, but after twelve years of living there with little progress and constant danger from ongoing wars, they retreated to Sydney, New South Wales, leaving only two of their group behind in Huahine and Eimeo, two of the Society Islands. Two years later, invited by Pomare II, who was at that time exiled from Tahiti and living in Eimeo, some missionaries returned, and Pomare became the first convert. Christianity spread quickly, and in 1815, after Pomare returned to Tahiti, he and his Christian followers were attacked. The battle ended in a decisive victory for Pomare, and for the first time in the violent history of the island, there was no massacre of the defeated and no destruction of the land. The main idols were destroyed; and whether it was due to the surprise the natives felt at the absence of retribution for this sacrilege or out of gratitude for the mercy of the victors, resistance to the new religion stopped, and the entire island soon became Christian, leading to significant changes in the customs of the inhabitants. In 1827, the British Government refused to accept a request to establish a protectorate over Tahiti.

In 1836 two French priests came to the island with the avowed intention of proselytising. They were expelled; and after several visits of French men-of-war, who came to obtain redress for this act, and an assurance of free entrance for French subjects, the island was taken possession of by a French squadron in 1843, and Queen Pomare, daughter of Pomare II, was de facto deposed. The island has been ever since under the dominion of France. Tahiti is now in a flourishing condition, and exports a considerable quantity of cotton, cocoanuts, and vanilla.

In 1836, two French priests arrived on the island with the clear goal of spreading their faith. They were expelled, and after several visits from French warships seeking compensation for this act and a guarantee of free access for French citizens, a French squadron took control of the island in 1843, and Queen Pomare, the daughter of Pomare II, was effectively removed from power. The island has been under French rule ever since. Tahiti is now thriving and exports a significant amount of cotton, coconuts, and vanilla.

The majority of the natives still profess the Protestant religion.

Most of the locals still practice the Protestant faith.

Papiete, a little westward of Matavai, is now the principal port and town of the island, the harbour possessing some advantages over the latter.

Papiete, a bit to the west of Matavai, is now the main port and town of the island, with the harbor having some advantages over the latter.

The Tahitians are marvellously fond of singing and dancing, and still retain their primitive and exceedingly free manners, and the custom of decorating themselves with flowers.

The Tahitians are incredibly fond of singing and dancing, and they still keep their natural and very laid-back ways, along with the tradition of decorating themselves with flowers.

The beauty of the island, with its neighbouring western group, is probably unsurpassed, and, considering all the circumstances, it says much for the discipline of the Endeavour that only two of her crew attempted to remain in what seemed a Paradise.

The beauty of the island, along with its neighboring western group, is probably unmatched, and given all the circumstances, it really speaks to the discipline of the Endeavour that only two of her crew tried to stay in what looked like Paradise.

Cook's efforts to make his men deal properly with the natives are well illustrated by the following extract from Mr. Molineux's Log, of the 29th April. The incident is not mentioned by Cook.

Cook's attempts to ensure his crew interacted properly with the locals are clearly shown in the following excerpt from Mr. Molineux's Log, dated April 29th. Cook doesn't mention this incident.

"Punished Hy. Jeffs, Seaman, with a dozen lashes for ill-behaviour on shore. He had been rude to a man's wife yesterday, of which the Indian complained, and Jeffs was confined immediately the Captain had the fact plainly proved, and next morning the Captain invited the offended Parties on board, who were ignorant of his intentions. All hands being called, and the Prisoner brought aft, the Captain explained the nature of his Crime in the most lively manner, and made a very Pathetick speech to the Ship's Company during his punishment. The woman was in the greatest agonies, and strongly interceded for him. The man's name was Tuburi and his wife's name Tamide. I remember them both last Voyage. I should have mentioned Tuburi being sorry to see Jeffs punished."

"Punished Hy. Jeffs, Seaman, with a dozen lashes for bad behavior on shore. He had been rude to a man's wife yesterday, which the Indian complained about, and Jeffs was confined as soon as the Captain confirmed the facts. The next morning, the Captain invited the affected parties on board, who had no idea what was going to happen. With everyone gathered and the prisoner brought back, the Captain explained the nature of his crime in a very animated way and gave a heartfelt speech to the crew during the punishment. The woman was in great distress and pleaded strongly for him. The man's name was Tuburi and his wife's name was Tamide. I remember them both from last voyage. I should have mentioned that Tuburi was sorry to see Jeffs punished."

It is evident, from what Cook himself tells us (above), and from what is now well known of the laxity of Tahitian morals, that this punishment would seem excessive to the natives, and especially to the women, who were accustomed themselves to bear whatever blame was bestowed.

It’s clear, from what Cook himself mentions (above), and from what’s now widely understood about the relaxed morals in Tahiti, that this punishment would seem severe to the locals, especially to the women, who were used to accepting any blame directed at them.

Note. For full description of original Tahitian manners and customs, see "Polynesian Researches," by W. Ellis (London, H.G. Bohn, 1853); "Iles Taiti," par MM. Vincendon-Dumoulin et Chas. Desgraz (Paris, 1844).

Note. For a complete description of original Tahitian manners and customs, see "Polynesian Researches," by W. Ellis (London, H.G. Bohn, 1853); "Iles Taiti," by MM. Vincendon-Dumoulin and Chas. Desgraz (Paris, 1844).


CHAPTER 4. TAHITI TO NEW ZEALAND.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES AT SEA.

[July 1769.]

[July 1769.]

FRIDAY, July 14th. Gentle breezes at North-East and Clear weather. I have before made mention of our departure from Royal Bay on the preceeding forenoon, and likewise that I had determined to run down to Huaheine and Ulietea* (* Raiatea.) before we stood to the Southward; but having discovered, from the Hills of George's Island, an Island laying to the Northward, we first stood that way to take a nearer View of it. This Island is called Tethuroa.* (* Tetiaroa.) It lies North 1/2 West, distant 8 Leagues from Point Venus, and is a small, low, uninhabited Island, frequented by the people of George's Island for fish, with which it is said to abound. At 6 A.M. the Westermost part of York Island bore South-East 1/2 South and the body of George's Island East 1/2 South. Punished the 2 Marines who attempted to desert from us at George's Island with 2 Dozen lashes each, and then released them from Confinement. At Noon the body of York Island* (* Eimeo, or Murea.) bore East by South 1/2 South, Royal Bay South 70 degrees 45 minutes East, distant 61 Miles; and an Island which we took to be Saunder's Island, discovered by Captain Wallace (called by the Natives Topoamanan),* (* Tubuai Manu.) bore South-South-West Latitude observed, 17 degrees 9 minutes South. Saw land bearing North-West 1/2 West, which Tupia calls the Island of Huaheine.

FRIDAY, July 14th. Gentle breezes from the Northeast and clear weather. I previously mentioned our departure from Royal Bay the morning before, and that I had planned to head down to Huaheine and Ulietea* (* Raiatea) before going south. However, after spotting an island to the north from the hills of George's Island, we altered our course to take a closer look. This island is called Tethuroa.* (* Tetiaroa) It is located North 1/2 West, about 8 leagues from Point Venus, and is a small, low, uninhabited island frequented by the people of George's Island for its abundant fish. At 6 A.M., the westernmost part of York Island was positioned South-East 1/2 South, and the main part of George's Island was East 1/2 South. I punished the 2 marines who tried to desert us at George's Island with 24 lashes each, and then released them from confinement. At noon, the body of York Island* (* Eimeo, or Murea) was East by South 1/2 South, Royal Bay was South 70 degrees 45 minutes East, 61 miles away; and an island we believed to be Saunder's Island, discovered by Captain Wallace (referred to by the natives as Topoamanan),* (* Tubuai Manu) was South-South-West. We observed land bearing North-West 1/2 West, which Tupia refers to as the island of Huaheine.

CHART OF THE SOCIETY ISLES, DISCOVERED BY LIEUTENANT JAMES COOK, 1769.
REPRODUCTION OF THE ORIGINAL PUBLISHED CHART.

 

Saturday, 15th. Light airs and Variable between the North and West-South-West. Clear weather. At 6 p.m. York Island bore South-East, and Huaheine West-North-West, and at 7 a.m. it bore West. Latitude observed at Noon 16 degrees 50 minutes South. Royal Bay South 37 degrees 30 minutes East, distant 22 Leagues.

Saturday, 15th. Light winds changing between the North and West-South-West. Clear skies. At 6 p.m., York Island was to the Southeast, and Huaheine was to the West-North-West; by 7 a.m., it was to the West. Latitude noted at noon was 16 degrees 50 minutes South. Royal Bay is at 37 degrees 30 minutes East, 22 Leagues away.

[At Huaheine.]

[In Huahine.]

Sunday, 16th. Winds at South and South-South-East. A Gentle Breeze, with some few showers of rain. At 6 p.m. the Island of Huaheine West 1/2 South, distant 7 or 8 leagues. At 8 a.m., being close in with the North-West part of the Island, sounded, but had no ground with 80 fathoms. Some of the Natives came off to the Ship, but they were very shy of coming near until they discover'd Tupia; but after that they came on board without hesitation. Among those who came on board was the King of the Island, whose name is Oree. He had not been long on board before he and I exchanged Names, and we afterwards address'd each other accordingly.* (* The Tahitians called Cook Tootee, which was their idea of the sound of his name, with a vowel termination, none of their words ending in a consonant.) At noon the North end of the Island bore South by East 1/2 East, distant 72 Leagues. Latitude observed, 16 degrees 40 minutes South. Three other Islands in sight, namely, Ulietea, Otaha, and Bolabola,* (* Tahaa and Borabora.) so called by the Natives.

Sunday, 16th. Winds from the South and South-South-East. A gentle breeze with a few light rain showers. At 6 p.m., the Island of Huaheine was located West 1/2 South, about 7 or 8 leagues away. At 8 a.m., when we got close to the North-West part of the Island, we took soundings but couldn't find bottom even at 80 fathoms. Some of the locals approached the ship, but they were hesitant to get close until they recognized Tupia; after that, they came aboard without any hesitation. One of those who came on board was the King of the Island, named Oree. He hadn’t been on board long before we exchanged names, and we later addressed each other that way.* (* The Tahitians called Cook Tootee, which was their interpretation of how his name sounded, adding a vowel at the end since none of their words end in a consonant.) At noon, the North end of the Island was bearing South by East 1/2 East, at a distance of 72 leagues. The latitude recorded was 16 degrees 40 minutes South. Three other islands were in view: Ulietea, Otaha, and Bolabola,* (* Tahaa and Borabora.) as referred to by the locals.

Monday, 17th. Winds Southerly, fine pleasant weather. At 3 p.m. anchored in a small Harbour on the West side of the Island called by the Natives Owarhe, in 18 fathoms water, clear ground, and secure from all winds. Soon after, I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Dr. Monkhouse, Tupia, the King of the Island, and some others of the Natives, who had been on board since the morning. The Moment we landed Tupia stripped himself as low as his waist, and desir'd Mr. Monkhouse to do the same. He then sat down before a great number of the Natives that were collected together in a large Shed or House, the rest of us, by his own desire, standing behind; he then begun a long speach or prayer, which lasted near a Quarter of an Hour, and in the Course of this Speech presented to the People two Handkerchiefs, a black silk Neckcloth, some beads, and two very small bunches of Feathers. These things he had before provided for that purpose. At the same time two Chiefs spoke on the other side in answer to Tupia, as I suppose, in behalf of the People, and presented us with some young Plantains plants, and 2 small bunches of Feathers. These were by Tupia order'd to be carried on board the Ship. After the Peace was thus concluded and ratified, every one was at liberty to go where he pleased, and the first thing Tupia did was to go and pay his Oblations at one of the Mories. This seem'd to be a common ceremony with this people, and I suppose always perform'd upon landing on each other's Territories in a peaceable manner. It further appear'd that the things which Tupia gave away was for the God of this People, as they gave us a Hog and some Cocoanuts for our God, and thus they have certainly drawn us in to commit sacriledge, for the Hog hath already received sentence of Death, and is to be dissected to-morrow. A.M. I set about Surveying the Island, and Dr. Monkhouse, with some hands, went ashore to Trade with the Natives, while the Long boat was employ'd compleating our Water.

Monday, 17th. The winds were from the south, and the weather was nice and pleasant. At 3 p.m., we anchored in a small harbor on the west side of the island, which the locals called Owarhe, in 18 fathoms of water, with clear ground and safe from all winds. Shortly after, I went ashore with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Dr. Monkhouse, Tupia, the King of the Island, and a few other locals who had been on board since the morning. As soon as we landed, Tupia stripped down to his waist and asked Mr. Monkhouse to do the same. He then sat down in front of a large group of locals gathered in a big shed or house, with the rest of us standing behind him as he requested. He began a long speech or prayer that lasted about fifteen minutes, during which he presented the people with two handkerchiefs, a black silk neckcloth, some beads, and two very small bunches of feathers. He had prepared these items beforehand for this purpose. Meanwhile, two chiefs responded to Tupia, likely on behalf of the people, and gave us some young plantain plants and two small bunches of feathers. Tupia ordered these to be taken back to the ship. After the peace was officially concluded and confirmed, everyone was free to go where they wanted. The first thing Tupia did was to go and make offerings at one of the Mories. This seemed to be a common ceremony among these people, likely performed whenever they landed on each other's territories in peace. It also appeared that the things Tupia gave away were for their God, as they gave us a hog and some coconuts for our God. This definitely seems to have led us into sacrilege, as the hog has already been sentenced to death and is set to be dissected tomorrow. In the morning, I began surveying the island, while Dr. Monkhouse and some crew members went ashore to trade with the locals, and our longboat was busy completing our water supply.

Tuesday, 18th. Gentle breezes at South and South-South-West. Clear weather. The Trading party had no Success to-day. The Natives pretend that they have not had time to collect their provisions from the Differant parts of the Island, but that on the Morrow we should have some; and as I had not seen so much of the Island as I desir'd, I resolved to stay one day longer to see if anything was to be got.

Tuesday, 18th. Light winds from the South and South-South-West. Clear skies. The Trading party wasn't successful today. The locals claim they haven't had time to gather their supplies from different parts of the Island, but they say we should have some by tomorrow. Since I hadn't seen as much of the Island as I wanted, I decided to stay another day to see if anything could be obtained.

Wednesday, 19th. P.M. Variable light Airs and clear weather. The Trading party had better success to-day than Yesterday. A.M. a Gentle breeze at South-East. As it was known to the Natives that we intended to sail to-day, Oree, the Chief, and several more, came on board to take their leave of us. To the Chief was given a small plate on which was Stamp'd the following inscription--viz., "His Britannick Majesty's Ship, Endeavour, Lieutenant Cook, Commander, 16th July, 1769, Huaheine." This was accompanied with some Medals, or Counters, of the English Coins, struck 1761, together with some other Presents. All these, but more particularly the Plate, the Chief promised never to part with. This we thought would prove as lasting a Testimony of our having first discover'd this Island as any we could leave behind. After this was done they were dismissed, and we began to prepare to leave the place. But as that falls out on the following day, I shall conclude this with a Discription of the Island, which is situated in the Latitude of 16 degrees 43 minutes South, and Longitude 150 degrees 52 minutes West from Greenwich and North 58 degrees West, distance, 31 leagues, from King George's Island, or Otaheite. It is about 7 Leagues in compass, and of a Hilly and uneven surface. It hath a safe and commodious Harbour, which lies on the West side, under the Northermost high land and within the North end of the Reef which lays along that side of the Island. Into this Harbour are 2 inlets, or openings in the Reef, about 1 1/2 Miles from each other. The Southermost is the Broadest, on the South side of which is a very small sandy Island. This Harbour is called by the Natives Ohwarhe. The produce of this Island is in all respects the same as King George's Island, and the Manner and Customs of the inhabitants much the same, only that they are not addicted to Stealing; and with respect to colour they are rather fairer than the natives of George's Island, and the whole more Uniformly of one Colour.

Wednesday, 19th. P.M. Variable light breezes and clear weather. The trading party had better success today than yesterday. A.M. a gentle breeze from the Southeast. Since the locals knew we planned to sail today, Oree, the chief, and several others came on board to say their goodbyes. The chief was given a small plate with the following inscription: "His Britannick Majesty's Ship, Endeavour, Lieutenant Cook, Commander, 16th July, 1769, Huaheine." This was accompanied by some medals, or tokens, of English coins minted in 1761, along with some other gifts. The chief promised never to part with these, especially the plate. We believed this would serve as a lasting reminder of our having first discovered this island. After this, they were dismissed, and we began preparing to leave the place. But since that will happen on the following day, I will conclude this with a description of the island, which is located at latitude 16 degrees 43 minutes South and longitude 150 degrees 52 minutes West from Greenwich, and 58 degrees North West, 31 leagues from King George's Island, or Otaheite. It measures about 7 leagues in circumference and has a hilly and uneven surface. There is a safe and convenient harbor on the west side, under the northernmost high land and within the northern end of the reef along that side of the island. This harbor has two inlets, or openings in the reef, about 1.5 miles apart. The southernmost is the widest, with a very small sandy island on its southern side. The natives call this harbor Ohwarhe. The produce of this island is similar to that of King George's Island, and the customs of the inhabitants are quite alike, except they are not inclined to stealing; and in terms of skin color, they are somewhat fairer than the natives of George’s Island, and overall, more uniform in color.

[At Raiatea.]

[At Raiatea.]

Thursday, 20th. Moderate breezes at East and East-North-East. Fair weather. At 1/2 past 2 p.m. weighed and made Sail for the Island of Ulietea, which lies South-West by West, Distance 7 or 8 leagues from Huaheine. At 1/2 past 6 we were within 3 Leagues of it, then shortened sail and stood off and on all night, and at daylight made Sail in shore, and soon after discover'd an opening in the Reef that lies along this side of the Island, within which, Tupia said, was a good Harbour. Upon this I hoisted out the Pinnace, and sent the Master in to Examine it, who soon made the Signal for the Ship to follow. Accordingly we stood in and Anchor'd in 22 fathoms, soft ground. Soon after we Anchor'd some of the Natives came on board the Ship with very little invitation.

Thursday, 20th. There were moderate breezes from the East and East-North-East. The weather was nice. At 2:30 p.m., we weighed anchor and set sail for the Island of Ulietea, which is South-West by West, about 7 or 8 leagues from Huaheine. By 6:30 p.m., we were within 3 leagues of it, then we reduced sail and stayed close to the shore all night. At dawn, we set sail towards the shore and soon spotted an opening in the reef along this side of the island, which Tupia said had a good harbor. So, I launched the pinnace and sent the master to explore it, who quickly signaled for the ship to come in. We proceeded to anchor in 22 fathoms of soft ground. Shortly after we anchored, some of the natives came on board the ship with very little encouragement.

Friday, 21st. Winds variable, and dark, cloudy weather, with frequent Showers of rain. At 1 p.m. I landed in Company with Mr. Banks and the other gentlemen. The first thing done was the performing of Tupia's ceremony in all respects as at Huaheine. I then hoisted an English jack, and took possession of the Island and those adjacent in the name of His Britannick Majesty, calling them by the same names as the natives do. A.M. sent the Master in the Long boat to examine the coast of the South part of the Island, and one of the Mates in the Yawl to sound the Harbour where the Ship lay, while I was employ'd in the Pinnace surveying the Northern part of the Island, and Mr. Monkhouse went ashore to trade with the Natives for such refreshments as were to be got.

Friday, 21st. The winds were variable, and the weather was dark and cloudy, with frequent rain showers. At 1 p.m., I landed along with Mr. Banks and the other gentlemen. The first thing we did was perform Tupia's ceremony just like we did at Huaheine. I then raised an English flag and took possession of the island and nearby ones in the name of His Britannic Majesty, using the same names the locals do. In the morning, I sent the Master in the longboat to explore the southern coast of the island, and one of the mates in the yawl to survey the harbor where the ship was anchored, while I worked in the pinnace surveying the northern part of the island, and Mr. Monkhouse went ashore to trade with the locals for any refreshments we could find.

Saturday, 22nd. P.M. the wind Variable with Showers of rain. A.M. strong Gales at South and hazey with rain, and which continued the most part of

Saturday, 22nd. In the afternoon, the wind was variable with rain showers. In the morning, there were strong gusts from the south, and it was hazy with rain, which mostly continued throughout the day.

Sunday, 23rd, in so much that I did not think it safe to break the Ship loose and put to sea as I intended.

Sunday, 23rd, I felt it wasn’t safe to release the ship and set sail as I had planned.

Monday, 24th. Winds variable from South-South-East to North-East. At 8 a.m. got under sail and plyed to the Northward within the Reef, in order to go out at the Northern Channell, it being the broadest; but being little wind and meeting with Shoals we had not before discovered, we turned down but slowly.

Monday, 24th. Winds varied from South-South-East to North-East. At 8 a.m., we set sail and headed north within the reef to exit through the northern channel, as it was the widest. However, with light winds and encountering shoals we hadn't discovered before, our progress was slow as we turned back.

Tuesday, 25th. First part, little wind at North-East; in the night calm, A.M. a fresh breeze at West-North-West, fair weather. At 3 p.m. Anchor'd in 22 fathoms Muddy bottom, the North Channell open bearing North-East 1/2 East, at 5 a.m. a breeze sprung up at North-West, weighed and put to Sea, and hauled to the Northward in order to take a View of the Island and Ataha and Bolabola; but before I proceed farther, I shall describe the Harbour we have been in.* (* It has no particular name, but extends the whole of the eastern side of Raiatea.) This Harbour, taken in its greatest Extent, is capable of holding any number of Shipping in perfect security, as it extends almost the whole length of this side of the Island, and is defended from the Sea by a reef of Coral rocks; the Southermost opening* (* Teava Moa Pass.) in this reef or Channell into the Harbour, which is not more than a Cable's length wide, is off the Eastermost point of the Island, and may be known by a small woody Island, which lies a little to the South-East of it. Between 3 and 4 miles North-West from this Island lies 2 other small Islands, and in the same direction as the reef, of which they are a part. Between these 2 Islands is another Channell* (* Iriru Pass.) into the Harbour that is a full Quarter of a Mile broad; still further to the North-West are some other small Islands, where, I am informed, is another small inlet, but this I did not see; but, as to the other 2, we enter'd the Harbour by the one and came out by the other.

Tuesday, 25th. First part, light wind from the North-East; calm at night. In the morning, a fresh breeze came from the West-North-West, with clear weather. At 3 p.m., we anchored in 22 fathoms of muddy bottom, with the North Channel open bearing North-East 1/2 East. By 5 a.m., a breeze picked up from the North-West, so we weighed anchor and headed to sea, steering North to get a better look at the islands of Ataha and Bolabola. But before I go further, let me describe the harbor we've been in.* (*It has no specific name but stretches along the entire eastern side of Raiatea.) This harbor, in its fullest extent, can accommodate any number of ships safely, as it runs almost the entire length of this side of the island and is protected from the ocean by a coral reef. The southernmost entrance* (*Teava Moa Pass.) into the harbor through this reef is only a cable's length wide, located off the easternmost point of the island, identifiable by a small wooded island to the South-East. About 3 to 4 miles North-West from this island are two more small islands, aligned with the reef of which they are part. Between these two islands is another channel* (*Iriru Pass.) into the harbor that is a full quarter of a mile wide. Further to the North-West, there are additional small islands where I've been told there’s another small inlet, but I did not see that; however, concerning the other two, we entered the harbor through one and exited through the other.

The principal refreshments we have got here consists in Plantains, Cocoa nuts, some Yams and a few Hogs and fowls. This side of the Island is neither Populous nor Rich in Produce, if compared to George's Island, or even Huaheine; however, here is no want of refreshments for a ship who may put in here and stay but a short time; and wood and water may be got everywhere, tho' the latter is not very convenient to come at.

The main supplies we have here include plantains, coconuts, some yams, and a few pigs and chickens. This side of the island isn’t very populated or rich in resources compared to George's Island or even Huaheine. However, there’s no shortage of provisions for a ship that may stop here briefly; wood and water are available everywhere, although the latter can be a bit hard to access.

[Off Bolabola.]

[Off Bolabola.]

Wednesday, 26th. Winds at West by North and West by South, but very Variable towards the Latter part. At 4 p.m. the North End of Ulietea South 75 degrees West, distance 2 leagues, and the south end of Otaha North 77 degrees West. About a League to the Northward of the South end of Otaha, on the East side of the Island, a mile or more from the Shore, lies 2 Small Islands. Between these Islands Tupia says there is a Channell into a very good harbour which lies within the Reef and it had all the appearance of such. Keept plying to Windward all night without getting any ground. At Noon the Peak on Bolabola West by South. Latitude observed 16 degrees 26 minutes South.

Wednesday, 26th. Winds coming from the West by North and West by South, but they were quite variable later on. At 4 p.m., the North End of Ulietea was South 75 degrees West, a distance of 2 leagues, and the south end of Otaha was North 77 degrees West. About a league north of the south end of Otaha, on the east side of the island, and a mile or more from the shore, there are 2 small islands. Tupia mentions that there is a channel between these islands leading into a very good harbor that lies within the reef, and it definitely looked like one. We kept sailing upwind all night without making any progress. At noon, the peak on Bolabola was West by South. Latitude observed was 16 degrees 26 minutes South.

Thursday, 27th. Variable light Airs of wind in the South-West Quarter, and fair weather. Seeing that there is a broad Channell between Otaha and Bolabola, I intend to go through that way and not run to the Northward of all; but as the wind is right an end, and very Variable withall, we get little or no ground. Between 5 and 6 o'Clock p.m., as we were standing to the Northward, we discover'd a small low Island lying North by West or North-North-West distant 4 or 5 Leagues from Bolabola. This Island is called Tubai. Tupia says it produces nothing but a few Cocoa Nuts, that there are only 3 families live upon it, but that the people from these Islands resort thither to Catch fish. At Noon the peak of Bolabola bore North 25 degrees West, and the north end of Otaha North 80 degrees West, distant 3 Leagues. Latitude observed 16 degrees 38 minutes South.

Thursday, 27th. There are light variable winds coming from the South-West and clear skies. Since there's a wide channel between Otaha and Bolabola, I plan to go that way instead of heading too far north. However, with the wind shifting around and being quite variable, we're making little progress. Between 5 and 6 p.m., as we were heading north, we spotted a small low island lying North by West or North-North-West, about 4 or 5 leagues from Bolabola. This island is called Tubai. Tupia mentions that it only has a few coconut trees and that only 3 families live there, but people from nearby islands come to fish. At noon, the peak of Bolabola was at North 25 degrees West, and the north end of Otaha was at North 80 degrees West, a distance of 3 leagues. The observed latitude was 16 degrees 38 minutes South.

Friday, 28th. Little wind and Variable between the South-West and North-West. At 6 a.m., being near the Entrance of the Harbour which lies on the East side of Otaha before mentioned,* (* Hamene Bay.) and finding that it might be examin'd without loosing time, I sent away the Master in the Long boat, with orders to sound the Harbour, and if the wind did not shift in our favour to land upon the Island and to Traffick with the Natives for such refreshments as were to be got. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander went along with him.

Friday, 28th. There was little wind, shifting between the South-West and North-West. At 6 a.m., being close to the Entrance of the Harbour on the East side of Otaha mentioned earlier, and realizing it could be explored without wasting time, I sent the Master off in the longboat with instructions to check the depth of the Harbour. If the wind didn’t change in our favor, he was to land on the Island and trade with the locals for whatever supplies were available. Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander accompanied him.

Saturday, 29th. Little wind and Variable. Kept plying on and off this day, waiting for the return of the Long boat. At 1/2 past 5 not seeing anything of her, fir'd a Gun for her to return, and as soon as it was dark hoisted a light. At 1/2 past 8 heard the report of a musquet, which we answered with a Gun; and soon after the Boat came on board with 3 small Hogs, a few Fowls, and a large Quantity of Plantains, and some Yams. They found the Natives very Sociable and ready to part with anything they had, and the Harbour safe and Commodious, with a good Anchorage in 25, 20, and 16 fathoms clear ground. As soon as the Boat was hoisted in we made Sail to the Northward, and at 8 o'Clock a.m. were close under the Peak of Bolabola, but as we could not weather the Island, we Tack'd and stood off until near Noon, then Tack'd again and stood to the South-West. At Noon the Peak of Bolabola bore South 75 degrees West; we were then distant from the Shore under it 2 or 3 miles, and from the Peak about 5 miles. Latitude observed 16 degrees 29 minutes South.

Saturday, 29th. There was little wind and it was variable. We kept moving on and off today, waiting for the return of the longboat. At 5:30 PM, not seeing anything of her, we fired a gun to signal her to return, and as soon as it got dark, we raised a light. At 8:30 PM, we heard the sound of a musket, which we responded to with a gun; soon after, the boat came on board with three small pigs, a few chickens, a large quantity of plantains, and some yams. They found the locals very friendly and willing to trade everything they had, and the harbor was safe and convenient, with good anchorage in 25, 20, and 16 fathoms of clear ground. As soon as the boat was lifted in, we set sail to the north, and at 8 AM, we were close to the peak of Bolabola. However, as we couldn’t get past the island, we tacked and went out until nearly noon, then tacked again and headed southwest. At noon, the peak of Bolabola was bearing South 75 degrees West; we were then 2 or 3 miles from the shore beneath it and about 5 miles from the peak. Latitude observed was 16 degrees 29 minutes South.

Sunday, 30th. Wind in the South-East Quarter. At first a Gentle breeze, but afterwards freshned upon us. P.M. made several Trips before we could weather the South end of Bolabola, which at last we accomplished between 7 and 8 o'Clock, and stood off South-South-West until 12 at night, then Tack'd and stood in until 4 a.m., then stood off again; but meeting with a large swell from the Southward, against which the Ship made little or no way, at 8 we tack'd and stood in Shore again. At this time we discovered an Island which bore from us North 63 degrees West, distant about 8 Leagues: at the same time the Peak of Bolabola bore North 1/2 East, distance 3 or 4 Leagues. This Island Tupia calls Maurua, and according to his account it is but small, and surrounded by a Reef of Rocks, and hath no Harbour fit for Shipping. It is inhabited, and its produce is the same as the other Islands we have touched at. It riseth in a high round hill in the middle of the Island, which may be seen 10 Leagues. At noon the South end of Otaha bore North 80 degrees East, distance 4 Leagues. Latitude observed 16 degrees 39 minutes South.

Sunday, 30th. Wind coming from the South-East. At first, it was a gentle breeze, but then it picked up. In the afternoon, we made several trips before we could get past the south end of Bolabola, which we finally did between 7 and 8 o'clock. We headed off South-Southwest until midnight, then tacked and sailed in until 4 a.m. After that, we set off again, but encountered a big swell coming from the south, which made it hard for the ship to move. At 8, we tacked and headed back to shore. At this time, we spotted an island that was to our North 63 degrees West, about 8 leagues away. Meanwhile, the peak of Bolabola was to our North 1/2 East, 3 or 4 leagues away. This island, which Tupia calls Maurua, is small and surrounded by a reef of rocks, with no harbor suitable for ships. It's inhabited, and its products are similar to the other islands we've visited. In the center, there's a high round hill that can be seen from 10 leagues away. At noon, the south end of Otaha was to our North 80 degrees East, 4 leagues away. Latitude recorded at 16 degrees 39 minutes South.

Monday, 31st. Fresh Gales in the South-East Quarter, and close, cloudy weather. Plying to windward all this day, on the South-West side of Otaha, without gaining little or anything. In the middle watch was obliged to double reef our Topsails, but in the morning it fell moderate, and we crowded all the sail we could. At Noon the South end of Otaha bore East, distance 2 Leagues. Latitude observed 16 degrees 40 minutes South. Tupia told us there was a very good Harbour within the Reef which lies on this side of Otaha; but this Harbour I shall discribe in another place.

Monday, 31st. Fresh winds coming from the southeast and overcast, cloudy weather. We spent the whole day sailing against the wind along the southwest side of Otaha, making very little progress. During the night watch, we had to double reef our topsails, but by morning the wind eased up, and we set all the sail we could. At noon, the south end of Otaha was to the east, about 2 leagues away. We observed the latitude to be 16 degrees and 40 minutes south. Tupia mentioned that there was a very good harbor inside the reef near this side of Otaha, but I will describe that harbor in another place.

[August 1769. At Raiatea.]

[August 1769. At Raiatea.]

Tuesday, August 1st. A fresh Gale at South-East the most part of this day. Keept plying to windward all the afternoon and night, and in the morning found ourselves nearly the length of the South end of Ulietea, and to windward of some Harbours that lay on the West side of this Island. Into one of them I intended to go with the Ship, in order to stop a Leak in the Powder room, which could not be easily done at Sea, and to take in more Ballast, as I found her too light to carry sail upon a wind. At Noon plying off one of the Harbour's mouth, the wind being right out.

Tuesday, August 1st. A strong southeast wind blew for most of the day. We kept sailing against the wind all afternoon and night, and by morning, we were nearly at the southern end of Ulietea, positioned upwind of some harbors on the island's west side. I planned to take the ship into one of these harbors to fix a leak in the powder room, which couldn’t be easily managed at sea, and to take on more ballast since I found the ship too light to sail properly in the wind. At noon, we were tacking off the mouth of one of the harbors, with the wind blowing directly out.

Wednesday, 2nd. Moderate breezes at South-East and East, with some Showers of Rain. At 3 p.m. anchor'd in the Entrance of the Channell leading into the Harbour* (* Rautoanui.) in 14 fathoms water; found a tide setting pretty strong out, which was the reason that we could not work in; carried out the Kedge Anchor in order to warp into the Harbour, but after this was done we could not Trip the Bower Anchor with all the purchass we could make, and was therefore obliged to lay still all night, but in the morning we did it with Ease, and warped the Ship into a proper birth, and moor'd in 28 fathoms, a sandy bottom. A great many of the Natives came off to us both last night and this morning, and brought with them Hogs, Fowls, Plaintains, etc., which they parted with at a very easy rate.

Wednesday, 2nd. Mild breezes from the South-East and East, with some rain showers. At 3 p.m., we anchored at the entrance of the channel leading into the harbor* (* Rautoanui.) in 14 fathoms of water; we found a strong tide flowing out, which is why we couldn't maneuver in. We deployed the kedge anchor to help warp into the harbor, but once that was done, we couldn't raise the bower anchor despite all our efforts, so we had to stay put all night. However, in the morning, we raised it easily and warped the ship into a suitable spot, mooring in 28 fathoms on a sandy bottom. A lot of the locals came to us both last night and this morning, bringing hogs, chickens, plantains, and other items, which they sold at a very reasonable price.

Thursday, 3rd. Winds from East-South-East to North-East; very Hot weather this afternoon. I went ashore to look for a place to get stones for Ballast, and a watering place, both of which I found very convenient; and in the morning sent an Officer a Shore to Superintend the getting off the Ballast and Water, and I went in the Pinnace to the Northward to survey that part of the Island, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, while the Carpenters were employ'd on board stopping the Leaks of the Powder room and Foresail room.

Thursday, 3rd. Winds from East-South-East to North-East; it was really hot this afternoon. I went ashore to find a place to get stones for ballast and a water source, both of which I found to be very convenient. In the morning, I sent an officer ashore to oversee getting the ballast and water, while I took the pinnace north to explore that part of the island, joined by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, while the carpenters worked on board fixing the leaks in the powder room and foresail room.

Friday, 4th. First and Latter parts, moderate breezes, at East-North-East; in the night, Calm, Hot, and sultry. In our rout to the Northward this afternoon we were entertained at one place with Musick and Dancing. The Musick consisted of 3 Drums, and the Dancing was mostly perform'd by 2 Young Women and one Man, and this seem'd to be their profession. The dress of the women was such as we had not seen before; it was neat, decent, and well chose, and in many respects not much unlike a European dress; only their Arms, Necks, and Shoulders were bare, and their headdress was the Tomow stuck with Flowers. They made very little use of their feet and Legs in Dancing, but one part or another of their bodies were in continual motion and in various postures, as standing, setting, and upon their Hands and knees, making strange Contorsions. Their Arms, hands, and Fingers they moved with great Agility and in a very Extraordinary manner, and altho' they were very exact in observing the same motion in all their movements, yet neither their Musick or Dancing were at all Calculated to please a European. There were likewise some men, who acted a kind of a Farce; but this was so short that we could gather nothing from it, only that it shew'd that these People have a Notion of Dramatick performances, and some of our Gentlemen saw them act a Farce the next day, wherein was 4 Acts, and it seem'd to them to represent a War between the Bolabola men and those of Ulietea, wherein the former triumph'd over the latter; but what might help them to draw this Conclusion was the knowing that such a thing has not long ago hapned between these 2 People, and that the Bolabola men at present possess most of the Lands on this Island. This is their grand Dramatick Heiva, and I believe is occasionally performed in all the Islands. Upon my return to the Ship in the evening I found that they had got on board 20 Tuns of Ballast, and this I thought would be sufficient. In the morning we sent all our water Casks on shore, and got them all off full by Noon. This morning I received a present from Opoony, the Eare dehi of Bolabola, who at this time was upon this Island. It consisted of 3 Hogs, some pieces of Cloth, Plantains, Cocoa Nuts, etc. These were sent by his Servants, and I was told that he would come the next day himself.

Friday, 4th. The day started with moderate breezes from the East-North-East; at night, it was calm, hot, and humid. On our journey north this afternoon, we enjoyed some music and dancing at one location. The music included three drums, and the dancing was mainly performed by two young women and one man, who seemed to be professionals. The women wore outfits we hadn't seen before; they were neat, modest, and well-chosen, resembling European clothing in some ways, except their arms, necks, and shoulders were bare, and they wore flower-adorned headpieces called Tomows. They didn't use their feet and legs much while dancing, but their bodies were constantly moving in various positions, such as standing, sitting, and even on their hands and knees, making peculiar contortions. Their arms, hands, and fingers moved with great agility and in an extraordinary way, and while they were precise in their motions, neither their music nor dancing would be considered pleasing to a European audience. There were also some men performing a short comedic skit; however, it was so brief that we couldn’t learn much from it, other than that these people have an idea of dramatic performances. Some of our gentlemen saw them perform a longer skit the next day, which had four acts and seemed to depict a conflict between the Bolabola men and the people of Ulietea, with Bolabola emerging victorious. This conclusion might have been influenced by the recent conflict between these two groups and the fact that the Bolabola men currently own most of the land on the island. This is their grand dramatic Heiva, which I believe is performed occasionally across all the islands. When I returned to the ship in the evening, I found they had taken aboard 20 tons of ballast, which I thought would be sufficient. In the morning, we sent all our water casks ashore and managed to get them all back full by noon. That morning, I received a gift from Opoony, the chief of Bolabola, who was on the island at that time. The gift included three pigs, some pieces of cloth, plantains, coconuts, and more. His servants delivered these, and I was told he would come by the next day himself.

Saturday, 5th. This evening we bought as much Fish as the whole Ship's Company could destroy while good. In the morning I sent the Master to the North End of the Island with the Long boat to Traffick with the Natives for Provisions, as they did not bring it to the Ship, as they had hitherto done; and myself, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, went in the Pinnace to the Southern part of the Island, partly on the same account and partly to Examine that part of the Island. In our rout we passed thro' 2 Harbours equally as good as the one in which the Ship lays, but the Country about them is poorer and but thinly inhabited, and we got no one thing worth bringing home with us, but the Master succeeded something better.

Saturday, 5th. This evening we bought as much fish as the entire ship's crew could eat while it was still fresh. In the morning, I sent the captain to the northern end of the island with the longboat to trade with the locals for supplies, since they didn’t bring any to the ship as they had done before. I, along with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, took the pinnace to the southern part of the island, partly for the same reason and partly to explore that area. On our way, we passed through two harbors just as good as the one where the ship is anchored, but the surrounding land is poorer and has very few inhabitants, and we didn’t find anything worth bringing back with us, although the captain had a bit more success.

Sunday, 6th. Variable light Airs and fair weather. A.M. I sent the Master again to the Northward to procure refreshments, who return'd not unsuccessfull. Opoony, the Chief, sent some of his people this morning to me to get something in return for the present he sent the other day; he not choosing, as I suppose, to trust himself on board, or perhaps he thought the persons he sent (who were 3 very pretty young Girls) would succeed better than he should do. Be this as it may, they went away very well satisfied with what they got, altho' I believe that they were disappointed in some things.

Sunday, 6th. Light variable winds and nice weather. In the morning, I sent the captain north again to gather supplies, and he returned successfully. Opoony, the Chief, sent some people to me today to get something in exchange for the gift he sent the other day; he probably didn’t want to come aboard himself, or maybe he thought the three very pretty young girls he sent would have better luck than he would. Regardless, they left quite pleased with what they received, although I think they were a bit let down about some items.

Monday, 7th. Variable light Airs. P.M. some Showers of rain. Being desirous to see King Opoony, we made a party this afternoon and I went ashore for that purpose, carrying along with us a small present. Upon our landing he did not receive us setting, as all the other Chiefs had hitherto done, or in any manner of Form; this we attributed to his Stupidity, for such he appeared to be. However, he gave me a Hog in return for the present I made him, and this was paying us full as great a Complement. Before we took our leave we let him know that we should go to Otaha in the morning in our Boats, and would be glad to have him along with us, and he accordingly promised to accompany us thither. Accordingly, very early in the morning, I set out with both Pinnace and Long boat for Otaha, and some of the Gentlemen along with me; and in our way called upon Opoony, who was in his Canoe ready to set out. As soon as we landed on Otaha I made him a present of a Axe; this I thought would induce him to incourage his Subjects to bring us such Provisions as we wanted, but I believe we had already got all they intended us, for after staying with him until Noon we were obliged to go away without geting any one thing.

Monday, 7th. Light, changing breezes. In the afternoon, some rain showers. Wanting to meet King Opoony, we organized a gathering this afternoon and I went ashore for that purpose, bringing a small gift. When we arrived, he didn’t welcome us as all the other chiefs had done before, nor did he show any formalities; we attributed this to his apparent ignorance. However, he gave me a pig in return for the gift I presented to him, which was quite a compliment. Before we left, we informed him that we would be heading to Otaha in the morning by boat and would be happy to have him join us, to which he promised he would come along. Early the next morning, I set out with both the pinnace and longboat for Otaha, with some gentlemen accompanying me. On our way, we stopped by to see Opoony, who was in his canoe, ready to depart. As soon as we landed at Otaha, I gave him an axe as a gift; I hoped this would encourage him to motivate his people to bring us the provisions we needed, but I think we had already received everything they intended to give us, because after spending time with him until noon, we had to leave without getting anything.

Tuesday, 8th. After leaving Opoony we proceeded towards the North point of the Island, and in our way pick'd up half a Dozen Hogs, as many Fowls, and some Plantains and Yams; and I had an opportunity to view and draw a Sketch of the Harbour which lies on this Side of the Island, and which was the only thing that induced me to make this Excursion. After it was dark we met with the Longboat, which I had in the morning dispatch'd to another part of the Island; and we now made the best of our way to the Ship and got on board about 10 at night. The Carpenter having finished stopping the Leaks about the Powder Room and Sailroom I now intend to sail as soon as ever the wind will permit us to get out of the Harbour.

Tuesday, 8th. After leaving Opoony, we headed towards the northern tip of the island, and along the way, we picked up half a dozen pigs, as many chickens, and some plantains and yams. I also had a chance to view and sketch the harbor on this side of the island, which was the only thing that motivated me to make this trip. After it got dark, we met up with the longboat I had sent out to another part of the island that morning. We then made our way back to the ship and boarded around 10 at night. The carpenter had finished sealing the leaks in the powder room and sail room, so I now plan to sail as soon as the wind allows us to leave the harbor.

Wednesday, 9th. P.M. had a light breeze of wind at North; in the night had much rain. A.M. little wind and Variable, with some Showers of rain. At 11 a.m. a breeze of wind sprung up at East, which carried us out of the Harbour, and as soon as the Boats were hoisted in made Sail to the Southward. Since we have been about these Islands we have expended but little of our Sea Provisions, and have at this last place been very plentifully supply'd with Hogs, Fowls, Plantains, and Yams, which will be of very great use to us in case we should not discover any lands in our rout to the Southward, the way I now intend to Steer.

Wednesday, 9th. In the evening, there was a light breeze coming from the north; during the night, we got a lot of rain. In the morning, there was little wind and it was variable, with some rain showers. At 11 a.m., a breeze picked up from the east, which helped us leave the harbor, and as soon as the boats were secured, we set sail southward. Since arriving in these islands, we've hardly touched our sea provisions, and here at our most recent stop, we've been generously stocked with hogs, chickens, plantains, and yams, which will be very helpful in case we don’t come across any land while heading south, the direction I plan to go now.

[Description of Society Islands.]

[Description of Society Islands.]

DESCRIPTION OF THE ISLANDS, ULIETEA, OTAHA AND BOLABOLA.

DESCRIPTION OF THE ISLANDS, ULIETEA, OTAHA AND BOLABOLA.

So called by the Natives, and it was not thought adviseable to give them any other Names; but these three, with Huaheine, Tuibai, and Maurua, as they lay contigious to one another, I have named Society Isles.

So named by the Natives, and it was deemed unwise to give them any other names; but these three, along with Huaheine, Tuibai, and Maurua, which are all next to each other, I have called the Society Isles.

They are situated between the Latitude of 16 degrees 10 minutes and 16 degrees 55 minutes South and between the Longitude 151 degrees 00 minutes and 151 degrees 42 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich. Ulietea and Otaha lay close to each other, and are both inclosed within a Reef of Coral Rocks; and altho' the distance between the one and the other is near 2 Miles, yet there is no Passage for Shipping. By means of this reef are form'd several excellent Harbours. The entrance into them are but narrow, but when a Ship is once in nothing can hurt her. Those on the East side have been already described. On the West side of Ulietea, which is the largest Island of the 2, are 3, the Northermost of which, called Oraotanue,* (* Rautoanui.) we lay in, the Channell leading in is a 1/4 of a Mile wide and lies between 2 low sandy Islands, which are the Northermost small Islands on this side. You have good Anchorage between or just within the 2 Islands in 28 fathoms soft ground. This harbour, tho' but small, yet it is preferable to any on the Island, on account of the easy getting of fresh Water, and being seated in the most fertile part of the Island. The other 2 harbours lay to the Southward of this, and not far from the South end of the Island. In both of them are good Anchorage in 10, 12, and 14 fathoms water: they are readily known by 3 small woody Islands that lay at their entrance, the Southermost Harbour lies within and to the Southward of the Southermost Island, and the other lies between the Northermost. There are more Harbours at the South End of this Island, as I am inform'd, but these were not examind by us.

They are located between 16 degrees 10 minutes and 16 degrees 55 minutes South and between 151 degrees 00 minutes and 151 degrees 42 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich. Ulietea and Otaha are close to each other, both enclosed within a reef of coral rocks. Even though the distance between them is nearly 2 miles, there is no passage for shipping. This reef creates several excellent harbors. The entrances to them are narrow, but once a ship is inside, it is safe from harm. The harbors on the east side have already been described. On the west side of Ulietea, which is the larger of the two islands, there are three harbors. The northernmost one, called Oraotanue, where we anchored, has a channel that is a quarter of a mile wide and lies between two low sandy islands that are the northernmost small islands on this side. You can find good anchorage between or just within the two islands in 28 fathoms of soft ground. This harbor, though small, is better than any other on the island because it offers easy access to fresh water and is located in the most fertile part of the island. The other two harbors are to the south of this one, not far from the southern end of the island. In both, there is good anchorage in 10, 12, and 14 fathoms of water; they are easily identified by three small wooded islands at their entrances. The southernmost harbor is located inside and to the south of the southernmost island, while the other lies between the northernmost islands. I’ve heard there are more harbors at the southern end of this island, but we didn’t examine those.

Otaha affords 2 very good Harbours, one on the East and the other on the West side; that on the East side called Ohamane* (* Hamene.) hath been already mentioned, the other is called Oharurua* (* Hurepiti.) and lies about the middle of the South-West side of the Island. It is pretty large, and affords good Anchorage in 20 and 25 fathoms, and there is no want of fresh Water. The breach in the Reef which forms a Channell into this harbour is 1/4 of a mile broad, steep too, on both sides, and the same may be said of all the others, and in general there is no danger but what is Visible.

Otaha has 2 great harbors, one on the east side and the other on the west. The eastern harbor, called Ohamane* (* Hamene), has already been mentioned, while the other is known as Oharurua* (* Hurepiti) and is located about the center of the southwest side of the island. It's quite large and offers good anchorage in 20 to 25 fathoms, with plenty of fresh water available. The gap in the reef that creates a channel into this harbor is 1/4 mile wide, with steep sides on both ends, and the same goes for all the other harbors. Generally, there's no danger that's not visible.

The Island of Bolabola lies North-West by West from Otaha, distant 4 Leagues, it is incompassed by a reef of Rocks and several small Islands, and the Circuit of the whole appear'd to be about 8 Leagues. On the South-West side of the Islands (as I am inform'd) is an opening in the Reef which admits of a Channell into a very good Harbour. This Island is very remarkable on account of a high Craggy hill upon it, which Terminates at Top in 2 Peaks, one higher than the other; this hill is so perpendicular that it appears to be quite inaccessible. The land on Ulietea and Otaha is of a very hilly, broken, and uneven surface, except what borders upon the Sea Coast, and high withall, yet the Hills look green and pleasant and are in many places cloathed with woods.

The Island of Bolabola is located Northwest by West from Otaha, about 4 leagues away. It's surrounded by a reef of rocks and several small islands, and the total perimeter is around 8 leagues. On the Southwest side of the island, there’s an opening in the reef that leads to a very good harbor. This island is notable for its high, craggy hill that has two peaks, one taller than the other. The hill is so steep that it seems almost impossible to climb. The land on Ulietea and Otaha is very hilly, broken, and uneven, except for the areas along the coastline, which are also elevated. The hills appear green and beautiful and are covered with woods in many spots.

The Produce of these Islands, and manners and Customs of the Natives are much the same as at King George's Island, only as the Bread fruit Tree is here in not such plenty, the natives to supply that deficiency plant and Cultivate a greater Quantity of Plantains and Yams of several sorts, and these they have in the greatest Perfection.

The produce of these islands and the habits and customs of the locals are very similar to those at King George's Island. However, since the breadfruit tree isn't as plentiful here, the locals compensate for this by planting and cultivating more plantains and yams of different kinds, which they grow to perfection.

The inhabitants are rather of a fairer Colour than the Generality of the Natives of George's Island, but more especially the Women, who are much fairer and handsomer, and the Men are not so much Addicted to thieving, and are more Open and free in their behaviour.

The residents are generally lighter-skinned than most of the natives of George's Island, particularly the women, who are much fairer and more attractive. The men are also less inclined to steal and behave more openly and freely.

The only differance we could see in their Religion was in the Houses of their Gods, which were very different to those we saw on George's Island. Those here were made about the Size and shape of a Coffin open at one End; they are laid upon a Number of small Wooden Arches, which are fram'd and fastned together like the Roof of a House, and these are generally supported about 3 or 4 feet above the ground by Posts. Over the box is a small roof or shade made of Palm thatch; in this Box are deposited the Oblations of the Gods, such as Pieces of Cloth, Human bone, etc., and these places they hold sacred, and some are placed in their Mories, and some not. They have a Custom of preserving the Sculls and under Jaw bones of the Dead, but wether of their Friends or Enemies I cannot pretend to say. Several of the Sculls, we observed, were broke, and its very probable that the owners of them had been kill'd in battle, as some of their Weapons are well Calculated for breaking of Heads; and from what we could learn it is a Custom with them to cut out the Lower jaw of their Enemies, but I believe not before they are kill'd, and these they keep as Trophies, and are sometimes hung up in their Houses.

The only difference we noticed in their religion was in the houses of their gods, which were very different from those we saw on George's Island. The ones here were shaped like an open coffin; they were placed on several small wooden arches, framed and fastened together like a house roof, and these were usually supported about 3 or 4 feet above the ground by posts. Above the box was a small roof or shade made of palm thatch; inside this box were the offerings to the gods, like pieces of cloth, human bones, etc., and they consider these places sacred. Some offerings are placed in their mories, while others are not. They have a custom of preserving the skulls and lower jawbones of the dead, but I can't say if they are from friends or enemies. We noticed that several skulls were broken, and it’s very likely that their owners had been killed in battle, as some of their weapons are quite capable of breaking skulls. From what we could gather, it’s a custom for them to cut out the lower jaw of their enemies, but I believe they do this only after killing them, and they keep these as trophies, which are sometimes hung up in their houses.

The Chief or King of Bolabola hath of late Years Usurped the Sovereignty of the other two, and the Bolabola men at this time possess great part of the Lands on Ulietea and Otaha that they have taken from the Natives. The Lands adjoining to the Harbours of Oraotanue belong'd to Tupia, the Person we have on board, who is a Native of Ulietea. These people are very ingenious in building their Proes or Canoes, and seem to take as much Care of them, having large Shades or Houses to put them in, built for the purpose, and in these houses they likewise build and repair them, and in this they shew a great deal of ingenuity far more than one could expect. They are built full Bellied, and after the very same Model as those Six we saw on George's Island, which I have already described, and some of them are full as large; it is more than probable that these 6 Proes were built at some of these Islands. In these Proes, or Pahies as they call them, from all the accounts we can learn, these people sail in those Seas from Island to Island for several hundred Leagues, the Sun serving them for a Compass by day, and the Moon and Stars by night. When this comes to be proved, we shall be no longer at a loss to know how the Islands lying in those Seas came to be peopled; for if the inhabitants of Ulietea have been at Islands laying 2 or 300 Leagues to the Westward of them, it cannot be doubted but that the inhabitants of those Western Islands may have been at others as far to Westward of them, and so we may trace them from Island to Island quite to the East Indies.

The Chief or King of Bolabola has recently taken control over the other two and the people of Bolabola currently occupy a significant portion of the lands on Ulietea and Otaha that they have seized from the locals. The lands near the harbors of Oraotanue belonged to Tupia, who is on our ship and is a native of Ulietea. These people are very skilled at building their canoes, which they take great care of. They have large sheds or houses specifically for storing them, and they also build and repair them in these houses, showcasing a remarkable level of craftsmanship that exceeds expectations. The canoes are built with a round belly and follow the same design as the six we saw on George's Island, which I've already described, and some of them are just as large; it's likely that these six canoes were made on some of these islands. According to what we've learned, in these canoes, or pahies as they call them, these people sail from island to island across several hundred leagues, using the sun for navigation during the day and the moon and stars at night. Once this is confirmed, it will help us understand how the islands in these seas became populated; if the people of Ulietea have visited islands that are 200 or 300 leagues to the west, it's reasonable to assume that the inhabitants of those western islands may have traveled even farther west, allowing us to trace their journeys from island to island all the way to the East Indies.

Tupia tells us that during the months of November, December, and January Westerly winds, with rain, prevail; and as the inhabitants of the Islands know very well how to make the proper use of the winds, there will no difficulty arise in Trading or Sailing from Island to Island, even tho' they lie in an East and West direction.* (* This paragraph is from the Admiralty copy of Cook's Journal. This fact is now well known. The islands here described, the Society Islands of Cook, and now known as the Leeward Group of the Society Islands, were generally under the dominion of Tahiti. At the time of Cook's visit, the chief of Bolabola was supreme over most of the group, and their tie to Tahiti was but slight. They are all very beautiful and fertile. Within the last decade they have formally been recognised as belonging to France.)

Tupia tells us that during November, December, and January, strong westerly winds with rain are common. The people of the Islands have a great understanding of how to navigate these winds, so there will be no issues with trading or sailing between the Islands, even though they run east to west. (* This paragraph is from the Admiralty copy of Cook's Journal. This fact is now well known. The islands discussed here are the Society Islands of Cook, now known as the Leeward Group of the Society Islands, which were mostly under the control of Tahiti. At the time of Cook's visit, the chief of Bolabola was in charge of most of the group, and their connection to Tahiti was minimal. They are all very beautiful and fertile. In the last decade, they have officially been recognized as belonging to France.)

[Sail from Society Islands.]

Sail from the Society Islands.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES IN THE SOUTH SEAS.

REMARKABLE OCCURRENCES IN THE SOUTH SEAS.

Thursday, August 10th. P.M., Light Airs and Calm, remainder fresh breezes and Cloudy. At 6 p.m. the South end of Ulietea South-East 1/2 East, distant 4 Leagues; but I take my departure from the Harbour, saild from in Latitude 16 degrees 46 minutes South, and Longitude 151 degrees 27 minutes West. At 7 a.m. found the Variation to be 5 degrees 50 minutes East. Wind Easterly; course South 16 degrees West; distance 50 miles; Latitude observed 17 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 41 minutes West.

Thursday, August 10th. P.M., Light breezes and calm, with fresh breezes and cloudy skies. At 6 p.m., the south end of Ulietea was southeast 1/2 east, 4 leagues away; I left the harbor, departing from Latitude 16 degrees 46 minutes South and Longitude 151 degrees 27 minutes West. At 7 a.m., the variation was 5 degrees 50 minutes East. Wind was coming from the east; I was headed south 16 degrees west; the distance traveled was 50 miles; observed latitude was 17 degrees 34 minutes South, and longitude was 151 degrees 41 minutes West.

Friday, 11th. Fresh breezes and Clear weather. Wind East; course South 4 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 18 degrees 59 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 45 minutes West.

Friday, 11th. Fresh breezes and clear weather. Wind from the East; course South 4 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 18 degrees 59 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 45 minutes West.

Saturday, 12th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. Wind East, East by North; course South 3/4 East; distance 77 miles; latitude 20 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 36 minutes West.

Saturday, 12th. Light breezes and nice weather. Wind East, East by North; course South 3/4 East; distance 77 miles; latitude 20 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 36 minutes West.

Sunday, 13th. Moderate breezes and Clear weather. Variation 5 degrees 40 minutes East. Wind East by North; course South 16 degrees East; distance 96 miles; latitude 21 degrees 47 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 9 minutes West.

Sunday, 13th. Light breezes and clear skies. Variation 5 degrees 40 minutes East. Wind East by North; course South 16 degrees East; distance 96 miles; latitude 21 degrees 47 minutes South, longitude 151 degrees 9 minutes West.

Monday, 14th. Fresh breezes and fair weather. At 2 p.m. saw land bearing South-East, which Tupia calls the Island of Ohetiroa.* (* Rurutu, one of the Tubuai or Austral Group. They are now under French protectorate.) At 6 was within 2 or 3 Leagues of it, the Extreams bearing from South by East to South-East; shortned sail and stood off and on all night; at 6 a.m. made Sail and stood in for the Land and run to Leeward of the Island, keeping close in shore all the time, saw several of the Natives as we run along shore, but in no great numbers. At 9 hoisted out the Pinnace and sent Lieutenant Gore, Mr. Banks, and Tupia to Endeavour to land upon the Island, and to speak with the Natives, and to try if they could learn from them what lands lay to the Southward of us, and likewise to see if there was Anchorage in a Bay which appear'd to our View, not that I intended to Anchor or make any stay here. Wind North-North-East; latitude 22 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 150 degrees 55 minutes West; at noon, Ohetiroa East 2 leagues.

Monday, 14th. Fresh breezes and clear weather. At 2 p.m., we spotted land to the South-East, which Tupia calls the Island of Ohetiroa.* (*Rurutu, part of the Tubuai or Austral Group. They are currently under French protection.) By 6, we were within 2 or 3 leagues of it, with the farthest points bearing from South by East to South-East; we reduced our sail and anchored off and on all night. At 6 a.m., we set sail and headed for the land, passing to the leeward of the island while staying close to shore. We saw several natives as we moved along the coast, but not in large numbers. At 9, we launched the Pinnace and sent Lieutenant Gore, Mr. Banks, and Tupia to try to land on the island, speak with the natives, and find out what lands lay to the south, as well as check if there was anchorage in a bay that was visible to us. I didn’t plan to anchor or stay here. Wind was North-North-East; latitude 22 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 150 degrees 55 minutes West; at noon, Ohetiroa was 2 leagues to the east.

Tuesday, 15th. Fresh breezes and fair weather. At 2 p.m. the Pinnace return'd on board without landing, not but what it was practicable, but they did not think it Altogether safe with only one Boat, as it would have been attended with some danger on account of the Surf and Rocks upon the Shore. The Natives were Arm'd, and Shewd no Signs either of fear or Friendship. Some of them came off to the Boat in a Canoe, and had some Nails and Beads given them; but with these they were not Satisfied, thinking they had a right to everything in the Boat, and at last grew so Troublesome that in order to get clear of them our People were obliged to fire some Musquets, but with no intent to hurt any of them; however, it so hapned that one Man was Slightly wounded in the head. The firing had the desired effect, and they thought fit to retire. After this, as the Boat lay near the Shore, some of them waded off to her, and brought with them some Trifles which they parted with for small Nails, etc. They seem'd desirous that our people should land, but this was looked upon as a Piece of Policy in them to get the whole Boat's Crew in their power; however, this was not attempted, as I had given orders to run no Risk. The Bay they went into, which lies on the West side of the Island, had in it 25 fathoms Water, but the bottom was very foul and Rocky. We had now made the Circuit of the Island (which did not appear to the best advantage), and found that there was neither a Harbour or safe Anchorage about it, and therefore I thought the Landing upon it would be attended with no advantage either to ourselves or any future navigators; and from the Hostile and thievish disposition of the Natives it appear'd that we could have no friendly intercourse with them until they had felt the Smart of our fire Arms, a thing that would have been very unjustifiable in me at this Time; we therefore hoisted in the Boat, and made Sail to the Southward.

Tuesday, 15th. There were fresh breezes and nice weather. At 2 p.m., the Pinnace came back on board without landing. It was possible to land, but they didn’t think it was completely safe with only one boat, as it could have been risky due to the surf and rocks on the shore. The locals were armed and showed no signs of fear or friendship. Some of them came out to the boat in a canoe and received some nails and beads, but they were not satisfied, thinking they had a right to everything in the boat. Eventually, they became so troublesome that our people had to fire some muskets, though there was no intent to hurt anyone; however, one man was slightly wounded in the head. The gunfire had the desired effect, and they decided to retreat. After that, while the boat was near the shore, some of them waded out to it and brought some trinkets to trade for small nails, etc. They seemed eager for our people to land, but this was seen as a strategy to gain control over the whole crew; we did not attempt this, as I had given orders to take no risks. The bay they entered, located on the west side of the island, had 25 fathoms of water, but the bottom was very rough and rocky. We had now circled the island (which did not look its best) and found that there was neither a harbor nor safe anchorage around it. Therefore, I thought landing there would not benefit us or any future navigators; given the hostile and thieving nature of the locals, it seemed we could have no friendly interaction with them until they had felt the sting of our firearms, which would have been very unjustifiable for me at that time. We therefore hoisted the boat and set sail to the south.

[Of the Austral Group.]

[From the Austral Group.]

This Island is situated in the Latitude of 22 degrees 27 minutes South, and in the Longitude of 150 degrees 47 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich.* (* Latitude is correct. Longitude 151 degrees 20 minutes West.) It is 13 miles in Circuit, and tolerably high; it appears to be neither Populous nor fertile; its produce seem'd to be nearly the same as the other Islands we have touched at, and likewise the Stature, Colour, Habit, and Arms of the Natives, only that some of them wore Pieces of Cloth like broad belts, different both in Shape and Colour to anything of the kind we had seen before, and their Arms, and in general everything they had about them, much neater made, and shew'd great proofs of an ingenious fancy. Tupia says that their are several Islands laying at different directions from this--that is, from the South to the West and North-West--and that 3 days' sail to the North-East is an Island called Manua, that is Bird Island, and that it lies 4 days' sail from Ulietea, which is one day less than from Ulietea to Ohetiroa.* (* Tupia was right except with respect to Manua, as there is no island answering his description.) From this account I shall be able to find the Situation of Manua pretty well. Since we have left Ulietea Tupia hath been very desirous for us to steer to the Westward, and tells us if we will go that way we shall be with plenty of Islands: the most of them he himself hath been at, and from the discription he gives of two of them they must be those discover'd by Capt. Wallace, and by him called Boscawen and Keppel's Islands, and those do not lay less than 400 Leagues to the Westward of Ulietea. He says that they are 10 or 12 days in going thither, and 30 or more in coming Back, and that their Pahies--that is their large Proes--sails much faster than this Ship. All this I believe to be true, and therefore they may with Ease sail 40 Leagues a day or more.

This island is located at 22 degrees 27 minutes South latitude and 150 degrees 47 minutes West longitude from the Greenwich Meridian. (*Latitude is correct. Longitude is actually 151 degrees 20 minutes West.) It has a circumference of 13 miles and is relatively high; it seems neither populated nor fertile. The products appear to be similar to those on other islands we’ve visited, as do the appearance, skin tone, clothing, and weapons of the natives. However, some of them wore cloth pieces resembling wide belts, which were different in shape and color from anything we had seen before. Their weapons and everything they carried were made much more neatly and showed signs of clever design. Tupia mentions that there are several islands in various directions from here—specifically to the South, West, and Northwest—and that three days' sailing to the Northeast brings us to an island called Manua, or Bird Island, which is four days' sailing from Ulietea. This is one day less than the distance from Ulietea to Ohetiroa.* (*Tupia was mostly correct, except regarding Manua, as there is no island fitting his description.) Based on this information, I should be able to pinpoint the location of Manua fairly accurately. Since we left Ulietea, Tupia has been eager for us to head West, claiming that if we do, we’ll find plenty of islands. He has been to most of them himself, and from the descriptions of two, they must be the ones discovered by Captain Wallace, which he named Boscawen and Keppel's Islands, located at least 400 leagues West of Ulietea. He says that it takes 10 to 12 days to reach them and over 30 days to return, and that their Pahies—large canoes—move much faster than this ship. I believe all of this to be true, and so they can easily sail 40 leagues a day or more.

The farthest Island to the Southward that Tupia hath been at, or knows anything of, lies but 2 days' Sail from Ohetiroa, and is called Moutou,* (* Tubuai.) but he says that his father once told him that there was Islands to the Southward of it; but we Cannot find that he either knows or ever heard of a Continent or large Track of Land. I have no reason to doubt Tupia's information of these Islands, for when we left Ulietea and steer'd to the Southward he told us that if we would keep a little more to the East (which the wind would not permit us to do) we should see Manua, but as we then steer'd we should see Ohetiroa, which hapned accordingly. If we meet with the Islands to the Southward he speaks off, it's well, but if not, I shall spend no more time searching for them, being now fully resolv'd to stand directly to the Southward in search of a Continent. Wind Northerly; course South 1/2 East; distance 94 miles; latitude 24 degrees 1 minute South, longitude 150 degrees 37 minutes West; at noon, Ohetiroa North 1/2 West, 31 leagues; variation 6 degrees 7 minutes East.

The southernmost island that Tupia has visited or knows about is just a two-day sail from Ohetiroa, and it’s called Moutou. He mentioned that his father once told him there were islands further south, but we can't find that he knows or has ever heard of a continent or large landmass. I have no reason to doubt Tupia's knowledge of these islands, because when we left Ulietea and headed south, he said that if we could steer a bit more to the east (which the wind wouldn’t let us do), we would sight Manua, but as we were heading, we would see Ohetiroa, which happened as he said. If we come across the islands he talks about further south, that’s great, but if not, I won't spend any more time searching for them since I’m now fully determined to head directly south in search of a continent. Wind from the north; course South 1/2 East; distance 94 miles; latitude 24 degrees 1 minute South, longitude 150 degrees 37 minutes West; at noon, Ohetiroa North 1/2 West, 31 leagues; variation 6 degrees 7 minutes East.

NOTE. As we advanced to the Southward into Cold weather, and a troubled Sea, the Hogs we got at Ulietea began to die apace. They cannot endure the least cold, nor will they hardly eat anything but vegetables, so that they are not at all to be depended upon at Sea. The fowls also have a complaint general among them which affects their heads, so that they continue holding it down betwixt their Legs until they die; this at least was the fate of most of ours. This is necessary to be known to those who come such Voyages as these, least they place too much dependance on the live stock they get at the Islands.

NOTE. As we traveled south into colder weather and rough seas, the pigs we got in Ulietea started to die quickly. They can’t handle even a little cold, and they barely eat anything except vegetables, so they aren't reliable at sea. The chickens also have a widespread issue that affects their heads, causing them to keep their heads down between their legs until they die; this was the fate of most of ours. It’s important for those who undertake these journeys to know this, so they don’t rely too much on the livestock they get from the islands.

Wednesday, 16th. Fresh breezes and Cloudy the first part; in the night, Squally, with rain; remainder, moderate and fair weather. At 8 am, saw the Appearances of high land to the Eastward; bore up towards it, but at 10 we discover'd it to be only Clouds, at which we hauld our wind to the Southward. At Noon found the Ship by Observation 21 Miles to the Northward of the Log, which may in some measure be owing to a South-West swell we have had all the last 24 hours. Wind North by West, West, West by South; course South 15 degrees East; distance 62 miles; latitude 25 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 150 degrees 19 minutes West.

Wednesday, 16th. Fresh breezes and cloudy in the morning; at night, squally with rain; the rest of the time, moderate and clear weather. At 8 am, noticed signs of high land to the east; we headed toward it, but by 10 we realized it was just clouds, so we changed our course to the south. At noon, we found the ship's position to be 21 miles north of the log, which might partly be due to a southwest swell we’ve experienced for the last 24 hours. Wind from the north by west, west, and west by south; course south 15 degrees east; distance 62 miles; latitude 25 degrees 00 minutes south, longitude 150 degrees 19 minutes west.

Thursday, 17th. A Gentle breeze with some flying showers of rain. Had a large Swell from the South-West all this day, much larger than yesterday, and this must be the reason why the observ'd Latitude differ'd from the Log again to day 16 miles. Wind West by South to South-West by South; course South-South-East; distance 76 miles; latitude 26 degrees 10 minutes South, longitude 149 degrees 46 minutes West.

Thursday, 17th. A gentle breeze with occasional light rain showers. There was a significant swell from the South-West all day, much bigger than yesterday, which is likely why the recorded latitude was off from the log by 16 miles again today. Wind was from West by South to South-West by South; course was South-South-East; distance covered was 76 miles; latitude was 26 degrees 10 minutes South, longitude was 149 degrees 46 minutes West.

Friday, 18th. The first part Calm; remainder light breezes and Clear. Variation per Amplitude in the evening 8 degrees 8 minutes East; in the Morning 7 degrees 56 minutes East. Carpenters employed repairing the Boats. The South-West swell still Continues, but not so much as Yesterday, and the observed Latitude and Log agrees. Wind Calm, North; course South 18 degrees East; distance 38 miles; latitude 26 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude 149 degrees 42 minutes West.

Friday, 18th. The first part was calm; the rest had light breezes and clear skies. Variation by amplitude in the evening was 8 degrees 8 minutes East; in the morning, it was 7 degrees 56 minutes East. Carpenters were busy repairing the boats. The south-west swell is still present, but not as strong as yesterday, and the observed latitude and log agree. Wind was calm from the north; course was South 18 degrees East; distance covered was 38 miles; latitude was 26 degrees 48 minutes South, longitude was 149 degrees 42 minutes West.

Saturday, 19th. Little wind with much rain in the night, the South-West swell still Continues, from which I conclude that there is no land near us in that Quarter. Wind North-West; course South-East by South; distance 62 miles; latitude 27 degrees 40 minutes South; longitude 149 degrees 6 minutes West.

Saturday, 19th. There was little wind and a lot of rain during the night. The South-West swell is still ongoing, which makes me think there’s no land nearby in that direction. The wind is coming from the North-West; we’re heading South-East by South; we’ve traveled 62 miles; latitude 27 degrees 40 minutes South; longitude 149 degrees 6 minutes West.

Sunday, 20th. Little wind all this day. Saw a large Albetross. Wind North-West; course South-East by South; distance 57 miles; latitude 28 degrees 24 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 25 minutes West.

Sunday, 20th. There was very little wind all day. I spotted a large Albatross. The wind was coming from the Northwest; we were headed Southeast by South; we covered a distance of 57 miles; our latitude was 28 degrees 24 minutes South, and our longitude was 148 degrees 25 minutes West.

Monday, 21st. Fresh Gales and Hazey weather. Saw 2 Pintado Birds, the first I have seen this Voyage; they are larger than a Pidgeon and checquer'd black and white over their backs and wings, with white Bellies, Black heads, and the end of their Tails black.* (* Cape pigeons, Daption Capensis.) Wind North-North-West; course South by East; distance 80 miles; latitude 29 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 22 minutes West.

Monday, 21st. Fresh gales and hazy weather. Saw 2 Pintado birds, the first I’ve seen on this trip; they’re bigger than a pigeon, with a checkered black and white pattern on their backs and wings, white bellies, black heads, and black tips on their tails.* (* Cape pigeons, Daption Capensis.) Wind North-North-West; course South by East; distance 80 miles; latitude 29 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 22 minutes West.

[Society Islands to New Zealand.]

[Society Islands to NZ.]

Tuesday, 22nd. First part Strong Gales with much rain, Thunder, and Lightning; remainder moderate and fair weather. About Noon saw some rock weed, an Albetross, and some Smaller Sea Birds. Wind North by West, South-West by West; course South 14 degrees East; distance 81 miles; latitude 31 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 00 minutes West.

Tuesday, 22nd. First part Strong Winds with a lot of rain, Thunder, and Lightning; rest of the day moderate and clear weather. Around Noon, spotted some seaweed, an Albatross, and some smaller seabirds. Wind coming from North by West, South-West by West; heading South 14 degrees East; distance 81 miles; latitude 31 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 148 degrees 00 minutes West.

Wednesday, 23rd. Little wind for the most part, and pretty clear weather. In the night had some Showers of rain. Saw a Grampus, and several Pintado Birds. Wind South-West to West-South-West; course South-South-East; distance 68 miles; latitude 31 degrees 6 minutes South; longitude 147 degrees 29 minutes West.

Wednesday, 23rd. Mostly calm with pretty clear weather. Had some rain showers overnight. Saw a dolphin and several painted birds. Wind from the South-West to West-South-West; heading South-South-East; distance 68 miles; latitude 31 degrees 6 minutes South; longitude 147 degrees 29 minutes West.

Thursday, 24th. The first part light Airs and Calm; Middle, moderate breezes and Cloudy; latter part very squally with rain. A.M. Variation per Azimuth 7 degrees 18 minutes East. At Noon took in the Topsails and got down Topgallant yards. Saw a Water Spout in the North-West; it was about the breadth of a Rainbow, of a dark Colour, the Upper end of the Cloud from whence it came was about 8 degrees above the Horizon. Wind Variable; course South-South-East; distance 41 miles; latitude 32 degrees 44 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 10 minutes West.

Thursday, 24th. The morning had light winds and calm conditions; the middle of the day brought moderate breezes and clouds; the latter part of the day turned very stormy with rain. In the morning, the variation by azimuth was 7 degrees 18 minutes East. At noon, we took in the topsails and lowered the topgallant yards. We spotted a waterspout in the northwest; it was about the width of a rainbow and dark in color. The upper part of the cloud that was forming it was around 8 degrees above the horizon. The wind was variable; we were heading South-South-East; the distance covered was 41 miles; our latitude was 32 degrees 44 minutes South, and our longitude was 147 degrees 10 minutes West.

Friday, 25th. The first and middle part Strong Gales and Squally with rain, remainder moderate and Cloudy. P.M. Unbent the Maintopsail being Split and bent another; in the night lay too under the Foresail, and in the morning made sail under the Courses and Topsails with one reef only. Had a large Sea from the Southward, saw several Albetrosses, Pintado Birds, and Sheer Waters; some of the Albetrosses were small, such as we usually saw off Cape Horn; all these kinds of birds are generally seen at a great distance from land. Wind, Southerly; course North-West; distance 26 miles; latitude 32 degrees 26 minutes South; longitude 147 degrees 32 minutes West.

Friday, 25th. The first and middle part of the day had strong gales and squalls with rain; the rest was moderate and cloudy. In the afternoon, we took down the mainsail since it was torn and replaced it with another; at night, we anchored under the foresail, and in the morning, we set sail with the courses and topsails, using just one reef. There was a big sea coming from the south, and we saw several albatrosses, pintado birds, and shearwaters; some of the albatrosses were small, like those we usually spotted off Cape Horn; these types of birds are usually seen far from land. Wind was from the south; course was northwest; distance traveled was 26 miles; latitude was 32 degrees 26 minutes south; longitude was 147 degrees 32 minutes west.

Saturday, 26th. Moderate and cloudy weather, a Swell from the South-West. By observation of the Sun and Moon made this morning, the Longitude of the Ship at Noon is 147 degrees 18 minutes 40 seconds, which differs but 11 minutes from that given by the Log. Wind South-West; course South 6 degrees East; South distance 13 miles; latitude 32 degrees 39 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 30 minutes West.

Saturday, 26th. Mild and cloudy weather, with swells coming from the southwest. Based on my observations of the sun and moon this morning, the ship’s longitude at noon is 147 degrees 18 minutes 40 seconds, which is only 11 minutes off from what the log shows. Wind is from the southwest; heading is South 6 degrees East; we've traveled 13 miles south; latitude is 32 degrees 39 minutes south, longitude is 147 degrees 30 minutes west.

Sunday, 27th. First part little wind and Cloudy; latter part, fresh Gales and Clear weather. Variation per Azimuth 6 degrees 40 minutes East. Saw several Albetrosses, Pintado Birds and Sheer Waters. Wind West, North-North-West; course South 5 degrees East; distance 55 miles; latitude 33 degrees 34 minutes, longitude 147 degrees 25 minutes.

Sunday, 27th. The first part of the day had light wind and cloudy skies; the latter part brought strong gales and clear weather. Variation per azimuth was 6 degrees 40 minutes east. We saw several albatrosses, painted birds, and shearwaters. The wind was coming from the west, north-northwest; our course was south 5 degrees east; we covered a distance of 55 miles; latitude was 33 degrees 34 minutes, longitude was 147 degrees 25 minutes.

Monday, 28th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy, with rain on the Latter part. At 10 departed this Life Jno. Rearden,* (* John Reading.) Boatswain's Mate; his Death was occasioned by the Boatswain out of mere good Nature giving him part of a Bottle of Rum last night, which it is supposed he drank all at once. He was found to be very much in Liquor last night, but as this was no more than what was common with him when he could get any, no farther notice was taken of him than to put him to Bed, where this morning about 8 o'clock he was found Speechless and past recovery. Wind Northerly; course South; distance 110 miles; latitude 35 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 25 minutes West.

Monday, 28th. Fresh winds and cloudy, with rain later. At 10 AM, John Rearden,* (* John Reading.) Boatswain's Mate, passed away; his death was caused by the Boatswain, out of pure good nature, giving him part of a bottle of rum last night, which he apparently drank all at once. He was found to be quite drunk last night, but since this was typical for him when he had access to it, no further action was taken other than to put him to bed, where he was found this morning around 8 o'clock, speechless and beyond recovery. Wind was from the north; course south; distance 110 miles; latitude 35 degrees 34 minutes south, longitude 147 degrees 25 minutes west.

Tuesday, 29th. Fore and Middle parts fresh Gales and Dark, Hazey weather with some rain. At 5 a.m. saw a Comet in the North. Wind North-West to South-West; course South 1/4 East; distance 96 miles; latitude 37 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 21 minutes West.

Tuesday, 29th. The morning and early afternoon were breezy with dark, hazy weather and some rain. At 5 a.m., I spotted a comet in the north. The wind was blowing from the northwest to southwest; our course was south 1/4 east; we covered a distance of 96 miles; our latitude was 37 degrees 0 minutes south, and our longitude was 147 degrees 21 minutes west.

Wednesday, 30th. Fresh breeze and fair weather. At 1 a.m. saw the Comet a little above the Horizon in the East. It pass'd the Meridian about 1/2 past 4; the Tail of the Comet Subtended an Angle of 42 degrees. At 8 a.m. Variation per Azimuth 7 degrees 9 minutes East. Bent another suit of Sails. Saw a piece of Rock weed, Some Pintado birds and Sheer Waters and a Green bird something smaller than a Dove, but it was not near enough to distinguish whether it was a Sea or Land bird; it was only seen by one Person, and he probably was Mistaken in the Colour. A Swell from the South-West, Wind Westerly; course South 3/4 East; distance 81 miles; latitude 38 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 6 minutes West.

Wednesday, 30th. There was a fresh breeze and nice weather. At 1 a.m., I saw the Comet just above the horizon in the east. It passed the meridian at around 4:30 a.m.; the tail of the comet made an angle of 42 degrees. At 8 a.m., the variation by azimuth was 7 degrees 9 minutes east. I set up another set of sails. I spotted some rockweed, a few pintado birds, some sheerwaters, and a small green bird that was a bit smaller than a dove, but it was too far away to tell if it was a sea or land bird; only one person saw it, and he might have been mistaken about the color. There was a swell coming from the southwest, with the wind coming from the west; our course was south 3/4 east; we traveled 81 miles; our latitude was 38 degrees 20 minutes south, and our longitude was 147 degrees 6 minutes west.

Thursday, 31st. The first part a fresh breeze and cloudy. At 6 p.m. hauld the wind to the South-West and close reefd the Topsails. At 1 a.m. being very squally with rain, took in the Topsails and brought too under the Mainsail. At 6 made Sail under the Courses. Saw some seaweed, sounded, but had no ground at 65 fathoms of Line. Some Albetrosses, Sheer Waters, and a great many Pintado Birds about the Ship with some hundreds of Birds that were smaller than Pidgeons, their backs were grey, their Bellies white, and the ends of their Tails black, and have a blackish line along the upper parts of the wings from the Tip of one to the other. We saw birds very like those near Faulklands Islands on the Coast of Patagonia, only they had not the black streak along the wings; they fly low like sheer waters or mother Carys birds, and are perhaps of the same Tribe, for Distinction sake I shall call them Doves.* (* Probably petrels of the genus Prion.) Wind Westerly; course South 4 degrees 15 minutes East; distance 68 miles; latitude 39 degrees 28 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 0 minutes West.

Thursday, 31st. The day started with a fresh breeze and cloudy skies. At 6 p.m., the wind shifted to the Southwest, and we furled the Topsails. At 1 a.m., it became very squally with rain, so we took in the Topsails and lay to under the Mainsail. By 6 a.m., we set sail under the Courses. We spotted some seaweed and tried sounding but found no ground at 65 fathoms of line. There were some Albatrosses, Shearwaters, and many Pintado birds around the ship, along with hundreds of smaller birds resembling pigeons; they had grey backs, white bellies, and black-tipped tails, plus a blackish line along the upper parts of their wings from one tip to the other. We saw birds that looked very similar to those near the Falkland Islands off the coast of Patagonia, except they didn't have the black streak along the wings. They fly low like sheerwaters or Mother Carey's chickens, and might belong to the same family. For differentiation, I’ll refer to them as Doves.* (* Probably petrels of the genus Prion.) Wind from the West; course South 4 degrees 15 minutes East; distance covered 68 miles; latitude 39 degrees 28 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 0 minutes West.

[September 1769.]

[September 1769.]

Friday, September 1st. Very strong Gales and heavy Squalls with rain; at 6 p.m. brought too under the Main Sail. At 6 a.m. set the Foresail, a Great Sea from the Westward. The same sort of Birds about the Ship as Yesterday, but not in such great Numbers. Wind, Westerly; Course, South 29 degrees East; distance 50 miles; latitude 40 degrees 12 minutes South, longitude 146 degrees 29 minutes West.

Friday, September 1st. Very strong winds and heavy squalls with rain; at 6 p.m. we stopped under the mainsail. At 6 a.m. we set the foresail, with a big sea coming from the west. The same types of birds were around the ship as yesterday, but not in such large numbers. Wind was coming from the west; our course was south 29 degrees east; distance covered was 50 miles; latitude was 40 degrees 12 minutes south, longitude was 146 degrees 29 minutes west.

Saturday, 2nd. Very strong Gales, with heavy squalls of Wind, hail, and rain. At 4 p.m., being in the Latitude of 40 degrees 22 minutes South, and having not the least Visible signs of land, we wore, and brought too under the Foresail, and reef'd the Mainsail, and handed it. I did intend to have stood to the Southward if the winds had been Moderate, so long as they continued Westerly, notwithstanding we had no prospect of meeting with land, Rather than stand back to the Northward, on the same Track as we came, but as the weather was so very Tempestious I laid aside this design, and thought it more adviseable to stand to the Northward into better weather, least we should receive such Damage in our Sails and Rigging as might hinder the further Prosecutions of the Voyage.* (* This long excursion to the south is a fine instance of Cook's thoroughness and determination in exploration. The belief in a southern continent was strong amongst most geographers; but it rested on nothing more than the false idea that dry lands in the two hemispheres should balance one another. Cook himself did not share the general belief; and few others in his position would have struggled for 1500 miles out of his direct course into bad weather, simply to disprove an idea, when so much unexplored ocean lay before him to the westward, with a fair wind and fine weather.) Some Albetrosses, Pintado birds, and Doves about the Ship, and a Bird larger than a Duck, his plumage of a Dark Brown, with a Yellow beak. We saw of these Birds in our Passage to the Northward, after doubling Cape Horn. At Noon the weather was more moderate; set the Reefd Mainsail. A great Sea from the West-South-West. Wind West; Course North 54 degrees 30 minutes East; distance 46 miles; latitude 39 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 145 degrees 39 minutes West.

Saturday, 2nd. Very strong gales with heavy bursts of wind, hail, and rain. At 4 p.m., being at a latitude of 40 degrees 22 minutes South and seeing no visible signs of land, we changed course and secured under the foresail, reefed the mainsail, and then took it down. I had planned to head south if the winds were moderate, as long as they continued from the west, even though we had no chance of encountering land. I preferred this to retracing our steps back north on the same route we came, but since the weather was so stormy, I decided to abandon that plan and thought it wiser to head north into better weather, lest we suffer damage to our sails and rigging that could hinder the progress of our voyage.* (*This long detour to the south shows Cook's thoroughness and determination in exploration. The belief in a southern continent was strong among most geographers, but it was based on the mistaken idea that the landmasses in the two hemispheres should balance each other. Cook himself did not share this belief, and few others in his position would have traveled 1500 miles off course into bad weather just to disprove a theory when so much unexplored ocean lay ahead to the west with a favorable wind and good weather.) We spotted some albatrosses, pintado birds, and doves around the ship, along with a bird larger than a duck, which had dark brown feathers and a yellow beak. We saw these birds on our way north after rounding Cape Horn. At noon, the weather was calmer; we set the reefed mainsail. There was a big sea coming from the west-southwest. Wind from the west; course north 54 degrees 30 minutes east; distance 46 miles; latitude 39 degrees 45 minutes south, longitude 145 degrees 39 minutes west.

Sunday, 3rd. The fore and Middle parts fresh gales, with hard Squalls; Latter more moderate. At 5 a.m. loos'd the Reef out of the Mainsail, and set the Topsail double reef'd, and before noon had all the Reefs out. Wind Westerly; course North; distance 50 miles; latitude 38 degrees 54 minutes South, longitude 145 degrees 39 minutes West.

Sunday, 3rd. The front and middle parts had strong winds with heavy squalls; the latter was calmer. At 5 a.m., we took the reef out of the mainsail and set the topsail with double reefs, and by noon, we had all the reefs out. The wind was from the west; our course was north; we covered a distance of 50 miles; our latitude was 38 degrees 54 minutes south, and our longitude was 145 degrees 39 minutes west.

Monday, 4th. First and latter parts, little wind and Cloudy; in the night Calm. Very few Birds about the Ship. Wind Westerly; course North by East; distance 26 miles; latitude 38 degrees 29 minutes South, longitude 145 degrees 32 minutes West.

Monday, 4th. In the early and later parts of the day, there was a light wind and it was cloudy; at night it was calm. There were very few birds around the ship. The wind was coming from the west; we were heading North by East; we covered a distance of 26 miles; our latitude was 38 degrees 29 minutes South, and longitude was 145 degrees 32 minutes West.

Tuesday, 5th. Fresh breezes and Cloudy weather. At 2 p.m. saw a piece of rock Weed. Variation, per Azimuth 7 degrees 0 minutes East. Wind West to North-West; course North 32 West; distance 44 miles; latitude 37 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 146 degrees 2 minutes West.

Tuesday, 5th. Fresh breezes and cloudy weather. At 2 p.m. saw a piece of rockweed. Variation, by azimuth, 7 degrees 0 minutes East. Wind from West to Northwest; course North 32 West; distance 44 miles; latitude 37 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 146 degrees 2 minutes West.

Wednesday, 6th. Fresh Gales and Squally, with rain. At Noon saw a Bird which was all white, except the Tip of each Wing; it was nearly as big as an Albetross. We saw 2 of these Birds in Latitude 19 degrees before we Arrived at George's Island. Wind Westerly; course South 87 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 70 miles; latitude 37 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 30 West.

Wednesday, 6th. Fresh gales and squally weather, with rain. At noon, we spotted a bird that was all white except for the tips of its wings; it was nearly the size of an albatross. We saw two of these birds at a latitude of 19 degrees before we reached George's Island. The wind was coming from the west; our course was South 87 degrees 30 minutes West; we traveled a distance of 70 miles; latitude 37 degrees 49 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 30 West.

Thursday, 7th. Fresh Gales and hard squalls, with rain. At 3 p.m. saw something upon the Water, which must either have been a Billet of Wood or a Seal. At Noon a hard gale and Squally, which obliged us to take in the Topsails. Wind Westerly; course South 80 degrees West; distance 15 miles; latitude 37 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 49 minutes West.

Thursday, 7th. Strong winds and intense squalls, with rain. At 3 p.m. spotted something on the water, which could have been a piece of wood or a seal. At noon, there was a strong gale and squally weather, which forced us to take in the topsails. Wind coming from the west; course set at South 80 degrees West; distance traveled 15 miles; latitude 37 degrees 52 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 49 minutes West.

Friday, 8th. P.M. very strong gales and Squally. A.M. more moderate; set the Topsails. At Noon the Observed Latitude was 13 Miles to the North of the Log. This I take to be owing to the great Sea we have had constantly of Late from the South-West. Wind Westerly; course North 1/4 East; distance 76 miles; latitude 36 degrees 36 minutes South, longitude 147 degrees 40 minutes West.

Friday, 8th. PM: very strong winds and squalls. AM: calmer; we set the topsails. At noon, the observed latitude was 13 miles north of the log. I believe this is due to the large seas we've been encountering lately coming from the southwest. Wind from the west; course north 1/4 east; distance 76 miles; latitude 36 degrees 36 minutes south, longitude 147 degrees 40 minutes west.

Saturday, 9th. Moderate breezes and dark, cloudy weather, sometimes Hazey, with Drizling Rain. Wind South-East; course North 77 degrees West; distance 76 miles; latitude 36 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 149 degrees 12 minutes West.

Saturday, 9th. Moderate breezes and dark, cloudy weather, sometimes hazy, with drizzling rain. Wind from the Southeast; course North 77 degrees West; distance 76 miles; latitude 36 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 149 degrees 12 minutes West.

Sunday, 10th. Fresh breezes and cloudy. At 9 a.m. we thought the Colour of the Sea was paler than Usual, which occasioned us to sound, but had no ground with 100 fathoms. Wind South-West, West-South-West; course North 52 degrees West; distance 97 miles; latitude 35 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 150 degrees 46 minutes West.

Sunday, 10th. There were fresh breezes and clouds. At 9 a.m., we noticed that the color of the sea seemed lighter than usual, so we checked the depth but found none with 100 fathoms. The wind was coming from the South-West, West-South-West; our course was North 52 degrees West; we traveled a distance of 97 miles; our latitude was 35 degrees 19 minutes South, and our longitude was 150 degrees 46 minutes West.

Monday, 11th. Fresh breezes, and for the most part thick, hazey weather, with rain. Wind South-West; course North 43 degrees West; distance 87 miles; latitude 34 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 152 degrees 00 minutes West.

Monday, 11th. Fresh breezes, mostly thick and hazy weather, with rain. Wind from the South-West; course North 43 degrees West; distance 87 miles; latitude 34 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 152 degrees 00 minutes West.

Tuesday, 12th. Fresh breezes and cloudy; a swell from the South-South-West. Some Albetrosses and Pintado Birds about the Ship. Wind Westerly; course North 30 degrees West; distance 73 miles; latitude 33 degrees 12 minutes South, longitude 152 degrees 44 minutes West.

Tuesday, 12th. Fresh winds and cloudy; a swell coming from the South-South-West. Some Albatrosses and Pintado Birds around the ship. Wind from the west; course North 30 degrees West; distance 73 miles; latitude 33 degrees 12 minutes South, longitude 152 degrees 44 minutes West.

Wednesday, 13th. Gentle breezes, with some flying Showers. At 6 p.m. Variation per Azimuth, 8 degrees 8 minutes East. Note, while we was between the Latitude of 37 and 40 degrees we had constantly blowing Tempestious weather, but since we have been to the Northward of 37 degrees, the weather hath been very moderate. Wind South-West and West-South-West; course North-North-West; distance 74 miles; latitude 32 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 153 degrees 16 minutes West.

Wednesday, 13th. Light breezes, with some scattered showers. At 6 p.m. Variation per Azimuth, 8 degrees 8 minutes East. Note, while we were between the latitudes of 37 and 40 degrees, we experienced consistently stormy weather, but since moving north of 37 degrees, the weather has been much milder. Wind from the South-West and West-South-West; course North-North-West; distance 74 miles; latitude 32 degrees 3 minutes South, longitude 153 degrees 16 minutes West.

Thursday, 14th. Gentle breezes, and sometimes Calm. A Swell from the South-South-West. Wind Variable; course South 86 degrees West; distance 33 miles; latitude 32 degrees 5 minutes South, longitude 153 degrees 54 minutes West.

Thursday, 14th. Gentle breezes, and sometimes calm. A swell from the south-southwest. Wind is variable; course south 86 degrees west; distance 33 miles; latitude 32 degrees 5 minutes south, longitude 153 degrees 54 minutes west.

Friday, 15th. First part, moderate and Cloudy, remainder Strong Gales and Squally. Several Albetrosses, Pintado Birds, and Sheer Waters about the Ship; some of the Albetrosses were all White. Wind North-East to South-East; course South 77 West; distance 139 miles; latitude 32 degrees 36 minutes South, longitude 156 degrees 34 minutes West.

Friday, 15th. First part was moderate and cloudy, then strong gales and squalls. Several albatrosses, painted birds, and shearwaters were around the ship; some of the albatrosses were completely white. Wind from the northeast to southeast; course was south 77 west; distance 139 miles; latitude 32 degrees 36 minutes south, longitude 156 degrees 34 minutes west.

Saturday, 16th. First part very strong Gales and Squally; remainder more moderate, with a large Swell from the Southward. Wind South-South-East, South, West-South-West; course North 60 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 31 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 158 degrees 16 minutes West.

Saturday, 16th. The first part of the day had very strong gales and squalls; the rest was more moderate, with a large swell coming from the south. Wind direction was South-South-East, South, and West-South-West; we were on a course of North 60 degrees West; covered a distance of 100 miles; latitude 31 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 158 degrees 16 minutes West.

Sunday, 17th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. Wind South-West; course North 25 West; distance 100 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 6 minutes West.

Sunday, 17th. Strong winds and cloudy. Wind from the South-West; heading North 25 West; distance 100 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 6 minutes West.

Monday, 18th. Moderate Gales and Cloudy, with a Swell from the Southward. Wind Westerly; course North by West 1/2 West; distance 78 miles; latitude 29 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 32 minutes West.

Monday, 18th. Moderate winds and cloudy, with swells coming from the south. Wind from the west; course North by West 1/2 West; distance 78 miles; latitude 29 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 32 minutes West.

Tuesday, 19th. Variable; light Airs and Calm. Variation per Amplitude at sunset, 8 degrees 36 minutes East; per Azimuth in the morning, 8 degrees 29 minutes East; mean, 8 degrees 32 1/2 minutes East. A large hollow swell from the Southward. Wind Variable; course East; distance 6 miles; latitude 29 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 25 minutes West.

Tuesday, 19th. Changing; light breezes and stillness. Variation by Amplitude at sunset, 8 degrees 36 minutes East; by Azimuth in the morning, 8 degrees 29 minutes East; average, 8 degrees 32 1/2 minutes East. A large, rolling swell coming from the South. Wind changing; heading East; distance traveled 6 miles; latitude 29 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 25 minutes West.

Wednesday, 20th. Light Airs and Calm. Wind Variable; course South-West by South; distance 20 miles; latitude 29 degrees 20 minutes South, longitude 159 degrees 47 minutes West.

Wednesday, 20th. Light breezes and calm. Wind varied; course southwest by south; distance 20 miles; latitude 29 degrees 20 minutes south, longitude 159 degrees 47 minutes west.

Thursday, 21st. Most part Gentle breezes and clear weather. Wind South Easterly; course South 50 degrees West; distance 62 miles; latitude 30 degrees 00 minutes South, longitude 160 degrees 42 minutes West.

Thursday, 21st. Mostly gentle breezes and clear skies. Wind from the southeast; course south 50 degrees west; distance 62 miles; latitude 30 degrees 00 minutes south, longitude 160 degrees 42 minutes west.

Friday, 22nd. Fresh breezes and Cloudy. The Southerly swell still Continues, from which I conjecture that there is no land near in that Direction. Wind South-East; course South 34 West; distance 81 miles; latitude 31 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude 161 degrees 35 minutes West.

Friday, 22nd. Fresh breezes and cloudy. The southerly swell is still ongoing, which makes me think there's no land nearby in that direction. Wind is coming from the southeast; course is south 34 west; distance traveled is 81 miles; latitude 31 degrees 7 minutes south, longitude 161 degrees 35 minutes west.

Saturday, 23rd. Gentle breezes and Cloudy weather. Wind South-East; course South-West by South; distance 62 miles; latitude 31 degrees 59 minutes South, longitude 162 degrees 44 minutes West.

Saturday, 23rd. Light breezes and cloudy weather. Wind from the South-East; course South-West by South; distance 62 miles; latitude 31 degrees 59 minutes South, longitude 162 degrees 44 minutes West.

Sunday, 24th. Moderate breezes and Cloudy. At Noon saw some sea-Weed. The Southerly swell is now quite gone down. Wind South-East to North-East; course South 35 West; distance 97 miles; latitude 33 degrees 18 minutes South, longitude 162 degrees 51 minutes West.

Sunday, 24th. Moderate breezes and cloudy. At noon, we spotted some seaweed. The southerly swell has calmed down quite a bit. Wind is from the southeast to northeast; course is south 35 west; distance is 97 miles; latitude is 33 degrees 18 minutes south, longitude is 162 degrees 51 minutes west.

Monday, 25th. Ditto weather. At 1 p.m. passed by a Piece of Wood, about 3 feet long and 7 or 8 Inches thick. Variation at 6 p.m. per Azimuth, 10 degrees 48 minutes East. A.M., got up all the Boatswain's Stores, to take an account of them. Wind North-East; course South 43 1/2 West; distance 103 miles; latitude 34 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 165 degrees 10 minutes West.

Monday, 25th. Same weather. At 1 p.m., we passed a piece of wood about 3 feet long and 7 or 8 inches thick. Variation at 6 p.m. by Azimuth was 10 degrees 48 minutes East. In the morning, we got all the Boatswain's supplies to take an inventory. Wind from the North-East; heading South 43 1/2 West; distance covered 103 miles; latitude 34 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 165 degrees 10 minutes West.

Tuesday, 26th. Fresh breezes and fair weather. Wind North-North-East; course South-West; distance 136 miles; latitude 36 degrees 9 minutes South, longitude 167 degrees 14 minutes West.

Tuesday, 26th. Fresh breezes and nice weather. Wind North-North-East; course South-West; distance 136 miles; latitude 36 degrees 9 minutes South, longitude 167 degrees 14 minutes West.

Wednesday, 27th. Very strong Gales and hazey, with rain the First and Middle part; Latter, moderate and clear weather. In the evening took in the Topsails and Mainsail, and lay too with her head to the Westward under the Foresail. During the night, at 4 a.m., made Sail. Saw several Pieces of Sea Weed at different times this 24 Hours. Wind North by East, Westerly; course South 28 West; distance 95 miles; latitude 37 degrees 33 minutes South, longitude 168 degrees 10 minutes West.

Wednesday, 27th. Very strong gales and hazy, with rain in the first and middle parts; later, moderate and clear weather. In the evening, we took in the topsails and mainsail and drifted with our head to the west under the foresail. During the night, at 4 a.m., we set sail again. Saw several pieces of seaweed at different times during the last 24 hours. Wind from the north by east, westerly; course south 28 west; distance 95 miles; latitude 37 degrees 33 minutes south, longitude 168 degrees 10 minutes west.

Thursday, 28th. First and Middle parts, fresh gales and Cloudy; Latter part, very strong Gales and Squally. At 4 p.m. saw a Seal aSleep upon the Water, and some Weed. A.M. saw several bunches of Sea Weed and a few Albetrosses and Sheer Waters. Wind Westerly; course South 21 degrees West; distance 92 miles; latitude 38 degrees 59 minutes South, longitude 169 degrees 5 minutes West.

Thursday, 28th. In the morning and middle of the day, there were fresh winds and cloudy skies; in the afternoon, very strong winds and squally conditions. At 4 p.m., I saw a seal sleeping on the water, along with some seaweed. In the morning, I spotted several clusters of seaweed and a few albatrosses and shearwaters. The wind was coming from the west; we were headed south 21 degrees west; the distance covered was 92 miles; latitude was 38 degrees 59 minutes south, longitude 169 degrees 5 minutes west.

Friday, 29th. The first part strong Gales and Squally; remainder a fresh breeze and settled weather. At 1 p.m. was obliged to take in the Topsails, but set them again at 4. At 11 a.m. saw a Bird something like a Snipe, only it had a short bill; it had the appearance of a land bird. Several Albetrosses, Pintado birds, and Sheer Waters about the Ship, and a Number of Doves; of these we have seen more or less ever since the 31st of last Month, the day we first saw them. Wind South-West; course North 59 degrees West; distance 60 miles; latitude 38 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 170 degrees 14 minutes West.

Friday, 29th. The first part of the day had strong gales and squalls; the rest of the day was a fresh breeze with clear weather. At 1 p.m., I had to take in the topsails, but set them again at 4. At 11 a.m., I spotted a bird that looked something like a snipe, but it had a short bill; it seemed to be a land bird. There were several albatrosses, painted birds, and shearwaters around the ship, along with a number of doves; we've seen more or less of them since the 31st of last month, the day we first noticed them. Wind was coming from the southwest; our course was North 59 degrees West; we traveled 60 miles; latitude 38 degrees 30 minutes South, longitude 170 degrees 14 minutes West.

Saturday, 30th. Moderate breezes and Settled weather. Saw a dark brown bird as big as a Raven; it is a Sea Fowl, and are seen in great Numbers about the Faulkland Islands, as I am told. We likewise saw several pieces of Sea Weed. Wind South Easterly; course North 87 1/2 West; distance 90 miles; latitude 38 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 172 degrees 20 minutes West.

Saturday, 30th. Moderate breezes and steady weather. I spotted a dark brown bird the size of a raven; it’s a sea bird and is frequently seen in large numbers around the Falkland Islands, according to what I've heard. We also came across several pieces of seaweed. Wind was blowing from the southeast; heading was North 87 1/2 West; distance covered was 90 miles; latitude 38 degrees 26 minutes South, longitude 172 degrees 20 minutes West.

[October 1769.]

[October 1769.]

Sunday, October 1st. Little Wind in the day time and Calm in the Night. At 8 a.m. sounded: no ground with 120 fathoms of line. Saw an immence number of Birds, the most of them were Doves; saw likewise a Seal aSleep upon the Water, which we at first took for a Crooked billet. These creatures, as they lay upon the Water, hold their fins up in a very odd manner, and very different to any I have seen before; we generally reckon that seals never go out of Soundings or far from Land, but the few we have seen in this Sea is certainly an exception to that rule. However, one would think that we were not far from some land, from the Pieces of Rock weed we see daily floating upon the Water. To-day we took up a small Piece of Stick, but to all appearance it had been a long time at Sea. The observ'd Latitude is considerable to the Northward of that given by the Log, in so much that I think there must be some Current seting from the Southward. Wind South to West by North; course North 16 degrees West; distance 43 miles; latitude 37 degrees 45 minutes South, longitude 172 degrees 36 minutes West.

Sunday, October 1st. Light wind during the day and calm at night. At 8 a.m., soundings showed no bottom with 120 fathoms of line. We saw a huge number of birds, most of them doves; we also saw a seal sleeping on the water, which we initially mistook for a crooked log. These creatures, while resting on the water, hold their fins up in a very strange way, unlike anything I’ve seen before. We usually think that seals stay close to land or in shallower waters, but the few we’ve spotted in this sea definitely break that rule. Still, one might think we're not far from land considering the pieces of seaweed we see floating every day. Today we picked up a small stick, but it looked like it had been adrift at sea for a long time. The observed latitude is quite a bit further north than what the log shows, suggesting there’s likely a current coming from the south. Wind from south to west by north; course north 16 degrees west; distance 43 miles; latitude 37 degrees 45 minutes south, longitude 172 degrees 36 minutes west.

Monday, 2nd. Little wind. At 3 p.m. hoisted out a Boat to try the Current, but found none. Saw several Grampusses. A.M. had a Boat in the Water, and Mr. Banks shott an Albetross which measured 10 feet 8 Inches from the tip of Wing to the other. He likewise shott 2 birds that were very much like Ducks, excepting their head and Bill; their plumage were dark brown. We first saw some of these birds in the Latitude of 40 degrees South, after our first coming into those Seas. Wind West-South-West, South-West; course North-North-West; distance 35 miles; latitude 37 degrees 10 minutes South, longitude 172 degrees 54 minutes West.

Monday, 2nd. There was little wind. At 3 p.m., we launched a boat to check the current, but didn’t find any. We saw several grampuses. In the morning, we had a boat in the water, and Mr. Banks shot an albatross that measured 10 feet 8 inches from wing tip to wing tip. He also shot 2 birds that looked a lot like ducks, except for their heads and bills; their feathers were dark brown. We first spotted some of these birds at a latitude of 40 degrees south after we entered those seas. Wind was from the west-southwest and southwest; our course was north-northwest; we traveled 35 miles; latitude 37 degrees 10 minutes south, longitude 172 degrees 54 minutes west.

Tuesday, 3rd. Little wind and sometimes Calm. A.M. Variation per Azimuth 13 degrees 22 minutes East. Saw some fish like a Skip Jack, and a small sort that appeared very Transparent. Took up a very small piece of wood with Barnacles upon it, a proof that it hath been some time at Sea. Some very large Albetrosses about the Ship and other birds. The observed Latitude is 10 Miles to the Northward of that given by the Log, and it was the same Yesterday, which I think is a Proof that there must be a Current setting to the Northward, notwithstanding we did not find any when we try'd it. Wind Southerly; course North 60 degrees West; distance 28 miles; latitude 36 degrees 56 minutes South, longitude 173 degrees 27 minutes West.

Tuesday, 3rd. There was little wind and sometimes it was calm. A.M. The variation by Azimuth was 13 degrees 22 minutes East. We saw some fish similar to a Skipjack, and a small type that looked very transparent. I picked up a tiny piece of wood covered in barnacles, indicating it had been at sea for some time. There were some very large albatrosses around the ship and other birds. The latitude we observed is 10 miles north of what the log indicated, and it was the same yesterday, which I think shows there must be a current moving north, even though we didn’t find any when we checked. The wind was from the south; we were heading North 60 degrees West; we covered a distance of 28 miles; our latitude is 36 degrees 56 minutes South, longitude 173 degrees 27 minutes West.

Wednesday, 4th. Gentle breezes and Cloudy weather. P.M. Variation per Azimuth 12 degrees 48 minutes East; sounded twice, but found no ground, with 120 fathoms of line. Saw some rock weed, but not in such plenty as of late. Wind South-East; course South 52 1/2 West; distance 86 miles; latitude 37 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 175 degrees 00 minutes West.

Wednesday, 4th. Light breezes and cloudy weather. Afternoon. Variation by azimuth 12 degrees 48 minutes East; sounded twice but found no bottom with 120 fathoms of line. Saw some rockweed, but not as much as before. Wind from the Southeast; course South 52 1/2 West; distance 86 miles; latitude 37 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 175 degrees 00 minutes West.

Thursday, 5th. Light, gentle breezes and Clear weather. P.M. saw one of the same sort of Birds as we saw last Saturday. These birds are of a dark brown or Chocolate Colour, with some white feathers under their wings, and are as big as Ravens. Mr. Gore says that they are in great plenty at Port Egmont in Faulklands Islands, and for that reason calls them Port Egmont Hens. Saw a great many Porpoisses, large and Small; the small ones had white bellies and Noses. A.M. saw 2 Port Egmont Hens, a Seal, some sea Weed, and a Piece of wood with Barnacles upon it. Wind South-East to East-North-East; course South 49 1/2 West; distance 63 miles; latitude 38 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 176 degrees 3 minutes West.

Thursday, 5th. Light, gentle breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, I spotted one of the same type of birds we saw last Saturday. These birds are dark brown or chocolate in color, with some white feathers under their wings, and are as big as ravens. Mr. Gore says they’re abundant at Port Egmont in the Falkland Islands, so he calls them Port Egmont Hens. I saw a lot of porpoises, both large and small; the small ones had white bellies and noses. In the morning, I saw 2 Port Egmont Hens, a seal, some seaweed, and a piece of wood covered in barnacles. The wind was from the southeast to east-northeast; the course was south 49 1/2 west; distance 63 miles; latitude 38 degrees 23 minutes south, longitude 176 degrees 3 minutes west.

Friday, 6th. Little wind, and fine pleasant weather. Saw some Seals, sea weed, and Port Egmont Hens. P.M. Variation per Azimuth 12 degrees 50 minutes East. Per Amplitude 12 degrees 40 minutes. A.M. per Azimuth 14 degrees 2 minutes East; the difference is 1 degree 3 minutes, and the Ship has only gone 9 Leagues in the Time. The Colour of the water appears to be paler than common, and hath been so for some days past; this makes us sound frequently, but can find no ground with 180 fathoms of Line. Wind East-North-East; course South-West; distance 62 miles; latitude 39 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 177 degrees 2 minutes West.

Friday, 6th. There was little wind and the weather was nice and pleasant. We saw some seals, seaweed, and Port Egmont Hens. This afternoon, the variation by azimuth was 12 degrees 50 minutes East. By amplitude, it was 12 degrees 40 minutes. This morning, by azimuth, it was 14 degrees 2 minutes East; the difference is 1 degree 3 minutes, and the ship has only traveled 9 leagues in that time. The water looks lighter than usual and has been like this for a few days; this causes us to check the depth often, but we can't find any ground with 180 fathoms of line. The wind was blowing from the East-North-East; our course was South-West; we covered a distance of 62 miles; our latitude is 39 degrees 11 minutes South, and our longitude is 177 degrees 2 minutes West.

[Make New Zealand.]

[Create New Zealand.]

Saturday, 7th. Gentle breezes and settled weather. At 2 p.m. saw land* (* The North island of New Zealand.) from the Masthead bearing West by North, which we stood directly for, and could but just see it of the Deck at sunset. Variation per Azimuth and Amplitude 15 degrees 4 1/2 minutes East; by observation of the Sun and Moon made this afternoon the Longitude of the Ship is 180 degrees 55 minutes West, by the mean of these and Subsequent observations the Error of the Ship's account in Longitude from George's Island is 3 degrees 16 minutes; that is, so much to the Westward of the Longitude resulting from the Log, which is what is inserted in the Columns. At Midnight brought too and sounded, but had no ground with 170 fathoms. At daylight made sail in for the Land, at Noon it bore from South-West to North-West by North, distant 8 Leagues. Latitude observed 38 degrees 57 minutes South; Wind North-East, South-East, Variable; course South 70 degrees West; distance 41 miles; latitude 38 degrees 57 minutes observed South; longitude 177 degrees 54 minutes West.

Saturday, 7th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. At 2 p.m., we spotted land* (*The North Island of New Zealand.) from the masthead, bearing West by North, which we headed straight for and could just see from the deck at sunset. The variation per azimuth and amplitude was 15 degrees 4.5 minutes East. By observing the Sun and Moon this afternoon, the ship's longitude is 180 degrees 55 minutes West. Based on these and subsequent observations, the error in the ship's longitude from George's Island is 3 degrees 16 minutes, meaning we are that much to the west of the longitude recorded in the log. At midnight, we brought up and measured the depth, but found no bottom with 170 fathoms. At daylight, we set sail toward the land; at noon, it was located from South-West to North-West by North, 8 leagues away. Latitude recorded was 38 degrees 57 minutes South; wind was North-East, South-East, variable; course was South 70 degrees West; distance covered was 41 miles; latitude observed was 38 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 177 degrees 54 minutes West.

Sunday, 8th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. At 5 p.m., seeing the opening of a Bay that appear'd to run pretty far inland, hauld our wind and stood in for it; but as soon as night came on we keept plying on and off until day light, when we found ourselves to leeward of the Bay, the wind being at North. By Noon we fetch'd in with the South-West point, but not being able to weather it we tacked and stood off. We saw in the Bay several Canoes, People upon the Shore, and some houses in the Country. The land on the Sea Coast is high, with Steep Cliffs; and back inland are very high Mountains. The face of the Country is of a hilly surface, and appears to be cloathed with wood and Verdure. Wind between the East-North-East and North.

Sunday, 8th. Light breezes and clear skies. At 5 p.m., noticing an opening in a bay that seemed to extend quite far inland, we changed our course to head towards it; but as soon as night fell, we continued sailing back and forth until dawn, when we realized we were downwind of the bay, with the wind coming from the north. By noon, we approached the southwest point, but since we couldn't get around it, we turned around and sailed away. In the bay, we spotted several canoes, people on the shore, and some houses in the area. The coastline is steep and high, and further inland are very tall mountains. The landscape is hilly and appears lush with trees and greenery. The wind is coming from between the east-northeast and north.


CHAPTER 5. EXPLORATION OF NORTH ISLAND OF NEW ZEALAND.

[October 1769. At Poverty Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[October 1769. At Poverty Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

MONDAY, 9th October. Gentle breezes and Clear Weather. P.M. stood into the Bay and Anchored on the North-East side before the Entrance of a small River,* (* Tauranga nui. The township of Gisborne is now situated on its eastern bank.) in 10 fathoms, a fine sandy bottom. The North-East point of the Bay bore East by South 1/2 South, and the South-West point South, distance from the Shore half a League. After this I went ashore with a Party of men in the Pinnace and yawl accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We landed abreast of the Ship and on the East side of the River just mentioned; but seeing some of the Natives on the other side of the River of whom I was desirous of speaking with, and finding that we could not ford the River, I order'd the yawl in to carry us over, and the pinnace to lay at the Entrance. In the mean time the Indians made off. However we went as far as their Hutts which lay about 2 or 300 Yards from the water side, leaving 4 boys to take care of the Yawl, which we had no sooner left than 4 Men came out of the woods on the other side the River, and would certainly have cut her off had not the People in the Pinnace discover'd them and called to her to drop down the Stream, which they did, being closely persued by the Indians. The coxswain of the Pinnace, who had the charge of the Boats, seeing this, fir'd 2 Musquets over their Heads; the first made them stop and Look round them, but the 2nd they took no notice of; upon which a third was fir'd and kill'd one of them upon the Spot just as he was going to dart his spear at the Boat. At this the other 3 stood motionless for a Minute or two, seemingly quite surprised; wondering, no doubt, what it was that had thus kill'd their Comrade; but as soon as they recovered themselves they made off, dragging the Dead body a little way and then left it. Upon our hearing the report of the Musquets we immediately repair'd to the Boats, and after viewing the Dead body we return'd on board. In the morning, seeing a number of the Natives at the same place where we saw them last night, I went on shore with the Boats, mann'd and arm'd, and landed on the opposite side of the river. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself only landed at first, and went to the side of the river, the natives being got together on the opposite side. We called to them in the George's Island Language, but they answer'd us by flourishing their weapons over their heads and dancing, as we suppos'd, the War Dance; upon this we retir'd until the Marines were landed, which I order'd to be drawn up about 200 yards behind us. We went again to the river side, having Tupia, Mr. Green, and Dr. Monkhouse along with us. Tupia spoke to them in his own Language, and it was an agreeable surprize to us to find that they perfectly understood him. After some little conversation had passed one of them swam over to us, and after him 20 or 30 more; these last brought their Arms, which the first man did not. We made them every one presents, but this did not satisfy them; they wanted everything we had about us, particularly our Arms, and made several attempts to snatch them out of our hands. Tupia told us several times, as soon as they came over, to take care of ourselves for they were not our friends; and this we very soon found, for one of them snatched Mr. Green's hanger from him and would not give it up; this encouraged the rest to be more insolent, and seeing others coming over to join them, I order'd the man who had taken the Hanger to be fir'd at, which was accordingly done, and wounded in such a manner that he died soon after. Upon the first fire, which was only 2 Musquets, the others retir'd to a Rock which lay nearly in the middle of the River; but on seeing the man fall they return'd, probably to carry him off or his Arms, the last of which they accomplished, and this we could not prevent unless we had run our Bayonets into them, for upon their returning from off the Rock, we had discharged off our Peices, which were loaded with small shott, and wounded 3 more; but these got over the River and were carried off by the others, who now thought proper to retire. Finding nothing was to be done with the People on this side, and the water in the river being salt, I embarked with an intent to row round the head of the Bay in search of fresh water, and if possible to surprise some of the Natives and to take them on board, and by good Treatment and Presents endeavour to gain their friendship with this view.

MONDAY, 9th October. Gentle breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, we moved into the bay and anchored on the northeast side before the entrance of a small river,* (*Tauranga nui. The town of Gisborne is now located on its eastern bank.) in 10 fathoms of fine sandy bottom. The northeast point of the bay was at East by South 1/2 South, and the southwest point was due South, about half a league from the shore. After this, I went ashore with a party of men in the pinnace and yawl, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We landed near the ship on the east side of the river mentioned; but seeing some of the natives on the other side, whom I wanted to speak with, and realizing we couldn't cross the river on foot, I ordered the yawl to take us over while the pinnace stayed at the entrance. Meanwhile, the natives fled. We walked to their huts, which were about 200 to 300 yards from the water, leaving four boys to watch the yawl. As soon as we left, four men emerged from the woods on the other side of the river and would have certainly cut us off if the crew in the pinnace hadn't spotted them and called out to the yawl to move downstream, which they did, closely pursued by the natives. The coxswain of the pinnace, responsible for the boats, fired two muskets over their heads; the first shot made them stop and look around, but they ignored the second one. When a third shot was fired, it hit one of them just as he was about to throw his spear at the boat. The other three stood frozen for a minute or two, seemingly shocked, probably wondering what had just killed their comrade. But as soon as they gathered themselves, they took off, dragging the dead body a short distance before leaving it. Upon hearing the muskets, we immediately returned to the boats, and after looking at the dead body, we went back on board. In the morning, seeing a group of natives at the same spot where we saw them the previous night, I went ashore with the boats, manned and armed, landing on the opposite side of the river. At first, only Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I disembarked and approached the river's edge, while the natives gathered on the other side. We called to them in the George's Island language, but they responded by waving their weapons and performing what we assumed was a war dance; so we retreated until the marines were landed, which I ordered to gather about 200 yards behind us. We approached the river again, accompanied by Tupia, Mr. Green, and Dr. Monkhouse. Tupia spoke to them in his own language, and it was a pleasant surprise to find they understood him perfectly. After some conversation, one of them swam across to us, followed by 20 or 30 more; those who followed brought their weapons, while the first man did not. We gave each of them gifts, but this didn’t satisfy them; they wanted everything we had, especially our arms, and made several attempts to grab them from us. Tupia warned us repeatedly that they were not our friends; we soon realized this when one snatched Mr. Green's hanger and wouldn't give it back. This encouraged the others to become bolder, and seeing more of them coming over to join, I ordered the man who had taken the hanger to be fired at, which was done, and he was wounded badly enough to die shortly after. Upon the first fire, which was just two muskets, the others retreated to a rock in the middle of the river; but seeing their comrade fall, they came back, probably to carry him off or take his arms, which they managed to do. We couldn't stop them unless we had used our bayonets, because by the time they returned from the rock, we had fired off our pieces, loaded with small shot, wounding three more; those wounded made it across the river and were carried off by the others, who then decided to leave. Seeing nothing could be done with the people on this side and knowing the river water was salt, I got back on the boat with the intent to row around the bay's head in search of fresh water, and if possible, surprise some of the natives to bring them on board, hoping that good treatment and gifts would help gain their friendship.

Tuesday, 10th. P.M., I rowed round the head of the bay, but could find no place to land on account of the Great Surf which beat everywhere upon the Shore. Seeing 2 Boats or Canoes coming in from Sea I rowed to one of them, in order to Seize upon the People; and came so near before they took notice of us that Tupia called to them to come alongside and we would not hurt them; but instead of doing this they endeavour'd to get away, upon which I order'd a Musquet to be fir'd over their Heads, thinking this would either make them surrender, or jump overboard; but here I was mistaken, for they immediately took to their Arms or whatever they had in the Boat, and began to attack us. This obliged us to fire upon them, and unfortunately either 2 or 3 were kill'd and one wounded, and 3 jumped overboard. These last we took up and brought on board, where they was Cloathed and Treated with all imaginable kindness; and to the Surprise of everybody became at once as cheerful and as merry as if they had been with their own Friends. They were all 3 Young, the eldest not above 20 years of Age, and the youngest about 10 or 12. I am aware that most Humane men who have not experienced things of this nature will Censure my Conduct in firing upon the People in their Boat, nor do I myself think that the reason I had for seizing upon her will at all justify me; and had I thought that they would have made the Least Resistance I would not have come near them; but as they did, I was not to stand still and suffer either myself or those that were with me to be knocked on the head.

Tuesday, 10th. P.M., I rowed around the head of the bay, but couldn’t find anywhere to land because of the huge surf crashing against the shore. I saw two boats or canoes coming in from the sea and rowed over to one of them to capture the people. We got so close before they noticed us that Tupia called out for them to approach with the promise that we wouldn’t harm them. Instead of coming over, they tried to escape, so I ordered a musket to be fired over their heads, hoping this would make them either surrender or jump overboard. However, I was mistaken; they immediately armed themselves with whatever they had on their boat and began to attack us. This forced us to fire back, and unfortunately, two or three were killed, one was wounded, and three jumped overboard. We rescued the last three and brought them on board, where they were clothed and treated with all possible kindness. To everyone’s surprise, they quickly became cheerful and as happy as if they were with their own friends. All three were young, the oldest not more than 20 years old and the youngest around 10 or 12. I know most compassionate people who haven’t experienced situations like this will criticize my actions in firing upon the people in their boat, and I agree that the reason I had for attempting to seize their boat doesn’t fully justify my actions. If I had thought they would resist at all, I wouldn’t have gotten close. But since they did resist, I couldn’t just stand there and let myself or my companions get hurt.

In the morning, as I intended to put our 3 Prisoners ashore, and stay here the day to see what effect it might have upon the other Natives, I sent an Officer ashore with the Marines and a party of men to cut wood, and soon after followed myself, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia, taking the 3 Natives with us, whom we landed on the West side of the River before mentioned. They were very unwilling to leave us, pretending that they should fall into the hands of their Enemies, who would kill and Eat them. However, they at last of their own accord left us and hid themselves in some bushes. Soon after this we discover'd several bodys of the Natives marching towards us, upon which we retir'd aCross the River, and joind the wooders; and with us came the 3 Natives we had just parted with, for we could not prevail upon them to go to their own people. We had no sooner got over the River than the others assembled on the other side to the Number of 150 or 200, all Arm'd. Tupia now began to Parly with them, and the 3 we had with us shew'd everything we had given them, part of which they laid and left upon the Body of the Man that was Kill'd the day before. These things seem'd so far to Convince them of our friendly intentions that one man came over to us, while all the others sat down upon the Sand. We everyone made this man a present, and the 3 Natives that were with us likewise presented him with such things as they had got from us, with which, after a short Stay, he retir'd aCross the River. I now thought proper to take everybody on board, to prevent any more Quarrels, and with us came the 3 Natives, whom we could not prevail upon to stay behind; and this appear'd the more strange as the man that came over to us was Uncle to one of them. After we had return'd on board we saw them Carry off the Dead Man; but the one that was Kill'd the first evening we Landed remain'd in the very spot they had left him.

In the morning, I planned to take our three prisoners ashore and stay here for the day to see what impact it might have on the other natives. I sent an officer ashore with the Marines and a group of men to cut wood and soon followed with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia, bringing the three natives with us. We dropped them off on the west side of the river previously mentioned. They were very reluctant to leave us, claiming they would fall into the hands of their enemies, who would kill and eat them. However, they eventually left us and hid in some bushes. Shortly after, we noticed several groups of natives marching towards us, prompting us to retreat across the river and join the woodcutters. The three natives we had just released came with us, as we couldn’t convince them to go back to their people. As soon as we crossed the river, the others gathered on the opposite side, numbering about 150 or 200, all armed. Tupia began to negotiate with them, and the three we had showcased everything we had given them, with some items laid upon the body of the man killed the day before. These actions seemed to convince them of our friendly intentions to some extent, as one man came over to us while the others sat down in the sand. We each gave this man a gift, and the three natives with us also offered him what they had received from us, after which he returned across the river. I thought it best to bring everyone back on board to avoid any more conflicts, and the three natives insisted on coming with us, which seemed odd since the man who had come over was the uncle of one of them. After we returned on board, we saw them carry off the dead man, but the one who was killed on the first evening we landed remained exactly where they had left him.

[Leave Poverty Bay.]

[Leave Poverty Bay.]

Wednesday, 11th. In the P.M., as I intended to sail in the Morning, we put the 3 Youths ashore, seemingly very much against their inclination; but whether this was owing to a desire they had to remain with us, or the fear of falling into the hands of their Enemies, as they pretended, I know not. The latter, however, seemed to be ill-founded, for we saw them carried aCross the River in a Catamaran, and walk Leasurely off with the other Natives. At 6 a.m. we weighed and stood out of the Bay, which I have named Poverty Bay, because it afforded us no one thing we wanted (Latitude 38 degrees 42 minutes South, Longitude 181 degrees 36 minutes West).* (* Latitude correct. Longitude is 181 degrees 57 minutes West.) It is in the form of a Horse Shoe, and is known by an Island lying close under the North-East point. The 2 points which forms the Entrance are high, with Steap white Cliffs, and lay a League and a half or 2 Leagues from Each other, North-East by East and South-West by West. The Depth of Water in this Bay is from 12 to 6 and 5 fathoms, a sandy bottom and good Anchorage, but you lay open to the winds between the South and East. Boats can go in and out of the river above mentioned at any time of Tide in fine weather; but as there is a Bar at the Entrance, on which the Sea Sometimes runs so high that no Boat can either get in or out, which hapned while we laid here; however, I believe that Boats can generally land on the North-East side of the river. The shore of this Bay, from a little within each Entrance, is a low, flat sand; but this is only a Narrow Slip, for the face of the Country appears with a variety of hills and Vallies, all cloathed with woods and Verdure, and to all appearance well inhabited, especially in the Vallies leading up from the Bay, where we daily saw Smoke at a great distance inland, and far back in the Country are very high Mountains. At Noon the South-West point of Poverty Bay, which I have named Young Nicks head (after the Boy who first saw this land),* (* In Mr. Molineux's Log, his name is given as Nicholas Young, but no such name appears in the official lists.) bore North by West, distance 3 or 4 leagues, being at this time about 3 Miles from the Shore, and had 25 fathoms Water, the Main Land extending from North-East by North to South. My intention is to follow the direction of the Coast to the Southward, as far as the Latitude of 40 or 41 degrees, and then to return to the Northward, in case we meet with nothing to incourage us to proceed farther.

Wednesday, 11th. In the afternoon, since I planned to set sail in the morning, we dropped off the three young men, seemingly against their wishes. I can't tell if they wanted to stay with us or if they were afraid of falling into the hands of their enemies, as they claimed. However, their fear seemed unfounded because we saw them being carried across the river on a catamaran and leisurely walking off with other locals. At 6 a.m., we lifted anchor and headed out of the bay, which I named Poverty Bay because it didn’t provide us with anything we needed (Latitude 38 degrees 42 minutes South, Longitude 181 degrees 36 minutes West).* (* Latitude correct. Longitude is 181 degrees 57 minutes West.) The bay is shaped like a horseshoe and is marked by an island close to the northeast point. The two points forming the entrance are high, with steep white cliffs, located a league and a half to two leagues from each other, northeast by east and southwest by west. The water depth in this bay varies from 12 to 6 and 5 fathoms, with a sandy bottom and good anchorage, but it is exposed to winds coming from the south and east. Boats can enter and exit the mentioned river at any tide during good weather; however, there is a bar at the entrance that sometimes has waves so high that no boat can get in or out, which happened while we were there. That said, I believe boats can usually land on the northeast side of the river. The shoreline of this bay, just inside each entrance, consists of a low, flat sand area, but this is just a narrow strip; beyond that, the landscape features a variety of hills and valleys, all covered in woods and greenery, and appears to be well inhabited, especially in the valleys leading up from the bay, where we consistently saw smoke in the distance inland, and far back in the country, there are very high mountains. At noon, the southwest point of Poverty Bay, which I named Young Nick's Head (after the boy who first saw this land),* (* In Mr. Molineux's Log, his name is given as Nicholas Young, but no such name appears in the official lists.) was located north by west, about 3 to 4 leagues away, at this time about 3 miles from shore, with 25 fathoms of water, the mainland stretching from northeast by north to south. My plan is to follow the coastline southward as far as latitude 40 or 41 degrees, and then head back north if we find nothing to encourage us to continue further.

[Off Portland Island, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Portland Island, North Island, New Zealand.]

Thursday, 12th. Gentle breezes at North-West and North, with frequent Calms. In the Afternoon, while we lay becalm'd, several Canoes came off to the Ship, but keept at a distance until one, who appeared to come from a different part, came off and put alongside at once, and after her all the rest. The people in this boat had heard of the Treatment those had met with we had had on board before, and therefore came on board without hesitation; they were all kindly treated, and very soon entered into a Traffick with our People for George's Island Cloth, etc.; giving in Exchange their Paddles, having little else to dispose of, and hardly left themselves a sufficient number to paddle ashore; nay, the people in one Canoe, after disposing of their Paddles, offer'd to sell the Canoe. After a stay of about 2 hours they went away, but by some means or other 3 were left on board, and not one boat would put back to take them in, and, what was more surprizing, those aboard did not seem at all uneasy with their situation. In the evening a light breeze springing up at North-West, we steer'd along Shore, under an easy sail, until midnight, then brought too. Soon after it fell Calm, and continued so until 8 o'Clock a.m., when a breeze sprung up at North, with which we stood along shore South-South-West. At and after sunrise found the variation to be 14 degrees 46 minutes East. About this time 2 Canoes came off to the Ship, one of which was prevailed upon to come along side to take in the 3 people we had had on board all night, who now seem'd glad of the opportunity to get ashore. As the People in the Canoe were a little shy at first, it was observed that one Argument those on board made use on to intice the others alongside, was in telling them that we did not Eat men; from which it should seem that these people have such a Custom among them. At the time we made sail we were abreast of the Point of Land set yesterday at Noon, from which the Land trends South-South-West. This point I have named Cape Table, on account of its shape and figure. It lies 7 Leagues to the Southward of Poverty Bay, in the Latitude of 39 degrees 7 minutes South, longitude 181 degrees 36 minutes West, it is of a moderate height, makes in a sharpe Angle, and appears to be quite flat at Top. In steering along shore to the Southward of the Cape, at the distance of 2 or 3 miles off, our soundings were from 20 to 30 fathoms, having a Chain of Rocks that appears at different heights above water, laying between us and the Shore. At Noon, Cape Table bore North 20 degrees East, distant 4 Leagues, and a small Island (being the Southermost land in sight) bore South 70 degrees West, distant 3 miles. This Island I have named Isle of Portland, on account of its very great resemblance to Portland in the English Channel. It lies about a mile from a Point on the Main, but there appears to be a ledge of Rocks extending nearly, if not quite, aCross from the one to the other. North 57 degrees East, 2 Miles from the South point of Portland, lies a sunken rock whereon the sea breaks; we passed between this Rock and the land having 17, 18, and 20 fathom Water. We saw a great Number of the Natives assembled together on the Isle of Portland; we likewise saw some on the Main land, and several places that were Cultivated and laid out in square Plantations.

Thursday, 12th. Soft breezes from the North-West and North, with frequent calm periods. In the afternoon, as we were waiting for the wind, several canoes approached the ship but kept their distance until one, seemingly from a different area, came alongside right away, followed by the others. The people in this canoe had heard about the treatment the previous visitors received on board, so they came aboard without hesitation; they were treated kindly and quickly began trading with our crew for cloth from George's Island, etc., exchanging their paddles since they had little else to offer, and barely left themselves enough paddles to get back to shore. In fact, one group in a canoe, after selling their paddles, even offered to sell the canoe itself. After about two hours, they left, but somehow three people were left on board, and none of the boats would return to take them back. Surprisingly, those on the ship didn’t seem worried at all about their situation. In the evening, a light breeze picked up from the North-West, and we sailed along the shore at an easy pace until midnight, when we anchored. Shortly after, it became calm again and stayed that way until 8 a.m., when a breeze came up from the North, allowing us to head south-south-west along the shore. At sunrise, we noted the variation to be 14 degrees 46 minutes East. Around this time, two canoes came to the ship, one of which we managed to convince to come alongside to pick up the three people we had on board overnight, who seemed glad to have the chance to get ashore. At first, the people in the canoe were a bit hesitant, and it was noted that one reason we used to coax them alongside was to assure them that we didn't eat people, suggesting that this might be a custom among them. When we set sail, we were at the point of land we had noted yesterday at noon, from which the land trends south-south-west. I named this point Cape Table because of its shape. It is located seven leagues south of Poverty Bay, at a latitude of 39 degrees 7 minutes South and longitude of 181 degrees 36 minutes West. It is of moderate height, forms a sharp angle, and appears quite flat on top. As we sailed along the shore south of the cape, two or three miles off, our depth ranged from 20 to 30 fathoms, with a chain of rocks rising above the water at various heights between us and the shore. At noon, Cape Table was at North 20 degrees East, four leagues away, and a small island (the southernmost land in sight) was at South 70 degrees West, three miles away. I named this island the Isle of Portland because it looks very much like Portland in the English Channel. It is about a mile from a point on the mainland, but there seems to be a ledge of rocks stretching nearly, if not entirely, across from one to the other. At North 57 degrees East, two miles from the south point of Portland, lies a submerged rock where the sea breaks; we passed between this rock and the mainland with depths of 17, 18, and 20 fathoms. We saw a large number of natives gathered on the Isle of Portland, and there were also some on the mainland, along with several areas that were cultivated and organized into square plantations.

Friday, 13th. At 1 p.m. we discover'd land behind or to the Westward of Portland, extending to the Southward as far as we could see. In hauling round the South end of Portland we fell into Shoal Water and broken ground, which we, however, soon got clear of. At this time 4 Canoes came off to us full of People, and keept for sometime under our stern threatning of us all the while. As I did not know but what I might be obliged to send our Boats ahead to sound, I thought these Gentry would be as well out of the way. I order'd a Musquet shott to be fir'd close to one of them, but this they took no notice of. A 4 Pounder was then fir'd a little wide of them; at this they began to shake their Spears and Paddles at us, but notwithstanding this they thought fit to retire. Having got round Portland, we hauled in for the Land North-West, having a Gentle breeze at North-East, which died away at 5 o'Clock and obliged us to Anchor in 21 fathoms, a fine sandy bottom: the South Point of Portland bore South-East 1/2 South distant about 2 Leagues, and a low Point on the Main bore North 1/2 East. In this last direction there runs in a deep bay behind the Land on which is Table Cape, which makes this Land a Peninsula, joined to the Main by a low, narrow neck of land; the Cape is the North Point of the Peninsula, and Portland the South. While we lay at Anchor 2 Boats came off to us, and so near as to take up some things we throw'd them out of the Ship, but would not come alongside. At 5 a.m. a breeze springing northerly we weigh'd and steer'd in for the Land. The shore here forms a very large Bay, of which Portland is the North-East Point, and the Bay above mentioned is an Arm of it. I would gladly have examin'd this Arm, because there appear'd to be safe Anchorage in it, but as I was not certain of this, and the wind being right an End, I did not care to spend time in Turning up to it. At Noon Portland bore South 50 degrees East, and the Southermost land in sight bore South-South-West, distant 10 or 12 Leagues, being about 3 miles from the Shore, and in this situation had 12 fathoms water--24 fathoms have been the most Water we have had since we have been within Portland, every where clear ground. The land near the Shore is of a moderate height, with white Cliffs and Sandy beaches. Inland are several Pretty high Mountains, and the whole face of the Country appears with a very hilly surface, and for the most part Covered with wood, and hath all the appearances of a very pleasant and fertile Country.

Friday, 13th. At 1 p.m. we spotted land to the west of Portland, stretching south as far as we could see. As we navigated around the southern tip of Portland, we encountered shallow water and rough terrain, but we cleared it quickly. At this moment, four canoes approached us, filled with people, and stayed behind our ship, threatening us the whole time. Since I might need to send our boats ahead to check the depth, I figured it would be best to get these folks out of our way. I ordered a gunshot to be fired near one of them, but they ignored it. Then we fired a 4-pound cannon a bit away from them, which made them shake their spears and paddles at us, but they still decided to retreat. After getting around Portland, we headed in towards the land to the northwest, with a gentle breeze coming from the northeast that died down by 5 o'clock, forcing us to anchor in 21 fathoms with a nice sandy bottom. The southern point of Portland was southeast by half south, about 2 leagues away, and a low point on the mainland was north by half east. In this direction, there is a deep bay behind the land where Table Cape is located, which makes this area a peninsula connected to the mainland by a low, narrow strip of land; the Cape is the northern point of the peninsula, and Portland is the southern point. While we were anchored, two boats came up to us close enough to retrieve some items we threw overboard, but they wouldn't come alongside. At 5 a.m., a northerly breeze picked up, so we weighed anchor and headed in towards the land. The shore here forms a very large bay, with Portland as the northeast point, and the previously mentioned bay being an arm of it. I would have liked to explore this arm because there seemed to be safe anchorage there, but since I wasn't sure about it and the wind was directly against us, I didn't want to waste time going in that direction. At noon, Portland was bearing south 50 degrees east, while the southernmost land in sight was south-southwest, about 10 or 12 leagues away, roughly 3 miles from the shore, where we had 12 fathoms of water. Since we entered Portland, we've had a maximum of 24 fathoms of clear water. The land near the shore is moderately elevated, with white cliffs and sandy beaches. Inland, there are several pretty high mountains, and the entire landscape appears quite hilly and mostly covered with trees, giving the impression of a very pleasant and fertile area.

Saturday, 14th. P.M. had Gentle breezes between the North-East and North-West. Kept running down along shore at the distance of 2 or 3 miles off. Our sounding was from 20 to 13 fathoms, an even sandy bottom. We saw some Canoes or Boats in shore, and several houses upon the Land, but no harbour or Convenient watering place--the Main thing we were looking for. In the night had little wind, and Sometimes Calm with Dirty, rainy weather. A.M. had Variable light Airs next to a Calm and fair weather. In the morning, being not above 2 Leagues from the South-West corner of the great Bay we have been in for the 2 days past, the Pinnace and Long boat were hoisted out in order to search for Fresh Water; but just as they were ready to put off we observed several Boats full of People coming off from the Shore, and for that reason I did not think it prudent to send our own from the Ship. The first that came were 5 in Number, in them were between 80 and 90 men. Every Method was tried to gain their Friendship, and several things were thrown overboard to them; but all we could do was to no purpose, neither would they accept of any one thing from us, but seem'd fully bent on attacking us. In order to prevent this, and our being obliged to fire upon them, I order'd a 4 Pounder Loaded with grape to be fir'd a little wide of them, letting them know at the same time by Means of Tupia what we were going to do; this had the desir'd effect, and not one of these would afterwards trust themselves abreast of the Ship. Soon after 4 more came off; one of these put what Arms they had into another Boat, and then came alongside so near as to take what things we gave them, and I believe might have been Prevailed upon to come on board had not some of the first 5 came up under our Stern and began again to threaten us, at which the people in this one Boat seem'd displeased; immediately after this they all went ashore. At Noon Latitude in per Observation 39 degrees 37 minutes South. Portland bore by our run from it East by North, distant 14 Leagues; the Southermost land in sight, and which is the South point of the Bay, South-East by South, distant 4 or 5 Leagues; and a Bluff head lying in the South-West corner of the Bay South by West 2 or 3 Miles. On each side of this bluff head is a low narrow sand or stone beach; between these beaches and the Main land is a pretty large lake of Salt Water, as I suppose. On the South-East side of this head is a very large flatt, which seems to extend a good way inland to the Westward; on this flatt are Several groves of Streight, tall Trees, but there seems to be a great Probability that the lake above mentiond extends itself a good way into this flatt Country. Inland are a Chain of Pretty high Mountains extending North and South; on the Summits and Sides of these Mountains were many Patches of Snow, but between them and the Sea the Land is Cloathed with wood.* (* The Endeavour was now off what is called Ahuriri Bay. The bluff head is known as Ahuriri Bluff, and the town of Napier, of 8000 inhabitants, lies at the back of it. The large sheet of salt water is called Manganui-o-rotu. There was no sheltered harbour for a vessel in the Endeavour's situation, but at present, harbour works have improved the entrance to the lagoon into which vessels drawing 12 feet can enter. Produce of the value of over a million pounds per annum is now exported from Napier.)

Saturday, 14th. In the afternoon, there were gentle breezes coming from the northeast to the northwest. We kept sailing along the shore about 2 or 3 miles out. Our depth ranged from 20 to 13 fathoms, with a smooth sandy bottom. We spotted some canoes or boats near the shore, along with several houses on land, but we didn’t find any harbor or convenient water source, which was the main thing we were looking for. At night, there was little wind, sometimes calm, with dirty, rainy weather. In the morning, we had variable light airs next to calm conditions and fair weather. Being just about 2 leagues from the southwest corner of the large bay we'd been in for the past 2 days, we launched the pinnace and longboat to look for fresh water; however, just as they were about to leave, we noticed several boats filled with people coming from the shore, so I didn’t think it was wise to send our boats from the ship. The first group was made up of 5 boats and held about 80 to 90 men. We tried every method to gain their friendship and threw several items overboard for them, but nothing worked, and they wouldn’t accept anything from us—they seemed fully intent on attacking us. To prevent this and avoid having to fire on them, I ordered a 4-pounder loaded with grape shot to be fired a little wide of them, while letting them know through Tupia what we were doing; this had the desired effect, and none of them dared come alongside the ship after that. Soon after, 4 more boats came over; one of these put its arms into another boat and then came alongside close enough to take what we offered them. I believe they could have been persuaded to come on board, but some of the first 5 boats approached our stern and began to threaten us again, which seemed to upset the people in this one boat; immediately after, they all returned to shore. At noon, our latitude was 39 degrees 37 minutes south. Portland, based on our run, was to the east-north-east, 14 leagues away; the southernmost land in sight, marking the south point of the bay, was south-east by south, about 4 or 5 leagues away; and a bluff head located in the south-west corner of the bay was south by west, 2 or 3 miles off. On either side of this bluff head, there were narrow sandy or stony beaches; between these beaches and the mainland, there was a fairly large saltwater lake, I presume. To the south-east of this head, there was a very large flat area extending quite a way inland to the west; on this flat were several groves of straight, tall trees, but it seemed likely that the aforementioned lake extended deep into this flat area. Inland, there was a chain of pretty high mountains running north and south; on their summits and sides were many patches of snow, but between them and the sea, the land was covered with woods. * (* The Endeavour was now off what is called Ahuriri Bay. The bluff head is known as Ahuriri Bluff, and the town of Napier, with 8000 inhabitants, lies behind it. The large sheet of salt water is called Manganui-o-rotu. There was no sheltered harbor for a vessel in the Endeavour's position, but currently, harbor works have improved the entrance to the lagoon, allowing vessels drawing 12 feet to enter. More than a million pounds worth of produce is now exported annually from Napier.)

[In Hawkes Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[In Hawkes Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 15th. P.M. stood over for the Southermost Land or South point of the Bay, having a light breeze at North-East, our soundings from 12 to 8 fathoms. Not reaching this point before dark, we stood Off and on all night, having Variable light Airs next to a Calm; depth of water from 8 to 7 fathoms; Variation 14 degrees 10 minutes East. At 8 a.m., being abreast of the South-West point of the Bay, some fishing Boats came off to us and sold us some stinking fish; however it was such as they had, and we were glad to enter into Traffick with them upon any Terms. These People behaved at first very well, until a large Arm'd boat, wherein were 22 Men, came alongside. We soon saw that this Boat had nothing for Traffick, yet as they came boldly alongside we gave them 2 or 3 pieces of Cloth, Articles they seem'd the most fond off. One Man in this Boat had on him a black skin, something like a Bear Skin, which I was desirous of having that I might be a better judge what sort of an Animal the first Owner was. I offer'd him for it a piece of Red Cloth, which he seem'd to jump at by immediately putting off the Skin and holding it up to us, but would not part with it until he had the Cloth in his possession and after that not at all, but put off the Boat and went away, and with them all the rest. But in a very short time they return'd again, and one of the fishing Boats came alongside and offer'd us some more fish. The Indian Boy Tiata, Tupia's Servant, being over the side, they seiz'd hold of him, pull'd him into the Boat and endeavoured to carry him off; this obliged us to fire upon them, which gave the Boy an opportunity to jump overboard. We brought the Ship too, lower'd a Boat into the Water, and took him up unhurt. Two or 3 paid for this daring attempt with the loss of their lives, and many more would have suffer'd had it not been for fear of killing the Boy. This affair occasioned my giving this point of land the name of Cape Kidnapper. It is remarkable on account of 2 White rocks in form of Haystacks standing very near it. On each side of the Cape are Tolerable high white steep Cliffs, Latitude 39 degrees 43 minutes South; Longitude 182 degrees 24 minutes West; it lies South-West by West, distant 13 Leagues from the Island of Portland. Between them is a large Bay wherein we have been for these 3 days past; this Bay I have named Hawkes Bay in Honour of Sir Edward, first Lord of the Admiralty; we found in it from 24 to 8 and 7 fathoms, everywhere good Anchoring. From Cape Kidnapper the Island Trends South-South-West, and in this direction we run along shore, keeping about a League off, having a steady breeze and Clear weather. At Noon the above Cape bore from us North 9 degrees East, distant 2 Leagues, and the Southermost land in sight South 25 degrees West Latitude in Per Observation 39 degrees 50 minutes South.

Sunday, 15th. In the afternoon, we made our way toward the Southernmost Land or South point of the Bay, with a light breeze coming from the North-East. Our depth readings were between 12 and 8 fathoms. Since we didn’t reach this point before dark, we stayed back and drifted all night, experiencing variable light winds that were nearly calm; the water depth ranged from 8 to 7 fathoms; the magnetic variation was 14 degrees 10 minutes East. At 8 a.m., as we lined up with the South-West point of the Bay, some fishing boats came out to us and sold us some pretty bad fish; it was the best they had, and we were glad to trade with them under any circumstances. These people were friendly at first, until a large armed boat with 22 men came alongside. We quickly realized that this boat didn’t have anything to trade, but since they came up boldly, we gave them 2 or 3 pieces of cloth, which they seemed most interested in. One man in this boat was wearing a black skin that looked a bit like bear skin, and I wanted to have it so I could better identify what kind of animal it belonged to. I offered him a piece of red cloth, which he eagerly accepted by quickly taking off the skin and holding it up to us. However, he wouldn’t let it go until he had the cloth in his hands, and after that, he didn’t give it up but pushed off with the boat and left with the others. But they returned shortly, and one of the fishing boats came back alongside and offered us more fish. The Indian boy Tiata, who was Tupia’s servant, was over the side when they grabbed him, pulled him into their boat, and tried to take him away; this forced us to fire upon them, giving the boy the chance to jump overboard. We turned the ship, lowered a boat into the water, and rescued him unhurt. Two or three of them paid for this bold attempt with their lives, and many more would have suffered had they not been afraid of harming the boy. Because of this incident, I named this point of land Cape Kidnapper. It is notable for the two white rocks shaped like haystacks standing very close by. On either side of the Cape are relatively high, steep white cliffs, at Latitude 39 degrees 43 minutes South; Longitude 182 degrees 24 minutes West; it lies South-West by West, 13 leagues from Portland Island. Between them is a large bay where we have been for the past three days; I named this bay Hawkes Bay in honor of Sir Edward, the first Lord of the Admiralty; we found depths ranging from 24 to 8 and 7 fathoms, with good anchoring everywhere. From Cape Kidnapper, the island trends South-South-West, and we continued along the shore, staying about a league off, with a steady breeze and clear weather. At noon, Cape Kidnapper bore from us North 9 degrees East, 2 leagues away, and the southernmost land visible was to the South 25 degrees West, with my observation putting it at Latitude 39 degrees 50 minutes South.

Monday, 16th. First and latter part, fresh breezes, Northerly; in the night, Variable and sometimes calm. At 2 p.m. passed by a Small but a Pretty high white Island lying close to the Shore. On this Island we saw a good many Houses, Boats, and Some People. We concluded that they must be fishers, because the Island was quite barren; we likewise saw several people upon the Shore in a small Bay on the Main within the Island. At 7 the Southermost land in sight bore South-West by South, and Cape Kidnapper North 3/4 East, distant 8 leagues, being then about 2 Leagues from the Shore, and had 55 fathoms. At 11 brought too until daylight, then made Sail along shore to the Southward. At 7 passed a pretty high point of Land, which lies South-South-West, 12 Leagues from Cape Kidnapper. From this point the Land Trends 3/4 of a point more to the Westward. At 10 saw more land appear to the Southward, at South-West by South. At Noon the Southermost land in sight bore South 39 degrees West, distant 8 or 10 Leagues, and a high Bluff head with Yellowish Cliffs bore West, distant 2 miles, Latitude observed 40 degrees 34 minutes South; depth of water 32 fathoms.

Monday, 16th. In the early and later parts of the day, there were fresh breezes from the north; during the night, the wind was variable and sometimes calm. At 2 p.m., we passed a small but fairly tall white island close to the shore. On this island, we saw quite a few houses, boats, and some people. We figured they must be fishermen since the island was quite barren; we also noticed several people on the shore in a small bay on the mainland within view of the island. At 7, the southernmost land we could see was bearing South-West by South, while Cape Kidnapper was at North 3/4 East, about 8 leagues away. At that point, we were around 2 leagues from the shore in 55 fathoms of water. At 11, we dropped anchor until daylight, then set sail along the shore to the south. At 7, we passed a fairly high point of land, situated South-South-West, 12 leagues from Cape Kidnapper. From this point, the land trends 3/4 of a point more to the west. At 10, we spotted more land appearing to the south, at South-West by South. At noon, the southernmost land in sight was bearing South 39 degrees West, about 8 or 10 leagues away, and a high bluff head with yellowish cliffs was to the west, around 2 miles away. Latitude observed was 40 degrees 34 minutes South; depth of water recorded was 32 fathoms.

[Returning North from Cape Turnagain.]

[Coming back North from Cape Turnagain.]

Tuesday, 17th. P.M. winds at West, a fresh breeze; in the night, Variable light Airs and Calm; a.m. a Gentle breeze between the North-West and North-East. Seeing no likelyhood of meeting with a Harbour, and the face of the Country Visibly altering for the worse, I thought that the standing farther to the South would not be attended with any Valuable discovery, but would be loosing of Time, which might be better employ'd and with a greater Probability of success in examining the Coast to the Northward. With this View, at 1 p.m. Tack'd and stood to the Northward, having the Wind at West, a fresh breeze.* (* If Cook had known the exact shape of New Zealand, he could scarcely have taken a better resolve, in view of saving time, than to turn northward again when he did.) At this time we could see the land extending South-West by South, at least 10 or 12 Leagues. The Bluff head or high point of land we were abreast off at Noon I have called Cape Turnagain because here we returned. It lies in the Latitude of 40 degrees 34 minutes South, Longitude 182 degrees 55 West, and 18 Leagues South-South-West and South-South-West 1/2 West from Cape Kidnapper. The land between them is of a very unequal height; in some places it is high, with White Cliffs next the Sea--in others low, with sandy beaches. The face of the Country is not nearly so well Cloathed with wood as it is about Hawkes Bay, but for the most part looks like our high Downs in England, and to all appearance well inhabited, for we saw several Villages as we run along shore, not only in the Vallies, but on the Tops and sides of the Hills, and Smokes in other places. The ridge of Mountains before mentioned extends to the Southward farther than we could see, and are every where Checquer'd with Snow. This night saw 2 Large fires up in the inland Country, a sure sign that it must be inhabited. At Noon Cape Kidnapper bore North 56 degrees West, distant 7 Leagues; latitude observed 39 degrees 52 minutes South.

Tuesday, 17th. P.M. Winds from the West, a fresh breeze; during the night, variable light winds and calm; A.M. a gentle breeze between the Northwest and Northeast. Seeing no chance of finding a harbor and the landscape clearly changing for the worse, I figured that continuing further south wouldn’t yield anything valuable, but would only waste time that could be better spent with a higher chance of success exploring the coast to the north. With this in mind, at 1 p.m. I tacked and headed north, with the wind coming from the west, a fresh breeze. (*If Cook had known the exact shape of New Zealand, he could hardly have made a better decision to save time by turning north when he did.*) At this time, we could see the land extending southwest by south for at least 10 or 12 leagues. The Bluff head or prominent point of land that we were level with at noon I named Cape Turnagain because that’s where we turned back. It’s located at a latitude of 40 degrees 34 minutes south, longitude 182 degrees 55 west, and 18 leagues south-southwest and south-southwest 1/2 west from Cape Kidnapper. The land between them is of very uneven height; in some areas, it’s high with white cliffs next to the sea—in others, low with sandy beaches. The landscape isn’t nearly as well covered with trees as it is around Hawkes Bay, but for the most part looks like our high downs in England, and it seems quite inhabited, as we saw several villages along the shore, not just in the valleys but also on the tops and sides of the hills, with smoke rising in other places. The mountain range I mentioned extends further south than we could see, and is everywhere dotted with snow. That night, we spotted two large fires in the inland area, a clear sign that it must be inhabited. At noon, Cape Kidnapper was bearing North 56 degrees West, 7 leagues away; latitude observed was 39 degrees 52 minutes south.

Wednesday, 18th. Variable light winds and fine weather. At 4 a.m. Cape Kidnapper bore North 32 degrees West, distant 2 Leagues. In this situation had 62 fathoms; and when the said Cape bore West by North, distant 3 or 4 Leagues, had 45 fathoms; Midway between the Isle of Portland and Cape Kidnapper had 65 fathoms. At Noon the Isle of Portland bore North-East 1/2 East, distant 4 Leagues; latitude observ'd 39 degrees 34 minutes South.

Wednesday, 18th. Light, variable winds and nice weather. At 4 a.m., Cape Kidnapper was to the North 32 degrees West, 2 leagues away. At this point, we had 62 fathoms of water; when the Cape was to the West by North, about 3 or 4 leagues away, we had 45 fathoms. Midway between the Isle of Portland and Cape Kidnapper, we noted 65 fathoms. At noon, the Isle of Portland was at North-East 1/2 East, 4 leagues away; latitude observed was 39 degrees 34 minutes South.

Thursday, 19th. The first part had Gentle breezes at East and East-North-East; in the night, fresh Gales between the South and South-West; dark, Cloudy weather, with Lightning and rain. At 1/2 past 5 P.M. Tack'd and stood to the South-East: the Isle of Portland bore South-East, distant 3 Leagues. Soon after we Tacked a boat or Canoe came off from the Shore, wherein were 5 People. They came on board without shewing the least signs of fear, and insisted upon staying with us the whole night; indeed, there was no getting them away without turning them out of the Ship by force, and that I did not care to do; but to prevent them playing us any Trick I hoisted their Canoe up alongside. Two appear'd to be Chiefs, and the other 3 their Servants. One of the Chiefs seem'd to be of a free, open, and Gentle disposition; they both took great notice of everything they saw, and was very thankful for what was given them. The 2 Chiefs would neither Eat nor Drink with us, but the other 3 Eat whatever was offer'd them. Notwithstanding that these people had heard of the Treatment the others had meet with who had been on board before, yet it appear'd a little strange that they should place so much Confidence in us as to put themselves wholy in our power wether we would or no, especially as the others we had meet with in this bay had upon every occasion behaved in quite a different manner. At 11 brought too until daylight (the night being dark and rainy), then made sail. At 7 a.m. brought too under Cape Table, and sent away the Indian Canoe. At this Time some others were putting off from the Shore, but we did not wait their coming, but made sail to the Northward. At Noon the Northermost land in sight North 20 degrees East, and Young Nicks head, or the South point of Poverty Bay, West-Northerly, near 4 Leagues. Latitude observed 38 degrees 44 minutes 30 seconds South.

Thursday, 19th. The day started with gentle breezes coming from the East and East-North-East; during the night, we experienced fresh gales from the South to the South-West, along with dark, cloudy weather that brought lightning and rain. At 5:30 PM, we tacked and headed Southeast, with the Isle of Portland to the Southeast, about 3 leagues away. Shortly after we tacked, a boat or canoe approached from the shore carrying 5 people. They boarded without showing any signs of fear and insisted on staying with us for the entire night; in fact, we couldn't get them to leave without force, which I wasn't keen on doing. To avoid any tricks, I hoisted their canoe up alongside. Two seemed to be chiefs, while the other three were their servants. One of the chiefs appeared to have a friendly, open, and kind nature; both chiefs observed everything closely and were very grateful for the gifts they received. The two chiefs refused to eat or drink with us, but the other three consumed whatever was offered. Despite having heard about how others had been treated on previous visits, it was a bit surprising that they placed so much trust in us to surrender completely to our control, especially since the others we encountered in this bay had always behaved quite differently. At 11 PM, we held still until daylight (the night was dark and rainy), then set sail. At 7 AM, we stopped under Cape Table and sent the Indian canoe away. At that time, a few others were heading toward the shore, but we didn't wait for them and instead sailed northward. By noon, the northernmost land in sight was to the North 20 degrees East, and Young Nick's head, or the southern point of Poverty Bay, was to the West-Northwest, about 4 leagues away. The latitude was observed at 38 degrees 44 minutes 30 seconds South.

Friday, 20th. P.M. a fresh breeze at South-South-West; in the night, variable light breezes, with rain; A.M. a fresh breeze at South-West. At 3 p.m. passed by a remarkable head, which I called Gable end Foreland on account of the very great resemblance the white cliff at the very point hath to the Gable end of a House. It is made still more remarkable by a Spir'd Rock standing a little distance from it. This head land lies from Cape Table North 24 degrees East, distant 12 Leagues. Between them the Shore forms a Bay, wherein lies Poverty Bay, 4 Leagues from the former and 8 Leagues from the Latter. From Gable end Foreland the land trends North by East as far as we could see. The land from Poverty Bay to this place is of a moderate but very unequal height, distinguished by Hills and Vallies that are Cover'd with woods. We saw, as we run along shore, several Villages, cultivated lands, and some of the Natives. In the evening some Canoes came off to the Ship, and one Man came on board to whom we gave a few Trifles and then sent him away. Stood off and on until daylight, and then made sail in shore in order to look into 2 Bays that appear'd to our view about 2 Leagues to the Northward of the Foreland. The Southermost we could not fetch, but in the other we Anchor'd about 11 o'Clock in 7 fathoms, a black sandy bottom. The North point bore North-East 1/2 North, distant 2 Miles, and the South Point South-East by East, distant one Mile, and about 3/4 of a Mile from the Shore. This Bay is not so much Shelter'd from the Sea as I at first thought it was; but as the Natives, many of whom came about us in their Canoes, appear'd to be of a friendly disposition, I was willing to try if we could not get a little water on board, and to see a little into the Nature of the Country before we proceeded further to the Northward.

Friday, 20th. P.M. a fresh breeze from the South-South-West; during the night, light breezes that varied, with some rain; A.M. a fresh breeze from the South-West. At 3 p.m., we passed a notable headland, which I named Gable End Foreland because the white cliff at the point looks very much like the gable end of a house. It's made even more distinctive by a spire-shaped rock standing a short distance away. This headland is situated from Cape Table at North 24 degrees East, 12 leagues away. Between them, the shore forms a bay, which contains Poverty Bay, 4 leagues from the former and 8 leagues from the latter. From Gable End Foreland, the land trends North by East as far as we could see. The land from Poverty Bay to this location is moderately uneven, marked by hills and valleys that are covered with woods. As we sailed along the shore, we saw several villages, cultivated lands, and some of the locals. In the evening, a few canoes came out to the ship, and one man came aboard. We gave him a few small items before sending him away. We stayed off the coast until daylight, then set sail inshore to explore two bays that appeared about 2 leagues north of the foreland. We couldn't reach the southernmost bay, but we anchored in the other bay around 11 o'clock in 7 fathoms of black sandy bottom. The North point was at North-East 1/2 North, 2 miles away, and the South point was at South-East by East, 1 mile away, and about 3/4 of a mile from the shore. This bay isn't as sheltered from the sea as I initially thought, but since the locals, many of whom approached us in their canoes, seemed friendly, I wanted to see if we could get some water onboard and learn a bit more about the land before heading further north.

Saturday, 21st. We had no sooner come to an Anchor, as mentioned above, than perceiving 2 old Men in the Canoes, who from their Garbe appear'd to be Chiefs, these I invited on board, and they came without Hesitation. To each I gave about 4 Yards of linnen and a Spike Nail; the linnen they were very fond of, but the Nails they seem'd to set no Value upon. Tupia explain'd to them the reasons of our Coming here, and that we should neither hurt nor Molest them if they did but behave in the same peaceable manner to us; indeed, we were under very little apprehension but what they would, as they had heard of what hapned in Poverty Bay. Between 1 and 2 p.m. I put off with the Boats mann'd and Arm'd in order to land to look for fresh Water, these 2 Men along with us; but the surf running very high, and it begun to blow and rain at the same time, I returned back to the Ship, having first put the 2 Chiefs into one of their Canoes. In the evening it fell moderate, and we landed and found 2 Small Streams of Fresh Water, and the Natives to all appearance very friendly and peaceable; on which account I resolved to Stay one day at least, to fill a little water and to give Mr. Banks an opportunity to Collect a little of the Produce of the Country. In the morning Lieutenant Gore went on shore to superintend the Watering with a Strong party of Men, but the getting the Casks off was so very difficult, on account of the Surf, that it was noon before one Turn came on board.

Saturday, 21st. As soon as we dropped anchor, we noticed two older men in canoes who looked like chiefs based on their clothing. I invited them on board, and they came aboard without hesitation. I gave each of them about four yards of linen and a spike nail; they really liked the linen, but they didn’t seem to care much for the nails. Tupia explained to them why we were there and assured them that we wouldn't harm them if they treated us peacefully in return. Honestly, we weren’t too worried because they had already heard about what happened in Poverty Bay. Between 1 and 2 p.m., I set out with the boats, manned and armed, to look for fresh water, taking the two men with us. However, since the surf was very high and it started to rain, I decided to return to the ship, first putting the two chiefs back in one of their canoes. In the evening, the weather calmed down, and we landed, discovering two small streams of fresh water. The natives seemed very friendly and peaceful, so I decided to stay at least one more day to obtain some water and give Mr. Banks a chance to collect a bit of local produce. In the morning, Lieutenant Gore went ashore to oversee the watering operation with a strong group of men, but getting the casks off was quite difficult because of the surf, and it wasn't until noon that the first batch was brought back on board.

[At Tegadoo Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[At Tegadoo Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 22nd. P.M. light breezes and Cloudy. About or a little after Noon several of the Natives came off to the Ship in their Canoes and began to Traffick with us, our people giving them George's Island Cloth for theirs, for they had little else to dispose of. This kind of exchange they seem'd at first very fond of, and prefer'd the Cloth we had got at the Islands to English Cloth; but it fell in its value above 500 p. ct. before night. I had some of them on board, and Shew'd them the Ship, with which they were well pleased. The same friendly disposition was observed by those on shore, and upon the whole they behaved as well or better than one could expect; but as the getting the Water from the Shore proved so very Tedious on account of the Surf, I resolved upon leaving this place in the morning, and accordingly, at 5 a.m., we weighed and put to Sea. This Bay is called by the Natives Tegadoo;* (* Anaura Bay.) it lies in the Latitude of 38 degrees 16 minutes South, but as it hath nothing to recommend it I shall give no discription of it. There is plenty of Wild Sellery, and we purchased of the Natives 10 or 15 pounds of sweet Potatoes. They have pretty large plantations of these, but at present they are scarce, it being too Early in the Season. At Noon the Bay of Tegadoo bore West 1/2 South, distant 8 Leagues, and a very high double peak'd Mountain some distance in land bore North-West by West. Latitude observed 38 degrees 13 minutes South; Wind at North, a fresh Gale.

Sunday, 22nd. P.M. light breezes and cloudy. Around noon, several locals came to the ship in their canoes and started trading with us. Our crew offered them George's Island cloth for theirs, as they had little else to trade. They seemed to really like this type of exchange at first and preferred the cloth we had from the islands over English cloth, but its value dropped by over 500% by evening. I had some of them aboard and showed them the ship, which they appreciated. The same friendly attitude was noticeable among those on shore, and overall, they behaved better than expected. However, since getting water from the shore was very tedious due to the surf, I decided to leave this place in the morning. So, at 5 a.m., we weighed anchor and set out to sea. This bay is called by the locals Tegadoo; it lies at a latitude of 38 degrees 16 minutes south, but since it has nothing noteworthy, I won’t describe it. There is plenty of wild celery, and we bought 10 to 15 pounds of sweet potatoes from the locals. They have quite large plantations of these, but they're currently scarce since it's too early in the season. At noon, the Bay of Tegadoo was in the direction of West 1/2 South, about 8 leagues away, and a very high double-peaked mountain further inland was to the North-West by West. Latitude observed was 38 degrees 13 minutes south; wind was from the north, a fresh gale.

Monday, 23rd. P.M. fresh Gales at North, and Cloudy weather. At 1 Tack'd and stood in shore; at 6 Sounded, and had 56 fathoms fine sandy bottom; the Bay of Tegadoo bore South-West 1/2 West, distance 4 Leagues. At 8 Tack'd in 36 fathoms, being then about 2 Leagues from land; stood off and on all night, having Gentle breezes. At 8 a.m., being right before the Bay of Tegadoo and about a League from it, some of the Natives came off to us and inform'd us that in a Bay a little to the Southward (being the same that we could not fetch the day we put into Tegadoo) was fresh Water and easey getting at it; and as the wind was now against us, and we gain'd nothing by beating to windward, I thought the time would be better spent in this Bay* (* Tolaga.) in getting on board a little water, and forming some Connections with the Natives, than by keeping the Sea. With this view we bore up for it, and sent 2 Boats in, Mann'd and Arm'd, to Examine the Watering Place, who returned about noon and conform'd the account the Natives had given. We then Anchor'd in 11 fathoms, fine sandy bottom; the North point of the Bay North by East and the South point South-East, and the watering place, which was in a Small Cove a little within the South point of the Bay, distance one Mile.

Monday, 23rd. P.M. Fresh winds from the North and cloudy weather. At 1 PM, we tacked and headed toward the shore; at 6 PM, we took soundings and found 56 fathoms of fine sandy bottom. The Bay of Tegadoo was to the South-West 1/2 West, about 4 leagues away. At 8 PM, we tacked in 36 fathoms, being about 2 leagues from land; we drifted back and forth all night with gentle breezes. At 8 AM, directly off the Bay of Tegadoo and about a league from it, some of the locals came out to us and informed us that there was fresh water easily accessible in a bay just to the south (the same one we couldn’t reach the day we entered Tegadoo). Since the wind was against us and we were gaining nothing by sailing into it, I figured our time would be better spent in this Bay* (*Tolaga.) collecting some fresh water and making connections with the locals than staying at sea. With this in mind, we headed for it and sent 2 armed boats to check out the watering site, which returned around noon and confirmed what the locals had said. We then anchored in 11 fathoms, with fine sandy bottom; the north point of the bay was to the North by East, the south point to the South-East, and the watering site was in a small cove a little past the south point of the bay, about a mile away.

Tuesday, 24th. Winds Westerly and fine weather. This afternoon, as soon as the Ship was moor'd, I went ashore to Examine the watering place, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. I found the Water good and the Place pretty Convenient, and plenty of Wood close to high Water Mark, and the Natives to all appearance not only very friendly but ready to Traffick with us for what little they had. Early in the morning I sent Lieutenant Gore ashore to Superintend the Cutting wood and filling of Water, with a Sufficient number of men for both purposes, and all the Marines as a Guard. After breakfast I went myself, and remain'd there the whole day; but before this Mr. Green and I took several observations of the Sun and Moon. The mean result of them gave 180 degrees 47 minutes West Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich; but as all the observations made before exceeded these, I have laid down this Coast agreeable to the means of the whole. At noon I took the Sun's Meridian Altitude with the Astronomical Quadrant, and found the Latitude 38 degrees 22 minutes 24 seconds South.

Tuesday, 24th. The winds were coming from the west and the weather was nice. This afternoon, as soon as the ship was anchored, I went ashore to check out the watering spot, along with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. I found the water was good, the location quite convenient, and there was plenty of wood close to the high water mark. The locals seemed not only very friendly but also ready to trade with us for what little they had. Early in the morning, I sent Lieutenant Gore ashore to supervise cutting wood and filling water, along with enough men for both tasks, and all the Marines as a guard. After breakfast, I went myself and stayed there the whole day; but before that, Mr. Green and I took several observations of the sun and moon. The average result gave us 180 degrees 47 minutes west longitude from the Greenwich Meridian; however, since all the previous observations were greater than these, I mapped this coastline based on the averages of everything. At noon, I measured the sun's meridian altitude with the astronomical quadrant and found the latitude to be 38 degrees 22 minutes 24 seconds south.

Wednesday, 25th. Winds and weather as Yesterday. P.M. set up the Armourer's Forge to repair the Tiller braces, they being broke. By night we had got on board 12 Tons of Water and two or 3 Boats' loads of Wood, and this I looked upon to be a good day's work. The Natives gave us not the least disturbance, but brought us now and then different sorts of Fish out to the Ship and Watering place, which we purchased of them with Cloth, beads, etc.

Wednesday, 25th. The winds and weather were the same as yesterday. In the afternoon, we set up the armourer's forge to fix the broken tiller braces. By night, we had managed to get onboard 12 tons of water and two or three boatloads of wood, which I considered a productive day. The locals didn’t disturb us at all, but occasionally brought various kinds of fish to the ship and the watering spot, which we bought from them with cloth, beads, and other items.

Thursday, 26th. P.M. had the winds from between the South and South-West, fair weather; the remainder, rainy, dirty weather. Notwithstanding we continued getting on board Wood and Water.

Thursday, 26th. In the afternoon, the winds were coming from the south and southwest, with nice weather; the rest of the time, it was rainy and miserable. Despite that, we kept loading wood and water.

Friday, 27th. Winds at South-West; first part rainy weather, the remainder fair. A.M. sent the Pinnace to drudge, but she met with no success; after this, I went and sounded the Bay. I made a Shift to land in 2 Places, the first time in the bottom of the bay, where I went a little way into the Country, but met with nothing extraordinary. The other place I landed at was at the North point of the Bay, where I got as much Sellery and Scurvy grass as loaded the Boat. This day we compleated our Water to 70 Tons, but not wood Enough.

Friday, 27th. Winds from the South-West; the morning was rainy, but the rest of the day was clear. In the morning, I sent the small boat to work, but it didn't have any luck. After that, I went to check the Bay. I managed to land in two places; the first was at the bottom of the bay, where I walked a bit into the countryside but found nothing special. The second place I landed was at the North point of the Bay, where I collected enough celery and scurvy grass to fill the boat. By the end of the day, we had filled our water supply to 70 tons, but we didn’t have enough wood.

Saturday, 28th. Gentle breezes Southerly and fine weather. Employ'd wooding, cutting, and making of Brooms, there being a Shrub here very fit for that purpose; and as I intended to sail in the morning some hands were employ'd picking of Sellery to take to Sea with us. This is found here in great plenty, and I have caused it to be boiled with Portable Soup and Oatmeal every morning for the people's breakfast; and this I design to continue as long as it will last, or any is to be got, and I look upon it to be very wholesome and a great Antiscorbutick.

Saturday, 28th. There were gentle southern breezes and nice weather. I spent the day gathering firewood, cutting, and making brooms, as there’s a shrub here that's perfect for that. Since I planned to set sail in the morning, some people were picking celery to take with us. There's plenty of it here, and I've had it boiled with portable soup and oatmeal every morning for the crew’s breakfast. I intend to keep this up as long as we have it or can get more, as I think it's very nutritious and a great way to prevent scurvy.

[At Tolaga Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[At Tolaga Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

Monday, 29th. P.M. Gentle breezes with Thunder and Lightning up the Country; in the night had light Airs off the land and very foggy; in the forenoon had a gentle breeze at North-North-East and Clear weather. At 4 a.m. unmoor'd, and at 6 weigh'd and put to Sea. At Noon the bay sail'd from bore North 63 degrees West, distant 4 Leagues. This bay is called by the Natives Tolaga;* (* It still goes by this name.) it is moderately large, and hath in it from 13 to 8 and 7 fathoms, clean sandy bottom and good Anchorage, and is shelterd from all winds except those that blow from the North-East Quarter. It lies in the Latitude of 38 degrees 22 minutes South, and 4 1/2 Leagues to the Northward of Gable end Foreland. Off the South point lies a small but high Island, so near to the Main as not to be distinguished from it. Close to the North end of this Island, at the Entrance into the Bay, are 2 high Rocks; one is high and round like a Corn Stack, but the other is long with holes thro' it like the Arches of a Bridge. Within these rocks is the Cove, where we cut wood and fill'd our Water. Off the North point of the Bay is a pretty high rocky Island, and about a Mile without it are some rocks and breakers. The variation of the Compass is here 14 degrees 31 minutes East, and the Tide flows at full and change of the Moon about 6 o'Clock, and rises and falls upon a Perpendicular 5 or 6 feet, but wether the flood comes from the Southward or Northward I have not been able to determine.

Monday, 29th. P.M. There were gentle breezes with thunder and lightning inland; during the night, we had light winds coming from the land and it was very foggy. In the morning, there was a gentle breeze blowing from the North-North-East and clear weather. At 4 a.m., we unmoored, and at 6 a.m., we weighed anchor and set out to sea. By noon, the bay was located at North 63 degrees West, about 4 leagues away. The natives call this bay Tolaga;* (*It still goes by this name.) it’s moderately large and has depths ranging from 7 to 13 fathoms, with a clean sandy bottom and good anchorage, sheltered from all winds except those coming from the northeast. It’s situated at a latitude of 38 degrees 22 minutes South, and 4 1/2 leagues north of Gable End Foreland. Off the south point, there’s a small but high island, so close to the mainland that it’s hard to distinguish between the two. Near the north end of this island, at the mouth of the bay, there are two tall rocks; one is high and round like a haystack, while the other is long and has holes through it like the arches of a bridge. Inside these rocks is the cove where we cut wood and filled our water. Off the north point of the bay, there’s a fairly high rocky island, and about a mile beyond it are some rocks and breakers. The compass variation here is 14 degrees 31 minutes East, and the tide flows during full and new moons around 6 o'clock, rising and falling about 5 to 6 feet perpendicularly, but I have not been able to determine whether the flood comes from the south or north.

During our stay in this bay we had every day more or less Traffick with the Natives, they bringing us fish, and now and then a few sweet Potatoes and several trifles which we deemd Curiosities; for these we gave them Cloth, Beads, Nails, etc. The Cloth we got at King George's Island and Ulietea, they valued more than anything we could give them, and as every one in the Ship were provided with some of this sort of Cloth, I suffer'd every body to purchase what ever they pleased without limitation; for by this means I knew that the Natives would not only sell but get a good Price for every thing they brought. This I thought would induce them to bring to Market whatever the Country afforded, and I have great reason to think that they did, yet it amounted to no more than what is above mentioned. We saw no 4 footed Animals, either Tame or Wild, or signs of any, except Dogs and Rats,* (* Cook's powers of observation are here evident. There were no other quadrupeds in New Zealand.) and these were very Scarce, especially the latter. The flesh of the former they eat, and ornament their clothing with their skins as we do ours with furs, etc. While we lay here I went upon some of the Hills in order to View the Country, but when I came there I could see but very little of it, the sight being interrupted by still higher hills. The Tops and ridges of the Hills are for the most part barren, at least little grows on them but fern; but the Valleys and sides of many of the Hills were luxuriously clothed with woods and Verdure and little Plantations of the Natives lying dispers'd up and down the Country. We found in the Woods, Trees of above 20 different sorts; Specimens of each I took on board, as all of them were unknown to any of us. The Tree which we cut for firing was something like Maple and yeilded a whitish Gum. There was another sort of a deep Yellow which we imagin'd might prove useful in dying. We likewise found one Cabage Tree* (* Palm.) which we cut down for the sake of the cabage. The Country abounds with a great Number of Plants, and the woods with as great a variety of beautiful birds, many of them unknown to us. The soil of both the hills and Valleys is light and sandy, and very proper for producing all kinds of Roots, but we saw only sweet potatoes and Yams among them; these they plant in little round hills, and have plantations of them containing several Acres neatly laid out and keept in good order, and many of them are fenced in with low paling which can only serve for Ornament.

During our time in this bay, we interacted with the locals almost every day. They brought us fish, and occasionally some sweet potatoes and other small items that we considered curiosities. In exchange, we gave them cloth, beads, nails, and more. The cloth we obtained from King George's Island and Ulietea was highly valued by them, more than anything else we offered. Since everyone on the ship had access to this type of cloth, I let everyone buy whatever they wanted without any restrictions. I figured this would encourage the locals to sell and get a fair price for everything they brought. I believed this would motivate them to offer whatever the land had to offer, and I have good reason to think they did, but it amounted to no more than what I've mentioned. We did not see any four-footed animals, tame or wild, or any signs of them, except for dogs and rats, which were quite rare, especially the latter. They ate the dogs' meat and used their skins for clothing, much like we do with furs. While we were here, I climbed some hills to look at the country, but when I reached the top, my view was blocked by even taller hills. The tops and ridges of the hills were mostly barren, with little more than ferns growing on them, but the valleys and sides of many hills were lush with forests and greenery, along with small plantations of the locals scattered across the land. We found over 20 different types of trees in the woods, and I collected samples of each since none were familiar to us. The tree we used for firewood resembled maple and produced a whitish gum. There was also another type with deep yellow wood that we thought might be useful for dyeing. We also found one cabbage tree, which is a type of palm, that we cut down for the cabbage. The area was rich in various plants, and the woods were home to many beautiful birds, many of which were unknown to us. The soil in both the hills and valleys was light and sandy, very suitable for growing all kinds of roots, but we only saw sweet potatoes and yams. They planted these in small round hills, creating plantations that spanned several acres, all neatly organized and well-maintained, with many enclosed by low fences that served mainly as decoration.

Monday, 30th. P.M. little wind and cloudy weather. At 1 Tack'd and stood in shore; at 7 o'Clock Tolaga Bay bore West-North-West, distant one League. Tack'd and lay her head off; had it calm until 2 a.m., when a breeze sprung up at South-West, and we made Sail to the Northward. At 6, Gable end Foreland bore South-South-West, and Tolaga bay South-South-West 1/4 West, distance 3 Leagues. At 8, being about 2 Miles from the shore, some Canoes that were fishing came after the Ship; but we having a fresh of wind they could not come up with us, and I did not chuse to wait for them. At Noon, Latitude per observation 37 degrees 49 minutes South, a small Island lying off the Northernmost land in sight, bore North 16 degrees East, distant 4 Miles; course from Tolaga bay North by East 1/2 East, distance 13 Leagues. The Land from thence is of a moderate but unequal height, forming several small bays wherein are sandy beaches. Hazey, cloudy weather prevented us from seeing much of the inland country, but near the Shore we could see several Villages and Plantations of the Natives. Soundings from 20 to 30 fathoms.

Monday, 30th. P.M. There was a slight wind and cloudy weather. At 1, we tacked and headed towards the shore; at 7 o'clock, Tolaga Bay was to the West-North-West, one league away. We tacked and pointed our bow out to sea; it was calm until 2 a.m. when a breeze picked up from the South-West, and we set sail northward. By 6, Gable End Foreland was to the South-South-West, and Tolaga Bay was South-South-West 1/4 West, three leagues away. At 8, about 2 miles from shore, some fishing canoes came after the ship, but with the fresh wind, they couldn't catch up, and I didn’t want to wait for them. At noon, our latitude by observation was 37 degrees 49 minutes South, and a small island off the northernmost land in sight was North 16 degrees East, 4 miles away; our course from Tolaga Bay was North by East 1/2 East, 13 leagues away. The land from there is of moderate but uneven height, forming several small bays with sandy beaches. Hazy, cloudy weather made it hard to see much of the inland area, but near the shore, we could see several villages and plantations belonging to the natives. Depths ranged from 20 to 30 fathoms.

[Off Cape Runaway, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Cape Runaway, North Island, New Zealand.]

Tuesday, 31st. At half-past one p.m. hauled round the Island above mentioned, which lies East 1 Mile from the North-East point of the land. The lands from hence Trends North-West by West, and West-North-West, as far as we could see. This point of Land I have called East Cape, because I have great reason to think that it is the Eastermost land on this whole Coast; and for the same reason I have called the Island which lays off it, East Island. It is but of a small circuit, high and round, and appears white and barren. The Cape is of a moderate height with white cliffs, and lies in the Latitude of 37 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds South, and Longitude 181 degrees 00 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich. After we had rounded the East Cape we saw, as we run along shore, a great number of Villages and a great deal of Cultivated land; and in general the country appear'd with more fertility than what we had seen before; it was low near the Sea, but hilly inland. At 8, being 8 leagues to the Westward of Cape East, and 3 or 4 miles from the shore, shortned sail and brought too for the night, having at this Time a fresh Gale at South-South-East and squally weather; but it soon fell moderate, and at 2 a.m. made Sail again to the South-West as the land now Trended. At 8 saw land which made like an Island bearing West. At the same time the South-Westermost part of the Main bore South-West. At 9, five Canoes came off to us, in one of which were upwards of 40 Men all Arm'd with Pikes, etc.; from this and other Circumstances it fully appear'd that they came with no friendly intentions; and I at this Time being very buisey, and had no inclination to stay upon deck to watch their Motions, I order'd a Grape shot to be fir'd a little wide of them. This made them pull off a little, and then they got together either to consult what to do or to look about them. Upon this I order'd a round shott to be fir'd over their heads, which frightend them to that degree that I believe they did not think themselves safe until they got ashore. This occasion'd our calling the Point of land off which this hapned, Cape Runaway. Latitude 37 degrees 32 minutes South, longitude 181 degrees 50 minutes West, and 17 or 18 Leagues to the Westward of East Cape. 4 Leagues to the Westward of East Cape is a bay which I have named Hicks's bay, because Lieutenant Hicks was the first who discover'd it.

Tuesday, 31st. At 1:30 p.m., we sailed around the aforementioned island, which is located one mile east from the northeast point of the land. The land from here trends northwest by west and west-northwest as far as we could see. I named this point of land East Cape because I have strong reason to believe it’s the easternmost land along this entire coast; for the same reason, I called the island off it East Island. It has a small circumference, is high and round, and appears white and barren. The cape has a moderate height with white cliffs and is located at a latitude of 37 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds south and a longitude of 181 degrees 00 minutes west from the Greenwich Meridian. After rounding East Cape, we saw plenty of villages and a lot of cultivated land as we moved along the shore. Overall, the countryside looked more fertile than what we had seen before; it was low near the sea but hilly inland. At 8, being 8 leagues west of East Cape and 3 or 4 miles from the shore, we shortened sail and stopped for the night, having at that time a fresh gale from the south-southeast and squally weather; however, it soon calmed down, and at 2 a.m., we set sail again to the southwest as the land now trended. At 8, we spotted land that looked like an island to the west. At the same time, the southwesternmost part of the mainland was to the southwest. At 9, five canoes approached us, one of which carried over 40 armed men with pikes, etc.; from this and other circumstances, it was clear they didn’t come with friendly intentions. I was busy at the time and wasn't keen on staying on deck to watch their movements, so I ordered a grape shot to be fired a little wide of them. This made them pull back somewhat, and then they gathered together to either discuss their next move or to assess the situation. I then ordered a round shot to be fired over their heads, which scared them so much that I believe they didn't feel safe until they reached the shore. This incident led us to name the point of land where this happened Cape Runaway, located at latitude 37 degrees 32 minutes south and longitude 181 degrees 50 minutes west, and 17 or 18 leagues to the west of East Cape. Four leagues to the west of East Cape is a bay that I named Hicks's Bay because Lieutenant Hicks was the first to discover it.

[November 1769.]

[November 1769.]

Wednesday, 1st November. P.M., as we stood along shore (having little wind, and Variable), we saw a great deal of Cultivated land laid out in regular inclosures, a sure sign that the Country is both fertile and well inhabited. Some Canoes came off from the shore, but would not come near the Ship. At 8 brought to 3 Miles from the Shore, the land seen yesterday bearing West, and which we now saw was an Island, bore South-West,* (* This should evidently be North-West.) distant 8 leagues. I have named it White Island,* (* White Island is an active volcano. It was evidently quiescent at the time of the Endeavour passing.) because as such it always appear'd to us. At 5 a.m. made Sail along shore to the South-West, having little wind at East-South-East and Cloudy weather. At 8 saw between 40 and 50 Canoes in shore. Several of them came off to the Ship, and being about us some time they ventur'd alongside and sold us some Lobsters, Muscels, and 2 Conger Eales. After these were gone some others came off from another place with Muscels only, and but few of these they thought proper to part with, thinking they had a right to everything we handed them into their Canoes without making any return. At last the People in one Canoe took away some linnen that was towing over the side, which they would not return for all that we could say to them. Upon this I fir'd a Musket Ball thro' the Canoe, and after that another musquet load with Small Shott, neither of which they minded, only pulled off a little, and then shook their paddles at us, at which I fir'd a third Musquet; and the ball, striking the Water pretty near them, they immediately apply'd their Paddles to another use; but after they thought themselves out of reach they got altogether, and Shook their Paddles again at us. I then gave the Ship a Yaw, and fir'd a 4 Pounder. This sent them quite off, and we keept on our course along shore, having a light breeze at East-South-East. At noon we were in the Latitude of 37 degrees 55 minutes, White Island bearing North 29 degrees West, distant 8 Leagues.

Wednesday, November 1. In the afternoon, while we were standing along the shore (with little wind and variable conditions), we noticed a lot of cultivated land arranged in neat fences, which is a clear sign that the area is fertile and well-populated. Some canoes came off from the shore but didn’t get close to the ship. At 8, we anchored 3 miles from the shore, with the land we saw yesterday to the west—which we now realized was an island—bearing southwest, about 8 leagues away. I named it White Island, since it always appeared that way to us. At 5 a.m., we set sail along the shore to the southwest, with a light breeze coming from the east-southeast and cloudy weather. At 8, we spotted between 40 and 50 canoes along the shore. Several came out to the ship, and after spending some time around us, they ventured alongside and sold us some lobsters, mussels, and 2 conger eels. Once they left, some others came from another place with only a few mussels, thinking they had the right to keep everything we handed them without giving us anything in return. Eventually, the people in one canoe took away some linen that was trailing over the side and wouldn’t give it back, no matter what we said. In response, I fired a musket ball through their canoe, followed by another musket shot with small shot. Neither registered with them; they just moved a little away and then shook their paddles at us. So, I fired a third musket; the ball struck the water nearby, and they quickly changed their paddling style. But once they thought they were out of range, they gathered together and shook their paddles again. I then turned the ship slightly and fired a 4-pound cannon, which drove them completely off. We continued on our course along the shore with a light breeze at east-southeast. At noon, we were at latitude 37 degrees 55 minutes, with White Island bearing north 29 degrees west, 8 leagues away.

Thursday, 2nd. Gentle breezes from North-West round Northerly to East-South-East and fair weather. At 2 p.m. saw a pretty high Island bearing West from us, and at 5 saw more Islands and Rocks to the Westward of it. Hauld our wind in order to go without them, but, finding that we could not weather them before dark, bore up, and run between them and the Main. At 7 was close under the first Island, from whence a large double Canoe full of People came off to us. This was the first double Canoe we had seen in this Country. They staid about the Ship until it was dark, then left us; but not before they had thrown a few stones. They told us the name of the Island, which was Mowtohora.* (* Motuhora, called also Whale Island.) It is but of a small Circuit, but high, and lies 6 Miles from the Main. Under the South side is Anchorage in 14 fathoms. South-West by South from this Island on the Main land, seemingly at no great distance from the Sea, is a high round Mountain, which I have named Mount Edgcombe. It stands in the middle of a large Plain, which make it the more Conspicuous. Latitude 37 degrees 59 minutes South, Longitude 183 degrees 07 minutes West. In standing to the Westward we Shoalded our Water from 17 to 10 fathoms, and knowing that we were not far from some Small Islands and Rocks that we had seen before dark, after Passing of which I intended to have brought too for the night, but I now thought it more prudent to tack, and spend the Night under the Island of Mowtohora, where I knew there was no danger. And it was well we did, for in the morning, after we had made Sail to the Westward, we discovered Rocks ahead of us Level with and under the Water.* (* Rurima Rocks.) They lay 1 1/2 Leagues from the Island Mowtohora, and about 9 Miles from the Main, and North-North-East from Mount Edgecumbe. We passed between these Rocks and the Main, having from 7 to 10 fathoms. The double Canoe which we saw last night follow'd us to-day under Sail, and keept abreast of the Ship near an hour talking to Tupia, but at last they began to pelt us with stones. But upon firing one Musquet they dropt aStern and left us. At 1/2 past 10 Passed between a low flat Island and the Main, the distance from one to the other being 4 Miles; depth of Water 10, 12, and 15 fathoms. At Noon the flat Island* (* Motunau.) bore from North-East to East 1/2 North, distance 5 or 6 Miles; Latitude in per Observation 37 degrees 39 minutes South, Longitude 183 degrees 30 minutes West. The Main land between this and the Island of Mowtohara, which is 10 Leagues, is of a moderate height, and all a level, flat Country, pretty clear of wood and full of Plantations and Villiages. These Villiages are built upon Eminences Near the Sea, and are Fortified on the land side with a Bank and a Ditch, and Pallisaded all round. Besides this, some of them appear'd to have out-works. We have before now observed, on several parts of the Coast, small Villiages inclosed with Pallisades and works of this kind built on Eminences and Ridges of hills, but Tupia had all along told us that they were Mories, or places of worship; but I rather think they are places of retreat or strong hold where they defend themselves against the Attack of an Enemy, as some of them seem'd not ill design'd for that Purpose.* (* In the contests with the Maories in after years, these Pahs, or forts, proved to be no despicable defences.)

Thursday, 2nd. There were gentle breezes coming from the Northwest, shifting to the North and then to the East-Southeast, with nice weather. At 2 p.m., we spotted a fairly tall island to the West, and by 5 p.m., we saw more islands and rocks to the West of it. We adjusted our course to avoid them, but realizing we wouldn't get past before dark, we decided to head between them and the mainland. By 7 p.m., we were close to the first island, where a large double canoe filled with people came out to meet us. This was the first double canoe we had seen in this country. They stayed with us until it got dark, then left after throwing a few stones. They told us the island was called Mowtohora.* (* Motuhora, also known as Whale Island.) It’s not very large but is high and sits 6 miles from the mainland. There’s anchorage on the South side in 14 fathoms. South-West by South from this island on the mainland, not far from the sea, there's a tall round mountain that I named Mount Edgcombe. It stands in a large plain, making it quite noticeable. Latitude 37 degrees 59 minutes South, Longitude 183 degrees 07 minutes West. While heading West, our water depth decreased from 17 to 10 fathoms, and knowing we were close to some small islands and rocks we had seen before dark, I initially planned to stop for the night after passing them. However, I thought it would be smarter to tack and spend the night under Mowtohora, where it was safe. It turned out to be a good decision because in the morning, after setting sail Westward, we discovered rocks ahead that were level with and just below the water.* (* Rurima Rocks.) They were 1.5 leagues from Mowtohora and about 9 miles from the mainland, located North-North-East of Mount Edgcombe. We navigated between these rocks and the mainland, with depths ranging from 7 to 10 fathoms. The double canoe we saw last night followed us today, staying alongside the ship for nearly an hour while chatting with Tupia, but then they started throwing stones at us. After firing a musket, they retreated and left us. At 10:30, we passed between a low flat island and the mainland, which were 4 miles apart; the water depth was 10, 12, and 15 fathoms. At noon, the flat island* (* Motunau.) was bearing from North-East to East 1/2 North, about 5 or 6 miles away; latitude based on our observation was 37 degrees 39 minutes South, longitude 183 degrees 30 minutes West. The mainland between this and Mowtohara, which is 10 leagues away, is of moderate height, all flat land, mostly clear of trees and filled with plantations and villages. These villages are built on elevated ground near the sea and are fortified on the land side with a bank and ditch, completely surrounded by palisades. Additionally, some appeared to have outworks. We've previously noted small villages enclosed by palisades along various parts of the coast, positioned on hills and ridges, but Tupia had consistently said these were 'mories' or places of worship. However, I believe they are likely strongholds or retreats where the inhabitants defend themselves against enemies, as some seemed well designed for that purpose.* (* In later conflicts with the Maoris, these 'Pahs,' or forts, proved to be formidable defenses.)

[In Bay of Plenty, North Island, New Zealand.]

[In Bay of Plenty, North Island, New Zealand.]

Friday, 3rd. P.M. Fresh Gales at North-East by East and hazey weather. At 2 pass'd a small high Island lying 4 Miles from a high round head on the Main* (* The island was Moliti; the high round head was Maunganui, which marks the entrance to Tauranga harbour, a good port, where now stands a small town of the same name.) from this head the land Trends North-West as far as we could see, and appeared to be very rugged and hilly. The weather being very hazey, and the Wind blowing fresh on shore, we hauled off close upon a wind for the weathermost Island in sight, which bore from us North-North-East, distant 6 or 7 Leagues. Under this Island we spent the Night, having a fresh gale at North-East and North-East by East, and hazey weather with rain; this Island I have called the Mayor. At 7 a.m. it bore South 47 degrees East, distant 6 Leagues, and a Cluster of small Islands and Rocks bore North 1/2 East, distant one League. At the time had a Gentle breeze at East-North-East and clear weather. The Cluster of Islands and Rocks just mentioned we named the Court of Aldermen; they lay in the Compass of about half a League every way, and 5 Leagues from the Main, between which and them lay other Islands. The most of them are barren rocks, and of these there is a very great Variety, some of them are of as small a Compass as the Monument in London, and Spire up to a much greater height; they lay in the Latitude of 36 degrees 57 minutes, and some of them are inhabited. At Noon they bore South 60 degrees East, distant 3 or 4 Leagues, and a Rock like a Castle lying not far from the Main, bore North 40 degrees West, one League. Latitude observed 36 degrees 58 minutes South; Course and distance since Yesterday noon is North-North-West 1/2 West, about 20 Leagues. In this Situation had 28 fathoms water, and a great many small Islands and Rocks on every side of us. The Main land appears here with a hilly, rugged, and barren surface, no Plantations to be seen, nor no other signs of its being well inhabited.

Friday, 3rd. P.M. Strong winds from North-East by East and hazy weather. At 2, we passed a small high island located 4 miles from a high rounded head on the mainland (*The island was Moliti; the high rounded head was Maunganui, marking the entrance to Tauranga harbour, a good port, where a small town of the same name now stands*). From this head, the land trends North-West as far as we could see and looked very rugged and hilly. With the weather being quite hazy and the wind blowing strongly onshore, we sailed off close to the wind towards the northernmost island in sight, which was bearing from us North-North-East, about 6 or 7 leagues away. We spent the night under this island, facing a strong gale from the North-East and North-East by East, along with hazy weather and rain; I named this island the Mayor. At 7 a.m., it was positioned South 47 degrees East, 6 leagues away, and a cluster of small islands and rocks was at North 1/2 East, 1 league away. At that time, we had a gentle breeze from East-North-East and clear weather. The cluster of islands and rocks mentioned earlier was named the Court of Aldermen; they spread about half a league in every direction and were located 5 leagues from the mainland, with other islands between them. Most of these are barren rocks, and they come in a great variety, some as small as the Monument in London, but rising to much greater heights; they lie at a latitude of 36 degrees 57 minutes, and some are inhabited. At noon, they were positioned South 60 degrees East, 3 or 4 leagues away, and a rock resembling a castle, not far from the mainland, was at North 40 degrees West, 1 league away. Latitude observed was 36 degrees 58 minutes South; since yesterday noon, we’ve traveled North-North-West 1/2 West, about 20 leagues. In this location, we had 28 fathoms of water, surrounded by numerous small islands and rocks. The mainland here appears hilly, rugged, and barren, with no signs of plantations or any indication of being well inhabited.

Saturday, 4th. The first and middle parts, little wind at East-North-East and Clear weather; the Latter had a fresh breeze at North-North-West and hazey with rain. At 1 p.m. 3 Canoes came off from the Main to the Ship, and after Parading about a little while they darted 2 Pikes at us. The first was at one of our Men as he was going to give them a rope, thinking they were coming on board; but the 2nd they throw'd into the Ship; the firing of one musquet sent them away. Each of these Canoes were made out of one large Tree, and were without any sort of Ornament, and the people in them were mostly quite naked. At 2 p.m. saw a large op'ning or inlet in the land, which we bore up for with an intent to come to an Anchor. At this time had 41 fathoms, which gradually decreased to 9 fathoms, at which time we were 1 1/2 Mile from a high Tower'd Rock lying near the South point of the inlet; the rock and the Northermost of the Court of Aldermen being in one bearing South 61 degrees East. At 1/2 past 7 Anchor'd in 7 Fathoms a little within the South Entrance of the Bay or inlet. We were accompanied in here by several Canoes, who stay'd about the Ship until dark; and before they went away they were so generous as to tell us that they would come and attack us in the morning; but some of them paid us a Visit in the night, thinking, no doubt, but what they should find all hands asleep, but as soon as they found their Mistake they went off. My reasons for putting in here were the hopes of discovering a good Harbour, and the desire I had of being in some convenient place to observe the Transit of Mercury, which happens on the 9th Instant, and will be wholy Visible here if the day is clear. If we be so fortunate as to obtain this observation, the Longitude of this place and Country will thereby be very accurately determined. Between 5 and 6 o'Clock in the morning several Canoes came off to us from all parts of the Bay; in them were about 130 or 140 People. To all appearances their first design was to attack us, being all Completely Arm'd in their way; however, this they never attempted, but after Parading about the Ship near 3 Hours, sometimes trading with us, and at other times Tricking of us, they dispersed; but not before we had fir'd a few Musquets and one great gun, not with any design to hurt any of them, but to shew them what sort of Weapons we had, and that we could revenge any insult they offer'd to us. It was observable that they paid but little regard to the Musquets that were fir'd, notwithstanding one ball was fir'd thro' one of their Canoes, but what Effect the great gun had I know not, for this was not fir'd until they were going away.

Saturday, 4th. The morning and afternoon were mostly clear with a light wind from the East-North-East; the evening brought a fresh breeze from the North-North-West and was hazy with rain. At 1 p.m., three canoes approached the ship from the main land, and after circling around for a bit, they threw two spears at us. The first was aimed at one of our men who was about to give them a rope, thinking they intended to come on board; the second spear was thrown into the ship. The discharge of one musket sent them fleeing. Each canoe was carved from a single large tree, lacking any decoration, and the people in them were mostly completely naked. At 2 p.m., we spotted a large opening or inlet along the shore, which we headed towards to anchor. At that moment, we measured 41 fathoms, which gradually decreased to 9 fathoms; at that point, we were 1.5 miles from a tall, tower-like rock near the south end of the inlet, with the rock and the northernmost part of the Council’s area bearing South 61 degrees East. At 7:30 p.m., we anchored in 7 fathoms just inside the south entrance of the bay or inlet. We were joined here by several canoes that lingered around the ship until dark; before leaving, they generously informed us that they planned to attack us in the morning. However, some of them visited us during the night, likely thinking we would all be asleep, but as soon as they realized their mistake, they left. My reasons for coming here were the hope of finding a good harbor and the desire to be in a convenient spot to observe the Transit of Mercury, which occurs on the 9th and will be fully visible here if the day is clear. If we are fortunate to make this observation, we can accurately determine the longitude of this location and country. Between 5 and 6 o'clock in the morning, several canoes came off to us from all over the bay, carrying about 130 or 140 people. It seemed their initial intent was to attack us, as they were all fully armed in their own way; however, they never attempted this. Instead, after circling the ship for nearly three hours, sometimes trading with us and other times tricking us, they eventually scattered. But not before we fired a few muskets and one cannon, not intending to harm them but to demonstrate the kind of weapons we had, and that we could retaliate if they insulted us. It was notable that they paid little attention to the musket fire, despite one bullet hitting one of their canoes, but I don't know what effect the cannon had, as that was not fired until they were leaving.

[At Mercury Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[At Mercury Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

At 10, the weather Clearing up a little, I went with 2 Boats to sound the Bay and to look for a more convenient Anchoring place, the Master being in one Boat, and I in the other. We pull'd first over the North Shore, where some Canoes came out to meet us, but as we came near them they retir'd to the Shore and invited us to follow them, but seeing they were all Arm'd I did not think fit to Except of their Invitation; but after Trading with them out of the Boat for a few Minutes we left them and went towards the head of the Bay. I observed on a high Point a fortified Village, but I could only see a part of the works, and as I intend to see the whole, shall say no more about it at this time. After having fix'd upon an Anchoring place not far from where the Ship lay I return'd on board.

At 10, the weather cleared up a bit, so I went out with two boats to explore the bay and search for a better spot to anchor. The captain was in one boat, and I was in the other. We first paddled across the North Shore, where some canoes came out to meet us, but as we got closer, they retreated to the shore and invited us to follow them. However, seeing that they were all armed, I didn’t think it was wise to accept their invitation. After trading with them from the boat for a few minutes, we left them and headed toward the head of the bay. I noticed a fortified village on a high point, but I could only see part of the defenses, and since I plan to check it out more thoroughly, I won’t say more about it now. After finding a good anchoring spot not far from where the ship was, I returned onboard.

Sunday, 5th. Winds at North-North-West, Hazey weather with rain in the night. At 4 p.m. weigh'd and run in nearer the South shore and Anchor'd in 4 1/2 fathoms, a soft sandy bottom, the South point of the Bay bearing East, distant 1 Mile, and a River (into which the boats can go at low Water) South-South-East, distant 1 1/2 Miles.* (* The bight in which the Endeavour anchored is now known as Cook Bay.) In the morning the Natives came off again to the Ship, but their behaviour was very different to what it was Yesterday morning, and the little traffick we had with them was carried on very fair and friendly. Two came on board the Ship--to each I gave a Piece of English Cloth and some Spike Nails. After the Natives were gone I went with the Pinnace and Long boat into the River to haul the Sean, and sent the Master to sound the Bay and drudge for fish in the Yawl. We hauled the Sean in several places in the River, but caught only a few Mullet, with which we returned on board about Noon.

Sunday, 5th. The winds were coming from North-North-West, with hazy weather and rain during the night. At 4 p.m., we weighed anchor and moved closer to the South shore, anchoring in 4.5 fathoms on a soft sandy bottom. The South point of the Bay was to the East, about 1 mile away, and a river (that boats can access at low tide) was located South-South-East, about 1.5 miles away.* (* The area where the Endeavour anchored is now called Cook Bay.) In the morning, the natives came to the ship again, but their behavior was very different from what it had been yesterday morning. The little trade we had with them was carried out in a friendly manner. Two came on board the ship; I gave each of them a piece of English cloth and some spike nails. After the natives left, I took the pinnace and longboat into the river to haul the seine and sent the master in the yawl to sound the bay and try to catch fish. We hauled the seine in several spots in the river but only caught a few mullet, which we brought back on board around noon.

Monday, 6th. Moderate breezes at North-North-West, and hazey weather with rain in the night. P.M. I went to another part of the Bay to haul the Sean, but meet with as little Success as before; and the Master did not get above 1/2 a Bucket full of Shells with the Drudge. The Natives brought to the Ship, and sold to our People, small Cockles, Clams, and Mussels, enough for all hands. These are found in great plenty upon the Sand Banks of the River. In the morning I sent the Long boat to Trawl in the Bay, and one Officer with the Marines and a party of men to Cut wood and haul the Sean, but neither the Sean nor the Trawl meet with any success; but the Natives in some measure made up for this by bringing several Baskets of dry'd or ready dress'd fish; altho' it was none of the best I order'd it all to be bought up in order to encourage them to Trade.

Monday, 6th. There were moderate breezes coming from the North-North-West, along with hazy weather and rain during the night. In the afternoon, I went to another part of the Bay to haul the seine, but had just as little success as before; the Master only managed to collect about half a bucket full of shells with the drag. The Natives came to the ship and sold our crew small cockles, clams, and mussels, enough for everyone. These are found in abundance on the sandbanks of the river. In the morning, I sent the longboat to trawl in the bay, along with one officer, Marines, and a group of men to cut wood and haul the seine, but neither the seine nor the trawl were successful. However, the Natives partially made up for this by bringing several baskets of dried or prepared fish; although it wasn’t the best quality, I had it all purchased to encourage them to trade.

Tuesday, 7th. The first part moderate and fair; the remainder a fresh breeze, northerly, with dirty, hazey, raining Weather. P.M. got on board a Long boat Load of Water, and Caught a dish of fish in the Sean. Found here a great Quantity of Sellery, which is boild every day for the Ship's Company as usual.

Tuesday, 7th. The first part was moderate and clear; the rest of the day brought a strong north wind, with dirty, hazy, rainy weather. In the afternoon, we loaded a long boat with water and caught a good amount of fish in the sea. We also found a large quantity of celery, which is boiled daily for the crew as usual.

Wednesday, 8th. P.M. fresh breeze at North-North-West and hazey, rainy weather; the remainder a Gentle breeze at West-South-West and Clear Weather. A.M. heeld and Scrubb'd both sides of the Ship and Sent a Party of Men ashore to Cutt wood and fill Water. The Natives brought off to the Ship, and Sold us for Small pieces of Cloth, as much fish as served all hands; they were of the Mackrell kind, and as good as ever was Eat. At Noon I observ'd the Sun's Meridian Zenith distance, by the Astronomical Quadrant, which gave the Latitude 36 degrees 47 minutes 43 seconds South; this was in the River before mentioned, that lies within the South Entrance of the Bay.

Wednesday, 8th. P.M. There was a fresh breeze from the North-North-West and hazy, rainy weather; the rest of the time, a gentle breeze from the West-South-West and clear skies. A.M. we heeled and scrubbed both sides of the ship and sent a group of men ashore to cut wood and fill water. The natives brought fish to the ship and sold us as much as we needed for small pieces of cloth; they were of the mackerel kind, and as good as any I've ever eaten. At noon, I observed the sun's meridian zenith distance with the astronomical quadrant, which gave a latitude of 36 degrees 47 minutes 43 seconds South; this was in the river mentioned earlier, located within the south entrance of the bay.

Thursday, 9th. Variable light breezes and Clear weather. As soon as it was daylight the Natives began to bring off Mackrell, and more than we well know what to do with; notwithstanding I order'd all they brought to be purchased in order to encourage them in this kind of Traffick. At 8, Mr. Green and I went on shore with our Instruments to observe the Transit of Mercury, which came on at 7 hours 20 minutes 58 seconds Apparent time, and was observed by Mr. Green only.* (* Mr. Green satirically remarks in his Log, "Unfortunately for the seamen, their look-out was on the wrong side of the sun." This probably refers to Mr. Hicks, who was also observing. It rather seems, however, as if Cook, on this occasion, was caught napping by an earlier appearance of the planet than was expected.) I, at this time, was taking the Sun's Altitude in order to Ascertain the time. The Egress was observed as follows:--

Thursday, 9th. There were light breezes and clear weather. As soon as it got light, the locals started bringing stuff for trade, and they brought more than we knew what to do with; even so, I instructed that everything they brought be bought to encourage them in this type of trade. At 8, Mr. Green and I went ashore with our instruments to observe the transit of Mercury, which occurred at 7 hours, 20 minutes, and 58 seconds apparent time, and was only observed by Mr. Green.* (* Mr. Green sarcastically notes in his log, "Unfortunately for the sailors, their look-out was on the wrong side of the sun." This likely refers to Mr. Hicks, who was also observing. However, it seems that Cook, this time, was caught off guard by the planet appearing earlier than expected.) At that moment, I was measuring the Sun's altitude to determine the time. The egress was observed as follows:--

By Mr. Green: Internal Contact at 12 hours 8 minutes 58 seconds Afternoon. External Contact at 12 hours 9 minutes 55 seconds Afternoon.

By Mr. Green: Internal Contact at 12:08:58 PM. External Contact at 12:09:55 PM.

By myself: Internal Contact at 12 hours 8 minutes 45 seconds Afternoon. External Contact at 12 hours 9 minutes 43 seconds Afternoon.

By myself: Internal Contact at 12:08:45 PM. External Contact at 12:09:43 PM.

Latitude observed at noon 36 degrees 48 minutes 28 seconds, the mean of this and Yesterday's observation gives 36 degrees 48 minutes 5 1/2 seconds South; the Latitude of the Place of Observation, and the Variation of the Compass was at this time found to be 11 degrees 9 minutes East. While we were making these observations 5 Canoes came alongside the Ship, 2 Large and 3 Small ones, in one were 47 People, but in the other not so many. They were wholy strangers to us, and to all appearance they came with a Hostile intention, being compleatly Arm'd with Pikes, Darts, Stones, etc.; however, they made no attempt, and this was very probable owing to their being inform'd by some other Canoes (who at this time were alongside selling fish) what sort of people they had to Deal with. When they first came alongside they begun to sell our people some of their Arms, and one Man offer'd to Sale a Haahow, that is a Square Piece of Cloth such as they wear. Lieutenant Gore, who at this time was Commanding Officer, sent into the Canoe a piece of Cloth which the Man had agreed to Take in Exchange for his, but as soon as he had got Mr. Gore's Cloth in his Possession he would not part with his own, but put off the Canoe from alongside, and then shook their Paddles at the People in the Ship. Upon this, Mr. Gore fir'd a Musquet at them, and, from what I can learn, kill'd the Man who took the Cloth; after this they soon went away. I have here inserted the account of this Affair just as I had it from Mr. Gore, but I must own it did not meet with my approbation, because I thought the Punishment a little too severe for the Crime, and we had now been long Enough acquainted with these People to know how to Chastise Trifling faults like this without taking away their Lives.

At noon, we recorded a latitude of 36 degrees, 48 minutes, 28 seconds. The average of this and yesterday's observation is 36 degrees, 48 minutes, 5 1/2 seconds South; this is the latitude of the observation point, and the compass variation at that time was found to be 11 degrees, 9 minutes East. While we were taking these measurements, five canoes approached the ship, two large and three small. One canoe had 47 people in it, but the others had fewer. They were completely unfamiliar to us and appeared to have hostile intentions, as they were fully armed with pikes, darts, stones, and more; however, they did not make any attacks, likely because other canoes nearby were selling fish and informed them about who we were. When they first came alongside, they began trying to sell some of their weapons to us, and one man offered to sell a Haahow, which is a square piece of cloth they wear. Lieutenant Gore, who was in charge at that moment, sent a piece of cloth to the canoe in exchange for the man's item. But as soon as he received Lieutenant Gore's cloth, he refused to exchange his own, pushed the canoe away, and then shook their paddles at the people on the ship. In response, Mr. Gore fired a musket at them, reportedly killing the man who took the cloth; after that, they quickly left. I've included this account exactly as I received it from Mr. Gore, but I must admit that I didn't agree with his actions, as I felt the punishment was too harsh for the offense. We had known these people long enough to figure out how to handle minor faults like this without taking their lives.

Friday, 10th. P.M., Gentle breezes and Variable; the remainder, a Strong breeze at East-North-East, and hazey weather. A.M., I went with 2 Boats, accompanied by Mr. Banks and the other Gentlemen into the River which Emptys itself into the head of the Bay, in order to Examine it; none of the Natives came off to the Ship this morning, which we think is owing to bad weather.

Friday, 10th. P.M., Light winds and changeable; later, a strong breeze from the East-North-East with hazy weather. A.M., I went with 2 boats, joined by Mr. Banks and the other gentlemen, into the river that flows into the head of the bay to explore it; no locals came out to the ship this morning, which we believe is due to the bad weather.

[Pahs in Mercury Bay, New Zealand.]

[Pahs in Mercury Bay, New Zealand.]

Saturday, 11th. Fresh Gales at East-North-East, and Cloudy, hazey weather with rain. Between 7 and 8 o'Clock p.m. I returnd on board from out the River, having been about 4 or 5 Miles up it, and could have gone much farther had the weather been favourable. I landed on the East side and went upon the Hills, from whence I saw, or at least I thought I saw, the head of the River. It here branched into several Channels, and form'd a Number of very low flat Islands, all cover'd with a sort of Mangrove Trees, and several places of the Shores of both sides the River were Cover'd with the same sort of wood. The sand banks were well stored with Cockles and Clams, and in many places were Rock Oysters. Here is likewise pretty plenty of Wild Fowl, such as Shags, Ducks, Curlews, and a Black bird, about as big as a Crow, with a long, sharp bill of a Colour between Red and Yellow; we also saw fish in the River, but of what sort I know not. The Country especially on the East side is barren, and for the most part destitute of wood, or any other signs of Fertility; but the face of the country on the other side looked much better, and is in many places cover'd with wood. We meet with some of the Natives and saw several more, and Smokes a long way inland, but saw not the least signs of Cultivation, either here or in any other part about the Bay, so that the inhabitants must live wholy on shell and other fish, and Fern roots, which they Eat by the way of Bread. In the Entrance of this river, and for 2 or 3 Miles up, it is very safe and Commodious Anchoring in 3, 4, and 5 fathoms, and Convenient places for laying a Ship aShore, where the Tide rises and falls about 7 feet at full and Change. I could not see whether or no any considerable fresh Water Stream came out of the Country into this river, but there are a number of small Rivulets which come from the Adjacent hills. [Pahs in Mercury Bay, New Zealand.] A little within the Entrance of the River on the East side is a high point or peninsula juting out into the River on which are the Remains of one of their Fortified towns. The Situation is such that the best Engineer in Europe could not have Chose a better for a Small Number of men to defend themselves against a greater; it is strong by Nature and made more so by Art. It is only Accessible on the land Side, and there have been cut a Ditch and a Bank raised on the inside. From the Top of the Bank to the Bottom of the Ditch was about 22 feet, and depth of the Ditch on the land side 14 feet; its breadth was in proportion to its depth, and the whole seem'd to have been done with great Judgment. There had been a row of Pickets on the Top of the Bank, and another on the outside of the Ditch; these last had been set deep in the ground and Sloping with their upper ends hanging over the Ditch. The whole had been burnt down, so that it is probable that this place had been taken and destroy'd by an Enemy. The people on this side of the Bay seem now to have no houses or fix'd habitations, but Sleep in the open Air, under Trees and in small Temporary shades; but to all appearance they are better off on the other side, but there we have not set foot. In the morning, being dirty rainy weather, I did not Expect any of the Natives off with fish, but thinking that they might have some ashore I sent a Boat with some Trade, who return'd about noon loaded with Oysters, which they got in the River which is abreast of the Ship, but saw no fish among the Natives.

Saturday, 11th. Fresh winds from the East-North-East and cloudy, hazy weather with rain. Between 7 and 8 p.m., I returned on board from the river, having gone about 4 or 5 miles up it, and I could have traveled much farther if the weather had been better. I landed on the east side and climbed the hills, from where I thought I could see the head of the river. It branched into several channels and formed several very low, flat islands, all covered with a type of mangrove trees, and several spots along both sides of the river were filled with the same kind of trees. The sandbanks were well stocked with cockles and clams, and in many places, there were rock oysters. There were also quite a few wild birds, such as shags, ducks, curlews, and a black bird, about the size of a crow, with a long, sharp bill colored between red and yellow. We also saw fish in the river, but I couldn't identify what kind. The land, especially on the east side, is barren and mostly lacking in wood or any signs of fertility, but the landscape on the opposite side looked much better and was wooded in many places. We encountered some of the natives and saw several more, along with smoke rising from far inland, but we didn't see any signs of cultivation here or in any other part around the bay, so the inhabitants must rely entirely on shellfish and other fish, as well as fern roots, which they eat like bread. At the entrance of this river, and for 2 or 3 miles upstream, there are safe and convenient anchoring spots in 3, 4, and 5 fathoms, and suitable areas for beaching a ship, where the tide rises and falls about 7 feet at full and new moons. I couldn't tell if any significant freshwater stream flowed out of the land into this river, but there are several small streams that come from the nearby hills. [Pahs in Mercury Bay, New Zealand.] Just inside the entrance of the river on the east side is a high point or peninsula that juts into the river, where the remains of one of their fortified towns can be found. The location is such that the best engineer in Europe couldn't have chosen a better spot for a small number of people to defend themselves against a larger force; it is naturally strong and further fortified by human efforts. It's only accessible from the land side, and there’s a ditch and bank raised on the inside. From the top of the bank to the bottom of the ditch is about 22 feet, and the depth of the ditch on the land side is 14 feet; its width was proportionate to its depth, and the entire construction seemed to have been done with great thought. There had been a row of pickets on top of the bank and another outside the ditch; the latter had been set deep in the ground, sloped down, with their tops extending over the ditch. The whole structure had been burnt down, suggesting that this place had been attacked and destroyed by an enemy. The people on this side of the bay now seem to have no permanent houses or fixed homes, instead sleeping outdoors under trees and in small temporary shelters; however, they appear to be better off on the other side, though we haven't explored that area. In the morning, with the dirty, rainy weather, I didn't expect any of the natives to come by with fish, but thinking they might have some on land, I sent a boat with some trade goods, which returned around noon loaded with oysters they collected from the river near the ship, but saw no fish among the natives.

Sunday, 12th. P.M. had Strong Gales at North-East, and hazey, rainy weather; A.M. a fresh breeze at North-West, and Clear weather. In the morning got on board a Turn of Water, and afterwards sent the Long boat into the River for Oysters to take to sea with us; and I went with the Pinnace and Yawl, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, over to the North side of the Bay in order to take a View of the Country and the Fortified Village which stands there. We landed about a mile from it, and were meet by the inhabitants in our way thither, who, with a great deal of good nature and friendship, conducted us into the place and shew'd us everything that was there.

Sunday, 12th. In the afternoon, we had strong winds coming from the northeast and hazy, rainy weather; in the morning, there was a fresh breeze from the northwest and clear skies. In the morning, we got on board a fresh supply of water, and later sent the long boat into the river to gather oysters to take with us at sea. I went along with the pinnace and yawl, joined by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to the north side of the bay to check out the landscape and the fortified village located there. We landed about a mile from it and were met by the locals who, with a lot of friendliness and goodwill, showed us around the place and everything it had to offer.

This village is built upon a high Promontory or point on the North side and near the head of the Bay. It is in some places quite inaccessible to man, and in others very difficult, except on that side which faced the narrow ridge of the hill on which it stands. Here it is defended by a double ditch, a bank and 2 rows of Picketing, the inner row upon the Bank; but not so near the Crown but what there was good room for men to Walk and handle their Arms between the Picketing and the inner Ditch. The outer Picketing was between the 2 Ditches, and laid sloping with their upper ends hanging over the inner Ditch. The Depth of this Ditch from the bottom to the Crown of the bank was 24 feet. Close within the inner Plcketing was erected by strong Posts a stage 30 feet high and 40 in length and 6 feet broad. The use of this stage was to stand upon to throw Darts at the Assailants, and a number of Darts lay upon it for that purpose. At right angles to this Stage and a few paces from it was another of the same Construction and bigness; this stood likewise within the Picketing, and was intended for the same use as the other--viz., to stand upon to throw stones and darts upon the Enemy as they advanc'd up the side of the Hill where lay the Main way into the place. It likewise might be intended to defend some little outworks and hutts that lay at the Skirts and on this side of the Hill. These outworks were not intended as advanced Posts, but for such of the Inhabitants to live in as had not room in the Main works, but had taken Shelter under it. Besides the works on the land side, above described, the whole Villiage was Pallisaded round with a line of pretty strong Picketing run round the Edge of the hill. The ground within having not been level at first, but laid Sloping, they had divided it into little squares and Leveled each of these. These squares lay in the form of an Amphitheatre, and were each of them Pallisaded round, and had communication one with another by narrow lanes and little gateways, which could easily be stoped up, so that if an Enemy had forced the outer Picketing he had several others to incounter before the place could be easily reduced, supposing them to defend everyone of the places one after another. The main way leading into this fortification was up a very steep part of the Hill and thro' a narrow passage about 12 feet long and under one of the Stages. I saw no door nor gate, but it might very soon have been barricaded up. Upon the whole I looked upon it to be very strong and well choose Post, and where a small number of resolute men might defend themselves a long time against a vast superior force, Arm'd in the manner as these People are. These seem'd to be prepared against a Siege, having laid up in store an immense quantity of Fern roots and a good many dry'd fish; but we did not see that they had any fresh Water nearer than a brook which runs close under the foot of a hill, from which I suppose they can at times get water, tho' besiged, and keep it in gouards until they use it. Under the foot of the point on which the Village stands are 2 Rocks, the one just broke off from the Main and other detatched a little from it. They are both very small, and more fit for Birds to inhabit than men; yet there are houses and places of defence on each of them, and about a Mile to Eastward of these is another of these small Fortified rocks, which communicates with the Main by a Narrow pathway, where there is a small Villiage of the Natives. Many works of this kind we have seen upon small Islands and Rocks and Ridges of hills on all parts of the Coast, besides a great number of Fortified towns, to all appearances Vastly superior to this I have described. From this it should seem that the People must have long and frequent Warrs, and must have been long accustomed to it, otherwise they never would have invented such strong holds as these, the Erecting of which must cost them immense labour, considering the Tools they have to work with, which are only made of Wood and Stone. It is a little strange that with such a Warlike People, as these undoubtedly are, no Omissive weapons are found among them, such as bows and Arrows, Slings, etc., things in themselves so easily invented, and are common in every other part of the world. The Arms they use are long spears or Lances, a Staff about 5 feet long. Some of these are pointed at one end like a Serjeant's Halberd, others are round and Sharp; the other ends are broad, something like the blade of an Oar. They have another sort about 4 1/2 feet long; these are shaped at one End like an Axe, and the other is made with a Sharp point. They have short Truncheons about a foot long, which they call Pattoo Pattoas; some made of wood, some of bone, and others of Stone. Those made of wood are Variously shaped, but those made of bone and Stone are of one shape, which is with a round handle, a broadish blade, which is thickest in the Middle and taper'd to an Edge all round. The use of these are to knock Men's brains out, and to kill them outright after they are wounded; and they are certainly well contrived things for this purpose. Besides these Weapons they Throw stones and Darts; the Darts are 10 or 12 feet long, are made of hard wood, and are barbed at one end. They handle all their Arms with great Agility, particularly their long Pikes or Lances, against which we have no weapon that is an equal match except a Loaded Musquet.

This village is built on a high point on the north side, near the head of the bay. In some areas, it's pretty much inaccessible to people, and in others, it's very challenging, except on the side that faces the narrow ridge of the hill it stands on. Here, it’s protected by a double ditch, an earth bank, and two rows of pickets, with the inner row on the bank; there was enough space for people to walk and handle their weapons between the pickets and the inner ditch. The outer pickets were placed between the two ditches, sloping down with their tops hanging over the inner ditch. The depth of this ditch from the bottom to the top of the bank was 24 feet. Just inside the inner pickets, a strong structure was built with posts, standing 30 feet high, 40 feet long, and 6 feet wide. This structure was used to throw darts at attackers, and there were a number of darts available for that purpose. Perpendicular to this structure and a few paces away was another of the same design and size; this was also inside the pickets and meant for the same purpose—throwing stones and darts at the enemy as they approached up the hill, which was the main route into the place. It could also be used to defend some small outposts and huts located on the edges and on this side of the hill. These outposts weren't intended as forward positions but were for residents who needed shelter and didn’t fit in the main fortifications. Besides the landward defenses, as described, the entire village was surrounded by a sturdy picket fencing along the edge of the hill. The terrain within wasn't level to begin with but was sloped, and they divided it into small squares, leveling each one. These squares were arranged in an amphitheater shape, each surrounded by pickets, with narrow lanes and small gateways for communication that could easily be blocked. If an enemy forced their way through the outer picket, they would encounter several more obstacles before easily capturing the area, assuming each zone was defended sequentially. The main entrance to this fortification was a very steep part of the hill through a narrow passage about 12 feet long and underneath one of the structures. I didn’t see any doors or gates, but it could have been quickly barricaded. Overall, I found it very strong and well-positioned, where a small number of determined individuals could fend off a much larger force, armed like these folks were. They appeared to be prepared for a siege, having stored a massive supply of fern roots and a good amount of dried fish; however, we didn’t see any fresh water closer than a brook that runs at the foot of the hill, which I assume they could use during a siege and store until needed. At the base of the point where the village sits, there are two small rocks, one just broken off from the main and another slightly separated from it. They are both quite small, more suitable for birds than humans, yet there are houses and defensive structures on each. About a mile to the east of these is another small fortified rock connected to the main by a narrow path, where there's a small village of the natives. We have seen many structures like this on small islands, rocks, and ridges along the coast, in addition to many fortified towns that seem vastly superior to the one I've described. This suggests that the people must have faced long and frequent wars and have been accustomed to conflict for a long time; otherwise, they wouldn't have constructed such strongholds, which must have taken immense labor to build, given the tools they have, which are only made from wood and stone. It’s a bit odd that with such a warlike people—who are certainly that—no offensive weapons are found among them, like bows and arrows, slings, etc., which are easily invented and common in every other part of the world. The weapons they use are long spears or lances, about 5 feet long. Some have pointed ends like a sergeant's halberd, while others are rounded and sharp. The other ends are broad, somewhat like an oar blade. They have another type about 4.5 feet long, shaped like an axe at one end, with a sharp point on the other. They carry short truncheons about a foot long, called pattoo pattoas; some are made of wood, some of bone, and others of stone. Those made of wood vary in shape, but those made of bone and stone are all the same shape: they have a round handle, a broad blade that is thickest in the middle and tapering to an edge all around. These are designed to knock people out and to kill them outright after they are wounded, and they're certainly well-made for this purpose. In addition to these weapons, they throw stones and darts; the darts are 10 to 12 feet long, made of hard wood, and barbed at one end. They handle all their weapons with great agility, particularly their long pikes or lances, against which we have no matching weapon except a loaded musket.

Monday, 13th. P.M., Gentle Breezes at North-West and Clear weather. After taking a Slight View of the Country and Loaded both boats with Sellery, which we found in Great plenty near the Sea beach, we return'd on board about 5 o'Clock. The Long boat at the same time return'd out of the River Loaded as deep as she could swim with Oysters. And now I intended to put to Sea in the morning if wind and weather will permit. In the night had the wind at South-East, with rainy, dirty, hazey weather, which continued all day, so that I could not think of Sailing, but thought myself very happy in being in a good Port. Samuel Jones, Seaman, having been confin'd since Saturday last for refusing to come upon deck when all hands were called, and afterwards refused to Comply with the orders of the officers on deck, he was this morning punished with 12 lashes and remited back to confinement.

Monday, 13th. P.M., Gentle Breezes from the Northwest and clear weather. After taking a brief look at the area and loading both boats with plenty of celery found near the beach, we returned on board around 5 o'clock. The longboat also came back from the river loaded as deep as it could go with oysters. I planned to set out to sea in the morning if the wind and weather allowed. During the night, the wind shifted to the southeast, bringing rainy, muddy, hazy weather that lasted all day, so I decided against sailing and felt grateful to be in a good harbor. Samuel Jones, a seaman, had been confined since last Saturday for refusing to come on deck when all hands were called and later not complying with the officers' orders. This morning, he was punished with 12 lashes and sent back to confinement.

Tuesday, 14th. Fresh Gales, Easterly, and rainy, Dirty weather.

Tuesday, 14th. Strong winds from the east and rainy, gloomy weather.

Wednesday, 15th. In the evening I went in the Pinnace and landed upon one of the Islands that lies off of the South Head of the Bay, with a view to see if I could discover any sunken rocks or other Dangers lying before the Entrance of the Bay, as there was a pretty large swell at this Time. The Island we landed upon was very small, yet there were upon it a Village, the inhabitants of which received us very friendly. This little Village was laid out in small Oblong squares, and each pailisaded round. The Island afforded no fresh Water, and was only accessible on one side: from this I concluded that it was not choose for any Conveniency it could afford them, but for its Natural Strength.

Wednesday, 15th. In the evening, I took the small boat and landed on one of the islands near the south end of the bay, aiming to see if I could find any submerged rocks or other dangers at the bay's entrance since there was a pretty big swell at that time. The island we landed on was very small, but it had a village whose inhabitants welcomed us warmly. The village was laid out in small rectangular plots, each surrounded by a fence. The island had no fresh water and was only accessible from one side. From this, I figured they chose it not for its conveniences but for its natural defenses.

[Sail from Mercury Bay, New Zealand.]

[Sail from Mercury Bay, New Zealand.]

At 7 A.M. weigh'd, with a light breeze at West, and clear weather, and made Sail out of the Bay, steering North-East, for the Northermost of a Number of Islands lying off the North point of the Bay. These Islands are of Various extents, and lye Scattered to the North-West in a parallel direction with the Main as far as we could see. I was at first afraid to go within them, thinking that there was no safe Passage, but I afterwards thought that we might; and I would have attempted it, but the wind, coming to the North-West, prevented it, so that we were obliged to stand out to Sea. At Noon was in the Latitude of 36 degrees 4 minutes South. The Northermost Island, above mentioned, bore North, distant half a League; the Court of Aldermen, South-East by South, distant 6 Leagues; and the Bay Sail'd from, which I have named Mercury Bay, on account of the observation being made there, South-West by West, distant 6 Miles.

At 7 A.M., we weighed anchor with a light breeze from the west and clear skies, and set sail out of the bay, heading northeast toward the northernmost of several islands off the north point of the bay. These islands vary in size and are scattered to the northwest in a line parallel to the mainland as far as we could see. At first, I was hesitant to go among them, thinking there was no safe route, but later I reconsidered and wanted to try. However, when the wind shifted to the northwest, it forced us to head out to sea instead. By noon, we were at a latitude of 36 degrees 4 minutes south. The northernmost island mentioned earlier was to the north, about half a league away; the court of aldermen was southeast by south, six leagues away; and the bay we had just left, which I named Mercury Bay because observations were made there, was southwest by west, six miles away.

Mercury Bay* (* At the head of Mercury Bay is a small settlement called Whitianga.) lies in the Latitude of 36 degrees 47 minutes South, and the Longitude of 184 degrees 4 minutes West, from the Meridian of Greenwich. It lies in South-West between 2 and 3 Leagues. There are several Islands lying both to the Southward and Northward of it, and a Small high Island or Rock in the Middle of the Entrance. Within this Island the depth of water doth no were Exceed 9 or 8 fathoms; the best Anchorage is in a sandy Bay which lies just within the South head in 5 and 4 fathoms, bringing a high Tower Rock, which lies without the head, in one with the head, or just shut in behind it. Here it is very Convenient Wooding and Watering, and in the River are an immense quantity of Oysters and other small Shell fish; and this is the only thing it is remarkable for, and hath occasioned my giving it the Name of Oyster River. But the Snugest and Safest place for a Ship to lay in that wants to stay there any time is in the River at the head of the Bay, and where there is every conveniency the place can afford. To sail up and into it keep the South shore all the way on board. As we did not learn that the Natives had any name for this River, I have called it the River of Mangroves,* (* Still so called.) because of the great quantity of these Trees that are found in it. The Country on the South-East side of this River and Bay is very barren, producing little else but Fern, and such other plants as delight in a Poor Soil. The land on the North-West side is pretty well cover'd with wood, the Soil more fertile, and would no doubt produce the Necessarys of Life, was it Cultivated. However, this much must be said against it, that it is not near so Rich nor fertile as the lands we have seen to the Southward; and the same may be said of its inhabitants, who, although pretty numerous, are poor to the highest degree when Compar'd to others we have seen. They have no Plantations, but live only on Fern roots and fish; their Canoes are mean, and without ornament, and so are their Houses, or Hutts, and in general everything they have about them. This may be owing to the frequent wars in which they are Certainly ingaged; strong proofs of this we have seen, for the people who resided near the place where we wooded, and who Slept every night in the Open Air, placed themselves in such a manner when they laid down to sleep as plainly shew'd that it was necessary for them to be always upon their Guard. They do not own Subjection to Teeratie, the Earadehi,* (* Cook did not realize that the New Zealanders were divided into independent tribes.) but say that he would kill them was he to come Among them; they confirm the Custom of Eating their Enemies, so that this is a thing no longer to be doubted. I have before observed that many of the People about this bay had no fix'd habitations, and we thought so then, but have since learnt that they have strong holds--or Hippas, as they call them--which they retire to in time of danger.

Mercury Bay* (* At the head of Mercury Bay is a small settlement called Whitianga.) is located at a latitude of 36 degrees 47 minutes South and a longitude of 184 degrees 4 minutes West from the Greenwich Meridian. It stretches southwest between 2 and 3 leagues. There are several islands both to the south and north of it, along with a small, high island or rock in the middle of the entrance. Inside this island, the water depth does not exceed 9 or 8 fathoms; the best anchorage is in a sandy bay just inside the south head at 5 to 4 fathoms, aligning a tall rock that sits outside the head with the head itself or just behind it. It’s very convenient for getting wood and water here, and the river has a huge supply of oysters and other small shellfish; this is its main feature, which is why I’ve named it Oyster River. The safest and most comfortable place for a ship to stay for any length of time is in the river at the head of the bay, where every convenience is available. To sail in, keep the south shore right alongside. Since we didn’t find out that the locals had any name for this river, I’ve called it the River of Mangroves,* (* Still so called.) due to the large number of these trees found there. The land on the southeast side of this river and bay is quite barren, growing little besides ferns and other plants that thrive in poor soil. The land on the northwest side is reasonably well-covered with woods, and the soil is more fertile, which would undoubtedly produce life’s necessities if it were cultivated. However, it must be noted that it isn’t nearly as rich or fertile as the lands we’ve seen to the south, and the same applies to its inhabitants, who, although relatively numerous, are extremely poor compared to others we’ve encountered. They have no farms and rely solely on fern roots and fish; their canoes are simple and unadorned, as are their houses or huts, along with everything else they possess. This may be due to the frequent wars they’re involved in; we’ve seen strong evidence of this, as the people living near where we gathered wood and who slept every night outdoors arranged themselves in a way that clearly showed they always needed to be on guard. They do not acknowledge subjection to Teeratie, the Earadehi,* (* Cook did not realize that the New Zealanders were divided into independent tribes.) but they claim he would kill them if he came among them; they affirm the custom of eating their enemies, so this cannot be doubted any longer. I’ve mentioned before that many of the people around this bay did not have permanent homes, and we thought so at the time, but we’ve since learned that they have strongholds — or Hippas, as they call them — where they retreat in times of danger.

We found, thrown upon the Shore in several places in this Bay, a quantity of Iron Sand, which is brought down out of the Country by almost every little fresh-water brook. This proves that there must be of that Ore not far inland. Neither of the Inhabitants of this Place, nor any other where we have been, know the use of Iron or set the least Value upon it, preferring the most Trifling thing we could give them to a Nail, or any sort of Iron Tools. Before we left this bay we cut out upon one of the Trees near the Watering Place the Ship's Name, date, etc., and, after displaying the English Colours, I took formal possession of the place in the Name of His Majesty.

We found a lot of iron sand scattered along the shore in several spots in this bay, which is carried down from the land by almost every small freshwater stream. This indicates that there must be iron ore not far inland. Neither the locals here nor anyone else we've met knows how to use iron or values it at all, preferring even the most trivial item we could give them over a nail or any type of iron tool. Before we left the bay, we carved the ship's name, date, and other details into one of the trees near the watering spot. After displaying the English flag, I officially took possession of the area in the name of His Majesty.

[Off Cape Colville, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Cape Colville, North Island, New Zealand.]

Thursday, 16th. Fresh breezes between the North-West and South-West, and fair weather. At 1 P.M., having got within the Group of Islands which lies of the North head of Mercury Bay, hauld our wind to the Northward, and Kept plying to windward all the day between these Islands and some others laying to the Northward of them, with a View to get under the Main land, the Extream North-West point of which we could see, at Noon, bore West by North, distant 6 or 8 Leagues; Latitude in Per Observation 36 degrees 33 minutes South.

Thursday, 16th. There were fresh breezes blowing between the Northwest and Southwest, with nice weather. At 1 P.M., after entering the group of islands off the North head of Mercury Bay, we headed our sails toward the north and continued sailing against the wind all day between these islands and others lying to the north of them, aiming to reach the mainland. The extreme northwest point of the mainland, which we could see at noon, had a bearing of West by North, about 6 or 8 leagues away; our latitude, according to our observation, was 36 degrees 33 minutes South.

Note, in speaking of Mercury Bay, I had forgot to mention that the Mangrove Trees found there produce a resinous substance very much like Rosin. Something of this kind, I am told, is found in both the East and West Indies. We found it, at first, in small Lumps upon the Sea Beach, but afterwards found it sticking to the Mangrove Trees, and by that means found out from whence it came.

Note, when talking about Mercury Bay, I forgot to mention that the mangrove trees there produce a resinous substance that resembles rosin. I've been told that something similar is found in both the East and West Indies. At first, we found it in small lumps on the beach, but later we discovered it sticking to the mangrove trees, which helped us figure out its source.

Friday, 17th. The fore and Middle parts had fresh Gales between the South-West and West by South, and Squally. Kept plying to windward in order to get under the land. At 6 A.M. fetched close under the lee of the Northernmost Island in sight, then Tackd and Stood to the Southward until 11, when we tack'd and Stood to the Northward. At this time the North head of Mercury Bay, or Point Mercury, bore South-East by East, distant 3 Leagues, being at this time between 2 and 3 Leagues from the Main land, and abreast of a place where there appear'd to be a Harbour;* (* Probably Waikawau Bay) but the heavy squalls which we had from the Land would not permit us to take a nearer View of it, but soon brought us under our Close reeft Topsails. At Noon Point Mercury bore South-East, distant 4 Leagues, and the weathermost point of the Main land in sight bore North 60 degrees West, distant 5 Leagues. Over the North-West side of Mercury Bay is a pretty high round hill, rising sloping from the Shore of the Bay. This hill is very conspicuous from where we now are.

Friday, 17th. The front and middle parts had strong winds between the southwest and west-southwest, and it was squally. We kept heading into the wind to get closer to the land. At 6 A.M., we got close under the protective side of the northernmost island in sight, then we tacked and headed south until 11, when we tacked and went north. At that time, the northern head of Mercury Bay, or Point Mercury, was bearing southeast by east, about 3 leagues away, while we were between 2 and 3 leagues from the mainland, opposite a spot that looked like a harbor; probably Waikawau Bay. However, the strong squalls coming from the land prevented us from getting a closer look and soon had us under our close-reefed topsails. At noon, Point Mercury was bearing southeast, 4 leagues away, and the furthest point of the mainland in sight was bearing north 60 degrees west, 5 leagues away. On the northwest side of Mercury Bay, there is a fairly high round hill that slopes down from the shore of the bay. This hill is very noticeable from our current position.

Saturday, 18th. First part strong Gales at South-West and South-South-West, with heavy squalls: in the morning had Gentle breezes at South and South-East, towards noon had Whifling light Airs all round the Compass. Kept plying to windward under close Reeft Topsails until daylight, at which time we had got close under the Main, and the wind coming at South-East we made sail and steer'd North-West by West, as the land lays, keeping close in shore. At 6 we passed a small Bay* (* Charles Cove.) wherein there appear'd to be Anchorage, and pretty good Shelter from the Sea Winds, at the Entrance of which lies a Rock pretty high above water. 4 Miles farther to the West-North-West is a very Conspicuous promontory or point of land which we got abreast of about 7 o'Clock; it lies in the Latitude of 36 degrees 26 minutes South and North 48 degrees West, 9 Leagues from Point Mercury. From this point the Land trends West 1/2 South near one League, then South-South-East as far as we could see. Besides the Islands laying without us we could see land round by the South-West as far as North-West, but whether this was the Main or Islands was not possible for us at this Time to determine; the fear of loosing the Main land determin'd me to follow its direction. With this View we hauld round the point* (* Cape Colville.) and Steer'd to the Southward, but meeting with Whifling light Airs all round the Compass, we made but little progress untill noon, when we found ourselves by Observation in the Latitude of 36 degrees 29 minutes South; a small Island* (* Channel Island.) which lays North-West 4 Miles from the Promontory above-mentioned bore North by East, distant 6 1/2 Miles, being at this time about 2 Miles from the Shore. While we lay under the land 2 large Canoes came off to us; in one of them were 62 people; they staid about us some time, then began to throw stones into the Ship, upon which I fir'd a Musquet ball thro' one of the Canoes. After this they retir'd ashore.

Saturday, 18th. We experienced strong gales coming from the South-West and South-South-West, accompanied by heavy squalls. In the morning, there were gentle breezes from the South and South-East, and by noon we had light winds swirling from all directions. We continued making progress against the wind with our close-reefed topsails until daylight, at which point we were close to the main shore, and when the wind shifted to the South-East, we set our sails and steered North-West by West, following the coastline closely. At 6 AM, we passed a small bay (*Charles Cove.*) that seemed to offer anchorage and good shelter from the sea winds; there was a rock at the entrance that was fairly high out of the water. Four miles farther to the West-North-West, we came to a prominent point of land, which we were alongside around 7 o'clock; it is located at Latitude 36 degrees 26 minutes South and Longitude 48 degrees West, about 9 leagues from Point Mercury. From this point, the land trends West 1/2 South for nearly a league, then South-South-East as far as we could see. Beyond the islands that lay beyond us, we could see land extending around to the South-West and North-West, but we couldn’t determine if it was mainland or islands; my concern about losing the mainland led me to follow its direction. With that in mind, we rounded the point (*Cape Colville.*) and headed South, but encountered light winds from all directions, making little progress until noon. At that time, we confirmed our position by observation as being in Latitude 36 degrees 29 minutes South; a small island (*Channel Island.*) that was 4 miles North-West from the previously mentioned promontory was bearing North by East, about 6 1/2 miles away, putting us around 2 miles from the shore. While we were anchored near the land, two large canoes came out to us; one of them had 62 people on board. They stayed with us for a while, then began throwing stones at the ship, so I fired a musket ball through one of the canoes. After that, they retreated to shore.

Sunday, 19th. At 1 p.m. a breeze sprung up at East, which afterwards came to North-East, and with it we steer'd along shore South by East and South-South-East, having from 25 to 18 fathoms Water. At 1/2 past 7, having run 7 or 8 Leagues since Noon, we Anchor'd in 23 fathoms, not choosing to run any farther in the Dark, having the land on both sides of us forming the Entrance of a Streight, Bay or River, lying in South by East, for on that point of the Compass we could see no land. At daylight A.M., the wind being still favourable, we weighed and run under an Easy sail up the inlet, keeping nearest the East side. Soon after we had got under Sail 3 large Canoes came off to the Ship, and several of the people came on board upon the very first invitation; this was owing to their having heard of our being upon the Coast and the manner we had treated the Natives. I made each of those that came on board a small present, and after about an Hour's stay they went away well Satisfied. After having run 5 Leagues from the place where we Anchor'd last night our Depth of Water gradually decreased to 6 fathoms, and into less I did not choose to go, and as the wind blew right up the inlet and tide of flood, we came to an Anchor nearly in the middle of the Channell, which is here about 11 Miles over, and after this sent 2 Boats to sound, the one on one side and the other on the other side.

Sunday, 19th. At 1 p.m., a breeze picked up from the east, which later shifted to the northeast. We steered along the shore, heading south by east and south-south-east, with water depths ranging from 25 to 18 fathoms. At 7:30 p.m., after covering about 7 or 8 leagues since noon, we anchored in 23 fathoms, deciding not to proceed further in the dark, as land was visible on both sides, marking the entrance of a strait, bay, or river to the south-east, where we couldn't see any land. At dawn, with the wind still in our favor, we weighed anchor and sailed smoothly up the inlet, staying close to the east side. Shortly after setting sail, three large canoes approached the ship, and several people came aboard at our invitation. They had heard about our presence on the coast and how we had treated the locals. I made a small gift to each visitor, and after about an hour, they left satisfied. After traveling 5 leagues from where we anchored the previous night, the water depth gradually decreased to 6 fathoms, and I didn't want to go any shallower. With the wind blowing directly up the inlet and the flood tide, we anchored nearly in the middle of the channel, which is about 11 miles wide here, and then sent two boats to take soundings, one on each side.

[At Frith of Thames, North Island, New Zealand.]

[At Frith of Thames, North Island, New Zealand.]

Monday, 20th. Moderate breezes at South-South-East and fair weather. At 2 p.m. the boats return'd from sounding, not having found above 3 feet more water than were we now lay; upon this I resolved to go no farther with the Ship but to examine the head of the Bay in the Boat, for as it appeard to run a good way inland, I thought this a good opportunity to see a little of the interior part of the Country and its produce. Accordingly at daylight in the morning I set out with the Pinnace and Long boat accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia. We found the inlet end in a River, about 9 miles above the Ship, into which we Enter'd with the first of the flood, and before we had gone 3 Miles up it found the Water quite fresh. We saw a number of Natives and landed at one of their Villages, the inhabitants of which received us with open Arms. We made but a Short stay with them but proceeded up the river until near Noon, when finding the face of the country to continue pretty much the same, and no alteration in the Course or stream of the River or the least probability of seeing the end of it, we landed on the West side in order to take a View of the lofty Trees which Adorn its banks, being at this time 12 or 14 Miles within the Entrance, and here the Tide of Flood runs as strong as it does in the River Thames below bridge.

Monday, 20th. There were moderate breezes from the South-Southeast and clear weather. At 2 p.m., the boats returned from sounding, having found only 3 feet more water than where we currently lay; based on this, I decided not to take the ship any further but to explore the head of the Bay in the boat. Since it appeared to extend quite a way inland, I thought it would be a good chance to see a bit of the interior and its resources. So, at daybreak the next morning, I set out with the pinnace and longboat, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia. We found that the inlet led into a river, about 9 miles above the ship, and we entered it with the first of the flood. Before we had traveled 3 miles up it, we discovered the water was completely fresh. We encountered several natives and landed at one of their villages, where the inhabitants welcomed us warmly. We stayed briefly with them before continuing up the river until nearly noon. When we found the landscape remained mostly the same, with no changes in the river's course or flow and little chance of reaching its end, we landed on the west side to admire the tall trees that lined its banks. At this point, we were about 12 or 14 miles inside the entrance, and the flood tide was flowing as strongly here as it does in the River Thames below the bridge.

Tuesday, 21st. After Landing as above-mention'd, we had not gone a hundred yards into the woods before we found a Tree that girted 19 feet 8 inches, 6 feet above the ground, and having a Quadrant with me, I found its length from the root to the first branch to be 89 feet; it was as Streight as an Arrow and Taper'd but very little in proportion to its length, so that I judged that there was 356 Solid feet of timber in this Tree, clear of the branches. We saw many others of the same sort, several of which were Taller than the one we measured, and all of them very stout; there were likewise many other sorts of very Stout Timber Trees, all of them wholy unknown to any of us. We brought away a few specimens, and at 3 o'Clock we embarqued in order to return (but not before we had named this river the Thames,* (* The flourishing town of Thames now stands at the eastern entrance of the river: population nearly 5000. Gold is found in the vicinity.) on account of its bearing some resemblance to that River in England) on board with the very first of the Ebb. In our return down the river, the inhabitants of the Village where we landed in going, seeing that we return'd by another Channell, put off in their Canoes and met us and Trafficked with us in the most friendly manner immaginable, until they had disposed of the few Trifles they had. The tide of Ebb just carried us out of the narrow part of the River into the Sea reach, as I may call it, where meeting with the flood and a Strong breeze at North-North-West obliged us to come to a Grapnel, and we did not reach the Ship until 7 o'Clock in the A.M. Intending to get under Sail at high water the Long boat was sent to take up the Kedge Anchor, but it blow'd so strong that she could not reach the Buoy, and the gale increasing soon obliged us to vear away more Cable and Strike Top Gallant Yards.

Tuesday, 21st. After landing as mentioned earlier, we hadn’t gone more than a hundred yards into the woods before we found a tree that was 19 feet 8 inches around, measured 6 feet above the ground. Using a quadrant I had with me, I measured its height from the root to the first branch to be 89 feet; it was as straight as an arrow and tapered very little for its length, so I estimated there were 356 solid feet of timber in this tree, excluding the branches. We saw many others like it, several taller than the one we measured, and they were all very sturdy; there were also many other types of very strong timber trees, all of them completely unknown to us. We collected a few samples, and at 3 o'clock we boarded the boat to return (but not before we named this river the Thames, because it reminded us of that river in England). We left just as the tide started to go out. On our way back down the river, the locals from the village where we landed earlier, noticing we took a different channel, came out in their canoes and greeted us, trading with us in the friendliest manner imaginable until they had sold the few small items they had. The ebbing tide helped carry us out of the narrow section of the river into what I might call the sea reach, where we encountered the flood tide and a strong north-northwest breeze, forcing us to drop anchor, and we didn’t reach the ship until 7 o’clock in the morning. Planning to sail at high tide, we sent the longboat to retrieve the kedge anchor, but it was blowing so hard that they couldn’t reach the buoy, and as the gale increased, we had to let out more cable and strike the topgallant yards.

Wednesday, 22nd. Winds at North-North-West. The A.M. fresh Gales and hazey with rain; the remainder, moderate and Clear. At 3 p.m. the Tide of Ebb making, we took up our Anchors and got under Sail and ply'd down the River until 8 o'Clock, when we again came to an Anchor in 7 fathoms, muddy bottom. At 3 a.m. weigh'd with the first of the Ebb and keept plying until the flood obliged us to anchor again. After this I went in the Pinnace over to the Western Shore, but found there neither inhabitants or anything else worthy of Note. At the time I left the Ship a good many of the Natives were alongside and on board Trafficking with our people for such Trifles as they had, and seem'd to behave as well as people could do, but one of them took the 1/2 hour glass out of the Bittacle, and was caught in the very fact, and for which Mr. Hicks, who was Commanding Officer, brought him to the Gangway and gave him a Dozen lashes with a Catt of nine Tails. The rest of the people seem'd not displeased at it when they came to know what it was for, and some old man beat the fellow after he had got into his Canoe; however, soon after this they all went away.

Wednesday, 22nd. Winds from the North-North-West. In the morning, there were fresh gales and it was hazy with rain; the rest of the day was moderate and clear. At 3 p.m., with the tide going out, we weighed anchor and set sail down the river until 8 o'clock, when we anchored again in 7 fathoms of muddy bottom. At 3 a.m., we lifted anchor with the first of the ebb tide and continued until the flood forced us to anchor again. After that, I took the pinnace over to the western shore, but found no inhabitants or anything noteworthy. When I left the ship, many of the natives were nearby and on board trading with our crew for small items, and they seemed to behave as well as could be expected. However, one of them took the half-hour glass out of the binnacle and was caught in the act. Mr. Hicks, the commanding officer, brought him to the gangway and gave him a dozen lashes with a cat o' nine tails. The rest of the people didn’t seem upset once they learned what had happened, and an old man even beat the guy after he got back into his canoe; however, shortly after that, they all left.

Thursday, 23rd. P.M. Gentle breezes at North-North-West and fair weather. Between 3 and 4 o'Clock got under Sail with the first of the Ebb and ply'd to windward until 9 when we anchor'd in 16 fathoms over upon the East shore. In the night had light Airs and Calm; at 3 A.M. weighed but had little or no wind until near noon, when a light breeze sprung up at North-North-West. At this time we were close under the West shore in 7 fathoms Water; Latitude 36 degrees 51 minutes South.

Thursday, 23rd. P.M. There were gentle breezes from the North-North-West and clear weather. Between 3 and 4 o'clock, we set sail with the start of the outgoing tide and sailed into the wind until 9, when we anchored in 16 fathoms off the East shore. During the night, we had light winds and calm conditions; at 3 A.M., we weighed anchor but had little to no wind until near noon, when a light breeze came up from the North-North-West. At that time, we were close to the West shore in 7 fathoms of water; Latitude 36 degrees 51 minutes South.

[Description of Frith of Thames, New Zealand.]

[Description of Frith of Thames, New Zealand.]

Friday, 24th. P.M., Fresh Gales and dark, Cloudy, squally weather, with Thunder, Lightning, and rain. Winds from the North-West to the South-West, and this last carried us by 7 o'Clock without the North-West point of the River, but the weather being bad and having land on all sides of us, and a Dark night coming on, I thought it most adviseable to Tack and stretch in under ye Point where we Anchor'd in 19 fathoms. At 5 a.m. weighed and made Sail to the North-West under our Courses and double Reef'd Topsails, the wind being at South-West by West and West-South-West, a strong Gale and Squally blowing right off the land, which would not permit us to come near it, so that from the time of our getting under Sail until' Noon (during which time we ran 12 Leagues) we had but a slight and distant View of the Coast and was not able to distinguish wether the points we saw were parts of the Main or Islands laying before it, for we never once lost sight of the Main Land.* (* The Endeavour was now in Hauraki Gulf and had passed the harbour where Auckland now stands, which is hidden behind a number of islands.) At noon our Latitude by observation was 36 degrees 15 minutes 20 seconds South, being at this time not above 2 Miles from a Point of Land on the Main and 3 1/2 Leagues from a very high Island* (* Little Barrier Island, now (1892) about to be made a reserve to protect native fauna.) which bore North-East by East of us; in this Situation had 26 fathoms Water. The farthest point we could see on the Main bore from us North-West, but we could see several small Islands laying to the Northward of that direction. The point of land we are now abreast off, I take to be the North-West Extremity of the River Thames, for I shall comprehend under that Name the Deep Bay we have been in for this week past, the North-East point of which is the Promontory we past on Saturday morning last, and which I have named Cape Colvill in honour of the Right hon'ble the Lord Colvill;* (* Cook had served under Rear Admiral Lord Colville in Newfoundland.) Latitude 36 degrees 26 minutes South; Longitude 184 degrees 27 minutes West. It rises directly from the Sea to a Considerable height, but what makes it most remarkable is a high Rock standing close to the pitch of the point, and from some points of view may be distinguished at a very great distance. From the South-West point of this Cape the river Extends itself in a direct line South by East, and is no where less than 3 Leagues broad until' you are 14 Leagues above the Cape, there it is at once Contracted to a Narrow stream. From this place it still continues the same South by East Course thro' a low flat Country or broad Valley that lies Parrallel with the Sea Coast, the End of which we could not see. The land on the East side of the Broadest part of this river is Tollerable high and hilly, that on the West side is rather low, but the whole is cover'd with woods and Verdure and looks to be pretty fertile, but we saw but a few small places that were Cultivated. About the Entrance of the narrow part of the River the land is mostly Cover'd with Mangroves and other Shrubs, but farther in are immense woods of as stout lofty timber as is to be found perhaps in any other part of the world. In many places the woods grow close upon the very banks of the River, but where it does not the land is Marshey such as we find about the Thames in England. We saw poles stuck up in many places in the River to set nets for Catching of fish; from this we immagin'd that there must be plenty of fish, but of what sort we know not for we saw none. The Greatest Depth of Water we found was 26 fathoms and decreaseth pretty gradually as you run up to 1 1/2 and 1 fathom. In the mouth of the fresh-water Stream or narrow part is 3 and 4 fathoms, but before this are sand banks and large flatts; Yet, I believe, a Ship of a Moderate draught of Water may go a long way up this River with a flowing Tide, for I reckon that the Tides rise upon a perpendicular near 10 feet, and is high water at the full and Change of the Moon about 9 o'Clock. Six Leagues within Cape Colvill, under the Eastern Shore, are several small Islands, these Islands together with the Main seem'd to form some good Harbours.* (* Coromandel Harbour.) Opposite to these Islands under the Western Shore lies some other Islands, and it appear'd very probable that these form'd some good Harbours likewise.* (* Auckland Harbour is one of them.) But even supposing there were no Harbours about this River, it is good anchoring in every part of it where the depth of Water is Sufficient, being defended from the Sea by a Chain of Large and Small Islands which I have named Barrier Isles, lying aCross the Mouth of it extending themselves North-West and South-East 10 Leagues. The South end of these Islands lies North-East 4 1/2 Leagues from the North-West point of the River, which I have named point Rodney; it lies West-North-West 9 leagues from Cape Colvill, Latitude 36 degrees 15 minutes; Longitude 184 degrees 58 minutes West. The Natives residing about this River do not appear to be very numerous considering the great Extent of Country; at least not many came off to the Ship at one Time, and as we were but little ashore ourselves we could not so well judge of their numbers. They are a Strong, well made, active People as any we have seen yet, and all of them Paint their Bodys with Red Oker and Oil from Head to foot, a thing that we have not seen before. Their Canoes are large, well built and Ornamented with Carved work in general as well as most we have seen.

Friday, 24th. P.M., Fresh winds and dark, cloudy, squally weather, with thunder, lightning, and rain. Winds blowing from the North-West to the South-West, and by 7 o'clock we passed the North-West point of the River. However, due to the bad weather and having land all around us, along with a dark night approaching, I thought it wise to tack and head under the point where we anchored in 19 fathoms. At 5 a.m., we weighed anchor and set sail to the North-West with our sails set and double reefed topsails, as the wind was blowing strongly from South-West by West and West-South-West, making it impossible for us to approach the land. From the time we got under sail until noon (during which we covered 12 leagues), we only had a vague and distant view of the coast and couldn't tell whether the points we could see were parts of the mainland or islands in front of it, as we never lost sight of the mainland.* (* The Endeavour was now in Hauraki Gulf and had passed the harbor where Auckland now stands, which is hidden behind several islands.) At noon, our latitude by observation was 36 degrees 15 minutes 20 seconds South, at this time being not more than 2 miles from a point of land on the mainland and 3 1/2 leagues from a very high island* (* Little Barrier Island, now (1892) about to be made a reserve to protect native fauna.) that was to the North-East by East of us; in this position, we had 26 fathoms of water. The furthest point we could see on the mainland was to the North-West, but we could see several small islands lying to the North of that direction. The point of land we are currently near, I believe to be the North-West Extremity of the River Thames, as I will include under that name the deep bay we've been in for the past week, the North-East point of which is the promontory we passed last Saturday morning, which I have named Cape Colvill in honor of the Right Honorable Lord Colvill;* (* Cook had served under Rear Admiral Lord Colville in Newfoundland.) Latitude 36 degrees 26 minutes South; Longitude 184 degrees 27 minutes West. It rises directly from the sea to a considerable height, but what makes it most remarkable is a high rock standing close to the edge of the point, which can be distinguished from a great distance from several viewpoints. From the South-West point of this Cape, the river extends directly South by East and is never less than 3 leagues wide until you are 14 leagues above the Cape, where it suddenly narrows to a stream. From this place, it continues the same South by East course through a low flat area or broad valley that runs parallel to the coastline, the end of which we could not see. The land on the East side of the widest part of this river is fairly high and hilly, while the West side is lower, but the whole area is covered with woods and greenery and appears to be quite fertile, although we only saw a few small cultivated areas. Around the entrance of the narrower part of the river, the land is mostly covered with mangroves and other shrubs, but further in, there are vast woods with tall timber that is possibly among the sturdiest in the world. In many places, the woods grow right up to the banks of the river, but where they don't, the land is marshy, similar to what we find around the Thames in England. We saw poles stuck in many places in the river for setting nets to catch fish; from this, we imagined there must be plenty of fish, though we didn't see any. The deepest water we found was 26 fathoms, gradually decreasing to 1 1/2 and then 1 fathom. At the mouth of the fresh-water stream or narrow part, it was 3 and 4 fathoms, but before this, there are sandbanks and large flats. Yet, I believe a ship with a moderate draft could go a long way up this river with the rising tide, as I estimate that the tides rise nearly 10 feet vertically, and high water occurs at full and new moons around 9 o'clock. Six leagues from Cape Colvill, along the Eastern shore, there are several small islands, these islands along with the mainland seem to create some good harbors.* (* Coromandel Harbour.) Opposite these islands along the Western shore are other islands, and it appeared very likely that these also formed some good harbors.* (* Auckland Harbour is one of them.) But even assuming there were no harbors around this river, anchoring is good in every part of it where the water depth is sufficient, as it is protected from the sea by a chain of large and small islands that I have named Barrier Isles, stretching across the mouth of it from North-West to South-East for 10 leagues. The southern end of these islands lies North-East 4 1/2 leagues from the North-West point of the river, which I have named Point Rodney; it lies West-North-West 9 leagues from Cape Colvill, Latitude 36 degrees 15 minutes; Longitude 184 degrees 58 minutes West. The natives living around this river do not seem very numerous given the vast area of land; at least not many came to the ship at one time, and since we spent little time on shore ourselves, we could not accurately assess their numbers. They are a strong, well-built, active people as any we've seen so far, and all of them paint their bodies with red ochre and oil from head to toe, something we haven't seen before. Their canoes are large, well-built, and decorated with carved work, generally more so than most we've seen.

Saturday, 25th. P.M., had fresh Gales at South-West, and Squally weather. We kept standing along Shore to the North-West, having the Main land on the one side and Islands on the other; our Soundings were from 26 to 12 fathoms. At 1/2 past 7 p.m. we Anchor'd in a Bay in 14 fathoms, sandy bottom. We had no sooner come to an Anchor than we caught between 90 and 100 Bream (a fish so called), this occasioned my giving this place the Name of Bream Bay.* (* Whangarei Bay.) The 2 points which forms this Bay lie North and South 5 Leagues from each other. The Bay is every where pretty broad and between 3 and 4 Leagues deep; at the bottom of it their appears to be a fresh water River.* (* Whangarei River. The district is very fertile. Coal mines are in the vicinity, and coal is exported.) The North head of the Bay, called Bream head, is high land and remarkable on account of several peaked rocks ranged in order upon the top of it; it lies in the Latitude 35 degrees 46 minutes South and North 41 degrees West, distant 17 1/2 Leagues from Cape Colvill. This Bay may likewise be known by some Small Islands lying before it called the Hen and Chickens, one of which is pretty high and terminates at Top in 2 peaks. The land between Point Rodney and Bream Head, which is 10 Leagues, is low and wooded in Turfs, and between the Sea and the firm land are white sand banks. We saw no inhabitants but saw fires in the Night, a proof that the Country is not uninhabited. At daylight A.M. we left the Bay and directed our Course along shore to the northward, having a Gentle breeze at South by West and Clear weather. A little after sunrise found the Variation to be 12 degrees 42 minutes Easterly. At Noon, our Latitude by observation was 36 degrees 36 minutes South; Bream head bore South distant 10 Miles; some small Islands (Poor Knights) at North-East by North distant 3 Leagues, and the Northermost land in sight bore North-North-West, being at this Time 2 miles from the Shore, and in this Situation had 26 fathoms; the land here about is rather low and pretty well cover'd with wood and seems not ill inhabited.

Saturday, the 25th. In the afternoon, we had fresh gales coming from the southwest and squally weather. We continued to move along the shore to the northwest, with the mainland on one side and islands on the other; our soundings ranged from 26 to 12 fathoms. At 7:30 p.m., we anchored in a bay with 14 fathoms of sandy bottom. No sooner had we dropped anchor than we caught between 90 and 100 bream (a type of fish), which is why I named this place Bream Bay.* (*Whangarei Bay.) The two points that form this bay lie north and south, 5 leagues apart. The bay is generally pretty wide and between 3 and 4 leagues deep; at the far end, there seems to be a freshwater river.* (*Whangarei River. The area is very fertile, and there are coal mines nearby, with coal being exported.) The northern head of the bay, called Bream Head, is high land and notable for the several peaked rocks arranged on top of it; it is located at latitude 35 degrees 46 minutes south and longitude 41 degrees west, 17.5 leagues from Cape Colvill. This bay can also be identified by some small islands in front of it called the Hen and Chickens, one of which is fairly high and has two peaks at the top. The land between Point Rodney and Bream Head, which is 10 leagues, is low and covered with turf, and there are white sandbanks between the sea and the solid land. We didn’t see any inhabitants but noticed fires during the night, indicating that the area is not uninhabited. At dawn, we left the bay and headed north along the shore, with a gentle breeze from the south by west and clear weather. Shortly after sunrise, we found the variation to be 12 degrees 42 minutes east. At noon, our latitude was 36 degrees 36 minutes south by observation; Bream Head was to the south, 10 miles away; some small islands (Poor Knights) were at north-east by north, 3 leagues distant, and the northernmost land in sight was to the north-northwest, just 2 miles from the shore, with a depth of 26 fathoms; the land in that area is relatively low and well-covered with trees and appears to be moderately inhabited.

[Off Cape Brett, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Cape Brett, North Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 26th. P.M., Gentle breezes between the East-North-East and North, kept ranging along shore to the Northward. At the distance of 4 or 5 Miles off saw several Villages and some Cultivated lands; towards evening several Canoes came off to us, and some of the Natives ventur'd on board; to 2, who appear'd to be Chiefs, I gave presents. After these were gone out of the Ship, the others became so Troublesome that in order to get rid of them we were at the expence of 2 or 3 Musquet Balls, and one 4 pound Shott, but as no harm was intended them, none they received, unless they hapned to over heat themselves in pulling on shore. In the Night had variable light Airs, but towards morning had a light breeze at South, and afterward at South-East; with this we proceeded slowly to the Northward. At 6 a.m. several Canoes came off from the place where they landed last night, and between this and noon many more came from other parts. Had at one time a good many of the people on board, and about 170 alongside; their behaviour was Tolerable friendly, but we could not prevail upon them to Traffic with us. At noon, the Mainland Extending from South by East to North-West by West; a remarkable point of land bore West, distant 4 or 5 miles. Latitude Observed 35 degrees 11 minutes South.

Sunday, 26th. P.M., Gentle breezes from the East-North-East to North continued along the shore to the North. About 4 or 5 miles away, we saw several villages and some cultivated land. In the evening, several canoes approached us, and some of the locals came aboard; I gave gifts to two who seemed to be chiefs. After they left the ship, the others became so bothersome that we ended up using 2 or 3 musket balls and one 4-pound shot to get rid of them, but we meant no harm, and none was done to them, unless they happened to overheat while pulling to shore. At night, there were varying light breezes, but towards morning, we had a light breeze from the South, and then from the South-East; with this wind, we slowly continued North. At 6 a.m., several canoes came from the spot where they landed the night before, and many more came from other areas before noon. At one point, we had quite a few people on board and about 170 alongside; their behavior was fairly friendly, but we couldn’t get them to trade with us. At noon, the mainland stretched from South by East to North-West by West; a notable point of land was located to the West, about 4 or 5 miles away. Latitude observed was 35 degrees 11 minutes South.

Monday, 27th. P.M., Gentle breezes Easterly, and Clear weather. At 3 passed the point of land afore-mentioned, which I have named Cape Brett in honour of Sir Piercy.* (* Rear Admiral Sir Piercey Brett was one of the Lords of the Admiralty when the Endeavour sailed.) The land of this Cape is considerable higher than any part of the Adjacent Coast. At the very point of the Cape is a high round Hillock, and North-East by North, near one Mile from this is a small high Island or Rock with a hole pierced thro' it like the Arch of a Bridge, and this was one reason why I gave the Cape the above name, because Piercy seem'd very proper for that of the Island. This Cape, or at least some part of it, is called by the Natives Motugogogo; Latitude 35 degrees 10 minutes 30 seconds South, Longitude 185 degrees 25 minutes West. On the West side of Cape Brett is a large and pretty deep Bay* (* The Bay of Islands.) lying in South-West by West, in which there appear'd to be several small Islands. The point that forms the North-West entrance I have named Point Pocock; it lies West 1/4 North, 3 or 4 Leagues from Cape Brett. On the South-West side of this Bay we saw several Villages situated both on Islands and on the Main land, from whence came off to us several large Canoes full of People, but, like those that had been alongside before, would not Enter into a friendly Traffick with us, but would Cheat whenever they had an opportunity. The people in these Canoes made a very good appearance, being all stout well-made men, having their Hair--which was black--comb'd up and tied upon the Crown of their heads, and there stuck with white feathers; in each of the Canoes were 2 or 3 Chiefs, and the Habits of these were rather superior to any we had yet seen. The Cloth they wore was of the best sort, and cover'd on the outside with Dog Skins put on in such a manner as to look Agreeable enough to the Eye. Few of these people were Tattow'd or marked in the face, like those we have seen farther to the South, but several had their Backsides Tattow'd much in the same manner as the inhabitants of the Islands within the Tropics. In the Course of this day, that is this afternoon and Yesterday forenoon, we reckoned that we had not less than 400 or 500 of the Natives alongside and on board the ship, and in that time did not range above 6 or 8 Leagues of the Sea Coast, a strong proof that this part of the Country must be well inhabited. In the Evening, the Wind came to the Westward of North, and we Tack'd and stood off North-East until 11 o'Clock, when the wind coming more favourable we stood again to the Westward. At 8 a.m we were within a Mile of Groups of Islands lying close under the Mainland and North-West by West 1/2 West, distance 22 Miles from Cape Brett. Here we lay for near 2 Hours, having little or no wind. During this time several Canoes came off to the Ship, and 2 or 3 of them sold us some fish--Cavallys as they are called--which occasioned my giving the Islands the same name. After this some others began to Pelt us with Stones, and would not desist at the firing of 2 Musquet Balls thro' one of their Boats; at last I was obliged to pepper 2 or 3 fellows with small Shott, after which they retir'd, and the wind coming at North-West we stood off to Sea. At Noon, Cavally Islands bore South-West by South, distant 4 Miles; Cape Brett South-East, distant 7 Leagues, and the Westermost land in sight, making like Islands, bore West by North; Latitude in per Observation 34 degrees 55 minutes South.

Monday, 27th. PM, Gentle easterly breezes and clear weather. At 3, we passed the previously mentioned point of land, which I named Cape Brett in honor of Sir Piercy.* (* Rear Admiral Sir Piercey Brett was one of the Lords of the Admiralty when the Endeavour sailed.) The land at this Cape is significantly higher than any part of the nearby coast. At the very tip of the Cape, there’s a high round hill, and North-East by North, about a mile away, is a small high island or rock with a hole through it like the arch of a bridge. This was one reason I chose the name for the Cape, as Piercy seemed fitting for the island. This Cape, or at least part of it, is called Motugogogo by the natives; Latitude 35 degrees 10 minutes 30 seconds South, Longitude 185 degrees 25 minutes West. On the west side of Cape Brett is a large and fairly deep bay* (* The Bay of Islands.) lying South-West by West, in which there appeared to be several small islands. The point forming the north-west entrance I named Point Pocock; it lies West 1/4 North, 3 to 4 leagues from Cape Brett. On the southwest side of this bay, we saw several villages situated both on islands and the mainland, from which several large canoes full of people came out to us. However, like those who had been alongside before, they would not engage in friendly trade and would cheat whenever they had the chance. The people in these canoes looked impressive, being all strong, well-built men, with black hair combed up and tied at the crown of their heads, adorned with white feathers. Each canoe had 2 or 3 chiefs, who were dressed somewhat better than anyone we had seen so far. Their clothes were of the finest quality and covered on the outside with dog skins arranged in a visually appealing way. Few of these people had tattoos or markings on their faces, like those we had seen further south, but several had their backs tattooed similarly to the inhabitants of tropical islands. Over the course of this day, that is, this afternoon and yesterday morning, we estimated that there were no less than 400 or 500 natives alongside and on board the ship, and during that time, we did not travel more than 6 or 8 leagues along the coastline, a strong indication that this area is well inhabited. In the evening, the wind shifted to the west of north, and we tacked and sailed off to the north-east until 11 o'clock, when the wind became more favorable, and we headed west again. At 8 AM, we were within a mile of groups of islands lying close under the mainland, North-West by West 1/2 West, 22 miles from Cape Brett. We stayed here for nearly 2 hours, with little or no wind. During this time, several canoes came to the ship, and 2 or 3 of them sold us some fish—cavallys, as they are called—leading me to name the islands after them. After that, some others started throwing stones at us and wouldn't stop even after we fired 2 musket balls across one of their boats; eventually, I had to shoot 2 or 3 of them with small shot, after which they retreated, and with the wind coming from the north-west, we sailed off to sea. At noon, the Cavally Islands were South-West by South, 4 miles away; Cape Brett was South-East, 7 leagues away, and the westernmost land in sight, appearing like islands, was West by North; Latitude by observation was 34 degrees 55 minutes South.

Tuesday, 28th. A Fresh breeze from the Westward all this day, which being right in our teeth, we kept beating to windward with all the sail we could Crowd, but instead of Gaining we lost ground. A.M., being close in with the land to the Westward of the Bay, which lies on this side of Cape Brett, we saw at some distance inland 2 pretty large Villages Pallisaded in the same manner as others we have seen. At noon, Cape Brett South-East by East 1/2 East, distant 6 Leagues; Latitude observed 35 degrees 0 minutes South.

Tuesday, 28th. A fresh breeze blew from the west all day, which was directly against us. We tried to sail upwind with all the sails we could manage, but instead of making progress, we lost ground. In the morning, while we were close to the land to the west of the bay near Cape Brett, we spotted two pretty large villages in the distance, surrounded by fences like others we've seen. At noon, Cape Brett was located southeast by east, half east, six leagues away; latitude observed was 35 degrees 0 minutes south.

[At Bay of Islands, North Island, New Zealand.]

[At Bay of Islands, North Island, New Zealand.]

Wednesday, 29th. Fresh Gales at North-West and West-North-West, kept plying to Windward until 7 A.M., and finding that we lost ground every board we made, I thought I could not do better than to bear up for the Bay, which lies to the Westward of Cape Brett, it being at this Time not above 2 Leagues to Leeward of us, for by putting in there we should gain some knowledge of it, on the Contrary, by Keeping the Sea with a Contrary wind, we were sure of meeting with nothing new. These reasons induced me to bear away for the Bay,* (* The Bay of Islands.) and at 11 o'Clock we Anchor'd under the South-West side of one of the many Islands* (* Motu Arohia.) that line the South-East side of it, in 4 1/2 fathoms; but as we fell into this shoald water all at once, we Anchor'd sooner than was intended, and sent the Master with 2 Boats to sound, who found that we had got upon a Bank that spitted off from the North-West end of the Island, and that on the outside of it was 8 and 10 fathoms Water.

Wednesday, 29th. Fresh winds from the North-West and West-North-West kept pushing us to windward until 7 A.M. Realizing that we were losing ground with every tack we made, I decided it would be better to head for the Bay, which is located to the west of Cape Brett, and was only about 2 leagues downwind from us at that time. By going in there, we would gain some understanding of the area; on the other hand, staying out at sea against the wind would mean we’d find nothing new. These reasons led me to change course for the Bay.* (*The Bay of Islands.) By 11 o'clock, we anchored on the South-West side of one of the many islands* (*Motu Arohia.) that line the South-East side, in 4 1/2 fathoms of water. However, as we suddenly entered this shallow water, we anchored sooner than planned and sent the Master with 2 boats to take soundings. He discovered that we had run aground on a bank that extended from the North-West end of the island, and that there was 8 to 10 fathoms of water outside it.

Thursday, 30th. P.M., had the winds Westerly, with some very heavy Showers of Rain. We had no sooner come to an Anchor than between 300 and 400 of the Natives Assembled in their Canoes about the Ship; some few were admitted on board, and to one of the Chiefs I gave a piece of Broad Cloth and distributed a few Nails, etc., among some others of them. Many of these People had been off to the Ship when we were at Sea, and seem'd to be very sencible of the use of Fire Arms, and in the Trade we had with them they behaved Tolerable well, but continued so not long, before some of them wanted to take away the Buoy,* (* The buoy on the anchor.) and would not desist at the firing of several Musquets until one of them was hurt by small Shott, after which they withdrew a small distance from the Ship, and this was thought a good opportunity to try what Effect a Great Gun would have, as they paid so little respect to a Musquet, and accordingly one was fir'd over their Heads. This, I believe, would have sent them quite off, if it had not been for Tupia, who soon prevail'd on them to return to the Ship, when their behaviour was such as gave us no room to suspect that they meant to give us any farther Trouble.

Thursday, 30th. P.M., the winds were coming from the west, with some heavy rain showers. We had just anchored when around 300 to 400 locals gathered in their canoes near the ship. A few were allowed on board, and I gave a piece of broadcloth to one of the chiefs and distributed some nails and other items to others. Many of these people had previously approached the ship while we were at sea, and they seemed quite aware of how to use firearms. During our trade with them, they behaved reasonably well, but it didn't last long before some tried to take the buoy* (* The buoy on the anchor.) and wouldn’t stop even after we fired several muskets. It wasn't until one of them was injured by small shot that they backed off a bit from the ship. We thought this was a good chance to see how effective a cannon would be, since they showed so little respect for a musket, and so we fired one over their heads. I believe this would have sent them running, but Tupia quickly convinced them to come back to the ship, and their behavior then caused no further concern that they intended to cause us any more trouble.

After the Ship was moved into Deeper Water I went with the Pinnace and Yawl, mann'd and Arm'd, and landed upon the Island, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We had scarce landed before all the Canoes left the Ship and landed at different parts of the Island, and before we could well look about us we were surrounded by 2 or 300 People, and, notwithstanding that they were all Arm'd, they came upon us in such a confused, straggling manner that we hardly suspected that they meant us any harm; but in this we were very soon undeceived, for upon our Endeavouring to draw a line on the sand between us and them they set up the War dance, and immediately some of them attempted to seize the 2 Boats. Being disappointed in this, they next attempted to break in upon us, upon which I fir'd a Musquet loaded with small Shott at one of the Forwardest of them, and Mr. Banks and 2 of the Men fir'd immediately after. This made them retire back a little, but in less than a minute one of the Chiefs rallied them again. Dr. Solander, seeing this, gave him a peppering with small Shott, which sent him off and made them retire a Second time. They attempted to rally several times after, and only seem'd to want some one of resolution to head them; but they were at last intirely dispers'd by the Ship firing a few shott over their Heads and a Musquet now and then from us. In this Skirmish only one or 2 of them was Hurt with small Shott, for I avoided killing any one of them as much as Possible, and for that reason withheld our people from firing. We had observed that some had hid themselves in a Cave in one of the Rocks, and sometime after the whole was over we went Towards them. The Chief who I have mentioned to have been on board the Ship hapned to be one of these; he, his wife, and another came out to meet us, but the rest made off. Those 3 people came and sat down by us, and we gave them of such things as we had about us. After this we went to another part of the Island, where some of the inhabitants came to us, and were as meek as lambs. Having taken a View of the Bay from the Island and Loaded both Boats with Sellery, which we found here in great plenty, we return'd on board, and at 4 A.M. hove up the Anchor in order to put to Sea, with a light breeze at East, but it soon falling Calm, obliged us to come too again, and about 8 or 9 o'Clock, seeing no probability of our getting to Sea, I sent the Master to Sound the Harbour. But before this I order'd Matthew Cox, Henry Stevens, and Emanl Parreyra to be punished with a dozen lashes each for leaving their duty when ashore last night, and digging up Potatoes out of one of the Plantations.* (* Cook's care to deal fairly with natives is evinced by this punishment.) The first of the 3 I remitted back to Confinement because he insisted that there was no harm in what he had done. All this Forenoon had abundance of the Natives about the Ship and some few on board. We Trafficked with them for a few Trifles, in which they dealt very fair and friendly.

After the ship was moved to deeper water, I went with the small boat and the yawl, equipped and armed, and landed on the island with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We had barely set foot on land when all the canoes left the ship and landed at different spots on the island. Before we could take a good look around, we were surrounded by 200 or 300 people. Even though they were all armed, they approached us in such a disorganized way that we hardly suspected they meant us any harm. However, we quickly realized we were mistaken. When we tried to draw a line in the sand between us and them, they began performing a war dance, and some tried to seize the two boats. When that didn’t work, they attempted to rush us. I fired a musket loaded with small shot at one of the ones in front, and Mr. Banks along with two of the men fired immediately after. This made them back off a little, but within a minute, one of their chiefs rallied them again. Dr. Solander, seeing this, took a shot at him with small shot, which sent him retreating and made the others pull back for a second time. They tried to regroup several times and seemed to be looking for someone with enough courage to lead them, but ultimately they dispersed entirely when the ship fired a few shots over their heads, along with occasional muskets from us. During this skirmish, only one or two of them were injured with small shot, as I tried to avoid killing anyone and kept our men from firing too much. We noticed some had hidden in a cave in one of the rocks, and sometime later, after everything calmed down, we approached them. The chief mentioned earlier, who had been on board the ship, happened to be among them; he, his wife, and another person came out to meet us, while the rest ran away. The three of them sat down with us, and we gave them some of the things we had. After this, we went to another part of the island where some of the inhabitants approached us and were very calm. After taking a look at the bay from the island and loading both boats with celery, which was abundant there, we returned on board. At 4 A.M., we lifted the anchor to head out to sea with a light breeze from the east, but it soon calmed down, forcing us to stop again. Around 8 or 9 o'clock, seeing no chance of getting to sea, I sent the master to sound the harbor. Before this, I ordered Matthew Cox, Henry Stevens, and Emanuel Parreyra to each receive a dozen lashes for leaving their duty ashore last night to dig up potatoes from one of the plantations. I let the first of the three return to confinement because he insisted that he had done nothing wrong. Throughout that morning, there were many natives around the ship and a few on board. We bartered with them for some trinkets, and they traded very fairly and kindly.

[December 1769.]

[December 1769.]

Friday, 1st December. Winds at North-North-West a Gentle breeze. At 3 p.m., the Boats having return'd from sounding, I went with them over to the South side of the Harbour, and landed upon the Main, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We met with nothing new or remarkable. The place where we landed was in a small sandy Cove, where there are 2 small Streams of Fresh Water and Plenty of Wood for fuel. Here were likewise several little Plantations planted with Potatoes and Yams. The Soil and Natural produce of the Country was much the same as what we have hitherto met with. The people we saw behaved to us with great marks of friendship. In the evening we had Some very heavy showers of rain, and this brought us on board sooner than we intended. A.M., the wind being still contrary, I sent some people ashore upon the Island to cut Grass for our Sheep, in the doing of which the inhabitants gave them no sort of disturbance, and in the same friendly manner did those behave that were alongside the Ship. Punished Matthew Cox with 6 Lashes, and then dismiss'd him.

Friday, December 1. Winds from the North-Northwest, a gentle breeze. At 3 p.m., after the boats returned from their soundings, I went with them to the south side of the harbor and landed on the mainland, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We found nothing new or noteworthy. We landed in a small sandy cove, which had two small streams of fresh water and plenty of wood for fuel. There were also several small plots where they had planted potatoes and yams. The soil and natural produce of the area were much the same as what we had encountered so far. The people we met were very friendly toward us. In the evening, we experienced some heavy rain showers, which caused us to return to the ship earlier than planned. In the morning, with the wind still unfavorable, I sent some people ashore on the island to cut grass for our sheep, and the locals did not disturb them at all, behaving just as kindly as those alongside the ship. I punished Matthew Cox with six lashes and then dismissed him.

Saturday, 2nd. Winds at North-West and North. P.M. a Gentle breeze; the remainder Strong Gales and hazey, with much rain towards Noon. At 8 a.m. hoisted out the Long boat, and sent her ashore for water, and the Pinnace to haul the Sean; but they had not got well ashore before it began to blow and rain very hard. This occasioned them to return on board with one Turn of water and but a very few fish.

Saturday, the 2nd. Winds from the Northwest and North. In the afternoon, a light breeze; the rest of the time was strong gusts and hazy, with a lot of rain around noon. At 8 a.m., we launched the longboat and sent it to shore for water, and we also sent the pinnace to haul the seine; however, they barely made it ashore before it started to blow and rain heavily. This forced them to come back on board with just one load of water and very few fish.

Sunday, 3rd. P.M., Strong Gales at North, with rain; the remainder Gentle breezes from the Westward. A.M., sent 2 Boats to sound the Harbour and one to haul the Sean, the latter of which met with very little Success.

Sunday, 3rd. P.M., Strong winds from the North, with rain; the rest were light breezes from the West. A.M., sent 2 boats to survey the harbor and one to fish with a seine, but the latter had very little success.

Monday, 4th. Gentle breezes at North-West, West-North-West, and West; very fair weather. P.M., Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself landed upon one of the Islands* (* Probably Motu-Rua.) on the North side of the one the Ship lays under. This Island is about 3 Miles in Circuit, and hath upon it 40 or 50 Acres of Land cultivated and planted with roots; here are likewise several small streams of Excellent water. This Island, as well as most others in this Bay, seem to be well inhabited. At 4 a.m. sent the Long boat to the above Island for water and some hands to cut Grass, and at 9, I went with the Pinnace and Yawl over upon the Main, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. In our way we passed by a point of land on which stood a Hippa or Fortified Village, the inhabitants of which waved us to come ashore, and accordingly we landed, which we had no sooner done than the People came about us with Quantitys of various sorts of fish, which we purchased of them for meer Trifles. After this they shew'd us the Village, which was a neat Compact place, and its situation well Choose. There were 2 or 3 more near unto this, but these we did not go to. We afterwards went a little way into the Country, and had some of the Natives along with us; we met with a good deal of Cultivated land, planted mostly with sweet potatoes. The face of the Country appear'd Green and pleasant, and the soil seem'd to be pretty rich and proper for Cultivation. The land is every where about this Bay of a moderate height, but full of small Hills and Vallies, and not much incumbered with wood. We met with about 1/2 a dozen Cloth plants, being the same as the inhabitants of the Islands lying within the Tropics make their finest Cloth on. This plant must be very scarce among them, as the Cloth made from it is only worn in small pieces by way of Ornaments at their ears, and even this we have seen but very seldom. Their knowing the use of this sort of Cloth doth in some measure account for the extraordinary fondness they have shew'd for it above every other thing we had to give them. Even a sheet of white paper is of more value than so much English Cloth of any sort whatever; but, as we have been at few places where I have not given away more or less of the latter, it's more than probable that they will soon learn to set a value upon it, and likewise upon Iron, a thing not one of them knows the use of or sets the least value upon; but was European commodities in ever such Esteem among them, they have no one thing of Equal value to give in return, at least that we have seen.

Monday, 4th. Gentle breezes from the Northwest, West-Northwest, and West; very nice weather. In the afternoon, Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I landed on one of the Islands* (* Probably Motu-Rua.) on the north side of the island where the ship is anchored. This island is about 3 miles around and has 40 to 50 acres of land cultivated with crops; there are also several small streams of excellent water. This island, like most others in this bay, appears to be well populated. At 4 a.m. I sent the longboat to the above island for water and some people to cut grass, and at 9, I went with the pinnace and yawl to the mainland, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. On our way, we passed by a point of land with a Hippa or fortified village, whose inhabitants waved us to come ashore, and we did so. As soon as we landed, people gathered around us with a variety of fish, which we bought from them for mere trifles. After this, they showed us the village, which was a neat, compact place, well situated. There were 2 or 3 more near this one, but we did not visit them. We then went a little way into the countryside, accompanied by some of the locals; we encountered quite a bit of cultivated land, mostly planted with sweet potatoes. The land appeared green and pleasant, and the soil seemed to be quite rich and suitable for cultivation. The land surrounding this bay is of moderate height, full of small hills and valleys, and not overly wooded. We came across about half a dozen cloth plants, which the inhabitants of the islands within the tropics use to make their finest cloth. This plant must be quite rare for them, as the cloth made from it is only worn in small pieces as ornaments in their ears, and even this we have seen only very rarely. Their knowledge of this type of cloth somewhat explains the extraordinary fondness they have shown for it over everything else we offered them. Even a sheet of white paper is considered more valuable than any amount of English cloth; however, since we have been to few places where I haven’t given away some of the latter, it’s likely they will soon learn to value it, along with iron, which none of them know how to use or value at all. Even if European commodities are highly esteemed among them, they do not have anything of equal value to give in return, at least not that we have seen.

Tuesday, 5th. P.M., had the winds at South-West and West-South-West, a fresh breeze. At 3 o'Clock we return'd on board, and after dinner Visited another part of the Bay, but met with nothing new. By the evening all our Empty Casks were fill'd with water, and had at the same time got on board a large quantity of Sellery, which is found here in great Plenty. This I still caused to be boild every morning with Oatmeal and Portable Soup for the Ship's Company's breakfast. At 4 a.m. weigh'd with a light breeze at South-East, but had Variable light Airs and sometimes Calm until near Noon, when a Gentle breeze sprung up at North. At this time we had not got out of the Bay; our Latitude by Observation was 35 degrees 9 minutes South. This Bay I have before observed, lies on the West side of Cape Brett: I have named it the Bay of Islands,* (* The principal settlement in the Bay of Islands is Russell. A little higher up the Waikare River, at Opua, coal obtained from mines in the vicinity is shipped. At Russell, then called Kororarika, the first settlement of missionaries was formed in 1814 by Samuel Marsden. Here also the Government of the Island was first established in 1840, but was soon removed to Auckland.) on account of the Great Number which line its shores, and these help to form Several safe and Commodious Harbours, wherein is room and Depth of Water sufficient for any number of Shipping. The one we lay in is on the South-West side of South-Westermost Island, that lies on the South-East side of the Bay. I have made no accurate Survey of this Bay; the time it would have requir'd to have done this discouraged me from attempting it; besides, I thought it quite Sufficient to be able to Affirm with Certainty that it affords a good Anchorage and every kind of refreshment for Shipping, but as this was not the Season for roots, we got only fish. Some few we Caught ourselves with hook and line and in the Sean, but by far the greatest part we purchased of the Natives, and these of Various sorts, such as Sharks, Stingrays, Breams, Mullet, Mackerel, and several other sorts. Their way of Catching them is the same as ours, viz., with Hook and line and Seans; of the last they have some prodidgious large made all of a Strong Kind of Grass. The Mackerel are in every respect the same as those we have in England, only some are larger than any I ever saw in any other Part of the World; although this is the Season for this fish, we have never been able to Catch one with hook and line. The inhabitants of this Bay are far more numerous than at any other place we have yet been in, and seem to live in friendship one with another, although it doth not at all appear that they are united under one head.* (* This district was found to be very populous when the missionaries came.) They inhabited both the Islands and the Main, and have a Number of Hippas, or Strong Holds, and these are all built in such places as nature hath in a great part fortified, and what she hath left undone the people themselves have finished. It is high water in this Bay at full and change of the Moon about 8 o'clock, and the tide at these times rises and falls upon a perpendicular 6 or 8 feet. It appears, from the few Observations I have been able to make of the Tides on the Sea-Coast, that the flood comes from the Southward, and I have lately had reasons to think that there is a current which comes from the Westward and sets along shore to the South-East or South-South-East, as the Land lays.

Tuesday, 5th. P.M., we had winds from the South-West and West-South-West, with a fresh breeze. At 3 o'clock we returned on board, and after dinner, we explored another part of the Bay but found nothing new. By evening, all our empty casks were filled with water, and we also brought on board a large amount of Sellery, which is abundant here. I continued to boil this every morning with oatmeal and portable soup for the crew's breakfast. At 4 a.m., we weighed anchor with a light breeze from the South-East, but had variable light breezes and sometimes calm until near noon, when a gentle breeze picked up from the North. At this time, we hadn't left the Bay; our latitude by observation was 35 degrees 9 minutes South. I've previously noted that this Bay is on the West side of Cape Brett; I've named it the Bay of Islands,* (*The main settlement in the Bay of Islands is Russell. Further up the Waikare River, coal from nearby mines is shipped from Opua. Russell, formerly known as Kororarika, was the site of the first missionary settlement established in 1814 by Samuel Marsden. The government of the Island was first set up here in 1840 but was soon moved to Auckland.) because of the many islands along its shores, which help create several safe and convenient harbors with enough room and depth for any number of ships. The one we are in is on the South-West side of the South-Westernmost Island, which is on the South-East side of the Bay. I haven’t done an accurate survey of this Bay; the time it would take to do so discouraged me from trying. Besides, I thought it was quite enough to confirm that it provides a good anchorage and all kinds of supplies for ships. However, since this isn’t the season for roots, we only managed to catch fish. A few we caught ourselves with hook and line and in the seine net, but most we purchased from the natives, and there were various types, including sharks, stingrays, bream, mullet, mackerel, and several others. They catch fish the same way we do, using hooks and lines, as well as seines; some of their seines are incredibly large, made from a strong type of grass. The mackerel are identical to those we have in England, though some are larger than any I've seen elsewhere. Even though this is the season for this fish, we have never been able to catch one with hook and line. The inhabitants of this Bay are noticeably more numerous than in any other place we’ve visited so far, and they seem to live in harmony, although it doesn’t seem like they’re united under one leader.* (*This district was found to be very populous when the missionaries arrived.) They occupy both the Islands and the mainland, and they have a number of hippas or strongholds, all built in places that nature has mostly fortified, and whatever she hasn’t completed, the people have finished themselves. It's high tide in this Bay at full and new moons around 8 o'clock, with the tide rising and falling about 6 to 8 feet vertically. From the few observations I've managed to make of the tides along the coast, it seems the flood comes from the South, and I've recently had reasons to believe that there’s a current coming from the West that runs along the shore to the South-East or South-South-East as the land lies.

[Sail from Bay of Islands, New Zealand.]

[Sail from Bay of Islands, New Zealand.]

Wednesday, 6th. P.M., had a Gentle breeze at North-North-West, with which we kept turning out of the Bay, but gain'd little or nothing; in the evening it fell little wind; at 10 o'Clock it was Calm. At this time the tide or Current seting the Ship near one of the Islands, where we were very near being ashore; but, by the help of our Boats and a light Air from the Southward, we got clear. About an hour after, when we thought ourselves out of all danger, the Ship struck upon a Sunken rock* (* Called Whale Rock, in Endeavour's chart.) and went immediately clear without receiving any perceptible damage. Just before the man in the Chains had 17 fathoms Water, and immediately after she struck 5 fathoms, but very soon Deepned to 20. This rock lies half-a-mile West-North-West from the Northermost or outermost Island that lies on the South-East side of the Bay. Had light Airs from the Land and sometimes Calm until 9 o'Clock a.m.; at this time we had got out of the Bay, and a breeze springing up at North-North-West, we stood out to Sea. At noon Cape Brett bore South-South-East 1/2 South, distant 10 miles. Latitude observed, 34 degrees 59 minutes South.

Wednesday, 6th. P.M., we had a gentle breeze from the North-North-West, which helped us keep turning out of the bay, but we gained very little. In the evening, the wind died down, and by 10 o'clock, it was calm. At this time, the tide or current was pushing the ship close to one of the islands, and we almost ran aground; however, with the help of our boats and a light breeze from the south, we managed to get free. About an hour later, when we thought we were in the clear, the ship hit a submerged rock (*Called Whale Rock, in Endeavour's chart.) but immediately got free without any noticeable damage. Just before the man in the chains recorded 17 fathoms of water, and immediately after we struck, it dropped to 5 fathoms but soon deepened to 20. This rock is located half a mile West-North-West from the northernmost or outermost island on the southeast side of the bay. We had light breezes from the land and sometimes calm until 9 o'clock a.m.; at that point, we had made it out of the bay, and a breeze picked up from the North-North-West as we headed out to sea. At noon, Cape Brett was positioned South-South-East 1/2 South, 10 miles away. Latitude observed was 34 degrees 59 minutes South.

Thursday, 7th. P.M., a fresh breeze from the Westward and Clear weather. At 3 o'Clock took several Observations of the Sun and Moon; the mean result of them gives 185 degrees 36 minutes West Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich. What winds we have had this 24 hours hath been against us, so that at Noon we had advanced but very little to the Westward.

Thursday, 7th. P.M., a fresh breeze coming from the west and clear weather. At 3 o'clock, I took several observations of the Sun and Moon; the average result shows 185 degrees 36 minutes west longitude from the Greenwich Meridian. The winds we've experienced in the last 24 hours have been against us, so by noon, we had made very little progress to the west.

Friday, 8th. Forepart of P.M. had a Gentle breeze at North-North-West, with which we stood in shore and fetched close under the Cavalle Islands. They are a Group of Small Islands lying close under the Main land, and 7 Leagues North 60 West from Cape Brett, and 3 1/2 Leagues from Point Rodney. From these Islands the Main land trends West by North. We were here Visited by several Canoes, and the People in them seem'd desirous of Trafficking with us, but at this time a breeze of wind sprung up at South, they could not keep up with the Ship, and I would not wait for them. The wind did not continue long at South before it veer'd to South-West and West, a light breeze. Found the Variation in the Evening to be 12 degrees 42 minutes East, and in the Morning 13 degrees East. Keept standing to the West-North-West and North-West until 10 A.M., at which time we tacked and stood in for the Shore, being about 5 Leagues off, and in this situation had 118 fathoms Water. At Noon Cape Brett bore South-East, distant 13 Leagues, and the Westermost land in sight bore West by South, being at this time about 4 Leagues from Land. Latitude in per Observation, 34 degrees 42 minutes South.

Friday, 8th. Early in the afternoon, there was a gentle breeze from the north-northwest, which allowed us to approach the Cavalle Islands closely. These are a group of small islands located just off the mainland, about 7 leagues north 60 west from Cape Brett, and 3.5 leagues from Point Rodney. From these islands, the mainland trends west by north. While we were here, several canoes visited us, and the people in them seemed eager to trade, but at that moment, the wind shifted to the south, and they couldn’t keep up with the ship. I didn’t wait for them. The south wind didn't last long before it shifted to the southwest and west, becoming a light breeze. In the evening, I recorded the variation as 12 degrees 42 minutes east, and in the morning, it was 13 degrees east. We continued heading west-northwest and northwest until 10 A.M., when we tacked and headed toward the shore, being about 5 leagues out, in a spot where we measured 118 fathoms of water. At noon, Cape Brett was to the southeast, 13 leagues away, and the westernmost land in sight was to the west by south, about 4 leagues from land at that time. Our latitude, based on observation, was 34 degrees 42 minutes south.

Saturday, 9th. P.M., had a Gentle Breeze at West, which in the Evening came to South and continued so all night; this by daylight brought us pretty well in with the land, 7 Leagues to the Westward of the Cavalle Isles, and where lies a deep Bay running in South-West by West and West-South-West, the bottom of which we could but just see, and there the land appear'd to be low and level, the 2 points which form the Entrance lie West-North-West and East-South-East 5 Miles from each other. This Bay I have named Doubtless Bay;* (* There is a small settlement called Mangonui in Doubtless Bay.) the wind not permitting us to look into this Bay we steer'd for the Westermost land we had in sight, which bore from us West-North-West, distant 3 Leagues, but before we got the length of it it fell calm, and continued so until 10 o'Clock, when a breeze sprung up at West-North-West, and with it we stood off North. While we lay becalm'd, several of the Natives came off to the Ship in 5 Canoes, but were fearful of venturing alongside. After these were gone, 6 more came off; these last came boldly alongside, and sold us fish of different sorts sufficient to give all hands a little.

Saturday, the 9th. In the evening, there was a gentle breeze from the west, which shifted to the south and continued throughout the night. By morning, we were fairly close to land, about 7 leagues west of the Cavalle Islands, near a deep bay that extends southwest by west and west-southwest. We could barely see the bottom of the bay, and the land appeared low and flat. The two points that form the entrance are 5 miles apart, one bearing west-northwest and the other east-southeast. I've named this bay Doubtless Bay;* (*There is a small settlement called Mangonui in Doubtless Bay.) Since the wind wouldn't let us explore the bay, we headed for the westernmost land we could see, which was 3 leagues away from us to the west-northwest. However, before we reached it, the wind died down completely and stayed calm until 10 o'clock when a breeze picked up from the west-northwest, allowing us to head north. While we were becalmed, several natives approached our ship in 5 canoes, but they were hesitant to get too close. After they left, 6 more canoes came over; these last ones were more confident and came alongside, selling us enough fish of various kinds to provide everyone with a little.

At noon, the Cavalle Islands bore South-East by East, distant 8 Leagues, and the Entrance of Doubtless Bay South by West distant 3 Leagues, and the North-West Extremity of the Land in sight, which we judge to be the Main, bore North-West by West. Our Latitude by observation was 34 degrees 44 minutes South.

At noon, the Cavalle Islands were located Southeast by East, 8 Leagues away, and the entrance to Doubtless Bay was South by West, 3 Leagues away. We could see the Northwest tip of the land, which we believe to be the mainland, bearing Northwest by West. Our latitude by observation was 34 degrees 44 minutes South.

[Off Rangaunu Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Rangaunu Bay, North Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 10th. Had the winds from the Western board all this day, a Gentle breeze and clear weather. In the evening found the Variation to be 12 degrees 41 minutes East per Azimuth and 12 degrees 40 minutes by the Amplitude; in the morning we stood Close in with the Land, 7 Leagues to the westward of Doubtless Bay. Here the shore forms another large open Bay; the Bottom of this and Doubtless Bay cannot be far from each other, being to all appearance only seperated by a low neck of land from which juts out a Peninsula or head land, which I have named Knockle Point. West by South 6 Leagues from this point and about the Middle of the Bay is a high Mountain or Hill standing upon a desart shore, on which account we called it Mount Camel; Latitude 34 degrees 51 minutes; Longitude 186 degrees 50 minutes. In this Bay we had 24 and 25 fathoms Water, the bottom good for Anchorage, but their seems to be nothing that can induce Shipping to put into it for no Country upon Earth can look more barren than the land about this bay doth. It is in general low, except the Mountain just Mentioned, and the Soil to all appearance nothing but white sand thrown up in low irregular hills, lying in Narrow ridges parrallel with the shore; this occasioned me to name it Sandy Bay.* (* Rangaunu Bay.) The first ridge behind the Sea beach is partly cover'd with Shrubs, Plants, etc., but the second ridge hath hardly any green thing upon it, which induced me to think that it lies open to the Western Sea.* (* This is the fact.) As barren as this land appears it is not without inhabitants. We saw a Village on this Side of Mount Camel and another on the Eastern side of the Bay, besides 5 Canoes that were pulling off to the Ship, but did not come up with us. At 9 a.m. we tacked and stood to the Northward at Noon. Latitude in Per observation 34 degrees 38 minutes. The Cavalle Isles bore South-East by East, distant 13 Leagues; the Northern Extremity of the land in sight making like an Island bore North-West 1/4 North, distant 9 Leagues, and Mount Camel bore South-West by South, distant 6 Leagues. Tacked and stood in Shore.

Sunday, 10th. We had winds from the west all day, with a gentle breeze and clear weather. In the evening, I found the variation to be 12 degrees 41 minutes east by azimuth and 12 degrees 40 minutes by amplitude; in the morning, we sailed close to the land, 7 leagues west of Doubtless Bay. Here, the shore creates another large open bay; the bottom of this bay and Doubtless Bay seem to be separated only by a low neck of land from which a peninsula or headland juts out, which I've named Knockle Point. West by south for 6 leagues from this point, roughly in the middle of the bay, there’s a high mountain or hill standing on a barren shore, which is why we called it Mount Camel; latitude 34 degrees 51 minutes; longitude 186 degrees 50 minutes. In this bay, we had 24 and 25 fathoms of water, with a good bottom for anchorage, but nothing seems to entice ships to dock here since the land around this bay looks incredibly barren. It's generally low, except for the mountain mentioned earlier, and the soil looks like nothing but white sand piled into low, irregular hills, lying in narrow ridges parallel to the shore; this led me to call it Sandy Bay.* (* Rangaunu Bay.) The first ridge behind the sea beach is partly covered with shrubs, plants, etc., but the second ridge hardly has any greenery, which made me think it’s exposed to the western sea.* (* This is the fact.) As barren as this land seems, it's not without inhabitants. We spotted a village on this side of Mount Camel and another on the eastern side of the bay, plus 5 canoes that were heading toward the ship but didn’t reach us. At 9 a.m., we tacked and sailed north. At noon, our latitude was observed at 34 degrees 38 minutes. The Cavalle Isles were located southeast by east, 13 leagues away; the northernmost tip of the visible land, which looked like an island, was northwest 1/4 north, 9 leagues away, and Mount Camel was southwest by south, 6 leagues away. We tacked and headed inshore.

Monday, 11th. Gentle breezes at North. M.d and pleasant weather. Keept plying all the day, but got very little to Windward; at Noon was in the Latitude of 34 degrees 32 minutes South, the Northermost inland set yesterday at noon bore North-West by West, distant 6 or 7 Leagues.

Monday, 11th. Gentle breezes from the north. Mild and pleasant weather. We kept sailing all day but made very little progress to windward; at noon, we were at a latitude of 34 degrees 32 minutes south. The northernmost land we saw yesterday at noon was to the northwest, about 6 or 7 leagues away.

Tuesday, 12th. Moderate breezes of Wind between the North-West and North and Smooth Water, yet we gain'd very little in plying to Windward; at Noon Mount Camel bore South by West 1/4, distant 4 or 5 Leagues. Latitude observed 34 degrees 34 minutes South.

Tuesday, 12th. There were light breezes coming from the Northwest and North and smooth waters, but we didn’t make much progress sailing into the wind; at noon, Mount Camel was located to the South by West 1/4, about 4 or 5 leagues away. The observed latitude was 34 degrees 34 minutes South.

Wednesday, 13th. Fore part of P.M., Moderate breezes at North by West and fair weather; stood in shore until 5 O'Clock, at which time we tack'd and stood to the North-East being 2 Leagues to the Northward of Mount Camel and 1 1/2 Mile from shore, and this situation had 22 fathoms water. At 10 it began to blow and rain, which brought us under double Reeft Top sails; at 12 Tack'd and Stood to the Westward until 7 A.M. when we Tack'd and stood again to North-East, being at this time about a Mile to windward of the place where we tack'd last night. Soon after we Tack'd it came on to blow very hard at North-North-West with heavy squalls attended with rain, this brought us under our Courses and Split the Main Top sail in such a manner that it was necessary to unbend it and bring another to the Yard. At 10 it fell more moderate and we set the Top sails double reef'd. At Noon had strong Gales and hazey weather, Tack'd and stood to the Westward. No land in sight for the first time since we have been upon the Coast.

Wednesday, 13th. Early in the afternoon, there were moderate breezes from the North by West and fair weather; we moved closer to the shore until 5 O'clock, when we tacked and headed North-East, being 2 leagues north of Mount Camel and 1.5 miles from shore, where the water was 22 fathoms deep. At 10, it started to blow and rain, so we reduced sail to double reefed topsails; at midnight, we tacked and headed West until 7 A.M., when we tacked again and went back to North-East, being about a mile to windward of where we tacked last night. Shortly after we tacked, the wind picked up significantly from North-North-West with heavy squalls and rain, which forced us to use our courses and split the main topsail badly enough that we had to take it down and replace it. By 10, the wind eased a bit, and we set the topsails double reefed. At noon, we experienced strong gales and hazy weather, tacked, and headed West. For the first time since we arrived on the coast, there was no land in sight.

Thursday, 14th. Strong Gales at West and West-South-West with Squalls at times attended with Rain. At 1/2 past 3 P.M. Tack'd and stood to the Northward. A small Island lying off Knockle point, bore South 1/2 West, distant half a League. In the evening brought the Ship under her Courses, having first Split the Fore and Mizen Top sails; at Midnight wore and Stood to the Southward until 5 a.m., then Tack'd and stood to the North-West. At this time saw the land bearing South, distant 8 or 9 Leagues; by this we found we had fell very much to Leeward since Yesterday morning. Set the Top sails close Reeft and the people to dry and repair the Damaged Sails. At Noon a strong Gale and clear weather, Latitude observ'd 34 degrees 6 minutes South. Saw land bearing South-West being the same North-Westermost land we have seen before, and which I take to be the Northern Extremity of this Country, as we have now a large swell rowling in from the Westward which could not well be, was we covered by any land on that point of the Compass.* (* The Endeavour was now to the northward of the north point of New Zealand.)

Thursday, 14th. Strong winds from the West and West-South-West with occasional squalls and rain. At 3:30 PM, we changed direction and headed north. A small island near Knockle Point was situated South 1/2 West, about half a league away. In the evening, we set the ship under her sails after tearing the fore and mizzen top sails. At midnight, we turned and headed south until 5 AM, then tacked and went northwest. At this point, we saw land to the south, about 8 or 9 leagues away; we realized we had drifted quite a bit to leeward since yesterday morning. We tightly reefed the top sails and had the crew dry and repair the damaged sails. At noon, it was a strong gale with clear weather; we observed our latitude at 34 degrees 6 minutes South. We spotted land to the southwest, the same northwestern land we had seen before, which I believe is the northern tip of this country, as we now have a large swell coming from the west that wouldn’t be possible if land were blocking it in that direction.* (* The Endeavour was now to the north of the northern point of New Zealand.)

[Off North Cape, New Zealand.]

[Off North Cape, New Zealand.]

Friday, 15th. Fresh Gales at South-West, and for the most part clear weather with a large Swell from the Westward. At 8 P.M. Tack'd and Stood to the South-East until 8 a.m., and then Tack'd and stood to the Westward with as much sail as the Ship could bear. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes South, and Longitude 183 degrees 45 minutes West, and by Estimation about 15 Leagues from the Land notwithstanding we used our utmost Endeavours to keep in with it.

Friday, 15th. Fresh gales from the southwest, mostly clear weather with a large swell coming from the west. At 8 PM, we tacked and headed southeast until 8 AM, then tacked again and went west with as much sail as the ship could handle. At noon, we were at a latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes south and a longitude of 183 degrees 45 minutes west, and by our estimation, we were about 15 leagues from the land, even though we did everything we could to stay close to it.

Saturday, 16th. Fresh breezes between the South by West and South-West. Clear weather with a Swell from the Westward. At 6 A.M. saw the land from the Mast Head bearing South-South-West. Got Top Gallant Yards up and set the Sail, unbent the Foresail to repair and brought another to the Yard. At Noon, Latitude observ'd 33 degrees 43 minutes South; Course made since Yesterday Noon North 60 degrees West; distance 56 Miles. The Land in sight bearing South by West, distant 14 Leagues.

Saturday, 16th. Fresh breezes coming from South by West and South-West. Clear weather with a swell from the west. At 6 A.M., saw land from the masthead bearing South-South-West. Raised the top gallant yards and set the sail, removed the foresail to repair it and brought another up to the yard. At noon, observed latitude at 33 degrees 43 minutes South; course made since yesterday noon was North 60 degrees West; distance covered was 56 miles. The land in sight was bearing South by West, 14 leagues away.

Sunday, 17th. A Gentle breeze between the South-West by West and West with Clear weather. In standing in Shore sounded several times and had no ground with 90 fathoms of line. At 8 a.m. Tack'd in 108 fathoms 3 or 4 miles from the Shore, being the same point of Land as we had to the North-West of us before we were blown off. At Noon it bore South-West, distant about 3 Miles. Mount Camel bore South by East, distant 11 Leagues, and the Westermost land in sight bore South 75 degrees West; Latitude observ'd 34 degrees 20 minutes South. The people at work repairing the Sails, the most of them having been Split in the late blowing weather.

Sunday, 17th. A gentle breeze coming from the South-West by West to West with clear weather. While approaching the shore, we sounded several times and found no ground with 90 fathoms of line. At 8 a.m., we tacked in 108 fathoms, 3 or 4 miles from the shore, at the same point of land we had previously seen to the North-West before we were blown off course. At noon, it was located to the South-West, about 3 miles away. Mount Camel was to the South by East, 11 leagues distant, and the westernmost land in sight was at South 75 degrees West; Latitude observed at 34 degrees 20 minutes South. The crew was busy repairing the sails, most of which had been torn during the recent strong winds.

Monday, 18th. Moderate breezes at West and West-North-West and Clear weather. At 4 p.m. Tack'd and stood in shore, in doing of which we meet with a Strong rippling, and the Ship fell fast to leeward, occasioned, as we thought, by a Current setting to the Eastward. At 8 Tack'd and stood off North until 8 a.m., when we Tack'd and stood in, being about 10 Leagues from the Land. At Noon the Point of Land we were near to yesterday at noon bore South-South-West, distant 5 Leagues. Latitude observed 34 degrees 8 minutes South.

Monday, 18th. There were moderate breezes from the West and West-Northwest with clear weather. At 4 p.m., we tacked and headed toward the shore. In doing so, we encountered strong ripples, and the ship drifted quickly to leeward, which we thought was caused by a current flowing to the east. At 8, we tacked and headed north until 8 a.m., when we tacked and moved in, being about 10 leagues from the land. At noon, the point of land we were near yesterday at noon was bearing South-South-West, 5 leagues away. The observed latitude was 34 degrees 8 minutes South.

Tuesday, 19th. The wind still continues at West. P.M., a moderate breeze and Clear weather. At 7 Tack'd in 35 fathoms; the point of land before mentioned bore North-West by North, distant 4 or 5 Miles, having not gained one inch to windward this last 24 hours, which is a great proof that there must be a Current setting to the Eastward.* (* This strong easterly current is now well known.) The Point of Land above mentioned I have called North Cape, judging it to be the Northermost Extremity of this Country. It lies in the Latitude of 34 degrees 22 minutes South and Longitude 186 degrees 55 minutes West from Greenwich,* (* This position is very correct.) and North 63 degrees West 31 Leagues from Cape Brett; it forms the North Point of Sandy Bay, and is a peninsula juting out North-East about 2 Miles, and Terminates in a Bluff head which is flatt at Top. The Isthmus which joins this head to the Mainland is very low, on which account the land off the Cape from several situations makes like an Island. It appears still more remarkable when to the Southward of it by the appearance of a high round Island at the South-East Point of the Cape; but this is likewise a deception, being a round hill join'd to the Cape by a low, narrow neck of Land; on the South-East side of the Cape there appears to be anchorage, and where ships must be covered from South-East and North-West winds. We saw a Hippa or Village upon the Cape and some few inhabitants. In the night had some Squalls attended with rain, which obliged us to take another Reef in our Topsails. At 8 a.m. Tack'd and stood in Shore, and being moderate loosed a Reef out of each Topsail and set the small sails. At noon we were in the Latitude of 34 degrees 2 minutes South, and being hazey over the land we did not see it.

Tuesday, 19th. The wind is still coming from the West. In the afternoon, there’s a moderate breeze and clear weather. At 7, we changed direction in 35 fathoms; the point of land previously mentioned was to the North-West, about 4 or 5 miles away, and we haven’t gained any ground against the wind in the last 24 hours, which strongly suggests there’s a current pushing us eastward. (* This strong easterly current is now well known.) I’ve named the Point of Land North Cape, believing it’s the northernmost point of this region. It’s located at a latitude of 34 degrees 22 minutes South and a longitude of 186 degrees 55 minutes West from Greenwich, (* This position is very correct.) and is 63 degrees North-West, 31 leagues from Cape Brett; it forms the northern point of Sandy Bay and is a peninsula stretching out North-East about 2 miles, ending in a flat-topped bluff. The isthmus connecting this headland to the mainland is very low, which makes the land off the Cape look like an island from several viewpoints. It’s even more striking to the south, where you see a high round island at the South-East point of the Cape; however, this too is an illusion, as it’s actually a round hill connected to the Cape by a low, narrow stretch of land. On the South-East side of the Cape, there seems to be a good anchorage where ships can be sheltered from South-East and North-West winds. We spotted a hippa or village on the Cape with a few inhabitants. During the night, we experienced some squalls with rain, which forced us to take in another reef on our topsails. At 8 a.m., we changed direction and moved toward the shore, and since conditions were moderate, we shook out a reef from each topsail and set the small sails. By noon, we were at a latitude of 34 degrees 2 minutes South, but it was hazy over the land, so we couldn’t see it.

Wednesday, 20th. P.M., Fresh breezes at West by North, and Clear weather. At 6 Tack'd and stood off, North Cape bore South, distant 3 or 4 Miles. At 4 a.m. Tack'd and stood in, Wind at West-North-West a fresh breeze, but at 9 it increased to a Strong Gale with heavy squalls attended with Thunder and Rain, which brought us under our Courses. At 11 it Cleared up and the Wind came to West-South-West; we set the Topsails, double Reef'd and Tack'd and stood to the North-West. At Noon, a Stiff Gale and Clear weather; Latitude observed 34 degrees 14 minutes South. North Cape South-South-West, distant 3 Leagues.

Wednesday, 20th. P.M., Fresh breezes from the West by North, and clear weather. At 6, we tacked and headed off, with North Cape to the South, about 3 or 4 miles away. At 4 a.m., we tacked and headed in, with the wind at West-North-West and a fresh breeze, but by 9 it picked up to a strong gale with heavy squalls, accompanied by thunder and rain, which forced us to take in our sails. At 11, it cleared up and the wind shifted to West-South-West; we set the topsails, double reefed, and tacked to head Northwest. At noon, it was a stiff gale and clear weather; latitude observed was 34 degrees 14 minutes South. North Cape is to the South-South-West, about 3 leagues away.

Thursday, 21st. Fresh breezes at South-West and clear weather with a heavy swell first from the West, then from the South-West. At 8 a.m. loosed the 2nd Reef out of the Topsails; at noon clear weather, no land in sight. The North Cape bore South 25 degrees East, distant 24 Leagues. Latitude observed 33 degrees 17 minutes South.

Thursday, 21st. There were fresh breezes from the South-West and clear weather with a strong swell, first from the West and then from the South-West. At 8 a.m., we let out the 2nd Reef from the Topsails; at noon, the weather remained clear, with no land in sight. The North Cape was located 25 degrees East, 24 Leagues away. The observed latitude was 33 degrees 17 minutes South.

Friday, 22nd. A moderate Gale at South by West and South-South-West and Cloudy weather. At 8 a.m. got up Top Gallant Yards and set the sails. At Noon Latitude observ'd 33 degrees 2 minutes South. Course and distant since Yesterday at Noon is North 69 1/2 West, 37 Miles. The North Cape bore South 39 degrees East, distant 38 Leagues.

Friday, 22nd. A moderate wind from the South by West and South-South-West with cloudy weather. At 8 a.m., we raised the top gallant yards and set the sails. At noon, we observed our latitude at 33 degrees 2 minutes South. The course and distance since yesterday at noon was North 69 1/2 West, 37 miles. The North Cape was located South 39 degrees East, 38 leagues away.

Saturday, 23rd. Gentle breezes between the South by West and South-West, and Clear settled weather, with a swell from the South-West. Course and distance sailed since Yesterday at Noon is South 60 degrees East, 30 Miles. Latitude observed 33 degrees 17 minutes South. North Cape South 36 minutes East, distant 27 Leagues.

Saturday, 23rd. Light winds blowing from the South by West to the South-West, and clear, calm weather, with a swell coming from the South-West. The course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon is South 60 degrees East, 30 miles. Latitude observed is 33 degrees 17 minutes South. North Cape is located South 36 minutes East, 27 leagues away.

Sunday, 24th. Light Airs next to a Calm all this 24 Hours. At 7 p.m. saw the land from the Mast head bearing South 1/2 East; at 11 a.m. saw it again bearing South-South-East, distant 8 Leagues. At Noon Latitude observed 33 degrees 48 minutes South.

Sunday, 24th. Light breezes near calm for the entire 24 hours. At 7 p.m., I spotted land from the masthead bearing South 1/2 East; at 11 a.m., I saw it again bearing South-South-East, 8 leagues away. At noon, the observed latitude was 33 degrees 48 minutes South.

Monday, 25th. A Gentle breeze at South-East, the weather a little hazey. P.M., stood to the South-West. At 4 the land above mentioned bore South-East by South, distant 4 Leagues. It proves to be a small Island, which we take to be the 3 Kings discover'd by Tasman; there are several Smaller Islands or Rocks lying off the South-West end and one at the North-East end. It lies in the Latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes South, and Longitude 187 degrees 45 minutes West and West 14 degrees North, 14 or 15 Leagues from the North Cape. At Midnight Tack'd and stood to the North-East until 6 a.m., then Tack'd and stood to the Southward. At Noon the Island of the 3 Kings bore East 8 degrees North, distant 5 or 6 Leagues. Latitude observed 34 degrees 12 minutes South, Longitude in 188 degrees 5 minutes West; variation per Azimuth taken this morning 11 degrees 25 minutes East.

Monday, 25th. A gentle breeze from the southeast, the weather a bit hazy. In the afternoon, it shifted to the southwest. At 4 o'clock, the previously mentioned land was seen bearing southeast by south, about 4 leagues away. It turns out to be a small island, which we believe to be the Three Kings discovered by Tasman; there are several smaller islands or rocks off the southwest end and one at the northeast end. It is located at a latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes south, and a longitude of 187 degrees 45 minutes west, about 14 or 15 leagues from the North Cape. At midnight, we tacked and headed northeast until 6 a.m., then tacked again and went southward. At noon, the island of the Three Kings was at east 8 degrees north, about 5 or 6 leagues away. Latitude observed was 34 degrees 12 minutes south, longitude 188 degrees 5 minutes west; the variation from the azimuth taken this morning was 11 degrees 25 minutes east.

Tuesday, 26th. Moderate breezes, Easterly and hazey weather; standing to the Southward close upon a wind. At Noon was in the Latitude of 35 degrees 10 minutes South and Longitude 188 degrees 20 minutes West. The island of the 3 Kings North 26 degrees West, distant 22 Leagues. In this situation had no land in sight, and yet by observation we are in the Latitude of the Bay of Islands, and by my reckoning but 30 Leagues to the Westward of the North Cape, from whence it appears that the Northern part of this land must be very narrow, otherwise we must have seen some part of the West side of it.

Tuesday, 26th. Light breezes, easterly winds, and hazy weather; heading southward close to the wind. At noon, I was at a latitude of 35 degrees 10 minutes south and a longitude of 188 degrees 20 minutes west. The island of the 3 Kings is to the north at 26 degrees west, about 22 leagues away. In this position, there was no land in sight, yet by observation, we are at the same latitude as the Bay of Islands, and by my calculations, only 30 leagues west of the North Cape. This suggests that the northern part of this land must be quite narrow; otherwise, we would have seen some part of its west side.

Wednesday, 27th. Winds at East. P.M., a fresh Gale, with which we stood to the Southward until 12 at Night, then Tack'd and Stood to the Northward. At 4 a.m. the wind began to freshen, and increased in such a manner that at 9 we were obliged to bring the Ship too under her Mainsail, it blowing at this time excessive hard with heavy Squalls attended with rain, and at the same time thick hazey weather. Course made good since Yesterday at Noon South-South-West 1/2 West, distance 11 Miles. Latitude in 35 degrees 19 minutes South, Longitude in 188 degrees 29 minutes West. The Island of the 3 Kings, North 27 degrees East, distant 77 Miles.

Wednesday, 27th. Winds from the East. In the afternoon, we faced a strong gale, and we headed south until midnight, then tacked and turned north. At 4 a.m., the wind started to pick up, and by 9, it had increased so much that we had to reduce the ship to just sailing on her mainsail; it was blowing extremely hard with heavy squalls and rain, along with thick, hazy weather. The course made since yesterday at noon was south-southwest and a half west, covering a distance of 11 miles. We are at a latitude of 35 degrees 19 minutes south and a longitude of 188 degrees 29 minutes west. The Island of the Three Kings is to the north at 27 degrees east, which is 77 miles away.

[Off North End of New Zealand.]

[Off North End of New Zealand.]

Thursday, 28th. The Gale continued without the least intermission until 2 a.m., when the wind fell a little and began to veer to the Southward and to the South-West where it fixed at 4, and we made Sail and steer'd East in for the Land under the Foresail and Mainsail, but was soon obliged to take in the latter as it began to blow very hard and increased in such a manner that by 8 o'Clock it was a meer Hurricane attended with rain and the Sea run prodidgious high. At this time we wore the Ship, hauld up the Topsail, and brought her too with her head to the North-West under a Reefed Mainsail, but this was scarcely done before the Main Tack gave way and we were glad to take in the Mainsail and lay too under the Mizen staysail and Ballanced Mizen, after which we reefd the Foresail and furl'd both it and the Mainsail. At Noon the Gale was a little abated, but had still heavy squalls attended with rain. Our Course made good to-day is North, a little Easterly, 29 miles; Latitude in per Account 34 degrees 50 minutes South; Longitude in 188 degrees 27 minutes West; the 3 Kings North 41 East; distant 52 Miles.

Thursday, 28th. The gale continued without any pause until 2 a.m., when the wind dropped slightly and started shifting to the south and southwest, settling at 4. We set sail and steered east toward the land under the foresail and mainsail, but we quickly had to take in the mainsail as the wind picked up fiercely, increasing so much that by 8 o'clock it was basically a hurricane, accompanied by rain and the sea became incredibly rough. At that point, we turned the ship around, hoisted the topsail, and brought her to a stop with her head facing northwest under a reefed mainsail, but this was hardly done before the main tack gave way. We were relieved to take in the mainsail and lay to under the mizen staysail and balanced mizen. After that, we reefed the foresail and furled both it and the mainsail. By noon, the gale had lessened a bit, but there were still heavy squalls with rain. Our course today was made good to the north, slightly east, 29 miles; latitude at our last calculation was 34 degrees 50 minutes south; longitude was 188 degrees 27 minutes west; the three Kings are north 41 east, 52 miles away.

Friday, 29th. Winds at South-West and South-West by West. A very hard Gale with Squalls but mostly fair weather. At 7 p.m. wore and lay on the other Tack. At 6 a.m. loosed the Reef out of the Foresail and Set it and the Reefd Mainsail. At 11 unbent both Foresail and Mainsail to repair, and bent others and made Sail under them. At Noon Latitude observed 34 degrees 45 minutes South. Course and distance saild since yesterday East by North 29 miles.

Friday, 29th. Winds from the South-West and South-West by West. A very strong gale with squalls but mostly fair weather. At 7 p.m., we changed direction and laid on the other tack. At 6 a.m., we loosened the reef out of the foresail and set it along with the reefed mainsail. At 11, we unbent both the foresail and mainsail to make repairs, then bent on new ones and sailed with them. At noon, we observed our latitude at 34 degrees 45 minutes South. The course and distance traveled since yesterday was East by North for 29 miles.

Saturday, 30th. Winds at South-West. P.M., hard Gales with some Squalls attended with rain. A.M., more moderate and fair. At 8 p.m. wore and stood to the North-West until 5 a.m., then wore and stood to the South-East and being pretty moderate we set the Topsails close Reef'd, but the South-West Sea runs so high that the Ship goes Bodily to leeward. At 6 saw the land bearing North-East distant about 6 Leagues which we judge to be the same as Tasman calls Cape Maria Van Dieman; at Noon it bore North-North-East 1/2 East and we could see the land extend to the East and Southward as far as South-East by East. Our Latitude by observation 34 degrees 50 minutes South.

Saturday, 30th. Winds from the South-West. In the afternoon, strong gales with some squalls and rain. In the morning, more moderate and clear. At 8 p.m., we turned and headed North-West until 5 a.m., then turned and headed South-East. With it being relatively calm, we set the topsails close-reefed, but the South-West sea is so rough that the ship drifts significantly to leeward. At 6, we saw land bearing North-East, about 6 leagues away, which we believe is the same land that Tasman referred to as Cape Maria Van Diemen; at noon, it bore North-North-East 1/2 East and we could see the land stretching East and South as far as South-East by East. Our latitude, based on observation, was 34 degrees 50 minutes South.

Sunday, 31st. Fresh gales at South-West and South-West by South accompanied by a large Sea from the same Quarter. At 1 p.m. Tack'd and Stood to the North-West until 8, then stood to the South-East. At this time the Island of the 3 Kings bore North-West by West, distant 11 Leagues, and Cape Maria Van Diemen North by East. At Midnight wore and Stood to the North-West until 4 a.m., then wore and Stood to the South-East; at Noon our Latitude by observation was 34 degrees 42 minutes South. The land of Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North-East by North distant about 5 Leagues.

Sunday, 31st. There were strong winds coming from the Southwest and Southwest by South, along with large waves from the same direction. At 1 p.m., we tacked and headed Northwest until 8, then changed course to Southeast. At this point, the Island of the 3 Kings was located Northwest by West, 11 leagues away, and Cape Maria Van Diemen was to the North by East. At midnight, we changed direction and headed Northwest until 4 a.m., then changed course again to Southeast; at noon, our latitude according to observation was 34 degrees 42 minutes South. The land of Cape Maria Van Diemen was to the Northeast by North, about 5 leagues away.

1770.

1770.

[January 1770.]

[January 1770.]

Monday, January 1st. P.M., fresh breezes at South-West by South and Squally, the remainder moderate breezes at South-West by South and South-West clear weather. At 7 p.m. Tack'd and stood to the Westward. At this time Mount Camel bore North 83 degrees East and the Northermost land or Cape Maria Van Diemen North by West, being distant from the Nearest Shore 3 Leagues; in this situation had 40 fathoms Water.

Monday, January 1st. In the afternoon, there were fresh winds coming from the South-West by South and gusty conditions, while the rest of the day had moderate breezes from the South-West by South with clear weather. At 7 p.m., we turned and headed West. At that moment, Mount Camel was located at North 83 degrees East and the northernmost land or Cape Maria Van Diemen was at North by West, about 3 leagues away from the nearest shore; at this point, we had 40 fathoms of water.

NOTE. Mount Camel doth not appear to lay little more than a Mile from the Sea on this Side* (* It is, in fact, about six miles, but the coast in front is so low that the mistake in estimation is very natural.) and about the same distance on the other, so that the land here cannot be above 2 or 3 Miles broad from Sea to Sea, which is what I computed when we were in Sandy Bay on the other side of the Coast. At 6 a.m. Tack'd and Stood to the Eastward, the Island of the 3 Kings North-West by North. At Noon Tack'd again and stood to the Westward, being in the Latitude of 34 degrees 37 minutes South; the Island of the 3 Kings bore North-West by North, distant 10 or 11 Leagues; and Cape Maria Van Diemen North 31 East, distant 4 1/2 Leagues; in this situation had 54 fathoms. I cannot help thinking but what it will appear a little strange that at this season of the Year we should be 3 Weeks in getting 10 Leagues to the Westward and 5 Weeks in getting 50 Leagues, for so long it is since we pass'd Cape Brett; but it will hardly be credited that in the midst of Summer and in the Latitude of 35 degrees South such a Gale of wind as we have had could have hapned which for its Strength and Continuance was such as I hardly was ever in before. Fortunately at this time we were a good distance from land, otherwise it would have proved fatal to us.* (* The north point of New Zealand is celebrated for bad weather.)

NOTE. Mount Camel is only about a mile from the sea on this side* (* It's actually around six miles away, but the coastline is so low that it's easy to misjudge.) and about the same distance on the other side, so this land can't be more than 2 to 3 miles wide from sea to sea, which is what I estimated when we were at Sandy Bay on the opposite side of the coast. At 6 a.m., we tacked and headed east, with the Island of the 3 Kings to the northwest by north. At noon, we tacked again and went west, at a latitude of 34 degrees 37 minutes south; the Island of the 3 Kings was north-west by north, about 10 or 11 leagues away; Cape Maria Van Diemen was north 31 east, about 4.5 leagues away; at this position, we were in 54 fathoms. I can't help but find it a little strange that at this time of year we spent 3 weeks covering 10 leagues to the west and 5 weeks covering 50 leagues since we passed Cape Brett; it’s hard to believe that during the summer and at a latitude of 35 degrees south, we could experience such a strong and persistent gale, which was unlike anything I’ve encountered before. Luckily, we were quite far from land at that time, or it could have been disastrous for us.* (* The northern point of New Zealand is known for its bad weather.)

Tuesday, 2nd. Fresh breezes at South-South-West and West accompanied with a rowling Sea from the South-West. At 5 p.m. the wind Veering to the Westward we Tack'd and Stood to the Southward. At this time the North Cape bore East 3/4 North and was just open of a point that lies 3 Leagues West by South from it, being now well assured that it is the Northermost Extremity of this Country and is the East point of a Peninsula which Stretches out North-West and North-West by North 17 or 18 Leagues, and as I have before observed is for the most part low and narrow except its Extremity where the land is Tollerable high and Extends 4 or 5 Leagues every way. Cape Maria Van Diemen is the West point of the Peninsula and lies in the Latitude of 34 degrees 30 minutes South; Longitude 187 degrees 18 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* This is extraordinarily accurate, seeing that the ship was never close to the Cape, and the observations were all taken in bad weather. The latitude is exact, and the longitude is only three miles in error. The persistence with which Cook clung to this point until he could resume his exploration and examination of the coast is very characteristic of the man. He would not willingly miss a mile of it, nor did he.) From this Cape the Land Trends away South-East by South and South-East to and beyond Mount Camel, and is everywhere a barren shore affording no better prospect than what ariseth from white sand Banks. At 1/2 past 7 p.m. the Island of the 3 Kings bore North-West by North and Cape Maria Van Diemen North-East by East, distant 4 Leagues. At 5 a.m. Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North-North-East 1/2 East and Mount Camel East. At Noon was in the Latitude of 35 degrees 17 minutes and Cape Maria Van Diemen by judgment bore North distant 16 Leagues; having no land in sight, not daring to go near it as the wind blow'd fresh right on shore and a high rowling Sea from the Same Quarter, and knowing that there was no Harbour that we could put into in case we were Caught upon a lee shore.

Tuesday, 2nd. Fresh breezes coming from the South-South-West and West, along with a choppy sea from the South-West. At 5 p.m., as the wind shifted to the West, we tacked and headed South. At this moment, North Cape was positioned East 3/4 North and was just visible from a point that lies 3 Leagues West by South from it. I was now confident that this is the northernmost tip of this country and the eastern point of a peninsula that stretches out North-West and North-West by North for 17 or 18 Leagues. As I’ve noted before, this area is mostly low and narrow, except for the tip where the land is somewhat high and extends 4 or 5 Leagues in all directions. Cape Maria Van Diemen is the western point of the peninsula, situated at a latitude of 34 degrees 30 minutes South and longitude 187 degrees 18 minutes West from Greenwich.* (* This is incredibly accurate, considering that the ship was never near the Cape, and all observations were made in bad weather. The latitude is spot on, and the longitude is only three miles off. Cook’s determination to stay at this point until he could continue his exploration of the coast is very characteristic of him. He wasn’t willing to miss a mile of it, and he didn’t.) From this Cape, the land trends Southeast by South and Southeast to and beyond Mount Camel, and the shore is mostly barren, offering nothing better than what comes from the white sandbanks. At 7:30 p.m., the Island of the 3 Kings was located North-West by North and Cape Maria Van Diemen North-East by East, 4 Leagues away. At 5 a.m., Cape Maria Van Diemen was North-North-East 1/2 East, and Mount Camel was East. By noon, we were at a latitude of 35 degrees 17 minutes, and Cape Maria Van Diemen, by estimation, was North, 16 Leagues away; with no land in sight, we didn’t dare approach as the wind was blowing strongly right towards the shore and there was a high, rolling sea from the same direction, knowing that there was no harbor we could enter if we got caught on a lee shore.

Wednesday, 3rd. Winds at West-South-West and South-West; a fresh breeze and Squally, the remainder moderate with frequent Squalls attended with rain. In the evening shortned Sail and at Midnight Tack'd and made a Trip to the North-West until 2 a.m., then wore and stood to the Southward. At daylight made Sail and Edged away in order to make the Land; at 10 saw it bearing North-East and appeared to be high land; at Noon it extended from North to East-North-East distant, by Estimation, 8 or 10 Leagues, and Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North 2 degrees 30 minutes West, distant 33 Leagues. Our Latitude by observation was 36 degrees 2 minutes South. A high rowling swell from the South-West.

Wednesday, 3rd. Winds from the West-Southwest and Southwest; a strong breeze and squally, the rest moderate with frequent squalls bringing rain. In the evening, we shortened sail and at midnight tacked, heading Northwest until 2 a.m., then turned and headed south. At daylight, we made sail and moved towards the land; by 10, we spotted it to the Northeast and it looked like high land; at noon, it stretched from North to East-Northeast, approximately 8 to 10 leagues away, with Cape Maria Van Diemen to the North 2 degrees 30 minutes West, about 33 leagues distant. Our latitude, based on observation, was 36 degrees 2 minutes South. There was a high rolling swell from the Southwest.

[Off Kaipara Harbour, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Kaipara Harbour, North Island, New Zealand.]

Thursday, 4th. Winds at South-West and South-West by South; mostly a fresh Gale accompanied with a rowling sea from the same Quarter. Being desirous of taking as near a View of the coast as we could with safety we keept Edging in for it until 7 o'Clock p.m., being at this time 6 Leagues from the Land. We then hauld our wind to South-East and keept on that Course close upon the wind all night, sounding several times but had no ground with 100 and 110 fathoms. At 8 o'Clock a.m. was about 5 Leagues from the Land and a place which lies in the Latitude of 36 degrees 25 minutes that had the Appearance of a Bay or inlet bore East.* (* This was Kaipara Harbour, although, on a closer inspection, Cook thought he had been deceived. It is the largest harbour on this part of the coast. The town of Helensville stands on one of its arms.) In order to see more of this place we kept on our Course until 11 o'Clock when we were not above 3 Leagues from it, and then found that it was neither a Bay nor inlet, but low land bounded on each side by higher lands which caused the deception. At this time we Tack'd and stood to the North-West. At Noon we were between 3 and 4 Leagues from the Land and in the Latitude of 36 degrees 31 minutes and Longitude 185 degrees 50 minutes West. Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North 25 West, distant 44 1/2 Leagues. From this I form my judgment of the direction of this Coast, which is nearly South-South-East 3/4 East and North-North-West 3/4 West, and must be nearly a Strait Shore. In about the Latitude 35 degrees 45 minutes is some high land adjoining to the Sea; to the Southward of that the land is of a moderate heigth, and wears a most desolate and inhospitable aspect. Nothing is to be seen but long sand Hills, with hardly any Green thing upon them, and the great Sea which the prevailing Westerly winds impell upon the Shore must render this a very Dangerous Coast. This I am so fully sencible of, that was we once clear of it I am determined not to come so near Again, if I can possible avoid it, unless we have a very favourable wind indeed.* (* The mingled audacity and caution of Cook's navigation off this coast must awake the admiration of every seaman.)

Thursday, 4th. Winds from the South-West and South-West by South; mostly a fresh gale with a rolling sea from the same direction. Wanting to get as close a view of the coast as safely possible, we kept edging in until 7 o’clock p.m., at which time we were 6 leagues from land. We then adjusted our course to South-East and continued that way, close-hauled all night, sounding several times but had no bottom with 100 and 110 fathoms. At 8 o’clock a.m., we were about 5 leagues from the land and a spot in the latitude of 36 degrees 25 minutes that appeared to be a bay or inlet to the east.* (* This was Kaipara Harbour, although upon closer inspection, Cook thought he had been misled. It is the largest harbour on this part of the coast. The town of Helensville sits on one of its arms.) To get a better look at this place, we continued on our course until 11 o’clock when we were no more than 3 leagues away and discovered that it was neither a bay nor an inlet, but low land bordered by higher ground, causing the confusion. At this point, we tacked and headed North-West. At noon, we were between 3 and 4 leagues from the land, situated at 36 degrees 31 minutes latitude and 185 degrees 50 minutes West longitude. Cape Maria Van Diemen was located North 25 West, 44 ½ leagues away. Based on this, I deduce the direction of this coastline, which is almost South-South-East ¾ East and North-North-West ¾ West, indicating it must be nearly a strait shore. Around latitude 35 degrees 45 minutes, there's some high land near the sea; south of that, the land is of moderate height and looks very desolate and unwelcoming. All that can be seen are long sand hills with hardly any greenery, and the powerful sea driven against the shore by prevailing westerly winds makes this a very dangerous coast. I am so aware of this that once we’re clear of it, I’m determined not to come near again, if possible, unless we have a very favorable wind.* (* The mix of boldness and caution in Cook's navigation along this coast should earn the admiration of every seaman.)

Friday, 5th. Fresh gales at South-West with frequent Squalls attended with rain. The South-West swell still keeping up we stood to the North-West all this day with a prest Sail in order to get an Offing. At Noon True Course made good North 38 West, distance 102 Miles. Latitude in per Observation 35 degrees 10 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North 10 degrees East; distant 41 Miles.

Friday, 5th. Fresh winds from the Southwest with frequent squalls bringing rain. The Southwest swell continued, so we headed Northwest all day with a pressed sail to gain some distance offshore. At noon, we had a true course of North 38 West, covering 102 miles. Our latitude, by observation, was 35 degrees 10 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen was at North 10 degrees East, 41 miles away.

Saturday, 6th. First part a fresh breeze at South-West by South; in the night had it at South. A.M., light Airs from the Southward next to a Calm, and Clear weather. Course made good to-day is North 76 West; distance 8 Miles; Latitude per Observation 35 degrees 8 minutes South.

Saturday, 6th. The first part of the day had a fresh breeze from the South-West by South; during the night, it was from the South. In the morning, there were light winds from the south, almost calm, and clear weather. The course taken today was North 76 West; distance was 8 miles; latitude according to observation was 35 degrees 8 minutes South.

Sunday, 7th. Variable light Airs and Sometimes Calm with Clear pleasant weather. At daylight saw the land which we took to be Cape Maria Van Diemen bearing North-North-East, distant 8 or 9 Leagues. At Noon Latitude in per Observation 35 degrees 0 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North, distant 11 Leagues.

Sunday, 7th. Light, changing breezes and sometimes still with clear, pleasant weather. At daybreak, we spotted land that we believed to be Cape Maria Van Diemen, to the North-North-East, about 8 or 9 leagues away. At noon, the latitude from our observation was 35 degrees, 0 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen was to the North, about 11 leagues away.

Monday, 8th. Gentle breezes at North-East and pleasant weather. At 6 p.m. saw the land bearing East, and sometime after saw a Turtle upon the Water. At Noon the land Extending from North to East, distant 5 or 6 Leagues, being the high land before mentioned and which it intersected in 2 places each having the appearance of a Bay or inlet, but I believe it is only low land.* (* These were Hokianga and False Hokianga.) Course and distance made good since Yesterday at Noon is South 33 East, 53 miles. Latitude per Observation 35 degrees 45 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen North 25 West, distant 30 Leagues.

Monday, 8th. Gentle breezes from the Northeast and nice weather. At 6 p.m., I saw land to the East, and shortly after noticed a turtle swimming on the water. At noon, the land stretched from North to East, about 5 or 6 leagues away, being the high land previously mentioned, with two spots that appeared like bays or inlets, though I think it’s just low land. (*These were Hokianga and False Hokianga.) The course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon are South 33 East, 53 miles. Latitude according to my observation is 35 degrees 45 minutes South. Cape Maria Van Diemen is North 25 West, 30 leagues away.

Tuesday, 9th. Gentle breezes between the North-East and North-West, Cloudy weather sailing along shore within sight of Land at Noon. Course and distance Sailed South 37 East, 69 Miles. Latitude in per Observation 36 degrees 39 minutes South; the place we were abreast of the 4th Instant, which we at first took for a Bay or Inlet* (* Kaipara.) bore North-East by North, distant 5 1/2 Leagues, and Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North 29 West, distant 47 Leagues.

Tuesday, 9th. Light winds from the North-East to the North-West, overcast skies as we sailed along the coast with land visible at noon. We traveled south 37 degrees east for 69 miles. Our latitude, based on our observation, was 36 degrees 39 minutes south; the spot we were level with on the 4th, which we initially thought was a bay or inlet (Kaipara), was located north-east by north, about 5.5 leagues away, and Cape Maria Van Diemen was to the north 29 degrees west, about 47 leagues away.

[Off Kawhia Harbour, North Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Kawhia Harbour, North Island, New Zealand.]

Wednesday, 10th. Winds at North-North-East and North, the first part a Gentle breeze, the remainder a fresh breeze and Cloudy with rain towards Noon. Continued a South-East Course until' 8 o'Clock p.m. at which time we had run 7 Leagues since Noon, and were between 3 and 4 Leagues from the Land which appear'd to be low and Sandy such as I have before Discribed, and we then steer'd South-East by East in a Parrallel direction with the Coast, our Depth of Water from 48 to 34 fathoms; a black sandy bottom; at daylight found ourselves between 2 and 3 Leagues from the land which was of a Moderate height and Cloathed with Wood and Verdure. At 7 o'Clock steer'd South by East and afterwards South by West, the land laying in that direction; at 9 was abreast of a Point of Land which rises sloping from the Sea to a Considerable height; it lies in the Latitude of 37 degrees 43 minutes South; I named it Woodyhead. South-West 1/2 West 11 Miles from this Head is a very small Island which we named Gannet Island, on account of the Great Number of these Birds we saw upon it. At Noon a high Craggy point bore East-North-East, distance 1 1/2 Leagues; this point I have named Albetross Point; it lies in the Latitude of 38 degrees 4 minutes South, and Longitude 184 degrees 42 minutes West, and from Woodyhead South 17 minutes West 7 Leagues. On the North side of it the shore forms a Bay wherein there appears to be anchorage and Shelter for Shipping against Southerly Winds;* (* Kawhia Harbour. There is a settlement here.) our Course and distance saild since Yesterday at Noon is South 37 East, distance 69 Miles. Cape Maria Van Diemen bore North 30 West, distant 82 Leagues.

Wednesday, the 10th. Winds from the North-North-East and North, starting with a gentle breeze, then turning into a fresh breeze, and it was cloudy with rain around noon. We continued on a South-East course until 8 p.m., at which point we had covered 7 leagues since noon and were about 3 to 4 leagues from land that appeared low and sandy, as I have described before. We then steered South-East by East, running parallel to the coast, with the water depth ranging from 48 to 34 fathoms and a black sandy bottom. At daylight, we found ourselves 2 to 3 leagues from land, which was moderately high and covered with woods and greenery. At 7 o'clock, we steered South by East and then South by West, as the land lay in that direction. By 9 o'clock, we were in line with a point of land that rises steeply from the sea to a considerable height; I named it Woodyhead. About 11 miles Southwest 1/2 West from this head is a very small island we named Gannet Island, due to the large number of these birds we saw there. At noon, a high, craggy point bore East-North-East, 1 1/2 leagues away; I named this point Albatross Point, which is at a latitude of 38 degrees 4 minutes South and longitude of 184 degrees 42 minutes West, and 7 leagues South 17 minutes West from Woodyhead. On the north side of it, the shore forms a bay with what seems to be anchorage and shelter for ships against southerly winds; (* Kawhia Harbour. There is a settlement here.) Our course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon was South 37 East, a distance of 69 miles. Cape Maria Van Diemen was located North 30 West, 82 leagues away.

Thursday, 11th. At 1/2 past Noon the wind Shifted at Once from North-North-East to South-South-West with which we stood to the Westward until 4 p.m., then Tack'd and stood on Shore until' 7, when we again stood to the Westward having but little wind. At this Time Albetross Point bore North-East, distant near 2 Leagues, and the Southermost land in sight bore South-South-West 1/2 West being a very high Mountain and made very much like the Peak of Teneriff; in this Situation had 30 fathoms Water; had little wind all night; at 4 a.m. Tacked and stood in Shore, but it soon after fell Calm and being in 42 fathoms Water; the People caught about 10 or 12 Bream. At 11 a light breeze sprung up from the Westward and we made Sail to the Southward. At Noon was by Observation in the Latitude of 38 degrees 4 minutes South; Albetross Point bore due East, distant 5 or 6 Leagues.

Thursday, 11th. At 12:30 PM, the wind suddenly shifted from North-Northeast to South-Southwest, and we headed west until 4 PM. Then we tacked and sailed towards shore until 7 PM, when we again headed west with little wind. At that time, Albatross Point was to the Northeast, about 2 leagues away, and the southernmost land in sight was to the South-Southwest ½ West, a very tall mountain resembling the peak of Tenerife. In this position, we had 30 fathoms of water and very little wind all night. At 4 AM, we tacked and headed inshore, but it soon became calm. We were in 42 fathoms of water, and the crew caught about 10 or 12 bream. At 11 AM, a light breeze picked up from the west, and we set sail southward. At noon, by observation, we were at a latitude of 38 degrees 4 minutes south; Albatross Point was due east, about 5 or 6 leagues away.

Friday, 12th. Gentle breezes from between the North-West and North-North-East; Fore and Middle part Clear Weather; the Latter part dark and Cloudy; steering along shore South by West and South-South-West at the distance of 4 Leagues off. At 7 p.m. saw the top of the Peaked Mountain to the Southward above the Clouds bearing from us South; at the same time the Southermost land we had in Sight bore South by West. Took several Azimuths both in the Evening and the Morning which gave the Variation 14 degrees 15 minutes Easterly. At Noon had the winds very Variable with dark cloudy weather attended with excessive heavy Showers of rain; at this time we were about 3 Leagues from the Shore which lies under the Peaked Mountain before mentioned. This Peak we did not see, it being hid in the Clouds, but judged it to bear about South-South-East, and some very remarkable peaked Islands, lying under the Shore, bore East-South-East, distant 3 or 4 Leagues.

Friday, 12th. There were gentle breezes from the North-West and North-North-East; the front and middle were clear weather; the latter part was dark and cloudy; we were steering along the shore South by West and South-South-West, 4 leagues off. At 7 p.m., we saw the top of the peaked mountain to the south above the clouds, bearing South from us; at the same time, the southernmost land in sight was to the South by West. I took several azimuth readings in the evening and morning, which showed a variation of 14 degrees 15 minutes east. At noon, the winds were very variable with dark, cloudy weather accompanied by heavy rain showers; at this time, we were about 3 leagues from the shore under the aforementioned peaked mountain. We could not see the peak, as it was hidden in the clouds, but we estimated it to be about South-South-East, and some very distinct peaked islands off the shore were to the East-South-East, 3 or 4 leagues away.

Saturday, 13th. Winds Variable. P.M., Cloudy weather. At 7 o'Clock sounded and had 42 fathoms water, being distant from the Shore between 2 and 3 Leagues and the Peaked Mountain as near as I could judge bore East. After it was Dark saw a fire upon the Shore, a sure sign that the Country is inhabited. In the night had some Thunder, Lightning, and Rain; at 5 a.m. saw for a few Minutes the Top of the Peaked Mountain above the Clouds bearing North-East. It is of a prodidgious height and its Top is cover'd with Everlasting Snow; it lies in the Latitude of 39 degrees 16 minutes South, and in the Longitude of 185 degrees 15 minutes West. I have named it Mount Egmont in honour of the Earl of Egmont.* (* The Earl of Egmont was First Lord of the Admiralty from 1763 to 1766. Mount Egmont is a magnificent conical mountain, surrounded on three sides by the sea, from which it rises to a height of 8300 feet.) This mountain seems to have a pretty large base and to rise with a Gradual Ascent to the Peak, and what makes it more Conspicuous is its being situated near the Sea and in the Midst of a flat Country which afforded a very good Aspect, being Cloathed with Woods and Verdure. The shore under the foot of this Mountain forms a large Cape which I have named Cape Egmont; it lies South-South-West 1/2 West, 27 Leagues from Albetross Point. On the North-East side of the Cape lay 2 Small Islands near to a very remarkable Point of the Main that riseth to a good height in the very form of a Sugar Loaf. To the Southward of the Cape the Land tends away South-East by East and East-South-East, and seems to be every where a bold shore. At Noon had variable light Airs and Clear weather. Latitude observ'd 39 degrees 32 minutes South. Cape Egmont bore about North-East, and we were about 4 Leagues from the Shore in that direction; in this situation had 40 fathoms Water.

Saturday, the 13th. Winds were variable. In the afternoon, it was cloudy. At 7 o'clock, we measured 42 fathoms of water, located about 2 to 3 leagues from the shore, with the Peaked Mountain appearing to bear east as best as I could estimate. After dark, I noticed a fire on the shore, a clear indication that the area is inhabited. During the night, we experienced some thunder, lightning, and rain; at 5 a.m., I caught a glimpse of the Peaked Mountain above the clouds to the northeast. It is incredibly tall, with its peak covered in everlasting snow; it lies at a latitude of 39 degrees 16 minutes south and a longitude of 185 degrees 15 minutes west. I have named it Mount Egmont in honor of the Earl of Egmont. (* The Earl of Egmont was First Lord of the Admiralty from 1763 to 1766. Mount Egmont is a stunning conical mountain, surrounded on three sides by the sea, rising to a height of 8,300 feet.) This mountain appears to have a sizable base and rises gradually to the peak, and its visibility is enhanced by its location near the sea and in the midst of flat land, which is beautifully covered in woods and greenery. The shore at the base of this mountain forms a large cape that I have named Cape Egmont; it is located south-southwest half west, 27 leagues from Albatross Point. On the northeast side of the cape, there are two small islands near a very notable point of land that rises steeply, shaped like a sugar loaf. South of the cape, the land stretches southeast by east and east-southeast, and appears to be a bold shoreline. At noon, we had variable light breezes and clear weather. Latitude observed was 39 degrees 32 minutes south. Cape Egmont was approximately northeast, and we were about 4 leagues from the shore in that direction; in this position, we had 40 fathoms of water.

[In North Part of Cook's Strait.]

[In the northern part of Cook's Strait.]

Sunday, 14th. P.M., had a Gentle Breeze at West. In the evening came to North-West by West and Continued so all night and blow'd a fresh breeze; we steer'd along shore East-South-East and South-East by East, keeping between 2 and 3 Leagues off. At 1/2 past 7 p.m. Saw for a few Minutes Mount Egmont which bore from us North 17 West, distant 10 Leagues. At 5 a.m. Steer'd South-East by South the land inclining more Southerly, but half an hour after we saw land bearing South-West by South which we hauld up for.* (* The north end of the South Island, New Zealand.) At this time the weather was squally attended with showers of rain. At noon had a Steady fresh breeze at West by North and Cloudy weather; the South-West Extremity of the Land in sight bore South 63 degrees West and some high land, which makes like an Island lying under the Main, bore South-South-East, distant 5 Leagues. The bottom of the Bay* (* This was the Northern part of Cook's Strait, but it was thought at the time to be a bay.) we are now in, and which bears from us South we cannot see, altho' it is very Clear in that Quarter. Our Latitude by Observation is 40 degrees 27 minutes South, Longitude 184 degrees 39 minutes West.* (* The western side of the North Island, which Cook took such trouble to follow, is 400 miles long, and is a most dangerous coast to explore, on account of the winds being mostly on shore. This prevented him from getting very close; and he missed the entrances to several harbours, such as the Manukau, the Waikato River, Whaingaroa, and others. No canoes were seen, as the coast is not favourable for such craft.)

Sunday, 14th. P.M., we had a gentle breeze from the West. In the evening, it turned to North-West by West and continued like that all night with a fresh breeze; we steered along the shore East-South-East and South-East by East, staying about 2 to 3 leagues off. At 7:30 p.m., we saw Mount Egmont for a few minutes, which was to our North 17 West, about 10 leagues away. At 5 a.m., we steered South-East by South as the land began to head more Southward, but half an hour later we spotted land to the South-West by South, which we headed towards. At this point, the weather was squally with rain showers. By noon, we had a steady fresh breeze from West by North and cloudy skies; the South-West tip of the land in sight bore South 63 degrees West and some high land, appearing like an island under the mainland, bore South-South-East, about 5 leagues away. We can't see the bottom of the Bay we are currently in, which lies to the South, even though it's clear in that direction. Our Latitude by Observation is 40 degrees 27 minutes South, Longitude 184 degrees 39 minutes West. The western side of the North Island, which Cook took such care to follow, is 400 miles long and is a very dangerous coast to explore due to the winds mostly being onshore. This prevented him from getting very close, and he missed the entrances to several harbors, such as Manukau, the Waikato River, Whaingaroa, and others. No canoes were seen, as the coast is not suitable for such vessels.

Monday, 15th. Fore and Middle parts, fresh breezes between the West and North-West and fair weather. At 8 p.m. we were within 2 Leagues of the Land, we discover'd in the morning, having run 10 Leagues since Noon; the land seen then bearing South 63 degrees West bore now North 59 degrees West, distant 7 or 8 Leagues and makes like an Island. Between this land or Island and Cape Egmont is a very broad and Deep Bay or inlet the South-West side of which we are now upon, and here the Land is of a Considerable height, distinguished by Hills and Valleys, and the Shore seems to form several Bays, into one of which I intend to go with the Ship in order to Careen her (she being very foul) and to repair some few defects, recruit our Stock of Wood, Water, etc. With this View we Keept plying on and off all Night, having from 80 to 63 fathoms Water; at daylight stood in for an inlet which runs in South-West.* (* Queen Charlotte's Sound, in the north-east part of the Middle Island.) At 8 a.m. we were got within the Entrance which may be known by a Reef of Rocks stretching off from the North-West point, and some rocky Islands lying off the South-East point. At 9 o'clock being little wind and Variable we were carried by the Tide or Current within 2 Cables length of the North-West Shore where we had 54 fathoms, but with the help of our Boats we got Clear, at this time we saw rise up twice near the Ship a Sea Lyon, the Head of which was Exactly like the head of the Male one described by Lord Anson. We likewise saw a Canoe with some of the Natives cross the Bay, and a Village situated upon a point of an Island, which lies 7 or 8 miles with the Entrance. At Noon we were the length of this Island, and being little wind had the Boats ahead Towing.

Monday, 15th. Fore and middle parts, fresh breezes between the West and North-West and clear weather. At 8 p.m., we were about 2 leagues from the land we spotted earlier in the morning, having traveled 10 leagues since noon; the land we saw then, bearing South 63 degrees West, now bore North 59 degrees West, about 7 or 8 leagues away, and looked like an island. Between this land or island and Cape Egmont, there's a wide and deep bay or inlet, and we are currently on the South-West side of it. The land here is quite high, marked by hills and valleys, and the shore seems to form several bays, one of which I plan to enter with the ship to careen her (she being quite dirty) and fix a few minor issues, as well as replenish our supplies of wood, water, etc. With this in mind, we kept moving in and out all night, with depths ranging from 80 to 63 fathoms. At daybreak, we headed toward an inlet that runs Southwest. At 8 a.m., we reached the entrance, which can be identified by a reef of rocks extending from the North-West point and some rocky islands off the South-East point. At 9 o'clock, with little wind and variable conditions, we were pushed by the tide or current within 2 cable lengths of the North-West shore where we had 54 fathoms, but with the help of our boats, we managed to clear the area. At this time, we saw a sea lion rise near the ship twice; its head looked exactly like the one described by Lord Anson. We also saw a canoe with some locals crossing the bay and a village located on a point of an island, which is about 7 or 8 miles from the entrance. At noon, we reached the distance of this island, and with little wind, we had the boats ahead towing.


CHAPTER 6. EXPLORATION OF MIDDLE ISLAND OF NEW ZEALAND.

[January 1770. In Queen Charlotte's Sound, New Zealand.]

[January 1770. In Queen Charlotte's Sound, New Zealand.]

TUESDAY, 16th. Variable light Airs and Clear settled weather. At 1 p.m. hauled close round the South-West end of the Island, on which stands the Village before mention'd, the inhabitants of which were all in Arms. At 2 o'Clock we anchor'd in a very Snug Cove,* (* Ship Cove, in Queen Charlotte's Sound.) which is on the North-West side of the Bay facing the South-West end of the Island in 11 fathoms; soft Ground, and moor'd with the Stream Anchor. By this time several of the Natives had come off to the Ship in their Canoes, and after heaving a few stones at us and having some Conversation with Tupia, some of them Ventur'd on board, where they made but a very short stay before they went into their Canoes again, and soon after left us altogether. I then went ashore in the bottom of the Cove, accompanied by most of the Gentlemen on board. We found a fine Stream of Excellent Water, and as to wood the land is here one intire forest. Having the Sean with us we made a few hauls and caught 300 pounds weight of different sorts of fish, which were equally distributed to the Ship's Company. A.M., Careen'd the Ship, scrubb'd and pay'd the Larboard side. Several of the Natives Visited us this Morning, and brought with them some stinking fish, which, however, I order'd to be bought up to encourage them in this kind of Traffick, but Trade at this time seem'd not to be their Object, but were more inclinable to Quarrel, and as the Ship was upon the Carreen I thought they might give us some Trouble, and perhaps hurt some of our people that were in the Boats alongside. For this reason I fir'd some small shott at one of the first Offenders; this made them keep at a proper distance while they stay'd, which was not long before they all went away. These people declared to us this morning, that they never either saw or heard of a Ship like ours being upon this Coast before. From this it appears that they have no Tradition among them of Tasman being here, for I believe Murtherers bay, the place where he anchor'd, not to be far from this place;* (* Tasman's Massacre Bay lies 70 miles to the West-North-West.) but this cannot be it from the Latitude, for I find by an Observation made this day at Noon that we are at an Anchor in 41 degrees 5 minutes 32 seconds South, which is 15 miles to the Southward of Murtherers Bay.* (* The bay in Queen Charlotte's Sound in which the Endeavour anchored, Ship Cove, lies 7 miles within the entrance on the western shore.)

TUESDAY, 16th. Variable light breezes and clear, settled weather. At 1 p.m., we navigated closely around the southwestern end of the island, where the village previously mentioned is located, and saw that all the inhabitants were armed. By 2 o'clock, we anchored in a snug cove,* (* Ship Cove, in Queen Charlotte's Sound.) on the northwest side of the bay facing the southwestern end of the island in 11 fathoms; the ground was soft, and we moored with the stream anchor. By this time, several locals had come to the ship in their canoes. After throwing a few stones at us and talking with Tupia, some of them dared to come on board, but they didn’t stay long before returning to their canoes and soon after leaving us completely. I then went ashore at the bottom of the cove with most of the gentlemen who were onboard. We found a nice stream of excellent water, and the land here was completely forested. With the seine net, we made a few hauls and caught 300 pounds of various kinds of fish, which we shared equally among the ship's crew. In the morning, we careened the ship, scrubbed, and paid the port side. Several locals visited us this morning and brought some foul-smelling fish, which I ordered to be bought to encourage them in this kind of trade. However, it seemed that trading wasn’t their main goal, as they appeared more inclined to quarrel. Since the ship was being careened, I feared they might create some trouble and possibly harm some of our people who were in the boats alongside. For this reason, I fired some small shot at one of the first offenders; this made them keep a proper distance while they stayed, which wasn’t long before they all left. These people told us this morning that they had never seen or heard of a ship like ours being on this coast before. This suggests they have no tradition regarding Tasman being here, as I believe Murderers Bay, where he anchored, is not far from this location;* (* Tasman's Massacre Bay lies 70 miles to the West-North-West.) but this cannot be it based on the latitude, because my observation made today at noon shows we are anchored at 41 degrees, 5 minutes, and 32 seconds south, which is 15 miles to the south of Murderers Bay.* (* The bay in Queen Charlotte's Sound in which the Endeavour anchored, Ship Cove, lies 7 miles within the entrance on the western shore.)

Wednesday, 17th. Light Airs, Calm and pleasant weather. P.M., righted ship and got the other Side ready for heeling out, and in the Evening Haul'd the Sean and caught a few fish. While this was doing some of us went in the pinnace into another Cove, not far from where the Ship lays; in going thither we meet with a Woman floating upon the Water, who to all appearance had not been dead many days. Soon after we landed we meet with 2 or 3 of the Natives who not long before must have been regaling themselves upon human flesh, for I got from one of them the bone of the Fore arm of a Man or Woman which was quite fresh, and the flesh had been but lately picked off, which they told us they had eat; they gave us to understand that but a few days before they had taken, Kill'd, and Eat a Boats Crew of their Enemies or strangers, for I believe they look upon all strangers as Enemies. From what we could learn the woman we had seen floating upon the Water was in this Boat and had been drowned in the fray. There was not one of us that had the least doubt but what these people were cannibals; but the finding this bone with part of the sinews fresh upon it was a stronger proof than any we had yet met with, and, in order to be fully satisfied of the truth of what they had told us, we told one of them that it was not the bone of a man, but that of a dog; but he, with great fervency, took hold of his Fore Arm, and told us again that it was that bone: and to convince us that they had eat the flesh he took hold of the flesh of his own Arm with his teeth and made Signs of Eating. A.M., Careen'd, Scrub'd, and pay'd the Starboard side of the Ship; while this was doing some of the Natives came alongside seemingly only to look at us. There was a woman among them who had her Arms, thighs, and Legs cut in several place's; this was done by way of Mourning for her Husband who had very lately been Kill'd and Eat by some of their Enemies as they told us and pointed towards' the place where it was done, which lay somewhere to the Eastward. Mr. Banks got from one of them a Bone of the fore Arm, much in the same state as the one before mentioned; and to show us that they eat the flesh, they bit and Naw'd the bone and draw'd it through their Mouths, and this in such a manner as plainly Shew'd that the flesh to them was a Dainty Bit.

Wednesday, 17th. Light breezes, calm and pleasant weather. In the afternoon, we straightened the ship and got the other side ready for heeling out. In the evening, we hauled the seine and caught a few fish. While this was happening, some of us took the pinnace into another cove not far from where the ship was anchored. On our way there, we encountered a woman floating in the water, who appeared to have been dead for only a few days. Shortly after we landed, we met 2 or 3 of the locals who not long before must have been feasting on human flesh, as I obtained a fresh forearm bone from one of them, and the flesh had just recently been picked off. They indicated that just a few days earlier, they had captured, killed, and eaten a boat crew from their enemies or strangers, as I believe they regard all outsiders as enemies. From what we gathered, the woman we had seen floating was in that boat and had drowned during the conflict. None of us doubted for a moment that these people were cannibals; however, finding this bone with some sinews still fresh on it was stronger proof than anything else we had encountered. To confirm their story, we told one of them it was not a human bone but that of a dog. He fervently grasped his forearm and insisted it was indeed that bone. To prove they had eaten the flesh, he bit into his own arm and made signs of eating. In the morning, we careened, scrubbed, and caulked the starboard side of the ship; while this was happening, some of the locals came alongside, seemingly just to observe us. Among them was a woman whose arms, thighs, and legs were marked in several places; this was done as a sign of mourning for her husband, who had been recently killed and eaten by their enemies, as they pointed towards the area where it happened, which lay somewhere to the east. Mr. Banks received from one of them a forearm bone, much like the one mentioned earlier; to show us they consumed the flesh, they bit and gnawed on the bone and drew it through their mouths, which clearly indicated that the flesh was a delicacy to them.

Thursday, 18th. Winds mostly from the South-West; a gentle breeze and Clear settled weather. P.M., righted the Ship and sent on shore all or most of our empty Casks, and in the Morning the Coopers went about Trimming them, and the Carpenters went to work to Caulk the sides and to repair other defects in the Ship, while the seamen are Employ'd in the hold Cutting Wood, etc., etc. I made a little Excursion in the pinnace in order to take a View of the Bay, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We met with nothing remarkable, and as we were on the West side of the Bay where the land is so closely cover'd with wood that we could not penetrate into the country.

Thursday, 18th. Winds mostly from the South-West; a gentle breeze and clear settled weather. In the afternoon, we righted the ship and sent nearly all our empty barrels ashore. In the morning, the coopers started trimming them, while the carpenters worked on caulking the sides and repairing other issues with the ship. The seamen were busy in the hold cutting wood, etc. I took a little trip in the pinnace to get a view of the bay, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We didn’t encounter anything noteworthy, and since we were on the west side of the bay where the land is densely wooded, we couldn't explore further inland.

Friday, 19th. Winds and weather as yesterday, and the employment of the people the same. In the P.M. some of our people found in the Skirts of the Wood 3 hip Bones of Men; they lay near to a Hole or Oven, that is a place where the Natives dress their Victuals; this Circumstance, trifling as it is, is still a further proof that these people eat human flesh. In the A.M. set up the Forge to repair the Braces of the Tiller and such other Iron work as was wanting. The Natives came alongside and sold us a quantity of large Mackrell for Nails, pieces of Cloth and paper, and in this Traffick they never once attempted to defraud us of any one thing but dealt as fair as people could do.

Friday, 19th. The winds and weather were the same as yesterday, and the activities of the people were unchanged. In the afternoon, some of our people found three human hip bones near a fire pit where the locals cook their food. This might seem insignificant, but it's another indication that these people eat human flesh. In the morning, we set up the forge to repair the braces of the tiller and other ironwork as needed. The locals came over and sold us a good amount of large mackerel for nails, pieces of cloth, and paper, and during this trade, they didn't try to cheat us at all; they were as honest as anyone could be.

Saturday, 20th. Winds Southerly and fair, pleasant weather. Employ'd wooding, Watering, etc., and in the A.M. sent part of the Powder ashore to be Air'd. Some of the Natives brought alongside in one of their Canoes 4 of the heads of the Men they had lately kill'd; both the Hairy Scalps and Skin of the faces were on. Mr. Banks bought one of the 4, but they would not part with any of the other on any account whatever. The one Mr. Banks got had received a blow on the Temple that had broke the Skull. This morning I set out in the Pinnace accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, in order to Survey the West Coast of the Bay; we took our rout towards the head of the Bay, but it was near noon before we had got beyond the place we had been before.

Saturday, 20th. The winds were coming from the south and the weather was nice. We spent the day collecting firewood, watering, and so on, and in the morning we sent some of the gunpowder ashore to air it out. Some of the locals brought alongside in one of their canoes 4 heads of the men they had recently killed; both the hairy scalps and the skin of the faces were intact. Mr. Banks bought one of the heads, but they refused to sell any of the others under any circumstances. The one Mr. Banks got had a blow on the temple that shattered the skull. This morning, I headed out in the pinnace with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander to survey the west coast of the bay; we aimed for the head of the bay, but it was nearly noon before we passed the point we had reached before.

Sunday, 21st. P.M., a Gentle breeze of Wind Southerly, the remainder light Airs and Calm with clear, settled weather. P.M., the people employ'd as usual, and at 8 o'Clock we return'd on board the Pinnace from surveying the bay, in the doing of which I met with an Excellent Harbour, but saw no inhabitants or any Cultivated land. In the A.M. after hauling the Sean for fish, I gave every body leave to go ashore at the Watering place to amuse themselves as they thought proper.

Sunday, 21st. In the afternoon, there was a gentle breeze from the south, with light winds and calm, clear weather. In the afternoon, the people were busy as usual, and at 8 o'clock, we returned on board the small boat after surveying the bay, during which I discovered an excellent harbor, but I didn't see any inhabitants or cultivated land. In the morning, after dragging the net for fish, I let everyone go ashore at the watering place to enjoy themselves as they pleased.

Monday, 22nd. P.M., and in the night had variable light Airs and Calms. A.M., had a fresh breeze Southerly and Cloudy weather. In the morning the people were set about the necessary business of the Ship, and I set out in the Pinnace accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, with a view of examining the head of the inlet, but after rowing between 4 and 5 Leagues up it, and finding no probability of reaching it, or even seeing the end,* (* The head of Queen Charlotte's Sound is 20 miles from where the Endeavour was lying.) the wind being against us and the day already half spent; we landed at Noon on the South-East side in order to try to get upon one of the Hills, to view the inlet from thence.

Monday, 22nd. In the afternoon and during the night, we had light, variable winds and calm conditions. In the morning, there was a fresh breeze coming from the south and cloudy weather. The crew got to work on the ship’s essential tasks, and I took off in the small boat, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to explore the head of the inlet. However, after rowing for about 4 to 5 leagues and realizing we likely wouldn't reach it or even see the end, (* The head of Queen Charlotte's Sound is 20 miles from where the Endeavour was lying.) with the wind against us and the day already half gone, we landed at noon on the southeast side to try climbing one of the hills for a better view of the inlet.

Tuesday, 23rd. P.M., Winds Southerly, a fresh breeze. Agreeable to what is mentioned above I took one hand with me and Climbed up to the Top of one of the Hills, but when I came there I was hindered from seeing up the inlet by higher hills, which I could not come at for impenetrable woods, but I was abundantly recompensed for the trouble I had in assending the Hill, for from it I saw what I took to be the Eastern Sea, and a Strait or passage from it into the Western Sea; a little to the Eastward of the Entrance of the inlet in which we now lay with the Ship. The Main land which lies on the South-East side of this inlet appeared to me to be a narrow ridge of very high hills, and to form a part of the South-West side of the Strait;* (* Cook's Strait, which divides the two islands of New Zealand.) the land on the opposite side seem'd to tend away East, as far as the Eye could see. To the South-East appeared an Open Sea, and this I took to be the Eastern. I likewise saw some Islands lying on the East side of the inlet, which before I had taken to be a part of the main land. As soon as I had desended the hill and we had refreshed ourselves, we set out in order to return to the Ship, and in our way passed through and Examin'd the Harbours, Coves, etc., that lay behind the Islands above mentioned. In this rout we met with an old Village in which were a good many Houses, but no Body had lived in them lately; we likewise saw another that was inhabited, but the day being so far spent, that we had not time to go to it, but made the best of our way to the Ship, which we reached between 8 and 9 o'Clock. In the night had much rain with Cloudy, Hazey weather, which continued by intervals until Noon.

Tuesday, 23rd. P.M., Winds from the South, a fresh breeze. Following up on what was mentioned earlier, I took one person with me and climbed to the top of one of the hills. However, when I got there, I couldn’t see the inlet because taller hills blocked my view, and I couldn’t get to those hills due to thick woods. Nonetheless, I was more than compensated for the effort it took to climb the hill, as from the top I saw what I believed to be the Eastern Sea and a strait or passage leading from it into the Western Sea, just a bit east of the entrance to the inlet where our ship was located. The mainland on the southeast side of this inlet appeared to be a narrow ridge of very high hills and seemed to be part of the southwest side of the strait; the land on the opposite side stretched east as far as I could see. To the southeast, there was an open sea, which I assumed was the Eastern Sea. I also noticed some islands on the east side of the inlet that I had previously thought were part of the mainland. As soon as I climbed down the hill and we refreshed ourselves, we set out to return to the ship, passing through and examining the harbors, coves, etc., behind the aforementioned islands. During this trip, we came across an old village with many houses, but no one had lived there recently; we also saw another village that was inhabited. However, since it was getting late, we didn’t have time to visit it and made our way back to the ship, which we reached between 8 and 9 o'clock. During the night, there was a lot of rain with cloudy, hazy weather, which continued intermittently until noon.

Wednesday, 24th. P.M., had a fresh breeze southerly and cloudy weather. After dinner I employ'd myself in carrying on the survey of the place, and upon one of the Islands where I landed were a number of houses but no inhabitants, neither had any been there lately. In the morning the Gunner was sent ashore with the remainder of the powder to-day, and the Long boat was sent with a Gang of hands to one of the Islands to cut Grass for our Sheep, and the rest of the people were employ'd about the usual work of the Ship. This forenoon some of us visited the Hippa which is situated on the point of the Island mentioned on our first arrival;* (* Motuara.) the inhabitants of this place shew'd not the least dislike at our coming, but, on the contrary, with a great deal of seeming good nature shew'd us all over the place. We found among them some human bones, the flesh of which they told us they had eat; they likewise informed us that there was no passage into the Sea thro' this inlet, as I had imagined their was, because above where I was in the Boat it turn'd away to the Westward. Leaving these people, we Travelled to the other end of the Island, and there took Water and Crossed over upon the Main, where we met with several Houses that were at present, or had very lately been, inhabited, but we saw but very few of the inhabitants, and these were in their Boats fishing; after Viewing this place we returned on board to Dinner.

Wednesday, 24th. P.M., there was a fresh breeze coming from the south and cloudy weather. After dinner, I spent my time continuing the survey of the area. On one of the islands where I landed, there were several houses but no people, and none had been there recently. In the morning, the gunner was sent ashore with the leftover powder, and the longboat was dispatched with a group of hands to one of the islands to cut grass for our sheep. The rest of the crew was busy with the usual ship work. This morning, some of us visited the Hippa, which is located at the point of the island we mentioned when we first arrived; the inhabitants of this place showed no dislike at our arrival. On the contrary, with a lot of apparent good nature, they gave us a tour of the area. We found some human bones among them, which they said they had eaten. They also told us that there was no passage to the sea through this inlet, contrary to what I had thought, because just above where I was in the boat, it turned westward. After leaving these people, we traveled to the other end of the island, where we took on water and crossed over to the mainland. There, we encountered several houses that were currently or had recently been inhabited, but we saw very few of the inhabitants, and those were in their boats fishing. After checking out this place, we returned on board for dinner.

Thursday, 25th. Winds at North West, a Gentle breeze and fair weather. P.M. the Long boat having return'd with a Load of Grass, she was employ'd bringing on board Wood and Water, and the Caulkers having finished Caulking the Ship's sides (a thing they have been employ'd upon ever since we came here), they were pay'd with Tar. Early in the A.M. the Long boat was sent again for Grass, and return'd at Noon with a Load.

Thursday, 25th. Winds from the northwest, a gentle breeze and nice weather. In the afternoon, the longboat returned with a load of grass, and it was then used to bring on board wood and water. The caulkers finished caulking the ship's sides (which they've been working on since we arrived here), and they were paid with tar. Early in the morning, the longboat was sent out again for grass and returned at noon with a load.

Friday, 26th. Gentle breezes and pleasant weather. In the P.M. I made a little Excursion in the pinnace along shore towards the Mouth of the inlet, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We found in a small Cove several of the Natives, of whom we purchased a quantity of fresh fish; and upon our return to the Ship found that the Sean had been equally as Successfull, which we generally haul morning and evening, and seldom fail of getting fish sufficient for all hands. In the A.M. I made an Excursion into one of the Bays which lye on the East side of the inlet, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. Upon our landing we assended a very high hill, from which we had a full View of the passage I had before discovered, and the land on the opposite shore, which appeared to be about 4 Leagues from us; but as it was hazey near the Horizon we could not see far to the South-East. However, I had now seen enough of this passage to Convince me that there was the Greatest probability in the World of its running into the Eastern Sea, as the distance of that Sea from this place cannot Exceed 20 Leagues even to where we where. Upon this I resolved after putting to Sea to Search this passage with the Ship. We found on the Top of the Hill a parcel of loose stones, of which we built a Pyramid, and left in it some Musquet balls, small Shott, beads, and whatever we had about us that was likely to stand the test of Time; after this we descended the hill, and found along with Tupia and the boat's Crew several of the Natives, setting in the most free and friendly manner imaginable. Tupia always accompanies us in every Excursion we make, and proves of infinate Service. In our return to the Ship we visited the Hippa we had seen on Tuesday last, which is situated on a small Island, or rather a Rock. The inhabitants of this place invited us ashore with their usual Marks of Friendship, and shew'd us all over the place; which indeed was soon done, for it was very small, yet it contain'd a good number of people, and they had in it, Split and hanging up to dry, a prodidgious quantity of various sorts of small fish, a part of which they sold to us for such Trifles as we had about us.

Friday, 26th. Gentle breezes and nice weather. In the afternoon, I took a little trip in the small boat along the shore towards the mouth of the inlet, joined by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. We found a few locals in a small cove, from whom we bought a good amount of fresh fish. Upon returning to the ship, we discovered that the net had also been quite successful, as we generally haul it in the morning and evening, and we rarely fail to catch enough fish for everyone. In the morning, I made an excursion into one of the bays on the east side of the inlet, with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. When we landed, we climbed a very high hill, which gave us a complete view of the passage I had discovered earlier, as well as the land on the opposite shore, which seemed to be about four leagues away; but since it was hazy near the horizon, we couldn't see far to the southeast. However, I had seen enough of this passage to convince me that it was very likely to lead into the eastern sea, since the distance to that sea from our location cannot exceed 20 leagues. Based on this, I decided, after we set sail, to explore this passage with the ship. At the top of the hill, we found a pile of loose stones, and we built a pyramid and left some musket balls, small shot, beads, and anything else we had on hand that might withstand the test of time; after this, we descended the hill and found, along with Tupia and the boat crew, several locals who were sitting in a very friendly and open manner. Tupia always accompanies us on every excursion and is of immense help. On our way back to the ship, we visited the Hippa we had seen last Tuesday, located on a small island, or rather a rock. The inhabitants of this place invited us ashore with their usual signs of friendship and showed us around, which didn't take long since it was very small, yet it had a good number of people. They had a huge quantity of various types of small fish split and hanging up to dry, some of which they sold to us for the trinkets we had on us.

Saturday, 27th. Fresh gales, Westerly. This day we got the Tiller properly secured, which hath been the Employment of the Armourers and part of the Carpenters since we Anchor'd at this place; the former in repairing and making new Iron work, and the Latter in fixing a Transom,* (* A transom is a curved piece of wood which supports the end of the tiller.) for the want of which the Tiller has often been in danger of being broke; the Iron braces that supply'd the want of a Transom have broke every time they have been repair'd. Coopers still employ'd repairing the Casks; some hands with the Long boat getting on board Stones to put into the bottom of the bread room to bring the Ship more by the Stern; while others were employ'd cutting wood, repairing the rigging, and fishing.

Saturday, 27th. Fresh winds from the west. Today we properly secured the tiller, which has been the focus of the armorers and some of the carpenters since we anchored here; the armorers have been repairing and making new ironwork, while the carpenters have been fixing a transom,* (* A transom is a curved piece of wood that supports the end of the tiller.) without which the tiller has often been at risk of breaking. The iron braces that replaced the need for a transom have broken every time they've been repaired. Coopers are still busy fixing the casks; some crew members are working on the longboat to bring stones on board to put in the bottom of the bread room to shift the ship's weight more to the stern; while others are engaged in cutting wood, repairing the rigging, and fishing.

Sunday, 28th. Strong Gales westerly. P.M. fair and Cloudy, the remainder thick, hazey weather, with much rain.

Sunday, 28th. Strong westerly winds. In the afternoon, it was clear and cloudy, but the rest of the day was thick, hazy weather with a lot of rain.

Monday, 29th. Winds as yesterday. P.M. rainy weather, the remainder fair and Cloudy. Pretty early in the A.M. an old man, who had made us several visits upon our first Arrival here, came on board, and told us that one of our boats had fir'd upon and wounded 2 of their people, one of which was dead of his wounds. This affair hapned on Sunday was a week, and never before now came to my Knowledge; on that day the Master and 5 Petty officers desir'd to have a small boat to go a fishing; but instead of Keeping within the usual bounds and under the protection of the Ship, they went over to the Hippa on the Island, from which some of the inhabitants put off in 2 Canoes, as they thought to attack them; this Caused the Master to fire, and, according to the report of the old Man, wounded 2, one of which is since dead; but this last circumstance was soon after contradicted by another of the Natives, who Mr. Green and Tupia saw ashore, and I wish this last report may be true, because I find the reasons for firing upon them are not very Justifiable. This morning I went out to the Mouth of the Inlet and landed upon the West point, and from the Top of a pretty high hill which is there I had a view of this Coast to the North-West. The farthest land I could see in that Quarter was an Island* (* Stephens Island. Cape Stephens, off which it lies, forms the western termination of the strait, Cook's, between the two islands of New Zealand. The Coast between this and Cape Jackson, where Cook was standing, is thickly indented with inlets of great extent. The two Capes were named after the Secretaries of the Admiralty.) about 10 Leagues off, and lying pretty near the Main, and is the same as hath been before mentioned. Between this Island and the place where I was lay some other Islands close under the Shore, which forms several Bays, where there appears to be safe Anchorage for Shipping. After I had set the different points, etc., we Erected upon the Top of the Hill a Tower or Pile of Stones, in which we left a Piece of Silver Coin, some Musquet Balls, Beads, etc., and left flying upon it a piece of an old Pendant. After this we return'd to the Boat, and in our way to the Ship visited some of the Natives we met with along shore, and purchased of them a small quantity of fish.

Monday, 29th. Winds were the same as yesterday. In the afternoon, it rained, but the rest of the day was fair and cloudy. Early in the morning, an old man, who had visited us several times when we first arrived here, came on board and told us that one of our boats had fired upon and wounded two of their people, one of whom had died from his injuries. This incident happened a week ago on Sunday and I only just learned about it now. On that day, the captain and five petty officers asked for a small boat to go fishing, but instead of staying within the usual limits and under the ship's protection, they went over to Hippa on the island, where some inhabitants came out in two canoes as if to attack them. This prompted the captain to fire, and according to the old man's report, it wounded two people, one of whom is now dead. However, shortly after, another native contradicted this, which Mr. Green and Tupia saw on shore, and I hope this latest report is true because I find the reasons for firing upon them are not very justifiable. This morning, I went out to the mouth of the inlet and landed on the west point. From the top of a pretty high hill there, I had a view of the coast to the northwest. The furthest land I could see in that direction was an island* (*Stephens Island. Cape Stephens, off which it lies, forms the western end of the strait, Cook's, between the two islands of New Zealand. The coast between this and Cape Jackson, where Cook was standing, is heavily indented with large inlets. The two capes were named after the Secretaries of the Admiralty.) about 10 leagues away, which is pretty close to the mainland, and is the same one that has been mentioned before. Between this island and where I was, there were some other islands close to the shore, forming several bays where it seems safe for ships to anchor. After I noted the different points, we built a tower or pile of stones on top of the hill, where we left a piece of silver coin, some musket balls, beads, etc., and we left a piece of an old pendant flying atop it. After this, we returned to the boat, and on our way back to the ship, we visited some natives we met along the shore and bought a small quantity of fish from them.

Tuesday, 30th. Winds at North-West, Gentle breezes, and fair weather. Early in the A.M. a boat was sent to one of the Islands to get Sellery to boil for the People's breakfasts. While our people were gathering it near some empty huts about 20 of the Natives landed there--Men, Women, and Children. They had no sooner got out of their Canoe than 5 or 6 Women set down together, and cut and sacrificed themselves--viz., their Legs, Shins, Arms, and Faces, some with Shells, and others with pieces of Jaspar. So far as our people could understand them, this was done on account of their husbands being lately killed and devoured by their Enemies. While the women was performing this Ceremony, the Men went about repairing the Huts without showing the least Concern. The Carpenter went with part of his people into the Woods to cut and Square some Timber to saw into boards for the use of the Ship, and to prepare two Posts to be set up with inscriptions on them.

Tuesday, 30th. Northwest winds, gentle breezes, and nice weather. Early in the morning, a boat was sent to one of the islands to collect celery for everyone’s breakfast. While our people gathered it near some empty huts, about 20 locals—men, women, and children—landed there. As soon as they got out of their canoe, 5 or 6 women sat down together and cut themselves—specifically their legs, shins, arms, and faces—with shells and pieces of jasper. From what our people could gather, they did this because their husbands had recently been killed and eaten by their enemies. While the women performed this ritual, the men went about fixing the huts without showing any concern. The carpenter took some of his crew into the woods to chop and square some timber to be sawed into boards for the ship's use and to prepare two posts to be set up with inscriptions on them.

Wednesday, 31st. Little wind and Variable. In the P.M. the Carpenters having prepared the 2 Posts with inscriptions upon them, setting forth the Ship's Name, Month, and Year, one of them was set up at the Watering Place, on which was hoisted the Union flag; and in the Morning I took the other over to the Island which is known by the name of Motuouru, and is the one that lies nearest to the Sea; but before I attempted to set up the Post I went first to the Hippa, having Dr. Monkhouse and Tupia along with me. We here met with the old Man I have before spoke of. The first thing I did was to inquire after the Man said to be kill'd by our people, and the one that was wounded at the same time, when it did not appear to me that any such accidents had happened. I next (by means of Tupia) explain'd to the old Man and several others that we were Come to set up a Mark upon the Island, in order to shew to any ship that might put into this place that we had been here before. They not only gave their free Consent to set it up, but promised never to pull it down. I then gave every one a present of one thing or another; to the old man I gave Silver, three penny pieces dated 1763, and Spike Nails with the King's Broad Arrow cut deep in them; things that I thought were most likely to remain long among them. After I had thus prepared the way for setting up the post, we took it up to the highest part of the Island, and after fixing it fast in the ground, hoisted thereon the Union flag, and I dignified this Inlet with the name of Queen Charlotte's Sound, and took formal possession of it and the Adjacent lands in the Name and for the use of his Majesty. We then drank her Majesty's health in a Bottle of wine, and gave the Empty bottle to the old man (who had attended us up the hill), with which he was highly pleased. Whilst the Post was setting up we asked the old man about the Strait or Passage into the Eastern sea, and he very plainly told us there was a Passage, and as I had some Conjectures that the lands to the South-West of this Strait (which we are now at) was an Island, and not a Continent, we questioned the old Man about it, who said it consisted of two Wannuas, that is 2 lands or Islands that might be Circumnavigated in a few days, even in 4. This man spoke of 3 lands, the 2 above mentioned which he called Tovy-poinammu,* (* The two Wannuas were doubtless the peninsulas lying west of Queen Charlotte's Sound. The third was the North Island. Te Wai Pounamu (The Water of the Greenstone, of which the most prized weapons were made) is the native name of the Middle Island; but there must have been some confusion as to the possibility of getting round this in four days. The name of the North Island is Te Ika o Maui (The Fish of Maui), but is given by Cook as Aeheino Mouwe. It has been suggested (Rusden) that the name given to him was Tehinga o Maui (The Fishing of Maui), and imperfectly rendered.) which Signifies green Talk or Stone, such as they make their Tools or ornaments, etc., and for the third he pointed to the land on the East side of the Strait; this, he said, was a large land, and that it would take up a great many Moons to sail round it; this he called Aeheino Mouwe, a name many others before had called it by. That part which borders on the strait he called Teiria Whitte. After we had done our business upon the Island we returned on board, bringing the old Man along with us, who after dinner went ashore in a Canoe that came to attend upon him.

Wednesday, 31st. There was little wind and it was variable. In the afternoon, the carpenters had prepared the two posts with inscriptions indicating the ship's name, month, and year. One of the posts was set up at the watering place, where the Union flag was raised. In the morning, I took the other post over to the island known as Motuouru, which is the closest to the sea. However, before I set up the post, I first went to the Hippa, accompanied by Dr. Monkhouse and Tupia. We encountered the old man I had mentioned before. The first thing I did was ask about the man who was said to have been killed by our people and the one who was wounded at the same time; from what I could tell, it seemed no such accidents had occurred. Then, with Tupia’s help, I explained to the old man and several others that we had come to mark the island so that any ship that stopped here would know we had been here before. They not only agreed to let us set it up but also promised never to take it down. I then gave everyone a gift; to the old man, I gave silver, three penny pieces dated 1763, and spike nails with the King’s broad arrow deeply cut into them—items I thought would last a long time among them. After preparing to set up the post, we carried it to the highest part of the island, and after firmly securing it in the ground, we raised the Union flag. I named this inlet Queen Charlotte's Sound and formally took possession of it and the surrounding lands in the name and for the use of His Majesty. We then toasted to Her Majesty’s health with a bottle of wine and gave the empty bottle to the old man (who had accompanied us up the hill), which he greatly appreciated. While the post was being set up, we asked the old man about the strait or passage into the eastern sea, and he clearly told us there was a passage. Since I suspected that the lands to the southwest of this strait (where we were) were islands rather than a continent, we asked the old man about it, and he said it consisted of two Wannuas, meaning two lands or islands that could be circumnavigated in a few days, even in four. This man mentioned three lands: the two previously referred to, which he called Tovy-poinammu, meaning green stone or jade, from which they made their tools and ornaments, and for the third, he pointed to the land on the east side of the strait. He said this was a large land and that it would take many moons to sail around it; he called it Aeheino Mouwe, a name many others had used before. The part bordering the strait, he referred to as Teiria Whitte. After we finished our business on the island, we returned on board, bringing the old man with us, who after dinner went ashore in a canoe that had come to collect him.

[February 1770.]

[February 1770.]

Thursday, February 1st. P.M. having compleated the Ship with wood, and filled all our water, the Boatswain was sent ashore with a party of Men to cut and make brooms, while others were Employ'd about the rigging, fishing, etc. In the night and the remainder of the day had a Strong Gale from the North-West, attended with very much rain.

Thursday, February 1st. In the afternoon, after finishing the ship with wood and refilling our water supply, the boatswain was sent ashore with a group of men to cut and make brooms, while others worked on the rigging, went fishing, and so on. During the night and the rest of the day, we experienced a strong wind from the northwest, accompanied by heavy rain.

Friday, 2nd. In the P.M. the Gale increased to a Storm, attended with rain and squalls, which came down in Excessive heavy gusts from off the high land, in one of which the hawser we had fast to the shore broke; this obliged us to let go another Anchor. Towards midnight the Gale moderated, and in the morning it fell Calm, and we took up the Sheet Anchor, looked at the best bower, and moored the ship again to the Shore. The heavy rain, which both fell and Continues to fall, hath caused the Brook we water'd at to overflow its banks, and carry away 10 small Casks we had Standing there full of Water, and notwithstanding we searched the whole Cove, we could not find one of them.

Friday, 2nd. In the afternoon, the strong wind picked up into a storm, accompanied by rain and squalls that came down in extremely heavy gusts from the high land. In one of those gusts, the line we had tied to the shore broke, forcing us to drop another anchor. By midnight, the wind calmed down, and in the morning it was completely still. We retrieved the sheet anchor, checked the best bower, and moored the ship to the shore again. The heavy rain that fell and continues to fall has caused the brook we used for water to overflow its banks, washing away 10 small barrels we had standing there full of water. Despite searching the entire cove, we couldn’t find a single one of them.

Saturday, 3rd. Winds Northerly, mostly fair weather. Very early in the A.M. sent the Long boat for Sellery to boil for the Ship's Company's breakfast, and as I intended sailing the first opportunity, I went over to the Hippa, which is on the East side of the sound, and purchased of the inhabitants a quantity of split and half dry'd fish, and such as I could get. While we were at this Hippa, Tupia made farther enquiry about the Lands and Strait, and these people confirm'd everything the old Man had before told us. About noon we took our leave of them, which some seem'd not sorry for; notwithstanding they sold us their fish very freely, there were some few among them who shew'd evident signs of disapprobation.

Saturday, 3rd. Winds from the North, mostly clear weather. Very early in the morning, I sent the longboat for celery to cook for the ship's crew's breakfast. Since I planned to set sail at the first opportunity, I went over to the Hippa, located on the east side of the sound, and bought a good amount of split and partially dried fish, along with whatever else I could find. While we were at this Hippa, Tupia asked more questions about the land and the strait, and these people confirmed everything the old man had told us before. Around noon, we said our goodbyes, which some people seemed not to mind; even though they sold us their fish quite willingly, a few among them showed clear signs of disapproval.

Sunday, 4th. Winds Northerly, a fresh breeze and fair weather. In the P.M., after returning from the Hippa, some of us made an Excursion along shore to the Northward, in order to Traffic with the Natives for fish, in which we had no great Success. In the evening got everything off from the Shore, designing to sail in the Morning, but the wind not permitting, we amused ourselves in fishing, collecting of shells, etc.

Sunday, 4th. The wind was coming from the north, bringing a fresh breeze and nice weather. In the afternoon, after coming back from the Hippa, some of us went on a trip along the shore to the north to trade with the locals for fish, but we weren't very successful. In the evening, we packed everything up from the shore, planning to sail in the morning, but since the wind didn't cooperate, we kept ourselves entertained by fishing, collecting shells, and other activities.

Monday, 5th. Winds and weather as Yesterday. In the A.M. Cast off the Hawser, hove short on the Bower, and carried out the Kedge Anchor, in order to warp the Ship out of the Cove. All the dry fish we have been able to procure from the Natives since we came here were this day divided amongst the Ship's Company.

Monday, 5th. Winds and weather were the same as yesterday. In the morning, we untied the hawser, pulled the bower anchor tight, and put out the kedge anchor to maneuver the ship out of the cove. All the dry fish we've been able to get from the locals since we arrived were shared among the crew today.

Tuesday, 6th. At 2 p.m. hove up the Anchor, warped the Ship out of the Cove, and got under Sail, but it soon after falling little wind, and that very Variable, we anchor'd again a little above Motu-ouru. The old man, seeing us under sail, came on board to take his leave of us. Amongst other conversation that passed between him and Tupia, he was asked if either he or any of his Ancestors had ever seen or heard of any Ship like this being in these parts; to which question he answer'd in the Negative, but said that his Ancestors had told him that there came once to this place a small Vessel from a distant part, wherein were 4 Men that were all kill'd upon their landing; and being asked where this distant land lay, he pointed to the North, intimating that it would take up a great many days to go thither. Something of this land was mentioned by the People of the Bay of Islands, who said that some of their Ancestors had been there; but it is very clear to us that there knowledge of this land is only traditionary.* (* This was doubtless the tradition current among the Maoris, that their ancestors came from islands to the north. See Note below.) Had it Calm all night until 6 o'clock in the Morning, when a light breeze sprung up at North, and we got again under sail; but as the wind proved very unsteady, we got no farther than just without Motu-ouru by noon, but had a fair prospect of getting clear out of the Sound, which I shall next describe.

Tuesday, 6th. At 2 p.m., we lifted the anchor, maneuvered the ship out of the cove, and set sail, but soon after the wind dropped and became very inconsistent, so we anchored again just above Motu-ouru. The old man, seeing us sail, came on board to say his goodbyes. During their conversation, he and Tupia discussed whether he or any of his ancestors had ever seen or heard of a ship like ours in these waters; he replied no, but mentioned that his ancestors had told him about a small vessel that once came to this place from a distant land, where four men were killed when they landed. When asked where this distant land was, he pointed to the north, indicating it would take many days to reach. The people of the Bay of Islands also mentioned this land, claiming some of their ancestors had been there, but it's evident that their knowledge of it is purely traditional. Had a calm night until 6 o'clock in the morning when a light breeze came up from the north, and we set sail again. However, the wind was very unsteady, and by noon we hadn't gone beyond Motu-ouru, but we had a good chance of clearing out of the sound, which I'll describe next.

DESCRIPTION OF QUEEN CHARLOTTE'S SOUND.

DESCRIPTION OF QUEEN CHARLOTTE SOUND.

The entrance of this Sound is situated in the Latitude of 41 degrees South and Longitude 184 degrees 45 minutes West, and near the middle of the South-West side of the Strait before mentioned. The land off the South-East head of the Sound called by the Natives, Koamaroo (off which lies 2 Small Islands and some rocks) makes the Narrowest part of the Strait. There stretcheth out 2 Miles North-East by North from the North-West head a reef of rocks, a part of which is above Water. This account of the 2 Heads will be found sufficient guide to know this sound, which is 3 Leagues broad at the Entrance, and lies in South-West by South-South-West, and West-South-West at least 10 Leagues, and is a collection of some of the finest harbours in the world, as will evidently appear from the plan which was taken with all the accuracy that time and Circumstances would admit. The Harbour or Cove in which we lay, called Ship Cove, is not inferior to any in the Sound, both in point of Security and other Conveniences. It lies on the West side of the Sound, and is the Southermost of 3 Coves lying within Motu-ouru, which Island bears East from it. You may sail into this Cove either between this last mentioned Island and the Isle Hamote, or Long Island, or between Motuouru and the West shore; in this last Channell are 2 Ledges of Rocks 3 fathoms under water, but they may be known by the Sea Weed which grows upon them. In sailing in or out of this sound with little wind attention must be had to the Tides, which flow 9 or 10 o'Clock full and Change of the Moon, and rises and falls upon a Perpendicular 7 or 8 feet. The flood comes in through the Strait from the South-East, and sets strong over upon the North-West Head and the reef laying off it; the Ebb sets with great rapidity to the South-East over upon the Islands and Rocks lying off the South-East Head. The Variation of the Compass from good observations we found to be 13 degrees 5 minutes East. The land about this Sound is of such height that we first saw it at the distance of 20 Leagues. It consists wholy of high hills and deep Valleys, well stored with a variety of excellent Timber, fit for all purposes except Ships' Masts, for which use it is too hard and heavy. The Sea abounds with a variety of fish, and in such plenty that, without going out of the Cove where we lay, we caught daily, what with the Sean, Hook, and Lines, quite sufficient for all hands, and upon our first arrival we found plenty of Shags and some few other Wild Fowls, which to people in our situation was fresh food not to be dispised. The Number of Inhabitants hardly exceeds 300 or 400 People. They live dispers'd along the Shore in search of their daily bread, which is fish and firn roots, for they Cultivate no part of the lands. Upon the appearance of danger they Retire to their Hippas or strongholds, for in this situation we found them, and they remain'd so for some days after. This people are poor when compared to many we have seen, and their Canoes are mean and without ornament. The little Traffick we had with them was wholy for fish, for we saw little else they had to dispose of. They had some knowledge of Iron, for they very readily took Nails in Exchange for fish, and sometimes Prefer'd them to anything else, which was more than the people of any other place would do. They were at first fond of Paper, but when they found it spoile by being wet they would not take it; nor did they set much value upon the cloth we got at George's Island, but shew'd an extraordinary fondness for English broad cloth and red Kersey, which shew'd them to be a more sensible People than many of their Neighbours. Besides the common dress, many of these People wore on their Heads round Caps made of Birds' feathers, which were far from being unbecoming.* (* Cook was not able to explore the whole of Queen Charlotte's Sound, which runs into the land for 25 miles. Towards the southern end is Picton, the port of Blenheim, the capital of the province of Marlborough.)

The entrance to this Sound is located at 41 degrees South latitude and 184 degrees 45 minutes West longitude, close to the middle of the southwestern side of the previously mentioned Strait. The land off the southeastern head of the Sound, called Koamaroo by the locals (with two small islands and some rocks nearby), marks the narrowest part of the Strait. A reef of rocks stretches out 2 miles northeast by north from the northwest head, part of which is above water. This description of the two heads will serve as a sufficient guide to identify this sound, which is 3 leagues wide at the entrance and extends southwest by south-southwest, and west-southwest for at least 10 leagues, and features some of the finest harbors in the world, as will be clearly illustrated by the plan created with the utmost accuracy possible at that time. The harbor or cove where we anchored, called Ship Cove, is as good as any in the Sound, both in security and other conveniences. It is located on the west side of the Sound and is the southernmost of three coves within Motu-ouru, which is an island to the east. You can enter this cove either between this island and Isle Hamote, also known as Long Island, or between Motuouru and the west shore. In the latter channel, there are two ledges of rocks three fathoms underwater, which can be identified by the seaweed growing on them. When sailing in and out of this sound with light winds, special attention must be paid to the tides, which flood at 9 or 10 o’clock full and change of the moon, rising and falling vertically by 7 or 8 feet. The flood tide comes in through the Strait from the southeast and flows strongly over the northwest head and the reef off it; the ebb tide flows rapidly southeast over the islands and rocks lying off the southeastern head. From our observations, we found the variation of the compass to be 13 degrees 5 minutes east. The land around this Sound rises high enough that we first sighted it from 20 leagues away. It consists entirely of high hills and deep valleys, rich in a variety of excellent timber, suitable for many purposes except for ship masts, as it is too hard and heavy for that use. The sea is full of various fish, so abundant that we caught enough each day with a seine, hook, and lines, just while staying in the cove, and upon our arrival, we found plenty of shags and a few other wild birds, which provided welcomed fresh food for our situation. The number of inhabitants is hardly more than 300 or 400 people. They live scattered along the shore, searching for their daily food, which consists of fish and fern roots, as they do not cultivate any land. When faced with danger, they retreat to their hippas or strongholds; we found them in this state, and they remained so for several days. These people are poor compared to many we have seen, and their canoes are simple and unadorned. The little trade we had with them was solely for fish, as we saw little else they had to offer. They had some understanding of iron, as they readily accepted nails in exchange for fish and sometimes preferred them over anything else, which was more than people in other places would do. They initially liked paper, but once they saw it spoiled when wet, they wouldn’t take it; they also did not value the cloth we obtained from George's Island, but showed a strong preference for English broadcloth and red kersey, indicating they were a more discerning people compared to many of their neighbors. In addition to their regular clothing, many of these people wore round caps made of birds’ feathers on their heads, which were quite becoming.

[In Cook's Strait, New Zealand.]

[In Cook Strait, New Zealand.]

Wednesday, 7th. In the P.M. had a light breeze at North by West, with which we got out of the Sound and stood over to the Eastward, in order to get the Strait well open before the tide of Ebb Made. At 7 the 2 Small Islands which lies off Cape Koamaroo, or the South-East head of Queen Charlotte's Sound, bore East, distant 4 miles. At this time we had it nearly Calm, and the tide of Ebb making out, we were Carried by the Rapidity of the Stream in a very short time close upon one of the Islands,* (* The Brothers. There is now a lighthouse on this island.) where we narrowly escaped being dashed against the Rocks by bringing the Ship to an Anchor in 75 fathoms Water, with 150 fathoms of Cable out. Even this would not have saved us had not the Tide, which first set South by East, by meeting with the Island changed its direction to South-East, and carried us past the first point. When the Ship was brought up she was about 2 Cables' Lengths of the Rocks and in the Strength of the Stream, which set South-East at least 4 or 5 Knotts or miles per Hour. A little before 12 o'Clock the Tide abated, and we began to heave; by 3 the Anchor was at the bows, and having a light breeze at North-West, we made sail over for the Eastern Shore; but having the tide against us we made but little way. The wind afterwards freshned, and Came to North and North-East, with which and the tide of Ebb we were in a short time hurried thro' the narrowest part of the Strait, and then stood away for the Southermost land we had in sight, which bore from us South by West. Over this land appeared a Prodigious high Mountain,* (* The Kairoura Range, the summit of which is 9500 feet high.) the Summit of which was covered with snow. The narrowest part of the Strait we have passed lies between Cape Koamaroo on Tovy-poinammu and Cape Teerawhitte on Aeheino-mouwe; the distance from the one to the other I judged to be between 4 and 5 Leagues. And notwithstanding the strength of the Tides, now that is known, there is no great danger in passing it; in the doing of which I am of opinion that the North-East Shore is the safest to keep upon, for upon that side there appeared no danger, whereas on the other shore there are not only the Islands and Rocks lying off Cape Koamaroo, for I discover'd from the hill from which I had the Second View of the Strait, a Reef of Rocks stretching from these Islands 6 or 7 Miles to the Southward, and lay about 2 or 3 Miles off from the Shore. I shall not pretend here to assign limits to the length of this Strait; a view of the Chart will best illustrate that. About North 9 Leagues from Cape Teerawhitte, under the same shore, is a high remarkable Island, that may be distinctly seen from Queen Charlotte Sound, from which it lies North-East by East 1/4 East, distant 6 or 7 Leagues. I have called it Entry Isle, and was taken Notice of when we first past it on Sunday 14th of last Month. On the East side of Cape Teerawhitte the Land Trends away South-East by East about 8 Leagues, where it ends in a point, and is the Southermost land on Aeheinomouwe, which I have named Cape Pallisser in Honour of my worthy friend Capt. Pallisser.* (* Captain Palliser, afterwards Sir Hugh, was Captain of the Eagle, Cook's first ship in the Royal Navy. He discovered Cook's talents, and was his warm friend throughout his life. Between Cape Teerawhitte and Cape Palliser is the entrance to Port Nicholson, wherein is situated Wellington, the capital of New Zealand. This entrance is, however, narrow, and Cook was never near enough to the land to discover it.) Latitude 41 degrees 34 minutes, Longitude 183 degrees 58 minutes, it bore from us this day at Noon South 79 degrees East, distant 12 or 13 Leagues, being then in the Latitude of 41 degrees 27 minutes South; at the same time Cape Koamaroo bore North 1/2 East, distant 7 or 8 Leagues. The Southermost point of land in sight bore South 16 degrees West, and the snowy Mountain South-West being about 3 Leagues from the shore and abreast of a Deep Bay or inlet called Cloudy bay, in the bottom of which appear'd low land cover'd with tall Trees.

Wednesday, 7th. In the afternoon, we had a light breeze coming from North by West, which helped us leave the Sound and head east to open up the Strait before the tide started to go out. At 7, the two small islands off Cape Koamaroo, or the southeast tip of Queen Charlotte's Sound, were east of us, about 4 miles away. At that moment, it was almost calm, and as the tide went out, we were quickly carried towards one of the islands,* (*The Brothers. There is now a lighthouse on this island.) and narrowly avoided crashing into the rocks by dropping anchor in 75 fathoms of water, using 150 fathoms of cable. Even this might not have saved us if the tide, which initially flowed south by east, hadn't changed direction upon hitting the island and pushed us past the first point. When the ship stopped, we were about 2 cable lengths from the rocks and caught in a strong current flowing southeast at least 4 to 5 knots or miles per hour. A little before noon, the tide lessened, and we started to heave; by 3, the anchor was pulled up, and with a light breeze from the northwest, we set sail toward the eastern shore. However, the opposing tide made little progress. Later, the wind picked up, shifting to north and northeast, and with that and the outgoing tide, we were soon rushed through the narrowest part of the Strait, then headed towards the southernmost land in sight, which was southwest from us. High above this land loomed an enormous mountain,* (*The Kairoura Range, the summit of which is 9500 feet high.) capped with snow. The narrowest section of the Strait we passed through lies between Cape Koamaroo on Tovy-poinammu and Cape Teerawhitte on Aeheino-mouwe; I estimated the distance between them to be around 4 to 5 leagues. Despite the force of the tides, I believe there is no major danger in passing through, and I think the northeast shore is the safest route because it showed no hazards, unlike the opposite shore, which has islands and rocks off Cape Koamaroo. From the hill where I had my second view of the Strait, I noticed a reef of rocks stretching from these islands about 6 or 7 miles southward, lying about 2 or 3 miles offshore. I won't attempt to define the length of this Strait; a look at the chart will clarify that best. About 9 leagues north from Cape Teerawhitte, along the same shore, there is a high, notable island visible from Queen Charlotte Sound, positioned northeast by east 1/4 east, around 6 or 7 leagues away. I named it Entry Isle, which we noted when we first passed it on Sunday, the 14th of last month. On the east side of Cape Teerawhitte, the land trends southeast by east for about 8 leagues, ending in a point, which is the southernmost land on Aeheinomouwe; I named it Cape Pallisser in honor of my good friend Capt. Pallisser.* (*Captain Palliser, later Sir Hugh, was the captain of the Eagle, Cook's first ship in the Royal Navy. He recognized Cook's talents and remained a close friend throughout Cook's life. Between Cape Teerawhitte and Cape Palliser is the entrance to Port Nicholson, which contains Wellington, the capital of New Zealand. This entrance is narrow, and Cook was never close enough to the land to discover it.) At latitude 41 degrees 34 minutes, longitude 183 degrees 58 minutes, it was located south 79 degrees east from us at noon today, about 12 or 13 leagues away; we were at latitude 41 degrees 27 minutes south; at the same time, Cape Koamaroo was north 1/2 east, about 7 or 8 leagues out. The southernmost visible land was at south 16 degrees west, and the snowy mountain was to the southwest, approximately 3 leagues from shore and opposite a deep bay or inlet called Cloudy Bay, where low-lying land covered with tall trees appeared at the bottom.

Thursday, 8th. In the P.M. had a fresh breeze at North-North-East and Cloudy weather. At 3 o'Clock was abreast of the Southermost point of land set at Noon, which I named Cape Campbell, Latitude 41 degrees 42 minutes South, Longitude 184 degrees 47 minutes West, it lies South by West, distant 12 or 13 Leagues from Cape Koamaroo, and together with Cape Pallisser forms the Southern Entrance of the Straits; the Distance of the one to the other is 13 or 14 Leagues West by South and East by North. From this Cape we steer'd along Shore South-West by South until 8 o'Clock, when the wind died away; but an Hour after a fresh breeze sprung up at South-West, and we put the Ship right before it. The reason of my doing this was owing to a notion, which some of the Officers had just started, that Aeheinomouwe was not an Island; founding their opinion on a supposition that the land might extend away to the South-East from between Cape Turnagain and Cape Pallisser, there being a space of about 12 or 13 leagues which we had not seen. For my own part, I had seen so far into this Sea the first time I discover'd the Strait, together with many other Concurrent testimonies of its being an Island, that no such supposition ever enter'd my thoughts; but being resolved to clear up every doubt that might Arise on so important an Object, I took the opportunity of the Shifting of the Wind to Stand to the Eastward, and accordingly steer'd North-East by East all night. At 9 o'Clock A.M. we were abreast of Cape Pallisser, where we found the Land trend away North-East towards Cape Turnagain, which I reckon'd to be distant from us about 26 Leagues, but as the weather was hazey so that we could not see above 4 or 5 Leagues ahead, we Still kept standing to the North-East, with a light breeze at South. At Noon Cape Pallisser bore North 72 degrees West, distant 3 Leagues; our Latitude by account is 41 degrees 30 minutes South.

Thursday, 8th. In the afternoon, there was a fresh breeze from the North-North-East and cloudy weather. At 3 o'clock, we were level with the southernmost point of land marked at noon, which I named Cape Campbell, Latitude 41 degrees 42 minutes South, Longitude 184 degrees 47 minutes West. It lies South by West, about 12 or 13 leagues from Cape Koamaroo, and together with Cape Pallisser, it forms the southern entrance of the Straits; the distance between the two is about 13 or 14 leagues West by South and East by North. From this Cape, we sailed along the shore South-West by South until 8 o'clock when the wind died down; but an hour later, a fresh breeze picked up from the South-West, and we put the ship right before it. I did this because of a suggestion made by some of the officers that Aeheinomouwe might not be an island; they based their opinion on the idea that the land could extend to the South-East from between Cape Turnagain and Cape Pallisser, seeing as there was a gap of about 12 or 13 leagues that we hadn't explored. Personally, I had seen enough of this sea the first time I discovered the Strait, along with many other testimonies indicating it was indeed an island, so that idea never crossed my mind. However, wanting to resolve any doubts regarding such an important subject, I took advantage of the shifting wind to head eastward, and accordingly steered North-East by East all night. By 9 o'clock A.M., we were abeam of Cape Pallisser, where we noticed the land trend away North-East towards Cape Turnagain, which I estimated to be about 26 leagues away. But as the weather was hazy, preventing us from seeing more than 4 or 5 leagues ahead, we continued heading North-East with a light breeze from the South. At noon, Cape Pallisser was at North 72 degrees West, about 3 leagues away; our latitude by account is 41 degrees 30 minutes South.

[Complete the Circuit of North Island, New Zealand.]

[Complete the Circuit of North Island, New Zealand.]

Friday, 9th. Gentle breezes at South and South-South-East, hazey Cloudy weather. In the P.M. 3 Canoes came off to the Ship, wherein were between 30 and 40 of the Natives, who had been pulling after us sometime. It appeared from the behaviour of these people that they had heard of our being upon the Coast, for they came alongside, and some of them on board the Ship, without shewing the least signs of fear. They were no sooner on board than they asked for Nails, but when Nails was given them they asked Tupia what they were, which was plain that they had never seen any before; yet they not only knowed how to ask for them, but know'd what use to make of them, and therefore must have heard of Nails, which they call Whow, the name of a Tool among them made generally of bone, which they use as a Chisel in making Holes, etc. These people asking so readily for Nails proves that their connections must extend as far North as Cape Kidnapper, which is 45 Leagues, for that was the Southermost place on this side the coast we had any Traffick with the Natives; and it is most probable that the inhabitants of Queen Charlotte's sound got the little knowledge they seem'd to have of Iron by the Connections they may have with the Teerawhitteans bordering upon them; for we have no reason to think that the inhabitants of any part of this land had the least knowledge of Iron before we came amongst them. After a short stay these people were dismissed with proper presents, and we continued our Course along shore to the North-East until 11 o'Clock A.M., when the weather clear'd up, and we saw Cape Turnagain bearing North by East 1/4 East, distant 7 Leagues. I then called the Officers upon deck, and asked them if they were now satisfied that this land was an Island; to which they answer'd in the Affirmative, and we hauled our wind to the Eastward.* (* The Endeavour had now completely circumnavigated the North Island of New Zealand, having spent four months in the exploration. That Cook had communicated his enthusiasm to his officers is evident; or, knowing his determination to leave nothing doubtful, they would not have started the idea that the North Island might not be really an island. The natural wish after so many months' absence from civilization must have been to get back to it, and to take things for granted that would otherwise delay their progress.) At Noon our Latitude by observation was 40 degrees 55 minutes South, which is 21 Miles to the Southward of Cape Turnagain, it bearing North by East, and Cape Pallisser by this day's run bears South 43 degrees West, 19 or 20 Leagues.

Friday, 9th. Gentle breezes from the South and South-South-East, hazy and cloudy weather. In the afternoon, 3 canoes came to the ship, carrying between 30 and 40 natives who had been paddling after us for a while. Their behavior suggested that they had heard of our presence on the coast, as they approached without showing any signs of fear. As soon as they were on board, they asked for nails, but when we gave them some, they asked Tupia what they were, indicating they had never seen them before. However, they not only knew how to ask for them but also understood their purpose, which means they must have heard about nails, which they call Whow—a term for a tool made generally of bone that they use as a chisel for making holes, etc. Their eagerness to ask for nails implies that their connections must extend as far north as Cape Kidnapper, which is 45 leagues away, as that was the southernmost point on this side of the coast where we had any trade with the natives. It's likely that the inhabitants of Queen Charlotte's Sound gained whatever limited knowledge they had of iron through connections with the Teerawhitteans living nearby, since we have no reason to believe that any part of this land knew anything about iron before our arrival. After a short visit, we provided them with appropriate gifts and continued our course along the shore to the northeast until 11 o'clock A.M., when the weather cleared up, and we saw Cape Turnagain bearing North by East 1/4 East, 7 leagues away. I then called the officers on deck and asked if they were now convinced that this land was an island; they responded affirmatively, and we adjusted our course to the eastward.* (*The Endeavour had now completely circumnavigated the North Island of New Zealand, having spent four months on exploration. It is clear that Cook had shared his enthusiasm with his officers, or they would not have suggested that the North Island might not truly be an island. After so many months away from civilization, their natural desire must have been to return and to accept things without questioning that would otherwise delay their progress.) At noon, our latitude by observation was 40 degrees 55 minutes South, which is 21 miles south of Cape Turnagain, bearing North by East, and Cape Pallisser, based on today's run, bears South 43 degrees West, 19 or 20 leagues away.

Saturday, 10th. Gentle breezes at South-East and Cloudy weather. At 4 P.M. Tack'd and stood South-West until 8 A.M., when being not above 3 or 4 Miles from the Shore we Tack'd, and stood off 2 hours, and then stood again to the South-West until noon, when being in the Latitude of 41 degrees 13 minutes South, and about 2 Miles from the Shore, the land of Cape Pallisser bearing South 53 degrees West, had 26 fathoms of water.

Saturday, 10th. Light breezes from the Southeast and cloudy weather. At 4 PM, we tacked and headed Southwest until 8 AM, when we were only about 3 or 4 miles from the shore. We tacked again and stayed off for 2 hours, then set course back to the Southwest until noon. At that point, we were at a latitude of 41 degrees 13 minutes South, about 2 miles from the shore, with Cape Pallisser to the South 53 degrees West and 26 fathoms of water underneath us.

Sunday, 11th. P.M. had light breeze from the South-East. In the night it was Calm until 9 a.m., when a Gentle breeze sprung up at East-North-East, with which we made sail to the Southward, having a large swell rolling in from that Quarter. At Noon was in the Latitude of 41 degrees 6 minutes South, distant from the Shore 1 1/2 Leagues; a remarkable hillock,* (* Castle Point.) which stands close to the Sea, bore North 1/2 East, distance 4 Leagues. At this time 2 Canoes came alongside the Ship, with whom we had some little Traffic, and then dismissed them.

Sunday, 11th. P.M. had a light breeze from the Southeast. At night it was calm until 9 a.m., when a gentle breeze picked up from the East-Northeast, allowing us to set sail southward, with a large swell rolling in from that direction. At noon, we were at a latitude of 41 degrees 6 minutes South, 1.5 leagues from the shore; a notable hill, (Castle Point), which is right by the sea, was located north-northeast, 4 leagues away. At that time, two canoes approached the ship, and we had a bit of trade with them before sending them off.

Monday, 12th. Most part of P.M. had a fresh breeze at North-East, which by sunset carried us the length of Cape Pallisser, and as the weather was clear I had an opportunity of Viewing the land of this Cape, which is of a height Sufficient to be seen in clear weather 12 or 14 Leagues, and is of a broken and hilly surface. Between the foot of the high land and the Sea is a border of low, flat land, off which lies some rocks, that appear above water. Between this Cape and Cape Turnagain the land near the shore is in many places low and flatt, and appear'd green and pleasant; but inland are many Hills. From Cape Pallisser to Cape Teerawhitte the land is tollerable high, making in Table-points, and the Shore forms 2 Bays; at least it appear'd so, for we were always too far off this part of the Coast to be particular.* (* The northern of these was the entrance to Port Nicholson, the harbour of Auckland.) The wind continued at North-East until 12 at Night, when it died away, and veer'd round to the West, and afterwards to South and South-South-East little wind, so that by noon we had advanced no farther than 41 degrees 52 minutes South Latitude. Cape Pallisser bearing North, distant 5 Leagues, and the Snowy mountain bore South 83 degrees West.

Monday, 12th. Most of the afternoon had a fresh breeze coming from the northeast, which by sunset helped us reach Cape Pallisser. The weather was clear, so I got a chance to see the land of this Cape, which is high enough to be visible in clear weather from 12 to 14 leagues away, and has a rugged, hilly terrain. Between the base of the high land and the sea is a strip of low, flat land, with some rocks that are visible above the water. Between this Cape and Cape Turnagain, the land near the shore is low and flat in many places, looking green and pleasant, but there are many hills inland. From Cape Pallisser to Cape Teerawhitte, the land is reasonably high, forming table-like points, and the shore appears to have two bays, or at least it looked that way, since we were always too far off the coast to be certain.* (* The northern of these was the entrance to Port Nicholson, the harbor of Auckland.) The wind stayed at northeast until midnight when it calmed down and shifted to the west, then to south and south-southeast with little wind, so by noon we hadn't progressed any farther than 41 degrees 52 minutes south latitude. Cape Pallisser was to the north, 5 leagues away, and the snowy mountain was to the south, 83 degrees west.

Tuesday, 13th. P.M. light Airs at South-East, the remainder Calm. At Noon found ourselves in the Latitude of 42 degrees 2 minutes South, Cape Pallisser bearing North 20 degrees East, distant 8 Leagues.

Tuesday, 13th. P.M. light winds from the South-East, the rest calm. At noon, we found ourselves at a latitude of 42 degrees 2 minutes South, with Cape Pallisser bearing North 20 degrees East, 8 leagues away.

Wednesday, 14th. P.M. a fresh breeze sprung up at North-East, and we Steer'd South-West by West for the Southermost land we had in sight, which bore from us at sunset South 74 degrees West. At this time we found the Variation to be 15 degrees 4 minutes East. At 8 A.M. it fell Calm; at this time we had run 21 Leagues South 58 degrees West since Yesterday at noon, which brought us abreast of the high Snowy mountain, it bearing from us North-West in this direction. It lay behind a Mountainous ridge of nearly the same height, which riseth directly from the Sea, and runs Parrallel with the Shore, which lies North-East 1/2 North and South-West 1/2 South. The North-East end of the ridge takes its rise but a little way inland from Cape Campbell. These mountains are distinctly seen both from Cape Koamaroo and Cape Pallisser, being distant from the former South-West 1/2 South 22 Leagues, and from the Latter West-South-West 30 Leagues: but they are of a height sufficient to be seen at a much greater distance. By some on board they are thought to be much higher than the Peak of Teneriffe, which I cannot agree to; neither do I think them so high as Mount Egmont, on the South-West Coast of Aeheinomouwe, founding my opinion on the summit of the Latter being almost wholy covered with Snow, whereas it only lies upon these in patches.* (* The highest peak of the Kaikoura Mountains, Mount Tapuaepuka, is 9500 feet high. It is therefore higher than Mount Egmont, but not so high as the Peak of Teneriffe. The snow lies thicker on the western side of New Zealand mountains, so Cook's parallel was fallacious. The Endeavour was now near the Kaikoura Peninsula, where a small town stands at the present day, the shipping port of an agricultural district.) At noon was in the Latitude of 42 degrees 34 minutes South; the Southermost land we had in sight bore South-West 1/2 West, and some low land that made like an Island lying close under the foot of the Ridge North-West by North, distant about 5 or 6 Leagues.

Wednesday, 14th. In the afternoon, a fresh breeze came up from the North-East, and we steered South-West by West toward the southernmost land we could see, which was positioned at sunset at South 74 degrees West. At this time, we noted the variation to be 15 degrees 4 minutes East. By 8 A.M., it was calm; at that point, we had traveled 21 leagues South 58 degrees West since yesterday at noon, bringing us opposite a high snowy mountain located to the North-West. It was behind a mountainous ridge of nearly the same height that rose directly from the sea and ran parallel with the shore, which extended North-East 1/2 North and South-West 1/2 South. The North-East end of the ridge begins a short distance inland from Cape Campbell. These mountains can be clearly seen from both Cape Koamaroo and Cape Pallisser, situated 22 leagues South-West 1/2 South from the former and 30 leagues West-South-West from the latter. However, they are tall enough to be visible from much farther away. Some aboard thought they were much taller than the peak of Teneriffe, which I disagree with; nor do I believe they are as tall as Mount Egmont on the South-West coast of Aeheinomouwe, as the summit of the latter is almost completely covered in snow, while the snow here only appears in patches. (*The highest peak of the Kaikoura Mountains, Mount Tapuaepuka, is 9500 feet high. Therefore, it is taller than Mount Egmont but not as tall as the Peak of Teneriffe. The snow is thicker on the western side of New Zealand mountains, so Cook's comparison was inaccurate. The Endeavour was now near the Kaikoura Peninsula, where a small town exists today, serving as the shipping port for an agricultural region.) At noon, we were at a latitude of 42 degrees 34 minutes South; the southernmost land we could see was at South-West 1/2 West, and there was some low land that appeared island-like lying close under the ridge to the North-West, about 5 or 6 leagues away.

Thursday, 15th. In the P.M. 4 Double Canoes, in which were 57 Men, came off to the Ship; they kept at the distance of about a Stone's throw from us, and would not be prevailed upon to put alongside by all that Tupia could say to them. From this we concluded that they never had heard of our being upon the coast. At 8 p.m. a breeze sprung up at South-South-West, with which we Stretched off South-East, because some on board thought they saw land in that Quarter. We continued on this course until 6 A.M., at which time we had run 11 Leagues, but saw no land but that which we had left. Soon after this it fell calm, and continued so for an hour; then a light breeze sprung up at West, which afterwards veer'd to the North, and we stood to the Westward. At Noon our Latitude by Observation was 42 degrees 56 minutes South, and the High Land we were abreast of yesterday at Noon, North-North-West 1/2 West.

Thursday, 15th. In the afternoon, four double canoes carrying 57 men came to the ship. They stayed about the distance of a stone's throw from us and wouldn’t be convinced to come alongside, no matter what Tupia said to them. From this, we figured they had never heard we were on the coast. At 8 p.m., a breeze came up from the South-South-West, and we headed Southeast because some people on board thought they saw land in that direction. We kept going this way until 6 a.m., at which point we had traveled 11 leagues but saw no land except for what we had left behind. Shortly after, it became calm for about an hour; then a light breeze came from the West, which later shifted to the North, and we sailed Westward. At noon, our latitude by observation was 42 degrees 56 minutes South, and the high land we were next to yesterday at noon was North-North-West 1/2 West.

Friday, 16th. In the P.M. had a light breeze North-East, with which we steer'd West, edging in for the land, which was distant from us about 8 Leagues. At 7 o'Clock the Southermost Extream of the land in sight bore West-South-West, being about 6 Leagues from the Shore; soon after this it fell Calm, and continued so most part of the night, with sometimes light Airs from the land. At daylight we discover'd land bearing South by West, and seemingly detached from the Coast we were upon; at 8 o'Clock a breeze sprung up at North by East, and we steer'd directly for it. At Noon was in the Latitude of 43 degrees 19 minutes South; the Peak on the Snowy Mountains bore North 20 degrees East, distant 27 Leagues; the Southern Extremity we could see of that land bore West, and the land discover'd in the morning, making like an Island, extending from South-South-West to South-West by West 1/2 West, distant about 8 Leagues; our Course and distance sail'd since yesterday at Noon South-West by West, 43 Miles; Variation by this Morning's Amplitude 14 degrees 39 minutes East.

Friday, 16th. In the afternoon, we had a light breeze from the North-East, allowing us to head West, getting closer to the land, which was about 8 leagues away. At 7 o'clock, the southernmost point of land we could see was to the West-South-West, about 6 leagues from the shore. Shortly after, it became calm and stayed that way for most of the night, with occasional light winds coming from the land. At daylight, we spotted land to the South by West, seemingly separated from the coast we were on; at 8 o'clock, a breeze picked up from North by East, and we headed straight for it. At noon, we were at a latitude of 43 degrees 19 minutes South; the peak on the snowy mountains was to the North 20 degrees East, 27 leagues away; the southernmost point of that land was to the West, and the land we saw in the morning looked like an island, extending from South-South-West to South-West by West 1/2 West, about 8 leagues away; our course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon were South-West by West, 43 miles; variation by this morning's amplitude was 14 degrees 39 minutes East.

[Off Banks Peninsula, New Zealand.]

[Off Banks Peninsula, NZ.]

Saturday, 17th. P.M. stood to the Southward for the land above mention'd, with the wind at North, a fresh breeze and Clear weather. At 8 o'Clock we had run 11 Leagues since Noon, when the land extended from South-West by West to North by West, being distant from the nearest shore about 3 or 4 Leagues; in this situation had 50 fathoms, a fine sandy bottom. Soon after this it fell Calm, and continued so until 6 A.M., when a light breeze sprung up at North-West, which afterwards veer'd to North-East. At sun rise, being very Clear, we plainly discover'd that the last mentioned land was an Island by seeing part of the Land of Tovy-poenammu open to the Westward of it, extending as far as West by South. At 8 o'Clock the Extreams of the Island bore North 76 degrees West and North-North-East 1/2 East, and an opening that had the Appearance of a Bay or Harbour, lying near the South point North 20 degrees West, distant 3 or 4 Leagues, being in 38 fathoms, a brown Sandy bottom. This Island,* (* It is not an island, but a mountainous peninsula, still called after Mr. Banks, but from the lowness of the land it adjoins, looks like an island. On the north side is the fine harbour of Lyttelton, the port of Christchurch, a town of nearly 40,000 inhabitants. The harbour on the south side, that Cook saw, is Akaroa, a magnificent port.) which I have named after Mr. Banks, lies about 5 Leagues from the Coast of Tovy poenammu; the South point bears South 21 degrees West from the higher peak on the Snowy Mountain so often mention'd, and lies in the Latitude of 43 degrees 52 minutes South and in the Longitude of 186 degrees 30 minutes West, by observations made of the Sun and Moon this morning. It is of a circular figure, and may be about 24 Leagues in Compass; the land is of a height sufficient to be seen 12 or 15 Leagues, and of a very broken, uneven Surface, and hath more the appearance of barrenness than fertility. Last night we saw smoke up it, and this morning some people, and therefore must be inhabited. Yesterday Lieutenant Gore, having the Morning Watch at the time we first saw this Island, thought he saw land bearing South-South-East and South-East by East; but I, who was upon Deck at the same time, was very Certain that it was only Clouds, which dissipated as the Sun rose. But neither this, nor the running 14 Leagues to the South, nor the seeing no land to the Eastward of us in the Evening, could Satisfy Mr. Gore but what he saw in the morning was, or might be, land; altho' there was hardly a possibility of its being so, because we must have been more than double the distance from it at that time to what we were either last night or this morning, at both of which times the weather was Exceeding Clear, and yet we could see no land either to the Eastward or Southward of us. Notwithstanding all this, Mr. Gore was of the same opinion this morning; upon this I order'd the Ship to be wore, and to be steer'd East-South-East by Compass on the other Tack, the point on which he said the land bore at this time from us.* (* Another instance of the general desire to leave nothing unexplored.) At Noon we were in the Latitude of 44 degrees 7 minutes South; the South point of Banks Island bore North, distant 5 Leagues.

Saturday, 17th. P.M. we headed south toward the land mentioned earlier, with the wind coming from the north, a fresh breeze, and clear weather. By 8 o'clock, we had covered 11 leagues since noon, with the land stretching from southwest by west to northwest, about 3 or 4 leagues from the nearest shore; here we found 50 fathoms with a nice sandy bottom. Soon after, it became calm and stayed that way until 6 A.M., when a light breeze picked up from the northwest and then shifted to the northeast. At sunrise, with clear skies, we clearly saw that the land we last mentioned was actually an island because we could see part of the land of Tovy-poenammu opening to the west of it, stretching out to west by south. By 8 o'clock, the farthest points of the island were bearing North 76 degrees West and North-North-East 1/2 East, and there was an opening that looked like a bay or harbor near the south point, bearing North 20 degrees West, about 3 or 4 leagues away, in 38 fathoms with a brown sandy bottom. This island,* (* It is not an island, but a mountainous peninsula, still named after Mr. Banks, though it looks like an island due to the low land it connects to. The fine harbor of Lyttelton, the port of Christchurch, which has nearly 40,000 inhabitants, is located on the north side. The harbor on the south side that Cook saw is Akaroa, a stunning port.) which I've named after Mr. Banks, is about 5 leagues from the coast of Tovy poenammu; the south point is located South 21 degrees West from the higher peak on the snowy mountain previously mentioned, positioned at 43 degrees 52 minutes South latitude and 186 degrees 30 minutes West longitude, based on observations made of the sun and moon this morning. The island is circular in shape and approximately 24 leagues around; its land is high enough to be seen from 12 to 15 leagues away and has a very broken, uneven surface, appearing more barren than fertile. Last night we saw smoke coming from it, and this morning we spotted some people, so it must be inhabited. Yesterday, Lieutenant Gore, who was on morning watch when we first sighted this island, thought he saw land bearing South-South-East and Southeast by East; however, I was on deck at the same time and was quite sure it was just clouds, which vanished as the sun rose. Yet, neither this, nor our journey of 14 leagues south, nor the absence of any visible land to the east in the evening could convince Mr. Gore that what he saw in the morning wasn’t land; although it was nearly impossible for it to be land since we would have been more than twice the distance from it at that time compared to last night or this morning, at both of which times the sky was extremely clear, and we still couldn’t see any land to the east or south of us. Despite this, Mr. Gore held the same belief this morning; as a result, I ordered the ship to turn around and head East-South-East by compass on the other tack, the direction from which he claimed the land was at that time from us.* (* Another example of the general desire to leave nothing unexplored.) By noon, we were at 44 degrees 7 minutes South latitude; the south point of Banks Island was bearing north, 5 leagues away.

Sunday, 18th. Gentle breezes at North and fair weather. P.M. stood East-South-East in search of Mr. Gore's imaginary land until 7 o'clock, at which time we had run 28 Miles since Noon; but seeing no land but that we had left, or signs of any, we bore away South by West, and continued upon that Course until Noon, when we found ourselves in the Latitude of 45 degrees 16 minutes South. Our Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday is South 8 minutes East, 70 Miles; the South point of Banks Island North 6 degrees 30 minutes West, distant 28 Leagues; Variation per Amplitude this Morning 15 degrees 30 minutes. Seeing no signs of Land, I thought it to no purpose standing any farther to the Southward, and therefore hauled to the Westward, thinking we were far enough to the Southward to weather all the land we had left; but this opinion was only founded on the information we had had from the Natives of Queen Charlotte's sound.* (* The ship was still 250 miles from the south point of New Zealand.)

Sunday, 18th. There were gentle breezes from the north and nice weather. In the afternoon, we headed East-South-East looking for Mr. Gore's imaginary land until 7 o'clock. By then, we had traveled 28 miles since noon, but we hadn’t seen any land except for what we had left behind or any signs of land. So, we changed our direction to South by West and continued on that course until noon, when we found ourselves at a latitude of 45 degrees 16 minutes South. Our course and distance sailed since yesterday was South 8 minutes East, 70 miles; the southern point of Banks Island was North 6 degrees 30 minutes West, 28 leagues away; the variation by amplitude this morning was 15 degrees 30 minutes. Since we saw no signs of land, I thought it was pointless to go further south, so we turned west, believing we were far enough south to avoid any land we had left behind; however, this opinion was based solely on the information we received from the natives of Queen Charlotte's Sound.* (*The ship was still 250 miles from the southern point of New Zealand.)

Monday, 19th. P.M. had a Moderate breeze at North-North-West and North until 8 o'clock, when it fell little wind, and was very unsettled until 10, at which time it fix'd at South, and freshen'd in such a manner that before the morning it brought us under our close reeft Topsails. At 8 a.m. having run 28 Leagues upon a West by North 1/2 North Course, and now judging ourselves to be to the Westward of the Land of Tovy Poenammu, we bore away North-West with a fresh Gale at South. At 10 o'clock, having run 11 Miles upon this Course, we saw land extending from the South-West to the North-West at the distance of about 10 Leagues from us, which we hauled up for. At Noon our Latitude per observation was 44 degrees 38 minutes South; the South-East point of Banks Island bore North 59 degrees 30 minutes East, distant 30 Leagues, and the Main body of the land in sight West by North. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon is North 66 degrees 45 minutes West, 96 Miles.

Monday, 19th. In the afternoon, we had a moderate breeze coming from the North-North-West and North until 8 o'clock, when the wind dropped a bit and remained quite unsettled until 10. At that time, it settled at South and picked up strength so much that by morning we had to use our close-reefed topsails. At 8 a.m., after traveling 28 leagues on a course of West by North 1/2 North, we figured we were to the west of the land of Tovy Poenammu, so we steered North-West with a fresh gale coming from the South. At 10 o'clock, after moving 11 miles on this course, we spotted land stretching from the South-West to the North-West, about 10 leagues away, which we headed for. At noon, our latitude from observation was 44 degrees 38 minutes South; the South-East tip of Banks Island was bearing North 59 degrees 30 minutes East, 30 leagues away, and the main body of the land visible was West by North. The course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon was North 66 degrees 45 minutes West, 96 miles.

[Off Timaru, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Timaru, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

Tuesday, 20th. All P.M. had little wind, which veer'd round from South by East to North-North-East. Steer'd South-South-West, but got very little to the Southward on account of a head Sea. At 2 o'Clock sounded in 35 fathoms, fine sandy Bottom, being about 6 Leagues from the land. At 7 o'Clock the Extreams of the land extending from South-West by South to North by West, distant from the nearest shore 6 Leagues, depth of water 32 fathoms. At 12 o'Clock it fell Calm, and continued so until 4 A.M., when a fresh breeze sprung up at South by West, with which we stood in shore West by South, 4 Leagues, our Depth of Water from 32 to 13 fathoms. In this last Depth we Tack'd and Stood off, being about 3 Miles from the Shore, which lies nearly North and South, and is here very low and flatt, and continues so up to the skirts of the hills, which are at least 4 or 5 Miles inland. The whole face of the Country appears barren, nor did we see any signs of inhabitants.* (* This is a little south of Timaru, a rising town in a fertile district; so deceptive is appearance from the sea.) Latitude at Noon 44 degrees 44 minutes South; Longitude made from Banks' Island to this land 2 degrees 22 minutes West.

Tuesday, 20th. In the afternoon, there was very little wind, which shifted from South by East to North-North-East. We steered South-South-West, but made very little progress south due to a head sea. At 2 o'clock, we measured the depth at 35 fathoms, with a nice sandy bottom, about 6 leagues from land. By 7 o'clock, the land extended from South-West by South to North by West, 6 leagues from the nearest shore, with a water depth of 32 fathoms. At 12 o'clock, it went calm and stayed that way until 4 A.M., when a fresh breeze picked up from South by West, allowing us to head inshore West by South for 4 leagues, with the depth of water dropping from 32 to 13 fathoms. In this last depth, we tacked and moved away, being about 3 miles from shore, which runs nearly North and South and is very low and flat here, extending to the base of the hills that are at least 4 or 5 miles inland. The entire landscape looks barren, and we didn’t see any signs of inhabitants. (*This is a little south of Timaru, a growing town in a fertile area; the appearance from the sea can be misleading.) Latitude at noon is 44 degrees 44 minutes South; Longitude from Banks' Island to this land is 2 degrees 22 minutes West.

Wednesday, 21st. Wind at South. A fresh Gale at 2 p.m., being in 50 fathoms, and 12 Leagues from the land, we tack'd and stood in Shore until 8 o'Clock, when we Tack'd and Stood off until 4 a.m.; then Tack'd and Stood in, at 8 o'Clock being 10 Leagues from the Land; had 57 fathoms. At Noon, being in the Latitude 44 degrees 35 minutes, and 5 or 6 Leagues from the land, had 36 fathoms; notwithstanding we have Carried as much sail as the Ship could bear, it is apparent from the observed Latitudes that we have been drove 3 Leagues to leeward since Yesterday.

Wednesday, 21st. Wind from the South. A strong breeze picked up at 2 p.m. while we were in 50 fathoms, 12 leagues from the shore. We tacked and headed towards land until 8 o'clock, when we tacked again and sailed away until 4 a.m. Then we tacked and moved in again, and at 8 o'clock we were 10 leagues from the shore, in 57 fathoms. By noon, at a latitude of 44 degrees 35 minutes and 5 or 6 leagues from land, we were in 36 fathoms; even though we had the ship under as much sail as possible, the recorded latitudes clearly show that we’ve been pushed back 3 leagues to leeward since yesterday.

Thursday, 22nd. Moderate breezes between the South-East and South by West, and dark gloomy weather, with a Swell from the South-East plying to windward, keeping between 4 and 12 Leagues from the land; depth of water from 35 to 53 fathoms, fine sandy bottom. A great many Sea fowl and Grampusses about the Ship. In the A.M. Condemn'd 60 fathoms of the B.B. Cable,* (* B.B. stands for Best Bower, one of the principal cables. The hempen cables of those days were a continual cause of solicitude, and required great care.) and converted it into Junk; at Noon had no Observation, but by the land judged ourselves to be about 3 Leagues farther North than Yesterday.

Thursday, 22nd. There were moderate breezes coming from the South-East to South by West, with dark, gloomy weather and a swell from the South-East pushing against the wind, staying about 4 to 12 leagues from the shore; water depth ranged from 35 to 53 fathoms, with a nice sandy bottom. There were a lot of seabirds and dolphins around the ship. In the morning, we condemned 60 fathoms of the B.B. cable, and turned it into junk; at noon, we had no observations, but by looking at the land, we estimated that we were about 3 leagues farther north than yesterday.

Friday, 23rd. Winds Southerly, a Gentle breeze, and for the most part Cloudy weather. At sunset, the weather clearing up, presented to our View a high peaked Mountain* (* There are so many lofty mountains in this region that it is impossible to identify this. This ship was now no farther south than she had been five days earlier.) bearing North-West by North, and at the same time we saw the Land more Distincter than at any time we had before, extending from North to South-West by South, the inland parts of which appear'd to be high and Mountainous. We cannot tell yet whether or no this land joins to, or makes a part of, the land we have left; from the accounts received from the Natives of Queen Charlotte's sound it ought not, because if it did it must have been impossible for us to have sail'd round it in 4 Days; besides, the Mountains inland and the soundings off the Coast seem to indicate this Country to be more extensive than any they spoke of lying to the Southward. Having a large hollow swell from the South-East, which made me expect the Wind from the same quarter, we keept plying from 7 to 15 Leagues from the land, depth of Water 44 to 70 fathoms; at Noon our Latitude, by Observation, was 44 degrees 40 minutes South; Longitude made from Banks's Island 1 degree 31 minutes West.

Friday, 23rd. The winds were coming from the south, with a gentle breeze, and mostly cloudy weather. As the sun was setting, the sky cleared up, revealing a high peaked mountain* (* There are so many tall mountains in this area that it's impossible to pinpoint which one this is. The ship hadn’t traveled any farther south than it had five days ago.) located to the northwest, and at the same time, we saw the land more clearly than we had before, stretching from north to southwest by south, with inland areas appearing to be high and mountainous. We still can’t tell if this land connects to or is part of the land we’ve already passed; according to the accounts from the locals in Queen Charlotte's Sound, it shouldn’t be, because if it did, we wouldn’t have been able to sail around it in four days. Additionally, the mountains inland and the soundings off the coast seem to indicate that this region is larger than anything they mentioned lying to the south. We were experiencing a large swell coming from the southeast, which made me expect the wind to come from that direction as well, so we kept moving from 7 to 15 leagues away from the land, with water depths ranging from 44 to 70 fathoms. At noon, our latitude, based on observations, was 44 degrees 40 minutes south; longitude calculated from Banks's Island was 1 degree 31 minutes west.

Saturday, 24th. Calm until 6 p.m., at which time a light breeze sprung up at East-North-East, with which we steer'd South-South-East all night, edging off from the Land because of a hollow swell which we had from the South-East; depth of water from 60 to 75 fathoms. At daylight the wind began to freshen, and before noon blowed a fresh Gale, and veer'd to North-North-East; at 8 a.m. Saw the land extending as far as South-West by South, which we steer'd directly for, and at Noon we were in the Latitude of 45 degrees 22 minutes South; the land in sight extending from South-West 1/2 South to North-North-West making high and hilly. Course and distance run since Yesterday at Noon is South 15 degrees West, 47 Miles. In the P.M., while we lay becalm'd, Mr. Banks, in a small Boat, shott 2 Port Egmont Hens, which were in every respect the same sort of Birds as are found in great Numbers upon the Island of Faro; they are of a very dark brown plumage, with a little white about the under side of their wings, and are as large as a Muscovy Duck. These were the first that we have seen since we arrived upon the Coast of this Country, but we saw of them for some days before we made land.

Saturday, 24th. It was calm until 6 p.m., when a light breeze picked up from the East-North-East. We steered South-South-East all night, moving away from the land due to a rolling swell from the South-East; the water depth ranged from 60 to 75 fathoms. At dawn, the wind started to pick up, and by noon it had turned into a fresh gale, shifting to North-North-East. At 8 a.m., we spotted land stretching as far as South-West by South, which we headed straight for, and by noon, we were at a latitude of 45 degrees 22 minutes South. The land in sight extended from South-West 1/2 South to North-North-West, appearing high and hilly. Since yesterday at noon, we traveled on a course of South 15 degrees West for 47 miles. In the afternoon, while we were calm, Mr. Banks, in a small boat, shot 2 Port Egmont Hens, which were identical to the birds commonly found on the Island of Faro. They had very dark brown feathers with a bit of white on the underside of their wings and were as large as a Muscovy Duck. These were the first we had seen since arriving on this coast, although we had spotted some days before we reached land.

[Off Otago, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Otago, South Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 25th. In the P.M. Steer'd South-West by South and South-West, edging in for the land, having the Advantage of a fresh Gale at North, which I was over desirous of making the most of, and by that means carried away the Maintop Gallant Mast and Foretopmast Steering Sail Boom; but these were soon replaced by others. Altho' we keept at no great Distance from the Shore, yet the weather was so Hazey that we could see nothing distinct upon the land, only that there were a ridge of Pretty high Hills lying Parrallel with, and but a little way from, the Sea Coast, which lies South by West and North by East, and seem'd to End in a high Bluff point to the Southward, which we run the length of by 8 o'Clock, when, being dark, and not knowing which way the Land Trended, we brought too for the night, having run 15 Leagues upon a South-West 1/2 West Course since Noon. The point bore at this time West, distant about 5 Miles, depth of Water 37 fathoms, the bottom small pebble stones. At 4 A.M. we made Sail, but by this time the Northerly wind was gone, and was succeeded by one from the Southward, which proved very Var'ble and unsteady. At day light the point above mention'd bore North, distant 3 Leagues, and we found that the land trended away from it South-West by West, as far as we could see. This point of land I have Named Cape Saunders, in Honour of Sir Charles* (* Admiral Sir Charles Saunders was First Lord of the Admiralty in 1766. He commanded the fleet at the capture of Quebec in 1759, in which Cook served.) (Latitude 45 degrees 55 minutes South; Longitude 189 degrees 4 minutes West). It requires no discription to know it by, the Latitude and the Angle made here by the Coast will be found quite sufficient; however, there is a remarkable saddle hill laying near the Shore, 3 or 4 Leagues South-West of the Cape. From 1 to 4 Leagues North of the Cape the Shore seem'd to form 2 or 3 Bays, wherein there appear'd to be Anchorage and Shelter from South-West, Westerly, and North-West winds.* (* One of these is Otago Harbour, where lies Dunedin, perhaps the most important commercial city in New Zealand.) I had some thoughts of bearing up for one of these places in the morning when the Wind came to South-West, but the fear of loosing time and the desire I had of pushing to the Southward, in order to see as much of the Coast as possible, or, if this land should prove to be an Island, to get round it, prevented me. Being not far from the Shore all this morning, we had an Opportunity of Viewing the Land pretty distinctly; it is of a Moderate height, full of Hills, which appear'd green and Woody, but we saw not the least signs of inhabitants. At Noon Cape Saunders bore North 30 degrees West, distant 4 Leagues. Latitude per Log, for we had no Observation, 46 degrees 0 minutes South.

Sunday, 25th. In the afternoon, we steered southwest by south and south-west, moving closer to the land, taking advantage of a fresh breeze from the north. I was overly eager to make the most of it, which caused us to lose the maintop gallant mast and the foretopmast steering sail boom; however, we quickly replaced them. Even though we stayed fairly close to the shore, the weather was so hazy that we could barely see anything clearly on land—only that there was a range of pretty high hills running parallel to the sea coast, which lay south by west and north by east. These hills seemed to end in a high bluff point to the south, which we reached by 8 o'clock. As it was getting dark and we weren't sure how the land extended, we stopped for the night after covering 15 leagues on a south-west half west course since noon. The point was then to the west, about 5 miles away, with a water depth of 37 fathoms and a bottom made of small pebbles. At 4 A.M. we set sail again, but by that time, the northern wind had died down and was replaced by an unpredictable southern wind. At daylight, the aforementioned point was north, about 3 leagues away, and we saw that the land extended south-west by west as far as we could observe. I named this point Cape Saunders in honor of Sir Charles. (Latitude 45 degrees 55 minutes south; Longitude 189 degrees 4 minutes west). There's no need for a detailed description; the latitude and coast angle here should be enough to identify it. However, there is a distinctive saddle-shaped hill near the shore, 3 or 4 leagues south-west of the cape. From 1 to 4 leagues north of the cape, the shore formed 2 or 3 bays that seemed to offer anchorage and shelter from south-west, westerly, and north-west winds. I thought about heading to one of these spots in the morning when the wind shifted to the south-west, but my concern about losing time and my desire to push southward to see as much of the coast as possible—or to find out if this land was an island—held me back. Being close to shore all morning gave us a good chance to view the land clearly; it is moderately high, full of hills that appeared green and wooded, but we saw no signs of inhabitants. At noon, Cape Saunders bore north 30 degrees west, 4 leagues away. Our log indicated a latitude of 46 degrees 0 minutes south, as we had no observation.

Monday, 26th. In the P.M. had the wind Whifling all round the Compass, sometimes blowing a fresh Gale, and at other times almost Calm. At 5 o'Clock it fixed at West-South-West, and soon blow'd so hard as to put us past our Topsails, and to split the foresail all to pieces. After getting another to the Yard, we continued standing to the Southward under 2 Courses. At 1 A.M. the wind Moderating, set the Topsails with one Reef out; but soon after day light the Gale increased to a Storm, with heavy Squalls, attended with rain. This brought us again under our Courses, and the Main Topsail being Split we unbent it and bent another. At 6 o'Clock the Southermost land in sight bore West by North, and Cape Saunders bore North by West, distant 8 Leagues; at Noon it bore North 20 minutes West, distant 14 Leagues. Latitude observed 46 degrees 35 minutes.

Monday, 26th. In the afternoon, the wind was swirling all around the compass, sometimes blowing a strong gale and other times nearly calm. At 5 o'clock, it settled at West-South-West and soon blew so hard that it put us past our topsails and completely tore apart the foresail. After getting another one onto the yard, we kept heading south under two courses. At 1 A.M., as the wind calmed down, we set the topsails with one reef out; but just after dawn, the gale picked up to a storm with heavy squalls and rain. This forced us back down to our courses, and when the main topsail ripped, we took it down and replaced it. At 6 o'clock, the southernmost land in sight was at West by North, and Cape Saunders was at North by West, 8 leagues away; at noon, it was at North 20 minutes West, 14 leagues distant. Latitude observed: 46 degrees 35 minutes.

Tuesday, 27th. A very hard gale at South-West by West, and West-South-West, with heavy squalls attended with Showers of rain, and a large hollow sea, without the least intermission the whole of this 24 Hours. We continued under our Courses from Noon until 7 P.M., when we handed the Mainsail, and lay too under the Foresail with the head to the Southward. Latitude at Noon 46 degrees 54 minutes; Longitude made from Cape Saunders 1 degree 24 minutes East.

Tuesday, 27th. A strong gale from the South-West by West and West-South-West, with heavy squalls bringing rain showers and a large, rough sea, continuing without a break the entire 24 hours. We kept our sails up from noon until 7 PM, when we took down the mainsail and stayed put under the foresail, facing south. Latitude at noon was 46 degrees 54 minutes; longitude calculated from Cape Saunders was 1 degree 24 minutes East.

Wednesday, 28th. Strong Gale at South-West, with a large Sea from the Same quarter. At 7 p.m. made sail under the Courses; at 8 a.m. set the Topsails close reefed. At Noon, being in the Latitude of 47 degrees 43 minutes South, and Longitude East from Cape Saunders 2 degrees 10 minutes, wore and stood to the Northward.

Wednesday, 28th. Strong winds from the southwest, with large waves coming from the same direction. At 7 p.m. we raised the sails; at 8 a.m. we furled the topsails tightly. At noon, we were at a latitude of 47 degrees 43 minutes south and 2 degrees 10 minutes east from Cape Saunders, then we turned and headed north.

[March 1770.]

[March 1770.]

Thursday, March 1st. Winds between the South-West and North-North-West, a fresh gale. In the P.M. found the Variation to be 16 degrees 34 minutes East. At 8 Tack'd and Stood to the Southward, with the wind at West, which before the morning veer'd to North-West, accompanied with hazey weather and drizzling rain; at day light loosed a reef out of Each Topsail, and set some of the small sails. At Noon our Latitude by account was 47 degrees 52 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Saunders 1 degree 8 minutes East.

Thursday, March 1st. Winds blew between the South-West and North-North-West, creating a fresh gale. In the afternoon, we found the variation to be 16 degrees 34 minutes East. At 8 o'clock, we tacked and headed south with the wind from the west, which shifted to the North-West overnight, bringing hazy weather and light rain. At daybreak, we loosened a reef from each topsail and set some of the smaller sails. By noon, our latitude was 47 degrees 52 minutes South, and our longitude, measured from Cape Saunders, was 1 degree 8 minutes East.

Friday, 2nd. Strong Gales from the West, with heavy Squalls, attended with showers of rain. In the P.M. Stood to the Southward till half-past 3, when being in the Latitude 48 degrees 0 minutes South and Longitude 188 degrees 00 minutes West, and seeing no Visible signs of Land, we Tack'd and Stood to the Northward, having a very large swell from the South-West by West. Soon after we tack'd we close reef'd the Topsails, and in the night were obliged to hand them, but at day light set them again. At Noon our Latitude by Observation was 46 degrees 42 minutes South, Cape Saunders bearing North 46 degrees West, distant 68 Miles.

Friday, 2nd. Strong winds from the west with heavy squalls and rain showers. In the afternoon, we headed south until half-past 3, when we were at 48 degrees 0 minutes South latitude and 188 degrees 00 minutes West longitude, and seeing no visible signs of land, we tacked and headed north, experiencing a large swell from the south-west by west. Shortly after we tacked, we closely reefed the topsails, and by night, we had to take them down, but we set them again at daybreak. At noon, our latitude by observation was 46 degrees 42 minutes South, with Cape Saunders bearing North 46 degrees West, 68 miles away.

Saturday, 3rd. P.M. Wind and weather as Yesterday. A.M. quite Moderate, yet the South-West swell continues, which makes me conjecture that there is no land near in that quarter. At Noon our Latitude was 46 degrees 42 minutes South, being East of Cape Saunders 1 degree 30 minutes.

Saturday, 3rd. P.M. Wind and weather just like yesterday. A.M. was pretty calm, but the South-West swell is still ongoing, which makes me think there's no land nearby in that direction. At noon, our latitude was 46 degrees 42 minutes South, which is 1 degree 30 minutes east of Cape Saunders.

Sunday, 4th. At 4 p.m. the Wind coming to the Northward we stood to the Westward with all the sail we could make. In the morning got up Topgallant yards, and set the sails; found the Variation to be 16 degrees 16 minutes East. Saw several Whales, Seals, and one Penguin; this bird was but Small of the sort, but seem'd to be such a one as we had never seen before. We have seen several Seals since we passed the Straits, but never saw one upon the whole Coast of Aeheinomouwe. We sounded both in the Night and the morning, but found no bottom with 150 fathoms Line; at Noon we saw Cape Saunders bearing North 1/2 West; our Latitude by observation was 46 degrees 31 minutes South.* (* The Endeavour had been blown off the land for seven days, and had barely recovered her position.)

Sunday, 4th. At 4 p.m., with the wind coming from the north, we headed west with all the sails we could manage. In the morning, we raised the topgallant yards and set the sails; we found the magnetic variation to be 16 degrees 16 minutes east. We spotted several whales, seals, and one small penguin; it looked like a type we'd never seen before. Since passing the straits, we’ve seen several seals, but none along the whole coast of Aeheinomouwe. We took soundings both at night and in the morning but found no bottom even with 150 fathoms of line; at noon, we saw Cape Saunders bearing north half west; our latitude by observation was 46 degrees 31 minutes south.* (*The Endeavour had been blown off the land for seven days and had barely recovered its position.)

[Off South Part of Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[Off South Part of Middle Island, New Zealand.]

Monday, 5th. Most part of P.M. had a fresh breeze at North by East. Half past 1 saw Land bearing West by South, which we steer'd for; before dark we were within 3 or 4 Leagues of it, and seeing no land farther to the South we were in hopes this would prove the Southern point. At 7 shortned sail, and kept under an easy sail all night, standing to the West-South-West, having the wind at North-West, and North-North-West until 2 a.m., when it fell Calm, and soon after a breeze sprung up at South-East by South, and daylight coming on we made sail. During the whole night we saw a large fire upon the land; a certain sign of its being inhabited. At 7 the Extreams of the land bore from North 38 degrees East to West 6 minutes South, being distant from the Shore about 3 Leagues. The land appear'd of a Moderate height, and not hilly. At 1/2 past 10 o'Clock the westermost land in sight bore West 1/2 North, distant 7 Leagues; at Noon had fresh Gales at South-South-East, and thick hazey weather with rain. Our Latitude by account was 46 degrees 50 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Saunders 1 degree 56 minutes West.* (* The ship was now off the south point of the Middle Island.)

Monday, 5th. Most of the afternoon had a fresh breeze coming from North by East. At 1:30, we spotted land to the West by South, which we steered toward; before dark, we were about 3 or 4 leagues away from it, and since we saw no land further South, we hoped this was the Southern point. At 7, we shortened sail and kept an easy pace all night, heading West-South-West, with the wind at North-West and North-North-West until 2 a.m., when it became calm, and soon after a breeze picked up from South-East by South, and with daylight approaching, we set sail. Throughout the night, we saw a large fire on the land, a clear sign of habitation. At 7, the extreme points of the land ranged from North 38 degrees East to West 6 minutes South, about 3 leagues from the shore. The land appeared to be of moderate height and not hilly. At 10:30, the westernmost land in sight was at West 1/2 North, 7 leagues away; at noon, we experienced fresh gales from South-South-East, along with thick hazy weather and rain. Our latitude by account was 46 degrees 50 minutes South, and we had made 1 degree 56 minutes West in longitude since leaving Cape Saunders.* (* The ship was now off the south point of the Middle Island.)

Tuesday, 6th. P.M. Winds at South by East and South-East, and thick hazey weather until 3 o'clock, when it clear'd up, and we saw the land extending from North-East by North to North-West 1/2 North, and soon after low land, making like an Island, bearing West 1/2 South. Keeping on our Course to the West by South, we in 2 hours' time saw high land over the low, extending to the Southward as far as South-West by South; we could not see this land join to that to the Northward of us, there either being a total seperation, a deep Bay, or low land between them. At 8 o'Clock, being within 3 Leagues of the low land (which we now took to be an Island* (* Ruapuke Island.)), we Tack'd and stood to the Eastward, having the wind at South, which proved very unsettled all night; by which means, and a little bad management, I found the Ship in the morning considerably farther to the Eastward than I expected, and the wind afterwards coming to South-West and West-South-West, so that at noon we found ourselves much about the same place as we were Yesterday, our Latitude by observation being 46 degrees 50 minutes South, the land extending from North-East by East to West by North 1/2 North, the nearest part bearing North, distance 3 Leagues; the land to the South-West just in sight.

Tuesday, 6th. P.M. Winds coming from South by East and Southeast, with thick hazy weather until 3 o'clock, when it cleared up, and we could see the land stretching from Northeast by North to Northwest 1/2 North. Soon after, we spotted low land, resembling an island, bearing West 1/2 South. We continued on our course to the West by South, and in 2 hours, we saw high land behind the low land, extending to the South as far as Southwest by South. We couldn't see this land connect to the northern land; there seemed to be either a complete separation, a deep bay, or low land between them. At 8 o'clock, being within 3 leagues of the low land (which we now believed to be an island* (* Ruapuke Island.)), we tacked and headed East, with the wind from the South, which was very unstable all night. Because of this and some poor management, I found the ship in the morning considerably farther East than I expected. The wind then shifted to South-West and West-South-West, so at noon we found ourselves roughly in the same spot as yesterday, our latitude by observation being 46 degrees 50 minutes South, with the land extending from Northeast by East to West by North 1/2 North, the nearest part bearing North, 3 leagues away; the land to the Southwest just visible.

Wednesday, 7th. Light Airs in the South-West quarter. P.M. Clear weather, remainder dark and Cloudy. In the P.M. found the Variation per several Azimuths, and the Amplitude to be 15 degrees 10 minutes East, and by the Amplitude in the morning to be 15 degrees 56 minutes East. Stood to the South-East until 8 a.m., then tack'd and stood to the North-West; but it soon after fell Calm, and continued so until noon, when by our account we were in the Latitude of 47 degrees 6 minutes South, and had made 12 Miles Easting since Yesterday at Noon.

Wednesday, 7th. Light winds from the Southwest. In the afternoon, the weather was clear, but the rest of the day was dark and cloudy. In the afternoon, we checked the variation using several azimuths, and the amplitude was 15 degrees 10 minutes East, while in the morning the amplitude was 15 degrees 56 minutes East. We headed Southeast until 8 a.m., then changed course and went Northwest; however, it soon became calm and stayed that way until noon, when by our calculations we were at a latitude of 47 degrees 6 minutes South and had traveled 12 miles east since yesterday at noon.

Thursday, 8th. Light Airs next to a Calm from South-South-East to North-East, with which we kept Steering to the South-West, but made but little way because of a swell which took us right ahead. At daylight A.M. we saw, or thought we saw, from the Masthead, the land which we have left to the Northward of us joined to that to the South-West of us; and at the same time we imagined we saw the land extend to the Southward as far as South-South-West; but after steering this Course until noon we discovered our Mistake, for there was no land to be seen to the Southward of West, which Course we now steer'd, being by observation in the Latitude of 47 degrees 12 minutes; Longitude made from Cape Saunders 2 degrees 2 minutes West.

Thursday, 8th. There were light winds almost calm, blowing from the South-South-East to the North-East, which allowed us to steer to the South-West, but we made little progress due to a swell coming at us directly. At dawn, we thought we spotted land to the North that we had left behind, connected to land to the South-West. At the same time, we imagined the land extended far to the South-South-West. However, after following this course until noon, we realized our mistake, as there was no land visible to the South of West. We then changed our course to West, being at an observed latitude of 47 degrees 12 minutes and longitude of 2 degrees 2 minutes West from Cape Saunders.

[Off South Cape of New Zealand.]

[Off South Cape of New Zealand.]

Friday, 9th. P.M. Winds at North, a Gentle breeze and Clear weather. Stood to the Westward until sunset, at which time the Extreams of the land bore from North by East to West, distant about 7 or 8 Leagues; Depth of Water 55 fathoms; Variation by the Amplitude 16 degrees 29 minutes East. The wind now veer'd to the Westward, and as the weather was fine and Moonlight we kept standing close upon a Wind to the South-West all night. At 4 a.m. Sounded, and had 60 fathoms; at daylight we discover'd under our lee bow Ledges of Rocks, on which the Sea broke very high, extending from South by West to West by South, and not above 3/4 of a Mile from us; yet upon sounding we had 45 fathoms, a Rocky bottom. The wind being at North-West we could not weather the Ledge, and as I did not care to run to leeward, we tackt and made a Trip to the Eastward; but the wind soon after coming to the North enabled us to go clear of all. Our soundings in passing within the Ledge was from 35 to 47 fathoms, a rocky bottom. This Ledge lies South-East, 6 Leagues from the Southermost part of the Land, and South-East by South from some remarkable hills which stand near the Shore. These rocks are not the only dangers that lay here, for about 3 Leagues to the Northward of them is another Ledge of Rocks, laying full 3 Leagues from the land, whereon the Sea broke very high. As we passed these rocks in the night at no great distance, and discover'd the others close under our Lee at daylight, it is apparent that we had a very fortunate Escape. I have named them the Traps, because they lay as such to catch unweary Strangers.* (* The dangerous Traps lie south and east of the South Island of New Zealand. The Endeavour had now at last got to the southward of the land. There is a small but high rock farther south, the Snares, that Cook did not sight this voyage.) At Noon our Latitude per observation was 47 degrees 26 minutes South; Longitude made from Cape Saunders 3 degrees 4 minutes West, the land in sight--which has very much the appearance of an Island* (* South or Stewart Island.)--extending North-East by North to North-West by West, distant from the Shore about 4 or 5 Leagues; the Eastermost ledge of rocks bore South-South-East, distant 1 1/2 Leagues; and Northermost North-East 1/2 East, 3 Leagues. This land is of a moderate height, and has a very barren Aspect; not a Tree to be seen upon it, only a few Small Shrubs. There were several white patches, on which the sun's rays reflected very strongly, which I take to be a kind of Marble such as we have seen in many places of this Country, particularly to the Northward.

Friday, 9th. P.M. Winds from the North, a gentle breeze and clear skies. We sailed westward until sunset, at which point the extremes of the land were visible from North by East to West, about 7 or 8 leagues away; depth of water was 55 fathoms; the variation according to the amplitude was 16 degrees 29 minutes East. The wind then shifted to the West, and since the weather was fine and there was moonlight, we continued sailing close to the wind towards the South-West all night. At 4 a.m., we took soundings and found 60 fathoms; at daylight, we saw ledges of rocks close to our bow where the sea was breaking very high, extending from South by West to West by South, not more than 3/4 of a mile away; yet on sounding, we found 45 fathoms of rocky bottom. With the wind from the North-West, we couldn’t get past the ledge, and not wanting to sail downwind, we tacked and made a trip eastward; however, the wind soon shifted to the North, allowing us to navigate clear of everything. Our soundings while passing inside the ledge ranged from 35 to 47 fathoms, again on a rocky bottom. This ledge lies South-East, 6 leagues from the southernmost part of the land, and South-East by South from some distinctive hills near the shore. These rocks aren’t the only dangers in the area, as there’s another ledge of rocks about 3 leagues to the North, lying 3 leagues offshore where the sea also breaks very high. As we passed these rocks during the night at a safe distance and spotted the others close to us at daylight, it’s clear that we had a very lucky escape. I named them the Traps because they lie there to ensnare unsuspecting travelers. (* The dangerous Traps lie south and east of the South Island of New Zealand. The Endeavour had now finally passed south of the land. There’s a small but tall rock further south, the Snares, that Cook did not see on this voyage.) At noon, our latitude by observation was 47 degrees 26 minutes South; longitude made from Cape Saunders was 3 degrees 4 minutes West, with land in sight—which looks very much like an island (* South or Stewart Island.)—extending from North-East by North to North-West by West, about 4 or 5 leagues from shore; the easternmost ledge of rocks was at South-South-East, 1.5 leagues away; and the northernmost at North-East 1/2 East, 3 leagues away. This land is of moderate height and appears very barren; not a tree in sight, just a few small shrubs. There were several white patches reflecting the sun's rays strongly, which I believe to be a type of marble similar to what we’ve seen in many places in this country, especially to the north.

Saturday, 10th. P.M. Moderate breezes at North-West by North and North with which we stood close upon a Wind to the Westward. At sunset the Southermost point of land, which I afterwards named South Cape,* (* South Cape is the southern point of Stewart Island. Cook's position for it is wonderfully exact.) and which lies in the Latitude of 47 degrees 19 minutes South, Longitude 192 degrees 12 minutes West from Greenwich, bore North 38 degrees East, distant 4 Leagues, and the Westermost land in sight bore North 2 degrees East. This last was a small Island, lying off the point of the Main.* (* Long Island, which lies, with others, on the west side of Stewart Island.) I began now to think that this was the Southermost land, and that we should be able to get round it by the West, for we have had a large hollow swell from the South-West ever since we had the last gale of wind from that Quarter, which makes one think there is no land in that direction. In the Night it began to blow, so that at or before daylight we were brought under our 2 Courses; but at 8 a.m. it fell moderate, and we set the Topsails close Reeft, and the Mizn and Mizn Staysail being split, we unbent them and bent others. At Noon, the wind Coming at West, we Tackt and stood to the Northward, having no land in sight; our Latitude by observation was 47 degrees 33 minutes South, Longitude West from the South Cape 0 degrees 59 minutes.

Saturday, 10th. P.M. There were moderate breezes coming from the North-West by North and North, allowing us to sail close to the wind towards the West. At sunset, the southernmost point of land, which I later named South Cape,* (* South Cape is the southern point of Stewart Island. Cook's position for it is remarkably accurate.) and which is located at Latitude 47 degrees 19 minutes South, Longitude 192 degrees 12 minutes West from Greenwich, was at North 38 degrees East, about 4 leagues away. The westernmost land in sight was at North 2 degrees East. This was a small island near the mainland.* (* Long Island, which is among others on the west side of Stewart Island.) I started to think that this was the southernmost land, and that we could get around it to the west since we had been experiencing a large, gentle swell from the South-West ever since the last strong winds from that direction, leading me to believe there was no land that way. During the night, the wind picked up, so by daybreak, we had to get our sails down to two courses; but by 8 a.m., it calmed down, and we set the topsails closely reefed. With the mainsail and mainsail staysail torn, we took them down and replaced them. At noon, as the wind shifted to the west, we tacked and headed north, with no land in sight. Our latitude by observation was 47 degrees 33 minutes South, longitude west from South Cape was 0 degrees 59 minutes.

Sunday, 11th. Winds between the West and North-West, a fresh Gale, and Clear weather. Stood away North-North-East close upon a wind without seeing any land until 2 A.M., when we discover'd an Island bearing North-West by North, distant 4 or 5 Leagues. Two hours after this we saw the Land ahead, upon which we Tackt and stood off until 6 o'Clock; then stood in, in order to take a nearer View of it. At 11, being about 3 Leagues from the land, and the wind seem'd to incline on Shore, we Tackt and stood off to the Southward. And now we thought that the land to the Southward, or that we have been sailing round these 2 days past, was an Island, because there appeared an Open Channell between the North part of that land and the South part of the other in which we thought we saw the Small Island we were in with the 6th Instant; but when I came to lay this land down upon paper from the several bearings I had taken, it appeared that there was but little reason to suppose it an Island. On the contrary, I hardly have a doubt but what it joins to, and makes a part of, the Mainland,* (* Cook was deceived, as Stewart is an island.) the Western extremity of which bore at Noon North 59 degrees West, and the Island seen in the Morning* (* This was called by Cook Solander Island.) South 59 degrees West, distant 5 Leagues. Latitude observed 46 degrees 24 minutes South, Longitude 192 degrees 49 minutes West. It is nothing but a barren rock of about a Mile in Circuit, remarkably high, and lies full 5 Leagues from the Main. The shore of the Main lies nearest East by South and West by North, and forms a large open bay, in which there is no appearance of a Harbour or other place of safety for shipping against South-West and Southerly winds. The face of the Country bears a very rugged Aspect, being full of high craggy hills, on the Summits of which were several patches of Snow. However, the land is not wholy barren; we could see wood, not only in the Valleys, but on several of the Hills; but we saw no signs of inhabitants.

Sunday, 11th. Winds between the West and North-West, a fresh gale, and clear weather. We headed North-North-East, sailing close to the wind without sighting any land until 2 A.M., when we spotted an island to the North-West, about 4 or 5 leagues away. Two hours later, we saw land ahead, and we tacked and moved away until 6 o'clock; then we moved in to get a closer look. At 11, being about 3 leagues from the land and noticing the wind seemed to shift toward the shore, we tacked and headed south. We now thought that the land to the south, which we had been sailing around for the last two days, was an island, as there appeared to be an open channel between the northern part of that land and the southern part of the other where we thought we had seen the small island we visited on the 6th. However, when I plotted this land on paper based on the different bearings I took, it seemed there was little reason to consider it an island. On the contrary, I have little doubt that it connects to and is part of the mainland. The western tip of that land was at noon North 59 degrees West, and the island seen in the morning was South 59 degrees West, 5 leagues away. The latitude recorded was 46 degrees 24 minutes South, longitude 192 degrees 49 minutes West. It is just a barren rock about a mile around, quite high, and lies 5 leagues from the mainland. The shore of the mainland is closest to East by South and West by North, forming a large open bay, which shows no sign of a harbor or safe place for ships against south-west and southerly winds. The landscape looks very rugged, filled with tall, craggy hills, with several patches of snow on the summits. However, the land isn't completely barren; we could see trees not only in the valleys but also on several hills, but we found no signs of inhabitants.

Monday, 12th. Fresh Gales between the West and North-West; latter part squally, with rain. Stood to the South-West by South until 11 a.m., at which time the wind shifted to the South-West by West. We wore, and stood to the North-North-West, being then in the Latitude of 47 degrees 40 minutes South, and Longitude 193 degrees 50 minutes West, having a Hollow Sea from the South-West.

Monday, 12th. Strong winds from the West and North-West; becoming squally later, with rain. We headed South-West by South until 11 a.m., when the wind changed to South-West by West. We changed course and headed North-North-West, finding ourselves at a latitude of 47 degrees 40 minutes South and a longitude of 193 degrees 50 minutes West, with a choppy sea coming from the South-West.

Tuesday, 13th. Strong Gale between the South-West by West and South-South-West, with a large Hollow sea from the same Quarter. In the P.M. had frequent Squalls, with Showers of rain; in the night had several very heavy squalls, attended with Showers of Hail, which obliged us to take in our Topsails. During the night steer'd North-North-West until 6 a.m., when, seeing no land, we steer'd North by East, and set the Main Topsail, single reeft. At 8 set the Foretopsail, single reeft, and loosed all the Reefs out of the Maintopsail, and Steer'd North-East by East 1/2 East in order to make the land. At 10 saw it bearing East-North-East, and appeared to be very high; but, being hazey over it, we could see nothing distinct neither now nor at Noon, when, by Observation, we were in the Latitude of 46 degrees 0 minutes South. Course and distance Sailed since Yesterday North 5 degrees West, 96 Miles. Longitude made from the South Cape 1 degree 40 minutes West.

Tuesday, the 13th. Strong winds between South-West by West and South-South-West, with big waves coming from the same direction. In the afternoon, we had frequent gusts along with rain showers; during the night, we experienced several very heavy squalls with hail showers that forced us to take in our topsails. Through the night, we steered North-North-West until 6 a.m., when, seeing no land, we changed course to North by East and raised the Main Topsail, single-reefed. At 8, we set the Foretopsail, single-reefed, and loosened all the reefs in the Maintopsail, steering North-East by East 1/2 East to reach land. At 10, we spotted land bearing East-North-East, which looked quite high; however, it was hazy, so we couldn’t make out any details, both now and at noon, when we observed that we were at a latitude of 46 degrees 0 minutes South. Since yesterday, we’ve traveled North 5 degrees West for 96 miles. Longitude recorded from the South Cape is 1 degree 40 minutes West.

[Off the New Zealand Sounds.]

[Off the New Zealand coast.]

Wednesday, 14th. In the P.M. had a fresh Gale from the Southward, attended with Squalls. At 2 it Clear'd up over the land, which appeared high and Mountainous. At 1/2 past 3 double reeft the Topsails, and hauld in for a Bay, wherein their appear'd to be good Anchorage, and into which I had thought of going with the Ship; but after standing in an hour, we found the distance too great to run before dark, and it blow'd too hard to attempt it in the night, or even to keep to Windward; for these reasons we gave it up, and bore away along shore. This bay I have named Dusky Bay. It lies in the Latitude of 45 degrees 47 minutes South; it is about 3 or 4 Miles broad at the Entrance, and seems to be full as deep. In it are several Islands, behind which there must be Shelter from all winds, provided there is a Sufficient Depth of Water.* (* Dusky Bay is one of the remarkable inlets known now as the New Zealand Sounds. They are very deep, narrow fiords, running into the high mountains, that here come close to the shore, and are much visited now for the sake of the grandeur of the scenery. Cook visited and surveyed Dusky Bay in his next voyage. The Endeavour had nearly as much tempestuous weather in rounding the south end of New Zealand as she had off the North Cape; but Cook managed to get a very fair idea of the coast, notwithstanding, by dint of perseverance.) The North point of this bay, when it bears South-East by South, is very remarkable, there being off it 5 high peaked rocks, standing up like the 4 fingers and thumb of a Man's hand; on which account I have named it Point Five Fingers. The land of this point is farther remarkable by being the only Level land near it, and extends near 2 Leagues to the Northward. It is pretty high, wholy cover'd with wood, and hath very much the Appearance of an Island, by its aspect being so very different from the Land behind it, which is nothing but barren rocky Mountains. At Sunset the Southermost Land in sight bore due South, distant 5 or 6 Leagues; and as this is the Westermost point of land upon the whole Coast I have called it West Cape. It lies about 3 Leagues to the Southward of the bay above-mentioned, in the Latitude of 45 degrees 54 minutes South, and Longitude 193 degrees 17 minutes West. The land of this Cape seems to be of a moderate height next the Sea, and hath Nothing remarkable about it that we could see, Except a very White Clift 2 or 3 Leagues to the Southward of it. The land to the Southward of Cape West trends away towards the South-East; to the Northward of it it Trends North-North-East and North-East. At 7 o'Clock brought the Ship too under the Foresail, with her head off Shore, having a fresh Gale at South by East. At Midnight it moderated, and we wore and lay her head in shore until 4 a.m.; then made Sail, and Steer'd along shore North-East 1/2 North, having a moderate breeze at South-South-East. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude 45 degrees 13 minutes South; Course and distance sailed since Yesterday North 41 degrees East, 62 Miles; Longitude made from Cape West 0 degrees 29 minutes East, being at this time about 1 1/2 Leagues from Shore. Sounded, and had no ground with 70 fathoms Line. A little before Noon we passed a little Narrow opening in the land, where there appear'd to be a very Snug Harbour,* (* Doubtful Sound, another of the fiords mentioned in note above.) form'd by an Island, in the Latitude of 45 degrees 16 minutes South; inland, behind this Opening, were Mountains, the summits of which were Cover'd with Snow that seem'd to have fallen lately, and this is not to be wondered at, for we have found it very cold for these 2 days past. The land on each side the Entrance of this Harbour riseth almost perpendicular from the Sea to a very considerable Height; and this was the reason why I did not attempt to go in with the Ship, because I saw clearly that no winds could blow there but what was right in or right out, that is, Westerly or Easterly; and it certainly would have been highly imprudent in me to have put into a place where we could not have got out but with a wind that we have lately found to blow but one day in a Month. I mention this because there was some on board that wanted me to harbour at any rate, without in the least Considering either the present or future Consequences.

Wednesday, 14th. In the afternoon, there was a strong gale coming from the south, with squalls. By 2 PM, it cleared up over the land, which looked high and mountainous. At 3:30, we double-reefed the topsails and headed for a bay that seemed to have good anchorage, which I had considered entering with the ship; however, after navigating for an hour, we realized the distance was too far to cover before dark, and it was blowing too hard to attempt it at night, or even maintain our position against the wind. For these reasons, we decided to abandon our plan and continued along the shore. I named this bay Dusky Bay. It is located at a latitude of 45 degrees 47 minutes south, about 3 to 4 miles wide at the entrance, and appears to be quite deep. There are several islands within it that likely provide shelter from all winds, assuming there’s enough water depth.* (* Dusky Bay is one of the notable inlets now known as the New Zealand Sounds. They are very deep, narrow fjords that reach into the high mountains, which come very close to the shore, and are popular today for their breathtaking scenery. Cook visited and mapped Dusky Bay on his next voyage. The Endeavour faced nearly as much rough weather rounding the southern end of New Zealand as it did off the North Cape; however, Cook managed to gain a good understanding of the coast through determination.) The northern point of this bay, when viewed from the southeast by south, is very distinctive, as there are five high, peaked rocks off of it, resembling a human hand with four fingers and a thumb; for this reason, I've named it Point Five Fingers. The land at this point is notable for being the only flat area nearby, stretching nearly 2 leagues to the north. It is fairly high, completely covered in forest, and appears island-like due to its striking contrast with the surrounding barren rocky mountains. At sunset, the southernmost land in sight was due south, about 5 or 6 leagues away; since this marks the westernmost point of land along the entire coast, I've called it West Cape. It lies about 3 leagues south of the previously mentioned bay, at a latitude of 45 degrees 54 minutes south and a longitude of 193 degrees 17 minutes west. The land at this cape seems to be moderately elevated next to the sea, and there’s nothing remarkable about it visible except for a very white cliff located 2 or 3 leagues to the south. The land to the south of Cape West trends southeastward; to the north of it, it trends northeast and north-northeast. At 7 o'clock, we brought the ship to a stop under the foresail, with her head pointed offshore, as a fresh gale came from the south-southeast. By midnight, the wind had calmed, so we turned and kept her head pointed toward the shore until 4 AM; then we set sail and steered along the shore north-east by north, with a mild breeze from the south-southeast. At noon, we were by observation at a latitude of 45 degrees 13 minutes south; our course and distance traveled since yesterday was north 41 degrees east, 62 miles; our longitude made from Cape West was 0 degrees 29 minutes east, placing us about 1.5 leagues offshore. We sounded the depth and found no ground at 70 fathoms. Just before noon, we passed a narrow opening in the land that appeared to lead to a snug harbor,* (* Doubtful Sound, another of the fjords mentioned above.) created by an island, at a latitude of 45 degrees 16 minutes south; behind this opening, there were mountains with snow-covered summits that seemed to have fallen recently, which isn't surprising, as it has been quite cold for the past two days. The land on either side of the harbor entrance rises almost straight up from the sea to a significant height; this is why I didn’t try to enter with the ship, as I clearly saw that the winds could only blow directly in or out, that is, either westerly or easterly; it would have been very unwise for me to enter a place where we could only escape with a wind that, as we've found, only blows one day a month. I mention this because there were some on board who insisted I should dock there regardless, without considering either the immediate or future consequences.

Thursday, 15th. Clear weather, Winds at South-West and South-West by South, a Gentle breeze, except in the night, when we had variable light Airs and Calm. In the evening, being about 2 Leagues from the land, we sounded, but had no ground with 103 fathoms. Variation per Azimuth 14 degrees East, per Amplitude 15 degrees 2 minutes East. With what wind we had we made the best of our way along shore to the North-East, keeping at the distance of 2 or 3 Leagues off from the Land. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 44 degrees 47 minutes, having run only 12 Leagues upon a North-East 1/4 North Course since Yesterday at Noon; Longitude made from Cape West 1 degree 3 minutes East.

Thursday, 15th. Clear weather, with winds from the South-West and South-West by South, a gentle breeze, except at night when we had variable light airs and calm. In the evening, being about 2 leagues from land, we checked the depth but found no bottom at 103 fathoms. Variation by Azimuth was 14 degrees East, and by Amplitude, it was 15 degrees 2 minutes East. With the wind we had, we made our way along the shore to the North-East, keeping 2 to 3 leagues off from the land. At noon, we were at a latitude of 44 degrees 47 minutes, having traveled only 12 leagues on a North-East 1/4 North course since yesterday at noon; longitude from Cape West was 1 degree 3 minutes East.

Friday, 16th. Winds at South-West; a fresh breeze and Clear. Steer'd along shore North-East 1/4 East until 6 p.m., when we Shortned Sail, and brought too for the Night. Variation per Azimuth 13 degrees 48 minutes East. At 4 A.M. made sail, and Stood in for the land. At daylight saw the appearance of an inlet into the land; but upon a nearer approach found that it was only a deep Valley, bounded on each side by high lands, upon which we bore away North-East 1/4 East along shore, keeping about 4 or 5 miles off. At Noon the Northermost point of land in sight bore North 60 degrees East, distant 10 Miles; Latitude per Observation 44 degrees 5 minutes; Longitude made from Cape West 2 degrees 8 minutes East.

Friday, 16th. Winds from the Southwest; a fresh breeze and clear skies. We steered along the shore to the Northeast 1/4 East until 6 p.m., when we shortened sail and anchored for the night. Variation per azimuth was 13 degrees 48 minutes East. At 4 A.M., we set sail and headed toward the land. At dawn, we noticed what looked like an inlet into the land; however, upon getting closer, we discovered it was just a deep valley surrounded by highlands. We then changed course to Northeast 1/4 East along the shore, keeping about 4 to 5 miles off. At noon, the northernmost point of land in sight was at North 60 degrees East, 10 miles away; latitude by observation was 44 degrees 5 minutes; longitude calculated from Cape West was 2 degrees 8 minutes East.

Saturday, 17th. Continued our Course along shore, having in the P.M. the advantage of a fresh Gale at South-West. At 2, past by the point afore-mentioned, which is of a Moderate height, with deep Red Clifts, down which falls 4 Small streams of Water, on which account it is named Cascades Point. Latitude 44 degrees 0 minutes South; Longitude 2 degrees 20 minutes East from Cape West. From this point the land at first Trends North 76 degrees East, but afterwards more to the Northward East-North-East, 8 Leagues. From this point and near the Shore lies a small low Island, which bore from us South by East, distant 1 1/2 Leagues. At 7 o'Clock we Shortned sail, and brought too under the Topsails, with her head off Shore, having 33 fathoms, and fine sandy bottom. At 10, had 50 fathoms, and at 12, wore in 65 fathoms, having drove about 5 Miles North-North-West since we brought too. Two hours after this had no ground with 140 fathoms; which shews that the soundings extend but a little way from the land. From 2 to 8 a.m. had it Calm and hazey, with drizzling rain, at which time a breeze sprung up at South-West, with which we steer'd along shore North-East by East 1/4 East, keeping about 3 Leagues from the land. At Noon had no Observation, being Hazey with rain. Our run since Yesterday at Noon is North-East by East, 55 Miles; Longitude from Cape West 3 degrees 12 minutes East.

Saturday, 17th. We continued our course along the shore, taking advantage of a fresh breeze coming from the Southwest in the afternoon. At 2, we passed by the previously mentioned point, which is of moderate height, with deep red cliffs, down which flow four small streams of water, hence its name, Cascades Point. Latitude 44 degrees 0 minutes South; Longitude 2 degrees 20 minutes East from Cape West. From this point, the land first trends North 76 degrees East, but then shifts more to the East-North-East, covering 8 leagues. Near the shore lies a small low island, which is located from us at South by East, 1.5 leagues away. At 7 o'clock, we shortened sail and came to a stop under the topsails, with the ship facing away from shore, in 33 fathoms of sandy bottom. At 10, we measured 50 fathoms, and at midnight, we veered in 65 fathoms, having drifted about 5 miles North-North-West since coming to a stop. Two hours later, we found no bottom at 140 fathoms, indicating that the soundings extend only a short distance from land. From 2 to 8 a.m., it was calm and hazy, with drizzling rain, when a breeze picked up from the Southwest, allowing us to steer along the shore North-East by East 1/4 East, keeping about 3 leagues from the land. At noon, we had no observation due to the hazy rain. Our course since yesterday at noon has been North-East by East for 55 miles; Longitude from Cape West is 3 degrees 12 minutes East.

[Off West Coast of Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[Off the West Coast of Middle Island, New Zealand.]

Sunday, 18th. In the P.M. had a fresh breeze at South-West by West, attended with drizzling rain. At 8, being about 3 Leagues from the land, shortned sail, and brought too, having run 10 Leagues North-East by East since noon; at this time had 44 fathoms, and 2 hours before had 17 fathoms, fine sandy bottom, being then about 1 League from the land. Had it Calm the most part of the Night, and until 10 a.m., when a light breeze sprung up at South-West by West. We Made sail along shore North-East by North, having a large swell from the West-South-West, which had risen in the Night. At Noon Latitude in per Observation 43 degrees 4 minutes South; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday is North 54 degrees East, 54 Miles; Longitude made from Cape West 4 degrees 12 minutes East. The Mountains and some of the Vallies we observed this morning were wholy cover'd with Snow, part of which we suppos'd to have fallen in the P.M. and fore part of the Night, at the time that we had rain--and yet the weather is not Cold.* (* They did not see Mount Cook, 12,300 feet high, and the highest mountain in New Zealand; no doubt the summit was in the clouds.)

Sunday, 18th. In the afternoon, we had a fresh breeze from the South-West by West, accompanied by light rain. At 8, being about 3 leagues from the shore, we reduced sail and stopped, having traveled 10 leagues North-East by East since noon; at that point, we were in 44 fathoms of water, while 2 hours earlier, we had been in 17 fathoms with a fine sandy bottom, about 1 league from land. The night was mostly calm until 10 a.m. when a light breeze picked up from the South-West by West. We set sail along the shore North-East by North, facing a large swell from the West-South-West that had built up overnight. At noon, our latitude by observation was 43 degrees 4 minutes South; our course and distance sailed since yesterday was North 54 degrees East, 54 miles; longitude made from Cape West was 4 degrees 12 minutes East. The mountains and some valleys we observed this morning were completely covered with snow, part of which we believe fell in the afternoon and early night when we had rain—and yet the weather isn't cold. (* They did not see Mount Cook, 12,300 feet high, the tallest mountain in New Zealand; undoubtedly, the summit was shrouded in clouds.)

Monday, 19th. In the P.M. had a fresh breeze at South-West by West and West-South-West, which we made the most of until 6, when we shortned sail, and at 10 brought too, and sounded 115 fathoms, judging ourselves to be about 5 Leagues from the land. At midnight it fell little wind, on which account we made sail. At 8 a.m. the wind veer'd to the North-West by North, with which we stood to the North-East close upon a wind until noon, at which time we Tack'd, being about 3 Leagues from the land, and by Observation in the Latitude of 42 degrees 8 minutes and Longitude from Cape West 5 degrees 5 minutes East* (* The Endeavour had passed the mouth of the Grey River, the district of the great coalfields of New Zealand.) Course and distance run since Yesterday at Noon North 35 degrees East, 68 Miles; Depth of Water 65 fathoms, the land extending from North-East by North to South-South-West.

Monday, 19th. In the afternoon, we had a fresh breeze coming from the South-West by West and West-South-West, which we took full advantage of until 6, when we reduced our sail. At 10, we stopped and sounded 115 fathoms, estimating ourselves to be about 5 leagues from land. At midnight, the wind died down a bit, so we set sail again. By 8 a.m., the wind shifted to the North-West by North, and we headed North-East, sailing close to the wind until noon, at which point we tacked, being about 3 leagues from land. Based on our observations, we were at a latitude of 42 degrees 8 minutes and a longitude of 5 degrees 5 minutes East from Cape West (*The Endeavour had passed the mouth of the Grey River, the area of the large coalfields of New Zealand).* The course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon was North 35 degrees East, 68 miles; the depth of water was 65 fathoms, with land extending from North-East by North to South-South-West.

Tuesday, 20th. Fresh Gales at North-West by North and North by West. P.M. fair weather; the remainder hazey, with rain, and Squall, which brought us under close Reeft Topsails. Stood to the Westward until 2 a.m., when we made a Trip to the Eastward, and afterwards stood to the Westward until Noon, when, by our reckoning, we were in the Latitude of 42 degrees 23 minutes South. Course and distance sail'd South 74 degrees West, 54 Miles; Longitude made from Cape West 5 degrees 55 minutes East. Tack'd and stood to the Eastward.

Tuesday, 20th. Strong winds from Northwest by North and North by West. In the afternoon, it was clear; the rest of the day was hazy, with rain and a squall that forced us to furl the topsails. We headed west until 2 a.m., then took a trip eastward, and afterward continued west until noon. According to our calculations, we were at a latitude of 42 degrees 23 minutes South. We sailed a course of South 74 degrees West for 54 miles; our longitude from Cape West was 5 degrees 55 minutes East. We tacked and headed east.

Wednesday, 21st. In the P.M. had a fresh Gale at North by West, attended with rain until 6, when the Wind shifted to South and South-South-West, and continued to blow a fresh Gale, with which we steer'd North-East by North until 6 A.M., at which time we haul'd in East by North in order to make the land which we saw soon after. At Noon our Latitude per Account was 41 degrees 37 minutes, and Longitude from Cape West 5 degrees 42 minutes East; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday North 60 degrees East, 92 miles. At this time we were not above 3 or 4 Leagues from the land, but being very foggy upon it we could see nothing distinct, and as we had not much wind, and a prodigious swell rowling in upon the Shore from the West-South-West, I did not think it safe to go nearer.

Wednesday, 21st. In the afternoon, we had a strong wind coming from the North by West, with rain until 6 PM, when the wind changed to South and South-South-West. It continued to blow strongly as we headed North-East by North until 6 AM. At that point, we turned East by North to reach the land we spotted shortly after. At noon, our latitude was 41 degrees 37 minutes, and our longitude from Cape West was 5 degrees 42 minutes East; we had sailed a course of North 60 degrees East for 92 miles since yesterday. At this point, we were only about 3 or 4 leagues from the land, but it was very foggy, so we couldn’t see anything clearly. Since we didn't have much wind and there was a huge swell rolling in from the West-South-West, I didn't think it was safe to get any closer.

Thursday, 22nd. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze from the South-South-West, with which we steer'd along shore North-East until 8, when being about 2 or 3 Leagues from shore we sounded, and had 34 fathoms, upon which we haul'd off North-West by North until 11, then brought too, having at this time 64 fathoms. At 4 a.m. made sail to the North-East, wind at South-South-West, a light breeze. At 8 the wind veer'd to the Westward, and soon after fell Calm; at this time we were about 3 or 4 Miles from the Shore, and in 54 fathoms, having a large swell from the West-South-West rowling Obliquely upon the Shore, which put me under a good deal of Apprehension that we should be obliged to Anchor; but by the help of a light Air now and then from the South-West quarter we were Enabled to keep the Ship from driving much nearer the shore. At Noon the Northermost land in sight bore North-East by East 1/4 East, distant 8 or 10 Leagues; our Latitude by account was 40 degrees 55 minutes South, Longitude from Cape West 6 degrees 35 minutes East; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon North 36 degrees East, 42 Miles; very foggy over the Land.

Thursday, 22nd. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze coming from the south-southwest, which allowed us to sail along the shore toward the northeast until 8 PM, when we were about 2 or 3 leagues from the shore. We measured the depth and found 34 fathoms, after which we changed course and headed northwest by north until 11 PM, stopping as we had 64 fathoms at that time. At 4 AM, we set sail again to the northeast, with a light breeze from the south-southwest. By 8 AM, the wind shifted to the west, and shortly after, it went calm. At this point, we were about 3 or 4 miles from the shore and in 54 fathoms, experiencing a large swell from the west-southwest rolling obliquely toward the shore, which made me quite anxious that we might have to anchor. However, with occasional light winds from the southwest, we managed to prevent the ship from drifting much closer to the shore. By noon, the furthest visible land was bearing northeast by east 1/4 east, about 8 or 10 leagues away; our calculated latitude was 40 degrees 55 minutes south, and our longitude from Cape West was 6 degrees 35 minutes east. Since yesterday at noon, we had sailed a course of north 36 degrees east for 42 miles, and it was very foggy over the land.

[Off Cape Farewell, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[Off Cape Farewell, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

Friday, 23rd. Light Airs from the Southward, at intervals Calm, the fore part hazey, the remainder clear, pleasant weather. At Noon our Latitude, by observation, 40 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds South, Longitude from Cape West 6 degrees 52 minutes East; the Eastermost point of Land in sight* (* Cape Farewell, the north point of the Middle Island.) bore East 10 degrees North, distant 7 Leagues, and a bluff head or point we were abreast of yesterday at Noon, off which lay some rocks above Water, bore South 18 degrees West, distant 6 Leagues. This point I have named Rocks Point, Latitude 40 degrees 55 minutes South. Having now nearly run down the whole of this North-West Coast of Tovy Poenammu, it is time I should describe the face of the Country as it hath at different times appeared to us. I have mentioned on the 11th Instant, at which time we were off the Southern part of the Island, that the land seen then was rugged and mountainous; and there is great reason to believe that the same ridge of Mountains extends nearly the whole length of the Island from between the Westermost Land seen that day and the Eastermost seen on the 13th. There is a space of about 6 or 8 Leagues of the sea Coast unexplored, but the Mountains inland were Visible enough. The land near the Shore about Cape West is rather low, and riseth with a gradual assent up to the foot of the Mountains, and appear'd to be mostly covered with wood. From Point Five Fingers down to the Latitude of 44 degrees 20 minutes there is a narrow ridge of Hills rising directly from the Sea, which are Cloathed with wood; close behind these hills lies the ridge of Mountains, which are of a Prodidgious height, and appear to consist of nothing but barren rocks, covered in many places with large patches of Snow, which perhaps have lain there since the Creation. No country upon Earth can appear with a more rugged and barren Aspect than this doth; from the Sea for as far inland as the Eye can reach nothing is to be seen but the Summits of these rocky Mountains, which seem to lay so near one another as not to admit any Vallies between them. From the Latitude of 44 degrees 20 minutes to the Latitude 42 degrees 8 minutes these mountains lay farther inland; the Country between them and the Sea consists of woody Hills and Vallies of Various extent, both for height and Depth, and hath much the Appearance of Fertility. Many of the Vallies are large, low, and flatt, and appeared to be wholy covered with Wood; but it is very probable that great part of the land is taken up in Lakes, Ponds, etc., as is very common in such like places. From the last mentioned Latitude to Cape Farewell, afterwards so Called, the land is not distinguished by anything remarkable; it rises into hills directly from the Sea, and is covered with wood. While we were upon this part of the Coast the weather was foggy, in so much that we could see but a very little way inland; however, we sometimes saw the Summits of the Mountains above the fogg and Clouds, which plainly shew'd that the inland parts were high and Mountainous, and gave me great reason to think that there is a Continued Chain of Mountains from the one End of the Island to the other.* (* This is, to a great extent, the case.)

Friday, 23rd. Light winds from the south, with calm periods; the front part was hazy, while the rest was clear and pleasant. At noon, our latitude, based on observation, was 40 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds South, and our longitude from Cape West was 6 degrees 52 minutes East. The easternmost point of land in sight, Cape Farewell (the northern point of the Middle Island), was positioned 10 degrees north of east, about 7 leagues away. The bluff head we were level with yesterday at noon, near some rocks above water, was 18 degrees south, 6 leagues away. I have named this point Rocks Point, Latitude 40 degrees 55 minutes South. Having nearly traveled down the entire northwest coast of Tovy Poenammu, it's time I describe the landscape as it has appeared to us at different times. On the 11th, when we were off the southern part of the island, I noted that the land we saw was rugged and mountainous; it seems likely that this mountain range extends nearly the entire length of the island from the westernmost land we saw that day to the easternmost seen on the 13th. There is an unexplored stretch of about 6 to 8 leagues of the sea coast, but the mountains inland were clearly visible. The land near the shore around Cape West is relatively low, gradually rising to the base of the mountains, which appeared mostly wooded. From Point Five Fingers down to Latitude 44 degrees 20 minutes, there is a narrow ridge of hills rising directly from the sea, covered in woods. Just behind these hills lies a ridge of mountains that are extremely high and seem to consist entirely of barren rocks, with many areas covered in large patches of snow that may have been there since the beginning. No country on Earth could look more rugged and barren than this; from the sea, as far inland as the eye can see, all that is visible are the summits of these rocky mountains, which seem so close together that no valleys can be seen between them. From Latitude 44 degrees 20 minutes to Latitude 42 degrees 8 minutes, these mountains recede further inland; the land between them and the sea consists of wooded hills and valleys of varying height and depth, appearing quite fertile. Many of the valleys are large, low, and flat, seemingly entirely covered in woods; however, it’s likely that much of the land is taken up by lakes, ponds, etc., as is common in such areas. From the last mentioned latitude to Cape Farewell, afterwards so named, the land isn’t distinguished by anything notable; it rises into hills directly from the sea and is covered in woods. While we were along this part of the coast, the weather was foggy, so we could only see a short distance inland; however, we occasionally caught glimpses of the mountain summits above the fog and clouds, which clearly indicated that the inland areas were high and mountainous, leading me to believe there is a continuous chain of mountains from one end of the island to the other.

Saturday, 24th. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze at South-West, which by Dark run us the length of the Eastern Point set at Noon, and not knowing what Course the land took on the other side, we brought too in 34 fathoms about one League from the land. At 8, it falling little wind, we fill'd and stood on until 12, at which time we brought too until 4 a.m., then made Sail. At daylight we saw low land extending from the above point to the East-South-East as far as the Eye could reach, the Eastern Extremity of which appear'd in round Hillocks; by this time the wind had veer'd to the Eastward, which obliged us to ply to windward. At Noon the point above mention'd bore South-West by South, distant 16 miles; Latitude observ'd 40 degrees 19 minutes South. This point I afterwards named Cape Farewell, for reasons which will be given in their proper place.

Saturday, 24th. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze coming from the southwest, which by dark helped us travel the length of the Eastern Point we noted at noon. Not knowing the course the land took on the other side, we stopped in 34 fathoms about a league from the shore. At 8, as the wind dropped, we filled our sails and continued until midnight, when we stopped again until 4 a.m., then set sail. At daybreak, we saw low land stretching from the mentioned point to the east-southeast as far as we could see, with the eastern tip appearing as round hillocks. By this time, the wind had shifted to the east, forcing us to work our way upwind. At noon, the aforementioned point was located southwest by south, 16 miles away; we recorded our latitude as 40 degrees 19 minutes south. I later named this point Cape Farewell for reasons I will explain at the appropriate time.

Sunday, 25th. Winds Easterly; towards Noon had little winds and hazey, with rain. Made several trips, but gain'd nothing to Windward, so that at Noon our Situation was nearly as Yesterday.

Sunday, the 25th. Winds from the east; around noon there was little wind and it was hazy, with rain. Made several trips, but gained nothing against the wind, so by noon our situation was nearly the same as yesterday.

Monday, 26th. At 3 p.m. the wind came to North, and we Steer'd East-South-East with all the Sail we could set until dark, when we shortned sail until the morning, having thick Misty weather. All Night we keept the lead going continually, and had from 37 to 48 fathoms. At day light we saw the land bearing South-East by East, and an Island laying near it bearing East-South-East, distant 5 Leagues. This I knew to be the Island* (* Stephens Island.) seen from the Entrance of Queen Charlotte's sound, from which it bears North-West by North, Distant 9 Leagues. At Noon it bore South-East, distant 4 or 5 miles, and the North-West head of Queen Charlotte's sound bore South-East by South, distant 10 1/2 Leagues; Latitude ohserv'd 43 degrees 33 minutes South.

Monday, 26th. At 3 p.m., the wind shifted to the North, and we steered East-South-East with all the sail we could set until dark, when we reduced our sails for the night due to thick misty weather. We kept the lead line going all night and recorded depths from 37 to 48 fathoms. At dawn, we spotted land to the South-East by East, and an island nearby bearing East-South-East, 5 leagues away. I recognized this as Island* (* Stephens Island), which we had seen from the entrance of Queen Charlotte's Sound, located to the North-West by North, 9 leagues distant. At noon, the island was to the South-East, about 4 or 5 miles away, and the North-West head of Queen Charlotte's Sound was South-East by South, 10.5 leagues away; latitude observed 43 degrees 33 minutes South.

[In Admiralty Bay, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

[In Admiralty Bay, Middle Island, New Zealand.]

Tuesday, 27th. Fresh breeze of Wind Westerly, and hazey, Misty weather, with Drizling rain. As we have now Circumnavigated the whole of this Country, it is time for me to think of quitting it; but before I do this it will be necessary to compleat our Water first, especially as we have on board above 30 Tons of Casks empty, and knowing that there is a Bay between the above-mentioned Island and Queen Charlotte's sound, wherein no doubt there is Anchorage and convenient Watering places. Accordingly, in the P.M. we hauled round the Island and into the bay,* (* Admiralty Bay.) leaving 3 more Islands* (* Rangitoto Islets.) on our Starboard hand, which lay close under the West Shore 3 or 4 Miles within the Entrance. As we run in we keept the lead going, and had from 40 to 12 fathoms. At 6 we Anchor'd in 11 fathoms, Muddy bottom, under the West Shore, in the Second Cove within the fore-mentioned Island. At daylight I took a Boat and went to look for a Watering place, and a proper birth to moor the Ship in, both of which I found convenient enough. After the Ship was moor'd I sent an Officer ashore to Superintend the Watering, and the Carpenter with his Crew to cut wood, while the Long boat was employed carrying on shore Empty Casks.

Tuesday, 27th. There was a fresh breeze from the west and hazy, misty weather, with drizzling rain. Now that we’ve circumnavigated the entire country, I need to think about leaving it; however, before I do, we need to fill up our water supply, especially since we have over 30 tons of empty casks on board. I know there’s a bay between the mentioned island and Queen Charlotte's Sound, which likely has good anchorage and convenient watering spots. So, in the afternoon, we sailed around the island and into the bay,* (* Admiralty Bay.) leaving three more islands* (* Rangitoto Islets.) to our right, which were close to the west shore, about 3 or 4 miles from the entrance. As we entered, we kept the depth sounder going and recorded depths from 40 to 12 fathoms. At 6, we anchored in 11 fathoms in muddy bottom, under the west shore, in the second cove of the aforementioned island. At daylight, I took a boat to find a watering place and a good spot to moor the ship, both of which I found easily. After the ship was moored, I sent an officer ashore to supervise the watering, along with the carpenter and his crew to cut wood, while the longboat was busy carrying empty casks ashore.

Wednesday, 28th. Winds Westerly, which in the A.M. blow'd a fresh Gale, attended with rain. Employ'd getting on board Wood and Water and fishing; in the Latter we were pretty Successfull.

Wednesday, 28th. The wind was coming from the west, blowing a strong gale in the morning and bringing rain. I spent the day loading wood and water onto the ship and fishing; we had pretty good luck with the fishing.

Thursday, 29th. In the P.M. had a Strong Gale from the Westward. A.M. Variable light Airs from the Eastward and hazey rainy weather the whole day; which, however, did not prevent us getting on board Wood and Water.

Thursday, 29th. In the afternoon, there was a strong wind coming from the west. In the morning, there were light winds from the east and hazy, rainy weather all day; however, this didn't stop us from getting wood and water on board.

Friday, 30th. Winds at South-East, a moderate breeze; the first and middle part dark, Hazey weather, with rain; the latter, fair. In the A.M., as the wind seem'd to be settled at South-East, and having nearly compleated our Water, we warped the Ship out of the Cove in order to have room to get under Sail. Before this was done it was Noon, at which time I went away in the Pinnace, in order to examine the Bay, and to Explore as much of it as the little time I had would Admit.

Friday, 30th. Winds from the South-East, a moderate breeze; the early and middle parts of the day were dark and hazy with rain; the latter part was clear. In the A.M., as the wind seemed to be steady from the South-East, and we were nearly out of water, we moved the ship out of the cove to have room to set sail. Before this was done, it was noon, and at that time, I took off in the small boat to explore the bay as much as I could in the limited time I had available.

Saturday, 31st. In the P.M., after rowing a League and a half or 2 Leagues up the Bay, I Landed upon a point of Land on the West side, where, from an Eminency, I could see this Western Arm of the Bay run in South-West by West, about 5 Leagues farther, yet did not see the Head of it. There appeared to be several other inlets, or at least small bays, between this and the North-West head of Queen Charlotte's sound, in every one of which I make no doubt but what there is Anchorage and Shelter for Shipping, as they are partly cover'd from the Sea wind by these Islands that lay without them.* (* There is a maze of inlets and harbours between Admiralty Bay and Queen Charlotte's Sound, a distance of 20 miles.) The land about this bay, at least what I could see of it, is of a very hilly, uneven Surface, and appears to be mostly cover'd with wood, Shrubs, Firns, etc., which renders Travelling both difficult and Fatiguing. I saw no inhabitants, neither have we seen any since we have been in this bay, but met with several of their Huts, all of which appear'd to have been at least 12 Months deserted.

Saturday, 31st. In the afternoon, after rowing a mile and a half to 2 miles up the Bay, I landed on a point of land on the west side, where, from a higher spot, I could see this western arm of the Bay stretching southwest for about 5 miles, but I couldn’t see where it ended. There seemed to be several other inlets, or at least smaller bays, between this and the northwest point of Queen Charlotte's Sound, where I’m sure there’s anchorage and shelter for ships, as they are partly protected from the sea winds by the islands that lie outside them.* (*There’s a network of inlets and harbors between Admiralty Bay and Queen Charlotte's Sound, covering a distance of 20 miles.) The land around this bay, at least what I could see, is very hilly and uneven, mostly covered in wood, shrubs, ferns, etc., which makes traveling both hard and tiring. I didn’t see any inhabitants, and we haven’t spotted any since we arrived in this bay, but we found several of their huts, all of which seemed to have been deserted for at least 12 months.

Upon my return to the Ship, in the Evening, I found the Water, etc., all on board, and the Ship ready for Sea; and being now resolv'd to quit this Country altogether, and to bend my thought towards returning home by such a rout as might Conduce most to the Advantage of the Service I am upon, I consulted with the Officers upon the most Eligible way of putting this in Execution. To return by the way of Cape Horn was what I most wished, because by this rout we should have been able to prove the Existance or Non-Existance of a Southern Continent, which yet remains Doubtfull; but in order to Ascertain this we must have kept in a higher Latitude in the very Depth of Winter, but the Condition of the Ship, in every respect, was not thought sufficient for such an undertaking. For the same reason the thoughts of proceeding directly to the Cape of Good Hope was laid aside, especially as no discovery of any Moment could be hoped for in that rout. It was therefore resolved to return by way of the East Indies by the following rout: upon Leaving this Coast to steer to the Westward until we fall in with the East Coast of New Holland, and then to follow the direction of that Coast to the Northward, or what other direction it might take us, until we arrive at its Northern extremity; and if this should be found impracticable, then to Endeavour to fall in with the Land or Islands discovered by Quiros.* (* Quiros, a Spanish navigator, discovered in 1605 Espiritu Santo, the northern island of the New Hebrides, which he supposed to be a part of a great southern continent. Cook, in his second voyage, thoroughly explored the New Hebrides group; and for some of the islands his charts are still the only guide.)

When I got back to the ship in the evening, I found all the supplies on board and the ship ready to set sail. Now determined to leave this country for good and focused on finding the best way to get home that would benefit my mission, I consulted with the officers about the most effective way to do this. I really wanted to return via Cape Horn because that route would allow us to investigate whether a southern continent exists, which is still in question. However, to confirm this, we would have needed to stay in higher latitudes during the depths of winter, and the ship’s condition wasn’t deemed good enough for that kind of journey. For the same reasons, we also dropped the idea of heading directly to the Cape of Good Hope, especially since no significant discoveries could be expected on that path. So, we decided to return via the East Indies by the following route: after leaving this coast, we would head west until we reached the east coast of New Holland, then follow that coast northward or in whatever direction it took us until we reached its northern tip. If that turned out to be unfeasible, we would try to make contact with the land or islands discovered by Quiros. (* Quiros, a Spanish navigator, discovered Espiritu Santo in 1605, the northern island of the New Hebrides, which he thought was part of a vast southern continent. Cook thoroughly explored the New Hebrides group during his second voyage, and for some of the islands, his charts remain the only reference.)

With this view, at daylight we got under Sail and put to Sea, having the Advantage of a fresh Gale at South-East and Clear weather. At Noon the Island, which lies off the North-West point of the Bay, bore East 9 degrees South, distant 10 Miles; our Latitude, by Observation, was 40 degrees 35 minutes South. This bay I have named Admiralty Bay; the North-West point Cape Stephens, and the East Point Jackson, after the 2 Secretarys.* (* The two secretaries of the Admiralty, Philip Stephens and George Jackson, both of whom showed great appreciation of Cook.) It may always be known by the Island above mentioned, which is pretty high, and lies North-East, 2 Miles from Cape Stephens; Latitude 40 degrees 37 minutes South; Longitude 185 degrees 6 minutes West. Between this Island and Cape Farewell, which is West by North and East by South, distant 14 or 15 Leagues from each other, the Shore forms a large deep Bay, the bottom of which we could hardly see in sailing in a Strait line from the one Cape to the other; but it is not at all improbable but what it is all lowland next the Sea, as we have met with less water here than on any other part of the Coast at the same distance from Land; however, a Bay there is, and is known on the Chart by the Name of Blind Bay, but I have reason to believe it to be Tasman's Murderers' Bay.* (* Blind Bay is now also known as Tasman Bay, and Massacre Bay is supposed to be a smaller bay in it, on the north-western side.)

With this in mind, at dawn we set sail and went to sea, benefiting from a fresh breeze from the southeast and clear weather. At noon, the island off the northwest point of the bay was in the direction of east 9 degrees south, about 10 miles away; our latitude, based on our observations, was 40 degrees 35 minutes south. I have named this bay Admiralty Bay; the northwest point is Cape Stephens, and the east point is Jackson, after the two secretaries.* (* The two secretaries of the Admiralty, Philip Stephens and George Jackson, both of whom showed great appreciation of Cook.) It can always be identified by the mentioned island, which is relatively high and lies two miles northeast of Cape Stephens; its latitude is 40 degrees 37 minutes south; longitude is 185 degrees 6 minutes west. Between this island and Cape Farewell, which is situated west by north and east by south, and is about 14 to 15 leagues apart, the shore forms a large deep bay. The bottom of the bay was hardly visible as we sailed in a straight line from one cape to the other; however, it’s quite possible that it is all lowland next to the sea, since we encountered less water here than in any other part of the coast at the same distance from land. Regardless, there is a bay here, known on the map as Blind Bay, but I have reason to believe it to be Tasman's Murderers' Bay.* (* Blind Bay is now also known as Tasman Bay, and Massacre Bay is thought to be a smaller bay in it, on the northwestern side.)

Before I quit this land altogether I shall give a short general discription of the Country, its inhabitants, their manners, Customs, etc., in which it is necessary to observe that many things are founded only on Conjecture, for we were too short a time in any one place to learn much of their interior policy, and therefore could only draw conclusions from what we saw at different times.

Before I leave this land for good, I’ll give a brief overview of the country, its people, their behavior, customs, and so on. It’s important to note that many of these observations are based on speculation since we didn’t spend enough time in any one place to really understand their internal policies. As a result, we can only draw conclusions from what we observed at various times.

[Description of New Zealand.]

[Description of New Zealand.]

SOME ACCOUNT OF NEW ZEALAND.

A Brief Overview of New Zealand.

Part of the East* (* This should be West Coast.) Coast of this Country was first discovered by Abel Tasman in 1642, and by him called New Zeland; he, however, never landed upon it; probably he was discouraged from it by the Natives killing 3 or 4 of his People at the first and only place he Anchor'd at. This country, which before now was thought to be a part of the imaginary Southern Continent, consists of 2 large Islands, divided from each other by a Strait or Passage of 4 or 5 Leagues broad. They are situated between the Latitude of 34 and 48 degrees South, and between the Longitude of 181 and 194 degrees West from the Meridian of Greenwich. The situation of few parts of the world are better determin'd than these Islands are, being settled by some hundreds of Observations of the Sun and Moon, and one of the Transit of Mercury made by Mr. Green, who was sent out by the Royal Society to observe the Transit of Venus.

Part of the East* (* This should be West Coast.) Coast of this country was first discovered by Abel Tasman in 1642, and he named it New Zealand; however, he never actually landed there. He was probably discouraged after the Natives killed 3 or 4 of his crew at the first and only place he anchored. This country, which was previously believed to be part of the imaginary Southern Continent, consists of 2 large islands, separated by a strait about 4 or 5 leagues wide. They are located between the latitudes of 34 and 48 degrees South, and the longitudes of 181 and 194 degrees West from the Greenwich Meridian. Few locations in the world are better mapped than these islands, which have been confirmed by hundreds of observations of the Sun and Moon, including one of the Transit of Mercury made by Mr. Green, who was sent out by the Royal Society to observe the Transit of Venus.

The Northermost of these Islands, as I have before observed, is called by the Natives Aeheinomouwe and the Southermost Tovy Poenammu. The former name, we were well assured, comprehends the whole of the Northern Island; but we were not so well satisfied with the latter whether it comprehended the whole of the Southern Islands or only a part of it. This last, according to the Natives of Queen Charlotte's Sound, ought to consist of 2 Islands, one of which at least we were to have sail'd round in a few days; but this was not verify'd by our own Observations. I am inclinable to think that they know'd no more of this land than what came within the Limits of their sight.* (* As before remarked, the natives at Queen Charlotte's Sound doubtless were speaking of the large peninsula and the islands which lie west of the Sound. There is a spot at the isthmus where canoes could be hauled over.) The Chart* (* See copy of this chart.) which I have drawn will best point out the figure and Extent of these Islands, the situation of the Bays and Harbours they contain, and the lesser Islands lay about them.

The northernmost of these islands, as I’ve mentioned before, is called by the locals Aeheinomouwe, while the southernmost one is Tovy Poenammu. We were quite sure that the former name refers to the entire Northern Island, but we weren't as confident about the latter—whether it refers to the whole Southern Islands or just part of it. According to the locals from Queen Charlotte's Sound, this area should consist of two islands, one of which we were supposed to sail around in a few days; however, we couldn't confirm this with our own observations. I suspect that they didn’t know much about this land beyond what they could see. (*As previously noted, the locals at Queen Charlotte's Sound were likely referring to the large peninsula and the islands to the west of the Sound. There is a spot at the isthmus where canoes can be carried over.) The chart* (*See copy of this chart.) I’ve created will best illustrate the shape and size of these islands, the locations of the bays and harbors they contain, and the smaller islands surrounding them.

And now I have mentioned the Chart, I shall point out such places as are drawn with sufficient accuracy to be depended upon and such as are not, beginning at Cape Pallisser and proceed round Aeheinomouwe by the East Cape, etc. The Coast between these 2 Capes I believe to be laid down pretty accurate, both in its figure and the Course and distance from point to point; the opportunities I had and the methods I made use on to obtain these requisites were such as could hardly admit of an Error. From the East Cape to Cape Maria Van Diemen, altho' it cannot be perfectly true, yet it is without any very Material error; some few places, however, must be excepted, and these are very Doubtfull, and are not only here, but in every other part of the Chart pointed out by a Pricked or broken line. From Cape Maria Van Diemen up as high as the Latitude of 36 degrees 15 minutes we seldom were nearer the Shore than from 5 to 8 Leagues, and therefore the line of the Sea Coast may in some places be erroneous. From the above Latitude to nearly the Length of Entry Island we run along and near the shore all the way, and no circumstance occurd that made me liable to commit any Material error. Excepting Cape Teerawhitte, we never came near the Shore between Entry Island and Cape Pallisser, and therefore this part of the coast may be found to differ something from the truth; in Short, I believe that this Island will never be found to differ Materially from the figure I have given it, and that the Coast Affords few or no Harbours but what are either taken notice of in this Journal, or in some Measure pointed out in the Chart; but I cannot say so much for Tovy Poenammu. The Season of the Year and Circumstance of the Voyage would not permit me to spend so much time about this Island as I had done at the other, and the blowing weather we frequently met with made it both dangerous and difficult to keep upon the Coast. However, I shall point out the places that may be Erroneous in this as I have done in the other. From Queen Charlotte's sound to Cape Campbell, and as far to the South-West as the Latitude 43 degrees, will be found to be pretty Accurate; between this Latitude and the Latitude 44 degrees 20 minutes the coast is very Doubtfully laid down, a part of which we hardly, if at all, saw. From this last mentioned Latitude to Cape Saunders we were generally at too great a distance to be Particular, and the weather at the same time was unfavourable. The Coast, as it is laid down from Cape Saunders to Cape South, and even to Cape West, is no doubt in many places very erroneous, as we hardly were ever able to keep near the Shore, and were sometimes blown off altogether. From the West Cape down to Cape Farewell, and even to Queen Charlotte's sound, will in most places be found to differ not much from the truth.* (* Cook's open and plain statement as to the comparative accuracy of different parts of his chart is much to be commended. It has been too much the fashion with first explorers to leave such matters to be discovered by the student. But the astonishing accuracy of his outline of New Zealand must be the admiration of all who understand the difficulties of laying down a coast; and when it is considered that this coastline is 2400 miles in extent, the magnitude of the task will be realised by everybody. Never has a coast been so well laid down by a first explorer, and it must have required unceasing vigilance and continual observation, in fair weather and foul, to arrive at such a satisfactory conclusion; and with such a dull sailer as the Endeavour was, the six and a half months occupied in the work must be counted as a short interval in which to do it.)

And now that I've mentioned the Chart, I want to highlight the areas that are accurately represented and those that aren’t, starting at Cape Pallisser and going around Aeheinomouwe by the East Cape, etc. I believe the coastline between these two capes is laid out quite accurately, both in shape and in the course and distance from point to point; the opportunities I had and the methods I used to gather this information were so reliable that there’s hardly room for error. From the East Cape to Cape Maria Van Diemen, while it may not be perfectly accurate, it doesn't contain any major errors; however, there are a few spots that are questionable, indicated by a dotted or broken line, and this applies here as well as in other parts of the Chart. From Cape Maria Van Diemen up to about 36 degrees 15 minutes latitude, we were rarely closer to the shore than 5 to 8 leagues, so the sea coastline may be incorrect in some areas. From that latitude to nearly the length of Entry Island, we traveled along and close to the shore the entire way, and nothing happened that would lead me to make significant mistakes. Except for Cape Teerawhitte, we didn’t come near the shoreline between Entry Island and Cape Pallisser, so this section of the coast might not be entirely accurate; overall, I believe this island will likely match the shape I’ve given it, and the coast offers few or no harbors except those mentioned in this journal or somewhat indicated in the Chart; however, I can’t say the same for Tovy Poenammu. The time of year and the conditions of the voyage didn’t allow me to spend as much time on this island as I did on the others, and the rough weather we often encountered made it both risky and challenging to stay close to the coast. Nonetheless, I’ll point out the areas that might be incorrect in this part just as I have done in the others. From Queen Charlotte's Sound to Cape Campbell, and as far southwest as 43 degrees latitude, the mapping is pretty accurate; however, between this latitude and 44 degrees 20 minutes, the coastline is very uncertain, part of which we hardly saw at all. From this last latitude to Cape Saunders, we were usually too far away to be specific, and the weather was not favorable at the same time. The coast, as represented from Cape Saunders to Cape South, and even to Cape West, is undoubtedly wrong in many places, as we rarely managed to stay close to the shore and were sometimes blown off entirely. From the West Cape down to Cape Farewell, and even to Queen Charlotte's Sound, it will generally be found to closely match the truth.

[Animals, Timber, etc., New Zealand.]

[Animals, Timber, etc., New Zealand.]

Mention is likewise made in the Chart of the appearance or aspect of the face of the Country. With respect to Tovy Poenammu, it is for the most part very Mountainous, and to all appearance a barren Country. The people in Queen Charlotte's sound--those that came off to us from under the Snowy Mountain, and the five we saw to the South-West of Cape Saunders--were all the inhabitants, or Signs of inhabitants, we saw upon the whole Island; but most part of the Sea Coast of Aeheinomouwe, except the South-West side, is well inhabited; and although it is a hilly, Mountainous Country, yet the very Hills and Mountains are many of them cover'd with wood, and the Soil of the plains and Valleys appear'd to be very rich and fertile, and such as we had an opportunity to examine we found to be so, and not very much incumber'd with woods.

The Chart also mentions the look of the country's landscape. In terms of Tovy Poenammu, it's mostly very mountainous and seems to be a barren land. The people in Queen Charlotte's Sound—those who came to us from under the Snowy Mountain, and the five we saw to the southwest of Cape Saunders—were the only inhabitants, or signs of inhabitants, we encountered on the whole island. However, most of the coastline of Aeheinomouwe, except the southwest side, is well-populated. Even though it's a hilly, mountainous area, many of the hills and mountains are covered in trees, and the soil in the plains and valleys looks very rich and fertile. When we examined it, we found it indeed to be fertile and not overly cluttered with woods.

It was the Opinion of every body on board that all sorts of European grain, fruit, Plants, etc., would thrive here; in short, was this Country settled by an industrious people they would very soon be supplied not only with the necessaries, but many of the Luxuries, of Life. The Sea, Bays, and Rivers abound with a great Variety of Excellent Fish, the most of them unknown in England, besides Lobsters, which were allowed by every one to be the best they ever had eat. Oysters and many other sorts of shell fish all Excellent in their kind. Sea and Water Fowls of all sorts are, however, in no great plenty; those known in Europe are Ducks, Shags, Gannets, and Gulls, all of which were Eat by us, and found exceeding good; indeed, hardly anything came Amiss to us that could be Eat by Man. Land fowl are likewise in no great plenty, and all of them, except Quails, are, I believe, unknown in Europe; these are exactly like those we have in England. The Country is certainly destitute of all sorts of beasts, either wild or tame, except dogs and Rats; the former are tame, and lived with the people, who breed and bring them up for no other purpose than to Eat, and rats are so scarce that not only I, but many others in the Ship, never see one. Altho' we have seen some few Seals, and once a Sea Lion upon this Coast, yet I believe they are not only very scarce,* (* There are a good many seals round the southern part of New Zealand, and a regular fishery is now established on Stewart Island. Cook saw nothing of the few natives that occupied the southern parts of the Island.) but seldom or ever come ashore; for if they did the Natives would certainly find out some Method of Killing them, the Skins of which they no doubt would preserve for Cloathing, as well as the Skins of Dogs and birds, the only Skins we ever saw among them. But they must sometimes get Whales, because many of the Patta Pattoas are made of the bones of some such fish, and an Ornament they wear at their breast (on which they set great Value), which are supposed to be made of the Tooth of a Whale; and yet we know of no method or instrument they have to kill these Animals.

Everyone on board agreed that various European grains, fruits, plants, and more would thrive here. In short, if this country were settled by hardworking people, they would soon have access not only to necessities but also many luxuries of life. The sea, bays, and rivers are filled with a wide variety of excellent fish, most of which are unknown in England, along with lobsters, which everyone agreed were the best they had ever eaten. Oysters and many other types of shellfish were all great in their own way. However, sea and waterfowl are not very plentiful; those recognized in Europe include ducks, shags, gannets, and gulls, all of which we ate and found extremely good; indeed, hardly anything that could be eaten by humans went to waste. Land fowl are also scarce, and all of them, except quails, are, as far as I know, unknown in Europe; the quails are just like those in England. The country is certainly lacking in all types of animals, both wild and tame, except for dogs and rats; the former are domesticated and live with the people, who raise them solely for food, and rats are so rare that not only I but many others on the ship have never seen one. Although we spotted a few seals and once saw a sea lion on this coast, I believe they are not only very scarce but seldom come ashore; if they did, the natives would certainly find a way to kill them, as they would undoubtedly preserve their skins for clothing, along with the skins of dogs and birds, which are the only skins we ever saw among them. However, they must sometimes catch whales since many of the patta pattoas are made from the bones of such fish, and they wear an ornament on their breasts (which they value highly) that is thought to be made from a whale's tooth; yet, we know of no method or instrument they have to hunt these animals.

In the woods are plenty of Excellent Timber, fit for all purposes except Ships' Masts; and perhaps upon a Close Examination some might be found not improper for that purpose. There grows spontainously everywhere a kind of very broad-bladed grass, like flags of the Nature of Hemp,* (* The New Zealand flax (Phormium Tenax) is now a considerable article of commerce. It furnishes a very strong fibre, and is made into rope, etc.) of which might be made the very best of Cordage and Canvas, etc. There are 2 sorts, one finer than the other; of these the Natives make Cloth, rope, Lines, netts, etc. Iron Ore is undoubtedly to be found here, particularly about Mercury Bays, where we found great quantities of Iron sand; however, we met with no Ore of any Sort, neither did we ever see any sort of Metal with the Natives. We met with some stones at Admiralty Bay that appear'd to be Mineral in some degree, but Dr. Solander was of Opinion that they contain'd no Sort of Metal* (* Gold and coal have been found in New Zealand in large quantities. Gold at Otago and Hokatika in the South Island, and at Thames in the North. The coalfields round the Grey River are enormous, and have no doubt a great future; and this useful mineral is also found in the Bay of Islands, and other places in the North Island. Other metals, as copper, silver, antimony, have also been found and worked.) The white stone we saw near the South Cape and some other parts to the Southward, which I took to be a kind of Marble, such as I had seen on one of the Hills I was upon in Mercury Bay, Mr. Banks--I afterwards found--was of Opinion that they were Mineral to the highest degree; he is certainly a much better Judge of these things than I am, and therefore I might be mistaken in my opinion, which was only founded on what I had before seen not only in this Country, but in other parts where I have been; and at the same time I must observe we were not less than 6 or 8 Leagues from the Land, and nearer it was not possible for us at that time to come without running the Ship into Apparent Danger. However, I am no Judge how far Mineral can be distinguished as such; certain it is that in Southern parts of this Country there are whole Mountains of Nothing Else but stone, some of which, no doubt, may be found to contain Metal.

In the woods, there's plenty of excellent timber suitable for everything except ship masts; and with a close look, some might actually be usable for that too. Everywhere, there's a type of broad-bladed grass that resembles hemp. (*The New Zealand flax (Phormium Tenax) is now a significant commercial product. It provides a very strong fiber, suitable for making rope, etc.) This grass could be used to create top-quality cordage, canvas, etc. There are two varieties, one finer than the other; the locals use these to make cloth, rope, lines, nets, etc. Iron ore can definitely be found here, especially around Mercury Bay, where we discovered large amounts of iron sand; however, we didn't come across any ore of any kind, nor did we ever see any metals with the locals. We found some stones at Admiralty Bay that seemed to be somewhat mineral, but Dr. Solander believed they contained no metals. (*Gold and coal have been found in large quantities in New Zealand. Gold at Otago and Hokatika in the South Island, and at Thames in the North. The coalfields around the Grey River are massive and likely have a great future; this useful mineral is also found in the Bay of Islands and other areas in the North Island. Other metals, like copper, silver, and antimony, have also been discovered and extracted.) The white stone we saw near the South Cape and some other parts to the south, which I thought was a type of marble—like what I had seen on a hill in Mercury Bay—was later assessed by Mr. Banks, who believed they were highly mineralized. He is certainly more knowledgeable about these matters than I am, so I might have been wrong in my assessment, which was only based on what I had seen not just in this country but also in other places I have visited. Furthermore, I must point out that we were at least 6 to 8 leagues from the land, and it wasn't safe for us to get closer without risking the ship's safety. However, I'm not an expert on how mineral content can be identified. What is certain is that in the southern parts of this country, there are entire mountains made of nothing but stone, some of which may contain metal.

Should it ever become an object of settling this Country, the best place for the first fixing of a Colony would be either in the River Thames or the Bay of Islands; for at either of these places they would have the advantage of a good Harbour, and by means of the former an Easy Communication would be had, and settlements might be extended into the inland parts of the Country. For a very little trouble and Expence small Vessels might be built in the River proper for the Navigation thereof. It is too much for me to assert how little water a Vessel ought to draw to Navigate this River, even so far up as I was in the Boat; this depends intirely upon the Depth of Water that is upon the bar or flat that lay before the narrow part of the River, which I had not an opportunity of making myself acquainted with, but I am of Opinion that a Vessel that draws not above 10 or 12 feet may do it with Ease. So far as I have been able to Judge of the Genius of these people it does not appear to me to be at all difficult for Strangers to form a settlement in this Country; they seem to be too much divided among themselves to unite in opposing, by which means, and kind and Gentle usage, the Colonists would be able to form strong parties among them.

If it ever becomes a goal to settle this country, the best spot to establish a colony would be either in the River Thames or the Bay of Islands. At either location, there would be the benefit of a good harbor, and the former would allow for easy communication, enabling settlements to expand into the inland areas of the country. With minimal effort and cost, small vessels could be built in the river for navigation. I can’t say for sure how little water a vessel needs to navigate this river, even as far up as I was in the boat; that really depends on the depth of water over the bar or flat that lies in front of the river's narrow part, which I didn’t get a chance to look into. However, I believe a vessel that draws no more than 10 or 12 feet should manage it easily. From what I’ve been able to observe about the character of these people, it doesn’t seem difficult for newcomers to establish a settlement here; they appear to be too divided among themselves to come together to oppose it. With kind and gentle treatment, the colonists would be able to form strong alliances among them.

The Natives of this Country are a Strong, rawboned, well made, Active People, rather above than under the common size, especially the Men; they are of a very dark brown colour, with black hair, thin black beards, and white teeth, and such as do not disfigure their faces by tattowing, etc., have in general very good features. The Men generally were their Hair long, Coomb'd up, and tied upon the Crown of their Heads; some of the women were it long and loose upon their Shoulders, old women especially; others again were it crop'd short. Their coombs are made some of bones, and others of Wood; they sometimes Wear them as an Ornament stuck upright in their Hair. They seem to enjoy a good state of Health, and many of them live to a good old Age.* (* The Maoris were remarkable for longevity, and for health and strength in old age.) Many of the old and some of the Middle aged Men have their faces mark'd or tattow'd with black, and some few we have seen who have had their buttocks, thighs, and other parts of their bodies marked, but this is less common. The figures they mostly use are spirals, drawn and connected together with great nicety and judgement. They are so exact in the application of these Figures that no difference can be found between the one side of the face and the other, if the whole is marked, for some have only one side, and some a little on both sides; hardly any but the old Men have the whole tattow'd. From this I conclude that it takes up some time, perhaps Years, to finish the Operation, which all Who have begun may not have perseverance enough to go through, as the manner in which it must be done must certainly cause intollerable pain, and may be the reason why so few are Marked at all--at least I know no other. The Women inlay the Colour of Black under the skins of their lips, and both sexes paint their faces and bodies at times more or less with red Oker, mixed with fish Oil.

The natives of this country are strong, lean, well-built, and active people, generally taller than average, especially the men. They have a very dark brown skin tone, black hair, thin black beards, and white teeth, and those who do not disfigure their faces with tattoos generally have good features. The men typically wear their hair long, styled up, and tied on top of their heads; some of the women wear their hair long and loose over their shoulders, especially the older women; whereas others have it cut short. Their combs are made from bones and wood; they sometimes wear them as decorations stuck upright in their hair. They seem to be in good health, and many live to an old age. Many of the older and some middle-aged men have their faces marked or tattooed with black, and a few of them have tattoos on their buttocks, thighs, and other parts of their bodies, but that's less common. The designs they mostly use are spirals, drawn and connected with great precision and care. They are so exact in applying these designs that you can't tell the difference between one side of the face and the other if the whole face is tattooed; some only have one side done, and others have a little on both sides; hardly any but the old men are fully tattooed. From this, I conclude that it takes time, perhaps years, to finish the process, and not everyone who starts has the perseverance to complete it, as the method certainly causes unbearable pain, which may explain why so few are tattooed at all—at least that’s all I can think of. The women insert black coloring under their lip skin, and both genders occasionally paint their faces and bodies with red ochre mixed with fish oil.

[Clothing of New Zealanders.]

New Zealand clothing.

Their common Cloathing are very much like square Thrumb'd Matts, that are made of rope Yarns, to lay at the doors or passages into houses to clean ones shoes upon. These they tie round their necks, the Thrumb'd side out, and are generally large enough to cover the body as low as the knee; they are made with very little Preparation of the broad Grass plant before mentioned. Beside the Thrumb'd Matts, as I call them, they have other much finer cloathing, made of the same plant after it is bleached and prepared in such a Manner that it is as white and almost as soft as flax, but much stronger. Of this they make pieces of cloth about 5 feet long and 4 broad; these are wove some pieces close and others very open; the former are as stout as the strongest sail cloth, and not unlike it, and yet it is all work'd or made by hand with no other Instrument than a Needle or Bodkin. To one end of every piece is generally work'd a very neat border of different colours of 4 or 6 inches broad, and they very often Trim them with pieces of Dog Skin or birds' feathers. These pieces of Cloth they wear as they do the other, tying one End round their Necks with a piece of string, to one end of which is fixed a Needle or Bodkin made of Bone, by means of which they can easily fasten, or put the string through any part of the Cloth; they sometimes wear pieces of this kind of Cloth round their Middles, as well as over their Shoulders. But this is not common, especially with the Men, who hardly ever wear anything round their Middles, observing no sort of Decency in that respect; neither is it at all uncommon for them to go quite Naked without any one thing about them besides a belt round their waists, to which is generally fastened a small string, which they tye round the prepuse; in this manner I have seen hundreds of them come off to and on board the Ship, but they generally had their proper Cloathing in the boat along with them to put on if it rain'd, etc. The Women, on the other hand, always wear something round their Middle; generally a short, thrumbd Matt, which reaches as low as their Knees. Sometimes, indeed, I have seen them with only a Bunch of grass or plants before, tyed on with a piece of fine platting made of sweet-scented grass; they likewise wear a piece of cloth over their Shoulders as the Men do; this is generally of the Thrum kind. I hardly ever saw a Woman wear a piece of fine cloth. One day at Talago I saw a strong proof that the Women never appear naked, at least before strangers. Some of us hapned to land upon a small Island where several of them were Naked in the Water, gathering of Lobsters and shell fish; as soon as they saw us some of them hid themselves among the Rocks, and the rest remain'd in the Sea until they had made themselves Aprons of the Sea Weed; and even then, when they came out to us, they shew'd Manifest signs of Shame, and those who had no method of hiding their nakedness would by no means appear before us.

Their typical clothing looks a lot like square mats made of rope yarns, designed for wiping shoes at the entrance of homes. They tie these around their necks with the textured side facing out and they're usually large enough to cover the body down to the knees. These are made with minimal preparation from the broad grass plant mentioned earlier. Besides these mats, which I call thrummed mats, they have much finer clothing made from the same plant after it’s been bleached and prepared, making it as white and soft as flax, but much stronger. They create pieces of cloth about 5 feet long and 4 feet wide; some are woven tightly while others are looser. The tightly woven ones are as sturdy as heavy sailcloth and look similar, yet they are all crafted by hand using only a needle or bodkin. Each piece usually has a neat border of different colors about 4 to 6 inches wide, and they often trim them with pieces of dog skin or bird feathers. They wear these cloth pieces like the mats, tying one end around their necks with a string that has a bone needle or bodkin attached, making it easy to secure or thread the string through any part of the cloth; sometimes they wrap these pieces around their waists as well as over their shoulders. However, this is not common, especially among men, who rarely wear anything around their waists and show little modesty in that regard; it's not unusual to see them completely naked except for a belt around their waists, to which a small string is usually tied around their foreskin. I've seen hundreds of them come on and off the ship like this, but they typically have their clothing in the boat to put on in case it rains, etc. Women, on the other hand, always wear something around their waists, usually a short thrummed mat that reaches their knees. Sometimes I've seen them with just a bunch of grass or plants tied on with a piece of fine plaiting made from sweet-smelling grass; they also wear a piece of cloth over their shoulders, like the men do, which is usually made of the thrummed kind. I’ve rarely seen a woman wear a piece of fine cloth. One day at Talago, I witnessed clear evidence that women don't appear naked, at least not in front of strangers. Some of us happened to land on a small island where several women were naked in the water, collecting lobsters and shellfish; as soon as they saw us, some hid among the rocks while the rest stayed in the water until they made aprons from seaweed. Even then, when they came out to us, they showed obvious signs of shame, and those who had no way to cover their nakedness refused to appear before us.

The Women have all very soft Voices, and may by that alone be known from the Men. The Making of cloth and all other Domestick work is, I believe, wholy done by them, and the more Labourious work, such as building Boats, Houses, Tilling the ground, etc., by the Men. Both men and women wear ornaments at their Ears and about their Necks; these are made of stone, bone, Shells, etc., and are variously shaped; and some I have seen wear human Teeth and finger Nails, and I think we were told that they did belong to their deceased friends. The Men, when they are dressed, generally wear 2 or 3 long white feathers stuck upright in their Hair, and at Queen Charlotte's sound many, both men and women, wore Round Caps made of black feathers.

The women all have very soft voices, which sets them apart from the men. I believe that making cloth and all other domestic tasks is completely done by them, while the more labor-intensive work, like building boats, houses, and farming, is done by the men. Both men and women wear ornaments in their ears and around their necks; these are made of stone, bone, shells, and other materials, coming in various shapes. Some I’ve seen even wear human teeth and fingernails, and I think we were told that these belonged to their deceased loved ones. When dressed up, the men usually wear two or three long white feathers sticking up in their hair, and many, both men and women, wore round caps made of black feathers during Queen Charlotte's visit.

[War Practices of New Zealanders.]

[New Zealanders' War Practices.]

The old men are much respected by the younger, who seem to be govern'd and directed by them on most Occasions. We at first thought that they were united under one head or Chief, whose Name is Teeratu; we first heard of him in Poverty Bay, and he was own'd as Chief by every one we met with from Cape Kidnappers to the Northward and Westward as far as the Bay of Plenty, which is a great extent of territories for an Indian Prince. When we were upon the East Coast they always pointed inland to the Westward for the place of his residence, which I believe to be in the Bay of Plenty, and that those Hippas or fortified Towns are Barrier Towns either for or against him; but most likely the former, and if so, may be the utmost Extent of his Dominions to the Westwards, for at Mercury bay they did not own him as their Prince, nor no where else either to the Westward or Southward, or any other single person; for at whatever place we put in at, or whatever people we spoke with upon the Coast, they generally told us that those that were at a little distance from them were their Enemies; from which it appear'd to me that they were very much divided into Parties, which make war one with another, and all their Actions and behaviour towards us tended to prove that they are a brave, open, war-like people, and void of Treachery.

The older men are highly respected by the younger generation, who seem to look to them for guidance on most occasions. At first, we thought they were united under one leader, Chief Teeratu. We first heard of him in Poverty Bay, and everyone we met from Cape Kidnappers to the north and west, as far as the Bay of Plenty, recognized him as their chief, which is quite a large territory for a tribal leader. When we were on the East Coast, they consistently pointed westward inland as his home. I believe this is in the Bay of Plenty, and that the fortified towns, or Hippas, serve as a defense either for him or against him; most likely the former. If that’s the case, it could mark the farthest extent of his territory to the west because in Mercury Bay, they did not recognize him as their leader, nor did anyone else to the west, south, or any other single person. At every place we visited or with every group we spoke to along the coast, they generally indicated that those living nearby were their enemies. It seemed to me they were significantly divided into factions that warred against one another. All their actions and interactions with us suggested they are a courageous and straightforward, warlike people, free from deceit.

Whenever we were Visited by any number of them that had never heard or seen anything of us before they generally came off in the largest Canoe they had, some of which will carry 60, 80, or 100 people. They always brought their best Cloaths along with them, which they put on as soon as they came near the Ship. In each Canoe were generally an old Man, in some 2 or 3; these used always to direct the others, were better Cloathed, and generally carried a Halbard or Battle Axe in their hands, or some such like thing that distinguished them from the others. As soon as they came within about a Stone's throw of the Ship they would there lay, and call out, "Haromoi harenta a patoo ago!" that is, "Come here, come ashore with us, and we will kill you with our patoo patoos!" and at the same time would shake them at us. At times they would dance the War dance, and other times they would trade with and talk to us, and Answer such Questions as were put to them with all the Calmness imaginable, and then again begin the War Dance, shaking their Paddles, Patoo patoos, etc., and make strange contortions at the same time. As soon as they had worked themselves up to a proper pitch they would begin to attack us with Stones and darts, and oblige us, wether we would or no, to fire upon them. Musquetry they never regarded unless they felt the Effect; but great Guns they did, because they threw stones farther than they could Comprehend. After they found that our Arms were so much superior to theirs, and that we took no advantage of that superiority, and a little time given them to reflect upon it, they ever after were our very good friends; and we never had an instance of their attempting to surprize or cut off any of our people when they were ashore; opportunity for so doing they must have had at one time or another.

Whenever visitors came to us for the first time, they usually arrived in their largest canoe, which could hold 60, 80, or even 100 people. They always brought their best clothes, putting them on as soon as they got close to the ship. Each canoe typically had an older man, sometimes two or three, who would direct the others. These leaders were dressed better and usually carried a halberd or a battle axe, which set them apart. As soon as they were about a stone's throw from the ship, they would stop and shout, "Haromoi harenta a patoo ago!" meaning, "Come here, come ashore with us, and we will kill you with our patoo patoos!" while shaking their weapons at us. Sometimes they would perform a war dance, and at other times, they would trade and talk with us, answering our questions with remarkable calmness before jumping back into their war dance, waving their paddles and patoo patoos, making strange movements at the same time. Once they built up enough energy, they would start throwing stones and darts at us, forcing us, whether we wanted to or not, to fire back. They didn’t pay much attention to muskets unless they felt the impact, but they respected the big guns because they could throw stones farther than they could understand. After they realized our weapons were far superior and that we didn’t take advantage of that, they became our good friends. We never had any incidents where they tried to surprise or attack our people when they were on land, even though they must have had the chance at some point.

It is hard to account for what we have every where been told, of their Eating their Enemies killed in Battle, which they most Certainly do; Circumstances enough we have seen to Convince us of the Truth of this. Tupia, who holds this Custom in great aversion, hath very often Argued with them against it, but they have always as streniously supported it, and never would own that it was wrong. It is reasonable to suppose that men with whom this custom is found, seldom, if ever, give Quarter to those they overcome in battle; and if so, they must fight desperately to the very last. A strong proof of this supposition we had from the People of Queen Charlotte's sound, who told us, but a few days before we Arrived that they had kill'd and Eat a whole boat's crew. Surely a single boat's crew, or at least a part of them, when they found themselves beset and overpowered by numbers would have surrender'd themselves prisoners was such a thing practised among them. The heads of these unfortunate people they preserved as Trophies; 4 or 5 of them they brought off to shew to us, one of which Mr. Banks bought, or rather forced them to sell, for they parted with it with the utmost reluctancy, and afterwards would not so much as let us see one more for any thing we could offer them.

It's hard to explain what we've always been told about them eating their enemies killed in battle, which they definitely do. We've seen enough evidence to convince us of this. Tupia, who strongly dislikes this practice, has often argued against it, but they have always vigorously defended it and never admitted it was wrong. It's reasonable to think that people with this custom rarely, if ever, show mercy to those they defeat in battle; if that's the case, they must fight desperately until the very end. A strong piece of evidence for this idea came from the people of Queen Charlotte's Sound, who told us just a few days before we arrived that they had killed and eaten an entire boat's crew. Surely a single boat crew, or at least part of them, would have surrendered if that was an option among them. They preserved the heads of these unfortunate individuals as trophies; they brought about 4 or 5 of them to show us, one of which Mr. Banks bought, or rather forced them to sell, because they let it go with great reluctance, and afterward wouldn’t even let us see another one no matter what we offered.

In the Article of Food these People have no great Variety; Fern roots, Dogs, Fish, and wild fowl is their Chief diet, for Cocos, Yams, and Sweet Potatoes is not Cultivated every where. They dress their Victuals in the same Manner as the people in the South Sea Islands; that is, dogs and Large fish they bake in a hole in the ground, and small fish, birds, and Shell fish, etc., they broil on the fire. Fern roots they likewise heat over the fire, then beat them out flat upon a stone with a wooden Mallet; after this they are fit for Eating, in the doing of which they suck out the Moist and Glutinous part, and Spit out the Fibrous parts. These ferns are much like, if not the same as, the mountain ferns in England.

In the article about food, these people don't have a wide variety. Their main diet consists of fern roots, dogs, fish, and wild birds, since coconuts, yams, and sweet potatoes aren't grown everywhere. They cook their food in the same way as people in the South Sea Islands; that is, they bake dogs and large fish in a hole in the ground, while they grill small fish, birds, shellfish, and so on over the fire. They also heat fern roots over the fire, then pound them flat on a stone with a wooden mallet; after that, they're ready to eat. When they do eat them, they suck out the moist and sticky part and spit out the fibrous bits. These ferns are very similar to, if not the same as, the mountain ferns in England.

They catch fish with Seans, Hooks and line, but more commonly with hooped netts very ingeniously made; in the middle of these they tie the bait, such as Sea Ears, fish Gutts, etc., then sink the Nett to the bottom with a stone; after it lays there a little time they haul it Gently up, and hardly ever without fish, and very often a large quantity. All their netts are made of the broad Grass plant before mentioned; generally with no other preparation than by Splitting the blade of the plant into threads. Their fish hooks are made of Crooked pieces of Wood, bones, and Shells.

They catch fish using seans, hooks, and line, but more often with cleverly crafted hoop nets. They tie bait, like sea ears and fish guts, in the middle of these nets and then sink them to the bottom with a stone. After leaving the net there for a short while, they gently pull it up, almost always without fail, and often retrieve a large quantity of fish. All their nets are made from the broad grass plant mentioned earlier, usually with minimal preparation, just by splitting the blade of the plant into threads. Their fish hooks are made from bent pieces of wood, bones, and shells.

WAR CANOE OF NEW ZEALAND.

 

[New Zealand Canoes, Houses, etc.]

[New Zealand Canoes, Homes, etc.]

The people shew great ingenuity and good workmanship in the building and framing their boats or Canoes. They are long and Narrow, and shaped very much like a New England Whale boat. Their large Canoes are, I believe, built wholy for war, and will carry from 40 to 80 or 100 Men with their Arms, etc. I shall give the Dimensions of one which I measured that lay ashore at Tolago. Length 68 1/2 feet, breadth 5 feet, and Depths 3 1/2, the bottom sharp, inclining to a wedge, and was made of 3 pieces hollow'd out to about 2 Inches or an Inch and a half thick, and well fastned together with strong platting. Each side consisted of one Plank only, which was 63 feet long and 10 or 12 Inches broad, and about 1 1/4 Inch thick, and these were well fitted and lashed to the bottom part. There were a number of Thwarts laid a Cross and Lashed to each Gunwale as a strengthening to the boat. The head Ornament projected 5 or 6 feet without the body of the Boat, and was 4 feet high; the Stern Ornament was 14 feet high, about 2 feet broad, and about 1 1/2 inch thick; it was fixed upon the Stern of the Canoe like the Stern post of a Ship upon her Keel. The Ornaments of both head and Stern and the 2 side boards were of Carved Work, and, in my opinion, neither ill design'd nor executed. All their Canoes are built after this plan, and few are less than 20 feet long. Some of the small ones we have seen with Outriggers, but this is not Common. In their War Canoes they generally have a quantity of Birds' feathers hung in Strings, and tied about the Head and stern as Additional Ornament. They are as various in the heads of their Canoes as we are in those of our Shipping; but what is most Common is an odd Design'd Figure of a man, with as ugly a face as can be conceived, a very large Tongue sticking out of his Mouth, and Large white Eyes made of the Shells of Sea Ears. Their paddles are small, light, and neatly made; they hardly ever make use of sails, at least that we saw, and those they have are but ill contrived, being generally a piece of netting spread between 2 poles, which serve for both Masts and Yards.

The people show great creativity and skill in building and framing their boats or canoes. They are long and narrow, shaped very much like a New England whale boat. Their large canoes are, I believe, built entirely for war and can carry 40 to 80 or even 100 men with their weapons, etc. I’ll give the dimensions of one I measured that was onshore at Tolago: Length 68.5 feet, width 5 feet, and depth 3.5 feet, with a sharp, wedge-like bottom, made from three pieces hollowed out to about 2 inches or an inch and a half thick, and securely fastened together with strong lashing. Each side consists of just one plank, which is 63 feet long and 10 or 12 inches wide and about 1.25 inches thick; these were well fitted and lashed to the bottom portion. There were several thwarts laid across and lashed to each gunwale for added strength. The head ornament extended 5 or 6 feet beyond the body of the boat and was 4 feet high; the stern ornament was 14 feet high, about 2 feet wide, and about 1.5 inches thick; it was fixed to the back of the canoe like the stern post of a ship on its keel. The ornaments on both the head and the stern, along with the two sideboards, were carved decorations, and, in my opinion, neither poorly designed nor executed. All their canoes are built according to this plan, and few are shorter than 20 feet long. Some of the smaller ones we've seen have outriggers, but this is uncommon. In their war canoes, they generally have strings of bird feathers hung about the head and stern as extra decoration. The designs at the front of their canoes are as varied as ours on our ships; however, the most common is a strangely designed figure of a man, with as ugly a face as you can imagine, a very large tongue sticking out of his mouth, and large white eyes made from sea ear shells. Their paddles are small, light, and well-made; they hardly ever use sails, at least not that we saw, and the ones they have are poorly constructed, usually just a piece of netting spread between two poles, serving as both masts and yards.

The Houses of these People are better calculated for a Cold than a Hot Climate; they are built low, and in the form of an oblong square. The framing is of wood or small sticks, and the sides and Covering of thatch made of long Grass. The door is generally at one end, and no bigger than to admit of a man to Creep in and out; just within the door is the fire place, and over the door, or on one side, is a small hole to let out the Smoke. These houses are 20 or 30 feet long, others not above half as long; this depends upon the largeness of the Family they are to contain, for I believe few familys are without such a House as these, altho' they do not always live in them, especially in the summer season, when many of them live dispers'd up and down in little Temporary Hutts, that are not sufficient to shelter them from the weather.

The houses of these people are better suited for a cold climate than a hot one; they're built low and shaped like an elongated square. The frame is made of wood or small sticks, and the walls and roof are covered with thatch made from long grass. The door is usually at one end and is just big enough for a person to squeeze in and out; just inside the door is the fireplace, and above the door or to one side, there's a small hole to let the smoke out. These houses are 20 to 30 feet long, while others are less than half that length; this depends on the size of the family they are meant to accommodate, as I believe few families are without such a house, even though they don’t always live in them—especially in the summer, when many of them disperse and stay in small temporary huts that don’t offer enough protection from the weather.

The Tools which they work with in building their Canoes, Houses, etc., are adzes or Axes, some made of a hard black stone, and others of green Talk. They have Chiszels made of the same, but these are more commonly made of Human Bones. In working small work and carving I believe they use mostly peices of Jasper, breaking small pieces from a large Lump they have for that purpose; as soon as the small peice is blunted they throw it away and take another. To till or turn up the ground they have wooden spades (if I may so call them), made like stout pickets, with a piece of wood tied a Cross near the lower end, to put the foot upon to force them into the Ground. These Green Talk Axes that are whole and good they set much Value upon, and never would part with them for anything we could offer.* (* The weapons of greenstone, found in the South Islands, were much prized. This hard material required years to shape into a mere, or short club, and these were handed down from father to son as a most valuable possession.) I offer'd one day for one, One of the best Axes I had in the Ship, besides a number of Other things, but nothing would induce the owner to part with it; from this I infer'd that good ones were scarce among them.

The tools they use to build their canoes, houses, and so on are adzes or axes, some made from a hard black stone and others from greenstone. They have chisels made of the same materials, but these are usually made from human bones. For small work and carving, I believe they mainly use pieces of jasper, breaking off small bits from a larger lump they keep for that purpose; as soon as a small piece gets dull, they throw it away and grab another. To till or turn the ground, they have wooden spades (if I can call them that), shaped like sturdy stakes, with a piece of wood tied across near the lower end, which they use to put their foot on to drive them into the ground. They place great value on intact and good greenstone axes and would never trade them for anything we could offer. *(*The weapons made of greenstone, found in the South Islands, were highly valued. This tough material took years to shape into a mere or short club, and these were passed down from father to son as a priceless possession.)* One day, I offered one of the best axes I had on the ship, along with several other items, but nothing could persuade the owner to let it go; from this, I gathered that good ones were rare among them.

Diversions and Musical instruments they have but few; the latter Consists of 2 or 3 sorts of Trumpets and a small Pipe or Whistle, and the former in singing and Dancing. Their songs are Harmonious enough, but very doleful to a European ear. In most of their dances they appear like mad men, Jumping and Stamping with their feet, making strange Contorsions with every part of the body, and a hideous noise at the same time; and if they happen to be in their Canoes they flourish with great Agility their Paddles, Pattoo Pattoos, various ways, in the doing of which, if there are ever so many boats and People, they all keep time and Motion together to a surprizing degree. It was in this manner that they work themselves to a proper Pitch of Courage before they used to attack us; and it was only from their after behaviour that we could tell whether they were in jest or in Earnest when they gave these Heivas, as they call them, of their own accord, especially at our first coming into a place. Their signs of Friendship is the waving the hand or a piece of Cloth, etc.

They have some entertainment and a few musical instruments; the instruments include two or three types of trumpets and a small pipe or whistle, while the entertainment consists of singing and dancing. Their songs are quite harmonious, but they sound very mournful to a European ear. In most of their dances, they move around like they’re frenzied, jumping and stomping their feet, contorting every part of their bodies, and making a terrible noise at the same time. If they’re in their canoes, they skillfully wave their paddles in various ways, and remarkably, even with many boats and people around, they all manage to keep in sync. This is how they worked themselves up to a suitable level of courage before they would attack us. It was only based on their later behavior that we could figure out if they were joking or serious when they put on these Heivas, as they call them, especially when we first arrived in a place. Their signs of friendship include waving a hand or a piece of cloth, etc.

We were never able to learn with any degree of certainty in what manner they bury their dead; we were generally told that they put them in the ground; if so it must be in some secret or by place, for we never saw the least signs of a burying place in the whole Country.* (* The burying places were kept secret. The body was temporarily buried, and after some time exhumed; the bones were cleaned, and hidden in some cave or cleft in the rocks. As bones were used by enemies to make implements, it was a point to keep these depositories secret, to prevent such desecration.) Their Custom of mourning for a friend or relation is by cutting and Scarifying their bodys, particularly their Arms and breasts, in such a manner that the Scars remain indelible, and, I believe, have some signification such as to shew how near related the deceased was to them.

We could never find out for sure how they bury their dead; we were mostly told that they put them in the ground. If that's the case, it must be done in a secret way or hidden place, because we never saw any signs of a burial site in the entire area. (*The burial sites were kept secret. The body was temporarily buried, then later exhumed; the bones were cleaned and hidden in some cave or crevice in the rocks. Since enemies used bones to make tools, it was important to keep these places secret to avoid desecration.) Their way of mourning for a friend or relative involves cutting and scarring their bodies, particularly on their arms and chests, in such a way that the scars are permanent. I believe these scars have some significance, like showing how closely related they were to the deceased.

[Maori and Tahiti Words.]

[Maori and Tahitian Words.]

With respect to religion, I believe these people trouble themselves very little about it; they, however, believe that there is one Supream God, whom they call Tawney,* (* Probably Tane-mahuta, the creator of animal and vegetable life. The Maori does not pray.) and likewise a number of other inferior deities; but whether or no they worship or Pray to either one or the other we know not with any degree of certainty. It is reasonable to suppose that they do, and I believe it; yet I never saw the least Action or thing among them that tended to prove it. They have the same Notions of the Creation of the World, Mankind, etc., as the people of the South Sea Islands have; indeed, many of their notions and Customs are the very same. But nothing is so great a proof of their all having had one Source as their Language, which differ but in a very few words the one from the other, as will appear from the following specimens, which I had from Mr. Banks, who understands their Language as well, or better than, any one on board.

Regarding religion, I think these people worry very little about it; however, they believe in one Supreme God, whom they call Tawney,* (* Probably Tane-mahuta, the creator of animal and plant life. The Maori does not pray.) along with several other lesser deities. But whether or not they worship or pray to either of them, we can't say for sure. It seems reasonable to think that they do, and I believe they do; yet I've never seen any actions or signs among them that confirm it. They have the same ideas about the creation of the world and humanity as the people of the South Sea Islands; in fact, many of their beliefs and customs are identical. But nothing proves that they all share a common origin more than their language, which differs only in a few words, as will be evident from the following examples I got from Mr. Banks, who understands their language as well, if not better than, anyone on board.

[Speculations on a Southern Continent.]

[Thoughts on a Southern Continent.]

There are some small differance in the Language spoke by the Aeheinomoweans and those of Tovy Poenammu; but this differance seem'd to me to be only in the pronunciation, and is no more than what we find between one part of England and another. What is here inserted as a Specimen is that spoke by the People of Aeheinomouwe. What is meant by the South Sea Islands are those Islands we ourselves Touched at; but I gave it that title because we have always been told that the same Language is universally spoke by all the Islanders, and that this is a Sufficient proof that both they and the New Zelanders have had one Origin or Source, but where this is even time perhaps may never discover.

There are some small differences in the language spoken by the Aeheinomoweans and those of Tovy Poenammu, but this difference seems to be only in the pronunciation, similar to what we find between different parts of England. What is included here as a sample is that spoken by the people of Aeheinomouwe. When referring to the South Sea Islands, I mean the islands we visited; I named it that way because we’ve always been told that the same language is spoken universally by all the islanders, and that this is sufficient proof that both they and the New Zealanders have a common origin or source, though where that might be may never be discovered.

It certainly is neither to the Southward nor Eastward, for I cannot perswaide myself that ever they came from America; and as to a Southern Continent, I do not believe any such thing exist, unless in a high Latitude. But as the Contrary opinion hath for many Years prevail'd, and may yet prevail, it is necessary I should say something in support of mine more than what will be directly pointed out by the Track of this Ship in those Seas; for from that alone it will evidently appear that there is a large space extending quite to the Tropick in which we were not, or any other before us that we can ever learn for certain. In our route to the Northward, after doubling Cape Horn, when in the Latitude of 40 degrees, we were in the Longitude of 110 degrees; and in our return to the Southward, after leaving Ulietea, when in the same Latitude, we were in the Longitude of 145 degrees; the differance in this Latitude is 35 degrees of Longitude. In the Latitude of 30 degrees the differance of the 2 Tracks is 21 degrees, and that differance continues as low as 20 degrees; but a view of the Chart will best illustrate this.

It’s definitely not to the South or East, because I just can’t convince myself that they ever came from America; and as for a Southern Continent, I don’t believe such a thing exists, unless in very high latitudes. However, since the opposite opinion has been popular for many years and may continue to be, I feel it’s necessary to say something to support my view beyond what will be directly shown by the path of this ship in those seas; because just from that alone, it will clearly show that there’s a large area extending all the way to the Tropic where we have not been, nor has anyone else that we can confirm. On our route northward, after rounding Cape Horn, when we were at 40 degrees latitude, we were at 110 degrees longitude; and on our way back south after leaving Ulietea, when we were at the same latitude, we reached 145 degrees longitude; the difference in this latitude is 35 degrees of longitude. At 30 degrees latitude, the difference between the two tracks is 21 degrees, and that difference continues down to 20 degrees; but looking at the chart will illustrate this best.

Here is now room enough for the North Cape of the Southern Continent to extend to the Northward, even to a pretty low Latitude. But what foundation have we for such a supposition? None, that I know of, but this, that it must either be here or no where. Geographers have indeed laid down part of Quiros' discoveries in this Longitude, and have told us that he had these signs of a Continent, a part of which they have Actually laid down in the Maps; but by what Authority I know not. Quiros, in the Latitude of 25 or 26 degrees South, discover'd 2 Islands, which, I suppose, may lay between the Longitude of 130 and 140 degrees West. Dalrymple lays them down in 146 degrees West, and says that Quiros saw to the Southward very large hanging Clouds and a very thick Horizon, with other known signs of a Continent. Other accounts of their Voyage says not a word about this; but supposing this to be true, hanging Clouds and a thick Horizon are certainly no signs of a Continent--I have had many proofs to the Contrary in the Course of this Voyage; neither do I believe that Quiros looked upon such things as known signs of land, for if he had he certainly would have stood to the Southward, in order to have satisfied himself before he had gone to the Northward, for no man seems to have had discoveries more at heart than he had. Besides this, this was the ultimate object of his Voyage.* (* It is conjectured that what Quiros saw was Tahiti, but his track on this voyage is very vague. There are certainly no islands in the latitude given except Pitcairn.) If Quiros was in the Latitude of 26 degrees and Longitude 146 degrees West, then I am certain that no part of the Southern Continent can no where extend so far to the Northward as the above mentioned Latitude. But the Voyage which seems to thrust it farthest back in the Longitude I am speaking of, viz., between 130 and 150 degrees West, is that of Admiral Roggeween, a Dutchman, made in 1722, who, after leaving Juan Fernandes, went in search of Davis's Island; but not finding it, he ran 12 degrees more to the West, and in the Latitude of 28 1/2 degrees discover'd Easter Island. Dalrymple and some others have laid it down in 27 degrees South and 106 degrees 30 minutes West, and supposes it to be the same as Davis's Isle, which I think cannot be from the Circumstance of the Voyage; on the other hand Mr. Pingre, in his Treatise concerning the Transit of Venus, gives an extract of Roggeween's Voyage and a map of the South Seas, wherein he places Easter Island in the Latitude of 28 1/2 degrees South, and in the Longitude of 123 degrees West* (* Easter Island is in longitude 110 degrees West, and is considered identical with Davis' Island.) his reason for so doing may be seen at large in the said Treatise. He likewise lays down Roggeween's rout through those South Seas very different from any other Author I have seen; for after leaving Easter Island he makes him to steer South-West to the height of 34 degrees South, and afterwards West-North-West. If Roggeween really took this rout, then it is not probable that there is any Main land to the Northward of 35 degrees South. However, Mr. Dalrymple and some Geographers have laid down Roggeween's track very different from Mr. Pingre. From Easter Isle they have laid down his Track to the North-West, and afterwards very little different from that of La Maire; and this I think is not probable, that a man who, at his own request, was sent to discover the Southern Continent should take the same rout thro' these Seas as others had done before who had the same thing in View; by so doing he must be Morally certain of not finding what he was in search of, and of course must fail as they had done. Be this as it may, it is a point that cannot be clear'd up from the published accounts of the Voyage, which, so far from taking proper notice of their Longitude, have not even mentioned the Latitude of several of the Islands they discover'd, so that I find it impossible to lay down Roggeween's rout with the least degree of accuracy.* (* Roggeween's track is still unknown.)

Here’s enough space for the North Cape of the Southern Continent to stretch northward, even to a pretty low latitude. But what do we base this assumption on? None, as far as I know, except the fact that it has to be here or nowhere. Geographers have indeed marked part of Quiros' discoveries in this longitude and told us that he observed signs of a continent, part of which has actually been placed on maps; but I don’t know by what authority. Quiros discovered two islands at a latitude of 25 or 26 degrees south, which I believe are located between 130 and 140 degrees west longitude. Dalrymple places them at 146 degrees west and claims that Quiros saw very large hanging clouds and a thick horizon to the south, along with other known signs of a continent. Other accounts of their voyage don’t mention this at all; but assuming it’s true, hanging clouds and a thick horizon are certainly not signs of a continent—I’ve had many experiences to the contrary during this voyage; nor do I believe Quiros thought of such things as known signs of land, because if he did, he would certainly have headed south to confirm before going north, since no one seemed more dedicated to discoveries than he was. Besides, this was the ultimate goal of his voyage. (*It is conjectured that what Quiros saw was Tahiti, but his route on this voyage is very vague. There are certainly no islands in the latitude given except Pitcairn.) If Quiros was at a latitude of 26 degrees and longitude 146 degrees west, then I’m certain that no part of the Southern Continent can extend that far northward as mentioned. The voyage that seems to push it farthest back in longitude, between 130 and 150 degrees west, is that of Admiral Roggeween, a Dutchman, made in 1722, who, after leaving Juan Fernandes, went in search of Davis's Island; but after not finding it, he traveled 12 degrees further west and discovered Easter Island at a latitude of 28 1/2 degrees. Dalrymple and some others placed it at 27 degrees south and 106 degrees 30 minutes west and believe it to be the same as Davis's Isle, which I think cannot be the case based on the circumstances of the voyage. On the other hand, Mr. Pingre, in his Treatise on the Transit of Venus, provides an excerpt of Roggeween's voyage and a map of the South Seas, in which he places Easter Island at a latitude of 28 1/2 degrees south and longitude of 123 degrees west. (*Easter Island is at longitude 110 degrees west and is considered the same as Davis' Island.) His reasoning can be found in detail in that treatise. He also portrays Roggeween’s route through those South Seas very differently from any other author I’ve seen; after leaving Easter Island, he has him steering southwest to 34 degrees south and then west-northwest. If Roggeween actually took this route, then it’s unlikely there is any mainland north of 35 degrees south. However, Mr. Dalrymple and some geographers have charted Roggeween's path quite differently from Mr. Pingre. They map his route from Easter Island to the northwest, which is very similar to La Maire's, and I find it unlikely that someone who requested to discover the Southern Continent would take the same route as others had before, as they had the same goal in mind; by doing so, he would be morally certain of not finding what he was looking for, and thus would surely fail like they did. Be that as it may, it’s a point that can’t be clarified from the published accounts of the voyage, which, instead of properly noting their longitude, have not even mentioned the latitude of several islands they discovered, making it impossible to map Roggeween's route with any degree of accuracy. (*Roggeween's track is still unknown.)

But to return to our own Voyage, which must be allowed to have set aside the most, if not all, the Arguments and proofs that have been advanced by different Authors to prove that there must be a Southern Continent; I mean to the Northward of 40 degrees South, for what may lie to the Southward of that Latitude I know not. Certain it is that we saw no Visible signs of Land, according to my Opinion, neither in our rout to the Northward, Southward, or Westward, until a few days before we made the Coast of New Zeland. It is true we have often seen large flocks of Birds, but they were generally such as are always seen at a very great distance from land; we likewise saw frequently peices of Sea or Rock Weed, but how is one to know how far this may drive to Sea. I am told, and that from undoubted Authority, that there is Yearly thrown up upon the Coast of Ireland and Scotland a sort of Beans called Oxe Eyes, which are known to grow no where but in the West Indies; and yet these 2 places are not less than 1200 Leagues asunder. Was such things found floating upon the Water in the South Seas one would hardly be perswaided that one was even out of sight of Land, so apt are we to Catch at everything that may at least point out to us the favourite Object we are in persuit of; and yet experiance shews that we may be as far from it as ever.

But to get back to our own journey, which must be considered as having dismissed most, if not all, the arguments and evidence put forward by various authors claiming there must be a Southern Continent; I'm talking about the area north of 40 degrees South, because I don’t know what lies south of that latitude. It's clear to me that we didn't see any visible signs of land, either on our route to the north, south, or west, until just a few days before we reached the coast of New Zealand. It's true we've often spotted large flocks of birds, but they were usually types that are always seen far away from land; we also frequently came across pieces of seaweed or rockweed, but how can anyone tell how far that may drift out to sea? I’ve been told, and by credible sources, that every year a type of bean called oxeye is washed up on the coasts of Ireland and Scotland, which is known to grow only in the West Indies; and yet those two places are no less than 1200 leagues apart. If such things were found floating in the South Seas, one would hardly be convinced that they were even out of sight of land, so eager are we to grasp at anything that might suggest the cherished objective we are pursuing; and yet experience shows that we might be just as far from it as ever.

Thus I have given my Opinion freely and without prejudice, not with any View to discourage any future attempts being made towards discovering the Southern Continent; on the Contrary, as I think this Voyage will evidently make it appear that there is left but a small space to the Northward of 40 degrees where the grand object can lay. I think it would be a great pity that this thing, which at times has been the Object of many Ages and Nations, should not now be wholy be clear'd up; which might very Easily be done in one Voyage without either much trouble or danger or fear of Miscarrying, as the Navigator would know where to go to look for it; but if, after all, no Continent was to be found, then he might turn his thoughts towards the discovery of those Multitude of Islands which, we are told, lay within the Tropical regions to the South of the Line, and this we have from very good Authority, as I have before hinted. This he will always have in his power; for, unless he be directed to search for the Southern lands in a high Latitude, he will not, as we were, be obliged to go farther to the Westward in the Latitude of 40 degrees than 140 or 145 degrees West, and therefore will always have it in his power to go to George's Island, where he will be sure of meeting with refreshments to recruit his people before he sets out upon the discovery of the Islands.* (* Cook carried out this programme in his second voyage, when he set at rest for ever the speculation regarding the Southern Continent.) But should it be thought proper to send a Ship out upon this Service while Tupia lives, and he to come out in her, in that case she would have a prodidgious Advantage over every ship that hath been upon discoveries in those Seas before; for by means of Tupia, supposing he did not accompany you himself, you would always get people to direct you from Island to Island, and would be sure of meeting with a friendly reception and refreshment at every Island you came to. This would enable the Navigator to make his discoveries the more perfect and Compleat; at least it would give him time so to do, for he would not be Obliged to hurry through those Seas thro' any apprehentions of wanting Provisions.

I’ve shared my opinion openly and without bias, not to discourage any future efforts to explore the Southern Continent. On the contrary, I believe this voyage will clearly show that there’s only a small area north of 40 degrees where the main land could be. It would be a shame for something that has intrigued many ages and nations not to be fully explored now; this could easily be accomplished in one voyage without much trouble, danger, or fear of failure, since the navigator would know where to look. But if no continent is found, he could then focus on discovering the numerous islands said to exist in the tropical regions south of the equator—something I’ve mentioned comes from reliable sources. He would always have that option because, unless he’s directed to search for southern lands in high latitude, he wouldn’t need to go far west of 40 degrees latitude, just beyond 140 or 145 degrees west. Therefore, he could always go to George's Island, where he’d be sure to find supplies to refresh his crew before targeting the islands. (*Cook followed this plan on his second voyage, which settled the speculation about the Southern Continent forever.) However, if it’s deemed appropriate to send a ship on this mission while Tupia is alive, and he comes along, that ship would have a significant advantage over every other exploratory ship in those waters. With Tupia’s guidance, even if he doesn’t join directly, you’d have locals to help you navigate from island to island, ensuring a warm welcome and supplies at each stop. This would allow the navigator to make more thorough and complete discoveries, at least giving him the time to do so, as he wouldn’t have to rush through those waters fearing a lack of provisions.

[Tupia's List of Islands.]

[Tupia's Island List.]

I shall now add a list of those Islands which Tupia and Several others have given us an account of, and Endeavour to point out the respective Situations from Otaheite, or George's Island; but this, with respect to many of them, cannot be depended upon. Those marked thus (*) Tupia himself has been at, and we have no reason to doubt his Veracity in this, by which it will appear that his Geographical knowledge of those Seas is pretty Extensive; and yet I must observe that before he came with us he hardly had an Idea of any land being larger than Otaheite.

I will now provide a list of the islands that Tupia and several others have described, along with their locations relative to Otaheite, or George's Island; however, this information about many of them may not be reliable. The ones marked with an asterisk (*) are islands that Tupia has visited himself, and we have no reason to question his truthfulness regarding these, which shows that he has a fairly extensive understanding of the geography of these seas. Still, I should note that before he joined us, he barely had any concept of land being larger than Otaheite.

 

 

The above list* was taken from a Chart of the Islands drawn by Tupia's own hands. (* This list is hopeless. With the exception of the Society Group (Huiheine, and the names that follow), Imao (Eimeo), Tapooamanuo, Tethuroa, and Ohiteroa, all lying near Tahiti, none can be recognised. Those north and east are no doubt names of the Paumotu Group, low coral islands, disposed in rings round lagoons, whose innumerable names are very little known to this day, and very probably the Tahitians had their own names for them.) He at one time gave us an account of near 130 Islands, but in his Chart he laid down only 74; and this is about the number that some others of the Natives of Otaheite gave us an account of; but the account taken by and from different people differ sencibly one from another both in names and numbers. The first is owing to the want of rightly knowing how to pronounce the names of the Islands after them; but be this as it may, it is very certain that there are these number of Islands, and very Probably a great many more, laying some where in the Great South Sea, the greatest part of which have never been seen by any European.

The list above* was taken from a chart of the islands created by Tupia himself. (* This list is pretty useless. Except for the Society Group (Huiheine and the names that follow), Imao (Eimeo), Tapooamanuo, Tethuroa, and Ohiteroa, which are all near Tahiti, none of the others can be recognized. The names to the north and east are likely from the Paumotu Group, which consists of low coral islands arranged in rings around lagoons, and their many names are not well known even today. It's very likely that the Tahitians had their own names for them.) He once told us about nearly 130 islands, but his chart only showed 74; this is about the number that some other natives of Otaheite mentioned as well. However, the accounts given by different people vary significantly in both names and numbers. This first discrepancy is due to the difficulties in accurately pronouncing the names of the islands as they were said to him. Still, it's very clear that there are at least this many islands, and likely many more, located somewhere in the Great South Sea, most of which have never been seen by any Europeans.

[Historical Notes on New Zealand.]

[Historical Notes on NZ.]

NOTES ON NEW ZEALAND.

NOTES ABOUT NEW ZEALAND.

As already stated by Cook in the Journal, New Zealand was first discovered by Abel Tasman, a Dutch navigator, in the year 1642. Sailing from Tasmania, he sighted the northern part of the Middle island, and anchored a little east of Cape Farewell in Massacre (Golden) Bay, so called by him because the Maoris cut off one of his boats, and killed three of the crew.

As Cook already mentioned in the Journal, New Zealand was first discovered by Abel Tasman, a Dutch navigator, in 1642. Sailing from Tasmania, he spotted the northern part of the Middle Island and anchored just east of Cape Farewell in Massacre (Golden) Bay, named by him because the Maoris attacked one of his boats and killed three crew members.

Tasman never landed anywhere, but coasted from Massacre Bay along the western side of the North Island to the north point. He passed outside the Three Kings, and thence away into the Pacific, to discover the Friendly Group.

Tasman never landed anywhere but sailed along the western side of the North Island, starting from Massacre Bay to the northern tip. He went around the Three Kings and then headed out into the Pacific to discover the Friendly Group.

No European eye again sighted New Zealand until Cook circumnavigated and mapped the islands.

No European saw New Zealand again until Cook sailed around and mapped the islands.

The warlike character of the natives is well shown in this Journal. On nearly every occasion they either made, or attempted to make, an attack, even on the ships, and in self-defence firearms had constantly to be used. Nevertheless, Cook's judgment enabled him to inaugurate friendly relations in most places where he stopped long enough to enable the natives to become acquainted with the strangers.

The aggressive nature of the natives is clearly illustrated in this Journal. Almost every time, they either launched or tried to launch an attack, even against the ships, and self-defense required the constant use of firearms. However, Cook's keen judgment allowed him to establish friendly relations in most places where he stayed long enough for the natives to get to know the newcomers.

It was not so with other voyagers. De Surville, a Frenchman, who called at Doubtless Bay very shortly after Cook left it, destroyed a village, and carried off a chief. Marion de Fresne was, in 1772, in the Bay of Islands, killed by the natives, with sixteen of his people, and eaten, for violation of some of their customs, and illtreatment of some individuals.

It wasn't the same for other travelers. De Surville, a Frenchman, arrived at Doubtless Bay shortly after Cook left, destroyed a village, and took a chief. Marion de Fresne was in the Bay of Islands in 1772 when he was killed by the locals, along with sixteen of his crew, and eaten for breaking some of their customs and mistreating some individuals.

Other outrages followed, committed on both sides, and it is no wonder that, though Cook represented the advantages of the island for colonization, it was not considered a desirable place in which to settle. The cannibalism of the Maoris especially made people shy of the country.

Other outrages followed, committed by both sides, and it’s no wonder that, even though Cook highlighted the island’s potential for colonization, it wasn’t seen as a desirable place to settle. The cannibalism practiced by the Maoris particularly made people hesitant about the country.

Intermittent communication took place between New Zealand and the new Colony of New South Wales, and at last, in 1814, Samuel Marsden, a clergyman of the Church of England, who had seen Maoris in New South Wales, landed in the Bay of Islands with other missionaries. This fearless and noble-minded man obtained the confidence of the Maoris, and a commencement of colonization was made.

Intermittent communication happened between New Zealand and the new Colony of New South Wales, and finally, in 1814, Samuel Marsden, a Church of England clergyman who had met Maoris in New South Wales, arrived in the Bay of Islands with other missionaries. This brave and ideals-driven man gained the trust of the Maoris, marking the beginning of colonization.

It was not, however, until 1840 that the New Zealand Company was formed to definitely colonize. They made their station at Wellington.

It wasn't until 1840 that the New Zealand Company was established to officially colonize. They set up their base in Wellington.

In the same year Captain Hobson, R.N., was sent as Lieutenant-Governor. Landing first at the Bay of Islands, he transferred his headquarters to the Hauraki Gulf in September 1840, where he founded Auckland, which remained the capital until 1876, when the seat of Government was transferred to Wellington.

In the same year, Captain Hobson, R.N., was appointed as Lieutenant-Governor. He first landed at the Bay of Islands and moved his headquarters to the Hauraki Gulf in September 1840, where he established Auckland, which stayed the capital until 1876, when the government seat was moved to Wellington.

The North Island, in which all these occurrences took place, contained by far the greater number of the natives, and it seems strange now that the first efforts to settle were not made in the Middle Island, which has proved equally suitable for Europeans, and where the difficulties of settlement, from the existence of a less numerous native population, were not so great. It is not necessary here to follow the complicated history of New Zealand in later years, which unfortunately comprises several bloody wars with the Maoris.

The North Island, where all these events happened, had by far the majority of the native population, and it seems odd now that the initial attempts to settle weren’t made in the South Island, which has turned out to be just as suitable for Europeans, and where the challenges of settlement, due to a smaller native population, weren’t as severe. There’s no need to go into the complex history of New Zealand in later years, which unfortunately includes several violent wars with the Maoris.

The present prosperous condition of this great colony is well known, but it has not been effected without the rapid diminution of the natives, who have met with the fate of most aborigines in contact with Europeans, especially when the former were naturally bold and warlike.

The current thriving state of this great colony is well known, but it hasn't happened without the swift decline of the native population, who have faced the same fate as most indigenous people when interacting with Europeans, especially when the former were naturally brave and combative.

The Maoris have retained the tradition of the original arrival of their race in a fleet of canoes from a country called Hawaiki, which is by some supposed to be Hawaii in the Sandwich Group. As we have seen, the language was practically the same as that of Tahiti, and there is no doubt that they came from some of the Polynesian islands. The date of the immigration is supposed to be the fifteenth century.

The Maoris have kept the story of their original arrival in a fleet of canoes from a place called Hawaiki, which some believe to be Hawaii in the Sandwich Islands. As we've seen, the language was almost identical to that of Tahiti, and there's no doubt that they came from some of the Polynesian islands. The immigration is thought to have happened in the fifteenth century.

Each canoe's crew settled in different parts of the North Island, and were the founders of the different great tribes into which the New Zealanders were divided. The more celebrated canoes were the Arawa, Tainui, Aotea, Kuruhaupo, Takitumu, and others.

Each canoe's crew settled in various parts of the North Island and became the founders of the different major tribes that New Zealanders were divided into. The more famous canoes were the Arawa, Tainui, Aotea, Kuruhaupo, Takitumu, and others.

The Arawa claimed the first landing, and the principal idols came in her. One of these is now in the possession of Sir George Grey. A large tribe on the east coast still bears the name of Arawa, and her name, that of the Tainui, and other of the canoes, are now borne by some of the great steamships that run to New Zealand.

The Arawa claimed the first landing, and the main idols came with her. One of these is now owned by Sir George Grey. A large tribe on the east coast still carries the name Arawa, and her name, along with the Tainui and other canoes, is now used by some of the large steamships that travel to New Zealand.

Cook, in the voyage with which we have to deal, completely examined the whole group. His pertinacity and determination to follow the whole coast is a fine instance of his thoroughness in exploration. No weather nor delay daunted him, and the accuracy with which he depicted the main features of the outline of the islands is far beyond any of the similar work of other voyagers. It is true that he missed in the south island many of the fine harbours that have played such an important part in the prosperity of the Colony; but when we consider the narrowness of their entrances, and the enormous extent of the coast line which he laid down in such a short time, this is not astonishing.

Cook, during the voyage we’re discussing, thoroughly explored the entire group of islands. His persistence and determination to follow the whole coastline show just how dedicated he was to exploration. No weather or delays deterred him, and the accuracy with which he mapped the main features of the islands is far superior to that of other explorers. It's true that he overlooked many of the excellent harbors in the South Island that have been crucial to the Colony's prosperity, but considering how narrow their entrances are and the vast stretch of coastline he mapped in such a short time, that’s not really surprising.

His observations on the natives and on the country display great acuteness of observation, and had the settlers displayed the same spirit of fair treatment and respect for the customs of the natives, much of the bloody warfare that has stained the annals of the Colony might have been averted; though it is scarcely possible that with such a high-spirited race the occupation of the islands, especially the North island, where the majority of the Maoris were, could have taken place without some disturbances.

His observations about the locals and the land show great insight, and if the settlers had shown the same attitude of fairness and respect for the natives' customs, a lot of the brutal conflicts that have marred the history of the Colony could have been avoided. However, it’s unlikely that with such a proud people, the occupation of the islands, especially the North Island where most of the Maoris lived, could have happened without some unrest.

New Zealand now contains 630,000 Europeans, and 41,000 Maoris. Its exports are valued at 10,000,000 pounds, and the imports at 6,250,000 pounds. There are 2000 miles of railways open. Such is the result of fifty years of colonization in a fertile and rich island, the climate of which may be described as that of a genial England.

New Zealand now has 630,000 Europeans and 41,000 Maoris. Its exports are worth 10,000,000 pounds, and its imports are valued at 6,250,000 pounds. There are 2,000 miles of railways in operation. This is the outcome of fifty years of colonization in a fertile and wealthy island, whose climate can be described as pleasantly similar to that of England.


CHAPTER 7. PASSAGE FROM NEW ZEALAND TO NEW HOLLAND.

[April 1770. From New Zealand to Australia.]

[April 1770. From New Zealand to Australia.]

SUNDAY, 1st April. In the P.M. had a moderate breeze at East, which in the Night Veer'd to the North-East, and was attended with hazey, rainy weather. I have before made mention of our quitting New Zeland with an intention to steer to the Westward, which we accordingly did, taking our departure from Cape Farewell in the Latitude of 40 degrees 30 minutes South and Longitude 185 degrees 58 minutes West from Greenwich, which bore from us at 5 p.m. West 18 degrees North, distance 12 Miles. After this we steer'd North-West and West-North-West, in order to give it a good berth, until 8 o'Clock a.m., at which time we steered West, having the Advantage of a fresh Gale at North by East. At Noon our Latitude by account was 40 degrees 12 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 1 degree 11 minutes West.

SUNDAY, April 1st. In the afternoon, we had a moderate breeze coming from the East, which shifted to the North-East during the night and brought hazy, rainy weather. I previously mentioned that we left New Zealand with plans to head West, which we did, departing from Cape Farewell at a latitude of 40 degrees 30 minutes South and a longitude of 185 degrees 58 minutes West from Greenwich. At 5 p.m., it was positioned 18 degrees North of us, 12 miles away. After that, we navigated North-West and West-North-West to keep a safe distance, until 8 a.m., when we headed West, benefiting from a fresh gale coming from North by East. By noon, our latitude was 40 degrees 12 minutes South, and we calculated our longitude from Cape Farewell to be 1 degree 11 minutes West.

Monday, 2nd. In the P.M. had a moderate Gale at North, with thick hazey weather, attended with rain. At 8 it fell little wind, and Veer'd to West-South-West, at which time we Tack'd. At Midnight the wind came to South-South-West, and increased to a brisk gale with fair Cloudy weather, which we made the most of as soon as it was daylight. At Noon our Latitude, by Observation, was 40 degrees 0 minutes, and Longitude made from Cape Farewell 2 degrees 31 minutes West.

Monday, 2nd. In the afternoon, there was a moderate gale coming from the north, with thick, hazy weather and rain. By 8 PM, the wind had lessened a bit and shifted to the west-southwest, which is when we tacked. At midnight, the wind shifted to south-southwest and picked up to a brisk gale with partly cloudy weather, which we took advantage of as soon as it got light. By noon, our latitude, based on observations, was 40 degrees 0 minutes, and we had made 2 degrees 31 minutes west in longitude from Cape Farewell.

Tuesday, 3rd. Cloudy weather; Winds at South-West and South-South-West, a fresh Gale, with which we made our Course good North-West by West, and distance run from Yesterday at Noon to this day at Noon 38 1/2 Leagues. Latitude, by observation, 38 degrees 56 minutes South; Longitude made from Cape Farewell 4 degrees 36 minutes West.

Tuesday, 3rd. It was cloudy with winds coming from the South-West and South-South-West, a strong breeze, which allowed us to head in a good direction of North-West by West, covering a distance of 38.5 leagues from yesterday at noon to today at noon. Latitude, by observation, was 38 degrees 56 minutes South; Longitude from Cape Farewell was 4 degrees 36 minutes West.

Wednesday, 4th. Had a steady brisk Gale at South-South-West with some flying showers of rain and large hollow Sea from the Southward. In the P.M. unbent the Maintopsail to repair, and brought another to the Yard and set it close reefed. At Noon our Latitude, by Observation, was 37 degrees 56 minutes South; Course and distance since Yesterday at Noon North 60 degrees West, 122 Miles; Longitude made from Cape Farewell 6 degrees 54 minutes West.

Wednesday, 4th. We had a strong, steady wind from the South-Southwest with some passing rain showers and a big, rolling sea coming from the south. In the afternoon, we took down the maintopsail to fix it and brought another one to the yard, setting it with close reefs. At noon, our latitude, based on observation, was 37 degrees 56 minutes South; our course and distance since yesterday at noon were North 60 degrees West, 122 miles; longitude made from Cape Farewell was 6 degrees 54 minutes West.

Thursday, 5th. Fresh Gales at South, which in the A.M. veer'd to South-East by South. At Noon our Latitude, by observation, was 37 degrees 23 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 9 degrees 10 minutes West; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon North 73 degrees 15 minutes West, 37 Leagues.

Thursday, 5th. Strong winds from the South, which in the morning shifted to South-East by South. At noon, our latitude, based on observation, was 37 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude calculated from Cape Farewell was 9 degrees 10 minutes West; course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon was North 73 degrees 15 minutes West, 37 leagues.

Friday, 6th. Winds between the South by East and South-East, with a Continued swell from the South-South-West. At Noon our Latitude in per Observation 37 degrees 18 minutes South; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon North 85 degrees West, 58 Miles. Longitude made from Cape Farewell 10 degrees 35 minutes West.

Friday, 6th. Winds coming from the South by East and South-East, with a steady swell from the South-South-West. At noon, our latitude, based on observation, is 37 degrees 18 minutes South; we traveled a course of North 85 degrees West, covering 58 miles since yesterday at noon. The longitude calculated from Cape Farewell is 10 degrees 35 minutes West.

Saturday, 7th. Gentle breezes at North-East, which in the A.M. Veer'd to North-West. In the P.M. found the Variation by the Mean of several Azimuths to be 13 degrees 50 minutes East, being then in the Latitude of 37 degrees 23 minutes South, and Longitude 196 degrees 44 minutes West. In the A.M. Punished Jno. Bowles, Marine, with 12 lashes for refusing to do his duty when order'd by the Boatswain's Mate and Serjeant of Marines. At Noon Latitude per Observation 37 degrees 35 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 11 degrees 34 minutes West; Course and distance run since Yesterday noon South 70 degrees 15 minutes West, 50 Miles.

Saturday, 7th. Light breezes coming from the Northeast, which shifted to the Northwest in the morning. In the afternoon, I calculated the variation from several azimuths to be 13 degrees 50 minutes East, while we were at a latitude of 37 degrees 23 minutes South and a longitude of 196 degrees 44 minutes West. In the morning, I punished Jno. Bowles, a Marine, with 12 lashes for refusing to do his duty when ordered by the Boatswain’s Mate and the Sergeant of Marines. At noon, the observed latitude was 37 degrees 35 minutes South, and the longitude made from Cape Farewell was 11 degrees 34 minutes West; we had traveled south at a course of 70 degrees 15 minutes west for 50 miles since yesterday noon.

Sunday, 8th. Gentle breezes from the North-West and North. In the P.M. found the Variation to be 13 degrees 56 minutes East. At Noon Latitude in per Observation 38 degrees 0 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 13 degrees 2 minutes West; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 70 degrees 15 minutes West, 74 Miles.

Sunday, 8th. Light breezes from the Northwest and North. In the afternoon, found the variation to be 13 degrees 56 minutes East. At noon, latitude based on observations was 38 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude made from Cape Farewell was 13 degrees 2 minutes West; the course and distance sailed since yesterday noon was South 70 degrees 15 minutes West, 74 miles.

Monday, 9th. Gentle breezes at North-West; pleasant weather and a Smooth Sea. In the A.M. saw a Tropic Bird, which, I believe, is uncommon in such high Latitudes. At Noon Latitude observ'd 38 degrees 29 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 14 degrees 45 minutes West; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 70 degrees 15 minutes West, 86 Miles.

Monday, 9th. Light breezes from the Northwest; nice weather and a calm sea. In the morning, I spotted a Tropic Bird, which I think is rare in these high latitudes. At noon, I observed a latitude of 38 degrees 29 minutes South, and a longitude of 14 degrees 45 minutes West from Cape Farewell; the course and distance traveled since yesterday noon were South 70 degrees 15 minutes West, 86 miles.

Tuesday, 10th. Gentle breezes at North-West by North, and clear settled weather. In the A.M. found the Variation, by the Amplitude, to be 11 degrees 25 minutes East, and by Azimuth 11 degrees 20 minutes. At Noon the observed Latitude was 38 degrees 51 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Farewell 16 degrees 45 minutes; Longitude in 202 degrees 43 minutes West; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 76 degrees 45 minutes West, 96 Miles.

Tuesday, 10th. Light winds from the Northwest, with clear and stable weather. In the morning, we found the variation using amplitude to be 11 degrees 25 minutes East and by azimuth 11 degrees 20 minutes. At noon, the observed latitude was 38 degrees 51 minutes South, and the longitude calculated from Cape Farewell was 16 degrees 45 minutes; longitude was 202 degrees 43 minutes West; course and distance sailed since yesterday noon was South 76 degrees 45 minutes West, 96 miles.

Wednesday, 11th. Gentle breezes from the North-West, and pleasant weather, with some few showers of rain. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 13 degrees 48 minutes East, which is 2 1/2 degrees more than it was yesterday, altho' I should have expected to have found it less, for the observations were equally good. At Noon Latitude in 39 degrees 7 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 17 degrees 23 minutes; and Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 62 degrees West, 34 Miles.

Wednesday, 11th. There were light breezes from the Northwest and nice weather, with a few rain showers. In the morning, I found the variation to be 13 degrees 48 minutes East, which is 2.5 degrees more than it was yesterday, although I would have expected it to be less since the observations were just as good. At noon, the latitude was 39 degrees 7 minutes South, and the longitude made from Cape Farewell was 17 degrees 23 minutes. The course and distance sailed since yesterday noon was South 62 degrees West, 34 miles.

Thursday, 12th. Calm, with now and then light Airs from the North-East and North-West; cloudy weather, but remarkably warm, and so it hath been for some days past. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 39 degrees 11 minutes, and Longitude from Cape Farewell 17 degrees 35 minutes West; Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 66 degrees West, 10 Miles.

Thursday, 12th. Calm, with occasional light breezes from the North-East and North-West; cloudy weather, but surprisingly warm, which has been the case for the past few days. At noon, we were at a latitude of 39 degrees 11 minutes and a longitude of 17 degrees 35 minutes west from Cape Farewell; our course and distance sailed since yesterday noon was South 66 degrees West for 10 miles.

Friday, 13th. Light Airs next to a Calm, with Clear pleasant weather; what little wind we had was from the North-West quarter. In the Course of this day found the Variation to be 12 degrees 27 minutes East, being at Noon, by observation, in the Latitude of 39 degrees 23 minutes South, and Longitude 204 degrees 2 minutes West; Course and distance since Yesterday noon South 62 degrees West, 26 Miles, and Longitude made from Cape Farewell 18 degrees 4 minutes West.

Friday, the 13th. Light breezes almost calm, with clear, nice weather; the little wind we did have was from the northwest. During the day, we found the variation to be 12 degrees 27 minutes east. At noon, based on our observations, we were at a latitude of 39 degrees 23 minutes south and a longitude of 204 degrees 2 minutes west. Our course and distance since yesterday noon have been south 62 degrees west for 26 miles, with a change in longitude from Cape Farewell of 18 degrees 4 minutes west.

Saturday, 14th. Calm serene weather, with sometimes light Airs from the Northward. At sun set found the Variation to be 11 degrees 28 minutes East, and in the Morning to be 11 degrees 30 minutes East. The Spritsail Topsail being wore to rags, it was condemn'd as not fit for its proper use, and Converted to repair the 2 Top Gallant Sails, they being of themselves so bad as not to be worth the Expence of new Canvas, but with the help of this sail may be made to last some time longer. At Noon Latitude in 39 degrees 25 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Farewell 18 degrees 21 minutes West; Course and distance since Yesterday noon South 18 degrees West, 13 Miles.

Saturday, 14th. Calm, clear weather, with occasional light breezes from the north. At sunset, we measured the variation to be 11 degrees 28 minutes East, and in the morning, it was 11 degrees 30 minutes East. The spritsail topsail was worn out, deemed unfit for its intended use, and was repurposed to repair the two top gallant sails, which were also in poor condition and not worth the cost of new canvas. With this sail, they may hold up a bit longer. At noon, our latitude was 39 degrees 25 minutes South, and the longitude calculated from Cape Farewell was 18 degrees 21 minutes West; since yesterday noon, we’ve traveled south 18 degrees west for a distance of 13 miles.

Sunday, 15th. In the P.M. had light Airs at North, which in the A.M. increased to a fresh Gale, with which we made the best of our way to the Westward, and by noon had run since yesterday upon a South 86 degrees 15 minutes West Course, 79 Miles. Latitude in, by Observation, 39 degrees 30 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Farewell 20 degrees 2 minutes West. Some flying fish seen this day.

Sunday, 15th. In the afternoon, there were light winds coming from the north, which picked up to a strong gale in the morning. With this wind, we made good progress westward and, by noon, we had traveled since yesterday on a south 86 degrees 15 minutes west course for 79 miles. Our latitude, measured by observation, was 39 degrees 30 minutes south, and our longitude from Cape Farewell was 20 degrees 2 minutes west. We saw some flying fish today.

Monday, 16th. Fresh Gales at North-North-West, with Cloudy, hazey weather. In the P.M. saw an Egg Bird, and yesterday a Gannet was seen; these are Birds that we reckon never to go far from land. We kept the lead going all night, but found no soundings with 100 and 130 fathoms line. At noon we were in the Latitude of 39 degrees 40 minutes South, and had made 22 degrees 2 minutes of Longitude from Cape Farewell; course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon South 82 degrees West, 108 Miles.

Monday, 16th. Fresh winds from the north-northwest, with cloudy, hazy weather. In the afternoon, we spotted an egg bird, and we saw a gannet yesterday; these are birds that we think never go far from land. We kept the lead line going all night but found no soundings with the 100 and 130 fathoms line. At noon, we were at a latitude of 39 degrees 40 minutes south and had made 22 degrees 2 minutes of longitude from Cape Farewell; the course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon were south 82 degrees west, 108 miles.

Tuesday, 17th. At 2 p.m. the wind came to West-South-West, at which time we Tack'd and stood to the North-West. Before 5 o'Clock we were obliged to close reef our Topsails, having a Strong gale, with very heavy squalls; about this time a Small land bird was seen to pearch upon the rigging. We sounded, but had no ground with 120 fathoms of line. At 8 o'Clock we wore and stood to the Southward until 12 at Night, then wore and stood to the North-West until 4 a.m., when we again stood to the Southward, having a fresh Gale at West-South-West, attended with Squalls and dark hazey unsettled weather until 9; at which time it fell little wind, and the weather soon after Clear'd up, which, a little after 11, gave us an Opportunity of taking several observations of the Sun and Moon, the Mean result of which gave 207 degrees 56 minutes West Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich. From these observations the Longitude of the Ship at Noon was 207 degrees 58 minutes, and by the Log 208 degrees 20 minutes, the difference being only 22 minutes; and this Error may as well be in the one as the other. Our Latitude at Noon was 39 degrees 36 minutes South, the Longitude made from Cape Farewell 22 degrees 22 minutes West.

Tuesday, the 17th. At 2 p.m., the wind shifted to West-South-West, so we tacked and headed North-West. Before 5 o'clock, we had to reef our topsails due to a strong gale and heavy squalls. Around this time, a small land bird was spotted perched on the rigging. We took soundings but couldn't find the bottom with 120 fathoms of line. At 8 o'clock, we changed course and headed South until midnight, then turned and went North-West until 4 a.m., when we again went South, facing a fresh gale from West-South-West, along with squalls and dark, hazy, unsettled weather until 9. The wind lessened a bit at that point, and the weather soon cleared up. A little after 11, we took several observations of the Sun and Moon, which averaged to 207 degrees 56 minutes West Longitude from the Greenwich Meridian. Based on these observations, the ship's longitude at noon was 207 degrees 58 minutes, while the log indicated 208 degrees 20 minutes, resulting in a difference of only 22 minutes. This error could apply to either measurement. Our latitude at noon was 39 degrees 36 minutes South, and the longitude made from Cape Farewell was 22 degrees 22 minutes West.

Wednesday, 18th. Winds Southerly, a hard gale, with heavy squalls, attended with Showers of rain and a great Sea from the same Quarter. At 3 p.m. Close reeft the Topsails, handed the Main and Mizen Topsail, and got down Top Gallant Yards. At 6 the Gale increased to such a height as to oblige us to take in the Foretopsail and Mainsail, and to run under the Foresail and Mizen all night; Sounding every 2 hours, but found no ground with 120 fathoms. At 6 a.m. set the Mainsail, and soon after the Foretopsail, and before Noon the Maintopsail, both close reeft. At Noon our Latitude by observation was 38 degrees 45 minutes South, Longitude from Cape Farewell 23 degrees 43 minutes West; and Course and distance run since Yesterday noon North 51 degrees West, 82 Miles. Last night we saw a Port Egmont Hen, and this morning 2 More, a Pintado bird, several Albetrosses, and black sheer Waters. The first of these birds are Certain signs of the nearness of land; indeed we cannot be far from it. By our Longitude we are a degree to the Westward of the East side of Van Diemen's Land, according to Tasman, the first discoverer's, Longitude of it, who could not err much in so short a run as from this land to New Zeland; and by our Latitude we could not be above 50 or 55 Leagues to the Northward of the place where he took his departure from.

Wednesday, 18th. The wind was coming from the south, blowing hard with heavy gusts, accompanied by rain showers and big waves from the same direction. At 3 p.m., we reefed the topsails, took in the main and mizen topsails, and lowered the top gallant yards. By 6, the gale had gotten so strong that we had to take in the foretopsail and mainsail and sailed under the foresail and mizen all night, sounding every 2 hours but found no bottom with 120 fathoms of line. At 6 a.m. we set the mainsail and shortly after the foretopsail, and before noon, we set the maintopsail, both reefed tightly. At noon, our latitude by observation was 38 degrees 45 minutes south, and our longitude from Cape Farewell was 23 degrees 43 minutes west. Since yesterday noon, we had traveled in a course of north 51 degrees west for 82 miles. Last night, we spotted a Port Egmont Hen, and this morning saw two more, along with a Pintado bird, several Albatrosses, and black sheer waters. The first of these birds are definite signs that land is nearby; we must be close to it. According to our longitude, we are one degree west of the east side of Van Diemen's Land, based on Tasman, the first discoverer’s, longitude for it, who wouldn’t have made a significant error on such a short journey from this land to New Zealand; by our latitude, we couldn't be more than 50 or 55 leagues north of where he set out from.


CHAPTER 8. EXPLORATION OF EAST COAST OF AUSTRALIA.

[April 1770.]

[April 1770.]

THURSDAY, 19th. In the P.M. had fresh Gales at South-South-West and Cloudy Squally weather, with a large Southerly Sea; at 6 took in the Topsails, and at 1 A.M. brought too and Sounded, but had no ground with 130 fathoms of line. At 5, set the Topsails close reef'd, and 6, saw land* (* The south-east coast of Australia. See chart.) extending from North-East to West, distance 5 or 6 Leagues, having 80 fathoms, fine sandy bottom. We continued standing to the Westward with the Wind at South-South-West until 8, at which time we got Topgallant Yards a Cross, made all sail, and bore away along shore North-East for the Eastermost land we had in sight, being at this time in the Latitude of 37 degrees 58 minutes South, and Longitude of 210 degrees 39 minutes West. The Southermost point of land we had in sight, which bore from us West 1/4 South, I judged to lay in the Latitude of 38 degrees 0 minutes South and in the Longitude of 211 degrees 7 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich. I have named it Point Hicks, because Lieutenant Hicks was the first who discover'd this Land. To the Southward of this point we could see no land, and yet it was clear in that Quarter, and by our Longitude compared with that of Tasman's, the body of Van Diemen's land ought to have bore due South from us, and from the soon falling of the Sea after the wind abated I had reason to think it did; but as we did not see it, and finding the Coast to trend North-East and South-West, or rather more to the Westward, makes me Doubtfull whether they are one land or no.* (* Had not the gale on the day before forced Cook to run to the northward, he would have made the north end of the Furneaux Group, and probably have discovered Bass Strait, which would have cleared up the doubt, which he evidently felt, as to whether Tasmania was an island or not. The fact was not positively known until Dr. Bass sailed through the Strait in a whale-boat in 1797. Point Hicks was merely a rise in the coast-line, where it dipped below the horizon to the westward, and the name of Point Hicks Hill is now borne by an elevation that seems to agree with the position.) However, every one who compares this Journal with that of Tasman's will be as good a judge as I am; but it is necessary to observe that I do not take the Situation of Vandiemen's from the Printed Charts, but from the extract of Tasman's Journal, published by Dirk Rembrantse. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 37 degrees 50 minutes and Longitude of 210 degrees 29 minutes West. The extreams of the Land extending from North-West to East-North-East, a remarkable point, bore North 20 degrees East, distant 4 Leagues. This point rises to a round hillock very much like the Ramhead going into Plymouth sound, on which account I called it by the same name; Latitude 37 degrees 39 minutes, Longitude 210 degrees 22 minutes West. The Variation by an Azimuth taken this morning was 8 degrees 7 minutes East. What we have as yet seen of this land appears rather low, and not very hilly, the face of the Country green and Woody, but the Sea shore is all a white Sand.

THURSDAY, 19th. In the afternoon, we experienced fresh gales from the South-South-West with cloudy, squally weather, and a large southerly sea. At 6, we took in the topsails, and at 1 A.M. we brought the ship to a stop and sounded the depths, but found no ground with 130 fathoms of line. At 5, we set the topsails with close reefed, and at 6, we spotted land* (* The southeast coast of Australia. See chart.) extending from North-East to West, about 5 or 6 leagues away, with 80 fathoms of fine sandy bottom. We continued heading west with the wind at South-South-West until 8, when we got the topgallant yards crossed, made all sail, and headed along the shore North-East towards the easternmost land we could see, being at that time in latitude 37 degrees 58 minutes South, and longitude 210 degrees 39 minutes West. The southernmost point of land we saw, which was located West 1/4 South from us, I estimated to be in latitude 38 degrees 0 minutes South and longitude 211 degrees 7 minutes West from Greenwich. I named it Point Hicks, after Lieutenant Hicks, the first to discover this land. To the south of this point, we couldn't see any land, and it was clear in that area. Based on our longitude compared to Tasman's, Van Diemen's land should have been due south from us, and since the sea calmed down after the wind died down, I believed it was there; however, since we didn't see it, and noticing that the coast trends North-East and South-West, or a bit more to the westward, makes me doubtful whether they are one land or not.* (* Had the gale the day before not forced Cook to head north, he would have reached the northern end of the Furneaux Group, and probably discovered Bass Strait, which would have clarified the doubt he clearly felt about whether Tasmania was an island or not. The fact was not positively known until Dr. Bass sailed through the Strait in a whale-boat in 1797. Point Hicks was simply a rise in the coastline where it dipped below the horizon to the west, and the name Point Hicks Hill is now used for a hill that seems to match its location.) However, anyone comparing this journal with Tasman's will judge as well as I do; but it is important to note that I don't derive the location of Van Diemen's from printed charts, but from the extract of Tasman's Journal published by Dirk Rembrantse. At noon, we were at latitude 37 degrees 50 minutes and longitude 210 degrees 29 minutes West. The extremes of the land extended from North-West to East-North-East, and a notable point bore North 20 degrees East, about 4 leagues away. This point rises to a round hillock that looks quite like the Ramhead entering Plymouth sound, which is why I named it the same; latitude 37 degrees 39 minutes, longitude 210 degrees 22 minutes West. The variation from an azimuth taken this morning was 8 degrees 7 minutes East. What we have seen of this land so far appears relatively low, not very hilly, with a green and wooded landscape, but the shoreline is all white sand.

Friday, 20th. In the P.M. and most part of the night had a fresh Gale Westerly, with Squalls, attended with Showers of rain. In the A.M. had the Wind at South-West, with Severe weather. At 1 p.m. saw 3 Water Spouts at once; 2 were between us and the Shore, and one at some distance upon our Larboard Quarter. At 6, shortned sail, and brought too for the Night, having 56 fathoms fine sandy bottom. The Northermost land in sight bore North by East 1/2 East, and a small Island* (* Gabo Island.) lying close to a point on the Main bore West, distant 2 Leagues. This point I have named Cape Howe* (* Cape Howe, called after Admiral Earl Howe, is the south-east point of Australia. The position is almost exact.); it may be known by the Trending of the Coast, which is North on the one Side and South-West on the other. Latitude 37 degrees 28 minutes South; Longitude 210 degrees 3 minutes West. It may likewise be known by some round hills upon the main just within it. Having brought too with her head off Shore, we at 10 wore, and lay her head in until 4 a.m., at which time we made sail along shore to the Northward. At 6, the Northermost land in sight bore North, being at this time about 4 Leagues from the Land. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 36 degrees 51 minutes South and Longitude of 209 degrees 53 minutes West, and 3 Leagues from the land. Course sail'd along shore since Yesterday at Noon was first North 52 degrees East, 30 miles, then North by East and North by West, 41 Miles. The weather being clear gave us an opportunity to View the Country, which had a very agreeable and promising aspect, diversified with hills, ridges, plains, and Valleys, with some few small lawns; but for the most part the whole was covered with wood, the hills and ridges rise with a gentle slope; they are not high, neither are there many of them.

Friday, the 20th. In the afternoon and most of the night, we experienced a fresh westerly gale with squalls and rain showers. In the morning, the wind shifted to the south-west, bringing severe weather. At 1 p.m., we spotted three water spouts at the same time; two were between us and the shore, and one was at a distance on our port side. At 6, we reduced our sail and anchored for the night in 56 fathoms of fine sandy bottom. The northernmost land in view was to the north by east 1/2 east, and a small island (Gabo Island) near a point on the mainland was to the west, about 2 leagues away. This point has been named Cape Howe (Cape Howe, named after Admiral Earl Howe, is the southeast point of Australia. The position is nearly exact); it can be identified by the coastline trend, which is north on one side and south-west on the other. Latitude 37 degrees 28 minutes south; Longitude 210 degrees 3 minutes west. It can also be recognized by some round hills on the mainland just inside it. After anchoring with our head turned off shore, we wore at 10 and pointed our vessel towards the shore until 4 a.m., when we set sail north along the coast. At 6, the northernmost land in sight was due north, about 4 leagues from the shore. At noon, we were at latitude 36 degrees 51 minutes south and longitude 209 degrees 53 minutes west, and 3 leagues from the land. Since yesterday at noon, our course along the shore was first north 52 degrees east for 30 miles, then north by east and north by west for 41 miles. The clear weather gave us a chance to observe the landscape, which appeared very pleasant and promising, characterized by hills, ridges, plains, and valleys, with a few small clearings; but for the most part, the area was covered with woods, and the hills and ridges rose gently; they were not high, and there weren’t many of them.

[Off Cape Dromedary, New South Wales.]

[Off Cape Dromedary, New South Wales.]

Saturday, 21st. Winds Southerly, a Gentle breeze, and Clear weather, with which we coasted along shore to the Northward. In the P.M. we saw the smoke of fire in several places; a Certain sign that the Country is inhabited. At 6, being about 2 or 3 Leagues from the land, we shortned Sail, and Sounded and found 44 fathoms, a sandy bottom. Stood on under an easey sail until 12 o'Clock, at which time we brought too until 4 A.M., when we made sail, having then 90 fathoms, 5 Leagues from the land. At 6, we were abreast of a pretty high Mountain laying near the Shore, which, on account of its figure, I named Mount Dromedary (Latitude 36 degrees 18 minutes South, Longitude 209 degrees 55 minutes West). The shore under the foot of the Mountain forms a point, which I have named Cape Dromedary, over which is a peaked hillock. At this time found the Variation to be 10 degrees 42 minutes East. Between 10 and 11 o'Clock Mr. Green and I took several Observations of the Sun and Moon, the mean result of which gave 209 degrees 17 minutes West Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich. By observation made yesterday we were in the Longitude 210 degrees 9 minutes. West 20 minutes gives 209 degrees 49 minutes the Longitude of the Ship to-day at noon per yesterday's observation, the Mean of which and to-day's give 209 degrees 33 minutes West, by which I fix the Longitude of this Coast. Our Latitude at Noon was 35 degrees 49 minutes South; Cape Dromedary bore South 30 degrees West, distant 12 Leagues. An Open Bay* (* Bateman Bay.) wherein lay 3 or 4 Small Islands, bore North-West by West, distant 5 or 6 Leagues. This Bay seem'd to be but very little Shelter'd from the Sea Winds, and yet it is the only likely Anchoring place I have yet seen upon the Coast.

Saturday, 21st. The winds were coming from the south, a gentle breeze, and the weather was clear as we coasted north along the shore. In the afternoon, we saw smoke rising in several places, a clear sign that the area was inhabited. At 6 PM, being about 2 or 3 leagues from land, we reduced sail and measured the depth, finding 44 fathoms with a sandy bottom. We continued on with a moderate sail until midnight, at which point we stopped until 4 AM when we set sail again, having found the depth to be 90 fathoms, 5 leagues from the shore. By 6 AM, we were opposite a pretty high mountain near the shore, which I named Mount Dromedary because of its shape (Latitude 36 degrees 18 minutes South, Longitude 209 degrees 55 minutes West). The shore at the base of the mountain forms a point that I’ve named Cape Dromedary, featuring a peaked hillock. At this time, I found the magnetic variation to be 10 degrees 42 minutes East. Between 10 and 11 o'clock, Mr. Green and I took several observations of the Sun and Moon; the average result placed us at 209 degrees 17 minutes West Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich. According to yesterday's observation, we were at Longitude 210 degrees 9 minutes. Subtracting 20 minutes gives us 209 degrees 49 minutes for the ship's Longitude today at noon according to yesterday's observation. The average of that and today’s gives 209 degrees 33 minutes West, which I use to fix the Longitude of this coast. Our Latitude at noon was 35 degrees 49 minutes South; Cape Dromedary was located at South 30 degrees West, 12 leagues away. An open bay (Bateman Bay) containing 3 or 4 small islands was to the northwest, about 5 or 6 leagues away. This bay seemed to offer very little shelter from the sea winds, yet it is the only suitable anchoring spot I have seen along the coast so far.

Sunday, 22nd. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze at South by West with which we steer'd along shore North by East and North-North-East at the distance of about 3 Leagues. Saw the smoke of fire in several places near the Sea beach. At 5, we were abreast of a point of land which, on account of its perpendicular Clifts, I call'd Point Upright; Latitude 35 degrees 35 minutes South; it bore from us due West, distant 2 Leagues, and in this Situation had 31 fathoms, Sandy bottom. At 6, falling little wind, we hauld off East-North-East; at this time the Northermost land in sight bore North by East 1/2 East, and at midnight, being in 70 fathoms, we brought too until 4 A.M., at which time we made sail in for the land, and at daylight found ourselves nearly in the same Place we were at 5 o'Clock in the evening, by which it was apparent that we had been drove about 3 Leagues to the Southward by a Tide or Current in the night. After this we steer'd along shore North-North-East, having a Gentle breeze at South-West, and were so near the Shore as to distinguish several people upon the Sea beach. They appeared to be of a very dark or black Colour; but whether this was the real Colour of their skins or the Cloathes they might have on I know not. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 35 degrees 27 minutes and Longitude 209 degrees 23 minutes; Cape Dromedary bore South 28 degrees West, distance 15 Leagues. A remarkable peak'd hill laying inland, the Top of which looked like a Pigeon house, and occasioned my giving it that name, bore North 32 degrees 33 minutes West, and a small low Island, laying close under the Shore, bore North-West, distance 2 or 3 Leagues; Variation of the Compass 9 degrees 50 minutes East. When we first discover'd this Island in the morning I was in hopes, from its appearance, that we should have found Shelter for the Ship behind it; but when we came to approach it near I did not think that there was even security for a Boat to land. But this, I believe, I should have attempted had not the wind come on Shore, after which I did not think it safe to send a Boat from the Ship, as we had a large hollow Sea from the South-East rowling in upon the land, which beat every where very high upon the Shore; and this we have had ever since we came upon the Coast. The land near the Sea coast still continues of a moderate height, forming alternately rocky points and Sandy beaches; but inland, between Mount Dromedary and the Pigeon house, are several pretty high Mountains, 2 only of which we saw but what were covered with Trees, and these lay inland behind the Pigeon House, and are remarkably flat a Top, with Steep rocky clifts all round them. As far as we could see the Trees in this Country hath all the appearance of being stout and lofty. For these 2 days past the observed Latitude hath been 12 or 14 Miles to the Southward of the Ship's account given by the Log, which can be owing to nothing but a Current set to the Southward.

Sunday, 22nd. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze from the South by West, which allowed us to sail along the shore to the North by East and North-North-East, covering about 3 leagues. We saw smoke from fires in several places near the beach. At 5 PM, we were opposite a point of land that I named Point Upright due to its steep cliffs; it was 35 degrees 35 minutes South in latitude and bore 2 leagues due West from us, where we found 31 fathoms with a sandy bottom. At 6 PM, the wind died down a bit, so we headed off East-North-East; at this time, the northernmost land in sight was North by East 1/2 East, and at midnight, we were in 70 fathoms, so we stopped until 4 AM. Then we set sail toward the land, and at daylight, we realized we were almost in the same spot we were at 5 o'clock the previous evening, showing that we had drifted about 3 leagues south during the night due to a tide or current. After this, we continued along the shore to the North-North-East, with a gentle breeze from the South-West, and we were close enough to the shore to see several people on the beach. They appeared to have very dark or black skin, but I couldn't tell if that was their natural skin color or the color of their clothing. At noon, our observations put us at a latitude of 35 degrees 27 minutes and a longitude of 209 degrees 23 minutes; Cape Dromedary was South 28 degrees West, 15 leagues away. A notable peaked hill inland, resembling a pigeon house, which is why I named it that, bore North 32 degrees 33 minutes West, and a small low island close to the shore was to the North-West, about 2 or 3 leagues away; the compass variation was 9 degrees 50 minutes East. When we first spotted this island in the morning, I hoped it would provide shelter for the ship, but when we approached it closely, I doubted there was even safe landing for a boat. However, I might have tried that if the wind hadn't shifted onshore; after that, I didn't think it was safe to send a boat from the ship since we had large rolling waves from the South-East crashing onto the land, which were very high against the shore and had been hitting since we arrived at the coast. The land near the coastline remains moderately high, alternating between rocky points and sandy beaches; however, inland, between Mount Dromedary and the pigeon house, there are several fairly high mountains, two of which we saw covered with trees, located behind the pigeon house, and they are notably flat on top, with steep rocky cliffs surrounding them. As far as we could see, the trees in this country appeared to be sturdy and tall. For the past two days, the observed latitude has been 12 or 14 miles further south than the ship's log indicates, which can only be due to a current pushing us south.

Monday, 23rd. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze at East, which in the night veer'd to North-East and North. At 1/2 past 4 P.M., being about 5 Miles from the Land, we Tack'd and stood off South-East and East until 4 A.M., at which time we Tack'd and stood in, being then about 9 or 10 Leagues from the land. At 8, it fell little wind, and soon after Calm. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 35 degrees 38 minutes and about 6 Leagues from the land, Mount Dromedary bearing South 37 degrees West, distant 17 Leagues, and the Pidgeon house North 40 degrees West; in this situation had 74 fathoms.

Monday, 23rd. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze coming from the east, which shifted to the northeast and north at night. At 4:30 PM, being about 5 miles from the land, we tacked and headed southeast and east until 4 AM, at which point we tacked again and sailed back in, being then about 9 or 10 leagues from shore. At 8, the wind dropped significantly, and soon after, it was calm. At noon, we measured our position to be at a latitude of 35 degrees 38 minutes, about 6 leagues from the land, with Mount Dromedary at a bearing of south 37 degrees west, 17 leagues away, and the Pidgeon house north 40 degrees west; at this position we had 74 fathoms.

Tuesday, 24th. In the P.M. had Variable light Airs and Calms until 6 o'Clock, at which time a breeze sprung up at North by West; at this time we had 70 fathoms Water, being about 4 or 5 Leagues from the land, the Pidgeon house bearing North 40 degrees West, Mount Dromedary South 30 degrees West, and the Northermost land in sight North 19 degrees East. Stood to the North-East until Noon, having a Gentle breeze at North-West, at which time we Tack'd and stood to the Westward, being then, by observation, in the Latitude of 35 degrees 10 minutes South and Longitude 208 degrees 51 minutes West. A point of land which I named Cape St. George, we having discovered it on that Saint's day, bore West, distant 19 Miles, and the Pidgeon house South 7 degrees West, the Latitude and Longitude of which I found to be 35 degrees 19 minutes South and 209 degrees 42 minutes West. In the morning we found the Variation to be, by the Amplitude, 7 degrees 50 minutes East, by several Azimuths 7 degrees 54 minutes East.

Tuesday, 24th. In the afternoon, we had light variable winds and calm conditions until 6 o'clock, when a breeze picked up from the North by West. At that time, we were in 70 fathoms of water, about 4 or 5 leagues from the shore, with the Pigeon house at North 40 degrees West, Mount Dromedary at South 30 degrees West, and the northernmost land visible at North 19 degrees East. We headed northeast until noon, with a gentle breeze coming from the northwest. At that point, we tacked and headed west, having determined our position to be at a latitude of 35 degrees 10 minutes South and a longitude of 208 degrees 51 minutes West. A point of land that I named Cape St. George was to the west, 19 miles away, while the Pigeon house was at South 7 degrees West. I recorded its latitude and longitude as 35 degrees 19 minutes South and 209 degrees 42 minutes West. In the morning, we found the magnetic variation to be 7 degrees 50 minutes East by amplitude, and 7 degrees 54 minutes East by several azimuths.

[Off Jervis Bay, New South Wales.]

[Off Jervis Bay, New South Wales.]

Wednesday, 25th. In the P.M. had a fresh breeze at North-West until 3 o'Clock, at which time it came to West, and we Tack'd and stood to the Northward. At 5 o'Clock, being about 5 or 6 Leagues from the land, the Pidgeon house bearing West-South-West, distant 9 Leagues, sounded and had 86 fathoms. At 8, being very squally, with lightning, we close reef'd the Topsails and brought too, being then in 120 fathoms. At 3 A.M. made sail again to the Northward, having the advantage of a fresh Gale at South-West. At Noon we were about 3 or 4 Leagues from the land and in the Latitude of 34 degrees 22 minutes and Longitude 208 degrees 36 minutes West. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon is North by East 49 Miles. In the Course of this day's run we saw the Smoke of fire in several places near the Sea beach. About 2 Leagues to the Northward of Cape St. George the Shore seems to form a bay,* (* Jervis Bay, a very fine port, but little use has been made of it up to the present time.) which appear'd to be shelter'd from the North-East winds; but as we had the wind it was not in my power to look into it, and the appearance was not favourable enough to induce me to loose time in beating up to it. The North point of this bay, on account of its Figure, I nam'd Long Nose. Latitude 45 degrees 4 minutes South, 8 Leagues to the Northward of this, is a point which I call'd Red Point; some part of the Land about it appeared of that Colour (Latitude 34 degrees 29 minutes South, Longitude 208 degrees 49 minutes West). A little way inland to the North-West of this point is a round hill, the top of which look'd like the Crown of a Hatt.

Wednesday, 25th. In the afternoon, we had a fresh breeze from the Northwest until 3 o’clock, when it shifted to the West, and we tacked and headed North. At 5 o’clock, being about 5 or 6 leagues from land, with the Pigeon House bearing West-Southwest, 9 leagues away, we took soundings and found 86 fathoms. At 8, facing very squally weather with lightning, we closely reefed the topsails and brought the ship to a halt, sitting in 120 fathoms. At 3 A.M., we set sail again to the Northward, benefiting from a strong gale from the Southwest. At noon, we were about 3 or 4 leagues from the shore, in latitude 34 degrees 22 minutes and longitude 208 degrees 36 minutes West. The course and distance traveled since yesterday noon was North by East for 49 miles. During today's journey, we noticed smoke rising from fires in several places near the beach. About 2 leagues north of Cape St. George, the shore seems to form a bay,* (*Jervis Bay, a very good port, but little use has been made of it so far.) which appeared to be sheltered from the Northeast winds; however, with the wind we had, I could not check it out, and the conditions weren’t good enough to make me want to waste time trying to reach it. I named the northern point of this bay Long Nose, due to its shape. Latitude 45 degrees 4 minutes South, 8 leagues to the North is a point I called Red Point; some parts of the land around it appeared to have that color (latitude 34 degrees 29 minutes South, longitude 208 degrees 49 minutes West). A short distance inland to the Northwest of this point is a round hill, the top of which looked like the crown of a hat.

Thursday, 26th. Clear, serene weather. In the P.M. had a light breeze at North-North-West until 5, at which time it fell Calm, we being then about 3 or 4 Leagues from the land and in 48 fathoms. Variation by Azimuth 8 degrees 48 minutes East, the extreams of the land from North-East by North to South-West by South. Saw several smokes along shore before dark, and 2 or 3 times a fire. In the Night we lay becalm'd, driving in before the Sea, until one o'Clock A.M., at which time we got a breeze from the land, with which we steer'd North-East, being then in 38 fathoms water. At Noon it fell little Wind, and veer'd to North-East by North, we being then in the Latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes and Longitude 208 degrees 27 minutes West, and about 5 Leagues from the land, which extended from South 37 degrees West to North 1/2 East. In this Latitude are some White Clifts, which rise perpendicular from the Sea to a moderate height.

Thursday, 26th. Clear, calm weather. In the afternoon, we had a light breeze from the North-North-West until 5 PM, when it became completely still. We were about 3 or 4 leagues from shore and in 48 fathoms of water. The variation by Azimuth was 8 degrees 48 minutes East, with the extremes of the land stretching from North-East by North to South-West by South. We saw several smoke plumes along the shore before dark, and 2 or 3 fires. During the night, we remained becalmed, drifting with the waves until 1 AM, at which point we caught a breeze from the land and steered North-East while in 38 fathoms of water. By noon, the wind died down a bit and shifted to North-East by North. We were then at a latitude of 34 degrees 10 minutes and a longitude of 208 degrees 27 minutes West, about 5 leagues from the land, which extended from South 37 degrees West to North 1/2 East. In this latitude, there are some white cliffs that rise steeply from the sea to a moderate height.

Friday, 27th. Var'ble light Airs between the North-East and North-West, clear pleasant weather. In the P.M. stood off Shore until 2, then Tackt and Stood in till 6, at which time we tack'd and stood off, being then in 54 fathoms and about 4 or 5 miles from the land, the Extreams of which bore from South, 28 degrees West to North 25 degrees 30 minutes East. At 12 we tack'd and stood in until 4 A.M., then made a Trip off until day light, after which we stood in for the land; in all this time we lost ground, owing a good deal to the Variableness of the winds, for at Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 34 degrees 21 minutes South, Red Point bearing South 27 degrees West, distant 3 Leagues. In this Situation we were about 4 or 5 Miles from the land, which extended from South 19 degrees 30 minutes West to North 29 degrees East.

Friday, 27th. Variable light winds from the Northeast to Northwest, clear and pleasant weather. In the afternoon, we stayed off the shore until 2, then tacked and headed in until 6, at which time we tacked and headed back out, being in 54 fathoms and about 4 or 5 miles from the land, which extended from South 28 degrees West to North 25 degrees 30 minutes East. At 12, we tacked and headed in again until 4 A.M., then made a trip out until daylight, after which we sailed in toward the land; during all this time we lost ground, mainly due to the changing winds, because at noon we were observed to be at a latitude of 34 degrees 21 minutes South, with Red Point bearing South 27 degrees West, 3 leagues away. In this position, we were about 4 or 5 miles from the land, which extended from South 19 degrees 30 minutes West to North 29 degrees East.

Saturday, 28th. In the P.M. hoisted out the Pinnace and Yawl in order to attempt a landing, but the Pinnace took in the Water so fast that she was obliged to be hoisted in again to stop her leakes. At this time we saw several people a shore, 4 of whom where carrying a small Boat or Canoe, which we imagin'd they were going to put in to the Water in order to Come off to us; but in this we were mistaken. Being now not above 2 Miles from the Shore Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Tupia, and myself put off in the Yawl, and pull'd in for the land to a place where we saw 4 or 5 of the Natives, who took to the Woods as we approached the Shore; which disappointed us in the expectation we had of getting a near View of them, if not to speak to them. But our disappointment was heightened when we found that we no where could effect a landing by reason of the great Surf which beat everywhere upon the shore. We saw haul'd up upon the beach 3 or 4 small Canoes, which to us appeared not much unlike the Small ones of New Zeland. In the wood were several Trees of the Palm kind, and no under wood; and this was all we were able to observe from the boat, after which we return'd to the Ship about 5 in the evening.* (* The place where Cook attempted to land is near Bulli, a place where there is now considerable export of coal. A large coal port, Wollongong, lies a little to the southward.) At this time it fell Calm, and we were not above a Mile and a half from the Shore, in 11 fathoms, and within some breakers that lay to the Southward of us; but luckily a light breeze came off from the Land, which carried us out of danger, and with which we stood to the Northward. At daylight in the morning we discover'd a Bay,* (* Botany Bay.) which appeared to be tollerably well shelter'd from all winds, into which I resolved to go with the Ship, and with this View sent the Master in the Pinnace to sound the Entrance, while we keept turning up with the Ship, having the wind right out. At noon the Entrance bore North-North-West, distance 1 Mile.

Saturday, 28th. In the afternoon, we lowered the Pinnace and Yawl to try and land, but the Pinnace took on water so quickly that we had to pull it back in to fix the leaks. At that time, we spotted several people on the shore, four of whom were carrying a small boat or canoe, which we thought they were going to launch to come over to us, but we were wrong. Being only about 2 miles from the shore, Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, Tupia, and I set off in the Yawl and rowed toward the land to a spot where we saw 4 or 5 natives, who ran into the woods as we approached the shore; this was disappointing as we had hoped to get a closer look at them, if not even to speak with them. Our disappointment grew when we found we couldn't land anywhere due to the heavy surf crashing along the shore. We saw 3 or 4 small canoes pulled up on the beach, which looked somewhat similar to the small ones from New Zealand. In the woods, there were several palm trees, and no underbrush; this was all we could observe from the boat, after which we returned to the ship around 5 in the evening.* (* The place where Cook tried to land is near Bulli, a place that currently has significant coal exports. A major coal port, Wollongong, is just a little to the south.) At this point, it became calm, and we were about a mile and a half from the shore in 11 fathoms, just within some breakers to the south of us; luckily, a light breeze came off the land, which carried us to safety, and we headed north. At dawn the next morning, we discovered a bay,* (* Botany Bay.) which seemed to be fairly sheltered from all winds, and I decided to take the ship in there. To prepare for this, I sent the Master in the Pinnace to sound the entrance while we kept maneuvering the ship with the wind blowing straight out. By noon, the entrance was bearing North-North-West, a distance of 1 mile.

[At Anchor, Botany Bay, New South Wales.]

[At Anchor, Botany Bay, New South Wales.]

Sunday, 29th. In the P.M. wind Southerly and Clear weather, with which we stood into the bay and Anchored under the South shore about 2 miles within the Entrance in 5 fathoms, the South point bearing South-East and the North point East. Saw, as we came in, on both points of the bay, several of the Natives and a few hutts; Men, Women, and Children on the South Shore abreast of the Ship, to which place I went in the Boats in hopes of speaking with them, accompanied by Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia. As we approached the Shore they all made off, except 2 Men, who seem'd resolved to oppose our landing. As soon as I saw this I order'd the boats to lay upon their Oars, in order to speak to them; but this was to little purpose, for neither us nor Tupia could understand one word they said. We then threw them some nails, beads, etc., a shore, which they took up, and seem'd not ill pleased with, in so much that I thought that they beckon'd to us to come ashore; but in this we were mistaken, for as soon as we put the boat in they again came to oppose us, upon which I fir'd a musquet between the 2, which had no other Effect than to make them retire back, where bundles of their darts lay, and one of them took up a stone and threw at us, which caused my firing a Second Musquet, load with small Shott; and altho' some of the shott struck the man, yet it had no other effect than making him lay hold on a Target. Immediately after this we landed, which we had no sooner done than they throw'd 2 darts at us; this obliged me to fire a third shott, soon after which they both made off, but not in such haste but what we might have taken one; but Mr. Banks being of Opinion that the darts were poisoned, made me cautious how I advanced into the Woods. We found here a few small hutts made of the Bark of Trees, in one of which were 4 or 5 Small Children, with whom we left some strings of beads, etc. A quantity of Darts lay about the Hutts; these we took away with us. 3 Canoes lay upon the beach, the worst I think I ever saw; they were about 12 or 14 feet long, made of one piece of the Bark of a Tree, drawn or tied up at each end, and the middle keept open by means of pieces of Stick by way of Thwarts. After searching for fresh water without success, except a little in a Small hole dug in the Sand, we embarqued, and went over to the North point of the bay, where in coming in we saw several people; but when we landed now there were nobody to be seen. We found here some fresh Water, which came trinkling down and stood in pools among the rocks; but as this was troublesome to come at I sent a party of men ashore in the morning to the place where we first landed to dig holes in the sand, by which means and a Small stream they found fresh Water sufficient to Water the Ship. The String of Beads, etc., we had left with the Children last night were found laying in the Hutts this morning; probably the Natives were afraid to take them away. After breakfast we sent some Empty Casks a shore and a party of Men to cut wood, and I went myself in the Pinnace to sound and explore the Bay, in the doing of which I saw some of the Natives; but they all fled at my Approach. I landed in 2 places, one of which the people had but just left, as there were small fires and fresh Muscles broiling upon them; here likewise lay Vast heaps of the largest Oyster Shells I ever saw.

Sunday, 29th. In the afternoon, the wind was from the south, and the weather was clear, so we headed into the bay and anchored about 2 miles inside the entrance in 5 fathoms of water, with the south point to the southeast and the north point to the east. As we entered, we saw several natives on both points of the bay, along with a few huts; men, women, and children on the south shore near the ship. I went ashore with Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and Tupia, hoping to talk to them. But as we got closer, everyone ran away except for two men who seemed determined to prevent us from landing. I ordered the boats to stop so we could communicate, but it was of little help since neither we nor Tupia could understand what they were saying. We then threw them some nails and beads onshore, which they picked up and seemed pleased with; it even looked like they were beckoning us to come ashore. However, we misunderstood, because as soon as we approached, they came to block us again. I fired a musket between the two, which only made them retreat to where some bundles of their darts were. One of them picked up a stone and threw it at us, prompting me to fire a second musket loaded with small shot; although some of the shot hit the man, it only made him grab a target. We landed immediately after this, but no sooner had we done so than they threw two darts at us. This forced me to fire a third shot, after which they both ran away, though not quickly enough that we couldn’t have caught one. Mr. Banks thought the darts might be poisoned, so I was cautious about advancing into the woods. We found a few small huts made of tree bark, in one of which were 4 or 5 small children; we left them some strings of beads, etc. There were many darts scattered around the huts, which we took with us. Three canoes were on the beach; they were the worst I think I’ve ever seen, about 12 or 14 feet long, made from a single piece of tree bark, tied at both ends, with the middle open supported by sticks acting as thwarts. After searching for fresh water unsuccessfully except for a little in a small hole dug in the sand, we embarked and crossed over to the north point of the bay, where we had seen several people as we came in, but now there was no one to be seen. We found some fresh water trickling down and forming pools among the rocks; but since it was difficult to access, I sent a team of men ashore in the morning to the place where we first landed to dig holes in the sand. By doing this and using a small stream, they found enough fresh water to supply the ship. The strings of beads and other items we left with the children last night were found lying in the huts this morning; probably the natives were afraid to take them. After breakfast, we sent some empty barrels ashore and a group of men to collect wood. I went myself in the pinnace to sound the bay and explore, during which I saw some of the natives, but they all ran away when I approached. I landed in two places; at one, the people had just left, as there were small fires and fresh mussels cooking on them; also, there were huge piles of the largest oyster shells I had ever seen.

Monday, 30th. As Soon as the Wooders and Waterers were come on board to Dinner 10 or 12 of the Natives came to the watering place, and took away their Canoes that lay there, but did not offer to touch any one of our Casks that had been left ashore; and in the afternoon 16 or 18 of them came boldly up to within 100 yards of our people at the watering place, and there made a stand. Mr. Hicks, who was the Officer ashore, did all in his power to intice them to him by offering them presents; but it was to no purpose, all they seem'd to want was for us to be gone. After staying a Short time they went away. They were all Arm'd with Darts and wooden Swords; the darts have each 4 prongs, and pointed with fish bones. Those we have seen seem to be intended more for striking fish than offensive Weapons; neither are they poisoned, as we at first thought. After I had return'd from sounding the Bay I went over to a Cove on the North side of the Bay, where, in 3 or 4 Hauls with the Sean, we caught about 300 pounds weight of Fish, which I caused to be equally divided among the Ship's Company. In the A.M. I went in the Pinnace to sound and explore the North side of the bay, where I neither met with inhabitants or anything remarkable. Mr. Green took the Sun's Meridian Altitude a little within the South Entrance of the Bay, which gave the Latitude 34 degrees 0 minutes South.

Monday, 30th. As soon as the wood and water crew came on board for dinner, about 10 or 12 locals arrived at the water source and took their canoes that were there, but didn't touch any of our barrels left on the shore. In the afternoon, 16 or 18 of them approached boldly within 100 yards of our people at the watering place and made their stand. Mr. Hicks, the officer on shore, tried his best to draw them in by offering gifts, but it was pointless; all they seemed to want was for us to leave. After a short while, they left. They were all armed with darts and wooden swords; the darts had four prongs and were tipped with fish bones. The ones we saw appeared more suited for fishing than for combat; they also weren't poisoned, as we initially thought. After returning from checking the bay's depth, I went over to a cove on the north side of the bay, where, in 3 or 4 hauls with the seine, we caught about 300 pounds of fish, which I distributed evenly among the ship's crew. In the morning, I took the pinnace to sound and explore the north side of the bay, where I didn’t encounter any inhabitants or anything notable. Mr. Green recorded the sun's meridian altitude just inside the south entrance of the bay, which gave the latitude as 34 degrees 0 minutes south.

[May 1770.]

[May 1770.]

Tuesday, May 1st. Gentle breezes, Northerly. In the P.M. 10 of the Natives again visited the Watering place. I, being on board at this time, went immediately ashore, but before I got there they were going away. I follow'd them alone and unarm'd some distance along shore, but they would not stop until they got farther off than I choose to trust myself. These were armed in the same manner as those that came Yesterday. In the evening I sent some hands to haul the Saine, but they caught but a very few fish. A little after sunrise I found the Variation to be 11 degrees 3 minutes East. Last night Forby Sutherland, Seaman, departed this Life, and in the A.M. his body Was buried ashore at the watering place, which occasioned my calling the south point of this bay after his name. This morning a party of us went ashore to some Hutts, not far from the Watering place, where some of the Natives are daily seen; here we left several articles, such as Cloth, Looking Glasses, Coombs, Beads, Nails, etc.; after this we made an Excursion into the Country, which we found diversified with Woods, Lawns, and Marshes. The woods are free from underwood of every kind, and the trees are at such a distance from one another that the whole Country, or at least great part of it, might be Cultivated without being obliged to cut down a single tree. We found the Soil every where, except in the Marshes, to be a light white sand, and produceth a quantity of good Grass, which grows in little Tufts about as big as one can hold in one's hand, and pretty close to one another; in this manner the Surface of the Ground is Coated. In the woods between the Trees Dr. Solander had a bare sight of a Small Animal something like a Rabbit, and we found the Dung of an Animal* (* This was the kangaroo.) which must feed upon Grass, and which, we judge, could not be less than a Deer; we also saw the Track of a Dog, or some such like Animal. We met with some Hutts and places where the Natives had been, and at our first setting out one of them was seen; the others, I suppose, had fled upon our Approach. I saw some Trees that had been cut down by the Natives with some sort of a Blunt instrument, and several Trees that were barqued, the bark of which had been cut by the same instrument; in many of the Trees, especially the Palms, were cut steps of about 3 or 4 feet asunder for the conveniency of Climbing them. We found 2 Sorts of Gum, one sort of which is like Gum Dragon, and is the same, I suppose, Tasman took for Gum lac; it is extracted from the largest tree in the Woods.

Tuesday, May 1st. Gentle breezes from the north. In the afternoon, 10 of the locals visited the watering place again. I was on board at the time and went ashore immediately, but by the time I arrived, they were leaving. I followed them alone and unarmed along the shore for a while, but they wouldn’t stop until they were farther away than I felt comfortable going. They were armed just like the ones who came yesterday. In the evening, I sent some crew members to haul the seine, but they only caught a few fish. A little after sunrise, I found the variation to be 11 degrees 3 minutes east. Last night, Forby Sutherland, a seaman, passed away, and in the morning, we buried his body ashore at the watering place, which is why I named the southern point of this bay after him. This morning, a group of us went ashore to some huts not far from the watering place, where we often see some of the locals; here we left several items like cloth, mirrors, combs, beads, nails, etc. After that, we took a trip into the countryside, which we found to be a mix of woods, fields, and marshes. The woods had no underbrush and the trees were spaced out enough that most of the area could be cultivated without cutting down any trees. We found the soil everywhere, except in the marshes, to be light white sand, producing a decent amount of good grass that grows in little tufts, about the size of a handful, and fairly close together, covering the ground. In the woods between the trees, Dr. Solander spotted a small animal similar to a rabbit, and we found droppings from an animal (*this was the kangaroo*) that must eat grass, which we believe could not be smaller than a deer; we also saw the tracks of a dog or a similar animal. We came across some huts and places where the locals had been, and at the beginning of our journey, we saw one of them; the others probably fled when we approached. I noticed some trees that had been cut down by the locals with some kind of blunt tool, and several trees that had been stripped of bark in the same way; many of the trees, especially the palms, had cut steps about 3 or 4 feet apart for easier climbing. We found two types of gum; one type is similar to gum dragon, which I believe is what Tasman mistook for gum lac; it's sourced from the largest tree in the woods.

Wednesday, 2nd. Between 3 and 4 in the P.M. we return'd out of the Country, and after Dinner went ashore to the watering place, where we had not been long before 17 or 18 of the Natives appeared in sight. In the morning I had sent Mr. Gore, with a boat, up to the head of the Bay to drudge for Oysters; in his return to the Ship he and another person came by land, and met with these people, who followed him at the Distance of 10 or 20 Yards. Whenever Mr. Gore made a stand and faced them they stood also, and notwithstanding they were all Arm'd, they never offer'd to Attack him; but after he had parted from them, and they were met by Dr. Monkhouse and one or 2 more, who, upon making a Sham retreat, they throw'd 3 darts after them, after which they began to retire. Dr. Solander, I, and Tupia made all the haste we could after them, but could not, either by words or Actions, prevail upon them to come near us, Mr. Gore saw some up the Bay, who by signs invited him ashore, which he prudently declined. In the A.M. had the wind in the South-East with rain, which prevented me from making an Excursion up the head of the bay as I intended.

Wednesday, 2nd. Between 3 and 4 PM, we returned from the countryside, and after dinner, we went ashore to the watering place. It wasn't long before 17 or 18 of the locals came into view. In the morning, I had sent Mr. Gore, along with a boat, to the head of the bay to look for oysters; on his way back to the ship, he and another person came by land and encountered these people, who followed him at a distance of 10 or 20 yards. Whenever Mr. Gore paused and faced them, they stopped too, and even though they were all armed, they never attempted to attack him. However, after he separated from them and was met by Dr. Monkhouse and one or two others, they pretended to retreat and threw three darts after them, after which they began to back off. Dr. Solander, I, and Tupia rushed after them as quickly as we could, but we couldn't get them to come closer with either words or actions. Mr. Gore spotted some up the bay who signaled for him to come ashore, which he wisely declined. In the morning, the wind was coming from the southeast with rain, which stopped me from making the excursion to the head of the bay as I had planned.

Thursday, 3rd. Winds at South-East, a Gentle breeze and fair weather. In the P.M. I made a little excursion along the Sea Coast to the Southward, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. At our first entering the woods we saw 3 of the Natives, who made off as soon as they saw us; more of them were seen by others of our people, who likewise made off as soon as they found they were discover'd. In the A.M. I went in the Pinnace to the head of the bay, accompanied by Drs. Solander and Monkhouse, in order to Examine the Country, and to try to form some Connections with the Natives. In our way thither we met with 10 or 12 of them fishing, each in a Small Canoe, who retir'd into Shoald water upon our approach. Others again we saw at the first place we landed at, who took to their Canoes, and fled before we came near them; after this we took Water, and went almost to the head of the inlet, were we landed and Travel'd some distance in land. We found the face of the Country much the same as I have before described, but the land much richer for instead of sand I found in many places a deep black soil, which we thought was Capable of producing any kind of grain. At present it produceth, besides Timber, as fine Meadow as ever was seen; however, we found it not all like this, some few places were very rocky, but this, I believe, to be uncommon. The stone is sandy, and very proper for building, etc. After we had sufficiently examin'd this part we return'd to the Boat, and seeing some Smoke and Canoes at another part we went thither, in hopes of meeting with the people, but they made off as we approached. There were 6 Canoes and 6 small fires near the Shore, and Muscles roasting upon them, and a few Oysters laying near; from this we conjectured that there had been just 6 people, who had been out each in his Canoe picking up the Shell fish, and come a Shore to eat them, where each had made his fire to dress them by. We tasted of their Cheer, and left them in return Strings of beads, etc. The day being now far spent, we set out on our return to the Ship.

Thursday, 3rd. Winds from the South-East, a gentle breeze and nice weather. In the afternoon, I took a short trip along the coastline to the south with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. As we first entered the woods, we spotted three locals, who ran away as soon as they saw us; others were seen by our crew, who also fled when they realized they were spotted. In the morning, I went in the pinnace to the head of the bay, accompanied by Drs. Solander and Monkhouse, to explore the area and try to make contact with the locals. On our way, we encountered about 10 or 12 of them fishing, each in a small canoe, who retreated into shallow water when we approached. We also saw more at the first place we landed who jumped into their canoes and escaped before we got close. After this, we took to the water again and went almost to the end of the inlet, where we landed and traveled some distance inland. The landscape looked much like what I had described before, but the land was much richer; instead of sand, we found deep black soil in many areas, which we thought could support any kind of grain. Right now, in addition to timber, it has some of the finest meadows you can imagine; however, not all of it was like this—some areas were quite rocky, though I believe that's unusual. The stone is sandy and very suitable for building, etc. After we thoroughly examined this area, we returned to the boat. Seeing some smoke and canoes nearby, we headed there, hoping to find the people, but they fled as we got closer. There were six canoes and six small fires near the shore, with mussels roasting on them and a few oysters nearby; from this, we guessed that six people had been out in their canoes collecting shellfish and had come ashore to eat, with each making their own fire to cook them. We tried some of their food and left them strings of beads, etc. As the day was getting late, we started our return to the ship.

Friday, 4th. Winds northerly, serene weather. Upon my return to the Ship in the evening I found that none of the Natives had Appear'd near the Watering place, but about 20 of them had been fishing in their Canoes at no great distance from us. In the A.M., as the Wind would not permit us to sail, I sent out some parties into the Country to try to form some Connections with the Natives. One of the Midshipmen met with a very old man and Woman and 2 Small Children; they were Close to the Water side, where several more were in their Canoes gathering of Shell fish, and he, being alone, was afraid to make any stay with the 2 old People least he should be discovr'd by those in the Canoes. He gave them a bird he had Shott, which they would not Touch; neither did they speak one word, but seem'd to be much frightned. They were quite Naked; even the Woman had nothing to cover her nudities. Dr. Monkhouse and another Man being in the Woods, not far from the watering place, discover'd 6 more of the Natives, who at first seem'd to wait his coming; but as he was going up to them he had a dart thrown at him out of a Tree, which narrowly escaped him. As soon as the fellow had thrown the dart he descended the Tree and made off, and with him all the rest, and these were all that were met with in the Course of this day.

Friday, 4th. The wind was coming from the north, and the weather was calm. When I returned to the ship in the evening, I noticed that none of the locals had come near the watering spot, but about 20 of them had been fishing in their canoes not too far away. In the morning, since the wind wouldn’t allow us to sail, I sent some groups into the countryside to try to connect with the locals. One of the midshipmen encountered a very old man and woman along with two small children; they were close to the water where several others were in their canoes collecting shellfish. He was alone, so he was afraid to stay with the two old people in case he was spotted by those in the canoes. He offered them a bird he had shot, but they wouldn’t touch it; they didn’t speak at all but seemed very frightened. They were completely naked; even the woman had nothing to cover herself. Dr. Monkhouse and another man were in the woods, not far from the watering place, and spotted six more locals who initially seemed to wait for him to approach. However, as he was walking toward them, someone threw a dart at him from a tree, which just barely missed him. After throwing the dart, the man climbed down the tree and ran away, taking all the others with him. These were the only locals encountered during the day.

Saturday, 5th. In the P.M. I went with a party of Men over to the North Shore, and while some hands were hauling the Sean, a party of us made an Excursion of 3 or 4 Miles into the Country, or rather along the Sea Coast. We met with nothing remarkable; great part of the Country for some distance inland from the Sea Coast is mostly a barren heath, diversified with Marshes and Morasses. Upon our return to the Boat we found they had caught a great number of small fish, which the sailors call leather Jackets on account of their having a very thick skin; they are known in the West Indies. I had sent the Yawl in the morning to fish for Sting rays, who returned in the Evening with upwards of four hundred weight; one single one weigh'd 240 pounds Exclusive of the entrails. In the A.M., as the wind Continued Northerly, I sent the Yawl again a fishing, and I went with a party of Men into the Country, but met with nothing extraordinary.

Saturday, 5th. In the afternoon, I went with a group of men to the North Shore, and while some were pulling in the Sean, a few of us took a trip about 3 or 4 miles into the countryside, or rather along the coastline. We didn’t see anything noteworthy; much of the land for some distance inland from the coastline is mostly barren heath, scattered with marshes and bogs. When we returned to the boat, we found they had caught a lot of small fish, which the sailors call leather jackets because they have very thick skin; they're known in the West Indies. I had sent the yawl out in the morning to catch stingrays, and it returned in the evening with over four hundred pounds; one weighed 240 pounds without the entrails. In the morning, as the wind continued from the north, I sent the yawl out fishing again, and I went with a group of men into the countryside, but we didn’t find anything unusual.

[Description of Botany Bay, New South Wales.]

[Description of Botany Bay, New South Wales.]

Sunday, 6th. In the evening the Yawl return'd from fishing, having Caught 2 Sting rays weighing near 600 pounds. The great quantity of plants Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander found in this place occasioned my giving it the Name of Botany Bay.* (* The Bay was at first called Stingray Bay. The plan of it at the Admiralty is called by this name, and none of the logs know Botany Bay. It seems probable that Cook finally settled on the name after the ship left, and when Banks had had time to examine his collections. A monument was erected in 1870 near the spot, on the southern side, where Cook first landed. Botany Bay was intended to be the site where the first settlement of convicts should be made, but on the arrival of Captain Phillip, on January 18th, 1788, he found it so unsuited for the number of his colony that he started in a boat to examine Broken Bay. On his way he went into Port Jackson, and immediately decided on settling there. On the 25th and 26th the ships went round, and Sydney was founded.) It is situated in the Latitude of 34 degrees 0 minutes South, Longitude 208 degrees 37 minutes West. It is capacious, safe, and Commodious; it may be known by the land on the Sea Coast, which is of a pretty even and moderate height, Rather higher than it is inland, with steep rocky Clifts next the Sea, and looks like a long Island lying close under the Shore. The Entrance of the Bay lies about the Middle of this land. In coming from the Southward it is discover'd before you are abreast of it, which you cannot do in coming from the Northward; the entrance is little more than a Quarter of a Mile broad, and lies in West-North-West. To sail into it keep the South shore on board until within a small bare Island, which lies close under the North Shore. Being within that Island the deepest of Water is on that side, 7, 6 and 5 fathoms a good way up; there is Shoald Water a good way off from the South Shore--from the inner South Point quite to the head of the harbour; but over towards the North and North-West Shore is a Channell of 12 or 14 feet at low Water, 3 or 4 Leagues up, to a place where there is 3 or 4 fathoms; but there I found very little fresh Water. We Anchor'd near the South Shore about a Mile within the Entrance for the Conveniency of Sailing with a Southerly wind and the getting of Fresh Water; but I afterwards found a very fine stream of fresh Water on the North shore in the first sandy Cove within the Island, before which the Ship might lay almost land locked, and wood for fuel may be got everywhere. Although wood is here in great plenty, yet there is very little Variety; the bigest trees are as large or larger than our Oaks in England, and grows a good deal like them, and Yields a reddish Gum; the wood itself is heavy, hard, and black like Lignum Vitae. Another sort that grows tall and Strait something like Pines--the wood of this is hard and Ponderous, and something of the Nature of America live Oak. These 2 are all the Timber trees I met with; there are a few sorts of Shrubs and several Palm Trees and Mangroves about the Head of the Harbour. The Country is woody, low, and flat as far in as we could see, and I believe that the Soil is in general sandy. In the Wood are a variety of very beautiful birds, such as Cocatoos, Lorryquets, Parrots, etc., and crows Exactly like those we have in England. Water fowl is no less plenty about the head of the Harbour, where there is large flats of sand and Mud, on which they seek their food; the most of these were unknown to us, one sort especially, which was black and white, and as large as a Goose, but most like a Pelican.* (* Most probably the Black and White or Semipalmated Goose, now exterminated in these parts.) On the sand and Mud banks are Oysters, Muscles, Cockles, etc., which I believe are the Chief support of the inhabitants, who go into Shoald Water with their little Canoes and peck them out of the sand and Mud with their hands, and sometimes roast and Eat them in the Canoe, having often a fire for that purpose, as I suppose, for I know no other it can be for. The Natives do not appear to be numerous, neither do they seem to live in large bodies, but dispers'd in small parties along by the Water side. Those I saw were about as tall as Europeans, of a very dark brown Colour, but not black, nor had they woolly, frizled hair, but black and lank like ours. No sort of Cloathing or Ornaments were ever seen by any of us upon any one of them, or in or about any of their Hutts; from which I conclude that they never wear any. Some that we saw had their faces and bodies painted with a sort of White Paint or Pigment. Altho' I have said that shell fish is their Chief support, yet they catch other sorts of fish, some of which we found roasting on the fire the first time we landed; some of these they strike with Gigs,* (* A fishing implement like a trident.) and others they catch with hook and line; we have seen them strike fish with gigs, and hooks and lines are found in their Hutts. Sting rays, I believe, they do not eat, because I never saw the least remains of one near any of their Hutts or fire places. However, we could know but very little of their Customs, as we never were able to form any Connections with them; they had not so much as touch'd the things we had left in their Hutts on purpose for them to take away. During our stay in this Harbour I caused the English Colours to be display'd ashore every day, and an inscription to be cut out upon one of the Trees near the Watering place, setting forth the Ship's Name, Date, etc. [Off Port Jackson, New South Wales.]Having seen everything this place afforded, we, at daylight in the morning, weigh'd with a light breeze at North-West, and put to Sea, and the wind soon after coming to the Southward we steer'd along shore North-North-East, and at Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 33 degrees 50 minutes South, about 2 or 3 Miles from the Land, and abreast of a Bay, wherein there appear'd to be safe Anchorage, which I called Port Jackson.* (* Cook having completed his water at Botany Bay, and having many hundreds of miles of coast before him, did not examine Port Jackson, the magnificent harbour in which Sydney, the capital of New South Wales, now lies. His chart gives the shape of what he could see very accurately, but the main arm of the harbour is hidden from the sea. He named the bay after Mr. (afterwards Sir George) Jackson, one of the Secretaries of the Admiralty. This fact is recorded on a tablet in the Bishop Stortford Church to the memory of Sir George Duckett, which name Sir George had assumed in later years. This interesting evidence was brought to light by Sir Alfred Stephen, Lieutenant-Governor of New South Wales, and puts an end to the legend which was long current, that Port Jackson was named after a sailor who first saw it. There was, moreover, no person of the name of Jackson on board.) It lies 3 leagues to the Northward of Botany Bay. I had almost forgot to mention that it is high water in this Bay at the full and change of the Moon about 8 o'Clock, and rises and falls upon a Perpendicular about 4 or 5 feet.

Sunday, 6th. In the evening, the Yawl returned from fishing, having caught 2 sting rays weighing nearly 600 pounds. The large amount of plants Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander found here led me to name it Botany Bay.* (* The bay was initially called Stingray Bay. The Admiralty’s plan refers to it as such, and none of the logs mention Botany Bay. It’s likely that Cook decided on the name after leaving the ship, once Banks had time to examine his collections. A monument was put up in 1870 near the spot where Cook first landed, on the southern side. Botany Bay was intended to be where the first convict settlement would be established, but when Captain Phillip arrived on January 18th, 1788, he found it unsuitable for his colony's size and headed out in a boat to explore Broken Bay. On his way, he entered Port Jackson and immediately decided to settle there. On the 25th and 26th, the ships went around, and Sydney was founded.) It is located at a latitude of 34 degrees 0 minutes South, longitude 208 degrees 37 minutes West. It is spacious, safe, and convenient; it can be identified by the coastline, which is fairly flat and moderate in height, a bit taller than inland, with steep rocky cliffs by the sea, resembling a long island lying close to the shore. The bay’s entrance is roughly in the center of this land. Coming from the south, it can be spotted before you are even parallel to it, which doesn’t happen when approaching from the north; the entrance is just over a quarter of a mile wide and lies to the west-northwest. To sail in, keep the south shore on your left until you reach a small bare island close to the north shore. Once you're past that island, the deepest water is on that side: 7, 6, and 5 fathoms for quite a way up; there is shallow water far off from the south shore—from the inner south point all the way to the head of the harbor; but on the north and northwest shore is a channel with 12 or 14 feet at low water, extending 3 or 4 leagues up, to an area where there are 3 or 4 fathoms; however, I found very little fresh water there. We anchored near the south shore about a mile inside the entrance for the convenience of sailing with a southerly wind and obtaining fresh water; later, I found a very nice stream of fresh water on the north shore in the first sandy cove within the island, where the ship could almost be landlocked, and wood for fuel is readily available everywhere. While wood is abundant here, there's not much variety; the biggest trees are as large or larger than our oaks in England, and they grow somewhat like them, producing a reddish gum; the wood is heavy, hard, and black like Lignum Vitae. Another species grows tall and straight, somewhat like pines—the wood of this is hard and dense, somewhat similar to American live oak. These two are the only types of timber trees I encountered; there are a few types of shrubs and several palm trees and mangroves around the head of the harbor. The area is wooded, low, and flat as far in as we could see, and I believe the soil is generally sandy. The woods host a variety of beautiful birds, such as cockatoos, lorikeets, parrots, etc., as well as crows that look exactly like those we have in England. Waterfowl are also plentiful around the head of the harbor, where there are large flats of sand and mud that they forage on; most of these were unknown to us, especially one type that was black and white and as large as a goose, but most resembled a pelican.* (* Most likely the black and white or semipalmated goose, now extinct in these parts.) The sand and mud banks are home to oysters, muscles, cockles, etc., which I believe are the main food source for the inhabitants, who go into shallow water with their small canoes and gather them from the sand and mud with their hands, sometimes roasting and eating them in the canoe, likely having a fire for that purpose, as I can’t think of any other reason. The natives don't seem to be numerous, nor do they appear to live in large groups, but are scattered in small parties along the waterside. Those I saw were about as tall as Europeans, with a very dark brown skin, but not black, nor did they have woolly, frizzy hair; it was black and straight like ours. No kind of clothing or ornaments were ever seen by any of us on any of them or in or around their huts; from this, I conclude they never wear any. Some we encountered had their faces and bodies painted with a sort of white paint or pigment. Although I mentioned that shellfish is their main food source, they do catch other types of fish, some of which we found roasting on the fire the first time we landed; some they spear with gigs,* (* A fishing tool similar to a trident.) and others they catch using hooks and lines; we have observed them spear fish with gigs, and hooks and lines were found in their huts. I believe they do not eat sting rays, as I never saw any remains of one near their huts or fireplaces. However, we knew very little about their customs, as we were unable to form any connections with them; they didn’t even touch the items we left in their huts for them to take. During our time in this harbor, I had the English colors displayed onshore every day and an inscription carved into one of the trees near the watering place, stating the ship’s name, date, etc. [Off Port Jackson, New South Wales.] After examining everything this place had to offer, we set sail at dawn with a light breeze from the northwest and headed to sea, and soon after, when the wind shifted to the south, we steered along the shore to the north-northeast, and at noon, according to our observation, we were at a latitude of 33 degrees 50 minutes south, about 2 or 3 miles from land, and in front of a bay that appeared to have safe anchorage, which I named Port Jackson.* (* Cook, having completed his water supply at Botany Bay and with many hundreds of miles of coast ahead, did not explore Port Jackson, the magnificent harbor where Sydney, the capital of New South Wales, now lies. His chart accurately depicts the shape of what he could see, but the main arm of the harbor is hidden from view from the sea. He named the bay after Mr. (later Sir George) Jackson, one of the Secretaries of the Admiralty. This fact is marked on a tablet in Bishop Stortford Church, in memory of Sir George Duckett, a name that Sir George assumed in later years. This interesting fact was uncovered by Sir Alfred Stephen, Lieutenant-Governor of New South Wales, which ends the long-standing legend that Port Jackson was named after a sailor who first spotted it. Furthermore, there was no one named Jackson on board.) It lies 3 leagues to the north of Botany Bay. I almost forgot to mention that high tide in this bay occurs at the full and new moon at around 8 o'clock, rising and falling by about 4 or 5 feet.

Monday, 7th. Little wind, Southerly, and Serene pleasant Weather. In the P.M. found the Variation by several Azimuths to be 8 degrees East; at sunset the Northermost land in sight bore North 26 degrees East; and some broken land that appear'd to form a bay bore North 40 degrees West, distant 4 Leagues. This Bay I named Broken bay,* (* The Hawkesbury River, the largest on the east coast of Australia, runs into Broken Bay.) Latitude 33 degrees 36 minutes South. We steer'd along shore North-North-East all night at the distance of about 3 Leagues from the land, having from 32 to 36 fathoms, hard sandy bottom. A little after sun rise I took several Azimuths with 4 Needles belonging to the Azimuth Compass, the mean result of which gave the Variation of 7 degrees 56 minutes East. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 33 degrees 22 minutes South, and about 3 Leagues from the land, the Northermost part of which in sight bore North 19 degrees East. Some pretty high land which projected out in 3 bluff Points, and occasioned my calling it Cape 3 Points (Latitude 33 degrees 33 minutes South), bore South-West, distant 5 Leagues; Longitude made from Botany Bay 0 degrees 19 minutes East.

Monday, 7th. There was little wind, coming from the south, and the weather was pleasantly calm. In the afternoon, I determined the variation using several azimuths to be 8 degrees east; at sunset, the northernmost land I could see was at North 26 degrees East, and some broken land that looked like it formed a bay was at North 40 degrees West, about 4 leagues away. I named this bay Broken Bay.* (* The Hawkesbury River, the largest on the east coast of Australia, runs into Broken Bay.) Its latitude is 33 degrees 36 minutes South. We sailed along the shore to the North-North-East all night, about 3 leagues from the land, with depths ranging from 32 to 36 fathoms and a hard sandy bottom. Shortly after sunrise, I took several azimuth readings using four needles from the azimuth compass, and the average result indicated a variation of 7 degrees 56 minutes east. At noon, we were at a latitude of 33 degrees 22 minutes South, about 3 leagues from the shore, with the northernmost part of the land in sight at North 19 degrees East. Some fairly high land that jutted out in three bluff points led me to name it Cape 3 Points (Latitude 33 degrees 33 minutes South), located to the southwest, about 5 leagues away; the longitude measured from Botany Bay was 0 degrees 19 minutes east.

Tuesday, 8th. Variable Light Airs and Clear weather. In the P.M. saw some smooks upon the Shore, and in the Evening found the Variation to be 8 degrees 25 minutes East; at this time we were about 2 or 3 Miles from the land, and had 28 fathoms Water. Our situation at Noon was nearly the same as Yesterday, having advanced not one Step to the Northward.

Tuesday, 8th. Light, changing breezes and clear weather. In the afternoon, I saw some smoke along the shore, and in the evening, I found the variation to be 8 degrees 25 minutes east. At that time, we were about 2 or 3 miles from land and had 28 fathoms of water. Our position at noon was almost the same as yesterday, as we hadn't moved a single step northward.

Wednesday, 9th. Winds northerly; most part a fresh breeze, with which we stood off Shore until 12 at Night. At the distance of 5 Leagues from the land had 70 fathoms, at the distance of 6 Leagues 80 fathoms, which is the Extent of the Soundings, for at the Distance of 10 Leagues off we had no ground with 150 fathoms. Stood in Shore until 8 o'Clock A.M., and hardly fetched Cape Three Points; having a little wind at North-West by North, we tack'd, and stood off until Noon, at which Time we Tack'd with the wind at North-North-East, being then in the Latitude of 33 degrees 37 minutes South, Cape Three Points bearing North West by West, distance 4 Leagues.

Wednesday, 9th. The winds were from the north; mostly a fresh breeze, with which we moved away from the shore until midnight. Five leagues from land, we measured 70 fathoms, and at six leagues, 80 fathoms, which was the extent of the soundings, because at ten leagues out, we found no bottom with 150 fathoms. We headed back toward the shore until 8:00 A.M. and barely reached Cape Three Points; with a slight wind from the northwest by north, we tacked and moved away until noon. At that time, with the wind from the north-north-east, we tacked again, being at a latitude of 33 degrees 37 minutes south, with Cape Three Points bearing northwest by west, 4 leagues away.

Thursday, 10th. In the P.M., had the wind at North-East by North, with which we stood in Shore until near 4 o'Clock, when we Tack'd in 23 fathoms Water, being about a Mile from the land, and as much to the Southward of Cape 3 Points. In the night the wind veer'd to North-West and West, and in the morning to South-West. Having the advantage of a light Moon, we made the best of our way along shore to the Northward. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 32 degrees 53 minutes South, and Longitude 208 degrees 0 minutes West, and about 2 Leagues from the land, which extended from North 41 degrees East to South 41 degrees West. A small round rock or Island,* (* Nobby Head, at the entrance of Newcastle Harbour, formed by the Hunter River. Newcastle is the great coal port of New South Wales. It has a population of 20,000, and exports 1,500,000 tons of coal in the year.) laying close under the land, bore South 82 degrees West, distance 3 or 4 Leagues. At sunrise in the Morning found the Variation to be 8 degrees East. In the Latitude of 33 degrees 2 minutes South, a little way inland, is a remarkable hill, that is shaped like the Crown of a Hatt, which we past about 9 o'Clock in the forenoon.

Thursday, 10th. In the afternoon, we had the wind coming from the North-East by North, which allowed us to approach the shore until around 4 o'clock, when we tacked in 23 fathoms of water, about a mile from land and also a mile south of Cape 3 Points. During the night, the wind shifted to the North-West and West, and by morning, it changed to South-West. Thanks to a bright moon, we made good progress along the shore to the north. By noon, we determined our position to be at a latitude of 32 degrees 53 minutes South and a longitude of 208 degrees 0 minutes West, roughly 2 leagues from land, which stretched from North 41 degrees East to South 41 degrees West. A small round rock or island, (* Nobby Head, at the entrance of Newcastle Harbour, formed by the Hunter River. Newcastle is the major coal port of New South Wales. It has a population of 20,000 and exports 1,500,000 tons of coal each year.) located right under the land, was bearing South 82 degrees West, at a distance of 3 or 4 leagues. At sunrise in the morning, we found the variation to be 8 degrees East. A bit inland at the latitude of 33 degrees 2 minutes South is a notable hill shaped like the crown of a hat, which we passed around 9 o'clock in the morning.

[Off Cape Hawke, New South Wales.]

[Off Cape Hawke, New South Wales.]

Friday, 11th. Winds Southerly in the day, and in the night Westerly; a Gentle breeze and Clear weather. At 4 P.M. past, at the distance of one Mile, a low rocky point which I named Point Stephens (Latitude 32 degrees 45 minutes); on the North side of this point is an inlet which I called Port Stephens* (* Called after Mr. Stephens, one of the Secretaries to the Admiralty. It is a large and fine harbour.) (Latitude 32 degrees 40 minutes; Longitude 207 degrees 51 minutes), that appear'd to me from the Masthead to be shelter'd from all Winds. At the Entrance lay 3 Small Islands, 2 of which are of a Tolerable height, and on the Main, near the shore, are some high round hills that make at a distance like Islands. In passing this bay at the distance of 2 or 3 miles from the Shore our soundings were from 33 to 27 fathoms; from which I conjectured that there must be a sufficient depth of Water for Shipping in the bay. We saw several smokes a little way in the Country upon the flat land; by this I did suppose that there were Lagoons which afforded subsistance for the Natives, such as shell-fish, etc., for we as yet know nothing else they have to live upon. At 1/2 past 5, the Northermost land in sight bore North 36 degrees East, and Point Stephens South-West, distant 4 Leagues, at which time we took in our Steerings,* (* Studding sails.) and run under an Easey sail all night until 4 A.M., when we made all sail; our soundings in the night were from 48 to 62 fathoms, at the distance of between 3 and 4 Leagues from the land. At 8 we were abreast of a high point of Land, which made in 2 Hillocks; this point I called Cape Hawke* (* After Admiral Sir Edward Hawke, First Lord of the Admiralty.) (Latitude 32 degrees 14 minutes South, Longitude 207 degrees 30 minutes West). It bore from us at this time West distant 8 Miles, and the same time the Northermost land in sight bore North 6 degrees East, and appear'd high and like an Island. At Noon this land bore North 8 degrees East, the Northermost land in sight North 13 degrees East, and Cape Hawke South 37 degrees West. Latitude in per Observation 32 degrees 2 minutes South, which was 12 Miles to the Southward of that given by the Log, which I do suppose to be owing to a Current setting that way. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon was first North-East by East, 27 Miles, then North 10 degrees East, 37 Miles; Longitude in 207 degrees 20 minutes West; Variation per morning Amplitude and Azimuth 9 degrees 10 minutes East.

Friday, 11th. Winds were from the South during the day and switched to the West at night; there was a gentle breeze and clear weather. At 4 P.M., I passed a low rocky point about one mile away, which I named Point Stephens (Latitude 32 degrees 45 minutes). On the north side of this point is an inlet that I called Port Stephens* (* Named after Mr. Stephens, one of the Secretaries to the Admiralty. It is a large and fine harbor.) (Latitude 32 degrees 40 minutes; Longitude 207 degrees 51 minutes), which appeared, from the masthead, to be sheltered from all winds. At the entrance, there were three small islands, two of which were fairly tall, and on the mainland, near the shore, were some high round hills that looked like islands from a distance. While passing this bay, at a distance of 2 to 3 miles from shore, our soundings were between 33 to 27 fathoms, leading me to believe there is sufficient water depth for shipping in the bay. We saw several smoke plumes in the flat country, suggesting there were lagoons that provided food for the natives, such as shellfish, etc., since we currently know nothing else they live on. At 5:30, the northernmost land in sight was at North 36 degrees East, and Point Stephens was to the Southwest, 4 leagues away. At this time, we took in our steerings,* (* Studding sails.) and sailed easily all night until 4 A.M., when we set all sails. Our soundings during the night were between 48 to 62 fathoms, 3 to 4 leagues from the land. By 8 A.M., we were level with a high point of land that had two hillocks; I named this point Cape Hawke* (* After Admiral Sir Edward Hawke, First Lord of the Admiralty.) (Latitude 32 degrees 14 minutes South, Longitude 207 degrees 30 minutes West). At this point, it was 8 miles to the west, while the northernmost land in sight was at North 6 degrees East and appeared high and island-like. At noon, this land bore North 8 degrees East, the northernmost land in sight was North 13 degrees East, and Cape Hawke was at South 37 degrees West. My observed latitude was 32 degrees 2 minutes South, which was 12 miles south of the value given by the log, likely due to a current flowing that way. Since yesterday at noon, we sailed first North-East by East for 27 miles, then North 10 degrees East for 37 miles; Longitude was at 207 degrees 20 minutes West; Variation according to the morning amplitude and azimuth was 9 degrees 10 minutes East.

Saturday, 12th. Winds Southerly, a Gentle breeze in the P.M. As we run along Shore we saw several smokes a little way in land from the Sea, and one upon the Top of a hill, which was the first we have seen upon elevated ground since we have been upon the Coast. At sunset we were in 23 fathoms, and about a League and a half from the land, the Northermost part of which we had in sight bore North 13 degrees East; and 3 remarkable large high hills lying Contigious to each other, and not far from the shore, bore North-North-West. As these Hills bore some resemblance to each other we called them the 3 Brothers. We steer'd North-East by North all Night, having from 27 to 67 fathoms, from 2 to 5 and 6 Leagues from the Land, and at day light we steer'd North for the Northermost land we had in sight. At noon we were 4 Leagues from the Land, and by observation in the Latitude of 31 degrees 18 minutes South, which was 15 miles to the Southward of that given by the Log. Our Course and distance made good since Yesterday noon was North 24 degrees East, 48 miles. Longitude 206 degrees 58 minutes West; several smokes seen a little way in land.

Saturday, 12th. The winds were gentle from the south in the afternoon. As we sailed along the shore, we noticed several smoke plumes a bit inland from the sea, and one on top of a hill, which was the first we had seen on elevated ground since we arrived on the coast. At sunset, we were in 23 fathoms of water, about a mile and a half from the shore; the northernmost part we could see was at North 13 degrees East, and three tall, notable hills near the coast bore North-North-West. Since these hills looked somewhat similar, we named them the Three Brothers. We steered North-East by North throughout the night, with depths ranging from 27 to 67 fathoms, about 2 to 6 miles from the shore. At dawn, we headed directly North toward the northernmost land we could see. By noon, we were 4 miles from the shore, and our observations placed us at a latitude of 31 degrees 18 minutes South, which was 15 miles south of what the log indicated. Our course and distance since yesterday noon was North 24 degrees East, 48 miles. Longitude 206 degrees 58 minutes West; several smoke plumes were visible a short distance inland.

Sunday, 13th. In the P.M. stood in shore with the Wind at North-East until 6, at which time we Tack'd, being about 3 or 4 miles from the land, and in 24 fathoms. Stood off shore with a fresh breeze at North and North-North-West until midnight, then Tack'd, being in 118 fathoms and 8 Leagues from the Land. At 3 a.m. the wind veer'd to the Westward, and we Tack'd and stood to the Northward. At noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 30 degrees 43 minutes South, and Longitude 206 degrees 45 minutes West, and about 3 or 4 Leagues from the Land, the Northermost part of which bore from us North 13 degrees West; and a point or head land, on which were fires that Caused a great Quantity of smoke, which occasioned my giving it the name of Smokey Cape, bore South-West, distant 4 Leagues; it is moderately high land. Over the pitch of the point is a round hillock; within it 2 others, much higher and larger, and within them very low land (Latitude 30 degrees 51 minutes, Longitude 206 degrees 5 minutes West). Besides the smoke seen upon this Cape we saw more in several places along the Coast. The observed Latitude was only 5 Miles to the Southward of the Log.

Sunday, 13th. In the afternoon, we stayed close to shore with the wind coming from the North-East until 6 PM, at which point we tacked, being about 3 or 4 miles from the land and in 24 fathoms of water. We headed away from the shore with a fresh breeze from the North and North-North-West until midnight, then we tacked again, finding ourselves in 118 fathoms and 8 leagues from the land. At 3 AM, the wind shifted to the West, so we tacked and headed North. By noon, we determined our position to be at a latitude of 30 degrees 43 minutes South and a longitude of 206 degrees 45 minutes West, about 3 or 4 leagues from the land, with the northernmost part of it bearing North 13 degrees West. There was a point or headland, where we saw fires that produced a lot of smoke, leading me to name it Smokey Cape, located to the South-West, 4 leagues away; it is moderately elevated land. At the top of the point, there is a round hillock, and within it are two much taller hills, and among them very low land (Latitude 30 degrees 51 minutes, Longitude 206 degrees 5 minutes West). In addition to the smoke we saw on this cape, we noticed more in several spots along the coast. The observed latitude was only 5 miles south of what was recorded in the log.

Monday, 14th. At the P.M. it fell Calm, and continued so about an hour, when a breeze sprung up at North-East, with which we stood in shore until 6 o'Clock, when, being in 30 fathoms and 3 or 4 Miles from the land, we Tack'd, having the wind at North-North-West. At this time Smoky Cape bore South 3/4 degrees West, distant about 5 Leagues, and the Northermost land in sight North 1/4 degrees East. At 8 we made a Trip in shore for an hour; after this the wind came off Shore, with which we stood along shore to the Northward, having from 30 to 21 fathoms, at the distance of 4 or 5 Miles from the Land. At 5 A.M. the Wind veer'd to North, and blow'd a fresh breeze, attended with Squalls and dark cloudy weather. At 8 it began to Thunder and Rain, which lasted about an Hour, and then fell Calm, which gave us an opportunity to sound, and found 86 fathoms, being about 4 or 5 Leagues from the Land; after this we got the wind Southerly, a fresh breeze and fair weather, and we Steer'd North by West for the Northermost land we had in sight. At noon we were about 4 Leagues from the land, and by observation in the Latitude of 30 degrees 22 minutes South, which was 9 Miles to the Southward of that given by the Log. Longitude in 206 degrees 39 minutes West, and Course and distance made good since Yesterday Noon North 16 degrees East, 22 miles; some Tolerable high land near the Shore bore West. As I have not mentioned the Aspect of the Country since we left Botany Bay, I shall now describe it as it hath at different times appear'd to us. As we have advanced to the Northward the land hath increased in height, in so much that in this Latitude it may be called a hilly Country; but between this and Botany Bay it is diversified with an agreeable variety of Hills, Ridges, and Valleys, and large plains all Cloathed with wood, which to all appearance is the same as I have before mentioned, as we could discover no Visible alteration in the Soil. Near the shore the land is in general low and Sandy, except the points which are rocky, and over many of them are pretty high hills, which at first rising out of the Water appear like a Island.

Monday, 14th. In the afternoon, it got calm and remained that way for about an hour, when a breeze picked up from the North-East, and we sailed toward the shore until 6 o'clock. We were in 30 fathoms and 3 or 4 miles from land when we tacked, with the wind at North-North-West. At this time, Smoky Cape was located South 3/4 degrees West, about 5 leagues away, and the northernmost land visible was North 1/4 degrees East. At 8, we took a short trip inshore for an hour; after that, the wind came from the shore, allowing us to sail along the coast to the north, in depths of 30 to 21 fathoms, about 4 or 5 miles from the land. At 5 A.M., the wind shifted to the North and blew a fresh breeze, bringing squalls and dark, cloudy weather. At 8, it started to thunder and rain, which lasted for about an hour, then it became calm, giving us a chance to sound and we found 86 fathoms, about 4 to 5 leagues from the land. Afterwards, we got a southerly wind, a fresh breeze, and fair weather, and steered North by West toward the northernmost land in sight. At noon, we were around 4 leagues from the land, and according to observation, we were at a latitude of 30 degrees 22 minutes South, which was 9 miles south of what the log indicated. Our longitude was 206 degrees 39 minutes West, and since yesterday noon, we had made a course and distance of North 16 degrees East, 22 miles; some moderately high land near the shore was to the West. As I haven't described the landscape since leaving Botany Bay, I'll now share how it has appeared to us at different times. As we moved north, the land grew taller, to the point where we can call it hilly in this latitude; however, between here and Botany Bay, the terrain features a pleasing variety of hills, ridges, valleys, and large plains, all covered with trees, which seem to be the same as previously mentioned, as we could detect no noticeable change in the soil. Near the shore, the land is generally low and sandy, except for rocky points where there are fairly high hills that, when they first rise from the water, appear to be islands.

Tuesday, 15th. Fresh Gales at South-West, West-South-West, and South-South-West. In the P.M. had some heavy Squalls, attended with rain and hail, which obliged us to close reef our Topsails. Between 2 and 4 we had some small rocky Islands* (* The Solitary Islands.) between us and the land; the Southermost lies in the Latitude of 30 degrees 10 minutes, the Northermost in 29 degrees 58 minutes, and about 2 Leagues or more from the land; we sounded, and had 33 fathoms about 12 Miles without this last island. At 8 we brought too until 10, at which time we made sail under our Topsails. Having the Advantage of the Moon we steer'd along shore North and North by East, keeping at the distance of about 3 Leagues from the land having from 30 to 25 fathoms. As soon as it was daylight we made all the sail we could, having the Advantage of a fresh Gale and fair weather.* (* During the night the entrance of the Clarence River, now the outlet for the produce of a large and rich agricultural district, was passed, and in the morning that of the Richmond River, which serves a similar purpose.) At 9, being about a League from the Land, we saw upon it people and Smoke in Several places. At noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 28 degrees 39 minutes South, and Longitude 206 degrees 27 minutes West; Course and distance saild since Yesterday at Noon North 6 degrees 45 minutes East, 104 Miles. A Tolerable high point of land bore North-West by West, distant 3 Miles; this point I named Cape Byron* (* Captain John Byron was one of Cook's predecessors in exploration in the Pacific, having sailed round the World in H.M.S. Dolphin, in company with the Tamar, in 1764 to 1766.) (Latitude 28 degrees 37 minutes 30 seconds South, Longitude 206 degrees 30 minutes West). It may be known by a remarkable sharp peaked Mountain lying in land North-West by West from it. From this point the land Trends North 13 degrees West. Inland it is pretty high and hilly, but near the Shore it is low; to the Southward of the Point the land is low, and Tolerable level.

Tuesday, 15th. Fresh gales from the South-West, West-South-West, and South-South-West. In the afternoon, we experienced some heavy squalls, accompanied by rain and hail, which forced us to reef our topsails. Between 2 and 4, we spotted some small rocky islands (*The Solitary Islands*) between us and the land; the southernmost is at a latitude of 30 degrees 10 minutes, the northernmost at 29 degrees 58 minutes, and they are about 2 leagues or more from the land. We took soundings and found 33 fathoms about 12 miles beyond the last island. At 8, we hove to until 10, when we set sail under our topsails. With the advantage of the moon, we steered along the coast north and north by east, keeping about 3 leagues from shore, with depths of 30 to 25 fathoms. As soon as daylight broke, we made all the sail we could, taking advantage of a fresh gale and fair weather. (*During the night, we passed the entrance of the Clarence River, now the outlet for the produce of a large and rich agricultural district, and in the morning, we passed the Richmond River, which serves a similar purpose.*) At 9, being about a league from land, we saw people and smoke in several places. At noon, our position was calculated to be at latitude 28 degrees 39 minutes south and longitude 206 degrees 27 minutes west; our course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon was north 6 degrees 45 minutes east, 104 miles. A fairly high point of land bore northwest by west, 3 miles away; I named this point Cape Byron* (*Captain John Byron was one of Cook's predecessors in exploration in the Pacific, having sailed around the world in H.M.S. Dolphin, alongside the Tamar, from 1764 to 1766.*) (Latitude 28 degrees 37 minutes 30 seconds south, Longitude 206 degrees 30 minutes west). It can be recognized by a distinct sharply peaked mountain located inland to the northwest. From this point, the land trends north 13 degrees west. Inland, it's pretty high and hilly, but close to the shore, it is low; to the south of the point, the land is low and fairly level.

[Off Point Danger, New South Wales.]

[Off Point Danger, New South Wales.]

Wednesday, 16th. Winds Southerly, a fresh Gale, with which we steer'd North along shore until sunset, at which time we discover'd breakers ahead, and on our Larboard bow, being at this time in 20 fathoms, and about 5 miles from the land. Haul'd off East until 8, at which time we had run 8 Miles, and had increased our Depth of Water to 44 fathoms. We then brought too with her head to the Eastward, and lay on this Tack until 10 o'Clock, when, having increased our Soundings to 78 fathoms, we wore and lay with her head in shore until 5 o'Clock a.m., when we made Sail. At daylight we were surprized by finding ourselves farther to the Southward than we were in the evening, and yet it had blown strong all night Southerly. We now saw the breakers again within us, which we passed at the distance of about 1 League; they lay in the Latitude of 28 degrees 8 minutes South, and stretch off East 2 Leagues from a point under which is a small Island; their situation may always be found by the peaked mountain before mentioned, which bears South-West by West from them, and on their account I have named it Mount Warning. It lies 7 or 8 Leagues in land in the Latitude of 28 degrees 22 minutes South. The land is high and hilly about it, but it is Conspicuous enough to be distinguished from everything else. The point off which these shoals lay I have named Point Danger;* (* Point Danger is the boundary point on the coast between New South Wales and Queensland.) to the Northward of it the land, which is low, Trends North-West by North; but we soon found that it did not keep that direction long before it turn'd again to the Northward. At Noon we were about 2 Leagues from the land, and by observation in the Latitude of 27 degrees 46 minutes, which was 17 Miles to the Southward of the Log; Longitude 206 degrees 26 minutes West. Mount Warning bore South 20 degrees West, distant 14 Leagues; the Northermost land in sight bore North. Our Course and distance made good since yesterday North 1 degree 45 minutes West, 53 miles.

Wednesday, 16th. The winds were from the south, a strong gale, and we steered north along the shore until sunset. At that time, we spotted breakers ahead and on our left side, being in 20 fathoms of water and about 5 miles from the land. We turned east and continued until 8 o'clock, having traveled 8 miles and increased our depth to 44 fathoms. We then stopped with the ship headed east and stayed this way until 10 o'clock, when we had increased our depth to 78 fathoms. We then changed course and headed inshore until 5 a.m., when we set sail. At daylight, we were surprised to find ourselves further south than we were the evening before, even though it had blown strongly from the south all night. We saw the breakers again nearby, which we passed about 1 league away; they were located at Latitude 28 degrees 8 minutes South and stretched eastward for 2 leagues from a point beneath which was a small island. Their location can always be identified by the pointed mountain I mentioned earlier, which is southwest of them; I've named it Mount Warning. It lies 7 or 8 leagues inland at Latitude 28 degrees 22 minutes South. The land around it is high and hilly, but it's clearly visible and distinguishable from everything else. The point near these shoals I've called Point Danger; to the north of it, the low land trends Northwest by North, though we soon found that it didn't stay that direction for long before turning back to the north. At noon, we were about 2 leagues from the land, and observations showed our latitude as 27 degrees 46 minutes, which was 17 miles south of our log; longitude 206 degrees 26 minutes west. Mount Warning bore South 20 degrees West, 14 leagues away, and the northernmost land in sight bore north. Our course and distance made good since yesterday was North 1 degree 45 minutes West, 53 miles.

[Off Moreton Bay, Queensland.]

[Off Moreton Bay, QLD.]

Thursday, 17th. Winds Southerly, mostly a fresh breeze, with which in the P.M. we steer'd along shore North 3/4 East, at the distance of about 2 Leagues off. Between 4 and 5 we discover'd breakers on our Larboard bow; our Depth of Water at this time was 37 fathoms. At sunset the Northermost land in sight bore North by West, the breakers North-West by West, distant 4 Miles, and the Northermost land set at Noon, which form'd a Point, I named Point Lookout, bore West, distant 5 or 6 Miles (Latitude 27 degrees 6 minutes).* (* There is some mistake in this latitude. It should be 27 degrees 26 minutes.) On the North side of this point the shore forms a wide open bay, which I have named Morton's Bay,* (* James, Earl of Morton, was President of the Royal Society in 1764, and one of the Commissioners of Longitude.) in the Bottom of which the land is so low that I could but just see it from the Topmast head. The breakers I have just mentioned lies about 3 or 4 Miles from Point Lookout; at this time we had a great Sea from the Southward, which broke prodigious high upon them. Stood on North-North-East until 8, when, being past the breakers, and having Deepned our water to 52 fathoms, we brought too until 12 o'Clock, then made sail to the North-North-East. At 4 A.M. we sounded, and had 135 fathoms. At daylight I found that we had in the night got much farther to the Northward and from the Shore than I expected from the Course we steer'd, for we were at least 6 or 7 Leagues off, and therefore hauled in North-West by West, having the Advantage of a Fresh Gale at South-South-West. The Northermost land seen last night bore from us at this time South-South-West, distant 6 Leagues. This land I named Cape Morton, it being the North point of the Bay of the same Name (Latitude 26 degrees 56 minutes South, Longitude 206 degrees 28 minutes). From Cape Morton the Land Trends away West, further than we could see, for there is a small space where we could see no land; some on board where of opinion that there is a River there because the Sea looked paler than usual. Upon sounding we found 34 fathoms fine white sandy bottom, which alone is Sufficient change, the apparent Colour of Sea Water, without the Assistance of Rivers. The land need only to be low here, as it is in a Thousand other places upon the Coast, to have made it impossible for us to have seen it at the distance we were off. Be this as it may, it was a point that could not be clear'd up as we had the wind; but should any one be desirous of doing it that may come after me, this place may always be found by 3 Hills which lay to the Northward of it in the Latitude of 26 degrees 53 minutes South. These hills lay but a little way inland, and not far from Each other; they are very remarkable on account of their Singular form of Elivation, which very much resembles Glass Houses,* (* The Glass houses form a well-known sea mark on entering Moreton Bay, as the name is now written. Brisbane, the capital of Queensland, stands on the river of the same name, which falls into Moreton Bay.) which occasioned my giving them that Name. The Northermost of the 3 is the highest and largest. There are likewise several other peaked hills inland to the Northward of these, but they are not near so remarkable. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 26 degrees 28 minutes South, which was 10 Miles to the Northward of the Log; a Circumstance that hath not hapned since we have been upon the Coast before. Our Course and distance run since Yesterday noon was North by West 80 Miles, which brought us into the Longitude of 206 degrees 46 minutes. At this time we were about 2 or 3 Leagues from the land, and in 24 fathoms Water; a low bluff point, which was the Southern point of an open Sandy bay,* (* Laguna Bay. The point is called Low Bluff.) bore North 52 degrees West, distant 3 Leagues, and the Northermost point of land in sight bore North 1/4 East. Several Smokes seen to-day, and some pretty far inland.

Thursday, 17th. The winds were coming from the south, mostly a fresh breeze, with which in the afternoon we steered along the shore to the North 3/4 East, about 2 leagues off. Between 4 and 5, we spotted breakers on our left side; at this time, the depth of water was 37 fathoms. At sunset, the northernmost land in sight was bearing North by West, the breakers were to the North-West by West, 4 miles away, and the northernmost land we noted at noon, which formed a point that I named Point Lookout, bore West, 5 or 6 miles away (Latitude 27 degrees 6 minutes). (*There is some mistake in this latitude. It should be 27 degrees 26 minutes.) On the north side of this point, the shore creates a wide open bay, which I named Morton's Bay,* (*James, Earl of Morton, was President of the Royal Society in 1764, and one of the Commissioners of Longitude.) where the land is so low that I could barely see it from the top of the mast. The breakers I just mentioned are about 3 or 4 miles from Point Lookout; at this time, we were facing a big sea from the south that crashed impressively high upon them. We headed North-North-East until 8, when we passed the breakers, and having deepened our water to 52 fathoms, we stopped until 12 o'clock, then set sail to the North-North-East. At 4 A.M., we took a sound and found 135 fathoms. At daylight, I realized that during the night we had moved much farther north and away from the shore than I expected from our course, as we were at least 6 or 7 leagues off; so we turned in to North-West by West, benefiting from a fresh gale at South-South-West. The northernmost land seen last night was then bearing from us South-South-West, 6 leagues away. I named this land Cape Morton, as it is the northern point of the bay of the same name (Latitude 26 degrees 56 minutes South, Longitude 206 degrees 28 minutes). From Cape Morton, the land stretches west, beyond what we could see, as there was a small area where we could see no land; some on board thought that a river might be there because the sea looked paler than usual. Upon sounding, we found 34 fathoms of fine white sandy bottom, which alone is enough to change the apparent color of the sea water, without any rivers involved. The land only needed to be low here, as it is in thousands of other places along the coast, making it impossible for us to see it from the distance we were at. Regardless, it was a point that couldn't be clarified while we had the wind; but anyone who wishes to investigate after me will find this spot by three hills to the north in the latitude of 26 degrees 53 minutes South. These hills lie just a short distance inland and close to each other; they are quite notable because of their unique elevation that resembles glass houses,* (*The Glass houses form a well-known sea mark on entering Moreton Bay, as it is now written. Brisbane, the capital of Queensland, stands on the river of the same name, which flows into Moreton Bay.) which is why I named them that. The northernmost of the three is the tallest and largest. There are also several other peaked hills inland to the north of these, but they are not nearly as remarkable. At noon, our observation placed us in the latitude of 26 degrees 28 minutes South, which was 10 miles north of the log; a situation that hasn't occurred since we have been on the coast before. Our course and distance run since yesterday noon was North by West 80 miles, bringing us into the longitude of 206 degrees 46 minutes. At this time, we were about 2 or 3 leagues from the land and in 24 fathoms of water; a low bluff point, which was the southern point of an open sandy bay,* (*Laguna Bay. The point is called Low Bluff.) bore North 52 degrees West, 3 leagues away, and the northernmost point of land visible bore North 1/4 East. We saw several smokes today, some quite far inland.

Friday, 18th. In steering along shore at the distance of 2 Leagues off our Soundings was from 24 to 32 fathoms Sandy bottom. At 6 P.M. the North point set at Noon bore North 1/4 West; distant 4 Leagues; at 10 it bore North-West by West 1/2 West, and as we had seen no land to the Northward of it we brought too, not knowing which way to steer, having at this time but little wind, and continued so for the most part of the night. At 2 P.M. we made sail with the wind at South-West, and at daylight saw the land extending as far as North 3/4 East. The point set last night bore South-West by West, distant 3 or 4 Leagues; I have named it Double Island Point, on account of its figure (Latitude 25 degrees 58 minutes South, Longitude 206 degrees 48 minutes West). The land within this point is of a moderate and pretty equal height, but the point itself is of such an unequal Height that it looks like 2 Small Islands laying under the land; it likewise may be known by the white Clifts on the North side of it. Here the land trends to the North-West, and forms a large open bay,* (* Wide Bay.) in the bottom of which the land appear'd to be very low, in so much that we could but just see it from the Deck. In crossing the mouth of this bay our Depth of Water was from 30 to 32 fathoms, a white sandy bottom. At Noon we were about 3 Leagues from the Land, and in the Latitude of 25 degrees 34 minutes South, Longitude 206 degrees 45 minutes West; Double Island Point bore South 3/4 West, and the Northermost land in sight North 3/4 East. The land hereabouts, which is of a moderate height, appears more barren than any we have yet seen on this Coast, and the Soil more sandy, there being several large places where nothing else is to be seen; in other places the woods look to be low and Shrubby, nor did we see many signs of inhabitants.

Friday, 18th. While navigating along the shore, we were 2 leagues off, with our depth ranging from 24 to 32 fathoms on sandy bottom. At 6 P.M., the north point that we noted at noon was at North 1/4 West, about 4 leagues away; by 10 o’clock, it had shifted to North-West by West 1/2 West. Since we hadn’t spotted any land to the north of it, we slowed down, unsure of which direction to go due to light winds, and stayed like this for most of the night. At 2 A.M., we set sail again with the wind from the South-West, and by daylight, we saw land extending as far as North 3/4 East. The point we noted last night was at South-West by West, about 3 or 4 leagues away; I named it Double Island Point because of its shape (Latitude 25 degrees 58 minutes South, Longitude 206 degrees 48 minutes West). The land behind this point is of moderate, fairly consistent height, but the point itself is so uneven that it resembles two small islands lying along the coast; it can also be identified by the white cliffs on its northern side. Here, the land trends to the North-West and forms a large open bay (*Wide Bay*), where the land at the bottom appeared very low, barely visible from the deck. As we crossed the bay's entrance, our water depth was between 30 to 32 fathoms on a white sandy bottom. At noon, we were about 3 leagues from the land, at the latitude of 25 degrees 34 minutes South, longitude 206 degrees 45 minutes West. Double Island Point was at South 3/4 West, and the northernmost land in sight was at North 3/4 East. The land around here, of moderate height, looks more barren than any we’ve seen along this coast, with sandier soil and several large patches where nothing grows; in other areas, the vegetation looks low and shrubby, and we didn’t see many signs of inhabitants.

Saturday, 19th. In the P.M. had Variable light Airs, and Calms; in the night had a light breeze from the land, which in the A.M. veer'd to South-West and South-South-West. In the evening found the Variation to be 8 degrees 36 minutes East, and in the Morning 8 degrees 20 minutes; as we had but little wind we keept to the Northward all night, having from 23 to 27 fathoms fine sandy bottom, at the Distance of 2 or 3 Leagues from the Land. At Noon we were about 4 Miles from it, and by observation in the Latitude of 25 degrees 4 minutes, and in this situation had but 13 fathoms; the Northermost land in Sight bore North 21 degrees West, distant 8 Miles; our Course and distance saild since yesterday at Noon was North 13 degrees 15 minutes East, 31 Miles.

Saturday, 19th. In the afternoon, we had varying light breezes and calm conditions; at night, a light breeze came from the land, which in the morning shifted to the South-West and South-South-West. In the evening, we noted that the variation was 8 degrees 36 minutes East, and in the morning, it was 8 degrees 20 minutes; since there was little wind, we headed north all night, with depths of 23 to 27 fathoms over fine sandy bottom, about 2 or 3 leagues from the shore. At noon, we were roughly 4 miles from the land, and based on our observations, we found ourselves at a latitude of 25 degrees 4 minutes, where the depth was only 13 fathoms; the farthest land in sight was to the North 21 degrees West, 8 miles away; our course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon was North 13 degrees 15 minutes East, 31 miles.

[Off Sandy Cape, Queensland.]

[Off Sandy Cape, QLD.]

Sunday, 20th. Winds Southerly, Gentle breezes. At 10 p.m. we passed, at the distance of 4 Miles, having 17 fathoms, a black bluff head or point of land, on which a number of the Natives were Assembled, which occasioned my naming it Indian Head; Latitude 25 degrees 0 minutes North by West, 4 Miles from this head, is another much like it. From this last the land Trends a little more to the Westward, and is low and Sandy next the Sea, for what may be behind it I know not; if land, it must be all low, for we could see no part of it from the Mast head. We saw people in other places besides the one I have mentioned; some Smokes in the day and fires in the Night. Having but little wind all Night, we keept on to the Northward, having from 17 to 34 fathoms, from 4 Miles to 4 Leagues from the Land, the Northermost part of which bore from us at daylight West-South-West, and seem'd to End in a point, from which we discover'd a Reef stretching out to the Northward as far as we could see, being, at this time, in 18 fathoms; for we had, before it was light, hauld our Wind to the Westward, and this course we continued until we had plainly discover'd breakers a long way upon our Lee Bow, which seem'd to Stretch quite home to the land. We then Edged away North-West and North-North-West, along the East side of the Shoal, from 2 to 1 Miles off, having regular, even Soundings, from 13 to 7 fathoms; fine sandy bottom. At Noon we were, by Observation, in the Latitude of 24 degrees 26 minutes South, which was 13 Miles to the Northward of that given by the Log. The extream point of the Shoal we judged to bear about North-West of us; and the point of land above-mentioned bore South 3/4 West, distant 20 Miles. This point I have named Sandy Cape,* (* Sandy Cape is the northern point of Great Sandy Island. A long narrow channel separates the latter from the mainland, and opens at its northern end into Harvey Bay, a great sheet of water 40 miles across. This channel is now much used by the coasting trade, as it avoids the long detour round Breaksea Spit, a most dangerous shoal.) on account of 2 very large white Patches of Sand upon it. It is of a height Sufficient to be seen 12 Leagues in Clear weather (Latitude 24 degrees 46 minutes, Longitude 206 degrees 51 minutes West); from it the Land trends away West-South-West and South-West as far as we could see.

Sunday, 20th. Winds from the South, gentle breezes. At 10 p.m., we passed a black bluff head or point of land, about 4 miles away, where a group of Natives were gathered. I named it Indian Head. Latitude 25 degrees 0 minutes North. Four miles from this head, there’s another similar point. From this last point, the land trends slightly more to the west and is low and sandy by the sea; I can’t tell what lies behind it, but if there is land, it must be all low since we couldn’t see any part of it from the masthead. We noticed people in other places as well, with some smoke during the day and fires at night. With little wind all night, we continued northward, with depths ranging from 17 to 34 fathoms, at distances of 4 miles to 4 leagues from the land. The northernmost part of the land appeared from us at daylight to be west-southwest and seemed to end in a point, where we spotted a reef extending northward as far as we could see, while in 18 fathoms. Before it got light, we had turned our course to the west, which we maintained until we clearly saw breakers stretching quite close to the land on our lee bow. We then adjusted our course northwest and north-northwest, along the east side of the shoal, staying 1 to 2 miles off, with regular, even soundings between 13 and 7 fathoms, on a fine sandy bottom. At noon, by observation, we were at latitude 24 degrees 26 minutes South—13 miles to the north of what the log indicated. We estimated the extreme point of the shoal to be about northwest of us, while the point of land mentioned earlier bore south 3/4 west, 20 miles away. I named this point Sandy Cape,* (*Sandy Cape is the northern point of Great Sandy Island. A long narrow channel separates the latter from the mainland and opens at its northern end into Harvey Bay, a large body of water 40 miles across. This channel is now frequently used for coastal trade, as it avoids the long detour around Breaksea Spit, a very dangerous shoal.) because of two large white patches of sand on it. It is tall enough to be seen 12 leagues away in clear weather (Latitude 24 degrees 46 minutes, Longitude 206 degrees 51 minutes West); from there, the land trends away west-southwest and southwest as far as we could see.

Monday, 21st. In the P.M. we keept along the East side of the Shoal until 2, when, judging there was water for us over, I sent a Boat a Head to sound, and upon her making the Signal for more than 5 fathoms we hauld our wind and stood over the Tail of it in 6 fathoms. At this time we were in the Latitude of 24 degrees 22 minutes South, and Sandy Cape bore South 1/2 East, distant 8 Leagues; but the Direction of the Shoal is nearest North-North-West and South-South-East. At this time we had 6 fathoms; the boat which was not above 1/4 of a mile to the Southward of us had little more than 5 fathoms. From 6 fathoms we had the next Cast, 13, and then 20 immediately, as fast as the Man could heave the Lead; from this I did suppose that the West side of the Shoal is pretty steep too, whereas on the other side we had gradual Soundings from 13 to 7 fathoms. This Shoal I called Break Sea Spit, because now we had smooth water, whereas upon the whole Coast to the Southward of it we had always a high Sea or swell from the South-East. At 6, the Land of Sandy Cape extending from South 17 degrees East to South 27 degrees East, distance 8 Leagues; Depth of Water, 23 fathoms, which depth we keept all Night, as we stood to the Westward with light Airs from the Southward; but between 12 and 4 A.M. we had it Calm, after which a Gentle breeze sprung up at South, with which we still keept on upon a Wind to the Westward. At 7 we Saw from the Masthead the Land of Sandy Cape bearing South-East 1/2 East, distance 12 or 13 Leagues. At 9, we discover'd from the Mast head land to the Westward, and soon after saw smooke upon it. Our depth of Water was now decreased to 17 fathoms, and by Noon to 13, at which time we were by observation in the Latitude of 24 degrees 28 minutes South, and about 7 Leagues from the Land, which extended from South by West to West-North-West. Longitude made from Sandy Cape 0 degrees 45 minutes West.

Monday, 21st. In the afternoon, we kept along the east side of the shoal until 2 PM. When I judged there was enough water for us to cross, I sent a boat ahead to check the depth. Once it signaled more than 5 fathoms, we changed our course and moved over the tail of it in 6 fathoms. At this moment, we were at a latitude of 24 degrees 22 minutes South, and Sandy Cape was bearing South 1/2 East, about 8 leagues away; the shoal extended mostly north-northwest and south-southeast. We had 6 fathoms, while the boat, which was only about a quarter of a mile south of us, measured just over 5 fathoms. From 6 fathoms, the next measurements were 13 and then 20, taken quickly as the crew member threw the lead. From this, I assumed that the west side of the shoal is pretty steep as well, while on the other side we encountered gradual depths from 13 to 7 fathoms. I named this shoal Break Sea Spit, as we now had calm water, unlike the high seas and swells we experienced along the coast to the south. By 6, Sandy Cape extended from South 17 degrees East to South 27 degrees East, still 8 leagues away, with a water depth of 23 fathoms, which we maintained throughout the night while heading west with light winds from the south. However, between midnight and 4 AM, we had calm conditions, followed by a gentle breeze from the south that allowed us to continue westward. At 7, we spotted Sandy Cape from the masthead, bearing South-East 1/2 East, about 12 or 13 leagues away. By 9, we noticed land to the west and soon after saw smoke rising from it. The water depth had decreased to 17 fathoms and by noon to 13 fathoms. At that time, our observation placed us at a latitude of 24 degrees 28 minutes South, about 7 leagues from the land, which stretched from South by West to West-North-West. Longitude made from Sandy Cape was 0 degrees 45 minutes West.

For these few days past we have seen at times a sort of Sea fowl we have no where seen before that I remember; they are of the sort called Boobies. Before this day we seldom saw more than 2 or 3 at a time, and only when we were near the land. Last night a small flock of these birds passed the Ship and went away to the North-West, and this morning from 1/2 an hour before sun rise to half an hour after, flights of them were continually coming from the North-North-West, and flying to the South-South-East, and not one was seen to fly in any other direction. From this we did suppose that there was a Lagoon, River, or Inlet of Shallow Water to the Southward of us, where these birds resorted to in the day to feed, and that not very far to the Northward lay some Island, where they retir'd too in the night.

For the past few days, we’ve occasionally spotted a type of seabird we don’t remember seeing before; they’re called Boobies. Until now, we rarely saw more than 2 or 3 at a time, and only when we were close to land. Last night, a small flock of these birds flew past the ship heading northwest, and this morning, from half an hour before sunrise to half an hour after, groups of them kept coming from the north-northwest and flying to the south-southeast, with none seen flying in any other direction. This made us think that there was a lagoon, river, or shallow inlet to the south where these birds go during the day to feed, and not far to the north there might be an island where they go at night.

Tuesday, 22nd. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze at South-East, with which we stood in for the land South-West until 4, when, being in the Latitude of 24 degrees 36 minutes South, and about 2 Leagues from land, in 9 fathoms, we bore away along shore North-West by West; at the same time we could see the land extending to the South-South-East about 8 Leagues. Near the Sea the land is very low, but inland are some moderately high hills, and the whole appeared to be thickly Cloathed with wood. In running along shore we shoalded our Water from 9 to 7 fathoms, and at one time had but 6 fathoms, which determined me to Anchor for the Night, and accordingly at 8 o'Clock we came too in 8 fathoms, fine gravelly bottom, about 5 miles from the land. This evening we saw a Water Snake, and 2 or 3 evenings ago one lay under the Ship's Stern some time; this was about 1 1/2 Yards in length, and was the first we had seen. At 6 A.M. weighed with a Gentle breeze Southerly, and Steer'd North-West 1/4 West, edging in for the land until we got Within 2 Miles of it, having from 7 to 11 fathoms; we then steer'd North-North-West as the land laid. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 24 degrees 19 minutes South; Longitude made from Sandy Cape 1 degree 14 minutes West.

Tuesday, 22nd. In the afternoon, we had a gentle breeze coming from the southeast, which allowed us to head toward the land to the southwest until 4 PM. At that point, we were at a latitude of 24 degrees 36 minutes south, about 2 nautical miles from the shore, in 9 fathoms of water. We then changed our course to follow the shore northwest by west, while also noticing the land extending to the south-southeast for about 8 nautical miles. The land near the sea is very low, but there are some moderately tall hills inland, all covered with dense forest. As we traveled along the shore, the water shallowed from 9 to 7 fathoms, and at one point, we even saw only 6 fathoms, which made me decide to anchor for the night. So, at 8 o'clock, we dropped anchor in 8 fathoms over a nice gravelly bottom, about 5 miles from the shore. This evening, we spotted a water snake, and a few evenings ago, one was resting under the ship’s stern for a while; it was about 1.5 yards long, and it was the first one we had seen. At 6 AM, we weighed anchor with a gentle southerly breeze and set a course of north-northwest 1/4 west, moving closer to the land until we were within 2 miles of it, with depths ranging from 7 to 11 fathoms. We then steered north-northwest as the land lay. At noon, we determined our position by observation to be at a latitude of 24 degrees 19 minutes south; longitude calculated from Sandy Cape was 1 degree 14 minutes west.

[At Anchor. Bustard Bay, Queensland.]

[At Anchor. Bustard Bay, QLD.]

Wednesday, 23rd. Continued our Course alongshore at the distance of about 2 Miles off, having from 12 to 9, 8 and 7 fathoms, until 5 o'Clock, at which time we were abreast of the South point of a Large open Bay,* (* Bustard Bay.) wherein I intended to Anchor. Accordingly we hauld in Close upon a Wind, and sent a boat ahead to sound; after making some Trips we Anchored at 8 o'Clock in 5 fathoms, a Sandy bottom. The South point of the bay bore East 3/4 South, distant 2 Miles; the North point North-West 1/4 North, about 2 Miles from the shore, in the bottom of the bay. Last night, some time in the Middle watch, a very extraordinary affair hapned to Mr. Orton, my Clerk. He having been drinking in the evening, some Malicious person or persons in the Ship took Advantage of his being Drunk, and cut off all the Cloaths from off his back; not being satisfied with this, they some time after went into his Cabin and cut off a part of both his Ears as he lay a Sleep in his Bed. The person whom he suspected to have done this was Mr. Magra, one of the Midshipmen; but this did not appear to me. Upon enquiry, however, as I had been told that Magra had once or twice before this in their drunken Frolicks cut off his cloaths, and had been heard to say (as I was told) that if it was not for the Law he would Murder him, these things consider'd, induced me to think that Magra was not Altogether innocent. I therefore for the present dismiss'd him the Quarter deck, and Suspended him from doing any duty in the Ship, he being one of those Gentlemen frequently found on board King's Ships that can very well be spared; besides, it was necessary in me to show my immediate resentment against the person on whom the suspicion fell, least they should not have stop'd here. With respect to Mr. Orton, he is a man not without faults; yet from all the inquiry I could make, it evidently appear'd to me that so far from deserving such Treatment, he had not designed injuring any person in the Ship; so that I do--and shall always--look upon him as an injured man. Some reasons, however, might be given why this misfortune came upon him, in which he himself was in some measure to blame; but as this is only conjecture, and would tend to fix it upon some people in the Ship, whom I would fain believe would hardly be guilty of such an Action, I shall say nothing about it, unless I shall hereafter discover the Offenders, which I shall take every method in my power to do, for I look upon such proceedings as highly dangerous in such Voyages as this, and the greatest insult that could be offer'd to my Authority in this Ship, as I have always been ready to hear and redress every complaint that have been made against any Person in the Ship.* (* This history of Mr. Orton's misadventure is omitted from the Admiralty copy. It is an illustration of the times to note that the fact of Orton having got drunk does not seem to call for the Captain's severe censure. In these days, though the practical joker receives punishment, the drunkard would certainly come in for a large share also.)

Wednesday, 23rd. We continued our course along the coast, about 2 miles offshore, with depths ranging from 12 to 7 fathoms until 5 o'clock, when we were opposite the south point of a large, open bay (*Bustard Bay*), where I planned to anchor. We steered closer to the wind and sent a boat ahead to sound the depth. After several trips, we anchored at 8 o'clock in 5 fathoms on a sandy bottom. The south point of the bay was located East 3/4 South, 2 miles away; the north point was North-West 1/4 North, around 2 miles from shore, at the end of the bay. Last night, during the middle watch, something very strange happened to Mr. Orton, my clerk. After a night of drinking, someone on board took advantage of his drunken state and cut off all his clothes. Not satisfied with that, they later entered his cabin and cut off part of both his ears while he was sleeping in his bed. He suspected Mr. Magra, one of the midshipmen, as the culprit; however, I wasn’t convinced. After some inquiry, I learned that Magra had previously cut Orton's clothes during drunken antics and had supposedly mentioned (as I was told) that if it weren’t for the law, he would kill him. Taking all this into account, I began to doubt Magra’s innocence. Therefore, I temporarily removed him from the quarterdeck and suspended him from his duties onboard, as he was one of those individuals commonly found on King’s ships who could easily be replaced. Additionally, I felt it was necessary to show immediate disapproval towards the suspected individual to prevent further incidents. As for Mr. Orton, while he has his faults, all my inquiries indicated that he did not deserve such treatment and had no intention of harming anyone on the ship. I do believe he is an injured man. That being said, there are some potential reasons why this unfortunate event happened to him that he may share some blame for; however, since this is just speculation, and I prefer to think that the people aboard are unlikely to commit such acts, I won’t mention it unless I discover the offenders later, which I’ll do everything I can to uncover. I regard such actions as extremely dangerous on voyages like this and the greatest insult to my authority on this ship, as I have always been open to hearing and addressing any complaints against anyone onboard. *(This account of Mr. Orton’s misadventure is omitted from the Admiralty copy. It reflects the times that Orton's drunkenness doesn't seem to warrant severe reprimand from the captain. Today, while practical jokers face punishment, drunkards would certainly also receive their share of consequences.)*

In the A.M. I went ashore with a party of men in order to Examine the Country, accompanied by Mr. Banks and the other Gentlemen; we landed a little within the South point of the Bay, where there is a Channel leading into a large Lagoon. The first thing that I did was to sound and examine the Channell, in which I found 3 fathoms, until I got about a Mile up it, where I met with a Shoal, whereon was little more than one fathom; being over this I had 3 fathoms again. The Entrance into this Channell lies close to the South point of this Bay, being form'd on the East by the Shore, and on the West by a large Spit of sand; it is about a 1/4 of a Mile broad, and lies in South by West; here is room for a few Ships to lay very secure, and a small Stream of Fresh Water. After this I made a little excursion into the Woods while some hands made 3 or 4 hauls with the Sean, but caught not above a dozen very small fish. By this time the flood was made, and I imbarqued in the Boats in order to row up the Lagoon; but in this I was hindred by meeting everywhere with Shoal Water. As yet we had seen no people, but saw a great deal of Smook up and on the West side of the Lagoon, which was all too far off for us to go by land, excepting one; this we went to and found 10 Small fires in a very small Compass, and some Cockle Shells laying by them, but the people were gone. On the windward or South side of one of the fires was stuck up a little Bark about a foot and a half high, and some few pieces lay about in other places; these we concluded were all the covering they had in the Night, and many of them, I firmly believe, have not this, but, naked as they are, sleep in the open air. Tupia, who was with us, observed that they were Taata Eno's; that is, bad or poor people. The Country is visibly worse than at the last place we were at; the soil is dry and Sandy, and the woods are free from underwoods of every kind; here are of the same sort of Trees as we found in Bottany Harbour, with a few other sorts. One sort, which is by far the most Numerous sort of any in the Woods, grow Something like birch; the Bark at first sight looks like birch bark, but upon examination I found it to be very different, and so I believe is the wood; but this I could not examine, as having no axe or anything with me to cut down a Tree. About the Skirts of the Lagoon grows the true Mangrove, such as are found in the West Indies, and which we have not seen during the Voyage before; here is likewise a sort of a palm Tree, which grows on low, barren, sandy places in the South Sea Islands. All, or most of the same sort, of Land and Water fowl as we saw at Botany Harbour we saw here; besides these we saw some Bustards, such as we have in England, one of which we kill'd that weighed 17 1/2 pounds, which occasioned my giving this place the Name of Bustard Bay (Latitude 24 degrees 4 minutes, Longitude 208 degrees 22 minutes West); we likewise saw some black and white Ducks. Here are plenty of small Oysters sticking to the Rocks, Stones, and Mangrove Trees, and some few other shell fish, such as large Muscles, Pearl Oysters, Cockels, etc. I measured the perpendicular height of the last Tide, and found it to be 8 foot above low water mark, and from the time of low water to-day I found that it must be high Water at the full and Change of the Moon at 8 o'Clock.

In the morning, I went ashore with a group of men to explore the area, accompanied by Mr. Banks and other gentlemen. We landed just inside the south point of the bay, where there’s a channel leading into a large lagoon. The first thing I did was measure and examine the channel, where I found 3 fathoms of water until I got about a mile up, where there was a shallow area with just over one fathom; beyond that, I had 3 fathoms again. The entrance to this channel is close to the south point of the bay, formed on the east by the shore and on the west by a large sandbank; it is about a quarter of a mile wide and runs south by west. There is room for a few ships to anchor securely, and a small stream of fresh water as well. After this, I took a brief walk into the woods while some crew members made three or four hauls with the seine but only caught about a dozen very small fish. By that time, the tide was high, so I boarded the boats to row up the lagoon; however, I was hindered by encountering shallow water everywhere. So far, we hadn’t seen any people, but we noticed a lot of smoke rising on the west side of the lagoon, which was too far off for us to reach by land, except for one spot. We went there and found ten small fires in a compact area, along with some cockle shells nearby, but the people were gone. On the windward or south side of one of the fires, we saw a small piece of bark about a foot and a half high, and a few pieces were scattered nearby; we concluded that this was all the shelter they had at night, and I believe many of them slept outside completely exposed. Tupia, who was with us, remarked that they were Taata Eno's, meaning poor people. The land is clearly worse than where we were before; the soil is dry and sandy, and there are no underbrush or other types of vegetation. The types of trees here are similar to those we found in Botany Harbour, with a few others as well. One type, which is by far the most common in the woods, resembles birch; the bark looks like birch bark at first glance, but upon closer inspection, I found it to be quite different, and I believe the wood is as well; however, I couldn’t examine it further since I didn't have an axe or anything to cut down a tree. Along the edges of the lagoon, we found the true mangrove, like those in the West Indies, which we had not seen during the voyage before; there was also a type of palm tree that grows in low, barren, sandy areas of the South Sea Islands. Most of the same types of land and waterfowl we saw at Botany Harbour were also here; in addition, we saw some bustards, similar to those in England, one of which we killed that weighed 17.5 pounds, prompting me to name this location Bustard Bay (Latitude 24 degrees 4 minutes, Longitude 208 degrees 22 minutes West); we also saw some black and white ducks. There are plenty of small oysters attached to the rocks, stones, and mangrove trees, along with a few other shellfish, such as large mussels, pearl oysters, cockles, etc. I measured the height of the last tide and found it to be 8 feet above low water mark, and from the time of low water today, I determined that it must be high water at the full and new moons at 8 o'clock.

Thursday, 24th. In the P.M. I was employ'd ashore in the Transactions before related; at 4 a.m. we weighed with a Gentle breeze at South, and made sail out of the Bay. In standing out our soundings were from 5 to 15 fathoms; when in this last Depth we were abreast of the North Point, and being daylight we discover'd breakers stretching out from it about North-North-East, 2 or 3 miles; at the Outermost point of them is a Rock just above Water. In passing these rocks at the distance of 1/2 a mile we had from 15 to 20 fathoms; being past them, we hauld along shore West-North-West for the farthest land we had in sight. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 23 degrees 52 minutes South; the North part of Bustard Bay bore South 62 degrees East, distance 10 miles, and the Northermost land in sight North 60 degrees West. Longitude in 208 degrees 37 minutes West, distance from the nearest shore 6 Miles; in this situation had 14 fathoms water.

Thursday, 24th. In the afternoon, I was busy on land with the previously mentioned activities; at 4 a.m. we set off with a light breeze coming from the south and sailed out of the bay. As we navigated out, our depth readings were between 5 and 15 fathoms; when we reached the 15 fathom mark, we were aligned with the North Point. With daylight breaking, we spotted shoals extending from it about North-North-East, 2 or 3 miles away; at the outermost point of these, there is a rock just above the water. While passing these rocks at a distance of half a mile, we had between 15 and 20 fathoms of water; once we moved past them, we made our way along the shore West-North-West toward the farthest land visible. By noon, our observations placed us at a latitude of 23 degrees 52 minutes South; the northern part of Bustard Bay was at South 62 degrees East, 10 miles away, and the northernmost land in sight was at North 60 degrees West. Our longitude was 208 degrees 37 minutes West, with a distance of 6 miles from the nearest shore; at this point, the water depth was 14 fathoms.

[Off Cape Capricorn, Queensland.]

[Off Cape Capricorn, QLD.]

Friday, 25th. In the P.M. had it calm until 5, when a light breeze sprung up at South-East, and we steer'd North-West as the land lay until 10, then brought too, having had all along 14 and 15 fathoms. At 5 A.M. we made sail; at daylight the Northermost point of the Main bore North 70 degrees West, and soon after we saw more land making like Islands, bearing North-West by North; at 9 we were abreast of the point, distant from it 1 mile; Depth of Water 14 fathoms. I found this point to lay directly under the Tropic of Capricorn, and for that reason call it by that Name. Longitude 209 degrees 0 minutes West. It is of a Moderate height, and looks white and barren, and may be known by some Islands which lie to the North-West of it, and some small Rocks one League South-East from it; on the West side of the Cape there appeared to be a Lagoon. On the 2 Spits which form the Entrance were a great Number of Pelicans; at least, so I call them. The most northermost land we could see bore from Cape Capricorn North 24 degrees West, and appeared to be an Island;* (* Hummocky Island.) but the Main land Trended West by North 1/2 North, which Course we steer'd, having from 15 to 16 fathoms and from 6 to 9, a hard sandy bottom. At Noon our Latitude by Observation was 23 degrees 24 minutes South; Cape Capricorn bore South 60 degrees East, distance 2 Leagues; a small Island North by East 2 Miles. In this Situation had 9 fathoms at the distance of 4 Miles from the Main land, which is here low and Sandy next the Sea, except the points which are moderately high and rocky; in land the Country is hilly, and affords but a very indifferent prospect.* (* Between Bustard Bay and Cape Capricorn is Port Curtis, in which stands the small town of Gladstone. Cape Capricorn is the eastern point of Curtis Island, and to the northward is Keppel Bay, into which falls the Fitzroy River. Up the latter, 35 miles from the sea, is Rockhampton, the second largest town of Queensland. All this coast is encumbered with shoals, outside of which Cook had so far prudently kept. To seaward begins the long chain of islands and reefs known as the Great Australian Barrier, which stretches up to Torres Straits. Cook was unaware of their existence, as they were out of sight, but he became painfully acquainted with them later, where the reefs approach the land, and make navigation along the coast anxious work; but he here began to get into difficulties with the shoals which stretch off the coast itself.)

Friday, 25th. In the afternoon, it was calm until 5 PM when a light breeze picked up from the southeast. We steered northwest as the land lay until 10 PM, then we stopped, having measured 14 and 15 fathoms all along. At 5 AM, we set sail; at sunrise, the northernmost point of the mainland appeared at North 70 degrees West, and shortly after, we spotted more land that looked like islands, bearing Northwest by North. At 9 AM, we were level with the point, about 1 mile away; the water depth was 14 fathoms. I found this point is directly under the Tropic of Capricorn, so I named it that. Longitude 209 degrees 0 minutes West. It is of moderate height, looks white and barren, and can be identified by some islands to the northwest and a few small rocks one league southeast from it. On the west side of the cape, there seemed to be a lagoon. There were many pelicans on the two spits forming the entrance; that's what I called them. The northernmost land we could see from Cape Capricorn bore North 24 degrees West and appeared to be an island; (* Hummocky Island.) but the mainland trended West by North half North, which course we followed, with depths ranging from 15 to 16 fathoms and a hard sandy bottom from 6 to 9. At noon, our latitude by observation was 23 degrees 24 minutes South; Cape Capricorn was at South 60 degrees East, 2 leagues away; a small island was 2 miles to the North by East. In this position, the water was 9 fathoms deep, located 4 miles from the mainland, which is low and sandy near the sea, except for the points that are moderately high and rocky; inland, the terrain is hilly and presents a rather poor view.* (* Between Bustard Bay and Cape Capricorn is Port Curtis, where the small town of Gladstone is located. Cape Capricorn is the eastern point of Curtis Island, with Keppel Bay to the north, into which the Fitzroy River flows. Up this river, 35 miles from the sea, lies Rockhampton, the second largest town in Queensland. This entire coast is littered with shoals, which Cook prudently navigated around. Farther out begins the long chain of islands and reefs known as the Great Australian Barrier, stretching up to Torres Straits. Cook was unaware of their existence as they were out of sight, but he would soon face challenges with them when the reefs approached land, making navigation along the coast tricky; however, he started to encounter difficulties with the shoals extending off the coast itself.)

Saturday, 26th. In the P.M. light breezes at East-South-East, with which we stood to the North-West until 4 o'Clock, when it fell calm, and soon after we Anchored in 12 fathoms. Cape Capricorn bearing South 54 degrees East, distant 4 Leagues, having the Main land and Islands in a manner all around us. In the night we found the tide to rise and fall near 7 feet, and the flood to set to the Westward and Ebb to the Eastward; which is quite the reverse to what we found it when at Anchor to the Eastward of Bustard Bay. At 6 a.m. we weigh'd with the Wind at South, a Gentle breeze, and stood away to the North-West, between the Outermost range of Islands* (* The Keppel Islands.) and the Main land, leaving several small Islands between us and the Latter, which we passed Close by. Our soundings was a little irregular, from 12 to 4 fathoms, which caused me to send a Boat ahead to sound. At noon we were about 3 Miles from the Main, about the same distance from the Islands without us; our Latitude by Observation was 23 degrees 7 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Capricorn 18 Miles West. The Main land in this Latitude is tolerable high and Mountainious; and the Islands which lay off it are the most of them pretty high and of a Small Circuit, and have more the appearance of barrenness than fertility. We saw smookes a good way in land, which makes me think there must be a River, Lagoon, or Inlet, into the Country, and we passed 2 places that had the Appearance of such this morning; but our Depth of Water at that Time was too little to haul in for them, where I might expect to meet with less.

Saturday, 26th. In the afternoon, there was a light breeze coming from the East-Southeast, which pushed us northwest until 4 o'clock when it became calm. Soon after, we anchored in 12 fathoms. Cape Capricorn was bearing South 54 degrees East, about 4 leagues away, with the mainland and islands surrounding us. At night, we noticed the tide rising and falling nearly 7 feet, with the flood tide flowing westward and the ebb tide eastward; this was the opposite of what we experienced when anchored to the east of Bustard Bay. At 6 a.m., we weighed anchor with a gentle breeze coming from the south and headed northwest, passing between the outermost islands (*The Keppel Islands*) and the mainland, leaving several small islands between us and the latter, which we passed close by. Our soundings were somewhat irregular, ranging from 12 to 4 fathoms, so I sent a boat ahead to take soundings. By noon, we were about 3 miles from the mainland and about the same distance from the outer islands; our latitude from observations was 23 degrees 7 minutes south, and our longitude from Cape Capricorn was 18 miles west. The mainland in this latitude is fairly high and mountainous, and most of the islands off it are also quite high and relatively small, looking more barren than fertile. We saw smoke further inland, which makes me think there could be a river, lagoon, or inlet into the country, and we passed two spots that appeared to be such this morning; however, the water depth at that time was too shallow to approach them, where I might expect to find more depth.

Sunday, 27th. We had not stood on to the Northward quite an hour before we fell into 3 fathoms, upon which I anchor'd, and Sent away the Master with 2 Boats to sound the Channell, which lay to Leeward of us between the Northermost Island and the Main Land, which appear'd to me to be pretty broad; but I suspected that it was Shoal, and so it was found, for the Master reported to me upon his return that he found in many places only 2 1/2 fathoms, and where we lay at Anchor we had only 16 feet, which was not 2 feet more than the Ship drew.* (* This was between Great Keppel Island and the Main. There is a mass of shoals here.) In the Evening the wind veer'd to East-North-East, which gave us an opportunity to stretch 3 or 4 miles back the way we Came before the Wind Shifted to South, and obliged us again to Anchor in 6 fathoms. At 5 o'Clock in the A.M. I sent away the Master with 2 Boats to search for a Passage out between the Islands, while the Ship got under sail. As soon as it was light the Signal was made by the boats of their having found a Passage, upon which we hoisted in the Boats, and made sail to the Northward as the land lay; soundings from 9 to 15 fathoms, having still Some small Islands without us.* (* The ship passed out between Great Keppel Island and North Keppel Island.) At noon we were about 2 Leagues from the Main Land, and by observation in the Latitude of 22 degrees 53 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Capricorn 0 degrees 20 minutes West. At this time the Northermost point of Land we had in sight bore North-North-West, distance 10 Miles; this point I named Cape Manyfold, from the Number of high Hills over it; Latitude 22 degrees 43 minutes South; it lies North 20 degrees West, distant 17 Leagues from Cape Capricorn. Between them the shore forms a large Bay, which I call'd Keppel Bay, and the Islands which lay in and Off it are known by the same name; in this Bay is good Anchorage, where there is a sufficient depth of Water; what refreshment it may afford for Shipping I know not.* (* As before mentioned, the Fitzroy River falls into Keppel Bay, and forms a good harbour, though much encumbered with sand banks.) We caught no fish here, notwithstanding we were at Anchor; it can hardly be doubted but what it afforded fresh Water in several places, as both Mainland and Islands are inhabited. We saw smokes by day and fires in the night upon the Main, and people upon one of the Islands.

Sunday, 27th. We had been heading north for about an hour when we hit 3 fathoms, so I dropped anchor and sent the Master out with 2 boats to explore the channel which lay downwind of us, between the northernmost island and the mainland. It seemed pretty wide to me, but I thought it could be shallow, and I was right. The Master reported back that in many spots, he found only 2 ½ fathoms, and where we were anchored, we only had 16 feet, which was barely 2 feet more than the ship's draft.* (* This was between Great Keppel Island and the mainland. There are a lot of shoals here.) In the evening, the wind shifted to East-North-East, allowing us to head back 3 or 4 miles in the direction we came before the wind turned south again, forcing us to anchor in 6 fathoms. At 5 A.M., I sent the Master out with 2 boats to look for a passage out between the islands while the ship got under sail. As soon as it was light, the boats signaled that they had found a passage, so we hoisted the boats back on board and set sail north as the land directed us; we measured depths from 9 to 15 fathoms, still keeping some small islands off to the side.* (* The ship went out between Great Keppel Island and North Keppel Island.) At noon, we were about 2 leagues from the mainland, and by observation, we were at latitude 22 degrees 53 minutes south, and longitude made from Cape Capricorn was 0 degrees 20 minutes west. At that point, the northernmost land we could see was bearing north-northwest, about 10 miles away; I named this point Cape Manyfold because of the number of high hills over it; latitude 22 degrees 43 minutes south; it lies at north 20 degrees west, 17 leagues from Cape Capricorn. Between them, the shore forms a large bay, which I called Keppel Bay, and the islands in and off it carry the same name; this bay has good anchorage with enough water depth; I’m not sure what kind of fresh water it might provide for shipping.* (* As mentioned before, the Fitzroy River flows into Keppel Bay, forming a good harbor, although it is heavily loaded with sandbanks.) We didn’t catch any fish here, even though we were anchored; it’s hard to doubt that fresh water is available in several places since both the mainland and the islands are inhabited. We saw smoke during the day and fires at night on the mainland, and people were visible on one of the islands.

[Off Cape Townshend, Queensland.]

[Off Cape Townshend, Queensland.]

Monday, 28th. Winds at South-South-East, a fresh breeze. At 3 o'Clock in the P.M. we passed Cape Manifold, from which the Land Trends North-North-West. The land of this Cape is tolerable high, and riseth in hills directly from the Sea; it may be known by 3 Islands laying off it, one near the Shore, and the other 2 Eight Miles out at Sea; the one of these is low and flat, and the other high and round.* (* Peak and Flat Islands.) At 6 o'Clock we shortned sail and brought too; the Northermost part of the Main we had in sight bore North-West, and some Islands lying off it bore North 31 degrees West; our soundings since Noon were from 20 to 25 fathoms, and in the Night 30 and 34 fathoms. At day light we made Sail, Cape Manifold bearing South by East, distance 8 Leagues, and the Islands set last night in the same directions, distance from us 4 Miles. The farthest point of the Main bore North 67 degrees West, distant 22 Miles; but we could see several Islands to the Northward of this direction.* (* The easternmost of the Northumberland Islands.) At 9 o'Clock we were abreast of the above point, which I named Cape Townshend* (* Charles Townshend was Chancellor of the Exchequer 1767.) (Latitude 22 degrees 13 minutes, Longitude 209 degrees 48 minutes West); the land of this Cape is of a moderate and pretty even height, and is more barren than woody. Several Islands lay to the Northward of it, 4 or 5 Leagues out at Sea. 3 or 4 Leagues to the South-East the Shore forms a bay,* (* Shoalwater Bay, a large inlet.) in the bottom of which there appeared to be an inlet or Harbour to the Westward of the Coast, and Trends South-West 1/2 South; and these form a very large Bay, which turns away to the Eastward, and probably communicates with the Inlet above mentioned, and by that Means makes the land of the Cape an Island. As soon as we got round the Cape we hauld our wind to the Westward in order to get within the Islands which lay scatter'd up and down in this bay in great number, and extend out to Sea as far as we could see from the Masthead; how much farther will hardly be in my power to determine; they are as Various in their height and Circuit as they are numerous.* (* The Northumberland islands, a very extensive group.) We had not stood long upon a Wind before we meet with Shoal Water, and was obliged to Tack about to avoid it; after which I sent a boat ahead, and we bore away West by North, leaving many small Islands, Rocks, and Shoals between us and the Main, and a number of Large Islands without us; soundings from 14 to 17 fathoms, Sandy Bottom. A little before noon the boat made the Signal for meeting with Shoal Water, upon which we hauld close upon a Wind to the Eastward, but suddenly fell into 3 1/4 fathoms water, upon which we immediately let go an Anchor, and brought the Ship up with all sails standing, and had then 4 fathoms Coarse sandy bottom. We found here a strong Tide setting to the North-West by West 1/2 West, at the rate of between 2 and 3 Miles an Hour, which was what Carried us so quickly upon the Shoal. Our Latitude by Observation was 22 degrees 8 minutes South; Cape Townshend bore East 16 degrees South, distant 13 Miles, and the Westermost part of the Main Land in sight West 3/4 North, having a number of Islands in sight all round us.* (* The ship was on the Donovan Shoal in Broad Sound Channel.)

Monday, 28th. Winds from the South-South-East, a fresh breeze. At 3 PM, we passed Cape Manifold, from which the land trends North-North-West. The land at this Cape is fairly high and rises into hills directly from the sea; it can be identified by three islands lying off it, one near the shore, and the other two eight miles out at sea. One of these is low and flat, while the other is high and round.* (* Peak and Flat Islands.) At 6 PM, we shortened sail and stopped; the northernmost part of the mainland we could see bore North-West, and some islands off it bore North 31 degrees West; our soundings since noon ranged from 20 to 25 fathoms, and at night 30 and 34 fathoms. At dawn, we set sail again, with Cape Manifold bearing South by East, 8 leagues away, and the islands we sighted last night in the same direction, 4 miles from us. The farthest point of the mainland bore North 67 degrees West, 22 miles away; however, we could see several islands to the north of this direction.* (* The easternmost of the Northumberland Islands.) At 9 AM, we were abreast of the point mentioned earlier, which I named Cape Townshend* (* Charles Townshend was Chancellor of the Exchequer 1767.) (Latitude 22 degrees 13 minutes, Longitude 209 degrees 48 minutes West); the land here is moderately even in height and is more barren than wooded. Several islands lay to the north, 4 or 5 leagues out at sea. About 3 or 4 leagues to the southeast, the shore forms a bay,* (* Shoalwater Bay, a large inlet.) in the bottom of which there appeared to be an inlet or harbor to the west of the coast, trending South-West 1/2 South; this forms a large bay that curves to the east, likely connecting with the inlet mentioned above, making the land at the Cape essentially an island. Once we rounded the Cape, we changed our course to the west to navigate within the numerous islands scattered in this bay, extending out to sea as far as we could see from the masthead; it's hard to determine how much farther they stretch; they vary greatly in height and shape as well as in number.* (* The Northumberland Islands, a very extensive group.) We hadn’t sailed long before encountering shallow water and had to tack to avoid it; afterward, I sent a boat ahead, and we headed West by North, passing many small islands, rocks, and shoals between us and the mainland, along with a number of large islands beyond us; soundings were from 14 to 17 fathoms with a sandy bottom. Shortly before noon, the boat signaled that they found shallow water, prompting us to head eastward, but we suddenly hit 3 1/4 fathoms of water, which led us to drop an anchor and bring the ship to a stop with all sails still up, now having 4 fathoms of coarse sandy bottom. We found a strong tide flowing to the North-West by West 1/2 West, moving at a speed of 2 to 3 miles per hour, which caused us to run aground so quickly. Our latitude, as observed, was 22 degrees 8 minutes South; Cape Townshend bore East 16 degrees South, 13 miles away, and the westernmost part of the mainland in sight was West 3/4 North, with several islands visible all around us.* (* The ship was on the Donovan Shoal in Broad Sound Channel.)

Tuesday, 29th. Fresh gales between the South-South-East and East-South-East, Hazey weather, with some showers of rain. In the P.M., having sounded about the Ship, and found that their was Sufficient Water for her over the Shoal, we at 3 o'clock weigh'd and made Sail, and stood to the Westward as the Land lay, having first sent a boat ahead to sound. At 6 we Anchor'd in 10 fathoms, Sandy bottom, about 2 Miles from the Main Land, the Westermost part of which bore West-North-West, having still a Number of Islands in sight a long way without us. At 5 a.m. I sent away the Master with 2 Boats to sound the Entrance of an inlet, which bore from us West, distance about 1 League, into which I intended to go with the Ship to wait a few days, until the Moon increased, and in the meantime to examine the Country. By such time as we had got the Ship under Sail the Boats made the Signal for Anchorage, upon which we stood in with the Ship, and Anchor'd in 5 fathoms, about a League within the Entrance of the inlet, which we judged to be a River running a Good way inland, as I observed the Tides to flow and Ebb something considerable.* (* It is in reality a narrow channel which runs into Broad Sound.) I had some thoughts of laying the Ship a Shore to Clean her bottom. With this view both the Master and I went to look for a Convenient place for that purpose, and at the same time to look for fresh Water, not one drop of which we could find, but met with several places where a Ship might be laid ashore with safety.

Tuesday, the 29th. We had fresh winds coming from the South-South-East and East-South-East, with hazy conditions and some rain showers. In the afternoon, after checking around the ship and confirming there was enough water for her to pass over the shoal, we weighed anchor and set sail at 3 o'clock, heading westward along the coastline, after sending a boat ahead to check the depth. By 6, we anchored in 10 fathoms on sandy bottom, about 2 miles from the mainland, with the westernmost point of land to the West-North-West, and several islands still visible far off. At 5 a.m., I sent the master with 2 boats to explore the entrance of an inlet located about a league to the west, where I planned to take the ship for a few days to wait for the moon to wax, and in the meantime, to explore the area. Once we had the ship under sail, the boats signaled for anchorage, so we moved in with the ship and anchored in 5 fathoms, about a league up the inlet, which we thought might be a river extending far inland, as I noticed the tides flowing and ebbing significantly. I considered beaching the ship to clean her bottom. To that end, both the master and I went to find a suitable spot for this and also to search for fresh water, but we couldn’t find a single drop; however, we did come across several places where a ship could be safely grounded.

[At Anchor, Thirsty Sound.]

[At Anchor, Thirsty Sound.]

Wednesday, 30th. In the P.M. I went again in search of Fresh Water, but had no better success than before; wherefore I gave over all thoughts of laying the Ship a Shore, being resolved to spend as little time as possible in a place that was likely to afford us no sort of refreshment. But as I had observed from the Hills the inlet to run a good way in, I thought this a good time to penetrate into the Country to see a little of the inland parts. Accordingly I prepared for making that Excursion in the morning, but the first thing I did was to get upon a pretty high Hill, which is at the North-West entrance of the inlet, before Sunrise, in order to take a view of the Sea Coast and Islands, etc., that lay off it, and to take their bearings, having the Azimuth Compass with me for that purpose, the Needle of which differ'd from its True position something very considerable, even above 30 degrees, in some places more, and in other less, for I try'd it in several places. I found it differ in itself above 2 points in the space of about 14 feet. The loose stones which lay upon the Ground had no effect upon the Needle; I therefore concluded that it must be owing to Iron Ore upon the Hill, visible signs of which appeared not only here, but in several other places. As soon as I had done here I proceeded up the inlet. I set out with the first of the flood, and long before high water got about 8 Leagues up it; its breadth thus far was from 2 to 4 or 5 Miles upon a South-West by South direction; but here it spread every way, and formed a Large lake, which communicated with the Sea to the North-West. I not only saw the Sea in this direction, but found the tide of flood coming strong in from the North-West. I likewise observ'd an Arm of this Lake extending to the Eastward, and it is not at all improbable but what it Communicates with the Sea in the bottom of the bay, which lies to the Westward of Cape Townshend.* (* This is exactly what it does.) On the South side of the Lake is a ridge of pretty high hills, which I was desirous of going upon; but as the day was far spent and high water, I was afraid of being bewilder'd among the Shoals in the night, which promised to be none of the best, being already rainy, dirty weather, and therefore I made the best of my way to the Ship. In this little Excursion I saw only 2 people, and those at a distance, and are all that we have seen in this place, but we have met with several fire places, and seen smokes at a distance. This inlet, which I have named Thirsty Sound, by reason we could find no fresh Water, lies in the Latitude of 22 degrees 05 minutes South, and Longitude 210 degrees 24 West; it may be known by a Group of small Islands Laying under the shore from 2 to 5 Leagues North-West from it.* (* Barren Islands.) There is likewise another Group of Islands laying right before it between 3 and 4 Leagues out at Sea.* (* Duke Islands.) Over each of the Points that form the Entrance is a pretty high, round Hill; that on the North-West is a Peninsula, surrounded by the Sea at high water; the distance from the one to the other is about 2 Miles bold to both Shores. Here is good Anchoring in 7, 6, 5, and 4 fathoms water, and very Convenient places for laying a Ship ashore, where at Spring Tides the tides doth not rise less than 16 or 18 feet, and flows at full and Change of the Moon about 11 o'Clock. We met with no fresh water, or any other kind of refreshments whatever; we saw 2 Turtle, but caught none, nor no sort of Fish or wild fowl, except a few small land birds. Here are the same sort of Water Fowl as we saw in Botany Bay, and like them, so shy that it is hardly possible to get within shott of them. No signs of Fertility is to be seen upon the Land; the Soil of the up lands is mostly a hard, redish Clay, and produceth several sorts of Trees, such as we have seen before, and some others, and clear of all underwoods. All the low lands are mostly overrun with Mangroves, and at Spring tides overflow'd by the Sea; and I believe in the rainy Seasons here are large land floods, as we saw in many places Gullies, which seem'd to have been made by torrents of Water coming from the Adjacent hills, besides other Visible signs of the Water having been a Considerable height above the Common Spring Tides. Dr. Solander and I was upon a rising Ground up the inlet, which we thought had at one time or another been overflow'd by the Sea, and if so great part of the Country must at that time been laid under Water. Up in the lakes, or lagoons, I suppose, are shell fish, on which the few Natives subsist. We found Oysters sticking to most of the Rocks upon the Shore, which were so small, as not to be worth the picking off.* (* Cook was very unfortunate in his landing here. The channel is at the end of a long headland between two bays, Shoalwater Bay and Broad Sound, and was a very unlikely place either to find water or get any true idea of the country.)

Wednesday, 30th. In the afternoon, I set out again to find fresh water, but I had no better luck than before; so I decided not to attempt to bring the ship ashore, determined to spend as little time as possible in a place that was unlikely to provide us with any refreshment. However, having noticed from the hills that the inlet extended quite far inland, I thought it would be a good time to explore the area a bit more. I got ready for the trip in the morning, but first, I climbed a pretty high hill at the northwest entrance of the inlet before sunrise to get a view of the coastline and surrounding islands, and to take their bearings with my azimuth compass. The needle was significantly off its true position, more than 30 degrees in some spots, and less in others, as I tested it in various locations. I noticed it could differ by more than 2 points in just 14 feet. The loose stones on the ground didn’t affect the needle, so I concluded it must be due to iron ore on the hill, which had visible signs not only here but in several other places too. Once I finished up here, I moved up the inlet. I set out with the incoming tide and made it about 8 leagues up before high water. The width of the inlet so far was about 2 to 5 miles in a south-west by south direction; however, it widened out into a large lake, which connected to the sea to the northwest. I not only saw the sea in that direction but also felt the strong flood tide coming from the northwest. I also noticed an arm of this lake stretching eastward, and it’s quite possible it connects with the sea at the bottom of the bay that lies west of Cape Townshend.* (* This is exactly what it does.) On the south side of the lake, there’s a ridge of pretty high hills that I wanted to explore, but since the day was getting late and it was high water, I worried about getting lost among the shoals at night, which wasn’t looking promising since the weather was already rainy and muddy, so I made my way back to the ship. During this little excursion, I only saw 2 people at a distance, which are the only ones we’ve come across here, though we have spotted several fire pits and seen smoke in the distance. This inlet, which I’ve named Thirsty Sound because we couldn’t find any fresh water, lies at latitude 22 degrees 05 minutes south and longitude 210 degrees 24 west; it can be identified by a group of small islands lying 2 to 5 leagues northwest of it.* (* Barren Islands.) There’s also another group of islands directly in front of it, 3 to 4 leagues out to sea.* (* Duke Islands.) At each point forming the entrance, there’s a pretty high round hill; the one on the northwest is a peninsula surrounded by sea at high tide; the distance from one hill to the other is about 2 miles from both shores. There’s good anchorage in 4, 5, 6, and 7 fathoms of water, and very suitable spots for beaching a ship, where at spring tides, the tide doesn’t rise less than 16 or 18 feet and flows at high and low tide around 11 o'clock. We did not find any fresh water or any other kind of refreshment; we saw 2 turtles but caught none, nor did we see any fish or wild fowl, just a few small land birds. There are the same kind of waterfowl as we spotted in Botany Bay, and like them, they are so skittish that it’s nearly impossible to get close enough to shoot them. There are no signs of fertility on the land; the soil in the uplands is mostly hard reddish clay and has several types of trees, some we’ve seen before and others new, without any underbrush. All the lowland areas are mostly taken over by mangroves and are flooded by the sea at spring tides; I believe there are large land floods during the rainy season since we saw many places with gullies that seem to have been shaped by torrents of water coming from the nearby hills, along with other visible signs of water having been much higher than normal spring tides. Dr. Solander and I were on a rise along the inlet that we thought had been flooded by the sea at one time, suggesting that a large part of the country must have been underwater then. Up in the lakes or lagoons, I assume there are shellfish on which the few natives rely. We found oysters stuck to most of the rocks along the shore, but they were so small that they weren’t worth harvesting.* (* Cook was very unfortunate in his landing here. The channel is at the end of a long headland between two bays, Shoalwater Bay and Broad Sound, and was a very unlikely place either to find water or get any true idea of the country.)

Thursday, 31st. Winds Southerly and South-East; Dark, Hazey weather, with rain. In the P.M., finding no one inducement to stay longer in this place, we at 6 a.m. Weighed and put to Sea, and stood to the North-West, having the Advantage of a fresh breeze at South-South-East. We keept without the Group of Islands which lay in Shore, and to the North-West of Thirsty Sound, as there appear'd to be no safe passage between them and the Main; at the same time we had a number of Islands without us extending out to Sea as far as we could see; as we run in this direction our depth of Water was 10, 8 and 9 fathoms.* (* The ship passed between the Duke Islands and the maze of reefs and islands lying North-West of Thirsty Sound.) At Noon the North-West point of Thirsty Sound, which I have named Pier head, bore South 36 degrees East, distant 5 Leagues; the East point of the other inlet, which Communicates with the former, as I have before mentioned, bore South by West, distance 2 1/2 Leagues, the Group of Islands above mentioned laying between us and the point. The farthest part of the Main in sight, on the other side of the inlet, bore North-West; our Latitude by Observation was 21 degrees 53 minutes South.

Thursday, 31st. Winds were coming from the South and South-East; it was dark and hazy, with rain. In the afternoon, since there was no good reason to stay here any longer, we weighed anchor at 6 a.m. and headed out to sea, sailing Northwest with a fresh breeze from the South-South-East. We kept outside the group of islands that were close to shore and Northwest of Thirsty Sound, as there didn’t seem to be any safe passage between them and the mainland; at the same time, we had several islands extending out to sea as far as we could see. As we traveled in this direction, the water depth was 10, 8, and 9 fathoms.* (* The ship passed between the Duke Islands and the maze of reefs and islands lying Northwest of Thirsty Sound.) At noon, the Northwest point of Thirsty Sound, which I named Pier Head, was positioned at South 36 degrees East, 5 leagues away; the East point of the other inlet, which connects to the former inlet, as I mentioned earlier, was at South by West, 2 1/2 leagues away, with the group of islands lying between us and the point. The farthest part of the mainland visible on the other side of the inlet was to the Northwest; our latitude by observation was 21 degrees 53 minutes South.

[June 1770.]

[June 1770.]

Friday, June 1st. At 1/2 an hour After Noon, upon the Boat we had ahead sounding making the Signal for Shoal Water, we hauld our wind to the North-East, having at that time 7 fathoms; the Next cast 5, and then 3, upon which we let go an Anchor, and brought the Ship up. The North-West point of Thirsty Sound, or Pier Head, bore South-East, distance 6 Leagues, being Midway between the Islands which lies off the East point of the Western inlet and 3 Small Islands directly without them,* (* The shoal is now known as Lake Shoal. The three Islands are the Bedwell Islands.) it being now the first of the flood which we found to set North-West by West 1/2 West. After having sounded about the Shoal, on which we found not quite 3 fathoms, but without it deep water, we got under Sail, and hauld round the 3 Islands just mentioned, and came to an Anchor under the Lee of them in 15 fathoms, having at this time dark, hazey, rainy weather, which continued until 7 o'Clock a.m., at which time we got again under sail, and stood to the North-West with a fresh breeze at South-South-East and fair weather, having the Main land in Sight and a Number of Islands all round us, some of which lay out at Sea as far as we could See. The Western Inlet before mentioned, known in the Chart by the Name of Broad Sound, we had now all open. It is at least 9 or 10 Leagues wide at the Entrance, with several Islands laying in and before, and I believe Shoals also, for we had very irregular Soundings, from 10 to 5 and 4 fathoms. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 21 degrees 29 minutes South, and Longitude made from Cape Townshend 59 degrees West. A point of Land, which forms the North-West Entrance into Broad Sound, bore from us at this Time West, distance 3 Leagues; this Cape I have named Cape Palmerston* (* Henry Viscount Palmerston was a Lord of the Admiralty, 1766 to 1778.) (Latitude 21 degrees 27 minutes South, Longitude 210 degrees 57 minutes West). Between this Cape and Cape Townshend lies the Bay of Inlets, so named from the Number of Inlets, Creeks, etc., in it.* (* The name Bay of Inlets has disappeared from the charts. Cook applied it to the whole mass of bays in this locality, covering over 60 miles. A look at a modern chart causes amazement that Cook managed to keep his ship off the ground, as the whole sea in his track is strewed with dangers.)

Friday, June 1st. At 12:30 PM, when we saw a boat ahead signaling for shallow water, we adjusted our sails to head North-East, having 7 fathoms at that moment; the next soundings were 5, and then 3 fathoms, at which point we dropped anchor and secured the ship. The North-West point of Thirsty Sound, or Pier Head, was situated Southeast, about 6 leagues away, positioned midway between the islands off the Eastern point of the Western inlet and 3 small islands just beyond them. (*The shoal is now known as Lake Shoal. The three islands are the Bedwell Islands.) It was then the beginning of the flood tide, which we observed setting North-West by West 1/2 West. After checking the depth around the shoal, where we found less than 3 fathoms, we noticed it was deep water beyond, so we set sail again and navigated around the 3 mentioned islands, finally anchoring under their shelter in 15 fathoms, while experiencing dark, hazy, rainy weather, which lasted until 7 AM. At that time, we set sail again and moved North-West with a fresh breeze from the South-South-East and fair weather, with the mainland in view and several islands surrounding us, some extending as far out to sea as we could see. The Western Inlet previously mentioned, labeled as Broad Sound on the chart, was now fully open to us. It is at least 9 or 10 leagues wide at the entrance, with several islands within and in front, and I suspect there are also shoals, as our soundings were very irregular, ranging from 10 to 5 and 4 fathoms. At noon, our observations placed us at a latitude of 21 degrees 29 minutes South and longitude from Cape Townshend at 59 degrees West. A point of land marking the North-West entrance to Broad Sound was to our West, 3 leagues away; I have named this cape Cape Palmerston (*Henry Viscount Palmerston was a Lord of the Admiralty, 1766 to 1778.) (Latitude 21 degrees 27 minutes South, Longitude 210 degrees 57 minutes West). Between this cape and Cape Townshend lies the Bay of Inlets, named for its numerous inlets, creeks, etc. (*The name Bay of Inlets has disappeared from the charts. Cook applied it to the whole mass of bays in this locality, covering over 60 miles. A look at a modern chart causes amazement that Cook managed to keep his ship off the ground, as the whole sea in his track is strewed with dangers.)

[Off Cape Hillsborough, Queensland.]

[Off Cape Hillsborough, Queensland.]

Saturday, 2nd. Winds at South-South-East and South-East, a gentle breeze, with which we stood to the North-West and North-West by North, as the land lay, under an easey Sail. Having a boat ahead, found our Soundings at first were very irregular, from 9 to 4 fathoms; but afterwards regular, from 9 to 11 fathoms. At 8, being about 2 Leagues from the Main Land, we Anchor'd in 11 fathoms, Sandy bottom. Soon after this we found a Slow Motion of a Tide seting to the Eastward, and rode so until 6, at which time the tide had risen 11 feet; we now got under Sail, and Stood away North-North-West as the land lay. From the Observations made on the tide last Night it is plain that the flood comes from the North-West; whereas Yesterday and for Several days before we found it to come from the South-East. This is neither the first nor second time that we have observed the same thing, and in my Opinion easy accounted for; but this I shall do in another place. At sun rise we found the Variation to be 6 degrees 45 minutes East. In steering along shore between the Island and the Main, at the Distance of 2 Leagues from the Latter, and 3 or 4 from the former, our soundings were Regular, from 12 to 9 fathoms; but about 11 o'Clock we were again embarrassed with Shoal Water,* (* Blackwood Shoals.) but got clear without letting go an Anchor; we had at one time not quite 3 fathoms. At Noon we were about 2 Leagues from the Main land, and about 4 from the Islands without us; our Latitude by Observation was 20 degrees 56 minutes South, Longitude made from Cape Palmerston 16 degrees West; a pretty high Promontory, which I named Cape Hillsborough,* (* Earl of Hillsborough was the First Secretary of State for the Colonies, and President of the Board of Trade when the Endeavour sailed.) bore West 1/2 North, distant 7 Miles. The Main Land is here pretty much diversified with Mountains, Hills, plains, and Vallies, and seem'd to be tollerably Cloathed with Wood and Verdure. These Islands, which lay Parrallel with the Coast, and from 5 to 8 or 9 Leagues off, are of Various Extent, both for height and Circuit; hardly any Exceeds 5 Leagues in Circuit, and many again are very small.* (* The Cumberland Islands. They stretch along the coast for 60 miles.) Besides the Chain of Islands, which lay at a distance from the Coast, there are other Small Ones laying under the Land. Some few smokes were seen on the Main land.

Saturday, 2nd. The winds were coming from the South-South-East and South-East, creating a gentle breeze that allowed us to head North-West and North-West by North, following the land, with an easy sail. With a boat leading the way, we found our depth readings were quite irregular at first, ranging from 9 to 4 fathoms; but later they became consistent at 9 to 11 fathoms. At 8 AM, about 2 leagues from the mainland, we dropped anchor in 11 fathoms over sandy bottom. Shortly after, we noticed a slow tide moving eastward, which we rode until 6, when the tide had risen 11 feet; we then set sail and continued North-North-West along the land. From the observations made on the tide last night, it was clear that the flood was coming from the North-West; in contrast to yesterday and several days prior when it came from the South-East. This isn’t the first or second time we've noticed this, and I believe it can be explained easily; but I'll discuss that elsewhere. At sunrise, we recorded a variation of 6 degrees 45 minutes East. While navigating along the shore between the island and the mainland, at a distance of 2 leagues from the latter and 3 or 4 from the former, our depth readings were consistent, ranging from 12 to 9 fathoms; however, around 11 o'clock we encountered shallow water, but we managed to steer clear without dropping anchor; at one point, we were nearly in 3 fathoms. At noon, we were about 2 leagues from the mainland and about 4 from the outer islands; our latitude as observed was 20 degrees 56 minutes South, with a longitude made from Cape Palmerston being 16 degrees West; a fairly high promontory, which I named Cape Hillsborough, bore West 1/2 North, 7 miles away. The mainland here is quite varied with mountains, hills, plains, and valleys, and appeared to be reasonably covered with wood and greenery. These islands, which run parallel with the coast and are located about 5 to 8 or 9 leagues offshore, vary in size both in height and circumference; few exceed 5 leagues in circumference, and many are quite small. Besides the chain of islands that lie offshore, there are other smaller ones located near the land. A few wisps of smoke were seen on the mainland.

Sunday, 3rd. Winds between the South by East and South-East. A Gentle breeze and Clear weather. In the P.M. we steer'd along shore North-West 1/2 West, at the distance of 2 Leagues from the Main, having 9 and 10 fathoms regular soundings. At sun set the furthest point of the Main Land that we could distinguish as such bore North 48 degrees West; to the Northward of this lay some high land, which I took to be an Island, the North West point of which bore North 41 degrees West; but as I was not sure that there was a passage this way, we at 8 came to an Anchor in 10 fathoms, muddy bottom. 2 hours after this we had a tide setting to the Northward, and at 2 o'clock it had fallen 9 Feet since the time we Anchored. After this the Tide began to rise, and the flood came from the Northward, which was from the Islands out at Sea, and plainly indicated that there was no passage to the North-West; but as this did not appear at day light when we got under Sail, and stood away to the North-West until 8, at this time we discover'd low land, quite a Cross what we took for an Opening between the Main and the Islands, which proved to be a Bay about 5 or 6 Leagues deep. Upon this we hauld our wind to the Eastward round the Northermost point of the Bay, which bore from us at this time North-East by North, distance 4 Leagues. From this point we found the Main land trend away North by West 1/2 West, and a Strait or Passage between it and a Large Island* (* Whitsunday Island.) or Islands laying in a Parrallel direction with the Coast; this passage we Stood into, having the Tide of Ebb in our favour. At Noon we were just within the Entrance, and by observation in the Latitude of 20 degrees 26 minutes South; Cape Hillsborough bore South by East, distant 10 Leagues, and the North point of the Bay before mentioned bore South 19 degrees West, distance 4 Miles. This point I have named Cape Conway* (* General H.S. Conway was Secretary of State 1765 to 1768.) (Latitude 20 degrees 30 minutes, Longitude 211 degrees 28 minutes), and the bay, Repulse Bay, which is formed by these 2 Capes. The greatest and least depth of Water we found in it was 13 and 8 fathoms; every where safe Anchoring, and I believe, was it properly examined, there would be found some good Harbour in it, especIally on the North Side within Cape Conway, for just within the Cape lay 2 or 3 Small Islands, which alone would shelter that side of the Bay from the South-East and Southerly winds, which seem to be the prevailing or Trade Winds. Among the many islands that lay upon this Coast there is one more Remarkable than the rest,* (* Probably Blacksmith Island.) being of a Small circuit, very high and peaked, and lies East by South, 10 Miles from Cape Conway at the South end of the Passage above mention'd.

Sunday, 3rd. Winds from the South by East and South-East. A gentle breeze and clear weather. In the afternoon, we steered along the shore North-West 1/2 West, about 2 leagues off the main land, with regular soundings of 9 and 10 fathoms. At sunset, the furthest point of the main land we could identify bore North 48 degrees West; to the north of this point, there was some high land that I thought was an island, the north-west point of which bore North 41 degrees West. Unsure if there was a passage this way, we anchored at 8 in 10 fathoms with a muddy bottom. Two hours later, there was a tide flowing to the north, and at 2 o'clock, it had dropped 9 feet since we anchored. After that, the tide started to rise, coming from the north, indicating no passage to the north-west. However, since this wasn’t clear at daylight when we set sail, we continued north-west until 8. At that point, we spotted low land that crossed what we thought was an opening between the main land and the islands, which turned out to be a bay about 5 or 6 leagues deep. We then changed our course to the east around the northernmost point of the bay, which bore from us at that moment North-East by North, a distance of 4 leagues. From this point, we found the main land trending away North by West 1/2 West, and a strait or passage between it and a large island (*Whitsunday Island*) or islands running parallel to the coast; we moved into this passage with the ebb tide in our favor. At noon, we were just inside the entrance, and after observation, we were at 20 degrees 26 minutes South latitude; Cape Hillsborough bore South by East, 10 leagues away, and the north point of the previously mentioned bay was at South 19 degrees West, 4 miles away. I named this point Cape Conway (*General H.S. Conway was Secretary of State from 1765 to 1768.*) (Latitude 20 degrees 30 minutes, Longitude 211 degrees 28 minutes) and the bay Repulse Bay, formed by these two capes. The deepest and shallowest water we found in it was 13 and 8 fathoms, respectively; anchoring is safe everywhere, and if properly examined, I believe there could be a good harbor, especially on the north side within Cape Conway, where just inside the cape are 2 or 3 small islands that would shelter that side of the bay from the south-east and southerly winds, which seem to be the prevailing trade winds. Among the many islands along this coast, there is one more remarkable than the rest (*probably Blacksmith Island*), small in size, very high and peaked, lying East by South, 10 miles from Cape Conway at the southern end of the mentioned passage.

[In Whitsunday Passage, Queensland.]

[In Whitsunday Passage, QLD.]

Monday, 4th. Winds at South-South-East and South-East, a Gentle breeze and Clear weather. In the P.M. Steerd thro' the passage* (* Whitsunday Passage. The aspect of the shores is very pleasing.) which we found from 3 to 6 or 7 Miles broad, and 8 or 9 Leagues in length, North by West 1/2 West and South by East 1/2 East. It is form'd by the Main on the West, and by Islands on the East, one of which is at least 5 Leagues in length. Our Depth of Water in running thro' was between 25 and 20 fathoms; everywhere good Anchorage; indeed the whole passage is one Continued safe Harbour, besides a Number of small Bays and Coves on each side, where ships might lay as it where in a Bason; at least so it appear'd to me, for I did not wait to Examine it, as having been in Port so lately, and being unwilling to loose the benefit of a light Moon. The land, both on the Main and Islands, especially on the former, is Tolerably high, and distinguished by Hills and Vallies, which are diversified with Woods and Lawns that looked green and pleasant. On a Sandy beach upon one of the Islands we saw 2 people and a Canoe, with an outrigger, which appeared to be both Larger and differently built to any we have seen upon the Coast. At 6 we were nearly the length of the North end of the Passage; the North Westermost point of the Main in sight bore North 54 degrees West, and the North end of the Island North-North-East, having an open Sea between these 2 points. [This passage I have named Whitsundays Passage, as it was discover'd on the day the Church commemorates that Festival, and the Isles which form it Cumberland Isles, in honour of His Royal Highness the Duke of Cumberland.* (* Henry Frederick, Duke of Cumberland, was a younger brother of George III.)] We keept under an Easey Sail and the Lead going all Night, having 21, 22, and 23 fathoms, at the distance of 3 Leagues from the land. At daylight A.M. we were abreast of the point above mentioned, which is a lofty promontory; that I named Cape Gloucester* (* William Henry, Duke of Gloucester and Edinburgh, a younger brother of George III.) (Latitude 19 degrees 57 minutes South, Longitude 211 degrees 54 minutes West). It may be known by an Island which lies out at Sea North by West 1/2 West, 5 or 6 Leagues from it; this I called Holbourn Isle.* (* Admiral Francis Holbourne commanded the fleet in North America in which Cook served in 1757.) There are also Islands laying under the Land between it and Whitsundays Passage. On the West side of the Cape the Land Trends away South-West and South-South-West, and forms a deep bay. The Sand in the bottom of this bay I could but just see from the Masthead; it is very low, and is a Continuation of the same low land as is at the bottom of Repulse Bay. Without Waiting to look into this bay, which I called Edgcumbe Bay,* (* In Port Denison, on the western side of Edgcumbe Bay, is the rising town of Bowen, the port of an agricultural district. There is good coal in the vicinity. Captain G. Edgcumbe commanded the Lancaster in the fleet in North America in 1758 in which Cook served. Afterwards Earl of Mount Edgcumbe.) we continued our Course to the Westward for the Westermost land we had in sight which bore from us West by North 1/2 North, and appeared very high. At Noon we were about 3 Leagues from the Land, and by observation in the Latitude of 19 degrees 47 minutes South, Cape Gloucester bearing South 63 degrees East, distant 7 1/2 Leagues.

Monday, 4th. Winds from the South-South-East and South-East, a light breeze and clear weather. In the afternoon, we navigated through the passage (* Whitsunday Passage. The shores look very pleasant.) which we found to be 3 to 6 or 7 miles wide, and 8 or 9 leagues long, trending North by West 1/2 West and South by East 1/2 East. It is formed by the mainland on the west and islands on the east, one of which is at least 5 leagues long. The water depth as we passed through ranged from 25 to 20 fathoms; there was good anchorage everywhere; in fact, the entire passage is a continuous safe harbor, along with several small bays and coves on each side where ships could rest as if in a basin; at least, that's how it seemed to me, as I didn’t take time to examine it, having recently been in port and wanting to make the most of the light moon. The land, both on the mainland and the islands, particularly on the mainland, is reasonably high and marked by hills and valleys, which are dotted with woods and lawns that looked green and inviting. On a sandy beach on one of the islands, we saw 2 people and a canoe with an outrigger, which seemed larger and built differently than any we had seen along the coast. At 6 o'clock, we were nearly at the north end of the passage; the northwestern point of the mainland in sight was bearing North 54 degrees West, and the north end of the island was North-North-East, with open sea between these two points. [I have named this passage Whitsundays Passage, as it was discovered on the day the church commemorates that festival, and the islands that form it Cumberland Isles, in honor of His Royal Highness the Duke of Cumberland.* (* Henry Frederick, Duke of Cumberland, was a younger brother of George III.)] We kept sailing under easy canvas, with the lead line in the water all night, having depths of 21, 22, and 23 fathoms, 3 leagues from the land. At dawn, we were in line with the aforementioned point, which is a tall promontory that I named Cape Gloucester* (* William Henry, Duke of Gloucester and Edinburgh, a younger brother of George III.) (Latitude 19 degrees 57 minutes South, Longitude 211 degrees 54 minutes West). It can be recognized by an island located at sea North by West 1/2 West, 5 or 6 leagues from it; I called this Holbourn Isle.* (* Admiral Francis Holbourne commanded the fleet in North America in which Cook served in 1757.) There are also islands lying along the land between it and Whitsundays Passage. On the western side of the cape, the land stretches away South-West and South-South-West, forming a deep bay. The sand at the bottom of this bay was barely visible from the masthead; it is very low and continues the same low land found at the bottom of Repulse Bay. Without taking time to explore this bay, which I named Edgcumbe Bay,* (* In Port Denison, on the western side of Edgcumbe Bay, is the rising town of Bowen, the port of an agricultural district. There is good coal in the vicinity. Captain G. Edgcumbe commanded the Lancaster in the fleet in North America in 1758 in which Cook served. He later became the Earl of Mount Edgcumbe.) we continued our course westward towards the westernmost land in sight, which was bearing from us West by North 1/2 North, and appeared very high. At noon, we were about 3 leagues from the land, and by observation, we were at a latitude of 19 degrees 47 minutes South, with Cape Gloucester bearing South 63 degrees East, 7 1/2 leagues away.

Tuesday, 5th. Winds between the South and East, a Gentle breeze, and Serene weather. At 6 a.m. we were abreast of the Western point of Land above mentioned, distant from it 3 Miles, which I have named Cape Upstart, because being surrounded with low land it starts or rises up singley at the first making of it (Latitude 19 degrees 39 minutes South, Longitude 212 degrees 32 minutes West); it lies West-North-West 14 Leagues from Cape Gloucester, and is of a height sufficient to be seen 12 Leagues; but it is not so much of a Promontory as it appears to be, because on each side of it near the Sea is very low land, which is not to be seen unless you are pretty well in with the Shore. Inland are some Tolerable high hills or mountains, which, like the Cape, affords but a very barren prospect. Having past this Cape, we continued standing to the West-North-West as the land lay, under an easey Sail, having from 16 to 10 fathoms, until 2 o'Clock a.m., when we fell into 7 fathoms, upon which we hauled our wind to the Northward, judging ourselves to be very near the land; as so we found, for at daylight we were little more than 2 Leagues off. What deceived us was the Lowness of the land, which is but very little higher than the Surface of the Sea, but in the Country were some hills. At noon we were in 15 fathoms Water, and about 4 Leagues from the land. Our Latitude by Observation was 19 degrees 12 minutes South; Cape Upstart bore 38 degrees 30 minutes East, distant 12 Leagues. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon North 48 degrees 45 minutes, 53 Miles. At and before Noon some very large smokes were Seen rise up out of the low land. At sun rise I found the Variation to be 5 degrees 35 minutes Easterly; at sun set last night the same Needle gave near 9 degrees. This being Close under Cape Upstart, I judged that it was owing to Iron ore or other Magnetical Matter Lodged in the Earth.

Tuesday, 5th. Winds from the South and East, a gentle breeze, and clear weather. At 6 a.m., we were parallel to the Western point of the land mentioned earlier, 3 miles away, which I’ve named Cape Upstart because it rises up from the low land around it (Latitude 19 degrees 39 minutes South, Longitude 212 degrees 32 minutes West). It lies West-North-West 14 leagues from Cape Gloucester and is tall enough to be seen from 12 leagues away. However, it’s not as much of a promontory as it seems because there’s very low land on either side of it near the sea, which isn’t visible unless you’re fairly close to the shore. Inland, there are some reasonably high hills or mountains, which, like the Cape, provide a rather barren view. After passing this Cape, we continued heading West-North-West as the land lay, sailing comfortably in depths of 16 to 10 fathoms until 2 a.m., when we hit 7 fathoms. We then adjusted our course northward, thinking we were very close to the land, and at daylight, we were just over 2 leagues away. What tricked us was the low elevation of the land, which is barely higher than the surface of the sea, although there are some hills inland. At noon, we found ourselves in 15 fathoms of water, about 4 leagues from the land. Our latitude, as observed, was 19 degrees 12 minutes South; Cape Upstart was at 38 degrees 30 minutes East, 12 leagues away. The course and distance traveled since yesterday noon was North 48 degrees 45 minutes, 53 miles. Around noon, we saw some large plumes of smoke rising from the low land. At sunrise, I found the variation to be 5 degrees 35 minutes East; at sunset last night, the same needle showed nearly 9 degrees. Being close to Cape Upstart, I suspected this was due to iron ore or other magnetic materials in the ground.

[Off Cleveland Bay, Queensland.]

[Off Cleveland Bay, QLD.]

Wednesday, 6th. Light Airs at East-South-East, with which we Steer'd West-North-West as the Land now lay; Depth of Water 12 and 14 fathoms. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 19 degrees 1 minute South, Longitude made from Cape Gloucester 1 degree 30 minutes West; Course and distance saild since Yesterday noon West-North-West, 28 Miles. In this situation we had the Mouth of a Bay all open extending from South 1/2 East to South-West 1/2 South, distance 2 Leagues. This bay, which I named Cleveland Bay,* (* In Cleveland Bay is Townsville, the largest town in Northern Queensland. Population 12,000.) appeared to be about 5 or 6 Miles in Extent every way. The East point I named Cape Cleveland, and the West, Magnetical Head or Island, as it had much the appearance of an Island; and the Compass did not traverse well when near it. They are both Tolerable high, and so is the Main Land within them, and the whole appeared to have the most rugged, rocky, and barren Surface of any we have yet seen. However, it is not without inhabitants, as we saw smoke in several places in the bottom of the bay. The Northermost land we had in sight at this time bore North-West; this we took to be an Island or Islands, for we could not trace the Main land farther than West by North.

Wednesday, 6th. There were light winds coming from the East-South-East, which allowed us to steer West-North-West as the land lay ahead. The water depth was 12 to 14 fathoms. At noon, we recorded our position at a latitude of 19 degrees 1 minute South and a longitude of 1 degree 30 minutes West from Cape Gloucester. Since yesterday noon, we had traveled West-North-West for 28 miles. In this position, we could see the mouth of a bay that stretched open from South 1/2 East to South-West 1/2 South, a distance of 2 leagues. I named this bay Cleveland Bay.* (* In Cleveland Bay is Townsville, the largest town in Northern Queensland. Population 12,000.) It appeared to be about 5 or 6 miles wide in all directions. I called the eastern point Cape Cleveland and the western point Magnetical Head or Island, as it looked much like an island; the compass also didn't work well nearby. Both points are reasonably high, as is the mainland in between them, and everything looked rugged, rocky, and barren compared to what we had seen so far. However, it wasn’t uninhabited; we saw smoke in several spots at the bottom of the bay. The northernmost land visible from our position was to the North-West; we assumed it to be an island or islands since we couldn’t track the mainland further than West by North.

Thursday, 7th. Light Airs between the South and East, with which we steer'd West-North-West, keeping the Main land on board, the outermost part of which at sun set bore from us West by North; but without this lay high land, which we took to be Islands. At daylight A.M. we were the Length of the Eastern part of this Land, which we found to Consist of a Group of Islands* (* Palm Islands.) laying about 5 Leagues from the Main. We being at this time between the 2, we continued advancing Slowly to the North-West until noon, at which time we were by observation in the Latitude of 18 degrees 49 minutes, and about 5 Leagues from the Main land, the North-West part of which bore from us North by West 1/2 West, the Island extending from North to East; distance of the nearest 2 Miles. Cape Cleveland bore South 50 degrees East, distant 18 Leagues. Our Soundings in the Course of this day's Sail were from 14 to 11 fathoms.

Thursday, 7th. There were light breezes coming from the South and East, which allowed us to head West-North-West, keeping the mainland in sight. By sunset, the farthest point of land we could see was to our West by North, but beyond that, we noticed high land that we assumed were islands. At dawn, we reached the eastern part of this land, which turned out to be a group of islands (Palm Islands), located about 5 leagues from the mainland. As we were positioned between the two, we continued to move slowly northwest until noon. At that time, we used observations to determine that we were at a latitude of 18 degrees 49 minutes, roughly 5 leagues from the mainland, with the northwestern part of it bearing from us North by West 1/2 West, and the island stretching from North to East; the nearest point was about 2 miles away. Cape Cleveland was situated at South 50 degrees East, 18 leagues away. Throughout the day, our soundings fluctuated from 14 to 11 fathoms.

Friday, 8th. Winds at South-South-East and South; first part light Airs, the remainder a Gentle breeze. In the P.M. we saw several large smokes upon the Main, some people, Canoes, and, as we thought, Cocoa Nut Trees upon one of the Islands; and, as a few of these Nutts would have been very acceptable to us at this Time, I sent Lieutenant Hicks ashore, with whom went Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to see what was to be got. In the Meantime we keept Standing in for the Island with the Ship. At 7 they returned on board, having met with Nothing worth Observing. The Trees we saw were a small kind of Cabbage Palms. They heard some of the Natives as they were putting off from the Shore, but saw none. After the Boat was hoisted in we stood away North by West for the Northermost land we had in sight, which we were abreast of at 3 o'Clock in the Morning, having passed all the Islands 3 or 4 hours before. This point I have named Point Hillock,* (* Point Hillock is the east point of Hinchinbrook Island, which is separated from the main by a narrow and tortuous channel.) on account of its Figure. The Land of this point is Tolerable high, and may be known by a round Hillock or rock that appears to be detached from the point, but I believe it joins to it. Between this Cape and Cape Cleveland the shore forms a Large bay, which I named Hallifax bay;* (* The Earl of Halifax was Secretary of State 1763 to 1765.) before it lay the Groups of Islands before mentioned, and some others nearer the Shore. These Islands shelter the Bay in a manner from all Winds, in which is good Anchorage. The land near the Shore in the bottom of the bay is very low and Woody; but a little way back in the Country is a continued ridge of high land, which appear'd to be barren and rocky. Having passed Point Hillock, we continued standing to the North-North-West as the land Trended, having the Advantage of a light Moon. At 6 a.m. we were abreast of a point of Land which lies North by West 1/2 West, 11 Miles from Point Hillick; the Land between them is very high, and of a craggy, barren surface. This point I named Cape Sandwich;* (* Earl of Sandwich was First Lord of the Admiralty 1763.) it may not only be known by the high, craggy land over it, but by a small Island which lies East one Mile from it, and some others about 2 Leagues to the Northward of it. From Cape Sandwich the Land trends West, and afterwards North, and forms a fine, Large Bay, which I called Rockingham Bay;* (* The Marquis of Rockingham was Prime Minister 1765 to 1766.) it is well Shelter'd, and affords good Anchorage; at least, so it appear'd to me, for having met with so little encouragement by going ashore that I would not wait to land or examine it farther, but continued to range along Shore to the Northward for a parcel of Small Islands* (* The Family Islands.) laying off the Northern point of the Bay, and, finding a Channel of a Mile broad between the 3 Outermost and those nearer the Shore, we pushed thro'. While we did this we saw on one of the nearest Islands a Number of the Natives collected together, who seem'd to look very attentively upon the Ship; they were quite naked, and of a very Dark Colour, with short hair. At noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 17 degrees 59 minutes, and abreast of the North point of Rockingham Bay, which bore from us West 2 Miles. This boundry of the Bay is form'd by a Tolerable high Island, known in the Chart by the Name of Dunk Isle; it lays so near the Shore as not to be distinguished from it unless you are well in with the Land. At this time we were in the Longitude of 213 degrees 57 minutes. Cape Sandwich bore South by East 1/2 East, distant 19 Miles, and the northermost land in sight North 1/2 West. Our depth of Water in the Course of this day's Sail was not more than 16, nor less than 7, fathoms.* (* About here the Great Barrier Reefs begin to close in on the land. Cook kept so close to the latter that he was unconscious as yet of their existence; but he was soon to find them.)

Friday, 8th. Winds from the South-South-East and South; light winds in the morning, followed by a gentle breeze in the afternoon. We saw several large plumes of smoke on the mainland, some people in canoes, and what we thought might be coconut trees on one of the islands. Since a few coconuts would have been a welcome treat, I sent Lieutenant Hicks ashore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, to check what they could find. Meanwhile, we continued to head toward the island with the ship. At 7 p.m., they returned on board, reporting that they found nothing of interest. The trees we saw turned out to be a small kind of cabbage palm. They heard some of the natives as they were leaving the shore, but they didn't see anyone. After we pulled the boat back in, we headed North by West toward the northernmost land in sight, which we reached at 3 a.m., having passed all the islands 3 to 4 hours earlier. I named this point Point Hillock,* (* Point Hillock is the east point of Hinchinbrook Island, which is separated from the main by a narrow and winding channel.) due to its shape. The land at this point is reasonably high and can be identified by a round hillock or rock that appears to be separate from the point, though I believe it is connected. Between this Cape and Cape Cleveland, the shoreline creates a large bay, which I named Hallifax Bay;* (* The Earl of Halifax was Secretary of State from 1763 to 1765.) in front of it lay the previously mentioned groups of islands, as well as some others closer to the shore. These islands provide shelter to the bay from all winds, offering good anchorage. The land near the shore at the bottom of the bay is very low and wooded, but a bit further inland, there is a continuous ridge of high land that looks barren and rocky. After passing Point Hillock, we continued heading North-North-West along the trending land, taking advantage of the light from the moon. At 6 a.m., we were level with a point of land lying North by West 1/2 West, 11 miles from Point Hillock; the land between them is very high and has a craggy, barren surface. I named this point Cape Sandwich;* (* The Earl of Sandwich was First Lord of the Admiralty in 1763.) it can be recognized not only by the high, rocky land above it but also by a small island that lies one mile to the east and a few others about two leagues to the north. From Cape Sandwich, the land trends west, then north, creating a beautiful, large bay that I called Rockingham Bay;* (* The Marquis of Rockingham was Prime Minister from 1765 to 1766.) it is well sheltered and seems to offer good anchorage. However, having encountered little encouragement while going ashore, I chose not to stop to investigate further but continued along the shore northward to a group of small islands* (* The Family Islands.) off the northern point of the bay. We found a channel about a mile wide between the three outermost islands and those nearer to the shore, so we passed through. While doing so, we spotted a number of natives gathered on one of the nearest islands, seemingly observing the ship intently; they were entirely naked, dark-skinned, and had short hair. At noon, we were positioned at a latitude of 17 degrees 59 minutes and directly opposite the northern point of Rockingham Bay, which was two miles to the west. This boundary of the bay is marked by a reasonably high island known on the chart as Dunk Isle; it is so close to the shore that it can only be distinguished when you're well in with the land. At this time, we were at a longitude of 213 degrees 57 minutes. Cape Sandwich was to the South by East 1/2 East, 19 miles away, and the northernmost land visible was North 1/2 West. The depth of water during this day's sail varied between 16 and 7 fathoms.* (* Around here, the Great Barrier Reefs start to come closer to the land. Cook was so close to the land that he was still unaware of their existence; but he was about to discover them.)

[Anchored near Cape Grafton, Queensland.]

[Anchored near Cape Grafton, QLD.]

Saturday, 9th. Winds between the South and South-East, a Gentle breeze, and Clear weather, with which we steer'd North by West as the land lay, the northern extream of which at sunset bore North 25 degrees West. We keept on our Course under an Easey sail all night, having from 12 to 16 fathoms, at the distance of about 3 or 4 Leagues from the Land. At 6 a.m. we were abreast of Some small Islands, which we called Frankland Isles, that lay about 2 Leagues from the Mainland, the Northern Point of which in sight bore North by West 1/2 West; but this we afterwards found to be an Island,* (* Fitzroy Island.) tolerable high, and about 4 Miles in Circuit. It lies about 2 Miles from the Point on the Main between which we went with the ship, and were in the Middle of the Channell at Noon, and by observation in the Latitude of 16 degrees 55 minutes, where we had 20 fathoms of water. The point of land we were now abreast of I called Cape Grafton* (* The Duke of Grafton was Prime Minister when Cook sailed.) (Latitude 16 degrees 55 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 11 minutes West); it is Tolerable high, and so is the whole Coast for 20 Leagues to the southward, and hath a very rocky surface, which is thinly cover'd with wood. In the night we saw several fires along shore, and a little before noon some people.

Saturday, 9th. Winds between the South and Southeast, a gentle breeze, and clear weather, so we steered North by West as the land lay. The northern tip at sunset was at North 25 degrees West. We kept on our course under an easy sail all night, with depths of 12 to 16 fathoms, about 3 or 4 leagues from the land. At 6 a.m., we were near some small islands, which we named Frankland Isles, located about 2 leagues from the mainland, with the northern point in view at North by West 1/2 West; however, we later discovered this to be an island (*Fitzroy Island*), fairly high and about 4 miles around. It lies about 2 miles from the point on the mainland that we navigated past, and we were in the middle of the channel at noon, with an observation placing us at a latitude of 16 degrees 55 minutes, where we found 20 fathoms of water. The point of land we were currently alongside I called Cape Grafton (*The Duke of Grafton was Prime Minister when Cook sailed.*) (Latitude 16 degrees 55 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 11 minutes West); it is fairly high, and so is the entire coast extending 20 leagues to the south, which has a very rocky surface, sparsely covered with trees. During the night, we saw several fires along the shore, and just before noon, we spotted some people.

Sunday, 10th. After hauling round Cape Grafton we found the land trend away North-West by West; 3 Miles to the Westward of the Cape is a Bay, wherein we Anchor'd, about 2 Miles from the Shore, in 4 fathoms, owsey bottom. The East point of the Bay bore South 74 degrees East, the West point South 83 degrees West, and a Low green woody Island laying in the Offing bore North 35 degrees East. The Island lies North by East 1/2 East, distance 3 or 4 Leagues from Cape Grafton, and is known in the Chart by the Name of Green Island. As soon as the Ship was brought to an Anchor I went ashore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander; the first thing I did was to look for fresh Water, and with that View rowed out towards the Cape, because in the bottom of the bay was low Mangrove land, and little probability of meeting with any there. But the way I went I found 2 Small streams, which were difficult to get at on account of the Surf and rocks upon the Shore. As we came round the Cape we saw, in a sandy Cove, a small stream of Water run over the beach; but here I did not go in the boat because I found that it would not be Easey to land. We hardly advanced anything into the Country, it being here hilly, which were steep and rocky, and we had not time to Visit the Low lands, and therefore met with nothing remarkable. My intention was to have stay'd here at least one day, to have looked into the Country had we met with fresh water convenient, or any other Refreshment; but as we did not, I thought it would be only spending of time, and loosing as much of a light Moon to little purpose, and therefore at 12 o'Clock at night we weighed and stood away to the North-West, having at this time but little wind, attended with Showers of rain.* (* In the next bay west of where Cook anchored is Cairns, a small but rising town in the centre of a sugar-growing district.) At 4 the breeze freshned at South by East, with fair weather; we continued steering North-North-West 1/2 West as the Land lay, having 10, 12, and 14 fathoms, at a distance of 3 Leagues from the Land. At 11 we hauld off North, in order to get without a Small Low Island* (* Low Isles. There is now a lighthouse on them.) which lay about 2 Leagues from the Main; it being about high Water, about the time we passed it, great part of it lay under water. About 3 Leagues to the North Westward of this Island, close under the Main land, is another Island,* (* Snapper Island.) Tolerable high, which bore from us at Noon North 55 degrees West, distant 7 or 8 Miles; we being at this time in the Latitude of 16 degrees 20 minutes South, Cape Grafton bore South 29 degrees East, distant 40 Miles, and the Northermost point of Land in Sight North 20 degrees West, and in this Situation had 15 fathoms Water. The Shore between Cape Grafton and the above Northern point forms a large but not very deep Bay, which I named Trinity Bay, after the day on which it was discover'd; the North point Cape Tribulation, because here began all our Troubles. Latitude 16 degrees 6 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 39 minutes West.

Sunday, 10th. After rounding Cape Grafton, we noticed that the land stretched away to the North-West by West. Three miles to the west of the Cape is a bay where we anchored about two miles from the shore in four fathoms of muddy bottom. The east point of the bay was at South 74 degrees East, the west point at South 83 degrees West, and a low, green, wooded island offshore was at North 35 degrees East. The island is located North by East 1/2 East, about three or four leagues from Cape Grafton, known on the chart as Green Island. Once the ship was anchored, I went ashore with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander; the first thing I did was look for fresh water. To do this, I rowed out towards the Cape because the bottom of the bay had low mangrove land with little chance of finding any fresh water there. However, as I went, I found two small streams, which were hard to access due to the surf and rocks along the shore. As we rounded the Cape, we saw a small stream of water flowing over the beach in a sandy cove; I didn’t approach here in the boat since landing seemed difficult. We hardly ventured far into the country, which was hilly, steep, and rocky, and we didn’t have time to explore the lowlands, so we didn’t find anything noteworthy. I intended to stay here for at least one day to explore the area if we found convenient fresh water or other provisions, but since we didn’t, I thought it would be a waste of time, especially with a light moon. Therefore, at midnight, we weighed anchor and headed North-West, with little wind and some rain. (* In the next bay west of where Cook anchored is Cairns, a small but growing town in the center of a sugar-growing district.) At 4 AM, the breeze picked up from the South by East, with fair weather; we continued steering North-North-West 1/2 West along the coastline, with depths of 10, 12, and 14 fathoms, three leagues off the shore. At 11 AM, we turned off North to go around a small, low island* (* Low Isles. There is now a lighthouse on them.) roughly two leagues from the mainland; since it was about high water when we passed it, a large part of it was submerged. About three leagues to the North-West of this island, right next to the mainland, is another island,* (* Snapper Island.) which is reasonably high, lying at North 55 degrees West from us at noon, approximately seven or eight miles away. At this time, we were at a latitude of 16 degrees 20 minutes South, with Cape Grafton bearing South 29 degrees East, 40 miles away, and the northernmost point of land visible at North 20 degrees West. In this position, we had 15 fathoms of water. The shore between Cape Grafton and the northernmost point forms a large but not very deep bay, which I named Trinity Bay after the day it was discovered. The northern point was named Cape Tribulation because it marked the beginning of all our troubles. Latitude 16 degrees 6 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 39 minutes West.

[The Ship Aground on Endeavour Reef.]

[The Ship Aground on Endeavour Reef.]

Monday, 11th. Wind at East-South-East, with which we steer'd along shore North by West at the distance of 3 or 4 Leagues off, having from 14 to 10 and 12 fathoms water. Saw 2 Small Islands in the Offing, which lay in the Latitude of 16 degrees 0 minutes South, and about 6 or 7 Leagues from the Main. At 6 the Northermost land in sight bore North by West 1/2 West, and 2 low, woody Islands,* (* Hope Islands.) which some took to be rocks above Water, bore North 1/2 West. At this time we shortened Sail, and hauld off shore East-North-East and North-East by East, close upon a Wind. My intention was to stretch off all Night as well to avoid the danger we saw ahead as to see if any Islands lay in the Offing, especially as we now begun to draw near the Latitude of those discover'd by Quiros, which some Geographers, for what reason I know not, have thought proper to Tack to this land. Having the advantage of a fine breeze of wind, and a clear Moon light Night in standing off from 6 until near 9 o Clock, we deepned our Water from 14 to 21 fathoms, when all at once we fell into 12, 10 and 8 fathoms. At this time I had everybody at their Stations to put about and come to an Anchor; but in this I was not so fortunate, for meeting again with Deep Water, I thought there could be no danger in standing on.* (* The ship passed just northward of Pickersgill Reef.) Before 10 o'Clock we had 20 and 21 fathoms, and Continued in that depth until a few minutes before 11, when we had 17, and before the Man at the Lead could heave another cast, the Ship Struck and stuck fast. Immediately upon this we took in all our Sails, hoisted out the Boats and Sounded round the Ship, and found that we had got upon the South-East Edge of a reef of Coral Rocks, having in some places round the Ship 3 and 4 fathoms Water, and in other places not quite as many feet, and about a Ship's length from us on the starboard side (the Ship laying with her Head to the North-East) were 8, 10, and 12 fathoms. As soon as the Long boat was out we struck Yards and Topmast, and carried out the Stream Anchor on our Starboard bow, got the Coasting Anchor and Cable into the Boat, and were going to carry it out in the same way; but upon my sounding the 2nd time round the Ship I found the most water a Stern, and therefore had this Anchor carried out upon the Starboard Quarter, and hove upon it a very great Strain; which was to no purpose, the Ship being quite fast, upon which we went to work to lighten her as fast as possible, which seem'd to be the only means we had left to get her off. As we went ashore about the Top of High Water we not only started water, but threw overboard our Guns, Iron and Stone Ballast, Casks, Hoop Staves, Oil Jarrs, decay'd Stores, etc.; many of these last Articles lay in the way at coming at Heavier. All this time the Ship made little or no Water. At 11 a.m., being high Water as we thought, we try'd to heave her off without Success, she not being afloat by a foot or more, notwithstanding by this time we had thrown overboard 40 or 50 Tuns weight. As this was not found sufficient we continued to Lighten her by every method we could think off; as the Tide fell the ship began to make Water as much as two pumps could free: at Noon she lay with 3 or 4 Streakes heel to Starboard; Latitude observed 15 degrees 45 minutes South.

Monday, 11th. The wind was coming from the East-South-East, so we steered along the shore North by West, about 3 or 4 leagues out, with water depths ranging from 14 to 10 and then 12 fathoms. We spotted 2 small islands in the distance, located at 16 degrees 0 minutes South and roughly 6 or 7 leagues from the mainland. By 6 PM, the northernmost land in sight was at North by West 1/2 West, and 2 low, wooded islands (Hope Islands) looked like rocks above water, bearing North 1/2 West. At that point, we reduced our sail and headed off the shore East-North-East and North-East by East, close to the wind. My plan was to drift off all night to avoid the dangers ahead and to see if there were any islands nearby, especially since we were approaching the latitude of those discovered by Quiros, which some geographers, for reasons unknown to me, have chosen to associate with this land. With a pleasant breeze and clear moonlight, we sailed from 6 until nearly 9 o'clock, increasing our depth from 14 to 21 fathoms, then suddenly dropping to 12, 10, and 8 fathoms. At that moment, I had everyone at their stations to turn the ship around and anchor, but I wasn't lucky in that regard; after encountering deep water again, I believed it was safe to continue on. Before 10 o'clock, we had depths of 20 and 21 fathoms, which persisted until a few minutes before 11, when it dropped to 17 fathoms. Just before the lead man could take another measurement, the ship struck and became stuck. We immediately took in all sails, launched the boats, and sounded the area around the ship, discovering we were on the southeast edge of a coral reef, with depths of 3 to 4 fathoms in some spots, and not quite that in others. About a ship's length off the starboard side (with the ship facing Northeast), there were depths of 8, 10, and 12 fathoms. Once the longboat was out, we lowered the yards and topmast, deployed the stream anchor off the starboard bow, got the coasting anchor and cable into the boat, and were ready to take it out in the same manner; but after sounding again around the ship, I found the deepest water was at the stern, so we sent the anchor out to the starboard quarter and applied a significant strain on it—which was useless, as the ship was completely stuck. We then began to lighten the ship as quickly as possible, the only strategy we had left to get her off. As we went ashore around high water, we not only started taking on water, but also threw overboard our guns, iron and stone ballast, barrels, hoop staves, oil jars, damaged stores, etc.; many of the last items were in the way of accessing heavier objects. Throughout this time, the ship was taking on little to no water. At 11 a.m., believing it was high water, we tried to float her off without success, as she was still a foot or more underwater, despite having thrown overboard 40 or 50 tons of weight by this point. Finding that insufficient, we continued to lighten her using every method we could imagine; as the tide went down, the ship began to take on water, as much as two pumps could handle. By noon, she was leaning to starboard with 3 or 4 streaks, latitude observed at 15 degrees 45 minutes South.

Tuesday, 12th. Fortunately we had little wind, fine weather, and a smooth Sea, all this 24 Hours, which in the P.M. gave us an Opportunity to carry out the 2 Bower Anchors, one on the Starboard Quarter, and the other right a Stern, got Blocks and Tackles upon the Cables, brought the falls in abaft and hove taught. By this time it was 5 o'Clock p.m.; the tide we observed now begun to rise, and the leak increased upon us, which obliged us to set the 3rd Pump to work, as we should have done the 4th also, but could not make it work. At 9 the Ship righted, and the Leak gain'd upon the Pumps considerably. This was an alarming and, I may say, terrible circumstance, and threatened immediate destruction to us. However, I resolv'd to risque all, and heave her off in case it was practical, and accordingly turn'd as many hands to the Capstan and Windlass as could be spared from the Pumps; and about 20 Minutes past 10 o'Clock the Ship floated, and we hove her into Deep Water, having at this time 3 feet 9 Inches Water in the hold. This done I sent the Long boat to take up the Stream Anchor, got the Anchor, but lost the Cable among the Rocks; after this turn'd all hands to the Pumps, the Leak increasing upon us.

Tuesday, 12th. Luckily, we had light winds, nice weather, and calm seas for a full 24 hours, which in the afternoon gave us the chance to drop the two bower anchors, one on the starboard quarter and the other right astern. We set up blocks and tackles on the cables, brought the falls in behind, and tightened them up. By then, it was 5 p.m. The tide we observed started to rise, and our leak got worse, which forced us to start the third pump; we would have used the fourth as well, but we couldn't get it to work. At 9, the ship righted itself, and the leak increased significantly, making the pumps struggle. This was an alarming and, I must say, terrifying situation that threatened our immediate destruction. However, I decided to take the risk and try to get her off if possible, so I put as many crew members as I could spare from the pumps onto the capstan and windlass. About 20 minutes past 10 o'clock, the ship floated, and we pulled her into deeper water, with 3 feet 9 inches of water in the hold at that time. After that, I sent the longboat to recover the stream anchor; we managed to get the anchor but lost the cable among the rocks. Following this, we all went back to the pumps as the leak continued to worsen.

A mistake soon after hapned, which for the first time caused fear to approach upon every man in the Ship. The man that attended the well took the Depth of water above the Ceiling; he, being relieved by another who did not know in what manner the former had sounded, took the Depth of water from the outside plank, the difference being 16 or 18 inches, and made it appear that the leak had gained this upon the pumps in a short time. This mistake was no sooner cleared up than it acted upon every man like a Charm; they redoubled their vigour, insomuch that before 8 o'clock in the morning they gained considerably upon the leak.* (* The circumstance related in this paragraph is from the Admiralty copy.) We now hove up the Best Bower, but found it impossible to save the small Bower, so cut it away at a whole Cable; got up the Fore topmast and Foreyard, warped the Ship to the South-East, and at 11 got under sail, and stood in for the land, with a light breeze at East-South-East. Some hands employ'd sewing Oakham, Wool, etc., into a Lower Steering sail to fother the Ship; others employ'd at the Pumps, which still gain'd upon the Leak.

A mistake soon happened that caused fear to spread among everyone on the ship for the first time. The man in charge of checking the well measured the water depth above the ceiling; when he was relieved, the next person, not knowing how the previous one had measured, took the depth from the outside plank. This difference was 16 or 18 inches, making it seem like the leak had gained on the pumps quickly. As soon as this mistake was cleared up, it acted like a charm on everyone; they worked even harder, and by 8 o'clock in the morning, they had made significant progress against the leak.* (*The situation described in this paragraph is from the Admiralty copy.) We now retrieved the best anchor but found it impossible to save the smaller one, so we cut it away with a whole cable. We raised the fore topmast and fore yard, maneuvered the ship to the southeast, and by 11, we were under sail, heading for the land with a light breeze from the east-southeast. Some crew members were busy sewing oakum, wool, etc., into a lower steering sail to plug the ship, while others were working the pumps, which were still losing ground against the leak.

[Fothering the Ship.]

[Fothering the Ship.]

Wednesday, 13th. In the P.M. had light Airs at East-South-East, with which we keept edging in for the Land. Got up the Maintopmast and Mainyard, and having got the Sail ready for fothering of the Ship, we put it over under the Starboard Fore Chains, where we suspected the Ship had suffer'd most, and soon after the Leak decreased, so as to be keept clear with one Pump with ease; this fortunate circumstance gave new life to every one on board.

Wednesday, 13th. In the afternoon, we had light winds from the east-southeast, which helped us maneuver closer to the land. We raised the main topmast and main yard, and once we prepared the sail for plugging the ship, we positioned it under the starboard fore chains, where we thought the ship had taken on the most water. Soon after, the leak lessened enough that we could manage it easily with one pump; this fortunate turn of events boosted everyone's spirits on board.

It is much easier to conceive than to discribe the satisfaction felt by everybody on this occasion. But a few minutes before our utmost Wishes were to get hold of some place upon the Main, or an island, to run the Ship ashore, where out of her Materials we might build a Vessel to carry us to the East Indies; no sooner were we made sencible that the outward application to the Ship's bottom had taken effect, than the field of every Man's hopes inlarged, so that we thought of nothing but ranging along Shore in search of a Harbour, when we could repair the Damages we had sustained.* (* The foregoing paragraph is from the Admiralty copy. The situation was indeed sufficiently awkward. When it is considered that the coast was wholly unknown, the natives decidedly hostile, the land unproductive of any means of subsistence, and the distance to the nearest Dutch settlements, even if a passage should be found south of New Guinea, 1500 miles, there was ample cause for apprehension if they could not save the ship. Knowing what we now know, that all off this coast is a continuous line of reefs and shoals, Cook's action in standing off might seem rash. But he knew nothing of this. There was a moon; he reduced sail to double reefed topsails with a light wind, as the log tells us, and with the cumbrous hempen cables of the day, and the imperfect means of heaving up the anchor, he was desirous of saving his men unnecessary labour. Cook was puzzled that the next tide did not, after lightening the ship, take him off; but it is now known that on this coast it is only every alternate tide that rises to a full height, and as he got ashore nearly at the top of the higher of the two waters he had to wait twenty-four hours until he got a similar rise. Lucky was it for them that the wind was light. Usually at this season the trade wind is strong, and raises a considerable sea, even inside the Barrier. Hawkesworth or Banks makes the proposition to fother the ship emanate from Mr. Monkhouse; but it is scarcely to be supposed that such a perfect seaman as Cook was not familiar with this operation, and he merely says that as Mr. Monkhouse had seen it done, he confided to him the superintendence of it, as of course the Captain had at such a time many other things to do than stand over the men preparing the sail. In 1886 the people of Cooktown were anxious to recover the brass guns of the Endeavour which were thrown overboard, in order to place them as a memento in their town; but they could not be found, which is not altogether surprising.) In justice to the Ship's Company, I must say that no men ever behaved better than they have done on this occasion; animated by the behaviour of every Gentleman on board, every man seem'd to have a just sence of the Danger we were in, and exerted himself to the very utmost. The Ledge of Rocks, or Shoal, we have been upon, lies in the Latitude of 15 degrees 45 minutes, and about 6 or 7 Leagues from the Main land; but this is not the only Shoal that lay upon this part of the Coast, especially to the Northward, and one which we saw to the Southward, the tail of which we passed over when we had the uneven Soundings 2 hours before we Struck. A part of this Shoal is always above Water, and looks to be white Sand; part of the one we were upon was dry at low Water, and in that place consists of Sand and stones, but every where else Coral Rocks. At 6 we Anchored in 17 fathoms, about 5 or 6 Leagues from the land, and one from the Shoal. At this time the Ship made about 15 Inches Water per hour. At 6 a.m. weigh'd and stood to the North-West, edging in for the land, having a Gentle breeze at South-South-East. At 9 we past close without 2 small low Islands, laying in the Latitude of 15 degrees 41 minutes, and about 4 Leagues from the Main; I have named them Hope Islands, because we were always in hopes of being able to reach these Islands. At Noon we were about 3 Leagues from the Land, and in the Latitude of 15 degrees 37 minutes South; the Northermost part of the Main in sight bore North 30 degrees West, and the above Islands extending from South 30 degrees East to South 40 degrees East. In this situation had 12 fathoms water and several sandbanks without us. The Leak now decreaseth, but for fear it should break out again we got the Sail ready fill'd for fothering; the manner this is done is thus: We Mix Oacham and Wool together (but Oacham alone would do), and chop it up Small, and then stick it loosely by handfulls all over the Sail, and throw over it Sheep dung or other filth. Horse Dung for this purpose is the best. The Sail thus prepared is hauld under the Ship's bottom by ropes, and if the place of the Leak is uncertain, it must be hauld from one part of her bottom to another until one finds the place where it takes effect. While the Sail is under the Ship the Oacham, etc., is washed off, and part of it carried along with the water into the Leak, and in part stops up the hole. Mr. Monkhouse, one of my Midshipmen, was once in a Merchant Ship which Sprung a Leak, and made 48 Inches Water per hour; but by this means was brought home from Virginia to London with only her proper crew; to him I gave the direction of this, who executed it very much to my satisfaction.

It's much easier to imagine than to explain the satisfaction everyone felt at this moment. Just a few minutes before, our greatest hopes were to find some place on the mainland or an island to run the ship aground, where we could use its materials to build a vessel to take us to the East Indies. As soon as we realized that the treatment applied to the ship's bottom was effective, everyone's hopes expanded, and we focused solely on searching along the shore for a harbor where we could fix the damage we had sustained. The previous paragraph is from the Admiralty copy. The situation was indeed quite awkward. Considering that the coast was completely unknown, the natives were definitely hostile, the land offered no means of sustenance, and the nearest Dutch settlements were 1500 miles away, even if a route could be found south of New Guinea, there was plenty of reason to worry if we couldn't save the ship. Knowing what we do now, that all along this coast is a continuous line of reefs and shallows, Cook's decision to remain offshore might seem risky. However, he didn't know any of this. There was a moon, he reduced sail to double reefed topsails with a light wind, as the log indicates, and with the heavy hemp cables of the time and limited means to raise the anchor, he aimed to spare his crew unnecessary labor. Cook was baffled that the next tide didn't, after lightening the ship, float him off; but it's now understood that along this coast, only every other tide fully rises, and since he got ashore almost at the peak of the higher tide, he had to wait twenty-four hours for another similar rise. Fortunately for them, the wind was light. At this time of year, the trade wind is usually strong and creates significant waves, even inside the Barrier. Hawkesworth or Banks suggests that the idea to fother the ship came from Mr. Monkhouse; however, it's hard to believe that such a skilled navigator as Cook was not familiar with this method, and he merely said that since Mr. Monkhouse had seen it done, he entrusted him to supervise it, as the Captain had many other tasks to manage at that time. In 1886, the people of Cooktown were eager to recover the brass guns of the Endeavour that had been thrown overboard to display them as a token in their town, but they couldn't find them, which isn't too surprising. To give credit to the ship's crew, I must say that no men ever behaved better than they did on this occasion; inspired by the conduct of every gentleman on board, each person seemed to understand the danger we were in and put forth their best effort. The ledge of rocks or shoal we encountered lies at a latitude of 15 degrees 45 minutes, about 6 or 7 leagues from the mainland; but this isn't the only shoal in this part of the coast, especially to the northward, and one seen to the southward, a part of which we crossed over when we encountered the inconsistent soundings 2 hours before we struck. A section of this shoal is always above water and appears to be white sand; part of the one we were on was dry at low tide and consisted of sand and stones, while elsewhere it was made up of coral rocks. At 6 o'clock, we anchored in 17 fathoms, about 5 or 6 leagues from the land, and 1 from the shoal. At this time, the ship took on about 15 inches of water per hour. At 6 a.m., we weighed anchor and headed northwest, edging closer to the land, with a gentle breeze from the south-southeast. By 9, we passed just outside two small low islands, located at 15 degrees 41 minutes latitude and about 4 leagues from the mainland; I named them Hope Islands because we always hoped we could reach them. At noon, we were about 3 leagues from the land, at a latitude of 15 degrees 37 minutes south; the northernmost part of the mainland in sight was to the north 30 degrees west, and the islands extended from south 30 degrees east to south 40 degrees east. In this position, we found 12 fathoms of water and several sandbanks around us. The leak was now decreasing, but to avoid it breaking out again, we prepared the sail for fothering; this is done by mixing oakum and wool together (though oakum alone could suffice), chopping it finely, and then loosely sticking handfuls all over the sail and throwing sheep dung or other waste over it. Horse dung is best for this purpose. The prepared sail is pulled under the ship’s bottom with ropes, and if the leak's location is uncertain, it must be moved from one part of the bottom to another until the spot where it’s effective is found. While the sail is under the ship, the oakum and other materials are washed off by the water and some of it is carried into the leak, which helps block the hole. Mr. Monkhouse, one of my midshipmen, had once been on a merchant ship that sprang a leak and was taking on 48 inches of water per hour; but with this method, he managed to bring it safely back from Virginia to London with just her standard crew. I assigned him the responsibility for this, and he executed it to my satisfaction.

[In Endeavour River, Queensland.]

[At Endeavour River, Queensland.]

Thursday, 14th. P.M., had a Gentle breeze at South-East by East. Sent the Master, with 2 Boats as well, to sound ahead of the Ship, as to look out for a Harbour where we could repair our defects, and put the Ship on a proper Trim, both of which she now very much wanted. At 3 saw an Opening that had the appearance of a Harbour; stood off and on while the Boats were examining it, who found that there was not a sufficient depth of Water for the Ship. By this time it was almost sun set, and seeing many shoals about us we Anchored in 4 fathoms about 2 miles from the Shore, the Main land extending from North 1/2 East to South by East 1/2 East. At 8 o'clock the Pinnace, in which was one of the Mates, return'd on board, and reported that they had found a good Harbour* (* Cook Harbour, Endeavour River.) about 2 Leagues to leeward. In consequence of this information we, at 6 a.m., weigh'd and run down to it, first sending 2 Boats ahead to lay upon the Shoals that lay in our way; and notwithstanding this precaution, we were once in 3 fathoms with the Ship. Having pass'd these Shoals, the Boats were sent to lay in the Channell leading into the Harbour. By this time it begun to blow in so much that the Ship would not work, having missed stays Twice; and being entangled among Shoals, I was afraid of being drove to Leeward before the Boats could place themselves, and therefore Anchoredd in 4 fathoms about a Mile from the Shore, and then made the Signal for the Boats to come on board, after which I went myself and Buoy'd the Channell, which I found very narrow, and the Harbour much smaller than I had been told, but very convenient for our Purpose. At Noon Latitude observed 15 degrees 26 minutes South. [Note. This day I restor'd Mr. Magra to his Duty, as I did not find him guilty of the crimes laid to his charge.]

Thursday, 14th. P.M., there was a gentle breeze from the Southeast by East. I sent the Master and two boats ahead to scout for a harbor where we could fix our issues and get the ship in proper shape, both of which were urgently needed. At 3, we spotted an opening that looked like a harbor; we circled around while the boats checked it out, but they found there wasn't enough water depth for the ship. By this time, it was almost sunset, and seeing many shoals around us, we anchored in 4 fathoms about 2 miles from shore, with the mainland stretching from North 1/2 East to South by East 1/2 East. At 8 o'clock, the pinnace, which had one of the mates on board, returned and reported that they found a good harbor (Cook Harbour, Endeavour River) about 2 leagues downwind. As a result of this information, we set off at 6 a.m. and headed toward it, first sending two boats ahead to check the shoals in our path; despite this precaution, we got down to 3 fathoms with the ship. Once we passed those shoals, the boats went to position themselves in the channel leading into the harbor. By then, the wind had picked up so much that the ship couldn't maneuver, having missed stays twice. Getting caught among the shoals, I worried about being pushed downwind before the boats could get into place, so I anchored in 4 fathoms about a mile from shore and signaled for the boats to come back on board. After that, I went myself and marked the channel, which I found to be very narrow, and the harbor much smaller than I had been led to believe, but still very suitable for our needs. At noon, I observed the latitude to be 15 degrees 26 minutes South. [Note. Today, I reinstated Mr. Magra to his duties, as I did not find him guilty of the charges against him.]

Friday, 15th. A fresh Gale at South-East and Cloudy weather, attended with Showers of Rain. In the Night, as it blow'd too fresh to break the Ship loose to run into the Harbour, we got down the Topgallant yards, unbent the Mainsail, and some of the Small sails; got down the Foretopgallant mast, and the Jibb Boom and Spritsailyard in, intending to lighten the Ship Forward as much as possible, in order to lay her ashore to come at the Leak.

Friday, 15th. A strong southeast wind and cloudy weather, accompanied by rain showers. During the night, since the wind was too strong to free the ship and sail into the harbor, we lowered the topgallant yards, removed the mainsail, and some of the smaller sails; we took down the foretopgallant mast, and brought in the jib boom and spritsailyard, intending to lighten the ship as much as possible at the front to address the leak.

Saturday, 16th. Strong Gales at South-East, and Cloudy, hazey weather, with Showers of Rain. At 6 o'Clock in the A.M. it moderated a little, and we hove short, intending to get under sail, but was obliged to desist, and veer away again; some people were seen ashore to-day.

Saturday, 16th. Strong winds from the southeast and cloudy, hazy weather with rain showers. At 6 o'clock in the morning, it eased up a bit, and we got ready to set sail, but we had to stop and adjust our course again; we saw some people on shore today.

Sunday, 17th. Most part strong Gales at South-East, with some heavy showers of rain in the P.M. At 6 a.m., being pretty moderate, we weigh'd and run into the Harbour, in doing of which we run the Ship ashore Twice. The first time she went off without much Trouble, but the Second time she Stuck fast; but this was of no consequence any farther than giving us a little trouble, and was no more than what I expected as we had the wind. While the Ship lay fast we got down the Foreyard, Foretopmast, booms, etc., overboard, and made a raft of them alongside.

Sunday, 17th. Most of the day had strong winds from the southeast, with some heavy rain showers in the afternoon. At 6 a.m., when conditions were fairly calm, we set sail and entered the harbor, but we ran the ship aground twice. The first time, we got off without much trouble, but the second time she got stuck. This didn't matter much beyond causing us a little hassle, and I expected it since we had the wind against us. While the ship was stuck, we lowered the foreyard, foretopmast, booms, etc., into the water and made a raft out of them alongside.

Monday, 18th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy, with Showers of Rain. At 1 p.m. the Ship floated, and we warped her into the Harbour, and moor'd her alongside of a Steep Beach on the South side; got the Anchors, Cables, and all the Hawsers ashore. In the A.M. made a Stage from the Ship to the Shore, Erected 2 Tents, one for the Sick, and the other for the Stores and Provisions; Landed all the empty Casks and part of the Provisions, and sent a boat to haul the Sean, which return'd without Success.

Monday, 18th. Fresh winds and cloudy skies, with rain showers. At 1 p.m., the ship floated, and we pulled her into the harbor, mooring her next to a steep beach on the south side. We got the anchors, cables, and all the ropes ashore. In the morning, we built a stage from the ship to the shore, set up two tents—one for the sick and the other for the supplies and provisions. We unloaded all the empty barrels and some of the provisions, and we sent a boat to haul the seine, which returned without success.

Tuesday, 19th. Fresh Gales at South-East and Cloudy weather, with frequent showers of Rain. P.M., landed all the Provisions and Part of the Stores; got the Sick ashore, which amounted, at this time, to 8 or 9, afflicted with different disorders, but none very dangerously ill. This afternoon I went upon one of the highest Hills over the Harbour, from which I had a perfect View of the inlet or River, and adjacent country, which afforded but a very indifferent prospect. The Low lands near the River is all over run with Mangroves, among which the salt water flows every tide, and the high land appear'd to be barren and Stoney. A.M., got the 4 remaining Guns out of the hold, and mounted them on the Quarter Deck; got a spare Anchor and Stock ashore, and the remaining part of the Stores and ballast that were in the Hold; set up the Forge, and set the Armourer and his Mate to work to make Nails, etc., to repair the Ship.

Tuesday, 19th. Fresh winds from the southeast and cloudy weather, with frequent rain showers. In the afternoon, we unloaded all the provisions and part of the supplies; we also brought ashore the sick, who numbered about 8 or 9, suffering from various ailments, but none were critically ill. Later, I went up to one of the highest hills overlooking the harbor, where I had a clear view of the inlet or river and the surrounding area, which looked quite unimpressive. The lowlands by the river are completely overrun with mangroves, where saltwater flows in with every tide, and the high ground appeared barren and rocky. In the morning, we got the last 4 guns out of the hold and set them up on the quarterdeck; we also brought ashore a spare anchor and stock, along with the remaining supplies and ballast from the hold; we set up the forge and had the armor and his mate start making nails and other items to repair the ship.

Wednesday, 20th. Winds at South-East, a fresh breeze, Fore and Middle parts rainy, the Latter fair. This day got out all the Officers' stores and the ground Tier of Water, having now nothing in the Fore and Main Hold But the Coals and a little Stone ballast.

Wednesday, 20th. Winds from the southeast, a fresh breeze. The front and middle sections were rainy, but the back was clear. Today we unloaded all the officers' supplies and the bottom tier of water, leaving only coal and a little stone ballast in the fore and main hold.

Thursday, 21st. P.M., landed the Powder, got out the stone ballast, wood, etc., which brought the Ship's Draught of water to 8 feet 10 inches Forward, and 13 feet abaft. This I thought, by trimming the Coals aft, would be sufficient, as I find the Tides will rise and fall upon a Perpendicular 8 feet at Spring tides; but after the Coals was trimm'd away from over the Leak we Could hear the Water come Gushing in a little abaft the Foremast about 3 feet from her Keel. This determin'd me to clear the hold intirely; accordingly very early in the Morning we went to work to get out the Coals, which was Employment for all hands.

Thursday, 21st. In the afternoon, we unloaded the powder and removed the stone ballast, wood, etc., which brought the ship's water level to 8 feet 10 inches in the front and 13 feet in the back. I thought that by moving the coal to the back it would be enough, as I found the tides rise and fall vertically by 8 feet during spring tides. However, after we moved the coal from over the leak, we could hear water gushing in a bit behind the foremast about 3 feet from the keel. This made me decide to completely clear the hold; so, very early in the morning, we got to work removing the coal, which took all hands.

[Ship Beached in Endeavour River.]

[Ship Stranded in Endeavour River.]

Friday, 22nd. Winds at South-East, fair weather. At 4 p.m., having got out most of the Coals, cast loose the Ship's moorings, and warped her a little higher up the Harbour to a place I had pitched upon to lay her ashore to stop the Leak; draught of water Forward 7 feet 9 inches and abaft 13 feet 6 inches. At 8, being high water, hauld her bow close ashore, but Keept her stern afloat, because I was afraid of Neaping her,* (* I.e., Having her so far on shore that they could not heave her off at Neap tide.) and yet it was necessary to lay the whole of her as near the ground as possible.* (* The town of Cooktown now stands where the Endeavour was beached, and the (as near as can be judged) exact spot is marked by a monument.) At 2 a.m. the Tide left her, which gave us an Opportunity to Examine the Leak, which we found to be at her Floor Heads, a little before the Starboard Fore Chains; here the Rocks had made their way thro' 4 planks, quite to, and even into the Timbers, and wounded 3 more. The manner these planks were damaged--or cut out, as I may say--is hardly credible; scarce a Splinter was to be seen, but the whole was cut away as if it had been done by the Hands of Man with a blunt-edge Tool. Fortunately for us the Timbers in this place were very close; other wise it would have been impossible to have saved the Ship, and even as it was it appeared very extraordinary that she made no more water than what she did. A large peice of Coral rock was sticking in one Hole, and several peices of the Fothering, small stones, etc., had made its way in, and lodged between the Timbers, which had stopped the Water from forcing its way in in great Quantities. Part of the Sheathing was gone from under the Larboard bow, part of the False Kiel was gone, and the remainder in such a Shatter'd Condition that we should be much better off if it was gone also; her Forefoot and some part of her Main Kiel was also damaged, but not Materially. What damage she may have received abaft we could not see, but believe not much, as the Ship makes but little water, while the Tide Keeps below the Leak forward. At 9 the Carpenters went to work upon the Ship, while the Armourers were buisy making Bolts, Nails, etc.

Friday, 22nd. Winds from the Southeast, clear weather. At 4 p.m., after removing most of the coal, we released the ship’s moorings and moved her higher up the harbor to a spot I had chosen to beach her and fix the leak; draft of water forward was 7 feet 9 inches and aft 13 feet 6 inches. At 8, during high tide, we pulled her bow close to shore but kept her stern afloat because I was worried about grounding her too much,* (* I.e., having her so far on shore that we couldn't pull her off at neap tide.) though it was necessary to position her as close to the ground as possible.* (* The town of Cooktown now stands where the Endeavour was beached, and the (as closely as can be estimated) exact spot is marked by a monument.) At 2 a.m., the tide went out, giving us a chance to inspect the leak, which we found at her floor heads, just before the starboard fore chains; here the rocks had penetrated through 4 planks, reaching into the timbers and damaging 3 more. The way these planks were damaged—almost like being cut out—was hard to believe; there were hardly any splinters visible, but the whole area looked as if it had been removed with a blunt-edged tool. Thankfully, the timbers in this location were very close together; otherwise, it would have been impossible to save the ship, and even then it seemed remarkable that she took on as little water as she did. A large piece of coral rock was lodged in one opening, and several pieces of packing material, small stones, etc., had entered and settled between the timbers, which helped prevent a large influx of water. Part of the sheathing was missing from under the port bow, some of the false keel was gone, and what remained was in such a shattered condition that we would be better off if it were also gone; her forefoot and a part of her main keel were damaged, but not significantly. We couldn't see what damage she might have sustained at the stern, but we believed it wasn't much, as the ship takes on very little water while the tide stays below the leak in the front. At 9, the carpenters began working on the ship while the armorers were busy making bolts, nails, and so forth.

Saturday, 23rd. Winds South Easterly, a fresh Gale and fair weather. Carpenters employed Shifting the Damaged planks as long as the tide would permit them to work. At low water P.M. we examined the Ship's bottom under the Starboard side, she being dry as far aft as the After-part of the Fore Chains; we could not find that she had received any other damage on this side but what has been mentioned. In the morning I sent 3 Men into the Country to shoot Pidgeons, as some of these birds had been seen flying about; in the evening they return'd with about 1/2 a Dozen. One of the Men saw an Animal something less than a greyhound; it was of a Mouse Colour, very slender made, and swift of Foot.* (* Kangaroo.) A.M., I sent a Boat to haul the Sean, who return'd at noon, having made 3 Hauls and caught only 3 fish; and yet we see them in plenty Jumping about the harbour, but can find no method of catching them.

Saturday, 23rd. Winds from the southeast, a strong gale and clear weather. Carpenters worked on shifting the damaged planks as long as the tide allowed. At low tide in the afternoon, we inspected the ship's hull on the starboard side; it was dry all the way back to the after part of the fore chains. We didn't find any additional damage on this side aside from what was already noted. In the morning, I sent three men out to hunt pigeons since some had been spotted in the area; they returned in the evening with about six. One of the men spotted an animal slightly smaller than a greyhound; it was mouse-colored, very slender, and quick on its feet. (*Kangaroo.) In the morning, I sent a boat to haul the seine, and they came back at noon after making three hauls, catching only three fish. We could see plenty jumping around in the harbor, but we couldn't find a way to catch them.

Sunday, 24th. Winds and weather as Yesterday. P.M., the Carpenters finished the Starboard side, and at 9 heeld the Ship the other way, and hauld her off about 2 feet for fear of Neaping. In the A.M. they went to work repairing the Sheathing under the Larboard bow, where we found 2 planks cut about half thro'. Early in the morning I sent a party of Men into the Country under the direction of Lieutenant Gore to seek for refreshments; they return'd about noon with a few Palm Cabbages and a Bunch or 2 of wild Plantains; these last were much Smaller than any I had ever seen, and the Pulp full of small Stones; otherwise they were well tasted. I saw myself this morning, a little way from the Ship, one of the Animals before spoke off; it was of a light mouse Colour and the full size of a Grey Hound, and shaped in every respect like one, with a long tail, which it carried like a Grey hound; in short, I should have taken it for a wild dog but for its walking or running, in which it jump'd like a Hare or Deer. Another of them was seen to-day by some of our people, who saw the first; they described them as having very small Legs, and the print of the Feet like that of a Goat; but this I could not see myself because the ground the one I saw was upon was too hard, and the length of the Grass hindered my seeing its legs.* (* These kangaroos were the first seen by Europeans. The name was obtained from the natives by Mr. Banks.)

Sunday, 24th. Winds and weather were the same as yesterday. In the afternoon, the carpenters finished the starboard side, and at 9, turned the ship the other way and pulled her off about 2 feet to avoid neap tide. In the morning, they started repairing the sheathing under the port bow, where we found two planks cut about halfway through. Early in the morning, I sent a group of men into the countryside under Lieutenant Gore's direction to look for fresh supplies; they returned around noon with a few palm cabbages and a couple of bunches of wild plantains. These plantains were much smaller than any I had ever seen, and the pulp was filled with small stones; otherwise, they tasted good. I saw one of the animals mentioned earlier this morning, a little way from the ship. It was light mouse-colored and the same size as a greyhound, shaped just like one, with a long tail held like a greyhound's. In short, I would have thought it was a wild dog if not for the way it moved, as it jumped like a hare or deer. Another one was seen today by some of our crew members who saw the first; they described them as having very small legs, and the footprints resembled those of a goat. However, I couldn't see this myself because the ground where I saw the first one was too hard, and the length of the grass prevented me from seeing its legs. (*These kangaroos were the first seen by Europeans. The name was obtained from the natives by Mr. Banks.*)

Monday, 25th. At low water in the P.M. While the Carpenters were buisey in repairing the Sheathing and plank under the Larboard bow I got people to go under the Ship's bottom, to examine all her Larboard side, she only being dry Forward, but abaft were 9 feet water. They found part of the Sheathing off abreast of the Mainmast about her floor heads, and a part of one plank a little damaged. There were 3 people who went down, who all agreed in the same Story; the Master was one, who was positive that she had received no Material Damage besides the loss of the Sheathing. This alone will be sufficient to let the worm into her bottom, which may prove of bad consequence. However, we must run all risque, for I know of no method to remedy this but by heaving her down, which would be a work of Emence Labour and time, if not impractical in our present situation.

Monday, 25th. At low tide in the afternoon. While the carpenters were busy fixing the sheathing and planks under the port bow, I had some people go underneath the ship to check the entire port side, as only the front section was dry, but there was 9 feet of water further back. They found some sheathing missing near the mainmast around the floor beams, and one plank was slightly damaged. Three people went down, and they all reported the same thing; the master was one of them and he was sure that there was no significant damage except for the loss of the sheathing. This alone is enough to allow worms to infest the bottom, which could lead to serious issues. However, we have to take the risk, since I don't know any way to fix this except by dry-docking her, which would be a huge job and time-consuming, if not impossible in our current situation.

The Carpenters continued hard at work under her bottom until put off by the Tide in the evening, and the morning Tide did not Ebb out far enough to permit them to work upon her, for here we have only one Tolerable low and high tide in 24 Hours. A.M., a party of Men were employ'd ashore filling water, while others were employ'd overhauling the rigging.

The carpenters kept working hard underneath her until the tide drove them away in the evening, and the morning tide didn’t go out far enough for them to work on her, since we only have one decent low and high tide every 24 hours. In the morning, a group of men was busy filling water ashore while others were busy checking the rigging.

Tuesday, 26th. Fair weather, a South-East wind, and a fresh Gale; at low Water P.M. the Carpenters finished under the Larboard bow and every other place the tide would permit them to come at. Lashed some Casks under the Ship's bows in order to help to float her, and at high water in the Night attempted to heave her off, but could not, she not being afloat partly owing to some of the Casks not holding that were Lashed under her. A.M., employed getting more Casks ready for the same purpose; but I am much afraid that we shall not be able to float her now the Tides are Taking off.

Tuesday, 26th. The weather was clear, with a southeast wind and a fresh gale. At low tide in the afternoon, the carpenters finished their work under the port bow and in every other spot where the tide allowed them access. They secured some barrels under the ship's bow to help lift her, and at high tide that night, they tried to get her off, but they couldn’t because she wasn’t floating, partly because some of the barrels they lashed under her weren’t holding. In the morning, they worked on preparing more barrels for the same purpose, but I’m very concerned that we won’t be able to get her floating now that the tides are receding.

Wednesday, 27th. A fresh breeze of Wind at South-East and Cloudy weather. P.M., lashed 38 empty Butts under the Ship's Bottom in order to float her off, which proved ineffectual, and therefore gave over all hopes of getting her off until the Next spring tides. At daylight we got a Considerable weight of sundry Articles from Aft forward to ease the Ship; the Armourer at work at the Forge repairing Iron work, etc., Carpenters caulking and Stocking one of the Spare Anchors, Seamen employ'd filling of Water and overhauling the rigging, and I went in the pinnace up the Harbour, and made several hauls with the Sean, but caught only between 20 and 30 pound of fish, which were given to the sick and such as were weak and Ailing.

Wednesday, 27th. A fresh breeze from the southeast and cloudy weather. In the afternoon, we secured 38 empty barrels under the ship's hull to try to float her off, but it didn't work. So, we gave up hope of getting her off until the next spring tides. At dawn, we moved a significant amount of various items from the back to the front to lighten the ship. The armorers were busy at the forge repairing ironwork, the carpenters were caulking and stocking one of the spare anchors, and the sailors were filling water and checking the rigging. I took the dinghy up the harbor and made several catches with the seine but only caught about 20 to 30 pounds of fish, which we gave to the sick and weak crew members.

Thursday, 28th. Fresh breezes and Cloudy. All hands employ'd as Yesterday.

Thursday, 28th. Fresh breezes and cloudy. Everyone is working as they did yesterday.

Friday, 29th. Wind and weather as Yesterday, and the employment of the People the same, Lieutenant Gore having been 4 or 5 miles in the Country, where he met with nothing remarkable. He saw the footsteps of Men, and likewise those of 3 or 4 sorts of wild beasts, but saw neither Man nor beast. Some others of our people who were out Yesterday on the North side of the River met with a place where the Natives have just been, as their fires was then burning; but they saw nobody, nor have we seen one since we have been in port. In these excursions we found some Wild Yamms or Cocos growing in the Swampy grounds, and this Afternoon I sent a Party of Men to gather some. The Tops we found made good greens, and eat exceedingly well when Boil'd, but the roots were so bad that few besides myself could eat them. This night Mr. Green and I observ'd an Emersion of Jupiter's first Satellite, which hapned at 2 hours 58 minutes 53 seconds in the A.M.; the same Emersion hapnd at Greenwich, according to Calculation, on the 30th at 5 hours 17 minutes 43 seconds A.M. The differance is 14 hours 18 minutes 50 seconds, equal to 214 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds of Longitude,* (* This was an excellent observation. The true longitude is 214 degrees 45 minutes.) which this place is West of Greenwich, and its Latitude 15 degrees 26 minutes South. A.M., I sent some hands in a Boat up the River to haul the Sean, while the rest were employ'd about the rigging and sundry other Dutys.

Friday, 29th. The wind and weather were the same as yesterday, and the people's activities were unchanged. Lieutenant Gore went about 4 or 5 miles into the countryside but didn't find anything notable. He saw footprints of people and several types of wild animals but didn't encounter any humans or animals. Some others from our group who were out yesterday on the north side of the river found a spot where the locals had just been, as their fires were still burning; however, they didn't see anyone, and we haven't seen anyone since we arrived in port. During these excursions, we discovered some wild yams or cocos growing in the swampy areas, and this afternoon I sent a group of men to gather some. The tops made good greens and tasted great when boiled, but the roots were so bad that only a few, including myself, could eat them. That night, Mr. Green and I observed an emergence of Jupiter's first satellite, which occurred at 2:58:53 AM; the same emergence happened at Greenwich, according to our calculations, on the 30th at 5:17:43 AM. The difference is 14 hours, 18 minutes, and 50 seconds, equal to 214 degrees, 42 minutes, and 30 seconds of longitude,* (* This was an excellent observation. The true longitude is 214 degrees, 45 minutes.) meaning this place is west of Greenwich, with a latitude of 15 degrees, 26 minutes south. In the morning, I sent some crew members in a boat up the river to haul the seine, while the rest were working on the rigging and various other duties.

Saturday, 30th. Moderate breezes at South-East, and clear serene weather. P.M., the Boat returned from hauling the Sean, having caught as much fish as came to a pound and a half a Man. A.M., I sent her again to haul the Sean, and some hands to gather greens, while others were employ'd about the rigging, etc., etc. I likewise sent some of the Young Gentlemen to take a plan of the Harbour, and went myself upon the hill, which is near the South point to take a view of the Sea.* (* Grassy Hill.) At this time it was low water, and I saw what gave me no small uneasiness, which were a Number of Sand Banks and Shoals laying all along the Coast; the innermost lay about 3 or 4 Miles from the Shore, and the outermost extended off to Sea as far as I could see without my glass, some just appeared above water.* (* These were the innermost reefs of the Great Barrier. There is a tolerably clear passage about 8 miles wide between them and the shore, though this has some small shoals in it.) The only hopes I have of getting clear of them is to the Northward, where there seems to be a Passage, for as the wind blows constantly from the South-East we shall find it difficult, if not impractical, to return to the Southward.

Saturday, 30th. Moderate breezes from the Southeast and clear, calm weather. In the afternoon, the boat returned from hauling the seine, having caught about a pound and a half of fish per person. In the morning, I sent her out again to haul the seine, while some people gathered greens, and others worked on the rigging, etc. I also sent some of the young gentlemen to map out the harbor and went myself up the hill near the south point to get a view of the sea.* (* Grassy Hill.) At that time, it was low tide, and I noticed something that made me quite uneasy: a number of sandbanks and shoals lying along the coast; the innermost ones were about 3 or 4 miles from shore, and the outermost extended out to sea as far as I could see without my binoculars, some barely showing above water.* (* These were the innermost reefs of the Great Barrier. There is a fairly clear passage about 8 miles wide between them and the shore, though there are some small shoals in it.) The only hope I have of getting clear of them is to the north, where there seems to be a passage, because with the wind constantly blowing from the southeast, it will be difficult, if not impossible, to head back south.

[July 1770.]

[July 1770.]

Sunday, 1st July. Gentle breezes at South-East, and Cloudy weather, with some Gentle Showers in the morning. P.M., the People return'd from hauling the Sean, having caught as much fish as came to 2 1/2 pound per Man, no one on board having more than another. The few Greens we got I caused to be boil'd among the pease, and makes a very good Mess, which, together with the fish, is a great refreshment to the people. A.M., a party of Men, one from each Mess, went again a fishing, and all the rest I gave leave to go into the Country, knowing that there was no danger from the Natives. To-day at Noon the Thermometer in the Shade rose to 87 degrees, which is 2 or 3 Degrees higher than it hath been on any day before in this place.

Sunday, July 1. There were gentle breezes from the southeast and cloudy weather, with some light showers in the morning. In the afternoon, the people returned from hauling the seine, having caught enough fish for each person to have about 2.5 pounds, so everyone on board had the same amount. I had the few greens we got boiled with the peas, making a great meal, which, along with the fish, was a wonderful refreshment for everyone. In the morning, a group of men, one from each mess, went fishing again, while I allowed the rest to go into the countryside since I knew there was no danger from the natives. Today at noon, the thermometer in the shade reached 87 degrees, which is 2 or 3 degrees higher than it has been on any previous day here.

Monday, 2nd. Ditto weather. P.M., the fishing-party caught as much fish as came to 2 pounds a Man. Those that were in the Country met with nothing New. Early in the A.M. I sent the Master in the pinnace out of the Harbour, to sound about the Shoals in the Offing and to look for a Channel to the Northward. At this time we had a breeze of wind from the land, which continued till about 9. What makes me mention this is, that it is the first Land breeze we have had since we have been in this River. At low water lashed empty Casks under the Ship's bows, being in some hopes of floating her the next high Water, and sent some hands a fishing, while others were employ'd in refitting the Ship.

Monday, 2nd. Same weather. In the afternoon, the fishing party caught enough fish to total about 2 pounds per person. Those who stayed in the area didn’t find anything new. Early in the morning, I sent the captain out in the small boat to check around the shoals offshore and look for a channel to the north. At that time, we had a land breeze that lasted until about 9. I mention this because it’s the first land breeze we’ve had since arriving in this river. At low tide, I secured empty barrels under the ship’s bow, hoping to float her during the next high tide, and sent some crew members fishing while others worked on repairing the ship.

Tuesday, 3rd. Winds at South-East, Fore and Middle part gentle breeze, the remainder a fresh gale. In the evening the fishing Party return'd, having got as much fish as came to 2 pounds a Man. At high water we attempted to heave the Ship off, but did not succeed. At Noon the Master return'd, and reported he had found a passage out to Sea between the Shoals, which passage lies out East-North-East or East by North from the River mouth. He found these Shoals to Consist of Coral Rocks; he landed upon one, which drys at low Water, where he found very large cockles* (* Tridacna.) and a Variety of other Shell fish, a quantity of which he brought away with him. He told me that he was 5 Leagues out at Sea, having at that distance 21 fathoms water, and judg'd himself to be without all the Shoals, which I very much doubted.* (* Cook was right. The shoals extend for four leagues farther.) After this he came in Shore, and Stood to the Northward, where he met with a Number of Shoals laying a little distance from the Shore. About 9 in the evening he landed in a Bay about 3 Leagues to the Northward of this Place, where he disturbed some of the Natives, whom he supposed to be at supper; they all fled upon his approach, and Left him some fresh Sea Eggs, and a fire ready lighted behind them; but there was neither House nor Hut near. Although these Shoals lay within sight of the Coast, and abound very much with Shell fish and other small fish, which are to be caught at Low water in holes in the Rocks, yet the Natives never visit them, for if they did we must have seen of these Large shells on shore about their fire places. The reason I do suppose is, that they have no Boats that they dare Venture so far out at Sea in.* (* Nevertheless the natives do get out to the islands which lie farther from the shore than these reefs, as Cook himself afterwards found.)

Tuesday, 3rd. Winds from the South-East, light breeze in the fore and middle parts, and a fresh gale elsewhere. In the evening, the fishing party returned, having caught enough fish for 2 pounds per person. At high tide, we tried to get the ship off, but we weren’t successful. At noon, the captain came back and reported that he found a passage out to sea between the shoals, which lies out East-North-East or East by North from the river mouth. He discovered that these shoals consist of coral rocks; he landed on one that dries at low tide, where he found very large cockles (Tridacna) and a variety of other shellfish, some of which he took with him. He told me he was 5 leagues out to sea, with 21 fathoms of water at that distance, and he believed he was beyond all the shoals, though I was skeptical. After that, he came back inshore and headed north, where he encountered several shoals a bit away from the coast. Around 9 in the evening, he landed in a bay about 3 leagues north of here, where he startled some locals who he thought were having dinner; they all ran away when he approached, leaving him some fresh sea eggs and a fire already lit behind them, but there were no houses or huts nearby. Although these shoals are visible from the coast and are rich in shellfish and other small fish that can be caught in the rock holes at low tide, the locals never visit them. If they did, we would have noticed large shells at their fire pits. I think the reason is that they don’t have boats that they would risk taking out so far into the sea.

Wednesday, 4th. Strong gales at South-East and fair weather. P.M., the fishing party return'd with the usual success; at High water hove the ship Afloat. A.M., employ'd trimming her upon an even Kiel, intending to lay her ashore once more, to come at her bottom under the Larboard Main Chains.

Wednesday, 4th. Strong winds from the southeast and nice weather. In the afternoon, the fishing party came back with their usual catch; at high tide, we got the ship floating. In the morning, we worked on leveling her out, planning to take her ashore again to access the bottom under the left side main chains.

Thursday, 5th. Strong breezes at South-East and fair weather. P.M. Warped the Ship over, and at high Water laid her ashore on the Sandbank on the South side of the River, for I was afraid to lay her broad side to the Shore where she lay before, because the ground lies upon too great a decent, and she hath already received some Damage by laying there these last Niep Tides, at least she still makes water.

Thursday, 5th. Strong breezes from the Southeast and nice weather. In the afternoon, I shifted the ship over and at high tide grounded her on the sandbank on the south side of the river, since I was worried about leaving her broadside to the shore like before, as the ground slopes too steeply, and she has already taken some damage from sitting there during the last few high tides; at least she still keeps taking on water.

[At Anchor, Endeavour River.]

[At Anchor, Endeavour River.]

Friday, 6th. Ditto weather. At low water in the P.M. had hardly 4 feet water under the Ship; yet could not repair the Sheathing that was beat off, the place being all under water. One of the Carpenter's crew, a Man I could trust, went down and Examin'd it, and found 3 Streakes of the Sheathing gone about 7 or 8 feet long, and the Main Plank a little rubbed; this account agrees with the report of the Master and others that were under her bottom before. The Carpenter, who I look upon to be well skill'd in his profession, and a good judge in these matters, was of Opinion that this was of little consequence; and as I found that it would be difficult, if not impractical, for us to get under her bottom to repair it, I resolved to spend no more time about it. Accordingly at high water hove her off, and moor'd her alongside the beach, where the Stores, etc., lay, and in the A.M. got everything in readiness for taking them on board, and at the same time got on board 8 Tuns of Water, and stow'd in the ground Tier in the after Hold. In the Morning Mr. Banks and Lieutenant Gore with 3 Men went in a small Boat up the Harbour, with a View to stay 2 or 3 days to try to Kill some of the Animals we have seen about this place.

Friday, 6th. The weather was the same. At low tide in the afternoon, there was barely 4 feet of water under the ship, so we couldn’t fix the sheathing that had come off because it was all underwater. One of the carpenter's crew, a guy I could trust, went down and checked it out. He found 3 strips of the sheathing were missing, about 7 or 8 feet long, and the main plank was slightly worn. This matched the report from the captain and others who had been under the ship earlier. The carpenter, who I believe is quite skilled and knowledgeable, thought this was not a big deal. Since I realized it would be tough, if not impossible, for us to get under the ship to fix it, I decided to not spend any more time on it. So, at high tide, we hove her off and moored her next to the beach where the stores, etc., were located. In the morning, we got everything ready to take on board, and at the same time, we loaded 8 tons of water into the after hold. In the morning, Mr. Banks and Lieutenant Gore, along with 3 men, went in a small boat up the harbor, planning to stay for 2 or 3 days to try to catch some of the animals we had seen around here.

Saturday, 7th. Fresh breezes at South-East and fair weather. Employ'd getting on board Coals, Ballast, etc., and caulking the Ship; a work that could not be done while she lay aground. The Armourer and his Mate are Still employ'd at the Forge making and repairing sundry Articles in the Iron way.

Saturday, 7th. There were fresh breezes from the southeast and good weather. We spent the day loading coal, ballast, etc., and caulking the ship, which couldn’t be done while it was on the ground. The armorer and his assistant are still busy at the forge, making and repairing various iron items.

Sunday, 8th. Gentle breeze and South-East, and clear weather. Early I sent the Master in a Boat out to Sea to sound again about the Shoals, because the account he had given of the Channell before mentioned was to me by no means Satisfactory; likewise sent some hands to haul the Sean, who caught near 80 pounds of fish; the rest of the people I gave leave to go into the Country.

Sunday, 8th. A gentle breeze from the southeast and clear weather. Early in the morning, I sent the captain out to sea on a boat to check the depths around the shoals again because his previous report about the channel didn’t satisfy me at all. I also sent some crew members to haul the seine, and they caught about 80 pounds of fish. I let the rest of the crew go into the countryside.

Monday, 9th. In the Day Ditto Winds, but in the night Calm. P.M., Mr. Gore and Mr. Banks return'd, having met with nothing remarkable; they were about 3 or 4 Leagues up in the Country without finding hardly any Variation either in the Soil or Produce. In the Evening the Master return'd, having been several Leagues out at Sea, and at that Distance off saw Shoals without him, and was of opinion there was no getting out to Sea that way. In his return he touched upon one of the Shoals, the same as he was upon the first time he was out; he here saw a great number of Turtle, 3 of which he Caught weighing 791 pounds. This occasion'd my sending him out again this morning provided with proper gear for Striking them, he having before nothing but a Boat Hook. Carpenters, Smiths, and Coopers at their respective Employments, and the Seamen employed getting on board stones, ballast, etc. This day all hands feasted upon Turtle for the First time.* (* As they had had nothing fresh but a little fish for four months, and scarcely any meat since they left the Society Islands, eleven months before, we can imagine that this was a feast.)

Monday, 9th. It was windy during the day, but calm at night. In the afternoon, Mr. Gore and Mr. Banks returned, having encountered nothing noteworthy; they were about 3 or 4 leagues inland but found little variation in the soil or produce. In the evening, the captain came back after going several leagues out to sea, where he observed shoals from a distance and concluded that there was no way to get out to sea that way. On his way back, he stopped at one of the shoals, the same one he had visited the first time he went out; there, he saw a large number of turtles and caught three, weighing a total of 791 pounds. This led me to send him out again this morning equipped with the right gear for hunting them, as he previously had only a boat hook. Carpenters, blacksmiths, and coopers were busy with their respective tasks, while the seamen were occupied with loading stones, ballast, etc. Today, everyone enjoyed turtle for the first time. (*Having had nothing fresh besides a little fish for four months and barely any meat since leaving the Society Islands eleven months ago, we can imagine this was quite the feast.)

Tuesday, 10th. Winds and weather as yesterday. Employ'd hoisting on board and stowing away the ground Tier of Water. P.M., saw 7 or 8 of the Natives on the South side of the River, and 2 of them came down upon the Sandy point opposite the Ship; but as soon as I put off in a Boat in order to speak with them they run away as fast as they could. At 11 Mr. Banks, who had gone out to Sea with Mr. Molineux, the Master, return'd in his own Small Boat, and gave but a Very bad account of our Turtlecatchers. At the time he left them, which was about 6 o'Clock, they had not got one, nor were they likely to get any; and yet the Master was so obstinate that he would not return,* (* This seems rather hard upon the Master.) which obliged me to send Mr. Gore out in the Yawl this morning to order the Boat and People in, in Case they could not be employ'd there to some Advantage. In the A.M. 4 of the Natives came down to the Sandy point on the North side of the Harbour, having along with them a small wooden Canoe with Outriggers, in which they seem'd to be employed striking fish, etc. Some were for going over in a Boat to them; but this I would not suffer, but let them alone without seeming to take any Notice of them. At length 2 of them came in the Canoe so near the Ship as to take some things we throw'd them. After this they went away, and brought over the other 2, and came again alongside, nearer than they had done before, and took such Trifles as we gave them; after this they landed close to the Ship, and all 4 went ashore, carrying their Arms with them. But Tupia soon prevailed upon them to lay down their Arms, and come and set down by him, after which most of us went to them, made them again some presents, and stay'd by them until dinner time, when we made them understand that we were going to eat, and asked them by signals to go with us; but this they declined, and as soon as we left them they went away in their Canoe. One of these Men was something above the Middle Age, the other 3 were young; none of them were above 5 1/2 feet high, and all their Limbs proportionately small. They were wholy naked, their Skins the Colour of Wood soot, and this seem'd to be their Natural Colour. Their Hair was black, lank, and cropt short, and neither wooly nor Frizled; nor did they want any of their Fore Teeth, as Dampier has mentioned those did he saw on the Western side of this Country. Some part of their Bodys had been painted with red, and one of them had his upper lip and breast painted with Streakes of white, which he called Carbanda. Their features were far from being disagreeable; their Voices were soft and Tunable, and they could easily repeat any word after us, but neither us nor Tupia could understand one word they said.

Tuesday, 10th. The winds and weather were the same as yesterday. We spent the time hoisting on board and stowing away the bottom tier of water. In the afternoon, I saw 7 or 8 natives on the south side of the river, and 2 of them came down to the sandy point opposite the ship; however, as soon as I got in a boat to talk to them, they ran away as fast as they could. At 11, Mr. Banks, who had gone out to sea with Mr. Molineux, the captain, returned in his small boat and reported poorly about our turtle catchers. At the time he left them, around 6 o'clock, they hadn’t caught any and weren’t likely to. Yet the captain was so stubborn he wouldn’t come back, which forced me to send Mr. Gore out in the yawl this morning to order the boat and crew back in case they couldn’t find anything else useful to do there. In the morning, 4 natives came down to the sandy point on the north side of the harbor, and they had a small wooden canoe with outriggers, which they seemed to be using to catch fish, etc. Some wanted to go over in a boat to them, but I wouldn’t allow that and ignored them instead. Eventually, 2 of them came in the canoe close to the ship and took some things we threw to them. After this, they left and brought over the other 2, coming alongside again, closer than before, and took small items we offered them. After that, they landed near the ship and all 4 went ashore with their weapons. But Tupia soon convinced them to lay down their arms and sit by him. After that, most of us joined them, gave them more gifts, and stayed with them until dinner time, when we indicated that we were going to eat and signaled for them to join us; however, they declined, and as soon as we left, they paddled away in their canoe. One of these men was somewhat older, while the other 3 were young; none of them were over 5 ½ feet tall, and all their limbs were proportionately small. They were completely naked, their skin the color of soot, which seemed to be their natural color. Their hair was black, straight, and cropped short, neither woolly nor frizzy; they also didn't lack any of their front teeth, unlike what Dampier mentioned about some he saw on the western side of this country. Some parts of their bodies were painted red, and one of them had his upper lip and chest painted with streaks of white, which he called Carbanda. Their features were quite pleasant; their voices were soft and melodic, and they could easily repeat any word after us, but neither we nor Tupia could understand anything they said.

Wednesday, 11th. Gentle land and Sea breezes. Employed Airing the Bread, stowing away water, Stores, etc. In the night the Master and Mr. Gore returned with the Long Boat, and brought with them one Turtle and a few Shell fish; the Yawl Mr. Gore left upon the Shoal with 6 Men to endeavour to strike more Turtle. In the morning 4 of the Natives made us another Short Visit; 3 of them had been with us the preceeding day, the other was a stranger. One of these men had a hole through the Bridge* (* The cartilage of the nostril.) of his nose, in which he stuck a peice of Bone as thick as my finger. Seeing this we examin'd all their Noses, and found that they had all holes for the same purpose; they had likewise holes in their Ears, but no Ornaments hanging to them; they had bracelets on their Arms made of hair, and like Hoops of small Cord. They sometimes may wear a kind of fillet about their Heads, for one of them had applied some part of an old shirt which I had given them to this use.

Wednesday, 11th. Gentle land and sea breezes. Spent the day airing the bread, stowing away water and supplies, etc. At night, the captain and Mr. Gore returned with the longboat, bringing a turtle and a few shellfish. Mr. Gore left the yawl on the shoal with six men to try to catch more turtles. In the morning, four locals paid us another short visit; three of them had been with us the day before, and the fourth was a stranger. One of these men had a hole through the bridge* (*the cartilage of the nostril) of his nose, in which he inserted a piece of bone as thick as my finger. Seeing this, we examined all their noses and found that they all had holes for the same purpose; they also had holes in their ears, but no ornaments hanging from them. They wore bracelets on their arms made of hair, resembling small cord hoops. Occasionally, they might wear a type of headband, as one of them had used part of an old shirt I had given them for that purpose.

Thursday, 12th. Winds and weather as Yesterday, and the Employment of the People the same. At 2 A.M. the Yawl came on board, and brought 3 Turtle and a large Skeat, and as there was a probability of succeeding in this kind of fishery, I sent her out again after breakfast. About this time 5 of the Natives came over and stay'd with us all the Forenoon. There were 7 in all--5 Men, 1 Woman, and a Boy; these 2 last stay'd on the point of Land on the other side of the River about 200 Yards from us. We could very clearly see with our Glasses that the Woman was as naked as ever she was born; even those parts which I always before now thought Nature would have taught a woman to Conceal were uncovered.

Thursday, 12th. The winds and weather were the same as yesterday, and the activities of the people remained unchanged. At 2 A.M., the Yawl returned and brought 3 turtles and a large skiff. Since there was a good chance of success with this type of fishing, I sent it out again after breakfast. Around this time, 5 of the natives came over and stayed with us all morning. There were 7 in total—5 men, 1 woman, and a boy; the latter two stayed on the point of land on the other side of the river, about 200 yards from us. We could clearly see through our binoculars that the woman was completely naked; even those parts I had thought nature would prompt a woman to cover were visible.

Friday, 13th. Gentle breezes from the South-East in day, and Calm or light Airs from the Land in the Night. Employ'd taking on board water, Stores, etc. At Noon the Yawl return'd with one Turtle and a large Sting ray.

Friday, 13th. Gentle breezes from the southeast during the day, and calm or light winds from the land at night. Spent time taking on water, supplies, etc. At noon, the yawl returned with one turtle and a large stingray.

Saturday, 14th. Gentle breezes at South-East and Hazey weather. In the P.M. compleated our water; got on board all the Bread, and part of our Stores; in the evening sent the Turtlers out again. A.M., employ'd getting on board stone ballast and Airing the spare Sails. Mr. Gore, being in the Country, shott one of the Animals before spoke of; it was a small one of the sort, weighing only 28 pound clear of the entrails; its body was ----* (* Blank in manuscript.) long; the head, neck, and Shoulders very Small in proportion to the other parts. It was hair lipt, and the Head and Ears were most like a Hare's of any Animal I know; the Tail was nearly as long as the body, thick next the Rump, and Tapering towards the End; the fore Legs were 8 Inches long, and the Hind 22. Its progression is by Hopping or Jumping 7 or 8 feet at each hop upon its hind Legs only, for in this it makes no use of the Fore, which seem to be only design'd for Scratching in the ground, etc. The Skin is cover'd with a Short, hairy furr of a dark Mouse or Grey Colour. It bears no sort of resemblance to any European animal I ever saw; it is said to bear much resemblance to the Jerboa, excepting in size, the Jerboa being no larger than a common rat.

Saturday, 14th. Light breezes from the southeast and hazy weather. In the afternoon, we finished our water supply and got onboard all the bread and some of our stores; in the evening, we sent the turtlers out again. In the morning, we were busy loading stone ballast and airing the spare sails. Mr. Gore, who was in the countryside, shot one of the animals mentioned earlier; it was a small one, weighing only 28 pounds after removing the entrails; its body was ----* (* Blank in manuscript.) long; the head, neck, and shoulders were very small compared to the other parts. It had hair on its lips, and its head and ears resembled those of a hare more than any other animal I know; the tail was almost as long as the body, thick near the rump, and tapered towards the end; the forelegs were 8 inches long, and the hind legs 22 inches. It moves by hopping or jumping 7 or 8 feet at a time on its hind legs only, as it doesn’t seem to use the forelegs, which appear to be designed just for scratching in the ground, etc. The skin is covered with a short, hairy fur of a dark mouse or gray color. It looks nothing like any European animal I've ever seen; it's said to resemble a jerboa a lot, except for its size, as the jerboa is no larger than a common rat.

Sunday, 15th. Gentle breezes at South-East and East. P.M., got on board the Spare Sails and sundry other Articles. In the A.M., as the people did not work upon the Ship, one of the Petty Officers was desirous of going out to Catch Turtles. I let him have the Pinnace for that purpose, and sent the Long boat to haul the Sean, who caught about 60 fish.

Sunday, 15th. Light winds from the Southeast and East. In the afternoon, I loaded the Spare Sails and some other items on board. In the morning, since the crew wasn’t working on the ship, one of the petty officers wanted to go out and catch turtles. I let him take the small boat for that, and sent the long boat to haul the seine, which caught about 60 fish.

Monday, 16th. Fore and Latter parts gentle breezes at East-North-East; in the night had light Airs and Calm. In the evening the Yawl came in with 4 Turtle and a Large Sting ray, and soon after went out again; but the Pinnace did not return as I expected. A.M., employ'd getting on board Cables; at the same time I went upon one of the high hills on the North side of the River, from which I had an extensive view of the inland Country, which consisted of hills, Valleys, and Large plains, agreeably diversified with Woods and Lawns.

Monday, 16th. The weather in the morning and evening was marked by gentle breezes from the East-North-East, and during the night, there were light winds and calm conditions. In the evening, the Yawl returned with 4 turtles and a large stingray and soon went back out again; however, the Pinnace did not return as I had expected. In the morning, I worked on getting the cables on board; at the same time, I climbed one of the high hills on the north side of the river, from where I had a wide view of the inland countryside, which was made up of hills, valleys, and large plains, pleasantly mixed with woods and lawns.

Tuesday, 17th. Wind at South-East, a fresh breeze; people employed as yesterday setting up the rigging. In the evening the Pinnace returned with 3 Turtles, 2 of which the Yawl caught and sent in. At 7 hours 41 minutes 17 seconds p.m. observ'd the first Satellite of Jupiter to Emerge, and the same Emersion hapned at Greenwich at 10 hours 00 minutes 52 seconds in the a.m.; the difference is 14 hours 19 minutes 35 seconds equal to 214 degrees 53 minutes 45 seconds of Longitude. The observation made on the 29th of last Month gave 214 degrees 42 minutes 30 seconds; the mean is 214 degrees 48 minutes 7 1/2 seconds, which this place is West of Greenwich.* (* As before mentioned, the true longitude is 214 degrees 45 minutes.)

Tuesday, 17th. Wind from the Southeast, a fresh breeze; people busy as yesterday setting up the rigging. In the evening, the Pinnace returned with 3 turtles, 2 of which were caught by the Yawl and sent in. At 7:41:17 PM, I observed the first satellite of Jupiter emerge, and the same emergence occurred at Greenwich at 10:00:52 AM; the difference is 14 hours, 19 minutes, and 35 seconds, which equals 214 degrees, 53 minutes, and 45 seconds of Longitude. The observation made on the 29th of last month gave 214 degrees, 42 minutes, and 30 seconds; the average is 214 degrees, 48 minutes, and 7.5 seconds, which indicates this location is west of Greenwich.* (*As previously mentioned, the true longitude is 214 degrees, 45 minutes.)

Wednesday, 18th. Wind at East-South-East, a Gentle breeze. P.M., I sent the Master and one of the Mates in the Pinnace to the Northward to look for a Channell that way clear of the Shoal. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself took a turn into the woods on the other side of the water, where we met with 5 of the Natives; and although we had not seen any of them before, they came to us without showing any signs of fear. 2 of these wore Necklaces made of Shells, which they seem'd to Value, as they would not part with them. In the evening the Yawl came in with 3 Turtle, and early in the A.M. she went out again. About 8 we were Visited by several of the Natives, who now became more familiar than ever. Soon after this Mr. Banks and I went over to the South* (* This should be North.) side of the River, and Travel'd 6 or 8 miles along shore to the Northward, where we ascended a high hill, from whence I had an extensive view of the Sea Coast; it afforded us a melancholy prospect of the difficulties we are to encounter, for in whatever direction we looked it was cover'd with Shoals as far as the Eye could see; after this we return'd to the Ship without meeting with anything remarkable, and found several of the Natives on board. At this time we had 12 tortoise or Turtle upon our Decks, which they took more Notice of than anything Else in the Ship, as I was told by the officers, for their Curiosity was Satisfied before I got on board, and they went away soon after.

Wednesday, 18th. Wind from the East-South-East, a light breeze. In the afternoon, I sent the Captain and one of the Mates out in the Pinnace to the north to look for a channel free of the shoals. Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I took a walk into the woods on the other side of the water, where we encountered five of the Natives. Although we hadn’t seen any of them before, they approached us without showing any fear. Two of them were wearing shell necklaces, which they seemed to value, as they wouldn’t part with them. In the evening, the Yawl returned with three turtles, and early in the morning it went out again. Around 8, we were visited by several of the Natives, who became more friendly than ever. Shortly after, Mr. Banks and I went over to the south side of the river and traveled 6 or 8 miles along the shore to the north, where we climbed a high hill. From there, I had a wide view of the coastline; it presented a grim outlook on the difficulties ahead, as every direction we looked was filled with shoals as far as the eye could see. After that, we returned to the ship without encountering anything noteworthy and found several of the Natives on board. At this point, we had 12 turtles on our decks, which attracted more attention from them than anything else on the ship, as the officers told me their curiosity was satisfied before I got on board, and they left soon after.

Thursday, 19th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. Employ'd getting everything in readyness for Sea. A.M., we were Visited by 10 or 11 of the Natives; the most of them came from the other side of the Harbour, where we saw 6 or 7 more, the most of them Women, and, like the men, quite naked. Those that came on board were very desirous of having some of our Turtles, and took the liberty to haul 2 of them to the Gangway to put over the side; being disappointed in this, they grew a little Troublesome, and were for throwing every thing overboard they could lay their hands upon. As we had no Victuals dress'd at this time, I offer'd them some bread to Eat, which they rejected with Scorn, as I believe they would have done anything else excepting Turtle;* (* No doubt, in the native view, the turtle belonged to them, and they considered the strangers had annexed their property.) soon after this they all went ashore, Mr. Banks, myself, and 5 or 6 of our people being their at same time. Immediately upon their Landing one of tbem took a Handful of dry grass and lighted it at a fire we had ashore, and before we well know'd what he was going about he made a larger Circuit round about us, and set fire to the grass in his way, and in an instant the whole place was in flames. Luckily at this time we had hardly anything ashore, besides the Forge and a Sow with a litter of young Pigs, one of which was scorched to Death in the fire. As soon as they had done this they all went to a place where some of our people were washing, and where all our nets and a good deal of linnen were laid out to dry; here with the greatest obstinacy they again set fire to the grass, which I and some others who were present could not prevent, until I was obliged to fire a Musquet load with small Shott at one of the Ring leaders, which sent them off. As we were apprised of this last Attempt of theirs we got the fire out before it got head, but the first spread like wild fire in the Woods and grass. Notwithstanding my firing, in which one must have been a little hurt, because we saw a few drops of blood on some of the linnen he had gone over, they did not go far from us; for we soon after heard their Voices in the woods, upon which Mr. Banks and I and 3 or 4 more went to look for them, and very soon met them coming toward us. As they had each 4 or 5 Darts, and not knowing their intention, we seized upon 6 or 7 of the first darts we met with. This alarm'd them so much that they all made off, and we follow'd them for near 1/2 a Mile, and then set down and called to them, and they stop'd also; after some little unintelligible conversation had passed they laid down their darts, and came to us in a very friendly manner. We now return'd the Darts we had taken from them, which reconcil'd everything. There were 4 Strangers among them that we had not seen before, and these were interduced to us by name by the others; the Man which we supposed to have been Struck with small Shott was gone off, but he could not be much hurt as he was at a great distance when I fir'd. They all came along with us abreast of the Ship, where they stay'd a short time, and then went away, and soon after set the woods on fire about a Mile and a half or two Miles from us.

Thursday, 19th. Gentle breezes and clear skies. I spent the morning getting everything ready for the sea. In the morning, about 10 or 11 locals visited us; most came from the other side of the harbor, where we spotted 6 or 7 more, mostly women, who, like the men, were completely naked. Those who came on board were eager to take some of our turtles and tried to haul 2 of them to the gangway to throw over the side. When they were disappointed, they became a bit troublesome and started tossing everything they could find overboard. Since we had no food prepared at that time, I offered them some bread to eat, but they rejected it with disdain, as I believe they would have done with anything except turtle; (*No doubt, from their perspective, the turtle belonged to them, and they saw the outsiders as having taken their property.) Shortly after, they all went ashore while Mr. Banks, I, and 5 or 6 of our crew were there. As soon as they landed, one of them took a handful of dry grass and lit it at a fire we had onshore, and before we knew what he was doing, he made a wide circle around us and set fire to the grass in his path, and in an instant, the whole area was ablaze. Fortunately, we had hardly anything ashore besides the forge and a sow with a litter of piglets, one of which was scorched to death in the fire. After doing this, they all went to where some of our crew were washing and where we had nets and a lot of linen spread out to dry; here, with great obstinacy, they set fire to the grass again, which I and some others present could not stop, until I had to fire a musket load with small shot at one of the leaders, which sent them running. Since we were aware of their last attempt, we managed to put out the fire before it spread too badly, but the first fire had already spread like wildfire through the woods and grass. Despite my shot, which must have hurt one of them a bit since we saw some blood on some of the linen he had crossed, they didn’t go far from us; soon after, we heard their voices in the woods, so Mr. Banks, I, and 3 or 4 others went to look for them, and we quickly met them coming toward us. Since they each had 4 or 5 darts, and not knowing their intentions, we grabbed 6 or 7 of the first darts we came across. This frightened them so much that they all ran off, and we followed them for almost half a mile, then sat down and called to them, and they stopped too. After some brief, indistinct conversation, they laid down their darts and approached us in a very friendly manner. We returned the darts we had taken from them, which settled everything. There were 4 strangers among them that we hadn’t seen before, and they were introduced to us by name by the others; the man we suspected had been shot with small shot was gone, but he couldn't have been badly hurt since he was far away when I fired. They all walked along with us beside the ship, where they stayed for a short time before leaving, and shortly after that, they set the woods on fire about a mile and a half or two miles from us.

Friday, 20th. Fresh breezes at South-East and Cloudy weather. P.M., got everything on board the Ship, new berth'd her, and let her swing with the tide. In the night the Master return'd with the pinnace, and reported that there was no safe Passage for the Ship to the Northward at low water. A.M., I went and Sounded and buoy'd the Bar, being now ready to put to sea the first opportunity.

Friday, 20th. Fresh breezes from the southeast and cloudy weather. In the afternoon, I got everything on board the ship, anchored her in a new position, and let her swing with the tide. At night, the captain returned with the small boat and reported that there was no safe passage for the ship to the north at low tide. In the morning, I went to check the depth and marked the bar, as we were now ready to set sail at the first opportunity.

Saturday, 21st. Strong breezes at South-East and Cloudy weather. P.M., sent a Boat to haul the Sean, which return'd with as much fish as came to 1 3/4 pounds per Man; the Yawl return'd with only one Turtle, which was caught in the Net, for it blew too hard for the Boat to strike any. In the morning I sent her out again, but she was obliged to return, not being able to get to Windward. The Carpenters employ'd in repairing the Boats and overhauling the Pumps, and as the Wind would not permit us to sail, I sent the Boatswain with some hands ashore to make rope, and a petty Officer with 2 Men to gather Greens for the Ship's Company.

Saturday, 21st. Strong breezes from the southeast and cloudy weather. In the afternoon, I sent a boat to haul the seine, which returned with enough fish to amount to 1 3/4 pounds per person; the yawl came back with just one turtle that got caught in the net, as the wind was too strong for the boat to catch anything else. In the morning, I sent her out again, but she had to return because she couldn’t make it to windward. The carpenters were busy repairing the boats and checking the pumps, and since the wind wouldn’t allow us to sail, I sent the boatswain with some crew members ashore to make rope, and a petty officer with two men to gather greens for the ship's company.

Sunday, 22nd. Fresh breezes at South-East and East-South-East. Employ'd as Yesterday. A.M., the weather would not permit us to Sail; sent the Turtlers out again. In opening of one to-day we found sticking thro' both Shoulder bones a wood Harpoon, or Turtle Peg, 15 Inches long, bearded at the end, such as we have seen among the Natives; this proves to a Demonstration that they strike Turtle, I suppose at the Time they come ashore to lay their Eggs, for they certainly have no boat fit to do this at Sea, or that will carry a Turtle, and this Harpoon must have been a good while in, as the wound was quite heal'd up.

Sunday, 22nd. Fresh breezes from the South-East and East-South-East. Worked as yesterday. In the morning, the weather didn't allow us to sail, so we sent the turtlers out again. While checking one today, we found a wooden harpoon, or turtle peg, 15 inches long, embedded through both shoulder bones, with a bearded end, similar to what we've seen among the natives. This clearly shows they catch turtles, probably when they come ashore to lay their eggs, since they definitely don't have a boat that's capable of doing this at sea or that can carry a turtle. This harpoon must have been in there for a while, as the wound was completely healed.

Monday, 23rd. Fresh breezes in the South-East quarter, which so long as it continues will confine us in Port. Yesterday, A.M., I sent some people in the Country to gather greens, one of which stragled from the rest, and met with 4 of the Natives by a fire, on which they were broiling a Fowl, and the hind leg of one of the Animals before spoke of. He had the presence of mind not to run from them (being unarm'd), least they should pursue him, but went and set down by them; and after he had set a little while, and they had felt his hands and other parts of his body, they suffer'd him to go away without offering the least insult, and perceiving that he did not go right for the Ship they directed him which way to go.

Monday, 23rd. There are fresh breezes coming from the southeast, which means we’ll be stuck in Port for now. Yesterday morning, I sent some people into the countryside to gather greens. One of them wandered away from the group and encountered four natives by a fire where they were cooking a chicken and the hind leg of one of the animals I mentioned earlier. He had the presence of mind not to run away from them (since he was unarmed), fearing they might chase him. Instead, he sat down with them, and after a little while, once they had checked his hands and other parts of his body, they let him leave without any trouble. Noticing that he wasn’t heading back to the ship, they pointed him in the right direction.

Tuesday, 24th. Winds and weather continues. The Seamen employ'd making ropes, Caulking the Ship, Fishing, etc.

Tuesday, the 24th. Winds and weather are ongoing. The sailors are busy making ropes, caulking the ship, fishing, etc.

Wednesday, 25th. Fresh gales at South-East and fair weather. In the evening the Yawl came in, having not been able to Strike one Turtle on account of the blowing weather, nor can we catch much fish with the Sean in the Harbour.

Wednesday, 25th. Strong winds from the Southeast and nice weather. In the evening, the Yawl returned, but they couldn’t catch a single turtle because of the windy conditions, and we can’t catch much fish with the seine in the harbor.

Thursday, 26th. Winds and weather as Yesterday. Such people as can be spared from the necessary Dutys of the Ship are employ'd fishing and gathering greens and other refreshments.

Thursday, 26th. The winds and weather are the same as yesterday. Those who can be spared from the essential duties of the ship are occupied with fishing and collecting greens and other supplies.

Friday, 27th. Very fresh Gales at South-East by South and fair weather. A.M., caught as much fish as served 3/4 pounds a man, and Mr. Gore shott one of the Animals before spoke of, which weighed 80 pounds and 54 pounds, exclusive of the entrails, Skin, and head; this was as large as the most we have seen.

Friday, 27th. Very fresh gales from the southeast and nice weather. In the morning, we caught enough fish to serve three-quarters of a pound per person, and Mr. Gore shot one of the animals mentioned earlier, which weighed 80 pounds and 54 pounds, not including the entrails, skin, and head; this was as large as the biggest we've seen.

Saturday, 28th. Winds and weather as above, without the least Variation the whole of the 24 hours. The Carpenters finish'd caulking the Ship.

Saturday, 28th. Winds and weather were the same as before, without the slightest change the entire 24 hours. The carpenters finished caulking the ship.

Sunday, 29th. Winds at South-East, a fresh breeze until 5 a.m., at which time it fell calm, and soon after had a light breeze from the land. Upon this I sent a Boat to see what water was upon the bar (it being 2 hours Ebb), and hove up the Anchor in order to put to Sea; but upon the return of the Boat came too again, as there were only 13 feet water on the Bar, which was 6 Inches less water than what the Ship Draw'd. After this I sent the Yawl to look for Turtle, as those we had got before were nearly all expended. About 8 the Sea breeze set in again, which put an end to our Sailing this day; after which I sent the Pinnace to haul the Sean; she return'd with only 20 pounds of Fish.

Sunday, 29th. The winds were from the Southeast, with a fresh breeze until 5 a.m., when it went calm, and soon after there was a light breeze from the land. Because of this, I sent a boat to check the water level on the bar (it being 2 hours into the ebb), and I weighed anchor to head out to sea; but when the boat returned, we had to anchor again, as there were only 13 feet of water on the bar, which was 6 inches less than the ship's draft. After that, I sent the yawl to look for turtles, since the ones we had caught before were almost all used up. Around 8, the sea breeze returned, which ended our sailing for the day; afterward, I sent the pinnace to haul the seine; it returned with only 20 pounds of fish.

Monday, 30th. Winds at South-East, a fresh Gale and fair weather in the P.M., the remainder Hazey, with rain, but the winds, tho more moderate, keept in the South-East quarter.

Monday, 30th. Winds from the South-East, a strong breeze and clear weather in the afternoon, the rest of the day hazy with rain, but the winds, although lighter, remained in the South-East direction.

Tuesday, 31st. Fresh Gales at South-East, and hazey with rain all P.M. and most part of the Night. At 2 a.m. I had thoughts of trying to Warp the Ship out of the Harbour, but upon my going first out in a Boat I found it blow too fresh for such an Attempt.

Tuesday, 31st. Fresh winds from the southeast, and it was hazy with rain all afternoon and most of the night. At 2 a.m., I considered trying to pull the ship out of the harbor, but when I went out in a boat first, I realized it was too windy for that attempt.

[August 1770.]

[August 1770.]

Wednesday, 1st August. Strong Gales from the South-East, with Squalls attended with Rain. P.M., the Yawl came in with 2 Rays, which together weighed 265 pounds; it blow'd too hard all the time they were out for striking Turtle. Carpenters employ'd overhauling the Pumps, all of which we find in a state of decay; and this the Carpenter says is owing to the Sap having been left in, which in time has decay'd the sound wood. One of them is quite useless, and was so rotten when hoisted up as to drop to peices. However, I cannot complain of a Leaky Ship, for the most water She makes is not quite an Inch an Hour.

Wednesday, August 1st. Strong winds from the southeast, with rain showers. In the afternoon, the yawl came back with 2 rays that weighed a total of 265 pounds; it was too windy the whole time they were out to catch turtles. The carpenters are busy fixing the pumps, all of which we found in pretty bad shape; the carpenter says it’s because the sap was left in, which has caused the good wood to rot over time. One of them is completely useless and was so rotten when we pulled it up that it fell apart. Still, I can’t really complain about leaks in the ship because the most water she takes in is less than an inch an hour.

Thursday, 2nd. Winds and weather as yesterday, or rather more Stormy; we have now no Success in the Sein fishing, hardly getting above 20 or 30 pounds a day.

Thursday, 2nd. Winds and weather are the same as yesterday, or even stormier; we are having no luck with the seine fishing, barely catching 20 or 30 pounds a day.

Friday, 3rd. Strong breezes, and hazey until 6 a.m., when it moderated, and we unmoor'd, hove up the Anchor, and began to Warp out; but the Ship tailing upon the Sand on the North side of the River, the Tide of Ebb making out, and a fresh breeze setting in, we were obliged to desist and moor the Ship again just within the Barr.

Friday, 3rd. Strong winds and hazy until 6 a.m., when it calmed down, and we untied, lifted the anchor, and started to pull out. However, the ship got stuck in the sand on the north side of the river with the outgoing tide and a fresh breeze picking up, so we had to stop and moor the ship again just inside the bar.

Saturday, 4th. In the P.M., having pretty moderate weather, I order'd the Coasting Anchor and Cable to be laid without the barr, to be ready to warp out by, that we might not loose the least opportunity that might Offer; for laying in Port spends time to no purpose, consumes our Provisions, of which we are very Short in many Articles, and we have yet a long Passage to make to the East Indies through an unknown and perhaps dangerous Sea; these Circumstances consider'd, make me very Anxious of getting to Sea. The wind continued moderate all night, and at 5 a.m. it fell calm; this gave us an opportunity to warp out. About 7 we got under sail, having a light Air from the Land, which soon died away, and was Succeeded by the Sea breezes from South-East by South, with which we stood off to Sea East by North, having the Pinnace ahead sounding. The Yawl I sent to the Turtle bank to take up the Net that was left there; but as the wind freshen'd we got out before her, and a little After Noon Anchor'd in 15 fathoms water, Sandy bottom, for I did not think it safe to run in among the Shoals until I had well view'd them at low Water from the Mast head, that I might be better Able to Judge which way to Steer; for as yet I had not resolved whether I should beat back to the Southward round all the Shoals, or seek a Passage to the Eastward or Northward, all of which appeared to be equally difficult and dangerous. When at Anchor the Harbour sail'd from bore South 70 degrees West, distant 4 or 5 Leagues; the Northermost point of the Main land we have in sight, which I named Cape Bedford* (* Probably after John, 4th Duke, who had been First Lord of the Admiralty, 1744 to 1747.) (Latitude 15 degrees 17 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 45 minutes West), bore North 20 degrees West, distant 3 1/2 Leagues; but we could see land to the North-East of this Cape, which made like 2 high Islands;* (* Direction Islands.) the Turtle banks bore East, distant one Mile. Latitude by Observation 15 degrees 23 minutes South; our depth of Water, in standing off from the land, was from 3 1/2 to 15 fathoms.

Saturday, 4th. In the afternoon, with pretty decent weather, I ordered the Coasting Anchor and Cable to be laid outside the bar, so we’d be ready to head out and not miss any opportunity that might come up; because staying in port was just wasting time, using up our supplies, which we were already low on in many items, and we still had a long journey to the East Indies through unknown and possibly dangerous waters. Considering these circumstances made me quite anxious to get to sea. The wind stayed moderate all night, and by 5 a.m. it calmed down. This gave us a chance to leave. Around 7, we set sail, catching a light breeze from the land, which soon faded away, followed by sea breezes from South-East by South, with which we sailed off to sea East by North, with the pinnace ahead sounding. I sent the yawl to the Turtle bank to pick up the net left there; but as the wind picked up, we got out ahead of her and shortly after noon, anchored in 15 fathoms of water, sandy bottom, because I didn’t think it was safe to get too close to the shoals until I had thoroughly surveyed them at low tide from the masthead, so I could determine the best course to steer. I hadn’t yet decided whether to head back south around all the shoals or look for a passage to the east or north, as all options seemed equally difficult and risky. While at anchor, the harbor was at a bearing of South 70 degrees West, about 4 or 5 leagues away; the northernmost point of the mainland we could see, which I named Cape Bedford (* Probably after John, 4th Duke, who had been First Lord of the Admiralty, 1744 to 1747.), (Latitude 15 degrees 17 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 45 minutes West), was at a bearing of North 20 degrees West, about 3.5 leagues away; but we could see land northeast of this cape, appearing as two high islands (* Direction Islands.); the Turtle banks were to the east, about one mile away. The latitude by observation was 15 degrees 23 minutes South; our water depth, as we stood off from the land, ranged from 3.5 to 15 fathoms.

[Description of Endeavour River.]

[Description of Endeavour River.]

I shall now give a Short description of the Harbour, or River, we have been in, which I named after the Ship, Endeavour River. It is only a small Barr Harbour or Creek, which runs winding 3 or 4 Leagues in land, at the Head of which is a small fresh Water Brook, as I was told, for I was not so high myself; but there is not water for Shipping above a Mile within the barr, and this is on the North side, where the bank is so steep for nearly a quarter of a Mile that ships may lay afloat at low water so near the Shore as to reach it with a stage, and is extreamly Convenient for heaving a Ship down. And this is all the River hath to recommend it, especially for large Shipping, for there is no more than 9 or 10 feet Water upon the Bar at low water, and 17 or 18 feet at high, the Tides rises and falling about 9 feet at spring Tide, and is high on the days of the New and full Moon, between 9 and 10 o'Clock. Besides, this part of the Coast is barrocaded with Shoals, as to make this Harbour more difficult of access; the safest way I know of to come at it is from the South, Keeping the Main land close on board all the way. Its situation may always be found by the Latitude, which hath been before mentioned. Over the South point is some high Land, but the North point is formed by a low sandy beach, which extends about 3 Miles to the Northward, then the land is again high.

I will now give a brief description of the harbor, or river, we've been in, which I named after the ship, Endeavour River. It's just a small bar harbor or creek that winds 3 or 4 leagues inland. At the head of it, there's a small freshwater brook, as I was told, since I didn't go that far myself; however, there isn't enough water for shipping more than a mile up the bar. This is on the north side, where the bank is so steep for nearly a quarter of a mile that ships can stay afloat at low tide close to the shore, allowing them to reach it with a platform, making it very convenient for docking a ship. That's all the river has to recommend it, especially for large ships, since there’s only about 9 or 10 feet of water over the bar at low tide and 17 or 18 feet at high tide. The tides rise and fall about 9 feet during spring tides, and it is high on the new and full moon days between 9 and 10 o'clock. In addition, this part of the coast is blocked by shoals, making access to the harbor more difficult. The safest way I know to approach it is from the south, keeping the mainland close all the way. Its location can always be found by the latitude I mentioned earlier. Over the southern point is some high land, but the northern point is formed by a low sandy beach that extends about 3 miles to the north, after which the land rises again.

The refreshments we got here were Chiefly Turtle, but as we had to go 5 Leagues out to Sea for them, and had much blowing weather, we were not over Stocked with this Article; however, what with these and the fish we caught with the Sean we had not much reason to Complain, considering the Country we were in. Whatever refreshment we got that would bear a Division I caused to be equally divided among the whole Company, generally by weight; the meanest person in the Ship had an equal share with myself or any one on board, and this method every commander of a Ship on such a Voyage as this ought ever to Observe. We found in several places on the Sandy beaches and Sand Hills near the Sea, Purslain and beans, which grows on a Creeping kind of a Vine. The first we found very good when boiled, and the latter not to be dispised, and were at first very serviceable to the Sick; but the best greens we found here was the Tarra, or Coco Tops, called in the West Indies Indian Kale,* (* Colocasia Macrorhiza.) which grows in most Boggy Places; these eat as well as, or better, than Spinnage. The roots, for want of being Transplanted and properly Cultivated, were not good, yet we could have dispensed with them could we have got them in any Tolerable plenty; but having a good way to go for them, it took up too much time and too many hands to gather both root and branch. The few Cabage Palms we found here were in General small, and yielded so little Cabage that they were not worth the Looking after, and this was the Case with most of the fruit, etc., we found in the woods.

The snacks we found here were mainly turtle, but since we had to go 5 leagues out to sea for them and battled a lot of windy weather, we didn’t have a lot of this item. However, with these and the fish we caught with the seine, we didn’t have much to complain about, considering where we were. Any food we got that could be shared, I made sure to split equally among the entire crew, usually by weight; the lowest-ranking person on the ship received the same share as I or anyone else on board, and every captain on a voyage like this should always follow this practice. We discovered purslane and beans in several spots on the sandy beaches and dunes near the sea. The purslane was quite tasty when boiled, and the beans were not to be overlooked; they proved very useful for the sick at first. However, the best greens we found were tarra, or coco tops, known in the West Indies as Indian kale, which grows in most boggy areas; these taste as good as, or better than, spinach. The roots, unfortunately, were not good due to not being transplanted or properly cultivated, but we could have made do with them if we could have found them in any reasonable quantity. But since they required a long trek to collect, it took up too much time and too many people to gather both roots and leaves. The few cabbage palms we found here were generally small and produced so little cabbage that they weren’t worth the effort to look after, and this was true for most of the fruit and other items we found in the woods.

Besides the Animals which I have before mentioned, called by the Natives Kangooroo, or Kanguru, here are Wolves,* (* Probably Dingos.) Possums, an Animal like a ratt, and snakes, both of the Venemous and other sorts. Tame Animals here are none except Dogs, and of these we never saw but one, who frequently came about our Tents to pick up bones, etc. The Kanguru are in the greatest number, for we seldom went into the Country without seeing some. The land Fowls we met here, which far from being numerous, were Crows, Kites, Hawkes, Cockadores* (* Cockatoos.) of 2 Sorts, the one white, and the other brown, very beautiful Loryquets of 2 or 3 Sorts, Pidgeons, Doves, and a few other sorts of small Birds. The Sea or Water fowl are Herns, Whisling Ducks, which perch and, I believe, roost on Trees; Curlews, etc., and not many of these neither. Some of our Gentlemen who were in the Country heard and saw Wild Geese in the Night.

Besides the animals I mentioned earlier, called by the natives Kangaroo, here are wolves, probably dingoes. There are also possums, an animal similar to a rat, and snakes, both venomous and non-venomous. The only domesticated animals here are dogs, and we only saw one that frequently came around our tents to scavenge for bones, etc. Kangaroos are the most numerous since we rarely ventured into the countryside without seeing some. The land birds we encountered here were not very many, including crows, kites, hawks, cockatoos—two types, one white and the other brown—very beautiful lorikeets in two or three varieties, pigeons, doves, and a few other small bird species. The sea or waterfowl include herons, whistling ducks, which perch and I believe roost in trees; curlews, etc., and there aren't many of these either. Some of our gentlemen who were in the area heard and saw wild geese at night.

The Country, as far as I could see, is diversified with Hills and plains, and these with woods and Lawns; the Soil of the Hills is hard, dry, and very Stoney; yet it produceth a thin Coarse grass, and some wood. The Soil of the Plains and Valleys are sandy, and in some places Clay, and in many Parts very Rocky and Stoney, as well as the Hills, but in general the Land is pretty well Cloathed with long grass, wood, Shrubs, etc. The whole Country abounds with an immense number of Ant Hills, some of which are 6 or 8 feet high, and more than twice that in Circuit. Here are but few sorts of Trees besides the Gum tree, which is the most numerous, and is the same that we found on the Southern Part of the Coast, only here they do not grow near so large. On each side of the River, all the way up it, are Mangroves, which Extend in some places a Mile from its banks; the Country in general is not badly water'd, there being several fine Rivulets at no very great distance from one another, but none near to the place where we lay; at least not in the Dry season, which is at this time. However we were very well supply'd with water by springs which were not far off.* (* Cooktown, which now stands on the Endeavour River, is a thriving place, and the northernmost town on this coast. It has some 2000 inhabitants, and is the port for a gold mining district. A deeper channel has now been dredged over the bar that gave Cook so much trouble, but it is not a harbour that will admit large vessels.)

The countryside, as far as I could see, is made up of hills and plains, along with woods and lawns. The soil on the hills is hard, dry, and very stony; however, it produces some thin coarse grass and some trees. The soil of the plains and valleys is sandy, with some areas being clay, and many parts are also quite rocky and stony, similar to the hills. In general, the land is mostly covered with long grass, trees, shrubs, and more. The entire area is filled with countless ant hills, some of which are 6 to 8 feet high and more than twice that in circumference. There are only a few kinds of trees here aside from the gum tree, which is the most common and is the same type we found on the southern coast, but they don't grow nearly as large here. On either side of the river, the mangroves stretch in some places up to a mile from the banks; generally, the area has decent water resources, with several nice streams not too far apart from one another, though none are close to where we were camped, at least not during the dry season, which it is now. However, we were well supplied with water from springs that were nearby. * (* Cooktown, which now stands on the Endeavour River, is a thriving place and the northernmost town on this coast. It has around 2000 residents and serves as the port for a gold mining area. A deeper channel has now been created over the bar that caused Cook so much trouble, but it is not a harbor that can accommodate large vessels.)

[At Anchor, Off Turtle Reef, Queensland.]

[At Anchor, Off Turtle Reef, Queensland.]

Sunday, 5th. In the P.M. had a Gentle breeze at South-East and Clear weather. As I did not intend to weigh until the morning I sent all the Boats to the Reef to get what Turtle and Shell fish they could. At low water from the Mast head I took a view of the Shoals, and could see several laying a long way without this one, a part of several of them appearing above water; but as it appear'd pretty clear of Shoals to the North-East of the Turtle Reef, I came to a Resolution to stretch out that way close upon a wind, because if we found no Passage we could always return back the way we went. In the Evening the Boats return'd with one Turtle, a sting ray, and as many large Clams as came to 1 1/2 pounds a Man; in each of these Clams were about 20 pounds of Meat; added to this we Caught in the night several Sharks. Early in the morning I sent the Pinnace and Yawl again to the Reef, as I did not intend to weigh until half Ebb, at which time the Shoals began to appear. Before 8 it came on to blow, and I made the Signal for the Boats to come on Board, which they did, and brought with them one Turtle. We afterwards began to heave, but the wind Freshening obliged us to bear away* (* To veer cable, i.e., pay out more cable, in order to hold the ship with the freshening wind.) again and lay fast.

Sunday, 5th. In the afternoon, there was a gentle breeze from the southeast and clear weather. Since I planned to wait until morning to set sail, I sent all the boats to the reef to collect any turtles and shellfish they could find. At low tide, from the masthead, I looked out over the shoals and saw several that extended far beyond this one, with parts of some visible above the water. Since it seemed fairly clear of shoals to the northeast of the turtle reef, I decided to head in that direction, close to the wind, because if we couldn’t find a passage, we could always turn back the way we came. In the evening, the boats returned with one turtle, a stingray, and enough large clams to provide 1.5 pounds per person; each of these clams contained about 20 pounds of meat. Additionally, we caught several sharks during the night. Early in the morning, I sent the pinnace and yawl back to the reef, as I didn’t plan to set sail until half ebb, when the shoals began to show. Before 8, the wind picked up, and I signaled the boats to come back on board, which they did, bringing one turtle with them. We then started to haul anchor, but the wind became stronger, forcing us to adjust our position again and hold steady.

Monday, 6th. Winds at South-East. At 2 o'Clock p.m. it fell pretty Moderate, and we got under sail, and stood out upon a wind North-East by East, leaving the Turtle Reef to windward, having the Pinnace ahead sounding. We had not stood out long before we discovered shoals ahead and on both bows. At half past 4 o'Clock, having run off 8 Miles, the Pinnace made the Signal for Shoal water in a place where we little Expected it; upon this we Tack'd and Stood on and off while the Pinnace stretched farther to the Eastward, but as night was approaching I thought it safest to Anchor, which we accordingly did in 20 fathoms water, a Muddy bottom. Endeavour River bore South 52 degrees West; Cape Bedford West by North 1/2 North, distant 5 Leagues; the Northermost land in sight, which made like an Island, North; and a Shoal, a small, sandy part of which appear'd above water, North-East, distance 2 or 3 Miles. In standing off from this Turtle Reef to this place our soundings were from 14 to 20 fathoms, but where the Pinnace was, about a Mile farther to the East-North-East, were no more than 4 or 5 feet of water, rocky ground; and yet this did not appear to us in the Ship. In the morning we had a strong Gale from the South-East, that, instead of weighing as we intended, we were obliged to bear away more Cable, and to Strike Top Gallant yards.

Monday, 6th. Winds from the Southeast. At 2 p.m., the wind calmed down a bit, so we set sail and headed out with a northeast by east course, leaving the Turtle Reef to our left, with the Pinnace up ahead checking the depth. We hadn’t been sailing long before we noticed shallow waters ahead and on both sides. At 4:30 p.m., having traveled 8 miles, the Pinnace signaled shoal water in a spot we didn’t expect; so we changed our course and maneuvered while the Pinnace continued eastward, but as night was coming, I thought it was safest to anchor, which we did in 20 fathoms of muddy bottom. Endeavour River lay to the South 52 degrees West; Cape Bedford was West by North 1/2 North, 5 leagues away; the northernmost land in sight looked like an island to the north; and there was a small sandy shoal, part of which was above water, to the northeast, about 2 or 3 miles away. In sailing from this Turtle Reef to this point, our depth ranged from 14 to 20 fathoms, but where the Pinnace was, about a mile further east-northeast, there was only 4 to 5 feet of rocky ground; this didn’t show up from the ship. In the morning, we faced a strong gale from the southeast, and instead of weighing anchor as we planned, we had to let out more cable and lower the top gallant yards.

Tuesday, 7th. Strong Gales at South-East, South-East by South, and South-South-East, with cloudy weather at Low water in the P.M. I and several of the Officers kept a look out at the Mast head to see for a Passage between the Shoals; but we could see nothing but breakers all the way from the South round by the East as far as North-West, extending out to Sea as far as we could see. It did not appear to be one continued Shoal, but several laying detached from each other. On the Eastermost that we could see the Sea broke very high, which made one judge it to be the outermost; for on many of those within the Sea did not break high at all, and from about 1/2 flood to 1/2 Ebb they are not to be seen, which makes the Sailing among them more dangerous, and requires great care and Circumspection, for, like all other Shoals, or Reefs of Coral Rocks, they are quite steep too. Altho' the most of these Shoals consist of Coral Rocks, yet a part of some of them is sand. The Turtle Reef and some others have a small Patch of Sand generally at the North end, that is only cover'd at high water. These generally discover themselves before we come near them. Altho' I speak of this as the Turtle Reef, yet it is not to be doubted but what there are Turtle upon the most of them as well as this one. After having well viewed our situation from the Mast Head, I saw that we were surrounded on every side with Dangers, in so much that I was quite at a loss which way to steer when the weather will permit us to get under sail, for to beat back to the South-East the way we came, as the Master would have had me done, would be an endless peice of work, as the winds blow constantly from that Quarter, and very Strong, without hardly any intermission;* (* The south-east trade wind blows home on this coast very strong from about June to October. Though the Barrier Reef prevents any great sea from getting up, the continuance of this wind is a great nuisance for a sailing ship from many points of view though from others it is an advantage.) on the other hand, if we do not find a passage to the Northward we shall have to come back at last. At 11 the Ship drove, and obliged us to bear away to a Cable and one third, which brought us up again; but in the morning the Gale increasing, she drove again. This made us let go the Small Bower Anchor, and bear away a whole Cable on it and 2 on the other; and even after this she still kept driving slowly, until we had got down Top gallant Masts, struck Yards and Top masts close down, and made all snug; then she rid fast, Cape Bedford bearing West-South-West, distant 3 1/2 Leagues. In this situation we had Shoals to the Eastward of us extending from the South-East by South to the North-North-West, distant from the nearest part of them about 2 Miles.

Tuesday, 7th. Strong winds from the Southeast, Southeast by South, and South-Southeast, with cloudy weather at low tide in the afternoon. I and several officers kept watch at the masthead looking for a passage between the shoals, but there was nothing but breakers all the way from the South around to the East as far as Northwest, extending out to sea as far as we could see. It didn’t seem to be one continuous shoal, but several separate ones. The easternmost one we could see had very high waves breaking, leading us to believe it was the outermost; many of the others didn’t break high at all, and from about halfway up to halfway down the tide, they’re not visible, making sailing among them more dangerous and requiring great care and caution, as they, like all other shoals or coral reefs, are quite steep. Although most of these shoals are made of coral, some parts consist of sand. The Turtle Reef and a few others generally have a small patch of sand at the northern end that’s only covered at high tide. These usually reveal themselves before we get too close. While I refer to this as the Turtle Reef, it’s likely that turtles are on most of the shoals as well. After thoroughly surveying our situation from the masthead, I noticed we were surrounded by dangers, making it difficult to decide which way to steer when the weather allows us to set sail. Heading back Southeast the way we came, as the captain suggested, would be futile since the winds blow constantly from that direction, and very strongly, with hardly any break; (The southeast trade wind blows strongly along this coast from about June to October. Although the Barrier Reef prevents large waves from forming, the persistence of this wind poses problems for sailing ships from various perspectives, though it does have some advantages.) on the other hand, if we can’t find a passage to the North, we’ll end up having to come back. At 11, the ship began to drift, forcing us to let out a cable and a third, which brought us back; but in the morning, as the gale increased, she drifted again. This prompted us to drop the small bower anchor and let out a whole cable on it and two on the other; even after this, she continued to drift slowly until we lowered the top gallant masts, struck the yards and topmasts close down, and made everything secure; then she held steady, with Cape Bedford bearing West-South-West, 3.5 leagues away. In this position, shoals were to the east of us, extending from Southeast by South to North-North-West, about 2 miles from the nearest part.

Wednesday, 8th. Strong gales at South-South-East all this day, in so much that I durst not get up Yards and Topmasts.

Wednesday, 8th. Strong winds from the South-Southeast all day, so I didn't dare to go up the yards and topmasts.

Thursday, 9th. In the P.M., the weather being something moderate, we got up the Top masts, but keept the Lower yards down. At 6 in the morning we began to heave in the Cable, thinking to get under sail; but it blow'd so fresh, together with a head sea, that we could hardly heave the ship a head, and at last was obliged to desist.

Thursday, 9th. In the afternoon, the weather was somewhat mild, so we raised the top masts but kept the lower yards down. At 6 in the morning, we started to haul in the cable, planning to set sail; however, the wind picked up and there was a head sea, making it difficult to get the ship moving forward, and we eventually had to stop.

[Off Cape Flattery, Queensland.]

[Off Cape Flattery, Queensland.]

Friday, 10th. Fresh Gales at South-South-East and South-East by South. P.M., the wind fell so that we got up the small Bower Anchor, and hove into a whole Cable on the Best Bower. At 3 in the morning we got up the Lower Yards, and at 7 weighed and stood in for the Land (intending to seek for a passage along Shore to the northward), having a Boat ahead sounding; depth of water as we run in from 19 to 12 fathoms. After standing in an hour we edged away for 3 Small Islands* (* Now called the Three Isles.) that lay North-North-East 1/2 East, 3 Leagues from Cape Bedford. To these Islands the Master had been in the Pinnace when the Ship was in Port. At 9 we were abreast of them, and between them and the Main, having another low Island between us and the latter, which lies West-North-West, 4 Miles from the 3 Islands. In this Channell had 14 fathoms water; the Northermost point of the Main we had in sight bore from us North-North-West 1/2 West, distant 2 Leagues. 4 or 5 Leagues to the North-East of this head land appeared 3 high Islands,* (* The Direction Islands.) with some smaller ones near them, and the Shoals and Reefs without, as we could see, extending to the Northward as far as these Islands. We directed our Course between them and the above headland, leaving a small Island* (* The Two Isles. Cook had now got among the numerous islands and reefs which lie round Cape Flattery. There are good channels between them, but they are very confusing to a stranger. Cook's anxiety in his situation can well be imagined, especially with his recent disaster in his mind.) to the Eastward of us, which lies North by East, 4 Miles from the 3 Islands, having all the while a boat ahead sounding. At Noon we were got between the head Land and the 3 high Islands, distant from the former 2, and from the latter 4 Leagues; our Latitude by observation was 14 degrees 51 minutes South. We now judged ourselves to be clear of all Danger, having, as we thought, a Clear, open Sea before us; but this we soon found otherwise, and occasioned my calling the Headland above mentioned Cape Flattery (Latitude 14 degrees 55 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 43 minutes West). It is a high Promontory, making in 2 Hills next the sea, and a third behind them, with low sandy land on each side; but it is better known by the 3 high Islands out at Sea, the Northermost of which is the Largest, and lies from the Cape North-North-East, distant 5 Leagues. From this Cape the Main land trends away North-West and North-West by West.

Friday, 10th. Fresh winds from the South-South-East and South-East by South. In the afternoon, the wind died down, so we brought up the small Bower Anchor and set out a whole Cable on the Best Bower. At 3 AM, we raised the Lower Yards, and at 7, we weighed anchor and headed toward the shore (planning to find a passage along the coast to the north), with a boat ahead sounding the water; the depth ranged from 19 to 12 fathoms as we moved in. After an hour, we adjusted our course towards 3 Small Islands* (*Now called the Three Isles.) located North-North-East 1/2 East, 3 leagues from Cape Bedford. The Master had visited these Islands in the Pinnace while the Ship was docked. At 9, we were level with them, and between those Islands and the mainland, we had another low Island between us and the latter, which lies West-North-West, 4 miles from the 3 Islands. In this channel, we found 14 fathoms of water; the northernmost point of the mainland we could see was to our North-North-West 1/2 West, 2 leagues away. 4 or 5 leagues to the Northeast of this headland, we spotted 3 high Islands,* (*The Direction Islands.) with some smaller ones nearby, and we could see shoals and reefs extending northward around these islands. We steered our course between them and the mentioned headland, leaving a small Island* (*The Two Isles. Cook had now entered the many islands and reefs surrounding Cape Flattery. There are navigable channels between them, but they can be quite confusing for someone unfamiliar. Given his recent troubles, Cook's anxiety in this situation is understandable.) to the east of us, which lies North by East, 4 miles from the 3 Islands, continually having a boat ahead sounding the depth. At noon, we found ourselves between the headland and the 3 high Islands, 2 leagues from the former and 4 leagues from the latter; our latitude by observation was 14 degrees 51 minutes South. We believed we were clear of danger, thinking we had an open sea ahead; however, we soon discovered otherwise, leading me to name the headland Cape Flattery (Latitude 14 degrees 55 minutes South, Longitude 214 degrees 43 minutes West). It is a high promontory featuring 2 hills near the sea and a third one behind them, with low sandy land on either side; it's better recognized by the 3 high islands offshore, the northernmost being the largest and positioned to the north-north-east of the Cape, 5 leagues away. From this Cape, the mainland trends off to the North-West and North-West by West.

Saturday, 11th. Fresh breezes at South-South-East and South-East by South, with which we steer'd along shore North-West by West until one o'Clock, when the Petty Officer at the Masthead called out that he saw land ahead, extending quite round to the Islands without, and a large reef between us and them; upon this I went to the Masthead myself. The reef I saw very plain, which was now so far to windward that we could not weather it, but what he took for Main land ahead were only small Islands, for such they appeared to me; but, before I had well got from Mast head the Master and some others went up, who all asserted that it was a Continuation of the Main land, and, to make it still more alarming, they said they saw breakers in a Manner all round us. We immediately hauld upon a wind in for the Land, and made the Signal for the Boat, which was ahead sounding, to come on board; but as she was well to leeward, we were obliged to edge away to take her up, and soon after came to an Anchor under a point of the Main in 1/4 less 5* (* The nautical manner of expressing four and three-quarters.) fathoms, about a Mile from the Shore, Cape Flattery bearing South-East, distant 3 1/2 Leagues. After this I landed, and went upon the point, which is pretty high, from which I had a View of the Sea Coast, which trended away North-West by West, 8 or 10 Leagues, which was as far as I could see, the weather not being very clear. I likewise saw 9 or 10 Small, Low Islands and some Shoals laying off the Coast, and some large Shoals between the Main and the 3 high Islands, without which, I was now well assured, were Islands, and not a part of the Mainland as some had taken them to be. Excepting Cape Flattery and the point I am now upon, which I have named point Lookout, the Main land next the sea to the Northward of Cape Bedford is low, and Chequer'd with white sand and green Bushes, etc., for 10 or 12 Miles inland, beyond which is high land. To the northward of Point Lookout the shore appear'd to be shoal and flat some distance off, which was no good sign of meeting with a Channell in with the land, as we have hitherto done. We saw the footsteps of people upon the sand, and smoke and fire up in the Country, and in the evening return'd on board, where I came to a resolution to visit one of the high Islands in the Offing in my Boat, as they lay at least 5 Leagues out at Sea, and seem'd to be of such a height that from the Top of one of them I hoped to see and find a Passage out to sea clear of the Shoals. Accordingly in the Morning I set out in the Pinnace for the Northermost and largest of the 3, accompanied by Mr. Banks. At the same time I sent the Master in the Yawl to Leeward, to sound between the Low Islands and the Main. In my way to the Island I passed over a large reef of Coral Rocks and sand, which lies about 2 Leagues from the Island; I left another to leeward, which lays about 3 Miles from the Island. [On Lizard Island, Queensland.] On the North part of this is a low, sandy Isle, with Trees upon it; on the reef we pass'd over in the Boat we saw several Turtle, and Chased one or Two, but caught none, it blowing too hard, and I had no time to spare, being otherways employ'd. I did not reach the Island until half an hour after one o'Clock in the P.M. on

Saturday, the 11th. There were fresh breezes coming from the South-South-East and South-East by South, so we navigated along the shore heading North-West by West until one o'clock, when the Petty Officer at the Masthead shouted that he spotted land ahead, extending all the way to the outer Islands, with a large reef between us and them. I decided to check from the Masthead myself. I could clearly see the reef, which was now far enough to windward that we couldn’t sail around it, but what he believed to be mainland ahead were actually just small Islands, or at least that’s what they looked like to me. However, before I could report back from the Masthead, the Master and a few others went up, all claiming that it was a continuation of the mainland. To make matters worse, they said they saw breakers all around us. We quickly tacked towards the land and signaled for the Boat, which was ahead sounding, to come back on board; but since it was well to leeward, we had to steer away to pick her up, and soon after, we anchored under a point of the mainland in 4 and 3/4 fathoms, about a mile from the shore, with Cape Flattery bearing South-East, 3 1/2 leagues away. After that, I landed and climbed up to the point, which was quite elevated, giving me a view of the coastline, stretching away North-West by West for 8 or 10 leagues—this was as far as I could see due to the hazy weather. I also spotted 9 or 10 small, low islands and some shoals off the coast, along with large shoals between the mainland and the 3 high islands, which I was now certain were islands and not part of the mainland as some had thought. Apart from Cape Flattery and the point I was on, which I named Point Lookout, the mainland next to the sea to the north of Cape Bedford was low and marked with white sand and green bushes for about 10 to 12 miles inland, beyond which there were highlands. North of Point Lookout, the shore seemed shallow and flat for some distance out, which didn’t bode well for finding a channel close to the land, as we had previously encountered. We noticed footprints of people on the sand, along with smoke and fire in the interior, and in the evening we returned on board, where I decided to visit one of the high islands offshore in my boat, since they were at least 5 leagues out at sea and looked high enough that I hoped to see and find a passage out to sea clear of the shoals from the top of one of them. So in the morning, I set out in the pinnace for the northernmost and largest of the three islands, accompanied by Mr. Banks. At the same time, I sent the Master in the yawl to leeward to sound between the low islands and the mainland. On my way to the island, I crossed a large reef of coral rocks and sand that lies about 2 leagues from the island; I left another one to leeward, which is about 3 miles from the island. On the northern part of this is a low sandy isle with trees on it; on the reef we passed over in the boat, we saw several turtles and chased one or two, but caught none because it was too windy, and I had no time to waste, being engaged with other matters. I didn’t reach the island until half an hour after one o'clock in the afternoon.

Sunday, 12th, when I immediately went upon the highest hill on the Island,* (* Lizard Island.) where, to my Mortification, I discover'd a Reef of Rocks laying about 2 or 3 Leagues without the Island, extending in a line North-West and South-East, farther than I could see, on which the sea broke very high.* (* This was the outer edge of the Barrier Reefs.) This, however, gave one great hopes that they were the outermost shoals, as I did not doubt but what I should be able to get without them, for there appeared to be several breaks or Partitions in the Reef, and Deep Water between it and the Islands. I stay'd upon the Hill until near sun set, but the weather continued so Hazey all the time that I could not see above 4 or 5 Leagues round me, so that I came down much disappointed in the prospect I expected to have had, but being in hopes the morning might prove Clearer, and give me a better View of the Shoals. With this view I stay'd all night upon the Island, and at 3 in the Morning sent the Pinnace, with one of the Mates I had with me, to sound between the Island and the Reefs, and to Examine one of the breaks or Channels; and in the mean time I went again upon the Hill, where I arrived by Sun Rise, but found it much Hazier than in the Evening. About Noon the pinnace return'd, having been out as far as the Reef, and found from 15 to 28 fathoms water. It blow'd so hard that they durst not venture into one of the Channels, which, the Mate said, seem'd to him to be very narrow; but this did not discourage me, for I thought from the place he was at he must have seen it at disadvantage. Before I quit this Island I shall describe it. It lies, as I have before observed, about 5 Leagues from the Main; it is about 8 Miles in Circuit, and of a height sufficient to be seen 10 or 12 Leagues; it is mostly high land, very rocky and barren, except on the North-West side, where there are some sandy bays and low land, which last is covered with thin, long grass, Trees, etc., the same as upon the Main. Here is also fresh Water in 2 places; the one is a running stream, the water a little brackish where I tasted it, which was close to the sea; the other is a standing pool, close behind the sandy beach, of good, sweet water, as I daresay the other is a little way from the Sea beach. The only land Animals we saw here were Lizards, and these seem'd to be pretty Plenty, which occasioned my naming the Island Lizard Island. The inhabitants of the Main visit this Island at some Seasons of the Year, for we saw the Ruins of Several of their Hutts and heaps of Shells, etc. South-East, 4 or 5 Miles from this Island, lay the other 2 high Islands, which are very small compared to this; and near them lay 3 others, yet smaller and lower Islands, and several Shoals or reefs, especially to the South-East. There is, however, a clear passage from Cape Flattery to those Islands, and even quite out to the outer Reefs, leaving the above Islands to the South-East and Lizard Island to the North-West.

On Sunday, the 12th, I went straight to the highest hill on the Island,* (* Lizard Island.) where, to my disappointment, I discovered a reef of rocks laying about 2 or 3 leagues off the island, stretching in a line from northwest to southeast, as far as I could see, and the sea was crashing heavily against it.* (* This was the outer edge of the Barrier Reefs.) However, this gave me hope that they were the furthest shoals, as I believed I could navigate around them, since there seemed to be several gaps or channels in the reef, and there was deep water between it and the islands. I stayed on the hill until near sunset, but the weather remained so hazy that I could only see about 4 or 5 leagues around me, leaving me feeling quite disappointed in the view I had hoped for. Still, I was optimistic that the morning would be clearer and provide me a better look at the shoals. With that in mind, I spent the night on the island, and at 3 in the morning, I sent a small boat with one of the crew members to take measurements between the island and the reefs, and to explore one of the channels. In the meantime, I went back up the hill, arriving there at sunrise, but found it even hazier than the evening before. Around noon, the small boat returned after reaching the reef, reporting depths of 15 to 28 fathoms. It was blowing so hard that they didn’t dare go into one of the channels, which the crew member thought seemed very narrow; but this didn’t discourage me, as I believed he must have seen it from an unfavorable angle. Before I leave this island, let me describe it. As I mentioned earlier, it's about 5 leagues from the mainland; it's about 8 miles in circumference and tall enough to be seen from 10 to 12 leagues away. Most of it is high land, rocky and barren, except on the northwest side, where there are some sandy bays and low land covered with thin, long grass, trees, and similar vegetation as on the mainland. There are also fresh water sources in two places; one is a running stream, which I found to be slightly brackish near the sea, and the other is a standing pool located just behind the sandy beach, with clear, sweet water, just like the other source a little distance from the beach. The only land animals we spotted here were lizards, and they seemed quite plentiful, which is why I named the island Lizard Island. The people from the mainland visit this island during certain times of the year, as we saw the ruins of several huts and piles of shells, etc. Southeast, about 4 or 5 miles from this island, are two other small, high islands, and near them are three more, even smaller and lower islands, along with several shoals or reefs, particularly to the southeast. However, there is a clear passage from Cape Flattery to those islands and all the way out to the outer reefs, with the aforementioned islands to the southeast and Lizard Island to the northwest.

Monday, 13th. At 2 P.M. I left Lizard Island in order to return to the Ship, and in my way landed upon the low sandy Isle mentioned in coming out. We found on this Island* (* Eagle Island.) a pretty number of Birds, the most of them sea Fowl, except Eagles; 2 of the Latter we shott and some of the others; we likewise saw some Turtles, but got none, for the reasons before mentioned. After leaving Eagle Isle I stood South-West direct for the Ship, sounding all the way, and had not less than 8 fathoms, nor more than 14. I had the same depth of Water between Lizard and Eagle Isle. After I got on board the Master inform'd me he had been down to the Islands I had directed him to go too, which he judged to lay about 3 Leagues from the Main, and had sounded the Channel between the 2, found 7 fathoms; this was near the Islands, for in with the Main he had only 9 feet 3 Miles off, but without the Islands he found 10, 12, and 14 fathoms. He found upon the islands piles of turtle shells, and some finns that were so fresh that both he and the boats' crew eat of them. This showed that the natives must have been there lately. After well considering both what I had seen myself and the report of the Master's, I found by experience that by keeping in with the Mainland we should be in continued danger, besides the risk we should run in being lock'd in with Shoals and reefs by not finding a passage out to Leeward. In case we persever'd in keeping the Shore on board an accident of this kind, or any other that might happen to the ship, would infallibly loose our passage to the East India's this Season,* (* In November the wind changes to the North-West, which would have been a foul wind to Batavia.) and might prove the ruin of both ourselves and the Voyage, as we have now little more than 3 Months' Provisions on board, and that at short allowance. Wherefore, after consulting with the Officers, I resolved to weigh in the morning, and Endeavour to quit the Coast altogether until such time as I found I could approach it with less danger. With this View we got under sail at daylight in the morning, and stood out North-East for the North-West end of Lizard Island, having Eagle Island to windward of us, having the pinnace ahead sounding; and here we found a good Channell, wherein we had from 9 to 14 fathoms. At Noon the North end of Lizard Island bore East-South-East, distant one Mile; Latitude observed 14 degrees 38 minutes South; depth of water 14 fathoms. We now took the pinnace in tow, knowing that there were no dangers until we got out to the Reefs.* (* From the 13th to the 19th the language used in Mr. Corner's copy of the Journal is quite different from that of the Admiralty and the Queen's, though the occurrences are the same. From internal evidences, it appears that Mr. Corner's copy was at this period the first written up, and that Cook amended the phrases in the other fair copies.)

Monday, 13th. At 2 PM, I left Lizard Island to return to the Ship. On my way, I landed on the low sandy Isle I mentioned when coming out. On this Island* (* Eagle Island.) we found quite a few Birds, mostly sea Fowl, except for Eagles; we shot 2 of the latter and some of the others. We also saw some Turtles, but couldn’t catch any for the reasons I mentioned before. After leaving Eagle Isle, I headed South-West directly towards the Ship, taking soundings all the way and had no less than 8 fathoms and no more than 14. I recorded the same depth of water between Lizard and Eagle Isle. When I got on board, the Captain informed me he had gone down to the Islands I directed him to, which he estimated to be about 3 Leagues from the Mainland, and he had sounded the Channel between the two, finding 7 fathoms; this was near the Islands since he found only 9 feet 3 Miles off the Mainland, but outside the Islands he found 10, 12, and 14 fathoms. He discovered piles of turtle shells on the islands, and some fins that were so fresh that both he and the crew ate some. This indicated that the natives must have been there recently. After considering both what I had observed myself and the Captain's report, I realized from experience that staying close to the Mainland would put us in constant danger. There was a risk of getting trapped by shoals and reefs without finding a way out to Leeward. If we continued to stay close to shore, any accident, including encountering such hazards, could cost us our passage to the East Indies this Season,* (* In November, the wind shifts to the North-West, which would have been a headwind to Batavia.) possibly jeopardizing both our safety and the Voyage, especially since we had just over 3 Months' worth of provisions on board, and that at short rations. Therefore, after consulting with the Officers, I decided to set sail in the morning and aim to leave the Coast entirely until I found it safer to approach. With that in mind, we got under sail at dawn the next morning, heading out North-East towards the North-West end of Lizard Island, with Eagle Island upwind of us and the pinnace ahead sounding; here we found a good channel where we had from 9 to 14 fathoms. At noon, the North end of Lizard Island was East-South-East, one mile away; the Latitude observed was 14 degrees 38 minutes South; the depth of water was 14 fathoms. We then towed the pinnace, knowing that there were no dangers until we reached the Reefs.* (* From the 13th to the 19th, the language used in Mr. Corner's copy of the Journal is quite different from that of the Admiralty and the Queen's, though the occurrences are the same. From internal evidence, it appears that Mr. Corner's copy was the first written up at this time, and that Cook amended the language in the other fair copies.)

[Pass Outside Barrier Reef, Queensland.]

[Pass Outside Great Barrier Reef, Queensland.]

Tuesday, 14th. Winds at South-East, a steady gale. By 2 P.M. we got out to the outermost reefs, and just fetched to Windward of one of the openings I had discover'd from the Island; we tacked and Made a short trip to the South-West, while the Master went in the pinnace to examine the Channel, who soon made the signal for the Ship to follow, which we accordingly did, and in a short time got safe out. This Channel* (* Now known as Cook's Passage.) lies North-East 1/2 North, 3 Leagues from Lizard Island; it is about one-third of a Mile broad, and 25 or 30 fathoms deep or more. The moment we were without the breakers we had no ground with 100 fathoms of Line, and found a large Sea rowling in from the South-East. By this I was well assured we were got with out all the Shoals, which gave us no small joy, after having been intangled among Islands and Shoals, more or less, ever since the 26th of May, in which time we have sail'd above 360 Leagues by the Lead without ever having a Leadsman out of the Chains, when the ship was under sail; a Circumstance that perhaps never hapned to any ship before, and yet it was here absolutely necessary. I should have been very happy to have had it in my power to have keept in with the land, in order to have explor'd the Coast to the Northern extremity of the Country, which I think we were not far off, for I firmly believe this land doth not join to New Guinea. But this I hope soon either to prove or disprove, and the reasons I have before assign'd will, I presume, be thought sufficient for my leaving the Coast at this time; not but what I intend to get in with it again as soon as I can do it with safety. The passage or channel we now came out by, which I have named, ----* (* Blank in MS.) lies in the Latitude of 14 degrees 32 minutes South; it may always be found and known by the 3 high Islands within it, which I have called the Islands of Direction, because by their means a safe passage may be found even by strangers in within the Main reef, and quite into the Main. Lizard Island, which is the Northermost and Largest of the 3, Affords snug Anchorage under the North-West side of it, fresh water and wood for fuel; and the low Islands and Reefs which lay between it and the Main, abound with Turtle and other fish, which may be caught at all Seasons of the Year (except in such blowing weather as we have lately had). All these things considered there is, perhaps, not a better place on the whole Coast for a Ship to refresh at than this Island. I had forgot to mention in its proper place, that not only on this Island, but on Eagle Island, and on several places of the Sea beach in and about Endeavour River, we found Bamboos, Cocoa Nutts, the seeds of some few other plants, and Pummice-stones, which were not the produce of the Country. From what we have seen of it, it is reasonable to suppose that they are the produce of some lands or Islands laying in the Neighbourhood, most likely to the Eastward, and are brought hither by the Easterly trade winds. The Islands discover'd by Quiros lies in this parrallel, but how far to the Eastward it's hard to say; for altho' we found in most Charts his discoveries placed as far to the West as this country yet from the account of his Voyage, compared with what we ourselves have seen, we are Morally certain that he never was upon any part of this Coast.* (* The Island of Espiritu Santo, in the New Hebrides, which Quiros discovered, lies 1200 miles to the eastward, and New Caledonia, from which these objects might equally have come, is 1000 miles in the same direction.) As soon as we had got without the Reefs we Shortened sail, and hoisted in the pinnace and Long boat, which last we had hung alongside, and then stretched off East-North-East, close upon a wind, as I did not care to stand to the Northward until we had a whole day before us, for which reason we keept making short boards all night. The large hollow sea we have now got into acquaints us with a Circumstance we did not before know, which is that the Ship hath received more Damage than we were aware of, or could perceive when in smooth Water; for now she makes as much water as one pump will free, kept constantly at work. However this was looked upon as trifling to the Danger we had lately made an Escape from. At day light in the morning Lizard Island bore South by West, distant 10 Leagues. We now made all the sail we could, and stood away North-North-West 1/2 West, but at 9 we steer'd North-West 1/2 North, having the advantage of a Fresh Gale at South-East; at Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 13 degrees 46 minutes South, the Lizard Island bore South 15 degrees East, distant 58 Miles, but we had no land in sight.

Tuesday, 14th. Winds from the South-East, a steady gale. By 2 P.M., we reached the outermost reefs and got to windward of one of the openings I had discovered from the island. We tacked and made a short trip to the South-West, while the captain took the pinnace to check the channel. He soon signaled for the ship to follow, which we did, and shortly after, we got safely out. This channel (*Now known as Cook's Passage.) is located North-East 1/2 North, 3 leagues from Lizard Island; it’s about one-third of a mile wide and 25 to 30 fathoms deep or more. Once we were clear of the breakers, we had no ground with 100 fathoms of line and encountered a large sea rolling in from the South-East. This confirmed that we had bypassed all the shoals, which brought us great relief after being entangled among islands and shoals for the past few weeks. Since May 26th, we have sailed over 360 leagues without using the leadsman while the ship was under sail—something that probably has never happened to any ship before, but it was necessary here. I would have been very happy to have stayed close to land to explore the coast to the northern end of the country, which I believe we were very close to, as I strongly suspect this land doesn't connect to New Guinea. I hope to prove or disprove this soon, and the reasons I mentioned earlier should suffice for leaving the coast at this time; still, I plan to return as soon as it's safe. The passage we just used, which I’ve named, ---- (*Blank in MS.) is at the Latitude of 14 degrees 32 minutes South; it can always be recognized by the three high islands within it, which I’ve called the Islands of Direction, because they help find a safe passage even for newcomers along the main reef and right into the main waters. Lizard Island, the northernmost and largest of the three, offers good anchorage on its north-west side, along with fresh water and wood for fuel. The low islands and reefs between it and the mainland are full of turtles and other fish that can be caught all year round (except during rough weather like we’ve just experienced). Considering all this, there might not be a better place along the coast for a ship to rest than this island. I forgot to mention earlier that not only on this island, but also on Eagle Island and several beaches around Endeavour River, we found bamboos, coconuts, some seeds of other plants, and pumice stones that aren't native to the area. From what we've observed, it's reasonable to assume they came from some nearby lands or islands, likely to the east, carried here by the easterly trade winds. The islands discovered by Quiros are in this parallel, but it's hard to determine how far east; even though most charts place his discoveries as far west as this country, the accounts of his voyage, compared to what we've seen ourselves, make it almost certain he never visited any part of this coast.* (*The island of Espiritu Santo, in the New Hebrides, discovered by Quiros, is 1200 miles east, and New Caledonia, from which these items might have equally come, is 1000 miles in the same direction.) As soon as we cleared the reefs, we shortened sail and hoisted in the pinnace and longboat, which we'd had alongside, then headed off East-North-East, close to the wind, as I didn't want to head north until we had a full day ahead, so we kept making short boards all night. The large, rolling sea we’ve entered now reveals damage to the ship we hadn’t noticed before when we were in smooth water; it now takes as much water as one pump can handle continuously. However, this was considered minor compared to the danger we had recently escaped. At daybreak, Lizard Island was to the South by West, 10 leagues away. We set all sail and headed North-North-West 1/2 West, but at 9 we changed course to North-West 1/2 North, taking advantage of a fresh gale from the South-East; at noon, by observation, we were at the Latitude of 13 degrees 46 minutes South, with Lizard Island bearing South 15 degrees East, 58 miles away, but we had no land in sight.

Wednesday, 15th. Fresh Trade at South-East and Clear weather. At 6 in the evening shortned sail and brought too, with her head to the North-East. By this time we had run near 12 Leagues upon a North-West 1/2 North Course since Noon. At 4 a.m. wore and lay her head to the South-West, and at 6 made all Sail, and steer'd West, in order to make the land, being fearful of over shooting the passage, supposing there to be one, between this land and New Guinea. By noon we had run 10 Leagues upon this Course, but saw no land. Our Latitude by observation was 13 degrees 2 minutes South, Longitude 216 degrees 00 minutes West, which was 1 degree 23 minutes to the West of Lizard Island.

Wednesday, 15th. Fresh winds from the southeast and clear weather. At 6 in the evening, we reduced our sail and stopped, pointing our bow to the northeast. By this time, we had traveled nearly 12 leagues on a northwest by north course since noon. At 4 a.m., we changed course to the southwest, and at 6, we set all sails and headed west to reach the land, worried we might miss the passage that we thought was between this land and New Guinea. By noon, we had traveled 10 leagues in this direction, but we saw no land. Our latitude by observation was 13 degrees 2 minutes south, and our longitude was 216 degrees 00 minutes west, which was 1 degree 23 minutes west of Lizard Island.

[Ship in Danger, Outside Barrier Reef.]

[Ship in Danger, Outside Barrier Reef.]

Thursday, 16th. Moderate breezes at East-South-East and fair weather. A little after Noon saw the Land from the Mast head bearing West-South-West, making high; at 2 saw more land to the North-West of the former, making in hills like Islands; but we took it to be a Continuation of the Main land. An hour after this we saw a reef, between us and the land, extending away to the Southward, and, as we thought, terminated here to the Northward abreast of us; but this was only on op'ning, for soon after we saw it extend away to the Northward as far as we could distinguish anything. Upon this we hauld close upon a Wind, which was now at East-South-East, with all the sail we could set. We had hardly trimm'd our sails before the wind came to East by North, which made our weathering the Reef very doubtful, the Northern point of which in sight at sun set still bore from us North by West, distant about 2 Leagues. However, this being the best Tack to Clear it, we keept standing to the Northward, keeping a good look out until 12 at night, when, fearing to run too far upon one Course, we tack'd and stood to the southward, having run 6 Leagues North or North by East since sun set; we had not stood above 2 Miles to the South-South-East before it fell quite Calm. We both sounded now and several times before, but had not bottom with 140 fathoms of line.* (* The description which follows, of the situation of the ship, and the occurrences until she was safely anchored inside the Barrier Reef, is from the Admiralty copy, as it is much fuller than that in Mr. Corner's.) A little after 4 o'clock the roaring of the surf was plainly heard, and at daybreak the Vast foaming breakers were too plainly to be seen not a mile from us, towards which we found the ship was carried by the Waves surprisingly fast. We had at this time not an air of Wind, and the depth of water was unfathomable, so that there was not a possibility of anchoring. In this distressed Situation we had nothing but Providence and the small Assistance the Boats could give us to trust to; the Pinnace was under repair, and could not immediately be hoisted out. The Yawl was put in the Water, and the Longboat hoisted out, and both sent ahead to tow, which, together with the help of our sweeps abaft, got the Ship's head round to the Northward, which seemed to be the best way to keep her off the Reef, or at least to delay time. Before this was effected it was 6 o'clock, and we were not above 80 or 100 yards from the breakers. The same sea that washed the side of the ship rose in a breaker prodidgiously high the very next time it did rise, so that between us and destruction was only a dismal Valley, the breadth of one wave, and even now no ground could be felt with 120 fathom. The Pinnace was by this time patched up, and hoisted out and sent ahead to Tow. Still we had hardly any hopes of saving the ship, and full as little our lives, as we were full 10 Leagues from the nearest Land, and the boats not sufficient to carry the whole of us; yet in this Truly Terrible Situation not one man ceased to do his utmost, and that with as much Calmness as if no danger had been near. All the dangers we had escaped were little in comparison of being thrown upon this reef, where the Ship must be dashed to pieces in a Moment. A reef such as one speaks of here is Scarcely known in Europe. It is a Wall of Coral Rock rising almost perpendicular out of the unfathomable Ocean, always overflown at high Water generally 7 or 8 feet, and dry in places at Low Water. The Large Waves of the Vast Ocean meeting with so sudden a resistance makes a most Terrible Surf, breaking Mountains high, especially as in our case, when the General Trade Wind blows directly upon it. At this Critical juncture, when all our endeavours seemed too little, a Small Air of Wind sprung up, but so small that at any other Time in a Calm we should not have observed it. With this, and the Assistance of our Boats, we could observe the Ship to move off from the Reef in a slanting direction; but in less than 10 Minutes we had as flat a Calm as ever, when our fears were again renewed, for as yet we were not above 200 Yards from the Breakers. Soon after our friendly Breeze visited us again, and lasted about as long as before. A Small Opening was now Seen in the Reef about a 1/4 of a Mile from us, which I sent one of the Mates to Examine. Its breadth was not more than the Length of the Ship, but within was Smooth Water. Into this place it was resolved to Push her if Possible, having no other Probable Views to save her, for we were still in the very Jaws of distruction, and it was a doubt wether or no we could reach this Opening. However, we soon got off it, when to our Surprise we found the Tide of Ebb gushing out like a Mill Stream, so that it was impossible to get in. We however took all the Advantage Possible of it, and it Carried us out about a 1/4 of a Mile from the breakers; but it was too Narrow for us to keep in long. However, what with the help of this Ebb, and our Boats, we by Noon had got an Offing of 1 1/2 or 2 Miles, yet we could hardly flatter ourselves with hopes of getting Clear, even if a breeze should Spring up, as we were by this time embay'd by the Reef, and the Ship, in Spite of our Endeavours, driving before the Sea into the bight. The Ebb had been in our favour, and we had reason to Suppose the flood which was now made would be against us. The only hopes we had was another Opening we saw about a Mile to the Westward of us, which I sent Lieutenant Hicks in the Small Boat to Examine. Latitude observed 12 degrees 37 minutes South, the Main Land in Sight distant about 10 Leagues.

Thursday, 16th. Moderate breezes from the East-South-East and clear weather. A little after noon, I spotted land from the masthead bearing West-South-West, appearing high; at 2 o'clock, I saw more land to the North-West of the previous sight, rising in hills like islands, but we believed it to be a continuation of the mainland. An hour later, we noticed a reef between us and the land, extending to the south, which we believed ended to the north of us. However, as we looked closer, we saw it stretch northward as far as we could see. We then headed into the wind, which was now from the East-South-East, with all the sail we could set. We had barely trimmed our sails before the wind shifted to East by North, making it uncertain whether we could navigate around the reef, the northern point of which was still in sight at sunset, about 2 leagues away from us. Still, since this was the best tack to clear it, we kept heading north, staying vigilant until midnight. Fearing we might drift too far on one course, we tacked and headed southward, having traveled 6 leagues north since sunset. We had not gone more than 2 miles to the South-South-East when it calmed completely. We both sounded the depths several times but found no bottom with 140 fathoms of line.* (* The following description of the ship's situation and events until she was safely anchored inside the Barrier Reef is from the Admiralty copy, which is much more detailed than Mr. Corner's.) A little after 4 o'clock, the roar of the surf was clearly audible, and at daybreak, the massive foaming breakers were clearly visible less than a mile away. At that time, the waves were pushing the ship ahead surprisingly fast. We had no wind, and the depth of water was immeasurable, so anchoring was impossible. In this distressing situation, we had no choice but to rely on Providence and the small assistance our boats could provide; the pinnace was under repair and couldn’t be launched immediately. The yawl was put in the water, and the longboat was launched, both sent ahead to tow us, which, along with our sweeps at the stern, turned the ship's head northward, which seemed the best way to keep her off the reef or at least buy some time. Before we accomplished this, it was 6 o'clock, and we were only 80 or 100 yards from the breakers. The same sea that washed against the side of the ship rose in an incredibly high breaker the next time it surged, so that between us and destruction was just a dismal valley the width of a wave, and still, we felt no ground with 120 fathoms of line. By then, the pinnace had been patched up, launched, and sent ahead to tow. Still, we hardly had any hope of saving the ship and even less for our lives, as we were a full 10 leagues from the nearest land, and the boats weren’t enough to carry us all. Yet in this truly terrifying situation, not one man stopped doing his best, and he did it with as much calmness as if no danger were near. All the perils we had escaped were minor compared to the threat of hitting this reef, where the ship would be smashed to pieces in an instant. A reef like this is barely known in Europe. It is a wall of coral rock rising almost straight out of the unfathomable ocean, always submerged at high water, generally 7 or 8 feet deep, and dry in places at low water. The large waves of the vast ocean meeting such a sudden obstacle create a terrible surf, breaking as high as mountains, especially when, as in our case, the general trade wind blows directly against it. At this critical moment, when all our efforts seemed insufficient, a slight breeze picked up, but it was so light that we wouldn’t have noticed it during a calm. With this, and the help of our boats, we saw the ship moving away from the reef at a diagonal. But within 10 minutes, we were back in a flat calm, and our fears returned since we were still only about 200 yards from the breakers. Soon after, our friendly breeze returned and lasted about as long as before. A small opening was now visible in the reef about a quarter mile away, which I sent one of the mates to investigate. Its width was no more than the length of the ship, but inside, the water was smooth. We decided to try to push her in there if possible, having no other options for saving her, because we were still in immediate danger, and it was uncertain whether we could reach this opening. However, we managed to get past it when to our surprise, we found the ebb tide rushing out like a mill stream, making it impossible to enter. We took all possible advantage of it, and it carried us about a quarter mile away from the breakers, but it was too narrow for us to stay in long. Nevertheless, thanks to this ebb and our boats, by noon we had gotten about 1.5 to 2 miles off; still, we could hardly feel hopeful about getting clear, even if a breeze picked up, since we were by then trapped by the reef, and the ship, despite our efforts, was being pushed before the sea into the bight. The ebb tide had worked in our favor, and we had reason to believe the incoming flood tide would be against us. Our only hope was another opening we saw about a mile west, which I sent Lieutenant Hicks in the small boat to check out. Latitude observed 12 degrees 37 minutes South, the mainland in sight about 10 leagues away.

[Pass Again Inside Barrier Reef.]

[Pass Again Inside Great Barrier Reef.]

Friday, 17th. While Mr. Hicks was Examining the opening we struggled hard with the flood, sometime gaining a little and at other times loosing. At 2 o'Clock Mr. Hicks returned with a favourable Account of the Opening. It was immediately resolved to Try to secure the Ship in it. Narrow and dangerous as it was, it seemed to be the only means we had of saving her, as well as ourselves. A light breeze soon after sprung up at East-North-East, with which, the help of our Boats, and a Flood Tide, we soon entered the Opening, and was hurried thro' in a short time by a Rappid Tide like a Mill race, which kept us from driving against either side, though the Channel was not more than a 1/4 of a Mile broad, having 2 Boats ahead of us sounding.* (* This picture of the narrow escape from total shipwreck is very graphic. Many a ship has been lost under similar circumstances, without any idea of anchoring, which would often save a vessel, as it is not often that a reef is so absolutely steep; but that Cook had this possibility in his mind is clear. As a proof of the calmness which prevailed on board, it may be mentioned that when in the height of the danger, Mr. Green, Mr. Clerke, and Mr. Forwood the gunner, were engaged in taking a Lunar, to obtain the longitude. The note in Mr. Green's log is: "These observations were very good, the limbs of sun and moon very distinct, and a good horizon. We were about 100 yards from the reef, where we expected the ship to strike every minute, it being calm, no soundings, and the swell heaving us right on.") Our deepth of water was from 30 to 7 fathoms; very irregular soundings and foul ground until we had got quite within the Reef, where we Anchor'd in 19 fathoms, a Coral and Shelly bottom. The Channel we came in by, which I have named Providential Channell, bore East-North-East, distant 10 or 12 Miles, being about 8 or 9 Leagues from the Main land, which extended from North 66 degrees West to South-West by South.

Friday, 17th. While Mr. Hicks was checking the opening, we fought hard against the flood, sometimes making a bit of progress and other times losing ground. At 2 o'clock, Mr. Hicks returned with good news about the opening. It was immediately decided to try to secure the ship there. Narrow and dangerous as it was, it seemed to be our only means of saving her and ourselves. A light breeze soon picked up from the East-North-East, and with the help of our boats and the flood tide, we quickly entered the opening, rushing through it in no time, propelled by a strong current like a mill race, which kept us from crashing into either side, even though the channel was no more than a quarter of a mile wide, with two boats ahead of us measuring the depth. (* This description of the narrow escape from total shipwreck is very vivid. Many ships have been lost under similar circumstances, without any plan for anchoring, which often could save a vessel, as it's not common for a reef to be so steep. But it’s clear that Cook had this possibility in mind. As proof of the calm that existed on board, it can be noted that in the height of the danger, Mr. Green, Mr. Clerke, and Mr. Forwood, the gunner, were busy taking a lunar measurement to determine the longitude. The note in Mr. Green's log states: "These observations were very good, the limbs of the sun and moon very distinct, and a clear horizon. We were about 100 yards from the reef, where we expected the ship to hit every minute; it was calm, there were no soundings, and the swell was pushing us right toward it.") Our depth of water ranged from 30 to 7 fathoms; the soundings were very irregular and there was foul ground until we were well inside the reef, where we anchored in 19 fathoms on a coral and shelly bottom. The channel we came through, which I have named Providential Channel, extended East-North-East, about 10 or 12 miles away, approximately 8 or 9 leagues from the mainland, which stretched from North 66 degrees West to South-West by South.

It is but a few days ago that I rejoiced at having got without the Reef; but that joy was nothing when Compared to what I now felt at being safe at an Anchor within it. Such are the Visissitudes attending this kind of Service, and must always attend an unknown Navigation where one steers wholy in the dark without any manner of Guide whatever. Was it not from the pleasure which Naturly results to a man from his being the first discoverer, even was it nothing more than Land or Shoals, this kind of Service would be insupportable, especially in far distant parts like this, Short of Provisions and almost every other necessary. People will hardly admit of an excuse for a Man leaving a Coast unexplored he has once discovered. If dangers are his excuse, he is then charged with Timerousness and want of Perseverance, and at once pronounced to be the most unfit man in the world to be employ'd as a discoverer; if, on the other hand, he boldly encounters all the dangers and Obstacles he meets with, and is unfortunate enough not to succeed, he is then Charged with Temerity, and, perhaps, want of Conduct. The former of these Aspersions, I am confident, can never be laid to my Charge, and if I am fortunate to Surmount all the Dangers we meet with, the latter will never be brought in Question; altho' I must own that I have engaged more among the Islands and Shoals upon this Coast than perhaps in prudence I ought to have done with a single Ship* (* Cook was so impressed with the danger of one ship alone being engaged in these explorations, that in his subsequent voyages he asked for, and obtained, two vessels.) and every other thing considered. But if I had not I should not have been able to give any better account of the one half of it than if I had never seen it; at best, I should not have been able to say wether it was Mainland or Islands; and as to its produce, that we should have been totally ignorant of as being inseparable with the other; and in this case it would have been far more satisfaction to me never to have discover'd it. But it is time I should have done with this Subject, which at best is but disagreeable, and which I was lead into on reflecting on our late Dangers.

Just a few days ago, I was thrilled to have made it past the Reef; but that joy was nothing compared to how I feel now being securely anchored within it. Such are the ups and downs that come with this kind of work, and they will always be present in unknown navigation where one has to steer completely in the dark without any guide at all. If it weren't for the satisfaction that naturally comes to a person from being the first to discover something, even if it’s just land or shoals, this kind of work would be unbearable, especially in remote places like this, low on supplies and nearly every other essential. People rarely accept an excuse for someone leaving unexplored territory they’ve once discovered. If danger is the excuse, then they are accused of being cowardly and lacking perseverance, and are instantly deemed the least suitable person to be a discoverer. Conversely, if someone boldly faces all the dangers and obstacles they encounter but unfortunately fails, they are then blamed for recklessness and possibly poor judgment. I’m confident that the first accusation can never be directed at me, and if I’m lucky enough to overcome all the dangers we come across, the second will never be questioned; although I have to admit that I’ve taken on more risks among the islands and shoals along this coast than I probably should have with just one ship (*Cook was so aware of the dangers of using a single ship for these explorations that he requested, and got, two vessels on his later voyages.) given all other considerations. But if I hadn’t, I wouldn’t have been able to provide a better account of even half of it than if I had never seen it; at best, I would have been unable to determine whether it was mainland or islands; and as for its resources, we would have been completely ignorant, as they are tied to the rest. In that case, it would have been much more satisfying for me to never have discovered it at all. But it’s time I move on from this topic, which is at best unpleasant, and which I was led to reflect on due to our recent dangers.

In the P.M., as the wind would not permit us to sail out by the same Channel as we came in, neither did I care to move until the pinnace was in better repair, I sent the Master with all the other Boats to the Reef to get such refreshments as he could find, and in the meantime the Carpenters were repairing the pinnace. Variations by the Amplitude and Azimuth in the morning 4 degrees 9 minutes Easterly; at noon Latitude observed 12 degrees 38 minutes South, Longitude in 216 degrees 45 minutes West. It being now about low water, I and some other of the officers went to the Masthead to see what we could discover. Great part of the reef without us was dry, and we could see an Opening in it about two Leagues farther to the South-East than the one we came in by; we likewise saw 2 large spots of sand to the Southward within the Reef, but could see nothing to the Northward between it and the Main. On the Mainland within us was a pretty high promontary, which I called Cape Weymouth (Latitude 12 degrees 42 minutes South, Longitude 217 degrees 15 minutes); and on the North-West side of this Cape is a Bay, which I called Weymouth Bay.* (* Viscount Weymouth was one of the Secretaries of State when the Endeavour sailed.)

In the afternoon, since the wind wouldn’t let us sail out through the same channel we came in, and I didn’t want to move until the pinnace was in better shape, I sent the Master with all the other boats to the reef to find some supplies. Meanwhile, the carpenters were fixing the pinnace. In the morning, the compass variations by amplitude and azimuth were 4 degrees 9 minutes east; at noon, we observed the latitude at 12 degrees 38 minutes south, and the longitude at 216 degrees 45 minutes west. With low tide now, some of the officers and I went up to the masthead to see what we could find. A large portion of the reef outside was dry, and we spotted an opening about two leagues further southeast than the one we’d entered. We also noticed two large sandy spots to the south within the reef, but nothing to the north between it and the mainland. On the mainland, we saw a pretty high promontory, which I named Cape Weymouth (latitude 12 degrees 42 minutes south, longitude 217 degrees 15 minutes); northwest of this cape is a bay that I called Weymouth Bay.* (* Viscount Weymouth was one of the Secretaries of State when the Endeavour sailed.)

Saturday, 18th. Gentle breezes at East and East-South-East. At 4 P.M. the Boats return'd from the Reef with about 240 pounds of Shell-fish, being the Meat of large Cockles, exclusive of the Shells. Some of these Cockles are as large as 2 Men can move, and contain about 20 pounds of Meat, very good. At 6 in the morning we got under sail, and stood away to the North-West, as we could not expect a wind to get out to Sea by the same Channel as we came in without waiting perhaps a long time for it, nor was it advisable at this time to go without the Shoals, least we should by them be carried so far off the Coast as not to be able to determine wether or no New Guinea joins to or makes a part of this land. This doubtful point I had from my first coming upon the Coast, determined, if Possible, to clear up; I now came to a fix'd resolution to keep the Main land on board, let the Consequence be what it will, and in this all the Officers concur'd. In standing to the North-West we met with very irregular soundings, from 10 to 27 fathoms, varying 5 or 6 fathoms almost every Cast of the Lead. However, we keept on having a Boat ahead sounding. A little before noon we passed a low, small, sandy Isle, which we left on our Starboard side at the distance of 2 Miles. At the same time we saw others, being part of large Shoals above water, away to the North-East and between us and the Main land. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 12 degrees 28 minutes South, and 4 or 5 Leagues from the Main, which extended from South by West to North 71 degrees West, and some Small Islands extending from North 40 degrees West to North 54 degrees West, the Main or outer Reef seen from the Masthead away to the North-East.

Saturday, 18th. Light breezes from the East and East-Southeast. At 4 PM, the boats returned from the reef with about 240 pounds of shellfish, which is the meat from large cockles, not including the shells. Some of these cockles are so big that two people can barely lift them and contain about 20 pounds of really good meat. At 6 AM, we set sail and headed Northwest, since we couldn't expect any wind to help us get out to sea through the same channel we came in, without possibly waiting a long time. It also didn’t seem wise to go outside the shoals at this time, for fear they might carry us too far off the coast, making it impossible to determine whether New Guinea is connected to or part of this land. I had been determined to clarify this uncertain point since my first arrival along the coast. I now firmly resolved to keep the mainland close, regardless of the consequences, and all the officers agreed. As we headed Northwest, we encountered very irregular depths, ranging from 10 to 27 fathoms, varying by 5 or 6 fathoms nearly every time we cast the lead. Nevertheless, we continued on with a boat ahead sounding the depths. A little before noon, we passed a low, small sandy island, leaving it about 2 miles to our starboard side. At the same time, we saw other islands, part of large shoals above water, to the Northeast, positioned between us and the mainland. At noon, we were by observation at a latitude of 12 degrees 28 minutes South, about 4 or 5 leagues from the mainland, which stretched from South by West to North 71 degrees West, with some small islands extending from North 40 degrees West to North 54 degrees West, and the main outer reef visible from the masthead to the Northeast.

[Amongst Shoals off Cape Grenville.]

[Among Shoals off Cape Grenville.]

Sunday, 19th. Gentle breezes at South-East by East and Clear wether. At 2 P.M., as we were steering North-West by North, saw a large shoal right ahead, extending 3 or 4 points on each bow, upon which we hauld up North-North-East and North-East by North, in order to get round to North Point of it, which we reached by 4 o'clock, and then Edged away to the westward, and run between the North end of this Shoal and another, which lays 2 miles to the Northward of it, having a Boat all the time ahead sounding. Our depth of Water was very irregular, from 22 to 8 fathoms. At 1/2 past 6 we Anchor'd in 13 fathoms; the Northermost of the Small Islands mentioned at Noon bore West 1/2 South, distant 3 Miles. These Islands, which are known in the Chart by the name of Forbes's Isles,* (* Admiral John Forbes was a Commissioner of Longitude in 1768, and had been a Lord of the Admiralty from 1756 to 1763.) lay about 5 Leagues from the Main, which here forms a moderate high point, which we called Bolt head, from which the Land trends more westerly, and is all low, sandy Land, but to the Southward it is high and hilly, even near the Sea. At 6 A.M. we got under sail, and directed our Course for an Island which lay but a little way from the Main, and bore from us at this time North 40 degrees West, distant 5 Leagues; but we were soon interrupted in our Course by meeting with Shoals, but by the help of 2 Boats ahead and a good lookout at the Mast head we got at last into a fair Channel, which lead us down to the Island, having a very large Shoal on our Starboard side and several smaller ones betwixt us and the Main land. In this Channel we had from 20 to 30 fathoms. Between 11 and 12 o'Clock we hauld round the North-East side of the Island, leaving it between us and the Main from which it is distant 7 or 8 Miles. This Island is about a League in Circuit and of a moderate height, and is inhabited; to the North-West of it are several small, low Islands and Keys, which lay not far from the Main, and to the Northward and Eastward lay several other Islands and Shoals, so that we were now incompassed on every side by one or the other, but so much does a great danger Swallow up lesser ones, that these once so much dreaded spots were now looked at with less concern. The Boats being out of their Stations, we brought too to wait for them. At Noon our Latitude by observation was 12 degrees 0 minutes South, Longitude in 217 degrees 25 minutes West; depth of Water 14 fathoms; Course and distance sail'd, reduced to a strait line, since yesterday Noon is North 29 degrees West, 32 Miles. The Main land within the above Islands forms a point, which I call Cape Grenville* (* George Grenville was First Lord of the Admiralty for a few months in 1763, and afterwards Prime Minister for two years.) (Latitude 11 degrees 58 minutes, Longitude 217 degrees 38 minutes); between this Cape and the Bolt head is a Bay, which I Named Temple Bay.* (* Richard Earl Temple, brother of George Grenville, was First Lord of the Admiralty in 1756.) East 1/2 North, 9 Leagues from Cape Grenville, lay some tolerable high Islands, which I called Sir Charles Hardy's Isles;* (* Admiral Sir C. Hardy was second in command in Hawke's great action in Quiberon Bay, 1759.) those which lay off the Cape I named Cockburn Isles.* (* Admiral George Cockburn was a Commissioner of Longitude and Comptroller of the Navy when Cook left England. Off Cape Grenville the Endeavour again got into what is now the recognised channel along the land inside the reefs.)

Sunday, 19th. Gentle breezes coming from the Southeast and clear weather. At 2 P.M., while we were heading Northwest by North, we spotted a large shoal directly ahead, extending 3 or 4 points on each side. We altered our course to North-Northeast and Northeast by North to navigate around its northern point, which we reached by 4 o'clock. Then we turned westward and sailed between the northern end of this shoal and another one lying 2 miles to the north, with a boat ahead continuously sounding the depth. The water depth varied from 22 to 8 fathoms. At 6:30, we anchored in 13 fathoms; the northernmost of the small islands mentioned at noon was 3 miles west, at a distance of ½ south. These islands, marked in the chart as Forbes's Isles, lay about 5 leagues from the mainland, which here forms a moderate high point called Bolt Head. From there, the land trends more westerly and is all low, sandy terrain, while to the south, it is high and hilly, even close to the sea. At 6 A.M., we set sail and pointed our course toward an island just a short distance from the mainland, which was bearing North 40 degrees West, 5 leagues away. However, our course was soon interrupted by encountering shoals, but with the help of two boats ahead and a good lookout from the masthead, we finally made it into a fair channel leading us down to the island, which had a large shoal on our starboard side and several smaller ones between us and the mainland. In this channel, the depth ranged from 20 to 30 fathoms. Between 11 and 12 o'clock, we went around the northeastern side of the island, leaving it between us and the mainland, from which it is 7 or 8 miles away. This island is about a league in circumference, moderately high, and inhabited. To the northwest of it are several small, low islands and keys not far from the mainland, while to the north and east lay several other islands and shoals, surrounding us on all sides. However, a significant danger often overshadows lesser ones, so these once-dreaded spots now felt less concerning. With the boats out of their stations, we stopped to wait for them. At noon, our latitude by observation was 12 degrees 0 minutes south, longitude 217 degrees 25 minutes west; the water depth was 14 fathoms; our course and distance sailed, straightened to a straight line since yesterday noon, was North 29 degrees West, 32 miles. The mainland within the aforementioned islands creates a point, which I named Cape Grenville (Latitude 11 degrees 58 minutes, Longitude 217 degrees 38 minutes); between this cape and Bolt Head lies a bay, which I named Temple Bay. East ½ North, 9 leagues from Cape Grenville, some reasonably high islands appeared, which I called Sir Charles Hardy's Isles; those lying off the cape were named Cockburn Isles.

[Nearing Cape York, Queensland.]

[Nearing Cape York, QLD.]

Monday, 20th. Fresh breezes at East-South-East. About one P.M. the pinnace having got ahead, and the Yawl we took in Tow, we fill'd and Steer'd North by West, for some small Islands we had in that direction. After approaching them a little nearer we found them join'd or connected together by a large Reef; upon this we Edged away North-West, and left them on our Starboard hand, steering between them and the Island laying off the Main, having a fair and Clear Passage; Depth of Water from 15 to 23 fathoms. At 4 we discover'd some low Islands and Rocks bearing West-North-West, which we stood directly for. At half Past 6 we Anchor'd on the North-East side of the Northermost, in 16 fathoms, distant from the Island one Mile. This Isle lay North-West 4 Leagues from Cape Grenville. On the Isles we saw a good many Birds, which occasioned my calling them Bird Isles. Before and at Sunset we could see the Main land, which appear'd all very low and sandy, Extends as far to the Northward as North-West by North, and some Shoals, Keys, and low sandy Isles away to the North-East of us. At 6 A.M. we got again under sail, with a fresh breeze at East, and stood away North-North-West for some low Islands* (* Boydong Keys.) we saw in that direction; but we had not stood long upon this Course before we were obliged to haul close upon a wind in Order to weather a Shoal which we discover'd on our Larboard bow, having at the same time others to the Eastward of us. By such time as we had weathered the Shoal to Leeward we had brought the Islands well upon our Leebow; but seeing some Shoals spit off from them, and some rocks on our Starboard bow, which we did not discover until we were very near them, made me afraid to go to windward of the Islands; wherefore we brought too, and made the signal for the pinnace, which was a head, to come on board, which done, I sent her to Leeward of the Islands, with Orders to keep along the Edge off the Shoal, which spitted off from the South side of the Southermost Island. The Yawl I sent to run over the Shoals to look for Turtle, and appointed them a Signal to make in case they saw many; if not, she was to meet us on the other side of the Island. As soon as the pinnace had got a proper distance from us we wore, and stood After her, and run to Leeward of the Islands, where we took the Yawl in Tow, she having seen only one small Turtle, and therefore made no Stay upon the Shoal. Upon this Island, which is only a Small Spott of Land, with some Trees upon it, we saw many Hutts and habitations of the Natives, which we supposed come over from the Main to these Islands (from which they are distant about 5 Leagues) to Catch Turtle at the time these Animals come ashore to lay their Eggs. Having got the Yawl in Tow, we stood away after the pinnace North-North-East and North by East to 2 other low Islands, having 2 Shoals, which we could see without and one between us and the Main. At Noon we were about 4 Leagues from the Main land, which we could see Extending to the Northward as far as North-West by North, all low, flat, and Sandy. Our Latitude by observation was 11 degrees 23 minutes South, Longitude in 217 degrees 46 minutes West, and Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon North 22 degrees West, 40 Miles; soundings from 14 to 23 fathoms. But these are best seen upon the Chart, as likewise the Islands, Shoals, etc., which are too Numerous to be Mentioned singly.* (* It is very difficult to follow Cook's track after entering Providential Channel to this place. The shoals and islands were so confusing that their positions are very vaguely laid down on Cook's chart. It is easy to imagine how slow was his progress and tortuous his course, with a boat ahead all the time constantly signalling shallow water. Nothing is more trying to officers and men.)

Monday, 20th. Fresh breezes from the East-Southeast. Around 1 P.M., after the pinnace got ahead and the Yawl we had in tow, we filled and steered North by West towards some small islands in that direction. As we got closer, we found that they were connected by a large reef; we then changed course to the Northwest and passed them on our right side, steering between them and the island off the mainland, with a clear passage; water depth ranging from 15 to 23 fathoms. At 4, we spotted some low islands and rocks to the West-Northwest and headed straight for them. At 6:30, we anchored on the Northeast side of the northernmost island in 16 fathoms, one mile away from the island. This island was located Northwest 4 leagues from Cape Grenville. We saw many birds on the islands, which led me to call them Bird Isles. Before and during sunset, we could see the mainland, which appeared very low and sandy, extending as far North as North-West by North, along with some shoals, keys, and low sandy islands to the Northeast of us. At 6 A.M., we set sail again, with a fresh breeze coming from the East, heading North-Northwest for some low islands (*Boydong Keys*) visible in that direction. However, it wasn't long before we had to sail close to the wind to navigate around a shoal we spotted on our left side, while other shoals were to our East. By the time we had passed the shoal to our leeward, the islands were well on our left. But upon seeing some shoals extending from them and some rocks on our right that we didn’t notice until very close, I became hesitant to sail upwind of the islands. So, we slowed down and signaled the pinnace, which was ahead, to come back on board. Once she was a safe distance away, we changed course and followed her, sailing downwind of the islands, where we towed the Yawl, which had only spotted a small turtle and therefore didn’t linger over the shoal. On this island, just a small patch of land with some trees, we saw many huts and homes of the natives, who we believed had come over from the mainland (about 5 leagues away) to catch turtles when they come ashore to lay their eggs. After taking the Yawl in tow, we kept heading North-Northeast and North by East toward 2 other low islands, with 2 shoals visible—one outside and one between us and the mainland. At noon, we were about 4 leagues from the mainland, which extended to the North as far as North-West by North, all low, flat, and sandy. Our latitude by observation was 11 degrees 23 minutes South, longitude 217 degrees 46 minutes West, and our course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon was North 22 degrees West, 40 miles; soundings from 14 to 23 fathoms. These are best seen on the chart, which also shows the islands, shoals, and so on, too numerous to mention individually. (*It is very difficult to follow Cook's track after entering Providential Channel to this location. The shoals and islands were so confusing that their positions are laid out vaguely on Cook's chart. One can imagine how slow his progress was and how winding his course, with a boat ahead constantly signaling shallow water. Nothing is more trying for the officers and crew.*)

Tuesday, 21st. Winds at East by South and East-South-East, fresh breeze. By one o'Clock we had run nearly the length of the Southermost of the 2 Islands before mentioned, and finding that we could not well go to windward of them without carrying us too far from the Main land, we bore up, and run to Leeward, where we found a fair open passage. This done, we steer'd North by West, in a parrallel direction with the Main land, leaving a small Island between us and it, and some low sandy Isles and Shoals without us, all of which we lost sight of by 4 o'Clock; neither did we see any more before the sun went down, at which time the farthest part of the Main in sight bore North-North-West 1/2 West. Soon after this we Anchor'd in 13 fathoms, soft Ground, about five Leagues from the Land, where we lay until day light, when we got again under sail, having first sent the Yawl ahead to sound. We steer'd North-North-West by Compass from the Northermost land in sight; Variation 3 degrees 6 minutes East. Seeing no danger in our way we took the Yawl in Tow, and made all the Sail we could until 8 o'Clock, at which time we discover'd Shoals ahead and on our Larboard bow, and saw that the Northermost land, which we had taken to be a part of the Main, was an Island, or Islands,* (*Now called Mount Adolphus Islands.) between which and the Main their appeared to be a good Passage thro' which we might pass by running to Leeward of the Shoals on our Larboard bow, which was now pretty near us. Whereupon we wore and brought too, and sent away the Pinnace and Yawl to direct us clear of the Shoals, and then stood after them. Having got round the South-East point of the Shoal we steer'd North-West along the South-West, or inside of it, keeping a good lookout at the Masthead, having another Shoal on our Larboard side; but we found a good Channel of a Mile broad between them, wherein were from 10 to 14 fathoms. At 11 o'Clock, being nearly the length of the Islands above mentioned, and designing to pass between them and the Main, the Yawl, being thrown a stern by falling in upon a part of the Shoal, She could not get over. We brought the Ship too, and Sent away the Long boat (which we had a stern, and rigg'd) to keep in Shore upon our Larboard bow, and the Pinnace on our Starboard; for altho' there appear'd nothing in the Passage, yet I thought it necessary to take this method, because we had a strong flood, which carried us on end very fast, and it did not want much of high water. As soon as the Boats were ahead we stood after them, and got through by noon, at which time we were by observation in the Latitude of 10 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds South. The nearest part of the Main, and which we soon after found to be the Northermost,* (* Cape York, the northernmost point of Australia.) bore West southerly, distant 3 or 4 Miles; the Islands which form'd the passage before mentioned extending from North to North 75 degrees East, distant 2 or 3 Miles. At the same time we saw Islands at a good distance off extending from North by West to West-North-West, and behind them another chain of high land, which we likewise judged to be Islands.* (* The islands around Thursday Island.) The Main land we thought extended as far as North 71 degrees West; but this we found to be Islands. The point of the Main, which forms one side of the Passage before mentioned, and which is the Northern Promontory of this Country, I have named York Cape, in honour of his late Royal Highness, the Duke of York.* (* Edward Augustus, Duke of York and Albany, was a brother of George III.) It lies in the Longitude of 218 degrees 24 minutes West, the North point in the Latitude of 10 degrees 37 minutes South, and the East point in 10 degrees 41 minutes. The land over and to the Southward of this last point is rather low and very flatt as far inland as the Eye could reach, and looks barren. To the Southward of the Cape the Shore forms a large open bay, which I called Newcastle bay, wherein are some small, low Islands and shoals, and the land all about it is very low, flatt, and sandy. The land on the Northern part of the Cape is rather more hilly, and the shore forms some small bays, wherein there appear'd to be good Anchorage, and the Vallies appear'd to be tolerably well Cloathed with wood. Close to the East point of the Cape are 3 small Islands, and a small Ledge of rocks spitting off from one of them. There is also an Island laying close to the North Point. The other Islands before spoke of lay about 4 Miles without these; only two of them are of any extent. The Southermost is the largest, and much higher than any part of the Main land. On the North-West side of this Island seem'd to be good Anchorage, and Vallies that to all appearance would afford both wood and fresh Water. These Isles are known in the Chart by the name of York Isles.* (* Now called Mount Adolphus Islands.) To the Southward and South-East of them, and even to the Eastward and Northward, are several low Islands, rocks, and Shoals. Our depth of Water in sailing between them and the Main was 12, 13, and 14 fathoms.* (* In this channel is the dangerous rock on which the steamship Quetta was wrecked, with such terrible loss of life, in 1890. By the Endeavour's track she must have passed very near it.)

Tuesday, 21st. Winds from the East by South and East-South-East, fresh breeze. By one o'clock, we had traveled nearly the length of the southernmost of the two mentioned islands. Realizing we couldn't navigate against the wind without straying too far from the mainland, we turned and sailed downwind, where we found a clear passage. After that, we steered North by West, parallel to the mainland, leaving a small island between us and it, along with some low sandy islands and shoals to the west, all of which we lost sight of by 4 o'clock. We had not seen anything more before sunset, at which time the furthest part of the mainland in view was to the North-North-West 1/2 West. Shortly after, we anchored in 13 fathoms of soft ground, about five leagues from the land, where we stayed until daylight, when we set sail again after sending the yawl ahead to sound. We headed North-North-West by compass from the northernmost land in sight; variation 3 degrees 6 minutes East. Seeing no danger in our path, we took the yawl in tow and made sail until 8 o'clock, at which point we discovered shoals ahead and on our port bow, realizing that the northernmost land, which we thought was part of the mainland, was actually an island or islands (*Now called Mount Adolphus Islands). Between these islands and the mainland, there seemed to be a good passage we could use by sailing downwind of the shoals on our port bow, which were now quite close to us. We then turned and brought the ship to a stop, sending the pinnace and yawl to guide us clear of the shoals, and then proceeded after them. After rounding the southeast point of the shoal, we steered northwest along the southwest or inside of it, keeping a good lookout at the masthead, as there was another shoal on our port side. However, we found a good channel about a mile wide between them, with depths of 10 to 14 fathoms. At 11 o'clock, as we approached the length of the previously mentioned islands and planned to pass between them and the mainland, the yawl fell behind after getting caught on a part of the shoal and could not get over. We brought the ship to a halt and sent the longboat (which we had rigged and kept at the stern) to stay inshore on our port bow, and the pinnace to our starboard; although the passage seemed clear, I felt it was necessary to take this precaution due to a strong flood tide that was moving us along rapidly, and it was nearly high tide. Once the boats were ahead, we followed them and made it through by noon. At that time, we observed that we were at a latitude of 10 degrees 36 minutes 30 seconds South. The nearest part of the mainland, which we soon identified as the northernmost (*Cape York, the northernmost point of Australia), was bearing West-Southwest, about 3 to 4 miles away; the islands forming the mentioned passage extended from North to North 75 degrees East, about 2 to 3 miles away. Simultaneously, we noticed islands at a good distance off extending from North by West to West-North-West, and behind them, another chain of high land, which we also believed to be islands (*The islands around Thursday Island). We thought the mainland extended as far as North 71 degrees West, but we later discovered it was islands. The point of the mainland forming one side of the aforementioned passage, known as the northern promontory of this country, I named York Cape, in honor of His Late Royal Highness, the Duke of York (*Edward Augustus, Duke of York and Albany, was a brother of George III). It is located at a longitude of 218 degrees 24 minutes West, with the northern point at a latitude of 10 degrees 37 minutes South, and the eastern point at 10 degrees 41 minutes. The land south of this last point is relatively low and very flat as far inland as the eye can see, appearing barren. To the south of the cape, the shoreline forms a large open bay, which I called Newcastle Bay, containing some small, low islands and shoals, with the surrounding land being very low, flat, and sandy. The land to the north of the cape is slightly more hilly, with the shoreline forming small bays that seem to provide good anchorage, and the valleys appear to be reasonably well covered with trees. Close to the eastern point of the cape are three small islands and a small ledge of rocks extending from one of them. There's also an island located near the northern point. The previously mentioned islands are about four miles beyond these, two of which are relatively extensive. The southernmost island is the largest, significantly higher than any part of the mainland. On the northwest side of this island, there appeared to be good anchorage and valleys that seemingly would offer both wood and fresh water. These islands are labeled on maps by the name of York Isles (*Now called Mount Adolphus Islands). Southward and southeast of them, as well as eastward and northward, there are several low islands, rocks, and shoals. The depth of water while sailing between them and the mainland was 12, 13, and 14 fathoms. (*In this channel is the dangerous rock on which the steamship Quetta was wrecked, with such terrible loss of life, in 1890. By the Endeavour's track, she must have passed very near it.)

[Land upon Possession Island.]

[Land on Possession Island.]

Wednesday, 22nd. Gentle breezes at East by South and clear weather. We had not steer'd above 3 or 4 Miles along shore to the westward before we discover'd the land ahead to be Islands detached by several Channels from the main land; upon this we brought too to Wait for the Yawl, and called the other Boats on board, and after giving them proper instructions, sent them away again to lead us thro' the Channell next the Main, and as soon as the Yawl was on board made sail after them with the Ship. Soon after we discover'd rocks and Shoals in this Channell, upon which I made the Signal for the boats to lead thro' the next Channel to the Northward* (* This led to Endeavour Strait, but the recognised track is the channel farther north.) laying between the Islands, which they accordingly did, we following with the Ship, and had not less than 5 fathoms; and this in the narrowest part of the Channel, which was about a Mile and a 1/2 broad from Island to Island. At 4 o'Clock we Anchor'd about a Mile and a 1/2 or 2 Miles within the Entrance in 6 1/2 fathoms, clear ground, distance from the Islands on each side of us one Mile, the Main land extending away to the South-West; the farthest point of which we could see bore from us South 48 degrees West, and the Southermost point of the Islands, on the North-West side of the Passage, bore South 76 degrees West. Between these 2 points we could see no land, so that we were in great hopes that we had at last found out a Passage into the Indian seas; but in order to be better informed I landed with a party of men, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, upon the Islands which lies at the South-East point of the Passage. Before and after we Anchor'd we saw a Number of People upon this Island, Arm'd in the same manner as all the others we have seen, Except one man, who had a bow and a bundle of Arrows, the first we have seen upon this Coast. From the appearance of the people we expected they would have opposed our landing; but as we approached the shore they all made off, and left us in peaceable possession of as much of the Island as served our purpose. After landing I went upon the highest hill, which, however, was of no great height, yet no less than twice or thrice the height of the Ship's Mastheads; but I could see from it no land between South-West and West-South-West, so that I did not doubt but there was a passage. I could see plainly that the lands laying to the North-West of this passage were compos'd of a number of Islands of Various extent, both for height and Circuit, ranged one behind another as far to the Northward and Westward as I could see, which could not be less than 12 or 14 Leagues.

Wednesday, 22nd. There were gentle breezes coming from the East by South and clear weather. We had only traveled about 3 or 4 miles along the shore to the west before we noticed that the land ahead was made up of islands separated by several channels from the mainland. We stopped to wait for the Yawl and called the other boats on board. After giving them some instructions, we sent them off again to lead us through the channel next to the mainland. Once the Yawl was on board, we set sail after them with the ship. Shortly after, we noticed rocks and shoals in this channel, so I signaled for the boats to lead us through the next channel to the north (this led to Endeavour Strait, but the recognized route is the channel further north) lying between the islands. They did so, and we followed with the ship, resting in no less than 5 fathoms even in the narrowest part of the channel, which was about a mile and a half wide from island to island. At 4 o'clock, we anchored about a mile and a half or 2 miles inside the entrance in 6 and a half fathoms, clear ground, positioned a mile away from the islands on each side of us, with the mainland extending to the southwest. The farthest point we could see bore South 48 degrees West, and the southernmost point of the islands on the northwest side of the passage was South 76 degrees West. Between these two points, we could see no land, so we hoped that we had finally discovered a passage into the Indian seas. To gather more information, I landed with a group of men, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, on the island located at the southeast point of the passage. Before and after we anchored, we saw several people on this island, armed just like those we had seen before, except for one man who had a bow and a bundle of arrows, which was the first we had encountered on this coast. Given the appearance of the people, we expected they would try to stop us from landing, but as we approached the shore, they all left, giving us peaceful possession of as much of the island as we needed. After landing, I climbed the highest hill, which wasn’t very tall but was at least twice or three times the height of the ship’s mastheads. From there, I couldn’t see any land between the southwest and west-southwest, so I had no doubt there was a passage. I could clearly see that the lands to the northwest of this passage were made up of many islands of varying sizes, both in height and area, lined up one behind another as far north and west as I could see, which must have been no less than 12 or 14 leagues.

Having satisfied myself of the great Probability of a passage, thro' which I intend going with the Ship, and therefore may land no more upon this Eastern coast of New Holland, and on the Western side I can make no new discovery, the honour of which belongs to the Dutch Navigators, but the Eastern Coast from the Latitude of 38 degrees South down to this place, I am confident, was never seen or Visited by any European before us; and notwithstanding I had in the Name of his Majesty taken possession of several places upon this Coast, I now once More hoisted English Colours, and in the Name of His Majesty King George the Third took possession of the whole Eastern coast from the above Latitude down to this place by the Name of New Wales,* (* The Admiralty copy, as well as that belonging to Her Majesty, calls it New South Wales. The island where the ceremony was performed was named on Cook's chart Possession Island, and is still so called.) together with all the Bays, Harbours, Rivers, and Islands, situated upon the said Coast; after which we fired 3 Volleys of small Arms, which were answer'd by the like number from the Ship.

Having confirmed the strong likelihood of a passage through which I plan to travel with the ship, and since I cannot explore any further along this eastern coast of New Holland, and on the western side I can't make any new discoveries—those honors belong to the Dutch navigators—I am confident that the eastern coast from the latitude of 38 degrees South down to this location has never been seen or visited by any Europeans before us. Even though I had previously taken possession of several places along this coast in the name of His Majesty, I once again raised the English flag and, in the name of His Majesty King George the Third, claimed the entire eastern coast from the aforementioned latitude down to this point, naming it New Wales.* (*The Admiralty copy, as well as the one belonging to Her Majesty, refers to it as New South Wales. The island where the ceremony took place is marked on Cook's chart as Possession Island, and it is still called that.) I then fired three volleys of small arms, which were returned by the same number from the ship.

This done, we set out for the Ship, but were some time in getting on board on account of a very Rapid Ebb Tide, which set North-East out of the Passage. Ever since we came in amongst the Shoals this last time we have found a Moderate Tide; the flood setting to the North-West and Ebb to the South-East; at this place is high water at full and change of the moon, about 1 or 2 o'Clock, and riseth and falleth upon a perpendicular about 10 or 12 feet. We saw upon all the Adjacent Lands and Islands a great number of smokes--a certain sign that they are inhabited--and we have daily seen smokes on every part of the Coast we have lately been upon. Between 7 and 8 o'Clock a.m. we saw several naked people, all or most of them Women, down upon the beach picking up Shells, etc.; they had not a single rag of any kind of Cloathing upon them, and both these and those we saw yesterday were in every respect the same sort of People we have seen everywhere upon the Coast. 2 or 3 of the Men we saw Yesterday had on pretty large breast plates, which we supposed were made of pearl Oyster Shells; this was a thing, as well as the Bow and Arrows, we had not seen before. At low water, which hapned about 10 o'Clock, we got under sail, and stood to the South-West, with a light breeze at East, which afterwards veer'd to North by East, having the Pinnace ahead; depth of Water from 6 to 10 fathoms, except in one place, were we passed over a Bank of 5 fathoms. At Noon Possession Island, at the South-East entrance of the Passage, bore North 53 degrees East, distant 4 Leagues; the Western extream of the Main land in sight South 43 degrees West, distant 4 or 5 Leagues, being all exceeding low. The South-West point of the largest Island* (* Prince of Wales Island.) on the North-West side of the passage bore North 71 degrees West, distant 8 Miles; this point I named Cape Cornwall (Latitude 10 degrees 43 minutes South, Longitude 218 degrees 59 minutes West),* (* This longitude is 70 minutes too far west, and one of the worst given in the Journal. There were no observations, and the dead reckoning among the shoals was difficult to keep.) and some low Islands lying about the Middle of the Passage, which I called Wallace's Isles, bore West by South 1/2 South, distance about 2 Leagues. Our Latitude by Observation was 10 degrees 46 minutes South.

Once we finished, we headed for the ship, but it took us some time to get on board due to a very strong ebb tide that was flowing northeast out of the channel. Since we came into the shoals this last time, we’ve encountered a moderate tide; the flood flows northwest and the ebb flows southeast. Here, high water happens at full and new moon around 1 or 2 o'clock, rising and falling about 10 to 12 feet. We saw a lot of smoke on all the nearby lands and islands—sure signs of habitation—and we've been seeing smoke along every part of the coast we’ve just traveled. Between 7 and 8 a.m., we spotted several naked people, mostly women, on the beach collecting shells, with not a single piece of clothing on them. Both these individuals and those we saw yesterday were exactly the same type of people we've observed along the coast. A couple of the men we saw yesterday were wearing large breastplates that we thought were made from pearl oyster shells; this, along with the bows and arrows, was something we hadn't encountered before. At low water, which occurred around 10 a.m., we set sail and headed southwest with a light east breeze, which later shifted to north by east, with the pinnace ahead; the water depth ranged from 6 to 10 fathoms, except in one spot where we passed over a bank of 5 fathoms. At noon, Possession Island, located at the southeast entrance of the passage, was 53 degrees east, about 4 leagues away. The western tip of the mainland visible to the south was located at 43 degrees west, approximately 4 or 5 leagues away, and was very low. The southwest point of the largest island (Prince of Wales Island) on the northwest side of the passage was 71 degrees west, 8 miles away; I named this point Cape Cornwall (Latitude 10 degrees 43 minutes south, Longitude 218 degrees 59 minutes west), and some low islands in the middle of the passage, which I called Wallace's Isles, were about 1.5 leagues away to the west-southwest. Our latitude, determined by observation, was 10 degrees 46 minutes south.

[In Endeavour Strait, Torres Strait.]

[In Endeavour Strait, Torres Strait.]

Thursday, 23rd. In the P.M. had little wind and Variable, with which and the Tide of Flood we keept advancing to the West-North-West; depth of Water 8, 7, and 5 fathoms. At 1/2 past 1 the pinnace, which was ahead, made the Signal for Shoal Water, upon which we Tackt and sent away the Yawl to sound also, and then Tack'd again, and stood after them with the Ship; 2 hours after this they both at once made the Signal for having Shoal water. I was afraid to stand on for fear of running aground at that time of the Tide, and therefore came to an Anchor in 1/4 less 7 fathoms, sandy ground. Wallice's Islands bore South by West 1/2 West, distant 5 or 6 Miles, the Islands to the Northward extending from North 73 degrees East to North 10 degrees East, and a small island* (* Booby Island.) just in sight bearing North-West 1/2 West. Here we found the flood Tide set to the Westward and Ebb to the Contrary. After we had come to Anchor I sent away the Master with the Long boat to sound, who, upon his return in the evening, reported that there was a bank stretching North and South, upon which were 3 fathoms Water, and behind it 7 fathoms. We had it Calm all Night and until 9 in the morning, at which time we weigh'd, with a light breeze at South-South-East, and steer'd North-West by West for the Small Island above mentioned, having first sent the Boats ahead to sound; depth of Water 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, and 3 fathoms when upon the Bank,* (* The Endeavour Strait is now little used, on account of this great bank, which nearly bars its western part. There is, however, deeper water than Cook found, a few miles to the southward; but it is just the difficulty of finding this narrow pass, so far from land, and the fact that there is a deep though narrow channel north of Prince of Wales Island, that has caused it to be abandoned. The passage of Torres Strait is, however, still an anxious bit of navigation.) it being now the last Quarter Ebb. At this time the most Northermost Islands we had in sight bore North 9 degrees East; the South-West point of the largest Islands on the North-West side of the Passage, which I named Cape Cornwall, bore East; distant 3 Leagues. This bank, at least so much as we sounded, extends nearly North and South, how far I cannot say; its breadth, however, is not more than 1/4 or at most 1/2 a Mile. Being over the Bank, we deepned our water to a 1/4 less 7 fathoms, which depth we carried all the way to the small Island ahead, which we reached by Noon, at which time it bore South, distant near 1/2 a Mile; depth of Water 5 fathoms. The most northermost land we had in sight (being part of the same Chain of Islands we have had to the Northward of us since we entered the Passage) bore North 71 degrees East; Latitude in, by Observation, 10 degrees 33 minutes South, Longitude 219 degrees 22 minutes West. In this situation we had no part of the Main land in sight. Being now near the island, and having but little wind, Mr. Banks and I landed upon it, and found it to be mostly a barren rock frequented by Birds, such as Boobies, a few of which we shott, and occasioned my giving it the name of Booby Island.* (* Booby Island is now the great landmark for ships making Torres Strait from the westward. There is a light upon it.) I made but very short stay at this Island before I return'd to the Ship; in the meantime the wind had got to the South-West, and although it blow'd but very faint, yet it was accompanied with a Swell from the same quarter. This, together with other concuring Circumstances, left me no room to doubt but we had got to the Westward of Carpentaria, or the Northern extremity of New Holland, and had now an open Sea to the Westward; which gave me no small satisfaction, not only because the danger and fatigues of the Voyage was drawing near to an end, but by being able to prove that New Holland and New Guinea are 2 separate Lands or Islands, which until this day hath been a doubtful point with Geographers.* (* Luis Vaez de Torres, commanding a Spanish ship in company with Quiros in 1605, separated from his companion in the New Hebrides. He afterwards passed through the Strait separating New Guinea from Australia, which now bears his name. This fact, however, was little known, as the Spaniards suppressed all account of the voyage; and though it leaked out later, the report was so vague that it was very much doubted whether he had really passed this way. On most charts and maps of the period, New Guinea was shown joined to Australia, and to Cook the establishment of the Strait may fairly be given. Only the year before Bougainville, the French navigator, who preceded Cook across the Pacific, and who was steering across the Coral Sea on a course which would have led him to Lizard Island, abandoned his search in that direction, after falling in with two reefs to the eastward of the Barrier, because he feared falling amongst other shoals, and had no faith whatever in the reports of the existence of Torres Strait. Had he persevered, he would have snatched from Cook the honour of the complete exploration of Eastern Australia, and of the verification of the passage between it and New Guinea. Bougainville paid dearly for his caution, as he found that retracing his steps against the trade wind, in order to pass eastward and northward of New Guinea, occupied such a weary time, that he and his people were nearly starved before they reached a place of refreshment.)

Thursday, 23rd. In the afternoon, there was little wind and it was variable. With this and the incoming tide, we kept moving west-northwest; the water depth was 8, 7, and 5 fathoms. At 1:30, the pinnace, which was ahead, signaled for shallow water, so we turned around and sent the yawl to check the depth as well. Then we tacked again and moved after them with the ship. Two hours later, both of them signaled again for shallow water. I was hesitant to proceed for fear of running aground at that point in the tide, so I anchored in 6¾ fathoms on sandy ground. Wallace's Islands were to the south by west, about 5 or 6 miles away; the islands to the north extended from 73 degrees east to 10 degrees east, and a small island (Booby Island) was in sight to the northwest. Here, we found the flood tide flowing westward and the ebb in the opposite direction. After anchoring, I sent the master and the longboat to take soundings. Upon his return in the evening, he reported a bank stretching north and south with 3 fathoms of water on it and 7 fathoms behind it. We had calm conditions all night and until 9 in the morning when we weighed anchor with a light breeze from the south-southeast and steered northwest by west toward the aforementioned small island, having first sent the boats ahead to sound; the water depth changed from 8, 7, 6, 5, 4, to 3 fathoms when we reached the bank. This area is now little used because of this substantial bank, which nearly blocks the western part. However, deeper water exists a few miles to the south, but the challenge of locating this narrow channel, far from land, and the presence of a deep but narrow channel north of Prince of Wales Island, have led to its abandonment. Nonetheless, the passage of Torres Strait remains a tricky navigation. At this time, the northernmost islands in sight were at 9 degrees east; the southwest point of the largest islands on the northwest side of the passage, which I named Cape Cornwall, was 3 leagues away to the east. This bank, at least the part we measured, extends nearly north and south, though its width is not more than ¼ or at most ½ a mile. Over the bank, we found the water deepened to 6¾ fathoms, which we maintained all the way to the small island ahead, which we reached by noon. At that time, it bore south and was about ½ a mile away, with the water depth at 5 fathoms. The northernmost land we could see, part of the same chain of islands to the north since we entered the passage, was at 71 degrees east; our latitude, by observation, was 10 degrees 33 minutes south, longitude 219 degrees 22 minutes west. In this position, there were no parts of the mainland visible. Now near the island and with little wind, Mr. Banks and I landed on it. We found it mostly to be barren rock, frequented by birds like boobies, a few of which we shot, which led me to name it Booby Island. Booby Island is now a significant landmark for ships heading into Torres Strait from the west. There's a light on it now. I didn’t stay long on this island before returning to the ship; by then, the wind had shifted to the southwest. Though it blew softly, it created a swell from the same direction. This, along with other factors, confirmed for me that we had reached the west of Carpentaria or the northern end of New Holland, and now had an open sea to the west. This brought me great satisfaction, not only because the dangers and fatigue of the voyage were nearing their end, but also because I could prove that New Holland and New Guinea are two separate lands or islands, a matter that had been unclear to geographers until that day. Luis Vaez de Torres, who commanded a Spanish ship alongside Quiros in 1605, had separated from his companion in the New Hebrides. He later passed through the strait that separates New Guinea from Australia, which now bears his name. This fact was not well-known because the Spaniards suppressed details of the voyage; although it emerged later, the reports were vague and made it unclear whether he had actually passed through. On most charts of the time, New Guinea was shown connected to Australia, and Cook can be credited with establishing the strait. Just the year prior, Bougainville, the French navigator who preceded Cook across the Pacific and was steering toward Lizard Island, gave up after encountering two reefs east of the barrier because he feared more shoals and didn’t trust reports of Torres Strait’s existence. Had he persisted, he would have taken the honor of fully exploring eastern Australia and confirming the passage between it and New Guinea. Bougainville paid dearly for his caution, as retracing his steps against the trade wind to pass east and north of New Guinea took so long that he and his crew were nearly starved before reaching a place of refreshment.

[Description of Endeavour Strait.]

[Description of Endeavour Strait.]

The North-East entrance of this passage or Strait lies in the Latitude of 10 degrees 27 minutes South, and in the Longitude of 218 degrees 36 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich.* (* As before mentioned, this longitude is over a degree in error. The sun was not available for lunars until the 24th August, and the first was observed on the 25th, when the ship was at Booby Island; but the result is not recorded in Mr. Green's log. Mr. Green was at this time ill. The latitude is a clerical error for 10.37, which Cook's chart shows, and is nearly correct.) It is form'd by the Main, or the northern extremity of New Holland, on the South-East, and by a Congeries of Islands to North-West, which I named Prince of Wales's Islands. It is very Probable that the Islands extend quite to New Guinea;* (* This conjecture was very near the truth. The whole of Torres Strait is obstructed by either islands or reefs that leave very little passage.) they are of Various Extent both for height and Circuit, and many of them seem'd to be indifferently well Cloath'd with wood, etc., and, from the smokes we saw, some, if not all of them, must be inhabited. It is also very probable that among these Islands are as good, if not better, passages than the one we have come thro', altho' one need hardly wish for a better, was the access to it from the Eastward less dangerous; but this difficulty will remain until some better way is found out than the one we came, which no doubt may be done was it ever to become an object to be looked for.* (* It is the western and not the eastern approach of Endeavour Strait that forms the difficulty, now the locality has been charted, for vessels of deeper draught than the Endeavour; though for small craft, as Cook says, you can hardly wish for a better.) The northern Extent of the Main or outer reef, which limit or bounds the Shoals to the Eastward, seems to be the only thing wanting to Clear up this point; and this was a thing I had neither time nor inclination to go about, having been already sufficiently harrass'd with dangers without going to look for more.* (* The east coast of Australia, which Cook had now followed from end to end, is 2000 miles in extent. He took four months over it, much less time than he had given to New Zealand; but this is easily accounted for. His people were getting worn out, and he was haunted by fears of not getting off the coast before the North-West monsoon set in, which would have been a foul wind for him in getting from Torres Straits to Batavia, and his provisions were running short. Besides this, there was the grave doubt whether Australia and New Guinea were really separated. If this turned out to be false, there was a long round to make, back to the eastern extremity of the latter, and the voyage to Batavia would have been infinitely extended. Considering these circumstances, Cook's exploration of the coast was wonderful, and the charts attached to this book attest the skill and unwearied pains taken in mapping it from such a cursory glance. He only stopped at four places: Botany Bay, Bustard Bay, Thirsty Sound, and the Endeavour River; and from the neighbourhood of these, with the view obtained as he coasted along, he had to form his opinion of the country--an opinion, as we shall see, singularly correct.)

The North-East entrance of this passage or Strait is located at a latitude of 10 degrees 27 minutes South and a longitude of 218 degrees 36 minutes West from the Greenwich Meridian. (*As previously mentioned, this longitude has an error of over a degree. The sun was unavailable for lunars until August 24th, with the first observation made on the 25th, when the ship was at Booby Island; however, this result is not recorded in Mr. Green's log because he was ill at the time. The latitude is a clerical error for 10.37, which Cook's chart shows to be nearly correct.) It is formed by the mainland, or the northern end of New Holland, to the South-East and a group of islands to the North-West, which I named Prince of Wales's Islands. It is very likely that these islands extend all the way to New Guinea; (*This guess was very close to the truth. The entirety of Torres Strait is blocked by either islands or reefs that leave very little navigable passage.) They vary in both height and area, and many of them appeared to be fairly well covered with vegetation, and based on the smoke we saw, some, if not all, must be inhabited. It also seems likely that among these islands there are equally good, if not better, passages than the one we just navigated, although one could hardly wish for a better access route if the approach from the East was less hazardous; however, this issue will persist until a better route is discovered than the one we used, which could surely be found if it were ever deemed important enough to investigate. (*It is the western approach of Endeavour Strait, not the eastern, that presents the challenge now that the location has been charted, for vessels with a deeper draft than the Endeavour; though for small crafts, as Cook states, you can hardly wish for a better route.) The northern extent of the main or outer reef, which bounds the shoals to the East, seems to be the only missing piece needed to clarify this point; and I neither had the time nor the desire to pursue it, having already endured enough dangers without seeking more. (*The east coast of Australia, which Cook had now followed from end to end, spans 2000 miles. He took four months to complete it, much less time than he spent in New Zealand, which is easily understandable. His crew was wearing out, and he was haunted by fears of not leaving the coast before the North-West monsoon set in, which would have brought unfavorable winds for his journey from Torres Straits to Batavia, and his supplies were running low. Additionally, there was serious doubt about whether Australia and New Guinea were truly separated. If they weren’t, it would require a long detour back to the eastern tip of New Guinea, extending the voyage to Batavia considerably. Considering these circumstances, Cook's exploration of the coast was remarkable, and the charts attached to this book reflect the skill and tireless effort he put into mapping it from such a brief observation. He only stopped at four places: Botany Bay, Bustard Bay, Thirsty Sound, and the Endeavour River; and from the vicinity of these areas, along with views obtained while coasting, he had to form his assessment of the land—an assessment that, as we will see, was remarkably accurate.)

This passage, which I have named Endeavour Straits, after the Name of the Ship, is in length North-East and South-West 10 Leagues, and about 5 leagues broad, except at the North-East entrance, where it is only 2 Miles broad by reason of several small Islands which lay there, one of which, called Possession Island, is of a Moderate height and Circuit; this we left between us and the Main, passing between it and 2 Small round Islands, which lay North-West 2 Miles from it. There are also 2 Small low Islands, called Wallice's Isles,* (* These are probably called after Captain Wallis, who made a voyage across the Pacific in the Dolphin in 1767, and discovered Tahiti.) laying in the Middle of the South-West entrance, which we left to the southward; the depth of Water we found in the Straits was from 4 to 9 fathoms. Every where good Anchorage, only about 2 Leagues to the Northward of Wallice's Islands is a Bank, whereon is not more than 3 fathoms at low Water, but probable there might be found more was it sought for. I have not been particular in describing this Strait, no more than I have been in pointing out the respective Situations of the Islands, Shoals, etc., on the Coast of New Wales; for these I refer to the Chart, where they are deliniated with all the accuracy that Circumstances would admit of.

This passage, which I've named Endeavour Straits after the ship, runs northeast to southwest for 10 leagues and is about 5 leagues wide, except at the northeast entrance, where it's only 2 miles wide due to several small islands nearby. One of these, called Possession Island, is of moderate height and size; we left it between us and the mainland, passing between it and two small round islands located 2 miles northwest of it. There are also two small low islands named Wallice's Isles, likely named after Captain Wallis, who crossed the Pacific in the Dolphin in 1767 and discovered Tahiti. These are in the middle of the southwest entrance, which we left to the south. The water depth in the straits varied from 4 to 9 fathoms. There’s good anchorage everywhere, but about 2 leagues north of Wallice's Islands, there's a bank where the water is no more than 3 fathoms at low tide. There might be more depth found if searched for. I haven't gone into detail describing this strait or the specific locations of the islands, shoals, etc., along the coast of New Wales; for those details, I refer to the chart, where they’re accurately represented as much as the circumstances allow.

With respect to the Shoals that lay upon this Coast I must observe, for the benefit of those who may come after me, that I do not believe the one 1/2 of them are laid down in my Chart; for it would be Absurd to suppose that we Could see or find them all. And the same thing may in some Measure be said of the Islands, especially between the Latitude of 20 and 22 degrees, where we saw Islands out at Sea as far as we could distinguish any thing. However, take the Chart in general, and I believe it will be found to contain as few Errors as most Sea Charts which have not undergone a thorough correction.* (* Cook's pride in his chart is well justified, as its general accuracy is marvellous, when one considers that he simply sailed along the coast. The great feature of this shore, however--the Barrier Reef--only appears on it at its northern end, where its approach to the land caused Cook to make such unpleasant acquaintance with it. See charts.) The Latitude and Longitude of all, or most of, the principal head lands, Bays, etc., may be relied on, for we seldom fail'd of getting an Observation every day to correct our Latitude by, and the Observation for settling the Longitude were no less Numerous, and made as often as the Sun and Moon came in play; so that it was impossible for any Material error to creep into our reckoning in the intermediate times. In justice to Mr. Green,* (* From this phrase, and from various remarks in Mr. Green's own log, it would appear that Mr. Green was not very easy to get on with; but there is no doubt of his unwearied zeal in astronomical observations.) I must say that he was indefatigable in making and calculating these observations, which otherwise must have taken up a great deal of my time, which I could not at all times very well spare; not only this, but by his instructions several of the petty Officers can make and calculate these observations almost as well as himself. It is only by such Means that this method of finding the Longitude at Sea can be put into universal practice; a Method that we have generally found may be depended upon within 1/2 a degree, which is a degree of Accuracy more than sufficient for all Nautical purposes. Would Sea Officers once apply themselves to the making and calculating these Observations they would not find them so very difficult as they at first imagine, especially with the Assistance of the Nautical Almanack and Astronomical Ephemeris, by the help of which the Calculation for finding the Longitude takes up but little more time than that of an Azimuth for finding the Variation of the Compass; but unless this Ephemeris is Published for some time to come, more than either one or 2 Years, it can never be of general use in long Voyages, and in short Voyages it's not so much wanted.* (* The "Nautical Almanac" was first published for 1767. That for 1770 was not published until 1769; but it seems probable that Cook either had proof sheets, or the manuscript calculations.) Without it the Calculations are Laborious and discouraging to beginners, and such as are not well vers'd in these kind of Calculations.

Regarding the shoals along this coast, I must point out, for the benefit of those who come after me, that I don't think I've recorded even half of them on my chart; it would be unrealistic to expect that we could see or discover them all. The same can be said to some extent about the islands, especially between latitudes 20 and 22 degrees, where we saw islands out at sea as far as we could distinguish anything. However, looking at the chart as a whole, I believe it has as few errors as most sea charts that haven't been thoroughly corrected.* (* Cook's pride in his chart is well justified, as its general accuracy is remarkable, considering he simply sailed along the coast. However, the main feature of this shore—the Barrier Reef—only appears at its northern end, where getting too close to it made Cook have an unpleasant encounter. See charts.) The latitude and longitude of most of the major headlands, bays, etc., can be trusted, as we rarely missed getting an observation every day to correct our latitude, and we had numerous observations for determining longitude, made as often as the sun and moon allowed; thus it was impossible for any significant errors to enter our calculations in between those times. In fairness to Mr. Green,* (* From this phrase and various comments in Mr. Green's own log, it seems that Mr. Green was not particularly easy to work with; however, there is no doubt about his tireless enthusiasm for astronomical observations.) I must say he was tireless in making and calculating these observations, which would have taken up a lot of my time that I couldn’t always spare; not only this, but through his instructions, several of the junior officers could make and calculate these observations nearly as well as he could. It's only by such means that this method of finding longitude at sea can become universally practiced; a method that we've generally found to be reliable within half a degree, which is more than accurate enough for all nautical purposes. If sea officers would apply themselves to making and calculating these observations, they would find them not nearly as difficult as they initially think, especially with the help of the Nautical Almanac and Astronomical Ephemeris, which make the calculation for finding longitude take only slightly more time than calculating an azimuth for finding compass variation; but unless this Ephemeris is published for some time to come, more than either one or two years, it can never be of general use in long voyages, and for short voyages, it’s not as essential.* (* The "Nautical Almanac" was first published for 1767. The one for 1770 wasn't published until 1769; however, it's likely that Cook either had proof sheets or the manuscript calculations.) Without it, the calculations are laborious and discouraging for beginners and for those who aren't well-versed in these kinds of calculations.

[Account of New South Wales Coast.]

[Account of New South Wales Coast.]

SOME ACCOUNT OF NEW WALES.* (* Called in Admiralty and the Queen's Copy New South Wales. It would appear that for this part of the voyage Mr. Corner's copy was the first written, and that Cook's first idea was to christen the country New Wales.)

SOME ACCOUNT OF NEW WALES.* (* Known in the Admiralty and the Queen's Copy as New South Wales. It seems that for this part of the journey, Mr. Corner's copy was the first one written, and Cook's initial idea was to name the land New Wales.)

In the Course of this Journal I have at different times made mention of the Appearance or Aspect of the face of the Country, the Nature of the Soil, its produce, etc. By the first it will appear that to the Southward of 33 or 34 degrees the land in general is low and level, with very few Hills or Mountains; further to the Northward it may in some places be called a Hilly, but hardly anywhere can be called a Mountainous, Country, for the Hills and Mountains put together take up but a small part of the Surface in Comparison to what the Planes and Valleys do which intersect or divide these Hills and Mountains. It is indifferently well water'd, even in the dry Seasons, with small brooks and Springs, but no great Rivers, unless it be in the Wet Season, when the low lands and Vallies near the Sea, I do suppose, are mostly laid under Water. The Small Brooks may then become large Rivers; but this can only happen with the Tropick. It was only in Thirsty Sound that we could find no fresh Water, and that no doubt was owing to the Country being there very much intersected with Salt Creeks and Mangrove land.

Throughout this journal, I've mentioned the appearance and condition of the land, the type of soil, its crops, and more. From my observations, south of 33 or 34 degrees, the land is generally flat and low, with very few hills or mountains. Further north, it can be considered hilly in some areas, but it's hardly a mountainous region since hills and mountains only make up a small portion of the landscape compared to the plains and valleys that separate them. The area is reasonably well-watered, even in dry seasons, with small streams and springs, but there are no significant rivers unless it’s the wet season, when the lowlands and valleys near the coast tend to be mostly underwater. During this time, smaller streams may become larger rivers, but this primarily occurs in the tropics. The only place we struggled to find fresh water was in Thirsty Sound, likely due to the area being heavily intersected with salt creeks and mangrove land.

The low land by the Sea, and even as far in land as we were, is for the most part friable, loose, sandy Soil yet indifferently fertile, and Cloathed with woods, long grass, shrubs, plants, etc. The Mountains or Hills are checquer'd with woods and Lawns; some of the Hills are wholy cover'd with Flourishing Trees; others but thinly, and the few that are upon them are small, and the spot of Lawns or Savannahs are rocky and barren, especially to the Northward, where the Country did not afford or produce near the Vegetation that it does to the Southward, nor were the Trees in the Woods half so tall and stout. The Woods do not produce any great variety of Trees; there are only 2 or 3 sorts that can be called Timber. The largest is the gum Tree, which grows all over the country; the wood of this Tree is too hard and ponderous for most common uses. The Tree which resembles our Pines I saw nowhere in perfection but in Botany Bay; this wood, as I have before observed, is something of the same Nature as American Live Oak; in short, most of the large Trees in this Country are of a hard and ponderous nature, and could not be applied to many purposes. Here are several sorts of the Palm kind, Mangrove, and several other sorts of small Trees and Shrubs quite unknown to me, besides a very great number of Plants hitherto unknown; but these things are wholy out of my way to describe, nor will this be of any loss, since not only plants, but every thing that can be of use to the Learned World will be very accurately described by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander. The Land naturally produces hardly anything fit for Man to eat, and the Natives know nothing of Cultivation. There are, indeed, growing wild in the wood a few sorts of Fruit (the most of them unknown to us), which when ripe do not eat amiss, one sort especially, which we called Apples, being about the size of a Crab Apple it is black and pulpey when ripe, and tastes like a Damson; it hath a large hard stone or Kernel, and grows on Trees or Shrubs.* (* The Black Apple, or Sapota Australis.)

The low-lying land by the sea, and even as far inland as we went, is mostly loose, sandy soil that isn’t very fertile, and is covered with woods, tall grass, shrubs, and various plants. The mountains or hills are dotted with trees and clearings; some hills are fully covered with lush trees, while others have only a few small trees, and the patches of open land or savannas are rocky and barren, especially to the north, where the land doesn't support as much vegetation as to the south, and the trees in the woods aren’t nearly as tall or strong. The woods don’t have a wide variety of trees; there are only two or three types that can be considered timber. The largest is the gum tree, which grows all over the area; the wood of this tree is too hard and heavy for most common uses. The tree that looks like our pines I only saw in Botany Bay; this wood, as I mentioned before, is somewhat similar to American live oak; in summary, most of the large trees in this country are hard and heavy, making them unsuitable for many purposes. There are several types of palm trees, mangroves, and various other small trees and shrubs that I don’t recognize, as well as many plants that are entirely unknown to me; however, I won’t attempt to describe these since Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander will provide detailed accounts of not only plants but everything useful to the learned world. The land hardly produces anything fit for human consumption, and the natives have no knowledge of farming. There are, indeed, a few types of wild fruit growing in the woods (most of which are unknown to us), which, when ripe, aren’t too bad to eat, especially one type that we called apples, about the size of a crab apple. It is black and pulpy when ripe and tastes like a damson; it has a large, hard stone or kernel and grows on trees or shrubs. (*The Black Apple, or Sapota Australis.)

In the Northern parts of the Country, as about Endeavour River, and probably in many other places, the Boggy or watery Lands produce Taara or Cocos,* (* A species of Taro, Colocasia macrorhiza.) which, when properly cultivated, are very good roots, without which they are hardly eatable; the Tops, however, make very good greens.

In the northern parts of the country, around Endeavour River, and likely in many other areas, the wet or boggy lands grow Taara or Cocos,* (* A type of Taro, Colocasia macrorhiza.) which, when cultivated correctly, produce tasty roots that are nearly inedible otherwise; however, the tops make excellent greens.

Land Animals are scarce, so far as we know confin'd to a very few species; all that we saw I have before mentioned. The sort which is in the greatest Plenty is the Kangooroo or Kanguru, so called by the Natives; we saw a good many of them about Endeavour River, but kill'd only 3, which we found very good Eating. Here are likewise Lizards, Snakes, Scorpions, Centapees, etc., but not in any plenty. Tame Animals they have none but Dogs, and of these we saw but one, and therefore must be very scarce, probably they eat them faster than they breed them; we should not have seen this one had he not made us frequent Visits while we lay in Endeavour River.

Land animals are rare, as far as we know, limited to just a few species; all that we observed I have mentioned before. The most abundant type is the kangaroo, called "kanguru" by the natives; we saw quite a few of them around Endeavour River, but only killed three, which we found to be very good eating. There are also lizards, snakes, scorpions, centipedes, etc., but not in large numbers. They have no domesticated animals except for dogs, and we only saw one, so they must be quite scarce; probably, they eat them faster than they can reproduce. We wouldn’t have seen this one if it hadn’t made regular visits while we were at Endeavour River.

The land Fowls are Bustards, Eagles, Hawks, Crows, such as we have in England, Cockatoes of 2 sorts, White and Brown, very beautiful Birds of the Parrot kind, such as Lorryquets, etc., Pidgeons, Doves, Quails, and several sorts of smaller birds. The Sea and Water Fowls are Herons, Boobies, Noddies, Guls, Curlews, Ducks, Pelicans, etc., and when Mr. Banks and Mr. Gore where in the Country, at the head of Endeavour River, they saw and heard in the Night great numbers of Geese. The Sea is indifferently well stocked with fish of Various sorts, such as Sharks, Dog-fish, Rockfish, Mullets, Breams, Cavallies, Mack'rel, old wives, Leather Jackets, Five Fingers,* (* Old wives are Enoploxus Armatus; Leather jackets, Monacanthus; Five fingers, Chilodactylus.) Sting rays, Whip rays, etc., all excellent in their kind. The Shell fish are Oysters of 3 or 4 sorts, viz., Rock Oysters and Mangrove Oysters, which are small, Pearl Oysters and Mud Oysters; these last are the best and Largest I ever saw. Cockles and Clams of several sorts, many of those that are found upon the Reefs are of a prodigious size, Craw fish, Crabs, Muscles, and a variety of other sorts. Here are also upon the Shoals and Reefs great Numbers of the finest Green Turtle in the world, and in the River and Salt Creeks are some Aligators.

The land birds include Bustards, Eagles, Hawks, and Crows, like those we have in England, along with two types of Cockatoos, White and Brown, as well as beautiful Parrot species like Lorryquets. There are also Pigeons, Doves, Quails, and several types of smaller birds. The sea and water birds consist of Herons, Boobies, Noddies, Gulls, Curlews, Ducks, and Pelicans. When Mr. Banks and Mr. Gore were in the country, at the head of Endeavour River, they saw and heard many Geese at night. The sea has a decent variety of fish, including Sharks, Dogfish, Rockfish, Mullets, Breams, Cavallies, Mackerel, Old Wives, Leather Jackets, and Five Fingers. (* Old wives are Enoploxus Armatus; Leather jackets are Monacanthus; Five fingers are Chilodactylus.) There are also Stingrays, Whip rays, and other excellent types. The shellfish include Oysters of three or four kinds: Rock Oysters and Mangrove Oysters, which are small; Pearl Oysters; and Mud Oysters, with the latter being the largest and best I've ever seen. There are Cockles and Clams of various kinds, many of which found on the reefs are enormous, along with Crawfish, Crabs, Mussels, and a variety of others. Additionally, there are great numbers of the finest Green Turtle in the world on the shoals and reefs, and some Alligators can be found in the river and salt creeks.

[Australian Natives.]

[Australian Natives.]

The Natives of this Country are of a middle Stature, streight Bodied and Slender limb'd; their Skins the Colour of Wood soot, their Hair mostly black, some Lank and others curled; they all wear it Cropt Short; their Beards, which are generally black, they likewise crop short, or Singe off. There features are far from being disagreeable, and their Voices are soft and Tunable. They go quite Naked, both Men and Women, without any manner of Cloathing whatever; even the Women do not so much as cover their privities, altho' None of us was ever very near any of their Women, one Gentleman excepted, yet we are all of us as well satisfied of this as if we had lived among them. Notwithstanding we had several interviews with the Men while we lay in Endeavour River, yet, wether through Jealousy or disregard, they never brought any of their women along with them to the Ship, but always left them on the Opposite side of the River, where we had frequent Opportunities viewing them thro' our Glasses. They wear as Ornaments, Necklaces made of Shells, Bracelets, or Hoops, about their Arms, made mostly of Hair Twisted and made like a Cord Hoop; these they wear tight about the upper parts of their Arms, and some have Girdles made in the same manner. The Men wear a bone, about 3 or 4 Inches long and a finger's thick, run thro' the Bridge* (* The cartilage of the nostril. Banks mentions that the bluejackets called this queer ornament the "spritsail yard.") of their Nose; they likewise have holes in their Ears for Ear Rings, but we never saw them wear any; neither are all the other Ornaments wore in Common, for we have seen as many without as with them. Some of these we saw on Possession Island wore breast plates, which we supposed were made of Mother of Pearl Shells. Many of them paint their Bodies and faces with a Sort of White paste or Pigment; this they apply different ways, each according to his fancy.

The Indigenous people of this country are of average height, with straight bodies and slender limbs; their skin is the color of charcoal, and their hair is mostly black, some straight and others curly. They all keep their hair cropped short, and their generally black beards are also trimmed short or singed off. Their features are quite pleasant, and their voices are soft and melodic. They go entirely naked, both men and women, without any clothing at all; even the women don’t cover their private parts, although none of us got too close to any of their women, one gentleman aside. Still, we are all certain of this as if we had lived among them. Despite several encounters with the men while we stayed at Endeavour River, whether out of jealousy or indifference, they never brought any of their women to the ship, always leaving them on the opposite side of the river, where we often had the chance to observe them through our glasses. They wear ornaments like necklaces made of shells, and bracelets or hoops around their arms, mostly made from twisted hair fashioned into cord-like hoops; they wear these tightly around the upper parts of their arms, and some have girdles made in a similar way. The men wear a bone about 3 or 4 inches long and as thick as a finger, which passes through the bridge* (*The cartilage of the nostril. Banks notes that the bluejackets called this peculiar ornament the "spritsail yard.") of their nose; they also have holes in their ears for earrings, but we never saw them wearing any. Not all the other ornaments are commonly worn, as we observed many with and without them. Some of those we saw on Possession Island wore breastplates, which we assumed were made from mother-of-pearl shells. Many of them paint their bodies and faces with a kind of white paste or pigment, applying it in various ways according to their personal preference.

Their offensive weapons are Darts; some are only pointed at one end, others are barb'd, some with wood, others with Stings of rays, and some with Sharks' Teeth, etc.; these last are stuck fast on with Gum. They throw the Darts with only one hand, in the doing of which they make use of a piece of wood about 3 feet long, made thin like the blade of a Cutlass, with a little hook at one End to take hold of the End of the dart, and at the other end is fix'd a thin piece of bone about 3 or 4 Inches long; the use of this is, I believe, to keep the dart steady, and to make it quit the hand in a proper direction. By the helps of these throwing sticks, as we call them, they will hit a mark at the Distance of 40 or 50 yards, with almost, if not as much, Certainty as we can do with a Musquet, and much more so than with a ball.* (* The invention of these throwing sticks, and of the Boomerang, is sufficient to prove the intelligence of the Australian aborigines.) These throwing sticks we at first took for wooden swords, and perhaps on some occasions they may use them as such; that is, when all their darts are expended. Be this as it may, they never Travel without both them and their Darts, not for fear of Enemies, but for killing of Game, etc., as I shall show hereafter. There defensive weapons are Targets, made of wood; but these we never saw used but once in Botany Bay.

Their offensive weapons are darts; some are pointed at one end, others have barbs, some are made of wood, others have razor-sharp tips, and some are fitted with shark teeth, etc.; the last are securely attached with gum. They throw the darts with one hand, using a stick about 3 feet long, shaped like a cutlass blade, with a little hook on one end to grip the dart and a thin piece of bone about 3 or 4 inches long fixed on the other end; I believe this helps keep the dart steady and makes it fly straight. With these throwing sticks, as we call them, they can hit a target at a distance of 40 or 50 yards with almost as much accuracy as we can with a musket, and much more than with a ball. (* The invention of these throwing sticks, and of the boomerang, clearly shows the intelligence of the Australian aborigines.) Initially, we thought these sticks were wooden swords, and they might use them as such when they run out of darts. Regardless, they never travel without both their throwing sticks and darts, not out of fear of enemies, but for hunting game, etc., as I will explain later. Their defensive weapons are wooden shields; however, we only saw them used once in Botany Bay.

I do not look upon them to be a warlike people; on the contrary, I think them a Timerous and inoffensive race, no ways inclined to Cruelty, as appear'd from their behaviour to one of our people in Endeavour River, which I have before mentioned, neither are they very numerous. They live in small parties along by the Sea Coast, the banks of Lakes, Rivers, Creeks, etc. They seem to have no fixed habitation, but move about from place to place like wild beasts in search of Food, and, I believe, depend wholy upon the Success of the present day for their Subsistance. They have wooden fish Gigs, with 2, 3, or 4 prongs, each very ingeniously made, with which they strike fish. We have also seen them strike both fish and birds with their Darts. With these they likewise kill other Animals; they have also wooden Harpoons for striking Turtle, but of these I believe they get but few, except at the seasons they come ashore to lay. In short, these people live wholy by fishing and hunting, but mostly by the former, for we never saw one Inch of Cultivated land in the whole Country. They know, however, the use of Taara, and sometimes eat them; we do not know that they Eat anything raw, but roast or broil all they eat on slow small fires. Their Houses are mean, small Hovels, not much bigger than an Oven, made of Peices of Sticks, Bark, Grass, etc., and even these are seldom used but in the Wet seasons, for in the daytimes we know they as often sleep in the Open Air as anywhere else. We have seen many of their Sleeping places, where there has been only some branches or peices of Bark, grass, etc., about a foot high on the Windward side.

I don’t see them as a warlike people; on the contrary, I find them to be a timid and harmless group, not inclined to cruelty, as demonstrated by their behavior towards one of our people at Endeavour River, which I mentioned earlier. They’re not very numerous either. They live in small groups along the coastline, the banks of lakes, rivers, creeks, and so on. They don’t have permanent homes but move around like wild animals in search of food, relying entirely on the success of each day for their survival. They have wooden fish spears with 2, 3, or 4 prongs, each crafted very skillfully, with which they catch fish. We’ve also seen them catch both fish and birds with their darts. They use these tools to hunt other animals as well; they have wooden harpoons for catching turtles, but they only get a few of those, mainly during the seasons when the turtles come ashore to lay eggs. In short, these people live entirely off fishing and hunting, but mostly fishing, since we never saw any cultivated land in the entire country. They do know how to use taro and sometimes eat it; we don’t know if they eat anything raw, but they cook everything over small, slow fires. Their homes are simple, small huts, not much bigger than an oven, made from sticks, bark, grass, and so on, and even those are rarely used except during the wet seasons, as we’ve seen them often sleeping outside during the day. We have come across many of their sleeping spots, where there were only a few branches or pieces of bark and grass, about a foot high on the windward side.

[Australian Canoes.]

[Australian Kayaks.]

Their Canoes are as mean as can be conceived, especially to the Southward, where all we saw were made of one peice of the Bark of Trees about 12 or 14 feet long, drawn or Tied together at one end. As I have before made mention, these Canoes will not Carry above 2 people, in general there is never more than one in them; but, bad as they are, they do very well for the purpose they apply them to, better than if they were larger, for as they draw but little water they go in them upon the Mud banks, and pick up Shell fish, etc., without going out of the Canoe. The few Canoes we saw to the Northward were made out of a Log of wood hollow'd out, about 14 feet long and very narrow, with outriggers; these will carry 4 people. During our whole stay in Endeavour River we saw but one Canoe, and had great reason to think that the few people that resided about that place had no more; this one served them to cross the River and to go a Fishing in, etc. They attend the Shoals, and flatts, one where or another, every day at low water to gather Shell fish, or whatever they can find to eat, and have each a little bag to put what they get in; this bag is made of net work. They have not the least knowledge of Iron or any other Metal that we know of; their working Tools must be made of Stone, bone, and Shells; those made of the former are very bad, if I may judge from one of their Adzes I have seen.

Their canoes are as basic as you can imagine, especially to the south, where all we saw were made from a single piece of tree bark, about 12 to 14 feet long, tied together at one end. As I mentioned before, these canoes generally hold no more than two people, and usually there's just one person in them. But, terrible as they are, they work well for what they need them for; they're actually better than if they were larger. Since they don’t draw much water, they can navigate through mud banks and collect shellfish and other food without leaving the canoe. The few canoes we saw to the north were made from hollowed-out logs, about 14 feet long and very narrow, with outriggers; these can hold four people. During our entire stay at Endeavour River, we only saw one canoe, which made us think that the few people living there had no more than that. This canoe was used to cross the river and go fishing. They check the shoals and flats every day at low tide to gather shellfish or whatever they can find to eat, and each has a little bag to store their catch in; this bag is made from netting. They have no knowledge of iron or any other metals that we know of; their tools must be made from stone, bone, or shells; those made from stone are quite poor quality, based on one of their adzes I saw.

Bad and mean as their Canoes are, they at Certain seasons of the Year (so far as we know) go in them to the most distant Islands which lay upon the Coast, for we never landed upon one but what we saw signs of People having been there before. We were surprized to find Houses, etc., upon Lizard Island, which lies 5 Leagues from the nearest part of the Main; a distance we before thought they could not have gone in their Canoes.

Bad and mean as their canoes are, they, at certain times of the year (as far as we know), use them to reach the most distant islands along the coast, because whenever we landed on one, we noticed signs that people had been there before. We were surprised to find houses and other structures on Lizard Island, which is located 5 leagues from the nearest part of the mainland; a distance we previously thought they couldn’t have traveled in their canoes.

The Coast of this Country, at least so much of it as lays to the Northward of 25 degrees of Latitude, abounds with a great Number of fine bays and Harbours, which are Shelter'd from all winds; but the Country itself, so far as we know, doth not produce any one thing that can become an Article in Trade to invite Europeans to fix a settlement upon it. However, this Eastern side is not that barren and miserable country that Dampier and others have described the Western side to be. We are to consider that we see this country in the pure state of nature; the Industry of Man has had nothing to do with any part of it, and yet we find all such things as nature hath bestow'd upon it in a flourishing state. In this Extensive Country it can never be doubted but what most sorts of Grain, Fruit, roots, etc., of every kind would flourish here were they once brought hither, planted and Cultivated by the hands of Industry; and here are Provender for more Cattle, at all seasons of the Year, than ever can be brought into the Country.* (* It says a good deal for Cook's penetration that he wrote like this, for the coast of Australia is not promising, especially in the dry season; and coming as he did from the more apparently fertile countries of Tahiti and New Zealand, Australia must have appeared but a barren land.) When one considers the Proximity of this Country with New Guinea, New Britain, and several other Islands which produce Cocoa Nutts and many other fruits proper for the support of man, it seems strange that they should not long ago be Transplanted here; by its not being done it should seem that the Natives of this Country have no commerce with their Neighbours, the New Guineans.* (* The climate is too dry for the cocoanut palm.) It is very probable that they are a different people, and speak a different Language. For the advantage of such as want to Clear up this point I shall add a small Vocabulary of a few Words in the New Holland Language which we learnt when in Endeavour River.* (* The languages of the different tribes differ very much. This results from the continual state of war in which they live, as they have no communication the one with the other.)

The coast of this country, at least the part north of 25 degrees latitude, is filled with many beautiful bays and harbors that are protected from all winds. However, as far as we know, the land itself doesn’t produce anything that could become a trade product to attract Europeans to settle here. Still, this eastern part isn’t the barren and miserable place that Dampier and others have described the western side to be. We must consider that we are seeing this land in its pure natural state; human efforts have had no influence on any part of it, and yet we find everything that nature has provided in a thriving condition. In this vast country, it’s clear that various grains, fruits, roots, and other types could thrive here if they were introduced, planted, and cultivated by human hands. There is enough forage for more livestock here throughout the year than could ever be brought into the country. (*It says a lot about Cook's insight that he wrote this, since the coast of Australia doesn’t seem very promising, especially in the dry season; coming from the more fertile regions of Tahiti and New Zealand, Australia would have seemed quite barren.) When considering the closeness of this land to New Guinea, New Britain, and several other islands that produce coconuts and many other fruits suitable for human consumption, it seems odd that they haven’t been brought here long ago. The fact that this hasn't happened suggests that the natives of this country have no trade or contact with their neighbors, the New Guineans. (*The climate is too dry for coconut palms.) It’s likely that they are a different people with their own distinct language. To help those who want to clarify this point, I will provide a small vocabulary of a few words in the New Holland language that we learned while at Endeavour River. (*The languages of different tribes vary greatly due to the continuous state of warfare in which they live, as they have no communication with one another.)

COLUMN 1: ENGLISH. COLUMN 2: NEW HOLLAND.

COLUMN 1: ENGLISH. COLUMN 2: NEW HOLLAND.

The Head : Whageegee. The Hair of the head : Morye or More. The Eyes : Meul. The Ears : Melea. The Lips : Yembe or Jembi. The Teeth : Mulere or Moile. The Chinn : Jaeal. The Beard : Waller. The Tongue : Unjar. The Nose : Bonjoo. The Naval : Toolpoor or Julpur. The Penis : Keveil or Kerrial. The Scrotum : Coonal or Kunnol. The Arms : Aw or Awl. The Hand : Marigal. The Thumb : Eboorbalga. The Fore, Middle and Ring fingers : Egalbaiga. Little Finger : Nakil or Eboonakil. The Thighs : Coman. The Knees : Ponga. The Legs : Peegoorgo. The Feet : Edamal. The Nails : Kolke or Kulke. A Stone : Walba. Sand : Joo'wal, Yowall, or Joralba. A Rope or Line : Goorgo or Gurka. Fire : Maianang or Meanang. The Sun : Galan or Gallan. The Sky : Kere or Kearre. A Father : Dunjo. A Son : Jumurre. A Man : Bamma or Ba ma. A Dog : Cotta or Kota. A Lorryquet : Perpere or Pier-pier. A Cocatoo : Wanda. Male Turtle : Poonja or Poinja. Female : Mamingo. A great Cockle : Moenjo or Moingo. Cocos Yams : Maracotu (?). A Canoe : Maragan.

The Head: Whageegee. The Hair of the head: Morye or More. The Eyes: Meul. The Ears: Melea. The Lips: Yembe or Jembi. The Teeth: Mulere or Moile. The Chin: Jaeal. The Beard: Waller. The Tongue: Unjar. The Nose: Bonjoo. The Navel: Toolpoor or Julpur. The Penis: Keveil or Kerrial. The Scrotum: Coonal or Kunnol. The Arms: Aw or Awl. The Hand: Marigal. The Thumb: Eboorbalga. The Fore, Middle and Ring fingers: Egalbaiga. Little Finger: Nakil or Eboonakil. The Thighs: Coman. The Knees: Ponga. The Legs: Peegoorgo. The Feet: Edamal. The Nails: Kolke or Kulke. A Stone: Walba. Sand: Joo'wal, Yowall, or Joralba. A Rope or Line: Goorgo or Gurka. Fire: Maianang or Meanang. The Sun: Galan or Gallan. The Sky: Kere or Kearre. A Father: Dunjo. A Son: Jumurre. A Man: Bamma or Ba ma. A Dog: Cotta or Kota. A Lorryquet: Perpere or Pier-pier. A Cockatoo: Wanda. Male Turtle: Poonja or Poinja. Female: Mamingo. A great Cockle: Moenjo or Moingo. Cocos Yams: Maracotu (?). A Canoe: Maragan.

[Australian Natives.]

Australian Natives

From what I have said of the Natives of New Holland they may appear to some to be the most wretched People upon Earth; but in reality they are far more happier than we Europeans, being wholy unacquainted not only with the Superfluous, but with the necessary Conveniences so much sought after in Europe; they are happy in not knowing the use of them. They live in a Tranquility which is not disturbed by the Inequality of Condition. The earth and Sea of their own accord furnishes them with all things necessary for Life. They covet not Magnificient Houses, Household-stuff, etc.; they live in a Warm and fine Climate, and enjoy every wholesome Air, so that they have very little need of Cloathing; and this they seem to be fully sencible of, for many to whom we gave Cloth, etc., left it carelessly upon the Sea beach and in the Woods, as a thing they had no manner of use for; in short, they seem'd to set no Value upon anything we gave them, nor would they ever part with anything of their own for any one Article we could offer them. This, in my opinion, Argues that they think themselves provided with all the necessarys of Life, and that they have no Superfluities.* (* The native Australians may be happy in their condition, but they are without doubt among the lowest of mankind. Confirmed cannibals, they lose no opportunity of gratifying their love of human flesh. Mothers will kill and eat their own children, and the women again are often mercilessly illtreated by their lords and masters. There are no chiefs, and the land is divided into sections, occupied by families, who consider everything in their district as their own. Internecine war exists between the different tribes, which are very small. Their treachery, which is unsurpassed, is simply an outcome of their savage ideas, and in their eyes is a form of independence which resents any intrusion on THEIR land, THEIR wild animals, and THEIR rights generally. In their untutored state they therefore consider that any method of getting rid of the invader is proper. Both sexes, as Cook observed, are absolutely nude, and lead a wandering life, with no fixed abode, subsisting on roots, fruits, and such living things as they can catch. Nevertheless, although treated by the coarser order of colonists as wild beasts to be extirpated, those who have studied them have formed favourable opinions of their intelligence. The more savage side of their disposition being, however, so very apparent, it is not astonishing that, brought into contact with white settlers, who equally consider that they have a right to settle, the aborigines are rapidly disappearing.)

From what I've shared about the Indigenous people of New Holland, some might see them as the most unfortunate people on Earth; however, they are actually much happier than we Europeans, as they are completely unaware not just of excess, but also of the essential comforts so highly sought after in Europe. They find happiness in not knowing how to use these things. They live in a peace that isn't disrupted by disparities in status. The earth and sea provide them with everything they need for life. They don’t crave luxurious homes or possessions; they enjoy a warm, pleasant climate and fresh air, so they require very little clothing. They seem fully aware of this, as many people we gave cloth to left it carelessly on the beach and in the woods, as if it had no use for them. In short, they seem to place no value on anything we gave them and wouldn't trade anything of theirs for any single item we offered. This, in my opinion, suggests that they believe they have all the necessities of life and that they do not have excess. (*The native Australians may be happy in their condition, but they are undoubtedly among the lowest of mankind. They are known cannibals, taking every opportunity to satisfy their taste for human flesh. Mothers will kill and eat their own children, and women are often cruelly treated by their husbands. There are no chiefs; the land is divided into sections occupied by families, who claim everything in their area as their own. Inter-tribal warfare exists among the very small tribes. Their unmatched treachery stems from their savage mindset and they view it as a form of independence that rejects any intrusion on THEIR land, THEIR wild animals, and THEIR rights in general. In their untamed state, they believe any means of removing an invader is acceptable. Both men and women, as Cook noted, are completely nude and lead a nomadic lifestyle, without a permanent home, living off roots, fruits, and whatever animals they can catch. Nonetheless, even though they are treated by the rougher colonists as wild beasts to be eradicated, those who have studied them tend to have favorable views of their intelligence. However, their more savage tendencies are quite evident, so it's not surprising that, when confronted with white settlers who believe they have a right to settle, the Indigenous people are quickly vanishing.)

I shall conclude the account of this Country with a few observations on the Currents and Tides upon the Coast, because I have mentioned in the Course of this Journal that the latter hath sometimes set one way and sometimes another, which I shall Endeavour to account for in the best manner I can. From the Latitude of 32 degrees, or above downwards to Sandy Cape in the Latitude of 24 degrees 46 minutes, we constantly found a Current setting to the Southward at the rate of 10 or 15 Miles per Day, more or less, according to the distance we were from the land, for it runs stronger in shore than in the Offing. All this time I had not been able to satisfy myself whether the flood-tide came from the Southward, Eastward, or Northward, but judged it to come from the South-East; but the first time we anchor'd upon the coast, which was in the Latitude of 24 degrees 30 minutes, and about 10 Leagues to the South-East of Bustard Bay, we found there the flood to come from the North-West. On the Contrary, 30 Leagues further to the North-West, on the South side of Keppel Bay, we found the Flood to come from the East, and at the Northern part of the said Bay we found it come from the Northward, but with a much Slower Motion than the Easterly Tide. Again, on the East side of the Bay of Inlets we found the flood to set strong to the Westward as far as the Op'ning of Broad sound, but on the North side of that sound the flood come with a Slow motion from the North-West; and when at Anchor before Repulse bay we found the flood to come from the northward. We need only admit the flood tide to come from the East or South-East, and then all these seeming Contradictions will be found to be conformable to reason and experience. It is well known that where there are deep Inlets, large Creeks, etc., into low lands, that it is not occasioned by fresh water Rivers; there is a very great indraught of the Flood Tide, the direction of which will be determin'd according to the possition or direction of the Coast which forms the Entrance into such Inlets; and this direction the Tide must follow, let it be ever so contrary to their general Course out at Sea, and where the Tides are weak, as they are in general upon this Coast, a large Inlet will, if I may so call it, attract the Flood tide for many Leagues. Any one need only cast an Eye over the Chart to be made sencible of what I have advanced. To the Northward of Whitsundays Passage there are few or no large Inlets, and consequently the Flood sets to the Northward or North-West, according to the direction of the Coast, and Ebb the Contrary; but this is to be understood at a little distance from land, or where there is no Creeks or Inlets, for where such are, be they ever so small, they draw the flood from the Southward, Eastward, and Northward, and, as I found by experience, while we lay in Endeavour River.* (* Cook's reasoning on the course of the flood stream is quite sound.) Another thing I have observed upon the Tides which ought to be remarked, which is that there is only one high Tide in 24 Hours, and that is the night Tide. On the Spring Tides the difference between the perpendicular rise of the night and day Tides is not less than 3 feet, which is a great deal where the Tides are so inconsiderable, as they are here.* (* This difference in the heights of consecutive tides is termed the diurnal inequality. It results from the tide wave being made up of a large number of undulations, some caused by the moon, some by the sun; some occurring twice a day, others only once. It occurs in all parts of the world, but is inconspicuous on the coasts of Europe. In Australia it is very marked, and occasions the night tides to be the highest at one time of the year, when the Endeavour was on the coast, and the day tides at the other. There are places on the east coast of Australia where the range of the tide is very great, but Cook did not anchor at any of them.) This inequality of the Tide I did not observe till we run ashore; perhaps it is much more so to the Northward than to the Southward. After we had got within the Reefs the second time we found the Tides more considerable than at any time before, except in the Bay of Inlets. It may be owing to the water being confin'd in Channels between the Shoals, but the flood always set to the North-West to the extremity of New Wales, from thence West and South-West into the India Seas.

I’ll wrap up my account of this country with some observations on the currents and tides along the coast. In the course of this journal, I mentioned that the tides sometimes flow one way and sometimes another, and I’ll try to explain this as best as I can. From latitude 32 degrees down to Sandy Cape at latitude 24 degrees 46 minutes, we consistently found a current moving southward at a speed of 10 to 15 miles per day, give or take, depending on how far we were from the land, as it runs stronger close to shore than further out. Until then, I couldn't determine whether the flood tide came from the south, east, or north, but I suspected it came from the southeast. However, when we first anchored on the coast at latitude 24 degrees 30 minutes, about 10 leagues southeast of Bustard Bay, we found the flood coming from the northwest. Conversely, 30 leagues further northwest, on the south side of Keppel Bay, we noticed the flood coming from the east, and at the northern part of that bay, it came from the north, though at a much slower pace than the easterly tide. Again, on the east side of the Bay of Inlets, we observed the flood strongly pushing west as far as the opening of Broad Sound, but on the north side of that sound, the flood came in more slowly from the northwest; and when at anchor in front of Repulse Bay, we found the flood coming from the north. If we consider the flood tide coming from the east or southeast, all these apparent contradictions will align with reason and experience. It’s well known that in areas with deep inlets or large creeks leading into lowlands, the significant influx of the flood tide isn’t caused by freshwater rivers; instead, the direction of the flood tide will depend on the positioning of the coast that forms the entrance to such inlets. The tide must follow this direction, even if it contradicts its general flow at sea, and where the tides are weak—particularly along this coast—a large inlet will attract the flood tide for many leagues. Just take a look at the chart to see what I mean. North of Whitsunday Passage, there are few or no large inlets, and as a result, the flood moves to the north or northwest, depending on the direction of the coast, and the ebb flows the opposite way. However, this applies at some distance from the land or where there are no creeks or inlets; where such features exist—even if they are small—they draw the flood from the south, east, and north, as I discovered while we were in Endeavour River. Another important point about the tides that should be noted is that there is only one high tide every 24 hours, which occurs at night. During spring tides, the difference between the rise of the night and day tides is no less than 3 feet, which is significant considering how small the tides are here. I didn’t notice this difference in the heights of consecutive tides until we ran ashore; it might be much more pronounced to the north than to the south. After we got past the reefs for the second time, we found the tides more significant than at any earlier point, except in the Bay of Inlets. This might be due to the water being confined in channels between the shoals, but the flood consistently flowed northwest towards the far end of New South Wales, then west and southwest into the Indian Seas.

[Historical Notes, East Coast of Australia.]

[Historical Notes, East Coast of Australia.]

HISTORICAL NOTES ON THE EAST COAST OF AUSTRALIA.

HISTORICAL NOTES ON THE EAST COAST OF AUSTRALIA.

PREVIOUS to Cook's visit no European, so far as is known, had ever sighted the East Coast of Australia, or, as it was then called, New Holland. The Dutch had examined and mapped the shores from the Gulf of Carpentaria on the north round by the west to Van Dieman's Land or Tasmania, but had not decided whether the latter was a part of the mainland or no. Dampier, in 1699, had the intention of passing south to explore the unknown eastern shore, but never carried it out, confining his attention to the northern part of the west coast, with which, and with good reason, he was not favourably impressed.

Before Cook's visit, no European, as far as anyone knows, had ever seen the East Coast of Australia, or as it was then called, New Holland. The Dutch had explored and mapped the shores from the Gulf of Carpentaria in the north around to Van Dieman's Land, or Tasmania, in the west, but they hadn’t determined if the latter was part of the mainland or not. Dampier, in 1699, planned to travel south to explore the unknown eastern shore but never went through with it, focusing instead on the northern part of the west coast, which he had good reason to find unimpressive.

On all maps of the time, the east coast, from Tasmania to the north, was shown as a dotted and more or less straight line, Tasmania being joined at the south, and generally New Guinea at the north.

On all maps from that time, the east coast, stretching from Tasmania to the north, was depicted as a dotted and mostly straight line, with Tasmania connected at the south and typically New Guinea at the north.

There is indeed one manuscript known as the Dauphin's Map, a copy of which is in the British Museum, of the date of about 1540, which shows a certain amount of the north-east coast, and has been thought by some to prove that some one had visited it. But an inspection of it shows that it is far more probably a case of imaginative coast drawing, such as occurs in other places in the same map, and in many others of the same and later dates, and there is certainly no record of any voyage to this coast.

There is one manuscript called the Dauphin's Map, a copy of which is in the British Museum, dating back to around 1540. It depicts a portion of the northeast coast and some have suggested that it proves someone visited that area. However, upon closer examination, it’s more likely an example of creative map-making, like what is seen in other parts of the same map and in many others from the same and later periods, and there is no record of any voyage to this coast.

After Cook's exploration it remained unvisited until 1788, when, owing mainly to Banks' influence, Botany Bay was pitched upon as a convict settlement, and a squadron, consisting of H.M.S. Sirius, the Supply brig, 3 storeships, and 6 transports, under the command of Captain Arthur Phillip, R.N., which had sailed from England on May 13th, 1787, arrived in that bay on January 18th, 1788, but immediately moved into Port Jackson, where the settlement of Sydney was formed.

After Cook's exploration, it was left untouched until 1788 when, largely due to Banks' influence, Botany Bay was chosen as a convict settlement. A squadron made up of H.M.S. Sirius, the Supply brig, three storeships, and six transports, commanded by Captain Arthur Phillip, R.N., set sail from England on May 13th, 1787, and arrived in the bay on January 18th, 1788. However, they quickly moved to Port Jackson, where the settlement of Sydney was established.

The early history of the Colony was one of struggle and starvation, and it was many years before any prosperity was attained. In 1839 the deportation of convicts ceased, but it was not until 1851, when gold was found, that free settlers in any large number came to the Colony.

The early history of the Colony was filled with hardships and hunger, and it took many years before any success was achieved. In 1839, the transportation of convicts ended, but it wasn't until 1851, when gold was discovered, that a significant number of free settlers arrived in the Colony.

Queensland, formerly the northern part of New South Wales, was formed a separate Colony in 1859.

Queensland, which used to be the northern part of New South Wales, became a separate colony in 1859.

A white population of about 1,500,000 now inhabits the eastern part of Australia, first explored by Cook, and their numbers are rapidly increasing.

A white population of around 1,500,000 now lives in the eastern part of Australia, which was first explored by Cook, and their numbers are growing quickly.

Although the products of the Colonies are mainly agricultural and mineral, a very large proportion of this population are in the large towns.

Although the products of the colonies are mostly agricultural and mineral, a significant portion of the population lives in large towns.

Sydney contains 230,000, Newcastle 20,000, Brisbane 55,000, Rockhampton 13,000.

Sydney has a population of 230,000, Newcastle has 20,000, Brisbane has 55,000, and Rockhampton has 13,000.

Wool, one of the staple products, is obtained from some 80,000,000 sheep, which, as Cook foresaw, have thriven well; and with 8,000,000 head of cattle supply another export in the shape of frozen meat. Coal and other minerals employ a large number of people, and the total value of exports amounts to about 24,000,000 pounds.

Wool, a key product, comes from about 80,000,000 sheep, which, as Cook predicted, have done really well; along with 8,000,000 cattle, they contribute to another export in the form of frozen meat. Coal and other minerals provide jobs for many people, and the total value of exports is around 24,000,000 pounds.

The uninhabited shores and untracked seas of Cook's time, only 120 years ago, are thus now teeming with life and trade; and it is no wonder that the name of the great explorer is more venerated, and the memory of his deeds is more fresh, in the Colonies than in the Mother country that sent him forth to find new fields for British enterprise.

The deserted coastlines and unexplored waters of Cook's era, just 120 years ago, are now bustling with life and commerce; it’s no surprise that the name of this great explorer is more respected, and the memory of his accomplishments is more vivid, in the Colonies than in the Mother Country that sent him out to discover new opportunities for British enterprise.


CHAPTER 9. FROM TORRES STRAIT TO BATAVIA.

[August 1770.]

[August 1770.]

FRIDAY, 24th. In the P.M. had light Airs from the South-South-West, with which, after leaving Booby Island, as before mentioned, we steer'd West-North-West until 5 o'clock, when it fell Calm, and the Tide of Ebb which sets to the North-East soon after making, we Anchor'd in 8 fathoms soft sandy bottom, Booby Island bearing South 50 degrees East, distant 5 miles; Prince of Wales Isles extending from North-East by North to South 55 degrees East. There appear'd to be an open clear passage between these Islands extending from North 64 degrees East to East by North. At 1/2 past 5 in the morning in purchasing* (* Weighing the anchor.) the Anchor, the Cable parted about 8 or 10 fathoms from the Anchor; I immediately order'd another Anchor to be let go, which brought the ship up before she had drove a cable's length from the Buoy; after this we carried out a Kedge, and warped the ship nearer to it, and then endeavour'd to sweep the Anchor with a Hawser, but miss'd it, and broke away the Buoy rope.* (* The kedge is a small anchor. Sweeping is dragging the middle of a rope, or hawser, held at the two ends from two boats some distance apart, along the bottom, with the object of catching the fluke of the anchor as it lies on the bottom, and so recovering it. It is a long and wearisome operation if the bottom is uneven. Cook, however, having already lost one of his large anchors, could not afford to leave this without an effort.) We made several Attempts afterwards, but did not succeed. While the Boats were thus employed we hove up the Kedge Anchor, it being of no more use. At Noon Latitude observed 10 degrees 30 minutes South. Winds at North-East, a fresh breeze; the Flood Tide here comes from the same Quarter.

FRIDAY, 24th. In the afternoon, there were light breezes from the South-Southwest. After leaving Booby Island, as mentioned before, we headed West-Northwest until 5 o'clock when it calmed down, and the ebb tide, which moves to the Northeast, started. We anchored in 8 fathoms of soft sandy bottom, with Booby Island bearing South 50 degrees East, 5 miles away, and Prince of Wales Isles stretching from Northeast by North to South 55 degrees East. There seemed to be a clear open passage between these islands extending from North 64 degrees East to East by North. At 5:30 in the morning, while weighing the anchor, the cable snapped about 8 or 10 fathoms from the anchor. I quickly ordered another anchor to be dropped, which stopped the ship before it drifted a cable’s length from the buoy. After that, we set out a kedge and pulled the ship closer to it, then tried to sweep the anchor with a hawser but missed and broke the buoy rope. We attempted several times afterward but were unsuccessful. While the boats were working on this, we lifted the kedge anchor since it was no longer useful. At noon, we observed latitude 10 degrees 30 minutes South. The winds were from the Northeast, a fresh breeze, and the flood tide here comes from the same direction.

Saturday, 25th. Winds at North-East and East-North-East, a gentle breeze. Being resolv'd not to leave the Anchor behind while there remain'd the least probability of getting of it, after dinner I sent the Boats again to sweep for it first with a small line, which succeeded, and now we know'd where it lay we found it no very hard matter to sweep it with a Hawser. This done, we hove the Ship up to it by the same Hawser, but just as it was almost up and down the Hawser slip'd, and left us all to do over again. By this time it was dark, and obliged us to leave off until daylight in the morning, when we sweep'd it again, and hove it up to the bows, and by 8 o'Clock weigh'd the other anchor, got under sail, and stood away North-West, having a fresh breeze at East-North-East. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 10 degrees 18 minutes South, Longitude 219 degrees 39 minutes West, having no land in sight, but about 2 miles to the Southward of us lay a Shoal,* (* Cook Reef.) on which the Sea broke, and I believe a part of it dry. At low Water it extended North-West and South-East, and might be about 4 or 5 Leagues in Circuit; depth of Water at this time and since we weigh'd 9 fathoms.

Saturday, 25th. Winds from the North-East and East-North-East, a gentle breeze. Determined not to leave the anchor behind as long as there was even a slight chance of retrieving it, I sent the boats out again after lunch to search for it first with a small line, which worked. Now that we knew where it was, we found it pretty straightforward to sweep it with a larger line. Once that was done, we pulled the ship towards it using the same line, but just as we were almost there, the line slipped, forcing us to start all over again. By this time, it was dark, and we had to stop until daylight in the morning. When morning came, we swept for it again and pulled it up to the front of the ship. By 8 o'clock, we raised the other anchor, set sail, and headed North-West, with a fresh breeze from the East-North-East. At noon, our position was 10 degrees 18 minutes South latitude and 219 degrees 39 minutes West longitude, with no land in sight. However, about 2 miles to the south, there was a shoal (*Cook Reef*) where the sea was breaking, and I believe part of it was above water. At low tide, it stretched North-West to South-East and was around 4 or 5 leagues in circumference; the depth of water at that time since we weighed anchor was 9 fathoms.

TRACK OF ENDEAVOUR FROM TORRES STRAIT TO JAVA. AUGUST AND SEPTEMBER 1770.

 

Sunday, 26th. Fresh breezes at East in standing to the North-West. We began to Shoalden our water from 9 to 7 fathoms, and at 1/2 past one, having run 11 Miles since Noon, the boat which was a head made the signal for Shoal Water, immediately upon which we let go an Anchor, and brought the Ship up with the sails standing as the boats was but a little way ahead, having but just relieved the Crew, and at same time we saw from the Ship Shoal Water* (* Cook Shoal.) in a manner all round us, and both wind and Tide setting upon it. We lay in 6 fathoms with the Ship, but upon sounding about her found hardly 2 fathoms, a very rocky bottom, not much above 1/2 a cable's length from us from the east round by the North and West as far as South-West, so that there was no way to get clear but the way we came. This was one of the many Fortunate Escapes we have had from Shipwreck, for it was near high water, and there run a short cockling sea that would soon have bulged the Ship had she struck. These Shoals that lay a fathom or 2 under Water are the most dangerous of any, for they do not shew themselves until you are close upon them, and then the water upon them looks brown like the reflection of dark clouds. Between 3 and 4 the Ebb began to make, when I sent the Master to sound to the Southward and South Westward, and in the meantime, as the Ship tended,* (* Swung to the tide.) hove up the Anchor, and with a little Sail stood to the Southward and afterwards edged away to the Westward, and got once more out of danger, where at sun set we Anchor'd in 10 fathoms Sandy bottom. Having a fresh of wind at East-South-East, at 6 o'clock in the morning we weighed and stood West, with a fresh of wind at East, having first sent a boat ahead to sound. I did intend to have steer'd North-West until we had made the Coast of New Guinea, designing if Possible to touch upon that Coast, but the meeting with these Shoals last night made me Alter the Course to West, in hopes of meeting with fewer dangers and deeper Water; and this we found, for by Noon we had deepned our water gradually to 17 fathoms, and this time we were by observation in the Latitude of 10 degrees 10 minutes South, Longitude 220 degrees 12 minutes West. Course and distance sail'd since yesterday at noon North 76 degrees West, 11 Leagues, no land in sight.

Sunday, 26th. Fresh breezes from the East and heading to the North-West. We started to decrease our water depth from 9 to 7 fathoms, and at 1:30 PM, having traveled 11 miles since noon, the boat in front signaled for shallow water. Immediately, we dropped anchor and brought the ship to a stop with the sails still up because the boat was only a short distance ahead, just having relieved the crew. At the same time, we noticed from the ship shallow water (Cook Shoal) all around us, with both wind and tide pushing towards it. We were in 6 fathoms with the ship, but when we sounded around her, we found hardly 2 fathoms, with a very rocky bottom, not much more than half a cable's length from us stretching from the east, around to the north and west as far as south-west. The only way to get clear was the way we came. This was one of the many fortunate escapes we've had from shipwreck because it was close to high tide, and there was a short, choppy sea that would have quickly damaged the ship had she struck. These shoals that sit a fathom or two below the water are the most dangerous of all because they don’t show themselves until you’re right on top of them, and then the water over them appears brown, like a reflection of dark clouds. Between 3 and 4, the ebb tide began to flow, so I sent the master to sound to the south and southwest. In the meantime, as the ship swung with the tide, we weighed anchor and with a little sail headed south, then veered west to get out of danger once more, and at sunset, we anchored in 10 fathoms of sandy bottom. With a fresh wind from the East-Southeast, we weighed anchor at 6 o'clock in the morning and headed west with a fresh wind from the East, first sending a boat ahead to sound the depths. I originally planned to steer northwest until we reached the coast of New Guinea, hoping to touch on that coast if possible, but encountering those shoals last night made me change our course to west, hoping to meet with fewer dangers and deeper water; and we found this to be true, as by noon we gradually deepened our water to 17 fathoms, and this time we were by observation at a latitude of 10 degrees 10 minutes south, longitude 220 degrees 12 minutes west. Our course and distance traveled since yesterday at noon was North 76 degrees West, 11 leagues, with no land in sight.

[Off South Coast of New Guinea.]

[Off South Coast of New Guinea.]

Monday, 27th. Fresh breezes between the East by North and East-South-East, with which we steer'd West until sun set; depth of Water from 27 to 23 fathoms. We now Reef'd the Topsails, shortened Sail, and hoisted in the pinnace and Long boat up alongside, and afterwards kept upon a Wind all night under our Topsails, 4 hours on one Tack and four hours on the other; depth of Water 25 fathoms, very even soundings. At daylight made all the Sail we could, and steer'd West-North-West until 8 o'clock, then North-West; at Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 9 degrees 56 minutes South, Longitude 221 degrees 00 minutes West; Variation 2 degrees 30 minutes East. Course and distance sail'd since yesterday at Noon North 73 degrees 33 minutes West, 49 miles.

Monday, 27th. We had fresh breezes coming from the East by North and East-South-East, with which we sailed West until sunset; the water depth varied from 27 to 23 fathoms. We reefed the topsails, reduced sail, and brought the pinnace and longboat alongside, then sailed with the wind all night under our topsails, spending four hours on one tack and four hours on the other; the water depth was 25 fathoms, with very consistent soundings. At dawn, we set all the sail we could and steered West-North-West until 8 o'clock, then changed to North-West; at noon, we calculated our position to be at a latitude of 9 degrees 56 minutes South and a longitude of 221 degrees 00 minutes West; variation was 2 degrees 30 minutes East. The course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon was North 73 degrees 33 minutes West, covering 49 miles.

Tuesday, 28th. Fresh breezes at East and East by South and fair weather. Continued a North-West Course until sun set, at which time we shortned sail, and haul'd close upon a Wind to the Northward; depth of Water 21 fathoms. At 8 Tack'd and stood to the Southward until 12, then stood to the Northward under little Sail until daylight, sounding from 25 to 17 fathoms; Shoalding as we stood to the Northward. At this time we made sail and steer'd North in order to make the land of New Guinea; from the time of our making sail until noon the depth of Water gradually decreased from 17 to 12 fathoms, a stony and shelly bottom. We were now by Observation in the Latitude of 8 degrees 52 minutes South, which is in the same Parrallel as the Southern parts of New Guinea as it is laid down in the Charts; but there are only 2 points so far to the South, and I reckon we are a degree to the Westward of both, and for that reason do not see the Land which trends more to the Northward. Our Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday is North-North-West, 69 Miles; Longitude in 221 degrees 27 minutes West. The Sea in many places is here cover'd with a kind of a brown scum, such as Sailors generally call spawn; upon our first seeing it it alarm'd us, thinking we were among Shoals, but we found the same depth of Water were it was as in other places; neither Mr. Banks nor Dr. Solander could tell what it was, altho' they had of it to Examine.

Tuesday, 28th. There were fresh breezes coming from the East and East by South, and the weather was nice. We continued on a North-West course until sunset, at which point we reduced sail and turned close to the wind heading North; the water depth was 21 fathoms. At 8 PM, we tacked and went South until midnight, then headed North again under less sail until daylight, sounding from 25 to 17 fathoms, getting shallower as we went North. At that time, we set sail and steered North to reach the land of New Guinea; from the moment we set sail until noon, the water depth gradually decreased from 17 to 12 fathoms, revealing a stony and shelly bottom. By our observations, we were at a latitude of 8 degrees 52 minutes South, which aligns with the southern parts of New Guinea as shown on the charts; however, there are only two points further south, and I believe we are a degree to the west of both, which is why we do not see the land that trends more to the North. Our course and distance traveled since yesterday is North-North-West, 69 miles; Longitude at 221 degrees 27 minutes West. In many areas, the sea is covered with a kind of brown scum that sailors often call spawn; when we first saw it, we were alarmed, thinking we were among shallows, but we found the depth of water was the same as in other places. Neither Mr. Banks nor Dr. Solander could explain what it was, even though they had some to examine.

Wednesday, 29th. Continued standing to the Northward, with a fresh gale at East by South and South-East until 6 o'clock, having very irregular and uncertain soundings from 24 to 7 fathoms. At 4 we made the Land from the Mast head, bearing North-West by North, and which appear'd to be very low. At 6 it extended from West-North-West to North-North-East, distant 4 or 5 Leagues. At this time hauld close upon a wind to the Eastward until 7 o'clock, then Tack'd and stood to the Southward until 12, at which time we wore and stood to the Northward until 4, then lay her Head off until daylight, when we again saw the Land, and stood North-North-West directly for it, having a fresh gale at East by South. Our Soundings in the night were from 17 to 5 fathoms, very irregular, without any sort of Rule with respect to our distance from the Land. At 1/2 past 6 a small low island, laying about a League from the Main, bore North by West, distant 5 miles; this island lays in the Latitude of 8 degrees 13 minutes South, Longitude 221 degrees 25 minutes West. I find it laid down in the Charts by the Name of St. Bartholomew or Whermoysen. We now steer'd North-West by West, West-North-West, West by North, West by South, and South-West by West, as we found the land to lay, having a Boat ahead of the Ship sounding; depth of water from 5 to 9 fathoms. When in 7, 8 or 9 fathoms we could but just see the Land from the Deck; but I did not think we were at above 4 Leagues off, because the land is exceeding low and level, and appeared to be well cover'd with wood; one sort appeared to us to be Cocoa Nutt Trees. By the Smookes we saw in different parts as we run along shore we were assured that the Country is inhabited. At Noon we were about 3 Leagues from the land, the Westermost part of which that we could see bore South 79 degrees West; our Latitude by Observation was 8 degrees 19 minutes South, Longitude 221 degrees 44 minutes West. The Island, St. Bartholomew, bore North 74 degrees East, distant 20.* (* The ship was now off the south coast of New Guinea, and near what is known as Princess Marianne Strait, which separates Frederick Henry Island from the main island. All this coast is very shallow, but very imperfectly charted to the present day.)

Wednesday, 29th. We kept heading north with a strong wind from the East by South and South-East until 6 o'clock, experiencing very irregular and uncertain depths from 24 to 7 fathoms. At 4, we spotted land from the masthead, bearing North-West by North, appearing very low. By 6, it extended from West-North-West to North-North-East, about 4 to 5 leagues away. At this point, we sailed close to the wind eastward until 7 o'clock, then tacked and headed south until midnight, when we changed course again to northward until 4, then pointed the ship’s head off until daylight, at which time we saw the land again and headed North-North-West directly toward it, with a fresh wind at East by South. During the night, our soundings varied from 17 to 5 fathoms, very irregular, with no consistent distance from the land. At 6:30, a small low island located about a league from the mainland was at North by West, 5 miles away; this island is in latitude 8 degrees 13 minutes South, longitude 221 degrees 25 minutes West. I found it marked on the charts as St. Bartholomew or Whermoysen. We now steered North-West by West, West-North-West, West by North, West by South, and South-West by West, following the land contours, with a boat ahead of the ship taking soundings; water depth ranged from 5 to 9 fathoms. When in 7, 8, or 9 fathoms, we could barely see the land from the deck, but I figured we were no more than 4 leagues off since the land was very low and flat, appearing well covered with trees; one type looked like coconut trees. From the smoke we saw in various places along the shore, we were assured the area was inhabited. At noon, we were about 3 leagues from the land, the westernmost part visible at South 79 degrees West; our latitude by observation was 8 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 221 degrees 44 minutes West. St. Bartholomew Island bore North 74 degrees East, 20 leagues away. (*The ship was now off the south coast of New Guinea, near what is known as Princess Marianne Strait, which separates Frederick Henry Island from the main island. This entire coast is very shallow but remains poorly charted even today.)

Thursday, 30th. Fresh breezes at South-East, East-South-East, and East by South. After steering South-West by West, 6 miles, we discover'd on our Starboard bow and ahead a Strong appearance of Shoal Water, and by this time we had Shoald our water from 10 to 5 fathoms; upon which I made the Pinnace Signal to Edge down to it, but she not going far enough, we sent the Yawl to sound in it, and at the same time hauld off close upon a Wind, with the Ship until 4, at which time we had run 6 Miles, but did not depen our water anything. We then Edged away South-West, 4 Miles more, but finding still Shoal Water we brought too, and call'd the Boats on board by Signal, hoisted them in, and then hauld off close upon a wind, being at this time about 3 or 4 Miles from the Land. The Yawl found only 3 fathoms water in the place where I sent her to sound, which place I weather'd about 1/2 a mile. Between 1 and 2 we passed a Bay or Inlet, before which lies a small Island that seems to Shelter it from the Southerly winds; but I very much doubt their being Water behind it for Shipping. I could not attempt it because the South-East Trade wind blows right in, and we have not as yet had any land breezes. We stretched off to Sea until 12 o'Clock, at which time we were 10 and 11 Leagues from the Land, and had depen'd our Water to 29 fathoms; we now tack'd and stood in until 4 o'Clock, when, being in 6 1/2 fathoms, we tack'd and lay her head off until day light, at which time we saw the land bearing North-West by West, distant about 4 Leagues. We now made sail and steer'd West-South-West, and then West by South, but coming into 54 fathoms we hauld off South-West until we depen'd our Water to 8 fathoms; we then keept away West by South and West, having 9 fathoms and the Land just in sight from the Deck, which we judged not above 3 or 4 Leagues off, as it is everywhere exceeding low. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 8 degrees 38 minutes South, Longitude 222 degrees 34 minutes West. St. Bartholomew Isle bore North 69 degrees East, distant 74 Miles.

Thursday, 30th. Fresh breezes coming from the South-East, East-South-East, and East by South. After heading South-West by West for 6 miles, we saw a strong indication of shallow water ahead and to our Starboard. At that point, our water depth dropped from 10 to 5 fathoms. I signaled the Pinnace to approach, but since she didn't go far enough, we sent the Yawl to sound the area while pulling the Ship back close to the wind until 4 o'clock. By that time, we had traveled 6 miles but hadn’t deepened our water at all. We then adjusted our course to South-West for another 4 miles, but still encountering shallow water, we stopped and signaled the boats to return on board, hoisted them in, and then sailed off close to the wind, being about 3 or 4 miles from the land. The Yawl found only 3 fathoms of water in the area where I sent her to sound, which was about half a mile away from where I was. Between 1 and 2 o'clock, we passed a Bay or Inlet in front of which lay a small island that seemed to shelter it from the southerly winds; however, I heavily doubted there being sufficient water behind it for shipping. I couldn’t attempt it because the South-East Trade wind was blowing directly in, and we hadn't experienced any land breezes yet. We sailed out to sea until noon, at which point we were 10 to 11 leagues from land and our water had deepened to 29 fathoms. We then tacked and headed back in until 4 o'clock, when we were in 6 1/2 fathoms. We tacked again and kept the ship head off until daylight, at which time we saw land bearing North-West by West, about 4 leagues away. We set sail and steered West-South-West, then West by South, but as we entered 54 fathoms, we turned off South-West until we deepened our water to 8 fathoms. We then continued West by South and West, with 9 fathoms and the land just in sight from the deck, which we estimated to be only about 3 or 4 leagues away since it was all very low. At noon, by observation, we were at a latitude of 8 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 222 degrees 34 minutes West. St. Bartholomew Isle bore North 69 degrees East, 74 miles away.

[Off Cape Walsche, New Guinea.]

[Off Cape Walsche, New Guinea.]

Friday, 31st. Between 12 and 1 in the P.M. Steer'd North-North-West, in which time we Shoalded our Water from 8 to 5 1/2, which I thought was little enough, and therefore keept away again West, and soon depen'd it to 7 fathoms, which depth we keept until 6, having the land just in sight from the Deck. At this time the Western Extream bore North, distant about 4 Leagues, and Seem'd to end in a point and turn away to the Northward; we took it to be Point St. Augustine or Walsche Caep, Latitude 8 degrees 24 minutes South, Longitude 222 degrees 55 minutes West.* (* This position is correct. Mr. Green had been assiduously observing lunars, and it appears strange that the error of the position of the north point of Australia was not discovered; but doubtless the discrepancy was put down to current.) We now shortned sail and hauld off South-South-West and South by West, having the wind at South-East and South-East by East, a Gentle breeze; we stood off 16 Miles, having from 7 to 27 fathoms, deepning gradually as we run off. At midnight we Tacked and stood in until daylight, at which time we could see no land, and yet we had only 5 1/2 fathoms. We now Steer'd North-West, having the same deepth of Water until near 9 o'Clock, when we began to Depen our Water to 6 1/2 and 7 fathoms. By this I thought that we were far Enough to the Westward of the Cape, and might haul to the Northward with Safety, which we now did, having the Wind at North-East by East, a light breeze. By Noon we had increased our Water to 9 fathoms, and were by Observation in the Latitude of 8 degrees 10 minutes South, which was 10 Miles to the Northward of that given by the Log; by which I conjectur'd that we had meet with a strong Current setting round the Cape, not only to the Northward, but to the Westward also, otherwise we ought to have seen the Land, which we did not.

Friday, 31st. Between 12 and 1 PM, we headed North-North-West, during which time our water depth dropped from 8 to 5.5 fathoms, which I thought was shallow enough, so I steered back West and quickly found a depth of 7 fathoms. We maintained this depth until 6, with land just visible from the deck. At this point, the westernmost tip was bearing North, about 4 leagues away, appearing to end in a point and turn northward; we believed it was Point St. Augustine or Walsche Caep, at Latitude 8 degrees 24 minutes South, Longitude 222 degrees 55 minutes West. (*This position is accurate. Mr. Green had diligently been observing lunars, and it's odd that the error in the position of the north point of Australia wasn't identified; presumably, the discrepancy was attributed to current.) We then reduced sail and steered off South-South-West and South by West, with the wind coming from the South-East and South-East by East, a gentle breeze; we moved off 16 miles, with depths ranging from 7 to 27 fathoms, gradually deepening as we continued. At midnight, we tacked and headed in until daylight, during which time we couldn't see any land, yet we were only at 5.5 fathoms. We then steered North-West, maintaining the same water depth until nearly 9 o'clock, when we began to find depths of 6.5 and 7 fathoms. This led me to think we were far enough west of the Cape to safely head north, which we did, with the wind at North-East by East, a light breeze. By noon, we had increased our depth to 9 fathoms and, by observation, were at Latitude 8 degrees 10 minutes South, which was 10 miles north of what the log indicated; from this, I guessed we were dealing with a strong current wrapping around the Cape, not only heading north but west as well, otherwise, we should have seen the land, which we did not.

[September 1770.]

[September 1770.]

Saturday, 1st September. In the P.M. and most part of the night had a fresh breeze from the South-East with which we keept standing in for the land North-East and East-North-East, close upon a wind, until half past 6, when we Anchor'd in 4 1/2 fathoms, soft muddy bottom, as we have every were found upon the Coast. About an hour before we Anchor'd we saw the land from the Mast head extending from the East by North to South-South-East, all very low; at the time we Anchor'd we found a small drean* (* Drain.) of a Tide setting away to the North-West, which continued until 2 in the morning, when the Water had fell 9 feet or better. This Tide of Ebb was then succeeded by the Flood, which came from the South-West; yet we did not find the Water to rise much upon a perpendicular, or else the greatest fall of the Tide had not been well attended to in the night, for at 6, when we got under sail, we had no more than 3 fathoms under the ship, and yet we could not see the land from the Deck. After getting under sail we stood to the Northward with a light breeze at East, and deepned our Water by noon to 10 fathoms, having the Land just in sight from the Mast head to the South-East. At this time we were in the Latitude of 7 degrees 39 minutes South, Longitude 222 degrees 42 minutes West; Port St. Augustine bore South 10 degrees West, distant 15 Leagues.

Saturday, September 1st. In the afternoon and most of the night, we had a fresh breeze from the southeast, which kept us heading toward the land to the northeast and east-northeast, sailing close to the wind, until half past 6, when we anchored in 4.5 fathoms of soft muddy bottom, as we've found everywhere along the coast. About an hour before we anchored, we spotted the land from the masthead stretching from the east by north to south-southeast, all very low. At the time we anchored, we noticed a small current of tide flowing away to the northwest, which continued until 2 in the morning, when the water had dropped by about 9 feet or so. This ebb tide was then followed by the flood tide, which came from the southwest; however, we didn’t see much rise in the water level vertically, or perhaps we hadn't paid enough attention to the greatest drop of the tide during the night. At 6, when we set sail, there was only 3 fathoms of water under the ship, and we couldn't see the land from the deck. After setting sail, we headed northward with a light east breeze and deepened our water to 10 fathoms by noon, with the land just visible from the masthead to the southeast. At this time, we were at a latitude of 7 degrees 39 minutes south and a longitude of 222 degrees 42 minutes west; Port St. Augustine was located at south 10 degrees west, about 15 leagues away.

Sunday, 2nd. In the P.M. had Calm until 2, when a light breeze sprung up at North by East, and we stood in for the Land East by North until 5, at which time we got the wind from the South-West, a light breeze, with which we steer'd North-East, edging in for the land, having it in sight from the Deck, and which I judged to be about 3 or 4 Leagues off, being very low land. Found the Variation to be 2 degrees 34 minutes East, and a little before 8 o'Clock, having but little wind, we Anchor'd in 7 fathoms, soft Muddy bottom. In the Afternoon and evening we saw several Sea Snakes, some of which the people in the Boat alongside took up by hand. At daylight in the Morning we got under sail, and stood away to the North-North-East, having a fresh gale at East, which by noon brought us into the Latitude of 7 degrees 14 minutes South, Longitude 222 degrees 30 minutes West; Depth of Water 13 fathoms. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday Noon is North 24 degrees East, 27 Miles, having at this time no land in sight, for the Land, according to the Charts, trends more Easterly than the Wind would permit us to sail.

Sunday, 2nd. In the afternoon, it was calm until 2 PM, when a light breeze picked up from the North by East, and we headed toward the land at East by North until 5 PM. At that time, we got a light breeze from the South-West, with which we steered North-East, moving closer to the land, which I could see from the deck and estimated to be about 3 or 4 leagues away, very low-lying. We found the variation to be 2 degrees 34 minutes East, and shortly before 8 o'clock, with little wind, we anchored in 7 fathoms of soft muddy bottom. In the afternoon and evening, we saw several sea snakes, some of which the crew in the boat alongside caught by hand. At daybreak in the morning, we set sail and headed away to the North-North-East, encountering a fresh gale from the East, which by noon brought us to the latitude of 7 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 222 degrees 30 minutes West; depth of water was 13 fathoms. Since yesterday noon, our course and distance traveled have been North 24 degrees East, 27 miles, with no land in sight, as the land, according to the charts, trends more easterly than the wind would allow us to sail.

Monday, 3rd. Steer'd North by East, with a fresh breeze at East by North until 7 in the Evening, when the wind came to South-East by South, with which we keept standing to the Eastward close upon a wind all Night, having from 17 to 10 fathoms pretty even Soundings. At daylight we saw the land extending from North by East to South-East, distant about 4 Leagues. We still keept standing in for it, having the advantage of a fresh gale at East-South-East and East by South, until near 9, when, being about 3 or 4 Miles off, and in 3 fathoms, we brought too and I went ashore in the pinnace, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, having a mind to land once in this Country before we quit it Altogether, which I now am determin'd to do without delay; for I found that it is only spending time to little purpose, and carrying us far out of our way, staying upon this Coast, which is so shallow that we can hardly keep within sight of land.

Monday, 3rd. We headed North by East, with a fresh breeze from East by North until 7 in the evening, when the wind shifted to South-East by South. With that, we continued heading East all night, having a consistent depth of 17 to 10 fathoms. At dawn, we spotted land stretching from North by East to South-East, about 4 leagues away. We kept moving toward it, benefiting from a fresh gale at East-South-East and East by South, until around 9, when we were about 3 or 4 miles away and in 3 fathoms of water. We stopped, and I went ashore in the pinnace with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, wanting to step foot on this land before we left it for good, which I now plan to do without hesitation. I realized that staying on this coast is a waste of time, taking us far off course, as it is so shallow that we can hardly keep the land in sight.

[Land in New Guinea.]

[Land in PNG.]

At the time we put off from the Ship we saw not the least sign of inhabitants; but we had no sooner landed than we saw the print of Men's feet fresh upon the sand, and a little way farther we found a small Shed or Hutt, about which lay green shells of Cocoa Nutts. By this we were well assured that the inhabitants were not far off; nay, we thought we heard their Voices in the woods, which were so close and thick that we did not think it safe to venture in, for fear of an Ambuscade, as we had only a Boat's crew with us, a part of which were left to look after the boat, which lay about a 1/4 of a Mile from the Shore. We therefore took a walk upon the Sea beach, but had not gone above 200 Yards before we were attack'd by 3 or 4 Men, who came out of the woods a little before us, but upon our firing upon them they retir'd. Finding that we could not search the Country with any degree of Safety, we return'd to the boat, and was followed by 60, or, as some thought, about 100, of the Natives, who had advanced in small parties out of the woods; but they suffer'd us to go to our boats without giving us any trouble. We had now time to view them attentively; we thought them to be about the size and Colour of the New Hollanders, with short, Cropt Hair, and quite naked like them. I thought these of a lighter Colour; but that may be owing to a whitish Pigment with which we thought their bodies were painted, because some appeared darker than others.

As soon as we set off from the ship, we didn’t see any signs of people. But the moment we landed, we noticed fresh footprints in the sand, and shortly after, we found a small shed or hut surrounded by green coconut shells. This made us sure that the locals were nearby; in fact, we thought we heard their voices in the dense woods. However, we didn’t consider it safe to go in, fearing an ambush, especially since we only had a crew from the boat with us, and some of them were left behind to watch over the boat, which was about a quarter of a mile from shore. So, we decided to take a walk along the beach, but we hadn’t gone more than 200 yards when we were attacked by 3 or 4 men who emerged from the woods ahead of us. However, when we fired at them, they retreated. Realizing we couldn’t explore the area safely, we returned to the boat and were followed by about 60, or perhaps as many as 100 of the locals, who approached in small groups from the woods but let us get to our boats without causing any trouble. We now had the chance to observe them closely; they seemed to be about the same size and color as the people from New Holland, with short hair and completely naked like them. I thought they looked a bit lighter in color, but that could have been due to a whitish pigment they seemed to have on their skin, as some appeared darker than others.

Their Arms were ordinary darts of about 4 feet long, made of a kind of reed, and pointed at one end with hard wood; but what appear'd more extraordinary to us was something they had which caused a flash of fire or Smoak, very much like the going off of a pistol or small Gun, but without any report. The deception was so great that the people in the Ship actually thought that they had fire Arms; indeed, they seem'd to use these things in imitation of such, for the moment the first man we saw made his appearance he fir'd off one of these things, and while we lay looking at them in the boat 4 or 5 would let them off all at once, which had all the appearance in the world of Volleys of Small Arms; but I am confident that nothing came from them but smook, but by what means this was done, or what purpose it answer'd, we were not able to Guess. I thought the Combustable matter was contain'd in a reed or piece of small Bamboo, which they gave a Swing round in the hand and caused it to go off.* (* The natives carry hollow canes with burning tinder for making fires.)

Their weapons were regular darts about 4 feet long, made from a type of reed, with a hard wooden point at one end. However, what seemed more extraordinary to us was something they had that created a flash of fire or smoke, very similar to the discharge of a pistol or small gun, but without any noise. The illusion was so convincing that the people on the ship genuinely believed they had firearms; in fact, they appeared to use these devices in imitation of such, because the moment the first man we saw showed up, he fired one of these things off, and while we were watching them from the boat, 4 or 5 would go off simultaneously, which looked just like volleys of small arms. But I’m sure that nothing came from them except smoke; we couldn't figure out how this was done or what purpose it served. I thought the combustible material was inside a reed or a small piece of bamboo, which they swung around in their hands to make it go off. (*The natives carry hollow canes with burning tinder for making fires.)

This place lies in the Latitude of 6 degrees 15 minutes South, about 65 Leagues to the North-East of Point St. Augustine, or Walsche Caep, and is near to what is called in the Charts by the long name of Cape de la Colta de St. Bonaventura.* (* Cook's landing place in New Guinea, on the western side of this great island, was on a part of the coast scarcely known to this day. It is in the part of the island claimed by the Dutch. Cook's insatiable desire to explore is well shown in this digression from his course to Batavia.) The land is very low, like every other part of the Coast we have seen here; it is thick and Luxuriously cloathed with woods and Verdure, all of which appear Green and flourishing. Here were Cocoa nutt Trees, Bread Fruit Trees, and Plantain Trees, but we saw no fruit but on the former, and these were small and Green; the other Trees, Shrubs, Plants, etc., were likewise such as is common in the South Sea Islands and in New Holland.

This place is located at a latitude of 6 degrees, 15 minutes South, about 65 leagues northeast of Point St. Augustine, also known as Walsche Caep, and is close to what the charts refer to as Cape de la Colta de St. Bonaventura. (*Cook's landing spot in New Guinea, on the western coast of this large island, was in an area that is still not very well known today. It lies within the section of the island claimed by the Dutch. Cook's endless desire to explore is clearly demonstrated by this detour from his route to Batavia.) The land is very low, similar to every other part of the coast we’ve seen here; it's thickly and luxuriously covered with woods and greenery, all of which looks green and thriving. We found coconut trees, breadfruit trees, and plantain trees, but we only saw small, green fruit on the coconut trees; the other trees, shrubs, and plants were typical of those found in the South Sea islands and New Holland.

Upon my return to the Ship we hoisted in the boat and made sail to the Westward, with a design to leave the Coast altogether. This, however, was contrary to the inclination and opinion of some of the Officers, who would have had me send a Party of Men ashore to cut down the Cocoa Nutt Trees for the sake of the Nutts; a thing that I think no man living could have justified, for as the Natives had attacked us for meer landing without taking away one thing, certainly they would have made a Vigerous effort to have defended their property; in which case many of them must have been kill'd, and perhaps some of our own people too, and all this for 2 or 300 Green Cocoa Nutts, which, when we had got them, would have done us little service; besides nothing but the utmost necessity would have obliged me to have taken this method to come at refreshments.

When we got back to the ship, we pulled in the boat and set sail west, intending to leave the coast completely. However, this went against the wishes and opinions of some of the officers, who wanted me to send a group of men ashore to chop down the coconut trees for the nuts. I believe no one could justify that, since the natives had already attacked us just for landing without taking anything, and they definitely would have fought hard to defend their property. In that case, many of them might have been killed, and possibly some of our own people too, all for 200 or 300 green coconuts, which wouldn’t have helped us much. Besides, I would only resort to such extreme measures to get supplies if it were absolutely necessary.

It's true I might have gone farther along the Coast to the Northward and Westward until we had found a place where the Ship could lay so near the Shore as to cover the people with her Guns when landed; but it is very probable that before we had found such a place we should have been carried so far to the West as to have been obliged to have gone to Batavia by the way of the Moluccas, and on the North side of Java, where we were all utter Strangers. This I did not think was so safe a Passage as to go to the South of Java and thro' the Straits of Sunda, the way I propose to myself to go. Besides, as the Ship is leakey, we are not yet sure wether or no we shall not be obliged to heave her down at Batavia; in this case it becomes the more necessary that we should make the best of our way to that place, especially as no new discovery can be Expected to be made in these Seas, which the Dutch have, I believe, long ago narrowly examin'd, as appears from 3 Maps bound up with the French History of Voyages to the Terra Australis, published in 1756,* (* De Brye's Voyages.) which Maps, I do suppose, by some means have been got from the Dutch, as we found the Names of many of the places are in that Language.

It's true I could have gone further up the coast to the north and west until we found a spot where the ship could anchor close enough to the shore to cover the people with her guns when they landed. However, it's very likely that before we found such a place, we would have drifted so far west that we would have had to go to Batavia via the Moluccas and around the north side of Java, where we are all complete strangers. I didn't think that route was as safe as going south of Java and through the Straits of Sunda, which is the path I plan to take. Additionally, since the ship is leaking, we're not yet sure if we'll have to dock her in Batavia for repairs. In this case, it becomes even more important that we make our way to that location, especially since no new discoveries can be expected in these waters, which the Dutch have, I believe, thoroughly explored long ago, as shown in three maps included in the French history of voyages to Terra Australis, published in 1756,* (*De Brye's Voyages.) I assume these maps were obtained from the Dutch, as we found many of the place names are in that language.

It should likewise seem from the same Maps that the Spaniards and Dutch have at one time or another circumnavigated the whole of the Island of New Guinea, as the most of the Names are in these 2 Languages; and such part of the Coast as we were upon I found the Chart tolerable good, which obliges me to give some Credit to all the rest, notwithstanding we neither know by whom or when they were taken, and I always understood, before I had a sight of these Maps, that it was unknown whether or no New Holland and New Guinea was not one continued land, and so it is said in the very History of Voyages these Maps are bound up in. However, we have now put this wholy out of dispute; but, as I believe, it was known before, tho' not publicly, I claim no other Merit than the Clearing up of a doubtful point. Another doubtfull point I should have liked to have clear'd up, altho' it is of very little, if of any Consequence, which is, whether the Natives of New Holland and those of New Guinea are, or were, Original, one People, which one might well suppose, as these 2 Countrys lay so near to each other, and the intermediate space fill'd up with Islands. On the other hand, if these 2 people have or ever had any friendly communication with Each other it seems strange, as I have before observed, that they should not have transplanted from New Guinea over to New Holland Cocoa Nutts, Bread fruit, Plantains, etc., etc., all very useful Articles for the support of Man, that We never saw grow in the latter, and which we have now seen in the former. La Maire hath given us a Vocabulary of Words spoken by the People of New Britain (which before Dampier's time was taken to be a part of New Guinea), by which it appears that the people of New Britain speak a very different Language from those of New Holland. Now should it be found that the Natives of New Britain and those of New Guinea have had One Origin, and speak the same Language, it will follow, of Course, that the New Hollanders are a different People from both.* (* In the north of Australia the natives are distinctly allied to the Papuans, but on the east of the continent they are of a type of their own, and speak many different languages.)

It should also be clear from the same maps that the Spaniards and Dutch have, at some point, traveled all the way around the Island of New Guinea, since most of the names are in these two languages. I found the chart to be quite good for the part of the coast we were on, which makes me give some credit to the rest of it, even though we don’t know who made them or when. I had always understood, before I saw these maps, that it was uncertain whether New Holland and New Guinea were connected as one land, which is also mentioned in the very history of voyages that these maps are listed with. However, we’ve now established this beyond doubt; although I believe it was known before, even if not publicly, I take no credit other than clearing up a point that was previously unclear. There’s another unclear point I would have liked to clarify, though it’s not of much significance, which is whether the natives of New Holland and those of New Guinea are or were originally the same people. One might think so since these two countries are so close together, with islands in between. On the other hand, if these two groups ever had any friendly contact, it seems odd, as I’ve noted before, that they wouldn’t have brought coconuts, breadfruit, plantains, and other useful items from New Guinea to New Holland, which we’ve seen grow in the former but never in the latter. La Maire has provided us with a vocabulary of words spoken by the people of New Britain (which was considered a part of New Guinea before Dampier’s time), showing that the people of New Britain speak a very different language from those of New Holland. If it turns out that the natives of New Britain and those of New Guinea have the same origin and speak the same language, it would naturally follow that the New Hollanders are a different people altogether. (*In the north of Australia, the natives are distinctly related to the Papuans, but on the eastern part of the continent, they represent a unique type and speak many different languages.)

[Off South-west Coast of New Guinea.]

[Off South-west Coast of New Guinea.]

Tuesday, 4th. Stood to the Westward all this day, having at first a moderate breeze Southerly, which afterwards freshned and Veered to South-East and East-South-East. We keept on sounding all the time, having from 14 to 30 fathoms not regular, but sometimes more and sometimes less. At noon we were in 14 fathoms; by observation in the Latitude of 6 degrees 44 minutes South, Longitude 223 degrees 51 minutes West. Course and distance sail'd since Yesteday Noon South 76 minutes West, 120 Miles.

Tuesday, 4th. We headed west all day, starting with a light breeze from the south, which later picked up and shifted to southeast and east-southeast. We kept taking soundings the whole time, ranging from 14 to 30 fathoms, though it varied at times. At noon, we measured 14 fathoms; based on our observations, we were at a latitude of 6 degrees 44 minutes south and a longitude of 223 degrees 51 minutes west. Since yesterday noon, we traveled south 76 minutes west, covering 120 miles.

Wednesday, 5th. Winds at East by South and South-East by East, a fresh gale and Clear weather, with which were run 118 Miles upon a South 69 degrees 15 minutes West Course, which at Noon brought us into the Latitude of 7 degrees 25 minutes South, Longitude 225 degrees 41 minutes West; depth of Water 28 fathoms, having been in soundings the whole of this day's run, generally between 10 and 20 fathoms. At half an hour past one in the Morning we past by a small low Island, which bore from us at that time North-North-West, distant 3 or 4 Miles; depth of Water 14 fathoms, and at daylight we discover'd another low Island extending from North-North-West and North-North-East, distant 2 or 3 Leagues. I believe I should have landed upon this Island to have known its produce, as it did not appear to be very small, had not the wind blown too fresh for such an undertaking, and at the time we passed the Island we had only 10 fathoms Water, a rocky bottom; I was therefore afraid of running down to leeward for fear of meeting with Shoal Water and foul ground. These Islands have no place on the Charts, unless they are the Arrow Isles, which, if they are, they are laid down much too far from New Guinea. I found the South part of these to lay in the Latitude 7 degrees 6 minutes South, Longitude 225 degrees 0 minutes West.* (* These were probably Karang and Ennu Islands, two outliers of the Arru Islands.)

Wednesday, 5th. Winds from East by South and South-East by East, a fresh breeze and clear weather, during which we traveled 118 miles on a course of South 69 degrees 15 minutes West. By noon, we reached a latitude of 7 degrees 25 minutes South and a longitude of 225 degrees 41 minutes West; water depth was 28 fathoms, having measured the soundings throughout the day's journey, generally between 10 and 20 fathoms. At 1:30 AM, we passed a small low island that was located to the North-North-West, about 3 or 4 miles away; the water depth was 14 fathoms. At daylight, we spotted another low island extending from North-North-West to North-North-East, approximately 2 or 3 leagues distant. I considered landing on this island to explore its resources, as it didn't seem very small, but the wind was too strong for such a venture. At the time we passed the island, we had only 10 fathoms of water with a rocky bottom, so I was worried about drifting downwind and hitting shallow water or rough ground. These islands aren’t shown on the charts, unless they are the Arrow Isles, which, if they are, are inaccurately placed too far from New Guinea. I found the southern part of these islands to be at a latitude of 7 degrees 6 minutes South and a longitude of 225 degrees 0 minutes West.* (* These were probably Karang and Ennu Islands, two outliers of the Arru Islands.)

Thursday, 6th. A steady fresh gale at East by South and clear weather, with which we steer'd West-South-West. At 7 in the Evening we took in the small Sails, reefd the Topsails, and sounded, having 50 fathoms; we still keept West-South-West all night, going at the rate of 4 1/2 Miles an hour. At 10 had 42 fathoms; at 11, 37; and at 12 o'Clock 45; 1 o'Clock 49; and at 3, 120; after which we could get no ground. In the evening we caught 2 Boobies, which settled upon the rigging, and these were the first of the kind we have caught in this manner the voyage, altho' I have heard of them being caught this way in great numbers. At daylight, in the Morning, we made all the sail we could, and at 10 o'Clock saw land extending from North-North-West to West by North, distant 5 or 6 League. At Noon it bore from North to West about the same distance; our Latitude by observation was 8 degrees 15 minutes South, Longitude 227 degrees 47 minutes West. This land is of an even and moderate height, and by our run from New Guinea ought to be a part of the Arrow Isles;* (* This was the southern part of the Tenimber Islands.) but it lays a degree farther to the South than any of these Islands are laid down in the Charts. We sounded, but had no ground, with 50 fathoms of Line.

Thursday, 6th. A steady fresh wind from East by South and clear weather, so we steered West-South-West. At 7 in the evening, we took in the small sails, reefed the topsails, and checked the depth, having 50 fathoms; we continued West-South-West all night, traveling at 4 1/2 miles per hour. At 10, we had 42 fathoms; at 11, 37; and at 12 o'clock, 45; at 1 o'clock, 49; and at 3, 120; after that, we couldn’t find any more ground. In the evening, we caught 2 boobies that landed on the rigging, which were the first of their kind we’ve caught this way on this voyage, although I’ve heard of them being caught in large numbers like this. At daybreak in the morning, we set all the sails we could, and at 10 o'clock, we spotted land stretching from North-North-West to West by North, about 5 or 6 leagues away. At noon, it was from North to West at about the same distance; our latitude by observation was 8 degrees 15 minutes South, longitude 227 degrees 47 minutes West. This land is of an even and moderate height, and based on our journey from New Guinea, it should be part of the Arrow Isles; but it lies a degree further South than any of these islands are shown on the charts. We checked the depth but had no ground, with 50 fathoms of line.

[Remarks on Charts.]

[Comments on Charts.]

Friday, 7th. As I was not able to satisfy myself from any Chart what land it was we saw to Leeward of us, and fearing it might trend away more Southerly, and the weather being hazey so that we could not see far, we steer'd South-West, which Course by 4 o'Clock run us out of sight of the land; by this I was assured that no part of it lay to the Southward of 8 degrees 15 minutes South. We continued standing to the South-West all night under an Easey sail, having the advantage of a fresh gale at South-East by East and East-South-East, and clear moon light; we sounded every hour, but had no bottom with 100 and 120 fathoms of line. At daylight in the Morning we steer'd West-South-West, and afterwards West by South, which by Noon brought us into the Latitude of 9 degrees 30 minutes South, and Longitude 229 degrees 34 minutes West, and by our run from New Guinea ought to be in sight of Wessels Isle, which, according to the Chart is laid down about 20 or 25 Leagues from the coast of New Holland; but we saw nothing, by which I conclude that it is wrong laid down; and this is not to be wonder'd at when we consider that not only these Islands, but the lands which bound this Sea have been discover'd and explored by different people and at different times, and compiled and put together by others, perhaps some Ages after the first discoveries were made. Navigation formerly wanted many of these helps towards keeping an Accurate Journal which the present Age is possessed of; it is not they that are wholy to blame for the faultiness of the Charts, but the Compilers and Publishers, who publish to the world the rude Sketches of the Navigator as Accurate surveys, without telling what authority they have for so doing; for were they to do this we should then be as good or better judge than they, and know where to depend upon the Charts, and where not. Neither can I clear Seamen of this fault; among the few I have known who are Capable of drawing a Chart or Sketch of a Sea Coast I have generally, nay, almost always, observed them run into this error. I have known them lay down the line of a Coast they have never seen, and put down Soundings where they never have sounded; and, after all, are so fond of their performances as to pass the whole off as Sterling under the Title of a Survey Plan, etc. These things must in time be attended with bad Consequences, and cannot fail of bringing the whole of their works in disrepute.* (* Cook had good reason for writing thus, and being himself scrupulously honest and careful, he felt this scamped work to be a disgrace to seamen.) If he is so modest as to say, Such and such parts, or the whole of his plan is defective, the Publishers or Vendures will have it left out, because they say it hurts the sale of the work; so that between the one and the other we can hardly tell when we are possessed of a good Sea Chart until we ourselves have proved it.

Friday, 7th. Since I couldn't figure out from any chart what land we saw to the leeward and worried it might extend further south, along with the hazy weather that limited our visibility, we headed southwest. By 4 o'clock, we lost sight of the land, which confirmed that no part of it was south of 8 degrees 15 minutes south. We continued to head southwest all night with a light sail, taking advantage of a fresh southeast to east-southeast breeze and clear moonlight. We took soundings every hour but found no bottom with 100 and 120 fathoms of line. At daylight the next morning, we steered west-southwest and later west by south, which by noon put us in the latitude of 9 degrees 30 minutes south and longitude 229 degrees 34 minutes west. Based on our journey from New Guinea, we should have seen Wessels Isle, which is supposed to be about 20 or 25 leagues from the coast of New Holland, but we saw nothing. This leads me to believe the chart is inaccurate. It's not surprising, considering that these islands and the lands surrounding this sea have been discovered and explored by different people at different times, and later compiled by others, possibly many years after the initial discoveries. Navigation in the past lacked many tools that we have today to maintain an accurate record, and the faultiness of charts isn't solely their fault, but also that of the compilers and publishers who present rough sketches by navigators as accurate surveys without disclosing their sources. If they did, we would be better judges of the charts’ reliability. I also can't entirely absolve seamen of this issue; among the few I've known who can create a chart or coast sketch, I've often seen them make similar errors. I've known them to map out coastlines they've never seen and add soundings where they’ve never actually taken measurements, yet they take pride in their work and pass it off as a legitimate survey plan. Such practices are bound to lead to negative consequences and discredit their entire body of work. If he humbly admits that parts of his plan are flawed, publishers will likely exclude that information, arguing it will hurt sales. As a result, we can hardly tell when we have a reliable sea chart unless we verify it ourselves.

Saturday, 8th. Winds Easterly, with a high Sea from the same Quarter. Our Course and distance sail'd this 24 Hours is South 86 degrees 30 minutes West, 102 Miles; Latitude in 9 degrees 36 minutes South, Longitude 231 degrees 17 minutes West.

Saturday, 8th. Easterly winds, with high seas from the same direction. Our course and distance traveled in the last 24 hours is South 86 degrees 30 minutes West, 102 miles; Latitude 9 degrees 36 minutes South, Longitude 231 degrees 17 minutes West.

Sunday, 9th. Light Airs and Clear weather the most part of this 24 Hours. In the evening found the Variation by several Azimuths to be 0 degrees 12 minutes West, and by the Amplitude 0 degrees 5 minutes West. At Noon we were by observation in the Latitude of 9 degrees 46 minutes South, Longitude 232 degrees 7 minutes West. Course and distance sail'd since yesterday at Noon South 78 degrees 45 minutes West, 52 Miles. For these 2 days past we have steer'd due West, and yet we have by observation made 16 Miles Southing--6 Miles Yesterday and 10 to-day; from which it should seem that there is a Current setting to the Southward and Westward withall, as I should suppose.

Sunday, 9th. Light winds and clear weather for most of the 24 hours. In the evening, we found the variation by several azimuths to be 0 degrees 12 minutes West, and by the amplitude 0 degrees 5 minutes West. At noon, our observations placed us at a latitude of 9 degrees 46 minutes South, longitude 232 degrees 7 minutes West. Since yesterday at noon, we sailed a course of South 78 degrees 45 minutes West for 52 miles. Over the past two days, we have been heading due West, yet our observations show we've made 16 miles south—6 miles yesterday and 10 miles today; this suggests there is a current pushing us southward and westward, as I would assume.

Monday, 10th. Light Airs Easterly, except in the morning, when we had it at North; at sunset found the Variation to be 0 degrees 2 minutes West, at the same time saw, or thought we saw, very high land bearing North-West, and in the Morning saw the same appearances of land in the same Quarter, which left us no room to doubt but what it was land, and must be either the Island of Timor land or Timor, but which of the 2 I cannot as yet determine.* (* This was Timor. What Cook calls Timor land is probably Timor Laut, another name for the principal island of the Tenimber Group.) At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 10 degrees 1 minute South, which was 15 Miles to the Southward of that given by the Log. Longitude in per Observation 233 degrees 27 minutes West.

Monday, 10th. Light easterly breezes, except in the morning, when it was from the north; at sunset, we found the variation to be 0 degrees 2 minutes west. At the same time, we saw— or thought we saw— very high land to the northwest. In the morning, we saw the same signs of land in the same direction, leaving us with no doubt that it was land, likely either Timor land or Timor, though I can't determine which one yet. (*This was Timor. What Cook calls Timor land is probably Timor Laut, another name for the main island of the Tenimber Group.) At noon, our observations put us at latitude 10 degrees 1 minute south, which was 15 miles south of what the log showed. Longitude by observation was 233 degrees 27 minutes west.

Tuesday, 11th. Variable light Airs and Clear weather. Steer'd North-West, in order to discover the Land plainer until 4 in the morning, at which time the wind came to North-West and West, with which we stood to the Southward until 9 o'Clock, when we Tack'd and stood North-West, having the wind at West-South-West. At sun rise in the morning we could see the land extend from West-North-West to North-East; at noon we could see it extend to the Westward as far as West by South 1/2 South, but no farther to the Eastward than North by East. We were now well assured that this was part of the Island of Timor, in consequence of which the last Island we saw must have been Timor land, the South part of which lies in the Latitude of 8 degrees 15 minutes South, Longitude 228 degrees 10 minutes, whereas in the Charts the South Point is laid down in Latitude 9 degrees 30 minutes. It is possible that the Land we saw might be some other Island; but then I cannot see how we could have miss'd seeing Timor land, soposing it to be right laid down in Latitude, as we were never to the Southward of 9 degrees 30 minutes; for my design was to have made that Island, and to have landed upon it to have seen what it produced, as it is (according to the Charts) a large Island, and not settled by the Dutch that I ever heard off. We were now in the Latitude of 9 degrees 37 minutes, Longitude 233 degrees 54 minutes West by observation of the Sun and Moon, and Yesterday we were by Observation in 233 degrees 27 minutes West. The difference is 27 minutes, which is exactly the same as what the Log gave; this, however, is a degree of accuracy in observation that is seldom to be expected.

Tuesday, 11th. Light variable winds and clear weather. Sailed North-West to get a better view of the land until 4 AM, when the wind shifted to North-West and West. We then headed South until 9 o'clock, when we tacked and went North-West with the wind coming from West-South-West. At sunrise, we could see the land stretching from West-North-West to North-East; by noon, it extended to the West as far as West by South 1/2 South, but not further East than North by East. We were now convinced that this was part of the Island of Timor, which meant the last island we saw had to be Timor land, whose southern part is at Latitude 8 degrees 15 minutes South, Longitude 228 degrees 10 minutes. On the maps, the southern point is shown at Latitude 9 degrees 30 minutes. It's possible the land we saw could have been another island, but I can't understand how we would have missed Timor land, assuming it is correctly placed on the map, as we were never south of 9 degrees 30 minutes. My goal was to reach that island and land to see what it had to offer, since it is shown as a large island on the maps and not settled by the Dutch to my knowledge. We were now at Latitude 9 degrees 37 minutes, Longitude 233 degrees 54 minutes West based on observations of the Sun and Moon, while yesterday we observed it at 233 degrees 27 minutes West. The difference is 27 minutes, which matches exactly with what the log recorded; this level of accuracy in observation is rarely expected.

[Off South Coast of Timor.]

[Off the coast of Timor.]

Wednesday, 12th. Winds between the South and West, a light breeze and Clear weather in the P.M.; stood in shore until 8 o'Clock, then Tack'd and stood off, being about 6 Leagues from the Land, which at dark extend from South-West 1/2 West to North-East; at this time we sounded and had no ground with 140 fathoms of line, being not above 4 Leagues from the Land. At 12 o'Clock we Tack'd and stood in, having but little wind, and continued so until noon, at which time we were by Observation in Latitude 9 degrees 36 minutes South; the Log this 24 Hours gave 18 Miles Westing, but it did not appear by the land that we had made so much. We saw several Smoaks upon the Land by day, and fires in the Night.

Wednesday, 12th. The winds were between the South and West, with a light breeze and clear weather in the afternoon; we stayed close to shore until 8 o'clock, then tacked and headed out, being about 6 leagues from the land, which at dark stretched from South-West 1/2 West to North-East. At this point, we sounded and found no bottom with 140 fathoms of line, only about 4 leagues from the land. At midnight, we tacked and headed back in, with very little wind, and continued that way until noon, at which time we were observed to be in Latitude 9 degrees 36 minutes South; the log for the last 24 hours recorded a westward distance of 18 miles, but it didn’t seem like we covered that much by the land. We saw several plumes of smoke on the land during the day, and fires at night.

Thursday, 13th. Stood in shore, with a light breeze at South by West until 1/2 past 5 o'Clock in the P.M., when, being a Mile and a 1/2 from the Shore, and in 16 fathoms, we tack'd and stood off. At this time the Extreams of the Land extended from North-East by East to West by South 1/2 South; this last was a low point, distant from us about 3 Leagues. We were right before a small Creek or Inlet into the low land, which lies in the Latitude of 9 degrees 34 minutes South. Probably it might be the same as Dampier went into in his Boat, for it did not seem to have depth of Water sufficient for anything else. In standing in shore we sounded several times, but found no soundings until we got within 2 1/2 Miles of the Shore, where we had 25 fathoms, soft bottom. We stood off Shore until 12 o'Clock, with the wind at South, then Tack'd and stood to the Westward 2 Hours, when the wind veer'd to the South-West and West-South-West, and then we stood to the Southward. In the Morning found the Variation to be 1 degree 10 minutes West by the Amplitude, and by the Azimuth 1 degree 27 minutes West; at Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 9 degrees 45 minutes South, Longitude 234 degrees 12 minutes West, and about 6 or 7 Leagues from the land, which extended from North 31 degrees East to West-South-West 1/2 West. Winds at South-South-West, a Gentle breeze.

Thursday, 13th. We were close to shore with a light breeze coming from the South by West until 5:30 PM, when, a mile and a half from the shore and in 16 fathoms of water, we changed direction and headed out. At that time, the land stretched from North-East by East to West by South ½ South; the latter was a low point about 3 leagues away. We were directly in front of a small creek or inlet into the low land, which is located at a latitude of 9 degrees 34 minutes South. This might be the same spot Dampier entered with his boat since it didn’t appear to have enough water depth for anything else. While we were heading toward the shore, we took soundings several times but didn’t get any readings until we were within 2.5 miles of the shore, where we found 25 fathoms of soft bottom. We stayed offshore until midnight with the wind coming from the South, then changed course and sailed west for 2 hours. The wind then shifted to South-West and West-South-West, so we turned south. In the morning, we found the variation to be 1 degree 10 minutes West using the amplitude, and 1 degree 27 minutes West using the azimuth; at noon, our observation placed us at a latitude of 9 degrees 45 minutes South and a longitude of 234 degrees 12 minutes West, about 6 or 7 leagues from the land, which stretched from North 31 degrees East to West-South-West ½ West. The wind was at South-South-West, with a gentle breeze.

Friday, 14th. Light Land and Sea breezes; the former we had from West by North, and only a few hours in the morning, the latter we had from the South-South-West and South. With these winds we advanced but slowly to the Westward. At Noon we were about 6 or 7 Leagues from the Land, which extended from North by East to South 78 degrees West; our Latitude by Observation was 9 degrees 54 minutes South. Course and Distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 68 degrees West, 24 Miles. We saw several Smoakes ashore in the P.M., and fires in the night, both upon the Low land and up in the Mountains.

Friday, 14th. We had light land and sea breezes; the land breeze was coming from the west-northwest, but it only lasted for a few hours in the morning. The sea breeze came from the south-southwest and south. With these winds, we moved slowly westward. By noon, we were about 6 or 7 leagues from the land, which stretched from north by east to south 78 degrees west; our latitude by observation was 9 degrees 54 minutes south. Since yesterday noon, we traveled south 68 degrees west for 24 miles. In the afternoon, we saw several smokes onshore and saw fires at night, both on the lowland and up in the mountains.

Saturday, 15th. In the P.M. had the Sea breezes at South-South-West and South, with which we stood to the Westward until 8 o'Clock, when being about 3 Leagues from the Land, and having very little wind, we tack'd and lay her Head off Shore. At 11 o'Clock we got the Land wind at North by West, with which we steer'd South-West by West along shore, keeping about 4 or 5 Miles from the Land on which in the morning we saw several Houses, Plantations, etc. At 9 o'Clock we got the wind at North-East by East, a light breeze; at Noon we were about 2 Leagues from the Land, which extended as far to the Southward as South-West by West; our Latitude by observation was 10 degrees 1 minute South. Course and Distance sail'd since Yesterday at Noon South 78 degrees 45 minutes West, 36 Miles.

Saturday, 15th. In the afternoon, we had sea breezes coming from the south-southwest and south, which allowed us to head west until 8 o'clock. At that point, we were about 3 leagues from shore and with very little wind, so we tacked and pointed the bow away from the land. At 11 o'clock, we picked up a land breeze from north by west, and we steered southwest by west along the shore, keeping about 4 or 5 miles from land, where we saw several houses and plantations in the morning. By 9 o'clock, the wind had shifted to northeast by east, a light breeze; at noon, we were about 2 leagues from the land, which extended as far south as southwest by west; our latitude was recorded as 10 degrees 1 minute south. Since yesterday at noon, we have traveled south 78 degrees 45 minutes west for a distance of 36 miles.

Sunday, 16th. Light breezes from the North-East by East, with clear weather, except in the morning, when we had it cloudy, with a few small Showers of Rain. Steer'd along shore South-West and South-West by West until 6 o'Clock in the morning, when we steer'd West-South-West, and at 9, West, at which time we saw the Island Rotte right ahead. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 10 degrees 39 minutes, Longitude 235 degrees 57 minutes; the South end of Timor bore North-North-West, distant 5 or 6 Leagues; the Island of Rotte extending from South 75 degrees West to North 67 degrees West, and the Island of Anaboa as Dampier calls it, or Seman* (* Semao. This island lies off the Dutch settlement of Koepang or Concordia in Timor; but Cook was right in supposing he would have received but a cold reception there. The Dutch discouraged any visits at their outlying settlements. Rotte is a large island lying off the south-west end of Timor.) as it is called in the Charts, which lies of the South end of Timor, bore North-West. Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday noon South 55 degrees 15 minutes West, 67 Miles. Dampier, who has given us a large and, so far as I know, an Accurate discription of the Island of Timor, says that it is 70 Leagues long and 16 Broad, and that it lies North-East and South-West. I found the East side to lie nearest North-East by East and South-West by West, and the South end to lie in the Latitude 10 degrees 23 minutes South, Longitude 236 degrees 5 minutes West from Greenwich. We run about 45 Leagues along the East side, which I observed to be free from Danger, and, excepting near the South end, the Land which bounds the Sea is low for 2, 3, or 4 Miles inland, and seem'd in many places to be intersected with Salt Creeks. Behind the low land are Mountains, which rise one above another to a considerable height. We continually saw upon it smoakes by day and fires by night, and in many places houses and plantations. I was strongly importuned by some of my Officers to go to the Dutch settlement at Concordia, on this Island, for refreshments; but this I refused to comply with, knowing that the Dutch look upon all Europeans with a Jealous Eye that come among these Islands, and our necessities were not so great as to oblige me to put into a place where I might expect to be but indifferently treated.

Sunday, the 16th. There were light breezes from the North-East by East, with clear weather, except in the morning when it was cloudy with a few light rain showers. We sailed along the coast South-West and South-West by West until 6 AM, when we changed course to West-South-West, and at 9 AM, to West, at which point we spotted Rotte Island directly ahead. At noon, we were at a latitude of 10 degrees 39 minutes and a longitude of 235 degrees 57 minutes; the southern tip of Timor was to the North-North-West, about 5 or 6 leagues away; Rotte Island extended from South 75 degrees West to North 67 degrees West, and the Island of Anaboa, or Seman* (* Semao. This island is off the Dutch settlement of Koepang or Concordia in Timor; Cook was correct in thinking he would be poorly received there. The Dutch discouraged any visits to their outer settlements. Rotte is a large island at the south-west end of Timor.) as indicated on the maps, was to the North-West of the southern tip of Timor. Since yesterday noon, we had sailed a distance of South 55 degrees 15 minutes West, 67 miles. Dampier, who provided a thorough and accurate description of Timor Island, states that it is 70 leagues long and 16 broad, and lies North-East and South-West. I found the east side to be nearest to North-East by East and South-West by West, with the southern tip situated at a latitude of 10 degrees 23 minutes South and a longitude of 236 degrees 5 minutes West from Greenwich. We covered about 45 leagues along the east side, which I noted was safe, and aside from near the southern tip, the land bordering the sea is low for 2, 3, or 4 miles inland, often intersected with salt creeks. Behind the low land, mountains rose one above the other to a significant height. We continuously saw smoke during the day and fires at night, along with many houses and plantations. Some of my officers strongly urged me to visit the Dutch settlement at Concordia for supplies, but I declined, knowing that the Dutch view all Europeans with suspicion when they come to these islands, and our needs were not pressing enough to risk going to a place where we might expect to be treated poorly.

[Anchor at Savu.]

[Dock at Savu.]

Monday, 17th. Winds Easterly, with which we steer'd West-North-West until 2 o'Clock, when being pretty near the North end of Rotte, we hauled up North-North-West, in order to go between it and Anaboa. After steering 3 Leagues upon this Course we edged away North-West by West, and by 6 we were clear of all the Islands; at this time the South part of Anaboa, which lies in the Latitude of 10 degrees 15 minutes South, bore North-East, distant 4 Leagues, and the Island of Rotte extending as far to the Southward as South 36 degrees West. The North End of this Island and the South end of Timor lies North 1/2 East and 1/2 West, distant about 3 or 4 Leagues from each other. At the West end of the Passage between Rotte and Anaboa are two Small Islands; the one lays near the Rotte shore and the other off the South-West point of Anaboa; there is a good Channel between the 2 of 5 or 6 Miles broad, which we came thro'. Being now clear of the Islands we steer'd a West course all night until 6 a.m., when we unexpectedly saw an Island* (* Savu. An island about twenty miles in length. It is but little visited or known by others than the Dutch to this day.) bearing West-South-West, for by most of the Maps we had on board we were to the Southward of all the Islands that lay between Timor and Java; at least there were none laid down so near Timor in this Latitude by almost one half, which made me at first think it a new discovery; but in this I was mistaken. We now steer'd directly for it, and by 10 o'Clock were close in with the North side, where we saw Houses, Cocoa Nutt Trees, and a Flock of Cattle grazing; these were Temptations hardly to be withstood by people in our situation, especially such as were but in a very indifferent State of Health, and I may say mind too, for in some this last was worse than the other, since I refused to touch at the Island of Timor, whereupon I thought I could not do less than to try to procure some refreshments here, as there appeared to be plenty.* (* Cook's utter indifference as to what he eat or drank made him regard privations in the matter of food with an equanimity which was not shared by the rest of his companions.) With this View we hoisted out the Pinnace, in which I sent Lieutenant Gore in shore to see if there were any Convenient place to land, sending some trifles along with him to give to the Natives in case he saw any. Mr. Gore landed in a small sandy cove near to some Houses, and was met on the beach by 8 or 10 of the people, who from both their behaviour and what they had about them shew'd that they had Commerce with Europeans; upon Mr. Gore's returning with this report, and likewise that there was No Anchorage for the Ship, I sent him away with both money and goods to try to purchase some refreshments, while we keept standing on and off with the Ship. At Noon we were about a Mile from the Shore of the Island, which extends from South-East to West-North-West, Latitude 10 degrees 27 minutes, Longitude 237 degrees 31 minutes West.

Monday, the 17th. The winds were coming from the east, and we steered west-northwest until 2 o'clock. We were nearing the northern end of Rotte, so we changed our course to north-northwest to navigate between it and Anaboa. After going on this course for 3 leagues, we adjusted to north-west by west, and by 6 o'clock, we had cleared all the islands. At this time, the southern part of Anaboa, located at a latitude of 10 degrees 15 minutes south, was northeast of us, about 4 leagues away, while the island of Rotte stretched as far south as south 36 degrees west. The northern end of this island and the southern end of Timor were positioned north half east and half west, roughly 3 or 4 leagues apart. At the western end of the passage between Rotte and Anaboa, there are two small islands; one is close to the Rotte shore, and the other is off the southwestern point of Anaboa. There is a good channel between these two that is 5 or 6 miles wide, which we passed through. Now clear of the islands, we steered west all night until 6 a.m., when we unexpectedly spotted an island* (* Savu. An island about twenty miles long. It's not frequently visited or known by anyone other than the Dutch to this day.) bearing west-southwest. Based on most of the maps we had on board, we were south of all the islands lying between Timor and Java; in fact, there were none marked so close to Timor at this latitude, at least not within one half's distance, which initially made me think it was a new discovery, but I was mistaken. We now headed directly toward it, and by 10 o'clock, we were close to the north side, where we saw houses, coconut trees, and a flock of cattle grazing. These were hard to resist for people in our situation, especially for those who were in poor health, and I can say that the state of mind for some was worse than their physical health since I had refused to stop at Timor. I thought it was only right to try to get some supplies here, as there seemed to be plenty.* (* Cook's complete indifference to what he ate or drank made him view food shortages with a calmness not shared by the rest of his companions.) With this goal in mind, we lowered the pinnace, and I sent Lieutenant Gore ashore to find a suitable place to land, taking some small items with him to offer to the locals if he encountered any. Mr. Gore landed in a small sandy cove near some houses and was greeted on the beach by 8 or 10 people, who, based on their behavior and what they had, showed signs of trade with Europeans. Upon Mr. Gore's return with this report, and noting there was no anchorage for the ship, I sent him out with both money and goods to try to buy some refreshments while we continued to maneuver the ship. By noon, we were about a mile from the shore of the island, which stretches from southeast to west-northwest, at a latitude of 10 degrees 27 minutes and a longitude of 237 degrees 31 minutes west.

Tuesday, 18th. As soon as Mr. Gore landed he was meet on the beach by several people, both Horse and Foot, who gave him to understand that there was a Bay to Leeward where we could Anchor, and likewise get refreshments. Upon Mr. Gore's return with this intelligence we bore away for the Bay, in which we Anchor'd at 7 o'Clock in 38 fathoms Water, Clean sandy bottom. About a Mile from Shore the North point of the Bay bore North 30 degrees East, 2 1/2 Miles, and the South point or West end of the Island bore South 63 degrees West. Two hours before we Anchor'd we saw Dutch Colours hoisted in a Village which stands about a Mile inland, and at day light in the Morning the same Colours were hoisted on the beach abreast of the Ship. By this I was no longer in doubt but what here was a Dutch settlement, and accordingly sent Lieutenant Gore on shore to wait upon the Governor, or chief person residing here, to acquaint him with the reasons that induced us to touch at this Island. Upon Mr. Gore's landing we could perceive that he was received by a Guard of the Natives, and not Dutch Troops, and Conducted up to the Village where the Colours were hoisted last night. Some time after this I received a message from him, acquainting me that he was there with the king of the Island, who had told him that he could not supply him with anything without leave from the Dutch Governor, who resided at another part of the Island, but that he had sent to acquaint him of our Arrival and request.

Tuesday, 18th. As soon as Mr. Gore landed, he was greeted on the beach by several people, both on horseback and on foot, who informed him that there was a bay to the leeward where we could anchor and also get some refreshments. When Mr. Gore returned with this information, we set sail for the bay, where we anchored at 7 o'clock in 38 fathoms of water, with a clean sandy bottom. About a mile from shore, the north point of the bay was at North 30 degrees East, 2 1/2 miles away, and the south point or west end of the island was at South 63 degrees West. Two hours before we anchored, we saw Dutch colors raised in a village that stands about a mile inland, and at dawn the next morning, the same colors were displayed on the beach in front of the ship. This confirmed my suspicion that there was a Dutch settlement here, so I sent Lieutenant Gore ashore to meet with the governor or the main person in charge to explain why we had come to this island. Upon landing, it was clear that he was welcomed by a guard of the natives, not Dutch troops, and was taken to the village where the colors had been raised the night before. Some time later, I received a message from him saying that he was there with the king of the island, who had told him that he couldn't provide any supplies without permission from the Dutch governor, who lived on another part of the island, but he had sent a message to inform him of our arrival and request.

[At Anchor. Savu.]

[At Anchor. Savu.]

Wednesday, 19th. At 2 P.M. the Dutch Governor, and king of this part of the Island, with his attendance, came on board with Mr. Gore (he having left 2 Gentlemen ashore as Hostages). We entertained them at Dinner in the best Manner we could, gave them plenty of good Liquor, made them some considerable presents, and at their going away Saluted them with 9 Guns. In return for these favours they made many fair Promises that we should be immediately supplied with everything we wanted at the same price the Dutch East India Company had it; and that in the morning Buffaloes, Hogs, Sheep, etc., should be down on the beach for us to look at, and agree upon a price. I was not at all at a loss for Interpreters, for both Dr. Solander and Mr. Sporing understood Dutch enough to keep up a Conversation with the Dutchman, and several of the Natives could speak Portuguese, which language 2 or 3 of my people understood. In the morning I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and several of the Officers and Gentlemen, to return the King's Visit; but my Chief Business was to see how well they would perform their Promises in regard to the things I wanted. We had not been long ashore before we found that they had promised more than they ever intended to perform; for, instead of finding Buffaloes upon the beach, we did not so much as see one, or the least preparations making for bringing any down, either by the Dutch Factor or the King. The former pretended he had been very ill all night, and told us that he had had a letter from the Governor of Concordia in Timor, acquainting him that a ship (meaning us) had lately passed that Island, and that if she should touch at this, and be in want of anything, he was to supply her; but he was not to suffer her to make any stay, nor to distribute, or leave behind her to be distributed, any valuable presents to the inferior Natives. This we looked upon to be Afection that hardly answer'd any purpose, unless it was leting us see how the Dutch had insinuated themselves into favour with these people, which never could be his intention. However, both he and the King still promised we should have what we wanted, but pretended the Buffaloes were far in the Country, and could not be brought down before night. With these excuses we were obliged to be satisfied. The King gave us a dinner of boil'd Pork and Rice, served up in Baskets after their manner, and Palm wine to drink; with this, and some of our own Liquor, we fair'd Tolerable well. After we had dined our Servants were called in to pertake of what remain'd, which was more than they could Eat.

Wednesday, 19th. At 2 PM, the Dutch Governor and king of this part of the Island, along with his entourage, came on board with Mr. Gore (who had left 2 gentlemen onshore as hostages). We hosted them for dinner in the best way we could, served them plenty of good liquor, gave them some significant gifts, and as they were leaving, we saluted them with 9 guns. In return for these favors, they made many nice promises that we would be immediately supplied with everything we needed at the same price the Dutch East India Company had it; and that in the morning, buffaloes, hogs, sheep, etc., would be brought down to the beach for us to check out and agree on a price. I had no trouble finding interpreters since both Dr. Solander and Mr. Sporing understood enough Dutch to hold a conversation with the Dutchman, and several of the natives spoke Portuguese, which a few of my people understood. In the morning, I went on shore, accompanied by Mr. Banks and several officers and gentlemen, to return the king's visit; but my main goal was to see how well they would keep their promises regarding the items I needed. We hadn’t been onshore long before we realized they had promised more than they intended to deliver; instead of finding buffaloes on the beach, we didn’t even see one or any preparations being made to bring any down, either by the Dutch factor or the king. The factor claimed he had been very ill all night and told us that he had received a letter from the governor of Concordia in Timor, informing him that a ship (referring to us) had recently passed that island, and that if it stopped here and needed anything, he was to supply it; however, he was instructed not to let it stay long or distribute, or leave behind for distribution, any valuable gifts to the lower natives. We viewed this as a formality that hardly served any purpose, unless it was to show us how the Dutch had ingratiated themselves with these people, which could never have been his intention. Nonetheless, both he and the king continued to promise we would get what we needed but claimed the buffaloes were far inland and couldn’t be brought down until night. With these excuses, we had to be satisfied. The king treated us to a meal of boiled pork and rice, served in baskets as they typically do, and palm wine to drink; with that, along with some of our own liquor, we managed quite well. After we finished dining, our servants were called in to share what remained, which was more than they could eat.

Thursday, 20th. We stay'd at the King's Pallace all the Afternoon, and at last were obliged to return on board without doing anything farther than a promise of having some Buffaloes in the morning; which we had now no great reason to rely on. In the morning I went on shore again, and was showed one small Buffaloe, which they asked 5 Guineas for. I offer'd 3, which the man told me he would gladly take, and sent a Message to the king to let him know what I had offer'd. The Messenger soon return'd, and let me know that I could not have it under 5 Guineas; and this I refused to give, knowing it was not worth one fifth part of the money. But this, my refusal, had like to have overset all we had before done, for soon after about 100 Men, some Arm'd with Musquets, others with Lances, came down to the Landing Place. Besides the officer that commanded this party, there came along with them a Man who spoke Portuguese, and I believe was born of Portuguese Parents. This man is here (as we afterwards Understood) as an Assistant to the Dutch Factor. He deliver'd to me the King's order, or rather those of the Dutch Factor, the purport of which was that we were to stay no longer than this day, pretending that the people would not trade with us because we wanted their provisions for nothing, etc.; whereas the Natives shew'd the greatest inclination imaginable to supply us with whatever they had, and were far more desirous of goods than money, and were, before this man came, selling us Fowls and Syrup as fast as they could bring these things down. From this and other Circumstances we were well Assured that this was all the Dutchman's doing, in order to extort from us a sum of Money to put into his own pocket. There hapned to be an old Raja at this time upon the beach, whose Interest I had secured in the Morning by presenting him with a Spy-glass; this man I now took by the hand, and presented him with an old broad sword. This effectually secured him in our Interest, for the Moment he got it he began to flourish it over the old Portuguese, and made him and the Officer commanded the party to sit down at his back side. Immediately after this trade was restored again for Fowls, etc., with more Spirit than ever; but before I could begin a Trade for Buffaloes, which was what we most wanted, I was obliged to give 10 Guineas for 2, one of which weigh'd only 160 pounds. After this I bought 7 more at a more reasonable price, one of which we lost after he was paid for. I might now have purchased as many as I pleased, for they now drove them down to the Water side by Herds; but having got as many as I well know'd what to do with, and likewise a number of Fowls, and a large quantity of Syrup, I resolved to make no longer stay.

Thursday, 20th. We stayed at the King's Palace all afternoon, and in the end, we had to go back on board without accomplishing anything other than a promise for some buffaloes in the morning, which we now had little reason to trust. In the morning, I went ashore again and was shown one small buffalo, which they wanted 5 guineas for. I offered 3, which the man said he would gladly accept, and he sent a message to the king to inform him of my offer. The messenger quickly returned, letting me know that I couldn’t get it for less than 5 guineas, which I refused to pay, knowing it wasn’t worth even a fifth of that amount. However, my refusal nearly jeopardized everything we had done so far, as soon after, about 100 men, some armed with muskets and others with lances, came down to the landing area. Along with the officer in charge of this group, there was a man who spoke Portuguese, and I believe he was born to Portuguese parents. We later learned that this man was here as an assistant to the Dutch factor. He handed me the king's orders, or rather those from the Dutch factor, telling us we could stay no longer than today, claiming the locals wouldn't trade with us because we wanted their provisions for nothing, etc. But the natives clearly showed a strong willingness to supply us with whatever they had and were much more interested in goods than money. Before this man arrived, they had been selling us chickens and syrup as fast as they could bring them down. From this and other signs, we were certain that this was all the Dutchman’s scheme to extort money for himself. There happened to be an old raja at the beach whose favor I had secured in the morning by giving him a spyglass; I took his hand and presented him with an old broadsword. This effectively secured his loyalty to us, as the moment he received it, he began to wave it around at the old Portuguese man and ordered the officer commanding the party to sit down behind him. Immediately after this, trade was restored for chickens and more with greater enthusiasm than ever. However, before I could start trading for buffaloes, which was our main goal, I had to pay 10 guineas for 2, one of which weighed only 160 pounds. After that, I bought 7 more at a more reasonable price, although we lost one after it was paid for. I could now have purchased as many as I wanted, as they were being driven down to the water in herds, but since I had gotten as many as I could handle, along with several chickens and a large quantity of syrup, I decided not to stay any longer.

Friday, 21st. We got under sail, and stood away to the Westward along the North side of the Island, and another smaller Island, which lies farther to the Westward, which last bore from us at Noon South-South-East, distant 2 Leagues.

Friday, 21st. We set sail and headed west along the north side of the island, and another smaller island further west, which was located to our south-southeast at noon, about 2 leagues away.

[Description of Savu.]

[Description of Savu.]

Before we proceed any further it will be proper in this place to say something of the Island we have been last at, which is called by the Natives Savu. The Middle of it lies in about the Latitude of 10 degrees 35 minutes South, Longitude 237 degrees 30 minutes West. It may be about 8 Leagues in length from East to West, but of what breadth I know not, because I only saw the North side. There are, as I am told, 3 Bays where Ships can Anchor; the best is on the South-West side of the South-East point; the one we lay in, called Seba, lies on the North-West side of the Island. This bay is very well sheltered from the South-East Trade wind, but lays wholy open to the North-West. The Land of this Island which bounds the Sea is, in general, low, but in the Middle of the Island are Hills of a moderate height, and the whole is agreeably diversified with woods and Lawns, which afford a most pleasing prospect from the Sea. We were told that the Island is but indifferently water'd in the dry Season, especially towards the latter end of it, at which time there is no running Stream upon the whole Island, only small Springs, which are all at a distance from the Sea side. The dry seasons commences in March or April, and ends in November; the remaining 3 or 4 Months they have Westerly winds with rain, and this the time their Crops of Rice, Calivances, and Indian Corn are brought forth, which are Articles that this Island produceth.

Before we go any further, it's important to say a bit about the island we were just at, called Savu by the locals. The center of it is located around 10 degrees 35 minutes South latitude and 237 degrees 30 minutes West longitude. It’s approximately 8 leagues long from east to west, but I can't say how wide it is since I only saw the northern side. I heard there are 3 bays where ships can anchor; the best one is on the southwest side of the southeast point. The bay we stayed in, called Seba, is on the northwest side of the island. This bay is well protected from the southeast trade winds but is completely exposed to the northwest. The land around the island is mostly low, but there are hills of moderate height in the middle, and the whole area is pleasantly varied with woods and lawns, offering a lovely view from the sea. We were told that the island doesn't have much water during the dry season, especially towards the end, when there are no running streams at all, only small springs that are all far from the seaside. The dry season starts in March or April and ends in November; for the remaining 3 or 4 months, they have westerly winds with rain, which is when their crops of rice, calabashes, and corn are produced, the main products of this island.

They also breed a great Number of Cattle, viz., Buffaloes, Horses, Hogs, Sheep, and Goats. Many of the former are sent to Concordia, where they are kill'd and salted, in order to be sent to the more Northern Islands, which are under the Dominion of the Dutch. Sheep and Goats' flesh is dried upon this Island, packed up in Bales, and sent to Concordia for the same purpose. The Dutch resident, from whom we had this information, told us that the Dutch at Concordia had lately behaved so ill to the Natives of Timor that they were obliged to have recourse to this Island and others Adjacent for provisions for their own subsistance, and likewise Troops (Natives of this Island) to assist the Dutch against those of Timor. Besides the above productions, here are an Emmence Number of Palm Trees, from which is extracted the Palm Wine, as it is called, a very sweet, agreeable, cooling Liquor. What they do not immediately use they boil down and make Syrup or Sugar of, which they keep in Earthen Jarrs. Here are likewise Cocoa Nutts, Tamerind Trees, Limes etc., but in no great plenty; Indico, Cotton, and Cinnamon, sufficient to serve the Natives; these last Articles, we were told, the Dutch discourage the growth of.

They also raise a large number of livestock, including buffalo, horses, pigs, sheep, and goats. Many of the buffalo are sent to Concordia, where they are slaughtered and salted to be transported to the northern islands controlled by the Dutch. The flesh of sheep and goats is dried on this island, packed into bales, and sent to Concordia for the same purpose. The Dutch resident, who provided us with this information, mentioned that the Dutch in Concordia had recently treated the natives of Timor so poorly that they had to rely on this island and nearby ones for food supplies and also for local troops to help them against the Timorese. In addition to these products, there are a large number of palm trees from which palm wine—a very sweet and refreshing drink—is made. What they don’t use right away, they boil down to make syrup or sugar, which they store in earthen jars. There are also coconuts, tamarind trees, limes, etc., but not in large quantities; indigo, cotton, and cinnamon are sufficient for the locals; we were told the Dutch discourage the growth of these last items.

The Island is divided into 5 Kingdoms, which have lived in Peace and Amity with each other for these hundred Years. At present the whole Island is partly under the direction of the Dutch East India Company, who have a Resident or Factor who constantly lives here, without whose leave the Natives are not to supply any other Nation with anything whatever; but the whole produce of the Island, besides what serves themselves, is in a manner the property of the Company. The Company by way of a Tribute oblige them to raise and pay Annually a certain quantity of Rice, Indian Corn, and Callivances, for which the Company makes Each of the Kings a yearly present of a Cask of Arrack, and some other Trifles; the live stock, Sheep and Goats' flesh, etc., they pay for in goods. The small Islands which lie about a League to the Westward of this pays Annually a Certain quantity of Arica Nutts, which is almost the only produce of that Island.

The Island is divided into 5 Kingdoms, which have lived in peace and friendship with each other for the past hundred years. Currently, the entire Island is partly under the control of the Dutch East India Company, which has an official residing here. Without the Company’s permission, the locals aren’t allowed to trade with any other nation. Essentially, everything produced on the Island, apart from what the locals use for themselves, belongs to the Company. The Company requires the locals to annually provide a certain amount of rice, corn, and other crops as a form of tribute, and in return, they give each King a yearly gift of a barrel of arrack and some other minor items. Livestock like sheep and goats are paid for with goods. The small Islands located about a league to the west of this one also pay an annual tribute of certain quantities of areca nuts, which are almost the only product from that Island.

The Island of Rotte is upon the same footing as this of Savu; both these Islands, and the 3 Solors, belong to the Government of Concordia. From what we could learn of the Island of Timor, it seems to be much upon the same footing as it was in Dampier's time, which is that the Dutch possess little more of that Island than what lies under the Command of the Fort Concordia; the rest is in possession either of the Native Indians or the Portuguese. We were likewise told that the Island of Ende belongs to the Portuguese; that the principal settlement is at Larentucha, where there is a Fort and a good Harbour. We were told that the Concordia, on the Island Timor, is a free Port for Ships of any nation to touch at, where they would not only be supplied with refreshments, but Naval Stores also. Trading ships might probably meet with a good reception, but Kings' ships, I am perswaided, would be looked upon as Spys. For my own part was I only in want of refreshments, and obliged to touch at any of these Islands, I should prefer going to a Portuguese settlement before any of the Dutch, and when I was solicited by the Officers to call at Timor, I proposed going to one of the Portuguese settlements; but this Mr. Hicks made some Objections to, which was sufficient for me to lay it aside, as I had not the least inclination to touch any where till we arriv'd at Batavia, for my falling in with Savu was more chance and not design.

The Island of Rotte is in the same situation as Savu; both islands, along with the three Solors, are under the control of the Government of Concordia. From what we gathered about the Island of Timor, it seems to be much like it was in Dampier's time, meaning the Dutch have little more than what is under the authority of Fort Concordia; the rest is in the hands of either the Native Indians or the Portuguese. We were also informed that the Island of Ende belongs to the Portuguese, with the main settlement at Larentucha, which has a fort and a good harbor. We heard that Concordia, on the Island of Timor, is a free port for ships of any nation to stop at, where they can not only get refreshments but also naval supplies. Trading ships would likely be well received, but I believe ships belonging to kings would be viewed as spies. Personally, if I needed refreshments and had to stop at any of these islands, I would prefer to go to a Portuguese settlement over any Dutch one. When the officers asked me to stop at Timor, I suggested going to one of the Portuguese settlements; however, Mr. Hicks had some objections, which was enough for me to drop the idea since I had no real desire to stop anywhere until we reached Batavia, as my encounter with Savu was more by chance than intention.

But to return to this Island, the Natives of which are of a Dark brown Colour, with long lank Hair; their Cloathing is a peice of Calicoe or other Cotton Cloath wrapped about their Middle; the better sort have another peice, which they wear over their Shoulders, and the most of them wear Turbands or Handkercheifs tyed round their Heads. They Eat of all the Tame Animals they have got, viz., Hogs, Horses, Buffaloes, Cocks and Hens, Dogs, Catts, Sheep and Goats, and are esteem'd much in the same order, as I have mentioned; that is, their Hog flesh, which is certainly as good as any in the world, they prefer before anything else; next to Hogs, Horses, and so on. Fish is not esteem'd by them, and is only eat by the common or poor people, who are allowed little else of meat kind.

But to return to this island, the natives of which have dark brown skin and long, straight hair; their clothing consists of a piece of calico or other cotton fabric wrapped around their waists. The wealthier individuals have an additional piece that they drape over their shoulders, and most of them wear turbans or handkerchiefs tied around their heads. They eat all the domesticated animals they have, including pigs, horses, buffalo, roosters, hens, dogs, cats, sheep, and goats, and they are valued in a similar order as mentioned. Their pork, which is certainly as good as any in the world, is their favorite, followed by horses and so on. Fish isn't valued by them and is mostly consumed by the common or poor people, who have little else in terms of meat.

They have a Custom among them, that whenever a king dies all the Cattle, etc., that are upon his Estate are kill'd, with which the Successor makes a feast, to which is invited all the principal people of the Island, who stay until all is consumed; after this they every one, according to his Abilities, make the young King a present, by which means he gets a fresh stock, which he is obliged to Husband for some time. The other principal men make also feasts, which are as extraordinary as these, for they seldom end so long as the giver has got anything left alive upon his Estate. They are said to be a people of good Morals, Virtuous and Chaste, each man having only one wife, which he keeps for life; Fornication and Adultry is hardly known among them. When a great Man marrys he makes presents to all his Wife's relations of European and other Foreign commodities to the value of 100 Rix Dollars. This Custom the Dutch East India Company find it to their Interest to incourage. They speak a Language peculiar to themselves, into which the Dutch have caus'd the new Testament to be Translated, and have introduced it, with the use of letters and writing, among them. By this means several hundred of them have been converted to Christianity; the rest are some heathens, and others of no religion at all, and yet they all stick up to the strict rules of Morality. They all, both Men and Women, Young and Old, Chew of the Beetle Leaf, Areca Nutts, and a sort of white lime, which I believe is made from Coral stone; this has such an effect upon the Teeth that very few, even of the Young people, have hardly any left in their Heads, and those they have are as black as Ink. Their houses are built on posts about 4 feet from the Ground; we asked the reason why they built them so, and was told that it was only Custom; they are, however, certainly the Cooler for it. They are thatched with Palm Leaves, and the Floors and sides are boarded.

They have a custom where, whenever a king dies, all the cattle and other livestock on his estate are killed. The successor then hosts a feast, inviting all the important people from the island, who stay until everything is eaten. After the feast, everyone gives the young king a gift based on their means, which helps him start fresh, and he's expected to manage it for a while. Other prominent men also host feasts, which are just as grand, continuing as long as the host has anything alive on his estate. They are said to be a people with good morals, virtuous and chaste, each man having only one wife for life; fornication and adultery are rarely seen among them. When a prominent man marries, he gives gifts to all his wife's relatives, consisting of European and other foreign goods, worth around 100 Rix Dollars. The Dutch East India Company encourages this custom because it benefits them. They speak a unique language, into which the Dutch have had the New Testament translated, and they have introduced letters and writing. Because of this, several hundred of them have converted to Christianity; the rest are either heathens or have no religion at all, yet they all adhere to strict moral rules. Both men and women, young and old, chew betel leaf, areca nuts, and a type of white lime that I believe is made from coral stone. This has such an effect on their teeth that very few young people have any teeth left, and those that do are as black as ink. Their houses are built on posts about four feet above the ground. When we asked why they build them this way, they said it was just tradition; however, it does keep them cooler. The roofs are thatched with palm leaves, and the floors and sides are boarded.

The man who resides upon this Island in behalf of the Dutch East India Company is a German by birth. His name is Johan Christopher Lange. It is hard to say upon what footing he is here. He is so far a Governor that the Natives dare do nothing without his consent, and yet he can transact no sort of business with Foreigners either in his own or that of the Company's name; nor can it be a place of either Honour or Profit. He is the only white man upon the Island, and has resided there ever since it has been under the direction of the Dutch, which is about 10 Years. He is allowed 50 Slaves (Natives of the Island) to attend upon him. These belong to, and are Maintained by, the Company. He goes the Circuit of the Island once in 2 Months; but on what account he did not tell us. When he makes these rounds he carries with him a certain quantity of Spirit to treat the great men with, which, he says, he is obliged to look well after, otherwise they would steal it and get drunk; and yet, at another time, he told us that he never knew a theft committed in the Island; but some of the Natives themselves contradicted him in this by stealing from us an Axe. However, from their behaviour to us in general I am of opinion that they are but seldom guilty of these Crimes. This going round the Island once in Two Months is most likely to see that the Natives make the necessary preparations for fulfilling their engagements with the Dutch, and to see that the Large Boats or small Vessels are taken proper care of, which the Dutch keep in all the Bays of this Island in order to collect and carry the grain, etc., to the Ship which comes Annually here. They are likewise employed in carrying cattle, grain, etc., to Timor; and, when not wanted, they are hauled aShore into Houses or Sheds built on purpose. As I have mentioned Slaves, it is necessary to observe that all the great men have Slaves which are the Natives of the Island. They can dispose of them one to another, but cannot sell them to go out of the Island. The price of a Slave is a good, large, fatt Hogg, Horse, etc. I have before mentioned that many of the people can speak Portuguese, but hardly any one Dutch. From this it is probable that this Island was formerly under the Jurisdiction of the Portuguese, tho' the Dutch Government never own'd as much, but said that the Dutch had Traded here these hundred years past.* (* This account of the economy of Savu is a good example of Cook's powers of observation. He was only four days at the island, and yet gives us a good idea of the place and its inhabitants.)

The guy living on this island for the Dutch East India Company is originally from Germany. His name is Johan Christopher Lange. It’s hard to figure out what his role is here. He acts as a governor since the locals won’t do anything without his approval, but he can’t handle any dealings with foreigners in his own name or the Company's. It's not a position of honor or profit. He’s the only white person on the island and has been there ever since the Dutch took over about ten years ago. He has 50 native slaves to assist him, which the Company provides for. He makes a tour around the island every two months, though he didn’t explain why. During these rounds, he takes a certain amount of alcohol to offer to the local leaders, claiming he has to keep an eye on it, or they’d steal it and get drunk. Yet, he also mentioned that he’s never witnessed any theft on the island, though some locals contradicted him by stealing an axe from us. Overall, based on their behavior towards us, I think they don’t commit these crimes very often. His regular visits every two months are likely to ensure the locals are prepared to fulfill their agreements with the Dutch and to check that the large boats or smaller vessels are being properly looked after. The Dutch keep these vessels in all the bays of the island to collect and transport grain and other goods to the ship that comes here annually. They’re also used to move cattle and grain to Timor; when not in use, they are pulled ashore to houses or sheds built specifically for that purpose. Since I've mentioned slaves, it’s important to note that all the local leaders have slaves who are native to the island. They can trade them with each other but can’t sell them off the island. The price for a slave is a large, fat pig, horse, etc. I previously mentioned that many people here can speak Portuguese, but hardly anyone speaks Dutch. This suggests that the island was once under Portuguese control, though the Dutch government has never admitted this, claiming that they’ve been trading here for the past hundred years.* (*This account of Savu's economy showcases Cook's keen observational skills. He spent only four days on the island but still provides a solid understanding of the place and its people.)

[Sail from Savu.]

[Sail from Savu.]

Saturday, 22nd. Winds at South-South-East, South-East, and East; a gentle breeze, which we steer'd West-South-West by Compass. At 4 o'Clock we discover'd a small low Island* (* Dama Island.) bearing South-South-West, distant 3 Leagues. The Island hath no place in any of our Charts: Latitude 10 degrees 47 minutes South, Longitude 238 degrees 28 minutes West. At Noon we were in the Latitude of 11 degrees 9 minutes South, Longitude 239 degrees 26 minutes West. Course and distance sail'd since yesterday noon, South 63 West, 67 miles.

Saturday, 22nd. Winds from South-South-East, South-East, and East; a gentle breeze, so we steered West-South-West by compass. At 4 o'clock, we spotted a small low island (*Dama Island*) bearing South-South-West, 3 leagues away. This island isn’t marked on any of our charts: Latitude 10 degrees 47 minutes South, Longitude 238 degrees 28 minutes West. By noon, we were at a latitude of 11 degrees 9 minutes South, Longitude 239 degrees 26 minutes West. Since yesterday noon, we’ve traveled South 63 West, covering 67 miles.

Sunday, 23rd. Winds Easterly; a moderate breeze, which by noon brought us into the Latitude of 11 degrees 10 minutes South, Longitude 240 degrees 48 minutes West. Course and distance saild since yesterday at noon is West, 8 miles.

Sunday, 23rd. Winds from the east; a gentle breeze, which by noon brought us to a latitude of 11 degrees 10 minutes south, longitude 240 degrees 48 minutes west. Since yesterday at noon, we have traveled west for 8 miles.

Monday, 24th. Winds at East and South-East; a moderate breeze, and fine, pleasant weather. In the evening found the Variation to be 2 degrees 44 minutes West. At noon our Latitude was 11 degrees 8 minutes South, Longitude 242 degrees 13 minutes West. Since we have been clear of the Islands we have had constantly a swell from the Southward which I do not suppose is owing to the winds blowing anywhere from thence, but to the Sea, being so determined by the portion of the Coast of New Holland.

Monday, 24th. Winds coming from the East and South-East; a mild breeze, and nice, pleasant weather. In the evening, we found the Variation to be 2 degrees 44 minutes West. At noon, our Latitude was 11 degrees 8 minutes South, Longitude 242 degrees 13 minutes West. Since we've been clear of the Islands, we've consistently felt a swell from the South, which I don't believe is due to winds coming from that direction, but rather because of the influence of the coastline of New Holland.

Tuesday, 25th. Moderate breezes at South-East, and clear, pleasant weather. At Noon our Latitude was 11 degrees 13 minutes South, and Longitude 244 degrees 41" West.

Tuesday, 25th. Light winds coming from the southeast, with clear and pleasant weather. At noon, our latitude was 11 degrees 13 minutes south, and longitude was 244 degrees 41' west.

Wednesday, 26th. Winds and weather as yesterday. At Noon Latitude in 11 degrees 10 minutes, Longitude 245 degrees 41" West.

Wednesday, 26th. The winds and weather are the same as yesterday. At noon, the latitude is 11 degrees 10 minutes, longitude 245 degrees 41" West.

Thursday 27th. Winds at South-South-East; a fresh breeze. In the evening found the variation to be 3 degrees 10 minutes West. At noon we were in the Longitude of 247 degrees 42 minutes West, and Latitude 10 degrees 47 minutes, which is 25 Miles to the Northward of the Log, which I know not how to account for.

Thursday 27th. Winds coming from the South-Southeast; a fresh breeze. In the evening, I found the variation to be 3 degrees 10 minutes West. At noon, we were at a longitude of 247 degrees 42 minutes West and a latitude of 10 degrees 47 minutes, which is 25 miles to the north of the log, and I can't explain that.

Friday 28th. Winds at South-South-East and South-East; a fresh breeze and Cloudy, with some Showers of rain. At Noon Latitude observed 10 degrees 51 minutes South, which is agreeable to the Logg, Longitude in 250 degrees 9 minutes, West.

Friday 28th. Winds from the South-South-East and South-East; a fresh breeze and cloudy, with some showers of rain. At noon, the observed latitude was 10 degrees 51 minutes South, which matches the log, longitude 250 degrees 9 minutes West.

Saturday, 29th. Moderate breeze at South-East and clear pleasant weather, Steer'd North-West all this day, in order to make the land of Java. At Noon we were by Observation in the Latitude of 9 degrees 31 minutes South and Longitude 251 degrees 40 minutes West.

Saturday, 29th. There was a light breeze from the southeast and the weather was clear and pleasant. We steered northwest all day to reach the land of Java. At noon, we observed that we were at a latitude of 9 degrees 31 minutes south and a longitude of 251 degrees 40 minutes west.

Sunday, 30th. Fresh gales and fair weather. In the A.M. I took into my possession the Officers', Petty Officers' and Seamen's Log Books and Journals, at least all that I could find, and enjoin'd every one not to divulge where they had been.* (* These logs are now in the Public Record Office. Mr. Green's log ends on the 2nd October. Not being an officer, Cook doubtless overlooked it at first. This log should by rights have been returned to Mr. Green, but as he died shortly after leaving Batavia, it has found its way, with the others, to the Record Office.) At noon our Course and distance sail'd since Yesterday at noon, is North 20 degrees West, 126 Miles, which brought us into the Latitude of 7 degrees 34 minutes South and Longitude 252 degrees 23 minutes West.

Sunday, 30th. Fresh winds and nice weather. In the morning, I took possession of the Officers', Petty Officers', and Seamen's Log Books and Journals, at least all that I could find, and instructed everyone not to reveal where they had been.* (* These logs are now in the Public Record Office. Mr. Green's log ends on October 2nd. Since Cook wasn't an officer, he likely overlooked it at first. This log should have been returned to Mr. Green, but since he died shortly after leaving Batavia, it has ended up, along with the others, at the Record Office.) At noon, our course and distance sailed since yesterday at noon is North 20 degrees West, 126 miles, bringing us to a latitude of 7 degrees 34 minutes South and longitude of 252 degrees 23 minutes West.

[October 1770. Enter Sunda Strait. ]

[October 1770. Arrive at Sunda Strait.]

Monday, 1st October. First and latter parts fresh breezes at South-East and fair weather; the Middle squally with Lightning and rain. At 7 p.m., being then in the Latitude of Java head, and not seeing any land, assured us that we had got too far to the Westward; upon which we hauld up East-North-East, having before Steerd North by East. At 12 o'Clock saw the Land bearing East, Tack'd, and stood to the South-West until 4, then stood again to the Eastward, having very unsettled squally weather which split the Main Topsail very much, and obliged us to bend the other; many of our Sails are now so bad that they will hardly stand the least puff of Wind. At 6 o'Clock Java head, on the West end of Java, bore South-East by East, distant 5 Leagues; soon after this saw Princes Island, bearing East 1/2 South. At 10 o'Clock saw the Island of Cracatoa* (* The great eruption, and consequent destruction of the larger part of this island in 1883, will be remembered. It lies in the centre of Sunda Strait.) bearing North-East, distant 7 Leagues; Princes Island extending from South 53 degrees East to South by West, distant 3 Leagues. Course and distance saild since Yesterday at Noon is North 24 degrees 30 minutes East, 70 Miles. Latitude in per Observation, 6 degrees 29 minutes South, Longitude 251 degrees 54 minutes; but either our Longitude must be erroneous or the Straits of Sunda must be faltily laid down in all Books and Charts; but this no doubt we shall have an opportunity to settle.* (* Cook's longitude was in error nearly three degrees. No lunars had been taken since they left Savu, and there is a current running westward. It is a good example of the error of dead reckoning, even with the most careful of navigators.)

Monday, October 1st. The morning and evening had fresh breezes from the Southeast and clear weather; however, the middle of the day was stormy with lightning and rain. By 7 p.m., being at the latitude of Java Head and not seeing any land, it was clear we had drifted too far west. We then adjusted our course to East-North-East, having previously sailed North by East. At midnight, we spotted land to the East, made a tack, and moved southwest until 4 a.m., then turned back to the east, facing very unsettled and squally weather that caused significant damage to our main topsail and forced us to repair it; many of our sails are now in such poor condition that they can barely withstand even a light breeze. At 6 a.m., Java Head, on the western tip of Java, was located Southeast by East, about 5 leagues away; shortly after, we saw Princes Island to the East 1/2 South. At 10 a.m., we sighted the island of Krakatoa (the massive eruption and resulting destruction of most of this island in 1883 will be remembered. It lies in the center of the Sunda Strait.) bearing Northeast, 7 leagues away; Princes Island ranged from South 53 degrees East to South by West, 3 leagues away. The course and distance traveled since noon yesterday were North 24 degrees 30 minutes East, 70 miles. Latitude by observation is 6 degrees 29 minutes South, Longitude 251 degrees 54 minutes; either our longitude is incorrect, or the Sunda Strait is wrongly depicted in all books and charts; but surely, we will have the chance to confirm this. (Cook's longitude was nearly three degrees off. No lunar observations had been taken since leaving Savu, and a current flows westward. This is a clear example of the pitfalls of dead reckoning, even for the most meticulous navigators.)

Tuesday, 2nd. In the P.M., had the wind at South-South-East, South-East by South and South-South-East, with which we stood to the Eastward close upon a wind. At 6 o'Clock the Hill on Princes Island bore South-West by South, and Cracatoa Island, North 10 Miles; in this situation had 58 fathoms, standing still to the Eastward. At 8 o'Clock had 52 fathoms, muddy bottom, at 10 23 fathoms. By 4 in the morning we fetched close in with the Java shore in 15 fathoms, then steer'd along shore. At 5 it fell Calm, which continued with some Variable light Airs until noon, at which time Anger Point bore North-East, distant 1 League, and Thwart-the-way Island North. In the morning I sent a Boat ashore to try to get some fruits for Tupia, who is very ill, and, likewise, to get some grass, etc., for the Buffaloes we have still left. The Boats return'd with only 4 Cocoa Nutts, a small bunch of Plantains, which they purchased of the Natives for a Shilling, and a few Shrubs for the Cattle.

Tuesday, 2nd. In the afternoon, the wind was from South-South-East, South-East by South, and South-South-East, which allowed us to travel eastward close to the wind. At 6 o'clock, the hill on Princes Island was to the South-West by South, and Cracatoa Island was 10 miles to the north; at this point, we had 58 fathoms of water and were moving steadily eastward. By 8 o'clock, the depth was 52 fathoms with a muddy bottom, and at 10, we measured 23 fathoms. By 4 in the morning, we got close to the Java shore in 15 fathoms, then steered along the coast. At 5, it became calm, and we had light variable winds until noon, when Anger Point was located to the North-East, 1 league away, and Thwart-the-way Island was to the North. In the morning, I sent a boat ashore to try to gather some fruits for Tupia, who is very ill, and also to collect some grass for the buffaloes we still have. The boats returned with only 4 coconuts, a small bunch of plantains that they bought from the natives for a shilling, and a few shrubs for the cattle.

Wednesday, 3rd. Soon after 12 o'Clock it fell quite Calm, which obliged us to Anchor in 18 fathoms, Muddy bottom, about 2 Miles from shore, where we found a strong Current setting to the South-West. Not long before we Anchor'd we saw a Dutch Ship laying off Anger Point, on board which I sent Mr. Hicks to enquire after News.* (* It will be recollected that the Endeavour was now two years and two months from England, without the slightest chance of any news from home. We can imagine the anxiety and excitement on board on thus approaching civilisation, though they had no prospect of personal letters. With the frequent communication of modern times, we can scarcely realise such circumstances, and should certainly consider them as an exceeding hardship.) Upon his return he inform'd me that there were 2 Dutch Ships from Batavia, one bound for Ceylon, and the other to the Coast of Mallabar, besides a small Fly-boat or Packet, which is stationed here to carry all Packets, Letters, etc., from all Dutch Ships to Batavia; but it seems more Probable that she is stationed here to examine all Ships that pass and repass these Straits. We now first heard the agreeable news of His Majesty's Sloop The Swallow being at Batavia about 2 Years ago.* (* The Swallow, Captain Cartaret, had sailed with the Dolphin in 1766, but separated from her on emerging from the Strait of Magellan. The Dolphin had reached England some months before Cook sailed, but nothing had been heard of the Swallow, and fears were entertained of her loss.) At 7 o'Clock a breeze sprung up at South-South-West, with which we weighed and stood to the North-East between Thwart-the-way Island and the Cap:* (* Thwart-the-Way is an island that lies right across the fairway of Sunda Strait. The Cap is another smaller island that lies North-East of it.) soundings from 18 to 26 fathoms. We had but little Wind all night, and having a Strong Current against us, we got no further by 8 o'Clock in the morning than under Bantam Point. At this time the wind came to North-East, and obliged us to Anchor in 22 fathoms about 2 Miles from the Shore. The above point bore North-East by East, distant 1 League. Here we found a strong Current setting to the North-West. In the morning we saw the Dutch packet standing after us, but after the wind Shifted to the North-East she bore away. One of the Dutch Captains told Mr. Hicks yesterday that the Current sets constantly to the South-Westward, and that it would continue to set so for a Month or Six Weeks longer.

Wednesday, 3rd. Shortly after noon, it became completely calm, which forced us to anchor in 18 fathoms, on a muddy bottom, about 2 miles from shore, where we noted a strong current flowing to the southwest. Not long before we anchored, we spotted a Dutch ship off Anger Point, and I sent Mr. Hicks to ask for news. (* It’s important to remember that the Endeavour had been away from England for two years and two months, with no chance of any news from home. We can only imagine the anxiety and excitement on board as they approached civilization, even though there was no prospect of personal letters. With the frequent communication in modern times, it’s hard to truly grasp such circumstances, and we would certainly consider them a severe hardship.) Upon his return, he informed me that there were 2 Dutch ships from Batavia: one heading to Ceylon, and the other to the Coast of Malabar, along with a small fly-boat or packet that is stationed here to carry all packets, letters, etc., from all Dutch ships to Batavia. However, it seems more likely that she is here to inspect all ships that pass through these straits. We also heard the good news that His Majesty's sloop, The Swallow, had been at Batavia about 2 years ago. (* The Swallow, captained by Cartaret, had set sail with the Dolphin in 1766 but had separated from her after leaving the Strait of Magellan. The Dolphin reached England several months before Cook's departure, but nothing had been heard about the Swallow, and there were fears that she might have been lost.) At 7 o'clock, a breeze came up from the South-Southwest, and we raised anchor and headed to the northeast between Thwart-the-way Island and The Cap. (* Thwart-the-Way is an island that lies directly across the fairway of Sunda Strait. The Cap is another smaller island located northeast of it.) The depth ranged from 18 to 26 fathoms. We had little wind all night, and with a strong current against us, we didn't progress any further by 8 o'clock in the morning than being just under Bantam Point. At that time, the wind shifted to the northeast, forcing us to anchor in 22 fathoms about 2 miles from the shore. The aforementioned point was located northeast by east, about 1 league away. Here, we encountered a strong current flowing to the northwest. In the morning, we saw the Dutch packet pursuing us, but when the wind shifted northeast, she turned away. One of the Dutch captains told Mr. Hicks yesterday that the current constantly flows to the southwest and is expected to continue for another month or six weeks.

[In Sunda Strait.]

[In Sunda Strait.]

Thursday, 4th. In the P.M. had the wind at North-East by North, which obliged us to lay fast. About 6 o'Clock in the evening one of the Country Boats came alongside in which was the Commander of the Packet before mentioned; he seem'd to have 2 Motives for coming, one to take an account of the Ship, and the other to sell us refreshments, for in the Boat were Turtle, Fowls, Birds, etc., all of which they held at a pretty high Price, and had brought to a bad market, as our Savu stock was not all expended. I gave a Spanish Dollar for a small Turtle which weighed only 36 pounds. With respect to the Ship, he wanted to know her name, the Captain's, the place we came last from and were bound, as I would not see him myself. I order'd that no account should be given him from whence we came; but Mr. Hicks, who wrote the Ship's name down in his book, put down from Europe. Seeing this he expressed some surprise, and said that we might write down what we pleased, for it was of no other use than for the information of such of our Country men as might pass these Streights. At 7 o'Clock a light breeze sprung up at South-South-East, with which we got under sail. At 1 A.M. Anchor'd again, having not wind to stem the Current which we found to run 3 Knotts; at 2 o'Clock we weighed again, but, finding that we lost ground, we were obliged to Anchor in 18 fathoms, the Island Pulo Morack, which lies close under the Shore 3 Miles to the Westward of Bantam Point: bore South-East by South, distance 1 1/2 miles. Latitude observed, 5 degrees 55 minutes South.

Thursday, 4th. In the afternoon, the wind was coming from the North-East by North, which forced us to stay put. Around 6 o'clock in the evening, one of the local boats came alongside, carrying the commander of the previously mentioned packet. He seemed to have two reasons for his visit: one was to check on the ship, and the other was to sell us some refreshments. In the boat, there were turtle, chickens, birds, and more, all priced quite high, and they brought them to a poor market since we hadn't used up all our supplies from Savu. I paid a Spanish dollar for a small turtle that weighed only 36 pounds. Regarding the ship, he wanted to know its name, the captain's name, where we last came from, and our next destination. Since I didn't want to speak with him directly, I instructed that no information be given about our origin. However, Mr. Hicks, who noted the ship's name in his book, wrote down "from Europe." Seeing this, he seemed surprised and said we could write whatever we liked, as it was only for the information of any of our countrymen who might pass through these straits. At 7 o'clock, a light breeze picked up from the South-South-East, allowing us to set sail. At 1 A.M., we anchored again because we didn't have enough wind to fight the current, which was running at 3 knots. At 2 o'clock, we weighed anchor again, but finding that we were losing ground, we had to anchor in 18 fathoms, near Pulo Morack island, which is close to the shore, 3 miles west of Bantam Point, bearing South-East by South at a distance of 1.5 miles. Latitude observed was 5 degrees 55 minutes South.

Friday, 5th. At 5 in the P.M. we weighed with a light breeze at South-West by South, which continued not long before it fell Calm, and obliged us to Anchor again. At 1 o'Clock we weigh'd with the Land wind at South-South-East, which died away in the Morning, and the Current running strong against us we Anchor'd in 17 fathoms. A little before this, a Proe came alongside, wherein was a Dutch Officer who came upon the same business as the other. He sent me down a printed paper in English containing 9 Articles or Questions, of which this is a Copy.

Friday, 5th. At 5 PM, we set sail with a light breeze from the South-West by South, but it didn't last long before we hit calm waters, forcing us to anchor again. At 1 o'clock, we lifted anchor with the land breeze from the South-South-East, which died down in the morning. With the current running strongly against us, we anchored in 17 fathoms. Shortly before this, a boat came alongside with a Dutch officer who was here for the same reason as the others. He sent me a printed paper in English containing 9 articles or questions, of which this is a copy.

"The Commanders and Officers of the Ships where this Paper may be presented, will be pleased to answer on the following Questions: viz., 1. "To what Nation the Ship belongs, and its Name. 2. "If it comes from Europe or any other place. 3. "From what place it lastly departed from. 4. "Where unto design'd to go. 5. "What, and how many, ships of the Dutch Company by departure from the last shore there lay'd, and their names. 6. "If one or more of these ships in Company with this is departed for this or any other place. 7. "If during the Voyage any particularity is hapned or seen. 8. "If not any ships in Sea, or the Streights of Sunda have seen or Hail'd in, and which. 9. "If any other News worth Attention at the place from whence the Ship lastly departed or during the vogage is hapned.

The commanders and officers of the ships where this paper is presented will be happy to answer the following questions: 1. "What nation does the ship belong to, and what is its name? 2. "Does it come from Europe or anywhere else? 3. "Where did it last set sail from? 4. "Where is it headed? 5. "What are the names of the ships from the Dutch Company that were anchored at the last shore it departed from, and how many are there? 6. "Have one or more of these ships left with this one for this location or any other destination? 7. "Did anything specific happen or was anything noteworthy observed during the voyage? 8. "Have any ships been seen or hailed in the sea or the Strait of Sunda, and which ones? 9. "Is there any other news from the place where the ship last departed or during the voyage that is worth mentioning?

"Batavia in the Castle, the By Order of the Governor General and the Counselors of India.

"Batavia in the Castle, the By Order of the Governor General and the Counselors of India."

"J. BRANDER BUNGL, Sect."

"J. BRANDER BUNGL, Secretary."

The first and fourth of these Questions I only answer'd, which when the Officer saw, he made use of the very same words the other had done before, viz.: that we might write what we pleased, for it was of no consequence, etc., and yet he immediately said that he must send that very paper away to Batavia by water, and that it would be there by to-morrow noon, which shows that the Governor and Counselors of India look upon such papers to be of some consequence. Be this as it may, my reason for taking notice of it in this Journal, is because I am well inform'd that it is but of very late years that the Dutch have taken upon them to examine all Ships that pass these Streights. At 10 o'Clock we weigh'd with a light breeze at South-West, but did little more than stem the Current. At Noon, Bantam Point* (* Bantam Point, now called St. Nicholas Point, is the north-west point of Java, and forms the north-eastern extreme of Sunda Strait.) and Pula Baba, in one bearing East by North, distant from the Point 1 1/2 Mile. Latitude observed, 5 degrees 53 minutes South.

I only answered the first and fourth Questions, and when the Officer saw this, he used the exact same words as the other one did before, saying that we could write whatever we wanted since it didn't matter, etc. Yet, he immediately added that he had to send that very paper to Batavia by water and that it would arrive by tomorrow noon, which shows that the Governor and Counselors of India consider such papers to have some importance. Regardless, my reason for mentioning it in this Journal is that I’ve been informed that it’s only in recent years that the Dutch have begun to inspect all the ships that pass through these Straits. At 10 o'clock, we set sail with a light breeze from the South-West, but we barely made any headway against the current. At noon, Bantam Point* (* Bantam Point, now called St. Nicholas Point, is the north-west point of Java, forming the north-eastern extreme of Sunda Strait.) and Pula Baba were in one bearing East by North, 1 1/2 miles away from the Point. Latitude observed: 5 degrees 53 minutes South.

Saturday, 6th. At 2 o'Clock P.M., finding we could not stem the Current, we anchor'd, with the Kedge Anchor, under Bantam Point, where we lay until 9, at which time Current made Slowly to the Eastward, and at the same time a light breeze springing up, we weigh'd and stood to the East until 10 o'Clock in the A.M., when the Current oblig'd us again to Anchor in 22 fathoms, Pula Baba bearing East by South 1/2 South, distant 3 or 4 Miles. Our sounding from Bantam Point to this place was from 36 to 22 fathoms.

Saturday, 6th. At 2:00 PM, since we couldn't fight the current, we anchored with the kedge anchor under Bantam Point, where we stayed until 9. At that time, the current began to move slowly eastward, and a light breeze picked up, so we weighed anchor and headed east until 10:00 AM, when the current forced us to anchor again in 22 fathoms, with Pula Baba bearing East by South 1/2 South, about 3 or 4 miles away. Our soundings from Bantam Point to this location ranged from 36 to 22 fathoms.

Sunday 7th. Light Air from the Southward with frequent Calms. At 6 o'Clock P.M., weighed with a light breeze at South-South-West, which was not sufficient to stem the current, and was therefore obliged to come too again, in 15 fathoms. At 10 o'Clock weighed again and stood to the Eastward with the Wind at South-South-East. At 11 A.M., Anchor'd in 21 fathoms, the West end of Wapping Island bore South, distant 3 Miles, and the Thousand Islands North by East 1/2 East, distant 3 or 4 Miles. Found the Current still set to the Westward.

Sunday 7th. There was a light breeze from the south with frequent calm spots. At 6 PM, we weighed anchor with a slight breeze from the South-South-West, which wasn’t strong enough to counter the current, so we had to stop again in 15 fathoms. At 10 PM, we weighed anchor again and headed East with the wind from the South-South-East. At 11 AM, we anchored in 21 fathoms, with the west end of Wapping Island to the south, about 3 miles away, and the Thousand Islands to the North by East ½ East, around 3 or 4 miles distant. We found the current was still flowing to the West.

Monday, 8th. Had it Calm until 4 in the P.M., when we got the Sea breeze at North-East very faint, with which we weighed and stood to the Eastward, past Wapping Island, and the first Island to the Eastward of it. Falling little wind we were carried by the Current between this last Island and the 2nd Island, to the Eastward of Wapping Island, where we were obliged to Anchor in 30 fathoms, being very near a ledge of Rocks which spitted out from one of the Islands. At 1/2 past 2 o'Clock in the A.M., weighed with the land wind at South and stood out clear of the shoal, where we were again obliged to come to an Anchor, having Variable light winds attended with Thunder and rain. At 5 o'Clock the weather being fair, and a light breeze at South, we weighed, but making little or no way against the Current, we soon came too again, in 28 fathoms, near a small Island not laid down in the Charts; Pulo Pare* (* Wapping Island is now known as Hoorn, and Pulo Pare as Agenietan Islands. They lie, among many others, to the north-west of Batavia Roads.) bore East-North-East, distant 6 or 7 Miles. While we lay here a Proe came alongside, where in were 2 Malays, who sold us 3 Turtles, weighing 147 pounds, for a Spanish Dollar. Some on board thought them dear, but I thought they were cheap, founding my Judgment on the price the two Dutchmen that were on board before set upon those they had, one of which we paid a Dollar for, that weighed only 36 pounds.

Monday, 8th. We had calm conditions until 4 PM when we caught a weak sea breeze coming from the northeast. With that, we weighed anchor and headed east, passing by Wapping Island and the first island to its east. As the wind dropped, the current carried us between this last island and the second one east of Wapping Island, where we had to anchor in 30 fathoms, quite close to a rocky ledge that jutted out from one of the islands. At 2:30 AM, we weighed anchor again with a land wind from the south and maneuvered clear of the shallow area, where we had to anchor once more due to variable light winds accompanied by thunder and rain. At 5 AM, with the weather clearing and a light breeze from the south, we weighed anchor again, but made little progress against the current, so we anchored again in 28 fathoms, near a small island not marked on the charts; Pulo Pare* (* Wapping Island is now known as Hoorn, and Pulo Pare as Agenietan Islands. They lie, among many others, to the north-west of Batavia Roads.) was bearing east-northeast, about 6 or 7 miles away. While we were anchored here, a proe came alongside with two Malays who sold us 3 turtles weighing a total of 147 pounds for a Spanish dollar. Some on board thought that was expensive, but I considered it a good deal, comparing it to the price the two Dutchmen charged for the one turtle they had, which we bought for a dollar and it only weighed 36 pounds.

Tuesday, 9th. A little past Noon weigh'd with a light breeze at North-East, and stood to the Eastward until 5 o'Clock, when, not being able to weather Pulo Pare, we Anchor'd in 30 fathoms, the said Island extending from South-East to South-South-West, distant 1 Mile. At 10 got the land wind at South, with which we weighed and stood to the East-South-East all night; depth of water, from 30 to 22 fathoms, and from 22 to 16 fathoms. When we Anchor'd at 10 o'Clock in the A.M. to wait for the Sea breeze, the Island of Edam bore South-West by West, distant 6 or 7 Miles. At Noon we weighed and stood in for Batavia Road, having the advantage of the Sea breeze at North-North-East.

Tuesday, 9th. A little past noon, we were sailing with a light breeze from the northeast and headed east until 5 o'clock. Since we couldn't get around Pulo Pare, we anchored in 30 fathoms, with the island extending from southeast to south-southwest, about 1 mile away. At 10, we got the land breeze from the south, so we weighed anchor and sailed southeast all night; the water depth ranged from 30 to 22 fathoms, then from 22 to 16 fathoms. When we anchored again at 10 o'clock in the morning to wait for the sea breeze, the island of Edam was to our southwest, about 6 or 7 miles away. At noon, we weighed anchor again and headed for Batavia Road, benefiting from the sea breeze coming from the north-northeast.

[Arrival at Batavia.]

[Arrival in Batavia.]

Wednesday, 10th, according to our reckoning, but by the people here Thursday, 11th. At 4 o'Clock in the P.M. Anchor'd in Batavia road, where we found the Harcourt Indiaman from England, 2 English Country Ships,* (* A country ship is a vessel under the English flag, but belonging to a port in English possessions abroad.) 13 Sail of large Dutch Ships, and a number of small Vessels. As soon as we Anchor'd* (* The Endeavour took nine days, and had to anchor fifteen times, in getting from Java Head, at the entrance of Sunda Strait, to Batavia, a distance of 120 miles.) I sent Lieutenant Hicks a shore to acquaint the Governor of our Arrival, and to make an excuse for not Saluting; as we could only do it with 3 Guns I thought it was better let alone.

Wednesday, the 10th, by our calendar, but by the local time, it’s Thursday, the 11th. At 4 PM, we anchored in Batavia road, where we found the Harcourt Indiaman from England, two English country ships, thirteen large Dutch ships, and several small vessels. As soon as we anchored, I sent Lieutenant Hicks ashore to inform the Governor of our arrival and to apologize for not saluting; since we could only manage three guns, I thought it was better to skip it.

[At Batavia.]

[At Batavia.]

The Carpenter now deliver'd me in the defects of the ship, of which the following is a copy:--

The carpenter has now given me the details about the ship's defects, of which the following is a copy:--

"The Defects of His Majesty's Bark Endeavour, Lieutenant James Cook, Commander.

"The Defects of His Majesty's Bark Endeavour, Lieutenant James Cook, Commander."

"The Ship very leaky (as she makes from 12 to 6 Inches water per hour), occasioned by her Main Kiel being wounded in many places and the Scarfe of her Stem being very open. The false Kiel gone beyond the Midships (from Forward and perhaps further), as I had no opportunity of seeing for the water when hauld ashore for repair. Wounded on her Starboard side under the Main Chains, where I immagine is the greatest leakes (but could not come at it for the water). One pump on the Starboard side useless, the others decayed within 1 1/2 Inch of the bore, otherwise Masts, Yards, Boats, and Hull in pretty good condition.

"The ship is very leaky (taking in 12 to 6 inches of water per hour) because her main keel has multiple wounds and the scarfe of her stem is very open. The false keel has been damaged beyond midships (from the front and possibly even further), as I couldn't see it due to the water when it was pulled ashore for repairs. There's damage on the starboard side under the main chains, where I imagine the biggest leaks are (but I couldn’t check because of the water). One pump on the starboard side is useless, and the others are worn down to within 1.5 inches of the bore. Otherwise, the masts, yards, boats, and hull are in pretty good condition."

"Dated in Batavia Road,

"Dated at Batavia Road,"

"this 10th of October, 1770.

this October 10, 1770.

"J. SATTERLY."

"J. SATTERLY."

Previous to the above, I had consulted with the Carpenter and all the other Officers concerning the Leake, and they were all unanimously of Opinion that it was not safe to proceed to Europe without first seeing her bottom; accordingly I resolved to apply for leave to heave her down at this place, and, as I understood that this was to be done in writing, I drew up the following request to be presented to the Governor, etc., etc.:--

Prior to the above, I talked with the Carpenter and all the other Officers about the leak, and they all agreed that it wasn't safe to head to Europe without first checking the bottom of the ship. So, I decided to ask for permission to dry-dock it here, and since I knew I had to do this in writing, I prepared the following request to present to the Governor, etc., etc.:--

"Lieutenant James Cook, commander of His Brittannick Majesty's Bark Endeavour, Requests of the Right Hon'ble Petrus Albertus Van der Parra, Governor-General, etc., etc., etc., the Indulgence of the following Articles, viz.:

"Lieutenant James Cook, commander of His Britannic Majesty's Bark Endeavour, requests the Right Honorable Petrus Albertus Van der Parra, Governor-General, etc., etc., etc., for the indulgence of the following articles, namely:

"Firstly, That he may be allow'd a proper and convenient place to heave down and repair His Brittannick Majesty's Ship under his command.

"Firstly, that he may be granted a suitable and convenient place to take down and repair His Britannic Majesty's ship under his command."

"Secondly, That he may have leave to purchase such few Trifling Naval stores as he may be in want of.

"Secondly, that he may be allowed to buy any small naval supplies he might need."

"Thirdly, That he may be permitted daily to purchase such provisions as he may want; also such an Additional quantity as may enable him to proceed on his passage home to England.

"Thirdly, that he may be allowed to buy whatever food he needs every day; also, an extra amount that will help him continue his journey back home to England."

"Dated on board His Brittannick Majesty's Bark Endeavour, in Batavia Road, the 11th October, 1770.

"Dated on board His Britannick Majesty's Bark Endeavour, in Batavia Road, the 11th October, 1770."

"JAMES COOK."

"James Cook."

In the morning I went on shore myself and had the foregoing request Translated into Dutch by a Scotch Gentleman, a Merchant here.

In the morning, I went ashore myself and had the previous request translated into Dutch by a Scottish gentleman, a merchant here.

Friday, 12th. At 5 o'clock P.M. I was introduced to the Governor-General, who received me very politely and told me that I should have every thing I wanted, and that in the Morning my request should be laid before the Council where I was desir'd to attend.

Friday, 12th. At 5 o'clock PM, I was introduced to the Governor-General, who welcomed me warmly and assured me that I would have everything I needed. He also mentioned that my request would be presented to the Council in the morning and that I was invited to attend.

About 9 o'clock in the Evening we had much rain, with some very heavy Claps of Thunder, one of which carried away a Dutch Indiaman's Main Mast by the Deck, and split it, the Maintopmast and Topgallantmast all to shivers. She had had an Iron Spindle at the Maintopgallant Mast head which had first attracted the Lightning. The ship lay about 2 Cable lengths from us, and we were struck with the Thunder at the same time, and in all probability we should have shared the same fate as the Dutchman, had it not been for the Electrical Chain which we had but just before got up; this carried the Lightning or Electrical matter over the side clear of the Ship. The Shock was so great as to shake the whole ship very sencibly. This instance alone is sufficient to recommend these Chains to all Ships whatever, and that of the Dutchman ought to Caution people from having Iron Spindles at their Mast heads.* (* No instance is known of ships fitted with properly constructed lightning conductors having received any damage.)

About 9 o'clock in the evening, we had a lot of rain, with some really loud thunder. One crash took out the main mast of a Dutch Indiaman, tearing it away at the deck and shattering both the maintopmast and topgallantmast. It had an iron spindle at the top of the maintopgallant mast, which was likely what attracted the lightning. The ship was about two cable lengths away from us, and we were struck by the thunder at the same time. We probably would have faced the same fate as the Dutchman if it weren't for the electrical chain we had just set up, which directed the lightning safely over the side of the ship. The shock was so intense that it shook our entire ship noticeably. This incident alone is enough to recommend these chains for all ships, and the Dutchman’s experience should warn people against having iron spindles at their mastheads. *(No instances are known of ships fitted with properly constructed lightning conductors sustaining any damage.)*

[At Batavia.]

[At Batavia.]

In the morning I went on shore to the Council Chamber and laid my request before the Governour and Council, who gave me for answer that I should have every thing I wanted.

In the morning, I went ashore to the Council Chamber and presented my request to the Governor and Council, who replied that I would get everything I needed.

Saturday, 13th. Received on board a Cask of Arrack and some Greens for the Ship's Company.

Saturday, 13th. We received a barrel of arrack and some greens for the crew.

Sunday, 14th. Early this morning a ship sail'd from hence for Holland by which I had just time to write 2 or 3 lines to Mr. Stephens, Secretary of the Admiralty, to acquaint him of our Arrival, after which I went on shore and waited upon the Shabander, who has the direction of the Town, Port, etc., to get an order to the Superintendent at Onrust to receive us at that Island, but this, I was told, would not be ready before Tuesday next. Received from the Shore Fresh Beef and Greens for the Ship's Company.

Sunday, the 14th. Early this morning, a ship left for Holland, and I had just enough time to write a couple of lines to Mr. Stephens, the Secretary of the Admiralty, to inform him of our arrival. After that, I went ashore and met with the Shabander, who oversees the town and the port, to get an order for the Superintendent at Onrust to welcome us to the island. However, I was told this wouldn't be ready until next Tuesday. I received fresh beef and greens from the shore for the ship's crew.

Monday, 15th. Fresh Sea and land breezes and fair weather. I had forgot to mention, that upon our arrival here I had not one man upon the Sick List; Lieut. Hicks, Mr. Green, and Tupia were the only people that had any complaints occasioned by a long continuance at Sea.* (* This was an achievement indeed, and Cook records it in this simple observation. Of the many ships which had arrived at Batavia after voyages across the Pacific, none but had come to an anchor with crews decimated and enfeebled through scurvy. Hawksworth mentions, probably on the authority of Banks, that when passing Torres Straits there were several incipient cases of this disease in the Endeavour. The fresh provisions obtained at Savu probably dissipated these symptoms, if they were symptoms; but Mr. Perry, the surgeon, in his report, given in the Introduction, distinctly states that there were no cases after leaving Tahiti.)

Monday, 15th. Fresh sea and land breezes with clear weather. I forgot to mention that when we arrived here, I didn’t have a single person on the sick list; Lieut. Hicks, Mr. Green, and Tupia were the only ones with any complaints due to being at sea for a long time. This was quite an achievement, and Cook notes it in this straightforward observation. Of the many ships that arrived in Batavia after crossing the Pacific, none came to anchor without their crews being weakened and diminished by scurvy. Hawksworth mentions, likely based on Banks' information, that there were several early cases of this disease in the Endeavour when passing through Torres Straits. The fresh provisions obtained at Savu probably helped relieve these symptoms, if they were actually symptoms; however, Mr. Perry, the surgeon, states in his report, included in the Introduction, that there were no cases after leaving Tahiti.

Tuesday, 16th. Finding, by a strict inquiry, that there were no private person or persons in the place that could at this time advance me a sufficient sum of money to defray the charge I might be at in repairing and refitting the Ship--at least, if there were any, they would be afraid to do it without leave from the Governor--wherefore I had nothing left but to apply to the Governor himself, and accordingly drew up the following request, which I laid before the Governor and Council this morning, in consequence of which the Shebander had orders to supply me with what money I wanted out of the Company's Treasure:--

Tuesday, 16th. After looking into it closely, I found that there was no individual here who could lend me enough money to cover the costs of repairing and refitting the ship. At least, if there were anyone, they would be hesitant to do it without permission from the Governor. So, I had no choice but to approach the Governor directly. I prepared the following request and presented it to the Governor and Council this morning, which led to the Shebander receiving orders to provide me with the funds I needed from the Company’s Treasure:--

"Lieutenant James Cook, Commander of His Brittannick Majesty's Bark the Endeavour, begs leave to represent to His Excellency the Right Honourable Petrus Albertus Van der Parra, Governor-General, etc., etc., That he will be in want of a Sum or Sums of Money in order to defray the Charge he will be at in repairing and refiting His Brittannick Majesty's Ship at this place; which sum or sums of money he is directed by his Instructions, and empower'd by his commission, to give Bills of Exchange on the respective Offices which Superintend His Brittannick Majesty's Navy.

Lieutenant James Cook, Commander of His Britannic Majesty's Bark the Endeavour, respectfully requests to inform His Excellency the Right Honourable Petrus Albertus Van der Parra, Governor-General, that he will need a sum or sums of money to cover the costs of repairing and refitting His Britannic Majesty's Ship at this location. He has been instructed and authorized by his commission to issue Bills of Exchange on the respective offices that oversee His Britannic Majesty's Navy.

"The said Lieutenant James Cook Requests of His Excellency, That he will be pleased to order him to be supply'd with such sum or sums of money, either out of the Company's Treasure, or permit such private persons to do it as may be willing to advance money for Bills of Exchange on the Honourable and Principal Officers and Commissioners of His Brittannick Majesty's Navy, the Commissioners for Victualling His Majesty's Navy, and the Commissioners for taking care of the Sick and Hurt.

Lieutenant James Cook requests His Excellency to please arrange for him to be provided with a sum of money, either from the Company's funds or by allowing private individuals to lend money for Bills of Exchange on the Honorable and Principal Officers and Commissioners of His Brittannick Majesty's Navy, the Commissioners for supplying His Majesty's Navy, and the Commissioners responsible for the care of the Sick and Injured.

"Dated on board His Brittannick Majesty's Bark the Endeavour, in Batavia Road, the 16th of October, 1770.

"Dated on board His Britannick Majesty's Bark the Endeavour, in Batavia Road, the 16th of October, 1770."

"JAMES COOK."

"James Cook."

Wednesday, 17th. In the P.M. I waited upon the Superintendent of Onrust, with an order from the Shebander, to receive us at that Island, but this order, the Superintendent told me, was not sufficient to impower him to give me the conveniences and assistance I wanted, and when I came to call upon the Shebander, I found this mistake was owing to the word "heave down" being wrong translated; this Circumstance, trifling as it is, will cause a delay of some days, as it cannot be set to rights until next Council day, which is not till Friday.

Wednesday, 17th. In the afternoon, I went to see the Superintendent of Onrust with an order from the Shebander to let us onto the Island. However, the Superintendent informed me that this order wasn’t enough to give me the conveniences and assistance I needed. When I went to speak with the Shebander, I discovered that this issue arose from a misinterpretation of the term "heave down." Though it seems like a minor detail, this will delay things by several days since it can’t be resolved until the next Council meeting, which isn’t until Friday.

Thursday, 18th. In the P.M. received on board 2 live Oxen, 150 Gallons of Arrack, 3 Barrels of Tar, and one of Pitch; at daylight in the A.M. took up our Anchor and run down to Onrust.

Thursday, 18th. In the afternoon, we took on 2 live oxen, 150 gallons of arrack, 3 barrels of tar, and one barrel of pitch. At daylight in the morning, we weighed anchor and sailed down to Onrust.

At 9 Anchor'd in 7 fathoms off Coopers Island, which lies close to Onrust. There are wharfs at both of these Islands, and ships land there stores, sometimes on the one and sometimes on the other, but it is only at Onrust where the proper conveniences are for heaving down. Soon after we Anchor'd I went on shore to the Officer of the Yard, to see if they could not allow us some place to land our stores, but this could not be granted without orders.

At 9, we anchored in 7 fathoms off Coopers Island, which is near Onrust. Both islands have wharfs where ships can unload their supplies, sometimes on one and sometimes on the other, but only Onrust has the right facilities for repairs. Shortly after we anchored, I went ashore to speak with the Officer of the Yard to see if we could get a place to unload our stores, but they couldn’t allow it without orders.

Friday, 19th. In the P.M. I sent a Petty Officer to Mr. Hicks, who Lodges ashore at Batavia for the recovery of his health, with orders to desire him to wait upon the Shebander, in order to get the necessary orders respecting us dispatched to this place as soon as possible.

Friday, 19th. In the afternoon, I sent a Petty Officer to Mr. Hicks, who is staying on land at Batavia to recuperate, with instructions to ask him to meet with the Shebander to get the necessary orders sent to us here as quickly as possible.

Saturday, 20th. Employ'd unrigging the ship, etc.

Saturday, 20th. Worked on taking apart the ship, etc.

Sunday, 21st. In the P.M. orders came down to the Officers of the yard to comply with everything I wanted, but we could not yet get a Wharfe to land our Stores, they being all taken up by shipping.

Sunday, 21st. In the afternoon, orders were issued to the officers at the yard to comply with all my requests, but we still couldn't secure a wharf to unload our supplies since they were all occupied by ships.

Monday, 22nd. In the A.M. two ships went from the Wharfes at Coopers Island, when we prepared to go along side one of them.

Monday, 22nd. In the morning, two ships left the docks at Coopers Island, and we got ready to board one of them.

FACSIMILE OF TUESDAY, 23RD OCTOBER, 1770.

 

Tuesday, 23rd. In the P.M. hauled along side one of the Wharfes, in order to take out our stores, etc., after which the Ship is to be deliver'd into the Charge of the proper Officers at Onrust, who will (as I am inform'd) heave her down, and repair her, with their own people, while ours must stand and look on, who, if we were permitted, could do every thing wanting to the Ship ourselves.* (* Here Mr. Corner's copy of the Journal ends abruptly. The record for the next day explains the reason, and there is no doubt that this was the copy of the Journal sent home. The Queen's copy ends on 10th October. The remainder of the Journal is taken from the Admiralty copy.)

Tuesday, 23rd. In the afternoon, we docked at one of the wharfs to unload our supplies, etc. After that, the ship will be handed over to the appropriate officers at Onrust, who, as I'm told, will take her out of the water and repair her with their own crew, while ours can only watch. If we were allowed, we could handle all the necessary work on the ship ourselves.* (* Here Mr. Corner's copy of the Journal ends abruptly. The record for the next day explains the reason, and there is no doubt that this was the copy of the Journal sent home. The Queen's copy ends on 10th October. The remainder of the Journal is taken from the Admiralty copy.)

[Reports Sent Home from Batavia.]

[Reports Sent Home from Batavia.]

Wednesday, 24th. Employ'd clearing the Ship, having a Store House to put our Stores, etc., in. In the P.M. I went up to Town in order to put on board the first Dutch Ship that Sails, a pacquet for the Admiralty containing a Copy of my Journal, a Chart of the South Sea, another of New Zeeland, and one of the East Coast of New Holland. In the morning the General, accompanied by the Water Fiscall, some of the Council, and the Commodore, each in their respective Boats, went out into the Road on board the oldest Captain, in order to appoint him Commodore of the Fleet, ready to Sail for Holland. The Ships was drawn up in 2 Lines, between which the General past to the new Commodore's Ship, which lay the farthest out. Each ship as he passed and repassed gave him 3 Cheers, and as soon as he was on board, and the Dutch Flag Hoisted at the Main Topmast Head, the other Commodore Saluted him with 21 Guns, and immediately after Struck his Broad Pendant, which was again hoisted as soon as the General left the other Ship; he was then Saluted with 17 Guns by the new made Commodore, who now hoisted a Common Pendant. This Ceremony of appointing a Commodore over the Grand Fleet, as they call it, we were told is Yearly perform'd. I went out in my Boat on purpose to see it, accompanied by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, because we were told it was one of the Grandest sights Batavia afforded; that may be too, and yet it did not recompense us for our trouble. I thought that the whole was but ill conducted, and the Fleet appear'd to be very badly mann'd. This fleet consists of 10 or 12 stout Ships; not only these, but all or most of their other Ships are pierced for 50 Guns, but have only their upper Tier mounted, and these are more by half than they have men to fight.

Wednesday, 24th. I spent the day clearing the ship and setting up a storage area for our supplies. In the afternoon, I went to town to send off the first Dutch ship that sails, a packet for the Admiralty containing a copy of my journal, a chart of the South Sea, another of New Zealand, and one of the east coast of New Holland. In the morning, the General, along with the Water Fiscall, some members of the Council, and the Commodore, each in their own boats, went out to meet the oldest captain to appoint him Commodore of the fleet preparing to sail for Holland. The ships were arranged in two lines, and the General passed through them to the new Commodore’s ship, which was the farthest out. Each ship he passed gave him three cheers, and as soon as he boarded and the Dutch flag was raised at the main topmast, the other Commodore saluted him with 21 guns. After that, he struck his broad pendant, which was hoisted again as soon as the General left the ship. He was then saluted with 17 guns by the newly appointed Commodore, who raised a common pendant. We were told that this ceremony of appointing a Commodore over the Grand Fleet is performed annually. I went out in my boat to see it, along with Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander, because we heard it was one of the grandest sights Batavia had to offer; it might be impressive, but it didn’t justify the effort we put in. I thought the whole event was poorly organized, and the fleet seemed to be very poorly manned. This fleet consists of 10 or 12 sturdy ships; not only these, but most of their other ships are built to carry 50 guns, yet they only have the upper tier mounted, which is far more than they have men to operate.

Thursday, 25th. In the evening I sent the Admiralty Packet on board the Kronenburg, Captain Fredrick Kelger, Commodore, who, together with another Ship, sails immediately for the Cape, where she waits for the remainder of the Fleet.*

Thursday, 25th. In the evening I sent the Admiralty Packet on board the Kronenburg, Captain Fredrick Kelger, Commodore, who, along with another ship, is setting sail immediately for the Cape, where they will wait for the rest of the fleet.*

(* The following letter to the Secretary of the Admiralty (now in Public Record Office) was also dispatched:--

(* The following letter to the Secretary of the Admiralty (now in Public Record Office) was also sent:--

"To Philip Stephens, Esq.

"To Philip Stephens, Esq."

"Sir,

"Hey,"

"Please to acquaint my Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty that I left Rio de Janeiro the 8th of December, 1768, and on the 16th of January following arrived in Success Bay in Straits La Maire, where we recruited our Wood and Water; on the 21st of the same month we quitted Straits La Maire, and arrived at George's Island on the 13th of April. In our Passage to this Island I made a far more Westerly Track than any Ship had ever done before; yet it was attended with no discovery until we arrived within the Tropick, where we discovered several Islands. We met with as Friendly a reception by the Natives of George's Island as I could wish, and I took care to secure ourselves in such a manner as to put it out of the power of the whole Island to drive us off. Some days preceeding the 3rd of June I sent Lieutenant Hicks to the Eastern part of this Island, and Lieutenant Gore to York Island, with others of the Officers (Mr. Green having furnished them with Instruments), to observe the Transit of Venus, that we may have the better Chance of succeeding should the day prove unfavourable; but in this We were so fortunate that the observations were everywhere attended with every favourable Circumstance. It was the 13th of July before I was ready to quitt this Island, after which I spent near a month in exploring some other Islands which lay to the Westward, before we steer'd to the Southward. On the 14th of August we discovered a small Island laying in the Latitude of 22 degrees 27 minutes South, Longitude 150 degrees 47 minutes West. After quitting this Island I steered to the South, inclining a little to the East, until we arrived in the Latitude 40 degrees 12 minutes South, without seeing the least signs of Land. After this I steer'd to the Westward, between the Latitude of 30 and 40 degrees until the 6th of October, on which day we discovered the East Coast of New Zeland, which I found to consist of 2 large Islands, extending from 34 to 48 degrees of South Latitude, both of which I circumnavigated. On the 1st of April, 1770, I quitted New Zeland, and steer'd to the Westward, until I fell in with the East Coast of New Holland, in the Latitude of 30 degrees South. I coasted the shore of this Country to the North, putting in at such places as I saw Convenient, until we arrived in the Latitude of 15 degrees 45 minutes South, where, on the night of the 10th of June, we struck upon a Reef of Rocks, were we lay 23 Hours, and received some very considerable damage. This proved a fatal stroke to the remainder of the Voyage, as we were obliged to take shelter in the first Port we met with, were we were detain'd repairing the damage we had sustain'd until the 4th of August, and after all put to Sea with a leaky Ship, and afterwards coasted the Shore to the Northward through the most dangerous Navigation that perhaps ever ship was in, until the 22nd of same month, when, being in the Latitude of 10 degrees 30 minutes South, we found a Passage into the Indian Sea between the Northern extremity of New Holland and New Guinea. After getting through the Passage I stood for the Coast of New Guinea, which we made on the 29th; but as we found it absolutely necessary to heave the Ship down to Stop her leaks before we proceeded home, I made no stay here, but quitted this Coast on the 30th of September, and made the best of my way to Batavia, where we Arrived on the 10th instant, and soon after obtained leave of the Governor and Council to be hove down at Onrust, where we have but just got alongside of the Wharf in order to take out our Stores, etc.

"Please inform my Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty that I left Rio de Janeiro on December 8, 1768, and on January 16 of the following year arrived in Success Bay in the Strait of Le Maire, where we gathered wood and water. On the 21st of that month, we left the Strait of Le Maire and arrived at George's Island on April 13. During our journey to this island, I took a more westerly route than any ship had done before, but we encountered no discoveries until we reached the tropics, where we discovered several islands. The natives of George's Island welcomed us very warmly, and I made sure we secured ourselves in such a way that it was impossible for the entire island to drive us away. A few days before June 3, I sent Lieutenant Hicks to the eastern part of the island and Lieutenant Gore to York Island, along with other officers (Mr. Green had provided them with instruments) to observe the transit of Venus, giving us a better chance of success should the day turn out unfavorable; luckily, the observations were all met with very favorable circumstances. It was July 13 before I was ready to leave the island, after which I spent almost a month exploring other islands to the west before we headed south. On August 14, we discovered a small island located at 22 degrees 27 minutes south latitude, 150 degrees 47 minutes west longitude. After leaving this island, I headed south, slightly east, until we reached 40 degrees 12 minutes south latitude without seeing any signs of land. After that, I steered west between 30 and 40 degrees until October 6, when we discovered the east coast of New Zealand, which I found to consist of two large islands, stretching from 34 to 48 degrees south latitude, both of which I circumnavigated. On April 1, 1770, I left New Zealand and sailed west until I encountered the east coast of New Holland at 30 degrees south latitude. I followed the coastline north, stopping at convenient locations until we reached 15 degrees 45 minutes south latitude, where, on the night of June 10, we struck a reef of rocks and were grounded for 23 hours, sustaining considerable damage. This proved a fatal blow to the remainder of the voyage, as we had to seek shelter in the first port we found and were delayed repairing the damage until August 4. After all that, we set sail with a leaking ship and continued north along the most dangerous navigation that any ship had ever faced, until the 22nd of the same month, when, at 10 degrees 30 minutes south latitude, we found a passage into the Indian Ocean between the northern tip of New Holland and New Guinea. After passing through the strait, I headed for the coast of New Guinea, which we reached on the 29th; however, since it was absolutely necessary to heave the ship down to stop her leaks before returning home, I did not stay long and left this coast on September 30, making my way to Batavia, where we arrived on the 10th, and soon after received permission from the governor and council to be heaved down at Onrust, where we have just gotten alongside the wharf to take out our stores, etc."

"I send herewith a copy of my Journal, containing the Proceedings of the whole Voyage, together with such Charts as I have had time to Copy, which I judge will be sufficient for the present to illustrate said Journal. In this Journal I have with undisguised truth and without gloss inserted the whole Transactions of the Voyage, and made such remarks and have given such discriptions of things as I thought was necessary in the best manner I was Capable off. Altho' the discoverys made in this Voyage are not great, yet I flatter myself they are such as may Merit the Attention of their Lordships; and altho' I have failed in discovering the so much talked of Southern Continent (which perhaps do not exist), and which I myself had much at heart, yet I am confident that no part of the Failure of such discovery can be laid to my charge. Had we been so fortunate not to have run a shore much more would have been done in the latter part of the Voyage than what was; but as it is, I presume this Voyage will be found as compleat as any before made to the South Seas on the same account. The plans I have drawn of the places I have been at were made with all the Care and accuracy that time and Circumstances would admit of. Thus far I am certain that the Latitude and Longitude of few parts of the World are better settled than these. In this I was very much assisted by Mr. Green, who let slip no one opportunity for making of Observations for settling the Longitude during the whole Course of the Voyage; and the many Valuable discoveries made by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander in Natural History, and other things useful to the learned world, cannot fail of contributing very much to the Success of the Voyage. In justice to the Officers and the whole Crew, I must say they have gone through the fatigues and dangers of the whole Voyage with that cheerfulness and Allertness that will always do Honour to British Seamen, and I have the satisfaction to say that I have not lost one Man by sickness during the whole Voyage. I hope that the repairs wanting to the Ship will not be so great as to detain us any length of time. You may be assured that I shall make no unnecessary delay either here or at any other place, but shall make the best of my way home. I have the Honour to be with the greatest respect,

I’m sending a copy of my Journal, which includes the details of the entire Voyage, along with some Charts that I managed to copy in time, which I think will be enough for now to illustrate the Journal. In this Journal, I have truthfully and straightforwardly documented everything that happened during the Voyage and made remarks and descriptions as I thought were necessary in the best way I could. Although the discoveries made during this Voyage aren’t significant, I believe they are worthy of your attention; even though I didn’t find the much-discussed Southern Continent (which might not exist), something I cared about a lot, I’m confident that none of the reasons for this lack of discovery fall on me. If we hadn’t been unfortunate enough to run aground, much more could have been accomplished in the latter part of the Voyage than what was actually done, but as it stands, I believe this Voyage will be regarded as complete as any previous expedition to the South Seas for the same purposes. The maps I've created of the places I've been to were drawn with as much care and accuracy as time and circumstances allowed. I’m quite sure that the latitude and longitude of few areas of the world are better established than these. I had great help from Mr. Green, who seized every opportunity to take observations and determine the longitude during the entire Voyage; and the many valuable discoveries made by Mr. Banks and Dr. Solander in natural history and other useful fields for the scholarly community will greatly enhance the Voyage's success. In fairness to the Officers and the entire Crew, I must say they have endured the challenges and dangers of the Voyage with a level of cheerfulness and alertness that will always honor British seamen, and I’m pleased to report that I haven't lost a single man to sickness during the entire Voyage. I hope that the repairs needed for the Ship won’t be so extensive as to keep us from departing for too long. You can be assured that I won’t cause any unnecessary delays, either here or elsewhere, but will make my way home as quickly as possible. I am honored to remain, with the utmost respect,

"Sir,

"Hey,"

"Your most Obedient Humble Servant,

"Your most obedient humble servant,"

"(Signed) JAMES COOK.

(Signed) JAMES COOK.

"Endeavour Bark, at Onrust, near Batavia, the 23rd of October, 1770."

"Endeavour Bark, at Onrust, near Batavia, the 23rd of October, 1770."

"Although the discoveries made in this voyage are not great." In these modest words does Cook describe his work. I read them to mean that with his love of accuracy he did not wish to claim his explorations of New Zealand and the East Coast of Australia as discoveries, as it was already known that lands existed there; but seeing how little was known, and how completely he did his work, there are but few men who would have refrained from classing them, as indeed he truly might have, as discoveries.)

"Even though the findings from this voyage aren't remarkable." In these humble words, Cook talks about his work. I interpret this to mean that, because of his commitment to accuracy, he didn't want to label his explorations of New Zealand and the East Coast of Australia as discoveries, since it was already known that land was there; but considering how little was understood and how thorough his work was, very few people would have held back from categorizing them—just as he could have, as genuine discoveries.

Friday, 26th. Set up the Ship's Tent for the reception of the Ship's Company, several of them begin to be taken ill, owing, as I suppose, to the extream hot weather.

Friday, 26th. Set up the Ship's Tent for the welcome of the Ship's Company; several of them are starting to feel unwell, probably due to the extreme heat.

[Heaving down at Batavia.]

[Arriving in Batavia.]

Saturday, 27th. Employed getting out Stores, Ballast, etc.

Saturday, 27th. Worked on getting out supplies, ballast, etc.

Sunday, 28th. Employ'd as above.

Sunday, 28th. Worked as above.

Monday, 29th, Tuesday, 30th, Wednesday, 31st. Employ'd clearing the Ship.

Monday, 29th, Tuesday, 30th, Wednesday, 31st. Worked on clearing the ship.

[November 1770.]

[November 1770.]

Thursday, November 1st. Got every thing out of the Ship, and all clear for going alongside of the Carreening, but about Noon I received a message from the Officer at Onrust acquainting me that they could not receive us there until they had first despatched the Ships bound to Europe, which were down here taking in pepper.

Thursday, November 1st. I got everything off the ship and was all set to head over to the Carreening, but around noon, I got a message from the officer at Onrust telling me they couldn't take us in until they finished sending off the ships headed to Europe, which were down here loading up on pepper.

Friday, 2nd, Saturday, 3rd, Sunday, 4th. Employ'd overhauling the rigging, and making rope, making and repairing Sails.

Friday, 2nd, Saturday, 3rd, Sunday, 4th. Worked on overhauling the rigging, making rope, and constructing and repairing sails.

Monday, 5th. Clear, hot sultry weather. In the A.M. transported the ship over to Onrust, alongside one of the Carreening Wharfs.

Monday, 5th. Clear, hot, humid weather. In the morning, moved the ship over to Onrust, next to one of the Carreening Wharfs.

Tuesday, 6th. In the A.M. the officers of the Yard took the Ship in hand, and sent on board a number of Carpenters, Caulkers, Riggers, Slaves, etc., to make ready to heave down.

Tuesday, 6th. In the morning, the officers of the Yard took charge of the Ship and sent a number of carpenters, caulkers, riggers, workers, etc., on board to prepare for the repairs.

Wednesday, 7th. Employ'd getting ready to heave down in the P.M. We had the misfortune to loose Mr. Monkhouse, the Surgeon, who died at Batavia of a Fever after a short illness, of which disease and others several of our people are daily taken ill, which will make his loss be the more severely felt; he was succeeded by Mr. Perry, his mate, who is equally as well skilled in his profession.

Wednesday, 7th. Spent the afternoon preparing to dock. We unfortunately lost Mr. Monkhouse, the Surgeon, who died in Batavia from a fever after a brief illness. Several of our crew are getting sick with the same illness and others, which will make his loss even harder to bear. He was replaced by Mr. Perry, his assistant, who is just as skilled in his profession.

Thursday, 8th. In the night had much Thunder, Lightning, and Rain; during the day fair weather, which gave us time to get everything in readiness for heaving down.

Thursday, 8th. There was a lot of thunder, lightning, and rain during the night; the day was nice, which gave us time to prepare everything for heaving down.

Friday, 9th. In the P.M. hove the Larboard side of the Ship, Kiel out, and found her bottom to be in a far worse condition than we expected; the false kiel was gone to within 20 feet of the Stern post, the main Kiel wounded in many places very considerably, a great quantity of Sheathing off, and several planks much damaged, especially under the Main Channell near the Kiel, where 2 planks and a 1/2, near 6 feet in length, were within 1/8th of an inch of being cutt through; and here the worms had made their way quite into the timbers, so that it was a matter of surprise to every one who saw her bottom how we had kept her above water, and yet in this condition we had sailed some hundreds of Leagues, in as dangerous a Navigation as in any part of the World, happy in being ignorant of the continual danger we were in. In the evening righted the Ship, having only time to patch up some of the worst places to prevent the water getting in in large quantitys for the present. In the morning hove her down again, and most of the Carpenters and Caulkers in the Yard (which are not a few) were set to work upon her Bottom, and at the same time a number of Slaves were employ'd bailing the water out of the Hold. Our people, altho' they attend, were seldom called upon; indeed, by this time we were so weakned by sickness that we could not muster above 20 Men and Officers that were able to do duty, so little should we have been able to have hove her down and repair'd her ourselves, as I at one time thought us capable of.

Friday, 9th. In the afternoon, we tilted the ship on the port side, lowered the keel, and discovered that the bottom was in much worse shape than we had anticipated. The false keel was gone up to 20 feet from the stern post, and the main keel was severely damaged in many places. A large amount of sheathing was missing, and several planks were badly damaged, especially under the main channel near the keel, where two and a half planks, nearly six feet long, were just an eighth of an inch from being completely cut through. The worms had burrowed deep into the timbers, leaving everyone who saw the bottom amazed that we had managed to keep her afloat. Despite this condition, we had sailed hundreds of leagues through some of the most perilous waters in the world, blissfully unaware of the constant danger we were in. In the evening, we righted the ship, having only enough time to patch up some of the worst areas to prevent a large amount of water from getting in for the time being. In the morning, we tilted her down again, and most of the carpenters and caulkers in the yard (which were many) got to work on the bottom, while a number of slaves were tasked with bailing out the water from the hold. Although our crew was present, they were rarely called upon. At this point, we had been so weakened by illness that we could hardly muster more than 20 men and officers capable of duty, making it impossible for us to tilt her down and repair her ourselves, as I had once thought we could.

Saturday, 10th. In the P.M. we were obliged to righten the ship before night, by reason of her making water in her upper works faster than we could free; it made it necessary to have her weather works inside and out caulked, which before was thought unnecessary.

Saturday, 10th. In the afternoon, we had to straighten the ship before nightfall because water was entering her upper parts faster than we could get it out; it became necessary to caulk her weathered parts both inside and out, which had previously been considered unnecessary.

Sunday, 11th. In the A.M., having caulked her upper works, hove out the Larboard side again, which a number of Workmen were employ'd repairing.

Sunday, 11th. In the morning, after sealing her upper sections, I pulled out the left side again, which several workers were busy fixing.

Monday, 12th. In the P.M. finished the Larboard side, and in the A.M. began to get ready to heave out the other.

Monday, 12th. In the afternoon, finished the left side, and in the morning, started to prepare to take out the other.

Tuesday, 13th. This day they hove the Starboard side Kiel out, which we found very little damaged, and was therefore soon done with.

Tuesday, 13th. Today they pulled out the starboard side of the keel, which we discovered was very minimally damaged, so it was finished quickly.

Wednesday, 14th. Employ'd clearing the Ship of the Carreening gear, her bottom being now thoroughly repair'd, and very much to my satisfaction. In justice to the Officers and Workmen of this Yard, I must say that I do not believe that there is a Marine Yard in the World where work is done with more alertness than here, or where there are better conveniences for heaving Ships down both in point of safety and despatch. Here they heave down by 2 masts, which is not now Practised by the English; but I hold it to be much safer and more expeditious than by heaving down by one mast; a man must not only be strongly bigotted to his own customs, but in some measure divested of reason, that will not allow this, after seeing with how much ease and safety the Dutch at Onrust heave down their largest ships.

Wednesday, 14th. Spent the day clearing the ship of the careening gear, as her bottom has now been thoroughly repaired, which I’m really satisfied with. To be fair to the officers and workers at this yard, I have to say that I don’t think there’s a marine yard in the world where work is done with more efficiency than here, or where there are better facilities for taking ships down in terms of safety and speed. Here, they use two masts to take down the ships, which isn’t something the English do anymore; however, I believe it’s much safer and quicker than using one mast. Anyone who won’t acknowledge this after seeing how easily and safely the Dutch at Onrust take down their largest ships must be very attached to their own customs and somewhat unreasonable.

Thursday, 15th. In the A.M. transported the Ship from Onrust to Cooper's Island, and moored her alongside the Wharf.

Thursday, 15th. In the morning, we moved the ship from Onrust to Cooper's Island and docked her next to the wharf.

Friday, 16th. Employ'd taking in Coals and Ballast; sent one of the decay'd Pumps up to Batavia to have a new one made by it.

Friday, 16th. Worked on loading coal and ballast; sent one of the broken pumps to Batavia to have a new one made.

Saturday, 17th, Sunday, 18th, Monday, 19th, Tuesday, 20th, Wednesday, 21st, Thursday, 22nd, Friday, 23rd, Saturday, 24th, Sunday, 25th. Employ'd rigging the Ship, getting on board Stores and Water, which last we have sent from Batavia at the rate of Six shillings and 8 pence a Leager, or 150 Gallons. We are now become so sickly that we seldom can muster above 12 or 14 hands to do duty.

Saturday, 17th, Sunday, 18th, Monday, 19th, Tuesday, 20th, Wednesday, 21st, Thursday, 22nd, Friday, 23rd, Saturday, 24th, Sunday, 25th. We worked on rigging the ship and loading supplies and water, which we received from Batavia at a cost of six shillings and eight pence per leager, or 150 gallons. We are now so sick that we can rarely get more than 12 or 14 people to perform their duties.

Monday, 26th. In the night had much rain, after which the Westerly Monsoons set in, which blow here generally in the night from the South-West or from the land, in the day from the North-West or North.

Monday, 26th. It rained a lot at night, after which the Western Monsoons began, typically blowing here at night from the South-West or from the land, and during the day from the North-West or North.

Tuesday, 27th, Wednesday, 28th, Thursday, 29th, Friday, 30th, [December 1770.] Saturday, December 1st, Sunday, 2nd, Monday, 3rd, Tuesday, 4th, Wednesday, 5th, Thursday, 6th, Friday, 7th. Employ'd getting on board Stores, Provisions, Water, rigging the Ship, repairing and bending the Sails. On the last of these days, having got all the Sick on board, and every other thing from the Island, we hauled off from the Wharfe with a design to run up to Batavia road, but the Wind proving scant obliged us to lay at anchor.

Tuesday, 27th, Wednesday, 28th, Thursday, 29th, Friday, 30th, [December 1770.] Saturday, December 1st, Sunday, 2nd, Monday, 3rd, Tuesday, 4th, Wednesday, 5th, Thursday, 6th, Friday, 7th. We were busy loading the ship with supplies, food, water, rigging the ship, and repairing and setting the sails. On the last day of this period, after getting all the sick on board and everything else from the island, we pulled away from the dock with the plan to head to Batavia Road, but with the wind being light, we had to anchor instead.

[At Batavia.]

[In Batavia.]

Saturday, 8th. Fresh breezes Westerly, and fair weather. At 10 A.M. weigh'd and run up to Batavia road, where we anchor'd in 4 1/2 fathoms water.

Saturday, 8th. Fresh breezes from the west and nice weather. At 10 A.M. we weighed anchor and moved up to Batavia road, where we anchored in 4 1/2 fathoms of water.

Sunday, 9th. First and latter parts ditto weather, middle squally with rain. In the P.M. sent on shore a Boat load of empty casks, and at the same time went myself in order to forward the things we wanted, and in the evening sent on board the new Pump, with some other stores that were immediately wanting.

Sunday, 9th. The weather was the same in the morning and evening, but there were strong winds and rain in the middle of the day. In the afternoon, I sent a boatload of empty barrels ashore and went myself to take care of the supplies we needed. In the evening, I had the new pump and some other urgent supplies sent on board.

Monday, 10th. For the most part Squally, with rain; the people employ'd scraping the paint work.

Monday, 10th. Mostly stormy, with rain; the workers were busy scraping the paint.

Tuesday, 11th, Wednesday, 12th, Thursday, 13th, Friday, 14th. For the most part of these days fair weather. Employ'd taking on board Provisions and Water; this last is put on board at 5 shillings a Leager or 150 Gallons.

Tuesday, 11th, Wednesday, 12th, Thursday, 13th, Friday, 14th. For the most part, the weather was pleasant. We spent the time loading provisions and water; the water was taken on board at 5 shillings per leager or 150 gallons.

Saturday, 15th. In the P.M. anchor'd here the Earl of Elgin, Captain Cooke, an English East India Company Ship from Madras, bound to China, but having lost her passage, put in here to wait for the next Season.

Saturday, 15th. In the afternoon, the Earl of Elgin, Captain Cooke, an English East India Company ship from Madras, arrived here. It was headed to China, but after missing its passage, it stopped here to wait for the next season.

Sunday, 16th, Monday, 17th. Employ'd taking on board Provisions; Scraping and Painting the Ship.

Sunday, 16th, Monday, 17th. Worked on getting supplies onboard; scraping and painting the ship.

Tuesday, 18th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. Anchored here the Phoenix, Captain Black, an English Country Ship from Bencoolen.

Tuesday, 18th. Light breezes and nice weather. Anchored here is the Phoenix, Captain Black, an English country ship from Bencoolen.

Wednesday, 19th, Thursday, 20th, Friday, 21st, Saturday, 22nd, Sunday, 23rd, Monday, 24th. Fresh breezes, and for the most part fair weather. Completed taking on board Provisions, Water, etc., and getting the Ship ready for sea.

Wednesday, 19th, Thursday, 20th, Friday, 21st, Saturday, 22nd, Sunday, 23rd, Monday, 24th. Fresh breezes and mostly nice weather. Finished loading provisions, water, etc., and getting the ship ready to set sail.

Tuesday, 25th. Having now compleatly refitted the ship, and taken in a sufficient quantity of Provisions of all kinds, I this afternoon took leave of the General, and such others of the principal Gentlemen as I had any connection with, all of whom upon every occasion gave me all the assistance I required. A small dispute, however, now hapned between me and some of the Dutch Naval Officers about a Seaman that had run from one of the Dutch Ships in the Road, and enter'd on board mine; this man the General demanded as a Subject of Holland, and I promised to deliver him up provided he was not an English Subject, and sent the necessary orders on board for that purpose. In the morning the Commodore's Captain came and told me that he had been on board my ship for the man, but that the Officer had refused to give him up, alledging that he was an Englishman, and that he, the Captain, was just then come from the General to demand the man of me as a Deanish Subject, he standing upon their Ship's books as born at Elsinore. I told him that I believed there must be some mistake in the General's message, for I apprehended he would not demand a Deanish Seaman from me who had committed no other crime than preferring the English Service before that of the Dutch; but to convince him how unwilling I was to disoblige any one concerned, I had sent orders on board to deliver the man to him in case he was found to be a Foreigner; but as that was not done I suspected that the man was a Subject of England, and if I found him to be such I was resolved to keep him. Soon after this I received a letter from Mr. Hicks, which I carried to the Shabander, and desired that it might be shewn to the General, and at the same time to acquaint him that, after my having such unanswerable proof of the man's being an English Subject, as was mentioned in that letter, it was impossible for me to deliver him up. After this I heard no more about it.

Tuesday, 25th. Having fully refitted the ship and stocked up on enough supplies of all kinds, I said goodbye to the General and a few other important gentlemen I had connections with, all of whom had always provided me with the assistance I needed. However, a small dispute arose between me and some Dutch naval officers about a sailor who had run away from one of the Dutch ships in the harbor and joined my crew. The General claimed him as a subject of Holland, and I promised to hand him over if he wasn't an English subject, and sent the necessary orders to that effect. In the morning, the Commodore's Captain came by and told me he had been on board my ship for the man, but the officer refused to hand him over, claiming he was English. He said he had just come from the General to demand the man from me as a Danish subject, as he appeared on their ship's records as being born in Elsinore. I told him I believed there had to be some mistake in the General's message, as I didn't think he would ask for a Danish sailor from me who had done no more than choose to serve in the English Navy instead of the Dutch. To show how unwilling I was to cause any trouble, I sent orders to deliver the man to him if he turned out to be a foreigner; but since that hadn't happened, I suspected the man was actually an English subject, and if I found him to be one, I was determined to keep him. Shortly after, I received a letter from Mr. Hicks, which I took to the Shabander and requested that it be shown to the General. I also asked him to inform the General that, with the undeniable proof of the man's English nationality provided in that letter, it was impossible for me to hand him over. After that, I didn't hear anything more about it.

Wednesday, 26th. In the P.M. myself, Mr. Banks, and all the Gentlemen came on board, and at 6 a.m. weigh'd and came to sail with a light breeze at South-West. The Elgin Indiaman saluted us with 3 cheers and 13 Guns, and soon after the Garrison with 14, both of which we return'd. Soon after this the Sea breeze set in at North by West, which obliged us to Anchor just without the Ships in the Road. The number of Sick on board at this time amounts to 40 or upwards, and the rest of the Ship's Company are in a weakly condition, having been every one sick except the Sailmaker, an old Man about 70 or 80 years of age; and what is still more extraordinary in this man is his being generally more or less drunk every day. But notwithstanding this general sickness, we lost but 7 men in the whole: the Surgeon, 3 Seamen, Mr. Green's Servant, and Tupia and his Servant, both of which fell a sacrifice to this unwholesome climate before they had reached the object of their wishes. Tupia's death, indeed, cannot be said to be owing wholy to the unwholesome air of Batavia; the long want of a Vegetable Diet, which he had all his life before been used to, had brought upon him all the Disorders attending a Sea life. He was a shrewd, sensible, ingenious man, but proud and obstinate, which often made his situation on board both disagreeable to himself and those about him, and tended much to promote the diseases which put a Period to his Life.* (* It is rather curious that Cook does not here record his sense of the value of Tupia's services as interpreter, which he has before alluded to in the Journal. There is no doubt that his presence on board when the ship was in New Zealand was the greatest advantage, affording a means of communication with the natives, which prevented the usual gross misunderstandings which arise as to the object of the visit of an exploring ship. Without him, even with Cook's humane intention and good management, friendly relations would have been much more difficult to establish.)

Wednesday, 26th. In the afternoon, I, Mr. Banks, and all the gentlemen came on board, and at 6 a.m. we weighed anchor and set sail with a light breeze coming from the southwest. The Elgin Indiaman greeted us with three cheers and 13 gunshots, and soon after, the Garrison saluted us with 14, both of which we returned. Shortly after this, the sea breeze changed to north by west, which forced us to anchor just outside the ships in the road. The number of sick on board at this time has reached 40 or more, and the rest of the crew is in weak condition, as everyone except the sailmaker, an old man about 70 or 80 years old, has been ill. What’s even more unusual about this man is that he is often somewhat drunk every day. Despite this widespread illness, we lost only 7 men in total: the surgeon, 3 seamen, Mr. Green's servant, and Tupia along with his servant, both of whom succumbed to this unhealthy climate before reaching their desired destination. Tupia's death cannot be fully attributed to the bad air of Batavia; the extended lack of a vegetable diet, which he had been accustomed to all his life, caused him various ailments typical of life at sea. He was a clever, sensible, and resourceful man, but also proud and stubborn, which often made his time aboard uncomfortable for himself and those around him, and largely contributed to the illnesses that ended his life. * (* It’s interesting that Cook doesn’t mention here how valuable Tupia's services as an interpreter were, even though he has referenced them earlier in the journal. There is no doubt that having him on board when the ship was in New Zealand provided significant advantages, facilitating communication with the locals and preventing the usual major misunderstandings that occur regarding the purpose of an exploring ship's visit. Without him, even with Cook's good intentions and management, establishing friendly relations would have been much more challenging.)

[Description of Batavia.]

[Description of Batavia.]

Batavia is a place that hath been so often visited by Europeans, and so many accounts of it extant, that any discription I could give would seem unnecessary; besides, I have neither abilities nor materials sufficient for such an undertaking, for whoever gives a faithful account of this place must in many things contradict all the Authors I have had an opportunity to consult; but this task I shall leave to some abler hand, and only take notice of such things that seem to me necessary for Seamen to know.

Batavia is a place that has been visited so many times by Europeans and has so many existing accounts that any description I could provide would seem unnecessary. Besides, I don’t have the skills or resources for such a task, because anyone giving an accurate account of this place will likely contradict many of the authors I’ve been able to consult. Instead, I’ll leave this task to someone more capable and will only mention the things that seem important for sailors to know.

The City of Batavia is situated on a low flatt near the Sea, in the Bottom of a large Bay of the same name, which lies on the North side of Java, about 8 Leagues from the Straits of Sunda; it lies in 6 degrees 10 minutes South Latitude, and 106 degrees 50 minutes East Longitude from the Meridian of Greenwich, settled by Astronomical Observations made on the spot by the Reverend Mr. Mohr, who has built a very ellegant Observatory, which is as well furnished with Instruments as most in Europe. Most of the Streets in the City have canals of water running through them, which unite into one Stream about 1/2 a mile before they discharge themselves into the Sea; this is about 100 feet broad, and is built far enough out into the Sea to have at its entrance a sufficient depth of Water to admit Small Craft, Luggage boats, etc. The communication between the Sea and the City is by this Canal alone, and this only in the day; for it is shut up every night by a Boom, through which no Boats can pass from about 6 o'clock in the evening to between 5 and 6 the next morning. Here stands the Custom house, where all goods, either imported or exported, pay the Customary Dutys; at least, an Account is here taken of them, and nothing can pass without a Permit, wether it pays duty or no. All kinds of refreshments, Naval Stores, and Sea Provisions are to be had here; but there are few Articles but what bear a very high Price, especially if you take them of the Company, which you are obliged to do if you want any Quantity; that is, of such Articles as they monoplie to themselves, which are all manner of Naval Stores and Salted Provisions.

The City of Batavia is located on flat land near the sea, at the bottom of a large bay with the same name, which is on the north side of Java, about 8 leagues from the Straits of Sunda. It sits at 6 degrees 10 minutes south latitude and 106 degrees 50 minutes east longitude from the Greenwich Meridian, determined by astronomical observations made on-site by the Reverend Mr. Mohr, who built a very elegant observatory equipped with instruments comparable to many in Europe. Most of the streets in the city have canals running through them, which merge into one stream about half a mile before flowing into the sea; this is about 100 feet wide and extends far enough into the sea to ensure enough depth at its entrance for small boats and cargo vessels. The only way to access the sea from the city is through this canal, and it’s only open during the day; at night, it’s closed off by a boom, so no boats can pass from around 6 PM until between 5 and 6 the next morning. The custom house is located here, where all goods being imported or exported are subject to the customary duties; at least, an account is maintained of them, and nothing can go through without a permit, whether it pays duty or not. You can find all kinds of refreshments, naval supplies, and seafood provisions here, but most items tend to be quite expensive, especially if you're buying from the Company, which you must do if you want a larger quantity; that is, for items they monopolize, including various naval supplies and salted provisions.

The Road of Batavia, or place where Shipping Anchor, lies right before the City, and is so large as to contain any number of Shipping. You anchor with the Dome of the Great Church, bearing about South in 7, 6, or 5 fathoms water, about 1 1/2 or 2 miles from the Shore; and nearer you cannot come with Large Ships, by reason of a Mud bank which lines all the Shore of the Bay. The ground that you Anchor in is of such a nature that the Anchors buries themselves so deep that it is with difficulty they are got out; for this reason Ships always lays at Single Anchor, being in no manner of danger of fouling them. You lay apparently open to the winds from the North-West to the East-North-East; but the Sea that is caused by these winds is a good deal broke before it reaches the Road by the small Islands and Shoals without. These Shoals have all of them either Buoys or Beacons upon them; but if these Guides should be moved, there is a very good Chart of this Bay and the Coast of Java as far as the Straits of Sunda, bound up in the English East India Pilot, sold by Mount & Page. In this Chart everything seems to be very accurately delineated.

The Road of Batavia, or the place where ships anchor, is right in front of the city and is spacious enough to hold any number of ships. You anchor with the dome of the Great Church to your south in 7, 6, or 5 fathoms of water, about 1.5 to 2 miles from the shore; and you can't get closer with large ships because of a mud bank that runs along the entire shore of the bay. The seabed where you anchor is such that the anchors bury themselves deeply, making them hard to pull up; for this reason, ships always anchor singly, with no risk of getting tangled. You seem to be exposed to winds from the northwest to the east-northeast, but the sea generated by these winds is considerably broken up before it reaches the road by the small islands and shoals offshore. These shoals all have buoys or beacons on them; however, if these markers were to be moved, there is a very good chart of this bay and the coast of Java all the way to the Straits of Sunda, included in the English East India Pilot, sold by Mount & Page. In this chart, everything appears to be very accurately depicted.

Fresh water and wood for fuel must be purchased here. The water is put on board the Ship in the Road at a Spanish Dollar, or 5 shillings a Leager, containing 150 Gallons; but if sent to Onrust, which is one League from the Road, it cost a Duccatoon, or 6 shillings 8 pence. The supplying shipping with water, especially Foreigners, is a perquisite of the Commodore, who is always an Officer in the State's Service, but acts here under the Company. He takes care to tell you that the Water is very good, and will keep sweet at Sea; whereas everybody else tells you that it is not so.

Freshwater and firewood need to be bought here. The water is loaded onto the ship in the road for a Spanish dollar, or 5 shillings per leager, which holds 150 gallons; however, if it’s sent to Onrust, about a league away from the road, it costs a ducat, or 6 shillings 8 pence. Supplying ships with water, especially foreign ones, is a privilege of the Commodore, who is always an officer in the State's Service but operates here under the Company. He makes sure to tell you that the water is very good and will stay fresh at sea, while everyone else claims that isn’t the case.

Be this as it will, Batavia is certainly a place that Europeans need not covet to go to; but if necessity obliges them, they will do well to make their stay as short as possible, otherwise they will soon feel the effects of the unwholesome air of Batavia, which, I firmly believe, is the Death of more Europeans than any other place upon the Globe of the same extent. Such, at least, is my opinion of it, which is founded on facts. We came in here with as healthy a Ship's Company as need go to Sea, and after a stay of not quite 3 months left it in the condition of an Hospital Ship, besides the loss of 7 men; and yet all the Dutch Captains I had an opportunity to converse with said that we had been very lucky, and wondered that we had not lost half our people in that time.* (* Batavia bears an evil reputation for health to this day; but it must be remembered that the Endeavour lay there during the rainy or most unhealthy season.)

Be that as it may, Batavia is definitely a place that Europeans shouldn't feel tempted to visit; however, if they have to go, they should make their stay as brief as possible. Otherwise, they will quickly feel the effects of Batavia's unhealthy air, which, I truly believe, has caused the death of more Europeans than any other place of similar size on Earth. At least, that’s my opinion based on facts. We arrived with a healthy crew, and after staying for just under three months, we left in the condition of a hospital ship, with the loss of seven men. Yet all the Dutch captains I spoke with said we had been very lucky and were surprised we hadn’t lost half our crew in that time. (* Batavia still has a bad reputation for health; but it should be noted that the Endeavour was there during the rainy season, which is the most unhealthy time.)


CHAPTER 10. BATAVIA TO CAPE OF GOOD HOPE.

[December 1770.]

[December 1770.]

THURSDAY, 27th. Moderate breezes at West and North-West, with fair weather. At 6 a.m. weighed, and stood out to Sea; at Noon the Island of Edam bore North by East, distant 3 miles.

THURSDAY, 27th. Light winds from the West and Northwest, with clear weather. At 6 a.m., we weighed anchor and headed out to sea; at noon, the Island of Edam wasNorth by East, 3 miles away.

Friday, 28th. Winds variable between the North and West. At 6 in the Evening anchored in 13 fathoms, Edam Island bearing East, distant 1 1/2 miles. At day light in the morning weighed again, and keept plying to windward between Edam and Duffin's Island, but gained very little owing to the variableness of the winds.

Friday, 28th. Winds were changing between the North and West. At 6 PM, we anchored in 13 fathoms, with Edam Island to the East, about 1.5 miles away. At dawn the next morning, we weighed anchor again and kept tacking against the wind between Edam and Duffin's Island, but made very little progress due to the shifting winds.

Saturday, 29th. In the P.M. anchored in 12 fathoms water in the Evening until daylight, when we got again under Sail, with the wind at West-South-West, and stood out North-West for the Thousand Islands. Before noon the wind veer'd to North-West, and we endeavour'd to turn through between Pulo Pare and Wapping Island.

Saturday, 29th. In the afternoon, we anchored in 12 fathoms of water in the evening until daylight, when we set sail again with the wind from the West-South-West and headed out North-West towards the Thousand Islands. Before noon, the wind shifted to North-West, and we tried to navigate between Pulo Pare and Wapping Island.

Sunday, 30th. After making a short trip to the North-East, we tacked, and weather'd Pulo Pare, and stood in for the Main, having the wind at North-West, a fresh breeze. We fetched Maneaters Island (a small island laying under the Main midway between Batavia and Bantam) after making a trip to the North-East, and finding that we lost ground, we stood in shore again and anchored in 13 fathoms, the above mentioned Island bearing South-West by West, distant 1 mile, and in one with Bantam Hill. At 7 A.M. weighed, with the wind at West-South-West, and stood to the North-West, and weather'd Wapping Island, having the current in our favour.

Sunday, 30th. After taking a quick trip to the North-East, we turned around and navigated past Pulo Pare, heading toward the mainland with the wind coming from the North-West, a fresh breeze. We reached Maneaters Island (a small island located under the mainland midway between Batavia and Bantam) after our trip to the North-East, and since we were losing ground, we approached the shore again and anchored in 13 fathoms, with the mentioned island to the South-West by West, about 1 mile away, and in line with Bantam Hill. At 7 A.M., we weighed anchor with the wind from the West-South-West and headed to the North-West, passing Wapping Island, with the current in our favor.

Monday, 31st. At 1 P.M. the wind veer'd to the Northward; we tack and stood to the Westward, and weather'd Pulo Baby. In the Evening Anchor'd between this Island and Bantam Bay, the Island bearing North, distant 2 miles, and Bantam Point West; at 5 a.m. weighed with the wind at West by South, which afterwards proved variable; at noon Bantam Point South-West 1/2 West, distant 3 Leagues.

Monday, 31st. At 1 PM, the wind shifted to the north; we tacked and headed west, passing Pulo Baby. In the evening, we anchored between this island and Bantam Bay, with the island to the north, 2 miles away, and Bantam Point to the west; at 5 AM, we weighed anchor with the wind coming from the west by south, which later turned out to be variable; at noon, Bantam Point was to the southwest half west, 3 leagues away.

JANUARY, 1771.

JAN, 1771.

Tuesday, 1st. In the P.M. stood over for the Sumatra Shore, having the wind at South-South-West, a fresh breeze, and the current in our favour; but this last shifted and set to the Eastward in the Evening, and obliged us to Anchor in 30 fathoms, under the Islands which lay off Verekens point, which point constitutes the narrowest part of the Straits of Sunda. Here we found the current set to the South-West the most part of the night; at 5 a.m. weigh'd with the wind at North-West, and stood to the South-West between the Island Thwart-the-way and Sumatra; the wind soon after coming to the westward we stood over for the Java Shore. At noon the South point of Peper Bay bore South-West by South, and Anger Point North-East 1/2 East, distant 2 Leagues; tacked and stood to the North-West.

Tuesday, 1st. In the afternoon, we headed for the Sumatra Shore, with a fresh breeze coming from the South-South-West and the current helping us along. However, the current changed and moved eastward in the evening, forcing us to anchor in 30 fathoms near the islands off Verekens point, which is the narrowest part of the Straits of Sunda. Here, we experienced a current flowing to the South-West for most of the night. At 5 a.m., we set sail again with the wind from the North-West, heading South-West between the Island Thwart-the-way and Sumatra. Soon after, as the wind shifted to the west, we made our way toward the Java Shore. By noon, the South point of Peper Bay was to the South-West by South, and Anger Point was North-East 1/2 East, about 2 leagues away; we then tacked and headed to the North-West.

Wednesday, 2nd. First and middle parts fresh breezes at South-West, and fair the remainder, squally with rain; plying to windward between Cracatoa and the Java shore without gaining anything.

Wednesday, 2nd. The first and middle parts of the day had fresh breezes from the Southwest, and the rest of the day was fair but squally with rain; we were sailing against the wind between Krakatoa and the Java shore without making any progress.

Thursday, 3rd. In the P.M. had it very squally, with heavy showers of rain; at 1/2 past 7 anchor'd in 19 fathoms, Cracatoa Island South-West, distance 3 Leagues. In the morning came to sail, having very squally variable weather; at Noon Cracatoa West 2 Leagues.

Thursday, 3rd. In the afternoon, it became very stormy with heavy rain showers; at 7:30 PM, we anchored in 19 fathoms near Cracatoa Island to the southwest, about 3 leagues away. In the morning, we set sail, dealing with very unpredictable weather; at noon, Cracatoa was 2 leagues to the west.

Friday, 4th. Most part of these 24 hours squally, rainy weather, winds variable between the North-North-West and South-South-West; at 5 p.m. anchor'd in 28 fathoms water, Cracatoa West, distant 3 miles. Some time after the wind veer'd to North-West, with which we got under sail, but the wind dying away we advanced but little to the South-West before noon, at which time Princes Island bore South-West, distance 8 or 9 Leagues.

Friday, 4th. Most of the last 24 hours had squally, rainy weather, with winds shifting between North-North-West and South-South-West. At 5 p.m., we dropped anchor in 28 fathoms of water, 3 miles from Cracatoa West. Shortly after, the wind shifted to the North-West, and we set sail, but as the wind died down, we made little progress to the South-West before noon, at which point Princes Island was to the South-West, about 8 or 9 leagues away.

Saturday, 5th. Had fresh breezes at South-West, with squally, rainy weather until the evening, when it clear up, and the wind veer'd to South and South-East, with which we stood to the South-West all night. In the morning the wind veer'd to North-East, which was still in our favour; at noon Princes Island bore West 1/2 South, distant 3 Leagues.

Saturday, 5th. We had fresh breezes coming from the Southwest, with squally, rainy weather until the evening, when it cleared up and the wind changed to South and Southeast, allowing us to head Southwest all night. In the morning, the wind shifted to Northeast, which was still in our favor; at noon, Princes Island was located West ½ South, 3 Leagues away.

[At Anchor. Princes Island, Sunda Strait.]

[At Anchor. Princes Island, Sunda Strait.]

Sunday, 6th. At 3 o'clock in the P.M. anchor'd under the South-East side of Princes Island in 18 fathoms water, in order to recruite our wood and water, and to procure refreshments for the people, which are now in a much worse state of health than when we left Batavia. After coming to an anchor I went on shore to look at the watering place, and to speak with the Natives, some of whom were upon the Beach. I found the watering place convenient, and the water to all appearance good, Provided proper care is taken in the filling of it. The Natives seemed inclined to supply us with Turtle, Fowls, etc.; Articles that I intended laying in as great a stock as possible for the benefit of the Sick, and to suffer every one to purchase what they pleased for themselves, as I found these people as easy to traffick with as Europeans. In the morning sent the Gunner ashore with some hands to fill water, while others were empboy'd putting the whole to rights, sending on shore Empty Casks, etc. Served Turtle to the Ship's Company. Yesterday was the only Salt meat day they have had since our arrival at Java, which is now near 4 months.

Sunday, 6th. At 3 o'clock in the afternoon, we anchored on the southeast side of Princes Island in 18 fathoms of water to restock our wood and water supplies, and to get some refreshments for the crew, who are now in much worse health than when we left Batavia. After anchoring, I went ashore to check out the watering spot and talk to the locals, some of whom were on the beach. I found the watering place convenient, and the water appeared to be good, as long as care is taken while filling it. The locals seemed willing to sell us turtle, chickens, and other supplies—items I wanted to stock up on for the benefit of the sick, allowing everyone to buy what they wanted for themselves, as I found these people just as easy to trade with as Europeans. In the morning, I sent the gunner ashore with some crew members to fill water, while others worked on getting everything back in order, sending empty barrels ashore, etc. We served turtle to the crew. Yesterday was the only day they've had salt meat since we arrived in Java, which is now approaching four months.

Monday, 7th. From this day till Monday 14th we were employ'd wooding and watering, being frequently interrupted by heavy rains. Having now compleated both we hoisted in the Long boat, and made ready to put to Sea, having on board a pretty good stock of refreshments, which we purchased of the natives, such as Turtle, Fowls, Fish, two species of Deer, one about as big as a small sheep, the other no bigger than a Rabbit; both sorts eat very well, but are only for present use, as they seldom lived above 24 hours in our possession. We likewise got fruit of several sorts, such as Cocoa Nutts, plantains, Limes, etc. The Trade on our part was carried on chiefly with money (Spanish Dollars); the natives set but little value upon any thing else. Such of our people as had not this Article traded with Old Shirts, etc., at a great disadvantage.

Monday, 7th. From this day until Monday the 14th, we worked on getting wood and water, often interrupted by heavy rains. Once we finished both tasks, we brought the longboat on board and prepared to set sail, having a good supply of refreshments that we bought from the locals, including turtle, chickens, fish, and two types of deer—one about the size of a small sheep and the other no bigger than a rabbit. Both kinds tasted good but were only for immediate consumption since they rarely lasted more than 24 hours with us. We also gathered various fruits like coconuts, plantains, and limes. Our trade was mostly done with money (Spanish dollars), as the locals valued little else. Those in our group without money traded old shirts, etc., but they were at a significant disadvantage.

[Batavia to Capetown.]

[Batavia to Cape Town.]

Tuesday, 15th. Had variable light airs of wind, with which we could not get under sail until the morning, when we weighed with a light breeze at North-East, which was soon succeeded by a calm.

Tuesday, 15th. We had shifting light winds, which prevented us from setting sail until the morning, when we finally got underway with a gentle breeze coming from the Northeast, but that was quickly followed by a calm.

Wednesday, 16th. Had it calm all P.M., which at 5 o'clock obliged us to Anchor under the South Point of Princes Island, the said Point bearing South-West by West, distance 2 miles. At 8 o'clock in the A.M. a light breeze sprung up at North, with which we weigh'd and stood out to Sea. At noon Java Head bore South-East by South, distance 2 Leagues, and the West Point of Princes Island North-North-West, distance 5 Leagues; Latitude Observed 6 degrees 45 minutes South. Java Head, from which I take my departure, lies in the Latitude of 6 degrees 49 minutes South, and Longitude 255 degrees 12 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich, deduced from several Astronomical Observations made at Batavia by the Reverend Mr. Mohr.* (* The true longitude of Java Head is 254 degrees 49 minutes West.)

Wednesday, 16th. It was calm all afternoon, which at 5 o'clock forced us to anchor under the South Point of Princes Island, with that point bearing South-West by West, a distance of 2 miles. At 8 o'clock in the morning, a light breeze came up from the North, so we weighed anchor and headed out to sea. At noon, Java Head was located South-East by South, 2 leagues away, and the West Point of Princes Island was North-North-West, 5 leagues away; the observed latitude was 6 degrees 45 minutes South. Java Head, which is my starting point, sits at a latitude of 6 degrees 49 minutes South and a longitude of 255 degrees 12 minutes West from the Meridian of Greenwich, as deduced from several astronomical observations made at Batavia by the Reverend Mr. Mohr.* (* The true longitude of Java Head is 254 degrees 49 minutes West.)

Thursday, 17th. Little wind and fair at 6 p.m. Java head bore East-North-East, distant 4 or 5 Leagues; at 6 a.m. it bore North-North-East, 12 Leagues. Wind North-East; course South 27 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 48 miles; latitude 7 degrees 32 minutes South; longitude 255 degrees 35 minutes West.

Thursday, 17th. There was little wind and it was clear at 6 p.m. Java head was to the East-North-East, about 4 or 5 leagues away; at 6 a.m. it was to the North-North-East, 12 leagues distant. The wind was from the North-East; we were heading South 27 degrees 15 minutes West; we traveled 48 miles; latitude was 7 degrees 32 minutes South; longitude was 255 degrees 35 minutes West.

Friday, 18th. Light Airs and Calms, with Showers of Rain. Wind Variable; course South-West 1/2 South; distance 30 miles; latitude 7 degrees 55 minutes South; longitude 255 degrees 54 minutes West.

Friday, 18th. Light breezes and calm with rain showers. Wind was variable; course Southwest 1/2 South; distance 30 miles; latitude 7 degrees 55 minutes South; longitude 255 degrees 54 minutes West.

Saturday, 19th. For the most part of these 24 hours had little wind and fair weather. Wind Westerly; course South 3 degrees East; distance 53 miles; latitude 8 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 255 degrees 51 minutes West.

Saturday, 19th. For most of these 24 hours, there was little wind and nice weather. Wind from the West; course South 3 degrees East; distance 53 miles; latitude 8 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 255 degrees 51 minutes West.

Sunday, 20th. Light Airs and Calms, with some Showers of Rain. Saw 2 Sail in the North-West Quarter standing to the South-West; one of them shew'd Dutch Colours. Wind North Westerly; course South 44 degrees West; distance 36 miles; latitude 9 degrees 14 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 15 minutes West.

Sunday, 20th. Light winds and calm, with some rain showers. I saw 2 ships in the Northwest heading Southwest; one of them was flying Dutch colors. Wind from the Northwest; course South 44 degrees West; distance 36 miles; latitude 9 degrees 14 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 15 minutes West.

Monday, 21st. First part Little wind, the remainder a Gentle breeze; the 2 Sail in sight. Wind Easterly; course South 57 degrees West; distance 58 miles; latitude 9 degrees 46 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 5 minutes West.

Monday, 21st. First part Little wind, the remainder a Gentle breeze; the 2 Sail in sight. Wind Easterly; course South 57 degrees West; distance 58 miles; latitude 9 degrees 46 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 5 minutes West.

Tuesday, 22nd. Little wind and fair weather. Wind South-Westerly; course North 10 degrees West; distance 17 miles; latitude 9 degrees 29 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 8 minutes West.

Tuesday, 22nd. Light wind and nice weather. Wind from the Southwest; heading North 10 degrees West; distance traveled 17 miles; latitude 9 degrees 29 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 8 minutes West.

Wednesday, 23rd. Ditto weather; a swell from the Southward, and which we have had ever since we left the Straits of Sunda. Wind Ditto; course East Southerly; distance 18 miles; latitude 9 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 50 minutes West.

Wednesday, the 23rd. Same weather; a swell coming from the south, which we've had since we left the Sunda Straits. Wind is the same; heading east-southeast; distance 18 miles; latitude 9 degrees 30 minutes south; longitude 256 degrees 50 minutes west.

Thursday, 24th. First part Light Airs, the remainder Calm. In the A.M. died John Trusslove, Corporal of Marines, a man much esteem'd by every body on board. Many of our people at this time lay dangerously ill of Fevers and Fluxes. We are inclinable to attribute this to the water we took in at Princes Island, and have put lime into the Casks in order to purifie it. Wind South-West by South to South-South-East; course South; distance 4 miles; latitude 9 degrees 34 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 50 minutes West.

Thursday, 24th. Light breezes in the morning, then calm for the rest of the day. In the morning, John Trusslove, Corporal of Marines, passed away, a man highly regarded by everyone on board. Many of our crew are seriously ill with fevers and dysentery. We think this might be due to the water we took on at Princes Island, so we’ve added lime to the barrels to purify it. Wind is coming from the South-West by South to South-South-East; heading South; traveled 4 miles; latitude 9 degrees 34 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 50 minutes West.

Friday, 25th. Light Airs and Calms; hot, sultry weather. Departed this life Mr. Sporing, a Gentleman belonging to Mr Banks's retinue. Wind Variable and Calms; course South 30 degrees East; distance 12 miles; latitude 9 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 44 minutes West.

Friday, 25th. Light winds and calm; hot, humid weather. Mr. Sporing, a gentleman in Mr. Banks’s group, passed away. Winds were variable and calm; heading South 30 degrees East; distance 12 miles; latitude 9 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 44 minutes West.

Saturday, 26th. First part little wind, the remainder calm and very hot; set up the Topmast Rigging, and clear'd ship between Decks, and wash her with Vinegar. Wind South Westerly; course South-East; distance 17 miles; latitude 9 degrees 56 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 32 minutes West.

Saturday, 26th. The first part of the day had little wind, and the rest was calm and really hot; we set up the topmast rigging, cleared the decks, and washed the ship with vinegar. The wind was from the southwest; our course was southeast; we covered 17 miles; latitude 9 degrees 56 minutes south; longitude 256 degrees 32 minutes west.

Sunday, 27th. Little wind, and sometimes calm. In the evening found the Variation to be 2 degrees 51 minutes West. Departed this life Mr. Sydney Parkinson, Natural History Painter to Mr. Banks, and soon after John Ravenhill, Sailmaker, a man much advanced in years. Wind Variable; course South 30 degrees West; distance 19 miles; latitude 10 degrees 12 minutes South; longitude 256 degrees 41 minutes West.

Sunday, 27th. There was little wind, and at times it was calm. In the evening, we found the variation to be 2 degrees 51 minutes West. Mr. Sydney Parkinson, Natural History Painter to Mr. Banks, passed away, and soon after, John Ravenhill, a seasoned sailmaker, also died. The wind was variable; we were headed South 30 degrees West; we covered a distance of 19 miles; our latitude was 10 degrees 12 minutes South; and our longitude was 256 degrees 41 minutes West.

Monday, 28th. Moderate breezes, with some Squalls, attended with Showers of Rain. Wind West-North-West, North-East; course South 43 degrees West; distance 66 miles; latitude 11 degrees 0 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 27 West.

Monday, 28th. Light winds, with a few gusts accompanied by rain showers. Wind from the West-North-West and North-East; heading South 43 degrees West; distance 66 miles; latitude 11 degrees 0 minutes South; longitude 257 degrees 27 West.

Tuesday, 29th. Very variable weather; sometimes squally, with rain, other times little wind and calms. In the Night died Mr. Charles Green, who was sent out by the Royal Society to observe the Transit of Venus. He had long been in a bad state of health, which he took no care to repair, but, on the contrary, lived in such a manner as greatly promoted the disorders he had had long upon him; this brought on the Flux, which put a period to his life. Wind North Westerly; course South 40 degrees West; distance 74 miles; latitude 11 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 258 degrees 15 minutes West.

Tuesday, 29th. The weather was very unpredictable; sometimes windy with rain, other times there was barely any wind and it was calm. During the night, Mr. Charles Green passed away. He was sent by the Royal Society to observe the Transit of Venus. He had been in poor health for a long time and didn’t take care of himself; instead, he lived in a way that worsened his ongoing health issues. This eventually led to dysentery, which caused his death. The wind was coming from the Northwest; our course was South 40 degrees West; we traveled 74 miles; latitude was 11 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude was 258 degrees 15 minutes West.

Wednesday, 30th. First and Latter parts moderate breezes and Cloudy weather; the middle Squally, with rain, Thunder, and Lightning. Died of the Flux Samuel Moody and Francis Haite, 2 of the Carpenter's Crew. Wind Easterly; course South 40 degrees West; distance 67 miles; latitude 12 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 258 degrees 59 minutes West.

Wednesday, 30th. The first and latter parts had moderate breezes and cloudy weather; the middle part was squally, with rain, thunder, and lightning. Samuel Moody and Francis Haite, two members of the carpenter's crew, died from dysentery. The wind was from the east; course South 40 degrees West; distance 67 miles; latitude 12 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 258 degrees 59 minutes West.

Thursday, 31st. First part Moderate and fair, the remainder frequent Squalls, attended with Showers of Rain. In the course of this 24 Hours we have had 4 men died of the Flux, viz., John Thompson, Ship's Cook; Benjamin Jordan, Carpenter's Mate; James Nickolson and Archibald Wolf, Seamen; a melancholy proof of the calamitieous situation we are at present in, having hardly well men enough to tend the Sails and look after the Sick, many of whom are so ill that we have not the least hopes of their recovery. Wind East-South-East; course South-West; distance 80 miles; latitude 13 degrees 42 minutes South; longitude 259 degrees 55 minutes West.

Thursday, 31st. The first part of the day was moderate and clear, but the rest was marked by frequent squalls and rain showers. Over the past 24 hours, we’ve lost 4 men to dysentery: John Thompson, the Ship's Cook; Benjamin Jordan, the Carpenter's Mate; James Nickolson and Archibald Wolf, both Seamen. This is a sad reminder of our disastrous situation, as we barely have enough healthy crew members to manage the sails and care for the sick, many of whom are so ill that we have little hope for their recovery. Wind is coming from the East-South-East; our course is South-West; we’ve traveled 80 miles; current latitude is 13 degrees 42 minutes South; longitude is 259 degrees 55 minutes West.

[February 1771.]

[February 1771.]

Friday, February 1st. Fresh Gales, with flying showers of rain. Clean'd between Decks, and washed with Vinegar. Wind South-East by South; course South 58 1/2 degrees West; distance 119 miles; latitude 14 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude 261 degrees 40 minutes West.

Friday, February 1st. Fresh winds with scattered rain showers. Cleaned between decks and washed with vinegar. Wind from the South-East by South; course South 58.5 degrees West; distance 119 miles; latitude 14 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude 261 degrees 40 minutes West.

Saturday, 2nd. A Fresh Trade, and mostly fair weather. Departed this life Daniel Roberts, Gunner's Servant, who died of the Flux. Since we have had a fresh Trade Wind this fatal disorder hath seem'd to be at a stand; yet there are several people which are so far gone, and brought so very low by it, that we have not the least hopes of their recovery. Wind East-South-East; course South 61 degrees West; distance 131 miles; latitude 15 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 264 degrees 16 minutes West.

Saturday, 2nd. A fresh trade wind and mostly nice weather. Daniel Roberts, the gunner's servant, has passed away from dysentery. Since we've had a strong trade wind, this deadly illness seems to have slowed down; however, there are several people who are so far gone and weakened by it that we have no hope for their recovery. Wind from the East-South-East; course South 61 degrees West; distance 131 miles; latitude 15 degrees 48 minutes South; longitude 264 degrees 16 minutes West.

Sunday, 3rd. Ditto weather. In the Evening found the variation to be 2 degrees 56 minutes West. Departed this life John Thurman, Sailmaker's Assistant. Wind Ditto; course South 65 degrees West; distance 128 miles; latitude 16 degrees 40 minutes South; longitude 266 degrees 16 West.

Sunday, 3rd. The weather was the same. In the evening, I found the variation to be 2 degrees 56 minutes West. John Thurman, the Sailmaker's Assistant, passed away. Wind was the same; course South 65 degrees West; distance 128 miles; latitude 16 degrees 40 minutes South; longitude 266 degrees 16 West.

Monday, 4th. A fresh Trade and hazey weather, with some Squalls, attended with Small Rain; unbent the Main Topsail to repair, and bent another. In the night died of the Flux Mr. John Bootie, Midshipman, and Mr. John Gathrey, Boatswain. Wind South-East; course South 69 degrees West; distance 141 miles; latitude 17 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 268 degrees 32 minutes West.

Monday, 4th. It was a breezy day with hazy weather and some squalls accompanied by light rain. We took down the main topsail to repair it and replaced it with another. During the night, Mr. John Bootie, the midshipman, and Mr. John Gathrey, the boatswain, died of dysentery. The wind was coming from the southeast; we were headed south 69 degrees west; we traveled 141 miles; our latitude was 17 degrees 30 minutes south; and our longitude was 268 degrees 32 minutes west.

Tuesday, 5th. A fresh Trade wind, and hazey, cloudy weather. Employ'd repairing Sails; appointed Samuel Evans, one of the Boatswain's Mates, and Coxswain of the Pinnace, to be Boatswain, in the room of Mr. Gathrey, deceased, and order'd a Survey to be taken of the Stores. Wind East by South; course West 15 degrees South; distance 141 miles; latitude 18 degrees 6 minutes South; longitude 270 degrees 54 minutes West.

Tuesday, 5th. A fresh trade wind and hazy, cloudy weather. I spent the day repairing sails; I appointed Samuel Evans, one of the boatswain's mates and coxswain of the pinnace, to be the new boatswain, replacing Mr. Gathrey, who has passed away, and ordered a survey to be conducted of the stores. Wind is coming from the east by south; course is west 15 degrees south; distance traveled is 141 miles; latitude is 18 degrees 6 minutes south; longitude is 270 degrees 54 minutes west.

Wednesday, 6th. A Fresh Trade wind and fair weather. In the night died Mr. John Monkhouse, Midshipman, and Brother to the late Surgeon. Wind South-East; course West 12 degrees South; distance 126 miles; latitude 18 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 272 degrees 28 minutes West.

Wednesday, 6th. A refreshing trade wind and nice weather. Last night, Mr. John Monkhouse, Midshipman and brother to the late Surgeon, passed away. Wind from the Southeast; course West 12 degrees South; distance 126 miles; latitude 18 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 272 degrees 28 minutes West.

Thursday, 7th. Gentle Gales, with some Showers in the night. In the Evening found the variation to be 3 degrees 24 minutes West, and in the Morning I took several observations of the Sun and Moon, the mean result of which, carried on to Noon, gave 276 degrees 19 minutes West Longitude from Greenwich, which is 2 degrees to the Westward of that given by the Log; this, I believe, is owing to a following Sea, which I have not as yet allowed, for I judge it to be 6 miles a day since we have had the South-East Trade wind. Wind South-East; course South 75 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 110 miles; latitude 18 degrees 58 minutes South; longitude 274 degrees 20 minutes per Log, 276 degrees 19 minutes per Observation.

Thursday, 7th. Light winds with some rain during the night. In the evening, I found the variation to be 3 degrees 24 minutes West. In the morning, I took several readings of the Sun and Moon; the average result, calculated to noon, showed a longitude of 276 degrees 19 minutes West from Greenwich, which is 2 degrees further West than what the log indicated. I believe this discrepancy is due to a following sea, which I haven't accounted for yet, estimating it to be 6 miles a day since we have been under the South-East Trade wind. Wind from the South-East; course South 75 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 110 miles; latitude 18 degrees 58 minutes South; longitude 274 degrees 20 minutes by the log, 276 degrees 19 minutes by observation.

Friday, 8th. Winds as Yesterday; clear weather in the day, and Showrey in the Night. In the morning took Observations again of the Sun and Moon, the mean result of which, reduced to noon, gave 278 degrees 50 minutes West, which is 2 degrees 31 minutes West of Yesterday's Observation; the log gives 2 degrees 20 minutes. Wind South-East; course South 78 degrees West; distance 127 miles; latitude 19 degrees 24 minutes South; longitude 276 degrees 40 minutes per Log, 278 degrees 50 minutes per Observation.

Friday, 8th. Winds like yesterday; clear during the day and rainy at night. In the morning, I took observations of the Sun and Moon again, and the average result, adjusted to noon, showed 278 degrees 50 minutes West, which is 2 degrees 31 minutes West of yesterday’s observation; the log records 2 degrees 20 minutes. Wind from the Southeast; heading South 78 degrees West; distance traveled 127 miles; latitude 19 degrees 24 minutes South; longitude 276 degrees 40 minutes by log, 278 degrees 50 minutes by observation.

Saturday, 9th. Gentle Gales and fair weather in the morning. Saw a Ship on our Larboard Quarter, which hoisted Dutch Colours. Wind South-East; course South 74 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 127 miles; latitude 19 degrees 58 minutes South.

Saturday, 9th. Light winds and nice weather in the morning. Spotted a ship on our left side, which flew Dutch flags. Wind from the Southeast; course South 74 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 127 miles; latitude 19 degrees 58 minutes South.

Sunday, 10th. Fresh breezes and Hazey weather. Lost sight in the night of the Dutch Ship, she having out sail'd us. Wind South-East quarter; course South 77 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 136 miles; latitude 20 degrees 28 minutes South; longitude 281 degrees 12 minutes West.

Sunday, 10th. Fresh breezes and hazy weather. We lost sight of the Dutch ship during the night; it outpaced us. Wind from the southeast; course south 77 degrees 15 minutes west; distance 136 miles; latitude 20 degrees 28 minutes south; longitude 281 degrees 12 minutes west.

Monday, 11th. Winds and weather as Yesterday. Some hands constantly employ'd repairing Sails. Wind Ditto; course South 75 degrees West; distance 126 miles; latitude 20 degrees 58 minutes South; longitude 283 degrees 22 minutes West.

Monday, 11th. The wind and weather were the same as yesterday. Some crew members were continuously working on repairing the sails. Wind was the same; course was South 75 degrees West; distance traveled was 126 miles; latitude was 20 degrees 58 minutes South; longitude was 283 degrees 22 minutes West.

Tuesday, 12th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. At 7 a.m. died of the Flux, after a long and painful illness, Mr. John Satterly, Carpenter, a man much Esteem'd by me and every Gentleman on board. In his room I appoint George Nowell, one of the Carpenter's Crew, having only him and one more left. Wind South-South-East; course South 71 minutes West; distance 83 miles; latitude 21 degrees 25 minutes South; longitude 284 degrees 46 minutes West.

Tuesday, 12th. Light breezes and nice weather. At 7 a.m., Mr. John Satterly, a carpenter and a man well-respected by me and every gentleman on board, passed away from the flux after a long and painful illness. I appointed George Nowell, one of the carpenter's crew, to take his place, as he is the only one left besides one other. Wind from the South-South-East; course heading South 71 minutes West; distance 83 miles; latitude 21 degrees 25 minutes South; longitude 284 degrees 46 minutes West.

Wednesday, 13th. Weather as Yesterday. Employ'd Surveying the Carpenter's Stores and repairing Sails. Wind Ditto; course South 72 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 87 miles; latitude 21 degrees 51 minutes South; longitude 286 degrees 15 minutes West.

Wednesday, 13th. Weather same as yesterday. Spent the day checking the carpenter's supplies and fixing sails. Wind was the same; heading South 72 degrees 30 minutes West; distance covered 87 miles; latitude 21 degrees 51 minutes South; longitude 286 degrees 15 minutes West.

Thursday, 14th. Moderate breezes and Cloudy, with some Showers of Rain. Variation per Azimuth 4 degrees 10 minutes West. Died Alexander Lindsay, Seaman; this man was one of those we got at Batavia, and had been some time in India. Winds Ditto; course South 73 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 105 miles; latitude 22 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude 288 degrees 3 minutes West.

Thursday, 14th. There were moderate breezes and cloudy skies, with some rain showers. Variation per azimuth was 4 degrees 10 minutes west. Alexander Lindsay, a seaman, passed away; he was one of the crew we got in Batavia and had spent some time in India. Winds were the same; course was South 73 degrees 15 minutes West; distance covered was 105 miles; latitude was 22 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude was 288 degrees 3 minutes West.

Friday, 15th. Ditto Weather. Died of the Flux Daniel Preston, Marine. Wind South-East by East; course South 81 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 123 miles; latitude 22 degrees 40 minutes; longitude 290 degrees 15 minutes West.

Friday, 15th. Same Weather. Daniel Preston, Marine, died of the Flu. Wind from the South-East by East; course South 81 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 123 miles; latitude 22 degrees 40 minutes; longitude 290 degrees 15 minutes West.

Saturday, 16th. A Fresh Trade and Cloudy weather. Employ'd repairing Sails, rigging, etc. Wind Ditto; course South 84 degrees West; distance 115 miles; latitude 22 degrees 52 minutes South; longitude 292 degrees 20 minutes West.

Saturday, 16th. A new trade and cloudy weather. Spent the day fixing sails, rigging, etc. Wind the same; course South 84 degrees West; distance 115 miles; latitude 22 degrees 52 minutes South; longitude 292 degrees 20 minutes West.

Sunday, 17th. Fresh Gales, with some Showers of rain. Variation per Azimuth 10 degrees 20 minutes Westerly. Wind South-East by South; course South 79 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 157 miles; latitude 23 degrees 20 minutes South; longitude 295 8 minutes West.

Sunday, 17th. Fresh winds, with some rain showers. Variation by azimuth 10 degrees 20 minutes west. Wind from the southeast by south; course south 79 degrees 45 minutes west; distance 157 miles; latitude 23 degrees 20 minutes south; longitude 295 degrees 8 minutes west.

Monday, 18th. Fair and pleasant weather. Wind South-East by East; course South 75 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 148 miles; latitude 23 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 297 degrees 46 minutes West.

Monday, 18th. Nice and pleasant weather. Wind from South-East by East; heading South 75 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 148 miles; latitude 23 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 297 degrees 46 minutes West.

Tuesday, 19th. Ditto weather. Wind South-East by East and South; course South 77 degrees West; distance 130 miles; latitude 24 degrees 26 minutes South; longitude 300 degrees 5 minutes West.

Tuesday, 19th. Same weather. Wind from South-East by East and South; course South 77 degrees West; distance 130 miles; latitude 24 degrees 26 minutes South; longitude 300 degrees 5 minutes West.

Wednesday, 20th. Fresh Gales and clear weather. Variation per Azimuth 12 degrees 15 minutes West. This morning the Carpenter and his Mate set about repairing the Long boat, being the first day they have been able to work since we left Princes Island. Wind South; course South 75 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 127 miles; latitude 24 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 302 degrees 21 minutes West.

Wednesday, 20th. Fresh winds and clear skies. Variation by Azimuth 12 degrees 15 minutes West. This morning, the Carpenter and his Mate started repairing the Longboat, the first day they’ve been able to work since we left Princes Island. Wind coming from the South; course South 75 degrees 45 minutes West; distance covered 127 miles; latitude 24 degrees 57 minutes South; longitude 302 degrees 21 minutes West.

Thursday, 21st. First and middle parts fair weather; Latter Squally, attended with Showers of Rain. Between 2 and 3 o'Clock p.m. took several Observations of the Sun and Moon; the mean result of them gave 306 degrees 33 minutes West Longitude from Greenwich, which is 1 degree 55 minutes West of account, and corresponds very well with the last Observations, for at that time the Ship was 2 degrees 10 minutes West of account. In the Night died of the Flux Alexander Simpson, a very good Seaman. In the Morning punished Thomas Rossiter with 12 lashes for getting Drunk, grossly assaulting the Officer of the Watch, and beating some of the Sick. Wind South to East-South-East; course West by South; distance 126 miles; latitude 25 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude 304 degrees 39 minutes per Account, 306 degrees 34 minutes per Observation.

Thursday, 21st. The weather was nice in the first half of the day and pretty clear in the middle; later, it got windy with some rain showers. Between 2 and 3 p.m., I took several readings of the Sun and Moon; their average gave 306 degrees 33 minutes West Longitude from Greenwich, which is 1 degree 55 minutes West of the expected location, and matches up pretty well with the last readings, as the ship was 2 degrees 10 minutes West of the expected position at that time. During the night, Alexander Simpson, a very good seaman, passed away from dysentery. In the morning, I punished Thomas Rossiter with 12 lashes for getting drunk, seriously assaulting the Officer of the Watch, and hitting some of the sick crew. The wind was coming from the South to East-South-East; we were heading West by South; the distance traveled was 126 miles; our latitude was 25 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude was 304 degrees 39 minutes by account, 306 degrees 34 minutes by observation.

Friday, 22nd. Fresh Trade and fair weather. Nothing remarkable. Wind South-East by South; course South 70 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 133 miles; latitude 26 degrees 5 minutes South; longitude 306 degrees 59 minutes West, 308 degrees 54 minutes per Observation.

Friday, 22nd. New trade and good weather. Nothing noteworthy. Wind from the South-East by South; heading South 70 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 133 miles; latitude 26 degrees 5 minutes South; longitude 306 degrees 59 minutes West, 308 degrees 54 minutes by Observation.

Saturday, 23rd. Ditto Winds and weather. Variation per Evening Amplitude 17 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind Ditto; course South 64 degrees 14 minutes West; distance 124 miles; latitude 26 degrees 59 minutes; longitude 309 degrees 6 minutes West, 311 degrees 28 minutes per Observation.

Saturday, 23rd. Same winds and weather. Variation for the evening amplitude is 17 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind remains the same; course is South 64 degrees 14 minutes West; distance traveled is 124 miles; latitude is 26 degrees 59 minutes; longitude is 309 degrees 6 minutes West, 311 degrees 28 minutes per observation.

Sunday, 24th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. In the A.M. took the opportunity of a fine morning to stay the Main Mast, and set up the Topmast Rigging. Saw an Albatross. Wind Ditto; course South 66 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 117 miles; latitude 27 degrees 45 minutes South; longitude 311 degrees 7 minutes West, 313 degrees 41 minutes per Observation.

Sunday, 24th. Mild breezes and nice weather. In the morning, I took advantage of the lovely morning to secure the main mast and set up the topmast rigging. Spotted an albatross. Wind the same; course South 66 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 117 miles; latitude 27 degrees 45 minutes South; longitude 311 degrees 7 minutes West, 313 degrees 41 minutes based on observation.

Monday, 25th. Gentle Gales, and fair weather. Variation per Evening Azimuth 24 degrees 20 minutes West, and by the Morning Amplitude 24 degrees West Longitude; by Observation of the [circle around a dot, sun] and [crescent, moon] is 3 degrees to the Westwarn of the Log, which shews that the Ship has gain'd upon the Log 1 degree 5 minutes in 3 Days, in which time we have always found the Observ'd Latitude to the Southward of that given by the Log. These Joint Observations proves that there must be a current setting between the South and West. Wind East by South; course South 58 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 122 miles; latitude 28 degrees 49 minutes South; longitude 313 degrees 6 minutes West, 316 degrees 6 minutes per Observation.

Monday, 25th. Gentle winds and nice weather. Variation by evening azimuth is 24 degrees 20 minutes West, and by the morning amplitude is 24 degrees West longitude; by observing the ☀️ (sun) and 🌙 (moon), it is 3 degrees to the West of the log, which shows that the ship has gained 1 degree 5 minutes on the log in 3 days, during which we have consistently found the observed latitude to be south of what the log indicates. These joint observations prove that there must be a current moving between the south and west. Wind is East by South; course is South 58 degrees 30 minutes West; distance is 122 miles; latitude is 28 degrees 49 minutes South; longitude is 313 degrees 6 minutes West, 316 degrees 6 minutes by observation.

Tuesday, 26th. Fresh Gales. Variation by Azimuth in the Evening 26 degrees 10 minutes West. Wind South-East by East; course South 82 degrees West; distance 122 miles; latitude 29 degrees 6 minutes South; longitude 315 degrees 24 minutes West.

Tuesday, 26th. Strong winds. Variation by azimuth in the evening 26 degrees 10 minutes West. Wind South-East by East; course South 82 degrees West; distance 122 miles; latitude 29 degrees 6 minutes South; longitude 315 degrees 24 minutes West.

Wednesday, 27th. Ditto Gales and Cloudy. In the A.M. died of the Flux Henry Jeffs, Emanuel Parreyra, and Peter Morgan, Seamen; the last came Sick on board at Batavia, of which he never recover'd, and the other 2 had long been past all hopes of recovery, so that the death of these 3 men in one day did not in the least alarm us.* (* These were the last deaths directly attributable to the dysentery contracted at Batavia. Though always enjoying an unenviable reputation, Batavia seems to have had, this year, a more unhealthy season than usual. The Endeavour lost seven persons while at Batavia, and twenty-three after sailing up to this date.) On the contrary, we are in hopes that they will be the last that will fall a sacrifice to this fatal disorder, for such as are now ill of it are in a fair way of recovering. Wind East by South, East by North-North-East; course South 77 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 108 miles; latitude 29 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 317 degrees 25 minutes West.

Wednesday, 27th. Same strong winds and cloudy. In the morning, Henry Jeffs, Emanuel Parreyra, and Peter Morgan, seamen, died from dysentery. The last one came aboard sick in Batavia and never recovered, while the other two had long been beyond hope of recovery, so the deaths of these three men in one day didn’t really alarm us. (* These were the last deaths directly linked to the dysentery contracted in Batavia. Although Batavia has always had a bad reputation, it seems this year was even more unhealthy than usual. The Endeavour lost seven crew members while at Batavia and twenty-three after setting sail up to this date.) On the contrary, we hope these will be the last victims of this deadly disease, as those who are currently ill are recovering well. Wind East by South, East by North-North-East; course South 77 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 108 miles; latitude 29 degrees 30 minutes South; longitude 317 degrees 25 minutes West.

Thursday, 28th. Moderate breezes and fair weather until near 5 o'Clock in the A.M., when a heavy Squall from the South-West, attended with rain, took us all aback, and obliged us to put before the wind, the better to take in our Sails; but before this could be done the Foretopsail was split in several places. By 6 o'clock the Topsails and Mainsail were handed, and we brought too under the Foresail and Mizen; at 8 it fell more moderate, and we set the Mainsail, and brought another Foretopsail to the Yard; at Noon had strong Gales and Cloudy weather. Wind North-East by East, North, and South-West; course South 85 1/2 degrees West; distance 88 miles; latitude 29 degrees 37 minutes South; longitude 319 degrees 5 minutes West.

Thursday, 28th. There were moderate breezes and clear weather until about 5 AM, when a heavy squall hit us from the southwest, bringing rain and catching us off guard. We had to face the wind to better manage our sails, but before we could do that, the foretopsail tore in several places. By 6 o'clock, we had taken down the topsails and mainsail, and we stabilized under the foresail and mizzen. At 8, the winds calmed down a bit, so we set the mainsail and raised another foretopsail. By noon, we experienced strong gales and cloudy weather. The wind was coming from the northeast by east, north, and southwest; our course was south 85.5 degrees west; we covered a distance of 88 miles; our latitude was 29 degrees 37 minutes south; and our longitude was 319 degrees 5 minutes west.

[March 1771.]

[March 1771.]

Friday, March 1st. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. Found the Bitts which secures the foot of the Bowsprit, loose; this obliged us to put before the wind until they were secured in the best manner our situation would admit; this done, we hauld our wind again to the Westward under the Courses and close Reef'd Topsails. Wind South-West to South by West; course South 86 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 71 miles; latitude 29 degrees 41 minutes South; longitude 320 degrees 26 minutes West.

Friday, March 1st. Fresh winds and cloudy. We found the fasteners holding the base of the bowsprit loose, which forced us to sail with the wind until we could secure them as best as we could in our situation. Once that was done, we turned back into the wind heading west under the courses and reefed topsails. The wind was coming from the southwest to south by west; our course was South 86 degrees 45 minutes West; we covered a distance of 71 miles; our latitude was 29 degrees 41 minutes South; and our longitude was 320 degrees 26 minutes West.

Saturday, 2nd. First part fresh Gales and Cloudy; remainder little wind, with some few showers of rain; a Sea from the South-West. Wind Southerly; course South 60 degrees West; distance 80 miles; latitude 30 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude 321 degrees 46 minutes West.

Saturday, 2nd. The first part had strong winds and cloudy skies; the rest of the day had light winds, with a few rain showers; there was a sea coming from the South-West. The wind was from the South; course South 60 degrees West; distance 80 miles; latitude 30 degrees 21 minutes South; longitude 321 degrees 46 minutes West.

Sunday, 3rd. First part little wind; remainder Gentle gales and clear weather, and the Sea pretty smooth. Wind North-East; course South 58 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 71 miles; latitude 31 degrees 1 minute South; longitude 323 degrees 2 minutes West.

Sunday, 3rd. In the beginning, there was a light breeze; for the rest of the day, gentle winds and clear skies, with the sea fairly calm. The wind was coming from the North-East; we were headed South 58 degrees 15 minutes West; traveled 71 miles; latitude 31 degrees 1 minute South; longitude 323 degrees 2 minutes West.

Monday, 4th. In the P.M. had a moderate breeze, which continued until 5 o'clock in the A.M., when it fell calm, and soon after a breeze sprung up at South-West. In the Evening, and most part of the Night, the weather was dark and cloudy, with much Lightning to the Westward. Variation 25 degrees 35 minutes West. Winds North-East to South-West; course South 67 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 87 miles; latitude 31 degrees 54 minutes South; longitude 324 degrees 36 minutes West.

Monday, 4th. In the afternoon, there was a moderate breeze that lasted until 5 o'clock in the morning, when it went calm, and soon after, a breeze picked up from the South-West. In the evening, and for most of the night, the weather was dark and cloudy, with a lot of lightning to the west. Variation 25 degrees 35 minutes West. Winds from North-East to South-West; course South 67 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 87 miles; latitude 31 degrees 54 minutes South; longitude 324 degrees 36 minutes West.

[Off Coast of Natal.]

[Off the Coast of Natal.]

Tuesday, 5th. Fresh Gales from the South-South-West, with squally, rainy weather, with which we stood to the Westward. In the evening some people thought they saw the appearance of land to the Northward; but this appear'd so improbable that I, who was not on deck at this time, was not acquainted with it until dark, when I order'd them to sound, but found no ground with 80 fathoms, upon which we concluded that no land was near. But daylight in the Morning proved this to be a mistake by shewing us the land at the distance of about 2 Leagues off. We had now the wind at South-East, blowing fresh right upon the land. When we made the land we were standing to the Westward; but, thinking the other the best tack to get off on, we wore, and hauld off to the Eastward, and by Noon had got an Offing of about 4 Leagues, the land at this time extending from North-East by North to West-South-West. This part of the Coast of Africa which we fell in with lies in about the Latitude of 32 degrees 0 minutes South, and Longitude 331 degrees 29 minutes West, and near to what is called in the Charts Point Nattall.* (* Natal.) It was a steep, craggy point, very much broke, and looked as if the high, craggy rocks were Islands. To the North-East of this point the land in General appear'd to rise, sloping from the Sea to a Moderate height; the Shore, alternately Rocks and Sands. About 2 Leagues to the North-East of the Point appear'd to be the mouth of a River, which probably may be that of St. Johns. At this time the weather was very hazey, so that we had but a very imperfect view of the land, which did not appear to great advantage. Wind South-South-West to South-East; course per Log North 31 degrees West; distance 32 miles; latitude 31 degrees 5 minutes South per Observation, 31 degrees 7 minutes per Reckoning; longitude 331 degrees 19 minutes per Observation, 324 degrees 56 minutes per Reckoning.

Tuesday, 5th. Fresh gales from the South-South-West, with squally, rainy weather, which we sailed into heading West. In the evening, some crew members thought they saw land to the North; however, this seemed so unlikely that I, not being on deck at the time, didn't learn about it until dark. When I ordered a depth sound, we found no bottom at 80 fathoms, leading us to conclude that land was not nearby. However, by daylight in the morning, we realized this was a mistake as land appeared about 2 leagues away. The wind was now blowing fresh from the South-East, right towards the land. When we made landfall, we were heading West, but thinking a different tack might be better to move away, we turned and sailed East. By noon, we had gained about 4 leagues off the coast, which extended from North-East by North to West-South-West. This part of the African coast we encountered is around 32 degrees 0 minutes South latitude and 331 degrees 29 minutes West longitude, near a point marked as Point Nattall in the charts. It was a steep, rocky point, very jagged, appearing almost as though the high, rugged rocks were islands. To the North-East of this point, the land generally seemed to rise, sloping gently from the sea to a moderate height, with the shore alternating between rocks and sand. About 2 leagues to the North-East of the point, there seemed to be the mouth of a river, which might be the St. Johns River. At this time, the weather was very hazy, so we had a rather unclear view of the land, which did not look particularly promising. Wind from South-South-West to South-East; course per log North 31 degrees West; distance 32 miles; latitude 31 degrees 5 minutes South by observation, 31 degrees 7 minutes by reckoning; longitude 331 degrees 19 minutes by observation, 324 degrees 56 minutes by reckoning.

Wednesday, 6th. Moderate Gales, with hazey, rainy weather. Stood to the Eastward all the day, having the land in sight, which at 4 p.m. extended from North-East by North to South-West by West, distant 5 Leagues. At 6 in the Morning we could only see it at West distant 7 or 8 Leagues. At Noon found the Ship by Observation 90 Miles to the Southward of account. Thus far the current has carried us to the South since the last observation, which was only 2 days ago; but it is plain, from the position of the Coast, that we have been carried full as far to the West also, notwithstanding we have been standing all the time to the East-North-East* (* The ship was now in the Agulhas Current.) Wind Southerly; course South 54 degrees East; distance 37 miles; latitude 32 degrees 4 minutes South; 330 degrees 44 minutes per Observation, 323 degrees 36 minutes per Reckoning.

Wednesday, 6th. Moderate winds with hazy, rainy weather. We headed east all day, having the land in sight, which at 4 p.m. stretched from Northeast by North to Southwest by West, about 5 leagues away. At 6 in the morning, we could only see it to the west, about 7 or 8 leagues distant. At noon, we determined that the ship was 90 miles south of where we expected. The current has pushed us south since the last observation just 2 days ago; however, it's clear from the coastline's position that we've also been pushed quite a bit to the west, even though we've been heading East-Northeast the whole time (* The ship was now in the Agulhas Current.) Wind from the south; course South 54 degrees East; distance 37 miles; latitude 32 degrees 4 minutes South; 330 degrees 44 minutes by observation, 323 degrees 36 minutes by reckoning.

Thursday, 7th. Cloudy, hazey weather; winds varying between the South-West by South and South-East by South; a light breeze at 1 p.m. Tack'd, and stood to the Westward, land at North, distant about 8 Leagues. At 6 saw it extending from North by West to West by North, distant 5 or 6 Leagues; at 8 tack'd, and stood to the Eastward till 12; then again to the Westward, standing 4 hours on one tack, and 4 on the other. At Noon very cloudy; had no observation; saw the land extending from North by West to West by North. Wind Southerly; course South 156 degrees 5 minutes West; distance 72 miles; latitude 32 degrees 54 minutes South; longitude 331 degrees 56 minutes West per Observation, 323 degrees 54 per Reckoning.

Thursday, 7th. It was cloudy and hazy; winds were shifting between South-West by South and South-East by South; there was a light breeze at 1 p.m. We tacked and headed westward, with land to the north about 8 leagues away. At 6 p.m., we saw it stretching from North by West to West by North, about 5 or 6 leagues distant; at 8 p.m., we tacked and headed east until midnight; then again to the west, sailing 4 hours on one tack and 4 hours on the other. At noon, it was very cloudy, and we had no observation; we saw the land extending from North by West to West by North. The wind was from the south; our course was South 156 degrees 5 minutes West; the distance covered was 72 miles; the latitude was 32 degrees 54 minutes South; the longitude was 331 degrees 56 minutes West by observation, 323 degrees 54 by reckoning.

Friday, 8th. In the P.M. stood to the Westward, with the wind at South by West until 4 o'clock; then again to the Eastward, having the land in sight, extending from North-North-East to West by North, distant 8 Leagues. At 12 the wind veer'd to the Eastward, and before Noon blow'd a fresh breeze, with which we steer'd South-West. At 7, the land extending from North-North-West to East-North-East, distant 10 or 12 Leagues, found the Variation by the Amplitude to be 28 degrees 30 minutes West, and by an Azimuth 28 degrees 8 minutes West. At Noon Latitude observ'd 34 degrees 18 minutes, which is 93 miles to the Southward of that given by the Log, or dead reckoning since the last observation. Wind Easterly; course South 39 1/2 degrees West; distance 109 miles; latitude 34 degrees 18 minutes South; longitude 333 degrees 19 minutes West per Observation, 324 degrees 23 minutes per Reckoning.

Friday, 8th. In the afternoon, we headed west with the wind coming from the south-southwest until 4 o'clock. Then we turned back east, with land in sight, stretching from north-northeast to west by north, about 8 leagues away. At noon, the wind shifted to the east, and before noon, it picked up into a fresh breeze, allowing us to steer southwest. By 7, the land was visible from north-northwest to east-northeast, about 10 to 12 leagues away. I found the variation by amplitude to be 28 degrees 30 minutes west and by azimuth 28 degrees 8 minutes west. At noon, the observed latitude was 34 degrees 18 minutes, which is 93 miles south of what the log indicated based on dead reckoning since the last observation. The wind was coming from the east; we were on a course of south 39 1/2 degrees west; distance traveled was 109 miles; latitude was 34 degrees 18 minutes south; longitude by observation was 333 degrees 19 minutes west and by reckoning was 324 degrees 23 minutes.

Saturday, 9th. A steady, fresh Gale, and settled weather. At 4 in the P.M. had high land in sight, bearing North-East by North. At Noon had little wind and clear weather; the observed Latitude 46 miles to the Southward of the Log, which is conformable to what has hapned the 4 preceeding days; and by Observation made of the Sun and Moon this morning found that the Ship had gain'd 7 degrees 4 minutes West of the Log since the last observation, 13 days ago. Wind Ditto; course South 65 degrees West; distance 210 miles; latitude 35 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude 337 degrees 6 minutes West per Observation, 326 degrees 53 minutes per Reckoning.

Saturday, 9th. A steady, fresh gale and clear weather. At 4 PM, we saw high land to the North-East by North. At noon, there was little wind and clear skies; the observed latitude was 46 miles south of the log, which matches what happened over the last four days. From an observation of the sun and moon this morning, I found that the ship had gained 7 degrees 4 minutes west of the log since the last observation 13 days ago. Wind was the same; course was South 65 degrees West; distance was 210 miles; latitude was 35 degrees 44 minutes South; longitude was 337 degrees 6 minutes West by observation, 326 degrees 53 minutes by reckoning.

Sunday, 10th. In the P.M. had a light breeze at North-East until 4 o'clock, when it fell calm, and continued so until 11, at which time a breeze sprung up at West-North-West, with which we stood to the Northward. In the Morning found the Variation to be 22 degrees 46 minutes; at Noon the observ'd Latitude was 14 Miles to the Northward of the Log, which shews that the current must have shifted. Wind North-East Westerly; course North 17 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 55 miles; latitude 34 degrees 52 minutes South; longitude 337 degrees 25 minutes West per Observation, 327 degrees 12 minutes per Reckoning.

Sunday, 10th. In the afternoon, we had a light breeze from the Northeast until 4 o'clock, when it went calm and stayed that way until 11, when a breeze picked up from the West-Northwest, and we headed North. In the morning, the variation was 22 degrees 46 minutes; at noon, the observed latitude was 14 miles North of the log, indicating that the current must have changed. Wind from the Northeast; course North 17 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 55 miles; latitude 34 degrees 52 minutes South; longitude 337 degrees 25 minutes West by observation, 327 degrees 12 minutes by reckoning.

Monday, 11th. First part light Airs at West; the remainder had a fresh gale at South-East, with which we steer'd West and West-North-West, in order to make the Land, which was seen from the Deck at 10 A.M. At Noon it extended from North-East to North-West, distant 5 Leagues; the middle appear'd high and mountainous, and the two Extremes low. Took several Observations of the Sun and Moon, which gave the Longitude, reduced to Noon, as per Column. Wind Ditto South-East; course North 85 degrees West; distance 79 miles; latitude 34 degrees 45 minutes South; longitude 338 degrees 48 minutes West per Observation, 328 degrees 35 minutes per Reckoning.

Monday, 11th. The first part of the day had light breezes from the West; for the rest, we faced a fresh gale from the South-East, which allowed us to head West and West-North-West to reach the land that was visible from the deck at 10 A.M. By noon, the land stretched from North-East to North-West, about 5 leagues away; the middle of it looked high and mountainous, while the two ends were low. I took several observations of the Sun and Moon, which helped determine the Longitude, adjusted to noon, as shown in the Table. Wind was also from the South-East; our course was North 85 degrees West; we covered 79 miles; latitude was 34 degrees 45 minutes South; longitude was 338 degrees 48 minutes West by observation, and 328 degrees 35 minutes by reckoning.

[Off Cape Agulhas.]

[Off Cape Agulhas.]

Tuesday, 12th. In the P.M. had the wind at South-East and East, with which we steer'd along shore West and West-South-West. At 6 Cape Laguillas* (* L'Agulhas.) bore West, distance 3 Leagues. At 8, the wind being then at South, we tack'd and stood off, being about 2 Leagues from the Cape, which bore about West-North-West. In this Situation had 33 fathoms water; the Wind continued between South-West and South all night, in times very Squally, with rain. At 2 a.m. tacked to the Westward until near 8, when we again stood off Cape Laguillas, North-West, distance 2 or 3 Leagues. At 9 the weather clear'd up, and the wind fix'd at South by West. We tack'd, and stood to the Westward. At Noon Cape Laguillas bore North-East by North, distant 4 Leagues. The land of this Cape is very low and sandy next the Sea; inland it is of a moderate height. Latitude 34 degrees 50 minutes South, Longitude 339 degrees 23 minutes West, or 20 degrees 37 minutes East, deduced from Yesterday's Observations. Wind East-South-East Southerly; course South 69 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 37 miles; Latitude 34 degrees 58 minutes South; longitude 339 degrees 30 minutes per Observation, 329 degrees 17 minutes per Reckoning.

Tuesday, 12th. In the afternoon, we had the wind coming from the Southeast and East, which we used to sail along the shore to the West and West-Southwest. At 6, Cape L'Agulhas was to the West, about 3 leagues away. At 8, with the wind coming from the South, we tacked and headed out, being roughly 2 leagues from the Cape, which was about West-Northwest from us. In this situation, we had 33 fathoms of water; the wind blew between Southwest and South all night, at times very gusty, with rain. At 2 a.m., we tacked to the West until nearly 8, when we again headed off Cape L'Agulhas to the Northwest, about 2 or 3 leagues away. At 9, the weather cleared up, and the wind settled at South by West. We tacked and moved to the West. At noon, Cape L'Agulhas was to the Northeast by North, 4 leagues away. The land at this Cape is very low and sandy by the sea; inland, it gains moderate height. Latitude 34 degrees 50 minutes South, Longitude 339 degrees 23 minutes West, or 20 degrees 37 minutes East, derived from yesterday's observations. Wind from the East-Southeast; course South 69 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 37 miles; Latitude 34 degrees 58 minutes South; Longitude 339 degrees 30 minutes by observation, 329 degrees 17 minutes by reckoning.

Wednesday, 13th. In the P.M., having the wind at South, we steer'd along shore West by South 1/2 South until 3 o'clock, when, finding this course carried us off from the land, we steer'd West by North; at 6 o'clock Cape Laguillas, or the high land over it, bore East by North 12 Leagues distance, and the westermost land in sight North-West 1/2 West. We continued a West by North course, with the wind at South-East until day light in the Morning, when we haul'd in North-West and North-West by North; at 8 the Cape of Good Hope North-West by North, and at 10 we were abreast of it, and distance off about 1 League or little more. We passed close without a rock, on which the Sea broke very high; it lies about a League right out to Sea from the Cape. After passing the Cape we kept along shore at the distance of about 1 League off, having a fresh Gale at South-East; at noon the Cape bore South-East, distance 4 Leagues. Latitude observed 34 degrees 15 minutes South, Longitude in, by our reckoning, corrected by the last observation, 341 degrees 7 minutes West, or 18 degrees 53 minutes East from Greenwich, by which the Cape lies in 34 degrees 25 minutes South Latitude, and 19 degrees 1 minute East Longitude from Greenwich, which nearly agrees with the observations made at the Cape Town by Messrs. Mason and Dixon in 1761; a proof that our observations have been well made, and that as such they may always be depended upon to a surprizing degree of accuracey. If we had had no such guide we should have found an error of 10 degrees 13 minutes of Longitude, or perhaps more to the East, such an effect the current must have had upon the ship.

Wednesday, 13th. In the afternoon, with the wind coming from the south, we sailed along the shore west by south half south until 3 o'clock. When we realized this direction was taking us away from the land, we changed course to west by north. At 6 o'clock, Cape Laguillas, or the high land above it, was 12 leagues away, bearing east by north, and the furthest western land we could see was northwest half west. We continued on a west by north course, with the wind from the southeast until daylight the next morning. Then we steered northwest and northwest by north. By 8, the Cape of Good Hope was at northwest by north, and at 10, we were even with it, about 1 league or a little more off. We passed just outside a rock where the sea was breaking very high; it lies about a league out to sea from the Cape. After passing the Cape, we sailed along the shore about 1 league out, with a fresh gale from the southeast. At noon, the Cape was southeast, 4 leagues away. We observed the latitude at 34 degrees 15 minutes south, and our reckoning for longitude, corrected by the last observation, was 341 degrees 7 minutes west, or 18 degrees 53 minutes east from Greenwich. The Cape lies at 34 degrees 25 minutes south latitude and 19 degrees 1 minute east longitude from Greenwich, which aligns closely with the observations made at Cape Town by Messrs. Mason and Dixon in 1761. This confirms that our observations have been accurate and can always be relied upon with surprising accuracy. Without such guidance, we would have discovered a discrepancy of 10 degrees 13 minutes in longitude, or even more to the east, likely due to the effects of the current on the ship.

Thursday, 14th. Winds at South-East, a fresh Gale, but as we approached the Lyons Tail or West point, Table Bay, we had flurries of wind from all Points of the Compass; this was occasioned by the high land, for clear of it the wind was still at South-East, and bbow'd so strong out of the Bay that we could not work the Ship in; we were therefore obliged to Anchor a good way without all the Ships at Anchor in the Road, in the whole 16 Sail, viz., 8 Dutch, 3 Danes, 4 French, a Frigate, and 3 Store Ships, and one English East Indiamen, who saluted us with 11 Guns; we returned 9. The Gale continued, which obliged us to lay fast all the morning.

Thursday, 14th. The winds were coming from the South-East, a strong gale, but as we got closer to the Lyons Tail or the West point of Table Bay, we experienced gusts of wind from all directions. This was caused by the high land, because once we were clear of it, the wind was steady from the South-East and blew so hard out of the Bay that we couldn't maneuver the ship in. We had to anchor quite a distance from all the ships already anchored in the road, a total of 16 vessels, including 8 Dutch, 3 Danes, 4 French, a frigate, 3 store ships, and one English East Indiaman, which greeted us with 11 guns; we responded with 9. The gale persisted, forcing us to stay put all morning.

Friday, 15th. Strong Gales at South-East all the Afternoon and most part of the Night, though in the Evening it fell a little moderate, which gave the Indiaman's Boat an opportunity to come on board us, with a Complement of a Basket of Fruit, etc,; she was the Admiral Pocock, Captain Riddell, homeward bound from Bombay. In the morning we got under sail, and stood into the Road, having variable light airs mostly from the Sea. A Dutch boat from the Shore came on board, in which were the Master Attendant and some other Gentlemen; the former directed us to a proper birth, where about 10 o'clock we anchored in 7 fathoms water, a Ouzey bottom; the Lyon Tail, or West point of the Bay, bore West-North-West, and the Castle South-West, distance 1 1/2 miles. I now sent a Petty Officer on shore to know if they would return our Salute, but before he return'd we Saluted, which was immediately return'd with the same number of Guns; after this I waited myself upon the Governour, who was pleased to tell me that I should have everything I wanted that the place afforded. My first care was to provide a proper place ashore for the reception of the Sick, for which purpose I order'd the Surgeon to look out for a House where they could be lodged and dieted. This he soon found, and agreed with the people of the house for 2 shillings a day per man; which I found was the customary Price and method of proceeding. I afterwards gave the Surgeon an order to superintend the whole.

Friday, the 15th. Strong winds from the southeast all afternoon and most of the night, although it calmed down a bit in the evening, giving the Indiaman's boat a chance to come aboard with a basket of fruit and other supplies; it was the Admiral Pocock, Captain Riddell, returning home from Bombay. In the morning, we set sail and made our way into the harbor, with light winds mostly coming from the sea. A Dutch boat from the shore came alongside, carrying the Master Attendant and a few other gentlemen; he directed us to a suitable berth, where we anchored around 10 o'clock in 7 fathoms of water with a muddy bottom; the Lyon Tail, or west point of the bay, was to the west-northwest, and the castle was southwest, about 1.5 miles away. I sent a petty officer ashore to see if they would return our salute, but before he returned, we fired our guns, which was immediately answered with the same number of shots. After that, I went to visit the Governor, who kindly assured me that I would have everything I needed from the area. My first concern was to find a proper place on land to care for the sick, so I instructed the surgeon to look for a house where they could be accommodated and fed. He soon found one and reached an agreement with the owners for 2 shillings a day per man; I discovered that this was the usual price and procedure. I later gave the surgeon the authority to oversee everything.

[Remarks on Dysentery.]

[Comments on Dysentery.]

Few remarks have hapned since we left Java Head that can be of much use to the Navigator, or any other Person, into whose hand this Journal may fall; such, however, as have occur'd I shall now insert. After our leaving Java head we were 11 days before we got the General South-East Trade wind, in which time we did not advance above 5 degrees to the South and 3 degrees to the West, having all the time Variable light Airs of Wind, interrupted by frequent Calms, the weather all the time hot and sultry, and the Air unwholesome, occasioned most probably by the Vast Vapours brought into these Latitudes by the Easterly Trade wind and Westerly Monsoons, both of which blow at this time of the Year in this Sea. The Easterly winds prevail as far as 12 or 10 degrees South, and the Westerly winds as far as 6 or 8 degrees; between them the winds are Variable, and I believe always more or less unwholesome, but to us it was remarkable from the Fatal Consequences that attended it, for whatever might be the cause of First bringing on the Flux among our people, this unwholesome Air had a Great share in it, and increased it to that degree that a Man was no sooner taken with it than he look'd upon himself as Dead. Such was the Despondency that reigned among the Sick at this time, nor could it be by any Means prevented, when every Man saw that Medicine, however skillfully Administered, had not the least effect. I shall mention what Effect only the immaginary approach of this disorder had upon one man. He had long tended upon the Sick, and injoyed a tolerable good State of Health; one morning, coming upon Deck, he found himself a little griped, and immediately began to stamp with his feet, and exclaim, "I have got the Gripes, I have got the Gripes; I shall die, I shall die!" In this manner he continued until he threw himself into a fit, and was carried off the Deck, in a manner, Dead; however he soon recover'd, and did very well.

Few events have occurred since we left Java Head that would be useful to the Navigator or anyone else who might read this Journal; nonetheless, I will now include those that did happen. After leaving Java Head, we spent 11 days trying to catch the General South-East Trade wind, during which we only managed to move about 5 degrees south and 3 degrees west. The entire time, we experienced variable light winds, frequently interrupted by calm spells, with hot and sultry weather that made the air unhealthy. This was probably due to the vast vapors brought into these latitudes by the Easterly Trade winds and Westerly Monsoons, which both blow during this time of year in this sea. The Easterly winds dominate up to 12 or 10 degrees south, while the Westerly winds extend to about 6 or 8 degrees; in between, the winds are variable and, I believe, consistently unhealthy. However, to us, it was particularly notable because of the fatal consequences that followed. Whatever initially caused the flux among our crew, the unhealthy air contributed significantly, worsening the situation to the point where a man who was struck down by it felt as if he were dead. Despondency spread among the sick at that time, and nothing could prevent it, as every man saw that medicine, no matter how skillfully administered, had no effect. I’ll mention the impact this imaginary approach of the disorder had on one particular man. He had been caring for the sick and was in generally good health, but one morning, when he came on deck, he felt a bit of discomfort and immediately began to stomp his feet, exclaiming, “I’ve got the Gripes, I’ve got the Gripes; I’m going to die, I’m going to die!” He continued in this manner until he threw himself into a fit and was carried off the deck, seemingly dead; however, he soon recovered and was fine.

We had no sooner got into the South-East Trade wind than we felt its happy Effect, tho' we lost several men after, but they were such as were brought so low and weak that there were hardly a possibility of there recovery; and yet some of them linger'd out in a State of Suspence a month after, who, in all Probability, would not have lived 24 Hours before this Change hapned. Those that were not so far gone remained in the same state for some time, and at last began to recover; some few, however, were seized with the disorder after we got into the Trade wind, but they had it but slightly, and soon got over it. It is worth remarking, that of all those who had it in its last stage only one man lived, who is now in a fair way of recovering; and I think Mr. Banks was the only one that was cured at the first Attack'd that had it to a great degree, or indeed at all, before we got into the South-East Trade, for it was before that time that his Cure was happily effected.

As soon as we got into the South-East Trade wind, we felt its positive effects, though we lost several men afterward. They were already in such poor condition that there was hardly any chance of their recovery. Yet, some of them lingered in a state of uncertainty for a month afterward, even though they likely wouldn’t have lived for 24 hours before this change happened. Those who weren't as far gone remained the same for a while but eventually began to recover; a few did fall ill after we entered the Trade wind, but their cases were mild, and they quickly got better. It's worth noting that of all those who were at the last stage of illness, only one man survived and is now on the path to recovery; I believe Mr. Banks was the only one who was cured after having a severe case before we got into the South-East Trade, as his treatment was successfully completed before that time.

It is to be wished, for the good of all Seamen, and mankind in general, that some preventative was found out against this disease, and put in practice in Climates where it is common, for it is impossible to Victual and water a Ship in those Climates but what some one article or another, according to different Peoples opinions, must have been the means of bringing on the Flux. We were inclinable to lay it to the water we took in at Princes Island, and the Turtle we got their, on which we lived several days; but there seems to be no reason for this when we consider that all the Ships from Batavia this Year suffer'd by the same disorder as much as we have done, and many of them arrived at this place in a far worse State; and yet not one of the Ships took any water in at Princes Island. The same may be said of the Harcourt Indiaman, Captain Paul, who sail'd from Batavia soon after our arrival, directly for the Coast of Sumatra; we afterwards heard that she, in a very short time, lost by Sickness above 20 men; indeed, this seem to have been a year of General Sickness over most parts of India, the Ships from Bengal and Madrass bring Melancholly Accounts of the Havock made there by the united force of Sickness and famine.

It’s hoped, for the benefit of all sailors and humanity in general, that some preventive measure is discovered against this disease and implemented in regions where it is common. It’s impossible to supply food and water to a ship in those areas without someone claiming that one thing or another, based on different people's opinions, must have caused the illness. We were inclined to blame the water we collected at Princes Island and the turtle we ate there for our sickness, which lasted several days. However, this doesn’t seem justified when we consider that every ship from Batavia this year experienced the same problem as we did, with many arriving at this location in much worse condition, even though none of them took on water at Princes Island. The same applies to the Harcourt Indiaman, Captain Paul, who set sail from Batavia shortly after we arrived, heading straight for the coast of Sumatra. We later heard that she quickly lost over 20 men to illness. In fact, this seems to have been a year of widespread sickness across most parts of India, with ships from Bengal and Madras bringing grim reports of the devastation caused by the combined forces of disease and famine.

Some few days after we left Java we saw, for 3 or 4 evenings succeeding one another, boobies fly about the ship. Now, as these birds are known to roost every night on land they seem'd to indicate that some Island was in our neighbourhood; probably it might be the Island Selam, which Island I find differently laid down in different Charts, both in Name and Situation.

A few days after we left Java, we noticed boobies flying around the ship for three or four evenings in a row. Since these birds are known to roost on land each night, it seemed like they were signaling that some island was nearby; it could be the Island Selam, which I see is represented differently in various charts, both in name and location.

The variation of the Compass off the West Coast of Java is about 3 degrees West, which Variation continues, without any sencible difference in the Common Track of Ships, to the Longitude of 288 degrees West, Latitude 22 degrees 0 minutes South. After this it begins to increase apace, in so much that in the Longitude of 295 degrees, Latitude 23 degrees, the Variation was 10 degrees 20 minutes West; in 7 degrees more of Longitude and one of Latitude it increased 2 degrees; in the same space farther to the West it increased 5 degrees; in the Latitude of 28 degrees and Longitude 314 degrees it was 24 degrees 20 minutes; in the Latitude 29 degrees and Longitude 317 degrees it was 26 degrees 10 minutes, and continued to be much the same for the space of 10 degrees farther to the West; but in the Latitude of 34 degrees, Longitude 333 degrees we observed it twice to be 28 1/4 degrees West; but this was the greatest Variation we observed, for in the Latitude of 35 1/2 degrees, Longitude 337 degrees, it was 24 degrees, and continued decreasing, so that of Cape Laguillas it was 22 degrees 30 minutes and in Table Bay it was 20 degrees 30 minutes West.

The compass variation off the West Coast of Java is about 3 degrees West, and this variation continues, without any noticeable difference in the common shipping route, to a longitude of 288 degrees West, latitude 22 degrees 0 minutes South. After this point, it starts to increase rapidly—by the time you reach longitude 295 degrees, latitude 23 degrees, the variation was 10 degrees 20 minutes West; in another 7 degrees of longitude and 1 degree of latitude, it increased by 2 degrees; further west, it increased by 5 degrees. At latitude 28 degrees and longitude 314 degrees, it was 24 degrees 20 minutes; at latitude 29 degrees and longitude 317 degrees, it was 26 degrees 10 minutes, and it stayed about the same for another 10 degrees west. However, at latitude 34 degrees and longitude 333 degrees, we recorded it as 28 1/4 degrees West, which was the highest variation we observed. At latitude 35 1/2 degrees, longitude 337 degrees, it was 24 degrees and continued to decrease, so that off Cape Laguillas it was 22 degrees 30 minutes, and in Table Bay it was 20 degrees 30 minutes West.

From what I have observed of the Current it doth not appear that they are at all considerable until you draw near the Meridian of Madagascar, for after we had made 52 degrees of Longitude from Java head we found, by observation, our Error in Longitude was only 2 degrees, and it was the same when we had made only 19 degrees. This Error might be owing partly to a Current setting to the Westward, or, what I thought most likely, that we did not make sufficient allowance for the set of the Sea before when we run, and, lastly, the assum'd Longitude of Java head might be wrong. If any Error lays there it Arises from the imperfection of the Charts I made use of in reducing the Longitude from Batavia to the above mentioned Head, for it cannot be doubted but the Longitude of Batavia is well Determined. After we had passed the Longitude of 307 degrees we began to find the Effects of the Westerly Currents, for in 3 days our Error in Longitude was 1 degree 5 minutes; its Velocity kept increasing as we got to the Westward, in so much that for 5 days successively, after we had made the land, we were drove to the South-West or South-West by West by the Currents not less than 20 Leagues a day; and this continued until we were within 60 or 70 Leagues of the Cape, where we found the Current to set sometimes one way and sometimes another, but mostly to the Westward.

From what I've seen of the current, it doesn’t seem significant until you get close to the meridian of Madagascar. After we traveled 52 degrees of longitude from Java Head, we found, through observation, that our error in longitude was only 2 degrees, and it was the same when we had covered just 19 degrees. This error could be partly due to a current flowing westward, or, what I think is more likely, that we didn’t account enough for the flow of the sea when we were sailing. Finally, the assumed longitude of Java Head could be incorrect. If there's any error, it arises from the imperfections in the charts I used to convert the longitude from Batavia to the mentioned head, as there’s no doubt that the longitude of Batavia is well determined. After we passed 307 degrees longitude, we started to feel the effects of the westerly currents; within three days, our error in longitude was 1 degree 5 minutes. The speed of the current kept increasing as we headed west, so that for five consecutive days after we sighted land, we were pushed southwest or southwest by west by the currents, traveling no less than 20 leagues a day. This continued until we were within 60 or 70 leagues of the Cape, where we found the current sometimes flowing one way and sometimes another, but mostly to the west.

After the Boobies above mentioned left us we saw no more birds till we got nearly abreast of Madagascar, where, in the Latitude of 27 3/4 degrees, we saw an Albatross. After that time we saw more of these birds every day, and in greater numbers, together with several other sorts; one sort about as big as a Duck, of a very Dark brown Colour, with a yellowish bill. The number of these birds increased upon us as we approached the Shore. As soon as we got into Soundings we saw Gannets, which we continued to see as long as we were on the Bank, which stretches off Laguillas 40 Leagues, and Extends along shore to the Eastward from Cape False, according to some charts, 160 Leagues; the Extent of this Bank is not well known, however, it is useful in directing Shipping when to haul in to make the land.

After the previously mentioned Boobies left us, we didn’t see any more birds until we got close to Madagascar, where, at a latitude of 27 3/4 degrees, we spotted an Albatross. From that point on, we started seeing more of these birds every day, and in greater numbers, along with several other types; one variety was about the size of a Duck, very dark brown in color, with a yellowish bill. The number of these birds increased as we approached the shore. As soon as we reached the soundings, we saw Gannets, which we continued to spot as long as we were on the Bank that stretches off Laguillas for 40 leagues and extends along the shore eastward from Cape False for about 160 leagues according to some charts; however, the exact extent of this Bank is not well known, but it is helpful for guiding ships on when to head in towards the land.

[At Anchor. Table Bay.]

[At Anchor. Table Bay.]

Saturday, 16th. Variable light Airs all this day. Moor'd the Ship and Struck Yards and Topmast, and in the morning got all the Sick (28) ashore to Quarters provided for them, and got off fresh meat and Greens for the People on board.

Saturday, 16th. There were light, shifting breezes all day. We moored the ship and lowered the yards and topmast. In the morning, we got all the sick (28) ashore to the quarters arranged for them and brought fresh meat and greens for the crew on board.

Sunday, 17th. In the A.M. sail'd for England the Admiral Pocock, Captain Riddle, by whom I sent Letters to the Admiralty and Royal Society. About noon came on a hard, dry Gale from the South-East.

Sunday, 17th. In the morning, Admiral Pocock set sail for England with Captain Riddle, and I sent letters to the Admiralty and Royal Society with him. Around noon, a strong, dry gale came in from the Southeast.

Monday, 18th. In the P.M. anchored in the offing an English Ship, which proved to be the Houghton Indiaman from Bengal. In the A.M. it fell moderate, and we began to water the Ship.

Monday, 18th. In the afternoon, we anchored offshore an English ship, which turned out to be the Houghton Indiaman from Bengal. In the morning, it calmed down a bit, and we started to take on water for the ship.

Tuesday, 19th. Variable Gentle breezes. All this day employ'd repairing Sails, Rigging, Watering, etc.

Tuesday, 19th. Light, changing breezes. Spent the whole day fixing sails, rigging, watering, and other tasks.

Wednesday, 20th. In the P.M. Sail'd the Houghton Indiaman, who saluted us with 11 Guns, which Complement we returned; this Ship, during her stay in India, lost by sickness between 30 and 40 men, and had at this time a good many down with the Scurvey. Other Ships suffer'd in the same proportion. Thus we find that Ships which have been little more than 12 months from England have suffer'd as much or more by Sickness than we have done, who have been out near 3 Times as long. Yet their sufferings will hardly, if att all, be mentioned or known in England; when, on the other hand, those of the Endeavour, because the Voyage is uncommon, will very probable be mentioned in every News Paper, and, what is not unlikely, with many Additional hardships we never Experienced; for such are the disposition of men in general in these Voyages that they are seldom content with the Hardships and Dangers which will naturally occur, but they must add others which hardly ever had existence but in their imaginations by magnifying the most Trifling accidents and circumstances to the greatest Hardships and unsurmountable dangers without the imediate interposition of Providence, as if the whole merit of the Voyage consisted in the Dangers and Hardships they underwent, or that real ones did not hapen often enough to give the mind sufficient anxiety. Thus Posterity are taught to look upon these Voyages as hazardous to the highest degree.

Wednesday, 20th. In the afternoon, the Houghton Indiaman set sail and saluted us with 11 guns, which we returned. This ship, during her stay in India, lost between 30 and 40 men to sickness, and at this time had quite a few dealing with scurvy. Other ships faced similar issues. We find that ships that have been away for just over 12 months from England have suffered as much or more from sickness than we have, despite being out nearly three times as long. Yet their struggles will hardly, if ever, be mentioned or known in England; while, on the other hand, the hardships of the Endeavour, due to the uniqueness of the voyage, will likely be reported in every newspaper, possibly with many additional challenges we never experienced. This is because people in general tend to not be satisfied with the hardships and dangers that naturally occur in these voyages; instead, they feel the need to add others that hardly ever happened but only exist in their imaginations, exaggerating the most trivial accidents and circumstances into the greatest hardships and overwhelming dangers without immediate divine intervention, as if the entire value of the voyage lies in the hardships and dangers they faced, or that real ones do not occur often enough to create sufficient anxiety. Thus, future generations are led to view these voyages as extremely hazardous.

Thursday, 21st. Fine Pleasant Weather. Employ'd getting on board water, overhauling the rigging, and repairing Sails. Sail'd for Batavia a Dutch Ship.

Thursday, 21st. Nice, pleasant weather. Spent the day getting water on board, checking the rigging, and repairing the sails. Set sail for Batavia on a Dutch ship.

Friday, 22nd, Saturday, 23rd, Sunday, 24th, Monday, 25th, Tuesday, 26th. Mostly Fine pleasant weather. On the 23rd compleated our water, after which I gave as many of the People leave to go on shore to refresh themselves as could be spared at one time.

Friday, 22nd, Saturday, 23rd, Sunday, 24th, Monday, 25th, Tuesday, 26th. Mostly nice, pleasant weather. On the 23rd, we completed our water supply, after which I allowed as many of the crew as could be spared at one time to go ashore and refresh themselves.

Wednesday, 27th. Winds variable and clear. Pleasant weather. Sailed for Holland 4 Sail Dutch Ships.

Wednesday, 27th. Winds are variable and clear. Nice weather. Sailed for Holland with 4 Dutch ships.

Thursday, 28th, Friday, 29th. Ditto weather. Employ'd fixing new Topmast and Backstays, repairing Sails, etc.

Thursday, 28th, Friday, 29th. Same weather. Worked on fixing the new topmast and backstays, repairing sails, etc.

Saturday, 30th. In the P.M. anchor'd here the Duke of Gloucester, English East India Ship from China. In the Evening a prodigious hard gale of wind came on at South-East, which continued till about 3 o'clock in the Morning. During the Gales the Table Mountains and Adjacent Hills were cap'd with Extraordinary while Clouds; the remainder of the Day light Airs and pleasant weather.

Saturday, 30th. In the afternoon, the Duke of Gloucester, an English East India ship from China, anchored here. In the evening, a strong gale of wind came up from the southeast, which lasted until about 3 o'clock in the morning. During the gales, the Table Mountains and nearby hills were covered with unusual white clouds; the rest of the day had light breezes and lovely weather.

Sunday, 31st. Clear pleasant weather all this day. In the Morning we got on board a whole Ox, which we cut up and salted. I had eat ashore some of as good and Fat Beef as ever I eat in my life, and was told that I might have as good to salt; but in this I was very much disappointed. The one I got was thin and Lean, yet well taisted; it weighed 408 pounds.

Sunday, 31st. The weather was clear and pleasant all day. In the morning, we loaded a whole ox on board, which we cut up and salted. I had eaten some of the best, fattest beef on shore that I’ve ever had, and I was told I could get more of the same to salt; but I was very disappointed. The meat I received was thin and lean, though it tasted good; it weighed 408 pounds.

[April 1771.]

[April 1771.]

Monday, April 1st. In the P.M. I observed a dark, dence haze like a Fog bank in the South-East Horizon, and which clouds began to gather over the Table Mountain; certain signs of an approaching gale from the same Quarter, which about 4 o'clock began to blow with great voialance, and continued more or less so the Remainder of these 24 Hours, the Table Mountain cap'd with White Clouds all the time. The weather dry and clear.

Monday, April 1st. In the afternoon, I saw a thick, dark haze like a fog bank on the southeastern horizon, and clouds started to form over Table Mountain; clear signs of a coming storm from that direction. Around 4 o'clock, the wind began to blow fiercely and kept up that way for the rest of the 24 hours, with Table Mountain covered in white clouds the whole time. The weather was dry and clear.

Tuesday, 2nd. First part fresh Gales at South-East, the remainder little wind and calms. In the P.M. sail'd for England the Duke of Gloucester Indiaman, who Saluted us at his departure. In the A.M. anchored here 2 Dutch Ships from Batavia, and a third at Anchor under Penguin Island in distress. Put on shore some Sick People.

Tuesday, 2nd. The first part of the day had fresh gales coming from the Southeast, while the rest of the day had little wind and calm conditions. In the afternoon, the Duke of Gloucester, an Indiaman, set sail for England and exchanged salutes with us as he left. In the morning, two Dutch ships from Batavia anchored here, and a third was anchored under Penguin Island in distress. Some sick people were put ashore.

Wednesday, 3rd. Fine, pleasant weather. Some people on shore on Liberty to refresh; the rest Employ'd repairing Sails and overhauling the Rigging.

Wednesday, 3rd. Nice, pleasant weather. Some people on shore at Liberty to relax; the rest were busy repairing sails and checking the rigging.

Thursday, 4th. Ditto Weather. Employ'd Painting the Ship and paying her sides.

Thursday, 4th. Same weather. Worked on painting the ship and covering her sides.

Friday, 5th. Var'ble light winds. Sail'd for Holland 3 Dutch Ships. Employ'd as above, and getting on board Provisions, etc.

Friday, 5th. Variable light winds. Sailed for Holland with 3 Dutch ships. Worked as mentioned above, and loading provisions, etc.

Saturday, 6th. Gentle breezes, with some rain in the Night.

Saturday, 6th. Light breezes, with some rain during the night.

Sunday, 7th. Gentle breezes, and fine, pleasant weather; a Signal for some Ships being in the offing.

Sunday, 7th. Light breezes and nice, enjoyable weather; a signal for some ships waiting offshore.

Monday, 8th. Gentle Breezes from the Westward. In the Night Anchor'd here the Europa, an English East Indiaman from Bengal, and in the Morning she saluted us with 11 Guns, which Complement we return'd.

Monday, 8th. Gentle breezes from the west. Overnight, the Europa, an English East Indiaman from Bengal, anchored here, and in the morning, she greeted us with 11 guns, which we returned.

Tuesday, 9th. Little wind at South-West, with Foggy, hazey weather. Employ'd making ready for Sea.

Tuesday, 9th. There’s a light wind from the southwest and foggy, hazy weather. I spent the day getting ready to set sail.

Wednesday, 10th. Gentle breezes at South-South-East and fair weather. Took on board 11 of our people from Sick Quarters.

Wednesday, 10th. Light breezes from the south-southeast and clear skies. Picked up 11 of our crew members from the medical quarters.

Thursday, 11th. Ditto weather. Employ'd getting on board various Articles of Provisions from the Shore.

Thursday, 11th. Same weather. Worked on loading different supplies from the shore.

Friday, 12th. Wind at South-West, fair weather. Set up the Topmast rigging, and bent the Sails.

Friday, 12th. Wind from the Southwest, clear skies. Set up the topmast rigging and attached the sails.

Saturday, 13th. Fresh breezes at South-West, and Cloudy, hazey weather, in the night Anchor'd here a Dutch Ship from Holland; she sail'd about 3 months ago in company with 2 more. The news brought by this Ship is that a War is dayley expected between England and Spain; Signals out for 4 or 5 Sail more being in the Offing, one of which is said to be a ship from England; took leave of the Gouvernour, intending to Sail to-morrow.

Saturday, 13th. There are fresh breezes coming from the South-West, and the weather is cloudy and hazy. Last night, a Dutch ship from Holland anchored here; it set sail about 3 months ago with 2 other ships. The news brought by this ship is that a war is expected any day now between England and Spain. Signals are out for 4 or 5 more ships that are nearby, one of which is said to be from England. I said goodbye to the governor, planning to sail tomorrow.

Sunday, 14th. Wind Westerly, gentle breezes. In the P.M. got all the Sick on board, many of whom are yet in a very bad state of health; 3 died here, but this loss was made up by the opportunity we had of compleating our full complement. In the morning unmoor'd and got ready for Sailing.

Sunday, 14th. Wind from the West, gentle breezes. In the afternoon, we got all the sick on board, many of whom are still in pretty bad shape; 3 died here, but we compensated for this loss by being able to complete our full crew. In the morning, we unmoored and got ready to sail.

Monday, 15th. None of the Ships in the Offing are yet arrived. Desirous as we must be of hearing news from England, I detemmin'd not to wait the arrival of these Ships, but took the advantage of a breeze of wind from the West-South-West; weigh'd and stood out of the Bay, saluted with 13 Guns, which Complement was return'd both by the Castle and Dutch Commodore. The Europa Saluted us as we passed her, which we return'd. This Ship was to have sail'd with or before us, but not liking the opportunity she lay fast. At 5 in the Evening anchor'd under Penguin or Robin Island in 10 fathoms water, the Island extending from West-North-West to South-South-West, distant 1 1/2 or 2 miles.

Monday, 15th. None of the ships in the harbor have arrived yet. As eager as we are to hear news from England, I decided not to wait for these ships and took advantage of a breeze coming from the West-South-West; we weighed anchor and set out of the bay, saluting with 13 cannon shots, which was returned by both the fort and the Dutch Commodore. The Europa saluted us as we passed, which we acknowledged. This ship was supposed to have sailed with us or before us, but didn’t like the conditions and stayed put. By 5 in the evening, we anchored under Penguin or Robin Island in 10 fathoms of water, with the island extending from West-North-West to South-South-West, about 1 ½ to 2 miles away.

In the Morning saw a Ship standing into Table Bay, under English Colours, which we took to be an Indiaman; at Noon Latitude observed 33 degrees 49 minutes South; Cape Town South 20 degrees East, distant 7 miles. As we could not Sail in the Morning for want of wind, I sent a Boat to the Island for a few Trifling Articles we had forgot to take in at the Cape, but the people on shore would not permit her to land, so that she return'd as she went, and I gave myself no further Trouble at it. Mr. Banks, who was in the Boat, was of opinion that it was owing to a mistake made respecting the rank of the Officer commanding the Boat; be this as it may, it seems probable that the Dutch do not admit of Strangers landing upon this Island least they should carry off some of those people which, for certain crimes, they Banish here for Life, as we were told was done by a Danish Ship a few years ago. But they might have a better reason for refusing our Boat to land, for it is not improbable but what there might be some English Seamen upon this Island whom they had sent from the Cape while we lay there, well knowing that if they came in my way I should take them on board; and this, I am told, is frequently done when any of His Majesty's Ships are in the Bay, for it is well known that the Dutch East India Ships are mostly mann'd by Foreigners.

In the morning, we saw a ship coming into Table Bay, flying the English flag, which we thought was an Indiaman. At noon, we recorded a latitude of 33 degrees 49 minutes South; Cape Town was 20 degrees East, about 7 miles away. Since we couldn't sail in the morning due to a lack of wind, I sent a boat to the island for a few small items we had forgotten to bring from the Cape, but the people on shore wouldn’t let her land, so she returned as she had come, and I didn’t bother with it any further. Mr. Banks, who was in the boat, believed it was due to a misunderstanding about the rank of the officer in charge; however, it seems likely that the Dutch don’t allow strangers to land on this island to prevent them from taking any of the people who have been banished here for life due to certain crimes, as we were told had happened with a Danish ship a few years back. But they might have had a better reason for refusing our boat’s landing, as it’s possible there were some English sailors on this island who they sent from the Cape while we were there, knowing I would take them on board if they crossed my path. I’ve been told this often happens when any of His Majesty’s ships are in the bay, since it’s well known that the Dutch East India ships are mostly manned by foreigners.

[Remarks on Cape of Good Hope.]

[Remarks on Cape of Good Hope.]

The Cape of Good Hope hath been so often discribed by Authors, and is so well known to Europeans, that any discription I can give of it may appear unnecessary. However, I cannot help observing that most Authors, particularly the Author of Mr. Byron's voyage, have heightened the picture to a very great degree above what it will bear; so that a Stranger is at once struck with surprise and disappointment, for no Country we have seen this voyage affords so barren a prospect as this, and not only so in appearance, but in reality.

The Cape of Good Hope has been described by so many writers and is so well-known to Europeans that any description I provide might seem unnecessary. However, I can’t help but point out that most authors, especially the one from Mr. Byron's voyage, have greatly exaggerated the portrayal of it; leaving a visitor both surprised and disappointed, as no country we have encountered on this journey offers such a barren view, both in appearance and reality.

The land over the Cape which constitutes the Peninsula form'd by Table Bay on the North, and False Bay on the South, consists of high barren Mountains; behind these to the East, or what may be called the Isthmus, is a vast extensive plane, not one thousand part of which either is or can be cultivated. The Soil consists mostly of a light kind of Sea sand, producing hardly anything but heath; every inch of Ground that will bear Cultivation is taken up in Small Plantations, consisting of Vineyards, Orchards, Kitchen Gardens, etc. Hardly any 2 lay together, but are dispers'd from one another at some Distance. If we may judge from circumstances, the Interior Parts of this Country is not more fertile; that is, the fertile land bears a very small proportion to the whole. We were told that they have settlements 28 days' journey inland, which is computed at 900 English Miles, and thus far they bring Provisions to the Cape by land. It is also said that the Dutch Farmers are so dispers'd about the country that some have no neighbours within 4 or 5 days' Journeys of them. Admitting these to be facts, and it will at once appear that the Country in General cannot be very fertile, for it would be absurd to suppose that they would raise provisions at such an immence distance, where the trouble and expence of bringing them to Market must increase, in proportion, could it be done nearer. The Dutch assign another reason for being obliged to extend their Scattered Settlements so far in land; which is, they never disturb the Original native, but always leave them in peaceable possession of whatever lands they may have appropriated to their own use, which in some places is pretty Extensive, and that probably none of the worst, by which good Policy the new Settlers very seldom if ever meet with any Disturbance from the Natives; on the contrary, many of them become their Servants, and mix among them, and are useful members to Society.

The land over the Cape that forms the Peninsula, bordered by Table Bay to the north and False Bay to the south, is made up of high, barren mountains. Behind these, to the east, or what can be called the isthmus, lies a vast, expansive plain, of which barely a thousandth can be cultivated. The soil is mostly a light type of sea sand that hardly produces anything except heath. Every usable piece of land is taken up by small plantations, including vineyards, orchards, and kitchen gardens. Rarely do any two plantations lie close together; they are scattered at some distance from one another. If circumstances are any indication, the interior parts of this country are not much more fertile; that is, the fertile land is a very small proportion of the whole. We were informed that there are settlements 28 days’ journey inland, estimated to be around 900 English miles, and that’s how far they bring provisions to the Cape by land. It’s also said that the Dutch farmers are so spread out across the country that some have no neighbors within 4 or 5 days’ journey. If these are facts, it becomes clear that the country in general cannot be very fertile, as it would be unreasonable to think they would raise provisions from such a vast distance, where the effort and cost of transporting them to market must increase considerably if done from closer locations. The Dutch offer another reason for being forced to spread their scattered settlements so far inland; they never disturb the original natives but always leave them peacefully in possession of whatever land they may have appropriated for their own use, which in some areas is quite extensive and probably among the better lands. This policy means that the new settlers very seldom, if ever, encounter disturbances from the natives; on the contrary, many of them become their servants, blend in with them, and are valuable members of society.

Notwithstanding the many disadvantages this Country labours under, such is the industry, economy, and good management of the Dutch that not only the necessary, but all the Luxuries, of Life are raised here in as great abundance, and are sold as cheap, if not cheaper, then in any part of Europe, some few Articles excepted. Naval Stores, however, do not want for price any more here than they do at Batavia; these are only sold by the company, who have a certain fix'd exorbitant Price, from which they never deviate.

Despite the many disadvantages this country faces, the Dutch are so industrious, economical, and well-managed that not only are the essentials but also all the luxuries of life produced here in great abundance and sold as cheaply, if not cheaper, than anywhere else in Europe, with a few exceptions. However, naval supplies are priced here just as they are in Batavia; these are only sold by the company, which has set a fixed high price that they never change.

The inhabitants of the Cape Town are in General well bred and Extreamly Civil and Polite to all Strangers; indeed, it is their Interest so to do, for the whole Town may be considered as one great Inn fitted up for the reception of all Comers and goers. Upon the whole, there is perhaps not a place in the known World that can Equal this in Affording refreshments of all kinds to Shipping. The Bay is Capacious, pretty safe, and Commodious; it lies open to the North-West winds, which winds, we are told, very seldom blow very Strong,* (* In the winter months these winds are very strong, and make the anchorage in Table Bay anything but safe.) but sometimes sends in a Great Sea, for which reason Ships moor North-East and South-West, and in such a manner as to have an Open Hawse with North-West winds. The South-East winds blow frequently with great Violence; but as this is right out of the Bay it is attended with no danger. Near the Town is a wharfe built of wood, run out a proper Distance into the Sea for the Conveniency of landing and Shipping off goods. To this wharfe water is convey'd in pipes and by means of Cocks. Several Boats may fill water at one and the same time. The Company keeps several large Boats or Hoys to carry goods, provisions, water, etc., to and from Shipping, as well Strangers as their own. Fuel is one of the Scarcest articles they have, and is brought a long way out of the Country, and Consists of Roots of Trees, Shrubs, etc. Except a few English Oaks which they have planted, this Country is wholly destitute of wood, except at too great a distance to be brought to the Cape.* (* Since Cook's day large plantations have been made in the vicinity of Capetown.) In the Article Timber, Boards, etc., they are chiefly supply'd from Batavia.

The people of Cape Town are generally well-mannered and extremely civil and polite to all visitors; in fact, it’s in their best interest to be this way, as the entire town can be seen as one big inn set up to welcome everyone. Overall, there’s probably no place in the known world that matches this when it comes to providing all kinds of refreshments for ships. The bay is spacious, fairly safe, and convenient; it's open to the north-west winds, which rarely blow very hard, though during the winter months these winds can be quite strong and make the anchorage in Table Bay anything but safe. However, they can sometimes bring in large waves, which is why ships anchor in a north-east to south-west direction, ensuring an open channel with the north-west winds. The south-east winds often blow fiercely, but since this comes directly out of the bay, there’s little danger associated with it. Near the town, there's a wooden wharf that extends a suitable distance into the sea to facilitate loading and unloading goods. Water is piped to this wharf using taps, allowing several boats to fill up at the same time. The company operates several large boats or hoys to transport goods, supplies, and water to and from ships, for both visitors and their own needs. Fuel is one of the scarcest resources here and is brought from far inland, consisting of roots from trees and shrubs. Other than a few English oaks they have planted, this area lacks wood, with any usable timber being found too far away to be transported to the Cape. They mainly rely on supplies of timber, boards, and other materials from Batavia.

3 of the winter months, viz., from the middle of May to the middle of August, the Dutch do not allow any of their Ships to lay in Table Bay, but oblige them to go into False Bay, where there is a very safe Harbour,* (* Simon's Bay, now the naval station, where there is a dockyard.) and every other Conveniency both for their own Shipping and Strangers, and where every produce of the Country can be had as cheap as at the Cape Town. The Dutch, I am told, never Deviate from this custom of sending their ships to False Bay at this Season of the Year, notwithstanding there had not a Gale of wind hapned for many years that would have put them in the least Danger in Table Bay.

During the winter months, specifically from mid-May to mid-August, the Dutch do not allow any of their ships to stay in Table Bay. Instead, they require them to go to False Bay, which has a very safe harbor (*Simon's Bay, now the naval station, where there is a dockyard*). This location provides all the necessary facilities for both their own ships and visiting ones, and all types of local produce can be found at prices as low as in Cape Town. I've been told that the Dutch never stray from this practice of sending their ships to False Bay during this time of year, even though there hasn't been a storm in many years that would pose any danger in Table Bay.

Table Bay is defended by a Square Fort, situated on the East side of the Town, close to the Sea beach, together with several other out works and Batterys along the Shore of the Bay on each side of the Town. They are so situated as to be cannonaded by Shipping, and are in a manner defenceless against a superior land force. The Garrison at present consists of 800 regulars, besides Militia of the Country, which comprehend every man able to bear Arms. They can, by means of Signals, alarm the whole Country in a very short time, and then every man is immediately to repair to the Cape Town. The French at Mauritius are supply'd with large Quantitys of Provisions from the Cape, viz., Salted Beef, Biscuit, Flour, and wine. While we lay in the Bay 2 Store Ships belonging to the King, of the Burthen of 50 or 60 Gun Ships, and a Snow, sail'd for that Island Loaded with Provisions, besides a large (King's) Frigate we left in the Bay taking in her Cargo. The Provisions contracted for this Year by the French were Salt Beef, 500,000 pounds; Flour, 400,000 pounds; Biscuit, 400,000 pounds; and Wine, 1,200 Leagers.

Table Bay is protected by a Square Fort located on the east side of town, near the beach, along with several other outworks and batteries along the bay's shoreline on both sides of the town. They are positioned such that they can be targeted by ships and are effectively defenseless against a stronger land force. The garrison currently consists of 800 regular troops, in addition to country militia, which includes every man capable of bearing arms. They can quickly alert the entire region through signals, and every man is required to head to Cape Town immediately. The French at Mauritius receive large supplies of provisions from the Cape, including salted beef, biscuits, flour, and wine. While we were in the bay, two store ships belonging to the King, each capable of carrying 50 or 60 guns, and a snow-shaped vessel, left for that island loaded with provisions, in addition to a large King's frigate we left in the bay taking on its cargo. The provisions contracted for this year by the French included 500,000 pounds of salted beef, 400,000 pounds of flour, 400,000 pounds of biscuits, and 1,200 leaguers of wine.


CHAPTER 11. CAPE OF GOOD HOPE TO ENGLAND.

[April 1771.]

[April 1771.]

TUESDAY, 16th. At 2 o'clock in the P.M. saw a large Ship behind the Island, under French Colours, standing into Table Bay; at 3 weigh'd with a Light breeze at South-East, and put to Sea; at 4 departed this Life Mr. Robert Molineux Master, a young man of good parts, but had unfortunately given himself up to Extravagancy and intemperance, which brought on disorders that put a Period to his Life. At 6 we had the Table Mountain and the Penguin Island in one bearing South-South-East, distant from the latter about 4 or 5 Leagues; had it calm most part of the night. In the morning a light breeze sprung up Southerly, with which we steer'd North-West; at noon we were by Observation in Latitude 33 degrees 30 minutes South. The Table Mountain bore South 54 degrees East, distant 14 Leagues. N.B. The Table Mountain lies directly over the Cape Town, from which last I take my departure; it lies in the Latitude of 33 degrees 56 minutes South, and Longitude 341 degrees 37 minutes West from Greenwich.

TUESDAY, 16th. At 2 PM, I saw a large ship behind the island, flying French colors, heading into Table Bay. At 3, we weighed anchor with a light breeze from the southeast and set out to sea. At 4, Mr. Robert Molineux, the captain, passed away. He was a young man of good character, but he unfortunately fell into extravagance and intoxication, which led to health issues that ended his life. At 6, we had Table Mountain and Penguin Island in sight to the south-southeast, about 4 or 5 leagues away from the latter; it was calm for most of the night. In the morning, a light breeze from the south picked up, allowing us to steer northwest; at noon, our position was at latitude 33 degrees 30 minutes south. Table Mountain was seen at south 54 degrees east, 14 leagues away. N.B. Table Mountain is directly over Cape Town, from which I started my journey; it is located at latitude 33 degrees 56 minutes south and longitude 341 degrees 37 minutes west from Greenwich.

Wednesday, 17th. Fresh breezes and fair weather, with a swell from the South-West. Wind Southerly; course North 50 degrees West; distance 118 miles; latitude 32 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 344 degrees 8 minutes West.

Wednesday, 17th. Fresh breezes and nice weather, with a swell coming from the South-West. Wind is from the South; course is North 50 degrees West; distance covered is 118 miles; latitude is 32 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude is 344 degrees 8 minutes West.

Thursday, 18th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. Swell as before. Wind Ditto; course North-West; distance 85 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 345 degrees 19 minutes West.

Thursday, 18th. Light breezes and clear skies. Waves are the same as before. Wind is the same; heading Northwest; distance 85 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 345 degrees 19 minutes West.

Friday, 19th. Little wind and Sometimes calm. Swell from the Southward. Wind South-East to North-West; course North 50 degrees West; distance 16 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 345 degrees 33 minutes West.

Friday, 19th. Light wind and sometimes calm. Swell coming from the south. Wind from South-East to North-West; course North 50 degrees West; distance 16 miles; latitude 31 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 345 degrees 33 minutes West.

Saturday, 20th. Gentle breezes and Clear weather. Wind Westerly; latitude 29 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 346 degrees 10 minutes West.

Saturday, 20th. Light winds and clear skies. Wind from the west; latitude 29 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 346 degrees 10 minutes West.

Sunday, 21st. A moderate trade wind and Pleasant weather. Wind Southerly; course North 54 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 28 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 347 degrees 42 minutes West.

Sunday, 21st. A gentle trade wind and nice weather. Wind coming from the south; course North 54 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 28 degrees 43 minutes South, longitude 347 degrees 42 minutes West.

Monday, 22nd. A Fresh Trade, and Pleasant weather. Exercised the People at Small Arms. Observations for Longitude with the Sun and Moon agree with the Log. Wind South-East; course North 50 degrees West; distance 118 miles; latitude 27 degrees 27 minutes South, longitude 349 degrees 24 minutes West.

Monday, 22nd. A New Trade and Nice Weather. Had the crew practice with Small Arms. Observations for Longitude with the Sun and Moon match the Log. Wind from the Southeast; heading North 50 degrees West; distance 118 miles; latitude 27 degrees 27 minutes South, longitude 349 degrees 24 minutes West.

Tuesday, 23rd. Gentle breezes, and Clear weather. Found the Variation in the Evening, by the Amplitude, to be 17 degrees 40 minutes West, and by Azimuth in the Morning 18 degrees 37 minutes. Employ'd repairing Boats and Sails. Exercis'd Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind South-East by South to West-South-West; course North 46 degrees West; distance 98 miles; latitude 26 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 350 degrees 42 minutes West.

Tuesday, 23rd. Light breezes and clear skies. In the evening, I found the variation by the amplitude to be 17 degrees 40 minutes West, and by azimuth in the morning 18 degrees 37 minutes. Spent time repairing boats and sails. Practiced with the big guns and small arms. Wind was from South-East by South to West-South-West; course North 46 degrees West; distance 98 miles; latitude 26 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 350 degrees 42 minutes West.

Wednesday, 24th. Ditto weather. Found the Variation to be 17 degrees 30 minutes West. Employ'd as yesterday. Wind West, West-North-West; course North 20 degrees West; distance 78 miles; latitude 25 degrees 6 minutes South, longitude 351 degrees 16 minutes West.

Wednesday, 24th. Same weather as before. Found the variation to be 17 degrees 30 minutes West. Worked as yesterday. Wind coming from the West, West-Northwest; course set to North 20 degrees West; distance traveled 78 miles; latitude 25 degrees 6 minutes South, longitude 351 degrees 16 minutes West.

Thursday, 25th. First part, moderate and Clear; Middle, Squally, with Rain; Latter, fresh Gales and Cloudy. Employ'd as above. Wind North-West, South-West; course North 20' West; distance 105 miles; latitude 23 degrees 28 minutes South, longitude 351 degrees 52 minutes West.

Thursday, 25th. Morning was mild and clear; afternoon got stormy with rain; evening brought strong winds and clouds. Worked as mentioned. Wind from the North-West and South-West; heading North 20° West; traveled 105 miles; latitude 23° 28' South, longitude 351° 52' West.

Friday, 26th. Fresh Gales, and a large Swell from the Southward. Wind South-South-West, South-East by South; course North 50 degrees West; distance 168 miles; latitude 21 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 354 degrees 12 minutes West.

Friday, 26th. Strong winds and a big swell coming from the south. Wind from South-South-West, South-East by South; heading North 50 degrees West; distance 168 miles; latitude 21 degrees 40 minutes South, longitude 354 degrees 12 minutes West.

Saturday, 27th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. Employ'd repairing Sails. Wind South-East 1/2 South; course North 55 degrees West; distance 168 miles; latitude 20 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 356 degrees 40 minutes West.

Saturday, 27th. Strong winds and overcast. Worked on fixing sails. Wind from the South-East 1/2 South; heading North 55 degrees West; traveled 168 miles; latitude 20 degrees 4 minutes South, longitude 356 degrees 40 minutes West.

Sunday, 28th. Ditto weather. Variation per Azimuth 14 degrees West. Wind South-East; course North 56 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 152 miles; latitude 18 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 358 degrees 54 minutes West.

Sunday, 28th. Same weather. Variation by Azimuth 14 degrees West. Wind from the South-East; course North 56 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 152 miles; latitude 18 degrees 41 minutes South, longitude 358 degrees 54 minutes West.

Monday, 29th. Ditto Gales. Variation 13 degrees 53 minutes West. In the A.M. crossed the line of our first Meridian, viz., that of Greenwich, having now Circumnavigated the Globe in a West direction. Wind South-East; course North 53 degrees West; distance 136 miles; latitude 17 degrees 19 minutes South, longitude 0 degrees 50 minutes West.

Monday, 29th. Same strong winds. The variation is 13 degrees 53 minutes West. In the morning, we crossed the line of our first Meridian, which is that of Greenwich, completing our journey around the globe heading West. The wind is from the South-East; our course is North 53 degrees West; we traveled a distance of 136 miles; latitude is 17 degrees 19 minutes South, and longitude is 0 degrees 50 minutes West.

Tuesday, 30th. Fresh Gales and Pleasant weather. Exercised the people at Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind South-East; course North 58 degrees West South, distance 126 miles; latitude 16 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 2 degrees 42 minutes West.

Tuesday, 30th. Strong winds and nice weather. The crew practiced with cannons and small arms. Wind from the Southeast; heading North 58 degrees West South, distance 126 miles; latitude 16 degrees 11 minutes South, longitude 2 degrees 42 minutes West.

[May 1771. At St. Helena.]

[May 1771. At St. Helena.]

Wednesday, May 1st. Fresh Trade and Pleasant weather. At 6 A.M. saw the Island of St. Helena bearing West, distant 8 or 9 Leagues. At Noon Anchor'd in the Road, before James's Fort, in 24 fathoms water. Found riding here His Majesty's Ship Portland and Swallow* (* This was not the same Swallow that preceded Cook in circumnavigation. She had been broken up.) Sloop, and 12 Sail of Indiaman. At our first seeing the Fleet in this Road we took it for granted that it was a War; but in this we were soon agreeably deceived. The Europa Indiaman Anchor'd here a little before us; she sail'd from the Cape 2 days after us, and brings an account the French Ship we saw standing into Table Bay was a French Man of War, of 64 Guns, bound to India, and that there were 2 more on their Passage. Wind South-East. At noon at Anchor in St. Helena Road.

Wednesday, May 1st. Fresh trade and nice weather. At 6 A.M. I spotted the Island of St. Helena to the West, about 8 or 9 leagues away. At noon, we dropped anchor in the harbor, in front of James's Fort, in 24 fathoms of water. We found His Majesty's Ship Portland and Swallow* (* This was not the same Swallow that sailed before Cook in the circumnavigation. She had been dismantled.) along with 12 East India Company ships already anchored here. When we first saw the fleet in the harbor, we assumed it was a war, but we were pleasantly surprised. The Europa, an East India Company ship, anchored here shortly before us; she left the Cape 2 days after us and reported that the French ship we saw coming into Table Bay was a French warship with 64 guns, heading to India, and that there were 2 more on their way. Wind from the Southeast. At noon, we were anchored in St. Helena harbor.

Thursday, 2nd. Clear, Pleasant weather. In the P.M. moor'd with the Kedge Anchor, and in the A.M. received some few Officers' stores from the Portland. Wind Ditto. At noon at Anchor in St. Helena Road.

Thursday, 2nd. Clear, pleasant weather. In the afternoon, we anchored with the Kedge Anchor, and in the morning, we received a few officers' supplies from the Portland. Wind the same. At noon, we were anchored in St. Helena Road.

Friday, 3rd. Clear, Pleasant weather. Employ'd repairing Sails, overhauling the Rigging, etc. Wind South-East. At noon at Anchor in St. Helena Road.

Friday, 3rd. Clear, pleasant weather. Worked on repairing sails, going through the rigging, etc. Wind from the southeast. At noon, anchored in St. Helena Road.

Saturday, 4th. Little wind and pleasant weather. At 6 A.M. the Portland made the Signal to unmoor, and at Noon to Weigh, at which time the Ships began to get under Sail. Wind Ditto. At noon at Anchor in St. Helena Road.

Saturday, 4th. Little wind and nice weather. At 6 A.M., the Portland signaled to unmoor, and at noon to weigh anchor, at which point the ships began to set sail. Wind the same. At noon, anchored in St. Helena Road.

Sunday, 5th. Gentle breezes and Clear weather. At 1 P.M. weigh'd, and stood out of the Road in company with the Portland and 12 Sail of Indiamen. At 6 o'clock James Fort, St. Helena, bore East 1/2 South, distant 3 Leagues. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 13 degrees 10 minutes West. Wind East by South; course North 50 degrees 30 minutes West; distance 71 miles; latitude 15 degrees 5 minutes South, longitude 6 degrees 46 minutes West.

Sunday, 5th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. At 1 PM, we weighed anchor and left the harbor alongside the Portland and 12 merchant ships. By 6 o'clock, James Fort, St. Helena, was to the East 1/2 South, about 3 leagues away. In the morning, we found the variation to be 13 degrees 10 minutes West. Wind was East by South; course was North 50 degrees 30 minutes West; distance traveled was 71 miles; latitude was 15 degrees 5 minutes South, longitude was 6 degrees 46 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. Moderate breezes and Cloudy weather. Sailing in Company with the Fleet. Wind East-South-East; course North 47 1/2 degrees West; distance 122 miles; latitude 13 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 8 degrees 27 minutes West.

Monday, 6th. Light breezes and cloudy weather. Sailing together with the fleet. Wind coming from the East-South-East; course North 47.5 degrees West; distance 122 miles; latitude 13 degrees 42 minutes South, longitude 8 degrees 27 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. Ditto Weather. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 12 degrees 5 minutes West. Exercised the people at Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind South-East; course North 46 degrees West; distance 137 miles; latitude 12 degrees 5 minutes South, longitude 10 degrees 9 minutes West.

Tuesday, 7th. Same weather. In the morning, found the variation to be 12 degrees 5 minutes west. Had the crew practice with the big guns and small arms. Wind was blowing from the southeast; we were on a course of north 46 degrees west; covered a distance of 137 miles; latitude 12 degrees 5 minutes south, longitude 10 degrees 9 minutes west.

Wednesday, 8th. A Steady breeze and Pleasant Weather. All the Fleet in Company. Wind South-East; course North 46 degrees 45 minutes West; distance 126 miles; latitude 10 degrees 39 minutes South, longitude 11 degrees 42 minutes West.

Wednesday, 8th. A steady breeze and nice weather. All the fleet is together. Wind is coming from the southeast; course is set to north 46 degrees 45 minutes west; distance traveled is 126 miles; latitude is 10 degrees 39 minutes south, longitude is 11 degrees 42 minutes west.

Thursday, 9th. Ditto Weather. In the Evening found the Variation to be 11 degrees 42 minutes West. Wind South-East by South; course North-West; distance 118 miles; latitude 9 degrees 16 minutes, longitude 13 degrees 17 minutes West.

Thursday, 9th. Same weather. In the evening, I found the variation to be 11 degrees 42 minutes West. Wind was from the South-East by South; we were heading North-West; distance covered was 118 miles; latitude was 9 degrees 16 minutes, longitude was 13 degrees 17 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. At 6 in the A.M. saw the Island of Ascention bearing North-North-West, distant 7 Leagues. Made the Signal to speak with the Portland, and soon after Captain Elliott himself came on board, to whom I deliver'd a Letter for the Admiralty, and a Box containing the Ship's Common Log Books, and some of the Officers' Journals, etc. I did this because it seem'd probable that the Portland would get home before us, as we sail much heavier than any of the Fleet.* (* The Portland and the India fleet got home three days before the Endeavour.) At Noon the Island of Ascention bore East by South, distant 4 or 5 Leagues. By our Observations it lies in the Latitude of 7 degrees 54 minutes South, and Longitude of 14 degrees 18 minutes West. A North-West by North course by Compass, or North-West a little Westerly by the Globe from St. Helena, will bring you directly to this Island. Wind Ditto; course North-West; distance 120 miles; latitude 7 degrees 51 minutes South, longitude 14 degrees 32 minutes West.

Friday, 10th. At 6 A.M., I saw Ascension Island to the North-North-West, about 7 leagues away. I signaled to communicate with the Portland, and soon after, Captain Elliott came aboard. I handed him a letter for the Admiralty and a box containing the ship's logbooks and some of the officers' journals, etc. I did this because it seemed likely that the Portland would return home before us, as we are sailing much heavier than any of the fleet. (*The Portland and the India fleet returned three days before the Endeavour.) At noon, Ascension Island was to the East by South, about 4 or 5 leagues away. By our calculations, it is located at a latitude of 7 degrees 54 minutes South and longitude of 14 degrees 18 minutes West. A North-West by North course by compass, or North-West slightly Westerly on the globe from St. Helena, will take you directly to this island. Wind same; course North-West; distance 120 miles; latitude 7 degrees 51 minutes South, longitude 14 degrees 32 minutes West.

Friday, 11th. A steady Trade wind and pleasant Weather. At 1/2 past 6 p.m. the Island of Ascention bore South-East 3/4 East, distant 11 or 12 Leagues. Sailing in Company with the Fleet. Wind Ditto; course North 42 degrees West, distance 117 miles; latitude 6 degrees 24 minutes South, longitude 15 degrees 51 minutes West.

Friday, 11th. A steady trade wind and nice weather. At 6:30 p.m., the Island of Ascension was located southeast by east, about 11 or 12 leagues away. Sailing together with the fleet. Wind was the same; course northwest at 42 degrees, distance 117 miles; latitude 6 degrees 24 minutes south, longitude 15 degrees 51 minutes west.

Saturday, 12th. First and Middle parts a Steady breeze, and fair the Latter; light Squalls, with rain. Wind South-East by South to South-East by East; course North 31 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 123 miles; latitude 4 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 16 degrees 54 minutes West.

Saturday, 12th. The first and middle parts had a steady breeze, and it was fair in the latter part; there were light squalls with rain. The wind was blowing from South-East by South to South-East by East; the course was North 31 degrees 15 minutes West; the distance covered was 123 miles; latitude 4 degrees 38 minutes South, longitude 16 degrees 54 minutes West.

Sunday, 13th. Gentle breezes and Clear Weather; hott and Sultry. Sailing in Company with the fleet. Variation 10 degrees West. Wind South-East by South; course North 32 1/2 degrees West; distance 119 miles; latitude 2 degrees 58 minutes South, longitude 17 degrees 58 minutes West.

Sunday, 13th. Light breezes and clear skies; hot and humid. Sailing together with the fleet. Variation of 10 degrees West. Wind from the South-East by South; heading North 32 1/2 degrees West; distance 119 miles; latitude 2 degrees 58 minutes South, longitude 17 degrees 58 minutes West.

Monday, 14th. Ditto Weather. Wind South-East by South; course North 32 1/2 degrees West; distance 109 miles; latitude 1 degree 26 minutes South, longitude 18 degrees 57 minutes West.

Monday, 14th. Same weather. Wind from South-East by South; course North 32.5 degrees West; distance 109 miles; latitude 1 degree 26 minutes South, longitude 18 degrees 57 minutes West.

Tuesday, 15th. Little wind and hot, Sultry weather. In the P.M. observed, meerly for the sake of Observing, an Eclipse of the Sun. In the A.M. brought another Foretopsail to the Yard, the old one being quite wore out. Wind East-South-East; course North 32 1/2 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 0 degrees 14 minutes South, longitude 19 degrees 43 minutes West.

Tuesday, 15th. There was little wind and it was hot, with sticky weather. In the afternoon, I watched a solar eclipse just for the sake of watching it. In the morning, I brought another fore topsail to the yard since the old one was completely worn out. The wind was coming from the east-south-east; we were headed north 32 1/2 degrees west; traveled 85 miles; latitude 0 degrees 14 minutes south, longitude 19 degrees 43 minutes west.

Wednesday, 16th. Light breezes and fair weather. Variation 9 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind South-East by South; course North 31 degrees West; distance 71 miles; latitude 0 degrees 47 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 20 minutes West.

Wednesday, 16th. Gentle breezes and nice weather. Variation 9 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind from South-East by South; course North 31 degrees West; distance 71 miles; latitude 0 degrees 47 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 20 minutes West.

Thursday, 17th. Ditto Weather. Sailing in Company with the Fleet. Wind Ditto; course North 31 degrees West; distance 61 miles; latitude 1 degree 39 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 50 minutes West.

Thursday, 17th. Same weather. Sailing with the fleet. Wind same; course North 31 degrees West; distance 61 miles; latitude 1 degree 39 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 50 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. First part ditto weather; remainder Squally, with Thunder and Rain. The observ'd Latitude is 14 Miles to the Northward of the Log. Sailing in Company with the Fleet. Wind South-South-East to East; course North 20 degrees West; distance 86 miles; latitude 3 degrees 0 minutes North, longitude 21 degrees 22 minutes West.

Saturday, 18th. The first part of the day had the same weather; the rest was windy, with thunder and rain. The observed latitude is 14 miles north of what was logged. We are sailing with the fleet. The wind is from the south-southeast to east; our course is north 20 degrees west; distance traveled is 86 miles; latitude is 3 degrees 0 minutes north, longitude is 21 degrees 22 minutes west.

Sunday, 19th. Cloudy, unsettled weather, with some rain. In the A.M. found the Variation by the Amplitude and Azimuth 7 degrees 40 minutes West. Hoisted a Boat out, and sent on board the Houghton for the Surgeon, Mr. Carret, in order to look at Mr. Hicks, who is so far gone in a Consumption that his Life is dispair'd of. Observation at Noon 16 Miles to the Northward of the Log. Wind South-East to South by East; course North 20 degrees West; distance 98 miles; latitude 4 degrees 32 minutes North, longitude 21 degrees 58 minutes West.

Sunday, 19th. It was cloudy with unpredictable weather, and there was some rain. In the morning, I determined the Variation using the Amplitude and Azimuth, which was 7 degrees 40 minutes West. We hoisted a boat out and sent it to the Houghton for the Surgeon, Mr. Carret, to check on Mr. Hicks, who is suffering severely from Consumption and is not expected to survive. At noon, we were 16 miles north of the logged position. The wind was coming from the South-East to South by East; our course was North 20 degrees West; we covered a distance of 98 miles; latitude 4 degrees 32 minutes North, longitude 21 degrees 58 minutes West.

[With India Fleet. Homeward Bound.]

[With India Fleet. Heading Home.]

Monday, 20th. Dark, cloudy, unsettled weather, with rain. At Noon the Observ'd Latitude was 27 Miles to the Northward of the Log. Sailing in Company with the Fleet. Wind Variable between the South and East; course North 19 degrees West; distance 70 miles; latitude 5 degrees 38 minutes North, longitude 22 degrees 21 minutes West.

Monday, 20th. It was dark, cloudy, and unpredictable weather with rain. At noon, the observed latitude was 27 miles north of what was recorded. We were sailing with the fleet. The wind was variable between south and east; our course was north 19 degrees west; we covered a distance of 70 miles; latitude 5 degrees 38 minutes north, longitude 22 degrees 21 minutes west.

Tuesday, 21st. Little wind, with some heavy showers of rain. At 2 p.m. had some Observations of the Sun and Moon, which gave the Longitude 24 degrees 50 minutes West, 2 degrees 28 minutes West of Account. In the morning it was Calm, and the Ships, being near one another, several of them had their Boats out to tow. We Observed the Portland to carry out a long Warp. I, being desirous to see the Machine they made use of, we hoisted out a Boat, and Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and myself went on board her, where we was show'd it. it was made of Canvas, in every respect like an Umbrello; its Circumference, if extended to a Circle, was 24 feet, tho' this was a Small one of the Sort; yet Captain Elliot told me that it would hold as much as 150 Men could haul. I was so well satisfied of the Utility of this Machine that I would not have delayed a moment in having one Made had not our Forge been render'd Useless by the loss of some of its parts. Winds Variable; course North 31 degrees West; distance 35 miles; latitude 6 degrees 8 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 8 minutes West.

Tuesday, 21st. There was little wind, with heavy rain showers. At 2 p.m., I made some observations of the Sun and Moon, which indicated a longitude of 24 degrees 50 minutes West, 2 degrees 28 minutes West of the account. In the morning, it was calm, and since the ships were close to each other, several had their boats out for towing. We noticed that the Portland was using a long warp. Wanting to see the machine they used, we launched a boat, and Mr. Banks, Dr. Solander, and I went aboard, where it was shown to us. It was made of canvas, similar to an umbrella; its circumference, if made into a circle, was 24 feet, although this was a smaller version. Captain Elliot informed me that it could hold as much as 150 men could pull. I was so impressed by the usefulness of this machine that I wouldn't have hesitated to have one made if our forge hadn't been rendered useless due to the loss of some parts. Winds were variable; course North 31 degrees West; distance 35 miles; latitude 6 degrees 8 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 8 minutes West.

Wednesday, 22nd. Variable, unsettled weather, with rain. About 9 o'clock in the A.M. the Portland shorten'd Sail for the Sternmost Ships to come up. As we imagin'd, this gave us an Opportunity to get a Head of the Fleet, after which we made such sail as was necessary to keep in Company. Wind Variable; course North-North-West 3/4 West; distance 58 miles; latitude 6 degrees 58 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 38 minutes West.

Wednesday, 22nd. Changeable, unpredictable weather, with rain. Around 9 o'clock in the morning, the Portland reduced sail for the last ships to catch up. As we expected, this gave us a chance to get ahead of the fleet, after which we made the necessary adjustments to stay in sync. Wind variable; course North-North-West 3/4 West; distance 58 miles; latitude 6 degrees 58 minutes North, longitude 25 degrees 38 minutes West.

Thursday, 23rd. Little wind from the Eastward, with frequent showers of Rain, and hazey weather. The Fleet astern of us all this day. At Noon we Shortned Sail for them to come up, the headmost being about 2 Leagues off. Wind East to North-East; course North 25 degrees West; distance 56 miles; latitude 7 degrees 49 minutes North, longitude 26 degrees 2 minutes West.

Thursday, 23rd. There was a light wind coming from the east, with frequent rain showers and hazy weather. The fleet was behind us all day. At noon, we reduced our sails to let them catch up, with the lead ship about 2 leagues away. The wind was blowing from the east to northeast; our course was north 25 degrees west; we traveled 56 miles; latitude 7 degrees 49 minutes north, longitude 26 degrees 2 minutes west.

Friday, 24th. First part Moderate breezes, and hazey, with rain; the latter, fresh breezes and fair. At 3 p.m., finding the Fleet to come fast up with us, we made all the Sail we could. Soon after it became hazey, and we lost sight of them until near 6, when it clear'd up a little, and we saw 3 Sail abreast of us, bearing East about 2 or 3 Miles' Distance; by this we saw that they not only kept a better wind, but out sail'd us upon a wind. It became again hazey, and we lost Sight of them, and notwithstanding we keept close upon a wind all night, with as much Sail out as we could bear, there was not one Sail in sight in the Morning. Wind North-East and North-North-East; course North 54 degrees West; distance 92 miles; latitude 8 degrees 42 minutes North, 27 degrees 18 minutes West.

Friday, 24th. In the morning, there were moderate breezes and hazy weather with rain; later, fresh breezes and clearer skies. At 3 p.m., noticing the Fleet was quickly closing in on us, we put up all the sails we could. Not long after, it became hazy again, and we lost sight of them until around 6, when the weather cleared slightly, revealing 3 ships side by side about 2 or 3 miles to the east. This showed us they not only had a better wind but were outpacing us as well. It got hazy again, and we lost sight of them. Despite keeping close to the wind all night with as much sail as we could handle, there wasn't a single ship in sight by morning. The wind was from the North-East and North-North-East; our course was North 54 degrees West; we covered 92 miles; our position was latitude 8 degrees 42 minutes North, 27 degrees 18 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. Moderate Trade Wind and Cloudy weather. Wind North-North-East; course North 50 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 92 miles; latitude 9 degrees 41 minutes North, longitude 28 degrees 30 minutes West.

Saturday, 25th. Light Trade Wind and cloudy weather. Wind from the North-North-East; course North 50 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 92 miles; latitude 9 degrees 41 minutes North, longitude 28 degrees 30 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. A Steady Trade and Cloudy Weather. About 1 o'Clock P.M. departed this Life Lieutenant Hicks, and in the Evening his body was committed to the Sea with the usual ceremonys. He died of a Consumption which he was not free from when we sail'd from England, so that it may be truly said that he hath been dying ever since, tho' he held out tolerable well until we got to Batavia. Wind North-East by North; course North 46 degrees West; distance 92 miles; latitude 20 degrees 47 minutes North, longitude 29 degrees 35 minutes West.

Sunday, 26th. Steady trade and cloudy weather. Around 1:00 PM, Lieutenant Hicks passed away, and in the evening, his body was laid to rest at sea with the usual ceremonies. He suffered from tuberculosis, which he had before we left England, so it's accurate to say he had been dying since then, although he managed fairly well until we reached Batavia. Wind from the North-East by North; course North 46 degrees West; distance 92 miles; latitude 20 degrees 47 minutes North, longitude 29 degrees 35 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. A Steady, fresh Trade and Cloudy weather. This day I gave Mr. Charles Clerk an order to act as Lieutenant in the room of Mr. Hicks, deceased, he being a Young Man extremely well qualified for that Station. Wind North-East; course North 39 degrees West; distance 103 miles; latitude 12 degrees 7 minutes North, longitude 30 degrees 40 minutes West.

Monday, 27th. A steady, fresh trade wind and cloudy weather. Today, I gave Mr. Charles Clerk an order to serve as Lieutenant in place of Mr. Hicks, who has passed away, as he is a young man very well qualified for that position. Wind northeast; course north 39 degrees west; distance 103 miles; latitude 12 degrees 7 minutes north, longitude 30 degrees 40 minutes west.

Tuesday, 28th. A steady Trade and fair weather. Wind North Easterly; course North 40 degrees West; distance 108 miles; latitude 13 degrees 30 minutes North, longitude 31 degrees 51 minutes West.

Tuesday, 28th. A steady trade and nice weather. Wind from the northeast; course northwest at 40 degrees; distance 108 miles; latitude 13 degrees 30 minutes north, longitude 31 degrees 51 minutes west.

Wednesday, 29th. Fresh Gales and Hazey. Wind Ditto; course North 31 1/2 degrees West; distance 128 miles; latitude 15 degrees 19 minutes North, longitude 33 degrees 2 minutes West.

Wednesday, 29th. Strong winds and hazy. Wind same; course North 31.5 degrees West; distance 128 miles; latitude 15 degrees 19 minutes North, longitude 33 degrees 2 minutes West.

Thursday, 30th. Ditto Gales and Cloudy. Fix'd a new maintopmast Backstay, the old one having broke several times. Wind Ditto; course North 31 degrees 15 minutes West; distance 124 miles; latitude 17 degrees 5 minutes North, longitude 34 degrees 9 minutes West.

Thursday, 30th. The same gales and cloudy weather. Put in a new maintopmast backstay since the old one had broken several times. Wind is the same; course is North 31 degrees 15 minutes West; distance traveled is 124 miles; latitude is 17 degrees 5 minutes North, longitude is 34 degrees 9 minutes West.

Friday, 31st. Strong Gales and Cloudy in the Evening. Got down Top Gallant Yards, and in the Morning found the Variation 5 degrees 9 minutes West. Wind North-East and North-East by East; course North 39 1/2 degrees West; distance 136 miles; latitude 18 degrees 50 minutes North, longitude 35 degrees 40 minutes West.

Friday, 31st. Strong winds and cloudy in the evening. Took down the top gallant yards, and in the morning found the variation to be 5 degrees 9 minutes West. Wind from the North-East and North-East by East; course North 39.5 degrees West; distance 136 miles; latitude 18 degrees 50 minutes North, longitude 35 degrees 40 minutes West.

[June 1771.]

[June 1771.]

Saturday, June 1st. Fresh Trade, and Cloudy weather. In the A.M. got up Top Gallant Yards. Wind North-East; course North 35 degrees West; distance 100 miles; latitude 20 degrees 12 minutes North, longitude 36 degrees 41 minutes West.

Saturday, June 1st. Fresh trade and cloudy weather. In the morning, we raised the top gallant yards. The wind was coming from the northeast; our course was 35 degrees west of north; we traveled 100 miles; latitude 20 degrees 12 minutes north, longitude 36 degrees 41 minutes west.

Sunday, 2nd. Moderate Gales and Clear weather. Variation 5 degrees 4 minutes West. Wind North-East to North-North-East; course North 49 degrees West; distance 104 miles; latitude 21 degrees 20 minutes North, longitude 38 degrees 5 minutes West.

Sunday, 2nd. Light gales and clear skies. Variation 5 degrees 4 minutes West. Wind from the North-East to North-North-East; heading North 49 degrees West; distance 104 miles; latitude 21 degrees 20 minutes North, longitude 38 degrees 5 minutes West.

Monday, 3rd. A Gentle Trade Wind, and Pleasant weather. Wind North-East; course North 44 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 22 degrees 21 minutes North, longitude 39 degrees 9 minutes West.

Monday, 3rd. A light trade wind and nice weather. Wind from the North-East; course North 44 degrees West; distance 85 miles; latitude 22 degrees 21 minutes North, longitude 39 degrees 9 minutes West.

Tuesday, 4th. Ditto weather. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 4 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind North-East; course North 34 degrees West; distance 91 miles; latitude 23 degrees 40 North, longitude 40 degrees 4 minutes West.

Tuesday, 4th. Same weather. In the morning, found the variation to be 4 degrees 30 minutes West. Wind was blowing from the Northeast; course was North 34 degrees West; distance traveled was 91 miles; latitude 23 degrees 40 North, longitude 40 degrees 4 minutes West.

Wednesday, 5th. Gentle breezes, with some Showers of Small Rain. Wind Ditto; course North 52 degrees West; distance 83 miles; latitude 24 degrees 31 minutes North, longitude 41 degrees 11 minutes West.

Wednesday, 5th. Light breezes, with a few light rain showers. Wind same; direction North 52 degrees West; distance 83 miles; latitude 24 degrees 31 minutes North, longitude 41 degrees 11 minutes West.

Thursday, 6th. Ditto weather. In the A.M. found the Variation by the mean of the Amplitude and Azimuth to be 5 degrees 34 minutes West, and by Observation of the Sun and Moon found the Ship in Longitude 43 degrees 18 minutes West of Greenwich, 2 degrees 51 minutes West of the Log since the last Observations; this I judge to be owing to a Westerly Current. Wind East-North-East to East; course North 3/4 West; distance 90 miles; latitude 26 degrees 1 minute North, longitude, per Observation Sun and Moon, 43 degrees 18 minutes West.

Thursday, 6th. Same weather as before. In the morning, I found the variation by averaging the amplitude and azimuth to be 5 degrees 34 minutes West. By checking the positions of the Sun and Moon, I determined the ship's longitude to be 43 degrees 18 minutes West of Greenwich, which is 2 degrees 51 minutes West according to the log since the last observations; I believe this is due to a westerly current. The wind is East-North-East to East; our course is North 3/4 West; we covered a distance of 90 miles; our latitude is 26 degrees 1 minute North, and longitude, based on the Sun and Moon observations, is 43 degrees 18 minutes West.

Friday, 7th. Moderate breezes, and Cloudy. A.M., Variation per mean of 20 Azimuths 5 degrees 20 minutes West. Wind East-North-East; course North 15 degrees West; distance 84 miles; latitude 27 degrees 22 minutes North, longitude 43 degrees 42 minutes West.

Friday, 7th. Light breezes and cloudy. In the morning, the variation based on the average of 20 azimuths was 5 degrees 20 minutes west. The wind was coming from the east-northeast; the course was north 15 degrees west; the distance traveled was 84 miles; latitude was 27 degrees 22 minutes north, longitude was 43 degrees 42 minutes west.

Saturday, 8th. Moderate breezes and Pleasant weather. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 5 degrees 24 minutes West. By the Observation of the Sun and Moon the Longitude of the Ship at Noon was 43 degrees 42 minutes West. Wind Easterly; course North; distance 88 miles; latitude 28 degrees 50 minutes North, longitude 43 degrees 42 minutes West.

Saturday, 8th. Moderate breezes and pleasant weather. In the morning, the variation was found to be 5 degrees 24 minutes West. By observing the sun and moon, the ship's longitude at noon was 43 degrees 42 minutes West. Wind was coming from the east; course was north; distance traveled was 88 miles; latitude was 28 degrees 50 minutes North, longitude was 43 degrees 42 minutes West.

Sunday, 9th. Clear, pleasant weather and a Smooth Sea. In the A.M. found the Variation to be 7 degrees 33 minutes West. Some Tropick birds flying about the Ship; we have seen of these birds every day since we passed the Tropick. Wind Ditto; course North by West 1/2 West; distance 81 miles; latitude 30 degrees 11 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 9 minutes West.

Sunday, 9th. Clear, nice weather and a calm sea. In the morning, we discovered the variation to be 7 degrees 33 minutes west. We spotted some tropic birds flying around the ship; we've seen these birds every day since we passed the tropic. Wind same; course north by west 1/2 west; distance 81 miles; latitude 30 degrees 11 minutes north, longitude 44 degrees 9 minutes west.

Monday, 10th. Little wind and Clear weather. Exercised the people at Small Arms. Wind Ditto; course North 30 degrees West; distance 71 miles; latitude 31 degrees 12 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 50 minutes West.

Monday, 10th. Little wind and clear weather. Trained the crew with small arms. Wind the same; heading North 30 degrees West; distance 71 miles; latitude 31 degrees 12 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 50 minutes West.

Tuesday, 11th. Ditto weather. A Smooth Sea. Wind North-East by East; course North 18 minutes West; distance 67 miles; latitude 32 degrees 16 North, longitude 45 degrees 14 minutes West.

Tuesday, 11th. Same weather. A calm sea. Wind from the North-East by East; heading North 18 minutes West; distance 67 miles; latitude 32 degrees 16 North, longitude 45 degrees 14 minutes West.

Wednesday, 12th. Light breezes and clear weather. Variation by the Amplitude in the Evening 7 degrees 0 minutes West, and by Azimuth in the Morning 6 degrees 55 minutes West. Exercised Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind East by South; course North-North-East; distance 48 miles; latitude 33 degrees 8 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 53 minutes West.

Wednesday, 12th. Light breezes and clear skies. Variation by the Amplitude in the Evening 7 degrees 0 minutes West, and by Azimuth in the Morning 6 degrees 55 minutes West. Practiced with Great Guns and Small Arms. Wind East by South; course North-North-East; distance 48 miles; latitude 33 degrees 8 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 53 minutes West.

Thursday, 13th. Little wind and pleasant weather. Found the Variation by the Amplitude in the Evening to be 8 degrees 23 minutes; in the Morning 8 degrees 15 minutes, and by Azimuth soon after 8 degrees 14 minutes West. Wind Ditto; Course North by East 1/2 East; distance 77 miles; latitude 34 degrees 14 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 25 minutes West.

Thursday, 13th. There was little wind and nice weather. In the evening, I found the variation using amplitude to be 8 degrees 23 minutes; in the morning, it was 8 degrees 15 minutes, and by azimuth shortly after, it was about 8 degrees 14 minutes west. The wind was the same; we headed North by East 1/2 East, covering a distance of 77 miles; latitude 34 degrees 14 minutes North, longitude 44 degrees 25 minutes West.

Friday, 14th. A Gentle Gale, and pleasant weather. In the A.M. saw 2 Turtle laying a Sleep upon the water. Wind East-South-East; course North 18 degrees East; distance 99 miles; latitude 35 degrees 48 minutes North, longitude 43 degrees 48 minutes West.

Friday, 14th. A light breeze and nice weather. In the morning, saw 2 turtles resting on the water. Wind East-South-East; course North 18 degrees East; distance 99 miles; latitude 35 degrees 48 minutes North, longitude 43 degrees 48 minutes West.

Saturday, 15th. Ditto Weather at Daylight. In the Morning saw a Sloop to Windward standing to the Eastward, which we run out of sight by Noon. Wind South-East; course North-East 1/2 East; distance 119 miles; latitude 37 degrees 2 minutes North, longitude 41 degrees 54 minutes West.

Saturday, 15th. Similar weather at dawn. In the morning, I saw a sloop off to the windward heading east, which we lost sight of by noon. Wind from the southeast; course northeast 1/2 east; distance 119 miles; latitude 37 degrees 2 minutes north, longitude 41 degrees 54 minutes west.

Sunday, 16th. A Steady breeze and pleasant weather, with some rain in the Night. At daylight in the Morning saw a Sail a head, which we came up and spoke with a little after 10 o'clock. She proved a Portoguee Ship from Rio de Janeiro, bound to Lisbon. Wind Ditto; course North-East 1/2 East; distance 119 miles; latitude 38 degrees 18 minutes North, longitude 40 degrees 38 minutes West.

Sunday, 16th. A steady breeze and nice weather, with some rain at night. At dawn in the morning, we spotted a sail ahead, which we reached and talked to a little after 10 o'clock. It turned out to be a Portuguese ship from Rio de Janeiro, heading to Lisbon. Wind was the same; course North-East 1/2 East; distance 119 miles; latitude 38 degrees 18 minutes North, longitude 40 degrees 38 minutes West.

Monday, 17th. Steady, Gentle Gales and pleasant weather. Variation in the Evening 9 degrees West. Wind South-South-East; course North 68 degrees East; distance 104 miles; latitude 38 degrees 57 minutes North, longitude 38 degrees 36 minutes West.

Monday, 17th. Steady, gentle winds and nice weather. Variation in the evening 9 degrees West. Wind from the South-South-East; course North 68 degrees East; distance 104 miles; latitude 38 degrees 57 minutes North, longitude 38 degrees 36 minutes West.

Tuesday, 18th. Little wind, and clear weather. At 2 p.m. found the Ship to be by Observation 1 degree 22 minutes to the Westward of Account carried on from the last Observation; in the Evening the Variation was 14 degrees 15 minutes West, and in the Morning 14 degrees 24 minutes. Wind South; course North 66 degrees East; distance 82 miles; latitude 39 degrees 52 minutes North, longitude 36 degrees 59 minutes West.

Tuesday, 18th. There was little wind and clear weather. At 2 p.m., the ship was observed to be 1 degree 22 minutes west of the position recorded from the last observation. In the evening, the variation was 14 degrees 15 minutes west, and in the morning it was 14 degrees 24 minutes. The wind was from the south; we were heading north 66 degrees east; the distance covered was 82 miles; our latitude was 39 degrees 52 minutes north, and longitude was 36 degrees 59 minutes west.

Wednesday, 19th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. At 2 p.m. found by observation the same Error in our Longitude as Yesterday, which I have now corrected. The Longitude of this day is that resulting from Observation. At 10 A.M. saw a Sail a head, which we soon came up with, and sent a Boat on board. She was a Schooner from Rhoad Island out upon the Whale fishery. From her we learnt that all was peace in Europe, and that the America Disputes were made up; to confirm this the Master said that the Coat on his back was made in old England. Soon after leaving this Vessel we spoke another from Boston, and saw a third, all out on the same account. Wind South to South-West; course North 73 degrees East; distance 127 miles; latitude 40 degrees 9 minutes North, longitude 36 degrees 44 minutes West.

Wednesday, 19th. Fresh winds and cloudy. At 2 p.m., I checked our Longitude and found the same error as yesterday, which I've now corrected. The Longitude for today is based on that observation. At 10 A.M., we spotted a sail ahead, which we quickly approached and sent a boat over. It was a schooner from Rhode Island out for whaling. From her, we learned that all was peaceful in Europe and that the disputes in America were settled; to confirm this, the captain said that the coat he was wearing was made in old England. Shortly after leaving this vessel, we spoke to another one from Boston and saw a third, all out for the same reason. Wind was from the South to South-West; course was North 73 degrees East; distance was 127 miles; latitude was 40 degrees 9 minutes North, longitude was 36 degrees 44 minutes West.

Thursday, 20th. Fresh Gales and Cloudy, with some Showers of rain. At day light in the Morning saw a Sail ahead standing to the East. A Swell from the North-North-West. Wind South-West, North-West, North; course North 80 1/2 degrees East; distance 121 miles; latitude 40 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude 33 degrees 10 minutes West.

Thursday, 20th. Fresh winds and cloudy, with some rain showers. At dawn in the morning, I saw a sail ahead heading east. There was a swell from the north-northwest. Wind from the southwest, northwest, north; course 80.5 degrees east; distance 121 miles; latitude 40 degrees 29 minutes north, longitude 33 degrees 10 minutes west.

Friday, 21st. Fresh Gales and Cloudy. In the P.M. saw a Sail astern standing to the South-East, and at 11 o'Clock A.M. saw from the Mast head 13 Sail of Stout Ships, which we took to be the East India Fleet. Wind Northerly; course East by North; distance 128 miles; latitude 40 degrees 33 minutes North, longitude 30 degrees 20 minutes West.

Friday, 21st. Strong winds and cloudy. In the afternoon, I spotted a sail behind us heading Southeast, and at 11:00 A.M. I saw from the masthead 13 large ships, which we assumed were part of the East India Fleet. Wind was from the north; course was East by North; distance traveled was 128 miles; latitude was 40 degrees 33 minutes North, longitude was 30 degrees 20 minutes West.

Saturday, 22nd. Fresh Gales, with Squalls, attended with rain. In the Evening had 14 Sail in sight, 13 upon our lee Quarter, and a Snow upon our lee Bow. In the Night split both Topgallant Sails so much that they were obliged to be unbent to repair. In the Morning the Carpenter reported the Maintopmast to be Sprung in the Cap, which we supposed hapned in the P.M., when both the Weather Backstays broke. Our Rigging and Sails are now so bad that something or another is giving way every day. At Noon had 13 Sail in sight, which we are well assured are the India Fleet, and are all now upon our Weather Quarter. Wind North to North-East; course North 81 degrees East; distance 114 miles; latitude 41 degrees 11 minutes, longitude 27 degrees 52 minutes West.

Saturday, 22nd. Fresh winds with squalls and rain. In the evening, we saw 14 ships, 13 on our left side and a snow on our front left. During the night, we tore both topgallant sails so badly that we had to take them down for repairs. In the morning, the carpenter reported that the maintopmast had a crack at the cap, which we think happened in the afternoon when both weather backstays snapped. Our rigging and sails are in such poor shape that something seems to break every day. At noon, we spotted 13 ships, which we’re pretty sure belong to the India fleet, all now on our right side. Wind is from the north to northeast; course is 81 degrees east; distance traveled is 114 miles; latitude is 41 degrees 11 minutes, longitude is 27 degrees 52 minutes west.

Sunday, 23rd. Fresh Gales and Squally, attended with Showers of rain. In the Evening all the Fleet were to Windward of us, and in the Morning not one was to be seen. Wind North-East by North to East-North-East; course South 69 1/2 degrees East; distance 80 miles; latitude 40 degrees 43 minutes North, longitude 26 degrees 13 minutes West.

Sunday, 23rd. Strong winds and squalls, with occasional rain showers. In the evening, the entire fleet was upwind of us, while in the morning, not a single ship was in sight. Wind coming from North-East by North to East-North-East; heading South 69 1/2 degrees East; distance covered 80 miles; latitude 40 degrees 43 minutes North, longitude 26 degrees 13 minutes West.

Monday, 24th. First part, moderate breezes; remainder, Squally. At Noon Tack'd. Wind North-East to East-South-East; course South 82 degrees East; distance 64 miles; latitude 40 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 24 degrees 49 minutes West.

Monday, 24th. First part of the day, moderate breezes; the rest, squally. At noon, we tacked. Wind was from North-East to East-South-East; course was South 82 degrees East; distance covered was 64 miles; latitude 40 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 24 degrees 49 minutes West.

Tuesday, 25th. First part and remainder a fresh breeze and Cloudy. Wind North-East to North-North-East; course South 85 degrees East; distance 58 miles; latitude 40 degrees 39 minutes North, longitude 23 degrees 33 minutes West.

Tuesday, 25th. First part and remainder a fresh breeze and cloudy. Wind northeast to north-northeast; course south 85 degrees east; distance 58 miles; latitude 40 degrees 39 minutes north, longitude 23 degrees 33 minutes west.

Wednesday, 26th. First part, breezes; remainder, little wind. Wind North by East; course North 86 degrees 45 minutes East; distance 72 miles; latitude 40 degrees 43 minutes North, longitude 21 degrees 58 minutes West.

Wednesday, 26th. In the beginning, there were light breezes; for the rest of the day, there was little wind. The wind was coming from the North by East; we headed on a course of North 86 degrees 45 minutes East; we covered a distance of 72 miles; our latitude was 40 degrees 43 minutes North, and longitude was 21 degrees 58 minutes West.

Thursday, 27th. Moderate breezes and Cloudy weather. Wind Westerly; course North 54 minutes East; distance 54 miles; latitude 41 degrees 14 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 59 minutes West.

Thursday, 27th. Mild breezes and cloudy weather. Wind from the west; course North 54 minutes East; distance 54 miles; latitude 41 degrees 14 minutes North, longitude 20 degrees 59 minutes West.

Friday, 28th. Fresh breezes, with Showers of Rain. Wind West to North-North-West; course North 38 degrees East; distance 123 miles; latitude 42 degrees 55 minutes North, longitude 19 degrees 18 minutes West.

Friday, 28th. Fresh breezes with rain showers. Wind from the West to North-North-West; heading North 38 degrees East; distance 123 miles; latitude 42 degrees 55 minutes North, longitude 19 degrees 18 minutes West.

Saturday, 29th. First part, little wind; remainder, Fresh Gales and Squally, with Showers of Rain. Wind South-West to West and North-East; course North 59 degrees 15 minutes East; distance 86 miles; latitude 43 degrees 39 minutes North, longitude 17 degrees 36 minutes West.

Saturday, 29th. In the beginning, there was a light wind; for the rest of the day, it turned into fresh gales and squalls, with some rain showers. The wind shifted from the South-West to the West and North-East; our course was North 59 degrees 15 minutes East; we traveled 86 miles; latitude 43 degrees 39 minutes North, longitude 17 degrees 36 minutes West.

Sunday, 30th. Gentle breezes and fair weather. Variation in the Evening 18 degrees 30 minutes West, and in the Morning 19 degrees 30 minutes. Wind Northerly; course North 50 degrees 45 minutes East; distance 87 miles; latitude 44 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 16 degrees 2 minutes West.

Sunday, 30th. Light breezes and nice weather. In the Evening, variation is 18 degrees 30 minutes West, and in the Morning, it’s 19 degrees 30 minutes. The wind is coming from the North; the course is North 50 degrees 45 minutes East; the distance covered is 87 miles; the latitude is 44 degrees 34 minutes North, and the longitude is 16 degrees 2 minutes West.

[July 1771.]

[July 1771.]

Monday, July 1st. Ditto weather. In the Night passed 2 Sail Standing to the South-West. Wind Ditto; course North 77 degrees 15 minutes East; distance 90 miles; latitude 44 degrees 54 minutes North, longitude 13 degrees 59 minutes West.

Monday, July 1st. Same weather as before. During the night, we passed 2 ships heading to the southwest. The wind was the same; we were on a course of North 77 degrees 15 minutes East; traveled 90 miles; latitude 44 degrees 54 minutes North, longitude 13 degrees 59 minutes West.

Tuesday, 2nd. Little wind and Cloudy, hazey weather. One Sail in Sight to the North-East. Wind Ditto; course East; distance 42 miles; latitude 45 degrees 54 minutes North, longitude 13 degrees 2 minutes West.

Tuesday, 2nd. Little wind and cloudy, hazy weather. One sail in sight to the northeast. Wind the same; course east; distance 42 miles; latitude 45 degrees 54 minutes north, longitude 13 degrees 2 minutes west.

Wednesday, 3rd. Little wind and pleasant weather. At 9 A.M. found the Ship by Observation of the Sun and Moon 1 degree 14 minutes East of Account. Six Sail in Sight. Wind North and North-West; course North 56 degrees East; distance 54 miles; latitude 45 degrees 24 minutes North, longitude 11 degrees 59 minutes West per Log, 10 degrees 45 minutes per Observation.

Wednesday, 3rd. There was little wind and nice weather. At 9 A.M. I found the ship by observing the sun and moon, 1 degree 14 minutes east of what we had on record. I spotted six sails. The wind was coming from the north and northwest; we were heading north 56 degrees east; our distance covered was 54 miles; latitude was 45 degrees 24 minutes north, longitude was 11 degrees 59 minutes west according to the log, and 10 degrees 45 minutes according to observation.

Thursday, 4th. Gentle breezes and Cloudy weather. Variation per Azimuth and Amplitude in the Evening 21 degrees 25 1/2 West, and in the Morning 20 degrees 10 minutes West. Wind West, North, and North-East; course South 85 degrees East; distance 55 miles; latitude 45 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees 44 minutes West per Log, 9 degrees 27 minutes per Observation.

Thursday, 4th. Light breezes and cloudy weather. Variation by azimuth and amplitude in the evening was 21 degrees 25 1/2 West, and in the morning, 20 degrees 10 minutes West. Winds came from the West, North, and Northeast; course was South 85 degrees East; distance covered was 55 miles; latitude was 45 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude was 10 degrees 44 minutes West according to the log, 9 degrees 27 minutes per observation.

Friday, 5th. Little wind and Cloudy. At 1 P.M. spoke a Dutch Galliot bound to Riga. At 5 Tack't, and stood to the Westward till 8 a.m., then to the Eastward. Wind North-East; course North 50 degrees East; distance 8 miles; latitude 45 degrees 34 minutes North, longitude 10 degrees 32 minutes West per Log, 9 degrees 18 minutes per Observation.

Friday, 5th. Little wind and cloudy. At 1 PM, I spoke to a Dutch Galliot heading to Riga. At 5, I turned and headed west until 8 AM, then I changed course to the east. Wind coming from the northeast; course north 50 degrees east; distance 8 miles; latitude 45 degrees 34 minutes north, longitude 10 degrees 32 minutes west per log, 9 degrees 18 minutes per observation.

Saturday, 6th. Gentle breezes and Cloudy. At 1 p.m. sent a Boat on board a Brig belonging to Boston, last from Gibraltar, and bound to Falmouth. Wind North-North-East; course North 72 degrees 30 minutes East; distance 37 miles; latitude 44 degrees 45 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 42 minutes West per Log, 8 degrees 28 minutes per Observation.

Saturday, 6th. Light breezes and cloudy. At 1 p.m., I sent a boat to a brig from Boston, which had just come from Gibraltar and was headed to Falmouth. The wind was blowing from the north-north-east; we were on a course of North 72 degrees 30 minutes East; the distance traveled was 37 miles; latitude was 44 degrees 45 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 42 minutes West according to the log, 8 degrees 28 minutes according to observation.

Sunday, 7th. Gentle breezes and Clear weather. In the Evening found the Variation by the Amplitude to be 22 degrees 30 minutes West. At 9 A.M. Spoke a Brig from Liverpool bound to Porto, and some time after another from London, bound to the Granades. She had been 3 days from Scilly, and reckoned herself in the Longitude of about 10 minutes West, which was about 40 minutes to the Westward of what we found ourselves to-day by Observation. We learnt from this Vessel that no account had been received in England from us, and that Wagers were held that we were lost. It seems highly improbable that the Letters sent by the Dutch Ships from Batavia should not come to hand, as it is now 5 months since these Ships sail'd from the Cape of Good Hope. Wind North-North-East and North-West; course North 50 degrees East; distance 49 miles; latitude 46 degrees 16 minutes North, longitude 9 degrees 39 minutes West per Account, 9 degrees 29 minutes per Observation.

Sunday, 7th. Gentle breezes and clear weather. In the evening, we found the variation by the amplitude to be 22 degrees 30 minutes west. At 9 A.M., we spoke to a brig from Liverpool heading to Porto, and a little later, another one from London, headed to the Grenadines. It had been 3 days since it left Scilly, and it estimated its longitude at about 10 minutes west, which was about 40 minutes west of what we determined today by observation. We learned from this vessel that no word had been received in England from us, and people were betting that we were lost. It seems very unlikely that the letters sent by the Dutch ships from Batavia haven't arrived, as it has now been 5 months since those ships left the Cape of Good Hope. Wind from the north-north-east and north-west; course north 50 degrees east; distance 49 miles; latitude 46 degrees 16 minutes north, longitude 9 degrees 39 minutes west according to the account, 9 degrees 29 minutes by observation.

Monday, 8th. Little wind and hazey weather. Swell from the Northward. Wind North-North-West to South-West; course North 46 degrees 45 minutes East; distance 43 miles; latitude 46 degrees 45 minutes North, longitude 8 degrees 54 minutes West.

Monday, 8th. Light wind and hazy weather. Swell coming from the north. Wind from North-North-West to South-West; course heading North 46 degrees 45 minutes East; distance traveled 43 miles; latitude 46 degrees 45 minutes North, longitude 8 degrees 54 minutes West.

Tuesday, 9th. Fore and middle parts a Gentle breeze, and thick, Foggy weather; remainder, a fresh Breeze and Cloudy. A swell from the North-North-West all day. Wind South Westerly; course North 21 degrees East; distance 100 miles; latitude 48 degrees 19 minutes North, longitude 8 degrees 1 minute West per Account, 8 degrees 7 minutes per Observation.

Tuesday, 9th. The front and middle sections had a light breeze and thick foggy conditions; the rest of the day saw a fresh breeze and cloudy skies. There was a swell coming from the North-North-West all day. The wind was blowing from the southwest; our course was North 21 degrees East; we covered a distance of 100 miles; our latitude was 48 degrees 19 minutes North and longitude was 8 degrees 1 minute West according to records, and 8 degrees 7 minutes according to observation.

Wednesday, 10th. Pleasant breezes and Clear weather. At 6 o'Clock in the Morning sounded, and Struck ground in 60 fathoms Shells and Stones, by which I judged we were the length of Scilly Isles. At Noon we saw land from the Mast Head, bearing North, which we judged to be about the Land's End. Soundings 54 fathoms, Coarse, Grey Sand. Wind Westerly; course North 44 degrees East; distance 97 miles; latitude 49 degrees 29 minutes North, longitude 6 degrees 18 minutes West.

Wednesday, 10th. Pleasant breezes and clear weather. At 6 AM, we sounded and hit the ground at 60 fathoms of shells and stones, indicating we were near the Scilly Isles. At noon, we spotted land from the masthead, heading north, which we thought was around the Land's End. Soundings were at 54 fathoms, with coarse grey sand. The wind was coming from the west; our course was north 44 degrees east; distance traveled was 97 miles; latitude was 49 degrees 29 minutes north, longitude 6 degrees 18 minutes west.

Friday, 11th. Steady fresh breezes and clear weather. At 2 in the P.M. saw the Lizardland, and at 6 o'clock the lighthouse bore North-West, distant 5 Leagues, we being at this time, by my reckoning, in the Longitude of 5 degrees 30 minutes West; soon after 2 Ships under their Topsails between us and the land, which we took for Men of War. At 7 o'clock in the morning the Start Point bore North-West by North, distant 3 Leagues, and at Noon we reckon'd ourselves about 5 Leagues short of Portland. This Forenoon a small cutter built vessel came under our Stern, and inquir'd after the India Fleet, which, they said, they were cruizing for and had not seen.

Friday, the 11th. We had steady fresh breezes and clear skies. At 2 PM, we spotted the Lizardland, and by 6 o'clock, the lighthouse was northwest of us, about 5 leagues away. At that moment, I estimated our position to be at a longitude of 5 degrees and 30 minutes west. Shortly after, we saw 2 ships under their topsails between us and the land, which we assumed were warships. At 7 o'clock in the morning, the Start Point was northwest by north, about 3 leagues away, and at noon, we figured we were around 5 leagues short of Portland. This morning, a small cutter-type vessel came up behind us and asked about the India Fleet, saying they were patrolling for it and hadn't seen any.

Friday, 12th. Winds at South-West, a fresh Gale, with which we run briskly up Channel. At 1/2 past 3 p.m. passed the Bill of Portland, and at 7 Peverell Point; at 6 a.m. passed Beachy head at the distance of 4 or 5 miles; at 10 Dungeness, at the distance of 2 miles, and at Noon we were abreast of Dover.

Friday, 12th. Winds from the Southwest, a strong breeze, which helped us move quickly up the Channel. At 3:30 p.m., we passed the Bill of Portland, and at 7 we went by Peverell Point; at 6 a.m., we passed Beachy Head, about 4 or 5 miles away; at 10, we reached Dungeness, about 2 miles away, and at noon we were right across from Dover.

Saturday, 13th. At 3 o'clock in the P.M. anchor'd in the Downs, and soon after I landed in order to repair to London.

Saturday, 13th. At 3 o'clock in the afternoon, I dropped anchor in the Downs, and shortly after, I landed to make my way to London.

(Signed) JAMs COOK.

(Signed) James Cook.

POSTCRIPT.

I HAVE made mention in Book 1st,* (* The Journal was written in thin books, afterwards bound together in England. The page given here is of this published copy.) page 76, of 2 Spanish Ships touching at Georges Island some months before our Arrival there. Upon our arrival at Batavia we were inform'd that 2 French Ships, commanded by the Sieur de Bougainville, had put in there about 2 years before us in their way home from the South Seas. We were told many Circumstances relating to the 2 Ships, all tending to prove beyond a doubt that they were the same 2 as were at George's Island as above mentioned, which we then conjectur'd to be Spaniards, being lead into that mistake by the Spanish Iron, etc., we saw among the Natives, and by Toobouratomita pitching upon the Colours of that Nation for those they wore, in which he might very easily be mistaken; but as to the Iron, etc., there might be no mistake, for we were told that either one or both of these Ships had put into the River de la Plata, where they disposed of all their European goods brought for that purpose, and purchased others to Trade with the Islanders in the South Sea; and I think we were told that they also touched upon the Spanish Main in the South Sea. As a proof of their having been trading with the Spaniards, Bougainville's Ship had on board a great Quantity of Spanish Dollars at the time she arrived at and left Batavia, some days after our arrival at the Cape of Good Hope. I was told by some French Officers, lately come from the Island Mauritius, that Orette, the Native of George's Island which Bougainville brought away with him, was now at the Maritius, and that they were going to fit out a Ship to carry him to his Native country, where they intend to make a Settlement; 100 Troops for that purpose were to go out in the same Ship. This account is confirmed by a French Gentleman we have on board, who has very lately been at the Maritius.* (* This intention was never carried out.) As I have no reason to doubt the truth of this account, it leads me to consider the rout that this Ship must take, which I think can be no other than that of Tasmans as far as the Coast of New Zeland; and if she fall in with that Coast to the Southward of Cape Farewell will very probably put into Admiralty Bay, or Queen Charlotte's sound, as Tasman's track will in some measure point out to her one or the other of these places. I think it is not likely she will venture through the Strait, even suppose she discovers it, but will follow Tasman's Track to the North Cape, where no doubt she will leave him, and follow the direction of the Coast to the South-East, as it will not be out of her way; by which means she will fall in with the most fertile part of that Country, and as they cannot know anything of the Endeavour's voyage, they will not hesitate a moment to declare themselves the first discoverers. Indeed, I cannot see how they can think otherwise, unless the Natives inform them to the contrary, which they may not choose to understand. The French Officers before spoke of would not allow that George's Island was first discover'd by the Dolphin, though no doubt Bougainville did; but it was not for the Interest of his Country, nor perhaps his own, to own it. Thus this Island, though of little value, may prove a Bone of Contention between the 2 Nations, especially if the French make a Settlement upon it, and the Dolphin's voyage, and this of ours, published by Authority to fix the prior right of discovery beyond disputes.

I mentioned in Book 1,* (* The Journal was written in small books, later compiled in England. The page shown here is from this published copy.) page 76, that two Spanish ships had stopped at Georges Island a few months before we got there. When we arrived in Batavia, we learned that two French ships, commanded by Sieur de Bougainville, had also been there about two years before us on their way home from the South Seas. We heard many details about these two ships, all suggesting they were the same ones that were at Georges Island as I previously mentioned, which we initially thought were Spanish. We were misled by the Spanish iron and other items we saw with the locals, and by Toobouratomita choosing the colors of that nation for their attire, which could easily lead to confusion. However, regarding the iron, we were informed that one or both of these ships had docked in the River de la Plata, where they sold all their European goods for that purpose and bought items to trade with the islanders in the South Sea. We were also informed that they might have made a stop at the Spanish Main in the South Sea. To prove they were trading with the Spaniards, Bougainville’s ship had a large amount of Spanish dollars when it reached and left Batavia, a few days after we arrived at the Cape of Good Hope. Some French officers, who had recently come from Mauritius, told me that Orette, a native of Georges Island whom Bougainville took with him, was now in Mauritius, and they were planning to send a ship to take him back to his homeland, where they intended to establish a settlement; 100 troops were to accompany him on that ship. This information was confirmed by a French gentleman aboard who had recently been to Mauritius.* (* This plan was never executed.) I have no reason to doubt the accuracy of this information, which makes me think about the route this ship must take, which I believe will follow Tasman's course towards the coast of New Zealand. If it encounters that coast south of Cape Farewell, it will likely anchor in Admiralty Bay or Queen Charlotte's Sound, as Tasman's route will guide it to one of those locations. I think it’s unlikely that the ship will navigate through the Strait, even if it discovers it, but it will follow Tasman's path to the North Cape, from where it will track along the coast to the southeast, which won’t be out of its way. This route would lead it to the most fertile part of that country, and since they wouldn't know anything about the Endeavour's voyage, they would not hesitate to claim they were the first discoverers. Honestly, I don't see how they could think otherwise unless the natives inform them otherwise, which they might not fully grasp. The French officers I mentioned previously would not acknowledge that Georges Island was first discovered by the Dolphin, although Bougainville surely thought otherwise; however, it wasn't in the interest of his country, or perhaps himself, to admit it. Therefore, this island, though of little worth, could become a point of contention between the two nations, especially if the French decide to settle there, and the Dolphin's voyage, along with ours, would be published by authorities to establish the prior right of discovery without dispute.

Now I am upon the Subject of discoveries, I hope it will not be taken amiss if I give it as my opinion that the most feasable method of making further discoveries in the South Sea is to enter it by the way of New Zeland, first touching and refreshing at the Cape of Good Hope; from thence proceed to the Southward of New Holland for Queen Charlotte's Sound, where again refresh Wood and water, taking care to be ready to leave that place by the latter end of September, or beginning of October at farthest, when you would have the whole Summer before you, and after getting through the Strait, might, with the prevailing Westerly Winds, run to the Eastward in as high a Latitude as you please, and if you meet with no lands would have time enough to get round Cape Horne before the Summer was too far spent; but if after meeting with no Continent, and you had other objects in view, then haul to the Northward, and after visiting some of the Islands already discovered, after which proceed with the trade wind back to the Westward in search of those before mentioned--thus the discoveries in the South Sea would be compleat.* (* This programme Cook carried out in his second voyage in the most complete manner possible.)

Now that I’m on the topic of discoveries, I hope it’s not seen as out of place if I share my opinion that the best way to make further discoveries in the South Sea is to enter it via New Zealand, first stopping at the Cape of Good Hope for supplies; from there, head south of New Holland to Queen Charlotte's Sound, where you can restock on wood and water. Make sure to be ready to leave that location by the end of September or early October at the latest, giving you the entire summer ahead of you. Once you pass through the Strait, you could take advantage of the prevailing westerly winds to head east at any latitude you choose. If you don’t encounter any land, you should have enough time to get around Cape Horn before summer ends. However, if you don’t find any continent and have other objectives in mind, then head north, visit some of the previously discovered islands, and then use the trade winds to return west in search of those mentioned earlier—this way, the discoveries in the South Sea would be complete.* (* This plan was executed by Cook during his second voyage in the most thorough manner possible.)


INDEX.

Admiralty, Letters to, 357, 379.

Admiralty, Letters to, 357, 379.

Agulhas:
Cape, 375.
Current, 373.

Agulhas:
Cape, 375.
Current, 373.

Albatrosses, 46, 47, 128.

Albatrosses, 46, 47, 128.

Anchors, Loss of, 276, 327.

Anchors, Loss of, 276, 327.

Anchor-stocks eaten by worms, 86.

Anchor stocks consumed by worms, 86.

Arru Islands, 336.

Arru Islands, 336.

Ascension Island, 387.

Ascension Island, 387.

AUSTRALIA, EAST COAST OF:
Animals, 318.
Appearance of, 252, 265, 267, 272, 294, 317.
Bedford, Cape, 292.
Birds, 318.
Booby Island, 314.
Botany Bay, 242 to 248.
Bustard Bay, 258, 260.
Canoes, 243, 321.
Capricorn, Cape, 260.
Cleveland Bay, 270.
Cook's Passage, 301.
Cornwall, Cape, 313.
Damage to ship, 280, 281, 284.
Danger Point, 253.
Danger, Ships in, 253, 254, 262, 263, 267, 274, 278, 279, 303, 328.
Dangerous navigation through the reefs, 306 to 310.
  Description of, 317.
Dromedary, Mount and Point, 239.
Endeavour Reef, 274, 276.
Endeavour River, 279.
  Sail from, 292.
  Description of, 293.
Endeavour Strait, 313.
  Description of, 314.
Exploration, Remarks on, 305.
First attempts at landing, 242.
Fish, 318.
Flattery, Cape, 297.
Fruits, 318.
Glass houses, 254.
Gloucester, Cape, 269.
Grafton, Cape, 273.
Grenville, Cape, 307.
Hicks Point, 237.
Hillsborough, Cape, 267.
Historical notes, 325.
Hope Islands, 277.
Houses, 321.
Howe, Cape, 238.
Jackson Port, 249.
Jervis Bay, 241.
Kangaroo, 280, 281, 287, 291, 294.
Language, 322.
Lizard island, 298.
Lookout Point, 298.
Magnetic Island, 271.
Moreton Bay, 254.
Natives, 239, 242, 244, 245, 248, 272, 286, 287, 288, 289, 290, 311, 312,
319, 320, 323.
New South Wales, name bestowed, 312.
Palmerston, Cape, 267.
Pigeon House, 239.
Possession Island, 311.
Providential Channel, 304.
Rays (fish), 247, 291, 295.
Rockingham Bay, 272.
Sandy Cape, 256.
Ship aground, 274 to 276, 279.
Ship beached for repair, 280.
Sighted, 237.
Smoky Cape, 251.
Stephens Port, 250.
Thirsty Sound, 264.
Tides, Observations on, 267, 268, 312, 324.
Timber, 318.
Torres Straits, Doubts of existence of, 301, 302, 306, 314, 335.
Townshend, Cape, 263.
Tribulation, Cape, 274.
Upstart, Cape, 270.
Weapons, 320.
Weymouth, Cape, 306.
Whitsunday Passage, 269. York, Cape, 310.

AUSTRALIA, EAST COAST OF:
Animals, 318.
Appearance of, 252, 265, 267, 272, 294, 317.
Bedford, Cape, 292.
Birds, 318.
Booby Island, 314.
Botany Bay, 242 to 248.
Bustard Bay, 258, 260.
Canoes, 243, 321.
Capricorn, Cape, 260.
Cleveland Bay, 270.
Cook's Passage, 301.
Cornwall, Cape, 313.
Damage to ship, 280, 281, 284.
Danger Point, 253.
Danger, Ships in, 253, 254, 262, 263, 267, 274, 278, 279, 303, 328.
Dangerous navigation through the reefs, 306 to 310.
  Description of, 317.
Dromedary, Mount and Point, 239.
Endeavour Reef, 274, 276.
Endeavour River, 279.
  Sail from, 292.
  Description of, 293.
Endeavour Strait, 313.
  Description of, 314.
Exploration, Remarks on, 305.
First attempts at landing, 242.
Fish, 318.
Flattery, Cape, 297.
Fruits, 318.
Glass houses, 254.
Gloucester, Cape, 269.
Grafton, Cape, 273.
Grenville, Cape, 307.
Hicks Point, 237.
Hillsborough, Cape, 267.
Historical notes, 325.
Hope Islands, 277.
Houses, 321.
Howe, Cape, 238.
Jackson Port, 249.
Jervis Bay, 241.
Kangaroo, 280, 281, 287, 291, 294.
Language, 322.
Lizard island, 298.
Lookout Point, 298.
Magnetic Island, 271.
Moreton Bay, 254.
Natives, 239, 242, 244, 245, 248, 272, 286, 287, 288, 289, 290, 311, 312,
319, 320, 323.
New South Wales, name bestowed, 312.
Palmerston, Cape, 267.
Pigeon House, 239.
Possession Island, 311.
Providential Channel, 304.
Rays (fish), 247, 291, 295.
Rockingham Bay, 272.
Sandy Cape, 256.
Ship aground, 274 to 276, 279.
Ship beached for repair, 280.
Sighted, 237.
Smoky Cape, 251.
Stephens Port, 250.
Thirsty Sound, 264.
Tides, Observations on, 267, 268, 312, 324.
Timber, 318.
Torres Straits, Doubts of existence of, 301, 302, 306, 314, 335.
Townshend, Cape, 263.
Tribulation, Cape, 274.
Upstart, Cape, 270.
Weapons, 320.
Weymouth, Cape, 306.
Whitsunday Passage, 269.
York, Cape, 310.

Banks, Mr., 2, 19, 38, 61, 63, 65, 72, 75, 76, 79, 81, 82, 87, 88, 111, 114, 115, 128, 130, 140, 165, 167, 184, 186, 200, 217, 225, 242, 245, 247, 259, 285, 288, 298, 311, 329, 332, 362, 377, 382.

Banks, Mr., 2, 19, 38, 61, 63, 65, 72, 75, 76, 79, 81, 82, 87, 88, 111, 114, 115, 128, 130, 140, 165, 167, 184, 186, 200, 217, 225, 242, 245, 247, 259, 285, 288, 298, 311, 329, 332, 362, 377, 382.


Batavia, 353 to 364:
Description of, 363. Sickly climate of, 359, 362, 364, 372.

Batavia, 353 to 364:
Overview of, 363. Unhealthy climate of, 359, 362, 364, 372.

Boats, Preservation of, 74.

Boats, Preservation of, 74.

Bolabola:
Description of, 117.
Passed, 113.

Bolabola:
Description of, 117.
Passed, 113.

Boobies, 257, 314, 336, 378.

Boobs, 257, 314, 336, 378.

Boot-topping, 19.

Boot-topping, 19.

Bougainville, 314:
His visit to Tahiti, 72, 76, 101, 314, 395.

Bougainville, 314:
His trip to Tahiti, 72, 76, 101, 314, 395.

Bow island, 56.

Bow Island, 56.

Buchan, Mr., Artist, Death of, 64.

Buchan, Mr., Artist, Death of, 64.

Canoes:
Australian, 243, 321.
New Zealand, 221, 222.
Society Islands, 118.
Tahiti, 97.
Voyages in, 119, 121.

Canoes:
Australia, 243, 321.
New Zealand, 221, 222.
Society Islands, 118.
Tahiti, 97.
Trips in, 119, 121.

Cape Colony, Remarks on, 382.

Cape Colony, Comments on, 382.

Cape Pigeons. See Pintado Birds.

Cape Pigeons. See Pintado Birds.

Capetown, 376, 383.

Cape Town, 376, 383.

Celery, Wild, 141, 154, 166, 190.

Celery, Wild, 141, 154, 166, 190.

Chain Island, 58.

Chain Island, 58.

Chart-making, Remarks on, 337.

Chart-making, Comments on, 337.

Clerke, Master's Mate, 76, 390.

Clerke, Master's Mate, 76, 390.

Cockles (Tridacna), 284, 295, 306.

Cockles (Tridacna), 284, 295, 306.

Cook, Captain:
Character, xlv.
Death of, xliii.
Early life, xiii.
Survey of Newfoundland, xv.
First voyage, xxi.
Second, xxix.
Third, xxxvii.

Cook, Captain:
Character, 45.
Death of, 43.
Early life, 13.
Survey of Newfoundland, 15.
First voyage, 21.
Second, 29.
Third, 37.

Cook, Mrs., xv., xliv.

Cook, Mrs., 15, 44.

Damage to ship, 280, 281, 284, 353, 359.

Damage to ship, 280, 281, 284, 353, 359.

Danger, Ship in, 169, 192, 204, 253, 254, 262, 263, 267, 274, 278, 279, 303, 308, 328, 330.

Danger, Ship in, 169, 192, 204, 253, 254, 262, 263, 267, 274, 278, 279, 303, 308, 328, 330.

Dipping Needle, 13, 44.

Dipping Needle, 13, 44.

Dolphin, H.M.S., Voyages of, xvii.

Dolphin, H.M.S., Voyages of, 17.

Downs, Return to, 394.

Downs, Go back to, 394.

Dutch:
regulations for ships, 351.
Home Fleet, 357.
Dispute with, 362.

Dutch:
rules for ships, 351.
Home Fleet, 357.
Disagreement with, 362.

Dysentery:
Deaths from, 368, 369, 370, 371, 372.
Remarks on, 377.

Dysentery:
Deaths from, 368, 369, 370, 371, 372.
Comments on, 377.

Egg-birds, 53.

Egg-laying birds, 53.

Fleet, Indian, 386.

Fleet, Indian, 386.

Flogging, 20, 22, 64, 76, 77, 79, 107, 108, 155, 166, 167, 371.

Flogging, 20, 22, 64, 76, 77, 79, 107, 108, 155, 166, 167, 371.

Fothering the ship, 276, 277.

Fothering the ship, 276, 277.

Fuegian natives, 37.

Fuegian natives, 37.

Funchal, 6.

Funchal, 6.

Good Hope, Cape of, 375.

Cape of Good Hope, 375.

Gore, Lieutenant, 76, 120, 198, 245, 282, 285, 341.

Gore, Lieutenant, 76, 120, 198, 245, 282, 285, 341.

Green, the Astronomer, 31, 35, 68, 76, 131, 150, 305, 316, 354, 368.

Green, the Astronomer, 31, 35, 68, 76, 131, 150, 305, 316, 354, 368.

Hicks, Lieutenant, 20, 69, 76, 85, 145, 160, 240, 244, 304, 349, 350, 354, 356, 388, 389.

Hicks, Lieutenant, 20, 69, 76, 85, 145, 160, 240, 244, 304, 349, 350, 354, 356, 388, 389.

Horn, Cape, 41:
Longitude of, 45.
Passage round, 48.

Horn, Cape, 41:
Longitude of, 45.
Passage around, 48.

Huaheine:
visited, 109.
Description of, 110.

Huaheine:
visited, 109.
Description of, 110.

Islands, List of, 229.

Islands, List of, 229.

Journal, Copy of, sent home, 356, 357.

Journal, copy of, sent home, 356, 357.

Kangaroos, 280, 281, 287, 291, 294, 318.

Kangaroos, 280, 281, 287, 291, 294, 318.

King George's Island. See Tahiti.

King George Island. Visit Tahiti.

Krakatoa (Cracatoa), 349.

Krakatoa, 349.

Lagoon Island, 55.

Lagoon Island, 55.

Language of New Zealand and Tahiti identical, 131, 225.

Language of New Zealand and Tahiti is identical, 131, 225.

Le Maire Strait, 34 to 39:
Description of, 42.
Directions for, 42.

Le Maire Strait, 34 to 39:
Description of, 42.
Directions for, 42.

Lightning conductors, 354.

Lightning rods, 354.

Line, Crossing the, 13.

Line, Crossing the, 13.

Local attraction, 264.

Local attraction, 264.

Lunars, Cook's remarks on, 316.

Lunars, Cook's comments on, 316.

Lunars, xxii.

Lunars, 22.

Magra, Midshipman, 258, 278.

Magra, Midshipman, 258, 278.

Molineux, Mr., Master, 67, 107, 285, 287, 290, 298, 300, 385.

Molineux, Mr., Master, 67, 107, 285, 287, 290, 298, 300, 385.

Monkhouse, Midshipman, 277, 369.

Monkhouse, Midshipman, 277, 369.

Monkhouse, Surgeon, 59, 64, 109, 359.

Monkhouse, Surgeon, 59, 64, 109, 359.

Mories or Temples, 83, 104, 118.

Mories or Temples, 83, 104, 118.

Natal, Coast of, 373.

Natal, Coast, 373.

Natives:
See Tahiti.
See East Coast of Australia.
See New Zealand.

Natives:
Check out Tahiti.
Check out the East Coast of Australia.
Check out New Zealand.

New Guinea:
Coast of, 330, 334.
Land in, 333.
Weapons, 333.

New Guinea:
Coast of, 330, 334.
Land in, 333.
Weapons, 333.

New South Wales:
See Australia, East Coast.
Remarks on, 317.

New South Wales:
Refer to Australia, East Coast.
Comments on, 317.

NEW ZEALAND:
Account of, 214.
Admiralty Bay, 213.
Animals, 217.
Attempt to seize a boy, 137.
Banks Peninsula, 197.
Brett, Cape, 163.
Burial, 224.
Camel, Mount, 171, 176, 177.
Campbell, Cape, 194.
Canoes, 221, 222.
Cannibalism, 156, 183, 184, 221.
Chart of, Accuracy of, 215.
Clothing, 219.
Colville, Cape, 158, 161.
Cook's Strait, 181, 186, 193.
Customs of mourning, 188.
Description of, 214.
Dusky Bay, 207.
Egmont, Mount, 180.
Farewell, Cape, 211.
First landing in, 130.
Food, 222.
Hauraki Gulf, 160.
Hawkes' Bay, 137.
Hemp or flax, 217.
Hippas, or Pahs, 147, 152, 153, 156, 164, 167, 169, 186, 192.
Houses, 223.
Iron sand, 156.
Islands, Bay of, 165, 169.
Jackson, Cape, 214.
Kaipara Harbour, 177.
Kairoura Mountain, 193, 196.
Left, 213.
Massacre or Murderers (Murtherers) Bay, 183, 214.
Mercury Bay, 148, 155.
Middle Island, Description of, 210.
Musical Instruments, 224.
Native, Name of, 189, 214.
Natives, Conflicts with, 131, 135, 136, 146, 147, 148, 151, 163, 164, 165, 166, 182, 187, 221.
  Description of, 218.
  Fearlessness of, 139, 221.
  Notes on, 230.
  Three captured, 132.
  Traditions of, 191.
  Traffic with, 134, 137, 141, 143, 145, 149, 151, 159, 160, 182, 192, 195.
North, Cape, 173.
Palliser (Pallisser), Cape, 193, 195.
Pattoo Pattoas, 154.
Places recommended for settling, 218.
Plenty, Bay of, 146.
Portland Island, 134.
Poverty Bay, 130.
Produce of, 216.
Queen Charlotte's Sound, 182, 191.
Religion, 224.
Ruapuke Island, 203.
Runaway, Cape, 145.
Saunders, Cape, 201.
Sighted, 129.
South Cape, 205.
Stephens Island, 188, 212.
Stewart Island, 205.
Tegadoo Bay, 141.
Thames, Frith of, 158, 161.
Three Kings, 174.
Timber, 159, 217.
Tolaga Bay, 142.
Tools, 223.
Traps, 204.
Turnagain, Cape, 130, 195.
Weapons, 154.

NEW ZEALAND:
Account of, 214.
Admiralty Bay, 213.
Animals, 217.
Attempt to seize a boy, 137.
Banks Peninsula, 197.
Brett, Cape, 163.
Burial, 224.
Camel, Mount, 171, 176, 177.
Campbell, Cape, 194.
Canoes, 221, 222.
Cannibalism, 156, 183, 184, 221.
Chart of, Accuracy of, 215.
Clothing, 219.
Colville, Cape, 158, 161.
Cook's Strait, 181, 186, 193.
Customs of mourning, 188.
Description of, 214.
Dusky Bay, 207.
Egmont, Mount, 180.
Farewell, Cape, 211.
First landing in, 130.
Food, 222.
Hauraki Gulf, 160.
Hawkes' Bay, 137.
Hemp or flax, 217.
Hippas, or Pahs, 147, 152, 153, 156, 164, 167, 169, 186, 192.
Houses, 223.
Iron sand, 156.
Islands, Bay of, 165, 169.
Jackson, Cape, 214.
Kaipara Harbour, 177.
Kairoura Mountain, 193, 196.
Left, 213.
Massacre or Murderers (Murtherers) Bay, 183, 214.
Mercury Bay, 148, 155.
Middle Island, Description of, 210.
Musical Instruments, 224.
Native, Name of, 189, 214.
Natives, Conflicts with, 131, 135, 136, 146, 147, 148, 151, 163, 164, 165, 166, 182, 187, 221.
  Description of, 218.
  Fearlessness of, 139, 221.
  Notes on, 230.
  Three captured, 132.
  Traditions of, 191.
  Traffic with, 134, 137, 141, 143, 145, 149, 151, 159, 160, 182, 192, 195.
North, Cape, 173.
Palliser (Pallisser), Cape, 193, 195.
Pattoo Pattoas, 154.
Places recommended for settling, 218.
Plenty, Bay of, 146.
Portland Island, 134.
Poverty Bay, 130.
Produce of, 216.
Queen Charlotte's Sound, 182, 191.
Religion, 224.
Ruapuke Island, 203.
Runaway, Cape, 145.
Saunders, Cape, 201.
Sighted, 129.
South Cape, 205.
Stephens Island, 188, 212.
Stewart Island, 205.
Tegadoo Bay, 141.
Thames, Frith of, 158, 161.
Three Kings, 174.
Timber, 159, 217.
Tolaga Bay, 142.
Tools, 223.
Traps, 204.
Turnagain, Cape, 130, 195.
Weapons, 154.

Ohetiroa, 120.

Ohetiroa, 120.

Ohwarrhe Harbour, 110.

Ohwarrhe Harbor, 110.

Onrust, the Dutch dockyard, 354, 356.

Onrust, the Dutch shipyard, 354, 356.

Otaha, 112:
Excursion to, 116.
Description of, 117.

Otaha, 112:
Trip to, 116.
Overview of, 117.

Otaheite. See Tahiti.

Otaheite. Check out Tahiti.

Oree, King of Huaheine, 109, 110.

Oree, King of Huaheine, 109, 110.

Orton, Mr., 258.

Orton, Mr., 258.

Osnaburg Island, 58.

Osnaburg Island, 58.

Oysters, 153, 156, 248, 260, 266, 318.

Oysters, 153, 156, 248, 260, 266, 318.

Pacific:
Exploration of, xv.
Explorers of, xvi.

Pacific:
Exploration of, 15.
Explorers of, 16.

Parkinson, Mr., 368.

Parkinson, Mr., 368.

Paumotu Archipelago, 55 to 58.

Paumotu Archipelago, 55-58.

Pepys' Island, 33.

Pepys' Island, 33.

Perry, Mr., Surgeon's Mate, 359.

Perry, Mr., Surgical Assistant, 359.

Pintado Birds, 122.

Pintado Birds, 122.

Port Egmont Hens, 129, 200.

Port Egmont Hens, 129, 200.

Poverty Bay, Incidents at, 130.

Poverty Bay, incidents at, 130.

Princes Island, Sunda Strait, 366.

Princes Island, Sunda Strait, 366.

Quiros, 213, 226, 301.

Quiros, 213, 226, 301.

Raiatea. See Ulietea.

Raiatea. Check out Ulietea.

Rays (fish), 247, 291, 295.

Rays (fish), 247, 291, 295.

Repairs effected, 360.

Repairs completed, 360.

Rio Janeiro:
Arrival at, 18.
Viceroy of, 19 to 22.
Description of, 24.

Rio de Janeiro:
Arrival at, 18.
Viceroy of, 19 to 22.
Description of, 24.

Roggeween, 227.

Roggeween, 227.

Rotte, 340.

Rotten, 340.

Rurutu. See Ohetiroa.

Rurutu. Check out Ohetiroa.

St. Helena, 386.

St. Helena, 386.

Savu, 341 to 347.

Savu, 341–347.

Scurvy, xvi., xvii:
Conquered, xxviii., xxx., xxxvi., xlvi.
Prevention against, xxiv., 59.

Scurvy, 16, 17:
Conquered, 28, 30, 36, 46.
Prevention against, 24, 59.

Seals, 128, 203, 217.

Seals, 128, 203, 217.

Society Islands, Description of, 116.

Society Islands, Description, 116.

Solander, Dr., 65, 131, 166, 167, 184, 186, 242, 245, 288, 311, 332, 342.

Solander, Dr., 65, 131, 166, 167, 184, 186, 242, 245, 288, 311, 332, 342.

Sour krout, 59.

Sauerkraut, 59.

Southern Continent, 51, 125, 226, 228.

Southern Continent, 51, 125, 226, 228.

Stranding of ship, 169, 274 to 276, 279.

Stranding of ship, 169, 274 to 276, 279.

Success Bay, 36, 42.

Success Bay, 36, 42.

Suicide of a Marine, 54.

Marine, 54, suicide.

Sumatra Strait, 349, 366.

Sumatra Strait, 349, 366.

Swallow, H.M.S.: Safety of, 350. Voyage of, xix.

Swallow, H.M.S.: Safety of, 350. Voyage of, xix.

Table Bay, 376 to 381, 383, 384.

Table Bay, 376 to 381, 383, 384.

Tahaa. See Otaha.

Tahaa. Check out Otaha.

TAHITI:
Arreoys Society, 95.
Arrival at, 59.
Breadfruit, 84.
Canoes, 97.
Chastity, Want of, 96.
Climate, 103.
Cloth manufacture, 99.
Clothing of natives, 93.
Cooking, Method of, 79.
Dead, Disposal of, 65, 81.
Description of, 88.
Desertion at, 80, 84,
Dogs as food, 79.
Emblems of peace, 64.
Expedition round, 81.
Fort erected at, 64, 68.
Funeral ceremonies, 102.
Government, 100.
History, Notes on, 105.
Houses, 96.
Images, 83.
Leave island, 87.
Manners and Customs, 94.
Mories (Morai) or temples, 83, 101.
Music, 94.
Natives of:
  Description of, 91.
  Rules for traffic with, 60.
Oamo or Amo, Chief, 80, 83, 105, 106.
Obariea, Queen, 67, 69, 70, 72, 79, 80, 83, 85, 86, 105.
Owhaa, Chief, 60, 63, 66.
Priests, 102.
Produce of, 89.
Religion, 101.
Sexes, separation at meals, 91.
Tattooing, 93.
Thefts at, 62, 63, 68, 73, 75, 78, 82.
Toobouratomita, Chief, 62, 65, 69, 71, 73, 77, 85.
Tools, 98.
Tootaha, Regent, 62, 67, 69, 70, 71, 74, 77, 85, 106.
Traffic for provisions, 60, 87.
Tupia, Priest. See Tupia.
Weapons, 99.
Wrestling, 71.

TAHITI:
Arreoys Society, 95.
Arrival at, 59.
Breadfruit, 84.
Canoes, 97.
Chastity, Lack of, 96.
Climate, 103.
Cloth production, 99.
Natives' clothing, 93.
Cooking methods, 79.
Dead, Disposal of, 65, 81.
Description of, 88.
Desertion at, 80, 84,
Dogs as food, 79.
Symbols of peace, 64.
Expedition around, 81.
Fort built at, 64, 68.
Funeral rituals, 102.
Government, 100.
History, Notes on, 105.
Houses, 96.
Images, 83.
Leaving the island, 87.
Manners and customs, 94.
Mories (Morai) or temples, 83, 101.
Music, 94.
Natives of:
  Description of, 91.
  Rules for trade with, 60.
Oamo or Amo, Chief, 80, 83, 105, 106.
Obariea, Queen, 67, 69, 70, 72, 79, 80, 83, 85, 86, 105.
Owhaa, Chief, 60, 63, 66.
Priests, 102.
Products of, 89.
Religion, 101.
Separation of sexes at meals, 91.
Tattooing, 93.
Thefts at, 62, 63, 68, 73, 75, 78, 82.
Toobouratomita, Chief, 62, 65, 69, 71, 73, 77, 85.
Tools, 98.
Tootaha, Regent, 62, 67, 69, 70, 71, 74, 77, 85, 106.
Trade for food, 60, 87.
Tupia, Priest. See Tupia.
Weapons, 99.
Wrestling, 71.

Teneriff, Peak of, 8.

Tenerife, Peak of, 8.

Tenimber Islands, 336.

Tenimber Islands, 336.

Tern. See Eggbirds.

Tern. See Eggbirds.

Thrum Cap Island, 56.

Thrum Cap Island, 56.

Tierra del Fuego, Expedition into, 38.

Tierra del Fuego, Expedition into, 38.

Timor, 338.

Timor, 338.

Tootaha, Regent of Tahiti. See Tahiti.

Tootaha, Regent of Tahiti. See Tahiti.

Transit of:
Mercury, 150.
Venus, 76.

Transit of:
Mercury, 150.
Venus, 76.

Tropic birds, 53.

Tropic birds, 53.

Tupia:
Priest of Tahiti, 102, 105, 109, 112, 131, 132, 136, 182, 187, 242, 286, 349, 354.
Death of, 363.
Islands known to, 229.
Knowledge of, 121.
Taken on board, 87.
Usefulness of, 363.

Tupia:
Priest of Tahiti, 102, 105, 109, 112, 131, 132, 136, 182, 187, 242, 286, 349, 354.
Death of, 363.
Islands known to, 229.
Knowledge of, 121.
Taken on board, 87.
Usefulness of, 363.

Turtle, 285, 287, 288, 290, 295, 301, 352.

Turtle, 285, 287, 288, 290, 295, 301, 352.

Two Groups Island, 57.

Two Groups Island, 57.

Ulietea:
Acting and dances at, 114.
Description of, 116.
Harbour, 111.
Opoony, King of, 115.
Rautoanui Harbour, 114.

Ulietea:
Performances and dances at, 114.
Description of, 116.
Harbor, 111.
Opoony, King of, 115.
Rautoanui Harbor, 114.

Variation, Remarks on, 104.

Variation, Remarks on, 104.

Venereal Disease, 76.

Sexually Transmitted Infection, 76.

Walsche, Cape, 331.

Walsche, Cape, 331.

Warping, Machine for, 389.

Warping Machine, 389.


CHART OF NEW ZEALAND, EXPLORED IN 1769 AND 1770, BY LIEUTENANT J. COOK, COMMANDER OF HIS MAJESTY'S BARK ENDEAVOUR, ENGRAVED BY I. BAYLY.
REPRODUCTION OF THE ORIGINAL PUBLISHED CHART.

 


PRINTERS' PLATE
"REST, PRAY, SLEEP."
Elliott Stock, 62, Paternoster Row.

 



Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!